Location via proxy:   [ UP ]  
[Report a bug]   [Manage cookies]                

Ic21 CPPC 06000 0921

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 2020

Industrial Control

Product Catalog

usa.siemens.com/controls
Index Things to Know About the Catalog
Product Overview

SIRIUS Control MSPs – 3RV10, 3RV20, 3RV21 Motor Starter Protectors


3RV27, 3RV28 Circuit Breakers 1
IEC Power Control 3RA19/29 & 3RV19/29 Accessories
Contactors – 3RT, 3TF, 3TC Contactors
3RA23 Reversing Contactors, 3RA24 Wye-Delta Starters
3RH Control Relays; 3RA19/28/29 & 3RT19/29 Accessories
2
Overload Relays – 3RU Thermal Overload Relays
3RB Solid State Overload Relays
3UF SIMOCODE pro Intelligent Motor Protection
3
Starters – 3RA2 Combination Starters
3RA6 Compact Combination Starters
3RE4 Enclosed HP Rated Starters
4
Power Distribution Systems –
8US Fast Bus Busbar Power Distribution System 5
SIRIUS Hybrid Hybrid Motor Starters – 3RM1 Motor Starters
ET 200SP & ET 200pro Motor Starters 6
Solid State Control M200D Motor Starters
Soft Starters – 3RW30, 3RW40, 3RW50, 3RW52 & 3RW55 Soft Starters
Class 73 & 74 Enclosed Soft Starters
Drives – SINAMICS G120X Drives, 6SL32
7
Solid-State Relays & Contactors –
3RF20 45mm Relays; 3RF21 22.5mm Relays; 3RF22 3-Phase Relays;
3RF23 Contactors; 3RF24 & 34 3-Phase Contactors; 3RF29 Modules
8
General Purpose Control Manual Starters & Switches; NEMA Contactors & Starters;
Overload relays; Duplex Controllers; Pump Panels; DP Contactors;
Lighting Contactors; Transformers
9
SIRIUS Command & Pilot Devices – 3SB2, 3SU1, 52 Pushbuttons, Selector Switches,

SIRIUS Monitor
Pilot Lights & Stations; 8WD Signal Columns 10
Function Relays – 3RN Thermistor Motor Protection; 3RP & 7PV Timers;
Control Circuit Components
3RS Temperature Monitoring Relays & Converters; 3RQ Coupling Relays;
3UG Monitoring Relays; 3TG Power Relays; 3TX71 & LZS Plug-in Relays
11
Terminal blocks –
8WA / 8WH Terminal Blocks
8WA Special Label Marking Instructions
12
Limit Switches – 3SE5 (IEC) & 3SE03 (NEMA)
Safety – 3SE5 Hinge & Interlock, 3SE6 Magnet, and 3SE7
Cable-operated Switches; 3SK & 3TK28 Safety Relays; 3RK3 MSS
13
AS-Interface – 6GK7 Masters; 3RK Slaves, I/O Modules, & Safety
Modules; 3SF2 Cable Pull, 3SF1 Limit & Interlock Switches
IO-Link – 6ES7 Masters; 3RK Input Modules
14
Programmable Relays – LOGO! 6ED Modular Relays
Power Supplies – SITOP 6EP Power Supplies
Ethernet Switches – 6GK Unmanaged Ethernet Switches
15
Control Circuit Protection 5SJ4 Miniature Circuit Breakers to UL 489
5SP & 5SY Supplementary Protectors to UL 1077
3NW7 Fuse Holders to UL 512
16
Circuit Breakers 120/240 V Lug In/Lug Out and DIN Rail Breakers
15 to 3200A Molded Case Circuit Breakers 17
Switches Safety Switches – VBII
Enclosed Switches – VBII & 3LD2
Disconnect Switches – 3LD, CFS, CNFS, MCS & VBII
18
Appendix - General Information UL and CSA File & Guide Numbers; On-line References;
General Information; Spring-Loaded Terminal Overview;
ICE Quick Reference List
19
(Section was last modified on 01/10/22) Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog
Index

Things you should know about the 2021 Industrial Catalog


This Catalog contains all selection More information can be found on the
and order-relevant data. on-line version of this catalog at
usa.siemens.com/iccatalog

Navigation All page references are linked. Click on the For accessories, see page 2/66.
page number to navigate to that page.

Clicking on the Page Number square at the


bottom of each page will return you to the 2/34
Table of Contents for that section.

Clicking on the Catalog Reference at the


bottom of a page will return you to the Table Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog
of Contents for the Catalog.

Delivery time (DT) or Standard delivery time (SD)


Preferred type Normal quantities of the products The delivery times specified here represent the state
A 9 to 10 working days are usually delivered within the as of 10/2020. For up-to-the-minute information,
B 11 to 13 working days specified time following receipt please visit our Industry Mall website at www.usa.
C 14 to 23 working days of an order. siemens.com/industrymall
D 24 to 38 working days
In exceptional cases, the actual Note: Delivery times do not appear on all selection
X On request delivery time may differ from pages due to space constraints or coil voltage
that specified. variations.

Price units (PU) The price unit defines the number of units, sets or lengths
to which the price and weight apply.

Packaging sizes (PS) The packaging size defines the number of units, sets or length, for outer packaging.
Only the quantity defined by the packaging size or a multiple thereof can be ordered.

Symbols
On many selection pages in this catalog, Connections Combicon connection
you will find these symbols to aid in the quick
identification of critical product features. Insulation piercing method

Fast Connect

Spring-type terminals

Flat connectors

Solder pin connections

Ring terminal lug connections

Screw terminals

Types of coordination Type of coordination "1" ToC


1

Type of coordination "2" ToC


2

Distinguishing between units Complete units

Modular system

Support function Configurator available in the Industry Mall

0/2 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Index
IEC Motor Starter Protectors Section 1
 IRIUS 3RV Motor Starter Protectors (MSPs) are built for a wide range of applications
S
and meet the requirements of control users worldwide. Each MSP features a manual ON/
OFF switch, a Class 10 adjustable bimetallic overload relay (Class 20 available in the two
largest frame sizes), and magnetic trip elements for short circuit protection.

3RV20 MSPs can be used in a variety of applications:


* Manual Motor Starter
* Manual Self-Protected Combination Motor Controller, Type E
* Combination Motor Controller Type F when combined with a 3RT contactor
* IEC Circuit Breaker for export applications
3RV21 MSPs with overload relay function (automatic RESET)
3RV27 are UL listed as a Circuit Breaker for branch circuit protection of both motor
and non-motor loads
3RV28 is UL listed as a Circuit Breaker for transformer protection
3RV29 is an infeed system for quick installation of MSP and contactor assemblies

IEC Contactors Section 2


 igh contact reliability, a narrow design, long life time, and the ability to operate under
H
extreme conditions (up to 60° C), ensure that SIRIUS 3RT Contactors are suited for
almost any application. A large array of easily installed, standard accessories may be
used to customize the contactors for different applications.

3RT*0 – 3 Pole Standard


3RT12 – 3 Pole Vacuum
3RT*3 – 4 Pole with 4 normally open poles for switching Resistive loads (AC-1)
3RT*4 – 3 Pole for switching Resistive loads (AC-1)
3RT25 – 4 Pole with 2 normally open & 2 normally closed poles
3RT26 – 3 Pole for switching capacitors
3RA*9 – Contactor Accessories
3RA23 – Reversing contactor assemblies
3RH2 – Coupling Relays
3TC – 2 Pole for switching DC loads
3TF6 – 3 Pole Vacuum, 630 & 700A

IEC Overload Relays Section 3


 omplete motor protection can be achieved through the SIRIUS family of
C
overload relays (OLR’s).

3RU21 – Thermal OLR’s, up to 100 A, are ambient compensated bimetallic in


Trip Class 10
3RB30 / 20 – Solid State OLR’s, up to 630 A, with an internal power supply and
4:1 FLA adjustment range in Trip Class 10 or 20
3RB31 / 21 – Features of the 3RB30 / 20 plus adjustable Trip Class 5 to 30,
ground fault detection, and remote reset
3RB22 / 23 – Features of the 3RB31 / 21 plus status LED’s and external power supply
3RB24 – Features of the 3RB23 plus communication via IO-Link
3UF7 – SIMOCODE pro intelligent motor protection is more than just a programmable
overload relay. By linking the motor and automated control circuits, SIMOCODE
allows for predictive and conditional maintenance on critical systems.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 0/3


Index
Section 4 IEC Starters
The SIRIUS 3RA1/2 Combination Starters consist of a pre-wired and
mechanically connected 3RV MSP and 3RT contactor, allowing for quick
installation of a complete branch circuit. The Non-Reversing or Reversing
assemblies come on a Fast Bus mounting shoe or as a Panel Mount version.

The SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters provide the functionality of an MSP,


Contactor and Electronic Overload Relay in one easy to install housing,
saving wiring and installation time. The SIRIUS 3RA6 Infeed system further
saves line side wiring in multiple motor panels.

The 3RE4 enclosed IEC family includes contactors and starters in NEMA 1,
3/3R/4/12 or 4X enclosures.

3RA2 – Combination Starters


3RA6 – Compact Non-Reversing & Reversing Combination Starters
3RE4 – Enclosed HP Rated Starters & Contactors

Section 5 Fast Bus Power Distribution System


The UL508A Fast Bus Multi-Motor Control System is a 3 phase insulated
busbar system used to reduce wire connections and hole drilling when
building control panels. Quickly mount Sirius 3RA combination starters
and/or Siemens circuit breaker assemblies.

The Siemens Fast Bus system uses standard off-the-shelf components,


with both domestic and international approvals, to allow for economical
installation, compact panel designs, touch safe equipment, that allow for
easy expansion and maintenance.

FB – Installation kits for quick ordering & installation


FBCB – Circuit breakers pre-assembled on Fast Bus adapter shoes
3RA – Combination starters for Fast Bus mounting (see section 4)
8US – Fast Bus components for Field assembly

Section 6 Hybrid Motor Starters


Hybrid technology provides reduced size, lower heat losses and longer
service life in motor starter applications by combining relay contacts, power
semiconductors and a solid-state overload relay.

The SIRIUS 3RM motor starters are compact, 22.5mm wide devices for
mounting in the control cabinet. The failsafe versions eliminate the need for
redundant controllers in safety applications. The ET 200SP motor starters
are an integral part of the ET 200SP I/O system and mount directly to the
rack.

The ET 200pro and SIRIUS M200D are enclosed controllers that connect to a
variety of communication protocols.

3RM – Non-reversing starters


3RK1308 – ET 200SP motor starters
3RK1304 – ET 200pro enclosed motor starters
3RK13*5 – SIRIUS M200D enclosed motor starters

0/4 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Index
Solid State Soft Starters & Variable Frequency Drives Section 7
SIRIUS Soft Starters and SINAMICS Drives are designed to ramp up your efficiency
at every turn. Easy to specify, integrate, operate, and maintain, our controls fulfill
your need for more thoughtful system-wide solutions.

3RW30 – Basic performance Soft Starters up to 75HP with built-in bypass contacts.
3RW40 – Basic performance Soft Starters up to 75HP with overload protection
and device self protection
3RW50 – Basic performance Soft Starters from 100 to 400 HP with soft torque
and communication options
3RW52 – General performance Soft starters from 100 to 400 HP with options
for plug-in HMI and communication modules
3RW55 – High performance Soft starters from 7.5 to 1000 HP with HMI,
autoparameterization and plug-in communication modules
Class 73 – Non-Combination Enclosed Soft Starters
Class 74 – Combination Enclosed Soft Starters with circuit breaker or fusible
disconnect
6SL32 – SINAMICS G120X Variable Frequency Drives

Solid State Switching Devices Section 8


Designed for high operating switching frequency the Sirius Solid State Relays and
Contactors feature a long lifespan of rugged reliability in adverse conditions, quiet
operation, compact size, and snap on function modules for convenient flexible use.

3RF20 – 1-Phase Relays in a 45mm wide “hockey-puck” design


3RF21 – 1-Phase Relays in a 22.5mm narrow width design
3RF22 – 3-Phase Relays in a 45mm wide design
3RF23 – 1-Phase Contactors, a 22.5mm wide relay mounted to a heat sink
3RF24 – 3-Phase Contactors, a 45mm wide relay mounted to a heat sink
3RF29 – Function Modules, such as, converters, load monitors and power
controllers
3RF34 – 3-Phase non-reversing and reversing Contactors for switching

General Purpose Control Section 9


Siemens NEMA controls are built rugged to withstand the most severe and
demanding industrial and continuous duty commercial applications. Siemens offers
the most complete and diverse product line in the world of NEMA. This includes
standard full NEMA sizes and motor matched half sizes exclusive to Siemens.
All are available as open or enclosed devices with a wide selection of accessories
and spare parts.

Manual Starters & Switches


Non-Reversing & Reversing Starters & Contactors
Combination Starters
Duplex and Multi-Speed
Pump Controllers
Solid State Overload Relays
Current Sensitive Relays
Definite Purpose Contactors
Lighting Contactors
Control Power Transformers

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 0/5


Index
Section 10 Pilot Devices
Siemens offers an extensive array of Pilot Devices and Signal Columns for a wide
variety of applications.

3SB2 – 16mm SIRIUS Pilot Devices for applications where panel space is a
premium
3SU1 – 22mm SIRIUS ACT Pilot Devices offer maximum flexibility, industry best
time install savings and environmental ratings in round-metal and round-plastic
versions
Class 52 – 30mm is the classic pushbutton design for the NEMA markets offering
both standard die cast metal and the ultra rugged BLACK MAX for corrosion
resistant applications
8WD – Signal Columns offer twist and connect technology in both 50mm and
70mm diameter styles. Single element signal beacons add additional options for
OEMs and panel builders

Section 11 Function Relays


The SIRIUS family of compact, DIN rail mountable function relays offers complete
solutions for monitoring, switching, interfacing and timing applications.

3RN – Thermistor Motor Protection


3RP / 7PV – Solid State Timing with single or multiple timing functions
3RS1 / 2 – Temperature Monitoring in solid, liquid and gaseous media
3RQ – Coupling Relays and Interfaces
3RS18 – Relay Interfaces
3RS70 – Interface Converters
3TG10 – Compact Power Relays/Contactors
3TX71 & LZS – Plug-in Relays & Timers
3UG4 – Line Monitoring of voltage and insulation or load monitoring of Current &
Cos Phi, Level Monitoring of conductive liquids, and under speed monitoring

Section 12 Terminal Blocks


For the wiring of machines and control systems, Siemens Terminal Blocks meet
or exceed the requirements of CSA, IEC, NEMA, UL, VDE and other international
standards. Meeting these requirements, combined with worldwide acceptability
and availability, enables Siemens Terminal Blocks to be used domestically, as well
as, in equipment which will be exported.

8WA1 / 8WH1 – Terminals with Screw Connection


8WH2 – Terminals with Spring-Loaded Connection
8WH3 – Terminals with Insulation Displacement Connection
8WH5 – Terminals with Combination Plug-in Connection
8WH6 – Terminals with iPo Plug-in and Installation Connections

Section 12 contains the ‘Table of Contents’ of the Terminal Block Supplemental


Catalog, Order No. PDCA-TERMB-1013; Labeling Plates for Ink Plotter System.

0/6 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Index
Safety Systems Section 13
Siemens Switches and Machine Safety devices provide the means for protecting
workers and equipment where hazardous conditions exist. Compliance with
NEMA, OSHA and international standards (IEC) are a critical requirement for
machine OEMs and end users. Siemens has provided safety relay and contactor
products to the international community for almost 50 years.

3SB38 – Two-Hand Control Stations


3SE03 – North American (NEMA) Limit Switches
3SE5 – International (IEC) Limit Switches
3SE5 / 3SE2 – Interlock Switches & Hinge Switches
3SE6 – RFID Non-Contact Safety Switches & Magnetic Monitoring Systems
3SE7 – Cable-Operated Switches
3SK – Modular Safety Relays
3TK28 – Safety Relays with special functions.
3RK3 – Modular Safety System (MSS)

AS-Interface & IO-Link Systems Section 14


Actuator-Sensor Interface is the simple and effective networking system for
the field level. It is extremely rugged even under the toughest of conditions. With
compatible safety components, AS-Interface offers safety applications according
to Safety Category 4. AS-Interface is easily linked to higher-level networks for a
complete automation solution — simple, safe and fast in the field.

IO-Link is an open communication standard based on point-to-point connection


between a Master and up to 4 devices. For an OEM wiring multiple motor
starters, IO-Link technology can greatly reduce control cabinet wiring for motor
starters while increasing diagnostics. For End Users, IO-Link provides a cost
effective way in to monitor common analog values such as motor current, power
consumption, temperature and voltage without adding an additional network.

Programmable Relays & Power Supplies Section 15


The LOGO! Programmable Relay is a compact, easy to use and low cost solution
for simple control tasks. Functions can be changed at the touch of a button
through the integrated operator panel or remote display.

SITOP offers a broad offering of compact single- and 3-phase switched mode
power supplies and 24VDC power security components, which provide reliable
solutions for the most common power interruptions, helping to minimize
downtimes and increase the efficiency of production.

SCALENCE Managed and Unmanaged Industrial Ethernet Switches with up to


eight RJ45 ports.

6ED1 – LOGO! Programmable Relays


6EP1 – SITOP Power Supplies and Power Security Components
6GK5 – SCALENCE Industrial Ethernet Switches

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 0/7


Index
Section 16 Control Circuit Protection
Siemens UL 489 miniature circuit breakers and accessories are designed to
provide branch circuit and feeder protection.

Siemens UL 1077 Supplementary Protectors are designed to provide additional


protection where branch circuit protection is already provided or, not required at
all. Since Siemens Supplementary protectors are made to trip faster than other
components, they are able to provide additional protection for more sensitive
devices inside a panel.

5SJ4 – Miniature Circuit Breakers up to 480Y / 277 VAC, 63A


5SY – High feature Supplementary Protectors from 0.3 to 63A
5SP – High amperage Supplementary Protectors from 80 to 125A
3NW7 – Cylindrical Fuse Holders meeting UL 512 and IEC 60269-1, -2, -3

Section 17 Circuit Breakers


Siemens offers a full line of interchangeable and non-interchangeable thermal-
magnetic trip circuit breakers with a wide variety of interrupting ratings from
10KAIC to 200KAIC. These circuit breakers are available with multi-functional
internal accessories, which are field installable on most breakers, and a full line of
external accessories. Electronic trip circuit breakers are available for 150A through
1600A breakers.

Molded Case Circuit Breakers


3VA – 600VAC Breakers
BQ and QR – 240VAC Breakers
CQD – 480VAC Breakers
GG, Sentron, and VL – 600VAC Breakers

Section 18 Switches
Siemens offers a complete line of both enclosed and open style switches to meet
a wide range of applications.

HF & HNF – Heavy Duty Safety Switches with Side Mounted Operating Handle
3LD2 – UL508 Open & Enclosed Rotary Switches (16-250A)
3LD3 – UL508 Compact Open Rotary Switches (16-63A)
3LD5 – UL489 Compact Open Rotary Switches (30-150A)
VBF & VBNF – Open Switches with Flange Mounted Operating Handle
MCS – Open Switches with Flange or Rotary Operating Handle
CFS – Open Compact Fusible Switches with Rotary Operating Handle
CNFS – Open Compact Non-fusible Switches with Rotary Operating Handle

0/8 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Motor Starter Protectors
Industrial Control Product Catalog 2021

contents
1 SIRIUS

Section

1
Section Overview 1/2 – 1/3

PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
Motor Starter Protectors
3RV20 MSP, Class 10/20 1/4 – 1/5
3RV21 MSP, Class 10 1/6 – 1/7
3RV10 MSP, Class 10 1/8
Circuit Breakers
3RV27, 3RV28 Circuit Breaker UL 489 1/9
Accessories
Auxiliary Switches 1/10
Auxiliary Releases 1/10
Busbars 1/11
Mounting Accessories 1/12 – 1/15
Rotary Operating Mechanisms 1/16 – 1/17
3RV29 Infeed System 1/18 – 1/21
General Data for Motor Starter Protectors
Manual Motor Starter Ratings 1/22
Group Installation Ratings 1/23
Combination Motor Controller Ratings 1/24
3RV27 and 3RV28 Circuit Breaker Ratings 1/25
Export Application Ratings 1/26 – 1/27
Rules for Mounting 1/28
Technical Data 1/29 – 1/32
Overview of MSP Functions & Applications 1/33
Application as a Combination Motor Controller 1/34
Application in DC Switching 1/35
Design 1/35
Characteristics 1/36
Circuit Diagrams 1/36
Dimensions 1/37 – 1/40
General Data for Accessories
Mountable Accessories
Overview 1/41 – 1/42
Circuit Diagrams 1/43 – 1/41
Dimensions 1/44
Busbar Accessories
Overview 1/45
Dimensions 1/46 – 1/47
Operating Mechanisms
Overview 1/48
Circuit Diagrams 1/49
Dimensions 1/49 – 1/50
Enclosures & Front Plates
Overview 1/51
Dimensions 1/52
Spring Terminal Infeed System
Design 1/53
Technical Data 1/53
Dimensions 1/54

(Section was last modified on 08/19/21) Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/1
IEC Power Control SIRIUS
Motor Starter Protectors

contents
1

SIRIUS 3RV motor starter protectors up to 100 A


MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS

Size S00, S0

For motor protection For motor protection General data for SIRIUS
CLASS 10 CLASS 20 motor starter protectors
Selection and ordering data Selection and ordering data Page
Size Rated Current Page Size Rated Current Page Technical data 1/22
S00 up to 16 A 1/4 S2 up to 65 A 1/5 Overview 1/32
S0 up to 40 A 1/4 S3 up to 100 A 1/5 Characteristics 1/36
S2 up to 65 A 1/5 Circuit diagrams 1/36
S3 up to 100 A 1/5 Dimension drawings 1/37

Circuit Breakers SIRIUS 3RV29 3RV MSP auxiliaries


3RV27, 3RV28 infeed system and accessories

Page Page Page


Selection and ordering data 1/9 Selection and ordering data 1/20-1/21 Selection and ordering data 1/10-1/11

Dimension drawings 1/40 Technical data 1/53 Technical data 1/31


Overview 1/14-1/19 Overview 1/41
Dimension drawings 1/54 Circuit diagrams 1/43
Dimension drawings 1/44

1/2 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
IEC Power Control SIRIUS
Accessories

contents

1
Accessories for motor starter
3RV busbar and

PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
protectors with Spring-Type Mounting Accessories
accessories
terminals

Page Page Page


Selection and ordering data 1/11 Selection and ordering data 1/10 Selection and ordering data 1/12 -1/15

Overview 1/45 Technical data 1/32 Overview 1/42


Technical data 1/46 Technical data 1/44

Rotary operating mechanisms Enclosures and front plates

Page Page
Selection and ordering data 1/17 Selection and ordering data 1/17

Technical data 1/32 Overview 1/51


Overview 1/48 Dimension drawings 1/52
Circuit diagrams 1/49
Dimension drawings 1/49

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/3
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
For Motor Protection
3RV20 Class 10 — up to 40A

Description Ordering Information


1

The 3RV20x MSPs are UL approved as Self Protected Combination Motor Controllers E ON/OFF rotary handle with lockout and
MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS

which are also called Type E. In this application, all the required functions for a motor visible trip indication.
branch are provided in one device: disconnect, short circuit protection, motor control and E Adjustment dial for setting to motor FLA.
overload protection. A type E terminal adaptor is required for screw terminal versions. E Class 10 overload trip characteristics.
3RV20x MSPs with spring terminal can only be applied as Type E when used in the E Short circuit trip at 13 times the maximum
3RV29 Infeed System. . The 3RV20x MSPs are also approved for use as follows: setting of the FLA adjustment dial.
– Manual Motor Controller: Motor starter, motor disconnect, control and overload— E Short circuit current rating:
protection. E Ambient compensated up to 140° F
– Group Installation: Motor starter only, motor disconnect, control and overload (applies to side by side mounting).
protection. E Phase loss sensitivity.
– Tap conductor Protection in Group Installation acc. NEC: Motor starter only; E Test trip function.
motor disconnect, control and overload protection. E Terminal versions: screw, spring, ring lug.
When the 3RV20x is used with one of the 3 above mentioned approvals, the 3RV20x can E Auxiliaries and Accessories
be installed downstream of one circuit breaker or fuse set. see pages 1/10–1/21.
E General Information see pages 1/33–1/36.
For more detailed application information and rules how to apply, size and rate the E Technical Data see pages 1/22–1/32.
3RV20x in control panels in general, in group installations or in accordance to interna- E Dimensions see page 1/37–1/40.
tional IEC standards visit our website: www.usa.siemens.com/controlpaneldesign

Note: Select MSP by motor Full Load Amperes. Horsepower ratings are for reference only.
Instant- UL short-
aneous circuit
Single-Phase Three-Phase
1) short breaking
HP Ratings HP Ratings
FLA circuit capacity Size S00 2) 4) Size S0 2) 4)
Adjustment release @ 277V/
Illustration Range [A] 115V 230V 200V 230V 460V 575V [A] 480V [kA] Order Number Order Number
0.11-0.16 — — — — — — 2.1 65 3RV2011-0AA●● 3RV2021-0AA●●
0.14-0.2 — — — — — — 2.6 65 3RV2011-0BA●● 3RV2021-0BA●●
0.18-0.25 — — — — — — 3.3 65 3RV2011-0CA●● 3RV2021-0CA●●
0.22-0.32 — — — — — — 4.2 65 3RV2011-0DA●● 3RV2021-0DA●●
0.28-0.4 — — — — — — 5.2 65 3RV2011-0EA●● 3RV2021-0EA●●
0.35-0.5 — — — — — — 6.5 65 3RV2011-0FA●● 3RV2021-0FA●●
0.45-0.63 — — — — — — 8.2 65 3RV2011-0GA●● 3RV2021-0GA●●
0.55-0.8 — — — — — — 10 65 3RV2011-0HA●● 3RV2021-0HA●●
0.7-1 — — — — — ½ 13 65 3RV2011-0JA●● 3RV2021-0JA●●
0.9-1.25 — — — — ½ ½ 16 65 3RV2011-0KA●● 3RV2021-0KA●●
1.1-1.6 — 1⁄10 — — ¾ ¾ 21 65 3RV2011-1AA●● 3RV2021-1AA●●
1.4-2 — 1⁄8 — — ¾ 1 26 65 3RV2011-1BA●● 3RV2021-1BA●●
1.8-2.5 — 1⁄6 ½ ½ 1 1½ 33 65 3RV2011-1CA●● 3RV2021-1CA●●
2.2-3.2 1⁄10 ¼ ½ ¾ 1½ 2 42 65 3RV2011-1DA●● 3RV2021-1DA●●
2.8-4 1⁄8 1⁄3 ¾ ¾ 2 3 52 65 3RV2011-1EA●● 3RV2021-1EA●●
3.5-5 1⁄6 ½ 1 1 3 3 65 65 3RV2011-1FA●● 3RV2021-1FA●●
4.5-6.3 ¼ ½ 1 1½ 3 5 82 65 3RV2011-1GA●● 3RV2021-1GA●●
5.5-8 1⁄3 1 2 2 5 5 104 65 3RV2011-1HA●● 3RV2021-1HA●●
7-10 ½ 1½ 2 3 5 7½ 130 65 3RV2011-1JA●● 3RV2021-1JA●●
9-12.5 ½ 2 3 3 7½ 10 163 65 3RV2011-1KA●● 3RV2021-1KA●●
10-16 1 2 3 5 10 — 208 65 3RV2011-4AA●● 3RV2021-4AA●●
13-20 1½ 3 5 5 10 — 260 65 — 3RV2021-4BA●●
16-22 1½ 3 5 7½ 15 — 286 65 — 3RV2021-4CA●●
18-25 2 3 5 7½ 15 — 325 65 — 3RV2021-4DA●●
23-28 2 5 7½ 10 20 — 364 50 — 3RV2021-4NA●●
27-32 2 5 7½ 10 20 — 400 50 — 3RV2021-4EA●●
3) 5)
30-36 3 5 10 10 25 — 432 12 — 3RV2021-4PA●●
3) 5)
34-40 3 7½ 10 10 30 — 480 12 — 3RV2021-4FA●●
Screw terminals, no auxiliary: ●● = 10
Screw Terminals, with 1NO/1NC Aux:●● = 15
Spring terminals, no auxiliary: ●● = 20
Spring Terminals, with 1NO/1NC Aux: ●● = 25
Ring Lug Terminals, no Auxiliary: ●● = 40

1) Select motor starter protector by motor full load amps. tion motor controller, a Type E terminal is required. 4) 3RV2 MSPs can only be used with Innovations
Horsepower ratings for reference only. See accessories page 1/10. contactors and accessories
2) The motor starter protectors rated up to 32 A can be 3) These products are NOT certified as Type E combi- 5) Spring and Ring Lug terminals are not available
used as manual motor controllers or as Type E combi- nation motor controllers. They can only be used as
nation motor controllers. For use as a Type E combina- manual motor controllers.

1/4 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
For Motor Protection
3RV10 Class 10 & 20 — up to 100A

Description Ordering Information

1
The 3RV203 / 204 MSPs are UL approved as Self Protected Combination Motor Controllers E ON/OFF rotary handle with lockout and

PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
which are also called Type E. In this application, all the required functions for a motor branch visible trip indication.
are provided in one device: disconnect, short circuit protection, motor control and overload E Adjustment dial for setting to motor FLA.

protection. A type E terminal adaptor is required for all screw terminal version S2 frame E Class 10 overload trip characteristics.

3RV2031 above 45A and all S2 frame 3RV2032 as well as for all S3 frame motor starter E Short circuit trip at 13 times the maximum

protectors. Spring terminal MSPs can only be applied as Type E when used in the 3RV29 setting of the FLA adjustment dial.
Infeed System. E Short circuit current rating:
E Ambient compensated up to 140° F
The 3RV203 / 204 MSPs are also approved for use as follows:
(applies to side by side mounting).
– Manual Motor Controller: Motor starter, motor disconnect, control and overload protection.
E Phase loss sensitivity.
– Group Installation: Motor starter only, motor disconnect, control and overload protection.
E Test trip function.
– Tap conductor Protection in Group Installation acc. NEC: Motor starter only; motor
E Auxiliaries and Accessories see
disconnect, control and overload protection.
pages 1/10–1/21.
When the 3RV203 / 204 is used with one of the 3 above mentioned approvals, they can be E General Information see pages 1/33–1/36.
installed downstream of one circuit breaker or fuse set. E Technical Data see pages 1/22–1/32.
E Dimensions see page 1/37–1/40.
For more detailed application information and rules how to apply, size and rate these MSPs in
control panels in general, in group installations or in accordance to international IEC standards
visit our website: www.usa.siemens.com/controlpaneldesign

Note: Select MSP by motor Full Load Amperes. Horsepower ratings are for reference only.
Single Phase 3 Phase UL short-
1) 1)
HP rating HP Rating Inst. circuit
FLA Short- breaking
Adjustment Circuit capacity Trip Class 10 Trip Class 20
Range Release @ 277V/
Illustration [A] 115V 240V 200V 230V 460V 575V [A] 480V [kA] 6) Order Number4) Order Number4)

3RV203 Frame Size S2


9.5 - 14 1.5 3 5 5 10 15 208 65 3RV2031-4SA10 3RV2031-4SB10
12 - 17 1.5 3 5 7.5 15 15 260 65 3RV2031-4TA10 3RV2031-4TB10
14 - 20 1.5 3 7.5 7.5 15 20 260 65 3RV2031-4BA10 3RV2031-4BB10
18 - 25 2 5 7.5 10 20 25 325 65 3RV2031-4DA10 3RV2031-4DB10
22 - 32 3 5 10 10 25 30 416 65 3RV2031-4EA10 3RV2031-4EB10
28 - 36 3 7.5 15 15 30 40 520 65 3RV2031-4PA10 3RV2031-4PB10
32 - 40 3 7.5 15 15 30 40 585 65 3RV2031-4UA10 3RV2031-4UB10
35 - 45 3 10 15 15 40 50 650 65 3RV2031-4VA10 3RV2031-4VB10
42 - 52 5 10 15 20 40 50 741 65 3RV2031-4WA10 3RV2031-4WB10
49 - 59 5 15 20 25 50 60 845 30 3RV2031-4XA10 3RV2031-4XB10
54 - 65 5 15 20 25 50 60 845 30 3RV2031-4JA10 3RV2031-4JB10
62 - 73 7.5 15 25 30 60 75 949 30 3RV2031-4KA10 3RV2031-4KB10
7)
70 - 80 7.5 15 25 30 60 75 1040 30 3RV2032-4RA10 3RV2032-4RB10

3RV204 Frame Size S3


28 - 40 3 7.5 15 15 30 40 520A 65 3RV2041-4FA10 3RV2042-4FB10
36 - 50 5 10 15 20 40 50 650A 65 3RV2041-4HA10 3RV2042-4HB10
45 - 63 5 15 20 25 50 60 819A 65 3RV2041-4JA10 3RV2042-4JB10
57 - 75 7.5 15 25 25 60 75 975A 65 3RV2041-4KA10 3RV2042-4KB10
65 - 84 7.5 15 25 30 60 75 1170A 65 3RV2041-4RA10 3RV2042-4RB10
3)
75 - 93 7.5 20 30 40 75 100 1300A 65 3RV2041-4YA10 3RV2042-4YB10
3)
80 - 100 10 25 40 40 75 100 1300A 65 3RV2041-4MA10 3RV2042-4MB10

1) Select motor starter protector by motor full load amps. 3) Shaded ratings apply for group installation only. These ratings 6) For 100kA SCCR rated MSPs, change the part
Horsepower ratings for reference only. do not apply as UL listed manual combination starters. number from 3RV2031 to 3RV2032. (applies to
2) Size S2 and S3 are listed as type E combination motor 4) Pre-assembled motor starter protector and transverse S2 frame only through 65A).
controllers. For required Type E terminals see page 1/13. auxiliary switch with 1NO + 1NC is available. Replace the last 7) Suitable for use with IE3/IE4 motors up to a
3RV2031 MSPs with a current setting limit of 45A or less digit of the order no. with a “5”. starting current of 720A. For higher starting
do not require a type E terminal and fulfill the spacing 5) 3RV1 MSPs can only be used with 3RT1 contactors currents use size S3.
requirements of UL508. and accessories. 3RV2 MSPs can only be used with 3RT2
contactors and accessories.

Refer to pages 1/22 to 1/24 when using an MSP in a Manual Motor Starter or a Manual Self-Protected Combination Motor Controller.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/5
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
3RV2 Motor Starter Protectors/Circuit Breakers
3RV21 Class 10 — up to 32A with overload relay function (automatic RESET) IE3/IE4 ready

Description Ordering Information


1

The 3RV21x MSPs are UL approved as Self Protected Combination Motor Controllers which E ON/OFF rotary handle with lockout and
MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS

are also called Type E. In this application, all the required functions for a motor branch are visible trip indication.
provided in one device: disconnect, short circuit protection, motor control and overload protec- E Adjustment dial for setting to motor FLA.
tion. A type E terminal adaptor is required for screw terminal versions. 3RV20x MSPs with E Class 10 overload trip characteristics.
spring terminal can only be applied as Type E when used in the 3RV29 Infeed System. The E Short circuit trip at 13 times the maximum
3RV21x MSPs are also approved for use as follows: setting of the FLA adjustment dial.
– Manual Motor Controller: Motor starter, motor disconnect, control and overload E Short circuit current rating:
protection. E Ambient compensated up to 140° F
– Group Installation: Motor starter only, motor disconnect, control and overload protection. (applies to side by side mounting).
– Tap conductor Protection in Group Installation acc. NEC: Motor starter only; E Phase loss sensitivity.
motor disconnect, control and overload protection. E Test trip function.
When the 3RV21x is used with one of the 3 above mentioned approvals, the 3RV21x E Terminal versions: screw only.
can be installed downstream of one circuit breaker or fuse set. E Auxiliaries and Accessories see
pages 1/10–1/21.
For more detailed application information and rules how to apply, size and rate the 3RV21x E General Information see pages 1/33–1/36.
in control panels in general, in group installations or in accordance to international IEC stan- E Technical Data see pages 1/22–1/32.
dards visit our website: www.usa.siemens.com/controlpaneldesign E Dimensions see page 1/37–1/40.

Note: Select MSP by motor Full Load Amperes. Horsepower ratings are for reference only.

Single-Phase Three-Phase
Setting range 1) UL short-
HP Ratings HP Ratings
for thermal Instantaneous circuit break-
overload electronic ing capacity
Illustration release 115V 230V 200V 230V 460V 575V release [A] @ 480V [kA] Catalog Number
2) 3)
Size S00
0.11 ... 0.16 — — — — — — 2.1 100 3RV2111-0AA10
0.14 ... 0.2 — — — — — — 2.6 100 3RV2111-0BA10
0.18 ... 0.25 — — — — — — 3.3 100 3RV2111-0CA10
0.22 ... 0.32 — — — — — — 4.2 100 3RV2111-0DA10
0.28 ... 0.4 — — — — — — 5.2 100 3RV2111-0EA10
0.35 ... 0.5 — — — — — — 6.5 100 3RV2111-0FA10
0.45 ... 0.63 — — — — — — 8.2 100 3RV2111-0GA10
0.55 ... 0.8 — — — — — — 10 100 3RV2111-0HA10
0.7 ... 1 — — — — — ½ 13 100 3RV2111-0JA10
0.9 ... 1.25 — — — — ½ ½ 16 100 3RV2111-0KA10
1.1 ... 1.6 — 1⁄10 — — ¾ ¾ 21 100 3RV2111-1AA10
1.4 ... 2 — 1⁄8 — — ¾ 1 26 100 3RV2111-1BA10
3RV2111-4FA10 1.8 ... 3RV2111-0BA10
2.5 — 1⁄6 ½ ½ 1 1½ 33 100 3RV2111-1CA10
2.2 ... 3.2 1⁄10 ¼ ½ ¾ 1½ 2 42 100 3RV2111-1DA10
2.8 ... 4 1⁄8 1⁄3 ¾ ¾ 2 3 52 100 3RV2111-1EA10
3.5 ... 5 1⁄6 ½ 1 1 3 3 65 100 3RV2111-1FA10
4.5 ... 6.3 ¼ ½ 1 1½ 3 5 82 100 3RV2111-1GA10
5.5 ... 8 1⁄3 1 2 2 5 5 104 100 3RV2111-1HA10
7 ... 10 ½ 1½ 2 3 5 7½ 130 100 3RV2111-1JA10
9 ... 12.5 ½ 2 3 3 7½ 10 163 100 3RV2111-1KA10
105) ... 16 1 2 3 5 10 — 208 55 3RV2111-4AA10
Size S02) 3)
A10 3RV2111-0BA10 105) ... 16 1½ 3 5 5 10 — 208 55 3RV2121-4AA10
135) ... 20 1½ 3 5 7½ 15 — 260 55 3RV2121-4BA10
165) ... 22 2 3 5 7½ 15 — 286 55 3RV2121-4CA10
185) ... 25 2 5 7½ 10 20 — 325 55 3RV2121-4DA10
23 ... 284) 3 5 10 10 25 — 364 55 3RV2121-4NA10
27 ... 324) 5) 6) 3 7½ 10 10 30 — 400 55 3RV2121-4EA10

1) Select motor starter protector by motor full load amps. combination motor controller, a Type E terminal is 6) Suitable for use with IE3/IE4 motors up to a starting
Horsepower ratings are for reference only. required. See accessories page 1/10. current of 256 A. For higher starting currents we
2) Accessories for mounting on the right and 3RV2915 4) These products are NOT certified as Type E combination recommend using 3RV2 motor starter protectors size S2.
three-phase busbars cannot be used. Accessories can motor controllers. They can only be used as manual 7) 3RV2 MSPs can only be used with Innovations
be ordered separately. motor controllers. contactors and accessories.
3) The motor starter protectors rated up to 32 A can 5) The setting range of the thermal overload releases has
be used as manual motor controllers or as Type E been extended.
combination motor controllers. For use as a Type E

1/6 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
3RV2 Motor Starter Protectors/Circuit Breakers
3RV21 Class 10 — up to 100A with overload relay function (automatic RESET)

Description Ordering Information

1
The 3RV2131/2142 MSPs are UL approved as Self Protected Combination Motor Controllers E ON/OFF rotary handle with lockout and

PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
which are also called Type E. In this application, all the required functions for a motor visible trip indication.
branch are provided in one device: disconnect, short circuit protection, motor control and E Adjustment dial for setting to motor FLA.
overload protection. A type E terminal adaptor is required for all screw terminal version E Class 10 overload trip characteristics.
S2 frame 3RV2131 above 45A as well as for all S3 frame motor starter protectors. Spring E Short circuit trip at 13 times the maximum
terminal MSPs can only be applied as Type E when used in the 3RV29 Infeed System.
setting of the FLA adjustment dial.
The 3RV2131/2142 MSPs are also approved for use as follows: E Short circuit current rating:
– Manual Motor Controller: Motor starter, motor disconnect, control and overload E Ambient compensated up to 140° F
protection. (applies to side by side mounting).
– Group Installation: Motor starter only, motor disconnect, control and overload protection. E Phase loss sensitivity.
– Tap conductor Protection in Group Installation acc. NEC: Motor starter only; motor E Test trip function.
disconnect, control and overload protection.
E Terminal versions: screw only.
When the 3RV2131/2142 is used with one of the 3 above mentioned approvals, they can be E Auxiliaries and Accessories
installed downstream of one circuit breaker or fuse set. see pages 1/10–1/21.
For more detailed application information and rules how to apply, size and rate these E General Information see pages 1/33–1/36.
MSPs in control panels in general, in group installations or in accordance to international E Technical Data see pages 1/22–1/32.
IEC standards visit our website: www.usa.siemens.com/controlpaneldesign E Dimensions see page 1/37–1/40.

Note: Select MSP by motor Full Load Amperes. Horsepower ratings are for reference only.

Single-Phase Three-Phase
Setting range 1) UL short-
HP Ratings HP Ratings
for thermal Instantaneous circuit break-
overload electronic ing capacity
Illustration release 115V 230V 200V 230V 460V 575V release [A] @ 480V [kA] Catalog Number
2)
Size S2
9.5 ... 14 1.5 3 5 5 10 15 208 65 3RV2131-4SA10
12 ... 17 1.5 3 5 7.5 15 15 260 65 3RV2131-4TA10
14 ... 20 1.5 3 7.5 7.5 15 20 260 65 3RV2131-4BA10
18 ... 25 2 5 7.5 10 20 25 325 65 3RV2131-4DA10
22 ... 32 3 5 10 10 25 30 416 65 3RV2131-4EA10
28 ... 36 3 7.5 15 15 30 40 520 65 3RV2131-4PA10
32 ... 40 3 7.5 15 15 30 40 585 65 3RV2131-4UA10
35 ... 45 3 10 15 15 40 50 650 65 3RV2131-4VA10
42 ... 52 5 10 15 20 40 50 741 65 3RV2131-4WA10
49 ... 59 5 15 20 25 50 60 845 65 3RV2131-4XA10
54 ... 65 5 15 20 25 50 60 845 65 3RV2131-4JA10
3RV2131-4WB10 3RV2142-4FA10
62 ... 73 7.5 15 25 30 60 75 949 65 3RV2131-4KA10
70 ... 804) 7.5 15 25 30 60 75 1040 65 3RV2131-4RA10
Size S3 with increased switching capacity2)
28 ... 40 3 7.5 15 15 30 40 520 55 3RV2142-4FA10
36 ... 50 5 10 15 20 40 50 650 55 3RV2142-4HA10
45 ... 63 5 15 20 25 50 60 819 55 3RV2142-4JA10
57 ... 75 7.5 15 25 25 60 75 975 55 3RV2142-4KA10
65 ... 84 7.5 15 25 30 60 75 1170 55 3RV2142-4RA10
3)
75 ... 93 7.5 20 30 40 75 100 1300 55 3RV2142-4YA10
3)
80 ... 1005) 10 25 40 40 75 100 1300 55 3RV2142-4MA10

WB10 3RV2142-4FA10

1) Select motor starter protector by motor full load amps. 4) Suitable for use with IE3/IE4 motors up to a starting 6) Size S2 and S3 are listed as type E combination motor
Horsepower ratings are for reference only. current of 720 A. For higher starting currents we controllers. For required Type E terminals see page
2) Accessories for mounting on the right and 3RV2915 recommend using 3RV2 motor starter protectors size S3. 1/10. 3RV2031 MSPs with a current setting limit of 45A
three-phase busbars cannot be used. Accessories can 5) Suitable for use with IE3/IE4 motors up to a starting or less do not require a type E terminal and fulfill the
be ordered separately. current of 780 A. For higher starting currents we spacing requirements of UL508.
3) Shaded ratings apply for group installation only. These recommend using 3VA circuit breakers. 7) 3RV2 MSPs can only be used with 3RT2 contactors and
ratings do not apply as UL listed manual combination accessories.
starters.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/7


3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
3RV1 Motor Starter Protectors
3RV10 Class 10 — up to 12A

Description Ordering Information


1

The 3RV101 MSP’s, can be used as components in Group Installation E ON/OFF rocker mechanism with lockout.
MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS

per NEC 430-53(C) to turn motors on and off. Each device has built-in E Adjustment dial for setting to motor FLA.
heater elements that provide overload protection and magnetic trip E Class 10 overload trip characteristics.
elements to protect the motor. When the 3RV101 is used as a
E Short circuit trip at 12 times the maximum setting of the
FLA adjustment dial.
component in Group Installation, multiple MSP’s can be installed
E Short circuit current rating:
below one ­circuit breaker to protect its own motor. A contactor can E Ambient compensated up to 140° F
be mounted to the MSP to provide a remotely operated starter.
(applies to side by side mounting).
E Phase loss sensitivity.
E Test trip function.
E Cage Clamp version.
E Terminal versions: screw, spring, ring lug.
E Auxiliaries and Accessories see pages 1/10–1/21.
E General Information see pages 1/33–1/36.
E Technical Data see pages 1/22–1/32.
E Dimensions see page 1/37–1/40.

Note: Select MSP by motor Full Load Amperes. Horsepower ratings are for reference only.

Single-Phase Three-Phase
FLA HP Ratings HP Ratings1) Instantaneous UL short-circuit Screw
Adjustment short circuit breaking capacity connection
Illustration Range [A] 115V 230V 200V 230V 460V 575V release [A] @ 480V [kA] Catalog Number

3RV101 Frame Size S002)


0.11–0.16 — — — — — —4) 2.1 65 3RV1011-0AA10
0.14–0.2 — — — — — — 2.6 65 3RV1011-0BA10
0.18–0.25 — — — — — — 3.3 65 3RV1011-0CA10
0.22­–0.32 — — — — — — 4.2 65 3RV1011-0DA10
0.28–0.4 — — — — — — 5.2 65 3RV1011-0EA10
0.35–0.5 — — — — — — 6.5 65 3RV1011-0FA10
0.45–0.63 — — — — — 1
⁄4 8.2 65 3RV1011-0GA10
0.55–0.8 — — — — 1
⁄4 1
⁄2 10 65 3RV1011-0HA10
0.7–1 — — — — 1
⁄2 1
⁄2 13 65 3RV1011-0JA10
0.9–1.25 — — — 1
⁄4 3
⁄4 3
⁄4 16 65 3RV1011-0KA10
1.1–1.6 — 1
⁄10 1
⁄4 1
⁄3 3
⁄4 1 21 65 3RV1011-1AA10
1.4–2 — 1
⁄8 1
⁄3 1
⁄2 1 1 1⁄2 26 65 3RV1011-1BA10
1.8–2.5 — 1
⁄6 1
⁄2 1
⁄2 1 1⁄2 1 1⁄2 33 65 3RV1011-1CA10
2.2–3.2 1
⁄10 1
⁄4 3
⁄4 3
⁄4 1 1⁄2 2 42 65 3RV1011-1DA10
2.8–4 1
⁄8 1
⁄3 3
⁄4 1 2 3 52 65 3RV1011-1EA10
3.5–5 1
⁄6 1
⁄2 1 1 3 3 65 65 3RV1011-1FA10
4.5–6.3 1
⁄4 3
⁄4 1 1⁄2 1 1⁄2 5 5 82 65 3RV1011-1GA10
5.5–8 1
⁄3 1 2 2 5 5 104 65 3RV1011-1HA10
7–10 1
⁄2 1 1⁄2 3 3 7 1⁄2 104) 130 65 3RV1011-1JA10
9–12 1
⁄2 2 3 3 7 1⁄2 10 156 65 3RV1011-1KA10
Accessories
Transverse auxiliary switch3) Approx. weight .02 kg 3RV1901-1E
1 NO + 1 NC separately

1) Select MSP by motor full load amps. Horse power 3) Shaded ratings apply for group installation only.
ratings for reference only. These ratings do not apply as UL listed manual
2) Size S00 MSP are listed for group installation only. combination starters.

1/8 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


3RV Circuit Breakers SIRIUS
UL 489
3RV — up to 70 A

1
Selection and ordering data
For Motor For Transformer
Protection 2) Protection 3)

PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
Thermal Short Circuit Instant- Instant-
overload breaking capacity aneous Order aneous Order
Rated release [kA] Over Number Over Number
Cur- (non-ad- Current Current
1)
rent justable) 480 480Y/ 600Y/ Release (Screw Weight Release (Screw Weight
[A] [A] VAC 277VAC 347VAC [A] Terminals) [kg] [A] Terminals) [kg]
Innovations Frame Size S00 4)
0.16 0.16 — 65 10 2.1 3RV2711-0AD10 0.390 3.3 3RV2811-0AD10 0.390
0.2 0.2 — 65 10 2.6 3RV2711-0BD10 0.390 4.2 3RV2811-0BD10 0.390
0.25 0.25 — 65 10 3.3 3RV2711-0CD10 0.390 5.2 3RV2811-0CD10 0.390
0.32 0.32 — 65 10 4.2 3RV2711-0DD10 0.390 6.5 3RV2811-0DD10 0.390
0.4 0.4 — 65 10 5.2 3RV2711-0ED10 0.390 8.2 3RV2811-0ED10 0.390
0.5 0.5 — 65 10 6.5 3RV2711-0FD10 0.390 10 3RV2811-0FD10 0.390
0.63 0.63 — 65 10 8.2 3RV2711-0GD10 0.390 13 3RV2811-0GD10 0.400
0.8 0.8 — 65 10 10 3RV2711-0HD10 0.390 16 3RV2811-0HD10 0.450
1 1 — 65 10 13 3RV2711-0JD10 0.450 21 3RV2811-0JD10 0.450
1.25 1.25 — 65 10 16 3RV2711-0KD10 0.450 26 3RV2811-0KD10 0.460
1.6 1.6 — 65 10 21 3RV2711-1AD10 0.460 33 3RV2811-1AD10 0.460
2 2 — 65 10 26 3RV2711-1BD10 0.460 42 3RV2811-1BD10 0.460
2.5 2.5 — 65 10 33 3RV2711-1CD10 0.460 52 3RV2811-1CD10 0.460
3.2 3.2 — 65 10 42 3RV2711-1DD10 0.460 65 3RV2811-1DD10 0.460
4 4 — 65 10 52 3RV2711-1ED10 0.450 82 3RV2811-1ED10 0.460
5 5 — 65 10 65 3RV2711-1FD10 0.460 104 3RV2811-1FD10 0.460
6.3 6.3 — 65 10 82 3RV2711-1GD10 0.460 130 3RV2811-1GD10 0.460
8 8 — 65 10 104 3RV2711-1HD10 0.460 163 3RV2811-1HD10 0.460
10 10 — 65 10 130 3RV2711-1JD10 0.460 208 3RV2811-1JD10 0.460
12.5 12.5 — 65 10 163 3RV2711-1KD10 0.460 260 3RV2811-1KD10 0.460
15 15 — 65 — 208 3RV2711-4AD10 0.470 286 3RV2811-4AD10 0.470
Innovations Frame Size S0 4)
20 20 — 50 — 260 3RV2721-4BD10 0.514 325 3RV2821-4BD10 0.516
22 22 — 50 — 286 3RV2721-4CD10 0.516 364 3RV2821-4CD10 0.528
Innovations Frame Size S3 5)
10 10 65 — 20 150 3RV2742-5AD10 0.460 — — —
15 15 65 — 20 225 3RV2742-5BD10 0.460 — — —
20 20 65 — 20 260 3RV2742-5CD10 0.460 — — —
25 25 65 — 20 325 3RV2742-5DD10 0.460 — — —
30 30 65 — 20 390 3RV2742-5ED10 0.460 — — —
35 35 — 65 20 455 3RV2742-5FD10 0.460 — — —
40 40 — 65 20 520 3RV2742-5GD10 0.460 — — —
45 45 — 65 20 585 3RV2742-5HD10 0.460 — — —
50 50 — 65 20 650 3RV2742-5JD10 0.460 — — —
60 60 — 65 20 780 3RV2742-5LD10 0.460 — — —
70 70 — 65 10 910 3RV2742-5QD10 0.460 — — —

1) 100 % rated value acc. to UL 489 and IEC 60947-2 4) Transverse and lateral auxiliary switches can be ordered busbars. Up until now it was limited to standard 3RV20
(100 % rated breaker). separately (see “Mountable accessories”). MSPs. These new approvals will greatly enhance appli-
2) Circuit breakers for system protection of motor and non- 5) Transverse auxiliary switches must not be mounted. cation flexibility for customers. Not only can they use the
motor loads. Requires use of separate overload protec- Lateral auxiliary switches can be ordered separately (see bus systems to feed motor loads, they can now feed
tion for motor applications. “Mountable accessories”). non-motor loads which should allow the bus systems
to feed complete control panel applications. Customers
3) Circuit breakers for system and transformer protection 6) Siemens now has UL/CSA approvals for using the
will need to remove the line side terminals on any 3RV27
according to UL/CSA. Specially designed for transform- 3RV27 and 3RV28 UL489 Circuit Breakers with the
or 28s that will be fed by the bus system. Contact your
ers with high inrush current. 3RV2917 Infeed System and with the 3RV1915 comb-
Siemens representative for more information.

Refer to page 1/25 when using as upstream protection of a Manual Motor Controller or a Manual Motor Controller Suitable for Tap Conductor Protection in
Group Installations.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/9
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
Accessories
Auxiliaries and Accessories
1

Selection and ordering data


Innovations
MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS

Fits 3RV2 Screw


Frame Connection
Type Version Width Size Order No.

Auxiliary switches 3)
mm Innovations
3RV2901-1E Transverse auxiliary 1 CO S00, S0, S2, 3RV2901-1D
switches 1 NO + 1 NC S3 1), 2) 3RV2901-1E
2 NO 1) 3RV2901-1F

3RV2901-1G S00, S0, S2,


Solid-state compatible, 1 CO 3RV2901-1G
transverse auxiliary S3
switches for use in dusty atmosphere
and in electronic circuits with
3RV2901-1A
low operating currents

Covering caps for transverse S00, S0, S2, 3RV2901-0H


auxiliary switch slots (pack of 10) S3

Lateral auxiliary 1 NO + 1 NC 9 S00, S0, S2, 1), 2) 3RV2901-1A


switches 2 NO 9 S3 1) 3RV2901-1B
(side mount) 2 NC 9 1) 3RV2901-1C
Width = 9 mm 2 NO + 2 NC 18 3RV2901-1J

Signaling switch4) Innovations


3RV2921-1M Signaling switch 1 NO + 1 NC 18 S00, S0, S2, 1), 2) 3RV2921-1M
(side mount) each S3
Individual tripped and
short-circuit signaling
Width = 18 mm

Auxiliary releases 5) Innovations


Undervoltage DC S00,
3RV2902-1AB4
releases 24 V S0, S2, 3RV2902-1AB4
(side mount) S3
Width = 18 mm AC 50 Hz AC 60 Hz
24 V — S00, 3RV2902-1AB0
110 V 120 V S0, S2, 3RV2902-1AF0
— 208 V S3 1), 2) 3RV2902-1AM1
230 V 240 V 1), 2) 3RV2902-1AP0
400 V 440 V 3RV2902-1AV0
415 V 480 V 3RV2902-1AV1
500 V 600 V 3RV2902-1AS0
Undervoltage 24V 24V S00, 3RV2922-1CB0
releases with 230 V 240 V S0, S2, 1) 3RV2922-1CP0
leading 400 V 440 V S3 1) 3RV2922-1CV0
auxiliary 415 V 480 V 1), 2)
3RV2922-1CV1
contacts 2 NO
(side mount)
Width = 18 mm
Shunt releases AC 50/60 Hz AC 50/60 Hz
6) 7)
(side mount) 100% ON 5 sec ON
Width = 18 mm 20-24 V 20-70 V S00, 1), 2) 3RV2902-1DB0
90-110 V 70-190 V S0, S2, 1), 2) 3RV2902-1DF0
210-240 V 190-330 V S3 1) 3RV2902-1DP0
350-415 V 330-500 V 3RV2902-1DV0
500 V 500 V 3RV2902-1DS0

1) This product is also available with spring terminals. The 3) Each motor starter protector can be fitted with one 5) One auxiliary release can be mounted at the right of
order no. must be changed in the 8th position to a transverse and one lateral auxiliary switch. The lateral each MSP. motor starter protector.
“2”:e.g. 3RV1901-2E or 3RV2901-2E auxiliary switch 2 NO + 2 NC is used without trans-
6) The response voltage at the lower limit of the voltage
verse auxiliary switch.
2) This product is also available with ring lug terminals. The range at 0.85 (Tu=60°C) is valid for 100% (infinite)
order no. must be changed in the 8th position to a “4”: 4) One signaling switch can be mounted at the left of the
7) The response voltage at the lower limit of the voltage
e.g. 3RV2901-4E motor starter protector. This accessory cannot be used
range at 0.9 (Tu=60°C) applies for a duty cycle of 5
on the 3RV27 and 3RV28 circuit breakers.
seconds at AC 50/60 Hz and DC.

1/10 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
Accessories
Mounting accessories

Selection and ordering data

1
Modu- Number of motor starter Rated For motor Order No. Order Weight
lar protectors that can be current starter quantity approx.

PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
spac- connected In at protectors
ing Without Incl. With 690 V Size
lateral lateral auxil-
acces- auxil- iary trip
sories iary unit
switch
mm A kg
Three-phase busbar systems for Classic and Innovations
For feeding several motor starter protectors with screw
terminals, mounted side-by-side on standard mounting
rails, insulated, with touch protection.
3RV19 15-1AB
45 2 -- -- 63 S00, S01)2) 3RV19 15-1AB 1 unit 0.044
3 S00, S01)2) 3RV19 15-1BB 1 unit 0.071
4 S00, S01)2) 3RV19 15-1CB 1 unit 0.099
5 S00, S01)2) 3RV19 15-1DB 1 unit 0.124
3RV19 15-1BB 55 -- 2 -- 63 S00, S01)2) 3RV19 15-2AB 1 unit 0.048
3 S00, S01)2) 3RV19 15-2BB 1 unit 0.079
4 S00, S01)2) 3RV19 15-2CB 1 unit 0.111
5 S00, S01)2) 3RV19 15-2DB 1 unit 0.140
63 -- -- 2 63 S00, S01)2) 3RV19 15-3AB 1 unit 0.052
3RV19 15-1CB
4 S00, S01)2) 3RV19 15-3CB 1 unit 0.120
55 2 -- -- 108 S23) 3RV19 35-1A 1 unit 0.150
3 S23) 3RV19 35-1B 1 unit 0.214
4 S23) 3RV19 35-1C 1 unit 0.295
3RV19 15-1DB 75 -- 2 2 108 S2 3RV19 35-3A 1 unit 0.161
3 3 S2 3RV19 35-3B 1 unit 0.262
4 4 S2 3RV19 35-3C 1 unit 0.369
1) Not suitable for 3RV21 motor starter protectors with overload relay 2) Not suitable for 3RV UL 489 circuit breakers.
function. The 3RV1915-5DB connecting piece is available for connecting 3) Auxiliary trip units and lateral auxiliary switches cannot be used in combi-
motor starter protectors from size S0 to size S00. nation.

Version Modular For motor Order No. Order Weight


spacing starter quantity approx.
protectors
Size
mm kg
Connecting pieces for three-phase busbars For Innovations
For connecting three-phase 45 S00, S0 3RV19 15-5DB 1 unit 0.042
busbars for motor starter
protectors of size S0 (left) to
3RV19 15-5DB size S00 (right)
Conductor cross-section, For motor
AWG cables, solid or stranded Tighten- starter 3RV2
For 3RV1 For 3RV2 ing protector Innovations 2)
MSP MSP torque size
AWG AWG Nm Order No.
Three-phase feeder terminals
3RV29 25-5AB Connection from top
— 10…4 3…4 S00 3RV2925-5AB
— 10…4 3…4 S0 3RV2925-5AB
3)
3RV2915-5B Connection from below
— 10…4 Input: 4, S00, S0 3RV2915-5B
Output:
2 ... 2.5
3RV2935-5A Connection from top
14...0 -- 4-6 S2 3RV2935-5A

Three-phase feeder terminals for constructing “Type E Starters” Innovations


3RV2935-5E Connection from top
— 10…4 3-4 S00 3RV2925-5EB
— 10…4 3-4 S0 3RV2925-5EB
8...0 10...2/0 4.5-6 S2 3RV2935-5E

1) Do not mix 3RV1 Classic Accessories with 3RV2 2) Do not mix 3RV2 Innovations Accessories with 3RV1 3) This terminal is connected in place of a switch, please
Innovations MSPs Classic MSPs take the space requirement into account.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/11
3RV Motor
Motor Starter
Starter Protectors
Protectors/Circuit Breakers
SIRIUS
SIRIUS 3RV2 Motor Starter Protectors/Circuit Breakers up to 80 A
Accessories
Accessories
Mounting accessories
Mounting accessories

Overview
1

Accessories for "Self-Protected Combination Motor Link modules


Controllers (Type E)" according to UL 508/UL 60947-4-1
MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS

Feeders can be easily assembled from single devices with the


The 3RV20 motor starter protectors with screw terminals are help of the link modules. The following table shows the different
approved according to UL 508/UL 60947-4-1 as "Self-Protected combination options for devices with screw or spring-type
Combination Motor Controllers (Type E)". terminals.
This requires increased clearance and creepage distances Combination 3RV2 3RT2 contactors; Link modules
(1 inch and 2 inches respectively) at the input side of the device, devices motor 3RW30, 3RW40 Screw Spring-type
which are achieved by mounting a terminal block or a phase starter soft starters; terminals terminals
barrier. protec- 3RF34 solid-state
tors/ contactors
3RV20 motor starter protectors with spring terminals can only circuit
be used as Type E when used in the 3RV29 Infeed System. breakers
Size Size
Link modules for connecting switching devices to 3RV2 motor starter
protectors/circuit breakers1)
3RT2 contac- S00 S00 3RA1921- 3RA2911-
tors with AC or 1DA00 2AA00
_013
79 c
DC coil S0 S00 --
B0
NS
S2 S2 3RA2931- --
1AA00
SIRIUS 3RV2928-1H terminal block* 3RT2 contac- S0 S0 3RA2921- 3RA2921-
tors with 1AA00 2AA00
AC coil S00 S0 --
3RT2 contac- S0 S0 3RA2921- 3RA2921-
tors with 1BA00 2AA00
DC coil S00 S0 --
7

00
408 3RW30 soft S00 S00 3RA2921- 3RA2911-
1_
IC0 starters 1BA00 2GA00
S0 S00 --
3RW30/ S0 S0 3RA2921- 3RA2921-
SIRIUS 3RV2938-1K phase barrier* 3RW40 1BA00 2GA00
soft starters S00 S0 --
* These accessories are only for screw terminals and mount on top of MSPs
S22) S22) 3RA2931- --
and are not for use on spring terminals which are located on the front of MSPs. 1AA00
If screw terminal MSPs and spring terminal contactors are preferred, a 3RF34 solid- S00/S0 S00 3RA2921- --
hybrid link module can be utilized. See note 3. state contac- 1BA00
tors
Motor starter Size Essential accessories Hybrid link modules for connecting contactors with spring-type
protectors/ for "Self-Protected Combination terminals to 3RV2 motor starter protectors/circuit breakers with
circuit breakers Motor Controllers (Type E)" according screw terminals3)
to UL 508/UL 60947-4-1
3RT2 contac- S00 S00 3RA2911- --
3RV201., 3RV202. S00/S0 3RV2928-1H terminal block or tors with AC or 2FA00
3RV2928-1K phase barrier DC coil S0 S0 3RA2921- --
3RV2031-4B1., S2 -- 2FA00
3RV2031-4D.1.,
3RV2031-4E1., -- Version not possible
3RV2031-4P.1., 1)
The link modules cannot be used for the 3RV2.21-4PA1., 3RV2.21-4FA1.,
3RV2031-4S.1., 3RV2.31-4K.1., 3RV2.31-4R.1., 3RV2.32-4K.1., 3RV2.32-4R.1., 3RV27 and
3RV2031-4T.1., 3RV28 motor starter protectors/circuit breakers.
3RV2031-4U.1., 2)
3RV2031-4V.1. To assemble the feeder between a motor starter protector and a soft starter
in size S2, the 3RA2932-1AC00 standard mounting rail adapter must be
3RV2031-4J.1., S2 3RV2938-1K phase barrier used.
3RV2031-4K.1., 3)
3RV2031-4R.1., The motor starter protector to contactor hybrid link modules cannot be
3RV2031-4W.1., used for the 3RV2.21-4PA1., 3RV2.21-4FA1., 3RV27 and 3RV28 motor
3RV2031-4X.1., starter protectors/circuit breakers. They are only suitable for constructing
3RV2032 direct-on-line starters.
3RV204 S3 3RT2946-4GA07 terminal block Note:
-- No accessories needed • Link modules can be used in
- Sizes S00 and S0: up to max. 32 A
Special 3-phase infeed terminals are required for constructing - Size S2: up to max. 65 A
“Type E Starters” with an insulated 3-phase busbar system
• Hybrid link modules can be used in
(see page 1/11). These infeed terminals are only available for 3RV20
- Sizes S00 and S0: up to max. 32 A
motor starter protectors with screw terminals.
The 3RV29 infeed system also enables the assembly of “Type E
Starters”, see page 1/18 onwards.
Note:
According to CSA, these terminal blocks and the phase barriers
can be omitted when the device is used as a "Self-Protected
Combination Motor Controller (Type E)".

1/12 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
7/38 Siemens IC 10 · 2015
maintaining the required voltage clearances
and as touch protection if box terminal is
removed (2 units can be mounted per motor
3RV Motor Starter Protectors
starter protector/circuit breaker) SIRIUS
Accessories
3RV2 (size S3) with
3RT1946-4EA1 (left)
Mounting accessories
Scale covers 3RV20, 3RV21, } 3RV2908-0P 100 10 units 41E
Sealable, 3RV24:
for covering the set current scale S00 ... S3
Selection and ordering data

1
3RV2908-0P
Covers for devices with screw terminals For motorScrew
starterterminalsInnovations Order

PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
Version
(box terminals) protector size 3RV2/3RT2 Order No. Quantity
Terminal blocks andAdditional touch protection
phase barriers to be fitted at theCombination
for “Self-Protected
box terminals
Motor Controllers (Type E)” according to UL 508 / UL 60947-4-1
(2 units required per device)
3RT2936-4EA2 Note:
• Main current level }
S2 clearance and 2-inch3RT2936-4EA2 1 1 unit 41B
7

UL 508 / UL 60947-4-1 demands 1-inch creepage distance at line side for


“Combination Motor Controller Type E”.S3 } 3RT2946-4EA2 1 1 unit 41B
Fixing accessories The following terminal blocks or phase barriers must be used on 3RV motor starter protectors.
3RV29 28-1H The terminal blocks or phase barriers cannot be used in combination with the 3RV19 .5 three-phase busbars.
Push-in lugs S00, S0 2 3RV2928-0B 100 10 units 41E
For construction with three-phase busbars, see “Accessories for busbar”
For screwing the motor starter protector/
Terminal blocks type E
circuit breaker onto mounting plates
Two unitsFor
areextended
required clearance and starter
for each motor S00, S0 3RV29 28-1H 1 unit
3RV2928-0B protector.creepage distances S0 — 1 unit
3RV29 28-1K (1 and 2 inch)
Tools for opening spring-type terminals S2 3RV29 35-5E 1 unit
1)
Screwdrivers S3 3RT2946-4GA07
Spring-type terminals 1 unit
For all SIRIUS
Phasedevices with spring-type terminals
barriers
Length approx. 200 mm,
For extended clearance and S00 ... S3 S00,2 S0 3RA2908-1A 3RV29 28-1K 1 1 unit 1 unit 41B
3.0 mm xcreepage
0.5 mm, distances (1 and 2 inch)
titanium gray/black, S2 3RV29 38-1K
3RA2908-1A 3RT1946-4GA07
partially insulated 1 unit
Terminal
Terminal covers
covers for
for box
box terminals
terminals on
on3RV2742
3RV2742and
andType
TypeEEterminal
terminal
block 3RT2946-4GA07
AdditionalAdditional touch protection
touch protection to be
to be fitted fitted at the
at the
box terminals
box terminals 3RV27423RV2742
(2 units required per device)
(2 units required and at and at
per device)
Type E terminal block 3RT2946-4GA07
Type E terminal block 3RT2946-4GA07
• Main current level S3 NEW NEU
X 3RV2948-1LA00 1 1 unit 41B
• Main current level S3 3RV2948-1LA00 1 unit
3RV2948-1LAA00
Actuating Size 3RT 3RV motor Innovations Order
voltage of contactor contactor starter protector 3RV2/3RT2 Order No. Quantity

Link modules for motor starter protector to contactor 2)


For mechanical and electrical connection between
motor starter protector and contactor with screw terminals.
Screw Terminals
Single-unit packaging
AC/DC S00 S00/S0 3RA19 21-1DA00 1 unit
AC S0 S00/S0 3RA29 21-1AA00 1 unit
AC S2 S2 3RA29 31-1AA00 1 unit
AC S3 S3 3RA19 41-1AA00 1 unit
DC S0 S00/S0 3RA29 21-1BA00 1 unit
DC S2 S2 3RA29 31-1AA00 1 unit
DC S3 S3 3RA19 41-1AA00 1 unit
Multi-unit packaging
AC/DC S00 S00/S0 3RA19 21-1D 10 units
3RA29 21-1AA00 AC S0 S00/S0 3RA29 21-1A 10 units
DC S0 S00/S0 3RA29 21-1B 10 units
AC/DC S2 S2 3RA29 31-1A 5 units
AC/DC S3 S3 3RA19 41-1A 5 units

For mechanical and electrical connection between motor starter


protector and contactor with spring-type terminals. Spring-type Terminals
Single-unit packaging * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
7/54 Siemens IC 10 · 2019 Illustrations are approximate
AC/DC S00 S00 3RA29 11-2AA00 1 unit
3)
AC S0 S0 3RA29 21-2AA00 1 unit
DC S0 S0 3RA29 21-2AA00 1 unit
Multi-unit packaging
AC/DC S00 S00 3RA29 11-2A 10 units
3)
AC S0 S0 3RA29 21-2A 10 units
3RA29 11-2AA00
DC S0 S0 3RA29 21-2A 10 units
Spacers
For compensating height on AC contactors
Single-unit packaging S0 S0 3RA29 11-1CA00 1 unit
Multi-unit packaging S0 S0 3RA29 11-1C 5 units
1) Transverse auxiliary switches cannot be installed when using this terminal block Note
2) The link modules for motor starter protector to contactor cannot be used for the Size S0 link modules can be used up to max. 32 A.
3RV2. 21-4PA1., 3RV2. 21-4FA1., 3RV27 and 3RV28 motor starter protectors Size S2 link modules can be used up to 65A max.
3) A spacer for height compensation on AC contactors size S0 is optionally available

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/13
LV1N_05_04.fm Page 30 Friday, September 27, 2013 2:28 PM

3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS


Accessories
SIRIUS 3RV2 Motor Starter Protectors/Circuit Breakers up to 40 A
Accessories
Mounting accessories

Mounting accessories
Selection and ordering data
1

Size Order No. PU PS* Weight


MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS

3RW30, 3RW40 3RV2 (UNIT, approx.


soft starters; motor starter protectors SET, M)
3RF34
solid-state contactors
kg
Link modules for motor starter protector to soft starter1) 3) and
motor starter protector to solid-state contactor
Connection between motor starter protector and soft Screw terminals
starter / solid-state contactor with screw terminals
Single-unit packaging
S00 S00/S0 3RA29 21-1BA00 1 1 unit 0.068
S0 S00/S0 3RA29 21-1BA00 1 1 unit 0.068
S2 3) S2 3RA29 31-1AA00 1 1 unit 0.104
S3 4) S3 3RA19 41-1AA00 1 1 unit 0.104
Multi-unit packaging
S00 S00/S0 3RA29 21-1B 1 10 units 0.068
S0 S00/S0 3RA29 21-1B 1 10 units 0.068
S2 3) S2 3RA29 31-1A 1 5 units 0.104
3RA29 21-1BA00
S3 4) S2 3RA19 41-1A 1 5 units 0.104
Connection between motor starter protector and Spring-type
soft starter with spring-type terminals terminals

Single-unit packaging
S00 S00 3RA29 11-2GA00 1 1 unit 0.038
S0 S0 3RA29 21-2GA00 1 1 unit 0.072
Multi-unit packaging
S00 S00 3RA29 11-2G 1 10 units 0.380
3RA29 21-2GA00 S0 S0 3RA29 21-2G 1 10 units 0.720
5

1) The link modules for motor starter protector to soft starter and for motor Note:
starter protector to solid-state contactor cannot be used for the S0 link modules can be used up to max. 32 A.
3RV2. 21-4PA1., 3RV2. 21-4FA1., 3RV27 and 3RV28 motor starter
protectors. S2 link modules can be used up to max. 65 A.

Actuating voltage of Size Order No. PU PS* Weight


contactor 3RT2 3RV2 (UNIT, approx.
contactors motor SET, M)
starter
protectors
kg
Hybrid link modules for motor starter protector to contactor1)
For mechanical and electrical connection
between motor starter protector with screw terminals
and contactor with spring-type terminals
Single-unit packaging
AC/DC S00 S00 3RA29 11-2FA00 1 1 unit 0.029
AC2)/DC S0 S0 3RA29 21-2FA00 1 1 unit 0.056

3RA29 11-2FA00
Multi-unit packaging
AC/DC S00 S00 3RA29 11-2F 1 10 units 0.290
AC2)/DC S0 S0 3RA29 21-2F 1 10 units 0.560
Spacers2)
for compensating the height on AC contactors
Single-unit packaging S0 S0 3RA29 11-1CA00 1 1 unit 0.001
Multi-unit packaging S0 S0 3RA29 11-1C 1 5 units 0.001

3RA29 21-2FA00
1) The hybrid link modules for motor starter protector to contactor cannot be Note:
used for the 3RV2. 21-4PA1., 3RV2. 21-4FA1., 3RV27 and 3RV28 motor Hybrid link modules can be used up to max. 32 A.
starter protectors or reversing starters.
2) A spacer for height compensation on AC contactors size S0 is optionally
available. See 3RA2911-1CA00
3) To assemble the starter between a motor starter protector and a soft starter
in size S2, the 3RA2932-1AC00 standard mounting rail adapter must be used.
4) It is only permissible to assemble the feeder between the motor starter
protector and the soft starter in Size S3 on a mounting plate.

1/14 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


5/30 SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 Illustrations are approximate
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
Accessories
Mounting accessories

Selection and ordering data

1
Weight
For SIRIUS Order approx.

PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
Type Design MSP size Order No. Quantity (kg)
Isolator module 1)
3RV2938-1A 3RV29 28-1A Visible isolating distance for S00, S0 3RV29 28-1A 1 unit 0.132
without padlock without padlock
isolating individual motor starter
protectors from the network,
1)
lockable in isolating position. S2 3RV29 38-1A 1 unit 0.368

Auxiliary terminal, 3 pole


3RT19 46-4F For connection of auxiliary S3 3RT29 46-4F 1 unit 0.10
and control cables to the main
conductor connections

Covers
3RV1 (size S3) with
3RT19 46-4EA1 Terminal cover Additional touch guard
for box terminals to be fitted at the box terminals S2 3RT29 36-4EA2 1 unit 0.014
(2 units can be mounted per MSP)
S3 3RT29 46-4EA2 1 unit 0.019

3RV29 28-4AA00 Terminal cover For maintaining the required


for cable lug and voltage clearance and as protection S3 3RT19 46-4EA1 1 unit 0.03
bar connection against the equipment being touched
if distant box terminals are used
(2 units can be mounted per MSP)
3RV29 08-4AA10
Terminal cover
2)
for devices with ring lug • Main current level S00, S0 3RV29 28-4AA00 1 unit 0.01
terminal connection 2)
• For transverse auxiliary switches S00, S0 3RV29 08-4AA10 1 unit 0.01
3RV29 08-0P Scale cover For covering the current setting
3)
scale. Packing unit: Bag with 10 S00, S0, S2 3RV29 08-0P 10 units
scale covers. S3 3RV19 08-0P 10 units

Fixing Material
3RB1900-0B Push-in lugs Two units are required for
For screwing the each motor starter protector. S00 3RB19 00-0B 10 units 0.10
motor starter protector
onto mounting plates.

Tools for opening spring-type terminals by hand


3RA29 08-1A Screwdriver Length approx. 200 mm,
For all SIRIUS 3.0 mm x 0.5 mm, S00, S0, 3RA29 08-1A 1 unit 0.045
devices with spring titanium gray/black S2
terminals partially insulated

1) The isolator module for size S2 can be used only with 3RV2 motor 2) Compatible with 3RV20 motor starter protectors.
starter protectors/circuit breakers up to max. 65 A. Similarly, it cannot
3) Compatible with 3RV20, 3RV21, and 3RV24 motor
be used with the transverse auxiliary switch or three-phase busbars.
starter protectors.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/15
© Siemens 2021

Protection
3RV equipment
Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
Motor starter protectors/circuit breakers
Accessories
SIRIUS 3RV2 motor starter protectors/circuit breakers
Rotary operating mechanisms
Accessories > Rotary operating mechanisms

Selection and ordering data


1

Version Color of Version of For motor starter SD Article No. Price PU PS* PG
MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS

actuator extension shaft protectors/circuit per PU (UNIT,


breakers SET, M)
mm Size d
Door-coupling rotary operating mechanisms NEW NEU

The door-coupling rotary operating mechanisms consist of a actuator, a coupling driver and a 130/330 mm long extension shaft
(6 mm x 6 mm).
The door-coupling rotary operating mechanisms are dimensioned for degree of protection IP64. For UL/CSA applications, they are
approved for Enclosure Types 1, 3R and 12. The door interlocking prevents accidental opening of the control cabinet door in the
ON position of the motor starter protector. The OFF position can be locked with up to three padlocks.
With the optional 3RV2926-0Q tolerance compensation, an offset can be compensated when installing the door-coupling rotary
operating mechanism.
Door-coupling Gray 130 S001) ... S3 X 3RV2926-1B 1 1 unit 41E
rotary 330 S001) ... S3 X 3RV2926-1K 1 1 unit 41E
operating
3RV2926-1B mechanisms
EMERGENCY Red/ 130 S001) ... S3 X 3RV2926-1C 1 1 unit 41E
OFF door- yellow 330 S001) ... S3 X 3RV2926-1L 1 1 unit 41E
coupling
rotary
operating
mechanisms

3RV2926-1C
Optional accessories
7

Tolerance -- -- -- X 3RV2926-0Q 1 1 unit 41E


compensation

3RV2926-0Q
1) Not for 3RV1011 motor starter protectors.

1/16 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Siemens IC 10 · 2021
© Siemens 2021

3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS


Protection equipment
Motor starter protectors/circuit breakers
Accessories SIRIUS 3RV2 motor starter protectors/circuit breakers
Rotary operating mechanisms
Accessories > Rotary operating mechanisms

Version Color of Version of For motor starter SD Article No. Price PU PS* PG

1
actuator extension shaft protectors/circuit per PU (UNIT,
breakers SET, M)

PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
mm Size d
Door-coupling rotary operating mechanisms for harsh conditions
The door-coupling rotary operating mechanisms consist of a actuator, a coupling driver, an extension shaft of 300 mm in length
(8 mm x 8 mm), a spacer and two metal brackets into which the motor starter protector/circuit breaker is inserted.
The door-coupling rotary operating mechanisms are designed to degree of protection IP65. For UL/CSA applications, they are
approved for Enclosure Types 1, 3R and 12. The door interlocking reliably prevents opening of the control cabinet door in the
ON position of the motor starter protector/circuit breaker. The OFF position can be locked with up to three padlocks.
Laterally mountable auxiliary releases and 2-pole auxiliary switches can be used.
The door-coupling rotary operating mechanisms thus meet the requirements for isolating functions according to IEC 60947-2.
With the optional 3RV2926-2Q tolerance compensation, an offset can be compensated when installing the door-coupling rotary
operating mechanism for harsh conditions.
Door-coupling Gray 300 S001), S0 NEW NEU
X 3RV2926-3B 1 1 unit 41E
3RV2946-3B
rotary S2 NEW NEU
X 3RV2936-3B 1 1 unit 41E
operating
mechanisms S3 NEW NEU
X 3RV2946-3B 1 1 unit 41E
EMERGENCY Red/ 300 S001), S0 NEW NEU
X 3RV2926-3C 1 1 unit 41E
OFF door- yellow S2 NEW NEU
X 3RV2936-3C 1 1 unit 41E
coupling
rotary S3 NEW NEU
X 3RV2946-3C 1 1 unit 41E
operating
mechanisms

3RV2946-3C
Optional accessories
Tolerance -- -- S00 ... S3 NEW NEU
X 3RV2926-2Q 1 1 unit 41E
compensation

7
3RV2926-2Q
Necessary accessories for mounting one main switch in size S3 according to UL 508A and NFPA 79
(see also page 7/55)
Shaft supports -- -- S3 NEW NEU
X 3RV2926-0P 1 1 unit 41E

3RV2926-0P
Supplementary
handles
• Standard Gray -- S3 2 3VA9137-0GC01 1 1 unit 12P

3VA9137-0GC01
• EMERGENCY Red/ -- S3 2 3VA9137-0GC05 1 1 unit 12P
OFF yellow

3VA9137-0GC05
1) Not for 3RV1011 motor starter protectors.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/17

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Siemens IC 10 · 2021
LV1N_05_04.fm Page 23 Friday, September 27, 2013 2:28 PM

3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS


SIRIUS
SIRIUS 3RV2
3RV2 Motor
Motor Starter
Starter Protectors/Circuit
Protectors/Circuit Breakers
Breakers up
up to
to 40
40 A
A
Accessories Accessories
Accessories
3RV29 infeed system
3RV29 infeed system
3RV29 infeed system
Overview
1

Overview
The 3RV29 infeed system is a convenient means of energy two sockets onto each of which a motor starter protector can
supply and distribution for a group of several motor starter
MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS

be snapped.
protectors or complete motor starters with a screw or spring-
type connection in sizes S00 and S0 (exception: this system Expansion modules are available for extending the system
cannot be used for the 3RV21). (three-phase busbars for system expansion). The individual
modules are connected through an expansion plug.
Siemens now has UL/CSA approvals for using the 3RV27 and
3RV28 UL489 Circuit Breakers with the 3RV2917 Infeed System The electrical connection between the three-phase busbars and
and with the 3RV1915 comb-busbars. Up until now it was lim- the motor starter protectors is implemented through plug-in
ited to standard 3RV20 MSPs. These new approvals will greatly connectors. The complete system can be mounted on a TH 35
enhance application flexibility for customers. Not only can they standard mounting rail to EN 60715 and can be expanded as
use the bus systems to feed motor loads, they can now feed required up to a maximum current carrying capacity of 63 A.
non-motor loads which should allow the bus systems to feed The system is mounted extremely quickly and easily thanks to
complete control panel applications. Customers will need to the simple plug-in technique. Thanks to the lateral infeed, the
remove the line side terminals on any 3RV27 or 28s that will be system also saves space in the control cabinet. The additional
fed by the bus system. overall height required for the infeed unit is only 30 mm. The
The 3RV29 infeed system is approved in accordance with alternative infeed possibilities on each side offer a high degree
IEC to 500V. It is also UL approved and authorized for “Self- of flexibility for configuring the control cabinet: Infeed on left-
Protected Combination Motor Controller” (Type E starter) as hand or right-hand side as well as infeed on one side and out-
well as for Type F starter (Type E starter + contactor). The feed on the other side to supply further loads are all possible.
system is based on a basic module complete with a lateral A terminal block with spring-type connections in combination
incoming unit (three-phase busbar with infeed). This infeed with with a standard mounting rail enables the integration of not only
spring-type terminals is mounted on the right or left depending SIRIUS motor starter protectors but also single-phase, 2-phase
on the version and can be supplied with a maximum conductor and 3-phase components such as 5SY miniature circuit breakers
cross-section of 4 AWG (with end sleeve). A basic module has or SIRIUS relay components.

55
3b
3b
5
5 3a
3a
5
5

1
1

2
2

4
4

7
7

6
6
NSB0_02078
NSB0_02078

1 3-phase busbar with infeed 3a Expansion plug 4 End cover 6 Contactor base
1 3-phase busbar with infeed 3a Expansion plug 4 End cover 6 Contactor base
2 3-phase busbar for system expansion 3b Extra-wide expansion plug 5 Plug-in connector 7 Terminal block
2 3-phase busbar for system expansion 3b Extra-wide expansion plug 5 Plug-in connector 7 Terminal block

3RV29 infeed system


3RV29 infeed system

1/18 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 5/23
SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 5/23
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
SIRIUS 3RV2 Motor Starter Protectors/Circuit Breakers up to 40 A
Accessories
Accessories
3RV29 infeed system
3RV29 infeed system
$ Three-phase busbars with infeed * Contactor base

1
A three-phase busbar with infeed unit is required for connecting Motor starters can be assembled in the system using the contac-
the energy supply. This module comprises one infeed module tor base. The contactor bases are suitable for contactors sizes

PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
and 2 sockets which each accept one motor starter protector. A S00 and S0 with spring-type and screw terminals and are simply
choice of two versions with infeed on the left or right is available. snapped onto the three-phase busbars. Direct-on-line starters
The infeed is connected using spring-type terminals. The and reversing starters are possible. One contactor base is re-
spring-type terminals permit conductor cross-sections of up to quired for direct-on-line starters and two are required for revers-
25 mm2 with end sleeves. An end cover is supplied with each ing starters.
module.
To assemble motor starters for reversing starters, the contactor
% Three-phase busbars for system expansion bases can be arranged alongside each other (90 mm overall
width). In this case the mechanical interlocking of the contactors
The three-phase busbars for system expansion allow the system is possible. The contactor bases are also suitable for soft start-
to be expanded. There is a choice of modules with 2 or 3 sock- ers size S00 and S0 with screw connection.
ets. The system can be expanded as required up to a maximum
current carrying capacity of 63 A. An expansion plug is supplied The infeed system is designed for mounting on a 35 mm stan-
with each module. dard mounting rail with 7.5 mm overall depth. This standard
mounting rail gives the contactor base a stable mounting sur-
&a Expansion plug face to sit on. If standard mounting rails with a depth of 15 mm
are used, the spacer connected to the bottom of the contactor
The expansion plug is used for electrical connection of adjacent base must be knocked out and plugged into the mating piece
three-phase busbars. The current carrying capacity of this plug that is also on the underside. Then the contactor base also has
equals 63 A. One expansion plug is supplied with each three- a stable mounting surface. When standard mounting rails with a
phase busbar for system expansion. Additional expansion plugs depth of 7.5 mm are used, the spacer has no function and can
are therefore only required as spare parts. be removed.
&b Extra-wide expansion plug The link modules are used for direct start motor starters, in which
The wide expansion plug makes the electrical connection be- case the use of a contactor base is not absolutely necessary.
tween two three-phase busbars, thus performing the same func- Motor starter protector and contactor assemblies can then be di-
tion as the 3RV29 17-5BA00 expansion plug; the electrical char- rectly snapped onto the sockets of the three-phase busbars. For
acteristics (e.g. a current carrying capacity of 63 A) are starters of size S00 and S0, the corresponding 3RA19 21-1....,
5

identical. 3RA29 11-2...., 3RA29 21-1.... or 3RA29 21-2.... link modules


should generally be used.
The 3RV29 17-5E expansion plug is 10 mm wider than the
3RV29 17-5BA00 expansion plug, hence in the plugged state + Terminal block
there is a distance of 10 mm between the connected three- The 3RV29 17-5D terminal block enables the integration of not
phase busbars. This distance can be used to lay the auxiliary only SIRIUS motor starter protectors but also single-phase,
current and control current wiring ("wiring duct"). The motor 2-phase and 3-phase components. Using the terminal block the
starter protector and contactor can be wired from underneath, 3 phases can be fed out of the system; which means that single-
which means that the complete cable duct above the system phase loads can also be integrated in the system. The terminal
can be omitted. block is plugged into the slot of the expansion plug and thus en-
ables outfeeding from the middle or end of the infeed system.
( End cover The terminal block can be rotated through 180° and be locked
The end cover is used to cover the three-phase busbar at the to the support modules of the infeed system. The 3RV19 17-7B
open end of the system. This cover is therefore only required 45 mm standard mounting rail for screwing onto the support
once for each system. An end cover is supplied with each three- plate is available in addition in order to be able to plug the sin-
phase busbar system with infeed. Further end covers are there- gle-phase, 2-phase and 3-phase components onto the infeed
fore only required as spare parts. system.

) Plug-in connector
The plug-in connector is used for the electrical connection be-
tween the three-phase busbar and the 3RV2 motor starter pro-
tector. These plug-in connectors are available in versions for
screw or spring-type terminals.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/19
5/24 SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012
SIRIUS
SIRIUS 3RV2 Motor Starter Protectors/Circuit Breakers up to 40 A
3RV Motor Starter Protectors

Accessories Accessories
3RV29 infeed system
3RV29 infeed system

Selection and ordering data


1

Type Version For 3RV20, Order No. Standard Weight


MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS

3RV23, Pack approx.


3RV24 Quantity
motor
starter
protectors
Size kg
Three-phase busbars with infeed
3-phase For 2 motor starter
busbars with protectors with
infeed screw connection or
incl. end cover spring-type
3RV29 17-6A terminals
• With infeed on the S00, S0 3RV29 17-1A 1 unit 0.369
left
• With infeed on the S00, S0 3RV29 17-1E 1 unit 0.369
right

3RV29 17-1A
Three-phase busbars for system expansion
Three-phase For motor starter
busbars protectors with
incl. 3RV29 17- screw connection or
5BA00 expansion spring-type
plug terminals
• For 2 motor starter S00, S0 3RV29 17-4A 1 unit 0.229
protectors
• For 3 motor starter S00, S0 3RV29 17-4B 1 unit 0.328
protectors

5
3RV29 17-4A
Plug-in connectors
Plug-in • For spring-type Spring-type
connectors terminals terminals
to make contact - Single-unit S001) 3RV29 17-5AA00 1 unit 0.046
with the motor packaging S02) 3RV29 27-5AA00 1 unit 0.059
starter protectors
- Multi-unit S001) 3RV29 17-5A 10 units 0.046
packaging S02) 3RV29 27-5A 10 units 0.059

3RV29 17-5AA00
• For screw Screw terminals
terminals
- Single-unit S001) 3RV29 17-5CA00 1 unit 0.029
packaging S02) 3RV19 27-5AA00 1 unit 0.040
- Multi-unit S001) 3RV29 17-5C 10 units 0.029
packaging 2) 3RV19 27-5A 10 units 0.036
S0
3RV29 17-5CA00

Type Version For Order No. Standard Weight


contactors Pack approx.
Quantity
Size kg
Contactor bases
Contactor bases Single-unit S00 3RV29 17-7AA00 1 unit 0.042
for mounting packaging
direct-on-line or S00, S0 3RV29 27-7AA00 1 unit 0.050
reversing starters

3RV29 27-7AA00
1) I > 14 A, note derating; see the system manual "SIRIUS Innovations",
Chapter "Motor Starter Protectors".
2) I > 16 A, note derating; see the system manual "SIRIUS Innovations",
Chapter "Motor Starter Protectors".

1/20 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Product Category IEC
Illustrations are approximate SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 5/25
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
SIRIUS 3RV2 Motor Starter Protectors/Circuit Breakers up to 40 A
Accessories
Accessories
3RV29 infeed system
3RV29 infeed system

1
Type Version Order No. Standard Weight
Pack approx.
Quantity

PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
kg
Terminal blocks
Terminal blocks Single-unit packaging 3RV29 17-5D 1 unit 0.049
For integration of
single-phase, two-phase
and three-phase
components

3RV29 17-5D
45 mm standard mounting rails
45 mm standard Single-unit packaging 3RV19 17-7B 1 unit 0.261
mounting rails
for mounting onto
bus bar adapters

3RV19 17-7B
Extra-wide expansion plugs
Extra-wide expansion Single-unit packaging 3RV29 17-5E 1 unit 0.037
plugs as accessory
5

3RV29 17-5E
Expansion plugs
Expansion plugs1) Single-unit packaging 3RV29 17-5BA00 1 unit 0.026
as spare part

3RV29 17-5BA00
End covers
End covers2) Multi-unit packaging 3RV29 17-6A 10 units 0.005
as spare part

3RV29 17-6A
Terminal blocks for device infeed
Terminal blocks for Single-unit packaging 3RV29 17-5FA00 1 unit 0.010
device infeed

3RV29 17-FA00

1) The expansion plug is included in the scope of supply of the 3RV29 17-4
three-phase busbars for system expansion.
2) The end cover is included in the scope of supply of the 3RV29 17-1 three-
phase busbars with infeed system.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/21
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
5/26 SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 Illustrations are approximate
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
3RV — up to 100 A (Domestic applications)

Permissible rated data of devices approved for North America (UL/CSA)


Permissible rated data of devices approved for North America (UL/CSA)
1

Motor starter protectors of the 3RV2 series are approved for These motor starter protectors can be used as "Manual Motor
Motor starter protectors of the 3RV2 series are approved for These motor starter protectors can be used as "Manual Motor
UL/CSA, and according to UL508/UL 60947-4-1 and CSA C22.2 Controllers" for "Group Installations", as "Manual Motor Control-
UL/CSA, and according to UL508/UL 60947-4-1 and CSA C22.2 Controllers" for "Group Installations", as "Manual Motor Control-
No. 14/CSA C22.2 No. 60947-4-1 they can be used on their own lers Suitable
Suitable for Tap Conductor Protection in Group Installations"
MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS

No. 14/CSA C22.2 No. 60947-4-1 they can be used on their own lers for Tap Conductor Protection in Group Installations"
and as "Self-Protected Combination Motor Controllers" (Type E).
or as load feeders in combination with a contactor. and as "Self-Protected Combination Motor Controllers" (Type E).
or as load feeders in combination with a contactor.

3RV motor starter protectors as "Manual Motor Controllers"


3RV motor starter protectors as "Manual Motor Controllers"
If used as a "Manual Motor Controller", the motor starter protector Approval of the 3RV as a Manual Motor Controller can be found
If used as a "Manual Motor Controller", the motor starter protector Approval of the 3RV as a Manual Motor Controller can be found
is always operated in combination with an upstream short-circuit under the following file numbers:
is always operated in combination with an upstream short-circuit under the following file numbers:
protection device. Approved fuses or a circuit breaker accord- • UL File No. 47705, CCN: NLRV,
protection device. Approved fuses or a circuit breaker accord- • UL File No. 47705, CCN: NLRV,
ing to UL 489/CSA C22.2 No. 5 can be used. These devices
ing to UL 489/CSA C22.2 No. 5 can be used. These devices • CSA Master Contract 165071, Product Class: 3211 05.
must be dimensioned according to the National Electrical Code • CSA Master Contract 165071, Product Class: 3211 05.
must be dimensioned according to the National Electrical Code
(UL) or Canadian Electrical Code (CSA).
(UL) or Canadian Electrical Code (CSA).
1)
Motor starter hp rating1) for FLA2) Rated current 240 V AC 480 V AC 600 V AC
Motor starter
protectors hp rating for FLA2)
max. Rated
I current 240 V AC 480 V AC 600 V AC
protectors max. Inn UL/CSA
UL/CSA
UL/CSA
UL/CSA
UL/CSA
UL/CSA
Ibc3)
3) Ibc3)
3) Ibc3)
3)
Ibc Ibc Ibc
Type V 1-phase 3-phase A kA kA kA
Type V 1-phase 3-phase A kA kA kA
Size S00
Size S00
0.16 ... 2 65 65 30
3RV2011, 3RV2111, 3RV2311, 3RV2411 0.16 ... 2 65 65 30
3RV2011, 3RV2111, 3RV2311, 3RV2411 2.5 65 65 30
2.5 65
65 65
65 30
FLA2) max. 115 1 2 3.2 30
3.2 65 65 30
FLA2) max. 115
200 1
2 2
3 4 65 65 30
16 A,480 V 200 2 3 4 65 65 30
16 A,480 V 5 65 65 30
12.5 A, 600 V 230 2 5 5 65 65 30
12.5 A, 600 V 230 2 5 6.3 65 65 30
460 -- 10 6.3 65 65 30
460
575/600 --
-- 10
10 8 65 65 30
575/600 -- 10 8 65 65 30
30
10 65 65
10 65 65 30
30
12.5 65 65
12.5
16 65
65 65 30

65 —
16 65 65
Size S0
Size S0
3RV2021, 3RV2121, 3RV2321, 3RV2421 0.16 ... 12.5 65 65 30
3RV2021, 3RV2121, 3RV2321, 3RV2421 0.16
16 ......
2512.5 65
65 65
65 30 4)
--/(30)4)
2)
FLA2) max. 115 3 5 16
28,...3225 65
65 65
50 --/(30)
--
FLA max. 115
200 3
5 5
10 28,
36, 32
40 65
65 50
12 --
--
40 A, 480 V 200 5 10 36, 40 65 12 --
40 A, 480 V 230 7 1/2 10
230
460 7
-- 1/2 10
30
460
575/600 --
-- 30
--
575/600 -- --
Size S2 3RV2031 3RV2032 3RV2031 3RV2032 3RV2031 3RV2032
14 65 100 65 100 25 25
3RV2031, 3RV2131, 3RV2331, 3RV2032, 3RV2332 17 65 100 65 100 25 25
20 65 100 65 100 25 25
FLA 2) MAX. 65A 115/120 5 10 25 65 100 65 100 25 25
600V 200/208 10 20 32 65 100 65 100 25 25
NEMA size 2 230/240 15 25 36 65 100 65 100 25 25
460/480 — 50 40 65 100 65 100 22 22
575/600 — 60 45 65 100 65 100 22 22
52 65 100 65 100 22 22
a) with max 225A Class J fuse 59 65 a) 100 a) 65 a) 100 a) 20 a) 25 a)
b) with max 250A Class J fuse 65 65 b) 100 b) 65 b) 100 b) 20 b) 25 b)
Size S3
Size S3
3RV20 41/3RV20 42, 3RV21 42, 3RV23 41/3RV23 42 16 65 65 30
3RV20 41/3RV20 42, 3RV21 42, 3RV23 41/3RV23 42 16
20 65
65 65
65 30
30
2) max. 99 A,
FLA2) 115 7 1/2 -- 20
25 65
65 65
65 30
30
FLA
600 V max. 99 A, 115
200 7
201/2 --
30 25 65 65 30
600 V 200 20 30 32 65 65 30
NEMA size 3 230 20 40 32
40 65
65 65
65 30
30
NEMA size 3 230
460 20
-- 40
75 40
50 65
65 65
65 30
30
460
575/600 --
-- 75
100 50 65 65 30
575/600 -- 100 63 65 65 30
63
75 65
65 65
65 30
30
75
90 65
65 65
65 30
10
90
100 65
65 65
65 10
10
100 65 65 10
1)
1) HP rating = Power rating in horse power (maximum motor rating).
2)
HP rating = Power rating in horse power (maximum motor rating).
2) FLA = Full Load Amps/Motor full load current.
3)
FLA = Full Load Amps/Motor full load current.
3) Corresponds to "short-circuit breaking capacity" according to UL/CSA.
4)
Corresponds to "short-circuit breaking capacity" according to UL/CSA.
4) The values in brackets only apply to 3RV2.23 motor starter protectors.
The values in brackets only apply to 3RV2.23 motor starter protectors.

1/22 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
3RV — up to 100 A (Domestic applications)

1
3RV motor starter protectors as "Manual Motor Controllers Suitable for Tap Conductor Protection in Group Installations"
The application as "Manual Motor Controllers Suitable for Tap protector according to UL 489 can be used.

PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
Conductor Protection in Group Installations" is only available These devices must be dimensioned according to the National
from UL. Electrical Code.
CSA does not
3RV motor recognize
starter this as
protectors approval!
"ManualWhen Motorthe motor starter
Controllers Suitable for Tap Conductor Protection in Group Installations"
protector is used as a "Manual Motor Controller Suitable for Tap The 3RV motor starter protectors are approved as "Manual
The application
Conductor as "Manual
Protection Motor
in Group Controllers itSuitable
Installations", for Tap
must always be Motor Controllers
protector accordingSuitable for Tap
to UL 489 canConductor
be used. Protection in
Conductor
combined withProtection in Group
upstream Installations"
short-circuit is only
protection. Asavailable
short-cir- Group Installations"
These devices mustunder the following
be dimensioned file number:
according to the National
from UL.
cuit-protection device, approved fuses or a motor starter •Electrical
UL File Code.
No. 47705, CCN: NLRV.
CSA does not recognize this approval! When the motor starter
protector is used as a "ManualhpMotor The 3RV motor starter protectors are approved as "Manual
Motor starter ratingController
1) for FLA2) Suitable for Tap
Rated 240 V AC
Motor Up tofor
Controllers Suitable 480Y/277V AC
Tap Conductor UpProtection
to 600Y/347V
in AC
Conductor
protectors Protection in Group Installations", it must always
max. In
current be
combined with upstream short-circuit protection. As short-cir- Group
UL Installations" under
UL the following file ULnumber:
cuit-protection device, approved fuses or a motor starter I•bcUL
3)
Ibc3) NLRV.
File No. 47705, CCN: Ibc3)

Type V 1-phase 1) 3-phase2) A kA kA kA


Motor starter hp rating for FLA Rated 240 V AC Up to 480Y/277V AC Up to 600Y/347V AC
Size S00
protectors max. current In
UL UL UL
3RV20 11 0.16 ... 0.8 65 3) 65 3) 30 3)
1 I65
bc Ibc
65 I30
bc
FLA2) max.16 A, 115/120 1 2 1.25 65 65 30
Type
480 Y / 277 V V
200/208 1-phase
2 3-phase
3 A kA kA kA
2 65 65 30
Size S00
NEMA size 0 230/240 2 5 2.5 65 65 30
3RV20 11 460/480 -- 10 3.2 ... 0.8
0.16 65 65 30
575/600 -- 10 1
4 65
65 65
65 30
30
FLA2) max.16 A, 115/120 1 2 1.25
5 65
65 65
65 30
30
480 Y / 277 V 200/208 2 3 6.3
2 65 65 30
NEMA size 0 230/240 2 5 8
2.5 65 65 30
460/480 -- 10 16
3.2 65 65 —
30
Size S0 575/600 -- 10 4 65 65 30
3RV20 21 5
0.63 ... 1.6 65
65 65
65 30
30
6.3
2 65
65 65
65 30
30
2)
FLA max. 115/120 2 5 8
2.5 65
65 65
65 30
30
200/208 3 7.5 16 65 65 —
25 A, 480 Y / 277 V 3.2 65 65 30
Size S0
12.5 A, 600 V 230/240 3 10 4 65 65 30
3RV20 21 460/480 3 20 5
0.63 ... 1.6 65 65 30
NEMA size 1 575/600 — — 2
6.3 65
65 65
65 30
30
FLA2) max. 115/120 2 5 2.5
8 65
65 65
65 30
30
25 A, 480 Y / 277 V 200/208 3 7.5 10
3.2 65 65 30
12.5 A, 600 V 230/240 3 10 12.5
4 65 65 30
460/480 3 20 25
5 65 65 —
30
NEMA size 1 575/600 — — 32
6.3 50
65 50
65 —
30
Size
Size S2S2 8 65
3RV2031 3RV2032 65
3RV2031 3RV2032 30
3RV2031 3RV2032
10 65 65 30
3RV10 31 1614 65 100 65 100 25 25
12.5 65 65 30
3RV2031, 3RV2032, 3RV2431 2017 65 100 65 100 25 25
FLA2) max. 115 3 -- 25
25 65
65 65
65 —
25
50 3220 65
50 100 65
50 100 25
— 25
FLAA,2)600
MAX.V 65A 200
115/120 751/2 1510 3225 65 100 65 100 25 25
Size S2
NEMA
600V size 2 230
200/208 10 10 2020 4032 65
65 100 65
65 100 25
25 25
3RV10 31 2
NEMA size 460
230/240 --15 4025 4536
16 65
65 100 65
65 100 25
25 25
575/600 -- 50 50
20 65 65 25
2) max. 460/480 — 50 40 65 100 65 100 22 22
Size S3
FLA 115 3 -- 25 65 65 25
50 A, 600 V 575/600 7—
200 1/2 1560 45 65 100 65 100 22 22
3RV20 4. 32
1652 65
65 65
65 25
30
65 100 65 100 22 22
NEMA size 2 230 10 20 40
20 65
65 65
65 25
30
460 -- 1/2 40 4559 65
65 100 30
65 42 --
25 --
FLA2) max. 115/120 7 -- 25 65 65 30
575/600
200/208 --
20 50
30 5065 65 100 65
30 42 25
-- --
100 A, 480 V 32 65 65 30
Size
75 S3 V
A, 600 230/240 20 40 40 65 65 30
3RV20 4. 460/480 -- 75 50
16 65 65 30
NEMA size 3 575/600 -- 75 20
63 65
65 65
65 30
30
FLA2) max. 115/120 7 1/2 -- 25
75 65
65 65
65 30
30
100 A, 480 V 200/208 20 30 90
32 65 65 --
30
75 A, 600 V 230/240 20 40 100
40 65 65 --
30
460/480 -- 75 50 65 65 30
NEMA
1) size 3 575/600 -- 75
HP rating = Power rating in horse power (maximum motor rating).
63 65 65 30
2)
FLA = Full Load Amps/Motor full load current. 75 65 65 30
3) 90 65 65 --
Complies with "short-circuit breaking capacity" according to UL.
100 65 65 --

1)
HP rating = Power rating in horse power (maximum motor rating).
2) FLA = Full Load Amps/Motor full load current.
3) Complies with "short-circuit breaking capacity" according to UL.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/23
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
3RV — up to 100 A (Domestic applications)

3RV motor starter protectors as "Self-Protected Combination Motor Controllers (Type E)"
1

UL 508/UL 60947-4-1 approval demands 1-inch clearance and when the device is used as a “Self-Protected Combination Motor
2-inch creepage distance at line side for “Self-Protected Combination Controller”.
MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS

3RV motor
Motor starter
Controller protectors
Type E”. as "Self-Protected Combination Motor Controllers (Type E)"
The 3RV20 motor starter protectors are approved as “Self-Protected
Therefore, 3RV20 motor starter protectors of sizes S00 to S2 are Combination Motor Controllers” under the following file numbers:
approved according to UL 508/UL 60947-4-1 in combination with the • UL File No. E156943, CCN: NKJH
terminal blocks listed below.
• CSA Master Contract 165071, Product Class: 3211 08
CSA does not require these extended clearances and creepage
distances. According to CSA, these terminal blocks can be omitted

Motor starter hp rating1) for FLA2) Rated current Up to 240 V AC Up to 480 Y/277 V AC Up to 600 Y/347 V AC
protectors max. In UL/CSA Ibc3) UL/CSA Ibc3) UL/CSA Ibc3)
Type V 1-phase 3-phase A kA kA kA
Size S00
Motor starter hp rating1) for FLA2) Rated current Up to 240 V AC Up to 480 Y/277 V AC Up to 600 Y/347 V AC
protectors max. In UL/CSA Ibc3) UL/CSA Ibc3) Ibc3)
3RV2011 + 3RV29 28-1H4) 5) 0.16 ... 12.5 65 65 UL/CSA
30
Type2) V 1-phase 3-phase A
16 kA
65 kA
65 kA

FLA max. 16 A 115 1 2
Size S00
480 V 200 2 3
3RV2011 + 3RV29 28-1H4) 5) 0.16 ... 12.5 65 65 30
NEMA size 0 230 2 5
16 65 65 —
FLA2) max. 16 A 230
115 —
1 10
2
480 V 575/600
200 —
2 10
3
Size S0
NEMA size 0 230 2 5
3RV2021 + 3RV29 28-1H2304) 5) — 10 0.63 ... 1.6 65 65 30
575/600 — 10 2 65 65 30
FLA 2) max. 2.5 65 65 30
Size S0 115 2 5
25 A, 480 V 2004) 5) 3 7.5 3.2 65 65 30
3RV2021 + 3RV29
12.5 A, 600 V 28-1H
230 3 10 0.63
4 ... 1.6 65
65 65
65 30
30
2 65
65 65
65 30
2) max. 460 — 20 5 30
FLA 115 2 5 2.5 65 65 30
NEMA size 1 575/600 — — 6.3 65 65 30
25 A, 480 V 200 3 7.5 3.2 65 65 30
8 65 65 30
12.5 A, 600 V 230 3 10 4 65
65 65
65 30
10 30
460 — 20 5 65 65 30
NEMA size 1 575/600 — — 12.5 65 65 30
6.3 65
65 65
65 30
16 —
8 65
65 65
65 30
20 —
10 65
65 65
65 30

22
12.5
25 65 65 30

16
32 65
50 65
50 —
20 65 65 —
Size S2 22 65
3RV2031 3RV2032 65
3RV2031 3RV2032 —
3RV2031 3RV2032
25
14 65
65 100 6565 100 —
25 25
Size S2 32 50 50 —
3RV2031/3RV2032 + 3RV2938-1K 4) 17 65 100 65 100 25 25
3RV2031/3RV2032 + 3RV2938 16 65 65 25
20
20 6565 100 6565 100 25
25 25
FLA 2)
2) MAX. 65A 115/120 5 10 25
25 6565 100 6565 100 25
25 25
Size S2
FLA
600V
max. 115
200/208
3
10
--
20 32 65 100 65 100 25 25
50 A, 600 V 200 7 1/2 15 32 65 65 25
3RV2031/3RV2032
NEMA
NEMA size
size 22 + 3RV2938
230/240
230 15
10 25
20 16
36
40 65
6565 100 65
6565 100 25
25
25 25
460/480
460 —
-- 50
40 20
40
45 65
6565 100 65
6565 100 25
22
25 22
2)
FLA max. 115
575/600 3
-- --
50 25
50 65 65 25
575/600 — 60 45 6565 100 6565 100 25
22 22
50 A, 600 15
Size S3 V 200 7 1/2 32
52 6565 100 6565 100 25
22 22
NEMA size 2 230 10 20 40 65 65 25
3RV2041 + 3RT2946-4GA07 4) 59
16 6565 100 2065 30 —30 —
460 -- 40 45 25
575/600 -- 50 20
65
50 6565 100 2065 30 —30
25 —
2) 25 65 65 30
Size S3
FLA max. 115 10 --
100 A, 480 V 200 4) 20 30 32 65 65 30
3RV2041 + 3RT2946-4GA07
230 20 40 16
40 65
65 65
65 30
30
75 A, 600 V 20 65 65 30
460 -- 75 50 65 65 30
FLA2) max.
NEMA size 3 115
575/600 10
-- --
75 25 65 65 30
200 20 30 63 65 65 30
100 A, 480 V 32
75 65
65 65
65 30
30
75 A, 600 V 230 20 40 40
90 65
65 65
65 30

460 -- 75 50
100 65
65 65
65 30

NEMA size 3 575/600 -- 75 63 65 65 30
Ratings of the auxiliary switches Lateral auxiliary65
75 switch with Transverse
65 auxiliary Transverse
30
and alarm switches 1 NO + 1 NC, 2 NO,
90 65 2 NC, switch
65 with auxiliary
— switch with
2
100 NO + 2 NC and signalling
65 switch 1 changeover
65 contact 1—NO + 1 NC, 2 NO
Ratings
Max. ratedof the auxiliary
voltage switches
• to NEMA u AC V 600
Lateral auxiliary switch with Transverse auxiliary 250
Transverse
and alarm switches • to NEMA s AC V 1600
NO + 1 NC, 2 NO, 2 NC, switch with 250
auxiliary switch with
Uninterrupted current A 210NO + 2 NC and signalling switch 1
5 changeover contact 1 NO + 1 NC, 2 NO
2.5
Breaking
Max. rated capacity
voltage • to NEMA u AC V A600
600 B600 C300
250
Q300 R300 R300
• to NEMA s AC V 600 250
1) HP rating = Power rating in horse power (maximum motor rating). 3) Corresponds to "short-circuit breaking capacity" according to UL/CSA.
U n i n t e r r u p t e d c u rre n t
2) FLA = Full Load Amps/Motor full load current. A 10 5
4) Not required for CSA. 2.5
Breaking capacity A600 B600 C300
5) Alternatively, the 3RV2928-1K phase barrier can also be used.
Q300 R300 R300
1) HP rating = Power rating in horse power (maximum motor rating). 3) Corresponds to "short-circuit breaking capacity" according to UL/CSA.
2) FLA = Full Load Amps/Motor full load current. 4) Not required for CSA.
5) Alternatively, the 3RV2928-1K phase barrier can also be used.

1/24 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
3RV27/28 circuit breakers

3RV27/28 circuit breakers

1
These circuit breakers are approved according to UL 489 and The 3RV27/28 circuit breakers are approved under the
CSA C22.2 No. 5-02 for 100 % rated current (100 % rated following file numbers:

PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
breaker). They can be used therefore as upstream short-circuit • UL File No. E235044, CCN: DIVQ,
protective devices for "Manual Motor Controllers" and "Manual
Motor Controllers Suitable for Tap Conductor Protection in • CSA Master Contract 165071, Product Class: 1432 01.
Group Installations".
Circuit breakers Rated 240 V AC 480 Y/277 V AC 480 V AC 600 Y/347 V AC
current In UL/CSA UL/CSA UL/CSA UL/CSA
Type A I bc1) kA Ibc1) kA Ibc1) kA Ibc1) kA
Size S00/S0
3RV27 11 / 3RV28 11 0.16 … 1.25 65 65 — 10
3RV27 21 / 3RV28 21 1.6 65 65 — 10
2 65 65 — 10
2.5 65 65 — 10
3.2 65 65 — 10
4 65 65 — 10
5 65 65 — 10
6.3 65 65 — 10
8 65 65 — 10
10 65 65 — 10
12.5 65 65 — 10
15 65 65 — --
20 50 50 — --
22 50 50 — --
Size S3
3RV27 42 10 65 65 65 20
15 65 65 65 20
20 65 65 65 20
25 65 65 65 20
30 65 65 65 20
35 65 65 — 20
40 65 65 — 20
45 65 65 — 20
50 65 65 — 20
60 65 65 — 20
70 65 65 — 10
1) Complies with "short-circuit breaking capacity" according to UL.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/25
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
3RV — up to 100 A (Export applications)

Technical specifications
1

Short-circuit breaking capacity Icu, Ics acc. to IEC 60947-2 table, a back-up fuse is required. It is also possible to install an
MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS

This table shows the rated ultimate short-circuit breaking upstream motor starter protector/circuit breaker with a limiter
capacity Icu and the rated service short-circuit breaking function.
capacity Ics of the 3RV2 motor starter protectors/circuit breakers
with different inception voltages dependent of the rated current The maximum rated current for the back-up fuse is specified in
In of the motor starter protectors/circuit breakers. the tables. The rated ultimate short-circuit breaking capacity
then applies as specified on the fuse.
Power can be supplied to the motor starter protectors/circuit
Fuseless construction
breakers via the terminals at the top or at the bottom without
restricting the rated data. If the short-circuit current at the place Motor starter protector contactor combinations for short-circuit
of installation exceeds the rated short-circuit breaking capacity currents up to 150 kA can be ordered in the form of fuseless load
of the motor starter protector/circuit breaker as specified in the feeders according to Chapter 6.

Motor starter Rated current Up to 240 V AC1) Up to Up to Up to Up to 690 V AC1)


protectors/circuit In 400 V1)/415 V AC2) 440 V1)/460 V AC2) 500 V1)/525 V AC2)
breakers (these values do not apply to 3RV17 42 circuit breakers)
Icu Ics Max. fuse Icu Ics Max. fuse Icu Ics Max. fuse Icu Ics Max. fuse Icu Ics Max.
(gL/gG) (gL/gG)3) (gL/gG)3) (gL/gG)3) fuse
(gL/gG)3)4)

Type A kA kA A kA kA A kA kA A kA kA A kA kA A
Size S00
3RV2.11 0.16 ... 1 100 100 ° 100 100 ° 100 100 ° 100 100 ° 100 100 °
1.25; 1.6 100 100 ° 100 100 ° 100 100 ° 100 100 ° 100 100 °
2; 2.5 100 100 ° 100 100 ° 100 100 ° 100 100 ° 10 10 25
3.2; 4 100 100 ° 100 100 ° 50 10 ° 100 100 ° 10; 6 10; 4 32
5; 6.3 100 100 ° 100 100 ° 50 10 ° 100 100 ° 6 4 32
8 100 100 ° 50 12.5 ° 50 50 63 42 42 63 6 4 50
10 100 100 ° 50 12.5 ° 50 50 80 42 42 63 6 4 50
12 100 100 ° 50 12.5 ° 50 50 80 42 42 80 4 4 63
16 100 100 ° 55 30 100 50 10 80 10 5 80 4 4 63
Size S0
3RV2.21 16 100 100 ° 55 25 100 50 10 80 10 5 80 4 2 63
20 100 100 ° 55 25 125 50 10 80 10 5 80 4 2 63
22 100 100 ° 55 25 125 50 10 100 10 5 80 4 2 63
25 100 100 ° 55 25 125 50 10 100 10 5 80 4 2 63
28 100 100 ° 55 25 125 30 10 125 10 5 100 4 2 100
32 100 100 ° 55 25 125 30 10 125 10 5 100 4 2 100
36 100 100 ° 20 10 125 12 8 125 6 3 100 3 2 100
40 100 100 ° 20 10 125 12 8 125 6 3 100 3 2 100
Size S2
3RV2.31 14; 17 100 100 ° 65 30 100 50 25 100 12 6 63 5 3 63
20 100 100 ° 65 30 100 50 25 100 12 6 80 5 3 80
25 100 100 ° 65 30 100 50 15 100 12 6 80 5 3 80
32; 36 100 100 ° 65 30 125 50 15 125 10 5 100 4 2 100
40; 45 100 100 ° 65 30 160 50 15 125 10 5 100 4 2 100
52 100 100 ° 65 30 160 50 15 125 10 5 125 4 2 125
59 ... 80 Values on request
Size S2, with increased
switching capacity
3RV2.32 14; 17 100 100 ° 100 50 ° 65 30 100 18 10 63 8 5 63
20; 25 100 100 ° 100 50 ° 65 30 100 18 10 80 8 5 80
32 ... 45 100 100 ° 100 50 ° 65 30 125 15 8 100 6 4 100
52 100 100 ° 100 50 ° 65 30 125 15 8 125 6 4 125
59 ... 80 Values on request
Size S3
3RV2. 41 40 100 100 ° 50 25 125 50 20 125 12 6 100 6 3 63
50 100 100 ° 50 25 125 50 20 125 12 6 100 6 3 80
63 100 100 ° 50 25 160 50 20 160 12 6 100 6 3 80
75 100 100 ° 50 25 160 50 20 160 8 4 125 5 3 100
90; 100 100 100 ° 50 25 160 50 20 160 8 4 125 5 3 125

Short-circuit resistant up to at least 50 kA


° No back-up fuse required, since short-circuit resistant up to 100 kA
1)
10 % overvoltage. 4)
Alternatively, fuseless limiter combinations for 690 V AC can also be used.
2)
5 % overvoltage.
3)
Back-up fuse only required if the short-circuit current at the place of
installation > Icu.

1/26 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
3RV — up to 100 A (Export applications)

Short-circuit breaking capacity IcuIT in the IT system In the colored areas, IcuIT is 100 kA, or in some ranges it is

1
(IT network) according to IEC 60947-2 50 kA. Therefore the motor starter protectors are short-circuit re-
sistant in these ranges.

PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
3RV motor starter protectors are suitable for operation in
IT systems. Values valid for triple-pole short-circuit are Icu up to If the short-circuit current at the place of installation exceeds the
Ics. In case of double ground fault on different phases at the in- rated short-circuit breaking capacity of the motor starter protec-
put and output side of a motor starter protector, the special tor as specified in the table, a back-up fuse is required. The max-
short-circuit breaking capacity IcuIT applies. The specifications imum rated current for the back-up fuse is specified in the ta-
in the table below apply to 3RV motor starter protectors. bles. The rated short-circuit breaking capacity then applies as
specified on the fuse.

Motor starter Rated current Up to 240 V AC1) Up to 400 V1)/415 V AC2) Up to 500 V1)/525 V AC2) Up to 690 V AC1) 5)
protectors In IcuIT Max. fuse IcuIT Max. fuse IcuIT Max. fuse IcuIT Max. fuse
(gL/gG)3) (gL/gG)3)4) (gL/gG)3) (gL/gG)3)

Type A kA A kA A kA A kA A
Size S00
3RV20, 0.16 ... 0.63 100 ° 100 ° On request On request On request On request
3RV26 11-0BD10 0.8; 1 100 ° 100 °
1.25; 1.6 100 ° 100 °
2; 2.5 100 ° 8 25
3.2; 4 100 ° 8;4 32
5; 6.3 100 ° 4 32:50
8; 10 100 ° 4 50
12.5 100 ° 4 63
16 55 80 4 63
Size S0
3RV2.21 16 55 80 4 63 2 50 1.5 40
20 55 80 4 63 2 50 1.5 50
22 55 80 4 63 2 50 1.5 50
25 55 80 4 63 2 50 1.5 50
28 55 80 2 63 2 63 1.5 63
32 55 80 2 63 2 63 1.5 63
36 20 80 2 63 2 63 1.5 63
40 20 80 2 63 2 63 1.5 63
Size S2
3RV2.31 14...25 100 ° 8 100 6 80 4 63
32...45 100 ° 6 125 4 100 3 80
52 100 ° 4 160 3 125 2 100
59 ... 80 Values on request
Size S2, with increased
switching capacity
3RV2.32 14 ... 25 100 ° 8 100 6 80 4 63
32 ... 45 100 ° 6 125 6 100 4 80
52 100 ° 6 160 6 125 4 100
59 ... 80 Values on request
Size S3
3RV2. 41 40 50 125 10 63 5 50 5 50
50 50 125 8 80 3 63 3 63
63 50 160 6 80 3 63 3 63
75 50 160 5 100 2 80 2 80
90; 100 50 160 5 125 2 100 2 100

Short-circuit resistant up to at least 50 kA


° No back-up fuse required, since short-circuit resistant up to 100 kA
1)
10 % overvoltage.
2)
5 % overvoltage.
3) Back-up fuse only required, if short-circuit current at the place of
installation > IcuIT.
4)
Alternatively, fuseless limiter combinations for 690 V AC can also be used.
5)
Over-voltage category II applies for applications on IT systems > 600V

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/27
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
3RV — up to 100 A

Technical data
1

Rules for mounting motor starter protectors/circuit breakers


MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS

When mounting MSPs, the following clearance must be maintained to grounded or live
parts.
SIRIUS MSP Clearance to grounded or live parts Minimum clearance between MSPs and grounded
Y X at the side Z or live parts
Type size mm mm mm
3RV2.1 S00 up to 690 V 30 70 9
3RV2. 2 S0 2) up to 500 V 30 90 9
up to 690 V 50 1) 90 30
3RV2. 3 S2 up to 690 V 50 — 10
3RV2. 4 S3 up to 240 V 50 167 10
up to 440 V 70 167 10
up to 500 V 110 167 10
up to 690 V 150 167 30
3RV27 42 S3 up to 240 V 90 167 10
up to 400 V 90 167 10

1) Up to and including the setting range of 32 A. For the 36/40 A setting range the clearance is 70 mm.
2) In conjunction with the type E terminal block 3RV2928-1H the applicable lateral clearance is 30 mm for all voltages.

Standard mounting for S0, S2 and S3

Wiring module

Size S0: 3RV19 15-1AB

Size S2: 3RV19 35-1A

Size S3: 3RA19 43-3D


(Caution: The wiring module demands
10 mm spacing between the MSPs)

Line Load side


side

1/28 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
© Siemens AG 2015
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
Motor Starter
General Data Protectors/Circuit Breakers
SIRIUS 3RV2 Motor Starter Protectors/Circuit Breakers up to 80 A
3RV — up to 80 A
General data

General data

1
Type 3RV2.1. 3RV2.2. 3RV2.3. 3RV27, 3RV28

PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
Size S00 S0 S2 S00, S0

H
Dimensions (W x H x D)
• Screw terminals mm 45 x 97 x 91 45 x 97 x 91 55 x 140 x 149 45 x 144 x 92

D
W
• Spring-type terminals mm 45 x 106 x 91 45 x 119 x 91 -- --
Standards
• IEC 60947-1, EN 60947-1 (VDE 0660 Part 100) Yes
• IEC 60947-2, EN 60947-2 (VDE 0660 Part 101) Yes
• IEC 60947-4-1, EN 60947-4-1 (VDE 0660 Part 102) Yes Yes Yes --
• UL 508/UL 60947-4-1, CSA C22.2 No. 14/CSA C22.2 No. 60947-4-1 Yes Yes Yes --
• UL 489, CSA C22.2 No. 5 -- -- -- Yes
Number of poles 3
Max. rated current In max A 16 40 80 22
(= max. rated operational current Ie)
Permissible ambient temperature
• Storage/transport °C –50 ... +80
• Operation In: 0.16 ... 32 A °C –20 ... +70 --
(current reduction above +60 °C)
In: 36 ... 40 A °C -- –20 ... +40 --
(the devices must
not be mounted
side-by-side and
they must not be
assembled with
link modules with
contactors.
A lateral clear-
ance of 9 mm is
required.)
In: 14 ... 80 A °C -- –20 ... +70 --
7

(current reduction
above +60 °C)
Permissible rated current at inside temperature of control cabinet
• +60 °C % 100
• +70 °C % 87
Permissible rated current at ambient temperature of enclosure
(applies for motor starter protector/circuit breaker inside enclosure ≤ 32 A)
• +35 °C % 100 On 100
• +60 °C % 87 request 87
Rated operational voltage Ue
• Acc. to IEC V AC 690 (when a molded-plastic enclosure is used only 500 V)
• Acc. to UL/CSA V AC 600
Rated frequency Hz 50/60
Rated insulation voltage Ui V 690
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 6
Utilization category
• IEC 60947-2 (motor starter protector/circuit breaker) A
• IEC 60947-4-1 (motor starter) AC-3
Trip class CLASS Acc. to IEC 60947-4-1 10 10/20 --
DC short-circuit breaking capacity (time constant t = 5 ms)
• 1 conducting path 150 V DC kA 10 On 10
• 2 conducting paths in series 300 V DC kA 10 request 10
• 3 conducting paths in series 450 V DC kA 10 10
Power loss Pv for each motor starter In: 0.16 ... 0.63 A W 5 -- 5
protector/circuit breaker In: 0.8 ... 6.3 A W 6 -- 6
Dependent on In: 8 ... 16 A W 7 -- 7
the rated current In In: 16 A W -- 7 10 7
(upper setting range)
In: 17 ... 25 A W -- 8 12 8
P In: 28 ... 32 A
R per conducting path = -------------- W -- 11 14 --
Ι 2× 3 In: 36 ... 40 A W -- 14 15 --
In: 45 ... 52 A W -- -- 17 --
In: ... 80 A W -- -- On request --
Shock resistance Acc. to IEC 60068-2-27 g/ms 25/11 (square and sine pulse)
Protection class IP on the front Acc. to IEC 60529 IP20
Touch protection Acc. to EN 50274 Finger-safe for vertical contact from the front
Temperature compensation Acc. to IEC 60947-4-1 °C –20 ... +60
Phase failure sensitivity Acc. to IEC 60947-4-1 Yes (only for 3RV23 motor starter protectors) No
Explosion protection – Safe operation of motors with Yes (only for 3RV20 motor starter protectors)
"increased safety" type of protection
EC type test certificate number according to DMT 02 ATEX F 001 II (2) GD On request No
directive 94/9/EC (ATEX)

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/29
7/16 Siemens IC 10 · 2015
© Siemens AG 2015
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data Motor Starter Protectors/Circuit Breakers
SIRIUS 3RV2 Motor Starter Protectors/Circuit Breakers up to 80 A
3RV — up to 80 A
General data

Conductor cross-sections of main circuit


1

Type 3RV2.11 3RV2.21 3RV2.31-4B1., 3RV2.31-4J.1., 3RV27, 3RV28


3RV2.31-4D.1., 3RV2.31-4K.1.,
MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS

3RV2.31-4E.1., 3RV2.31-4R.1.,
3RV2.31-4P.1., 3RV2.31-4W.1.,
3RV2.31-4S.1., 3RV2.31-4X.1.,
3RV2.31-4T.1., 3RV2431-4VA1.,
3RV2.31-4U.1., 3RV2.32
3RV2.31-4V.1.
Size S00 S0 S2 S00, S0
Connection type Screw terminals

Terminal screw M3, M4, M6, M4,


Pozidriv size 2 Pozidriv size 2 Pozidriv size 2 Pozidriv size 2
Operating devices mm ∅ 5 ... 6 ∅ 5 ... 6 ∅ 5 ... 6 ∅ 5 ... 6
Prescribed tightening torque Nm 0.8 ... 1.2 2 ... 2.5 3.0 ... 4.5 2.5 ... 3
Conductor cross-sections (min./max.),
1 or 2 conductors can be connected
• Solid or stranded mm2 2 x (0.75 ... 2.5)1), 2 x (1 ... 2.5)1), 2 x (1 ... 25)1), 2 x (1 ... 35)1), 2 x (1 ... 10)1),
2x4 2 x (2.5 ... 10)1) 1 x (1 ... 35)1) 1 x (1 ... 50)1) max. 1 x 25
• Finely stranded with end sleeve (DIN 46228-1) mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5)1), 2 x (1 ... 2.5)1), 2 x (1 ... 16)1), 2 x (1 ... 25)1), 1 x (1 ... 16),
2 x (0.75 ... 2.5)1) 2 x (2.5 ... 6)1), 1 x (1 ... 25)1) 1 x (1 ... 35)1) max. 6 + 16
1 x 10
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 2 x (20 ... 16)1), 2 x (16 ... 12)1), 2 x (18 ... 3)1), 2 x (18 ... 2)1), 2 x (14 ... 10)
2 x (18 ... 12)1) 2 x (14 ... 8)1) 1 x (18 ... 2)1) 1 x (18 ... 1)1)
Connection type Spring-type terminals

Operating devices mm 3.0 x 0.5 and 3.5 x 0.5


Conductor cross-sections (min./max.),

7
1 or 2 conductors can be connected
• Solid or stranded mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 4) 2 x (1 ... 10) --
• Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 2.5) 2 x (1 ... 6) --
• Finely stranded with end sleeve (DIN 46228-11) mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 2.5) 2 x (1 ... 6) --
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 2 x (20 ... 12) 2 x (18 ... 8) --
Max. external diameter of the conductor insulation mm 3.6 3.6 --
Connection type Ring terminal lug connections

Terminal screw M3, M4, --


Pozidriv size 2 Pozidriv size 2
Operating devices mm ∅ 5 ... 6 ∅ 5 ... 6 --
Prescribed tightening torque Nm 0.8 ... 1.2 2 ... 2.5 --
Usable ring terminal lugs d3 mm d2 = min. 3.2, d2 = min. 4.3, --
• DIN 46234 without d2 d3 = max. 7.5 d3 = max. 12.2
insulation sleeve
• DIN 46225 without
insulation sleeve
• DIN 46237 with insulation sleeve
I201_12740

• JIS C2805 Type R without


insulation sleeve
• JIS C2805 Type RAV with
insulation sleeve
• JIS C2805 Type RAP with
insulation sleeve
1)
If two different conductor cross-sections are connected to one clamping
point, both cross-sections must be in the range specified.

1/30 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Siemens IC 10 · 2015 7/19
© Siemens AG 2015
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data Motor Starter Protectors/Circuit Breakers
SIRIUS 3RV2 Motor Starter Protectors/Circuit Breakers up to 80 A
3RV — up to 80 A
General data

1
3RV2.1. 3RV2.2. 3RV2.3. 3RV27, 3RV28
S00 S0 S2 S00, S0
Front transverse auxiliary switches

PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
Switching capacity for different voltages
1 CO 1 NO + 1 NC, 2 NO
Rated operational current Ie
• At AC-15, alternating voltage
- 24 V A 4 2
- 230 V A 3 0.5
• At AC-12 = Ith, alternating voltage
- 24 V A 10 2.5
- 230 V A 10 2.5
• At DC-13, direct voltage L/R 200 ms
- 24 V A 1 1
- 48 V A -- 0.3
- 60 V A -- 0.15
- 110 V A 0.22 --
- 220 V A 0.1 --
Minimum load capacity V 17
mA 1
Front transverse solid-state compatible auxiliary switches
Switching capacity for different voltages
1 CO
Rated operational voltage Ue Alternating voltage V 125
Rated operational current Ie/AC-14 at Ue = 125 V A 0.1
Rated operational voltage Ue Direct voltage L/R 200 ms V 60

7
Rated operational current Ie/DC-13 at Ue = 60 V A 0.3
Minimum load capacity V 5
mA 1
Lateral auxiliary switches with signaling switch
Switching capacity for different voltages:
Lateral auxiliary switch with 1 NO + 1 NC, 2 NO, 2 NC, 2 NO + 2 NC
Signaling switch
Rated operational current Ie
• At AC-15, alternating voltage
- 24 V A 6
- 230 V A 4
- 400 V A 3
- 690 V A 1
• At AC-12 = Ith, alternating voltage
- 24 V A 10
- 230 V A 10
- 400 V A 10
- 690 V A 10
• At DC-13, direct voltage L/R 200 ms
- 24 V A 2
- 110 V A 0.5
- 220 V A 0.25
- 440 V A 0.1
Minimum load capacity V 17
mA 1
Auxiliary releases
Undervoltage releases Shunt releases
Power consumption
• During pick-up
- A C vo lt a g es VA/W 20.2/13 20.2/13
- DC voltages W 20 13 ... 80
• During uninterrupted duty
- A C vo lt a g es VA/W 7.2/2.4 --
- DC voltages W 2.1 --
Response voltage
• T ripping V 0.35 ... 0.7 x Us 0.7 ... 1.1 x Us
• Pick-up V 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us --
Opening time maximum ms 20

Short-circuit protection for auxiliary and control circuits


Melting fuses operational class gG A 10
Miniature circuit breakers C characteristic A 6 (prospective short-circuit current < 0.4 kA)

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/31
Siemens IC 10 · 2015 7/17
© Siemens AG 2015
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
Motor Starter
General Data Protectors/Circuit Breakers
SIRIUS 3RV2 Motor Starter Protectors/Circuit Breakers up to 80 A
3RV — up to 80 A
General data

Conductor cross-sections for auxiliary and control circuits


1

Type 3RV2.11 3RV2.21 3RV2.31, 3RV2.32 3RV27, 3RV28


MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS

Size S00 S0 S2 S00, S0


Connection type Screw terminals

Terminal screw M3, Pozidriv size 2


Operating devices mm ∅ 5 ... 6
Prescribed tightening torque Nm 0.8 ... 1.2
Conductor cross-sections (min./max.), 1 or 2 conductors can be connected
• Solid or stranded mm 2 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5)1), 2 x (0.75 ... 2.5)1)
• Finely stranded with end sleeve (DIN 46228-1) mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5)1), 2 x (0.75 ... 2.5)1)
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 2 x (18 ... 14)1), 2 x (20 ... 16)1)
Connection type Spring-type terminals

Operating devices mm 3.0 x 0.5 and 3.5 x 0.5


Conductor cross-sections (min./max.), 1 or 2 conductors can be connected
• Solid or stranded mm 2 2 x (0.5 ... 2.5)
• Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 2.5)
• Finely stranded with end sleeve (DIN 46228-1) mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5)
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 2 x (20 ... 14)
Max. external diameter of the conductor insulation mm 3.6
Connection type Ring terminal lug connections

Terminal screw M3, Pozidriv size 2


Operating devices mm ∅ 5 ... 6
7

Tightening torque Nm 0.8 ... 1.2


Usable ring terminal lugs d3 mm d2 = min. 3.2, d3 = max. 7.5
• DIN 46234 without insulation sleeve d2
• DIN 46225 without insulation sleeve
• DIN 46237 with insulation sleeve
• JIS C2805 Type R without insulation sleeve
I201_12740

• JIS C2805 Type RAV with insulation sleeve


• JIS C2805 Type RAP with insulation sleeve
1)
If two different conductor cross-sections are connected to one clamping
point, both cross-sections must be in the range specified.

Terminals for "Self-Protected Combination Motor Controllers (Type E)


according to UL 508/UL 60947-4-1"
Type 3RV2928-1H
Prescribed tightening torque Nm 2.5 ... 3
Conductor cross-sections
• Front clamping point connected
- Solid mm² 1 ... 10
- Finely stranded with end sleeve mm² 1 ... 16
NSB0_00479

- Stranded m m² 2.5 ... 25


- AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 14 ... 3
- Terminal screw M4
• Rear clamping point connected
- Solid mm² 1 ... 10
- Finely stranded with end sleeve mm² 1 ... 16
NSB0_00480

- Stranded m m² 1.5 ... 25


- AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 14 ... 6
- Terminal screw M4
• Both clamping points connected
- Front clamping point:
Solid mm² 1 ... 10
1 ... 101), 1 ... 61)
NSB0_00481

Finely stranded with end sleeve mm²


Stranded mm² 2.5 ... 10
AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 14 ... 6
Terminal screw M4
- Rear clamping point:
Solid mm² 1 ... 10
Finely stranded with end sleeve mm² 1 ... 101), 1 ... 161)
Stranded mm² 2.5 ... 10
AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 16 ... 3
Terminal screw M4
1)
The following can be connected when both clamping points are connected:
- Front 1 ... 10 mm² and rear 1 ... 10 mm²
- Front 1 ... 6 mm² and rear 1 ... 16 mm²

1/32 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
7/20 Siemens IC 10 · 2015
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
3RV — up to 100 A

Overview

1
S00 MSP with laterally mounted Construction
undervoltage release with leading 3RV Motor Starter Protectors The motor starter protectors are • Size S2 - 3RV203

PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
auxiliary switch
(MSPs) are built for a world of available in four sizes: Maximum rated current is 50
applications while meeting the Amps. Suitable for motors up
requirements of control users to 50 HP at 600V.
worldwide. Each MSP features • Size S00 - 3RV201
a manual ON/OFF switch, a Maximum rated current is 16 • Size S3 - 3RV204
Class 10 adjustable bimetallic Amps. Suitable for motors up Maximum rated current is
overload relay (Class 20 avail- to 10 HP at 600V. Available in 100 Amps. Suitable for
able in the two largest frame both screw terminal and spring- motors up to 100 HP at 600V.
sizes), and magnetic trip ele- type terminal versions.
ments for short circuit protec- • Size S0 - 3RV202
tion. Maximum rated current is 40
Amps. Suitable for motors up
to 20 HP at 600V. Available in
both screw terminal and spring-
type terminal verisons.

Functions
Releases Release classes Operating mechanisms
3RV motor starter protectors The release classes of thermally S00, S0, S2 and S3 MSPs are In the case of MSPs with
are equipped with bimetallic- delayed releases are based on actuated via a rotary operating rotary operating mechanisms,
based, inverse-time delayed the tripping time (tA) at 7.2 times mechanism. If the MSP trips, an electrical signal can be out-
overload releases - electromag- the operational current in cold the rotary operating mechanism put via a signalling switch to
netic short-circuit releases. state (excerpt from IEC 60 947- switches to the tripped position indicate that the MSP has
4): to indicate this. Before the MSP tripped.
The overload releases can be
set in accordance with the load • CLASS 10 A 2 s < tA < 10 s is reclosed, the rotary operating All operating mechanisms can
current. The overcurrent re- • CLASS 10 4 s < tA < 10 s mechanism must be reset man- be locked in 0 position with a
leases are permanently set to a • CLASS 20 6 s < tA < 20 s ually to 0 position, in order to padlock (shackle diameter
value 13 times the rated current • CLASS 30 9 s < tA < 30 s prevent the former from closing 3.5 to 4.5 mm).
and thus enable trouble-free by mistake before the fault has
start-up of motors. The release must trip within this
been cleared.
time!
The scale cover can be sealed
to prevent unauthorized adjust-
ments to the set current.

Application
Operating conditions Motor Protection
3RV MSPs are suitable for use 3RV MSPs use bimetallic Each MSP has a fourth bimetal- A built-in differential trip bar
in any climate. They are heater elements to provide lic strip that reacts only to the causes the MSP to trip faster
designed for operation in class 10 or 20 overcurrent pro- ambient temperature inside the on a phase loss condition, to
closed rooms under normal tection for both AC and DC control panel. This ambient help reduce motor damage
conditions (e.g. no dust, corro- motors. The bimetallic heaters compensation prevents the from phase loss.
sive vapours or harmful gases). sense the motor current MSP from nuisance tripping
Suitable enclosures must be directly, so the overloads are when the panel temperature is Magnetic trip elements in each
higher than the ambient tem- MSP take the device off line
provided for installation in dusty insensitive to high frequencies,
or damp rooms. harmonic waves and sinusoi- perature of the motor. when it senses currents of 13
dal currents and voltages. times the maximum FLA dial
setting.

3RT2 0 1 1 - 0 A A 1 0
SIRIUS MSP or Application Frame Size Standard Amperage Range Class Terminal Type Auxiliary
Circuit Breaker 0 = Motor Protection 3 = S2 Possible choices listed below see A = 10 1 = Screw Switch
7 = UL 489 4 = S3 page 1/4-1/7 for an entire listing 2 = Spring Loaded
0, 1, 4 B through K 4 = Ring Lug
3RV2 0 1 1 - 0 A A 1 0
SIRIUS Application Frame Size Standard Amperage Range Class Terminal Type Auxiliary
Innovations 0 = Motor Protection 1 = S00 Possible choices listed below see A = 10 1 = Screw Switch
MSP or 7 = UL 489 2 = S0 page 1/4-1/7 for an entire listing B = 20 2 = Spring Loaded
Circuit Breaker
3 = S2 0, 1, 4 B through K 4 = Ring Lug
4 = S3

Note: MPSs and Contactors of the same frame size are made to easily fit together with the use of a link module.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/33
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
Mounting accessories

Applications:
1

The 3RV MSPs can be used


in a variety of applications:
MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS

As a manual starter As a Self-protected manual As part of a Combination As a circuit breaker for export
combination starter, Type E. Motor Contoller, Type F When exporting to many coun-
All 3RV MSPs are UL listed as
Manual Motor Controllers per Most 3RV MSPs have also been When a 3RT contactor is con- tries outside of the U.S. and
UL508. This makes them ideal UL listed as UL508 Type E, Self- nected to the load side of a 3RV North America, the 3RV can be
for applications requiring sim- protected Manual Combination device that is rated as a "Man- applied as a thermal magnetic
ple manual starting and stop- Starters. This UL listing allows ual Self-protected Combination circuit breaker for use in motor
ping of motors. A separate the MSP to be mounted in a Motor Controller, Type E", the branch circuits.
short circuit protective device, manually operated machine assembly can be applied as a 3RV29 28-1K 3RV29 38-1K
such as a circuit breaker or without having to add separate "Combination Motor Controller,
fuses, is still required ahead of short circuit protection Type F". This versions allows
the MSP. This up-stream pro- upstream. for remote starting and stopping
tective device should be sized of the motor load.
per NEC code, not to exceed These devices have a short cir-
400% of the maximum FLA cuit current rating of 65 kA @ These assemblies have a short
adjustment dial setting. 240V, 480Y/277V and up to circuit current rating of 65 kA @
30kA @ 600Y/347V. 240V, 480Y/277V and up to 30
As a component in a group kA @ 600Y/347V.
installation Terminals for "Combination Motor Controller Type E" to UL 508
A group motor installation indi- The 3RV MSP for motor protec- The terminal block 3RT29 46- 3RV29 28-1H
cates multiple motor controllers tion is approved according to 4GA07 must be used for size
under one short circuit protec- UL 508 as "Combination Motor S3. The standard box terminal is
tive device, such as a circuit Controller Type E". to be replaced by this terminal
breaker. 3RV MSPs have a block.
group installation short-circuit As of July, 2001, UL 508
current rating of 65 kA at 480V demands at line-side of the According to CSA, these termi-
and up to 30kA at 600V. By device used for this purpose an nal blocks can be omitted when
using a link module, a 3RT con- increased clearance and creep- the device is used as "Combina-
tactor can be directly mounted age distance (1" or 2"). tion Motor Controller Type E".
to the load side of the MSP. 3RT29 46-4GA07
Here, the terminal block 3RV29 By using a link module, a 3RT
3RV MSPs have been UL 28-1H must be used for size S0. contactor can be directly mount-
tested with and without 3RT The block is simply screwed to ed to the load side of a 3RV MSP.
contactors for group installa- the basic unit. This assembly of a 3RV and a
tion. 3RT provides a complete, re-
Basic units of size S2 are motely operated, combination
already compliant with new starter, Type F.
clearance and creepage dis-
tance requirements.

Terminals for "Combination Motor Controller Type E" to UL 508


3RV29 28-1H 3RT29 46-4GA07
44.8 73.6
27.5
38.9

1/34 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
3RV — up to 100 A

Switching of direct current

1
3RV motor starter protectors fo r alternating currents are also The response values of the overload release remain unchanged;
suitable for DC switching. the response values of a short-circuit release increase by ap-

PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
proximately 30 % for DC. The example circuits for DC switching
The maximum permissible DC voltage per conducting path can be seen in the table below.
must, however, be adhered to. Higher voltages require a series
connection with 2 or 3 conducting paths.
Example circuit for size S00 to S3 3RV motor starter protectors
Example circuit for size S00 Maximum permitted Notes
to S3 3RV motor starter protectors DC voltage Ue

L+ L 150 V DC Three-pole switching, non-grounded system1)


If there is no possibility of a ground fault, or if every ground fault is rectified immediately
(ground-fault monitoring), then the maximum permitted DC voltage can be tripled.
M
NSB0_00001a

L+ L 300 V DC Two-pole switching, grounded system


The grounded pole is always assigned to the individual conducting path, so that there
are always 2 conducting paths in series in the event of a ground fault.
M
NSB0_00002a

L+ L 450 V DC Single-pole switching, grounded system


3 conducting paths in series. The grounded pole is assigned to the unconnected con-
ducting path.
M
NSB0_00003a

1)
It is assumed that this circuit always provides safe disconnection even in
the event of a double ground fault that bridges two contacts.

Design
Mounting Screw connection The box terminals of the S3 MSP with Spring-type terminal
MSPs can be removed in order connection
The motor starter protectors are 3RV MSPs of sizes S00 and
to connect conductors with
secured in position by snap- S0 are fitted with terminals with
cable lugs or connecting bars.
ping them onto 35 mm standard captive screws and clamping
A terminal cover is available to
mounting rails according to DIN pieces, allowing the connection
help prevent contact with shock
EN 50 022. A mounting rail with of 2 conductors with different
protection and to ensure that
a height of 15 mm is required cross-sections.
the required clearances and
for S3 MSPs. A 75-mm mount- creepage distances are main-
The box terminals of the S2 and
ing rail can be used as an alter- tained if the box terminals are
native here. S3 MSPs also enable 2 con-
ductors with different cross- removed.
S2 and S3 MSPs can also be sections to be connected. With
screwed directly onto a base- the exception of S3 MSPs Spring-type connection 2)
plate. which are equipped with 4 mm
hexagon socket terminal As an alternative to screw ter-
The push-in lugs 3RV29 28-0B screws, all terminal screws are minals, S00 and S0 devices are
are available for screw mount- tightened with a Pozidriv screw- also available with Spring-type
ing of S00 and S0 MSPs. driver size 2. terminal connection.
This screwless Spring-type
3RV2928-0B terminal technique, as known
for modular terminal blocks,
offers shock-proof and vibration
proof connection of conductors.
Devices with Spring-type con-
nection allow independent con-
nection of two conductors per
terminal.

1) It is assumed that this circuit always provides safe cut-out, even in the event of a
double earth fault that bridges two contacts.
2) For notes on Spring-type terminal connection, see section 19.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/35
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
3RV — up to 100 A

Characteristics
1

The time/current characteristic, (short-circuit releases, ’N’ re- Typical time/current characteristic of 3RV
the current limiting characteris- leases) are based on the rated
MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS

tics and the I ²t characteristics current In that represents the


were determined in accor- maximum value of the setting
dance with DIN VDE 0660 or range for MSPs with adjustable
IEC 60 947. overload releases. If the current
is set to a lower value, the trip-
The tripping characteristic of ping current of the ’N’ release is
the inverse-time delayed increased by a corresponding
overload releases (thermal factor.
overload releases or ’A’
releases) for DC and AC with a The characteristics of the elec-
frequency of 0 to 400 Hz also tromagnetic overcurrent
apply to the time/current char- releases apply to frequencies
acteristic. of 50/60 Hz. Appropriate cor-
rection factors must be used for
The characteristics apply to the lower frequencies up to
cold state. At operating temper- 16 2/3 Hz, for higher frequen-
ature, the tripping times of the cies up to 400 Hz and for DC.
thermal releases are reduced to
approximately 25 %. The printed characteristic curve
determined for the MSP relates
Under normal operating condi- to a specific setting range. It is,
tions, all three poles of the however, also valid as a sche-
device must be loaded. The matic representation of MSPs
three main conducting paths with other current ranges.
must be connected in series in
order to protect single-phase or
DC loads.
With 2-pole and 3-pole loading,
the maximum deviation in the
tripping time for 3 times the set-
ting current and upwards is
± 20 % and thus in accordance
with DIN VDE 0165.
The tripping characteristics for
the instantaneous, electromag-
netic overcurrent releases

Circuit diagrams
Internal connections
Motor starter protectors
3RV.

1/36 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
3RV — up to 100 A

Dimension drawings

1
3RV2 MSP, size S00 3RV2 MSP, size S0

PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
3RV20 11 3RV20 21
45 49 96.9 45 96.9

49
97

97
5 5

3RV2 MSP, size S2


149.4
55 144.4 12.4 30
4.8

1/ L1 3/ L2 5/ L3
70
140

130

2/ T1 4/ T2 6/ T3
5

3RV2.31 motor starter protector (<= 45A)

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/37
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
3RV — up to 100 A

3RV2.32 MSP, size S2


1

149.3
55 144.3 12.4 30
MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS

4.8

1/ L1 3/ L2 5/ L3 70
140

130
2/ T1 4/ T2 6/ T3

5
3RV2.4 size S3

176

70 171 30

1 / L1 3 / L2 5 / L3
83
165

155

2 / T1 4 / T2 6 / T3
5

20

3RV2 MSP, size S00, 3RV2111


65

45 96.9
49
97

1/38 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


3RV2041-4FA10 Subject to change without notice Product Category IEC
Page 7/8 11/22/2019 © Copyright Siemens
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
3RV — up to 100 A

3RV2 MSP, size S0 , 3RV2121

1
65

45 96.9

PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
49
97

3RV2 MSP, size S2 , 3RV2131

149.4

74.8 144.4 12.4 30

4.8

1 / L1 3 / L2 5 / L3

95
96
70

NC
140

130

NO

98
97

2 / T1 4 / T2 6 / T3
5

3RV2 MSP, size S3 , 3RV2142


3RV2121-4BA10 Subject to change without notice
Page 7/9 90 11/22/2019 176 © Copyright Siemens
70 171 30

1 / L1 3 / L2 5 / L3
83

95
96
NC
165

155

NO

98
97

2 / T1 4 / T2 6 / T3
5

20

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/39


3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
3RV — up to 100 A

3RV1 MSP, size S00, 3RV1.1


1

75

45 70
MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS

1 / L1 3 / L2 5 / L3

45
90

2 / T1 4 / T2 6 / T3

3RV27 and 3RV28 circuit breakers, size S00, S0 and S3


3RV27 21, 3RV28 21

1) Mounting according to EN 60715


25 to standard mounting rail TH 35.
27

2) Drilling pattern.
Ø5
126
112
45

144

106

2)
3RV1011-1AA10 1) 11/22/2019
Subject to change without notice
© Copyright Siemens
Page 6/7
17

NSB0_01726b

14 14 55
45 79
92

3RV27 circuit breakers, size S3


3RV27 42

22,5 22,5 1) Mounting according to


30 EN 60715 on TH 35 standard
mounting rail, 15 mm deep,
26

Ø5 or TH 75 standard mounting rail.


2) Drilling pattern.
168
129
155

155
45

2)

1)
NSB0_01531c

5
70 132
7 153
157
169

1/40 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


© Siemens AG 2015
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
Motor Starter Protectors/Circuit Breakers
General Data SIRIUS 3RV2 Motor Starter Protectors/Circuit Breakers up to 80 A
Accessories
Mountable accessories
Mountable accessories

Overview

1
Mounting location and function

PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
The 3RV2 motor starter protectors/circuit breakers have three These components are easily fitted to the switches without the
main contact elements. In order to achieve maximum flexibility, use of any tools according to requirements.
auxiliary switches, signaling switches, auxiliary releases and
isolator modules can be supplied separately. Overview graphic, see page 7/7.

Front side Transverse auxiliary An auxiliary switch block can be inserted transversely on the front.
Note: switches, solid-state The overall width of the motor starter protectors/circuit breakers remains
compatible transverse unchanged.
• A maximum of four auxiliary contacts with auxiliary switches
auxiliary switches can be mounted on each
motor starter protector/circuit breaker. 1 NO + 1 NC
or
2 NO
or
1 CO
Left-hand side Lateral auxiliary switches One of the three lateral auxiliary switches can be mounted on the left side
Notes: (2 contacts) per motor starter protector/circuit breaker. The contacts of the auxiliary
1 NO + 1 NC switch close and open together with the main contacts of the motor starter
• A maximum of four auxiliary contacts with protector/circuit breaker.
auxiliary switches can be mounted on each or
motor starter protector/circuit breaker. 2 NO The width of the lateral auxiliary switch with two contacts is 9 mm.
• Lateral auxiliary switches (two contacts) or
and signaling switches can be mounted 2 NC
separately or together. Lateral auxiliary switches One lateral auxiliary switch with four contacts can be mounted on the left
• The signaling switch cannot be used for the (4 contacts) side per motor starter protector/circuit breaker. The contacts of the auxiliary
3RV27 and 3RV28 circuit breakers. switch close and open together with the main contacts of the motor starter
2 NO + 2 NC
protector/circuit breaker.
The width of the lateral auxiliary switch with four contacts is 18 mm.
Signaling switches One signaling switch can be mounted on the left side of each motor starter

7
Tripping 1 NO + 1 NC protector.
Short circuit 1 NO + 1 NC The signaling switch has two contact systems.
One contact system always signals tripping irrespective of whether this was
caused by a short circuit, an overload or an auxiliary release. The other
contact system only switches in the event of a short circuit. There is no
signaling as a result of switching off with the actuator.
In order to be able to switch on the motor starter protector again after a short
circuit, the signaling switch must be reset manually after the error cause has
been eliminated.
The overall width of the signaling switch is 18 mm.
Right-hand side Auxiliary releases
Notes: Shunt releases For remote-controlled tripping of the motor starter protector/circuit breaker.
• One auxiliary release can be mounted per The release coil should only be energized for short periods (see circuit
motor starter protector/circuit breaker. diagrams).
• Accessories cannot be mounted at the or
right-hand side of the 3RV21 motor starter
protectors for motor protection with overload Undervoltage releases Trips the motor starter protector/circuit breaker when the voltage is inter-
relay function. rupted and prevents the motor from being restarted accidentally when the
voltage is restored. Used for remote-controlled tripping of the motor starter
protector/circuit breaker.
Particularly suitable for EMERGENCY-STOP disconnection by way of corre-
sponding EMERGENCY-STOP pushbuttons according to DIN EN 60204-1.
or
Undervoltage releases with Function and use as for the undervoltage release without leading auxiliary
leading auxiliary contacts contacts, but with the following additional function: the auxiliary contacts will
2 NO open in switch position OFF to deenergize the coil of the undervoltage
release, thus interrupting energy consumption. In the "tripped" position,
these auxiliary contacts are not guaranteed to open. The leading contacts
permit the motor starter protector/circuit breaker to reclose.
The overall width of the auxiliary release is 18 mm.
Top Isolator modules Isolator modules can be mounted to the upper connection side of the motor
Notes: starter protectors.
• The isolator module cannot be used for the The supply cable is connected to the motor starter protector through the
3RV27 and 3RV28 circuit breakers. isolator module.
• The isolator module for size S2 The plug can only be unplugged when the motor starter protector is open
- can only be used with 3RV2 motor starter and isolates all 3 poles of the motor starter protector from the network.
protectors/circuit breakers up to max. 65 A The shock-protected isolation point is clearly visible and secured with a
- cannot be used with the transverse auxiliary padlock to prevent reinsertion of the plug.
switch
• The isolator module covers the terminal screws
of the transverse auxiliary switch. If the isolator
module is used, we therefore recommend that
either the lateral auxiliary switches be fitted or
that the isolator module not be mounted until For a complete overview of which accessories can be used for. the
the auxiliary switch has been wired. various motor starter protectors/circuit breakers, see page 7/2

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/41
Siemens IC 10 · 2015 7/31
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
Mountable accessories

Overview
1

8
S00 and S0 motor starter protectors with mountable accessories
MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS

NSB0_02076
4

6.1

Motor starter protectors, sizes S2 or S3, with mountable accessories

Mountable accessories for all sizes S00 ... S3 Mountable accessories for sizes Mountable accessories for sizes
1 Transverse auxiliary switch 6.1 Undervoltage release with S00, S0 7 Signaling switch (can not be S00 ... S3
leading auxiliary contacts used with 3RV27 and 3RV28
2 Lateral auxiliary switch with 2 contacts
(can not be used with 3RV21 S2, S3 circuit breakers)
3 Lateral auxiliary switch with 4 contacts circuit breakers) 8 Isolator module (can not be S0 and S2
4 Shunt release 6.2 Undervoltage release with used with 3RV27 and 3RV28
leading auxiliary contacts circuit breakers)
5 Undervoltage release
9 Terminal block E

1/42 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
Mountable accessories

Circuit diagrams

1
Internal connections

PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
Shunt release Undervoltage Undervoltage release Lateral auxiliary switch
release with leading auxiliary contacts with 4 contacts
3RV19 02-1D / 3RV29 02-1D 3RV19 02-1A / 3RV29 02-1A 3RV19 01-1J / 3RV29 01-1J
3RV19 22-1C / 3RV29 22-1C

Transverse auxiliary switch Lateral auxiliary switch SignalIng switch


with 2 contacts
3RV19 01-1D 3RV19 01-1E 3RV19 01-1F 3RV19 01-1A 3RV19 01-1B 3RV19 01-1C 3RV19 21-1M / 3RV29 21-1M
3RV29 01-1D 3RV29 01-1E 3RV29 01-1F 3RV29 01-1A 3RV29 01-1B 3RV29 01-1C
3RV19 01-1G 3RV19 01-2E 3RV19 01-2A 3RV19 01-2B 3RV19 01-2C
3RV29 01-1G 3RV29 01-2E 3RV29 01-2A 3RV29 01-2B 3RV29 01-2C

External connections
Shunt release Undervoltage release

S0; S1; S2 OFF pushbuttons in system


Q1 Motor starter protectors
S Auxiliary switch of
MSP Q1
F1; F2 Fuses (gL/gG)
max. 10 A
F3 Shunt release
F4 Undervoltage release

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/43
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
Mountable accessories

Circuit diagrams
1

Typical circuits
MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS

3RV2 MSPs with 3RV29 21-1M signalling switch

H1: "Short circuit" signal H1; H2 Indicator lights

F1 Fuses (gL/gG)
H2: "Overload" or "Tripped by max. 10 A
auxiliary release" signal
Q1 MSP

S1 Signalling switch

Separate "Tripped" and "Short circuit" signals

Motor starter protectors tripped by means of pushbutton or


EMERGENCY STOP button in the system

The leading auxiliary contacts open in F1; F2 Fuses (gL/gG)


"OFF" position of the MSP to max. 10 A
switch off the coil voltage of the under-
voltage release, thus avoiding power Q1 MSP
consumption in switched off state.
F4 Undervoltage release
In the "tripped" position of the MSP,
these contacts are not guaranteed to S1; S2, S3 OFF pushbuttons in system
open.

Dimension drawings
Isolator modules
3RV29 28-1A 3RV29 38-1A
for MSPs size S00, S0 for MSPs size S2
54.8 144.7
56.9
107.9

For dimension drawings of auxiliary switches, signalling switches


and auxiliary releases, see page 1/37 and 1/40.

1/44 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
3RV Motor Starter Protectors up to 100 A
Accessories – Busbar accessories

Overview

1
Busbar adapters

PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
The MSPs are mounted directly The MSPs are snapped onto SIRIUS MSPs and combination starters with FastBus-busbar adapters
with the aid of busbar adapters the adapter and connected on snapped onto busbars
on FastBus-busbar systems with the line side. This prepared unit
40 mm and 60 mm centerline is then plugged directly onto the
spacing, in order to save space busbar system, and is thus con-
and to reduce wiring times and nected both mechanically and
costs. electrically at the same time.
FastBus-busbar adapters for Refer to page 1/10 for busbar
busbar systems with 40 mm adapters for specific MSPs and
centerline spacing are suitable accessories.
for copper busbars with a width
of 12 mm to 15 mm, while those Further busbar adapters for
with 60 mm centerline spacing snap-mounting direct-on-line
are suitable for widths of 12 mm starters and reversing starters,
to 30 mm. The busbars can be as well as additional accesso-
4 to 5 mm or 10 mm thick. ries such as line terminals and
outgoing terminals, busbar
copper, etc., can be found in
Section 5.

Insulated three-phase busbar system 8US busbar adapters for 60 mm systems


Three-phase busbar systems provide an easy, time-saving and The motor starter protectors are mounted directly with the aid of
clearly arranged means of feeding 3RV2 motor starter protectors busbar adapters on busbar systems with 60 mm center-to-cen-
with screw terminals. They can be used for the different types of ter clearance in order to save space and to reduce infeed times
motor starter protector up to 32 A. The 3RV19 15 three-phase and costs.
busbar systems are generally unsuitable for the 3RV21 motor
starter protectors for motor protection with overload relay func- The busbar adapters for busbar systems with 60 mm center-to-
tion and for the 3RV27 and 3RV28 circuit breakers according to center clearance are suitable for copper busbars with a width of
UL 489 / CSA C22.2 No. 5-02. 12 mm to 30 mm. The busbars can be 5 mm or 10 mm thick.

The busbars are suitable for between 2 and 5 circuit break- The motor starter protectors are snapped onto the adapter and
ers/motor starter protectors. However, any kind of extension is connected on the line side. This prepared unit is then plugged
possible by clamping the tags of an additional busbar (rotated directly onto the busbar system, and is thus connected both me-
by 180°) underneath the terminals of the respective last motor chanically and electrically at the same time.
starter protector. For further busbar adapters for snap-mounting direct-on-line
A combination of motor starter protectors of different sizes is starters and reversing starters as well as additional accessories
possible. The motor starter protectors are supplied by appropri- such as line terminals and outgoing terminals, flat copper profile,
ate feeder terminals. etc., can be found in Section 5.

3RV29 25-5AB
3RV19 15-1CB

3RV29 15-5B
NSB0_02079

NSB0_02080

3RV19 15-6AB

SIRIUS three-phase busbar system size S00/S0 SIRIUS load feeders with busbar adapters snapped onto busbars
The three-phase busbar systems are finger-safe. They are de- The three-phase busbar systems can also be used to construct
signed for any short-circuit stress which can occur at the output “Type E Starters” according to UL/CSA. Special feeder terminals
side of connected motor starter protectors. must be used for this purpose however (see “Selection and
Ordering Data” on page 1/11).

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/45
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
Busbar accessories

Dimension drawings
1

3RV19 15-1. . 3-phase busbar


for S00 and S0 MSPs , modular spacing 45 mm
MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS

for 2 MSPs 3RV19 15-1AB


for 3 MSPs 3RV19 15-1BB
for 4 MSPs 3RV19 15-1CB
for 5 MSPs 3RV19 15-1DB

3RV19 15-2. . 3-phase busbar


for S00 and S0 circuit-breakers, modular spacing 55 mm
for 2 MSPs with accessories 3RV19 15-2AB
for 3 MSPs with accessories 3RV19 15-2BB
for 4 MSPs with accessories 3RV19 15-2CB
for 5 MSPs with accessories 3RV19 15-2DB

3RV19 15-3. . 3-phase busbar


for S00 and S0 MSPs, modular spacing 63 mm
for 2 MSPs with accessories 3RV19 15-3A
for 3 MSPs with accessories 3RV19 15-3B
for 4 MSPs with accessories 3RV19 15-3C

3RV19 35-1. . 3-phase busbar


for S2 MSP, modular spacing 55 mm
for 2 MSPs 3RV19 35-1A
for 3 MSPs 3RV19 35-1B
for 4 MSPs 3RV19 35-1C
15
33
98

55
110
168

1/46 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
Busbar accessories

Dimension drawings

1
3RV19 35-3. . 3-phase busbar
for S2 MSP, modular spacing 75 mm

PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
for 2 MSPs with accessories 3RV19 35-3A
for 3 MSPs with accessories 3RV19 35-3B
for 4 MSPs with accessories 3RV19 35-3C
15

33
98

75
130
168

3RV29 25-5AB. 3-phase line-side terminals 3RV29 25-5EB 3-phase line-side terminal
connection from above, 3RV29 35-5B a) 3RV1. 1 19 mm connection from above,
size S00 and S0 connection from above, 3RV1. 2 23 mm size S0
size S00 and S0




3RV19 35-5A 3-phase line-side terminal 3RV19 15-5DB Connector


for MSP size S2 For connecting a 3-phase busbar for
MSPs of the size S0
(left) to size S00 (right)
112
55
NSB00061b
34

91
161

3RV19 25-5EB to construct “Type E Starters” 3RV29 35-5E


Connected from top, for motor starter protector size S0 Connected from top, for motor starter protector size S2

54.5 76.5
55,3
44 33,8
30,8

78,8

65.8

NSB0_02012
127,8

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/47
© Siemens 2021

Protection
3RV equipment
Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
Motor starter protectors/circuit breakers
General Data
SIRIUS 3RV2 motor starter protectors/circuit breakers
Busbar accessories
Accessories > Rotary operating mechanisms

Overview
1

Door-coupling rotary operating mechanisms Door-coupling rotary operating mechanism for mounting one
main switch in size S3 according to UL 508A and NFPA 79
MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS

Motor starter protectors/circuit breakers with a rotary operating


mechanism can be mounted in a control cabinet and operated For the installation of a door-coupling rotary operating
externally by means of a door-coupling rotary operating mechanism for harsh conditions for a main switch (only possible
mechanism. When the cabinet door with motor starter in frame size S3) in a UL control cabinet (according to UL 508A
protector/circuit breaker is closed, the operating mechanism and NFPA 79), the standard stipulates a second handle in the
is coupled. When the motor starter protector/circuit breaker control cabinet. With the cabinet door open, it shall only be
closes, the coupling is locked which prevents the door from possible to switch on this supplementary handle by means
being opened unintentionally. This interlock can be defeated of a "deliberate action".
by the maintenance personnel. In the OPEN position, the rotary
The figure below shows the setup required for this purpose, with
operating mechanism can be secured against reclosing with
the 3RV2946-3C door-coupling rotary operating mechanism for
up to three padlocks. Inadvertent opening of the door is not
harsh conditions, the 3RV2926-0P shaft support, and the
possible in this case either.
3VA9137-0GC05 supplementary handle (EMERGENCY OFF
With the optional 3RV2926-.Q tolerance compensation, an offset version).
can be compensated when installing the door-coupling rotary
To switch on the supplementary handle, the handle must be
operating mechanism. For this purpose, the standard coupling
pressed against a spring in the direction of the mounting plane.
head on the shaft is removed and replaced by the tolerance
This is the required "deliberate action" so that the supplementary
compensation.
handle does not turn empty and the circuit breaker can be closed.
3RV2926-1B door-coupling rotary operating
mechanism for sizes S00 to S3
Comprising: 3RV2946-3C EMERGENCY OFF door-coupling rotary operating
1 Actuator mechanism for size S3

2 Plastic cover Comprising:


IC 01_ 0 0711

1 Actuator
3 Coupling driver
7

2 Plastic cover
4 Extension shaft (6 mm x 6 mm),
130 mm long 3 Coupling driver
5 Coupling enclosure 5 4 Extension shaft (8 mm x 8 mm), 300 mm long
5 Spacer
6 Control cabinet door

IC01_00713
4
6 Metal brackets for inserting
3 motor starter protector/circuit breaker

7 Control cabinet door 6


2 Required for assembly of main control
switch in accordance with UL 508A
6 and NFPA 79
1
(can be optionally ordered):
8 3RV2926-0P shaft support 8
SIRIUS 3RV2926-1B door-coupling rotary operating mechanism 9 3VA9137-0GC05 9
supplementary handle 5
3RV2926-3B door-coupling rotary operating (EMERGENCY OFF
mechanism for sizes S00 and S0 version)
IC01_00712

4
Comprising:
1 Actuator
3
2 Plastic cover
3 Coupling driver 6
2
4 Extension shaft (8 mm x 8 mm),
300 mm long 7
5 Spacer 5
1
6 Metal brackets for inserting
motor starter protector/circuit
breaker 4 SIRIUS 3RV2946-3C EMERGENCY OFF door-coupling rotary operating
mechanism for harsh operating conditions according to UL 508A and
7 Control cabinet door NFPA 79 with optional shaft support and supplementary handle
3 (EMERGENCY OFF version)

7
1

SIRIUS 3RV2926-3B door-coupling rotary operating mechanism for harsh


conditions

1/48 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC

Siemens IC 10 · 2021
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
Rotary operating mechanisms

Circuit diagrams

1
Typical circuits
3RV MSP with 3RV19 36/3RV19 46 remote-controlled motorized

PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
operating mechanism
US
~ ~
- +

1
O 2
M
3
4
5

L I T
v

NSB00024a

Dimensional drawings
Door coupling rotary mechanism
3RV29 26-0B/3RV29 26-0C short shaft 4), for MSP sizes S00, S0, S2 and S3

66
45 19 25
15
1...4 1) Lockable in 0 position, with
shackle diameter max. 8 mm
2) Mounting with screw cap
1) 3) Supplied with a shaft length of
330 mm; adaptable by shortening
of the shaft.
4) Supplied with a shaft length of
5 2) 130 mm; adaptable by shortening
of the shaft.
max 127 33 17 5) Grounding terminal 35 mm2 and
min 55 bracket for 330 mm shaft.

3
4)
24.3

Ø2
2.5
NSB01108

max 130
min 56

3RV29 26-0K/3RV29 26-0L long shaft (with bracket) 3), for MSP sizes S00, S0, S2 and S3
66
16 45 19 25
15
1...4

I ON

1)
0 OFF

NSB01090a

5 2)

5) max 327 33 17
min 55

3
3)
24.3

Ø2
2.5
NSB01108

max 330
min 56

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/49
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
Rotary operating mechanisms

Dimension drawings
1

3RV29 . 6-2. Door coupling rotary mechanism for heavy duty


3RV29 26-2., 3RV29 36-2., 3R29 46-2.
MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS

for sizes S00, S0, S2 and S3


Drilling template, door Drilling template, base
G J
NSB01091a

65
75

B
A

40
6

max. 341
D E F 62 14 H C
min. 42

Type Size Dimensions


A B C D E F G H I
3RV29 26-2. S00, S0 125 111 50 77 112 50 27 9 42
3RV29 36-2. S2 170 144 60 87 162 50 27 10 47
3RV29 46-2. S3 194 180 60 100 187 48 25 10 53
max. 330
min. 11 mm without shaft
min. 31

1/50 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
3RV Motor Starter Protectors
Motor Starter ProtectorsSIRIUS
General Data SIRIUS 3RV1 Motor Starter Protectors up to 100 A
Accessories — Enclosures and front plates
Accessories
Enclosures and front plates

Overview

1
Enclosure Front plates

PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
For stand-alone installation of motor starter protector size S2 Motor starter protectors are frequently required to be actuated in
(In max = 65 A), molded-plastic enclosures for surface mounting any enclosure. Front plates equipped with a rotary operating
are available. mechanism for motor starter protector sizes S2 and S3 are avail-
able for this purpose.
When installed in a molded-plastic enclosures the motor starter
protectors have a rated operational voltage Ue of 500 V.
The molded-plastic enclosures are designed to degree of pro-
tection IP55.

NSB0_02194
NSB0_02193

Front plate for size S2

7
Enclosures for surface mounting
All enclosures are equipped with N and PE terminals. There are
two knock-out cable entries for cable glands at the top and two
at the bottom; also on the rear corresponding cable entries are
scored. There is a knockout on the top of the enclosure for indi-
cator lights that are available as accessories.
In the enclosure for motor starter protector size S2 there is also
room for the laterally mounted auxiliary release. There is no pro-
vision for installing a motor starter protector with a signaling
switch.
The molded-plastic enclosures of the size S2 motor starter pro-
tectors are fitted with a rotary operating mechanism.
The enclosures can be supplied with either a black rotary oper-
ating mechanism or with an EMERGENCY-STOP rotary operat-
ing mechanism with a red/yellow knob.
The rotary operating mechanisms can be locked in the Open po-
sition with up to 3 padlocks.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/51
Siemens IC 10 · 2012 7/61
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
Mounting accessories

Dimension drawings
1

3RV19 . 3-1. . . . Cast aluminum enclosure for wall mounting


MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS

for MSPs of size S2


3RV19 33-1. . . .

1) Knock-outs for M32 (left) and M40 (right).


2) M32 knock-outs for rear-side cable entry.
3) Opening for padlock with shackle diameter max. 8 mm.
4) Indicator light 3RV19 03-5.

Molded-plastic front plate 3RV19 23-4.


for MSP sizes S0, S2, S3
3RV29 23-4B
3RV29 23-4E
3RV19 23-4G (only for size S0)

1/52 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
3RV Spring-type terminal infeed system

Design

1
Installation guidelines

PROTECTORS
MOTOR STARTER
Distance in Y direction from live, earthed or insulated parts ac-
cording to IEC 60947-4: 10 mm.
In addition, the installation guidelines for motor starter protectors
or fuseless load feeders including the clearances must be com-
plied with.

Technical specifications
Type 3RV29 .7
Rated operational voltage Ue
• IEC
- 10 % overvoltage V 500
- 5 % overvoltage V 525
• UL/CSA V 600
Rated frequency Hz 50/60
Rated current In A 63
Permissible ambient temperature
• During storage/transport °C -50 ... +80
• During operation °C -20 ... +60
Permissible rated current of the 3RV10 11 motor starter protectors
(size S00) at control cabinet internal temperature
• +60 °C % 100
Permissible rated current of the 3RV10 21 motor starter protectors
(size S0) up to 16 A at control cabinet internal temperature
• +60 °C % 100
Permissible rated current for 3RV1. 21 motor starter protectors (size S0)
from 16 A at control cabinet internal temperature
• +40 °C % 100
• +60 °C % 87
Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60529 IP201)
Touch protection acc. to IEC 61140 Finger-safe
Conductor cross-sections for main circuit infeed
• Solid, stranded: mm2 4 ... 25
• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 4 ... 25
• Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 6 ... 25
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 10 ... 3
Conductor cross-sections of terminal block
• Solid mm2 1.5 ... 6
• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 1.5 ... 4
• Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 1.5 ... 6
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 15 ... 10
1)
In infeed terminal compartment without a conductor connected: IP00.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 1/53
3RV Motor Starter Protectors SIRIUS
General Data
3RV Cage clamp infeed system

Cage Clamp infeed system


1

3-phase busbars with line-side terminals


for 2 circuit-breakers of sizes S00 and S0
MOTOR STARTER
PROTECTORS

3RV29 17-1.
108
75 108 a

70

80
128

128
45

4,5
NSB0_01248

278
15
7,5
75

S00 S0
a 104 125

3-phase busbars for system expansion


for 2 and 3 circuit-breakers of sizes S00 and S0
3RV29 17-4.
90 135 a
75 120
80
70

128
128

128
45

4,5
278

NSB0_01249
15
7,5
75

S00 S0
a 104 125

1/54 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies
Industrial Control Product Catalog 2021

contents
Section Overview 2/2 - 2/5 SIRIUS Contactor Spare Parts
Coils
2 SIRIUS

Section

2/96 - 2/100
Product Overview 2/6 - 2/7
Arc Chutes 2/101
SIRIUS Contactors Contact Kits 2/101
3RT20, 3-pole to 95A 2/8

2
Obsolete Contactor / Relay Spare Parts...... 2/104 - 2/105
3RT10, 3-pole to 500A 2/9
3RT10, 3-pole to 500A with Integrated Safety 2/11 - 2/10 Design / Function Overview

Assemblies
Contactors and
3RT12, 3-pole Vacuum to 500A 2/12 3RT20 Contactors, S00 to S3 2/106 - 2/107
3RT23, 4-pole with 4 NO 2/13 3RT10 Contactors, S6 to S12 2/108 - 2/109
3RT24, 3-pole for Resistive Loads 2/14 WYE-Delta Starters 2/112 - 2/117
3RT25, 4-pole with 2 NO + 2 NC 2/15 3RH2 Control Relays 2/118
3RT26, for Capacitor Switching 2/21 3TF6 Vacuum Contactors up to 820A 2/119
3RT20, Interface Coupling Contactors 2/22 - 2/23 3RT / 3RH Accessories 2/120 - 2/122
3RT20 Motor Contactors for DC Operation 2/18 - 2/20 Technical Data
3RH21 Contactor Relays 2/16 - 2/17 3RT10 / 3RT20 Contactors 2/123 - 2/153
3RA13 / 3RA23 Reversing Contactors 2/39 - 2/46 3RT12 Vacuum Contactors 2/129, 2/154 - 2/159
3RT, 3TF Safety Contactors and 3RT24 Resistive Load Contactors 2/160 - 2/167
3RH2, 3TH2 Safety Control Relays 2/24 - 2/25
3RT23 4-pole Contactors 4 NO 2/168 - 2/169
Function Modules for Communications 2/26 - 2/38
3RT25 4-pole Contactors 2 NO & 2 NC 2/170 - 2/171
3RA24, Wye-Delta Starting 2/47 - 2/50
3RT26 Capacitor Switching Contactors 2/172
Contactor Coil Codes 2/51
3RT20 Interface Relays 2/173
SIRIUS Control Relays & Coupling Relays 3TF6 Vacuum Contactors up to 820A 2/174 - 2/179
3RH2 Control Relays 2/52 3TC DC Switching Contactors 2/180 - 2/183
3RH24 Latched Control Relays 2/53 Accessories 2/184 - 2/186
Auxiliary Switches 2/53 3RH2 Control and Latching Relays 2/187 - 2/190
3RH21 Coupling Relays 2/54 3RH21 Coupling Relays 2/191
Special Application Contactors (3TF6 / 3TB5 / 3TC) Circuit Diagrams
3TF6 Vacuum Contactors up to 820A 2/55 - 2/56 3RT Contactors & Accessories 2/192 - 2/200
3TC DC Switching Contactors 2/57 - 2/58 3RA23 Reversing Contactors 2/201
3TB5 Contactor Coils 2/102 - 2/103 WYE-Delta Starters 2/202
3TF6 Vacuum Contactors up to 820A 2/203
SIRIUS Contactor & Relay Accessories
3RH2 Control & Latching Relays 2/205
Overview 2/59 - 2/67
3RH21 Coupling Relays 2/204
Auxiliary Switches 2/68 - 2/71
AuxiliaryTime Delay and Latching Blocks 2/72 - 2/73 Position of Terminals
Surge and EMC Suppressors 2/75 - 2/76 3RT Contactors and Accessories 2/205 - 2/209
Contactor Accessories 2/78 - 2/81 3RT Capacitor Contactors 2/208
Reversing Accessories 2/82 - 2/84 3TF6 Vacuum Contactors up to 820A 2/210
Wye-delta Accessories 2/85 3RH2 Control Relays 2/205
NEMA 1 Enclosures 2/95 Dimensions
SIRIUS Current Monitoring Relays 3RT, 3-pole Contactors S00 to S3 2/211 - 2/214
3RR21 Basic Versions 2/86 - 2/89 3RT10, 3-pole Contactors S6 to S12 2/215 - 2/216
3RR22 Standard Versions 2/86 - 2/89 3RT24, 3-pole Contactors for Resistive Loads 2/215 - 2/216
3RR24 with IO-Link 2/90 - 2/93 3RT10, Contactors S6 to S12, integrated safety 2/217
Accessories 2/94 3RT12, 3-pole Vacuum Contactors 2/218
3RT23, 3RT25 4-pole Contactors 2/219
Special Application Contactor Accessories
3RT26, Contactors for Capacitor Switching 2/220
Auxiliary Contacts 2/55
3RA13 / 23 Reversing Contactors 2/221 - 2/223
Box Terminals and Covers 2/56
3TF6 Vacuum Contactors up to 820A 2/224
Surge Suppressors for 3TB, 3TC, 3TF 2/56
Contactor Accessories 2/225 - 2/226
3RH2 Control and Coupling Relays 2/227

(Section was last modified on 05/18/21) Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/1
IEC Power Control SIRIUS
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies
Contactors for switching three-phase motors

contents
Contactors for switching three-phase motors
2 Assemblies
Contactors and

3RT20 contactors, 3-pole 3RT10 contactors, 3-pole, 3RT20 NEMA


3 to 75 HP, Sizes S00 to S3 100 to 400 HP, labeled contactors,
with screw, spring or ring lug sizes S6, S10 and S12 NEMA size 0 to 6
connections Page Page Page
Selection and ordering data Selection and ordering data Selection and ordering data
• AC/DC operation 2/8 • AC/DC operation 2/11 • AC/DC operation 2/8, 2/11
• Accessories 2/68 • Accessories 2/68 • Accessories 2/68
• Spare parts 2/96 • Spare parts 2/100 • Spare parts 2/96
Description 2/106 Description 2/108 Description 2/106
Technical data 2/123 Technical data 2/125 Technical data 2/123
Internal circuit diagrams 2/192 Internal circuit diagrams 2/198 Internal circuit diagrams 2/192
Position of terminals 2/205 Position of terminals 2/206 Position of terminals 2/205
Dimension drawings 2/211 Dimension drawings 2/215 Dimension drawings 2/211

Contactor assemblies for switching three-phase motors

3RT12 vacuum contactors, 3-pole, 3RA13 / 23 contactor assemblies for Wye Delta for
150 to 400 HP, reversing, 3 to 75 HP, sizes S00 to S3 customer assembly of
sizes S10 and S12 with screw or spring loaded connections sizes S00 to S12
Page Page Page
Selection and ordering data Selection and ordering data Selection and ordering data
• AC/DC operation 2/12 • AC/DC operation 2/42 • For wye-delta starting 2/49
• Accessories 2/68 • Accessories 2/82 • Accessories 2/85
• Spare parts 2/100 • Spare parts 2/96 • Spare parts 2/96
Description 2/108 Overview 2/40 Overview 2/110
Technical data 2/154 Description 2/39 Description 2/112
Internal circuit diagrams 2/198 Circuit diagrams 2/201 Circuit diagrams 2/202
Position of terminals 2/206 Position of terminals 2/206
Dimension drawings 2/218 Dimension drawings 2/221

2/2 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


IEC Power Control SIRIUS
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies
Contactors for special applications

contents
Contactors for special applications

2
Assemblies
Contactors and
3RT14 / 24 contactors, 3RT23 contactors, 3RT25 contactors,
Ie /AC-1: 140 to 690 A, AC-1: 18 to 140 A with 4 NO main AC-3: 7.5-25 HP with 2 NO + 2 NC
3-pole, sizes S3 to S12, contacts, sizes S00 to S3 main contacts, sizes S00 to S2
with screw connections with screw or spring connections with screw or spring connections
Page Page Page
Selection and ordering data Selection and ordering data Selection and ordering data
• AC/DC operation 2/14 • AC/DC operation 2/13 • AC/DC operation 2/15
• Accessories 2/68 • Accessories 2/68 • Accessories 2/68
• Spare parts 2/99 • Spare parts 2/96 • Spare parts 2/96
Descriptions 2/14 Description 2/13 Description 2/15
Technical Data 2/160 Technical Data 2/168 Technical Data 2/170
Internal circuit diagrams 2/198 Internal circuit diagrams 2/193 Internal circuit diagrams 2/192
Position of terminals 2/206 Position of terminals 2/209 Position of terminals 2/205
Dimension drawings 2/213 Dimension drawings 2/219 Dimension drawings 2/219

3RT26 capacitor 3RT20 coupling relays up to 20 HP


contactors, up to 75 kvar, (interface,) 3-pole, for switching 3RT Safety Contactors and
sizes S00 to S2 motors, sizes S00 and S0 3RH Safety Control Relays
with screw connections with screw or spring connections Page
Page Page
Selection and ordering data
Selection and ordering data Selection and ordering data • Safety with standard devices 2/24
• AC/DC operation 2/21 • DC operation 2/22 • Safety with permanently
• Accessories 2/68 • Accessories 2/68 mounted auxiliaries 2/25
• Spare parts 2/98 • Spare parts 2/96 • Accessories 2/75
Descriptions 2/14 Description 2/22 Description 2/24
Technical Data 2/172 Technical Data 2/173 Technical Data 2/123
Internal circuit diagrams 2/192 Internal circuit diagrams 2/192
Position of terminals 2/208 Position of terminals 2/205
Dimension drawings 2/220 Dimension drawings 2/211

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/3


IEC Power Control SIRIUS
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies
Contactors for special application

contents
Contactors for special applications
2 Assemblies
Contactors and

3TF68 and 3TF69 vacuum 3TB50 to 3TB56 contactors


contactors, 500 to 700 HP; with DC solenoid system,
contactor assemblies 3TC Contactors
100 to 300 HP
Page Page Page
Selection and ordering data Selection and ordering data Selection and ordering data
• AC/DC operation 2/55 • Spare parts 2/103 • DC operation 2/57
• Accessories 2/55 • Spare parts 2/57
• Spare parts 2/55
Descriptions 2/119 Technical Data 2/180
Technical Data 2/174
Internal circuit diagrams 2/203
Position of terminals 2/210
Dimension drawings 2/224

3RT1 SIRIUS Nomenclature


3RT1 0 3 5 1 A B0 1
SIRIUS Application Frame Current Terminal Coil Type Coil Voltage Aux Contacts A)
Contactor 0 = 3 pole Standard 5 = S6 Designation 2 = Spring Loaded A = AC/DC (S6-S12) See Coil 0 = None
2 = 3 pole Vacuum 6 = S10 Choices = Coil only N = UC Solid state Selection Chart 4 = 2NO + 2NC (S6-S12)
4,5,6 6 = Busbar Terminal page 2/51
3 = 4 pole NO 7 = S12 (S6-S12) 5 = 1NO + 1 NC (S6-S12)
4 = 3 pole resistive load P = UC Solid state 6 = 2 NO + 2 NC (S6-S12)
5 = 4 pole 2 NO + 2 NC with RLT (S6-S12) A) per EN50012
6 = 3 pole Capacitive

3RT2 SIRIUS Innovations Nomenclature


3RT2 0 1 5 1 A B0 1
SIRIUS Application Frame Current Terminal Coil Type Coil Voltage Aux Contacts A)
Innovations 0 = 3 pole Standard 1 = S00 3,4,5,6,7,8 1 = Screw A = AC (S0-S3) See Coil Selection 0 = 1NO + 1NC (S0-S3)
3 = 4 pole NO 2 = S0 2 = Spring Loaded B = DC Chart page 2/51 1 = 1 NO (S00)
Contactor
5 = 4 pole 2 NO + 2 NC 3 = S2 3 = Spring Loaded N = UC Electronic 2 = 1 NC (S00)
6 = 3-pole Capacitive 4 = S3 Coil only 4 = 2NO + 2NC (S00-S3)
4 = Ring Lug A) per EN50012

Note: MSPs and Contactors of the same frame size are made to easily fit together with the use of a link module or can be purchased pre-assembled as 3RA starter
assemblies. See section 4.
Note: Contactors and Overloads of the frame size S00 - S3 are made to easily fit together without the use of accessories.
Note: This is only a guide to decode the model number. All possible combinations of these are not available.

2/4 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


IEC Power Control

Contactors and Contactor Assemblies


SIRIUS control relays

Contents
SIRIUS contactor relays

2
Assemblies
Contactors and
3RH21, 3RH22 control relays 4- and 8-pole, 3RH24 latched control relays, 4-pole,
size S00, AC/DC operation Page size S00, AC/DC operation Page
Selection and ordering data Selection and ordering data
• With screw connections 2/52 • With screw connections 2/53
• With spring connections 2/52 • Accessories for 3RH2 2/53
• Accessories for 3RH2 2/53
Overview 2/16 Application 2/118
Technical data 2/187 Technical data 2/187
Terminal diagrams 2/204 Terminal diagrams 2/204
Position of terminals 2/205 Position of terminals 2/205
Dimension drawings 2/227 Dimension drawings 2/227

SIRIUS coupling relays (interface) SIRIUS current monitoring relays

3RH21 coupling relays for switching auxiliary circuits, 3RR current monitoring relays for direct mounting
4-pole, size S00, DC operation Page to SIRIUS contactors Page
Selection and ordering data Selection and ordering data
• With screw connections 2/54 • Basic versions 2/89
• with Cage Clamp connections 2/54 • Standard versions 2/89
• Versions with IO-Link 2/93
• Accessories for 3RR 2/94

Application 2/54 Overview 2/86


Technical data 2/191 Application 2/86
Terminal diagrams 2/204 Technical data 2/87
Position of terminals 2/205
Dimension drawings 2/227

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/5


IEC Power Control

Contactors and Contactor Assemblies


Overview
2 Assemblies
Contactors and

Type S00 3RT20 1 S0 3RT20 2 S2 3RT20 3

3RT20 contactors
Type 3RT2015 3RT2016 3RT2017 3RT2018 3RT2023 3RT2024 3RT2025 3RT2026 3RT2027 3RT2028 3RT2035 3RT2036 3RT2037 3RT2038
AC/DC operation (p. 2/8) (p. 2/8) (p. 2/8)
Type
AC/DC operation
Maximum 3-phase horsepower ratings at 460V (UL and CSA listed values)
200 V HP 1.5 2 3 3 2 3 5 7.5 10 10 10 15 20 20
230 V HP 2 3 3 5 3 3 5 7.5 10 10 15 15 20 25
460 V HP 3 5 7.5 10 5 7.5 10 15 20 25 30 40 50 50
575 V HP 5 7.5 10 10 7.5 10 15 20 25 25 40 50 50 60
AC-3
Ie/AC-3/400V A 6 9 12 16 9 12 17 25 32 38 40 50 65 80
230 V kW 1.5 2.2 3 4 2.2 3 4 5.5 7.5 11 11 15 18.5 22
400 V kW 3 4 5.5 7.5 4 5.5 7.5 11 15 18.5 18.5 22 30 37
500 V kW 3.5 4.5 5.5 7.5 4.5 7.5 10 11 18.5 18.5 22 30 37 37
690 V kW 4 5.5 5.5 7.5 7.5 7.5 11 11 18.5 18.5 22 22 37 45
1000 V kW — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
AC-4 (at Ia = 6 x Ie)
400 V kW 3 4 4 5.5 4 5.5 7.5 7.5 11 11 18.5 22 30 37
400 V (200,000 kW
operating cycles) 1.15 2 2 2.5 2 2.6 3.5 4.4 6 6 11.6 12.6 14.7 15.8
AC-1 (40°C, ≤ 690V)
Ie A 18 22 22 22 40 40 40 40 50 50 60 70 80 90

Accessories for contactors


Auxiliary switch blocks front 3RH29 11 (p. 2/68) 3RH29 11 (p. 2/68)
lateral 3RH29 11 (p. 2/70) 3RH29 21 (p. 2/70)
Terminal covers — — 3RT29 36 (p. 2/79)
Box terminals — — —
Surge suppressor 3RT29 16 (p. 2/75) 3RT29 26 (p. 2/75) 3RT29 36 (p. 2/75)
3RU21 and 3RB3 overload relays (Section 3)
3RU21, thermal, 3RU21 16 0.1-16A (p. 3/10) 3RU21 26 0.18-40A (p. 3/10) 3RU21 36 11-80A (p. 3/10)
CLASS 10
3RB30/31, solid-state, 3RB30 16 0.1-16A (p. 3/22) 3RB30 26 0.1-40A (p. 3/22) 3RB30 36 12-80A (p. 3/22)
CLASS 5, 10, 20 and 30 3RB31 13 (p. 3/23) 3RB31 23 (p. 3/23) 3RB31 33 (p. 3/23)
3RB22/23, solid-state, 3RB2.83+ 0.3-25A (p. 3/34) 3RB22, 10-100A (p. 3/34)
CLASS 5, 10, 20 and 30 3RB29 06 3RB22, 3RB23 and 3RB24 with
current measuring module
3RV20 circuit-breakers (Section 1)
Type 3RV20 11 0.18-16A (p. 1/4) 3RV20 21 11-40A (p. 1/4) 3RV20 31 9.5-80A (p. 1/5)
Link modules 3RA29 11 (p. 1/10) 3RA29 21 (p. 1/10) 3RA29 31 (p. 1/10)

3RA23 Reversing contractor assemblies


Complete units Type 3RA2315 3RA2316 3RA2317 3RA2318 3RA2324 3RA2325 3RA2326 3RA2327 3RA2328 3RA2335 3RA2336 3RA2337 3RA2338
(page 2/42) (page 2/44) (page 2/45)
460 V HP 3 5 7.5 10 7.5 10 15 20 25 30 40 50 50
Installation kits /
wiring connectors 3RA2913-2AA1 (p. 2/83) 3RA2923-2AA1 (p. 2/83) 3RA2933-2AA1 (p. 2/83)

Mechanical interlocks 3RA2912-2H (p. 2/84) 3RA2922-2H (p. 2/84) 3RA2934-2B (p. 2/82)

2/6 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


IEC Power Control

Contactors and Contactor Assemblies


Overview

2
Assemblies
Contactors and
Type S3 3RT2. 4 S6 3RT1. 5 S10 3RT1. 6 S12 3RT1. 7 S14 3TF6

3RT20 contactors
Type 3RT2045 3RT2046 3RT2047 3RT1054 3RT1055 3RT1056 3RT1064 3RT1065 3RT1066 3RT1075 3RT1076 — —
AC/DC operation (p. 2/8) (p. 2/11) (p. 2/11) (p. 2/11)
Type 3RT1264 3RT1265 3RT1266 3RT1275 3RT1276 3TF68 3TF69
AC/DC operation (p. 2/12) (p. 2/12) (p. 2/55)
Maximum 3-phase horsepower ratings at 460V (UL and CSA listed values)
200 V HP 25 30 30 40 50 60 60 75 100 125 150 200 290
230 V HP 30 30 40 50 60 75 75 100 125 150 200 250 350
460 V HP 60 75 75 100 125 150 150 200 250 300 400 500 700
575 V HP 60 75 100 125 150 200 200 250 300 400 500 650 860
AC-3
Ie/AC-3/400V A 80 95 110 115 150 185 225 265 300 400 500 630 820
230 V kW 22 22 30 37 45 55 55 75 90 132 160 200 260
400 V kW 37 45 55 55 75 90 110 132 160 200 250 335 450
500 V kW 45 55 75 75 90 110 160 160 200 250 355 434 600
690 V kW 55 75 90 110 132 160 200 250 250 400 400/500 600 800
1000 V kW 37 — — 75 90 90 90/315 132/355 132/400 250/560 250/710 600 800
AC-4 (at Ia = 6 x Ie)
400 V kW 37 45 55 55 75 90 110 132 160 200 250 355 400
400 V (200,000 kW
operating cycles) 17.9 22 24.3 29 38 45 54/78 66/93 71/112 84/140 98/161 168 191
AC-1 (40°C, ≤ 690V)
Ie A 125 130 130 160 185 215 275/330 330 330 430/610 610 700 910

Accessories for contactors


Auxiliary switch front 3RH29 11 (p. 2/68) 3RH19 21 (p. 2/68) ­

blocks lateral 3RH29 21 (p. 2/70) 3RH19 21 (p. 2/70) 3TY7 561 (p. 2/55)
Terminal covers 3RT2946-4EA2 (p. 2/81) 3RT19 56-4EA1/2/3 (p. 2/81) 3RT19 66-4EA1/2/3 (p. 2/81) 3TX7 686/696 (p. 2/56)
Box terminals — 3RT19 55/56-4G (p. 2/81) 3RT19 66-4G (p. 2/81) —
Surge suppressor 3RT29 36 (p. 2/75) 3RT19 56-1C (RC element) (p. 2/75) 3TX7 572 (p. 2/56)

3RU21 and 3RB3 overload relays (Section 3)


3RU21, thermal, 3RU21 46 18-100A (p. 3/10) — — — —
CLASS 10
3RB30/31, solid-state, 3RB30 46 12.5-100A (p. 3/22) 3RB20 56 50–200A (p. 3/22) 3RB20 66 50–630A (p. 3/22) 3RB20 66 160–630A 3RB20 66 160–630A
CLASS 5, 10, 20 and 30 3RB31 43 (p. 3/23) 3RB21 56 (p. 3/23) 3RB21 66 (p. 3/23) 3RB21 66 (p. 3/22) 3RB21 66 (p. 3/22)
3RB22/23, solid-state, 3RB2.83 + 20–200A (p. 3/34) 3RB2.83 + 63–640A (p. 3/34)
CLASS 5, 10, 20 and 30 3RB29 56 3RB29 56

3RV20 circuit-breakers (Section 1)


Type 3RV20 41 45-100A (p. 1/5) — — — —
Link modules 3RA19 41 (p. 1/10) — — — —

3RA23 Reversing contractor assemblies


Complete units Type 3RA23 45 3RA23 46 3RA23 47 — — — —
(p. 2/46)

460 V HP 60 75 75 100 125 150 150 200 250 300 400 500 700
Installation kits / 3RA2943-2AA1 (p. 2/83) 3RA1953-2A (p. 2/83) 3RA1963-2A (p. 2/83) 3RA1973-2A (p. 2/83) 3TX7680-1A
wiring connectors
Mechanical interlocks 3RA2934-2B 3RA1954-2A (p. 2/82) 3TX7686-1A

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/7


IEC Power Control SIRIUS
Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT contactors, 3-pole – Size S00 to S3

Selection and ordering data


2

3RT201.-1A 3RT201. -2A. . . 3RT2028-1N... 3RT2025-2B... 3RT2035-1A... 3RT2045-1A...


Contactors and
Assemblies

Amp Single-phase Three-phase Auxiliary Spring-Loaded Weight


Ratings HP ratings HP ratings contacts Screw Terminals Terminals1) approx.
Frame
Size AC3 AC1 115V 208V 230V 208V 230V 460V 575V NO NC Order No. Order No. kg

3RT 3-pole contactors


6 18 0.25 0.5 0.75 1.5 2 3 5 1 0 3RT2015-1■ ●●1 3RT2015-2 ■ ●●1
0 1 3RT2015-1■ ●●2 3RT2015-2 ■ ●●2
9 22 0.33 1 1 2 3 5 7.5 1 0 3RT2016-1■ ●●1 3RT2016-2 ■ ●●1
0 1 3RT2016-1■ ●●2 3RT2016-2 ■ ●●2
S00 0.24/0.29
12 22 0.5 1.5 2 3 3 7.5 10 1 0 3RT2017-1■ ●●1 3RT2017-2 ■ ●●1
0 1 3RT2017-1■ ●●2 3RT2017-2 ■ ●●2
16 22 1 2 2 3 5 10 10 1 0 3RT2018-1■ ●●1 3RT2018-2 ■ ●●1
0 1 3RT2018-1■ ●●2 3RT2018-2 ■ ●●2
9 40 1 1 1 2 3 5 7.5 1 1 3RT2023-1■ ●●0 3RT2023-2 ■ ●●0
12 40 1 2 2 3 3 7.5 10 1 1 3RT2024-1■ ●●0 3RT2024-2 ■ ●●0
17 40 1 2 3 5 5 10 15 1 1 3RT2025-1■ ●●0 3RT2025-2 ■ ●●0
S0 0.42/0.60
25 40 2 3 3 7.5 7.5 15 20 1 1 3RT2026-1■ ●●0 3RT2026-2 ■ ●●0
32 50 2 5 5 10 10 20 25 1 1 3RT2027-1■ ●●0 3RT2027-2 ■ ●●0
38 50 3 5 5 10 10 25 25 1 1 3RT2028-1■ ●●0 3RT2028-2 ■ ●●0
40 60 3 5 7.5 10 15 30 40 1 1 3RT2035-1■ ●●0 3RT2035-3 ■ ●●0
50 70 3 7.5 10 15 15 40 50 1 1 3RT2036-1■ ●●0 3RT2036-3 ■ ●●0
S2 0.99/1.121
65 80 5 10 10 20 20 50 50 1 1 3RT2037-1■ ●●0 3RT2037-3 ■ ●●0
802) 90 5 10 15 20 25 50 60 1 1 3RT2038-1■ ●●0 3RT2038-3 ■ ●●0
80 125 7.5 10 15 25 30 60 60 1 1 3RT2045-1■ ●●0 3RT2045-3 ■ ●●0
S3 95 130 10 10 20 30 30 75 75 1 1 3RT2046-1■ ●●0 3RT2046-3 ■ ●●0 1.8/2.8
110 130 10 10 20 30 40 75 100 1 1 3RT2047-1■ ●●0 3RT2047-3 ■ ●●0
■ ■
AC Coil = A A
Size S2 & S3 only: Replace “B” with “K” for 24VDC coil only DC Coil = B B
Size S0-S3 only: UC Electronic with integrated varistor UC Coil = N N

Single-phase Three-phase Auxiliary Screw Terminals Screw Terminals Weight


HP ratings HP ratings contacts with AC coil with 24 VDC coil approx.
NEMA Amp
SIze Ratings 115V 230V 208V 230V 460V 575V NO NC Order No. Order No. kg

NEMA Labeled Contactors


0 18 1 2 3 3 5 5 1 0 3RT2018-1A ●●1-0UA0 3RT2018-1BB41-0UA0 0.28
1 27 2 3 7.5 7.5 10 10 1 1 3RT2027-1A ●●0-0UA0 3RT2027-1BB40-0UA0 0.42
2 45 3 7.5 10 15 25 25 1 1 3RT2036-1A ●●0-0UA0 3RT2036-1NB30-0UA0 0.986/1.121
3 90 7.5 15 25 30 50 50 1 1 3RT2046-1A ●●0-0UA0 3RT2046-1NB30-0UA0 1.8 / 2.8

Note: Ring lug terminals are also available in size S00 & S0 AC Coil Selection for 3RT201 through 3RT204
contactors, except contactors with communication inter- ●●Coil Code C23) H24) K6 P6 U6 V6 T6
face or UC coil. Change the 8th digit of the order number
to a “4”, e. g. 3RT2015-4AK61. 60 Hz 24 V 48 V 120 V 240 V 277 V 480 V 600 V
50 Hz 24 V 48 V 110 V 220 V — — —
For further coil voltages, see page 2/51.
For auxiliaries and accessories, see page 2/68-2/85.
For spare parts, see page 2/96-2/101. DC Coil Selection for 3RT201 & 3RT202 (for 3RT203 & 3RT204 see UC)
For technical data, see page 2/123-2/144. ●●Coil Code A45) B4 W4 E4 F4 G4 M4
For description, see page 2/106-2/107. DC 12 V 24 V 48 V 60 V 110 V 125 V 220 V
For int. circuit diagrams, see page 2/192-2/199.
For dimension drawings, see page 2/211-2/214. UC Coil Selection for 3RT202 UC Coil Selection for 3RT203 & 3RT204
●●Coil Code B3 F3 P35) ●● B3 F3 P36)
1) All
terminals are spring loaded on frame sizes S00 & S0. UC 21-28V 95-130V 200-280V 20-33V 83-155V 175-280V
Only the coil terminals are spring loaded on frame sizes
S2 & S3. 3) Use Code B0 for 3RT201, S00 5) 3RT201 and 3RT202 only
2) Max UL FLA = 65A at 460V 4) Use Code H0 for 3RT201, S00 6) at upper limit = 1.1 x Us

2/8 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
IEC Power Control SIRIUS
Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT contactors, 3-pole – Size S6-S12 and NEMA size 4-6

Selection and ordering data

* AC/DC Coils with built in surge suppressor


* Coil Types (40Hz to 60Hz, DC):
* Conventional Coil
* Solid-state operated coil with wider range and 24 V DC PLC input
* Solid-state operated coil with Remaining Lifetime Indication (RLT)

2
* Box terminals ordered separately

Assemblies
Contactors and
3RT1054-6A. . 6 3RT1065-6P. . 5

Spring-type
Amp Single-phase Three-phase Auxiliary Screw Terminals terminals on coil Weight
Ratings HP ratings HP ratings contacts on coil and aux. and aux. contacts approx.
Frame
Size AC3 AC1 115V 230V 200V 230V 460V 575V NO NC Order No. Order No. kg

3RT 3-pole Contactors


115 160 — 25 40 50 100 125 2 2 3RT1054-6 ■ ●●6 3RT1054-2 ■ ●●6
S6 150 185 — 30 50 60 125 150 2 2 3RT1055-6 ■ ●●6 3RT1055-2 ■ ●●6 3.5
185 215 — 30 60 75 150 200 2 2 3RT1056-6 ■ ●●6 3RT1056-2 ■ ●●6
225 275 — — 60 75 150 200 2 2 3RT1064-6 ■ ●●6 3RT1064-2 ■ ●●6
S10 265 330 — — 75 100 200 250 2 2 3RT1065-6 ■ ●●6 3RT1065-2 ■ ●●6 6.7
300 330 — — 100 125 250 300 2 2 3RT1066-6 ■ ●●6 3RT1066-2 ■ ●●6
400 430 — — 125 150 300 400 2 2 3RT1075-6 ■ ●●6 3RT1075-2 ■ ●●6
S12 10.5
500 610 — — 150 200 400 500 2 2 3RT1076-6 ■ ●●6 3RT1076-2 ■ ●●6
■ ■
UC Conventional Coil A A
Solid State Operated Coil = N N
Solid State Operated Coil with RLT = P●●5 —

Spring-type
Single-phase Three-phase Auxiliary Screw Terminals terminals on coil Weight
HP ratings HP ratings contacts on coil and aux. and aux. contacts approx.
NEMA Amp
SIze Ratings 115V 230V 208V 230V 460V 575V NO NC Order No. Order No. kg

NEMA Labeled Contactors


4 135 — 30 40 50 100 100 2 2 3RT1056-6A●●6-0UA0 — 3.5
5 300 — — 100 125 250 300 2 2 3RT1066-6A●●6-0UA0 — 6.7
6 400 — — 150 200 400 500 2 2 3RT1076-6A●●6-0UA0 — 10.5

All coil voltages are in the adjacent table.


Sizes S6 to S12 Coil Codes - UC operation (AC 50 to 60 Hz and DC)
For auxiliaries and accessories,
see page 2/66-2/83. UC Conventional Coil Solid-State Coil
For spare parts, see page 2/94-2/99.
For technical data, see page 2/143-2/151. Rated control 3RT1. 5.-.A Rated control 3RT1. 5.-.N 3RT1. 5.-.P
For description, see page 2/106-2/107. supply voltage Us supply voltage Us
3RT1. 6.-.A 3RT1. 6.-.N 3RT1. 6.-.P
For int. circuit diagrams, see page 2/196-2/198. Us min ... Us max1) Us min ... Us max1)
For dimension drawings, see page 2/213-2/217. 3RT1. 7.-.A 3RT1. 7.-.N 3RT1. 7.-.P
Coil Codes ●● Coil Codes ●● ●●
23 ... 26 V AC/DC B3 21 ... 27.3 V AC/DC B3 —
42 ... 48 V AC/DC D3 96 ... 127 V AC/DC F3 F3
110 ... 127 V AC/DC F3 200 ... 277 V AC/DC P3 P3
200 ... 220 V AC/DC M3
220 ... 240 V AC/DC P3
240 ... 277 V AC/DC U3
1) Operating range:
380 ... 420 V AC/DC V3
0.8 x Us min to 1.1 × Us max.
440 ... 480 V AC/DC R3
500 ... 550 V AC/DC S3
575 ... 600 V AC/DC T3

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/9
IEC Power Control SIRIUS
Contactors for Switching Motors with Integrated Safety
3RT contactors, 3-pole up to 400 HP

Contactor with integrated failsafe connection

Features Benefits
New Contactors from 100 to 400 HP for • Savings on standard outputs in the
direct control by fail-safe controllers controller
2

• First contactor with fail-safe input • Space savings due to elimination of


Contactors and
Assemblies

the coupling level


• Certified for use up to the highest
safety level • Less wiring
• SIL CL 2 with one / SIL CL 3 with two • Simplified safety assessment
contactors

Overview
The size S6 to S12 range of tried and tested contactors from 100 The big advantage of this solution is that it saves on additional,
to 400 HP @ 480V has been expanded to include versions suitable possibly positively-driven coupling relays and makes evaluation of
for direct control from fail-safe controllers, rendering the coupling safety information considerably easier.
level superfluous. The new contactors are also available with non- This reduction in coupling relays is also a huge plus point for
removable, lateral auxiliary switches, enabling fulfilment of Swiss non-safety applications. Whereas previously space, money and
Accident Insurance Institute (SUVA) requirements. wiring expertise were required in order to operate contactors from
The new contactors constitute the logical extension and further 100 HP and higher using controllers, both functional and safety
development of the SIRIUS Modular System, serving to promote switching can now take place by direct activation.
safe switching. They are the first contactors on the market to be Using the Safety Evaluation Tool you can quickly find the right
equipped with an input for fail-safe signals. This makes it possible contactor and safely configure your application.
to attain SIL 2 and/or PL c with just one contactor and SIL 3 and/
or PL e with two contactors in series according to IEC 62061 and
ISO 13849-1.

Save space and costs with a direct connection to the controller – no need for coupling relays!

Detecting Evaluating Reacting Detecting Evaluating Reacting


L/+
L/+

Feedback

Feedback

F-DQ
F-DQ DQ
A1
A1
PLC-IN
F-PLC-IN
A2 A2

A1
A1
PLC-IN
F-PLC-IN
A2
A2

N/-
N/-/-

Previous configuration: NEW configuration:


3RT1 size S6 for high motor outputs 3RT1 size S6 for high motor outputs
with standard PLC-IN with new contactor with fail-safe F-PLC-IN
• Normal switching duty via standard IO and • A1-A2 supplied via standard power supply (unit)
PLC-IN • Normal switching duty via F-DQ and F-PLC-IN
• Safety-related tripping initated by monitoring • Safety-related tripping via the same signal
coupled links
• Feedback of the two S6 size 3RT1
• Feedback of the two S6 size 3RT1 contacts via standard IO
and the coupling relays via standard IO

2/10 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


IC10_03_04.fm Page 72 Friday, January 24, 2020 9:51 AM

IEC Power Control SIRIUS


Contactors forfor
Power Contactors Switching Motors with Integrated Safety
Switching Motors
3RT contactors, 3-pole up to 400 HP IE3/IE4 ready

SIRIUS 3RT contactors, 3-pole up to 250 kW


AC/DC
AC/DC Operation
operation
• Solid-state operatingmechanism
mechanism (with(with integrated • Version with removable lateral auxiliary switches or permanently
• Solid-state operating integratedvaristor) with
varistor) • Version with removable lateral auxiliary switches or permanently
mounted auxiliary switches and additional approval according to
withfail-safe
fail-safecontrol input
control for safety-related
input applications
for safety-related to SIL CL
applications to 3 mounted auxiliary switches and additional approval according
• 24
SIL CLV3DC control signal input, e.g. for control via the fail-safe SUVA(on
to SUVA (on request)
request)
• 24 Voutput
DC control
modulesignal input, e.g.
of a controller for control
(F-PLC) via
or safety the fail-safe
relay • For
• For screw
screw fixing
fixing
output module
• Attainable of a Integrity
Safety controller (F-PLC)
Level (SIL): or safety relay • Auxiliaryand
• Auxiliary andcontrol
control conductors:
conductors: Screw
Screwororspring-type
spring-typeterminals
• Main conductors: Busbar connections; a connection kit with

2
• Attainable
– With one Safety Integrity
contactor: SILLevel
CL 2 (SIL):
acc. to IEC 62061 or PL c acc. terminals
- Withtoone ISOcontactor:
13849-1 SIL CL 2 acc. to IEC 62061 or PL c acc. • Mainscrews, spring washer
conductors: Busbarand nut is enclosed.
connections;
to– ISO
With 13849-1
two contactors in series: SIL CL 3 acc. to IEC 62061 or a connection kit with screws, spring washer and nut is

Assemblies
Contactors and
- WithPL two contactors in series: SIL CL 3 toacc. to IEC 62061 testor enclosed.
For more information on safety systems, see Section 13.
3

e acc. to ISO 13849-1according IEC 60947-4-1,


PL econditions
acc. to ISO for 13849-1
utilization category AC-1 For more information on safety systems, see from page 11/1
onwards.

3RT105.-6S.36 3RT106.-6S.36 3RT107.-6S.36 3RT105.-6S.36-3PA0 3RT107.-6S.36-3PA0


SizeSelection
Rated data
and according
ordering to IEC 60947-4-1
data Auxiliary Rated control SD Screw terminals PU PS* PG
AC-3, contacts, supply voltage (UNIT,
tu: 60 °C lateral Us SET, M)
Amp Single-phase Three-phase Auxiliary Rated control Screw Terminals
Operational
Ratings RatingsHPof three-phase
ratings HPVersion
ratings 50/60 Hz AC contacts supply voltage Us on coil and aux.
Frame current Ie motors at 50 Hz and or DC
Size up to AC3 AC1 115V 230V 200V 230V 460V 575V NO NC 50/60 Hz AC or DC
Article No. Price Order No.
Solid-state operating mechanism per PU
500 V 400 V
With two removable laterally mounted auxiliary switches
A kW NO NC V d
115 160 — 25 40 50 100 125 2 2 96 ... 127 3RT1054-6SF36
Solid-state operating mechanism
200 … 270 3RT1054-6SP36
With two removable
150 laterally
185 —mounted
30 auxiliary
50 switches
60 125 150 2 2 96 ... 127 3RT1055-6SF36
S6
S6 115 55 2 2 96 ... 127 5 200 … 277
3RT1054-6SF36 3RT1055-6SP36
1 1 unit 41B
185 215 — 30 60 75 200 … 200
150 270 25 3RT1054-6SP36
2 96 ... 127 1 1 unit
3RT1056-6SF36 41B
150 75 2 2 96 ... 127 5 3RT1055-6SF36
200 … 277 1 1 unit
3RT1056-6SP36 41B
225 275 — — 60 75 200 ... 200
150 277 25 3RT1055-6SP36
2 96 ... 127 1 1 unit
3RT1064-6SF36 41B
185 90 2 2 96 ... 127 5 3RT1056-6SF36
200 … 277 1 1 unit
3RT1064-6SP36 41B
265 330 — — 75 100 200 ... 250
200 277 25 3RT1056-6SP36
2 96 ... 127 1 1 unit
3RT1065-6SF36 41B
S10
S10 225 110 2 2 96 ... 127 5 3RT1064-6SF36
200 … 277 1 1 unit
3RT1065-6SP36 41B
300 330 — — 100 125 200 ... 300
250 277 25 3RT1064-6SP36
2 96 ... 127 1 1 unit
3RT1066-6SF36 41B
265 132 2 2 96 ... 127 5 3RT1065-6SF36
200 … 277 1 1 unit
3RT1066-6SP36 41B
400 430 — — 125 150 200 ... 400
300 277 25 3RT1065-6SP36
2 96 ... 127 1 1 unit
3RT1075-6SF36 41B
300 160 2 2 96 ... 127 5 3RT1066-6SF36
200 … 277 1 1 unit
3RT1075-6SP36 41B
S12 200 ... 500
277
500 610 — — 150 200 400 25 3RT1066-6SP36
2 96 ... 127 1 1 unit
3RT1076-6SF36 41B
S12 400 200 2 2 96 ... 127 5 3RT1075-6SF36
200 … 277 1 1 unit
3RT1076-6SP36 41B
200 ... 277 5 3RT1075-6SP36 1 1 unit 41B
500 250 2 2 96 ... 127 5 3RT1076-6SF36 1 1 unit 41B
With two permanently laterally mounted auxiliary switches
200 ... 277 5 3RT1076-6SP36 1 1 unit 41B
115 160 — 25 40 50 100 125 2 2 96 ... 127 3RT1054-6SF36-3PA0
With two permanently laterally mounted auxiliary switches
200 … 270 3RT1054-6SP36-3PA0
S6 115 55 2 2 96 ... 127 5 3RT1054-6SF36-3PA0 1 1 unit 41B
150 185 — 30 50 60 125 150 2 2 96 ... 127 3RT1055-6SF36-3PA0
S6 200 … 270 5 3RT1054-6SP36-3PA0 1 1 unit 41B
200 ... 277 3RT1055-6SP36-3PA0
150 75 2 2 96 ... 127 5 3RT1055-6SF36-3PA0 1 1 unit 41B
185 215 — 30 60 75 150
200 ... 200
277 25 2 96 ... 127
3RT1055-6SP36-3PA0 3RT1056-6SF36-3PA0
1 1 unit 41B
200 ... 277 3RT1056-6SP36-3PA0
185 90 2 2 96 ... 127 5 3RT1056-6SF36-3PA0 1 1 unit 41B
225 275 — — 60 75 150
200 ... 200
277 25 2 96 ... 127
3RT1056-6SP36-3PA0 3RT1064-6SF36-3PA0
1 1 unit 41B
S10 225 110 2 2 96 ... 127 5 200 ... 277
3RT1064-6SF36-3PA0 3RT1064-6SP36-3PA0
1 1 unit 41B
265 330 — — 75 100 200
200 ... 250
277 25 2 96 ... 127
3RT1064-6SP36-3PA0 3RT1065-6SF36-3PA0
1 1 unit 41B
S10
265 132 2 2 96 ... 127 5 200 ... 277
3RT1065-6SF36-3PA0 3RT1065-6SP36-3PA0
1 1 unit 41B
300 330 — — 100 125 200 ... 300
250 277 25 3RT1065-6SP36-3PA0
2 96 ... 127 1 1 unit
3RT1066-6SF36-3PA0 41B
300 160 2 2 96 ... 127 5 200 ... 277
3RT1066-6SF36-3PA0 3RT1066-6SP36-3PA0
1 1 unit 41B
400 430 — — 125 150 200 ... 400
300 277 25 3RT1066-6SP36-3PA0
2 96 ... 127 1 1 unit
3RT1075-6SF36-3PA0 41B
S12 400 200 2 2 96 ... 127 5 3RT1075-6SF36-3PA0
200 ... 277 1 1 unit
3RT1075-6SP36-3PA0 41B
S12 200 ... 500
277
500 610 — — 150 200 400 25 3RT1075-6SP36-3PA0
2 96 ... 127 1 1 unit
3RT1076-6SF36-3PA0 41B
500 250 2 2 96 ... 127 5 3RT1076-6SF36-3PA0
200 ... 277 1 1 unit
3RT1076-6SP36-3PA0 41B
200 ... 277 5 3RT1076-6SP36-3PA0 1 1 unit 41B

Accessories and spare parts, see pages 3/76 to 3/125.


Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/11
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT12 vacuum contactors, 3-pole

Selection and ordering data


AC/DC operation (40 Hz ... 60 Hz, DC)
Withdrawable coils
Integrated coil circuit (varistor)
Auxiliary and control conductors: screw connections
Main conductor: bar connections
Size Horsepower ratings Auxiliary Rated control Order No. Weight
2

and utilization categories contacts, supply volt- approx.


lateral age Us
AC-3 Ratings of three-phase AC-1
Contactors and
Assemblies

Maximum motors Maximum


inductive resistive
200 V 230 V 460 V 575 V
current current

Amps HP HP HP HP Amps NO NC AC/DC V kg


Conventional operating mechanism
3RT12 6 . S10 225 60 75 150 200 330 2 2 110 ... 127 3RT12 64-6AF3 6 6.4
220 ... 240 3RT12 64-6AP36
265 75 100 200 250 330 2 2 110 ... 127 3RT12 65-6AF3 6
220 ... 240 3RT12 65-6AP36
300 100 125 250 300 330 2 2 110 ... 127 3RT12 66-6AF3 6
220 ... 240 3RT12 66-6AP36
S12 400 125 150 300 400 610 2 2 110 ... 127 3RT12 75-6AF3 6 9.6
220 ... 240 3RT12 75-6AP36
500 150 200 400 500 610 2 2 110 ... 127 3RT12 76-6AF3 6
220 ... 240 3RT12 76-6AP36

Solid-state operating mechanism · for DC 24 V PLC output


3RT12 7 . S10 225 60 75 150 200 330 2 2 96 ... 127 3RT12 64-6NF3 6 6.4
200 ... 277 3RT12 64-6NP36
265 75 100 200 250 330 2 2 96 ... 127 3RT12 65-6NF3 6
200 ... 277 3RT12 65-6NP36
300 100 125 250 300 330 2 2 96 ... 127 3RT12 66-6NF3 6
200 ... 277 3RT12 66-6NP36
S12 400 125 150 300 400 610 2 2 96 ... 127 3RT12 75-6NF3 6 9.6
200 ... 277 3RT12 75-6NP36
500 150 200 400 500 610 2 2 96 ... 127 3RT12 76-6NF3 6
200 ... 277 3RT12 76-6NP36

Universal Coil Selection for 3RT126 through 3RT127: Conventional Operation


Coil Code B3 D3 F3 M3 P3 U3 V3 R3 S3 T3
Volts AC/DC 23 .. 26 V 42 .. 48 V 110 .. 127 V 200 .. 220 V 220 .. 240 V 240 .. 277 V 380 .. 420 V 440 .. 480 V 500 .. 550 V 575 .. 600 V
40 - 60 Hz, DC

Solid State Selection for 3RT126 through 3RT127: Solid-State


Coil Code B3 F3 P3
Volts AC/DC 21 .. 27.3 V 96 .. 127 V 200 .. 277 V
40 - 60 Hz, DC

For further vacuum contactors, 500Hp and


700Hp (3TF68/69), see page 2/55.
For auxiliaries and accessories, see page 2/70 .
For spare parts, see page 2/100-2/101.
For technical
For further vacuum
data, see contactors, 500Hp and
page 2/154-2/159.
700Hp
For (3TF68/69),
int. circuit see
diagrams, seepage
page 2/28.
2/198
For auxiliariesdrawings,
For dimension and accessories,
see pagesee page 2/37-50.
2/218.
For spare parts, see page 2/56-58.
For technical data, see page 2/96, 2/91-122.
For int. circuit diagrams, see page 2/156.
For dimension drawings, see page 2/178.
2/12 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Special Applications
3RT23 contactors, 4-pole (4 NO contacts) for switching resistive loads (AC-1)

Standards
Size S0: In order to make 4-pole contactor assemblies using two
3RT232. contactors, the fourth pole of the left-hand contactor must
IEC 60947-1, EN 60947-1 always be moved to the left-hand side. The contactor assembly
IEC 60947-4-1, EN 60947-4-1 can then be made easily with the aid of the 3RA2922-2H mechani-
IEC 60947-5-1, EN 60947-5-1 (auxiliary switches) cal interlock and connecting clip set fitted between the
two contactors.
Design Sizes S2 and S3: Contactor assemblies can be made using two
The contactors are suitable for use in any climate. They are safe 3RT23 3 or 3RT23 4. contactors in conjunction with the laterally

2
from touch to DIN VDE 0106, Part 100. The accessories for the mountable mechanical interlock and the mechanical connectors.
3-pole SIRIUS contactors can also be used for the 4-pole de- The mechanical interlock for fitting onto the front cannot be used

Assemblies
Contactors and
signs. for size S2 and S3 contactors.
Mountable auxiliary contacts
Size S00: 4 auxiliary contacts of which up to 3 can be NC. Application
Size S0 & S2: 4 additional auxiliary contacts up to 3 can be NC. • Switching resistive loads
Sizes S2 and S3: Up to 4 auxiliary contacts (either laterally • Isolating systems with unearthed or poorly earthed neutral
mounted or snappped onto the top). conductors
Contactor assemblies with mechanical interlock • System transfers when alternative AC power supplies are used
The 4-pole 3RT23 contactors with 4 NO contacts as the main • As contactors which only carry current and do not have to switch
contacts are suitable for making contactor assemblies with a me- in case of inductive loads – e.g. variable-speed operating
chanical interlock, e.g. for system transfers. mechanisms
Size S00: Contactor assemblies can be made using two 3RT231. • Switching mixed loads in distribution systems (e.g. for supply-
contactors in conjunction with the mechanical interlock and two ing heaters, lamps, motors, PC power supply units) with p.f. >
connecting clips (Order No. 3RA2912-2H, pack comprising 10 0.8 according to IEC 60947-4-1, test conditions for utilization
interlocking elements and 20 clips for 10 contactor assemblies, category AC-1
see accessories on page 2/72).

Selection and ordering data


Rating data Auxiliary contacts
Rated AC Operation Rated DC Operation
AC-1 UL ratings control control
Max resist.
AC loads Ident- supply
Screw supply
Screw
current Ieat 600 V, ification voltage Us Terminals 1) voltage Terminals 1)
40°C 60°C 60 Hz No. Version 50/60 Hz Order No. Us Order No.
Amps Amps NO NC V AC V DC

For screwing and stapping onto 35 mm mounting rail


3RT23 17-1AP60 Size S00 – Auxiliary switches can be retrofitted
18 16 18 — — — 24 3RT23 16-1AB00 24 3RT23 16-1BB40
110/120 3RT23 16-1AK60 125 3RT23 16-1BG40
220/240 3RT23 16-1AP60 220 3RT23 16-1BM40
22 20 20 — — — 24 3RT23 17-1AB00 24 3RT23 17-1BB40
110/120 3RT23 17-1AK60 125 3RT23 17-1BG40
220/240 3RT23 17-1AP60 220 3RT23 17-1BM40
Size S0 – Terminal designations according to EN 50012 —1 NO + 1 NC, identification number 11E
3RT23 27-1AP60 35 2) 30 2) 30 11E 1 1 24 3RT23 25-1AC20 24 3RT23 25-1BB40
110/120 3RT23 25-1AK60 125 3RT23 25-1BG40
220/240 3RT23 25-1AP60 220 3RT23 25-1BM40
40 2) 35 2) 35 11E 1 1 24 3RT23 26-1AC20 24 3RT23 26-1BB40
110/120 3RT23 26-1AK60 125 3RT23 26-1BG40
220/240 3RT23 26-1AP60 220 3RT23 26-1BM40
50 2) 42 2) 38 11E 1 1 24 3RT23 27-1AC20 24 3RT23 27-1BB40
110/120 3RT23 27-1AK60 125 3RT23 27-1BG40
220/240 3RT23 27-1AP60 220 3RT23 27-1BM40
3RT23 36-1AP60 Size S2 V UC
60 55 60 11E 1 1 24 3RT23 36-1AC20 20-33 3RT23 36-1NB30
110/120 3RT23 36-1AK60 83-155 3RT23 36-1NF30
220/240 3RT23 36-1AP60 175-280 3RT23 36-1NP30
110 95 105 11E 1 1 24 3RT23 37-1AC20 20-33 3RT23 37-1NB30
110/120 3RT23 37-1AK60 83-155 3RT23 37-1NF30
220/240 3RT23 37-1AP60 175-280 3RT23 37-1NP30
Size S3 V UC
140 130 120 — — — 24 3RT23 46-1AC20 20-33 3RT23 46-1NB30
110/120 3RT23 46-1AK60 83-155 3RT23 46-1NF30
220/240 3RT23 46-1AP60 175-280 3RT23 46-1NP30

1) Size S00 and S0 contactors are also available with For further voltages, see page 2/51. For technical data, see page 2/168-2/169.
spring-type terminals. Replace the 8th digit of the order For coil voltage tolerance, p. 2/51 For in. circuit diagrams, see page 2/193-2/198.
no. with a “2” e.g. “3RT23 16-2AK60” For auxiliaries and accessories, For dimension drawings, see page 2/219.
2) Minimum conductor cross-section 8 AWG.
see page 2/68-2/85.
For spare parts, see page 2/96-2/101.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/13
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Special Applications
3RT24, 3-pole for switching resistive loads (AC-1)

Application
AC and DC operation The contactors are suitable for (AC-1) or as contactors, for The accessories for the SIRIUS
(size S3) use in any climate. They are example in variable-speed 3RT10/3RT20 contactors can
UC operation (AC/DC) safe from touch to DIN VDE drives which normally only have also be used here.
(sizes S6 to S12) 0106 Part 100. to carry the current.
IEC 60 947, EN 60 947 3RT14/3RT24 contactors are
(VDE 0660) used for switching resistive loads.
2

Selection and ordering data


Contactors and
Assemblies

Ratings UL Ratings Rated control Order No. Weight


AC-1 utilization category, supply voltage Us approx.
IEC Ratings
3RT24 46-1A . .0 Maximum Rated power of three phase Max 230/ 460/ 575/
current loads cos Ø = 0.95 (@ 60°C) Current 240V 480V 600V
230V 400V 500V 690V Hp Hp Hp kg
Amps kW kW kW kW Amps
With screw connections · for screwing and snapping onto
35 mm and 75 mm standard mounting rails
Size S3 · (without auxiliary contacts)
AC operation
140 50 86 107 148 140 15 30 40 24 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT24 46-1AC2 0 1.8
120 V, 60 Hz 3RT24 46-1AK6 0
240 V, 60 Hz 3RT24 46-1AP6 0
DC operation · DC solenoid system
140 50 86 107 148 131 15 30 40 DC 24 V 3RT24 46-1BB4 0 2.7
DC 48 V 3RT24 46-1BW40
AC/DC operation (40 Hz ... 60 Hz, DC) Integrated coil circuit (varistor) Main conductor: bar connections
Withdrawable coils Auxiliary and control conductors: screw connections
Size Ratings UL Auxiliary Rated control Order No. Weight
AC-1 utilization category, Rating contacts, supply voltage Us approx.
lateral
IEC Ratings
3RT14 6 . AC-1 Rated power of three phase Max
Maximum loads cos Ø = 0.95 (@ 60°C) Current
resistive
current 230V 400V 500V 690V
Amps kW kW kW kW Amps NO NC AC/DC V kg
Conventional operating mechanism
S6 275 95 165 205 285 210 2 2 110 ... 127 3RT14 56-6AF36 3.1
220 ... 240 3RT14 56-6AP36
S10 400 145 250 315 430 360 2 2 110 ... 127 3RT14 66-6AF36 5.7
220 ... 240 3RT14 66-6AP36
S12 690 245 430 535 740 580 2 2 110 ... 127 3RT14 76-6AF36 9.1
220 ... 240 3RT14 76-6AP36
Solid-state operating mechanism · for DC 24 V PLC output
3RT14 7 . S6 275 95 165 205 285 210 2 2 96 ... 127 3RT14 56-6NF36 3.1
200 ... 277 3RT14 56-6NP36
S10 400 145 250 315 430 360 2 2 96 ... 127 3RT14 66-6NF36 5.7
200 ... 277 3RT14 66-6NP36
S12 690 245 430 535 740 580 2 2 96 ... 127 3RT14 76-6NF36 9.1
200 ... 277 3RT14 76-6NP36
Solid-state operating mechanism · for DC 24 V PLC
with remaining lifetime indication
S6 275 95 165 205 285 210 1 1 96 ... 127 3RT14 56-6PF35 3.1
200 ... 277 3RT14 56-6PP35
S10 400 145 250 315 430 360 1 1 200 ... 277 3RT14 66-6PP35 5.7
S12 690 245 430 535 740 580 1 1 200 ... 277 3RT14 76-6PP35 9.1

Universal Coil Selection for 3RT145 through 3RT147: Conventional Operation For further coil voltages, see page 2/51.
Coil Code B3 D3 F3 M3 P3 U3 V3 R3 S3 T3
For auxiliaries and accessories,
Volts AC/DC 23 .. 26 V 42 .. 48 V 110 .. 127 V 200 .. 220 V 220 .. 240 V 240 .. 277 V 380 .. 420 V 440 .. 480 V 500 .. 550 V 575 .. 600 V see page 2/68-2/85.
40 - 60 Hz, DC For spare parts, see page 2/96-2/101.
For technical data, see page 2/160-2/167.
For int. circuit diagrams, see page 2/198.
Universal Coil Selection for 3RT145 through 3RT147: Solid-State Note: B3 code not available for
Coil Code B3 F3 P3 For dimension drawings,
Remaining Lifetime Contactors.
Volts AC/DC 21 .. 27.3 V 96 .. 127 V 200 .. 277 V see page 2/213, 2/215-2/216.
40 - 60 Hz, DC

2/14 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Special Applications
3RT25 contactors, 4-pole (2 NO + 2 NC) contacts for switching motors

AC and DC operation Application


Mountable auxiliary contacts
IEC 60 947-4-1/EN 60 947-4-1 Size S00 and S0: • Changing the polarity of hoisting
(VDE 0660, Part 102) 4 auxiliary contacts, of which up to 4 can gear motors
be NC contacts. • Switching two separate loads from
the same source
Design
Size S2
The contactors are suitable for use in any Up to 4 auxiliary contacts (either laterally

2
climate. They are safe to touch accord- mounted or snapped onto the top; auxiliary
ing to EN 50274. The accessories for the switch blocks to EN 50 012 and EN 50

Assemblies
Contactors and
3-pole SIRIUS contactors can also be 005)
used for the 4-pole designs.

Selection and ordering data


Rating data
AC-1 Max Rated Rated
AC-2/AC-3 Tu: up to 60°C AC Operation 2) DC Operation 2)
resistive control control
Max Max motor current Auxiliary supply Screw terminals supply Screw terminals
Current Ie HP at contacts voltage voltage
at 400 V 460 V, 60 Hz 40°C 60°C Version Us Order No. Us Order No.
Amps NO NC Amps NO NC V AC, 50/60 Hz V DC

For screwing and snapping onto 35 mm standard mounting rail


3RT25 16-1AB00 Size S00 3) - Auxiliary switches can be retrofitted

9 5 18 16 — — 24 3RT25 16-1AB00 24 3RT25 16-1BB40


110/120 3RT25 16-1AK60 125 3RT25 16-1BG40
220/240 3RT25 16-1AP60 220 3RT25 16-1BM40
12 7.5 4) 22 20 — — 24 3RT25 17-1AB00 24 3RT25 17-1BB40
110/120 3RT25 17-1AK60 125 3RT25 17-1BG40
220/240 3RT25 17-1AP60 220 3RT25 17-1BM40
3RT25 26-1AC20 16 10 4) 22 20 — — 24 3RT25 18-1AB00 24 3RT25 18-1BB40
110/120 3RT25 18-1AK60 125 3RT25 18-1BG40
220/240 3RT25 18-1AP60 220 3RT25 18-1BM40
Size S0 - Terminal designations according to EN 50012, 1 NO + 1 NC, identification number 11E

25 15 15 40 35 1 1 24 3RT25 26-1AC20 24 3RT25 26-1BB40


110/120 3RT25 26-1AK60 125 3RT25 26-1BG40
220/240 3RT25 26-1AP60 220 3RT25 26-1BM40
3RT25 35-1AC20 Size S2
1 R1 R3 3 13 21
A1 NO NC

NO NC
A2 V UC
2 R2 R4 4 14 22
35 30 20 60 55 1 1 24 3RT25 35-1AC20 20-33 3RT25 35-1NB30
110/120 3RT25 35-1AK60 83-155 3RT25 35-1NF30
220/240 3RT25 35-1AP60 175-280 3RT25 35-1NP30
41 30 25 70 60 1 1 24 3RT25 36-1AC20 20-33 3RT25 36-1NB30
110/120 3RT25 36-1AK60 83-155 3RT25 36-1NF30
220/240 3RT25 36-1AP60 175-280 3RT25 36-1NP30

For further voltages, see page 2/51. 1) For changing polarity; not suitable for reversing. 3) Size S00:
For auxiliaries and accessories, see page 2/68-2/85. 2) Size S00 and S0 contactors are also available
Coil voltage tolerance
For spare parts, see page 2/96-2/101. at 50 Hz: 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us
with spring-type terminals. Replace the 8th
For technical data, see page 2/170-2/171. at 60 Hz: 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us
digit of the order no. with a “2” e.g. “3RT25
For int. circuit diagrams, see page 2/193-2/198. 16-2AK60” 4) The NC contact can switch up to 5 HP.
For dimension drawings, see page 2/219.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/15
SIRIUS
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies
3RT, 3RH Contactors for Special Applications
3RT, 3RH Contactors
Contactors with ExtendedforOperating
SpecialRange 0.7 ... 1.25 x Us, for Railway Applications
Applications
3RH21 contactor relays
3RH21 contactor relays

Overview Application
DC operation For operation in installations which are subject both to consider-
able variations in the control voltage and to high ambient tem-
IEC 60947-4-1, EN 60947-4-1, for requirements according to peratures, e. g. railway applications under extreme climatic
IEC 60077-1 and IEC 60077-2. conditions, rolling mills, etc.
The contactor relays are finger-safe according to EN 50274. The Also for control supply voltages with battery buffer for longer
size S00 contactor relays have spring-type connections for all
2

operating times should the battery charging fail.


terminals.
Contactor relays without series resistor
Ambient temperature
Contactors and
Assemblies

Control and auxiliary circuits


The permissible ambient temperature for operation of the con-

3
tactor relays (across the full coil operating range) is -40 to These contactor relays have an extended operating range from
+70 °C. 0.7 to 1.25 x Us; the solenoid coils are fitted with a suppressor
diode. An additional series resistor is not required.
Uninterrupted duty at temperatures > +60 °C reduces the
mechanical endurance, the current carrying capacity of the con- Note:
ducting paths and the switching frequency. An additional auxiliary switch block cannot be mounted.
Control and auxiliary circuits Side-by-side mounting
The solenoid coils of the contactor relays have an extended coil A clearance of 10 mm is required for side-by-side mounting at
operating range from 0.7 to 1.25 x Us and are fitted as standard ambient temperatures > 60 °C ≤ 70 °C.
with suppressor diodes to provide protection against overvolt- Contactor relays with series resistor
age. The opening delay is consequently 2 to 5 ms longer than for
standard contactors. Control and auxiliary circuits
The DC solenoid systems of the contactor relays are modified (to
hold-in coil) by means of a series resistor.
The size S00 contactor relays are supplied prewired with a plug-
on module containing the series resistor. The suppressor diode
is integrated.

L+
L-

S1

E1+
RV K1

K1 13 23 31
NSB0_02177

A2-
14 24 32

A 4-pole auxiliary switch block (according to EN 50005) can be


fitted additionally.
Side-by-side mounting
Side-by-side mounting is permitted at ambient temperatures up
to 70 °C.

2/16 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 3/53
SIRIUS
3RT, 3RH Contactors for Special Applications
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies

3RT, 3RH Contactors


Contactors with Extendedfor SpecialRange
Operating 0.7 ... 1.25 x Us, for Railway Applications
Applications
3RH21 contactor relays
3RH21 contactor relays

Selection and ordering data


DC operation · DC solenoid system
Spring-type terminals
For screw and snap-on mounting onto standard mounting rail
Solenoid coil fitted with suppressor diode

2
Assemblies
Contactors and
3

3RH21 22-2K . 40 3RH21 22-2K . 40-0LA0


Rated operational current Contacts Rated control supply Spring-type terminals Weight
Ie/AC-15/AC-14 voltage Us approx.
Tu: 70 °C at
230 V 400 V 500 V 690 V Version
Order No.

A A A A NO NC V DC kg
3RH21 contactor relays
Size S00
Without series resistor
Terminal designations according to EN 50011
2 NO + 2 NC, identification number 22E
13 21 31 43
A1(+)

A2(–)
14 22 32 44
10 3 2 1 2 21) 24 3RH21 22-2KB40 0.300
110 3RH21 22-2KF40 0.300
With series resistor
Terminal designations according to EN 50005
2 NO + 1 NC, identification number 21E
13 23 31
A1(+)

A2(–)
14 24 32
10 3 2 1 2 12) 24 3RH21 22-2KB40-0LA0 0.300
110 3RH21 22-2KF40-0LA0 0.300
1) It is not possible to mount an auxiliary switch block.
2) 4-pole auxiliary switch block according to EN 50005 can be mounted.

More information
Contactors Type 3RH21 ..
Upright mounting position
• Contactors with series resistor Special version (on request)
• Contactors without series resistor Special version (on request)
Ambient temperature
• During operation °C -40 ... +70
• During storage °C -55 ... +80
Solenoid coil operating range DC 0.7 ... 1.25 x Us
Power consumption of the solenoid coils For cold coil and 1.0 x Us
• Contactors with series resistor - Closing W 13
- Closed W 4
• Contactors without series resistor - Closing W 2.8
- Closed W 2.8

All specifications and technical specifications not mentioned


here are identical to those of the standard contactor relays.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/17


3/54 SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 Illustrations are approximate
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3RT, 3RH Contactors for Special Applications
3RT, 3RH Contactors
Contactors with ExtendedforOperating
SpecialRange
Applications
0.7 ... 1.25 x Us, for Railway Applications
3RT20 motor contactors, 7.5 ... 25 HP
3RT20 motor contactors, 7.5 ... 25 HP
3RT20 1. contactors with series resistor
Overview
Control and auxiliary circuits
DC operation
The solenoid coils of the contactors have an extended coil oper-
IEC 60947-4-1, EN 60947-4-1, ating range from 0.7 to 1.25 x Us and are fitted as standard with
for requirements according to IEC 60077-1 and IEC 60077-2. suppressor diodes to provide protection against overvoltage.
The contactors are finger-safe according to EN 50274. The The DC solenoid systems of the contactors are modified (to
contactors have spring-type connections as well as screw
2

holding excitation) by means of a series resistor.


connections. The size S00 and S0 contactors have spring-type
connections for all terminals. L+
Contactors and
Assemblies

L-
Ambient temperature

3
S1
The permissible ambient temperature for operation of the con-
tactors (across the full coil operating range) is -40 to +70 °C.
Uninterrupted duty at temperatures > +60 °C reduces the E1+
mechanical endurance, the current carrying capacity of the Rv
conducting paths and the switching frequency. Q1

Control and auxiliary circuits


Q1 1/L1 3/L2 5/L3
The solenoid coils of the contactor relays have an extended coil
operating range from 0.7 to 1.25 or 1.3 x Us and are fitted as

NSB0_02178
A2-
standard with suppressor diodes. The opening delay is 2/T1 4/T2 6/T3
consequently 2 to 5 ms longer than for standard contactors.

Application The size S00 contactors are supplied prewired with a plug-on
module containing the series resistor. The suppressor diode is
For operation in installations which are subject both to integrated. A 4-pole auxiliary switch block (according to
considerable variations in the control voltage and to high EN 50005) can be fitted additionally.
ambient temperatures, e. g. railway applications under extreme
A circuit diagram showing the terminals is labeled on each con-
climatic conditions, rolling mills, etc.
tactor. One NC of the auxiliary contacts is required for the series
Also for control supply voltages with battery buffer for longer resistor function. The selection and ordering data shows the
operating times should the battery charging fail. number of additional, unassigned auxiliary contacts. With size
S00 it is possible to extend the number of auxiliary contacts.
Contactors without series resistor
Side-by-side mounting
Control and auxiliary circuits
At ambient temperatures up to 70 °C, the size S00 contactors
These contactors have an extended operating range from and contactor relays are allowed to be mounted side by side.
0.7 to 1.25 x Us; on size S00 the coils are fitted with suppressor
diodes, on size S0 with varistors. An additional series resistor is 3RT20 2. contactors with solid-state operating mechanism,
not required. extended operating range
Note: Control and auxiliary circuits
An additional auxiliary switch block cannot be mounted.
The solenoid coils of the contactors have an extended coil oper-
Side-by-side mounting ating range from 0.7 to 1.3 x Us and are fitted as standard with
varistors to provide protection against overvoltage.
A clearance of 10 mm is required for side-by-side mounting at
ambient temperatures > 60 °C ≤ 70 °C. The contactors are energized via upstream control electronics
which ensure the coil operating range of 0.7 to 1.3 x Us at an
ambient temperature of 70 °C. They are supplied as complete
units with integrated coil electronics. A varistor is integrated for
damping opening surges in the coil.
The mounting possibilities for auxiliary switches correspond to
those of the standard contactors for switching motors in the
matching size (see page
page 2/60).
3/6).
Side-by-side mounting
Side-by-side mounting is permitted at ambient temperatures up
to 70 °C for these contactor versions in size S0.

2/18 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 3/55
SIRIUS
3RT, 3RH Contactors for Special Applications
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies

3RT, 3RH Contactors


Contactors with Extendedfor SpecialRange
Operating 0.7 ... 1.25 x Us, for Railway Applications
Applications
3RT20 motor contactors, 7.5 ... 25 HP
3RT20 motor contactors, 7.5 ... 25 HP

Selection and ordering data


DC operation · DC solenoid system
Spring-type terminals
For screw and snap-on mounting onto standard mounting rail
Solenoid coil fitted with suppressor diode (S00)

2
Assemblies
Contactors and
3

3RT20 1 . -2K . 4 . 3RT20 1 . -2K . 42-0LA0


Rated data Auxiliary contacts Rated control Spring-type terminals Weight
AC-3 supply voltage approx.
Operational Ratings of Ident. Version Us
current Ie induction motors No.
at at Order No.

400 V 200 V 230 V 460 V 575 V


A HP HP HP HP NO NC V DC kg
3RT20 contactors for switching motors
Size S00
Without series resistor4)
Terminal designations according to EN 50012 or EN 50005
• 1 NO, identification number 10E
A1(+) 1/L1 3/L2 5/L3 13

A2(–)
2/T1 4/T2 6/T3 14
• 1 NC, identification number 01
A1(+) 1/L1 3/L2 5/L3 21

A2(–)
2/T1 4/T2 6/T3 22
12 -- 3 7.5 10 10E1) 1 -- 24 3RT20 17-2KB41 0.300
125 3RT20 17-2KG41 0.300
12 -- 3 7.5 10 011) -- 1 24 3RT20 17-2KB42 0.300
125 3RT20 17-2KG42 0.300
With series resistor

A1(+) 1/L1 3/L2 5/L3

A2(–)
2/T1 4/T2 6/T3
12 -- 3 7.5 10 --2) -- 13) 24 3RT20 17-2KB42-0LA0 0.300
125 3RT20 17-2KG42-0LA0 0.300
16 -- 5 10 10 --2) -- 13) 24 3RT20 18-2KB42-0LA0 0.300
125 3RT20 18-2KG42-0LA0 0.300
For
Foraccessories
accessoriesand
andspare
spareparts,
parts,see page
see 2/68-2/71.
page 3/93.
1) It is not possible to mount an auxiliary switch block. A clearance of 10 mm
is required for side-by-side mounting at ambient temperatures > 60 °C.
2) One 4-pole auxiliary switch block according to EN 50005 can be mounted;
no distance required up to 70 °C.
3) NC contact cannot be used because it is required for switching the series
resistor.
4) Versions available with screw terminals.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/19
3/56 SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 Illustrations are approximate
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3RT, 3RH Contactors for Special Applications
3RT, 3RH Contactors
Contactors with ExtendedforOperating
SpecialRange
Applications
0.7 ... 1.25 x Us, for Railway Applications
3RT20 motor contactors, 7.5 ... 25 HP
3RT20 motor contactors, 7.5 ... 25 HP
DC operation · DC solenoid system
Spring-type terminals
For screw and snap-on mounting onto standard mounting rail
Solenoid coil fitted with varistor (S0)
2 Assemblies
Contactors and

3
3RT20 2. -2K . 4 0 3RT20 2 . -2X . 40-0LA2

Rated data Auxiliary contacts Rated control Spring-type terminals Weight


AC-3 supply voltage approx.
Operational Ratings of Ident. Version Us
current Ie induction motors No.
at at Order No.

400 V 200 V 230 V 460 V 575 V


A HP HP HP HP NO NC V DC kg
3RT20 contactors for switching motors
Size S0
Terminal designations according to EN 50012
1 NO + 1 NC, identification number 11E
1/L1 3/L2 5/L3 13 21
A1(+)

A2(–)
2/T1 4/T2 6/T3 14 22

Without series resistor1)


16 -- 5 10 15 11E 1 1 24 3RT20 25-2KB40 0.600
125 3RT20 25-2KG40 0.600
25 -- 7.5 15 20 11E 1 1 24 3RT20 26-2KB40 0.600
125 3RT20 26-2KG40 0.600
32 -- 10 20 25 11E 1 1 24 3RT20 27-2KB40 0.600
125 3RT20 27-2KG40 0.600
With solid-state operating mechanism
16 -- 5 10 15 11E 1 1 24 3RT20 25-2XB40-0LA2 0.580
125 3RT20 25-2XG40-0LA2 0.580
25 -- 7.5 15 20 11E 1 1 24 3RT20 26-2XB40-0LA2 0.580
125 3RT20 26-2XG40-0LA2 0.580
32 -- 10 20 25 11E 1 1 24 3RT20 27-2XB40-0LA2 0.580
125 3RT20 27-2XG40-0LA2 0.580
38 -- 10 25 25 11E 1 1 24 3RT20 28-2XB40-0LA2 0.580
125 3RT20 28-2XG40-0LA2 0.580
For
Foraccessories
accessoriesand
andspare
spareparts,
parts,see
seepage
page2/68-2/71.
3/93.
1) It is not possible to mount an auxiliary switch block. A clearance of 10 mm
is required for side-by-side mounting at ambient temperatures > 60 °C.

More information
Contactors Type 3RT20 17 3RT20 2. 3RT20 2.-2XB40- 3RT20 2.-2XF40-
0LA2 0LA2
Ambient temperature
• During operation °C -40 ... +70
• During storage °C -55 ... +80
Solenoid coil operating range DC 0.7 ... 1.25 x Us 0.7 ... 1.3 x Us
Power consumption of the solenoid coils For cold coil and 1.0 x Us
• Contactors with series resistor - Closing W 13 -- -- --
- Closed W 4 -- -- --
• Contactors without series resistor - Closing W 2.8 4.5 -- --
- Closed W 2.8 4.5 -- --
• Contactors with solid-state operating - Closing W -- -- 6.7 13.2
mechanism
- Closed W -- -- 0.8 1.56

All specs and technical specs not mentioned here are identical
to those of the standard contactors for switching motors.

2/20 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Illustrations are approximate SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 3/57
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Special Applications
3RT26 capacitor contactors

This prevents disturbances in The capacitor contactors of The capacitor contactors of


AC operation
the power system and welding size S00 contain either 1NO size S2 can be fitted addition-
IEC 60947-5, DIN EN 60947-5-1, of the contactors. or 1NC in the basic unit and ally with a 2-pole auxiliary
(VDE 0660 Part 200) another unassigned NC switch on the right side (2 NO,
Only discharged capacitors are
contact in the auxiliary switch 2 NC or 1 NO + 1 NC), type
The contactors are suitable for permitted to be switched on
block fitted to the basic unit. 3RH19 21-1EA.. for lateral
use in any climate and are with capacitor contactors. mounting.
finger safe per DIN EN 50274. Recommendation: use dis- The auxiliary switch block
charge chokes for parallel con- which is snapped onto the For the capacitor making and
breaking capacity of the basic

2
The 3RT26 capacitor contactors nection with the capacitors. capacitor contactor of sizes
are application specific variants S0 contains the three leading 3RT20 contactor variant, see
of the size S00 to S2 SIRIUS NO contacts and one stan- the technical data.

Assemblies
Contactors and
Innovations contactors. The dard NO contact, which is
capacitors are precharged by unassigned.
means of the mounted leading
NO contacts and resistors; only
then do the main contacts close.

Selection and ordering data


AC operation
AC-6b utilization category Current Auxiliary Rated control Screw connection Weight
For switching three-phase capacitors at an contacts, supply voltage approx.
ambient temperature of 60 °C 2) unassigned Us1) 3)
UL capacitor rating at operational voltage Order No.
200/208 230/240 460/480 575/600
Phase kvar kvar kvar kvar AC kg
For screwing and snapping onto 35 mm standard mounting rail
3RT26 17-1AK63 Size S00
1Ø 3.6 4 8.3 10 18 1NO / 1NC 24 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT26 17-1AB03 0.24
3Ø 6.2 6.9 14 17 120 V, 60 Hz 3RT26 17-1AK63
240 V, 60 Hz 3RT26 17-1AP63

Size S0
1Ø 4.8 5.3 11 13 24 1NO / 2NC 24 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT26 25-1AC25 0.49
3Ø 8.3 9.1 18 23 120 V, 60 Hz 3RT26 25-1AK65
240 V, 60 Hz 3RT26 25-1AP65

1Ø 5.8 6.4 13 16 29 1NO / 2NC 24 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT26 26-1AC25 0.49


3Ø 10 11 22 28 120 V, 60 Hz 3RT26 26-1AK65
240 V, 60 Hz 3RT26 26-1AP65

3RT2637-1NF35 1Ø 6.6 7.3 15 18 33 1NO / 2NC 24 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT26 27-1AC25 0.49


3Ø 11 13 25 31 120 V, 60 Hz 3RT26 27-1AK65
240 V, 60 Hz 3RT26 27-1AP65

1Ø 8.6 9.5 20 24 43 1NO / 2NC 24 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT26 28-1AC25 0.59


3Ø 15 16 33 41 120 V, 60 Hz 3RT26 28-1AK65
240 V, 60 Hz 3RT26 28-1AP65

Size S2
1Ø 14 16 33 40 72A 2 NC 23-33 VUC 3RT26 36-1NB35 1.11
3Ø 25 27 55 69 83-155 VUC 3RT26 36-1NF35
175-280 VUC 3RT26 36-1NP35

1Ø 20 22 45 54 98A 2 NC 20-33 VUC 3RT26 37-1NB35 1.11


3Ø 34 38 75 94 83-155 VUC 3RT26 37-1NF35
175-280 VUC 3RT26 37-1NP35
1) Coil voltage tolerance: 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us.
2) A clearance of 10 mm is required for side-by-side mounting at ambient temperatures > 60 °C

For further voltages, see page 2/51.


DC Coil Selection for 3RT261 only
For auxiliaries and accessories,
see page 2/68-2/85. ●● Coil Code B4 W4 E4 F4 G4 M4
For technical data, see page 2/172. DC 24 V 48 V 60 V 110 V 125 V 220 V
For wiring diagram, see page 2/200.
For dimension drawings, see page 2/220. UC Coil Selection for 3RT262 UC Coil Selection for 3RT263
●● Coil Code NB3 NF3 NP3 ●● Coil Code B3 F3 P3
UC 21-28V 95-130V 200-280V 20-33V 83-155V 175-280V
3) at upper limit = 1.1 x Us

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/21
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Special Applications
3RT20 coupling contactors (interface) for switching motors, 3-pole

AC and DC operation
IEC 60947, EN 60947. The 3RT20 1 coupling contactors Depending on the version, the
The 3RT20 coupling contactors for cannot be expanded with auxiliary solenoid coils are supplied either
switching motors are tailored to the switch blocks. without overvoltage damping or with
special requirements of working with Coupling contactors have a low a diode, suppressor diode or varistor
electronic controls. power consumption and an extended connected as standard.
solenoid coil operating range.
2 Assemblies
Contactors and

Selection and ordering data


DC operation

3RT2015-1HB41 3RT2015-2HB41

Surge Ratings Auxiliary contacts Screw connection Spring-type connection Weight


suppressor Utilization category approx.
AC-3 Ident. Design Order No. Order No. (screw/
no. spring)
Maximum Maximum1)
inductive horsepower
current ratings
at 460 V

Amps HP NO NC kg

For screwing and snapping onto 35 mm standard mounting


rail
Size S00
Terminal designations according to EN 50 012
Rated control supply voltage Us = DC 24 V, coil voltage tolerance 0.7 to 1.25 × Us
Power consumption of the coils 2.8 W at 24 V (no auxiliary switch blocks can be mounted)

Diode, varistor 7 3 10E 1 – 3RT20 15-1HB41 3RT20 15-2HB41 0.28/0.30


or RC element 01 – 1 3RT20 15-1HB42 3RT20 15-2HB42
can be mounted

Diode 7 3 10E 1 – 3RT20 15-1J B41 3RT20 15-2J B41 0.28/0.30


integrated 01 – 1 3RT20 15-1J B42 3RT20 15-2J B42
Suppressor diode 7 3 10E 1 – 3RT20 15-1KB41 3RT20 15-2KB41 0.28/0.30
integrated 01 – 1 3RT20 15-1KB42 3RT20 15-2KB42
Diode, varistor 9 5 10E 1 – 3RT20 16-1HB41 3RT20 16-2HB41 0.28/0.30
or RC element 01 – 1 3RT20 16-1HB42 3RT20 16-2HB42
can be mounted

Diode 9 5 10E 1 – 3RT20 16-1J B41 3RT20 16-2J B41 0.28/0.30


integrated 01 – 1 3RT20 16-1J B42 3RT20 16-2J B42

Suppressor diode 9 5 10E 1 – 3RT20 16-1KB41 3RT20 16-2KB41 0.28/0.30


integrated 01 – 1 3RT20 16-1KB42 3RT20 16-2KB42
Diode, varistor 12 7.5 10E 1 – 3RT20 17-1HB41 3RT20 17-2HB41 0.28/0.30
or RC element 01 – 1 3RT20 17-1HB42 3RT20 17-2HB42
can be mounted

Diode 12 7.5 10E 1 – 3RT20 17-1J B41 3RT20 17-2J B41 0.28/0.30
integrated 01 – 1 3RT20 17-1J B42 3RT20 17-2J B42
Suppressor diode 12 7.5 10E 1 – 3RT20 17-1KB41 3RT20 17-2KB41 0.28/0.30
integrated 01 – 1 3RT20 17-1KB42 3RT20 17-2KB42

For technical data, see page 2/173.


For int. circuit diagrams, see page 2/192-2/197.
For dimension drawings, see page 2/211.
1)
1) Complete
Complete HP
HP ratings on page
ratings on 2/89.
page 2/126

2/22 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Special Applications
3RT20 coupling contactors (interface) for switching motors

Selection and ordering data


DC operation

2
Assemblies
Contactors and
3RT2015-1VB41 3RT2015-2VB41 3RT2024-1KB40

Surge Ratings Auxiliary contacts Screw connection Spring-type connection Weight


suppressor Utilization category approx.
AC-3 Ident. Design Order No. Order No. (screw/
no. spring)
Maximum Maximum
inductive horsepower
current ratings
at 460 V

Amps HP NO NC kg
For screwing and snapping onto
35 mm standard mounting rail
Size S00
Terminal designations according to EN 50 012
Rated control supply voltage Us =DC 24 V, coil voltage tolerance 0.85 to 1.85 × Us
Power consumption of the coils 1.6 W at 24 V (no auxiliary switch blocks can be mounted)

Diode, varistor 7 3 10E 1 – 3RT20 15-1MB41-0KT0 3RT20 15-2M B41-0KT0 0.28/0.30


or RC element 01 – 1 3RT20 15-1M B42-0KT0 3RT20 15-2M B42-0KT0
can be mounted
Diode 7 3 10E 1 – 3RT20 15-1VB41 3RT20 15-2VB41 0.28/0.30
integrated 01 – 1 3RT20 15-1VB42 3RT20 15-2VB42

Suppressor diode 7 3 10E 1 – 3RT20 15-1SB41 3RT20 15-2SB41 0.28/0.30


integrated 01 – 1 3RT20 15-1SB42 3RT20 15-2SB42
Diode, varistor 9 5 10E 1 – 3RT20 16-1M B41-0KT0 3RT20 16-2M B41-0KT0 0.28/0.30
or RC element 01 – 1 3RT20 16-1M B42-0KT0 3RT20 16-2M B42-0KT0
can be mounted
Diode 9 5 10E 1 – 3RT20 16-1VB41 3RT20 16-2VB41 0.28/0.30
integrated 01 – 1 3RT20 16-1VB42 3RT20 16-2VB42

Suppressor diode 9 5 10E 1 – 3RT20 16-1SB41 3RT20 16-2SB41 0.28/0.30


integrated 01 – 1 3RT20 16-1SB42 3RT20 16-2SB42
Diode, varistor 12 7.5 10E 1 – 3RT20 17-1M B41-0KT0 3RT20 17-2M B41-0KT0 0.28/0.30
or RC element 01 – 1 3RT20 17-1M B42-0KT0 3RT20 17-2M B42-0KT0
can be mounted
Diode 12 7.5 10E 1 – 3RT20 17-1VB41 3RT20 17-2VB41 0.28/0.30
integrated 01 – 1 3RT20 17-1VB42 3RT20 17-2VB42
Suppressor diode 12 7.5 10E 1 – 3RT20 17-1SB41 3RT20 17-2SB41 0.28/0.30
integrated 01 – 1 3RT20 17-1SB42 3RT20 17-2SB42

Size S0
Rated control supply voltage Us = DC 24 V, coil voltage tolerance 0.7 to 1.25 × Us
Power consumption of the coils 4.5 W at 24 V no auxiliary switch blocks can be mounted.

Varistor 12 7.5 11E 1 1 3RT20 24-1KB40 3RT20 24-2KB40 0.58/0.60


integrated
16 10 11E 1 1 3RT20 25-1KB40 3RT20 25-2KB40 0.58/0.60
25 15 11E 1 1 3RT20 26-1KB40 3RT20 26-2KB40 0.58/0.60
32 20 11E 1 1 3RT20 27-1KB40 3RT20 27-2KB40 0.58/0.60

For technical data, see page 2/173.


For int. circuit diagrams, see page 2/192-2/197.
For dimension drawings, see page 2/211.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/23


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors & Relays for Safety Applications
3RT, 3TF safety contactors and 3RH2, 3TH2 safety control relays

Applications

“Safety” Contactors Siemens Contactors for “Safety” Control Relays Siemens Control Relays for
Safety rated contactors are “Safety” applications: Safety rated control relays “Safety” applications:
required to have mirrored All Siemens standard 3RT, 3TF6, are required to have positively All SIRIUS 3RH control relays
contact construction accord- 40HN & 40PH Contactors are driven contact elements (with at least 1 NC contact)
ing to IEC 60947-4-1 Annex F. provided with positively driven according to IEC 60947-5-1 meet or exceed the criteria for
2

A mirror contact is a Normally (mirror) contacts which meet or Annex L. Positively driven con- “Safety Control Relays” accord-
Closed (NC) auxiliary contact exceed the criteria for “Safety tact elements are a combination ing to IEC 60947-5-1 Annex L.
Contactors and
Assemblies

which can not be closed simul- Contactors” according to IEC of NO auxiliary contacts and NC This is true for the basic 3RH
taneously with a Normally Open 60947-4 Annex F which auxiliary contacts whose con- relay with or without an addi-
(NO) main contact. describes the requirements for struction prevents them from tional auxiliary contact block.
mirror contact performance. being closed simultaneously.
In some industries, such as When applying Safety Contac-
automotive, requirements have tors in safety circuits, the NC In some industries, such as
been established that a safety auxiliary contacts must be wired automotive, requirements have
rated contactor must also have in series or parallel and must been established that a safety
permanently mounted auxiliary be used as monitoring contacts rated control relays must also
contact blocks. See page 2/25 with feedback to the safety have permanently mounted
for Contactors with permanently evaluation device (i.e. safety auxiliary contact blocks. See
mounted auxiliary contacts. relay or failsafe logic controller). page 2/20 for Control Relays
with permanently mounted
auxiliary contacts.

3RT20 2. -1A .00 3RT10 7. -6A ..6 3RH29 21. -1F 3RH29 21. -1DA 11 3RH21 3RH24 3RH2911-2HA..

Frame Frame
size Contactors Auxiliary contact block size Control Relays Auxiliary contact block
3RT201 3RH21
3RH2911
3RT231 3RH2911 S00 3RH24
S00
3RT251 3TH20 3TX44
3RT261 3RH1911
3RT202
3RT232 3RH2921
S0
3RT252
3RT262 3RH2921
3RT203
3RT233
S2 3RH2921
3RT253
3RT263
3RT204
3RT234
S3 3RH2921
3RT244
3RT264
3RT105
S6 3RH1921
3RT145
3RT106
S10 3RT126 3RH1921
3RT146
3RT107 For contactors, see pages 2/8-2/11.
S12 3RT127 3RH1921 For auxiliaries contact blocks, see pages 2/68-2/70.
3RT147 For control relays, see pages 2/52-2/54.
3TF6 3TY7561-1UA00 For auxiliaries contact blocks, see page 2/68-2/70..

2/24 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors & Relays for Safety Applications
3RT safety contactors, 3RH2 safety control relays with permanently mounted auxiliary contact blocks

Application
"Safety" Control Relays
IEC 60947-4-1 IEC 60947-5-1
“Safety” Contactors for contactors
Safety rated control relays are required for control
Safety rated contactors are required to to have positively driven contact relays
have mirrored contact construction elements according to IEC 60947-5-1
according to IEC 60947-4 Annex F. A Annex L. Positively driven contact
mirror contact is a Normally Closed (NC) elements are a combination of NO
auxiliary contact which can not be closed auxiliary contacts and NC auxiliary

2
simultaneously with a Normally Open contacts whose construction prevents
(NO) main contact. In some industries, them from being closed simultaneously.

Assemblies
Contactors and
such as Automotive, the auxiliary contact In some industries, such as automotive,
blocks are required to be permanently the auxiliary contact blocks are required
attached to meet the requirements of to be permanently attached to meet the
“unitentional misuse” as specified in IEC requirements of "unitentional misuse" as
60292, paragraph 3.12. Tested by SUVA. specified in IEC 60292, paragraph 3.12.
3RT202* -1AK64-3MA0 Tested by SUVA. 3RH22**-2BB40

Application
Max. Single-phase Three-phase
Frame current HP ratings HP ratings Auxiliary contacts Screw Spring-Type
Size AC3 AC1 115V 220/240V 200V 230V 460V 575V Terminals Terminals 1)
A A HP HP HP HP HP HP Ident. No. NO NC Order No. Order No.
Contactors with permanently mounted auxiliary contact blocks
S00 6 18 ¼ ¾ 1½ 2 3 5 22E 2 2 3RT2015-1●●●4-3MA0 3RT2015-2●●●4-3MA0
9 22 1⁄3 1 2 3 5 7½ 22E 2 2 3RT2016-1●●●4-3MA0 3RT2016-2●●●4-3MA0
12 22 ½ 2 3 3 7½ 10 22E 2 2 3RT2017-1●●●4-3MA0 3RT2017-2●●●4-3MA0
16 22 1 2 3 5 10 10 22E 2 2 3RT2018-1●●●4-3MA0 3RT2018-2●●●4-3MA0
S0 9 40 1 1 2 3 5 7½ 22E 2 2 3RT2023-1●●●4-3MA0 3RT2023-2●●●4-3MA0
12 40 1 2 3 3 7½ 10 22E 2 2 3RT2024-1●●●4-3MA0 3RT2024-2●●●4-3MA0
17 40 1 3 5 5 10 15 22E 2 2 3RT2025-1●●●4-3MA0 3RT2025-2●●●4-3MA0
25 40 2 3 7½ 7½ 15 20 22E 2 2 3RT2026-1●●●4-3MA0 3RT2026-2●●●4-3MA0
32 50 2 5 10 10 20 25 22E 2 2 3RT2027-1●●●4-3MA0 3RT2027-2●●●4-3MA0
38 50 3 5 10 10 25 25 22E 2 2 3RT2028-1●●●4-3MA0 3RT2028-2●●●4-3MA0
S2 40 60 3 7½ 10 15 30 40 22E 2 2 3RT2035-1●●●4-3MA0 3RT2035-3●●●4-3MA0
50 70 3 10 15 15 40 50 22E 2 2 3RT2036-1●●●4-3MA0 3RT2036-3●●●4-3MA0
65 80 5 10 20 20 50 50 22E 2 2 3RT2037-1●●●4-3MA0 3RT2037-3●●●4-3MA0
804) 90 5 15 20 25 50 60 22E 2 2 3RT2038-1●●●4-3MA0 3RT2038-3●●●4-3MA0
S3 80 120 7½ 15 25 30 60 75 22E 2 2 3RT2045-1●●●4-3MA0 3RT2045-3●●●4-3MA0
95 120 10 20 30 30 75 100 22E 2 2 3RT2046-1●●●4-3MA0 3RT2046-3●●●4-3MA0
S6 150 185 -- 30 50 60 125 150 22E 2 2 3RT1055-6●●●6-3PA0 —
185 215 -- 30 60 75 150 200 22E 2 2 3RT1056-6●●●6-3PA0 —
S10 225 275 -- -- 60 75 150 200 22E 2 2 3RT1064-6●●●6-3PA0 —
265 330 -- -- 75 100 200 250 22E 2 2 3RT1065-6●●●6-3PA0 —
300 330 -- -- 100 125 250 300 22E 2 2 3RT1066-6●●●6-3PA0 —

Control circuit coil options: Replace ●●● with the desired code
Frame Size S00 - S0 ●●● Frame Size S2 ●●● Frame Size S3 ●●● Frame Size S6 - S10 ●●●
120 V AC AK6 120 V AC AK6 120 V AC ** AK6 23 … 26 V UC*, conventional coil AB3
120 V AC, integrated varistor CK6 120 V AC w/ Varistor CK6 24V DC KB4 21-27 V UC*, solid state coil NB3
230 V AC AP0 24 V DC w/Varistor KB4 w/ integrated varistor w/ PLC interface
24 V DC BB4 24V AC/DC NB3 110 … 127 V UC*, conventional coil AF3
24 V DC, integrated varistor DB4 w/integrated varistor
*UC coil: accepts DC voltage or
24 V DC, integrated diode assy. FB4 AC voltage, 40 to 60 Hz.

Frame Max. current Rated control supply Screw Spring


Size at 240 V 2) voltage Us Auxiliary contacts Terminals 3) Terminals 3)
A Indent. No. NO NC Order No. Order No.
Control relays with permanently mounted auxiliary contact blocks
S00-S00 10 110 V AC, 50 Hz / 120 V AC, 60 Hz 44E 4 4 3RH2244-1AK60 3RH2244-2AK60
10 24 V DC 44E 4 4 3RH2244-1BB40 3RH2244-2BB40
10 110 V AC, 50 Hz / 120 V AC, 60 Hz 62E 6 2 3RH2262-1AK60 3RH2262-2AK60
10 24 V DC 62E 6 2 3RH2262-1BB40 3RH2262-2BB40

For other voltages see page 2/51. For int. circuit diagrams, see page 2/192-2/198.
For accessories, see pages 2/75-2/80. For dimension drawings, see pages 2/211-2/218. 2) For AC-15/AC-14, max current for front mounted auxiliary contacts = 6 A.
For spare parts, see pages 2/96-2/99. 3) The 3RH22 control relays are also available with ring lug terminals. Replace
1) All terminals are spring loaded on frame size S00 and S0.
For technical data, see pages 2/123-2/144. Only the coil and auxiliary contact terminals are spring the 8th digit of the order number with a “4”, e. g. 3RH2244-4AK60
For description, see pages 2/106-2/107. loaded on frame sizes S2 & S3. 4) Max UL FLA = 65A at 460V

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/25
SIRIUS
Function Modules for Mounting onto SIRIUS 3RT2 Contactors
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies

Function Modules for Mounting onto SIRIUS 3RT2 Contactors


Introduction
Introduction

Overview
The function modules for mounting onto contactors enable the
assembly of starters and contactor assemblies for direct-on-line,
reversing and wye-delta starting without any additional, compli-
cated wiring of the individual components. They include the key
control functions required for the particular starter, e. g. timing
and interlocking, and can be connected to the control system by
2

either parallel wiring or through IO-Link or AS-Interface.


Contactors and
Assemblies

Version SIRIUS function modules SIRIUS function modules SIRIUS function modules
for IO-Link1) for AS-Interface1)
3

for parallel wiring


For direct-on-line starting Timing relays: ON or OFF-delay with With screw or spring-type terminals With screw or spring-type terminals
semiconductor output
With screw or spring-type terminals

For reversing starting Wiring modules 1 function module for size S00, S0 & S2, 1 function module for size S00, S0 & S2,
for sizes S00, S0 & S2 screw and spring-type connection, plus screw and spring-type connection, plus
With screw or spring-type terminals · the respective wiring modules1) the respective wiring modules1)
(with screw terminals for main and control
circuit)

For wye-delta starting 1 function module for size S00, S0 & S2, For wye-delta starting: 1 function module For wye-delta starting: 1 function module
screw and spring-type connection of the for size S00, S0 & S2, plus screw and for size S00, S0 & S2, plus screw and
contactors, plus the respective wiring spring-type connection, plus the respec- spring-type connection, plus the respec-
modules2) tive wiring modules2) tive wiring modules2)

Accessories Sealable covers Operator panel for autonomous controlling AS-Interface addressing units
of up to 4 starters Sealable covers
Module connector for the grouping of
starters
Connection cable between the operator
panel and the starter group
Sealable covers

1) Use of the communication-capable function modules for IO-Link or Note:


AS-Interface requires contactors with communication interface When the function modules are used, no other auxiliary switches
(see pages 2/28). are allowed to be mounted on the basic units.
2) The modules for the control current wiring, which are included in the wiring
kit, are not required.

2/26 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


3/76 SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012
SIRIUS
Function Modules for Mounting onto SIRIUS 3RT2 Contactors
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies

Function Modules for Mounting onto SIRIUS 3RT2 Contactors


SIRIUS function modules
SIRIUS function modules

Overview Application
Simply by being plugged in place, the SIRIUS function modules The snap-on function modules for direct-on-line starting are
enable different functionalities required for the assembly of start- used above all for realizing timing functions independently of the
ers to be realized in the starter. The function modules and wiring control system.
kits help to reduce the wiring work within the starter practically to
zero. With the OFF-delay variant of the timing relay it is possible for
example for the fan motor for cooling a main drive to be switched

2
SIRIUS function modules for direct-on-line starting off with a delay so that sufficient cooling after operation is guar-
anteed even if the plant and its control system have already
The electronic timing relays which can be mounted onto the been switched off.

Assemblies
Contactors and
contactor are available in these versions:
• Sizes S00 and S0 for applications in the range from The ON-delay timing relays enable for example the time-delayed
starting of several drives so that the summation starting current

3
24 to 240 V AC/DC (wide voltage range)
does not rise too high, which could result in voltage failure.
• Size S2 for applications in either the range from 24 to
90 V AC/DC or 90 to 240 V AC/DC The function modules for wye-delta starting are mostly used
where current-limiting measures for starting a drive are required,
Both the electrical and mechanical connection are made by e.g. for large fans and ventilators, and a high level of availability
simple snapping on and locking. is essential at the same time. This technology has been used
A protection circuit (varistor) is integrated in each module. with success for several decades and has the additional advan-
tage of requiring relatively little know-how. Through the use of
The electronic timing relay with semiconductor output uses function modules, the assembly work with simple standard com-
two contact legs to actuate the contactor underneath by means ponents is even easier and error-free.
of a semiconductor after the set time t has elapsed.
The switching state feedback is performed by a mechanical Benefits
switching state indicator (plunger). In addition, the auxiliary
switches in the contactors are freely accessible and can be used The use of snap-on function modules for direct-on-line starting
for feedbacks to the control system or for signal lamps. (timing relays) results in the following advantages:
• Reduction of control current wiring
A sealable cover is available to protect against careless
adjustment of the set times. • Prevention of wiring errors
• Reduction of testing costs
SIRIUS function modules for reversing starting
• Implementation of timing functions independently of the
The wiring kits for reversing starters enable the cost-effective control system
assembly of contactor assemblies. They can be used for all
• Less space required in the control cabinet compared to a
applications with reversing duty up to 50 HP.
separate timing relay
For a detailed description see page 2/39.
• No additive protection circuit required (varistor integrated)
SIRIUS function modules for wye-delta starting
The use of function modules for wye-delta starting results in the
Both interlocking and timing functions are required for the following advantages:
assembly of wye-delta starters. With the function modules for
• Operation solely through the line contactor A1/A2 – no further
wye-delta starting and the matching link modules for the main
wiring needed
circuit, these starters can be assembled easily and with abso-
lutely no errors. • Reduction of the control current wiring inside the contactor
assembly and to the higher-level control system where
The entire sequence in the control circuit is integrated in the applicable
snap-on modules. This covers:
• Prevention of wiring errors
• An adjustable wye time t from 0.5 to 60 s
• Reduction of testing costs
• A non-adjustable dead interval of 50 ms
• Integrated electrical interlocking saves costs and prevents
• Electrical contacting to the contactors by means of coil errors
pick-off (contact legs)
• Less space needed in the control cabinet compared to using
• Feedback of the switching state at the contactor using a a separate timing relay
mechanical switch position indicator (plunger)
• Adjustable starting in star mode from 0.5 to 60 s
• Electrical interlocking between the contactors
• Independent of the contactor's control supply voltage
These modules do not require their own terminals and can there- (24 to 240 V AC/DC)
fore be used for contactors with both screw and spring-type • Varistor integrated – no additive protection circuit required
terminals in the S00, S0 and S2. To start the wye-delta starter,
only the first of the three contactors (line contactor) is actuated. • No control current wiring thanks to plug-in technology and
All other functions then take place inside the individual connecting cables
modules. • Mechanically coded assembly enables easy configuration
and reliable wiring
This also offers advantages if the timing function was previously
implemented in a controller, as it again results in a significant • Fewer versions – one module kit for screw and spring-type
reduction in the number of PLC outputs, the programming work connection and for the two sizes S00 to S2
and the wiring outlay. • Mechanical interlocking (with wiring kit for the main circuit)
The kits for the main circuit include the mechanical interlock, the
star jumper, the wiring modules at the top and at the bottom, and
the required connecting clips.
A protection circuit (varistor) is integrated in the basic module.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/27


SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 3/77
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT2 contactors, 3-pole – Communication Contactors

Selection and ordering data

• Ideal for diagnostics to the automation controller • Reduces control wiring in the panel
• Quickly locate and rectify faults • Available for 24VDC control systems
• Configuration available in Step 7 and TIA Portal • Easily snap on IO-Link or AS-Interface
• Easy engineering of parameters modules onto contactors
• For DOL, reversing and wye delta starters up to 50 HP
2

• Manual starter operation with optional operator panel


Contactors and
Assemblies

Spring-type
Amp Single-phase Three-phase Auxiliary Screw Terminals Terminals 1) Weight
Ratings HP ratings HP ratings contacts 24 V DC coil 24 V DC coil approx.
Frame
Size AC3 AC1 115V 230V 208V 230V 460V 575V NO NC Order No. Order No. kg
3RT 3-pole Contactors
1 0 3RT2015-1BB41-0CC0 3RT2015-2BB41-0CC0
7 18 0.25 0.75 1.5 2 3 5
0 1 3RT2015-1BB42-0CC0 3RT2015-2BB42-0CC0
1 0 3RT2016-1BB41-0CC0 3RT2016-2BB41-0CC0
9 22 0.33 1 2 3 5 7.5
0 1 3RT2016-1BB42-0CC0 3RT2016-2BB42-0CC0
S00 0.28
1 0 3RT2017-1BB41-0CC0 3RT2017-2BB41-0CC0
12 22 0.5 2 3 3 7.5 10
3RT2018-1BB41-0CC0 0 1 3RT2017-1BB42-0CC0 3RT2017-2BB42-0CC0
1 0 3RT2018-1BB41-0CC0 3RT2018-2BB41-0CC0
16 22 1 2 3 5 10 10
0 1 3RT2018-1BB42-0CC0 3RT2018-2BB42-0CC0
9 40 1 1 2 3 5 7.5 1 1 3RT2023-1BB40-0CC0 3RT2024-2BB40-0CC0
12 40 1 2 3 3 7.5 10 1 1 3RT2024-1BB40-0CC0 3RT2024-2BB40-0CC0
16 40 1 3 5 5 10 15 1 1 3RT2025-1BB40-0CC0 3RT2025-2BB40-0CC0
S0 0.58
25 40 2 3 7.5 7.5 15 20 1 1 3RT2026-1BB40-0CC0 3RT2026-2BB40-0CC0
32 50 2 5 10 10 20 25 1 1 3RT2027-1BB40-0CC0 3RT2027-2BB40-0CC0
3RT2028-1BB40-0CC0
38 50 3 5 10 10 25 25 1 1 3RT2028-1BB40-0CC0 3RT2028-2BB40-0CC0

40 60 3 7.5 10 15 30 40 1 1 3RT2035-1NB30-0CC0 3RT2035-3NB30-0CC0

50 70 3 10 15 15 40 50 1 1 3RT2036-1NB30-0CC0 3RT2036-3NB30-0CC0
S2 1.122
65 80 5 10 20 20 50 50 1 1 3RT2037-1NB30-0CC0 3RT2037-3NB30-0CC0

3RT2038-1NB30-0CC0 80 90 5 15 20 25 50 60 1 1 3RT2038-1NB30-0CC0 3RT2038-3NB30-0CC0

80 125 7.5 15 25 30 60 60 1 1 3RT2045-1NB30-0CC0 3RT2045-3NB30-0CC0

S3 95 130 10 20 30 30 75 75 1 1 3RT2046-1NB30-0CC0 3RT2046-3NB30-0CC0 1.85

110 130 10 20 30 40 75 100 1 1 3RT2047-1NB30-0CC0 3RT2047-3NB30-0CC0


3RT2045-1NB30-0CC0

1) All terminals are spring loaded in sizes S00 and S0.


For sizes S2-S3, only the coil and aux contacts are spring loaded.

Communication capable contactors are ideal for starter feedback to the automation level.
IO-Link starters in the cabinet save considerable wiring effort. AS-Interface is best suited
for distributed systems.

For reversing contactors with communication capability, see pages 2/41-2/45


For accessories, see page 2/29, 2/32, 2/36.
For technical data, see page 2/33, 2/37, 2/38
For description, see page 2/26.
For further information on IO-Link and AS-Interface, see page 2/30-2/31 and 2/34-2/35.

2/28 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


SIRIUS
Function Modules for Mounting onto SIRIUS 3RT2 Contactors
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies

Function Modules for Mounting onto SIRIUS 3RT2 Contactors


SIRIUS function modules for reversing starting / wye-delta starting
SIRIUS function modules
for reversing starting / wye-delta starting

Selection and ordering data

2
Assemblies
Contactors and
3RA28 16-0EW20 3RA29 13-2AA1 3RA29 13-2BB2
For Rated control supply Time setting range t Screw terminals Weight Spring-type 2) Weight

3
contactors voltage Us1) approx. terminals approx.
Order No. Order No.
Type V s kg kg
Assembly kits for reversing starting
Assembly kits for making 3-pole contactor
assemblies
The assembly kit contains:
Mechanical interlock;
2 connecting clips for 2 contactors,
wiring modules on the top and bottom
3RT20 1 . • For size S00 3RA29 13-2AA1 0.046 3RA29 13-2AA2 0.070
3RT20 2 . • For size S0 3RA29 23-2AA1 0.089 3RA29 23-2AA2 0.112
3RT20 3 . • For size S2 (w/o mechanical interlock, see pg. 2/45) 3RA29 33-2AA1 0.159 3RA29 33-2AA2 0.156
Assembly kits for wye-delta starting
Assembly kits for making 3-pole contactor
assemblies
The assembly kit contains:
Mechanical interlock,
4 connecting clips for 3 contactors;
star jumper,
wiring modules on the top and bottom
3RT20 1 . • For size S00 3RA29 13-2BB1 0.051 3RA29 13-2BB2 0.080
3RT20 2 . • For size S0 (only main circuit for version with 3RA29 23-2BB1 0.099 3RA29 23-2BB2 0.133
spring-type terminals)
3RT20 3 . • For size S2 (only main circuit for version with 3RA29 33-2BB1 0.242 3RA29 33-2BB2 0.182
spring-type terminals)

Function modules for wye-delta starting


The electrical connection between the function
module and the contactor assembly is estab-
lished automatically by snapping on and plug-
ging in the connecting cables.
Wye-delta function (varistor integrated)
3RT20 1 . 24 ... 240 AC/DC 0.5 ... 60 3RA28 16-0EW20 0.170 3RA28 16-0EW20 0.170
3RT20 2 . (10, 30, 60
3RT20 3. selectable)
Accessories
Sealable covers 3RA29 10-0 0.002 3RA29 10-0 0.002
for 3RA27, 3RA28, 3RA29
1)
AC voltage values apply for 50 Hz and 60 Hz. Note:
2)
Assembly kits in sizes S0 and S2 are supplied with When the function modules are used, no other auxiliary switches
wiring modules for the main circuit only. are allowed to be mounted on the basic units.
Function Function charts
Timing relay energized
Contact closed
Contact open
2 NO contacts (internally connected)
Wye-delta function 3RA28 16-0EW20
(varistor integrated) A1/A2
NSB0_02072

• 1 NO contact, delayed
Y
• 1 NO contact, instantaneous
t 50 ms

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/29


Illustrations are approximate SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 3/79
SIRIUS
Function Modules for Mounting onto SIRIUS 3RT2 Contactors
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies

Function Modules for Mounting onto SIRIUS 3RT2 Contactors


SIRIUS function modules for IO-Link
SIRIUS function modules for IO-Link

Overview
The SIRIUS function modules for IO-Link enable the assembly of control system through IO-Link, with the possibility of connecting
starters and contactor assemblies for direct-on-line, reversing up to four starters as a group to one port of the IO-Link master.
and wye-delta starting without any additional, complicated
wiring of the individual components. They include the key control Through this type of connection to the control system, a
functions required for the particular starter, e. g. timing and maximum of wiring is saved. The following essential signals are
interlocking. The electrical and mechanical connection to the transmitted:
2

contactor is established by snapping on and locking. An • Availability of the starter in response to an indirect inquiry from
additive protection circuit for the individual contactors can be the motor starter protector
dispensed with completely, and feedback from the contactor
Contactors and
Assemblies

• Starter operation
contacts is performed with Hall sensors which provide reliable
feedback concerning the switching state even under extremely • Feedback concerning the switching state of the starter

3
dusty conditions. The starters are connected to the higher-level

Availability

Control

PLC Feedback through PLC IO-Link


switching state

NSB0_02084a

Signal transmission through IO-Link


The inquiry from the motor starter protector does not take place This requires the use of communication versions of the contactors
through additional wiring between the auxiliary switch and the with communication interface (see page 2/28).
module but by means of a voltage inquiry at the contactor input.

Motor starter
protector

Contactor
NSB0_02086

Availability signal through voltage pick-off

2/30 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 3/81
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Function Modules for Mounting onto SIRIUS 3RT2 Contactors
Function Modules for Mounting onto SIRIUS 3RT2 Contactors
SIRIUS function modules for IO-Link
SIRIUS function modules for IO-Link
By grouping up to four starters it is possible to connect up to potential at the master of the ET200S is the same as that of the
16 starters to one master of the ET200S. All the signals of the controls, a further reduction in wiring is possible by providing the
individual controls are made available through only 3 individual control supply voltage to the contactors by jumpering the corre-
wires per starter group directly in the process image. If the sponding communication wires.

Group formation for 4 starters max. per IO-Link port

2
1 2 3 4
Direct-on- Direct-on- Reversing Reversing
line starter line starter starter starter

Assemblies
Contactors and
3

Port 1

...
NSB0_02087b

Port 2

Group formation with IO-Link


In case of a malfunction, the corresponding error signals are This easy integration of the starters in the TIA world does not limit
also sent directly to the PLC in acyclic mode. This is in addition the flexibility in the field in the least. For example, all function
to transmission of the switching signals and status signals. modules have special terminals in order to enable direct local
disconnection. These terminals can be connected for example
Possible error signals: to a position switch. The input interrupts the voltage supply to the
• Device defect contactor coil directly, i. e. without going through the PLC. These
• No main voltage (motor starter protector tripped) terminals are jumpered in the as-delivered state.
• No control supply voltage Local manual operation of the complete starter group is also
• Limit position on the right / on the left straight-forward using a operator panel. The latter is easily con-
nected to the last starter and can be built into the front panel of
• Manual mode the control cabinet if required. This offers significant advantages
• Process image fault particularly for commissioning.

Application Benefits
The use of SIRIUS function modules with IO-Link is recom- • Reduction of the control current wiring to no more than one
mended above all in machines and plants in which there are cable having three conductors for four starters
several motor starters in one control cabinet. Using IO-Link, the • Elimination of testing costs and wiring errors
connection of these starters to the automation level is easy, • Reduction of configuration work
quick and error-free. And with IO modules no longer needed, the
width of the ET200S becomes far smaller. • Integration in TIA for clear diagnostics if a fault occurs
• Fewer IO modules saves space in the control cabinet
• All essential timing and interlocking functions for reversing
duty and wye-delta starting are integrated
• No additional control circuit required
Furtherinformation
Further informationononthetheapplication
application and
and benefits
benefits of the
of the SIRIUS
SIRIUS
functionmodules
function modulesforforconnection
connection to to
thethe control
control system
system through
through
IO-Linkcan
IOLink canbebe found
found in Chapter
in Chapter 4 "Industrial
14 “Industrial Communication".
Communication”.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/31


3/82 SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Function Modules SIRIUS
for Mounting onto SIRIUS 3RT2 Contactors Function Modules
3RA27 Function Modules for IO-Link for Mounting on 3RT2 Contactors
SIRIUS function modules for IO-Link
For direct-on-line starting / for reversing starting / for wye-delta starting

Selection and ordering data

Version Screw terminals Spring-type Weight


terminals
2

Order No. Order No. kg


Function modules for direct-on-line starting

3
Contactors and
Assemblies

IO-Link connection 3RA2711-1AA00 3RA2711-2AA00


Includes one module connector for assembling
an IO-Link group

3RA2711-1AA00

3RA2711-2AA00
Function modules for reversing starting1)
IO-Link connection, 3RA2711-1BA00 3RA2711-2BA00
comprising one basic and one coupling module
and an additional module connector for assembling
an IO-Link group

3RA2711-1BA00

3RA2711-2BA00
Assembly kits for making 3-pole contactor
assemblies
The assembly kit contains:
mechanical interlock,
2 connecting clips for two contactors,
wiring modules on the top and bottom
3RA2923-2AA1 • For size S00 3RA2913-2AA1 3RA2913-2AA2
• For size S0
- For main, auxiliary and control circuits 3RA2923-2AA1 --
- Only for main circuit2) -- 3RA2923-2AA2
• For size S2
- For main, auxiliary and control circuits 3RA2933-2AA1 --
3RA2923-2AA2
- Only for main circuit2) -- 3RA2933-2AA2

1) For prewired contactor assemblies for reversing starting with voltage Matching contactors with communications interface required;
tap-off, see pages 2/42 and 2/45. When these contactor assemblies are see pages 2/26.
used, the assembly kit for the wiring is already integrated.
2) Version in sizes S0 and S2 with spring-type terminals:
Only the wiring modules for the main circuit are included.
No connectors are included for the auxiliary and control circuit.

2/32 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2015 3/201
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Function Modules
Function Modules for Mounting onto SIRIUS 3RT2 Contactors
SIRIUS 3RA27 Function Modules for IO-Link for Mounting on 3RT2 Contactors
SIRIUS function modules for IO-Link
For direct-on-line starting / for reversing starting / for wye-delta starting

Version Screw terminals Spring-type Weight


terminals
Order No. Order No. kg
Function modules for wye-delta starting1)
IO-Link connection, 3RA2711-1CA00 3RA2711-2CA00
comprising one basic module and two coupling
modules, plus an additional module connector for

2
assembling an IO-Link group
3

3RA2711-1CA00

Assemblies
Contactors and
Assembly kits for making 3-pole contactor
assemblies2)
The assembly kit contains:
mechanical interlock,
4 connecting clips for 3 contactors;
star jumper,
wiring modules on the top and bottom
3RA2923-2BB1 • For size S00 3RA2913-2BB1 3RA2913-2BB2
• For size S0
- For main, auxiliary and control circuits 3RA2923-2BB1 --
- Only for main circuit3) -- 3RA2923-2BB2
• For size S2
- For main, auxiliary and control circuits 3RA2933-2BB1 --
3RA2923-2BB2 - Only for main circuit3) -- 3RA2933-2BB2
1) For complete contactor assemblies for wye-delta starting including Matching contactors with communications interface required;
function modules, see pages 2/49 and 2/50. see pages 2/28.
2) When using the function modules for wye-delta starting, the wiring
modules for the auxiliary current are not required.
3) Version in sizes S0 and S2 with spring-type terminals:
Only the wiring modules for the main circuit are included.
No connectors are included for the auxiliary and control circuit.

Version Order No. Weight


kg
Accessories
Module connector set, comprising: 3RA2711-0EE10
• 2 module connectors, 14-pole, short
• 2 interface covers
Module connectors
3RA2711-0EE10 • 14-pole, 9 cm 3RA2711-0EE06
For size jump + 1 space
• 14-pole, 26 cm 3RA2711-0EE07
For various space combinations
3RA2711-0EE06 • 14-pole, 33.5 cm 3RA2711-0EE08
For various space combinations
• 10-pole, 9 cm 3RA2711-0EE16
For separate control signal infeed
within an IO-Link group
3RA2711-0EE15 Interface covers 3RA2711-0EE15
(Set of 5)
Sealable covers 3RA2910-0
For 3RA27, 3RA28, 3RA29

3RA2910-0
Operator panels1)
Operator panel (set), comprising: 3RA6935-0A
• 1 x operator panel
• 1 x enabling module
• 1 x interface cover
• 1 x fixing terminal
3RA6935-0A
Connection cable, 3RA2711-0EE11
length 2 m, 10- to 14-pole
3RA2711-0EE11 For connecting the operator panel to the communication module
Enabling modules (replacement) 3RA6936-0A
Interface covers (replacement) 3RA6936-0B
1) Suitable only for communication through IO-Link.
For manuals, see
http://support.automation.siemens.com/WW/view/en/39319600.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/33


* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
3/202 Siemens IC 10 · 2015 Illustrations are approximate
SIRIUS
Function Modules for Mounting onto SIRIUS 3RT2 Contactors
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies

Function Modules for Mounting onto SIRIUS 3RT2 Contactors


SIRIUS function modules for AS-Interface
SIRIUS function modules for AS-Interface

Overview
The SIRIUS function modules for AS-Interface enable the nected to one master and the address is entered in normal man-
assembly of starters and contactor assemblies for direct-on-line, ner with an addressing unit.
reversing and wye-delta starting without any additional, compli-
cated wiring of the individual components. They include the key Through the AS-Interface connection to the control system, a
control functions required for the particular starter, e. g. timing maximum of wiring is saved. The wiring outlay is reduced to the
and interlocking. The electrical and mechanical connection to control supply voltage and the two individual wires for
2

the contactor is established by snapping on and locking. An AS-Interface.


additional control circuit for the individual contactors can be The following essential signals are transmitted:
eliminated with completely because a varistor is integrated in the
Contactors and
Assemblies

• Availability of the starter in response to an indirect inquiry from


modules. Feedback from the contactor contacts is performed the motor starter protector
with Hall sensors which provide reliable feedback concerning

3
the switching state even under extremely dusty conditions. • Starter operation
Connection of the starters to the higher-level control system • Feedback concerning the switching state of the starter
takes place through AS-Interface with the Specification V2.1 in
A/B technology. As the result, up to 62 starters can be con-

Availability

Control

PLC Feedback through PLC AS-Interface


switching state

NSB0_02085a

Signal transmission through AS-Interface


The inquiry from the motor starter protector does not take place This requires use of communication versions of the contactors
through additional wiring between the auxiliary switch and the with communication interface (see page 2/28).
module but by means of a voltage inquiry at the contactor input.

Motor starter
protector

Contactor
NSB0_02086

Availability signal through voltage pick-off

2/34 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 3/85
SIRIUS
Function Modules for Mounting onto SIRIUS 3RT2 Contactors
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies

Function Modules for Mounting onto SIRIUS 3RT2 Contactors


SIRIUS function modules for AS-Interface
SIRIUS function modules for AS-Interface

Direct-on-line starter Reversing starter star-delta starter

2
NSB0_02088a

Assemblies
Contactors and
3

Addr. 1a Addr. 1b Addr. 2a

AS-Interface

Topology with AS-Interface


This easy integration of the starters in the TIA world does not limit to a position switch. The input interrupts the voltage supply to the
the flexibility in the field in the least. For example, all function contactor coil directly, i. e. without going through the PLC. These
modules have special terminals in order to enable direct local terminals are jumpered in the as-delivered state.
disconnection. These terminals can be connected for example,

Application Benefits
The use of SIRIUS function modules with AS-Interface is recom- • Reduction of control current wiring
mended above all in machines and plants requiring easy • Elimination of testing costs and wiring errors
connection of several different sensors and actuators both • Reduction of configuration work
inside and outside the control cabinet to the higher-level control
system. And with IO modules no longer needed, the width of the • Elimination of IO modules saves space in the control cabinet
PLC is far smaller. • All essential timing and interlocking functions for reversing
duty and wye-delta starting are integrated
• No additional control circuit required

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/35


3/86 SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Function Modules
Function Modules for Mounting onto SIRIUS 3RT2 Contactors
SIRIUS 3RA27 Function Modules for AS-Interface for Mounting on 3RT2 Contactors
SIRIUS function modules for AS-Interface
For direct-on-line starting / for reversing starting / for wye-delta starting

Selection and ordering data

Version Screw terminals Spring-type Weight


terminals
32

Order No. Order No. kg


Function modules for direct-on-line starting
Contactors and
Assemblies

AS-Interface connection 3RA2712-1AA00 3RA2712-2AA00

3RA2712-1AA00

3RA2712-2AA00
Function modules for reversing starting1)
AS-Interface connection, 3RA2712-1BA00 3RA2712-2BA00
comprising one basic and one coupling module

3RA2712-1BA00

3RA2712-2BA00
Assembly kits for making 3-pole contactor
assemblies
The assembly kit contains:
mechanical interlock,
2 connecting clips for two contactors,
wiring modules on the top and bottom
3RA2923-2AA1 • For size S00 3RA2913-2AA1 3RA2913-2AA2
• For size S0
- For main, auxiliary and control current 3RA2923-2AA1 --
- Only for main current -- 3RA2923-2AA2
• For size S2
- For main, auxiliary and control current 3RA2933-2AA1 --
3RA2923-2AA2
- Only for main current -- 3RA2933-2AA2

Matching contactors with communications interface required; 1) For prewired contactor assemblies for reversing starting with communication
see page 2/28. interface, see pages 2/42 and 2/45. When these contactor assemblies are
used, the assembly kit for the wiring is already integrated.
For matching AS-Interface masters, routers and power supply
units, see Chapter 14 “Industrial Communication”.

2/36 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
3/206 Siemens IC 10 · 2015 Illustrations are approximate
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Function Modules for Mounting onto SIRIUS 3RT2 ContactorsFunction Modules
SIRIUS 3RA27 Function Modules for AS-Interface for Mounting on 3RT2 Contactors
SIRIUS function modules for AS-Interface
For direct-on-line starting / for reversing starting / for wye-delta starting

Version Screw terminals Spring-type Weight


terminals
Order No. Order No. kg
Function modules for wye-delta starting1)
AS-Interface connection, 3RA2712-1CA00 3RA2712-2CA00
comprising one basic module and two coupling
modules

2
3
3RA2712-1CA00

Assemblies
Contactors and
3RA2712-2CA00
Assembly kits for making 3-pole contactor
assemblies
The assembly kit contains:
mechanical interlock,
4 connecting clips for 3 contactors;
star jumper,
wiring modules on the top and bottom
3RA2923-2BB1 • For size S00 3RA2913-2BB1 3RA2913-2BB2
• For size S0
- For main, auxiliary and control circuits 3RA2923-2BB1 --
- Only for main circuit -- 3RA2923-2BB2
• For size S2
- For main, auxiliary and control circuits 3RA2933-2BB1 --
3RA2923-2BB2 - Only for main circuit -- 3RA2933-2BB2
1) For complete contactor assemblies for wye-delta starting including Matching contactors with communications interface required;
function modules, see pages 2/49 and 2/50. see page 2/28.
For matching AS-Interface masters, routers and power supply
units, see Chapter 14 “Industrial Communication”.

Version Order No. Weight


kg
Accessories
Module connector set, comprising: 3RA2711-0EE10
• 2 module connectors, 14-pole, short
• 2 interface covers

3RA2711-0EE10
Module connectors
• 14-pole, 9 cm 3RA2711-0EE06
For size jump + 1 space
3RA2711-0EE06
Interface covers 3RA2711-0EE15
(Set of 5)

3RA2711-0EE15
Sealable covers 3RA2910-0
For 3RA27, 3RA28, 3RA29

3RA2910-0

For manuals, see


http://support.automation.siemens.com/WW/view/en/39318922.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/37


* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2015 3/207
© Siemens AG 2015
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Function Modules
Function Modules for Mounting onto SIRIUS 3RT2 Contactors
SIRIUS 3RA28 Function Modules for Mounting on 3RT2 and 3RH21 Contactors
SIRIUS function modules
Introduction

Technical specifications
Type 3RA2811 3RA2831 3RA2812 3RA2832 3RA2816
Can be used for size S00, S0 S2 S00, S0 S2 S00, S0, S2
Function ON-delay OFF-delay Wye-delta function
with control signal
2

General data
Rated insulation voltage Ui V AC 300

3
Contactors and
Assemblies

Pollution degree 3
Overvoltage category III
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV AC 4
Operating range of excitation 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us,
0.95 ... 1.05 times the rated frequency
Overvoltage protection Varistor integrated
Rated power W 1 1
• Power consumption at 230 V AC, 50 Hz VA 1 2
DIAZED protection Operational class gG A -- 4
Switching frequency for load
• With Ie at 230 V AC h-1 2 500 --
• With 3RT2 contactor at 230 V AC h-1 2 500 --
Recovery time ms 50 150
Minimum ON period ms -- 35 --
Residual current Max. mA 5 -- --
Voltage drop Max. VA 3.5 -- --
With conducting output
Setting accuracy Typ. ±15 %
With reference to upper limit of
scale
Repeat accuracy Max. ±1 %
Electrical endurance
• With 3RT2028 contactor Operating cycles 100 000 --
• At AC-15, 250 V, 3 A Operating cycles -- 100 000
Mechanical endurance Operating cycles 100 x 106 10 x 106
Permissible ambient temperature
• During operation °C -25 ... +60
• During storage °C -40 ... +80
Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60947-1, Appendix C IP20
Shock resistance g/ms 15/11
Half-sine acc. to IEC 60068-2-27
Vibration resistance
According to IEC 60068-2-6 Hz/mm 10 ... 55/0.35
Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) IEC 61000-6-2, IEC 61000-6-4, IEC 61812-1, IEC 60947-4-1
Overvoltage protection Varistor integrated
Permissible mounting position Any (see contactor)
Conductor cross-sections
Connection type Screw terminals
(1 or 2 conductors can be connected)
• Solid mm 2 1 x (0.5 ... 4), 2 x (0.5 ... 2.5) --
• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 1 x (0.5 ... 2.5), 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5) --
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 2 x (20 ... 14) --
• Terminal screws M3 (for standard screw driver size 2 or Pozidriv 2) --
• Tightening torque Nm 0.8 ... 1.2 --
Connection type Spring-type terminals
(1 or 2 conductors can be connected)
• Operating devices mm 3.0 x 0.5 --
• Solid mm 2 2 x (0.25 ... 1.5) --
• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 x (0.25 ... 1.5) --
• Finely stranded m m2 2 x (0.25 ... 1.5) --
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 2 x (24 ... 16) --

2/38 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Siemens IC 10 · 2015 3/195
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactor Assemblies for Switching Motors
3RA reversing contactor assemblies

Design The following points should be If the front-mounted mechani- Principle of operation
noted: cal interlock is used for size S2
Complete equipment The operating times of the
Size S00 to S3 contactors, two location
assemblies individual 3RT10/20 contactors
holes for single-pole auxiliary
The fully wired reversing contac- • For maintained-contact are rated in such a way that no
switch blocks are provided on
tor assemblies are suitable for operation: overlapping of the contact mak-
the front of each S2 contac-
use in any climate. They are safe use contactors with an NC ing and the arcing time between
tor while three additional,
from touch to EN 50274. two contactors can occur on

2
contact in the basic unit for single-pole auxiliary switch
The contactor assemblies each the electrical interlock. reversing, providing they are
blocks can be snapped onto
consist of two contactors with interlocked via their auxiliary

Assemblies
Contactors and
• For momentary-contact S3 contactors. The maximum
identical ratings. The contactors switches (NC contact interlock)
operation: auxiliary switch complements
are mechanically and electri- and the operating mechanisms.
use contactors with an NC per contactor stated on page 2/14
cally interlocked (NC contact An additional dead interval of
contact in the basic unit for must not be exceeded.
interlock). The main and control 50 ms is necessary on reversing
the electrical interlock; in When size S3 contactors are if the individual contactors are
circuits are wired according to addition, an auxiliary switch combined with a frontmo- used at voltages > 500 V. The
the circuit diagrams on block with at least one unted mechanical interlock, operating times of the individual
page 2/201. NO contact for latching is the 3RA19 33-2B and 3RA19 contactors are not affected by
For motor protection, either required per contactor. 43-2B installation kits cannot the mechanical interlock.
3RU2 or 3RB3 overload relays Size S0 and S2 be used.
for direct mounting or individual
Contactors come equipped Sizes S6 to S12 Surge suppression
mounting or thermistor motor
protection tripping units must be with integrated 1 NO and 1NC To insert the mechanical inter-
aux contacts in each contactor. Sizes S00 to S3
ordered separately. lock, the prestamped location
Both electrical interlocking and holes positioned opposite on All contactor assemblies can be
latching are satisfied with the the contactor must be knocked fitted with RC elements or varis-
Components for customer integrated auxiliaries. Mechani- tors for damping opening surges
assembly out. The internal auxiliary con-
cal interlocking is required in tacts (up to 1 NO + 1 NC per in the coil.
Installation kits for all sizes are either size and comes in the
available for customer assembly contactor) can be used for the As with the individual contac-
assembly kits except for size electrical interlock and latching. tors, the surge suppressors can
of reversing contactor assem- S2 where you need to order
blies. The mechanical interlock itself either be plugged onto the front
3RA2934-2B interlock sepa- does not contain any auxiliary of the contactors (S00) or fitted
Contactors, overload relays, the rately. contacts. Additional auxiliary onto the coil terminals on the
mechanical interlock and — for Sizes S3 contacts can be used on the top or bottom (S3). For sizes S0
momentary-contact operation — outside and front (on the front and S2, the surge protection
auxiliary switch blocks for latch- • For maintained-contact
in the case of 3RT10) of the fits behind the hinged door on
ing must be ordered separately operation:
reversing contactor assembly. the front of the contactor and
the contactors have no auxil-
iary contact in the basic unit; does not take up any additional
NC contacts for the electrical space.
interlock are therefore inte- Sizes S6 to S12
grated in the mechanical in- The contactors are fitted with
terlock that can be mounted varistors as standard.
on the side of each contactor
(one contact each for the left
and right-hand contactors).
• For momentary-contact
operation:
the electrical interlock is the
same as for maintained-con-
tact operation; in addition,
an auxiliary switch with one
NO contact for latching is
required per contactor. This
contact can be snapped
onto the top of the contac-
tors. Alternatively, auxiliary
switch blocks mounted on
the side can be used; they
must be fitted onto the out-
side of each contactor.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/39


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactor Assemblies for Switching Motors
3RA13 and 3RA23 reversing contactor assemblies

Overview
The 3RA13 and 3RA23 Sizes S00 to S12 For overload relays for motor The and approvals only
reversing contactor assemblies As components for customer protection, see section 3. apply to the complete contactor
can be ordered as follows: assembly. assemblies and not to the com-
Sizes S00 to S3 The 3RA23 and 3RA13 contactor ponents for customer assembly.
There is also a range of acces- assemblies have screw connections
Fully wired and tested, open sories (auxiliary switch blocks, and are available for screwing AC and DC operation
type, with mechanical and surge suppressors, etc.) that or snapping onto 35 mm standard
2

See pages 2/42 through 2/46


electrical interlock. 1) must be ordered separately. mounting rails. The 3RA23 contactor for complete part numbers.
assemblies are also available
Contactors and
Assemblies

with spring-type terminals.

Maximum AC-3 Size Order No.


horsepower rating maximum
at 460 V AC inductive current
Contactor Mechanical Mechanical Mechanical Installation kit Fully wired and
interlock 2) interlock 3) interlock 4) tested contactor
HP A assembly

3 7 S00 3RT20 15 3RA29 13-2AA1 6) – – 3RA29 13-2AA1 6) 3RA23 15-8XB30- ...


5 9 3RT20 16 3RA23 16-8XB30- ...
7.5 12 3RT20 17 3RA23 17-8XB30- ...
10 16 3RT20 18 3RA23 18-8XB30- ...
7.5 12 S0 3RT20 24 3RA29 23-2AA1 6 ) – – 3RA29 23-2AA1 6) 3RA23 24-8XB30- ...
10 16 3RT20 25 3RA23 25-8XB30- ...
15 25 3RT20 26 3RA23 26-8XB30- ...
20 32 3RT20 27 3RA23 27-8XB30- ...
25 38 3RT20 28 3RA23 28-8XB30- ...
30 40 S2 3RT20 35 3RA29 34-2B – – 3RA29 33-2AA1 7) 3RA23 35-8XB30-1 . .
40 50 3RT20 36 3RA23 36-8XB30-1 . .
50 65 3RT20 37 3RA23 37-8XB30-1 . .
50 80 3RT20 38 3RA23 38-8XB30-1 . .
50 65 S3 3RT20 45 3RA29 34-2B – – 3RA29 43-2AA1 8) 3RA23 45-8XB30-1 . .
60 80 3RT20 46 3RA23 46-8XB30-1 . .
75 95 3RT20 47 3RA23 47-8XB30-1 . .
100 115 S6 3RT10 54 – – 3RA19 54-2A 3RA19 53-2A 9 ) –
125 150 3RT10 55
150 185 3RT10 56
150 225 S10 3RT10 64 – – 3RA19 54-2A 3RA19 63-2A 9 ) –
200 265 3RT10 65
250 300 3RT10 66
300 400 S12 3RT10 75 – – 3RA19 54-2A 3RA19 73-2A 9 ) –
400 500 3RT10 76

For accessories, see page 2/82-2/85. 1) An additional dead interval of 50 ms is neces- 7) Installation kit contains: 2 connecting clips for
For circuit diagrams, see page 2/201. sary on reversing at voltages > 500 V. 2 contactors; wiring connectors on the top and
For dimension drawings, see page 2) Laterally mountable with one auxiliary contact bottom and the mechanical interlock.
2/221-2/223. (except no auxiliary contact in S2 & S3) 8) Installation kit contains: 2 connecting clips for
3) For front mounting with one auxiliary contact. 2 contactors; wiring connectors on the top and
bottom.
4) Laterally mountable without auxiliary contact.
9) Installation kit contains: wiring connector on the
5) Interlock must be ordered with installation kit.
top and bottom.
6) Installation kit contains: mechanical interlock;
2 connecting clips for 2 contactors; wiring
connectors on the top and bottom.

2/40 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactor Assemblies for Switching Motors Reversing Contactor Assemblies

3RA23 reversing contactor assemblies


SIRIUS 3RA23 reversing contactor assemblies, up to 55 kW
Fully wired and tested reversing contactor assemblies · Size S00
S00 ·–Up
Uptoto7.5
10 kW
HP
The figure shows the version with screw terminals

2
3
Assemblies
Contactors and
5
7
1 4
2
10

IC01_00621
10
3

8
9
6
6
6

6
6

Mountable accessories (optional) Complete reversing contactor assembly


To be ordered separately Type Individual parts Type
Q11 Q12
6 Auxiliary switch block, front1) 3RH2911 1 2 Contactors, 3 kW 3RT2015 3RT2015
7 Auxiliary switch block, lateral 3RH2921 1 2 Contactors, 4 kW 3RT2016 3RT2016
8 Surge suppressors 3RT2916 1 2 Contactors, 5.5 kW 3RT2017 3RT2017
9 Solder pin adapters 3RT1916-4KA1 1 2 Contactors, 7.5 kW 3RT2018 3RT2018
10 Function module for connection to 3RA271.-1BA00 3 ... 5 Assembly kit 3RA2913-2AA1
the control system comprising:
3 Mechanical interlock2)
4 Two connecting clips for two contactors2)
5 Wiring modules on the top and bottom for
connecting the main current circuits, electrical
interlock included3), interruptible (NC contact
interlock)
1) Auxiliary switch block according to EN 50005 must be used.
2)
The parts 3 and 4 can only be ordered together as
3RA2912-2H mechanical connectors.
3)
3RT201. contactors with one NC contact in the basic unit are required for
the electrical interlock. An additional NO contact is required for momen-
tary-contact operation.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/41
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3RA23, 3RA24 Contactor Assemblies
Contactor Assemblies for Switching Motors
3RA23 Reversing Contactor Assemblies
3RA23 reversing contactor assemblies
3RA23 complete units, 3 ... 25 HP
Fully wired and tested contactor assemblies2) · Size S00 · Up to 10 HP
2 Assemblies
Contactors and

3RA23 18 -8XE30-1 BB4 3RA23 1 . -8XB30-1A . . 3RA23 1 . -8XB30-2A . .

3
AC data UL data Screw terminals Weight
approx.
Amp Single-phase Three-phase Rated control Auxiliary Spring-type terminals
ratings HP ratings HP ratings supply voltage Us contacts
AC2/AC3 115 V 230 V 200 V 230 V 460 V 575 V at 50/60 Hz NO NC Order No.
V kg
AC operation, 50/60 Hz
Size S00 1)
7 1/4 3/4 1 1/2 2 3 5 24 AC 0 2 3RA23 15-8XB30-@AB0 0.46/0.50
7 1/4 3/4 1 1/2 2 3 5 110/120 AC 0 2 3RA23 15-8XB30-@AK6 0.46/0.50
7 1/4 3/4 1 1/2 2 3 5 220/240 AC 0 2 3RA23 15-8XB30-@AP6 0.46/0.50
9 1/3 1 2 3 5 7 1/2 24 AC 0 2 3RA23 16-8XB30-@AB0 0.46/0.50
9 1/3 1 2 3 5 7 1/2 110/120 AC 0 2 3RA23 16-8XB30-@AK6 0.46/0.50
9 1/3 1 2 3 5 7 1/2 220/240 AC 0 2 3RA23 16-8XB30-@AP6 0.46/0.50
12 1/2 2 3 3 7 1/2 10 24 AC 0 2 3RA23 17-8XB30-@AB0 0.46/0.50
12 1/2 2 3 3 7 1/2 10 110/120 AC 0 2 3RA23 17-8XB30-@AK6 0.46/0.50
12 1/2 2 3 3 7 1/2 10 220/240 AC 0 2 3RA23 17-8XB30-@AP6 0.46/0.50
16 1 2 3 5 10 10 24 AC 0 2 3RA23 18-8XB30-@AB0 0.46/0.50
16 1 2 3 5 10 10 110/120 AC 0 2 3RA23 18-8XB30-@AK6 0.46/0.50
16 1 2 3 5 10 10 220/240 AC 0 2 3RA23 18-8XB30-@AP6 0.46/0.50
DC operation
7 1/4 3/4 1 1/2 2 3 5 24 DC 0 2 3RA23 15-8XB30-@BB4 0.58/0.62
9 1/3 1 2 3 5 7 1/2 24 DC 0 2 3RA23 16-8XB30-@BB4 0.58/0.62
12 1/2 2 3 3 7 1/2 10 24 DC 0 2 3RA23 17-8XB30-@BB4 0.58/0.62
16 1 2 3 5 10 10 24 DC 0 2 3RA23 18-8XB30-@BB4 0.58/0.62
With communication interface3)
7 1/4 3/4 1 1/2 2 3 5 24 DC 0 2 3RA23 15-8XE30-@BB4 0.58/0.62
9 1/3 1 2 3 5 7 1/2 24 DC 0 2 3RA23 16-8XE30-@BB4 0.58/0.62
12 1/2 2 3 3 7 1/2 10 24 DC 0 2 3RA23 17-8XE30-@BB4 0.58/0.62
16 1 2 3 5 10 10 24 DC 0 2 3RA23 18-8XE30-@BB4 0.58/0.62

Screw terminals 1
Spring-loaded terminals 2
1)
For other voltages see page
page 2/51
3/17. 1) For coil
coil operating
operating range,
range,see
seepage
page2/51.
3/17.
2)
2) The contactors integrated
integrated in
in the
the contactor
contactor assemblies
assemblies have
haveno
no unas-
unassigned
For accessories and
and spare
spare parts,
parts, see
see page
page2/68-2/85.
3/93. auxiliary
signed contacts.
auxiliary contacts.
3) communication modules.
modules. See Section 2
3) For use with 3RA27 and 3RA28 communication
andpages
See also page
2/263/76.
to 2/33.

2/42 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Illustrations are approximate SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 3/31
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactor Assemblies
Reversing Contactor for Switching Motors
Assemblies

3RA23 reversing contactor assemblies


SIRIUS 3RA23 reversing contactor assemblies, up to 55 kW
Fully wired and tested reversing contactor
contactor assemblies · Size S0
S0 ·–Up
Uptoto18.5
25 HP
kW
The figure shows the version with screw terminals

2
3

Assemblies
Contactors and
1
7
4 2

IC01_00622
9 3

8 5

6
6 6

6
6

Mountable accessories (optional) Complete reversing contactor assembly


To be ordered separately Type Individual parts Type
Q11 Q12
6 Auxiliary switch block, front 3RH2911 1 2 Contactors, 5.5 kW 3RT2024 3RT2024
7 Auxiliary switch block, lateral 3RH2921 1 2 Contactors, 7.5 kW 3RT2025 3RT2025
8 Surge suppressors 3RT2926 1 2 Contactors, 11 kW 3RT2026 3RT2026
9 Function module for connection to 3RA271.-1BA00 1 2 Contactors, 15 kW 3RT2027 3RT2027
the control system Contactors, 18.5 kW 3RT2028 3RT2028
1 2
3 ... 5 Assembly kit 3RA2923-2AA1
comprising:
3 Mechanical interlock1)
4 Two connecting clips for two contactors1)
5 Wiring modules on the top and bottom for
connecting the main current circuits, electrical
interlock included (NC contact interlock)
1)
The parts 3 and 4 can only be ordered together as 3RA2922-2H
mechanical connectors.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/43


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3RA23, 3RA24 Contactor Assemblies
Contactor Assemblies for Switching Motors
3RA23 Reversing Contactor Assemblies
3RA23 reversing contactor assemblies
3RA23 complete units, 3 ... 25 HP
Fully wired and tested contactor assemblies · Size S0 · up to 25 HP
2 Assemblies
Contactors and

3
3RA23 2 4 -8XE30-1 BB4 3RA23 2 . -8XB30-1 A . . 3RA23 2 . -8XB30-2 A . .
AC data UL data Screw terminals Weight
approx.
Amp Single-phase Three-phase Rated control Auxiliary Spring-type terminals
ratings HP ratings HP ratings supply voltage Us contacts
AC2/AC3 115 V 230 V 200 V 230 V 460 V 575 V at 50/60 Hz NO NC Order No.
V kg
AC operation, 50/60 Hz
Size S01)
12 1 2 3 3 7 1/2 10 24 AC 2 2 3RA23 24-8XB30-@AC2 0.84/0.94
12 1 2 3 3 7 1/2 10 110/120 AC 2 2 3RA23 24-8XB30-@AK6 0.84/0.94
12 1 2 3 3 7 1/2 10 220/240 AC 2 2 3RA23 24-8XB30-@AP6 0.84/0.94
16 1 3 5 5 10 15 24 AC 2 2 3RA23 25-8XB30-@AC2 0.84/0.94
16 1 3 5 5 10 15 110/120 AC 2 2 3RA23 25-8XB30-@AK6 0.84/0.94
16 1 3 5 5 10 15 220/240 AC 2 2 3RA23 25-8XB30-@AP6 0.84/0.94
25 2 3 7 1/2 7 1/2 15 20 24 AC 2 2 3RA23 26-8XB30-@AC2 0.84/0.94
25 2 3 7 1/2 7 1/2 15 20 110/120 AC 2 2 3RA23 26-8XB30-@AK6 0.84/0.94
25 2 3 7 1/2 7 1/2 15 20 220/240 AC 2 2 3RA23 26-8XB30-@AP6 0.84/0.94
32 2 5 10 10 20 25 24 AC 2 2 3RA23 27-8XB30-@AC2 0.84/0.94
32 2 5 10 10 20 25 110/120 AC 2 2 3RA23 27-8XB30-@AK6 0.84/0.94
32 2 5 10 10 20 25 220/240 AC 2 2 3RA23 27-8XB30-@AP6 0.84/0.94
38 3 5 10 10 25 25 24 AC 2 2 3RA23 28-8XB30-@AC2 0.84/0.94
38 3 5 10 10 25 25 110/120 AC 2 2 3RA23 28-8XB30-@AK6 0.84/0.94
38 3 5 10 10 25 25 220/240 AC 2 2 3RA23 28-8XB30-@AP6 0.84/0.94
DC operation
12 1 2 3 3 7 1/2 10 24 DC 2 2 3RA23 24-8XB30-@BB4 1.22/1.32
16 1 3 5 5 10 15 24 DC 2 2 3RA23 25-8XB30-@BB4 1.22/1.32
25 2 3 7 1/2 7 1/2 15 20 24 DC 2 2 3RA23 26-8XB30-@BB4 1.22/1.32
32 2 5 10 10 20 25 24 DC 2 2 3RA23 27-8XB30-@BB4 1.22/1.32
38 3 5 10 10 25 25 24 DC 2 2 3RA23 28-8XB30-@BB4 1.22/1.32
With communication interface 2)
12 1 2 3 3 7 1/2 10 24 DC 2 2 3RA23 24-8XE30-@BB4 1.22/1.32
16 1 3 5 5 10 15 24 DC 2 2 3RA23 25-8XE30-@BB4 1.22/1.32
25 2 3 7 1/2 7 1/2 15 20 24 DC 2 2 3RA23 26-8XE30-@BB4 1.22/1.32
32 2 5 10 10 20 25 24 DC 2 2 3RA23 27-8XE30-@BB4 1.22/1.32
38 3 5 10 10 25 25 24 DC 2 2 3RA23 28-8XE30-@BB4 1.22/1.32

Screw terminals 1
Spring-loaded terminals 2
1)
For othervoltages
For other voltages
see see
pagepage
2/51. 3/17. 1) For coil
coil operating
operating range,
range,see page2/51.
seepage 3/17.
2) communication modules.
modules. See Section 2
For accessories andand
sparespare
parts, parts,
see page 2/68-2/85. 2) For use with 3RA27 and 3RA28 communication
For accessories see page 3/93. andpages
See also page
2/263/76.
to 2/33.

2/44 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Illustrations are approximate SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 3/33
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactor Assemblies for Switching Motors
3RA23 reversing contactor assemblies

Selection and ordering data


Size S2 · up to 50 HP
UL data
AC data Single-phase Three-phase
Amp
ratings
HP ratings HP ratings
Rated control Auxiliary
Screw Weight
AC2/AC3 115
IC10_03_09.fm Page 159 Friday, June 23, 2017 3:43 PM V 230 V 200 V 230 V 460 V 575 V supply voltage 1) contacts Terminals approx.

2
A HP HP HP HP HP HP NO NC Order No. kg
AC operation

Assemblies
Contactors and
40 3 7.5 10 15 30 40
24 V, 50/60 Hz 2 2 3RA2335-8XB30-1AC2 1.72
120 V, 60 Hz 2 2 3RA2335-8XB30-1AK6
240 V, 60 Hz 2 2 3RA2335-8XB30-1AP6
50 3 10 15 15 40 50 24 V, 50/60 Hz Reversing
2 2 Contactor Assemblies
3RA2336-8XB30-1AC2 1.72
120 V, 60 Hz 2 2 3RA2336-8XB30-1AK6
240 V, 60 Hz 2 2 3RA2336-8XB30-1AP6
50 24 V, 50/60 Hz 2 2 3RA2337-8XB30-1AC2
65 5 10 20 20 50
SIRIUS 3RA23
120 V, 60 Hz
reversing
2
contactor
2
assemblies, up2.548
3RA2337-8XB30-1AK6
to 55 kW
240 V, 60 Hz 2 2 3RA2337-8XB30-1AP6
80 1) 5 15 20 25 50 60 24 V, 50/60 Hz 2 2 3RA2338-8XB30-1AC2 2.548
120 V, 60 Hz 2 2 3RA2338-8XB30-1AK6
For Reversing 240 V, 60 Hz 2 2 3RA2338-8XB30-1AP6
Contactors with AC/DC operation
communication 40 3 7.5 10 15 30 40 20-33 AC/DC 2 2 3RA2335-8XB30-1NB3 2.5
interface: replace 50 20-33 AC/DC 2 2 3RA2336-8XB30-1NB3
50 3 10 15 15 40
the 8XB30-1NB3
65 5 10 20 20 50 50 20-33 AC/DC 2 2 3RA2337-8XB30-1NB3
with 8XE30-1NB3.
80 1) 5 15 20 25 50 60 20-33 AC/DC 2 2 3RA2338-8XB30-1NB3

3
1) Max UL FLA = 65A at 460V

Mountable
Fully wiredaccessories
and tested(to be ordered
reversing separately):
contactor The fully· wired and tested contactor assembly includes the following
assemblies
components:
Size S2 · Up to 50 HP
The figure shows the version with screw terminals
4

3
1
5 2
7 IC01_00623a

9
9

8
6
6 4
6
The connecting leads
are not shown.

6
6

Accessory accessories (optional)


Mountable Order No. Page Components
Complete reversing contactor Order assemblyNo. Page
K1 K2
To be ordered separately Type Individual parts Type
12 Mechanical interlock, 1 2 Contactors, 20 HP 3RT10 33
Q11 3RT10
Q1233
6 Amountable
uxiliary switon the
ch b lockfront
, front3RA19 24-1A
3RH2911 Contactors, 125
1 12 2 Contactors, 8.5 HP
kW 3RT103R34T2035 3RT10 3RT2 035
34
14 AAuxiliary
7 switch
uxiliary sw itch bloblock,
ck, lateral 3RH2921 Contactors, 22
1 12 2 Contactors, k W 3 RT 2 0 3 6 3R T 2 036
30 HP 3RT10 35 3RT10 35
mountable on the front 3RH19 21-1CA..
8 Surge suppressors 3RT2936 Contactors, 30
1 12 2 Contactors, k W
40 HP 3
3RT10 36R T 2 03 7 3 RT
3RT10 362 037
9 Auxiliarymodule
15 Function switchfor block,
connection to 3RA271 . -1BA00 1 42 Contactors, 37 kW 3RT2038 3RT2038
laterally
the controlmountable
system 3RH19 21-1EA.. Mechanical interlock,
3 4 Assemblymountable
laterally kit 3RA19 3RA2933-2AA1
24-2B
16 Surge comprising:
suppressor 3RT19 26-1.... 5 6 Installation kit 3RA19 33-2A
For further voltages, see page 2/51. 3 Two connectors for two contactors
For overview, see page 2/39-2/40.
Coil voltage tolerance:
3RT19 36-1.... The installation kit contains:
at 50Hz: 0.8 to 1.1 x Us 4 Wiring modules on the top and bottom for connecting the
For accessories, see page 2/68-2/85. 2main
connecting clipscurrent
and auxiliary for 2 contactors with a interlock
circuits, electrical clearance of
For circuit diagrams, see page 2/202. at 60Hz: 0.85 to 1.1 x Us 5
10 mm (NC contact interlock)
included
For dimension drawings, see page 2/221. at AC/DC: 0.8 to 1.1 x Us
5 Mechanical interlock
Wiring connectors 3RA2934-2B
on the top and bottom
6
(must
forbeconnecting
ordered separately)
the main conducting paths

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/45
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactor Assemblies for Switching Motors
3RA23 reversing contactor assemblies

Selection and ordering data


Selection and ordering data
Size S3 · up to 75 HP
UL data
IC10_03_09.fm Page 160 Friday, June 23, 2017 AC
3:43 PM
data
Amp
Single-phase Three-phase Fully wired
HP ratings HP ratings and tested
ratings Rated control Auxiliary Weight
AC2/AC3 115 V 230 V 200 V 230 V 460 V 575 V supply voltage 1) contacts contactor assembly approx.
2

A HP HP HP HP HP HP NO NC Order No. kg
AC operation
Reversing Contactor Assemblies
Contactors and
Assemblies

80 5 15 20 25 50 60 24 V, 50/60 Hz 0 2 3RA2345-8XB30-1AC2 3.9


120 V, 60 Hz 0 2 3RA2345-8XB30-1AK6
240 V, 60 Hz 0 2 3RA2345-8XB30-1AP6
SIRIUS 3RA23 reversing contactor
95 assemblies,
7.5 15 25 up 30
to 55 60
kW 75 24 V, 50/60 Hz 0 2 3RA2346-8XB30-1AC2 3.9
120 V, 60 Hz 0 2 3RA2346-8XB30-1AK6
240 V, 60 Hz 0 2 3RA2346-8XB30-1AP6
110 10 20 30 30 75 100 24 V, 50/60 Hz 0 2 3RA2347-8XB30-1AC2 3.9
120 V, 60 Hz 0 2 3RA2347-8XB30-1AK6
240 V, 60 Hz 0 2 3RA2347-8XB30-1AP6
AC/DC operation
80 5 15 20 25 50 60 20-33 V AC/DC 0 2 3RA2345-8XB30-1NB3 5.7
95 7.5 15 25 30 60 75 20-33 V AC/DC 0 2 3RA2346-8XB30-1NB3
110 10 20 30 30 75 100 20-33 V AC/DC 0 2 3RA2347-8XB30-1NB3
3

Mountable accessories (to be ordered separately): The fully wired and tested contactor assembly includes the following
Fully wired
Mountable and tested
accessories reversing
(to be ordered contactorThe
separately): components:
assemblies
fully wired·and tested contactor assembly includes the following
Size S3 · Up to 75 HP components:

The figure shows the version with screw terminals 4


1

2
3

7 5

IC01_00624
9
9

8 4

6
6
6
The connecting leads
are not shown.
The connecting leads
are not shown.
Accessor y 6 6
Order No. Page Components Order No. Page
Accessor y Order No. Page Components OrderK1 No. K2 Page
12 Mechanical interlock, 1 2 Contactors, 60 HP K1 3RT2045K2 3RT2045
Mountable accessories (optional) Complete reversing contactor assembly
mountable
12 Mechanical on the front
interlock, 3RA19 24-1A 1 2 1Contactors, 60 HP75 HP 3RT2045
2 Contactors, 3RT20463RT2045 3RT2046
To be ordered separately Type Individual parts Type
mountable
14 Auxiliary on the frontblock, 3RA19 24-1A
switch 1 2 1Contactors, 75 HP75 HP 3RT2046
2 Contactors, 3RT20473RT2046 3RT2047
mountable on the front 3RH19 21-1CA.. Q11 Q12
14 Auxiliary switch block, 1 2 4Contactors, 3RT20473RT2045
11 15AuAuxiliary
xiliaryon
mountable swthe
itchfront
switchbloblock,
ck, front 3RH19 21-1CA..
3RH2911 Conta75
1 2 Mechanical ctoHP 37 kW 3RT2047
rs, interlock, 3RT2045
4 laterally mountable 3RA19 24-2B
15 12 Aulaterally
xiliaswitch
Auxiliary r y swmountable
itcblock,
h block, lateral 3RH19
3R21-1EA..
H 2921 1Mechanical
2 Contacinterlock,
tors, 45 kW 3RT2046 3RT2046
5laterally mountable
6 Installation kit 3RA19 24-2B43-2A
3RA19
laterally
13 rgemountable
16SuSurge susuppressor
ppressors 3RH19 21-1EA..
3RT19
3R26-1....
T2936 1 2 Contactors, 55 kW 3RT2047 3RT2047
5 6 Installation kit
The installation 3RA19 43-2A
kit contains:
Function
Surge
16 14 module for connection
suppressor 3RT193RT19
3R36-1....
A271 . -1BA00
26-1.... 3 4 Assembly kit 3RA2943-2AA1
to the control system (the associated module
3RT19 36-1.... The installation kit contains:
5comprising:
2 connecting clips for 2 contactors with a clearance of
connectors 3RA2711-0EE17 must be ordered separately 3 10Two
mmconnectors
5 2 connecting clips for 2for
contactors with a clearance of
two contactors
For further voltages, see page 2/51. 106mm
4 Wiring connectors
Wiring modules on onthe
thetop
top
andand bottom
bottom for connecting the main
1) Coil voltage tolerance
For overview, see page 2/39-2/40. at 50 Hz: 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us 6 Wiring connectors
and auxiliaryon the
currenttop and bottom
circuits, electrical interlock included
For accessories, see page 2/68-2/85. 1) Coil voltage tolerance
at 60 Hz: 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us (NC contact interlock)
at 50 Hz: 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us
For circuit diagrams, see page 2/202. at 60 Hz: 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us 5 Mechanical interlock 3RA2934-2B
For dimension drawings, see page 2/221. (must be ordered separately)

2/46 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
SIRIUS
3RA23, 3RA24 Contactor Assemblies
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies

3RA24
3RA24 Contactor Assemblies
Contactor Assemblies for Wye-Delta
for Wye-Delta StartingStarting
3RA24 complete units, 5.5 ... 22 kW
3RA24 complete units, 5.5 ... 22 kW

Overview
These 3RA24 contactor assemblies for wye-delta starting are Motor protection
designed for standard applications.
Overload relays or thermistor motor protection releases can be
Note: used for overload protection.
Contactor assemblies for wye-delta starting in special applica-
tions such as very heavy starting or wye-delta starting of The overload relay can be either mounted onto the line contactor
or separately fitted. It must be set to 0.58 times the rated motor

2
special motors must be customized. Help with designing such
special applications is available from Technical Assistance. current.
Surge suppression

Assemblies
Contactors and
The 3RA24 contactor assemblies for wye-delta starting can be
ordered as follows: Sizes S00 and S0
3

Sizes S00 and S0 Surge suppression (varistor) is included in the function modules
• Fully wired and tested, with electrical and mechanical for wye-delta starting.
interlock.
Function modules for wye-delta starting
• As individual parts for customer assembly.
The 3RA28 16-0EW20 wye-delta function module (see
A dead interval of 50 ms on reversing is already integrated in the page 2/29 replaces the complete wiring in the control circuit
function module for wye-delta starting. and can be used in the voltage range from 24 to 240 V AC/DC.
There is also a range of accessories (lateral auxiliary switch It is snapped onto the front of the contactor assembly size S00
blocks, etc.) that must be ordered separately. or S0.
For overload relays for motor protection see Chapter 3 One function module comprises a complete module kit:
"Overload Relays" --> "3RB3 Solid-State Overload Relays". • One 3RA29 12-0 basic module with integrated control logic
and time setting,
The 3RA24 contactor assemblies have screw or spring-type
terminals and are suitable for screwing or snapping onto TH 35 • And two 3RA29 11-0 coupling modules with related connect-
standard mounting rails. ing cables.
With the fully wired and tested 3RA24 contactor assemblies, the The scope of supply comprises a complete module kit for one
auxiliary contacts included in the basic devices are unassigned. contactor assembly for wye-delta starting size S00 or S0,
regardless of the connection method.
Screw terminals
Rated data Size
at AC 50 Hz 400 V
Power Operational current Motor current Line/delta contactor Star contactor Order No.
Ie complete
kW A A
5.5 12 9.5 ... 13.8 S00-S00-S00 3RT2015-1.... 3RT2015-1.... 3RA2415-8XF32-1...
7.5 16 12.1 ... 17 3
3RT2017-1.... 3RT2015-1.... 3RA2416-8XF32-1...
11 25 19 ... 25 3RT2018-1....
3 3RT2016-1.... 3RA2417-8XF32-1...
11 25 19 ... 25 S0-S0-S0 3RT2024-1...0 3RT2024-1...0 3RA2423-8XF32-1...
15 32 24.1 ... 34 3RT2026-1...0 3RT2024-1...0 3RA2425-8XF32-1...
18.5 40 34.5 ... 40 3RT2026-1...0 3RT2024-1...0 3RA2425-8XF32-1...
22 50 31 ... 43 3RT2027-1...0 3RT2026-1...0 3RA2426-8XF32-1...
4
22/30 50 31 ... 43 S2-S2-S0 3RT2035-1...0 3RT2026-1...0 3RA2434-8XF32-1...
37 80 62.1 ...77.8 3RT2035-1...0 3RT2027-1...0 3RA2435-8XF32-1...
45 86 69 ... 86 3RT2036-1...0 3RT2028-1...0 3RA2436-8XF32-1...
55 115 77.6 ...108.6 S2-S2-S2 3RT2037-1...0 3RT2035-1...0 3RA2444-8XF32-1...
75 150 120.7 ... 150 3RT2045-1...0 3RT2036-1...0 3RA2445-8XF32-1...
90 160 86 ... 160 3RT2046-1...0 3RT2037-1...0 3RA2446-8XF32-1...

Spring-type terminals
Rated data Size
at AC 50 Hz 400 V
Power Operational current Motor current Line/delta contactor Star contactor Order No.
Ie complete
kW A A
5.5 12 9.5 ... 13.8 S00-S00-S00 3RT2015-2.... 3RT2015-2.... 3RA24 15-8XF31-2. . .
7.5 16 12.1 ... 17 3RT2017-2.... 3RT2015-2.... 3RA24 16-8XF31-2. . .
11 25 19 ... 25 3RT2018-2.... 3RT2016-2.... 3RA24 17-8XF31-2. . .
11 25 19 ... 25 S0-S0-S0 3RT2024-2....0 3RT2024-2....0 3RA24 23-8XF32-2. . .
15 32 24.1 ... 34 3RT2026-2....0 3RT2024-2....0 3RA24 25-8XF32-2. . .
18.5 40 34.5 ... 40 3RT2026-2....0 3RT2024-2....0 3RA24 25-8XF32-2. . .
25 50 31 ... 43 3RT2027-2....0 3RT2026-2....0 3RA24 26-8XF32-2. . .

Note:
The selection of contactor types refers to fused configurations.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/47


3/36 SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3RA23, 3RA24 Contactor Assemblies
3RA24 Contactor Assemblies3RA24
for Wye-Delta Starting for Wye-Delta Starting
Contactor Assemblies
3RA24 complete units, 5.5 ... 22 kW
3RA24 complete units, 5.5 ... 22 kW
Components for customer assembly contactors (top) and between the delta and star contactors
(bottom).
Assembly kits with wiring modules and mechanical connectors
are available for contactor assemblies for wye-delta starting. Control circuit
Contactors, overload relays, function modules for wye-delta
starting or wye-delta timing relays, auxiliary switches for Features:
electrical interlock – if required also feeder terminals and base • Time setting range 0.5 to 60 s (3 selectable settings)
plates – must be ordered separately. • Wide voltage range 24 to 240 V AC/DC
• Dead interval of 50 ms, non-adjustable.
2

The wiring kits for sizes S00 and S0 contain the top and bottom
main conducting path connections between the line and delta
Contactors and
Assemblies

Screw terminals

3
Accessories for Overload relay, thermal Overload relay, solid-state
customer assembly (trip class CLASS 10) (trip class CLASS 10)
Power Function modules Assembly kit B, Star jumper Setting range Order No. Setting range Order No.
for wye-delta for single infeed
starting
kW A A
5.5 3RA28 16-0EW20 3RA29 13-2BB11) 3RT29 16-4BA31 5.5 ... 8 3RU21 16-1HB0 4 ... 16 3RB30 16-1TB0
7.5 7 ... 10 3RU21 16-1JB0
11 11 ... 16 3RU21 16-4AB0
11 3RA28 16-0EW20 3RA29 23-2BB12) 3RT29 26-4BA31 11 ... 16 3RU21 26-4AB0 6 ... 25 3RB30 26-1QB0
15 14 ... 20 3RU21 26-4BB0
18.5 20 ... 25 3RU21 26-4DB0
22 20 ... 25 3RU21 26-4DB0
Spring-type terminals
Accessories for Overload relay, thermal Overload relay, solid-state
customer assembly (trip class CLASS 10) (trip class CLASS 10)
Power Function modules Assembly kit B, Star jumper Setting range Order No. Setting range Order No.
for wye-delta for single infeed
starting
kW A A
5.5 3RA28 16-0EW20 3RA29 13-2BB21) 3RT29 16-4BA32 5.5 ... 8 3RU21 16-1HC0 4 ... 16 3RB30 16-1TE0
7.5 7 ... 10 3RU21 16-1JC0
11 11 ... 16 3RU21 16-4AC0
11 3RA28 16-0EW20 3RA29 23-2BB22) 3RT29 26-4BA32 11 ... 16 3RU21 26-4AC0 6 ... 25 3RB30 26-1QE0
15 14 ... 20 3RU21 26-4BC0
18.5 20 ... 25 3RU21 26-4DC0
22 20 ... 25 3RU21 26-4DC0
1) The assembly kit contains: mechanical interlock, 4 connecting clips; wiring 2) The assembly kit contains: mechanical interlock, 4 connecting clips; wiring
modules on the top (connection between line and delta contactor) and on modules on the top (connection between line and delta contactor) and on
the bottom (connection between delta and star contactor); star jumper and the bottom (connection between delta and star contactor); star jumper.
auxiliary circuit wiring.

Order No. scheme


Digit of the Order No. 1. - 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. 15. 16.
@@@ @ @ @ @ – @ @ @ @ @ – @ @ @ @
SIRIUS contactor assemblies 3RA
2nd generation 2
Device type (e. g. 4 = contactor assembly for wye-delta starting) 4
Contactor size (1 = S00, 2 = S0) @
Power dependent on size (e. g. 25 = 15 kW) @
Type of overload relay (8X = without) @ @
Assembly @
(F = ready-assembled, E, H = ready-assembled with communication)
Interlock (3 = mechanical and electrical) @
Free auxiliary switches @
(e. g. S00: 1 = 3 NO total, S0: 2 = 3 NO + 3 NC total)
Connection type (1 = screw, 2 = spring) @
Operating range / solenoid coil circuit (e. g. A = AC standard / without) @
Rated control supply voltage (e. g. K6 = 110/120 V, 50/60 Hz) @ @
Example 3RA 2 4 2 5 – 8 X F 3 2 – 1 A K 6

Note: For your orders, please use the order numbers quote in the
catalog in the Selection and ordering data.
The Order No. scheme is presented here merely for information
purposes and for better understanding of the logic behind the
order numbers.

2/48 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 3/37
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3RA23, 3RA24 Contactor Assemblies
3RA24 Contactor Assemblies3RA24
for Wye-Delta Starting for Wye-Delta Starting
Contactor Assemblies
3RA24 complete units, 5.5 ... 22 kW
3RA24 complete units, 5.5 ... 22 kW
Fully wired and tested contactor assemblies · Size S00-S00-S00 · Up to 11 kW

2
Assemblies
Contactors and
3RA24 1 . -8XE31-2BB4 3RA24 1 . -8XF31-1A . 0 3RA24 1 . -8XF31-2A.0

3
Rated data AC-3 Rated control Screw terminals Weight Spring-type terminals Weight
Opera- Ratings of supply voltage approx. approx.
tional induction motors Us1) at Order No. Order No.
current Ie at 50 Hz and 50/60 Hz
up to
400 V 230 V 400 V 500 V 690 V
A kW kW kW kW V kg kg
AC operation, 50/60 Hz
12 3.3 5.5 7.2 9.2 24 AC 3RA24 15-8XF31-1AB0 0.910 3RA24 15-8XF31-2AB0 0.910
110/120 AC 3RA24 15-8XF31-1AF0 0.850 3RA24 15-8XF31-2AF0 0.910
220/240 AC 3RA24 15-8XF31-1AP0 0.850 3RA24 15-8XF31-2AP0 0.910
16 4.7 7.5 10.3 9.2 24 AC 3RA24 16-8XF31-1AB0 0.910 3RA24 16-8XF31-2AB0 0.910
110/120 AC 3RA24 16-8XF31-1AF0 0.850 3RA24 16-8XF31-2AF0 0.910
220/240 AC 3RA24 16-8XF31-1AP0 0.850 3RA24 16-8XF31-2AP0 0.910
25 5.5 11 11 11 24 AC 3RA24 17-8XF31-1AB0 0.850 3RA24 17-8XF31-2AB0 0.910
110/120 AC 3RA24 17-8XF31-1AF0 0.850 3RA24 17-8XF31-2AF0 0.910
220/240 AC 3RA24 17-8XF31-1AP0 0.850 3RA24 17-8XF31-2AP0 0.910
DC operation
12 3.3 5.5 7.2 9.2 24 DC 3RA24 15-8XF31-1BB4 0.910 3RA24 15-8XF31-2BB4 0.910
16 4.7 7.5 10.3 9.2 24 DC 3RA24 16-8XF31-1BB4 0.910 3RA24 16-8XF31-2BB4 0.910
25 5.5 11 11 11 24 DC 3RA24 17-8XF31-1BB4 1.030 3RA24 17-8XF31-2BB4 1.090
For IO-Link connection
12 3.3 5.5 7.2 9.2 24 DC 3RA24 15-8XE31-1BB4 1.030 3RA24 15-8XE31-2BB4 1.090
16 4.7 7.5 10.3 9.2 24 DC 3RA24 16-8XE31-1BB4 1.030 3RA24 16-8XE31-2BB4 1.090
25 5.5 11 11 11 24 DC 3RA24 17-8XE31-1BB4 1.030 3RA24 17-8XE31-2BB4 1.090
For AS-Interface connection
12 3.3 5.5 7.2 9.2 24 DC 3RA24 15-8XH31-1BB4 1.050 3RA24 15-8XH31-2BB4 1.110
16 4.7 7.5 10.3 9.2 24 DC 3RA24 16-8XH31-1BB4 1.050 3RA24 16-8XH31-2BB4 1.110
25 5.5 11 11 11 24 DC 3RA24 17-8XH31-1BB4 1.050 3RA24 17-8XH31-2BB4 1.110
1)
The wye-delta starters listed here are assembled from individual Coil operating range
contactors which are UL Listed. The overall assembly Catalog at 50 Hz: 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us; at 60 Hz: 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us.
Number is not UL Listed.
For other voltages see page 2/51.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/49


Illustrations are approximate SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 3/39
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3RA23, 3RA24 Contactor Assemblies
3RA24 Contactor Assemblies3RA24
for Wye-Delta Starting for Wye-Delta Starting
Contactor Assemblies
3RA24 complete units, 5.5 ... 22 kW
3RA24 complete units, 5.5 ... 22 kW
Fully wired and tested contactor assemblies · Size S0-S0-S0 · Up to 22 kW
2 Assemblies
Contactors and

3
3RA24 2 . -8XE32-1BB4 3RA24 2 . -8XF32-1A . 2 3RA24 2 . -8XF32-2A . 2
Rated data AC-3 Rated control Screw terminals Weight Spring-type terminals Weight
Opera- Ratings of supply voltage approx. approx.
tional induction motors Us1) at Order No. Order No.
current Ie at 50 Hz and 50/60 Hz
up to
400 V 230 V 400 V 500 V 690 V
A kW kW kW kW V kg kg
AC operation, 50/60 Hz
25 7.1 11 15.6 19 24 AC 3RA24 23-8XF32-1AC2 1.370 3RA24 23-8XF32-2AC2 1.530
110/220 AC 3RA24 23-8XF32-1AK6 1.370 3RA24 23-8XF32-2AK6 1.530
220/240 AC 3RA24 23-8XF32-1AP6 1.370 3RA24 23-8XF32-2AP6 1.530
32 / 40 11.4 15 / 19 19 24 AC 3RA24 25-8XF32-1AC2 1.370 3RA24 25-8XF32-2AC2 1.530
18.5 110/220 AC 3RA24 25-8XF32-1AK6 1.370 3RA24 25-8XF32-2AK6 1.530
220/240 AC 3RA24 25-8XF32-1AP6 1.370 3RA24 25-8XF32-2AP6 1.530
50 -- 22 19 19 24 AC 3RA24 26-8XF32-1AC2 1.390 3RA24 26-8XF32-2AC2 1.550
110/220 AC 3RA24 26-8XF32-1AK6 1.390 3RA24 26-8XF32-2AK6 1.550
220/240 AC 3RA24 26-8XF32-1AP6 1.390 3RA24 26-8XF32-2AP6 1.550
DC operation
25 7.1 11 15.6 19 24 DC 3RA24 23-8XF32-1BB4 1.940 3RA24 23-8XF32-2BB4 2.100
32 / 40 11.4 15 / 19 19 24 DC 3RA24 25-8XF32-1BB4 1.940 3RA24 25-8XF32-2BB4 2.100
18.5
50 -- 22 19 19 24 DC 3RA24 26-8XF32-1BB4 1.960 3RA24 26-8XF32-2BB4 2.120
For IO-Link connection
25 7.1 11 15.6 19 24 DC 3RA24 23-8XE32-1BB4 1.940 3RA24 23-8XE32-2BB4 2.100
32 / 40 11.4 15 / 19 19 24 DC 3RA24 25-8XE32-1BB4 1.940 3RA24 25-8XE32-2BB4 2.100
18.5
50 -- 22 19 19 24 DC 3RA24 26-8XE32-1BB4 1.960 3RA24 26-8XE32-2BB4 2.120
For AS-Interface connection
25 7.1 11 15.6 19 24 DC 3RA24 23-8XH32-1BB4 1.960 3RA24 23-8XH32-2BB4 2.120
32 / 40 11.4 15 / 19 19 24 DC 3RA24 25-8XH32-1BB4 1.960 3RA24 25-8XH32-2BB4 2.120
18.5
50 -- 22 19 19 24 DC 3RA24 26-8XH32-1BB4 1.980 3RA24 26-8XH32-2BB4 2.140
1)
The wye-delta starters listed here are assembled from individual Coil operating range at 50 Hz:
contactors which are UL Listed. The overall assembly Catalog 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us ; at 60 Hz: 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us.
Number is not UL Listed.
For other voltages see page 2/51 .

2/50 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Illustrations are approximate SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 3/41
IC10_03_04.fm Page 50 Friday, April 17, 2015 3:43 PM
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3RT / 3RA Contactors
Rated control supply voltages
Power Contactors for Switching Motors

Selection and ordering data


SIRIUS 3RT20 contactors, 3-pole, up to 37 kW
Contactor type 3RT201 3RT231 3RT202 3RT232 3RT2617 3RT203 3RT233 3RT104
Rated control supply voltage Us 3RA211 3RT251 3RA212 3RT252 3RT2627 3RA213 3RT253 3RT134
Options 3RT2637 3RT144
3RA114
Rated control supply voltages, possible on request
S00 No.) S00
(change of the 10th and 11th digits of the Article S0 S0 S00-S2 S2 S2 S3

2
Rated control
Rated control supplyContactor
supply voltagestype
(changes
3RT201to 10th and 11th positions
3RT202 of the Order No.)
3RT203 3RT231, 3RT232, 3RT233,
voltage
AC Us
Operation 1) 3RT251 3RT252 3RT253

Assemblies
Contactors and
Size S00 B0 S0 B0 S2
B0 B0 S00 B0 S0B0 B0 S2 B0
Coils for 50 Hz 24 V AC
Sizes S00 to S2
(exception: 42 V AC D0 D0 D0 -- -- D0 -- D0
1)
3

AC S00:
size operation
50 48 V AC H0 H0 H0 -- -- H0 -- H0
and 60 Hzcoils
Solenoid 2)
for 50110
Hz (exception:
V AC 60 Hz2))
Size S00: 50 and F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 F0
24 V AC 230 V AC B0 P0 B0 P0 P0
B0 P0 B0 P0 B0P0 P0 B0 P0
42 V AC 400 V AC D0 V0 D0 V0 D0
V0 V0 D0 V0 --V0 V0 -- V0
48 V AC H0 H0 H0 H0 -- --
Coils for
110 V AC 24 V AC F0 B0 F0 B0 C2
F0 C2 F0 C2 F0C2 C2 F0 C2
50 and 60 Hz
230 V AC 2) 42 V AC P0 D0 P0 D0 D2
P0 D2 P0 -- P0D2 D2 P0 D2
240 V AC 48 V AC U0 H0 U0 H0 U0
H2 H2 -- -- --H2 H2 -- H2
400 V AC V0 V0 V0 V0 V0 V0
110 V AC F0 F0 G2 G2 G2 G2 G2 G2
Solenoid coils for 50 and 60 Hz2)
208 V AC M2 M2 M2 M2 M2 M2 M2 M2
24 V AC 220 V AC B0 N2 C2 N2 C2
N2 N2 B0 N2 C2N2 N2 C2 N2
42 V AC D0 D2 D2 D0 D2 D2
48 V AC 230 V AC H0 P0 H2 P0 L2
H2 L2 H0 L2 H2L2 L2 H2 L2
110 V AC 240 V AC F0 P2 G2 P2 G2
P2 P2 F0 P2 G2P2 P2 G2 P2
220 V AC N2 N2 N2 N2 N2 N2
For USA
230 V AC 50 Hz: 60 Hz:
P0 L2 L2 P0 L2 L2
and Canada
Solenoid
3) 110and
coils (for USA V AC
Canada 120
3)) V AC K6 K6 K6 K6 K6 K6 K6 K6
220 V AC 240 V AC P6 P6 P6 P6 P6 P6 P6 P6
50 Hz 60 Hz
277 V AC — — — U6 — U6 U6 U6
110 V AC 120 V AC K6 K6 K6 K6 K6 K6
220 V AC 240 V AC 480 VP6 AC V6 P6 — V6
P6 — P6 — V6
P6 V6 P6 V6
Solenoid coils (for Japan) 600 V AC — — — T6 — T6 T6 T6
For
50/60Japan
Hz4)
50/60 Hz
60 Hz5)
4): 60 Hz5):
100 V AC 110 V AC G6 G6 G6 G6 G6 G6 G6 G6
100 V AC 110 V AC G6 G6 G6 G6 G6 G6
200 V AC 200
220VVAC
AC 220 VN6 AC N6 N6 N6 N6
N6 N6 N6 N6 N6
N6 N6 N6 N6
400 V AC 440VVAC
400 AC 440 VR6 AC R6 R6 R6 R6 R6 R6 R6 R6
R6 R6 R6 R6
1)
DC operation
DC Operation1)
12 V DC 12 V DC A4 A4 A4 A4 --
— — A4 — A4— — -- —
24 V DC B4 B4 -- B4 B4 --
42 V DC 24 V DC D4 B4 D4 B4 B4
-- B4 D4 — D4— — -- —
48 V DC 42 V DC W4 D4 W4 D4 D4
-- D4 W4 — W4— — -- —
60 V DC 48 V DC E4 W4 E4 W4 --
W4 W4 -- — --— — -- —
110 V DC F4 F4 -- F4 F4 --
125 V DC 60 V DC G4 E4 G4 E4 E4
-- E4 G4 — G4— — -- —
220 V DC 72 V DC M4 J8 M4 J8 --
J8 J8 M4 — M4— — -- —
230 V DC 80 V DC P4 — P4 — --
— — P4 — --— — -- —
Examples 110 V DC F4 F4 F4 F4 — — — —
AC operation 125 V DC
3RT2023-1AP00 G4screw terminals;
Contactor with G4 G4
with solenoid coil forG4 — control supply
50 Hz for rated — voltage 230— V AC —
220 V DC
3RT2023-1AG20 M4screw terminals;
Contactor with M4 with solenoid
M4 coil forM4
50/60 Hz for —
rated control — —110 V AC
supply voltage —
DC operation 230 V DC
3RT2025-2BB40 P4 spring-typeP4terminals; for
Contactor with P4rated control—supply voltage
— 24 V DC — — —
Coil codes for frame sizes S6-S12 can be found
3RT2025-2BG40 on page
Contactor with 2/9. Further voltages
spring-type terminals;onforrequest
rated control supply voltage 125 V DC

Rated control supply Contactor type -- 3RT2. 2.-.N Rated control supply Contactor 3RT2. 3.-.N 3RT2. 2.-.N
voltage voltage type
Us min ... Us max6) Size S00 S0 Us min ... Us max6) Size S2 S3
Sizes S00 to S3
AC/DC operation (50/60 Hz AC, DC)
21 ... 28 V AC/DC -- B3 20 ... 33 V AC/DC B3 B3
95 ... 130 V AC/DC -- F3 83 ... 155 V AC/DC F3 F3
200 ... 280 V AC/DC7) -- P3 175 ... 280 V AC/DC P3 P3
1) For deviating coil voltages and coil operating ranges of sizes S00 and S0, 4) Coil operating range
the SITOP power 24 V DC power supply unit with wide range input Size S00: at 50/60 Hz: 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us
(93 to 264 V AC; 30 to 264 V DC) can be used for coil excitation Size S0: at 50 Hz: 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us
(For more SITOP information see section 15). at 60 Hz: 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us
2) 5)
Coil operating range Coil operating range
at 50 Hz: 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us at 60 Hz: 0.8 ...1.1 x Us
at 60 Hz: 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us 6)
Coil operating range for S0: 0.7 x Us min ... 1.3 x Us max
3)
Coil operating range Coil operating range for S2: 0.8 x Us min ...1.1 x Us max
Size S00: at 50 Hz: 0.85.... 1.1 x Us 7) The following applies to S0 and U
s max = 280 V: Upper limit =1.1 x Us max
at 60 Hz: 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us
Size S0 to S3: at 50 Hz and 60 Hz: 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/51


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Control Relays, Coupling Relays
3RH21 control relays, 4-pole

Selection and ordering data


AC and DC operation
2 Assemblies
Contactors and

3RH11 . . -1 . . . . 3RH11 . . -2 . . . .

Rated current Auxiliary contacts


at 240 V Ident- Version Rated control AC Operation Rated control DC Operation
NEMA ification supply Screw supply Screw
Size S00 – Terminal designations A600/Q600 No. voltage Us Terminals1) 2) voltage Us Terminals1) 2
according to EN 50011
Amps NO NC V AC 50/60 Hz 3) Order No. V DC Order No.

For screw and snap-on mounting onto TH 35 standard mounting rail


10 40E 4 — 24 3RH2140-1AB00 24 3RH2140-1BB40
110/120 3RH2140-1AK60 110 3RH2140-1BF40
220/240 3RH2140-1AP60 220 3RH2140-1BM40

10 31E 3 1 24 3RH2131-1AB00 24 3RH2131-1BB40


110/120 3RH2131-1AK60 110 3RH2131-1BF40
220/240 3RH2131-1AP60 220 3RH2131-1BM40

10 22E 2 2 24 3RH2122-1AB00 24 3RH2122-1BB40


110/120 3RH2122-1AK60 110 3RH2122-1BF40
220/240 3RH2122-1AP60 220 3RH2122-1BM40

Notes: 1) The 3RH21 contactor relays are also available with spring-type terminals. Replace the 8th digit of the
For further voltages, see page 2/51. order number with a “2” e.g. “3RH2140-2AB00”
For accessories, see pages 2/68-2/79.
For technical data, see pages 2/187-2/190. 2) The 3RH21 contactor relays are also available with ring lug terminals. Replace the 8th digit of the
order number with a “4” e.g. “3RH2140-4AB00”
For overview, see page 2/118.
For position terminals, see page 2/204-2/205. 3) AC coil operating range at 50 Hz: 0.8 to 1.1 x Us at 60 Hz: 0.85 to 1.1 x Us
For dimension drawings, see page 2/126. 4) For AC-15/AC-14 the following applies: Ie = 6A for mounted auxiliary contacts.

2/52 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Control Relays, Coupling Relays
3RH24 latched control relays, 4-pole

Overview
The contactor coil and the coil of the release solenoid are both RC elements, varistors diodes or diode assemblies can
designed for uninterrupted duty. be fitted to both coils from the front for damping opening
surges in the coil.
The number of auxiliary contacts can be extended by means of
front auxiliary switch blocks (up to 4 poles).

2
Selection and ordering data
Size S00 – Terminal designations according to EN 5001

Assemblies
Contactors and
Rated current Aux. contacts Rated Rated
at 240 V Ident. Version control control
AC-14, AC-15 No. supply AC Operation supply DC Operation
NEMA voltage Us voltage Us
A600/Q600 Screw Terminals1) Screw Terminals

Amps NO NC V AC Order No. V DC Order No.


For screw and snap-on mounting onto TH 35 standard mounting rail
10 40E 4 — 24, 50/60 Hz 3RH2440-1AB00 24 3RH2440-1BB40
( ) 13 23 33 43
E1(+) A1+
110, 50 Hz/120, 60 Hz 3RH2440-1AK60 110 3RH2440-1BF40
220, 50 Hz / 240, 60 Hz 3RH2440-1AP60 125 3RH2440-1BG40
E2(-) A2(-) 14 24 34 44
230, 50/60 Hz 3RH2440-1AP00 220 3RH2440-1BM40

10 31E 3 1 24, 50/60 Hz 3RH2431-1AB00 24 3RH2431-1BB40


E1(+) A1(+) 13 21 33 43
110, 50 Hz / 120, 60 Hz 3RH2431-1AK60 110 3RH2431-1BF40
3RH2422-1BB40 220, 50 Hz / 240, 60 Hz 3RH2431-1AP60 125 3RH2431-1BG40
E2(–) A2(–) 14 22 34 44
230, 50/60 Hz 3RH2431-1AP00 220 3RH2431-1BM40
10 22E 2 2 24, 50/60 Hz 3RH2422-1AB00 24 3RH2422-1BB40
E1(+) A1(+) 13 21 31 43
110, 50 Hz / 120, 60 Hz 3RH2422-1AK60 110 3RH2422-1BF40
220, 50 Hz / 240, 60 Hz 3RH2422-1AP60 125 3RH2422-1BG40
E2(–) A2(–) 14 22 32 44
230, 50/60 Hz 3RH2422-1AP00 220 3RH2422-1BM40

For accessories for 3RH24, see below and page 2/68-2/79 For position of terminals, see page 2/204-2/205.
For technical data, see page 2/187-2/190. For dimension drawings, see page 2/227.
For overview, see page 2/118.

Auxiliary switch blocks for 3RH21, 3RH24 control relays


Size S00 – For assembling to control relays For contactor Contacts Weight
to have 8 contacts type HS Version approx.
Block
Ident.
Screw Terminals Spring Terminals
No.
NO NC kg. Order No. Order No.
Auxiliary switch blocks for snapping onto the front according to EN 50011
3RH2140, 80E 4 — 0.050 3RH2911-1GA40 3RH2911-2GA40
3RH2440,
Ident. No.
40 E

3RH2140, 71E 3 1 0.050 3RH2911-1GA31 3RH2911-2GA31


3RH2440,
Ident. No.
40 E
3RH2911-1GA40
3RH2140, 62E 2 2 0.050 3RH2911-1GA22 3RH2911-2GA22
3RH2440,
Ident. No.
40 E

3RH2140, 53E 1 3 0.050 3RH2911-1GA13 3RH2911-2GA13


3RH2440,
Ident. No.
40 E

3RH2140, 44E — 4 0.050 3RH2911-1GA04 3RH2911-2GA04


3RH2911-2GA40 3RH2440,
Ident. No.
40 E

1) Coil voltage tolerance For further accessories see pages 2/68-2/79


at 50 Hz: 0.8 to 1.1 x Us
at 60 Hz: 0.85 to 1.1 x Us

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/53
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Coupling Relays
3RH21 coupling relays for switching auxiliary circuits, 4 pole

DC operation The 3RH21 coupling relays for The 3RH21 coupling relays Coupling relays have a low power
IEC 60 947 and EN 60 947 switching auxiliary circuits are cannot be extended with consumption, an extended coil
tailored to the special requirements auxiliary switch blocks. voltage tolerance and an integrated
of working with electronic controls. surge suppressor for damping
opening surges on select versions
2 Assemblies
Contactors and

Selection and ordering data


DC operation Rated current Auxiliary contacts
at 240 V Ident- Version
Size S00 – Terminal designations Surge NEMA ification Weight
according to EN 50 011 suppressor A600/Q600 No. Screw Terminals1) Spring Terminals1) approx.
Amps NO NC Order No. Order No. kg.

For screw and snap-on mounting onto TH 35 standard mounting rail


Rated control supply voltage Us = Diode, varistor, 10 40E 4 — 3RH2140-1HB40 3RH2140-2HB40 0.300
24 V DC, coil voltage tolerance or RC element 10 31E 3 1 3RH2131-1HB40 3RH2131-2HB40 0.300
0.7 to 1.25 x Us can be mounted 10 22E 2 2 3RH2122-1HB40 3RH2122-2HB40 0.300
Power consumption of the coils
2.8 W at 24 V (no auxiliary switch Diode integrated 10 40E 4 — 3RH2140-1JB40 3RH2140-2JB40 0.300
blocks can be mounted) 10 31E 3 1 3RH2131-1JB40 3RH2131-2JB40 0.300
10 22E 2 2 3RH2122-1JB40 3RH2122-2JB40 0.300

Suppressor 10 40E 4 — 3RH2140-1KB40 3RH2140-2KB40 0.300


diode integrated 10 31E 3 1 3RH2131-1KB40 3RH2131-2KB40 0.300
10 22E 2 2 3RH2122-1KB40 3RH2122-2KB40 0.300

3RH2140-1HB40

Rated control supply voltage Us Diode, varistor, 10 40E 4 — 3RH2140-1MB40-0KT0 3RH2140-2MB40-0KT0 0.300
= 24 V DC, coil voltage tolerance or RC element 10 31E 3 1 3RH2131-1MB40-0KT0 3RH2131-2MB40-0KT0 0.300
0.85 to 1.85 x Us can be mounted 10 22E 2 2 3RH2122-1MB40-0KT0 3RH2122-2MB40-0KT0 0.300
Power consumption of the coils
1.6 W at 24 V (no auxiliary switch Diode 10 40E 4 — 3RH2140-1VB40 3RH2140-2VB40 0.300
blocks can be mounted) integrated 10 31E 3 1 3RH2131-1VB40 3RH2131-2VB40 0.300
10 22E 2 2 3RH2122-1VB40 3RH2122-2VB40 0.300

Suppressor 10 40E 4 — 3RH2140-1SB40 3RH2140-2SB40 0.300


diode integrated 10 31E 3 1 3RH2131-1SB40 3RH2131-2SB40 0.300
10 22E 2 2 3RH2122-1SB40 3RH2122-2SB40 0.300

3RH2140-2SB40

For technical data, see 2/191.


Suppressor element Diode integrated Suppressor diode
For position of terminals, see 2/204-2/205.
mountable integrated
For dimension drawings, see 2/227.

40E
1) Ring lug terminals are also available.
Replace the 8th digit of the order number
with a “4”, e.g. 3RH2140-4HB40
31E

22E

2/54 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Switching Motors
3TF68 and 3TF69 vacuum contactors, 3-pole

Selection and ordering data

Maximum Maximum power ratings Max.


inductive UL Ratings IEC resistive
current ratings current Auxiliary Rated control Weight
AC-3 200 V 230 V 460 V 575 V 1000 V AC-1 contacts supply voltage 1) approx.
A HP HP HP HP kW A NO NC V Order No. kg

2
AC operation 2) 3)

Size 14

Assemblies
Contactors and
3TF68 Auxiliary and control conductors: screw terminals
Main conductor: bar connections
• AC Operation
630 200 250 500 600 600 700 4 4 110-132, 50/60 Hz 3TF6844-nCF7 15
630 200 250 500 600 600 700 4 4 200-240, 50/60 Hz 3TF6844-nCM7 15
820 290 350 700 860 800 910 4 4 110-132, 50/60 Hz 3TF6944-nCF7 19
820 290 350 700 860 800 910 4 4 200-240, 50/60 Hz 3TF6944-nCM7 19
UL ratings shown in above table: n=0
For IEC use only up to 1000 V: n=8
• DC Operation
630 200 250 500 600 600 700 3 3 24 V DC 3TF6833-nDB4 16.9
820 290 350 700 860 800 910 3 3 24 V DC 3TF6933-nDB4 20.9
UL ratings shown in above table: n=1
For IEC use only up to 1000 V: n=8

Accessories and Spare parts for 3TF68 and 3TF69 vacuum contactors

Selection and ordering data

For contactor Weight


Details type approx.
Order No. kg
Coils
AC Operation
The coils are fitted with varistors for damping surges as standard; 3TF68 3TY7683-0C●● 0.65
the coil is supplied with the closing electronics included. 3TF69 3TY7693-0C●●
DC Operation
Reversing contactors are required for size 14 contactors:
Contactor type Reversing contactor type 3TF68 3TY7683-0D●● 0.56
3TF68 and 3TF69: 3TC44 (70 mm wide, 85 mm high) 3TF69 3TY7693-0D●●
The coils are supplied without a reversing contactor.
●● For rated control supply voltages, see page 2/104.
3TY7

Vacuum interrupters
In order to ensure reliable operation of the contactors, only 3TF68 3TY7680-0B 3.2
Siemens original replacement interrupters should be used. 3TF69 3TY7690-0B
3 vacuum interrupters with mouning parts per set. 3.5
Auxiliary switch blocks with screw terminals
1 NO and 1 NC First auxiliary switch block, left or right. 3TF68 / 3TF69 3TY7561-1AA00 0.042
Replacement type for: 3TY7561-1A, -1B
1 NO and 1 NC First auxiliary switch block, left or right late break 3TF68 / 3TF69 3TY7561-1EA00 0.042
1 NO and 1 NC Second auxiliary switch block, left or right. 3TF68 / 3TF69 3TY7561-1KA00 0.042
Replacement type for: 3TY7 561-1K, -1L
Auxiliary switches for coil reconnection, for DC economy circuit with screw connections
1 NC Auxiliary switch block late break 3TF68 / 3TF69 3TY7681-1G 0.042
Solid-state compatible auxiliary switch block with screw terminals
For mounting onto the side of contactors. For use in dusty atmosphere 3TF68 / 3TF69 3TY7561-1UA00 0.042
and electronic circuits with rated operational currents
3TY7561-1. Ie AC-14 and DC-13 from 1 mA to 300 mA at 3 V to 60 V.

For accessories, see page 2/55-2/56. 1) For further voltages, see page 2/104.
For technical data, see page 2/174-2/179. 2) Surge suppression integrated: fitted with varistor.
For description, see page 2/119. 3) For EMC, see description on page 2/119.
3TF68/69 vacuum contactors are supplied with integrated surge suppression for the main conducting paths (for
For internal circuit diagrams, see page 2/213.
description, see page 2/119). In operation in circuits with DC choppers, frequency converters, variable-speed drives,
For position of terminals, see page 2/210 for example, this protective circuitry is not required. It might be damaged by voltage peaks and harmonics generated,
For dimension drawings, see page 2/224. possibly followed by phase-to-phase shortcircuits. For this reason. the contactors can be supplied without overvoltage
damping. To order these versions add a “-Z” and the order code “A02”.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/55
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Switching Motors
Accessories and Spare parts for 3TF68 and 3TF69 vacuum contactors

Selection and ordering data

For contactor Design Order No. Weight Std.


approx. Pack
Size Type kg Qty
Interface for control by PLC
3TX7 090-0D Coil voltage tolerance: DC 17 V to 30 V
2

Power consumption: 0.5 W at DC 24 V


Fitted with varistor
For technical data, see Part 7.
Contactors and
Assemblies

14 3TF68 and For snapping onto the side of auxiliary switch 3TX7 090-0D 0.1 1
3TF69 blocks, with surge suppression

Terminal covers
3TX7 686-0A (Order No. and price per set)
14 3TF68 for protection against inadvertent contact 3TX7 686-0A 0.17 1 set =
with the exposed busbar connections 2 units
3TF69 (DIN VDE 0106 Part 100)" 3TX7 696-0A

Link for paralleling (star jumper) · 3-pole, without terminal 1)


3TX7 680-0D 14 3TF68 3TX7 680-0D 0.26 1
Cover plate for paralleling link
14 3TF68 A cover plate must be used in order to protect 3TX7 680-0E 0.18 1
against inadvertent contact (DIN VDE 0106
Part 100).

Box terminals for laminated copper bars


3TX7570-1E Without auxiliary conductor terminal
14 3TF68 With single covers for protection against inad- 3TX7 570-1E 0.6 1
vertent contact (EN 50274)

With auxiliary conductor terminal

14 3TF69 Conductor cross-sections for auxiliary conduc- 3TX7 690-1F 2.0 1


tors:
Solid: 2 × (0.75 ... 2.5) mm 2
Finely stranded
with end sleeve: 2 × (0.5 ... 2.5) mm2
Solid or stranded: 2 × (18 ... 12) AWG
Tightening torque: 0.8 Nm ... 1.4 Nm
(7 ... 12 lb.in)

Surge suppressors — Varistors


3TX7 572-3G 3TF68 and For DC economy circuit; Rated control
14 for lateral snapping onto supply voltage,
3TF69
auxiliary switches V DC
24 … 48 3TX7 572-3G 0.09 1
The varistor is included 48 … 127 3TX7 572-3H 0.09 1
in the scope of supply of 127 … 240 3TX7 572-3J 0.09 1
the 3TF68 and 3TF69
contactors with AC operation.

Includes the peak value


of the alternating voltage
on the DC side.

1) The link for paralleling can be reduced by one pole.

2/56 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


DC Power Controls SIRIUS
Contactors and Replacement Parts
General Purpose - Type 3TC

Ordering information
• Select Contactor from table below.
• Complete catalog number replace the two daggers (††) with appropriate
coil voltage suffix. See corresponding coil voltage suffix table below.
• Technical Data see page 2/180-2/183.
• Dimensions see page 2/224.
3TC44 3TC5 2

2
2 Pole DC HP Ratings Auxiliary

Assemblies
Contactors and
Frame Ampere Rating (DC-3, DC-5) contacts AC-Operated DC-Operated
Size Open Enclosed 115 V 230 V 500 V 575 V NO NC Order No. Order No.
3TC DC Contactors
2 40 40 5 10 15 15 2 2 3TC4417–0B†† 3TC4417–0A††
4 75 68 8 18 40 45 2 2 3TC4817–0B†† 3TC4817–0A††
8 220 200 25 50 100 100 2 2 3TC5217–0B†† 3TC5217–0A††
12 330 300 40 75 150 150 2 2 3TC5617–0B†† 3TC5617–0A††

Device Frame Size Catalog Number


Coils, AC 24V AC 120V AC 220/240V AC 277V AC 480V AC 600V AC
3TC4417-0B†† 3TY7403-0AC2 3TY7403-0AK6 3TY7403-0AP6 3TY7403-0AU1 3TY7403-0AV0 3TY7403-0AS0
3TC4817-0B†† 3TY6483-0AC1 3TY6483-0AK6 3TY6483-0AP6 3TY6483-0AP0 3TY6483-0AV0 3TY6483-0AS0
3TC 3TC5217-0B†† 3TY6523-0AK6 3TY6523-0AP6 3TY6523-0AP0 3TY6523-0AV0
3TC5617-0B†† 3TY6566-0AK6 3TY6566-0AP0 3TY6566-0AV0 3TY6566-0AS0
3TY6483-0AK6

Coils, DC 24V DC 48V DC 110V DC 125V DC 230V DC


3TC4417-0A†† 3TY6443-0BB4 3TY6443-0BF4 3TY6443-0BG4
3TC4817-0A†† 3TY6483-0BB4 3TY6483-0BW4 3TY6483-0BF4 3TY6483-0BG4
3TC
3TC5217-0A†† 3TY6523-0BB4 3TY6523-0BF4 3TY6523-0BG4 3TY6523-0BP4
3TC5217-0A†† 3TY6563-0BB4 3TY6563-0BF4 3TY6563-0BG4 3TY6563-0BP4
3TY6483-0BB4

Frame Contactor Mounting Solid Order No. Coil Suffix Table ††


size type position state
Replace †† in the contactor Order No.
Auxiliary Contact Blocks with 1 NO + 1 NC contacts 2) with a coil code from the table below.
2, 4 3TC44 or 1st block, left or right — 3TY6501-1AA00 V AC 50/60 Hz Code V DC Code
3TC48 2nd block, left or right Yes3) 3TY7561-1UA00 24 C1 24 B4
4 3TC48 2nd block, left 5) — 3TY6501-1K 120 K1* 36 V4
2nd block, right5) — 3TY6501-1L 240 P1 48 W4
3TY6501-1A 8, 12 3TC52 or 1st block, left — 3TY6561-1A 460 V0 60 E4
3TC56 1st block, right — 3TY6561-1B 600 S0 72 J8
*Use suffix K2 for 3TC44. 110 F4
2nd block, left5) — 3TY6561-1K
125 G4
2nd block, right5) — 3TY6561-1L
220 M4
230 P4
Device Type Frame Size Catalog Number
Main Contacts 1)

3TC44 3TY2440-0A
3TC48 3TY2480-0A
3TC 3TC52 3TY2520-0A
3TC56 3TY2560-0A
3TY2480-0A 1)
Main contact kits for size 3TC48 and larger include springs.
Smaller sizes do not.
Arc Chutes
2) On DC operated contactors the maximum number of auxiliary
3TC44 3TY2442-0A contacts is 2 NO, 2 NC.
3TC 3TC48 3TY2482-0A 3)
For use in dusty atmosphere and electronic circuits with rated
operational currents Ie AC-14 and DC-13 from 1 mA to 300 mA
3TC52 3TY2522-0A
at 3V to 60V. With 1 changeover contact.
3TC56 3TY2562-0A
4) Discount Code: DC Contactors
3TY2482-0A 5) Can only be mounted on AC-operated contactors.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/57
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Special Applications
DC Contactor Replacement Parts Contactors for Switching DC Voltage
General Purpose - Type 3TC 3TC contactors,
1- and 2-pole, 32 ... 400 A

For contactors Version Rated control supply Order No. Std.


voltage Us Pack
Size Type V AC V DC Qty
Surge suppressors · Varistors
2 3TC441) Varistors2) 24 ... 48 24 ... 70 3TX7 402-3G 1
with line spacer, for mounting onto 48 ... 127 70 ... 150 3TX7 402-3H 1
the coil terminal 127 ... 240 150 ... 250 3TX7 402-3J 1
2

240 ... 400 3TX7 402-3K 1


400 ... 600 3TX7 402-3L 1
4 3TC48 Varistors2) 24 ... 48 24 ... 70 3TX7 462-3G 1
Contactors and
Assemblies

for sticking onto the contactor base 48 ... 127 70 ... 150 3TX7 462-3H 1
3TX7 402-3 . or for mounting separately 127 ... 240 150 ... 250 3TX7 462-3J 1
240 ... 400 3TX7 462-3K 1
400 ... 600 3TX7 462-3L 1
8 and 12 3TC52, Varistor 24 ... 48 3TX7 462-3G 1

4
3TC56 for sticking onto the contactor base 48 ... 127 3TX7 462-3H 1
or for mounting separately 127 ... 240 3TX7 462-3J 1
240 ... 400 3TX7 462-3K 1
400 ... 600 3TX7 462-3L 1
8 and 12 3TC52, Varistors2) 24 ... 70 3TX7 522-3G 1
3TX7 462-3 . 3TC56 for separate screw connection or 70 ... 150 3TX7 522-3H 1
snapping onto TH 35 standard 150 ... 250 3TX7 522-3J 1
mounting rail

3TX7 522-3 .
Surge suppressors · RC elements
4 3TC48 RC elements 24 ... 48 3TX7 462-3R
For lateral snapping onto auxiliary 24 ... 70 3TX7 522-3R
switch or TH 35 standard mounting 48 ... 127 3TX7 462-3S
rail 70 ... 150 3TX7 522-3S
127 ... 240 3TX7 462-3T
150 ... 250 3TX7 522-3T
240 ... 400 3TX7 462-3U
400 ... 600 3TX7 462-3V
3TX7 462-3 . , 8 and 12 3TC52, RC elements 24 ... 48 3TX7 522-3R
3TX7 522-3 . 3TC56 For lateral snapping onto auxiliary 48 ... 127 3TX7 522-3S
switch or TH 35 standard mounting 127 ... 240 3TX7 522-3T
rail 240 ... 400 3TX7 522-3U
400 ... 600 3TX7 522-3V
Surge suppressors · Diodes
4 to 12 3TC48, Diode assemblies3) 24 ... 250 3TX7 462-3D
3TC52, . (diode and Zener diode) for DC
3TC56 solenoid system, for sticking onto
the contactor base or for mounting
separately

3TX7 462-3 .
Terminal covers
6 3TC48 For protection against inadvertent contact with 3TX6 506-3B 1 set=
exposed busbar connections. Can be screwed 6 units
on free screw end. Covers one busbar connection
10 and 14 3TC52, 3TX6 546-3B 1 set=
3TC56 6 units

3TX6 506-3B

1) The connection piece for mounting the surge suppressor must be bent
slightly.
2) Includes the peak value of the alternating voltage on the DC side.
3) Not for DC economy circuit.

2/58 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2012 4/57
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactor Relays

Contactor relays and coupling relays – Size S00 with accessories


SIRIUS 3RH2 contactor relays, 4- and 8-pole

■ Overview
Contactor relays,
size S00, with accessories

10

2
Assemblies
Contactors and
11
11
1

2
5

IC01_00632a
8
9
3

12
13 14
11
6
4
5 11
7

10
1 Contactor relay
2 Coupling contactor relay for auxiliary circuits

3 3RA28 function module 10 Solder pin adapter for contactor relays with 4-pole auxiliary switch block
4 1-pole auxiliary switch block, cable entry from the top 11 Solder pin adapter
5 2-pole auxiliary switch block, cable entry from the top 12 Additional load module for increasing the permissible residual current
6 1-pole auxiliary switch block, cable entry from the bottom 13 Surge suppressor with LED
7 2-pole auxiliary switch block, cable entry from the bottom 14 Surge suppressor without LED
8 4-pole auxiliary switch block
(terminal designations according to EN 50011 or EN 50005)
For contactor relays
9 2-pole auxiliary switch block, solid-state compatible version
(terminal designations according to EN 50005) For increasing the permissible residual current

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/59


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Power Contactors for Switching Motors

3RT2 contactors and coupling relays – Size S00 with mountable accessories
General data

■ Overview
The SIRIUS family of controls
The SIRIUS modular system with its components for the
switching, starting, protection and monitoring of motors and
industrial systems stands for the fast, flexible and space-saving
construction of control cabinets.
2

3RT2 contactors

3
Size S00 with mountable accessories
Contactors and
Assemblies

10

11

12

13

16

1 15
18 1
6 2
7 17
8

IC01_00614
16
9

3
4
5
14

1 Contactor size S00 13

2 2-pole auxiliary switch block, laterally mountable 11 Star jumper, 3-pole, without connecting terminal
3 1-pole auxiliary switch block, for snapping onto the front 12 Link for paralleling, 3-pole, with connecting terminal
cable entry from the top 13 Solder pin adapter
4 2-pole auxiliary switch block, for snapping onto the front 14 Connection module (adapter and connector) for contactors
cable entry from the bottom with screw-type connection
5 4-pole auxiliary switch block, for snapping onto the front 15 Safety main current connector for two contactors
6 3RA28 function module Assembly kit 3RA2913-2AA1
7 3RA27 function module for AS-Interface, direct starting comprising:
8 3RA27 function module for IO-Link, direct starting 16 Wiring modules on the top and bottom for connecting the main,
auxiliary and control current paths, electrical interlock 1)
9 Surge suppressor with/without LED
included (NC contact interlock), can be broken off
10 Three-phase feeder terminal (NC contact interlock)
17 Mechanical interlocks 2)
18 Two connecting clips for two contactors 2)

For contactors
For contactors and coupling contactors
1)
3RT201. contactors with one NC contact in the basic unit
are required for the electrical interlock. An additional NO contact
is required for momentary-contact operation.
2) The parts 17 and 18 can only be ordered together as 3RA2912-2H
mechanical connectors.

For accessories
2/60 and spare
Siemens Industry Inc.,parts, seeControl
Industrial pagesCatalog
3/75 to 3/123.

Siemens IC 10 · 2017 3/7


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Power Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT2 contactors and coupling relays – Size S0 with mountable accessories
General data
3RT2 contactors
Size S0 with mountable accessories

16

14

2
3

Assemblies
Contactors and
15

2 18
1
17
1
7 20
8
9

IC01_00615
19

5
4 10

6
18

13

14
3
11

12
1 Contactor size S0

2 2-pole auxiliary switch block, laterally mountable 12 Link for paralleling, 3-pole, with connecting terminal
3 1-pole auxiliary switch block, for snapping onto the front 13 Connection module (adapter and plug) for contactors
cable entry from the top with screw-type connection
4 4-pole auxiliary switch block, for snapping onto the front 14 Coil terminal module, on the top and bottom
5 2-pole auxiliary switch block, for snapping onto the front 15 Three-phase feeder terminal
cable entry from the bottom
16 Link for paralleling (star jumper), 3-pole,
6 Surge suppressor with/without LED without connecting terminal
7 3RA27 function module for AS-Interface, direct starting 17 Safety main current connector for two contactors
8 3RA28 function module Assembly kit 3RA2923-2AA1
9 3RA27 function module for IO-Link, direct starting comprising:
10 Pneumatically delayed auxiliary switch block 18 Wiring modules on the top and bottom for connecting the
main current paths, electrical interlock included (NC
11 Mechanical latching block
contact interlock)
19 Mechanical interlocks 1)
20 Two connecting clips for two contactors 1)

For contactors
For contactors and coupling contactors
1) The parts19 and 20 can only be ordered together as 3RA2912-2H
mechanical connectors.

For accessories and spare parts, see pages 3/75 to 3/123.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/61

3/8 Siemens IC 10 · 2017


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Power Contactors for Switching Motors

3RT2 contactors – Size S2 with mountable accessories General data


3RT2 contactors
Size S2 with mountable accessories

13

12
2

3
Contactors and
Assemblies

11

15
1
16
14
2 1
17

7
8
9

IC01_00616a
6
3 15
5
4 11

1 Contactor, size S2
10
2 2-pole auxiliary switch block, laterally mountable 13 Link for paralleling (star jumper), 3-pole,
without connection terminal
3 1-pole auxiliary switch block, for snapping onto the front,
cable entry from above 14 Safety main current connector for two contactors
4 4-pole auxiliary switch block, for snapping onto the front Assembly kit 3RA2933-2AA1
5 2-pole auxiliary switch block, for snapping onto the front, comprising:
cable entry from below 15 Wiring modules on the top and bottom for connecting the
6 Surge suppressor with/without LED main current paths, electrical interlock included
(NC contact interlock)
7 3RA27 function modules for AS-Interface, direct-on-line starting
16 Two connecting clips for two contactors
8 3RA28 function modules
9 3RA27 function modules for IO-Link, direct-on-line starting To be ordered separately:
10 Link for paralleling, 3-pole, with connection terminal 17 Mechanical interlocks
11 Coil terminal module, top and bottom
12 Three-phase feeder terminal

For accessories and spare parts, see pages 3/71 to 3/119.


Accessories see pages 2/68 to 2/83.

2/62 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

Siemens IC 10 · 2018 3/9


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Power Contactors for Switching Motors

3RT2 contactors
General data – Size S3 with mountable accessories

3RT2 contactors
Size S3 with mountable accessories

13

12

2
3

Assemblies
Contactors and
11

14
1

2 15 1

16

7
8
9

IC01_00617a
6

14
3
5
4

11

1 Contactor, size S3
10
2 2-pole auxiliary switch block, laterally mountable 10 Links for paralleling, 3-pole, with connection terminal
3 1-pole auxiliary switch block, for snapping onto the front, 11 Coil terminal module, top and bottom
cable entry from above
12 Single-phase infeed terminals (3 units)
4 4-pole auxiliary switch block, for snapping onto the front
13 Links for paralleling (star jumper), 3-pole
5 2-pole auxiliary switch block, for snapping onto the front, without connecting terminal
cable entry from below Assembly kit 3RA2943-2AA1
6 Surge suppressor with/without LED comprising:
7 3RA27 function modules for AS-Interface, direct-on-line starting 14 Wiring modules on the top and bottom for connecting the main,
8 3RA28 function modules auxiliary and control current paths, electrical interlock1)
included, can be broken off (NC contact interlock)
9 3RA27 function modules for IO-Link, direct-on-line starting
15 Two connectors for two contactors
To be ordered separately:
16 Mechanical interlock
1)
3RT201. contactors with one NC contact in the basic unit
are required for the electrical interlock. An additional NO contact
is required for momentary-contact operation.

For accessories
Accessories and spare parts,
see pages 2/68 tosee pages 3/71 to 3/119.
2/83. Motor Starters see Chapter 4 Combination
Starters & Starters for group installation

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/63

3/10 Siemens IC 10 · 2018


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Power Contactors for Switching Motors

3RT1 contactors – Sizes S6 to S12 with mountable accessories General data


3RT1 contactors
Sizes S6 to S12 with mountable accessories
(illustration for basic unit)

1
2

3
IC01_00618a
Contactors and
Assemblies

5
7
2

3
8

1 3RT10 and 3RT14 air-break contactor, sizes S6, S10 and S12

2 Auxiliary switch block, solid-state time-delay 7 Terminal cover for cable lug and busbar connection
(ON or OFF-delay or star-delta (wye-delta) starting)
8 Terminal cover for box terminal
3 4-pole auxiliary switch block
9 Box terminal block
4 1-pole auxiliary switch block (up to 4 can be snapped on)
5 2-pole auxiliary switch block, laterally mountable left or right
6 Surge suppressor (RC element) for plugging into top of withdrawable coil
Accessories identical for sizes S6 to S12
Different accessories for sizes S6 and S10/S12

For accessories and spare parts, see pages 3/71 to 3/119.


For accessories see pages 2/68 to 2/85.
For mountable overload relays see Chapter 3,
“Overload Relays”.

2/64 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

Siemens IC 10 · 2018 3/11


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Reversing Contactor Assemblies
3RT1 contactors – Sizes S6, S10 and S12 reversing contactors
Reversing contactor assemblies consisting of SIRIUS 3RT1 contactors, up to 250 kW
Reversing contactor assemblies for customer assembly · Size S6 · Up to 90 kW

2
Assemblies
Contactors and
3

2
4

IC01_00583a
7
7

Mountable accessories (optional) Reversing contactor assembly for customer assembly


To be ordered separately Type Page Individual parts Type Page
Q11 Q12
6 Auxiliary switch block, front 3RH1921 3/92 1 2 Contactors, 55 kW 3RT1.54 3RT1.54 3/66 ... 3/68
7 Auxiliary switch block, lateral 3RH1921 3/94 1 2 Contactors, 75 kW 3RT1.55 3RT1.55 3/66 ... 3/68
1 2 Contactors, 90 kW 3RT1.56 3RT1.56 3/66 ... 3/68
3 Assembly kit 3RA1953-2A 3/105
consisting of:
Wiring modules on the top and bottom
for contactors without box terminals
for connecting the main and auxiliary
circuits, electrical interlock included
(NC contact interlock)
4 Two connectors for two contactors 3RA1932-2D 3/109
5 Mechanical interlock 3RA1954-2A 3/109
(must be ordered separately)
6 Base plate for reversing contactor 3RA1952-2A 3/113
assemblies

For accessories see pages 2/68-2/85.


Mountable overload relays see Chapter 3,
“Overload Relays”.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/65


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Reversing Contactor Assemblies
3RT1 contactors – Sizes S6, S10 and S12 reversing contactors
Reversing contactor assemblies consisting of SIRIUS 3RT1 contactors, up to 250 kW
Reversing contactor assemblies for customer assembly · Size S10 · Up to 160 kW

5
2 Assemblies
Contactors and

3
3

7 2

IC01_00584a
6
6

Mountable accessories (optional) Reversing contactor assembly for customer assembly


To be ordered separately Type Page Individual parts Type Page
Q11 Q12
6 Auxiliary switch block, front 3RH1921 3/92 1 2 Contactors, 110 kW 3RT1.64 3RT1.64 3/66 ... 3/68
7 Auxiliary switch block, lateral 3RH1921 3/94 1 2 Contactors, 132 kW 3RT1.65 3RT1.65 3/66 ... 3/68
1 2 Contactors, 160 kW 3RT1.66 3RT1.66 3/66 ... 3/68
3 Assembly kit 3RA1963-2A 3/105
consisting of:
Wiring modules on the top and
bottom
for contactors without box terminals
for connecting the main and
auxiliary circuits, electrical inter-
lock included (NC contact interlock)
4 Mechanical interlock 3RA1954-2A 3/109
(must be ordered separately)
5 Base plate for reversing contactor 3RA1962-2A 3/113
assemblies

For accessories see pages 2/68-2/85.


For mountable overload relays see Chapter 3,
“Overload Relays”.

2/66 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Power Contactors for Switching Motors

3RT1 contactors – Sizes S6 to S12 with accessories General data


3RT1 contactors
Sizes S6 to S12 with mountable accessories

2
3
Assemblies
Contactors and
3
4
5

5
1

IC01_00620a

1 3RT10 and 3RT14 air-break contactor, sizes S6, S10 and S12
(3RT1054, size S6 shown here)
2 3RT12 vacuum contactor, sizes S10 and S12
(3RT1266, size S10 shown here)
3 Withdrawable coils for 3RT1...-.A... contactors with conventional operating mechanism
(size S10: differentiation between 3RT10/3RT14 air-break contactors and 3RT12 vacuum contactors)
(size S12: the same for air-break and vacuum contactors)
4 Withdrawable coils for 3RT1...-.N... contactors with solid-state operating mechanism.
(size S10: differentiation between 3RT10/3RT14 air-break contactors and 3RT12 vacuum contactors)
(size S12: the same for air-break and vacuum contactors)
5 Withdrawable coils and laterally mountable module (plug-on) for 3RT1...-.P... air-break
contactors with solid-state operating mechanism and remaining lifetime indicator
6 Surge suppressor (RC element), plug-mountable on withdrawable coils
• 3RT1...-.A... with conventional operating mechanism
• 3RT1...-.N... with solid-state operating mechanism

Same accessories for sizes S6 to S12


Different accessories depending on size

For surge suppressors see page 2/75,


Forwithdrawable
accessories coils see page
and spare 2/100.
parts for
For mountable
• 3RT10 overload
and 3RT14 relays see
contactors, see Chapter 3, to 3/119
pages 3/71
“Overload
• 3RT12 Relays”.
vacuum contactors, see pages 3/132 to 3/135

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/67


Siemens IC 10 · 2018 3/13
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Accessories for 3RT contactors / 3RH control relays
Auxiliary switch blocks

Selection and ordering data


2 Assemblies
Contactors and

3RH2911-1HA01 3RH2911-2HA01 3RH19 21-1HA. . 3RH19 21-2HA . .

For contactors/ Rated Contactor Connections Auxiliary contacts Screw Spring


control relays operational with position Terminals1) Terminals1)
Current 3) HS block Version
6A Ident. No.
NEMA Order No. Order No.
A600/Q600
Type NO NC NO NC

Auxiliary switch blocks for snapping onto the front according to EN 50012
(also compliant with the requirements according to EN 50005)
Size S00 2)
For assembling contactors with 2, 3, 4, or 5 auxiliary contacts
3RT201., 11E — 1 — — 3RH2911-1HA01 3RH2911-2HA01
Ident. No. 10E 12E — 2 — — 3RH2911-1HA02 3RH2911-2HA02
3RT231. 13E — 3 — — 3RH2911-1HA03 3RH2911-2HA03
3RT251. 21E 1 — — — 3RH2911-1HA10 3RH2911-2HA10
21E 1 1 — — 3RH2911-1HA11 3RH2911-2HA11
22E 1 2 — — 3RH2911-1HA12 3RH2911-2HA12
23E 1 3 — — 3RH2911-1HA13 3RH2911-2HA13
31E 2 — — — 3RH2911-1HA20 3RH2911-2HA20
31E 2 1 — — 3RH2911-1HA21 3RH2911-2HA21
32E 2 2 — — 3RH2911-1HA22 3RH2911-2HA22
41E 3 — — — 3RH2911-1HA30 3RH2911-2HA30
41E 3 1 — — 3RH2911-1HA31 3RH2911-2HA31
Size S0 to S3
For assembling contactors with 3, 4, or 5 auxiliary contacts
3RT202. , 12E — 1 — — 3RH2911-1HA01 3RH2911-2HA01
Ident. No. 11E 13E — 2 — — 3RH2911-1HA02 3RH2911-2HA02
3RT232. 14E — 3 — — 3RH2911-1HA03 3RH2911-2HA03
3RT252. 21E 1 — — — 3RH2911-1HA10 3RH2911-2HA10
3RT203. 22E 1 1 — — 3RH2911-1HA11 3RH2911-2HA11
3RT233. 23E 1 2 — — 3RH2911-1HA12 3RH2911-2HA12
3RT235. 24E 1 3 — — 3RH2911-1HA13 3RH2911-2HA13
31E 2 — — — 3RH2911-1HA20 3RH2911-2HA20
32E 2 1 — — 3RH2911-1HA21 3RH2911-2HA21
33E 2 2 — — 3RH2911-1HA22 3RH2911-2HA22
41E 3 — — — 3RH2911-1HA30 3RH2911-2HA30
42E 3 1 — — 3RH2911-1HA31 3RH2911-2HA31
Auxiliary switch blocks for snapping onto the front according to EN 50012

Sizes S6 to S12
4-pole

3RT1. 4 to 22 (with location 2 2 — — 3RH1921-1XA22-0MA0 3RH1921-2XA22-0MA0


3RT1. 7, digits 5, 6, 7, 8)
3RT11.

EN50005 and EN50012 designate the markings 1) The 3RH2911-.HA.. aux. switches are available with 3) UL ratings: See appendix page 19/7
of the auxiliary terminal numbers. ring-lug terminals. Replace the 8th digit of the Order
For position of the terminals see pages 2/204-2/208. No. with a “4”.
For int. circuit diagrams see page 2/192. 2) Size S00 can be mounted according to EN 50012
3RH29 aux blocks are not intended for use with 3RT1 or only on basic units which have no integrated NC
3RH1 contactors and relays. contact.
3RH19 aux blocks are not intended for use with 3RT2 or
3RH2 contactors and relays.
For auxiliary switch blocks for 3RH2140 and 3RH2440 see
page 2/53.

2/68 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Accessories for 3RT contactors / 3RH control relays
Auxiliary switch blocks

Selection and ordering data

2
Assemblies
Contactors and
3RH2911-1FA40 3RH2911-2FA40 3RH19 21-1C. . . 3RH19 21-2C . . . 3RH19 21-1LA . . 3RH19 21-1MA..

For contactors/ Rated Contactor Connections Auxiliary contacts Screw Spring


control relays operational with position Terminals1) Terminals1)
Current 3) HS block Version
6A Ident. No.
NEMA Order No. Order No.
A600/Q600
Type NO NC NO NC

Auxiliary switch blocks for snapping onto the front according to EN 50005
Sizes S00 to S3
2- or 4-pole auxiliary switch blocks for assembling contactors
with 3 and 5 or 4 and 6 auxiliary contacts
3RT2. 1., 40 4 — — — 3RH2911-1FA40 3RH2911-2FA40
3RT2. 2., 22 2 2 — — 3RH2911-1FA22 3RH2911-2FA22
3RT2. 3., 04 1) — 4 — — 3RH2911-1FA04 3RH2911-2FA04
3RH21 .., 11 2) — — 1 1 3RH2911-1FB11 3RH2911-2FB11
3RH24 .. 22 2) 1 1 1 1 3RH2911-1FB22 3RH2911-2FB22
22 2) — — 2 2 3RH2911-1FC22 3RH2911-2FC22
1- and 2- pole auxiliary switch blocks, cable entry from above or below
3RT2. 1., 10 Top 1 — — — 3RH2911-1AA10 —
3RT2. 2., Bottom 1 — — — 3RH2911-1BA10 —
3RT2. 3., 01 Top — 1 — — 3RH2911-1AA01 —
3RH21 .., Bottom — 1 — — 3RH2911-1BA01 —
3RH24 .. 11 Top 1 1 — — 3RH2911-1LA11 —
Bottom 1 1 — — 3RH2911-1MA11 —
20 Top 2 — — — 3RH2911-1LA20 —
Bottom 2 — — — 3RH2911-1MA20 —

Sizes S6 to S12
Single-pole auxiliary switch blocks (also compliant with EN 50012)

3RT1. 4 to — 1 — — — 3RH1921-1CA10 3RH1921-2CA10


3RT1. 7, — — 1 — — 3RH1921-1CA01 3RH1921-2CA01
3RT11 — — — 1 — 3RH1921-1CD10 —
— — — — 1 3RH1921-1CD01 —

EN50005 and EN50012 designate the markings 1) Mounting is permitted only on basic units which 3) UL ratings: See appendix page 19/7
of the auxiliary terminal numbers. have no integrated NC contact.
For position of the terminals see pages 2/204-2/208. 2) Version with early make and delayed break contacts
For int. circuit diagrams see page 2/192.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/69
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Accessories for 3RT contactors / 3RH control relays
Laterally mountable auxiliary switch blocks

Selection and ordering data


2 Assemblies
Contactors and

3RH2911-1DA02 3RH2911-2DA02 3RH19 21-1EA. . 3RH2921-1DA02


-1KA. .

For contactors/ Rated Contactor Mountable Auxiliary contacts Screw Spring


control relays operational with to contactor/ Terminals1) Terminals1)
Current 4) HS block contactor Version
6A Ident. No. relay side
NEMA Order No. Order No.
A600/Q600
Type NO NC

Laterally mountable auxiliary switch blocks according to EN 50012


Laterally mountable auxiliary switch block, 2-pole
Size S00 1) 2)
3RT201. A600/Q600 12E right or left — 2 3RH2911-1DA02 3RH2911-2DA02
Ident. No. 10E A600/Q600 21E right or left 1 1 3RH2911-1DA11 3RH2911-2DA11
Size S0 to S3
3RT2.2. 3) A600/Q600 13E right or left — 2 3RH2921-1DA02 3RH2921-2DA02
Ident.No. 11E A600/Q600 22E right or left 1 1 3RH2921-1DA11 3RH2921-2DA11
3RT2.3. A600/Q600 31E right or left 2 — 3RH2921-1DA20 3RH2921-2DA20

First laterally mountable auxiliary switch block, 2-pole


Sizes S6 to S12
3RT1. 3 to 3RT1. 7 A600/Q600 right or left 1 1 3RH1921-1DA11 3RH1921-2DA11
Second laterally mountable auxiliary switch block, 2-pole
Sizes S6 to S12
3RT1. 4 to 3RT1. 7 A300/Q300 right or left 1 1 3RH1921-1JA11 3RH1921-2JA11
Laterally mountable auxiliary switch blocks according to EN 50005
First laterally mountable auxiliary switch block, 2-pole
Sizes S00 1) 2)
3RT2.1. A600/Q600 02 right or left — 2 3RH2911-1DA02 3RH2911-2DA02
Ident.No. 10E A600/Q600 11 right or left 1 1 3RH2911-1DA11 3RH2911-2DA11
A600/Q600 20 right or left 2 — 3RH2911-1DA20 3RH2911-2DA20

Sizes S0 to S3
3RT2.2., A600/Q600 02 right or left — 2 3RH2921-1DA02 3RH2921-2DA02
3RT2.3.3) A600/Q600 11 right or left 1 1 3RH2921-1DA11 3RH2921-2DA11
A600/Q600 20 right or left 2 — 3RH2921-1DA20 3RH2921-2DA20
Sizes S6 to S12
3RT1. 4 to A300/Q300 right or left — 2 3RH1921-1EA02 3RH1921-2EA02
3RT1. 7 A300/Q300 right or left 1 1 3RH1921-1EA11 —
A300/Q300 right or left 2 — 3RH1921-1EA20 3RH1921-2EA20
Second laterally mountable auxiliary switch block, 2-pole
Sizes S6 to S12
3RT1. 4 to A300/Q300 right or left — 2 3RH1921-1KA02 3RH1921-2KA02
3RT1. 7 A300/Q300 right or left 1 1 3RH1921-1KA11 —
A300/Q300 right or left 2 — 3RH1921-1KA20 3RH1921-2KA20

EN50005 and EN50012 designate the markings 1) With size S00, mounting according to EN 50012 is per- 3) With 3RT23 2., 3RT25. 2. mountable only on the right.
of the auxiliary terminal numbers. mitted only on basic units which have no NC contact
4) UL ratings: See appendix page 19/7
For position of the terminals see pages 2/204-2/208. integrated.
For int. circuit diagrams see pages 2/192-2/197. 2) Ident. No. 41, 32 and 23 according to EN 50012 is
also possible. Please note the corresponding circuit
diagrams for mounting 3RH29 11-1DA.. on the left.

2/70 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Accessories for 3RT contactors / 3RH control relays
Solid-state auxiliary switch blocks

Selection and ordering data

n Operation in dusty atmospheres


n Solid-state circuits with rated operational currents Ie/AC-14 and DC-13 from 1 … 300 mA at 3 … 60 V
n Hard gold-plated contacts

2
n Mirror contacts according to EN 60947-4-1, Appendix F, for laterally mountable auxiliary switches

Assemblies
Contactors and
Selection and ordering data

3RH2911-1NF02 3RH2911-2NF02 3RH2911-2DE11 3RH1921-2DE11 3RH29 21-2DE11

For contactors/ Contactor Mountable Auxiliary contacts Screw Spring


control relays with to contactor/ Terminals1) Terminals1)
Version
HS block contactor
Ident. No. relay side
Order No. Order No.
Type NO NC NO NC

Solid-state compatible auxiliary switch blocks for snapping onto the


front according to EN 50005 1)
Sizes S00 to S3
3RT2. 1., 02 — — — 2 3RH2911-1NF02 3RH2911-2NF02
3RT2.2., 3RT2.3. 11 1 — — 1 3RH2911-1NF11 3RH2911-2NF11
3RH21 .., 20 2 — — — 3RH2911-1NF20 3RH2911-2NF20
3RH24 ..
Sizes S6 to S12
3RT1. 4 to — 1 1 1 1 3RH1921-1FE22 3RH19 21-2FE22
3RT1. 7 — — 2 2 — 3RH1921-2FJ22

Solid-state compatible auxiliary switch blocks, laterally mountable,


according to EN 50012
First laterally mountable auxiliary switch block, 2-pole
Size S00 2)
3RT2. 1., 21E right 1 — — 1 — 3RH2911-2DE11
Ident. No. 10E
Size S0 to S3
3RT2. 2, 3RT2. 3 22E right 1 — — 1 — 3RH2921-2DE11
Ident. No. 10E
Sizes S6 to S12
3RT1. 4 to right or left 1 — — 1 — 3RH1921-2DE11
3RT1 . 7
Second laterally mountable auxiliary switch block, 2-pole
Sizes S6 to S12
3RT1. 4 to right or left 1 — — 1 — 3RH1921-2JE11
3RT1. 7
Solid-state compatible auxiliary switch blocks, laterally mountable,
according to EN 50005
Size S00
3RT2. 1., 11 right or left 1 — — 1 — 3RH2911-2DE11
Ident. No. 10E
Size S0 to S2
3RT2. 2., 11 right or left 1 — — 1 —
­ 3RH2921-2DE11
3RT2. 3

EN50005 and EN50012 designate the markings 1) The 3RH29 11-.NF.. auxiliary switches are also 2) Size S00 can be mounted according to EN 50012
of the auxiliary terminal numbers. available with ring lug terminal connection. The 8th only on basic units which have no integrated NC
digit of the order number must be replaced with “4”, contact.
For position of the terminals see pages 2/204 -2/208.
e. g.: 3RH2911-1NF11 -> 3RH2911-4NF11
For int. circuit diagrams see pages 2/192-2/197.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/71
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Accessories for 3RT contactors / 3RH control relays
Auxiliary switch blocks, delayed

Selection and ordering data

For Rated control Time setting Output / auxiliary Screw Spring


contactors supply voltage Us 1) range t contacts Terminals Terminals
Type V Sec Order No. Order No.

Time-delay, solid-state auxiliary switch blocks for snapping


2

onto the front according to DIN 46199-5


The electrical connection between the solid-state time-delay
Contactors and
Assemblies

auxiliary switch and the contactor underneath is established


automatically when it is snapped on and locked into place.
Sizes S00 to S3
3RA2813-1AW10 ON-delay (varistor integrated)
3RT2., 24 … 240 AC/DC 0.05 … 100 1 CO 3RA2813-1AW10 3RA2813-2AW10
3RH21 2) (1, 10, 100, 1 NO + 1 NC 3RA2813-1FW10 3RA2813-2FW10
3RH24 selectable)
OFF-delay with auxiliary voltage (varistor integrated)
24 … 240 AC/DC 0.05 … 100 1 CO 3RA28 14-1AW10 3RA28 14-2AW10
(1, 10, 100, 1 NO + 1 NC 3RA28 14-1FW10 3RA28 14-2FW10
selectable)
OFF-delay without auxiliary voltage3) (varistor integrated)
24 … 240 AC/DC 0.05 … 100 1 CO 3RA2815-1AW10 3RA2815-2AW10
(1, 10, 100, 1 NO + 1 NC 3RA2815-1FW10 3RA2815-2FW10
selectable)

Sizes S6 to S12
3RT1926-2FJ11 ON-delay (varistor integrated)
3RT10, 24 AC/DC 4) 0.05 … 1 1 NO + 1 NC 3RT19 26-2EJ11 —
3RT13, 0.5 … 10 1 NO + 1 NC 3RT19 26-2EJ21 —
3RT14, 5 … 100 1 NO + 1 NC 3RT19 26-2EJ31 —
3RT15 100 … 127 AC 4) 0.05 … 1 1 NO + 1 NC 3RT19 26-2EC11 —
0.5 … 10 1 NO + 1 NC 3RT19 26-2EC21 —
5 … 100 1 NO + 1 NC 3RT19 26-2EC31 —
4)
200 … 240 AC 0.05 … 1 1 NO + 1 NC 3RT19 26-2ED11 —
0.5 … 10 1 NO + 1 NC 3RT19 26-2ED21 —
5 … 100 1 NO + 1 NC 3RT19 26-2ED31 —
OFF-delay without auxiliary voltage 5)
24 AC/DC 4) 0.05 … 100 1 NO + 1 NC 3RT19 26-2FJ11 —
(1, 10, 100, 1 NO + 1 NC 3RT19 26-2FJ21 —
selectable) 1 NO + 1 NC 3RT19 26-2FJ31 —
100 … 127 AC 4) 0.05 … 100 1 NO + 1 NC 3RT19 26-2FK11 —
(1, 10, 100, 1 NO + 1 NC 3RT19 26-2FK21 —
selectable) 1 NO + 1 NC 3RT19 26-2FK31 —
200 … 240 AC 4) 0.05 … 100 1 NO + 1 NC 3RT19 26-2FL11 —
(1, 10, 100, 1 NO + 1 NC 3RT19 26-2FL21 —
selectable) 1 NO + 1 NC 3RT19 26-2FL31 —
WYE-delta function
24 AC/DC 4) 1.5 … 30 each have: 3RT19 26-2GJ51 —
100 … 127 AC 4) 1.5 … 30 1 NO delayed 3RT19 26-2GC51 —
200 … 240 AC 4)
1.5 … 30 1 NO instant 3RT19 26-2GD51 —
interval 50ms

For technical data, see pages 2/184-2/185. 1) AC voltage values apply for 50 Hz and 60 Hz. 4) Terminals A1 and A2 for the rated control supply
For int. circuit diagrams, see page 2/200. voltage of the solid-state time-delay auxiliary switch
2) Cannot be fitted onto coupling relays.
must be connected to the associated contactor by
For position of terminals, see page 2/208. 3) Setting of output contacts in as-supplied state not means of connecting leads.
defined (bistable relay). Application of the control
When the solid-state time-delay auxiliary switches are 5) Position of the output contacts not defined in the
supply voltage once results in contact change-over
used, no other auxiliary switches are allowed to be as-delivered state (bistable relay). Applying the con-
to the correct setting.
trol voltage once results in the contacts switching to
mounted on the basic units.
the correct position.

2/72 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Power Contactors
Accessories forfor
3RTSwitching Motors / 3RH control relays
contactors
Accessories for 3RT2 Contactors
Function modules, delay blocks
Delay and latching blocks

Selection and ordering data

2
3

3RA2812-1DW10 3RA2811-2CW10

Assemblies
Contactors and
1)
For contactors Rated control supply voltage Us Time setting range t Screw terminals Spring-type Weight
terminals
Order No. Order No.
Type V AC/D C s kg
Timing relays for mounting on 3RT2 contactors
Sizes S00 to S3
The electrical connection between the timing relay and the
contactor underneath is established automatically when it is
snapped on and locked.
ON-delay
Two-wire design, varistor integrated
3RT20.., 24 ... 240 0.05 ...100 3RA2811-1CW10 3RA2811-2CW10
3RT23.., (1, 10, 100; selectable)
3RT25..,
3RH212),
3RH24
3RT203 . 24 ... 90 0.05 ...100 3RA2831-1DG10 3RA2831-2DG10
90 ... 240 (1, 10, 100; selectable) 3RA2831-1DH10 3RA2831-2DH10
OFF-delay with control signal
Varistor integrated
3RT20.., 24 ... 240 0.05 ...100 3RA2812-1DW10 3RA2812-2DW10
3RT23.., (1, 10, 100; selectable)
3RT25..,
3RH212),
3RH24
3RT203 . 24 ... 90 0.05 ...100 3RA2832-1DG10 3RA2832-2DG10
90 ... 240 (1, 10, 100; selectable) 3RA2832-1DH10 3RA2832-2DH10
1)
AC voltage values apply for 50 Hz and 60 Hz.
2)
Cannot be fitted onto coupling relays.

For contactors Rated control supply Time setting range t Screw terminals Weight
voltage Us
Order No.
Type V s kg
OFF-delay devices
Sizes S00 to S2
For contactors with DC operation
Non-adjustable delay time
3RT201. -1BF4., 110 AC/DC S00: > 0,1 3RT2916-2BK01
3RT202. -1BF4., S0: > 0,08
3RT203. -1NF3., 110 DC S2: > 0,25
3RH2. . . -1BF40
3RT201. -1BM4./1BP4. , 220/230 AC/DC S00: > 0,5 3RT2916-2BL01
3RT202. -1BM4./1BP4. , S0: > 0,3
3RT203. -1NP3., 220/230 DC S2: > 0,8
3RH2. . . -1BM40/1BP40
3RT201.-1BB4., 24 DC S00: > 0,2 3RT2916-2BE01
3RT2916-2B.01 3RT202.-1BB4., S0: > 0,1
3RT203.-1NB3., S2: > 0,1
3RH2.. .-1BB40
Mechanical latching blocks
Size S0
For snapping onto the front of contactors
The contactor remains in the energized state
after a voltage failure
3RT202 . 24 AC/DC -- 3RT2926-3AB31
110 AC/DC -- 3RT2926-3AF31
For description, see page 2/121. 1) AC voltage ratings apply for 50 and 60 Hz.
230 AC/DC -- 3RT2926-3AP31
For technical data, see page 2/184. 2) The 3RA28 time-delay blocks are available
For circuit diagrams, see page 2/200. with spring-type terminals. Replace the 8th
digit of the order number with a “2”.
3RT2926-3A.31
3) Cannot be fitted onto coupling relays
For technical specifications, see page 3/54.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/73
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
3/70 Siemens IC 10 · 2015 Illustrations are approximate
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Accessories for 3RT contactors / 3RH control relays
Function modules, delay blocks, and mechanical latching blocks

Selection and ordering data

For Rated control Time setting Screw Weight


contactors supply voltage Us 1) range t Terminals 2) approx.
Type V sec Order No. kg
Off-delay device
2

3RT2916-2B.01 Sizes S00 to S2


For contactors with DC operation. Non-adjustable delay time
Contactors and
Assemblies

3RT2., 110 AC/DC S00: > 0.1 3RT2916-2BK01 0.150


3RH2. . .-1BF40 S0: > 0.08; S2: > 0.25
3RT2., 220 ... 230 AC/DC S00: > 0.5 3RT2916-2BL01 0.150
3RH2. . .-1BM40 S0: > 0.3; S2: > 0.8
3RT2., 24 DC S00: > 0.2 3RT2916-2BE01 0.150
3RT2916-2BE01 3RH2. . .-1BB40 S0: > 0.1; S2: > 0.1
Sizes S3
3RT2. 4 24 DC S3: 70 fixed 3RT2916-2BE01 0.093

Pneumatic delay blocks, terminal designation according to EN 50005 4)


3RT2926-2PA01 Size S0
For snapping onto the front of contactors 5) Auxiliary contacts 1 NO and 1 NC
With ON-delay — 0.1 ... 30 3RT2926-2PA01 0.080
3RT2. 2 1 ... 60 3RT2926-2PA11 0.080
With OFF-delay — 0.1 ... 30 3RT2926-2PR01 0.080
3RT2. 2 1 ... 60 3RT2926-2PR11 0.080

Mechanical latching blocks


For mounting onto the front of contactors
3RT2926-3AB31 The contactor remains in the energized state even after voltage failure
Size S0
24 AC/DC — 3RT2926-3AB31 0.100
3RT2. 2 110 AC/DC — 3RT2926-3AF31 0.100
230 AC/DC — 3RT2926-3AP31 0.100

For description, see page 2/121. 1) AC voltage ratings apply for 50 and 60 Hz. 4) Versions according to DIN VDE 0116
For technical data, see page 2/184. on request.
2) The 3RA28 time-delay blocks are available
For circuit diagrams, see page 2/200. with spring-type terminals. Replace the 8th 5) In addition to these, no other auxiliary
digit of the order number with a “2”. contacts are permitted.
3) Cannot be fitted onto coupling relays

2/74 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Power
Accessories for 3RT contactors / 3RH control Contactors for Switching Motors
relays
Accessories for 3RT2 Contactors
Surge suppressors
Surge suppressors

Selection and ordering data


For Version Rated control supply voltage Us1) Order No. Weight
contactors
AC operation DC operation
Type V AC V DC kg
Surge suppressors without LED (also for spring-type terminals)

2
Size S00

3
For plugging onto the front side of the contactors

Assemblies
Contactors and
(with and without auxiliary switch block)
3RT2.1, Varistors 24 ... 48 24 ... 70 3RT2916-1BB00
3RH2. 48 ... 127 70 ... 150 3RT2916-1BC00
127 ... 240 150 ... 250 3RT2916-1BD00
240 ... 400 -- 3RT2916-1BE00
400 ... 600 -- 3RT2916-1BF00
3RT2.1, RC elements 24 ... 48 24 ... 70 3RT2916-1CB00
3RH2. 48 ... 127 70 ... 150 3RT2916-1CC00
3RT2916-1B.00 127 ... 240 150 ... 250 3RT2916-1CD00
240 ... 400 -- 3RT2916-1CE00
400 ... 600 -- 3RT2916-1CF00
3RT2.1, Noise suppression diodes -- 12 ... 250 3RT2916-1DG00
3RH2.
3RT2.1, Diode assemblies -- 12 ... 250 3RT2916-1EH00
3RH2. (diode and Zener diode) for
DC operation
Size S0
For plugging onto the front side of the contactors
(prior to mounting of the auxiliary switch block)
3RT2.2 Varistors 2) 24 ... 48 24 ... 70 3RT2926-1BB00
48 ... 127 70 ... 150 3RT2926-1BC00
127 ... 240 150 ... 250 3RT2926-1BD00
240 ... 400 -- 3RT2926-1BE00
400 ... 600 -- 3RT2926-1BF00
3RT2.2 RC elements 24 ... 48 24 ... 70 3RT2926-1CB00
3RT2926-1E.00 48 ... 127 70 ... 150 3RT2926-1CC00
127 ... 240 150 ... 250 3RT2926-1CD00
240 ... 400 -- 3RT2926-1CE00
400 ... 600 -- 3RT2926-1CF00
3RT2.2 Diode assembly -- 24 3RT2926-1ER00
for DC operation -- 30 ... 250 3RT2926-1ES00
Size S2 and S3
For plugging onto the front side of the contactors
(prior to mounting of the auxiliary switch block)
3RT2.3. Varistors 2)3) 24 ... 48 24 ... 70 3RT2936-1BB00
3RT2.4. 48 ... 127 70 ... 150 3RT2936-1BC00
127 ... 240 150 ... 250 3RT2936-1BD00
240 ... 400 -- 3RT2936-1BE00
400 ... 600 -- 3RT2936-1BF00
3RT2936-1B.00
3RT2.3. RC elements 24 ... 48 24 ... 70 3RT2936-1CB00
48 ... 127 70 ... 150 3RT2936-1CC00
127 ... 240 150 ... 250 3RT2936-1CD00
240 ... 400 -- 3RT2936-1CE00
400 ... 600 -- 3RT2936-1CF00
3RT2.3. Diode assembly 3) -- 24 3RT2936-1ER00
3RT2.4. for DC operation -- 30 ... 250 3RT2936-1ES00

3RT2936-1E.00
Size S3
For plugging into the two recesses on the left next to the
connection block for auxiliary switches and coils A1 and
A2. The connecting cables are wired to A1 and A2.
3RT2.4 RC elements 24 ... 48 24 ... 70 3RT2946-1CB00
48 ... 127 70 ... 150 3RT2946-1CC00
127 ... 240 150 ... 250 3RT2946-1CD00
240 ... 400 -- 3RT2946-1CE00
400 ... 600 -- 3RT2946-1CF00

1)
Can be used for AC operation for 50/60 Hz. Please inquire about other voltages.
2)
The varistor is already integrated into the AC/DC contactors.
3RT2946-1C.00 3)
Surge suppressors 3RT2936-1B/1E (version E03) can be used in 3RT2.4 contactors.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/75
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2015 3/71
IC10_03_05.fm Page 103 Tuesday, September 1, 2020 3:26 PM

Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS


Accessories for 3RT contactors / 3RH control relays
Switching
Surge suppressors Devices – Contactors and Contactor Assemblies – for Switching Motors
Power Contactors for Switching Motors
Selection and ordering data
Accessories for SIRIUS 3RT contactors and SIRIUS 3RH2 contactor relays > Surge suppressors

For Version Rated control supply voltage Us1) SD Article No. Price PU PS*
contactors AC operation DC operation per PU (UNIT,
SET, M)
Type V AC V DC d
2

Surge suppressors without LED


Sizes S6 to S12
Contactors and
Assemblies

For connecting to withdrawable coil for contactors with Screw terminals


• Standard operating mechanisms 3RT1...-.A...
• Solid-state operating mechanisms 3RT1...-.N...

3
3RT1.5 ... RC elements 24 ... 48 24 ... 70 } 3RT1956-1CB00 1 1 unit
3RT1.7 48 ... 127 70 ... 150 } 3RT1956-1CC00 1 1 unit
127 ... 240 150 ... 250 } 3RT1956-1CD00 1 1 unit
240 ... 400 -- } 3RT1956-1CE00 1 1 unit
400 ... 600 20 3RT1956-1CF00 1 1 unit
3RT1956-1C.00
Spring-loaded terminals

3RT1.5 ... RC elements 24 ... 48 24 ... 70 } 3RT1956-1CB02 1 1 unit


3RT1.7 48 ... 127 70 ... 150 2 3RT1956-1CC02 1 1 unit
127 ... 240 150 ... 250 } 3RT1956-1CD02 1 1 unit
240 ... 400 -- 2 3RT1956-1CE02 1 1 unit
400 ... 600 20 3RT1956-1CF02 1 1 unit
3RT1956-1C.02
1)
Can be used for AC operation for 50/60 Hz. Other voltages on request.

For con- Version Rated control supply Power con- SD Article No. Price PU PS* PG
tactors voltage Us1) sumption
Rated controlP supply per PU (UNIT,
of LED SET, M)
For AC DC voltage Us 1) Weight
contactors Version operation operation ACatoperation
Us
DC operation approx.
Order No.
TType
yp e V AC V DC m
V AC W d DC
V mW kg
Surge suppressors with LED (also for spring-loaded terminals)
Surge suppressors with LED (also for spring-type terminals)
Size S00
3RT2916-1J.00 Size S00 For For plugging onto the front side of the contactors
plugging onto the front of the contactors
(with and without auxiliary switch block)
(with or without auxiliary switches)
3RT2.1, Varistor 24 … 48 12 … 24 10 … 120 3RT2916-1JJ00 0.010
3RT2.1,
3RH2. Varistors 24 ... 48 12 ... 24 48 …127
10 ... 120 } … 3RT2916-1JJ00
24 70 20 … 470 1
3RT2916-1JK00 1 unit
0.010 41B
3RH2 48 ... 127 24 ... 70 12720… ...
240470 } … 3RT2916-1JK00
70 150 50 … 700 1
3RT2916-1JL00 1 unit
0.010 41B
127 ... 240 70 ... 150 50 ... 700 } 3RT2916-1JL00 1 1 unit 41B
-- —
150 ... 250 160 ... 950 150
2 ...3RT2916-1JP00
250 160 … 950 3RT2916-1JP00
1 0.010
1 unit 41B
3RT2.1,
3RT2.1, Noise
Noise -- 24 ... 70 — 20 ... 470 } … 3RT2916-1LM00
24 70 20 … 470 1
3RT2916-1LM00 1 unit
0.010 41B
3RH2
3RH2. suppression
suppression-- 50 ... 150 — 50 ... 700 2 … 3RT2916-1LN00
50 150 50 … 700 1
3RT2916-1LN00 1 unit
0.010 41B
3RT2916-1J.00 diodes
diode -- 150 ... 250 — 160 ... 950 } …3RT2916-1LP00
150 250 160 … 950 1
3RT2916-1LP00 1 unit
0.010 41B
Size S0
3RT2926-1MR00 Size S0 For For
plugging intoonto
plugging the front of the
the front contactors
side of the contactors
(before mounting
(prior the auxiliary
to mounting switch)switch block)
of the auxiliary
3RT2.2
3RT2.2 Varistors
Varistor 24 ... 48 12 ... 24 24 …1048 } … 3RT2926-1JJ00
... 120 12 24 10 … 120 3RT2926-1JJ00
1 0.010
1 unit 41B
48 ... 127 24 ... 70 48 …127 } … 3RT2926-1JK00
20 ... 470 24 70 20 … 470 1
3RT2926-1JK00 1 unit
0.010 41B
127 ... 240 70 ... 150 12750
… ...
240 } … 3RT2926-1JL00
700 70 150 50 … 700 1
3RT2926-1JL00 1 unit
0.010 41B
3RT2.2 Diode -- 24 20 ... 470 } 3RT2926-1MR00 1 1 unit 41B
3RT2.2 Diode
assemblies — 24 20 … 470 3RT2926-1MR00 0.010
assembly
3RT2926-1MR00
Sizes S2 and S3
For plugging into the front of the contactors
3RT2936-1J.00 Size S2 (before
For plugging
mountingonto the frontswitch)
the auxiliary side of the contactors
(prior2)to mounting of the auxiliary switch block)
and S3 Varistors
3RT2.3, 24 ... 48 12 ... 24 10 ... 120 5 3RT2936-1JJ00 1 1 unit 41B
3RT2.3,
3RT2.4 Varistor 2) 48 ... 127 24 ... 70 24 …2048
... 470 12
5 … 3RT2936-1JK00
24 10 … 120 3RT2936-1JJ00
1 0.010
1 unit 41B
3RT2.4 127 ... 240 70 ... 150 48 …127
50 ... 700 24
} … 3RT2936-1JL00
70 20 … 470 3RT2936-1JK00
1 0.010
1 unit 41B
127 … 240 70 … 150 50 … 700 3RT2936-1JL00 0.010

3RT2936-1JJ00
1)
Can be used for AC operation for 50/60 Hz. Other voltages on request.
2) 1) Can be used for AC operations for 50/60 Hz. 2. 3RT2936 (version E03) surge suppressors can be
From product version E03 onwards, 3RT2936 surge suppressors can be used for 3RT2.4 contactors.
Other voltages on request.
used for 3RT2.4 contactors.

2/76 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Accessories for 3RT contactors / 3RH control relays
Surge suppressors, terminals, labels

Selection and ordering data

For Weight
contactors Version Order No. approx.
Units kg
Main conducting path surge suppression module for 3RT12 vacuum contactors

2
Sizes S10 For damping overvoltages and protecting the motor windings against
and S12 multiple reignition when switching off three-phase motors.
3RT12 For connection on the contactor feeder side (2-T1/4-T2/6-T3).

Assemblies
Contactors and
For separate installation.
Rated operational voltage Ue ≥ 500 V AC ... ≤ 690 V AC 3RT1966-1PV3 0.18
Rated operational voltage Ue ≤ 1000 V AC 3RT1966-1PV4 0.36

Auxiliary conductor terminal, 3-pole


3RT2946-4F
Size S3
3RT204. For connecting auxiliary and control leads to the main 3RT2946-4F
conductor terminals (for one side).

Blank Labels
3RT29 00- 1SB20
Unit labeling plates
20 mm x 7 mm, pastel 340 units 3RT2900-1SB20 0.200
PC labeling system for individual inscription
of unitlabeling plates available from:
murrplastik Systems, Inc.
10 mm x 7 mm 816 units 3RT2900-1SB10 0.294
IC01_00181

Links for paralleling

3RT1916-4BB31 3RT1916-4BB41 3RT1936-4BB31 3RT1956-4BA31

Standard
For Maximum resistive current Ie/AC-1 Max. conductor Screw package Weight
Size contactors (at 60 °C) of contactors cross sections Terminals quantity approx.
Type A kg
Order No.
S00 3RT201. 3-pole, with terminal 1), 2) 4 AWG, stranded 3RT1916-4BB31 0.015
S0 3RT202. 0 AWG, stranded 3RT2926-4BB31 0.042
S2 3RT203. 95 mm2 3RT1936-4BB31 0.139

S3 3RT204. 3-pole, with through hole 185 mm2 3RT1946-4BB31 0.205


S6 3RT1. 5 (WYE jumpers) 1), 2) — 3RT1956-4BA31 0.159
S10/S12 3RT1. 6 — 3RT1966-4BA31 0.541
3RT1. 7
S00 3RT231. 4-pole, with terminal 1), 2) 4 AWG, stranded 3RT1916-4BB41 0.016
3RT251.

1) Can be used for AC operation for 50/60 Hz.


Please inquire about further voltages.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/77


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Power
Accessories for 3RT contactors / 3RH control Contactors for Switching Motors
relays
Accessories for 3RT2 Contactors
Other function blocks, PLC control, load modules, control kit
Other function blocks

Selection and ordering data


For contactors Version Order No. Weight
Type
EMC suppression modules; 3-phase, up to 10 HP
Size S00 (for contactors with AC or DC operation)
Screw terminals
2

3RT201 RC elements (3 x 220 Ω /0.22 µF)

3
Contactors and
Assemblies

Up to 400 V 3RT2916-1PA1
Up to 575 V 3RT2916-1PA2
Up to 690 V 3RT2916-1PA3
3RT201 Varistors
Up to 400 V 3RT2916-1PB1
Up to 575 V 3RT2916-1PB2
3RT2916-1PA. Up to 690 V 3RT2916-1PB3
Coupling links for control by PLC
Size S0
3RT2. 2 For mounting onto the coil terminals of the contactors 3RH2924-1GP11
(only for contactors with screw terminals)
With LED for indicating switching state.
With integrated varistor for damping opening surges.
24 V DC control,
17 ... 30 V DC operating range

3RH2924-1GP11
Sizes S00 to S3
3RT2.1, For mounting on the front side of contactors
3RT2.2, with AC, DC or AC/DC operation
3RT2.3 24 V DC control, 3RH2914-1GP11
17 ... 30 V DC operating range
Spring-type terminals

24 V DC control, 3RH2914-2GP11
3RH2914-1GP11 17 ... 30 V DC operating range
Additional load modules
Size S00
3RT2.1, For plugging onto the front side of the contactors with or 3RT2916-1GA00
3RH2. without auxiliary switch blocks
For increasing the permissible residual current and for limiting
the residual voltage. It ensures the safe opening of contactors
with direct control via 230 V AC semiconductor outputs of
SIMATIC controllers. It acts simultaneously as a surge
suppressor.
Rated voltage:
50/60 Hz, 180 to 255 V AC
3RT2916-1GA00
LED module for indicating contactor operation
Sizes S00 to S3
3RT2.. For snapping into the location hole of an inscription label 3RT2926-1QT00
on the front of a contactor
either directly on the contactor or on the front auxiliary switch.
The LED module is connected to coil terminals A1 and A2 of
the contactor and indicates its energized state.
Yellow LED.
Rated voltage:
24 ... 240 V AC/DC, with reverse polarity protection.
3RT2926-1QT00
Control kit
Sizes S00 to S3
For manual operation of the contactor contacts
for start-up and service
3RT2.1, 3RT2916-4MC00
3RH2.
3RT2.2 3RT2926-4MC00
3RT2916-4MC00 3RT2. 3 3RT2936-4MC00

2/78 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Product Category IEC
Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2015 3/73
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Power Contactors
Accessories forfor
3RTSwitching Motors / 3RH control relays
contactors
Accessories for 3RT2 Contactors
Terminals, covers, adapters, connectors
Terminals, covers, adapters, connectors

Selection and ordering data


For contactors Version Order No. Weight
Type
Sealable covers
Sizes S00 to S3
3RT2.1, Sealable covers 3RT2916-4MA10

2
3RT2.2, for preventing manual operation
3RT2.3,
3

(Not suitable for coupling relays)


3RT2.4,

Assemblies
Contactors and
3RH2.1)

3RT2916-4MA10
Connection modules for contactors with screw terminals
Sizes S00 and S0
Adapters for contactors Screw terminals
Ambient temperature Tu max = 60 °C
3RT2 .1, Size S00, 3RT1916-4RD01
3RH2. rated operational current Ie at
AC-3/400 V: 20 A
3RT2. 2 Size S0, 3RT1926-4RD01
3RT1926-4RD01
rated operational current Ie at
AC-3/400 V: 25 A
3RT2 .1, Plugs for contactors 3RT1900-4RE01
3RT2.2, Size S00, S0
3RH2.

3RT1900-4RE01
Terminal covers for contactors with box terminals
Size S2
Covers for box terminals
3RT203 For 3-pole contactors 3RT2936-4EA2
3RT233, For 4-pole contactors (see Chapter 4) 3RT2936-4EA4
3RT253
3RT2936-4EA2
Coil connection modules
Sizes S0 and S2
3RT2.2, Connection from top 3RT2926-4RA11
3RT2.3 Connection from below 3RT2926-4RB11
Connection diagonally 3RT2926-4RC11

3RT2926-4RA11
Spring-type terminals

3RT2.2 Connection from top 3RT2926-4RA12


Connection from below 3RT2926-4RB12

3RT2926-4RA12
Covers for contactors with ring cable lug connections
Size S00
Ring terminal lug connec-
tions
3RT2.1, Covers for ring terminal lug connections 3RT2916-4EA13
3RH2 Single covers

3RT2916-4EA13
Size S0
3RT2. 2 Covers for ring terminal lug connections 3RT2926-4EB13
Set for one device,
comprising 4 single covers:
- 2 x 3RT2926-4EB13
3RT2926-4EB13 - 2 x 3RV2928-4AA00

Technical specifications for connection modules, see page 3/56.


1)
Exception:
1) Exception: contactors
contactors and contactor
and contactor relays
relays with with
auxiliary auxiliary
switch block switch block
mounted
mounted ontoonto the front.
the front.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry* Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/79
You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
3/74 Siemens IC 10 · 2015 Illustrations are approximate
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Power
Accessories for 3RT contactors / 3RH control Contactors for Switching Motors
relays
Accessories for 3RT2 Contactors
Terminals, covers, adapters, connectors
Terminals, covers, adapters, connectors

For contactors Version Order No. Weight


Type
Screw adapters for fixing the contactors
Sizes S0 and S2
3RT2.2, Screw adapters for easier screw fixing 3RT1926-4P
3RT2.3 2 units required per contactor
2

(1 pack contains 10 sets for 10 contactors)


NSB0_01470

3RT1926-4P

3
Contactors and
Assemblies

Solder pin adapters for contactors up to 7.5 HP / 12 A


Size S00, up to 7.5 HP
Screw terminals

3RT2.1, Assembly kit for soldering contactors onto a printed cir- 3RT1916-4KA1
3RH21 cuit board.
For 1 contactor, 1 set is required.

3RT1916-4KA1
Solder pin adapters for contactors up to 7.5 HP / 12 A
with mounted 4-pole auxiliary switch block
Size S00, up to 7.5 HP
3RT2.1, Assembly kit for soldering contactors with an auxiliary 3RT1916-4KA2
3RH21 switch block onto a printed circuit board.
For 1 contactor, 1 set is required.

3RT1916-4KA2
Safety main current connectors for 2 contactors
Sizes S00 to S2
For series connection of 2 contactors
3RT2 .1 3RA2916-1A
3RT2. 2 3RA2926-1A
3RT2.3 3RA2936-1A

3RA2926-1A

1) Exception: contactors and contactor relays with auxiliary switch block


mounted onto the front.

2/80 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Product Category IEC
Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2015 3/75
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Accessories for 3RT contactors / 3RH control relays
Terminals, covers, accessories

Selection and ordering data

For Design Order No. Weight


contactors approx.
Size Type kg.
Box terminal block for contactors with screw connections
3RT19 5. -4G For circular conductors and ribbon cables For connect-

2
able cross-sections, see technical data of contactors,
page 2/99

Assemblies
Contactors and
S3 3RT20 4 10 AWG (solid), 0 AWG (stranded) / 2.5 to 70 mm2 3RT29 46-4G
S6 3RT1. 5 up to 70 mm2 / 2/0 AWG 3RT19 55-4G 0.23
(3RB205) up to 120 mm2 / 4/0 AWG 3RT19 56-4G 0.26
S10, 3RT1. 6, 240 mm2 - 500 mm2 / 500 MCM - 750 MCM 3RT19 66-4G 0.64
S12 3RT1. 7 with auxiliary conductor connection
(3RB206)

Covers for contactors with screw connections


3RT29 36-4EA2 Terminal cover for box terminals
S2 3RT20 3 Additional shock-hazard protection for mounting on the 3RT29 36-4EA2 0.012
box terminals
(2 units required per contactor)
S3 3RT20 4 3RT19 46-4EA2

S6 3RT1 . 5 Length: 25 mm 3RT19 56-4EA2 0.016


S10, 3RT1 . 6, Length: 30 mm 3RT19 66-4EA2
S12 3RT1 . 7
Terminal cover for cable lug and busbar connection
3RT19 46-4EA1 S3 3RT20 4 For complying with the phase clearances and as 3RT19 46-4EA1 0.028
3RT24 4 shock-hazard protection in the case of a distant box
terminal 1)
(2 units required per contactor)
S6 3RT1 . 5 Length: 100 mm 3RT19 56-4EA1 0.05
S10, 3RT1 . 6, Length: 120 mm 3RT19 66-4EA1
S12 3RT1 . 7
For covering bars between the contactor and
3RB20 overload relay
or wiring connector for contactor assemblies
S6 3RT1 . 5 Length: 27 mm 3RT19 56-4EA3 0.018
S10, 3RT1 . 6, Length: 42 mm 3RT19 66-4EA3
S12 3RT1 . 7

Weight
Design Order No. Package approx.
quantity kg
Insulation stop for securely holding back the conductor insulation
on conductors up to 1 mm2 (17 AWG)
3RT1916-4JA02
Insulation stop strips can be inserted in cable entry of the spring terminal
(2 strips per contactor required)
• For basic devices S00 (3RT201. or 3RH2. ), removable individually 3RT2916-4JA02 20 strips 0.005

• For auxiliary and control circuit on basic devices size S0 and S2 (3RT2.2., 3RT1916-4JA02 20 strips 0.010
3RT2.3.) and for mountable 3RH29 auxiliary switches, removable in pairs

Tool for opening spring-type terminals


3RA2908-1A Screwdriver
for all SIRIUS devices with spring-type terminals 3RA2908-1A 1 unit 0.045
Length: approx. 200 mm,
3.0 mm x 0.5 mm,
titanium gray//black, partially insulated

1) Refer to the note on page 2/144, conductor cross-sections.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/81
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactor Assemblies for Switching Motors
3RA13, 3RA23 reversing contactor assemblies

Accessories

For Size Design Order No. Weight


contactors approx.
Type kg
Mechanical interlocks
3RA19 24-2B S2 laterally mountable for 3RT2 S2 contactors only.
2

3RT2.3 3RA2934-2B 0.04


There are no NC auxiliary contacts. Use the integrated NC
auxiliary on the contactor.
Contactors and
Assemblies

3RT204, S3 1) laterally mountable each with one auxiliary contact 3RA2934-2B 0.05
3RT234, (1 NC) per contactor (can only couple contactors of max.
3RT245 1 level different size. The mounting depth of the smaller
contactor has to be adapted.)
Interlock width: 10 mm

3RA19 54-2G
3RT204 S3 adapter to mechanically interlock a 3RT204 with a 3RT105 3RA1954-2G
to to
3RT105 S6 includes the adapter and QTY 2 - 3RA1942-2G mechanical
connectors

requires the 3RA1954 - 2A to be ordered separately

Note:
Fits 3RT104 AC coil versions only.
Does not fit 3RT104 DC coil versions.
3RA19 54-2A
3RT1. 5 S6, laterally mountable without auxiliary contacts; 3RA1954-2A 0.02
to S10, size S6, S10 and S12 contactors
3RT1. 7 S12 can be interlocked with each other as required;
no adaptation of mounting depth is necessary.
Contactor clearance 10 mm.

Baseplates 1 unit

3RA1972-2A 3RT10 5 S6 for customer mounting of contactor assemblies 3RA1952-2A 1.3


for reversing
3RT1. 6 S10 3RA1962-2A 2.4
3RT1. 7 S12 3RA1972-2A 2.6

1) Can also be used for size S3 4-pole contactors.

2/82 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactor Assemblies for Switching Motors
3RA13, 3RA23 reversing contactor assemblies

Accessories

For Screw Spring Pkg.


contactors Size Details Terminals Terminals qty.
Type Order No. Order No.

Assembly kits for making 3-pole contactor assemblies

2
3RA2913-2AA1 3RT201 S00 The assembly kit contains:
Mechanical interlock,

Assemblies
Contactors and
2 connecting clips for 2 contactors,
Wiring modules on the top and
bottom
• For main, auxiliary and control 3RA2913-2AA1 3RA2913-2AA2 1 kit
circuits

3RA2923-2AA2 3RT202 S0 The assembly kit contains:


Mechanical interlock,
2 connecting clips for 2 contactors,
Wiring modules on the top and
bottom
• For main, auxiliary and control 3RA2923-2AA1 ­— 1 kit
circuits 1)
• Only for main circuit 2) ­— 3RA2923-2AA2 1 kit

3RA2933-2AA1 3RT203 S2 The installation kit contains:


2 connecting clips for 2 contactors,
Wiring modules on the top and
bottom 3RA2933-2AA1 — 1 kit

• Only for main circuit 3) — 3RA2933-2AA2 1 kit

3RA2943-2AA1 3RT204 S3 The installation kit contains:


2 connecting clips for 2 contactors,
Wiring modules on the top and
bottom and the mechanical interlock 3RA2943-2AA1 —

3RA19 53-2A 3RT105 S6 The installation kit contains:


Wiring modules on the top and bottom
(for connection with box terminal)

3RA19 53-2A — 1 kit

3RT105 S6 The installation kit contains: 3RA1953-2M 1 kit


3RT1. 6 S10 Wiring modules on the top and bottom 3RA1963-2A
3RT1. 7 S12 (for connection without box terminals) 3RA1973-2A

1) Use of the 3RA2923-2AA1 assembly kit in conjunction with the 2) Version in size S0 with spring-type terminals: Only the 3) Version in size S2 with spring-type terminals in the
3RT202.-.....-3MA0 contactors is limited because the auxiliary wiring modules for the main circuit are included. No con- auxiliary and control circuits: Only the wiring mod-
switches in the basic unit are not allowed to be used on account nectors are included for the auxiliary and control circuit. ules for the main circuit are included. A cable set is
of the permanently mounted auxiliary switch block. included for the auxiliary circuit.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/83
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactor Assemblies for Switching Motors
3RA13, 3RA23 reversing contactor assemblies

Accessories

Contactor
For gap for Screw Spring Pkg.
contactors Size interlock Version Terminals Terminals qty.
Type Order No. Order No.

Wiring modules
2

3RA2913-3DA1 3RT201 S00- 0 mm Top (in-phase) 3RA2913-3DA1 3RA2913-3DA2 1


S00 Bottom (phase reversal) 3RA2913-3EA1 3RA2913-3EA2 1
Contactors and
Assemblies

3RT202 S0- 0 mm Top (in-phase) 3RA2923-3DA1 3RA2923-3DA2 1


S0 Bottom (phase reversal) 3RA2923-3EA1 3RA2923-3EA2 1

3RA2913-3EA1 3RT203 S2- 10 mm Top (in-phase) 3RA1933-3D 3RA1933-3D 1


S2 Bottom (phase reversal) 3RA1933-3E 3RA1933-3E 1

3RT204 S3- 10 mm Top (in-phase) 3RA1943-3D 3RA1943-3D 1


S3 Bottom (phase reversal) 3RA1943-3E 3RA1943-3E 1
3RA1953-3D 3RT105 S6- 10 mm Top (in-phase, for connection 3RA1953-3D 3RA1953-3D 1
S6 with box terminal)

3RA1953-3P Top (with phase reversal, 3RA1953-3P 3RA1953-3P 1


for connection without box
terminal)

Contactor
For gap for Pkg.
contactors Size interlock Interlock Type Version Order No. qty.
Type
Mechanical connectors1)
3RA29. 2-2H 3RT201 S00- 0 mm Laterally For 3-pole contactors and 3RA2912-2H 1 set
S00 mountable 4-pole contactors

3RT202 S0- 0 mm Laterally For 3-pole contactors and 3RA2922-2H 1 set


S0 mountable 4-pole contactors

3RA2932-2C 3RT203 S2- 0 mm Laterally For 3-pole contactors 3RA2932-2C 5 sets


S2 mountable
10 mm Laterally For 3-pole contactors 3RA2932-2D 5 sets
mountable
3RA2932-2D 3RT233 Laterally For 4-pole contactors 3RA2932-2G 5 sets
mountable
3RT2. 4 S3- 0 mm Mountable For 3-pole contactors 3RA2932-2C 10 sets
S3 on front

3RA2932-2G 10 mm Laterally For 3-pole contactors 3RA2932-2D 10 sets


mountable
For 4-pole contactors 3RA2942-2G 10 sets

3RA1942-2G 3RT1. 5 S6- 10 mm Laterally Top (with phase reversal, 3RA1932-2D 10 sets
S6 mountable for connection without box
terminal)

Note: Standard package quantities may change. 1) 1 set for 1 contactor. Size S00 & S0: 1 set includes 2 connectors
Check Industry Mall for current package quantities. and 1 interlock. Size S2: The mechanical interlock must be
ordered separately. S3-S6: 1 set includes 2 connectors; one
connector for top and one connector for bottom.

2/84 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactor Assemblies for Switching Motors
WYE-delta accessories

Accessories
Design Sizes Order No. Weight
approx.
kg
Installation kits 1) 2)
The installation kit contains:
Mechanical interlock, 4 connecting clips, S00-S00-S00 3RA2913-2BB1 1 set 0.05

2
WYE jumper, Wiring connectors on the top and
bottom,- For main, auxiliary, and control circuits 3)

Assemblies
Contactors and
The installation kit contains:
mechanical interlock, 4 connecting clips, S0-S0-S0 3RA2923-2BB1 1 set 0.10
WYE jumper, wiring connectors on the top
3RA19 53-2B 1 set
and bottom - For main, auxiliary, and S2-S2-S0 3RA2933-2C 0.16
control circuits 3) S2-S2-S2 3RA2933-2BB1 0.16

The installation kit contains: S3-S3-S2 3RA2943-2C 0.33


WYE jumper on the top
S3-S3-S3 3RA2943-2BB1 0.16
Wiring jumper on the bottom
S6-S6-S6 3RA1953-2B 0.85
(The wiring connector on the top is not
included in the scope of supply. A S6-S6-S6 3RA1953-2N 0.60
3RA19 53-2N, 3RA19 63- double infeed between the line contactor S10-S10-S10 3RA1963-2B 1.80
2B, 3RA19 73-2B and the delta contactor is recommended.) S12-S12-S12 3RA1973-2B 2.20
3-phase feeder terminal
Feeder terminal block for the line contactor for large 1 unit
conductor cross-sections
Conductor cross-section: 6 mm2, 10 AWG S00 3RA2913-3K 0.02
Conductor cross-section: 16 mm2, 6 AWG S0 3RV2925-5AB 0.04
Conductor cross-section: 70 mm , 2/0 AWG
2 S2 3RV2935-5A 0.10
1-phase feeder terminals
Conductor cross-section: 95 mm2 S3 3RA2943-3L 0.280
3-phase busbar
For in-phase bridging of all input terminals of the 1 unit
line contactor (K1) S0 3RV1915-1AB 0.03
and the delta contactor (K3) S2 3RV2935-5E 0.15
Link for paralleling, 3-pole (WYE jumpers)
3RT19 26-4BA31 Without terminal (the links for paralleling can be S001) 3RT1916-4BA31 1 unit 0.010
reduced by one pole) S01) 3RT1926-4BA31 0.020
S2 3RT1936-4BA31 0.02
S3 3RT1946-4BA31 0.02
S6 4) 3RT1956-4BA31 0.15
S10, S12 4) 3RT1966-4BA31
Baseplates
For customer assembly of WYE-delta contactor 1 unit
assemblies with a laterally mounted time-delay

Side-by-side mounting S2 S2 S0 3RA2932-2F 0.45

10 mm clearance between K3 and K2 S2 S2 S2 3RA2932-2F 0.48

Side-by-side mounting S3 S3 S2 3RA2942-2F 0.72

Side-by-side mounting S3 S3 S3 3RA2942-2F 0.72

10 mm clearance between K1, K3 and K2 S. S. S. 1 unit


S6 S6 S3 3RA1952-2E 2.0
S6 S6 S6 3RA1952-2F 2.1
S10 S10 S6 3RA1962-2E
S10 S10 S10 3RA1962-2F
S12 S12 S10 3RA1972-2E
S12 S12 S12 3RA1972-2F

1) Size S00, S0 and S2 installation kits for paralleling are available in spring-type terminals. 3) Also requires quantity (1) 3RA2816-0EW20 function module set for all control functions.
Change the last digit of the order number to a “2”. See page 2/47.
2) When using the function modules for wye-delta starting, the wiring modules for the 4) The 3RT19 56-4EA1 (S6) or 3RT19 66-4EA1 (S10, S12) cover can be used for
auxiliary current are not required. See page 2/47 for more information. shock-hazard protection.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/85


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactor Assemblies for Switching Motors Relays
SIRIUS 3RR21, 3RR22 Monitoring Relays for Mounting onto 3RT2 Contactors
Current Monitoring Relays
Current and active current monitoring

Overview Benefits
• Can be mounted directly on 3RT2 contactors and
3RA23 reversing contactor assemblies, in other words,
there is no need for additional wiring in the main circuit
• Optimally coordinated with the technical characteristics of the
3RT2 contactors
2

• No separate current transformer required


• Versions with wide voltage supply range
Contactors and
Assemblies

• Variably adjustable to overshoot, undershoot or range


monitoring
• Freely configurable delay times and RESET response
• Display of ACTUAL value and status messages
• All versions with removable control current terminals
• All versions with screw terminals or spring-type terminals
• Simple determination of the threshold values through direct
reference to actually measured values for setpoint loading
• Range monitoring and selectable active current measurement
SIRIUS 3RR2242, 3RR2142 and 3RR2243 current monitoring relays mean that only one device for monitoring a motor is required
along the entire torque curve
The SIRIUS 3RR2 current monitoring relays are suitable for the • In addition to current monitoring it is also possible to monitor
load monitoring of motors or other loads. In two or three phases for broken cables, phase failure, phase sequence, residual
they monitor the rms value of AC currents for overshooting or current and motor blocking
undershooting of set threshold values.
Whereas apparent current monitoring is used above all in con- Application
nection with the rated torque or in case of overload, the active
current monitoring option can be used to observe and evaluate • Monitoring of current overshoot and undershoot
the load factor over a motor's entire torque range. • Monitoring of broken conductors
The 3RR2 current monitoring relays can be integrated directly in • Monitoring of no-load operation and load shedding, e.g. in the
the feeder by mounting onto the 3RT2 contactor; separate wiring event of a torn V-belt or no-load operation of a pump
of the main circuit is therefore superfluous. No separate trans- • Monitoring of overload, e.g. on conveyor belts or cranes due
formers are required. to an excessive load
For a line-oriented configuration or simultaneous use of an • Monitoring the functionality of electrical loads such as heaters
overload relay, terminal supports for stand-alone installation are • Monitoring of wrong phase sequence on mobile equipment
available for separate standard rail mounting. such as compressors or cranes
Versions • Monitoring of high-impedance faults to ground, e.g. caused
by damaged insulation or moisture
Basic versions

10
The basic versions with two-phase apparent current monitoring,
a CO contact output and analog adjustability provide a high
level of monitoring reliability especially in the rated and overload
range.
Standard versions
The standard versions monitor the current in three phases with
selectable active current monitoring. They have additional diag-
nostics options such as residual current monitoring and phase
sequence monitoring, and they are also suitable for monitoring
motors below the rated torque. These devices have an addi-
tional independent semiconductor output, an actual value indi-
cator, and are digitally adjustable.
Both versions are available optionally with screw or spring-type
terminals, in each case for sizes S00 and S0. With variants of
size S2 the main current paths always have screw terminals;
the control current side can have screw or spring-type terminals.
Note:
In addition to the features of the standard versions, 3RR24
monitoring relays for mounting onto 3RT2 contactors for IO-Link
also offer the possibility of transmitting the measured values and
diagnostics data to a controller via an IO-Link. Furthermore,
the devices can be parameterized on the devices themselves or
via IO-Link.

2/86 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Siemens IC 10 · 2015 10/79
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Relays
Contactor Assemblies for Switching Motors
SIRIUS 3RR21, 3RR22 Monitoring Relays for Mounting onto 3RT2 Contactors
Current Monitoring Relays
Current and active current monitoring

Technical specifications
Function charts of 3RR214.-.A.30 basic variants, analog dial adjustable
Closed-circuit principle upon application of the control supply voltage

Current overshoot Range monitoring

2
B1-B2

Assemblies
Contactors and
B1-B2
> 1~ = 0
> < 1~ = 0

Hysteresis 6,25 % ▲
Hysteresis 6,25 %
Hyst. 6,25 %

2~ = 0
2~ = 0

NSB0_02050
NSB0_02048
31/34 31/34
31/32 31/32
FAULT FAULT
LED LED
OFF FLASH OFF FLASH OFF FLASH ON OFF FLASH OFF O F F FLASH O N FLASH O F F FLASH ON OFF FLASH ON O F F FLASH O F F
slow slow slow fast slow slow slow slow fast

onDel onDel Del onDel onDel Del Del

Current undershoot

B1-B2
< 1~ = 0

Hysteresis 6,25 %

10

2~ = 0
NSB0_02049

31/34
31/32
FAULT
LED O F F FLASH O N FLASH O F F FLASH ON OFF FLASH O F F
slow slow slow fast

onDel onDel Del

Circuit diagrams

B1 / AC/DC 31 B1 / AC/DC 31

2T1 4T2 6T3 B2 32 34 14/22 A2 2T1 4T2 6T3 B2 32 34


IC01_00199 IC01_00201

3RR2141-1A.30 3RR2141-2A.30, 3RR2142-.A.30, 3RR2143-.A.30

Note:
It is not necessary to protect the measuring circuit for device
protection. The protective device for line protection depends
on the cross-section used.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/87


10/80 Siemens IC 10 · 2015
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactor Assemblies for Switching Motors Relays
SIRIUS 3RR21, 3RR22 Monitoring Relays for Mounting onto 3RT2 Contactors
Current Monitoring Relays
Current and active current monitoring
Function charts of 3RR224.-.F.30 standard versions, digitally adjustable
With the closed-circuit principle selected upon application of the control supply voltage

Current overshoot Range monitoring


2

B1-B2
> >n x B1-B2
Contactors and
Assemblies

> < 1,2 ~ = 0


nx ▲
▲, !▲
Hysteresis
▲, !▲ Hyst.
Hysteresis ▼, !▼

3~ = 0
3~ = 0
31/34
31/34 31/32

NSB0_02053
31/32 Q on
NSB0_02051
Q on Q off
Q off
onDel onDel Del RsDel Del RsDel
onDel onDel Del RsDel RsDel

Current undershoot with residual current monitoring Phase sequence monitoring

B1-B2
B1-B2
> 1+ 2+ 3 ≥

Hysteresis
▼, !▼ L3- L 2- L1

3~ = 0 3~ = 0

31/34 31/34

10
31/32 31/32
NSB0_02052

NSB0_02054
Q on
Q on
Q off
Q off
onDel onDel Del RsDel

Circuit diagrams

B1 / AC/DC 31 B1 / AC/DC 31

2T1 4T2 6T3 Q B2 32 34 14/22 A2 2T1 4T2 6T3 Q B2 32 34


IC01_00200 IC01_00202

3RR2241-1F.30 3RR2241-2F.30, 3RR2242-.F.30, 3RR2243-.F.30

Note:
It is not necessary to protect the measuring circuit for device
protection. The protective device for line protection depends
on the cross-section used.

2/88 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Siemens IC 10 · 2015 10/81
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactor Assemblies for Switching Motors Relays
SIRIUS 3RR21, 3RR22 Monitoring Relays for Mounting onto 3RT2 Contactors
Current Monitoring Relays
Current and active current monitoring

Selection and ordering data


SIRIUS 3RR21/3RR22 current monitoring relays
• For load monitoring of motors or other loads
• Multi-phase monitoring of undercurrent and overcurrent
• Starting and tripping delay can be adjusted separately
• Tripping delay 0 to 30 s

2
• Auto or Manual RESET

Assemblies
Contactors and
3RR2141-1AW30 3RR2142-1AW30 3RR2241-1FW30 3RR2242-1FW30 3RR2141-2AA30 3RR2243-3FW30

Size Measuring range Hysteresis Control supply voltage Us Screw terminals Spring-type
terminals

Order No. Order No.


A A V
Basic versions
• Analogically adjustable
• Closed-circuit principle
• 1 CO contact
• 2-phase current monitoring
• Apparent current monitoring
• Start-up delay 0 ... 60 s
S00 1.6 ... 16 6.25 % of 24 AC/DC 3RR2141-1AA30 3RR2141-2AA30
threshold value 24 ... 240 AC/DC 3RR2141-1AW30 3RR2141-2AW30

S0 4 ... 40 6.25 % of 24 AC/DC 3RR2142-1AA30 3RR2142-2AA30


threshold value 24 ... 240 AC/DC 3RR2142-1AW30 3RR2142-2AW30

S2 8 ... 80 6.25 % of 24 AC/DC 3RR2143-1AA30 3RR2143-3AA30


threshold value 24 ... 240 AC/DC 3RR2143-1AW30 3RR2143-3AW30

Standard versions
• Digitally adjustable
• LC display

10
• Open or closed-circuit principle
• 1 CO contact
• 1 semiconductor output
• 3-phase current monitoring
• Active current or apparent current monitoring
• Phase sequence monitoring
• Residual current monitoring
• Blocking current monitoring
• Reclosing delay time 0 ... 300 min
• Start-up delay 0 ... 99 s
• Separate settings for warning and alarm thresholds
S00 1.6 ... 16 0.1 ... 3 24 AC/DC 3RR2241-1FA30 3RR2241-2FA30
24 ... 240 AC/DC 3RR2241-1FW30 3RR2241-2FW30

S0 4 ... 40 0.1 ... 8 24 AC/DC 3RR2242-1FA30 3RR2242-2FA30


24 ... 240 AC/DC 3RR2242-1FW30 3RR2242-2FW30

S2 8 ... 80 0.2 ... 16 24 AC/DC 3RR2243-1FA30 3RR2243-3FA30


24 ... 240 AC/DC 3RR2243-1FW30 3RR2243-3FW30

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/89
Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2015 10/83
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactor Assemblies for Switching Motors Relays
SIRIUS 3RR24 Monitoring Relays for Mounting onto 3RT2 Contactors for IO-Link
Current Monitoring Relays with IO-Link
Current and active current monitoring

Overview
• Rapid parameterization of the same devices by duplication of
the parameterization in the controller
• Parameter transmission by upload to a controller by IO-Link
call or by parameter server (if IO-Link master from IO-Link
Specification V 1.1 and higher is used)
2

• Consistent central data storage in the event of parameter


change locally or via a controller
Contactors and
Assemblies

• Automatic reparameterizing when devices are exchanged


• Blocking of local parameterization via IO-Link possible
• Faults are saved in parameterizable and non-volatile fashion
to prevent an automatic start up after voltage failure and to
make sure diagnostics data is not lost
• By integration into the automation level the option exists of
parameterizing the monitoring relay at any time via a display
unit or displaying the measured values in a control room or
locally at the machine/control cabinet
Even without communication via IO-Link the devices continue to
SIRIUS 3RR2441, 3RR2442 and 3RR2443 current monitoring relays function fully autonomously:
The SIRIUS 3RR24 current monitoring relays for IO-Link are • Parameterization can take place locally at the device,
suitable for the load monitoring of motors or other loads. In three independently of a controller
phases they monitor the rms value of AC currents for • In the event of failure or before the controller becomes
overshooting or undershooting of set threshold values. available the monitoring relays work as long as the control
Whereas apparent current monitoring is used above all in supply voltage (24 V DC) is present
connection with the rated torque or in case of overload, the • If the monitoring relays are operated without the controller,
active current monitoring option, which is also selectable, can the 3RR24 monitoring relays for IO-Link have, thanks to the
be used to observe and evaluate the load factor over a motor's integrated SIO mode, an additional semiconductor output,
entire torque range. which switches when the adjustable warning threshold is
exceeded
The 3RR24 current monitoring relays for IO-Link can be inte-
grated directly in the feeder by mounting onto the 3RT2 contac- Thanks to the combination of autonomous monitoring relay func-
tor; separate wiring of the main circuit is therefore superfluous. tion and integrated IO-Link communication, redundant sensors
No separate transformers are required. and/or analog signal converters – which previously took over the
transmission of measured values to a controller, leading to con-
For a line-oriented configuration or simultaneous use of an
siderable extra cost and wiring outlay – are no longer needed.
overload relay, terminal supports for stand-alone installation are
available for separate standard rail mounting. Because the output relays are still present, the monitoring relays
increase the functional reliability of the system, since only the
The SIRIUS 3RR24 current monitoring relays for IO-Link also
controller can fulfill the control tasks if the current measured
offer many other options based upon the monitoring functions of

10
values are available, whereas the output relays can also be used
the conventional SIRIUS 3RR2 monitoring relays:
for the disconnection of the system if limit values that cannot be
• Measured value transmission to a controller, including resolu- reached during operation are exceeded.
tion and unit, may be parameterizable as to which value is
cyclically transmitted For further information on the IO-Link communication system,
see Chapter 14.
• Transmission of alarm flags to a controller
• Full diagnosis capability by inquiry as to the cause of the fault
in the diagnosis data record
• Remote parameterization is also possible, in addition to or
instead of local parameterization

2/90 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Siemens IC 10 · 2015 10/89
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Relays
Contactor Assemblies for Switching Motors
SIRIUS 3RR24 Monitoring Relays for Mounting onto 3RT2 Contactors for IO-Link
Current Monitoring Relays with IO-Link
Current and active current monitoring

Benefits Application
• Can be mounted directly on 3RT2 contactors and • Monitoring of current overshoot and undershoot
3RA23 reversing contactor assemblies, in other words, • Monitoring of broken conductors
there is no need for additional wiring in the main circuit
• Monitoring of no-load operation and load shedding, e.g. in the
• Optimally coordinated with the technical characteristics of the event of a torn V-belt or no-load operation of a pump
3RT2 contactors
• Monitoring of overload, e.g. on pumps due to a dirty filter

2
• No separate current transformer required system
• Variably adjustable to overshoot, undershoot or range • Monitoring the functionality of electrical loads such as heaters
monitoring

Assemblies
Contactors and
• Monitoring of wrong phase sequence on mobile equipment
• Freely configurable delay times and RESET response such as compressors or cranes
• Display of ACTUAL value and status messages • Monitoring of high-impedance faults to ground, e.g. caused
• All versions with removable control current terminals by damaged insulation or moisture
• All versions with screw or spring-type terminals The use of SIRIUS monitoring relays for IO-Link is particularly
• Simple determination of the threshold values through direct recommended for machines and plant in which these relays,
reference to actually measured values for setpoint loading in addition to their monitoring function, are to be connected
• Range monitoring and selectable active current measurement to the automation level for the rapid, simple and fault-free
mean that only one device for monitoring a motor is required provision of the current measured values and/or for remote
along the entire torque curve parameterization.
• In addition to current monitoring it is also possible to monitor The monitoring relays can either relieve the controller of monitor-
for current unbalance, broken cables, phase failure, ing tasks or, as a second monitoring entity in parallel to and
phase sequence, residual current and motor blocking independent of the controller, increase the reliability in the
process or in the system. In addition, the elimination of AI and
• Integrated counter for operating cycles and operating hours to IO modules allows the width of the controller to be reduced
support requirements-based maintenance of the monitored despite significantly expanded functionality.
machine or application
• Simple cyclical transmission of the current measured values,
relay switching states and events to a controller
• Remote parameterization
• Automatic reparameterizing when devices are exchanged
• Simple duplication of identical or similar parameterizations
• Reduction of control current wiring
• Elimination of testing costs and wiring errors
• Reduction of configuration work
• Integration in TIA means clear diagnostics if a fault occurs
• Cost saving and space saving in control cabinet due to the
elimination of AI and IO modules as well as analog signal
converters and duplicated sensors
10

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/91


10/90 Siemens IC 10 · 2015
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactor Assemblies for Switching Motors Relays
SIRIUS 3RR24 Monitoring Relays for Mounting onto 3RT2 Contactors for IO-Link
Current Monitoring Relays with IO-Link
Current and active current monitoring

Technical specifications
Function charts of 3RR24 for IO-Link, digitally adjustable
With the closed-circuit principle selected upon application of the control supply voltage

Current overshoot Range monitoring


2

L+/L-
Contactors and
Assemblies

> >n x L+/L-


> < 1,2 ~ = 0
nx ▲
▲, !▲
Hysteresis

▲, !▲ Hyst.
Hysteresis ▼, !▼

3~ = 0
3~ = 0
31/34
31/34 31/32

IC01_00186
31/32 Q on
IC01_00185

Q on Q off
Q off
onDel onDel ▲Del RsDel ▼Del RsDel
onDel onDel ▲Del RsDel RsDel

Current undershoot with residual current monitoring Phase sequence monitoring

L+/L-
>
L+/L-
1+ 2+ 3 ≥

Hysteresis
▼, !▼
L3-L2-L1

3~ = 0

10
3~ = 0

31/34 31/34
31/32 31/32
IC01_00187

IC01_00188
Q on
Q on
Q off
Q off
onDel onDel ▼Del RsDel

Circuit diagrams

L+ C/Q L- 31 L+ C/Q L- 31

IO-Link IO-Link

2T1 4T2 6T3 32 34 14/22 A2 2T1 4T2 6T3 32 34


IC01_00189 IC01_00190

3RR2441-1AA40 3RR2441-2AA40, 3RR2442-.AA40, 3RR2443-.AA40


Note:
It is not necessary to protect the measuring circuit for device
protection. The protective device for line protection depends
on the cross-section used.

2/92 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Siemens IC 10 · 2015 10/91
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Relays
Contactor Assemblies for Switching Motors
SIRIUS 3RR24 Monitoring Relays for Mounting onto 3RT2 Contactors for IO-Link
Current Monitoring Relays
Current and active current monitoring

Selection and ordering data


SIRIUS 3RR24 current monitoring relays for IO-Link
• For load monitoring of motors or other loads
• Multi-phase monitoring of undercurrent and overcurrent
• Starting and tripping delay can be adjusted separately
• Tripping delay 0 to 999.9 s

2
• Auto or Manual RESET

Assemblies
Contactors and
3RR2441-1AA40 3RR2442-1AA40 3RR2441-2AA40 3RR2442-2AA40 3RR2443-1AA40 3RR2443-3AA40

Size Measuring range Hysteresis Control supply voltage Us Screw terminals Spring-type
terminals
Order No. Order No.
A A V
• Digitally adjustable
• LC display
• Open or closed-circuit principle
• 1 CO contact
• 1 semiconductor output (in SIO mode)
• 3-phase current monitoring
• Active current or apparent current monitoring
• Current unbalance monitoring
• Phase sequence monitoring
• Residual current monitoring
• Blocking current monitoring
• Operating hours counter
• Operating cycles counter
• Reclosing delay time 0 ... 300 min
• Start-up delay 0 ... 999.9 s
• Separate settings for warning and alarm thresholds
S00 1.6 ... 16 0.1 ... 3 24 DC 3RR2441-1AA40 3RR2441-2AA40

S0 4 ... 40 0.1 ... 8 24 DC 3RR2442-1AA40 3RR2442-2AA40


10

S2 8 ... 80 0.2 ... 16 24 DC 3RR2443-1AA40 3RR2443-3AA40

Siemens Industry* Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/93


You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
10/92 Siemens IC 10 · 2015 Illustrations are approximate
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Relays
Contactor Assemblies for Switching Motors
SIRIUS 3RR21, 3RR22 Monitoring Relays for Mounting onto 3RT2 Contactors
Current Monitoring Relay Accessories
Current and active current monitoring

Accessories

Use Version Size Order No. Standard


Pack
Quantity

Terminal supports for stand-alone installation1)


2

For 3RR21, For separate mounting of the overload relays Screw terminals
3RR22, or monitoring relays; screw and snap-on mounting
3RR24 onto TH 35 standard mounting rail according to
Contactors and
Assemblies

IEC 60715
• Screw connection S00 3RU2916-3AA01 1 unit
S0 3RU2926-3AA01 1 unit
S2 3RU2936-3AA01 1 unit

3RU2916-3AA01
Spring-type
terminals
• Spring-type connection S00 3RU2916-3AC01 1 unit
S0 3RU2926-3AC01 1 unit

3RU2926-3AC01
Blank labels
For 3RR21, Unit labeling plates2)
3RR22, For SIRIUS devices
3RR24
20 mm x 7 mm, titanium gray 3RT2900-1SB20 340 units
IC01_00181

3RT2900-1SB20
Sealable covers
For 3RR21, Sealable covers 3RR2940 5 units
3RR22, For securing against unintentional or unauthorized
3RR24 adjustment of settings

For 3RR21 Sealing foil 3TK2820-0AA00 1 unit


10

For securing against unauthorized adjustment of


setting knobs
3RR2940
Tools for opening spring-type terminals
For auxiliary Screwdrivers Spring-type
circuit For all SIRIUS devices with spring-type terminals; terminals
connections 3.0 mm x 0.5 mm; length approx. 200 mm,
titanium gray/black, partially insulated 3RA2908-1A 1 unit

3RA2908-1A
1)
The accessories are identical to those of the 3RU21 thermal overload
relays and the 3RB3 electronic overload relays, see Chapter 3
"Overload Relays".
2)
PC labeling system for individual inscription
of unit labeling plates available from:
Systems, Inc.
www.murrplastic.com

2/94 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
10/84 Siemens IC 10 · 2015 Illustrations are approximate
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactor Assemblies for Switching Motors
NEMA 1 Enclosure

Selection and ordering data

* NEMA Type 1 Enclosures


* Lift off cover
* Accepts SIRIUS power control components
* Non-reversing contactors
* Reversing contactors

2
* Starters with thermal overload relays
* Starters with solid-state overload relays

Assemblies
Contactors and
Application

The 49EC14*B separate enclosures are designed for field assembly of a wide range of Siemens
SIRIUS open style control components and field modification kits as listed in the charts below. 49EC14EB110705R
Note that certain components require the addition of a DIN Rail kit for proper mounting in the enclosure.

NEMA 1 Enclosures
Max. current Contactor Max. current Overload relay Required DIN rail kit NEMA 1 Enclosure
A Non-reversing Reversing A Thermal Solid-state Order No. Order No.
16 3RT201 3RA231 16 3RU2116 3RB3016 MTR5 49EC14EB110705R
38 3RT202 3RA232 40 3RU2126 3RB3026 MTR5
50 3RT203 50 3RU2136 3RB3036 — 49EC14GB140807R
12 3RA231 12 3RU2116 3RB3016 MTR5
25 3RA232 25 3RU2126 3RB3036 MTR5
50 3RA233 50 3RU2136 3RB3036 —
95 3RT204 100 3RU2146 3RB3046 — 49EC14IB201208R
95 3RA234 100 3RU2146 3RB3046 —

Accessories for NEMA 1 Enclosures


Accessory type Description Marking Voltage Order No.
Start-stop 49SBPB5
Push button
Reset (blue) 49MBRS
2 position Off-on 49SBSB4
49SBPB5
Hand-off-auto 49SBSB1
Selector switch
3 position For-off-rev 49SBSB2
High-off-low 49SBSB3

Legends: ON, RUN, 24 V AC 49SBLBJ


Pilot light Lens colors: OFF, OL TRIPPED, 120 V AC 49SBLBF
red, green, FORWARD, 208, 240, 277 V AC 49SBLBG
49SBSB1 REVERSE, LOW 480 V AC
amber 49SBLBH
Accessories for NEMA 1 Enclosures HIGH 600 V AC 49SBLBE
Accessory type Description Legends Voltage Order No.
Push buttons Momentary Start - Stop none 49SDPB5
Monentary Reset (blue) 49MBRS
Selector Switch 2 position Off - On none 49SDSB4
3 position Hand - Off - Auto none 49SDSB1
49SBLBF For - Off - Rev 49SDSB2
High - Off - Low 49SDSB3
Pilot light Light module and lens color: ON, RUN, OFF, 24 to 240 AC DC 49SDLBU
RED, GREEN, and AMBER" OL TRIPPED 277V AC 49SDLBL
Light module and lens color: REV - FOR or 24 to 240 AC DC 49SDLB7RU
RED, RED HIGH - LOW 277V AC 49SDLB7RL
Light module and lens color: REV - FOR or 24 to 240 AC DC 49SDLB7GU
GREEN, GREEN HIGH - LOW 277V AC 49SDLB7GL

For 3RT contactors, see page 2/8.


For 3RA reversing, see pages 2/39.
For thermal overloads, see page 3/10.
For solidstate overloads, see pages 3/22.
For enclosure dimensions, see figures 1, 2, and 3 on page 9/150.

Product Category: NEMA Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/95
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Accessories and Spare Parts
3RT
For Contactors
3RT2, 3RH2 Contactors and Contactor Relays
Spare parts for 3RT2 contactors
Spare parts for 3RT2 contactors

Selection and ordering data


For screw, spring-type and ring lug terminal connection
2
Contactors and
3 Assemblies

3RT29 24-5A . 01
For contactors Rated control supply voltage Us Order No. Weight
approx.
Size Type 50 Hz 50/60 Hz 60 Hz
V V V kg
Solenoid coils • AC operation
S0 3RT20 23, 24 -- -- 3RT29 24-5AB01 0.100
3RT20 24, 42 -- -- 3RT29 24-5AD01 0.100
3RT20 25 48 -- -- 3RT29 24-5AH01 0.100
110 -- -- 3RT29 24-5AF01 0.100
230 -- -- 3RT29 24-5AP01 0.100
400 -- -- 3RT29 24-5AV01 0.100
-- 24 -- 3RT29 24-5AC21 0.100
-- 42 -- 3RT29 24-5AD21 0.100
-- 48 -- 3RT29 24-5AH21 0.100
-- 110 -- 3RT29 24-5AG21 0.100
-- 220 -- 3RT29 24-5AN21 0.100
-- 230 -- 3RT29 24-5AL21 0.100
110 -- 120 3RT29 24-5AK61 0.100
220 -- 240 3RT29 24-5AP61 0.100
-- 100 110 3RT29 24-5AG61 0.100
-- 200 220 3RT29 24-5AN61 0.100
-- 400 440 3RT29 24-5AR61 0.100
S0 3RT20 26 , 24 -- -- 3RT29 26-5AB01 0.100
3RT20 27, 42 -- -- 3RT29 26-5AD01 0.100
3RT20 28 48 -- -- 3RT29 26-5AH01 0.100
3RT23 2 5, 110 -- -- 3RT29 26-5AF01 0.100
3RT23 26, 230 -- -- 3RT29 26-5AP01 0.100
3RT23 27
400 -- -- 3RT29 26-5AV01 0.100
3RT25 2 6
-- 24 -- 3RT29 26-5AC21 0.100
-- 42 -- 3RT29 26-5AD21 0.100
-- 48 -- 3RT29 26-5AH21 0.100
-- 110 -- 3RT29 26-5AG21 0.100
-- 208 -- 3RT29 26-5AM21 0.100
-- 220 -- 3RT29 26-5AN21 0.100
-- 230 -- 3RT29 26-5AL21 0.100
110 -- 120 3RT29 26-5AK61 0.100
220 -- 240 3RT29 26-5AP61 0.100
-- 100 110 3RT29 26-5AG61 0.100
-- 200 220 3RT29 26-5AN61 0.100
-- 400 440 3RT29 26-5AR61 0.100
500 -- 3RT29 26-5AQ21 0.100
277 3RT29 26-5AU61 0.100
480 3RT29 26-5AV61 0.100
600 3RT29 26-5AT61 0.100

Note:
Contactors with AC and AC/DC coils have different depths.
It is only possible to replace the coils on AC contactors with
AC coils, and on AC/DC contactors with AC/DC coils. It is not
possible to replace the coils on DC contactors in the S0 frame.

2/96 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
3/110 SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2016
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Power Contactors for Switching Motors
Accessories
Contactor and Sparefor
Assemblies Parts for SIRIUS 3RT
Switching Contactors and SIRIUS 3RH2 Contactor Relays
Motors
Spare Parts
Spare parts for 3RT2 contactors
Solenoid coils
Screw terminals and spring-type terminals

2
3
Assemblies
Contactors and
3RT2934-5A. 01 3RT2934-5N. 31
For contactors Rated control supply voltage Us SD Article No. Price PU PS* PG
50 Hz 50/60 Hz 60 Hz DC per PU (UNIT,
SET, M)
Type V V V d
Solenoid coils · AC operation
Size S2
3RT203. -.A, 24 -- -- -- 5 3RT2934-5AB01 1 1 unit 41B
3RT233. -.A, 42 -- -- -- 5 3RT2934-5AD01 1 1 unit 41B
3RT253. -.A 48 -- -- -- 5 3RT2934-5AH01 1 1 unit 41B
110 -- -- -- 5 3RT2934-5AF01 1 1 unit 41B
230 -- -- -- 5 3RT2934-5AP01 1 1 unit 41B
400 -- -- -- 5 3RT2934-5AV01 1 1 unit 41B
-- 24 -- -- 5 3RT2934-5AC21 1 1 unit 41B
-- 42 -- -- 5 3RT2934-5AD21 1 1 unit 41B
-- 48 -- -- 5 3RT2934-5AH21 1 1 unit 41B
-- 110 -- -- 5 3RT2934-5AG21 1 1 unit 41B
-- 220 -- -- 5 3RT2934-5AN21 1 1 unit 41B
-- 230 -- -- 5 3RT2934-5AL21 1 1 unit 41B
110 -- 120 -- 5 3RT2934-5AK61 1 1 unit 41B
220 -- 240 -- 5 3RT2934-5AP61 1 1 unit 41B
-- -- 480 -- 5 3RT2934-5AV61 1 1 unit 41B
-- -- 600 -- 5 3RT2934-5AT61 1 1 unit 41B
-- 100 110 -- 5 3RT2934-5AG61 1 1 unit 41B
-- 200 220 -- 5 3RT2934-5AN61 1 1 unit 41B
-- 400 440 -- 5 3RT2934-5AR61 1 1 unit 41B
Size S3
3RT2.4.-. A 24 -- -- -- X 3RT2944-5AB01 1 1 unit 41B
42 -- -- -- X 3RT2944-5AD01 1 1 unit 41B
48 -- -- -- X 3RT2944-5AH01 1 1 unit 41B
110 -- -- -- X 3RT2944-5AF01 1 1 unit 41B
230 -- -- -- X 3RT2944-5AP01 1 1 unit 41B
400 -- -- -- X 3RT2944-5AV01 1 1 unit 41B
-- 24 -- -- X 3RT2944-5AC21 1 1 unit 41B
-- 42 -- -- X 3RT2944-5AD21 1 1 unit 41B
-- 48 -- -- X 3RT2944-5AH21 1 1 unit 41B
-- 110 -- -- X 3RT2944-5AG21 1 1 unit 41B
-- 220 -- -- X 3RT2944-5AN21 1 1 unit 41B
-- 230 -- -- X 3RT2944-5AL21 1 1 unit 41B
110 -- 120 -- X 3RT2944-5AK61 1 1 unit 41B
220 -- 240 -- X 3RT2944-5AP61 1 1 unit 41B
-- -- 480 -- X 3RT2944-5AV61 1 1 unit 41B
-- -- 600 -- X 3RT2944-5AT61 1 1 unit 41B
-- 100 110 -- X 3RT2944-5AG61 1 1 unit 41B
-- 200 220 -- X 3RT2944-5AN61 1 1 unit 41B
-- 400 440 -- X 3RT2944-5AR61 1 1 unit 41B
Solenoid coils · AC/DC operation, with varistor
Size S2
3RT203. -.A, -- 20 ... 33 -- 20 ... 33 5 3RT2934-5NB31 1 1 unit 41B
3RT233. -.A, -- 30 ... 42 -- 30 ... 42 5 3RT2934-5ND31 1 1 unit 41B
3RT253. -.A -- 48 ... 80 -- 48 ... 80 5 3RT2934-5NE31 1 1 unit 41B
-- 83 ... 155 -- 83 ... 155 5 3RT2934-5NF31 1 1 unit 41B
-- 175 ... 280 -- 175 ... 280 5 3RT2934-5NP31 1 1 unit 41B
Size S3
3RT2.4.-. A -- 20 ... 33 -- 20 ... 33 X 3RT2944-5NB31 1 1 unit 41B
-- 30 ... 42 -- 30 ... 42 X 3RT2944-5ND31 1 1 unit 41B
-- 48 ... 80 -- 48 ... 80 X 3RT2944-5NE31 1 1 unit 41B
-- 83 ... 155 -- 83 ... 155 X 3RT2944-5NF31 1 1 unit 41B
-- 175 ... 280 -- 175 ... 280 X 3RT2944-5NP31 1 1 unit 41B
Note:
It is only possible to replace the coils on AC contactors with AC coils, and on AC/DC contactors with AC/DC coils.

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/97
Illustrations are approximate. Siemens IC 10 · 2017 3/121
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3RT Contactors
Spare parts for 3RT1 contactors

Selection and ordering data

For contactor Rated control supply Screw connection Spring-type connection Weight
voltage Us approx.
Order No. Order No.

Size
2

Type kg
Coils · AC operation
Contactors and
Assemblies

3RT19 24-5A . 01 S0 3RT10 2 ., 24 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 24-5AB01 3RT19 24-5AB02 0.069


3RT13 2 ., 42 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 24-5AD01 3RT19 24-5AD02
3RT15 2 . 48 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 24-5AH01 3RT19 24-5AH02
110 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 24-5AF01 3RT19 24-5AF02
230 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 24-5AP01 3RT19 24-5AP02
400 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 24-5AV01 3RT19 24-5AV02
24 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 24-5AC21 3RT19 24-5AC22
42 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 24-5AD21 3RT19 24-5AD22
48 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 24-5AH21 3RT19 24-5AH22
110 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 24-5AG21 3RT19 24-5AG22
208 v, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 24-5AM21 3RT19 24-5AM22
220 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 24-5AN21 3RT19 24-5AN22
230 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 24-5AL21 3RT19 24-5AL22
110 V, 50 Hz/120 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 24-5AK61 3RT19 24-5AK62
220 V, 50 Hz/240 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 24-5AP61 3RT19 24-5AP62
277 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 24-5AU61 3RT19 24-5AU62
480 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 24-5AV61 3RT19 24-5AV62
600 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 24-5AT61 3RT19 24-5AT62
100 V, 50/60 Hz/110 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 24-5AG61 3RT19 24-5AG62
200 V, 50/60 Hz/220 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 24-5AN61 3RT19 24-5AN62
400 V, 50/60 Hz/440 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 24-5AR61 3RT19 24-5AR62

3RT19 24-5A . 02 S2 3RT10 33 24 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 34-5AB01 3RT19 34-5AB02 0.088


3RT10 34 42 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 34-5AD01 3RT19 34-5AD02
48 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 34-5AH01 3RT19 34-5AH02
110 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 34-5AF01 3RT19 34-5AF02
230 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 34-5AP01 3RT19 34-5AP02
400 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 34-5AV01 3RT19 34-5AV02
42 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 34-5AD21 3RT19 34-5AD22
48 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 34-5AH21 3RT19 34-5AH22
24 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 34-5AC21 3RT19 34-5AC22
110 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 34-5AG21 3RT19 34-5AG22
208 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 34-5AM21 3RT19 34-5AM22
220 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 34-5AN21 3RT19 34-5AN22
230 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 34-5AL21 3RT19 34-5AL22
110 V, 50 Hz/120 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 34-5AK61 3RT19 34-5AK62
220 V, 50 Hz/240 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 34-5AP61 3RT19 34-5AP62
277 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 34-5AU61 3RT19 34-5AU62
480 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 34-5AV61 3RT19 34-5AV62
600 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 34-5AT61 3RT19 34-5AT62
100 V, 50/60 Hz/110 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 34-5AG61 3RT19 34-5AG62
200 V, 50/60 Hz/220 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 34-5AN61 3RT19 34-5AN62
400 V, 50/60 Hz/440 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 34-5AR61 3RT19 34-5AR62

3RT19 34-5A . 01 3RT10 35, 24 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 35-5AB01 3RT19 35-5AB02 0.088


3RT10 36, 42 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 35-5AD01 3RT19 35-5AD02
3RT13 3 ., 48 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 35-5AH01 3RT19 35-5AH02
3RT15 3 . 110 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 35-5AF01 3RT19 35-5AF02
230 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 35-5AP01 3RT19 35-5AP02
400 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 35-5AV01 3RT19 35-5AV02
24 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 35-5AC21 3RT19 35-5AC22
42 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 35-5AD21 3RT19 35-5AD22
48 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 35-5AH21 3RT19 35-5AH22
110 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 35-5AG21 3RT19 35-5AG22
208 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 35-5AM21 3RT19 35-5AM22
220 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 35-5AN21 3RT19 35-5AN22
230 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 35-5AL21 3RT19 35-5AL22
110 V, 50 Hz/120 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 35-5AK61 3RT19 35-5AK62
220 V, 50 Hz/240 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 35-5AP61 3RT19 35-5AP62
277 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 35-5AU61 3RT19 35-5AU62
480 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 35-5AV61 3RT19 35-5AV62
600 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 35-5AT61 3RT19 35-5AT62
100 V, 50/60 Hz/110 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 35-5AG61 3RT19 35-5AG62
200 V, 50/60 Hz/220 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 35-5AN61 3RT19 35-5AN62
400 V, 50/60 Hz/440 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 35-5AR61 3RT19 35-5AR62

2/98 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3RT Contactors
Spare parts for 3RT1 contactors

Selection and ordering data

For contactor Rated control supply Screw connection Spring-type connection Weight
voltage Us approx.
Order No. Order No.

Size

2
Type kg
Coils · AC operation

Assemblies
Contactors and
3RT19 44-5A . 01 S3 3RT10 44 24 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 44-5AB01 3RT19 44-5AB02 0.130
42 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 44-5AD01 3RT19 44-5AD02
48 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 44-5AH01 3RT19 44-5AH02
110 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 44-5AF01 3RT19 44-5AF02
230 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 44-5AP01 3RT19 44-5AP02
400 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 44-5AV01 3RT19 44-5AV02
24 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 44-5AC21 3RT19 44-5AC22
42 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 44-5AD21 3RT19 44-5AD22
48 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 44-5AH21 3RT19 44-5AH22
110 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 44-5AG21 3RT19 44-5AG22
208 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 44-5AM21 3RT19 44-5AM22
220 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 44-5AN21 3RT19 44-5AN22
230 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 44-5AL21 3RT19 44-5AL22
110 V, 50 Hz/120 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 44-5AK61 3RT19 44-5AK62
220 V, 50 Hz/240 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 44-5AP61 3RT19 44-5AP62
277 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 44-5AU61 3RT19 44-5AU62
480 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 44-5AV61 3RT19 44-5AV62
600 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 44-5AT61 3RT19 44-5AT62
100 V, 50/60 Hz/110 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 44-5AG61 3RT19 44-5AG62
3RT19 45-5A . 01 200 V, 50/60 Hz/220 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 44-5AN61 3RT19 44-5AN62
400 V, 50/60 Hz/440 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 44-5AR61 3RT19 44-5AR62
3RT10 45, 24 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 45-5AB01 3RT19 45-5AB02 0.130
3RT10 46, 42 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 45-5AD01 3RT19 45-5AD02
3RT13 4 ., 48 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 45-5AH01 3RT19 45-5AH02
3RT14 46 110 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 45-5AF01 3RT19 45-5AF02
230 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 45-5AP01 3RT19 45-5AP02
400 V, 50 Hz 3RT19 45-5AV01 3RT19 45-5AV02
24 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 45-5AC21 3RT19 45-5AC22
42 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 45-5AD21 3RT19 45-5AD22
48 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 45-5AH21 3RT19 45-5AH22
110 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 45-5AG21 3RT19 45-5AG22
208 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 45-5AM21 3RT19 45-5AM22
220 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 45-5AN21 3RT19 45-5AN22
230 V, 50/60 Hz 3RT19 45-5AL21 3RT19 45-5AL22
3RT19 45-5AP02
110 V, 50 Hz/120 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 45-5AK61 3RT19 45-5AK62
220 V, 50 Hz/240 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 45-5AP61 3RT19 45-5AP62
277 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 45-5AU61 3RT19 45-5AU62
480 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 45-5AV61 3RT19 45-5AV62
600 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 45-5AT61 3RT19 45-5AT62
100 V, 50/60 Hz/110 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 45-5AG61 3RT19 45-5AG62
200 V, 50/60 Hz/220 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 45-5AN61 3RT19 45-5AN62
400 V, 50/60 Hz/440 V, 60 Hz 3RT19 45-5AR61 3RT19 45-5AR62

Coils · DC operation
3RT19 44-5BM42 S2 3RT10 3 ., 24 V 3RT19 34-5BB41 3RT19 34-5BB42 0.558
3RT13 3 ., 42 V 3RT19 34-5BD41 3RT19 34-5BD42
3RT15 3 . 48 V 3RT19 34-5BW41 3RT19 34-5BW42
60 V 3RT19 34-5BE41 3RT19 34-5BE42
110 V 3RT19 34-5BF41 3RT19 34-5BF42
125 V 3RT19 34-5BG41 3RT19 34-5BG42
220 V 3RT19 34-5BM41 3RT19 34-5BM42
230 V 3RT19 34-5BP41 3RT19 34-5BP42
S3 3RT10 4 ., 24 V 3RT19 44-5BB41 3RT19 44-5BB42 0.916
3RT13 4 ., 42 V 3RT19 44-5BD41 3RT19 44-5BD42
3RT14 4 . 48 V 3RT19 44-5BW41 3RT19 44-5BW42
60 V 3RT19 44-5BE41 3RT19 44-5BE42
110 V 3RT19 44-5BF41 3RT19 44-5BF42
125 V 3RT19 44-5BG41 3RT19 44-5BG42
220 V 3RT19 44-5BM41 3RT19 44-5BM42
230 V 3RT19 44-5BP41 3RT19 44-5BP42

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/99
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3RT Contactors
Spare parts for 3RT1 contactors

Selection and ordering data

For contactor Rated control supply voltage Order No. Weight


Us min to Us max approx.
Size Type AC/DC V kg
Withdrawable coils
Conventional operating mechanism
2

3RT19 55-5A . . . S6 3RT10 5, 23 ... 26 3RT19 55-5AB31 0.49


3RT14 5 42 ... 48 3RT19 55-5AD31
Contactors and
Assemblies

110 ... 127 3RT19 55-5AF31


200 ... 220 3RT19 55-5AM31
220 ... 240 3RT19 55-5AP31
240 ... 277 3RT19 55-5AU31
380 ... 420 3RT19 55-5AV31
440 ... 480 3RT19 55-5AR31
500 ... 550 3RT19 55-5AS31
575 ... 600 3RT19 55-5AT31
S10 3RT10 6, 23 ... 26 3RT19 65-5AB31 0.65
3RT14 6 42 ... 48 3RT19 65-5AD31
110 ... 127 3RT19 65-5AF31
200 ... 220 3RT19 65-5AM31
220 ... 240 3RT19 65-5AP31
240 ... 277 3RT19 65-5AU31
380 ... 420 3RT19 65-5AV31
440 ... 480 3RT19 65-5AR31
500 ... 550 3RT19 65-5AS31
575 ... 600 3RT19 65-5AT31
3RT12 6 23 ... 26 3RT19 66-5AB31
Vacuum 42 ... 48 3RT19 66-5AD31
contactor 110 ... 127 3RT19 66-5AF31
200 ... 220 3RT19 66-5AM31
220 ... 240 3RT19 66-5AP31
240 ... 277 3RT19 66-5AU31
380 ... 420 3RT19 66-5AV31
440 ... 480 3RT19 66-5AR31
500 ... 550 3RT19 66-5AS31
575 ... 600 3RT19 66-5AT31
S12 3RT10 7, 23 ... 26 3RT19 75-5AB31 1.1
3RT14 7, 42 ... 48 3RT19 75-5AD31
3RT12 7 110 ... 127 3RT19 75-5AF31
Vacuum 200 ... 220 3RT19 75-5AM31
contactor 220 ... 240 3RT19 75-5AP31
240 ... 277 3RT19 75-5AU31
380 ... 420 3RT19 75-5AV31
440 ... 480 3RT19 75-5AR31
500 ... 550 3RT19 75-5AS31
575 ... 600 3RT19 75-5AT31
Withdrawable coils
Solid-state operating mechanism · for DC 24 V PLC output
3RT19 55-5N . . . S6 3RT10 5, 21 ... 27.3 3RT19 55-5NB31 0.49
3RT14 5 96 ... 127 3RT19 55-5NF31
200 ... 277 3RT19 55-5NP31
S10 3RT10 6, 21 ... 27.3 3RT19 65-5NB31 0.65
3RT14 6 96 ... 127 3RT19 65-5NF31
200 ... 277 3RT19 65-5NP31

3RT12 6 21 ... 27.3 3RT19 66-5NB31


Vacuum 96 ... 127 3RT19 66-5NF31
contactor 200 ... 277 3RT19 66-5NP31
S12 3RT10 7, 21 ... 27.3 3RT19 75-5NB31 1.1
3RT14 7, 96 ... 127 3RT19 75-5NF31
3RT12 7 200 ... 277 3RT19 75-5NP31
Vacuum
contactor
Solid-state operating mechanism · for DC 24 V PLC output/PLC relay output, with remaining lifetime indication
(withdrawable coil with lateral electronics module)
S6 3RT10 5, 96 ... 127 3RT19 55-5PF31 1.1
3RT14 5 200 ... 277 3RT19 55-5PP31
S10 3RT10 6, 96 ... 127 3RT19 65-5PF31 1.1
3RT14 6 200 ... 277 3RT19 65-5PP31

S12 3RT10 7, 96 ... 127 3RT19 75-5PF31 1.1


3RT14 7 200 ... 277 3RT19 75-5PP31

2/100 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3RT Contactors
Spare parts for 3RT1 contactors

Selection and ordering data

For contactor Design Order No. Weight Pack.


approx.
Size Type kg
Arc chutes

2
S2 3RT20 3 . For AC coil contactors only 3RT29 36-7A 1 unit
3RT20 3 . For UC (AC/DC) coil contactors only 3RT29 36-7B

Assemblies
Contactors and
S3 3RT10 4 ., 3RT19 46-7A
3RT14 46

S6 3RT10 54 3RT19 54-7A 0.72


3RT10 55 3RT19 55-7A
3RT10 56 3RT19 56-7A
S10 3RT10 64 3RT19 64-7A 1.24
3RT10 65 3RT19 65-7A
3RT10 66 3RT19 66-7A
S12 3RT10 75 3RT19 75-7A 1.4
3RT10 76 3RT19 76-7A

S6 3RT14 56 3RT19 56-7B 0.72


S10 3RT14 66 3RT19 66-7B 1.24
S12 3RT14 76 3RT19 76-7B 1.4
Contacts with fixing parts
for contactors with 3 main contacts
S2 3RT20 35 Main contacts (3 NO) 3RT29 35-6A 1 set
3RT20 36 for AC-3 utilization category 3RT29 36-6A
3RT20 37 (1 set = 3 moving and 6 fixed contacts 3RT29 37-6A
3RT20 38 with fixing parts) 3RT29 38-6A

S3 3RT10 44 3RT19 44-6A


3RT10 45 3RT19 45-6A
3RT10 46 3RT19 46-6A

S6 3RT10 54 3RT19 54-6A 0.28


3RT10 55 3RT19 55-6A
3RT10 56 3RT19 56-6A

S10 3RT10 64 3RT19 64-6A 0.48


3RT10 65 3RT19 65-6A
3RT10 66 3RT19 66-6A

S12 3RT10 75 3RT19 75-6A 0.9


3RT10 76 3RT19 76-6A

S3 3RT14 46 Main contacts (3 NO) 3RT19 46-6D


for AC-1 utilization category
(1 set = 3 moving and 6 fixed contacts
S6 3RT14 56 with fixing parts) 3RT19 56-6D 0.28
S10 3RT14 66 3RT19 66-6D 0.48
S12 3RT14 76 3RT19 76-6D 0.9
for 3RT12 vacuum contactors
S10 3RT12 64 3 vacuum interrupters 3RT19 64-6V 1.4 1 set
3RT12 65 with fixing parts 3RT19 65-6V
3RT12 66 3RT19 66-6V
S12 3RT12 75 3RT19 75-6V 1.5
3RT12 76 3RT19 76-6V
for contactors with 4 main contacts
S2 3RT23 36 Main contacts (4 NO contacts) 3RT29 36-6E 1 set
3RT23 37 for utilization category AC-1 3RT29 37-6E
S3 3RT13 44 (1 set = 4 moving and 8 fixed contacts 3RT19 44-6E
3RT13 46 with fixing parts) 3RT19 46-6E

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/101
Discount Code: Replacement Parts
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies
3TB World Series Contactors
3T Contactors
Rated
Rated control
control supply
supply voltages
voltages for coils
for coils

Selection and ordering data

Coil type 3TY6 503-0A.. 3TB50 3TY7 683-0C.. 3TF68


Rated control Control supply 3TY6 523-0A.. 3TB52 3TY7 693-0C.. 3TF69
supply voltage Us voltage at 3TY6 543-0A.. 3TB54
3TY6 566-0A.. 3TB56

Rated control supply voltages (changes to 10th and 11th positions of the Order No.)
AC operation
2

Coils for 50 Hz
50 Hz 60 Hz
Contactors and
Assemblies

AC 24 V AC 39 V B0 –
AC 32 V AC 28 V – –
AC 36 V AC 42 V G0 –
AC 42 V AC 50 V D0 –
AC 48 V AC 58 V H0 –
AC 60 V AC 72 V E0 –
AC 110 V AC 132 V F0 –
AC 125/127 V AC 150/152 V L0 –
AC 230/220 V AC 277 V P0 1) –
AC 240 V AC 288 V U0 –
AC 400/380 V AC 480/460 V V0 1) –
AC 415 V AC 500 V R0 –
AC 500 V AC 600 V S0 –
Coils for 50/60 Hz
AC 110 V ... 132 V – F7
AC 200 V ... 240 V – M7
AC 230 V ... 277 V – P7 2)
AC 380 V ... 460 V – Q7
AC 500 V ... 600 V – S7

Coil type 3TY6 503-0B.. 3TB50 3TY7 683-0D.. 3TF68


Rated control supply 3TY6 523-0B.. 3TB52 3TY7 693-0D.. 3TF69
voltage Us 3TY6 543-0B.. 3TB54
3TY6 563-0B.. 3TB56

Rated control supply voltages (changes to 10th and 11th positions of the Order No.)
DC operation
DC 24 V B4 B4
DC 30 V C4 –
DC 36 V V4 –
DC 42 V D4 –
DC 48 V W4 –
DC 60 V E4 –
DC 110 V F4 F4
DC 125 V G4 G4
DC 180 V K4 –
DC 220 V M4 M4
DC 230 V P4 P4

Due to the mature nature of some product series, supply cannot be guaranteed on all versions listed on this page.

1) Coil voltage tolerance at 220 V or 380 V: 2) Lower tolerance range limit at 220 V:
0.85 to 1.15 x Us; 0.85 x Us acc. to IEC 60 947.
lower tolerance range limit acc. to
IEC 60 947.

2/102 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3TB World Series Contactors
Spare parts

Coils, AC1)
Catalog No
Frame
Size 24V AC 120V AC 208V AC 220/240V AC 277V AC 480V AC 600V AC
3TB40–44 3TY7403-0AC2 3TY7403-0AK6 3TY7403-0AM1 3TY7403-0AP6 3TY7403-0AU1 3TY7403-0AV0 3TY7403-0AS0
3TB47–48 3TY6483-0AC1 3TY6483-0AK6 3TY6483-0AM1 3TY6483-0AP6 3TY6483-0AP0 3TY6483-0AV0 3TY6483-0AS0
3TB52 — 3TY6523-0AK6 3TY6523-0AM1 3TY6523-0AP6 3TY6523-0AP0 3TY6523-0AV0 —
3TB56 — — — — 3TY6566-0AP0 3TY6566-0AV0 3TY6566-0AS0

2Assemblies
Contactors and
3 TY 6 4 6 3 - 0A K 6

Coils, DC
Catalog No
Frame
Size 12V DC 24V DC 42V DC 48V DC 110V DC 125V DC 240V DC
­­ 3TB40–43 3TY4803-0BA4 3TY4803-0BB4 3TY4803-0BD4 3TY4803-0BW4 3TY4803-0BF4 3TY4803-0BG4 3TY4803-0BQ4
3TB44 3TY6443-0BA4 3TY6443-0BB4 3TY6443-0BD4 3TY6443-0BW4 3TY6443-0BF4 3TY6443-0BG4 3TY6443-0BQ4
3TB46 — — 3TY6463-0BD4 3TY6463-0BW4 3TY6463-0BF4 — 3TY6463-0BQ4
3TB47–48 — 3TY6483-0BB4 3TY6483-0BD4 3TY6483-0BW4 3TY6483-0BF4 3TY6483-0BG4 —
3TB50 — 3TY6503-0BB4 3TY6503-0BD4 3TY6503-0BW4 3TY6503-0BF4 3TY6503-0BG4 3TY6503-0BQ4
3TB52 — 3TY6523-0BB4 3TY6523-0BD4 — 3TY6523-0BF4 3TY6523-0BG4 —
3T Y 6 4 8 3 - 0BB 4 3TB54 — 3TY6543-0BB4 3TY6543-0BD4 3TY6543-0BW4 3TY6543-0BF4 — 3TY6543-0BQ4
3TB56 — 3TY6563-0BB4 3TY6563-0BD4 — 3TY6563-0BF4 3TY6563-0BG4 3TY6563-0BQ4
3TB58 — — — — — — — obsolete

Main Contacts (Includes 3 Moving and 6 Fixed Contacts)2)


Frame
Size Catalog No
3TB40–43 Not Replaceable
3TB44 3TY6440-0A
3TB46 3TY6460-0A
3TB47 3TY6470-0A
3TB48 3TY6480-0A
3TB50 3TY6500-0A
3TB52 3TY6520-0A
3TB54 3TY6540-0A
3TB56 3TY6560-0A
3TY6500-0A 3TB58 3TY6580-0A

Select Complete Catalog Number From Above 1) Coil Voltages


Old Number New Number Old Number New Number
3TY6465-0A†† 3TY6463-0A†† A8 K6
3TY6485-0A†† 3TY6483-0A†† B8 M1
3TY6505-0A†† 3TY6503-0A†† C8 P6
3TY6525-0A†† 3TY6523-0A†† D8 Q0
3TY6545-0A†† 3TY6543-0A†† E8 S0
3TY6565-0A†† 3TY6566-0A†† F8 C1
G8 P0
Due to the mature nature of some product series, supply cannot be guaranteed on all versions listed on this page.

1)Some old 3TB coil catalog numbers have been superceded. Cross to current catalog number from these tables.
2)Main contact kits for size 3TB47 and larger include springs. Smaller sizes do not.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/103
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3TF World Series Contactors
Spare parts

Coils, AC Type 3TF and CRL†F


Catalog No
Frame 24V AC, 60Hz 120V AC, 60Hz 208V AC, 60Hz 240V AC, 60Hz 277V AC, 60Hz 460V AC, 60Hz 600V AC, 60Hz
Size 24V AC, 50Hz 110V AC, 50Hz 173V AC, 50Hz 220V AC, 50Hz 220V AC, 50Hz 380V AC, 50Hz 500V AC, 50Hz
3TF30–33
3TY7403-0AC2 3TY7403-0AK6 3TY7403-0AM1 3TY7403-0AP6 3TY7403-0AU1 3TY7403­-0AV0 3TY7403-0AS0
3TF40–43
3TF34–35,
3TY7443-0AC2 3TY7443-0AK6 3TY7443-0AM1 3TY7443-0AP6 3TY7443-0AU1 3TY7443-0AV0 3TY7443-0AS0
2

3 TY 7 4 0 3 - 0AK 6 3TF44–45
3TF46–47 3TY7463-0AC2 3TY7463-0AK6 3TY7463-0AM1 3TY7463-0AP6 3TY7463-0AU1 3TY7463-0AV0 3TY7463-0AS0
3TF48–49 3TY7483-0AC2 3TY7483-0AK6 3TY7483-0AM1 3TY7483-0AP6 3TY7483-0AU1 3TY7483-0AV0 3TY7483-0AS0
Contactors and
Assemblies

3TF50–51 3TY7503-0AC2 3TY7503-0AK6 3TY7503-0AM1 3TY7503-0AP6 3TY7503-0AU1 3TY7503-0AV0 3TY7503-0AS0


3TF52–53 3TY7523-0AC2 3TY7523-0AK6 3TY7523-0AM1 3TY7523-0AP6 3TY7523-0AU1 3TY7523-0AV0 3TY7523-0AS0
3TF54–55 3TY7543-0AC2 3TY7543-0AK6 3TY7543-0AM1 3TY7543-0AP6 3TY7543-0AU1 3TY7543-0AV0 3TY7543-0AS0
3TF56 3TY7563-0AC2 3TY7563-0AK6 3TY7563-0AM1 3TY7563-0AP6 3TY7563-0AU1 3TY7563-0AV0 3TY7563-0AS0
3TF57 —­ 3TY7573-0CF7 — 3TY7573-0CM7 — 3TY7573-0CQ7 —
3TF68 —­ 3TY7683-0CF7 — 3TY7683-0CM7 — 3TY7683-0CQ7 3TY7683-0CS7
3 TY 7 4 8 3 - 0A K6 3TF69 —­ 3TY7693-0CF7 — 3TY7693-0CM7 — 3TY7693-0CQ7 3TY7693-0CS7

Coils, DC Type 3TF and CRL†F


Catalog No
Frame
Size 12V DC 24V DC 42V DC 48V DC 110V DC 125V DC 240V DC
DC Solenoid
3TF30–33
3TY4803-0BA4 3TY4803-0BB4 3TY4803-0BD4 3TY4803-0BW4 3TY4803-0BF4 3TY4803-0BG4 3TY4803-0BQ4
3TF40–43
3TF34–35,
3TY7443-0BA4 3TY7443-0BB4 3TY7443-0BD4 3TY7443-0BW4 3TY7443-0BF4 3TY7443-0BG4 —
3TF44–45
3TF46–47 — 3TY7463-0BB4 3TY7463-0BD4 3TY7463-0BW4 — 3TY7463-0BG4 3TY7463-0BQ4
DC Economy Circuit (Replacement coils only. Does not include interlock or interposing relay.)
3TF46–47 — 3TY7463-0DB4 3TY7463-0DD4 3TY7463-0DW4 3TY7463-0DF4 3TY7463-0DG4 3TY7463-0DQ4
3TF48–49 — — 3TY7483-0DD4 3TY7483-0DW4 3TY7483-0DF4 3TY7483-0DG4 3TY7483-0DQ4
3T Y 4 8 0 3 - 0BB4 3TF50–51 — 3TY7503-0DB4 3TY7503-0DD4 3TY7503-0DW4 3TY7503-0DF4 3TY7503-0DG4 3TY7503-0DQ4
3TF52–53 — 3TY7523-0DB4 3TY7523-0DD4 3TY7523-0DW4 3TY7523-0DF4 3TY7523-0DG4 3TY7523-0DQ4
3TF54–55 — — 3TY7543-0DD4 3TY7543-0DW4 3TY7543-0DF4 3TY7543-0DG4 3TY7543-0DQ4
3TF56 — 3TY7563-0DB4 3TY7563-0DD4 3TY7563-0DW4 — 3TY7563-0DG4 3TY7563-0DQ4
3TF57 —­ 3TY7573-0DB4 3TY7573-0DD4 3TY7573-0DW4 3TY7573-0DF4 3TY7573-0DG4 3TY7573-0DQ4
3TF68 —­ 3TY7683-0DB4 — — 3TY7683-0DF4 — —

Main Contacts (Includes 3 Moving and 6 Fixed Contacts) Arc Chutes


Frame Frame
Size Catalog No List Price $ Size Catalog No
3TF30–35 Not Replaceable 3TF30–35 Not Replaceable
3TF40–43 Not Replaceable 3TF40–43 Not Replaceable
3TF44 3TY7440-0A 3TF44 3TY7442-0A
3TF45 3TY7450-0A 3TF45 3TY7452-0A
3TF46 3TY7460-0A 3TF46 3TY7462-0A
3TF47 3TY7470-0A 3TF47 3TY7472-0A
3TF48 3TY7480-0A 3TF48 3TY7482-0A
3TF49 3TY7490-0A 3TF50 3TY7502-0A
3TF50 3TY7500-0A 3TF51 3TY7512-0A­
3TF51 3TY7510-0A­ 3TF52 3TY7522-0A­
3TF52 3TY7520-0A­ 3TF53 3TY7532-0A­
3 T Y7 4 6 0 - 0A 3TF53 3TY7530-0A­ 3TY 7482-0A 3TF54 3TY7542-0A­
3TF54 3TY7540-0A­ 3TF55 3TY7552-0A­
3TF55 3TY7550-0A­ 3TF56 3TY7562-0A­
3TF56 3TY7560-0A­ 3TF57 3TY7572-0A­
3TF57 3TY7570-0A­ 3TF68 Not Available
3TF68 3TY7680-0B­1) 3TF69 Not Available
3TF69 3TY7690-0B­1)

Due to the mature nature of some product series, supply cannot be guaranteed on all versions listed on this page.
1) Vacuum bottles with mounting hardware.

2/104 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3TF Contactors and 3TH Control Relays
Spare parts

Auxiliary Contact Blocks


Auxiliary Contacts NO/Early NC/Early Auxiliary Contact Block Obsolete Current
Illustration Frame Size NO NC Make Break Mounting Position Position Location Catalog No Catalog
1 — — — — Top — 3TX4010-2A
— 1 — — — Top — 3TX4001-2A
3TF30 to 3TF35,
— — 1 — — Top — 3TX4010-4A
3TH3
— — — 1 — Top — 3TX4001-4A
3TF40 to 3TF43 Not Replaceable

2
3TF44 to 3TF68 1 1 — — 3 1 2 4 1 Left 3TY7561-1A 3TY7561-1AA00
1 1 — — 2 Right 3TY7561-1B 3TY7561-1AA00

Assemblies
Contactors and
1 — — 1 4 Right 3TY7561-1K 3TY7561-1EA00
3TF46 to 3TF68 1 1 — — 3 Left 3TY7561-1K 3TY7561-1KA00
3T Y 7 5 6 1 - 1A 2nd Aux Contact Block 1 1 — — 4 Right 3TY7561-1L 3TY75611KA00
3TF46 to 3TF68 1 1 — — 3 Left 3TY7561-1U 3TY7561-1UA00
For Electronic Circuits 1 1 — — 4 Right 3TY7561-1V 3TY7561-1UA00

Mechanical Interlocks
Frame
Size Catalog No
3TF44-54 3TX7466-1A
3 T X7 4 6 6 - 1A

Arc Chutes
Frame Frame
Type Size Catalog No List Price $ Size Catalog No
3TB40–43 Not Replaceable 3TB50 3TY6502-0A
3TB44 — 3TB52 3TY6522-0A
3TB 3TB46 — 3TB54 3TY6542-0A
3TB47 — 3TB56 3TY6562-0A

3 T Y6 4 6 2 - 0A 3TB48 3TY6482-0A 3TB58 —

Control Relays, Type 3TH3, 3TH4 Coils, AC


Catalog No
Frame
Type Size 24V AC 120V AC 208V AC 220/240V AC 277V AC 480V AC 600V AC
3TH30–33
3TH 3TY7403-0AC2 3TY7403-0AK6 3TY7403-0AM1 3TY7403-0AP6 3TY7403-0AU1 3TY7403-0AV0 3TY7403-0AS0
3TH40–43
3TY7403-0AK6

Coils, DC
Catalog No
Frame
Type Size 12V DC 24V DC 42V DC 48V DC 110V DC 125V DC 240V DC

3TH30–33
3TH 3TY4803-0BA4 3TY4803-0BB4 3TY4803-0BD4 3TY4803-0BW4 3TY4803-0BF4 3TY4803-0BG4 3TY4803-0BQ4
3TH40–43

Auxiliary Contact Blocks1)


Auxiliary Contacts
Frame Normally Open/ Normally Closed/
Type Size NO NC Early Make Late Break Block Location Catalog No
1 — — — Top 3TX4010-2A
— 1 — — Top 3TX4001-2A
3TH 3TH3
— — 1 — Top 3TX4010-4A
— — — 1 Top 3TX4001-4A

Control Relays, Type 3TH8 Coils, AC


Catalog No List
Frame
Type Size 24V AC 120V AC 208V AC 220/240V AC 277V AC 480V AC 600V AC Price $
3TH 3TH80–83 3TY7403-0AC2 3TY7403-0AK6 3TY7403-0AM1 3TY7403-0AP6 3TY7403-0AU1 3TY7403-0AV0 3TY7403-0AS0

Coils, DC
Catalog No List
Frame
Type Size 12V AC 24V AC 42V AC 48V AC 110V AC 125V AC 240V AC Price $
3TH 3TH80–83 3TY4803-0BA4 3TY4803-0BB4 3TY4803-0BD4 3TY4803-0BW4 3TY4803-0BF4 3TY4803-0BG4 3TY4803-0BQ4

Due to the mature nature of some product series, supply cannot be guaranteed on all versions listed on this page.
1) Maximum 4 blocks per relay.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/105
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT contactors, 3-pole, sizes S00 to S3

3RT20 1. contactors (size S00),


AC and DC operation Motor protection Terminal designations acc. to EN 50 012 or DIN 50 005.
IEC 60 947, EN 60 947 3RU overload relays can be Contactors, EN 50012,
(VDE 0660), UL 508 mounted onto the 3RT contac- 1 aux. contact
tors for protection against over-
loads. The overload relays must
Design be ordered separately (see
section 3).
The 3RT contactors are suit-
2

able for use in any climate.


They are safe from touch to Surge suppression
Contactors and
Assemblies

DIN VDE 0106 Part 100. Ident. No. 10E Ident. No. 01
The 3RT contactors are avail- The 3RT contactors can be
able screw, spring-type, or retrofitted with RC elements,
varistors, diodes or diode Aux. switch blocks, Aux. switch blocks,
ring lug connections. assemblies (combination of an EN 50012, EN 50005,
An auxiliary contact is inte- interference suppression diode 4, 3 or 1 contacts 4 or 2 contacts
grated in the basic unit of size and a Zener diode for short trip-
S00 contactors. The basic units ping times) for suppressing
of sizes S0 to S3 only contain opening surges in the coil.
the main conducting paths.
The surge suppressors are
All the basic units can be plugged onto the front of size
extended with auxiliary switch S00 contactors. Space is pro-
blocks. Cabinet units with 2 NO Ident. No. 32E, Ident. No. 40, 31,
vided for them next to a snap-
+ 2 NC (terminal designations on auxiliary switch block. 23E, 22E, 11E 22, 20, 11, 02, 03, 04
acc. to EN 50 012) are avail-
able as of size S0; the auxiliary With all size S0 to S3 contac-
switch block is removable. tors, varistors and RC elements
Contactors, Contactors,
can be plugged on directly at EN 50012 EN 50005,
The size S3 contactors have the coil terminals, either on the 5, 4 or 2 5 or 3
removable box terminals for the top or underneath. Diode aux. contacts aux. contacts
main conductor connections. assemblies are available in two
Ring cable lugs or bars can different designs with different
thus also be connected. polarities. Depending on the
application, they can be
attached either only on the bot- NSB0_02062a
Contact reliability tom (assembly with circuit-
breaker) or only on the top
If voltages ≤ 110 V and currents Ident. No. 32E, Ident. No. 40, 31,
(assembly with overload relay).
≤ 100 mA are to be switched, 23E, 22E, 11E 22, 20, 11, 02, 03, 04
the auxiliary contacts of 3RT The plug-in direction of the
contactors and 3RH contac- diodes and diode assemblies is
tor relays should be used to determined by a coding with identification numbers
Auxiliary switch blocks
ensure good contact stability. device. Exceptions: 40 to 02. The identification
3RT29 26-1E.00 and The 3RT basic units can be numbers on the auxiliary switch
These auxiliary contacts are blocks apply only to the
3RT19 36-1T.00; in these cases extended with various auxiliary
suitable for electronic circuits attached auxiliary contacts.
the plug-in direction is identi- switch blocks, depending on
with currents ≥ 1 mA at a volt-
fied by "+" and "–". the application: Single or 2-pole auxiliary switch
age of 17 V.
Coupling relays are supplied Size S00 (3RT201) blocks that can be connected
either without surge suppres- on either the top or the bottom
Short-circuit protection of sion or with a varistor or diode Contactors with one NO contact facilitate quick, straightforward
contactors connected as standard, as the auxiliary contact and wiring, especially when assem-
according to the design. with either screw or bling feeders. These auxiliary
For the short-circuit protection spring-type connections, iden- switch blocks are only available
of contactors without an over- tification number 10E, can be with screw-type terminals.
load relay, see the technical Note extended to obtain contactors
data. The opening times of the NO with 2, 4 or 5 auxiliary contacts The solid-state compatible
contacts and the closing times in accordance with EN 50 012 3RH29 11-1NF.. auxiliary switch
For the short-circuit protection using auxiliary switch blocks. blocks for size S00 contactors
of the NC contacts increase if
of contactors with an overload The identification numbers 11E, contain two enclosed contact
the contactor coils are pro-
relay, see section 3. 22E, 23E and 32E on the auxil- elements. They are ideal for
tected against voltage peaks
(interference suppression iary switch blocks apply to the switching low voltages and cur-
diode 6 to 10 times; diode complete contactors. These rents (hard gold-plated con-
assemblies 2 to 6 times; varis- auxiliary switch blocks cannot tacts) or for use in dusty atmo-
tor +2 ms to 5 ms). be combined with contactors sphere. The contacts do not
that have an NC contact in their have positively-driven opera-
basic unit, identification num- tion.
ber 01, as these are coded. All the above-mentioned auxil-
All size S00 contactors with one iary switch variants can be
auxiliary contact, identification snapped into the location holes
number 10E or 01, and the con- on the front of the contactors.
tactors with 4 main contacts The auxiliary switch block has a
can be extended to obtain con- centrally positioned release
tactors with 3 or 5 auxiliary con- lever for disassembly.
tacts (contactors with 4 main
contacts: 2 or 4 auxiliary con-
tacts) according to EN 50 005
using auxiliary switch blocks

2/106 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT2 contactors, 3-pole, sizes S00 to S3

3RT20 2. to 3RT20 4. contactors (sizes S0 to S3), 3RT20 2. to 3RT20 4. contactors (sizes S0 to S3),
single-pole auxiliary switch blocks, single-pole auxiliary switch blocks,
terminal designations acc. to EN 50 005 or EN 50 012. terminal designations acc. to EN 50 005 or EN 50 012.

2
Assemblies
Contactors and
1 NC

Sizes S0 to S3 (3RT202 to In addition, 2-pole auxiliary The laterally mountable auxil- Sizes S0 and S2 (3RT202
3RT204) switch blocks (screw-type ter- iary switch blocks to EN 50 012 and 3RT203)
minals) are provided for cable can only be used if no 4-pole
An extensive range of auxiliary Up to four auxiliary contacts can
entries from above or below in auxiliary switch blocks are
switch blocks is available for be mounted, whereby any
the style of a four-connector snapped onto the front. If sin-
various applications. The con- design of the auxiliary switch
block (feeder auxiliary switch). gle-pole auxiliary switch blocks
tactors themselves do not have blocks is permitted. If two 2-
are used in addition, the loca-
an integrated auxiliary conduct- If the available installation pole, laterally mounted, auxil-
tion digits on the contactor
ing path. depth is restricted, 2-pole auxil- iary switch blocks are used, one
must be noted.
iary switch blocks (screw or must be mounted on the left and
The auxiliary switch variants
spring-type connections) can Two enclosed contact ele- one on the right for the sake of
are identical for all size S0 to
be mounted laterally on the left ments and two standard con- symmetry.
S3 contactors.
or right. tact elements are available for
Under certain circumstances,
One 4-pole or up to four single- the 3RH29 21-.FE22 solid-state
The auxiliary switch blocks more auxiliary contacts are
pole auxiliary switch blocks (with compatible auxiliary switch
designed for mounting onto the allowed for size S2 (please ask
screw or spring-type connec- block mountable on the front.
front can be disassembled with for details).
tions) can be snapped onto the The laterally mountable
the aid of a centrally positioned
front of the contactors. When the 3RH29 21-2DE11 solid-state With regard to 3RT23 and
release lever; the laterally
contactors are energized, the compatible auxiliary switch 3RT24 4-pole contactors,
mountable auxiliary switch
NC contacts open before the block contains 2 enclosed con- please refer to pages 2/12 to 2/14.
blocks can be removed easily
NO contacts close. tact elements (1 NO + 1 NC).
by pressing on the fluted grips.
The enclosed contact elements Sizes S3 to S12 (3RT204 to
The terminal designations of the
The terminal designations of are ideal for switching low volt- 3RT107)
single-pole auxiliary switch
the individual auxiliary switch ages and currents (hard gold-
blocks consist of location digits Up to eight auxiliary contacts
blocks comply with EN 50 005 plated contacts) or for use in a
on the basic unit and function can be mounted, whereby the
or EN 50 012, while those of the dusty atmosphere. The con-
digits on the auxiliary switch following points must be noted:
complete contactors with an tacts are positively driven.
blocks. • Of these eight auxiliary con-
auxiliary switch block with 2 NO
+ 2 NC comply with EN 50 012. tacts, no more than four must
be NC contacts.
• If laterally mounted auxiliary
switch blocks are used, they
must be symmetrical.
With regard to 3RT15 4-pole
contactors, please refer
to pages 2/13 to 2/15.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/107


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT1 contactors, 3-pole, sizes S6 to S12

Overview

Design
• 3RT10 contactors for switch- Operating mechanism Withdrawable coils Auxiliary contact complement
ing motors
Two types of solenoid-oper- To allow easy coil changing, for The contactors can be
• 3RT12 vacuum contactors for ated mechanism are available: example if the application is equipped with a maximum of
switching motors changed, the magnetic coil can 8 auxiliary contacts, with iden-
• Conventional operating mech-
2

• 3RT14 contactors for AC-1 anism be pulled out upwards without tical auxiliary switch blocks
applications tools after the release mecha- from S0 to S12. Of these, no
• Solid-state operating mecha- nism has been actuated, and more than 4 are permitted to be
Contactors and
Assemblies

nism can be replaced by any other NC contacts.


(with 3 performance levels) required coil of the same size. • 3RT10 and 3RT14 contac-
UC operation tors: auxiliary contacts
mounted laterally and on front
The contactors can be AC
(40 to 60 Hz) and DC driven. • 3RT12 vacuum contactors:
auxiliary contact mounted lat-
erally
Contactors with conventional operating mechanism
3RT1...-.A:
The magnetic coil is switched Multi-voltage range for the con- In addition, allowance is also contactor switches reliably and
on and off directly with the con- trol supply voltage Us: made for a coil voltage toler- no thermal overloading occurs.
trol supply voltage Us via termi- Several closely adjacent control ance of 0.8 times the lower
nals A1/A2. supply voltages, available rated control supply voltage
around the world, are covered (Us min) and 1.1 times the upper
by just one coil, for example rated control supply voltage
UC 110-115-120-127 V or (Us max), within which the
UC 220-230-240 V.

Contactors with solid-state operating mechanism


The power required for reliable • Extended coil voltage toler- • Defined ON and OFF thresh- Electromagnetic compatibility
switching and holding is sup- ance 0.7 to 1.25 × Us: olds: (EMC)
plied selectively to the magnetic On account of the broad As of voltages ≥ 0.8 × Us min, The contactors with solid-state
coil by series-connected control range for the rated control the electronics reliably switch operating mechanism conform
electronics. supply voltage and the addi- the contactor on and as of to the requirements for opera-
tionally allowed coil voltage ≤ 0.5 × Us min it is reliably tion in industrial plants.
Features: tolerance of 0.8 × Us min to 1.1 switched off. The differential
× Us max, an extended coil volt- travel in the switching thresh- • Noise immunity
• Extended voltage range for – Burst (IEC 61 000-4-4): 4 kV
the control supply voltage Us: age tolerance of at least 0.7 to olds prevents chattering of
1.25 × Us, within which the the main contacts and hence – Surge (IEC 61 000-4-5): 4 kV
Compared with the conven- contactors will operate reli- increased wear or welding – Electrostatic discharge,
tional operating mechanism, ably, is available for the most when operated in weak, ESD (IEC 61 000-4-2): 8/15 kV
the solid-state operating common control supply volt- unstable networks. Similarly, – Electromagnetic field
mechanism covers an even ages of 24, 110 and 230 V. thermal overloading of the (IEC 61 000-4-3): 10 V/m
broader range of globally contactor coil is prevented if • Emitted interference
available control supply volt- • Bridging short-time voltage
dips: the voltage applied is too low Limiting value class A to
ages within one coil variant. – the contactor is not EN 55 011
For example, the globally Control voltage failures dip- switched on and is operated
available voltages 200-208- ping to 0 V (at A1/A2) are with overexcitation. Note:
220-230-240-254-277 V are bridged for up to approx. In connection with converters,
covered with the coil for UC 25 ms, therefore preventing • Low control power consump- the control cables should be
200 to 277 V (Us min to Us max). unintentional disconnection. tion when closing and in installed separately from the
closed state. load cables to the converter.

3RT1...-.N: for DC 24 V PLC output


2 control options:
• Control without an interface • Conventional control by
directly via a DC 24 V /≥ 30 applying the control supply
mA PLC output (EN 61 131- voltage at A1/A2 via a switch-
2). Connection via a 2-pole ing contact.
plug-in connection; the con-
nector, using screwless Note:
spring-force technology, is The sliding-dolly switch must
included in the scope of sup- be in the "PLC OFF" position
ply. The control supply volt- (= setting ex works).
age for supplying power to
the solenoid operating mech-
anism must be connected to
A1/A2. Sliding-dolly switch, must $ Sliding-dolly switch, must
Note: be in PLC "ON" position be in PLC "OFF" position
Before start-up, the sliding- Plug-in connection, 2-pole
dolly switch for PLC operation
must be moved to the "PLC ON"
position (setting ex works:
"PLC OFF").

2/108 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Technical data
I/O configuration (hex) 7
ID code (hex)
Contactors
Power supply and Contactor Assemblies V
F
26.5 to 31.6 (in accordance with AS-Interface specification)
SIRIUS
AS-Interface current input
Contactors for Switching Motors
Contact loading at SF1/2
mA
mA
max. 20
3 to 6
Watchdog function (disconnection of outputs in event of AS-Interface fault) Built-in
3RT1 contactors, 3-pole, sizes S6 to S12
Indication LED Statuses Status description
During operation, the LEDs
Overview AS-Interface ON ON Flashing Flashing
on the contactor indicate the
states shown
Contactors opposite.
with green
solid-state operating mechanism Station address 0
red
3RT1...-.P: for DC 24 V PLC output or PLC relay output, with indication of remaining lifetime No AS-Interface communication
yellow
(Indication of remaining lifetime RLT: see 2/69.) AS-Interface communication OK
Diagnosing the contactors using•the application program
The remaining lifetime RLT 2 control options:
• Inputs status signal is available at • Outputs
• Contactor control without an • Contactor control via relay
Input signals terminals R1/R2
Device status via a floating interface directly via a
Output signals outputs,
Device e.g. by
status

2
relay contact (hard gold- DC 24 V "running"
/≥ 30 mA – PLC
DI0 "ready" 0 plated,
Device not ready/manual
enclosed) and can beoperation DO0 0 Contactor off
PLC output (EN 61 131-2) via – SIMOCODE-DP 3UF5
1 processed
Device ready/automatic
for exampleoperation
via 1 Contactor on
terminals IN+/IN-. via terminals H1/H2.

Assemblies
Contactors and
DI1 "running" 0 SIMOCODE-DP
Contactor off or PLC inputs DO1 0 Contact
– loading:
1 or elsewhere.
Contactor on 1 Us–/approx. 5 mA.
DI2 "remaining lifetime" 0 Permissible current
Remaining lifetime RLTcarrying
> 20 % DO2 0 –
When operated via SIMO-
1 capacity
Remainingoflifetime
relay output
RLT ≤ 20R1/
% 1CODE-DP,
– a communication
DI3 "free input" R2:
0 No input signal at SF1/2 DO3 0link –to PROFIBUS-DP is also
– Ie/AC-15/24 to 230 V: 3 A
1 Input signal at SF1/2 1provided.

– Ie/DC-13/24 V: 1 A

Indication of remaining lifetime (RLT)


• LED indicators
Main contactor contacts are operations
The following– these offerare
statuses no Advantages:
wearing parts and must be information
indicated byabout
LEDscontact wear
on the lat- • Signalling via a relay contact • Advice to change contacts at
replaced in good time when –erally
but instead
mounted entails determin-
electronics or AS-i when a remaining life- the appropriate time.
they reach the end of their ser- ing and evaluating the actual
module: time of 20module
Electronics % is reached,
of 3RT1 i. e. • Optimum utilization of the
vice life. The degree of erosion progress
– Contactorof erosion of each of
ON (energized when
...-.P the contact material is
contactor contact material.
of the contact material and thestate):
three main contacts by 80 % worn.
Plug-in connection, 7-pole • Visual inspection of the condi-
hence the electrical endurance electronic
Green LED means; the results
("ON") S1•Changeover
Additional switch
visual from
indication
auto- of tion of contacts no longer
(= number of make-break oper- are stored, and
– Indication a warninglife-
of remaining is various
matic levels
control of erosion
via PLC semi- via necessary.
ations)
To supplyvaries,
powerdepending
to the solenoidon time (see
issued when2/69)
specified limits are conductor output to local
LEDs on the laterally mounted • Reduction of ongoing operat-
the loading,
operating utilizationand
mechanism category,
the reached. Even if the control control
electronics modules when a ing costs.
duty type lifetime
remaining etc. Routine inspec-
indication, supply voltage at A1/A2 fails, S2 Local controllifetime
remaining option of 60 % Electronics module of 3RT1
•...-.P
Optimum planning of mainte-
the control supply
tions/visual checks voltage Us
by mainte- the stored data is not lost. After contactor
(green), 40 % (orange) and nance measures.
Plug-in connection, 7-pole
must
nance bestaff
run are
to terminals
needed in A1/A2
order the main contacts are replaced, 20 % (red) is reached. • Avoidance of unforeseen
Possibility of switching from auto-
of
tothe laterally the
determine mounted
state of elec-
the measurement of the remaining S1 Changeover switch from auto-
plantcontrol,
stoppages.
matic control to local control via matic e.g. via
tronics module. The
main contacts. The control
"remaining lifetime must be reset with the terminals H1/H2, i.e. automatic SIMOCODE-DP or PLC relay
inputs
lifetimeofindication"
the contactor are takes
facility "RESET" button (hold down the control via a PLC or SIMOCODE- output to local control
brought out to a 7-pole
over this task. This does plug-in
not RESET button for approx. 2 DP/PROFIBUS-DP can be deac- S2 Local control option
connection; the connector,
comprise counting the make- sec. with a ball-point pen or tivated, for example during
using
break screwless spring-force similar tool). start-up or in the event of a
technology, is included in the
fault, and the contactor can be
scope of supply.
controlled manually.

3RT1...-.Q: communication-capable with integrated AS-Interface and indication of remaining lifetime


3RT12 vacuum contactors Inputs and outputs are brought Control circuit:
out to a 10-pole plug-in connec-
In contrast with the 3RT10 con- They are therefore particularly Notes on operation:
• Contactor control through This additional equipment is
tion; the connectors (6-pole for
tactors – the main contacts oper- well suited to frequent switching
external connection and 4-pole
– Switching motors
AS-Interface with rated
via terminals not required for operation in
in an
jogging/mixed operation, AS-i+/AS-i–. Terminals
voltagesAS-i+
ate in air under atmospheric for AS-Interface) using for operational Ue circuits with converters. It
conditions – the contact gaps example in crane control sys- and> AS-i–
500 V:are each brought might be damaged by the
screwless spring-force technol-
of the 3RT12 vacuum contac- tems. outIntwice
ordertotoa damp
4-poleovervolt-
connec- voltage peaks and harmonics
ogy, are included in the scope
tors are contained in hermeti- torages
separate
and from thethe
protect other
motor generated.
ofAdvantages:
supply.
cally enclosed vacuum contact control
windinginputs and areagainst
insulation jum-
• Very long electrical endurance – Switching DC voltage:
tubes. Neither arcs nor arcing pered.
multiple reignition when
gases are produced. The partic- • •LED
High short-time current-carry-
indicators: switching off three-phase
Vacuum contactors are basi-
ing capacity for heavy starting Advantages: cally unsuitable for switching
ular benefit of 3RT12 vacuum •The
Nofollowing
open arcs,statuses are
no arcing motors,
– The it is recommended
AS-Interface cable is to DC voltage.
contactors, however, is that indicated
gases, i.e.by no
LEDs on the clear-
minimum lat- fit the
not contactors
interrupted on the
when the out-
their electrical endurance is at erally
ances mounted electronics
from earthed parts going sideis(T1/T2/T3)
connector removed with the $ Electronics module of 3RT1
least twice as long as that of module:
required either 3RT19
– The 66-1PV.remains
contactor surge sup- ...-.Q contactor
3RT10 contactors. •– Longer
Contactor ON (energized
maintenance intervals pressionofmodule
capable – RC
operation viavaris-
the % Plug-in connection, 6-pole
state):
• Increased plant availability tor – control
local (accessory).
inputs via its & Plug-in connection, 4-pole
Green LED ("ON") own 6-pole connector. S1 Changeover switch from auto-
– Automatic/local control: matic control, e.g. via AS-
Green LED ("AUTO") • Control signals via AS-i:
Interface, to local control
– Bus status: – Contactor ON/OFF · S1 open: automatic mode
Green/red dual LED ("AS-i") • Status signals via AS-i: S2 Local control option
– Remaining lifetime RLT (see – Contactor ON/OFF
separate description 2/16) – Automatic/local control Possibility of switching from
To supply power to the solenoid – Remaining lifetime RLT automatic control to to local
operating mechanism and the – Signal via free input, e.g. control via terminals H1/H2/H3,
• AS-Interface address jack
remaining lifetime indication, overload relay tripped. i.e. automatic control via AS-
"ADDR":
the control supply voltage Us Interface can be deactivated, for
must be run to terminals A1/A2 The contactor address can be example during start-up up or in
of the laterally mounted elec- assigned in the built-in state. the event of a fault, and the
tronics module. The contactor contactor can be controlled
itself is controlled via the inte- manually.
grated AS-Interface.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/109


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactor Assemblies for Switching Motors
Contactor assemblies for WYE-delta starting

Overview
The contactor assemblies for
star-delta starting can be
ordered as follows:
• Sizes S00-S0 as assemblies. (see pages 2/47-2/48)
• Sizes S2-S12 as components for customer assembly
2

Calculated Size Accessories for


Contactors and
Assemblies

horsepower customer assembly


ratings
at 460 V AC
Operat. Motor current Line/delta WYE contactor Time-delay relay Installation kit A
current Ie contactor double
HP A A infeed

30 50 9.5 ... 13.8 S2-S2-S0 3RT2028 3RT2026 3RP2574-1N.30 3RA2933-2C 3)


12.1 ... 17.2
15.5 ... 21.5
19 ... 27.6
24.1 ... 34
31 ... 43
37.9 ... 55.2
48.3 ... 65 3RT2935
50 80 62.1 ... 77.8 S2-S2-S2 3RT2035 3RA2933-2BB1 3)
60 86 69 ... 86 3RT2036
75 115 31 ... 43.1 S3-S3-S2 3RT2045 3RT2035 3RP2574-1N.30 3RA2943-2C 3)
37.9 ... 55.2
48.3 ... 69
62.1 ... 77.6
77.6 ... 108.6
100 150 98.3 ... 129.3 3RT2045 3RT2036
120.7 ... 150

125 160 86 ... 160 S6-S6-S3 3RT1054 3RT2045 3RP2574-1N.30


150 195 86 ... 195
190 230 86 ... 230 3RT1055 3RT2046
200 280 86 ... 280 3RT1056 3RT2046
250 350 95 ... 350 S10-S10-S6 3RT1064 3RT1054 3RP2574-1N.30
300 430 95 ... 430 3RT1065 3RT1056
400 540 347 ... 540 S12-S12-S10 3RT1075 3RT1064 3RP2574-1N.30
450 610 347 ... 610
500 690 347 ... 690 3RT1065

650 850 347 ... 850 3RT1076 3RT1066

Foraccessories,
For accessories,see
see page
page 2/50.
2/85. 1) The installation kit contains mechanical inter- 2) The installation kit contains 5 connecting clips;
Forcircuit
circuitdiagrams,
diagrams, see page 2/162. lock; 3 connecting clips; wiring connectors on wiring connectors on the top (connection
For see page 2/202. the top (connection between line contactor and between line contactor and delta contactor) and
delta contactor) and the bottom (connection the bottom (connection between delta contactor
between delta contactor and star contactor); and WYE contactor); star jumper.
WYE jumper.

2/110 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactor Assemblies for Switching Motors
Contactor assemblies for WYE-delta starting

2
Overload relay, thermal Overload relay, solid-state

Assemblies
Contactors and
Installation kit B WYE jumper Baseplates Range of Order No. Range of Order No.
for single infeed overload relay, overload relay, overload relay, overload relay,
thermal [A] thermal solid-state [A] solid-state

3RA1933-3D 4) 3RT1926-4BA31 3RA2932-2E 5.5 ... 8 3RU2136-1HB – –


7 ... 10 3RU2136-1JB0 12.5 ... 50 3RB3036-1UB0
9 ... 12.5 3RU2136-1KB0
11 ... 16 3RU2136-4AB0
14 ... 20 3RU2136-4BB0
18 ... 25 3RU2136-4DB0
22 ... 32 3RU2136-4EB0 20 ... 80 3RB3036-1WB0
28 ... 40 3RU2136-4FB0
3RT1936-4BA31 3RA2932-2F 36 ... 45 3RU2136-4GB0
40 ... 50 3RU2136-4HB0
3RA1943-3D 4) 3RT1946-4BA31 3RA2942-2E 28 ... 40 3RU2146-4FB0 12.5 ... 50 3RB3046-1UB0
36 ... 45 3RU2146-4HB0
45 ... 63 3RU2146-4JB0
57 ... 75 3RU2146-4KB0
70 ... 90 3RU2146-4LB0 32 ... 115 3RB3046-1XB0
80 ... 100 7) 3RU2146-4MB0

3RA1953-3D 5) 3RT1946-4BA31 3RA1952-2E – – 50 ... 200 3RB2056-1FC2

3) Installation kit contains wiring connector on the 5) A mechanical interlock adapter, 3RA1954-2G, is 6) Only use wiring connector on the top from
bottom (connection between delta contactor required to use the standard 3RA1954-2A reversing contactor assembly (note conductor
and WYE contactor) and WYE jumper. mechanical interlock for the AC version of the cross-sections); order WYE jumper in addition.
4) Wiring connector on top from reversing contac- S6-S6-S3 WYE-Delta starter. The S6-S6-S3 7) For overload relays >100A, see 3RB2 electronic
tor assembly (note conductor cross-sections). WYE-Delta DC version would require a special Section 3, page 23.
custom build spacer, which is not manufactured,
to allow the mechanical interlock to operate.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/111


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactor Assemblies for Switching Motors
Contactor assemblies for WYE-delta starting

The ratings given in the above Motor protection


Application Design
table are only applicable to mo-
WYE-delta starting can only be tors with a starting current ratio Components for customer as- Overload relays or thermistor
used either if the motor normally of IA ≤8.4 × IN and using either sembly motor protection tripping units
operates in a d (delta) connec- a 3RT19 16-2G or 3RT19 26-2G can be used for overload pro-
tion or starts softly or if the load Installation kits with wiring con- tection.
solid-state time-delay auxiliary nectors and, if necessary,
torque during * starting is low switch block with a WYE-delta The overload relay can be ei-
and does not increase sharply. mechanical connectors are
function or a 3RP1574 WYE- available for contactor assem- ther mounted onto the line con-
On the *step the motors can delta time-delay relay with a tactor or separately fitted. It
blies for WYE-delta starting.
2

carry approximately 50 % (class dead interval of approximately must be set to 0.58 times the
KL 16) or 30 % (class KL 10) of Contactors, overload relays,
50 ms on reversing. star-delta time-delay relays and rated motor current.
their rated torque; the starting
For the circuit diagrams for the auxiliary switches for the elec-
Contactors and
Assemblies

torque is approximately 1/3 of


that during direct on-line start- main and control circuits, see trical interlock – if required also
page 2/161. The size selected feeder terminals, mechanical Surge suppression
ing. The starting current is
approximately 2 to 2.7 times the for the installation kits for WYE- interlocks 1) and baseplates –
Sizes S00 to S3
rated motor current. delta starting is determined by must be ordered separately.
the line contactor. The wiring installation kits for All contactor assemblies can
The changeover from * to d be fitted with RC elements,
sizes S00 and S0 contain the
must not be effected until the varistors or diode assemblies
top and bottom main conduct-
motor has run up to rated for damping opening surges in
ing path connections between
speed. Drives which require this the coil.
the line and delta contactors
changeover to be performed
(top) and between the delta As with the individual contac-
earlier are unsuitable for WYE-
and WYE contactors (bottom). tors, the surge suppressors can
delta starting.
In the case of sizes S2 to S12 either be plugged onto the top
only the bottom main conduct- of the contactors (S00) or fitted
ing path connection between onto the coil terminals on the
the delta and WYE contactors is top or bottom (S0 to S3).
included in the wiring connec-
Sizes S6 to S12
tor, owing to the larger conduc-
tor cross-section at the infeed. The contactors are fitted with
varistors as standard.

1) Exception:
The mechanical interlock between the delta and
WYE contactors is included in the installation kit
for size S00 contactor assemblies.

2/112 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


SIRIUS
3RA23, 3RA24 Contactor Assemblies
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies

Contactor Assemblies
3RA24 Contactor for Switching
Assemblies Motors
for Wye-Delta Starting
LV1N_03_05.fm Page 38 Friday, October 18, 2013 3:24 PM

Contactor assemblies for WYE-delta starting Contactor Assemblies for Star-Delta (Wye-Delta) Starting
3RA24 complete units, 5.5 ... 22 kW
3RA23, 3RA24 Contactor Assemblies
Selection and ordering data
3RA24 Contactor Assemblies for Wye-Delta Starting
SIRIUS 3RA24 contactor assemblies for star-delta (wye-delta) starting, up to 90 kW
Fully
Fully wired
wired and
and tested
tested contactor
contactor assembliesfor
assemblies · Size S00-S00-S00
star-delta · Up to
(wye-delta) 11 kW · Size S00-S00-S00 · Up to 11 kW
starting
3RA24
TheThe
figure complete
figure shows
shows thethe units,
version
version 5.5
with
with ... 22terminals
screw
screw kW
terminals

Selection and ordering data 16 6

2
Fully wired and tested contactor assemblies · Size S00-S00-S00 · Up to 11 kW
The figure shows the version with screw terminals

Assemblies
Contactors and
9 6

3
3

16
7

6
5
3

1 5

1 2

IC01_00625a
7 2

4 5
4

NSB0_02066a
1 3

7 6 2
6
4

NSB0_02066a
Mountable accessories 8
Fully wired and tested contactor
3 assemblies
Individual parts Order No. Page Individual parts Order No. Page
8 6
Q111) Q132) Q122)
16 Three-phase feeder terminal3) 3RA29 13-3K 4 1 2 3 Contactor, 5.5 kW 3RT20 15 3RT20 15 3RT20 15
Mountable accessories (optional) Complete contactor assembly for star-delta (wye-delta) starting
1 2 3 Contactor, 7.5 kW 3RT20 17 3RT20 17 3RT20 15
To be ordered separately Type Page Individual parts Type Page
Mountable accessories Fully
1 2 wired and tested
3 Contactor, 11 kW contactor assemblies
3RT20 18 3RT20 18 3RT20 16
Q112) Q13 Q12
Individual parts Order No. Page In
4di5vid6ualAssembly
parts kit O rder N13-2BB1
3RA29 o. Page
9 Three-phase infeed terminal1) 3RA2913-3K 3/110 2/85 1 2 3 Contactors, 5.5 kW
comprising 3RT2015 3RT2015 3RT2015 2/8 3/57
3/50,
Q111) Q132) Q122)
1 2 13 2 Contactors, 7.5 kW interlock 3RT2017 3RT2017 3RT2015 3/50,
4 Mechanical 2/8 3/57
16 Three-phase feeder terminal3) 3RA29 13-3K 4 3 Contactor, 5.5 kW 3RT20 15 3RT20 15 3RT20 15
1 2 3 Contactors, 5 4 11 kW
connecting clips 3RT2018 3RT2018 3RT2016 3/50, 2/8 3/57
1 2 3 Contactor, 7.5 kW 3RT20 17 3RT20 17 3RT20 15
4 ... 7 Assembly kit S00-S00-S00
6 Wiring modules on the3RA2913-2BB1
top and bottom 2/85
3/106
3 Contactor, 11 kW
1 2 comprising: 3RT20 18 3RT20 18 3RT20 16
for connecting the main current paths
7 5 46 Assembly
4 Mechanical
Function kitinterlock
modules 3RA29
3RA28 13-2BB1
16-0EW20
comprising
for wye-delta starting
5 Four connecting clips for three contactors
1) Use version with 1 NO. 4 Mechanical interlock
6 Note:
Wiring modules on top and bottom for
2) Use version with 1 NC. 5 4 connecting
connecting clips
the main and auxiliary circuits
7 6
WhenWiring
the function modules for contactor assemblies for wye-
3) Part
16 can only be mounted with contactors with screw terminal. Star jumpermodules on the top and bottom
deltaforstarting are used,
connecting no current
the main other auxiliary
paths switches are allowed
2/29
8 Functionbemodules
toFunction
mounted for star-delta 3RA2816-0EW20
on the basic 3/101
7 (wye-delta) modules
starting 3RA28units.
16-0EW20
for wye-delta starting
1)
1)
PartUse
9 version
can only with
be 1mounted
NO. in the case of contactors with screw terminal. Note:
Complete contactor assemblies for star-delta (wye-delta)
2)
2) TheUse version
version withwith
1 NO1 NC.
is required for momentary-contact operation. starting
When thesee page 3/174.
function modules for contactor assemblies for wye-
3) Part
16 can only be mounted with contactors with screw terminal. delta starting are used, no other auxiliary switches are allowed
to be mounted on the basic units.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/113


3/38 SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012
IC10_03_10.fm Page 168 Wednesday, February 28, 2018 3:29 PM

Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS


3RA23, 3RA24 Contactor Assemblies
Contactor Assemblies
3RA24 Contactor for Switching
Assemblies for Wye-DeltaMotors
Starting
Contactor Assemblies for Star-Delta (Wye-Delta) Starting
Contactor
LV1N_03_05.fm Page 40assemblies for2013
Friday, October 18, WYE-delta
3:24 PM starting
3RA24 complete units, 5.5 ... 22 kW
SIRIUS 3RA24
Fully wired contactor
and assemblies
tested contactor for star-delta
assemblies (wye-delta)
· Size S0-S0-S0 · Up starting,
to 22 kW up to 90 kW
Thewired
Fully
3RA23, 3RA24 Contactor Assemblies
figure and
shows the version
tested with assemblies
contactor screw terminals
The figure shows the version with screw terminals
for star-delta (wye-delta) starting · Size S0-S0-S0 · Up to 22 kW

3RA24 Contactor Assemblies 16


for Wye-Delta Starting
10 6
3RA24 complete units, 17
5.5 ... 22 kW
2

9
Fully wired and tested contactor assemblies · Size S0-S0-S06· Up to 22 kW
Contactors and
Assemblies

The figure shows the version with screw terminals


7
33

16
6
17 5
1
1 5 2
7
2
3

IC01_00626a
4

NSB0_02067b
4
5 3

1
6
7
2
6
Mountable accessories Fully wired and 4tested contactor assemblies
Individual parts Order No. Page Individual parts Order No. Page

NSB0_02067b
3 Q11 Q13 Q12
8
16 Three-phase feeder terminal1) 3RV29 25-5AB 3/43 1 2 3 Contactor, 11 kW 3RT20 24 3RT20 24 3/10 3RT20 24
17 Three-phase busbar 1)
3RV19 15-1AB 3/43 1 2 683 Contactors, 15/18.5 kW 3RT20 26 3RT20 26 3/10 3RT20 24
1 2 3 Contactor, 22 kW 3RT20 27 3RT20 27 3RT20 26 3/10
Mountable accessories (optional) Complete 4 5 6contactor
Assembly assembly
kit for star-delta
3RA29 23-2BB1 (wye-delta) starting 3/43
To be ordered separately Type Page Individual partsThe assembly kit contains:Type Page
Mountable accessories Fully wired and tested contactor assemblies
Q11 Q13 Q12
Individual parts Order No. Page Individual par4ts Mechanical interlock Order No. Page
9 Three-phase infeed terminal1) 3RV2925-5AB 2/85 3/110 1 2 3 Contactors, 11 kW
5 Connecting clipsQ11 3RT2024
Q13 3RT2024 3RT2024 2/8
Q12 3/51, 3/61
10 Three-phase
16 busbar1)
Three-phase feeder 3RV29 25-5AB 1/8
terminal1) 3RV1915-1AB 3/110
3/43 1 12 23 3 Contactors,
6 Wiring
Contactor, 15/18.5
11 kW kW on
modules the3RT2026
3RT20 top 3RT2026
24 and3RT20
bottom 3RT2024
24 3RT20 2/8
3/51, 3/61
24 3/10
1 12 23 3 Contactors, for22
connecting
kW the main current paths
3RT2027 3RT2027 3RT2026 2/8
3/51, 3/61
17 Three-phase busbar1) 3RV19 15-1AB 3/43 Contactors, 15/18.5 kW 3RT20 26 3RT20 26 3RT20 24 3/10
4 1... 277 3 Assembly
Function
Contactor,
modules
kit S0-S0-S0 3RA28 16-0EW20
3RA2923-2BB1
22 kWstarting 3RT20 27 3RT20 27 3RT20 26 3/10
3/44
2/85
3/106
for wye-delta
comprising:
4 5 6 Assembly
1) The parts 16 and 17 can only be mounted with contactors with screw kit
Mechanical interlock
3RA29 23-2BB1 3/43
4 Note:
terminal. The Four
assembly kit contains:
connecting clips for three contactors
5 When the function modules for contactor assemblies for wye-
4 Mechanical interlock
Wiring
6 delta modules
starting onused,
are top andnobottom
otherfor
auxiliary switches are allowed
to Connecting
5 connecting
be mounted theclips
main and auxiliary circuits
on the basic units.
7 6 Star
Wiring modules on the top and bottom
jumper
Functionfor modules
connecting the main current
for star- paths
3RA2816-0EW20 2/29
3/101
8
7 Function
delta modules
(wye-delta) starting 3RA28 16-0EW20 3/44
for wye-delta starting
1)
1) The
Theparts and17
parts169 and 10can
canonly
onlybebemounted
mountedwith
withcontactors with
contactors screw
with screw Note:
Complete contactor assemblies for star-delta (wye-delta)
terminal.
terminal, the 6 wiring modules must be removed beforehand. starting
When see page
the function 3/175. for contactor assemblies for wye-
modules
delta starting are used, no other auxiliary switches are allowed
to be mounted on the basic units.

2/114 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


3/40 SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactor Assemblies for Star-Delta (Wye-Delta) Starting
Contactor Assemblies for Switching Motors
Contactor Assemblies for Star-Delta (Wye-Delta) Starting
Contactor assemblies for WYE-delta starting
SIRIUS 3RA24 contactor assemblies for star-delta (wye-delta) starting, up to 90 kW
on and ordering data SIRIUS 3RA24
Fully wired and tested contactor assemblies contactor
for star-delta assemblies
(wye-delta) for star-delta
starting (wye-delta)
· Size S2-S2-S01)
· starting, up to 90 kW
Sizeto
Up S2-S2-S0 · up
45 kWand
and to 65 A,
S2-S2-S2 30·HP
55 kW 1)
Fully wired tested contactor assemblies for star-delta (wye-delta) starting · Size S2-S2-S0 ·
Up
Thetofigure
45 kW and the
shows S2-S2-S2
version· with
55 kWscrew terminals in S2-S2-S2
The figure shows the version with screw terminals in S2-S2-S2
10
10

2
33
5

Assemblies
Contactors and
5

11
onents to be ordered separately:
11

6
6
4
4

8
8

IC01_00627a
IC01_00627a
1
1 2
2 3
3

5
5
The connecting leads
are not shown.
9
9 9
9
ory Order No. Page Components Order No. Page
Mountable accessories (optional) Complete contactor K1 assemblyK3 for star-delta
K2 (wye-delta) starting
Mountable
To be orderedaccessories
separately (optional)
Type Page Complete contactor assembly for star-delta
Individual parts
1 2 3 Contactors,
Type (wye-delta) starting Page
chanical interlock, laterally mountable,
th must be adapted To be ordered separately Type Page IndivA,
50/60 idu30
al p
HParts 3RT20 35 3RT20 35 T3RT20
ype 26 Q13
Q11 Q12 Page
1.5 mm; K2: 0 mm 3RA19 24-2B
11 Three-phase infeed terminal 3RV2935-5A 3/110
8 1 2 3 Contactors,
Time-delay relay, 22/30 kW Q11
3RT2035 Q13
3RT2035 Q12
3RT2026 3/53, 3/62
d-state time-delay 11auxiliary switch
Three-phase block,
infeed terminal 3RV2935-5A 3/110 laterally
11 22 mountable
33 Contactors,3RP15
Contactors, 37 kW
22/3074-1N.30
kW 3RT2035 Sec.
3RT2035 11
3RT2035
3RT2035 3RT2027
3RT2026 3/53, 3/62
3/53, 3/62
untable on the front 3RT19 26-2G... 9 Contactors,
11 22 33switch
Auxiliary Contactors, 45 kW
37
block withkW 3RT2036
3RT2035
one unassigned 3RT2036
3RT2035 3RT2028
3RT2027 3/53, 3/62
3/53, 3/62
iliary switch block, NO11contact
22 33 Contactors, 3RH19
Contactors, 55 kW
45 kW21-1CA10 3RT2036
3RT2037 3RT2037
3RT2036 3RT2035
3RT2028 3/53, 3/62
3/53, 3/62
rally mountable 3RH19 21-1EA.. Auxiliary
10 ... 77switch
44 ... blockkit
Assembly
Assembly forS2-S2-S0
kit local control
S2-S2-S2 3RA2933-2BB1
3RA2933-2C 3/106
3/106
ge suppressor 3RT19 26-1.... 2 units comprising:
3RH19 21-1CA01
comprising:
3RT19 36-1.... 3 units Four3RH19
44 Four 21-1CA10
connectors
connectors for three
for three contactors
contactors (not
(not required
required for
for fully
fully pre-
pre-
hase feeder terminal 3RV19 35-5A 11 Baseplate wired
wired contactor
contactor
3RA19 32-2Eassemblies for
assemblies for star-delta
star-delta (wye-delta)
(wye-delta) starting)
starting)
Wiring modules
modules onon top
top and
and bottom
bottom forfor
hase busbar 3RV19 35-1A 6 Installation kit55 Wiring
3RA19 33-2C
connecting the
connecting the main
main and
and auxiliary
auxiliary circuits
circuits
h-in lug 2) for time-delay The installation
6
kitStar
contains
jumper the
S2 WYE jumper on the top
6 Star jumper S2
y for screw mounting 3RP19 03 Sec.11 and the wiring jumper on the bottom for connecting the
Cable for
77 Cable
main conducting paths. for connecting
connecting the
the A2
A2 coil
coil contact
contact from
from the
the line
line contactor
contactor
with the
with the A2
A2 coil
coil contact
contact of
of the
the delta
delta contactor
contactor
(not shown
(not shown in in the
the drawing)
drawing)
88 Mechanical interlock
Mechanical interlock 3RA2934-2B
3RA2934-2B 3/109
3/109
99 Function modules
Function modules for
for star-delta
star-delta 3RA2816-0EW20
3RA2816-0EW20 3/101
3/101
(wye-delta) starting
(wye-delta) starting
10
10 Base plate
Base plate star-delta
star-delta (wye-
(wye- 3RA2932-2F
3RA2932-2F 3/113
3/113
delta)
delta)

1)
Complete contactor assembly for star-delta
1) Not included (wye-delta)
in scope of supply starting in size
of complete Complete
2) Possible contactor assemblies for star-delta (wye-delta)
in principle.
1) S2-S2-S0 (not shown): Thecontactor
3RA2933-2Cassemblies; available
assembly kit is toasbe
accessory.
used here, Ifstarting
a solid-state
seetime-delay auxiliary switch block
page 3/176.
Complete contactor assembly for star-delta (wye-delta) starting in size
see page 3/106. Complete
For overview,
is mountedsee contactor
ontopage ofassemblies
2/112.
the front for star-delta (wye-delta)
K3, an ordinary
S2-S2-S0 (not shown): The 3RA2933-2C assembly kit is to be used here, starting
auxiliary see block
switch page 3/176.
can only be mounted onto
see page 3/106. For circuit diagrams, see page 2/202.
the side.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/115

Siemens IC 10 · 2018 3/169


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactor Assemblies for Switching Motors
Contactor Assemblies for Star-Delta (Wye-Delta) Starting
Contactor assemblies for WYE-delta starting
on and ordering data SIRIUS 3RA24 contactor assemblies for star-delta (wye-delta) starting, up to 90 kW
Size S2-S2-S2
Fully · uptested
wired and to 86 A, 60 HP assemblies for star-delta (wye-delta) starting · Size S2-S2-S01) ·
contactor
Up to 45 kW and S2-S2-S2 · 55 kW
The figure shows the version with screw terminals in S2-S2-S2

10
2 Assemblies
Contactors and

3
5

Components to be ordered separately:


11

IC01_00627a
1
2
3

9
The connecting leads
9 are not shown.

Mountable accessories (optional) Complete contactor assembly for star-delta (wye-delta) starting
To be ordered separately Type Page Individual parts Type Page
ory Order No. Page Components Order No. Page
K1 K3 Q11
K2 Q13 Q12
chanical interlock, Three-phase24-2B
11lateral3RA19 infeed terminal 3RV2935-5A 3/110
1 2 3 1 2 3 Contactors, 55 kW
Contactors, 3RT2037 3RT2037 3RT2035 3/53, 3/62
d-state time-delay auxiliary switch block, 507HPAssembly3RT20
80 4A,... kit S2-S2-S2
35 3RT20 35 3RA2933-2BB1
3RT20 34 3/106
untable on the front 3RT19 26-2G... comprising:
1 2 3 Contactors,
chanical interlock, 4 Four connectors for three contactors (not required for fully pre-
untable on the front 3RA19 24-1A 86 A, 60 HP wired 3RT20 36 3RT20
contactor 36 3RT20
assemblies 34
for star-delta (wye-delta) starting)
8 Time-delay relay,
5 Wiring modules on top and bottom for
iliary switch block,
ral 3RH19 21-1EA.. lateral 3RP15 74-1N.30
connecting the main and auxiliary circuits
9 Auxiliary switch
6 block with one
Star jumper S2 unassigned
ge suppressor 3RT19 26-1....
3RT19 36-1.... NO contact 7 Cable 3RH19 21-1CA10
for connecting the A2 coil contact from the line contactor
10 with the
Auxiliary switch block forA2 coil control
local contact of the delta contactor
hase feeder terminal 3RV19 35-5A (not shown in the drawing)
2 units 3RH19 21-1CA01
hase busbar 3RV19 35-1A 3 units
8 Mechanical 3RH19 21-1CA10 3RA2934-2B
interlock 3/109
h-in lug 2) for time-delay relay 11 Baseplate
9 3RA19 32-2F
Function modules for star-delta 3RA2816-0EW20 3/101
screw mounting 3RP19 03 (wye-delta) starting
6 Installation kit 3RA19 33-2B
The10installation
Basekitplate star-delta
contains the (wye-
WYE jumper 3RA2932-2F
on top and 3/113
delta)
the wiring jumper on bottom for connecting the main
conducting paths.

1) Not included in scope of supply of complete 2) Possible in principle. If a solid-state time-delay


contactor assemblies; available as accessory. auxiliary switch block is mounted onto the front
1) Foroverview, see page 2/112.for star-delta (wye-delta) starting in size of K3, a standard auxiliary assemblies
switch block can
Complete contactor assembly Complete contactor foronly
star-delta (wye-delta)
For circuit (not
S2-S2-S0 diagrams, see
shown): page
The 2/202. assembly kit is to be used here,
3RA2933-2C be mounted onto the side.
starting see page 3/176.
see page 3/106.

2/116 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


IC10_03_10.fm Page 170 Wednesday, April 11, 2018 8:17 PM
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactor Assemblies for Switching Motors
Contactor assemblies for WYE-delta starting
Contactor Assemblies for Star-Delta (Wye-Delta) Starting
on and ordering data
Size S3-S3-S2 · up to 150 A, 100 HP
SIRIUS 3RA24 contactor assemblies for star-delta (wye-delta) starting, up to 90 kW
Fully wired and tested contactor assemblies for star-delta (wye-delta) starting · Size S3-S3-S21) · Up to 90 kW

10
5

2
Assemblies
Contactors and
11
3

Components to be ordered separately:

6
2
4
1
3
8

IC01_00628b
5

9
9
The connecting leads
Mountable accessories (optional) Complete contactor assembly for
arestar-delta
not shown. (wye-delta) starting
To be ordered separately Type Page Individual parts Type Page
Q11 Q13 Q12
ory Order No.
11 Single-phase Page 3RA2943-3L
infeed terminal Components
3/110 1 2 3 Order
Contactors, 55 kWNo. 3RT2045 Page
3RT2045 3RT2035 3/54, 3/62
(3 units are required)
1 2 3 Contactors, K175 kW K3 K2
3RT2045 3RT2045 3RT2036 3/54, 3/62
chanical interlock, lateral, 1 2 3 Contactors, Contactors, 90 kW 3RT2046 3RT2046 3RT2037 3/54, 3/62
1 2 3
th must be adapted 1154 A,
0 mm; K2: 27.5 mm 3RA19 24-2B ...75
7 HP
Assembly3RT20 45 3RT20 45 3RA2943-2C
kit S3-S3-S2 3RT20 35 3/106
1 2 3 Contactors, comprising:
d-state time-delay auxilary switch block,
150 A, 100 HP 4 Two3RT20
connectors for three
45 3RT10 45contactors
3RT20 36(not required for fully pre-
untable on the front 3RT19 26-2G... wired contactor assemblies for star-delta (wye-delta) starting)
iliary switch block, lateral3RH19 21-1EA.. 8 Time-delay relay, lateral 3RP15 74-1N.30
5 Wiring modules on top and bottom (S3-S2) for connecting the
ge suppressor 3RT19 . 6-1.... 9 Auxiliary switch block withauxiliary
main and one unassigned
circuits and a cable set for the auxiliary
h-in lug 2) for time-delay relay NO contact 3RH19 21-1CA10
circuit
screw mounting 3RP19 03 10 Auxiliary switch
6 block for local
Star jumper S2 control
2 units 7 Cable3RH19 21-1CA01
for connecting the A2 coil contact from the line contactor
3 units with3RH19 21-1CA10
the A2 coil contact of the delta contactor
11 Baseplate (not 3RA19
shown in the drawing)
42-2E
6 8
Installation Mechanical
kit interlock
3RA19 43-2C 3RA2934-2B 3/109
Function
9 kit contains
The installation themodules
WYE jumperfor star-delta
on the3RA2816-0EW20
top and the wir- 3/101
ing jumper on the bottom(wye-delta) starting the main conducting
for connecting
10 Base plate star-delta (wye- 3RA2942-2F 3/113
1) Not included in scope of supply of the complete
contactor assemblies; available as an accessory. delta)
2) Possible in principle.If a solid-state time-delay aux-
1) Contactor assembly for star-delta
iliary switch block is mountedfor onto the front of K3, Complete
(wye-delta) starting customer assem- For overview,contactor assemblies
see page 2/112. for star-delta (wye-delta)
a standard
bly in size S3-S3-S3 (not shown): auxiliary switchassembly
The 3RA2943-2BB. block cankitonly bebe
is to starting
For circuitsee page see
diagrams, 3/177.
page 2/202.
used here, see page 3/106. mounted onto the side.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/117


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3RH Contactor Relays
Control Relays, Coupling Relays
3RH21 control relays, size S00 with 4 or 8 contacts
3RH2 contactor relays, 4- and 8-pole
AC and DC operation In addition, fully mounted 3RH22 8-pole contactor relays are
available; the mounted 4-pole auxiliary switch block in the 2nd
IEC 60947, EN 60947. tier is not removable. The terminal designations are according to
The 3RH2 contactor relays have screw,
These ring lug terminal
auxiliary or
switch blocks EN 50011.
Application terminals. Four contacts are available in the basic
spring-type Overview
(3RH29 11-1GA ..) cannot be These versions are built according to special Swiss regulations
unit.
AC and DC operation combined with control relays SUVA and are distinguished
3RH2. contactor relays acc. to ENexternally
50 011 andby a red labeling plate.
with identification numbers 31E EN 50 005
The 3RH2
IEC 60 947,contactor
EN 60 947relays are suitable for use in any climate. Of the auxiliary contacts (integrated plus mountable) possible
and 22E; they are coded.
2

They
(VDE are finger-safe according to EN 50274. The devices with
0660) on the device,
ring lug terminal connection comply All with
control relaysofwith
degree 4 con-
protection Control relay, EN no more than four NC contacts are permitted.
50 011,
tacts in accordance with 4 contacts
IP20 when fitted with the related terminal cover.
Contactors and
Assemblies

Design EN 50 011, identification num-


Contact
The 3RH21 reliability
control relays are bers 40E to 22E, can be Contactor relay, EN 50 011,
suitable for use in any climate. extended with auxiliary switch

3
4 contacts
High contact
They are stability
safe from at to
touch low voltages and40currents,
blocks suitable
to 02 to obtain for
control
solid-state circuits
DIN VDE 0106 Part 100. with currents ≥ 1 mA at
relays a voltage
with of 17 V.in
6 or 8 contacts
accordance with EN 50 005.
Surge suppression
The 3RH21 control relays have
The identification numbers on Ident. No. 40E Ident. No. 31E, 22E
screw, spring style or ring lug
RC elements,Four
connections. varistors,
contacts are or the
diodes auxiliary
diode switch blocks
assemblies (combina-
tion of a diode
available in the and Zener diode)apply
basica unit. only
can be to the attached
plugged onto all auxil-
con-
iary switch
tactor relays from the front for damping blocks.
opening surges in the Aux. switch blocks,
Ident. No. 40E Aux. switch blocks,
Ident. No. 31E, 22E
coil. Thereliability
plug-in direction is determined by a coding device. 4 contacts 4 or 2 contacts
Contact
Surge suppression
Note:
High contact stability at low Aux. switch blocks, Aux. switch blocks,
The OFF-delay
voltages of the NO
and currents, contact RC
suitable andelements, varistors,
the ON-delay diodes
of the EN 50 011, EN 50 005,
NC contact are
for electronic increased
circuits or diode coils
with if the contactor assemblies (combina-
are attenuated 4 contacts 4 or 2 contacts
≥ 1 mA at
currents voltage
against a voltage
peaks tion of a diode
of suppression
(noise diodeand
6 toa10
Zener
times;
diode) can be plugged onto all
17 V. assemblies 2 to 6 times, varistor Ident. No. 80E, Ident. No. 40, 31,
diode +2 to 5 ms).
control relays from the front for 71E, 62E, 53E, 44E 22, 20, 11, 02
Auxiliary switch blocks damping opening surges in the
Auxiliary switch blocks coil. The plug-in direction is
The 3RH2 contactor
The 3RH21 relays
control relays cancan bedetermined
expanded by byaup to four
coding Control relay, Ident. No. 80E,
y , Control relay, Ident. No. 40, 31,
contacts
be expanded by the
by addition
up to fourofcon-
snap-on auxiliary switch blocks.
device. EN 50 011 71E, 62E, 53E, 44E
Hilfsschütze
EN 50EN50
005, 005,
tacts by the addition of mount- DIN 22, 20, 11, 02
The auxiliary switch block can easily be snapped onto the front 8 contacts 88oroder
6 contacts
6 Kontakte
able auxiliary switch blocks. Note block has a centrally po-
of the contactors. The auxiliary switch
The auxiliary
sitioned switch
release block
lever for can
disassembly.
The opening times of the NO Contactor relay, Contactor relay,
Hilfsschütze
easily be snapped onto the contacts and the closing times EN 50 011 EN
The
front contactor relays
of the relays. Thewith 4 contacts
auxiliary according to ENincrease
50011,if DIN50EN50
005,005,
of the NC contacts 8 contacts 88oroder
6 contacts
6 Kontakte
with the identification
switch block has a centrally number 40E, can
the be extended
relay with 80E to
coils are protected
44E auxiliary
positioned switch
release blocks
lever to obtain
for dis- contactor
against voltagerelays
peakswith
(sup-
NSB00067

assembly.
8 contacts according to EN 50011.pression The identification
diode 6 to 10 numbers
times, Ident. No. 80E, Ident. No.40, 31,
80E to 44E relays
The control on thewithauxiliary
4 con-switch diode
blocksassemblies
apply to the2 tocomplete
6 times, 71E, 62E, 53E, 44E 22, 20, 11, 02
contactors. These auxiliary
tacts in accordance with switchvaristor
blocks +2
(3RH29
ms to 11–1GA..)
5 ms).
NSB0_02105

cannot
EN 50 011, be combined with contactor relays with identification
with the identifica-
numbers
tion number 31E andcan
40E, 22E;
be they are coded. Ident. No. 80E,
extended with 80E to 44E auxi- 71E, 62E, 53E, 44E
All contactor relays with
liary switch blocks to obtain 4 contacts according to EN 50011, iden-
tification
control relays numbers
with 840E to 22E,
contacts in can be extended with auxiliary
switch
accordance blocks 40EN
with to 02
50 to
011.obtain contactor relays with 6 or 8 con-
tacts in accordance
The identification with EN
numbers 80E50005. The identification numbers
on the auxiliary
to 44E switchswitch
on the auxiliary blocks apply only to the attached auxiliary
switch blocks.
blocks apply to the complete
relays (see illustration along-
Order
side). No. scheme
Digit of the Order No. 1st - 4th 5th 6th 7th 8th 9th 10th 11th 12t 13th 14th 15th 16th
3rd h
3RH24 latched control relays, size S00 @@@ @ @ @ @ – @ @ @ @ @ – @ @ @ @
SIRIUS contactor relays 3RH
2nd generation
Application 2
Device
AC andtype
DC (e. g. 1 = 4-pole contactorThe
operation relay, 3 = 8-pole
terminal contactor relay)
designations com- @ of auxiliary con-
The number from the front for damping
Number
IEC of NO
60 947, 60 947 (e. g. 2 = 2 NO)ply with EN 50 011.
ENcontacts tacts can be@extended by opening surges.
(VDE 0660)
Number of NC contacts (e. g. 2 = 2 NC)The relay coil and the coil of the means of auxiliary
@ switch The control relay can also
release blocks (up to 4 poles).
Connection type (1 = screw, 2 = spring, 4 = ringsolenoid
lug) are both @ be switched on and released
designed for continuous duty. RC elements, varistors, diodes manually.
Operating range / solenoid coil circuit (e. g. A = AC standard / without)
or diode assemblies can be @
Rated control supply voltage (e. g. K6 = 110/120 V, 50/60 Hz ) plugged onto both coils @ @
No significance @
Special version @ @ @ @
Example 3RH 2 1 2 2 – 1 A K 6 0

Note:
The Order No. scheme is presented here merely for information For your orders, please use the order numbers quote in the
purposes and for better understanding of the logic behind the catalog in the Selection and ordering data.
order numbers.

2/118 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 3/59
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Switching Motors
3TF68 and 3TF69 vacuum contactors, 3-pole

Contactors and Contactor Assemblies

Design Surge suppression


EN 60 947-4-1 Main contacts Auxiliary contacts Control circuit
(VDE 0660 Part 102). Contact erosion indication The terminal designations com- Protection of the coil circuits
The 3TF contactors are suitable with 3TF68/69 vacuum con- ply with EN 50 012. against surges:
for use in any climate. They are tactors When the contactors are ener- AC operation
safe from touch according to The contact erosion of the vac- gized, the NC contacts open • fitted with varistors as stand-
DIN VDE 0106 Part 100. Termi-

2
uum interrupters can be moni- before the NO contacts close. ard.
nal covers (see accessories) tored in the closed position by
may have to be fitted onto the Contact reliability DC operation
means of three white double

Assemblies
Contactors and
connecting bars, depending on slides on the contactor base. The auxiliary contacts are Retrofitting options:
the configuration with other extremely reliable and as such • varistors.
devices. The vacuum interrupter must be are suitable for electronic cir-
replaced if the distance indi- cuits
cated by one of the double
• with currents 1 mA,
slides is less than 0.5 mm while
the contactor is in the closed • at voltages greater than 17 V.
position.
It is advisable to replace all
three interrupters in order to
ensure maximum reliability.

Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC)


3TF68/69..-.C contactors for AC
Contactor Rated control supply Overvoltage type Severity to Surge strength
operation are equipped with an Type voltage Us (IEC 60 801) IEC 60 801
electronically controlled sole-
noid mechanism with a high 3TF68 44-.C.., 110 V ... 132 V Burst 3 2 kV
level of immunity to interference 3TF69 44-.C.. Surge 4 6 kV
(see table opposite).
200 V ... 276 V Burst 4 4 kV
Note: Surge 4 5 kV
In operation in installations
380 V ... 600 V Burst 4 4 kV
where it is not possible to Surge 4 6 kV
observe the emitted interfer-
ence limits, e.g. as an output
contactor in static frequency
changers, use of 3TF68/69..-.Q
contactors (NS E catalogue,
available in German) is recom-
mended, without a main con-
ductor path circuit (for further
information refer also to the
description below).

Circuit of the main conducting paths Short-circuit protection


of contactors
An integrated RC varistor circuit The contactors can therefore It might be damaged by the For assembling fuseless load
in the main conducting paths of be used without reservation for voltage peaks and harmonics feeders, please select a circuit-
the contactors damps the rate all AC switching applications, generated. This may also cause breaker/contactor combination
of rise of switching overvoltages including three-phase motors phase-to-phase short-circuits in according to the brochure enti-
to uncritical values. Multiple with the demanding AC-4 utili- the contactors. tled "Verbraucherabzweige in
restriking of the switching arcs zation category. Remedy: Order the special sicherungsloser Bauweise",
is thereby prevented. Important note contactor design without surge Order No. E20001-P285-A726
The operator of an installation suppression. In this case the (available in German only).
The surge suppression circuit is
can thus assume that the dan- not necessary when 3TF68/69 Order No. must be supple-
ger to the motor winding arising contactors are used in circuits mented with "-Z" and the order
from switching overvoltages with e.g. d.c. choppers, fre- code "A02". No additional
with a high rate of rise is ruled quency converters or variable- charge is made.
out. speed drives.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/119


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Accessories for 3RT / 3RH Contactors
Solid-state, time-delay auxiliary switch box

The timer module, which is The contactor on which the A varistor is integrated in the The OFF-delay variant operates
available in "ON-delay" and solid-state, time-delay auxiliary timer module for damping without an auxiliary power sup-
"OFF-delay" designs, allows switch block is mounted oper- opening surges in the contactor ply. Minimum ON period:
time-delayed functions up to ates without a delay. coil. 200 ms.
100 s (3 distinct delay ranges). The solid-state, time-delay aux- A single-pole auxiliary switch
It contains a relay with one NO Size S00 (3RT201) iliary switch block cannot be block can be snapped onto the
contact and one NC contact; The solid-state, time-delay aux- mounted on size S00 coupling front of the contactor in addition
the relay is switched either after relays. to the timer module.
2

iliary switch block is fitted onto


an ON-delay or after an OFF- the front of the contactor. The The timer module has no inte-
delay. timer module is supplied with Sizes S0 to S12 (3RT202 to grated components for damp-
Contactors and
Assemblies

The timer module with a WYE- power directly by plug-in con- 3RT107) ing opening surges.
DELTA function is equipped tacts via the coil terminals of The solid-state, time-delay aux-
with one delayed and one the contactor, in parallel with iliary switch block is fitted onto
instantaneous NO contact, with A1/A2. The time function is acti- the front of the contactor.
an interval time of 50 ms vated by closing the contactor
between the two (see diagram). on which the auxiliary switch The timer module is supplied
The delay time of the NO con- block is mounted. The OFF- with power via two terminals
tact can be set between 1.5 s delay variant operates without (A1/A2); the time delay of the
and 30 s. an auxiliary power supply. Mini- auxiliary switch block can be
mum ON period: 200 ms. activated either by a parallel
link to any contactor coil or by
WYE-delta function any power source.

Solid-state time-delay block


with semiconductor output
The timer module, which is Size S00 (3RT201) Sizes S0 to S3 (3RT202 to #
available in "ON-delay" and The variant for size S00 contac- 3RT107)
"OFF-delay" with auxiliary tors is fitted onto the front of the The time-delay block for size S0
power supply designs, allows contactor (with the supply volt- to S3 contactors is plugged into
time-delayed functions up to age switched off) and then slid coil terminals A1 and A2 on top
100 s (3 distinct delay ranges). into its latched position; at the of each contactor; the time-
Contactors fitted with a time- same time, the time-delay relay delay relay is connected both
delay block close or open after is connected by means of plug- electrically and mechanically
a delay according to the set in contacts to coil terminals A1 by means of pins.
time. and A2 of the contactor. Any $
A varistor is integrated in the
The ON-delay variant of the contactor coil terminals which timer module for damping
time-delay relay is connected in are not required are sealed off opening surges in the contactor
series with the contactor coil; by means of covers on the coil.
terminal A1 of this coil must not enclosure of the time-delay
be connected. block, to prevent them from
With the OFF-delay variant of being connected inadvertently Configuration note
the time-delay relay, the con- (for circuit diagrams, see page Activation of loads parallel to
tactor coil is contacted directly 2/149). the start input is not permitted
via the relay; terminals A1 and A varistor is integrated in the with AC operation (see #). Time-delay block
A2 of the coil must not be con- timer module for damping Contactor
The 3RT19 16-2D .../3RT19 26-
nected. opening surges in the contactor 2D ... time-delay blocks with an
The time-delay relays are suit- coil. OFF delay have a voltage-car-
able for both AC and DC opera- The solid-state, time-delay rying start input B1. This means
tion. block cannot be mounted on that if there is a parallel load on
size S00 coupling relays. terminal B1, activation can be
simulated with AC voltage. In
this case, the additional load (e.
g. contactor K3) must be wired
as shown in $.

2/120 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Accessories for 3RT / 3RH Contactors
3-phase EMC interference suppression module for size S00 contactor

A so-called backr-e.m.f. (elec- The connection between the


tromotive force) is produced main conducting path and the
when motors or various induc- EMC interference suppression
tive loads are turned off. Volt- module enables contact arcing,
age peaks of up to 4 000 V may which is responsible for contact
occur as a result, with a fre- erosion and the majority of
quency spectrum from 1 kHz to clicking noises, to be reduced;
10 MHz and a rate of voltage this in turn is conducive to an

2
variation from 0.1 to 20 V/ns. electromagnetically compati-
ble design.
Since the EMC interference

Assemblies
Contactors and
Capacitive input to various ana-
log and digital signals makes it suppression module achieves a
necessary to suppress interfer- significant reduction in radio-
ence in the load circuit. frequency components and the
voltage level in three phases,
the contact endurance is also
improved considerably. This
makes an important contribu-
tion towards enhancing the reli-
ability and availability of the
system as a whole.
There is no need for fine gradu-
ations within each perfor-
mance class, as smaller motors
inherently have a higher induc-
tance, so that one solution for
all fixed-speed drives up to
7.5 HP is adequate.

Two electrical variants are The advantages of the RC cir- The varistor circuit is able to
available: cuit lie mainly in the reduction in absorb high energy levels and
the rate of rise and in its RF is also suitable for frequencies
damping ability. The selected from 10 to 400 Hz (variable-
values ensure effective interfer- speed drives). There is no limit-
ence suppression over a wide ing below the knee-point volt-
range. age, however.

OFF-delay device
for size S00 to S3 contactors
AC and DC operation contactor does not open. The A contactor opens after a delay Operation
IEC 60 947, EN 60 947 3RT19 16/3RT29 16 OFF-delay when the capacitors of the con- In the case of the versions for
devices are specifically designed tactor coil, built into the OFF- rated control supply voltages of
For screwing and snapping for operation with the 3RT contac- delay device, are switched in
onto 35 mm standard mounting 110 V and 230 V, either AC volt-
tors and 3RH contactor relays parallel. In the event of voltage age or DC voltage can be
rail. The OFF-delay devices of the SIRIUS series. failures, the capacitors are dis-
have screw connections. applied on the line side, where
charged via the coil and as the variant for 24 V is
thereby delay the opening of designed for DC operation only.
Principle of operation the contactor.
Application The OFF-delay device operates A DC-operated contactor is con-
The OFF-delay device pre- If the command devices are nected to the output in accor-
without external voltage on a upstream of the OFF-delay
vents a contactor from drop- capacitive basis, and can be dance with the input voltage that
ping out unintentionally when device in the circuit, the OFF is applied.
energized with either AC or DC delay takes effect with every
there is a short-time voltage dip (24 V version for DC operation The mean value of the OFF
or voltage failure. It supplies the opening operation. If the open-
only). Voltage matching, which ing operation is downstream of delay is approximately 1.5 times
necessary power for a series- is only necessary with AC oper- the specified minimum time.
connected, DC-operated con- the OFF-delay device, an OFF
ation, is performed using a rec- delay only applies in the event
tactor during a voltage dip to tifier bridge.
ensure that the of failure of the mains voltage.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/121


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Accessories for 3RT Contactors
Interface for mounting on size S0 to S3 contactors

Application Functions
DC operation Design Surge suppression Mounting
IEC 60 947 and EN 60 947 System-compatible operation The 3RH29 24-1GP11 interface The 3RH29 24-1GP11 interface
The interface is suitable for use with DC 24 V, coil voltage toler- has an integrated surge sup- is mounted directly on the con-
in any climate. It is safe from ance 17 V to 30 V. pressor (varistor) for the con- tactor coil.
touch to DIN VDE 0106 Part Low power consumption in con- tactor coil being switched.
100. The terminal designations formity with the technical data
2

conform to EN 50 005. of the electronic systems.


A light-emitting diode indicates
Contactors and
Assemblies

the circuit state.

Terminal diagram Connection example


3RH19/29 24-1GP11 3RH19/29 24-1GP11
with surge suppression with surge suppression

Interface Interface
Contactor Contactor

2/122 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3RT Power Contactors for Switching Motors
Contactor Assemblies for Switching Motors
3RT2 contactors
3RT20 contactors, 3-pole, 3 ... 25 HP

More information

Contactors Type 3RT2


Size S00 and S0
Width mm 45
Rated data of the auxiliary contacts
According to IEC 60947-5-1/EN 60947-5-1

2
The data apply to integrated auxiliary contacts and contacts in the
auxiliary switch blocks for contactor sizes S00 to S01)
Rated insulation voltage Ui (pollution degree 3) V 690

Assemblies
Contactors and
Conventional thermal current Ith = A 10
Rated operational current Ie/AC-12
3

AC load
Rated operational current Ie/AC-15/AC-14
• For rated operational voltage Ue 24 V A 101)
110 V A 101)
125 V A 101)
220 V A 101)
230 V A 101)
380 V A 3
400 V A 3
500 V A 2
660 V A 1
690 V A 1
DC load
Rated operational current Ie/DC-12
• For rated operational voltage Ue 24 V A 6
60 V A 6
110 V A 3
125 V A 2
220 V A 1
440 V A 0.3
600 V A 0.15
Rated operational current Ie/DC-13
• For rated operational voltage Ue 24 V A 6
60 V A 2
110 V A 1
125 V A 0.9
220 V A 0.3
440 V A 0.14
600 V A 0.1
Contact reliability at 17 V, 1 mA Frequency of contact faults <10-8 i. e. <1 fault per 100 million operating
acc. to EN 60947-5-4 cycles
Endurance of the auxiliary contacts
It is assumed that the operating mechanisms are switched randomly,
i. e. not synchronized with the phase angle of the supply system. NSB0_02061a

The contact endurance is mainly dependent on the breaking current.


The characteristic curves apply to:
• Integrated auxiliary contacts on 3RT20
• Auxiliary switch blocks 3RH 29 11, 3RH29 21 for contactors size S00
and S0.

I
I I I I

Diagram legend:
Ia = Breaking current
Ie = Rated operational current

1) Integrated auxiliary contacts in size S0, auxiliary switches for snapping


onto the front and for mounting onto the side in size S00 and S0: Ie = 6 A at
AC-14/AC-15.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/123


3/18 SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012
SIRIUS
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies
3RT Power Contactors for Switching Motors
Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT2 contactors
3RT20 contactors, 3-pole, 3 ... 25 HP

Endurance of the main contacts


Size S00
The characteristic curves show the contact endurance of
the contactors when switching resistive and inductive AC Operating cycles at
loads (AC-1/AC-3) depending on the breaking current and
rated operational voltage. It is assumed that the operating

230 V

500 V

690 V

400 V
Contactor 3RT20 15, 3RT20 16 3RT20 17, 3RT20 18
mechanisms are switched randomly, i. e. not synchronized type (3 HP, 5 HP) (7.5 HP, 10 HP)
with the phase angle of the supply system. 10 7
2

10 7 8 6 8
NSB0_02059

The rated operational current Ie complies with utilization cat- 8 6


4 6
6 4
egory AC-4 (breaking six times the rated operational cur- 4
Contactors and
Assemblies

4
rent) and is intended for a contact endurance of at least 2
2
200,000 operating cycles. 10 6
2

3
2
10 6 8 10 6
If a shorter endurance is sufficient, the rated operational 10 6 8 6
current Ie/AC-4 can be increased. Ie 8 6
4
8
6
6 4
If the contacts are used for mixed operation, i. e. normal 4
4
2
switching (breaking the rated operational current according 2 2
to utilization category AC-3) in combination with intermittent 2 10 5
inching (breaking several times the rated operational cur- 10 5 8 10 5
rent according to utilization category AC-4), the contact en- 10 5 8 6 8
durance can be calculated approximately from the following 8 6
4 6
equation: 6 4 4
4 2
2 2
2 10 4
4
10 8 10 4
2 3 4 5 6 8 10 20 a (A) 40 50 60 80
Characters in the equation: 7 9 12 16 e (A)

X Contact endurance for mixed operation in operating 3 5 7.5 10 PN (HP)


cycles
A Contact endurance for normal operation (Ia = Ie) in Size S0
operating cycles
B Contact endurance for inching (Ia = multiple of Ie) in
operating cycles
230 V

500 V

690 V

400 V

3RT20 23 3RT20 24 3RT20 25 3RT20 26


C Inching operations as a percentage of total switching (5 HP) (7.5 HP) (10 HP) (15 HP)
operations 10 7 NSB0_02060
10 7 8 6 8
8 6 6
4
6 4 4
4 2
2 2 3RT20 27, 3RT20 28
2 10 6 (20 HP, 25 HP)
10 6 8 10 6
10 6 8 6 8
8 6 6
4
6 4 4
4 2
2 2
2 10 5
10 5 8 10 5
10 5 8 6 8
8 6 6
4
6 4 4
4 2
2 2
2 10 4
10 4 8 104
3 4 5 6 8 10 20 30 40 50 60 80 100 150 a(A)
9 12 17 25 32 38 e(A)
5 7.5 10 15 20 25 PN (HP)

Diagram legend:
PN= Rated power for squirrel-cage motors at 460 V
Ia = Breaking current
Ie = Rated operational current

2/124 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 3/19
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT contactors
3RT1 contactors

Technical data

Endurance of the main contacts


Size S2 Size S3
Operating cycles at
230 V

500 V

690 V

400 V

Contactor 3RT2035 3RT2036 3RT2037 3RT2038

2
7 type (18,5 kW) (22 kW) (30 kW) (37 kW)
7 10
10 8 6 8 IC01_00456
8 6 4 6

Assemblies
Contactors and
6 4 4
4 2
2 6 2
2 6 10 6
6 10 8 10
10 8 6 8
8 6 4 6
6 4 4
4 2
2 5 2
2 5 10 5
5 10 8 10
10 8 6 8
8 6 4 6
6 4 4
4 2
2 2
2 4
4 10 4
10 8 10
10 20 30 40 50 60 80 100 150 200 300 400500
Breaking current a (A)

Sizes S6 to S12

3RT12 vacuum contactors


Sizes S10 and S12

I
I

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/125


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies 3RT Power Contactors for Switching MotorsSIRIUS
Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT2 contactors
3RT20 contactors, 3-pole, 3 ... 25 HP

Contactors Type 3RT20 15 3RT20 16 3RT20 17 3RT20 18


Size S00 S00 S00 S00
Width mm 45 45 45 45
s and u rated data
Rated insulation voltage V AC 600
Uninterrupted current, at 40 °C • Open and enclosed A 20
2

Maximum horsepower ratings


(s and u approved values)
• Rated power for induction motors At 200 V hp 1.5 2 3 3
Contactors and
Assemblies

at 60 Hz 230 V hp 2 3 3 5
460 V hp 3 5 7.5 10

3
575 V hp 5 7.5 10 10
Short-circuit protection1) At 600 V kA 5 5 5 5
(contactor or overload relay) • Fuse CLASS J2) A 40 40 40 40
• Circuit breakers with overload A 50 50 50 50
protection according to UL 489
• Combination motor controllers --3) --3) --3) --3)
type E according to UL 508
NEMA/EEMAC ratings
NEMA/EEMAC size -- 0
• Uninterrupted current - Open A -- 18
- Enclosed A -- 18
• Rated power for induction motors At 200 V hp -- 3
at 60 Hz 230 V hp -- 3
460 V hp -- 5
575 V hp -- 5
Overload relays • Type 3RU21 1 / 3RB30 1
• Setting range A 0.11 ... 16 / 0.1 ... 16

Contactors Type 3RT20 23 3RT20 24 3RT20 25 3RT20 26 3RT20 27 3RT20 28


Size S0 S0 S0 S0 S0 S0
Width mm 45 45 45 45 45 45
s and u rated data
Rated insulation voltage V AC 600 600
Uninterrupted current, at 40 °C • Open and enclosed A 35 42
Maximum horsepower ratings
(s and u approved values)
• Rated power for induction motors At 200 V hp 2 3 5 7.5 10 10
at 60 Hz 230 V hp 3 3 5 7.5 10 10
460 V hp 5 7.5 10 15 20 25
575 V hp 7.5 10 15 20 25 25
Short-circuit protection1) At 600 V kA 5 5 5 5 5 5
(contactor or overload relay) • Fuse CLASS J2) A 45 45 45 70 110 110
• Circuit breakers with overload A 70 70 70 100 100 100
protection according to UL 489
• Combination motor controllers
type E according to UL 508
- At 480 V Type 3RV20 2
A --
kA --3)
- At 600 V Type 3RV20 2
A --
kA --3)
NEMA/EEMAC ratings
NEMA/EEMAC size -- 1
• Uninterrupted current - Open A -- 27
- Enclosed A -- 27
• Rated power for induction motors At 200 V hp -- 7.5
at 60 Hz 230 V hp -- 7.5
460 V hp -- 10
575 V hp -- 10
Overload relays • Type 3RU21 2 / 3RB30 2
• Setting range A 1.8 ... 40 / 0.1 ... 40
1) For more information about short-circuit values,
e. g. for protection against short-circuit currents, see UL reports
(http://support.automation.siemens.com) for the individual devices.
2) Values for RK5 fuses on request.
3) Values on request.

2/126 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 3/27
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT20 contactors

and ratings of the contactors


Contactor Size S2 S2 S2 S2 S3 S3 S3
Type 3RT20 35 3RT20 36 3RT20 37 3RT20 38 3RT20 45 3RT20 46 3RT20 47
Rated Insulation Voltage AC V 600 600
Continuous current, at 40 °C
Free air and enclosed A 55 60 80 90 90 105

2
Maximum horsepower Ratings at 115 V hp 3 3 5 5 5 7.5 10
ratings single at 230 V hp 7.5 10 10 15 15 15 -

Assemblies
Contactors and
phase motors
at 50/60 Hz

and approved values


Ratings at 200 V hp 10 15 20 20 20 25 30
of three-phase motors 230 V hp 15 15 20 25 25 30 30
at 50/60 Hz 460 V hp 30 40 50 50 50 60 75
575 V hp 40 50 50 60 60 75 100
Short-circuit protection Fuse or circuit- kA 5 10 10 10 5 10 10
breaker A 150 200 250 250 250 300 350
acc. to UL 489 A 150 200 200 200 250 300 400

NEMA/EEMAC ratings NEMA/EEMAC Size 2 - 3


Conventional thermal current Free air A - 45 - - 90
Enclosed A - 45 - - 90
Ratings at 200 V hp - 10 - - 25
of three-phase motors 230 V hp - 15 - - 30
at 60 Hz 460 V hp - 25 - - 50
575 V hp - 25 - - 50

Overload Relay Type A 3RU213 / 3RB303 3RU11 4


Setting Range 11 … 80 / 12 … 80 18 … 100
Contactor Size S00 - S0 S2 - S12 Screw and
Screw and Screw and Screw and Spring con-
Spring connection Spring connection Spring connection nection
Integrated or Laterally mountable Single pole and Laterally
snap-on aux. aux. switch block 4-pole Snap-on mountable
switch block aux. switch block aux. switch
block

and ratings of the auxilary contactors


Rated Voltage AC 600 600 600 600
Switching Capacity At 240 VAC A A 600, P 600 A 600, Q 600 A 600, P 300 A 300, Q 300
Uninterrupted current 10 10 10 10

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/127


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT10 contactors

Technical data

Contactor Size S6 S6 S6 S10 S10 S10


Type 3RT10 54 3RT10 55 3RT10 56 3RT10 64 3RT10 65 3RT10 66
s and u ratings of the contactors
Rated insulation voltage AC V 600 600
2

Continuous current, at 40 °C Free air and enclosed A 140 195 195 250 330 330
Maximum horsepower ratings Ratings at 115 V
single 230 V HP 25 30 30
Contactors and
Assemblies

phase motors
at 50/60 Hz
(s and u-approved values)
Ratings 200 V HP 40 50 60 60 75 100
of three-phase motors 230 V HP 50 60 75 75 100 125
at 50/60 Hz 460 V HP 100 125 150 150 200 250
575 V HP 125 150 200 200 250 300
Short-circuit protection kA 10 10 10 10 18 18
CLASS RK5 fuse A 450 500 500 700 800 800
Circuit-breaker
acc. to UL 489 A 350 450 500 500 700 800
NEMA/EEMAC ratings NEMA/EEMAC SIZE – 4 – – – 5
Conventional thermal current Free air A – 150 – – – 300
Enclosed A – 135 – – – 270
Ratings a t 200 V HP – 40 – – – 75
of three-phase motors 230 V HP – 50 – – – 100
at 60 Hz 460 V HP – 100 – – – 200
575 V HP – 100 – – – 200
Overload relay Type 3RB20 56 3RB20 66

Contactor Size S12 S12


Type 3RT10 75 3RT10 76

Rated insulation voltage AC V 600


Continuous current, at 40 °C Free air and enclosed A 400 540
Maximum horsepower ratings
(s and u-approved values)
Ratings a t 200 V HP 125 150
of three-phase motors 230 V HP 150 200
at 50/60 Hz 460 V HP 300 400
575 V HP 400 500
Short-circuit protection kA 18 30
CLASS RK5 fuse A 1000 1200
Circuit-breaker
acc. to UL 489 A 900 900
NEMA/EEMAC ratings NEMA/EEMAC SIZE – 6
Conventional thermal current Free air A – 600
Enclosed A – 540
Ratings a t 200 V HP – 150
of three-phase motors 230 V HP – 200
at 60 Hz 460 V HP – 400
575 V HP – 400
Overload relay Type 3RB20 66

2/128 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT12 vacuum contactors, 3RT contactors for resistive loads

Technical data

Contactor Size S10 S10 S10 S12 S12


Type 3RT12 64 3RT12 65 3RT12 66 3RT12 75 3RT12 76
s and u ratings of the contactors
Rated insulation voltage AC V 600 600

2
Continuous current, at 40 °C Free air and enclosed A 330 540
Maximum horsepower ratings
(s and u-approved values)

Assemblies
Contactors and
Ratings a t 200 V HP 60 75 100 125 150
of three-phase motors 230 V HP 75 100 125 150 200
at 50/60 Hz 460 V HP 150 200 250 300 400
575 V HP 200 250 300 400 500
Short-circuit protection kA 10 18 18 18 30
CLASS RK5 fuse A 700 800 800 1200 1200
Circuit-breaker
acc. to UL 489 A 500 700 900 1000 1200
NEMA/EEMAC ratings NEMA/EEMAC SIZE – 5 – 6
Conventional thermal current Free air A – –
Enclosed A – –
Ratings a t 200 V HP – –
of three-phase motors 230 V HP – –
at 60 Hz 460 V HP – –
575 V HP – –
Overload relay Type 3RB20 66 3RB20 66

Contactor Size S3 S6 S10 S12


Type 3RT14 46 3RT14 56 3RT14 66 3RT14 76
Rated insulation voltage AC V 600
Maximum UL resistive load ratings A 110 210 360 580

Contactor Size S00 S00 S00 S0 S0 S0 S0 S2 S3 S3


Type 3RT23 15 3RT23 16 3RT23 17 3RT23 24 3RT23 25 3RT23 26 3RT23 27 3RT23 36 3RT13 44 3RT13 46
Rated insulation voltage AC V 600
Maximum UL resistive A 16 18 20 30 30 35 42 60 100 110
load ratings

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/129


3RT Power Contactors for Switching Motors
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT2.
3RT201. contactors
contactors, 3-pole, 3 ... 25 HP

Type 3RT20 15, 3RT20 16 3RT20 17, 3RT20 18


Size S00 S00
Dimensions (W x H x D)1) mm 45 x 57.5 x 73 / 45 x 70 x 73

H
• With mounted auxiliary switch block mm 45 x 57.5 x 116 / 45 x 70 x 121

D
W
• With mounted function block mm 45 x 57.5 x 142 / 45 x 70 x 142
General data
Permissible mounting positions
2

AC and DC
The contactors are designed for operation on a operation
360° 22,5° 22,5°

NSB0_00478c
vertical mounting surface.
Contactors and
Assemblies
3

Upright mounting position AC and DC Special design required.


operation Positions 13 to 16 of the Order No. must be
changed to -1AA0. Additional charge.
NSB0_00477a

Mechanical endurance
• Basic unit Operating 30 million
cycles
• Basic unit with snap-on auxiliary switch block Operating 10 million
cycles
• Solid-state compatible auxiliary switch block Operating 5 million
cycles
2)
Electrical endurance
Rated insulation voltage Ui (pollution degree 3) V 690
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 6
Protective separation between the coil and the main V 400
contacts acc. to EN 60947-1, Appendix N
Mirror contacts
A mirror contact is an auxiliary NC contact that cannot be closed
simultaneously with a NO main contact.
• 3RT20 1 ., 3RT23 1 . (removable auxiliary switch block) Yes, this applies to both the basic unit as well as to between the basic unit
and the mounted auxiliary switch block acc. to EN 60947-4-1, Appendix F
• 3RT20 1 ., 3RT23 1 . (permanently mounted auxiliary switch block) Yes, acc. to EN 60947-4-1, Appendix F
• 3RH29 19- . NF . . solid-state compatible auxiliary switch blocks have no
mirror contacts.
Ambient temperature
• During operation °C -25 ... +60
• During storage °C -55 ... +80
Protection class IP on the front acc. to IEC 60529 IP20, coil assembly IP40
Touch protection on the front acc. To IEC 60529 Finger-safe, for vertical contact from the front
(screw and spring-type terminal)
Shock resistance rectangular pulse
• AC operation g/ms 6.7/5 and 4.2/10 7.3/5 and 4.7/10
• DC operation g/ms 6.7/5 and 4.2/10 7.3/5 and 4.7/10
Shock resistance sine pulse
• AC operation g/ms 10.5/5 and 6.6/10 11.4/5 and 7.3/10
• DC operation g/ms 10.5/5 and 6.6/10 11.4/5 and 7.3/10
Conductor cross-sections 3)

Short-circuit protection for contactors without overload relays


For short-circuit protection for contactors with overload relays
see Section 3: Overload Relays
For short-circuit protection for fuseless load feeders
see Section 4: Combination Starters
Main circuit
• Fuse links, operational class gG :
NH 3NA, DIAZED 5SB, NEOZED 5SE acc. to IEC 60947-4-1/ EN 60947-4-1
- Type of coordination "1" A 35 50
- Type of coordination "2" A 20 25
4)
- Weld-free A 10 10
• Miniature circuit breakers (up to 230 V) with C characteristic A 10 10
Short-circuit current 1 kA, type of coordination "1"
Auxiliary circuit
• Fuse links, operational class gG : DIAZED 5SB, NEOZED 5SE A 10
(weld-free protection for Ik ≥ 1 kA)
• Miniature circuit breakers up to 230 V with C characteristic A 6
Short-circuit current Ik < 400 A
1) Dimensions for devices with screw terminals / spring-type terminals. 3) For conductor cross-sections see page 2/132 .
2) 4)
For endurance of the main contacts see page 2/124. Test conditions according to IEC 60947-4-1.

2/130 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


3/20 SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3RT Power Contactors for Switching Motors
Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT2. 1. contactors
3RT20 contactors, 3-pole, 3 ... 25 HP

Contactors Type 3RT20 15, 3RT20 16 3RT20 17, 3RT20 18


Size S00 S00
Width mm 45 45
Control
Solenoid coil operating range
• AC operation 50 Hz 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us
60 Hz 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us

2
• DC operation Up to 50 °C 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us
Up to 60 °C 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us
Power consumption of the solenoid coils (when coil is cold and 1.0 x Us)

Assemblies
Contactors and
• AC operation, 50/60 Hz, - Closing VA 27/24.3 37/33
standard version - P.f. 0.8/0.75 0.8/0.75

3
- Closed VA 4.2/3.3 5.7/4.4
- P.f. 0.25/0.25 0.25/0.25

• AC operation, 50 Hz, - Closing VA 26.4 36


USA/Canada - P.f. for closing 0.81 0.8
- Closed VA 4.4 5.9
- P.f. for closed 0.24 0.24

• AC operation, 60 Hz, - Closing VA 31.7 43


USA/Canada - P.f. for closing 0.81 0.8
- Closed VA 4.8 6.5
- P.f. for closed 0.25 0.25
• DC operation Closing = Closed W 4 4
Permissible residual current of the electronics (with 0 signal)
• AC operation <3 mA x (230 V/Us)1) <4 mA x (230 V/Us)1)
1)
• DC operation <10 mA x (24 V/Us)
Operating times2)
Total break time = Opening delay + Arcing time
• AC operation - Closing delay ms 9 ... 35 8 ... 33
at 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us - Opening delay ms 3.5 ... 14 4 ... 15
• DC operation - Closing delay ms 30 ... 100 30 ... 100
at 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us - Opening delay ms 7 ... 13 7 ... 13
• Arcing time ms 10 ... 15 10 ... 15
Operating times for 1.0 x Us2)
• AC operation - Closing delay ms 9.5 ... 24 9 ... 22
- Opening delay ms 4 ... 14 4.5 ... 15
• DC operation - Closing delay ms 35 ... 50 35 ... 50
- Opening delay ms 7 ... 12 7 ... 12
1) The 3RT29 16-1GA00 additional load module is recommended 2) The OFF-delay of the NO contact and the ON-delay of the NC contact are
for higher residual currents. increased if the contactor coils are attenuated against voltage peaks
(noise suppression diode 6 to 10 times; diode assemblies 2 to 6 times,
varistor +2 to 5 ms).

Contactors Type 3RT20 15 3RT20 16 3RT20 17 3RT20 18


Size S00 S00 S00 S00
Main circuit
AC capacity
Utilization category AC-1
Switching resistive loads
• Rated operational current Ie At 40 °C up to 690 V A 18 22 22 22
At 60 °C up to 690 V A 16 20 20 20
• Rated power for AC loads1) 230 V kW 6.3 7.5 7.5 7.5
P.f.= 0.95 (at 60 °C) 400 V kW 11 13 13 13
500 V kW 13.8 17 17 17
690 V kW 19 22 22 22
• Minimum conductor cross-section At 40 °C mm2 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5
for loads with Ie At 60 °C mm2 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5
Utilization category AC-3
• Rated operational currents Ie Up to 400 V A 7 9 12 16
440 V A 7 9 11 15
500 V A 6 7.7 9.2 12.4
690 V A 4.9 6.7 6.7 8.8
• Rated power for slipring or squirrel- At 200 V HP 1.5 2 3 3
cage motors at 50 and 60 Hz 230 V HP 2 3 3 5
460 V HP 3 5 7.5 10
575 V HP 5 7.5 10 10
Thermal load capacity 10 s current2) A 56 72 96 128
1) Industrial furnaces and electric heaters with resistance heating, etc. 2) According to IEC 60947-4-1.
(increased power consumption on heating up has been taken into For rated values for various start-up conditions
account). see Section 3 --> "Overload Relays".

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/131


SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 3/21
SIRIUS
3RT Power Contactors for Switching Motors
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies

Contactors for Switching Motors


3RT2. 1. contactors
3RT20 contactors, 3-pole, 3 ... 25 HP

Contactors Type 3RT20 15 3RT20 16 3RT20 17 3RT20 18


Size S00 S00 S00 S00
Width mm 45 45 45 45
Main circuit
AC capacity
Power loss per conducting path At Ie/AC-3 W 0.42 0.7 1.24 2.2
Utilization category AC-4 (for Ia = 6 x Ie)1)
2

• Rated operational current Ie Up to 400 V A 6.5 8.5 8.5 11.5


• Rated power for squirrel-cage motors with 50 Up to 400 V kW 3 4 4 5.5
Contactors and
Assemblies

Hz and 60 Hz
• The following applies to a contact endurance of about 200 000 operating
3

cycles:
- Rated operational currents Ie Up to 400 V A 2.6 4.1 4.1 5.5
690 V A 1.8 3.3 3.3 4.4
- Rated power for squirrel-cage motors with At 230 V kW 0.67 1.1 1.1 1.5
50 Hz and 60 Hz 400 V kW 1.15 2 2 2.5
500 V kW 1.45 2 2 3
690 V kW 1.15 2.5 2.5 3.5
Switching frequency
Switching frequency z in operating cycles/hour
• Contactors without overload relays No-load switching h-1 10 000
frequency AC
Dependence of the switching frequency z' on No-load switching h-1 10 000
the operational current I' and operational frequency DC
voltage U': Rated operation
z' = z ⋅ (Ie/I') ⋅ (400 V/U')1.5 ⋅ 1/h AC-1 (AC/DC) h-1 1 000
AC-2 (AC/DC) h-1 750
AC-3 (AC/DC) h-1 750
• Contactors with overload relays (mean value) AC-4 (AC/DC) h-1 250
1) h-1 15
The data only apply to 3RT25 16 and 3RT25 17 (2 NO + 2 NC) up to a
rated operational voltage of 400 V.

Contactors Type 3RT20 15 3RT20 16 3RT20 17 3RT20 18


Size S00 S00 S00 S00
mm 45 45 45 45
Conductor cross-sections
Main conductors and auxiliary conductors Screw terminals
(1 or 2 conductors can be connected)
• Solid mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5)1); 2 x (0.75 ... 2.5)1) according to IEC 60947;
max. 2 x (0.5 ... 4)
• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5)1); 2 x (0.75 ... 2.5)1)
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 2 x (20 ... 16)1); 2 x (18 ... 14)1); 2 x 12
• Terminal screw M3 (for standard screwdriver size 2 and Pozidriv 2)
• Tightening torque Nm 0.8 ... 1.2 (7 ... 10.3 lb.in)
Main conductors, auxiliary conductors and coil terminals Spring-type terminals
(1 or 2 conductors can be connected)
• Operating devices mm 3.0 x 0.5; 3.5 x 0.5
• Solid mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 4)
• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 2.5)
• Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 2.5)
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 1 x (20 ... 12)
Auxiliary conductors for front and laterally mounted auxiliary switches
(1 or 2 conductors can be connected)
• Operating devices mm 3.0 x 0.5; 3.5 x 0.5
• Solid mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 2.5)
• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5)
• Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5)
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 2 x (20 ... 14)
Main conductors and auxiliary conductors Ring lug terminal connection

• Terminal screw d3 M3, Pozidriv 2


• Operating devices d2 mm Ø 5 ... 6
• Tightening torque Nm 0.8 ... 1.2
• Usable ring terminal lugs mm d2 = min. 3.2
- DIN 46234 without insulation sleeve
- DIN 46225 without insulation sleeve mm d3 = max. 7.5
- DIN 46237 with insulation sleeve
- JIS C2805 Type R without insulation sleeve
I2_12740

- JIS C2805 Type RAV with insulation sleeve


- JIS C2805 Type RAP with insulation sleeve
An "insulation stop" must be used for conductor cross-sections ≤ 1 mm²
For tool for opening the spring-type terminals (see Accessories on page 2/81).
(see Accessories on page 2/81). 1)
If two different conductor cross-sections are connected to one clamping
Maximum external diameter of the conductor insulation: 3.6 mm. point, both cross-sections must lie in the range specified.

2/132 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


3/22 SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT2. 2. contactors

Type 3RT20 23 3RT20 24 3RT20 25 3RT20 26 3RT20 27 3RT20 28


Size S0 S0 S0 S0 S0 S0
Dimensions (W x H x D) for AC operation1) mm 45 x 85 x 97 / 45 x 101.5 x 97
• With mounted auxiliary switch block mm 45 x 85 x 141 / 45 x 101.5 x 144

H
• With mounted function block 45 x 85 x 166 / 45 x 101.5 x 166

D
W
Dimensions (W x H x D) for DC operation1) mm 45 x 85 x 107 / 45 x 101.5 x 107

2
• With mounted auxiliary switch block mm 45 x 85 x 151 / 45 x 101.5 x 154
• With mounted function block 45 x 85 x 176 / 45 x 101.5 x 176
General data

Assemblies
Contactors and
Permissible mounting positions
360° 22,5° 22,5°

NSB0_00478c
The contactors are designed for operation on a
vertical mounting surface.

Upright mounting position

AC and D operation NSB0_00477a

Special version required, also applies to


3RT20 2 . - . K . 40 . coupling relays.
Mechanical endurance
• Basic unit Operating 10 million
cycles
• Basic unit with snap-on auxiliary switch block Operating 10 million
cycles
• Solid-state compatible auxiliary switch block Operating 5 million
cycles
Electrical endurance 2)

Rated insulation voltage Ui (pollution degree 3) V 690


Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 6
Protective separation between the coil and the main contacts V 400
(acc. to EN 60947-1, Appendix N)
Mirror contacts
A mirror contact is an auxiliary NC contact that cannot be closed
simultaneously with a NO main contact.
• 3RT20 2 . , 3RT23 2 . (removable auxiliary switch block) Yes, acc. to EN 60947-4-1, Appendix F
• 3RT20 2 . , 3RT23 2 . (permanently mounted auxiliary switch block) Yes, acc. to EN 60947-4-1, Appendix F
Permissible ambient temperature
• During operation °C -25 ... +60
• During storage °C -55 ... +80
Protection class IP on the front acc. to IEC 60529 IP20, coil assembly IP20
Touch protection on the front acc. to IEC 60529 Finger-safe, for vertical contact from the front
(screw and spring-type terminal)
Shock resistance rectangular pulse
• AC operation g/ms 7.5/5 and 4.7/10 8.3/5 and 5.310
• DC operation g/ms >10/5 and 7.5/10 >10/5 and 7.5/10
Shock resistance sine pulse
• AC operation g/ms 11.8/5 and 7.4/10 13.5/5 and 8.3/10
• DC operation g/ms >15/5 and >10/10 >15/5 and >10/10
Conductor cross-sections 3)

Short-circuit protection for contactors without overload relays


Main circuit For short-circuit protection for contactors with overload relays
• Fuse links, operational class gG : see "Protection Equipment --> Overload Relays".
Type NH 3NA, DIAZED 5SB, NEOZED 5SE For short-circuit protection for fuseless load feeders
acc. to IEC 60947-4-1/ EN 60947-4-1 see "Motor Starters".
- Type of coordination "1" A 63 100 125
- Type of coordination "2" A 25 35 50
- Weld-free4) A 10 16 16
• Miniature circuit breakers with C characteristic A 25 32 40
(short-circuit current 3 kA, type of coordination "1")
Auxiliary circuit
• Fuse links, operational class gG : DIAZED 5SB, NEOZED 5SE A 10
(weld-free protection for Ik ≥ 1 kA)
• Miniature circuit breaker with C characteristic A 10
(short-circuit current Ik < 400 A)
1) Dimensions for devices with screw terminals / spring-type terminals. 3)
For conductor cross-sections page 2/136.
2) 4) Test conditions according to IEC 60947-4-1.
For endurance of the main contacts see page 2/124.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/133


SIRIUS
3RT Power Contactors for Switching Motors
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies

Contactors for Switching Motors


3RT20.2. contactors
3RT20 contactors, 3-pole, 3 ... 25 HP

Contactors Type 3RT20 23 ... 3RT20 26 ... 3RT20 2. 3RT20 2. 3RT20 2.


3RT20 25 3RT20 28 -.NB3 -.NF3.. -.NP3
Size S0 S0 S0 S0 S0
Width mm 45 45 45 45 45
Control
Solenoid coil operating range AC/DC 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us 0.7 ... 1.3 x Us
Power consumption of the solenoid coils (when coil is cold and 1.0 x Us)
2

• AC operation, 50 Hz, - Closing VA 65 77 6.5 13.6 16.1


standard version - P.f. 0.82 0.82 0.98 0.98 0.98
Contactors and
Assemblies

- Closed VA 7.6 9.8 1.26 1.91 3.41


- P.f. 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25
3

• AC operation, 50/60 Hz, - Closing VA 68/67 81/79 6.5/5.7 13.6/13.2 16.1/15.9


standard version - P.f. 0.72/0.74 0.72/0.74 0.98/0.96 0.98/0.99 0.99/0.99
- Closed VA 7.9/6.5 10.5/8.5 1.26/1.30 1.91/1.90 3.41/3.58
- P.f. 0.25/0.28 0.25/0.28 0.78/0.8 0.61/0.61 0.36/0.45
• AC operation, 50 Hz, USA/Canada - Closing VA 65 77 -- -- --
- P.f. 0.82 0.82 -- -- --
- Closed VA 7.6 9.8 -- -- --
- P.f. 0.25 0.28 -- -- --
• AC operation, 60 Hz, USA/Canada - Closing VA 73 87 -- -- --
- P.f. 0.76 0.76 -- -- --
- Closed VA 7.2 9.4 -- -- --
- P.f. 0.28 0.28 -- -- --
• DC operation Closing/closed W 5.9/5.9 5.9/5.9 6.7/0.8 13.2/1.56 15/1.83
Permissible residual current of the electronics (with 0 signal)
• AC operation mA < 6 mA x < 7 mA x (230 V/Us)
(230 V/Us)
• DC operation mA < 16 mA x (24 V/Us)
Operating times for 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us1)
Total break time = Opening delay + Arcing time
• AC operation - Closing delay ms 9 ... 38 8 ... 40 60 ... 80 50 ... 70 60 ... 80
- Opening delay ms 4 ... 16 4 ... 16 30 ... 45 35 ... 45 35 ... 45
• DC operation - Closing delay ms 50 ... 170 50 ... 170 60 ... 75 50 ... 70 50 ... 75
- Opening delay ms 15 ... 17.5 15 ... 17.5 30 ... 45 35 ... 45 40 ... 50
• Arcing time ms 10 10 10 10 10
Operating times for 1.0 x Us1)
• AC operation - Closing delay ms 10 ... 18 10 ... 17 65 ... 80 50 ... 70 60 ... 80
- Opening delay ms 4 ... 16 4 ... 16 30 ... 45 35 ... 45 30 ... 50
• DC operation - Closing delay ms 55 ... 80 55 ... 80 60 ... 80 56 ... 70 60 ... 80
- Opening delay ms 16 ... 17 16 ... 17 30 ... 45 35 ... 45 30 ... 50
1) The OFF-delay of the NO contact and the ON-delay of the NC contact are
increased if the contactor coils are attenuated against voltage peaks
(varistor +2 ms to 5 ms, diode assembly: 2 to 6 times).

2/134 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


3/24 SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012
SIRIUS
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies
3RT Power Contactors for Switching Motors
Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT20 2. contactors
3RT20 contactors, 3-pole, 3 ... 25 HP

Contactors Type 3RT20 23 3RT20 24 3RT20 25 3RT20 26 3RT20 27 3RT20 28


Size S0 S0 S0 S0 S0 S0
Width mm 45 45 45 45 45 45
Main circuit
AC capacity
Utilization category AC-1,
switching resistive loads

2
• Rated operational current Ie At 40 °C up to 690 V A 40 50
At 60 °C up to 690 V A 35 42

Assemblies
Contactors and
• Rated power for AC loads1) 230 V kW 13.3 15.5
P.f. = 0.95 (at 60 °C) 400 V kW 23 27.5

3
500 V kW 29 35
690 V kW 40 47.5
• Minimum conductor cross- At 40 °C mm2 10 10
section for loads with Ie At 60 °C mm2 10 10
Utilization category AC-3
• Rated operational currents Ie Up to 400 V A 9 12 17 25 32 38
440 V A 9 12 17 22 32 35
500 V A 9 12 17 18 32 32
690 V A 9 9 13 13 21 21
• Rated power for slipring or At 230 V HP 3 3 5 7.5 10 10
squirrel-cage motors at 460 V HP 5 7.5 10 15 20 25
50 and 60 Hz 575 V HP 7.5 10 15 20 25 25
Thermal load capacity 10 s current2) A 80 110 150 200 260 300
Power loss per conducting path at Ie/AC-3 W 0.4 0.5 0.9 1.6 2.7 3.8
Utilization category AC-4 (for Ia = 6 x Ie)
• Rated operational current Ie Up to 400 V A 8.5 12.5 15.5 15.5 22
• Rated power for squirrel-cage At 400 V kW 4 5.5 7.5 7.5 11
motors with 50 and 60 Hz
• The following applies to a contact endurance of
about 200 000 operating cycles:
- Rated operational currents Ie Up to 400 V A 4.1 5.5 7.7 9 12
690 V A 3.3 5.5 7.7 9 12
- Rated power At 110 V kW 0.5 0.73 1 1.2 1.6
for squirrel-cage motors At 230 V kW 1.1 1.5 2 2.5 3.4
with 50 and 60 Hz 400 V kW 2 2.6 3.5 4.4 6
500 V kW 2 3.3 4.6 5.6 7.5
690 V kW 2.5 4.6 6 7.7 10.3
Switching frequency
Switching frequency z in operating cycles/hour
• Contactors without overload No-load switching frequency h-1 5 000
relays AC
-1
No-load switching frequency h 1 500
Dependence of the switching fre- DC
quency z' on the operational cur- AC-1 (AC/DC) h-1 1 000
rent I’ and operational voltage U’: AC-2 (AC/DC) h-1 1 000 750
z’ = z ⋅ (Ie/I’) ⋅(400 V/U’)1.5 ⋅1/h AC-3 (AC/DC) h-1 1 000 750
AC-4 (AC/DC) h-1 300 250
• Contactors with overload relays (mean value) h-1 15
1) Industrial furnaces and electric heaters with resistance heating, etc.
(increased power consumption on heating up has been taken into
account).
2) According to IEC 60947-4-1.
For rated values for various start-up conditions
see Section 3 --> "Overload Relays" .

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/135


SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 3/25
SIRIUS
3RT Power Contactors for Switching Motors
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies

Contactors for Switching Motors


3RT20 2. contactors
3RT20 contactors, 3-pole, 3 ... 25 HP

Contactors Type 3RT20 23 3RT20 24 3RT20 25 3RT20 26 3RT20 27 3RT20 28


Size S0 S0 S0 S0 S0 S0
Width mm 45 45 45 45 45 45
Conductor cross-sections (1 or 2 conductors connectable)
Main conductors Screw terminals

Conductor cross-section
2

• Solid mm² 2 x (1 ... 2.5)1); 2 x (2.5 ... 10)1) according to IEC 60947
• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm² 2 x (1 ... 2.5)1); 2 x (2.5 ... 6)1); 1 x 10
Contactors and
Assemblies

• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 2 x (16 ... 12); 2 x (14 ... 8)
• Terminal screws M4 (Pozidriv size 2)
3

- Tightening torque Nm 2 ... 2.5 (18 ... 22 lb.in)


Auxiliary conductors
• Solid mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5)1); 2 x (0.75 ... 2.5)1) according to IEC 60947
• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5)1); 2 x (0.75 ... 2.5)1)
• Solid or stranded AWG (2 x) AWG 2 x (20 ... 16)1); 2 x (18 ... 14)1); 1 x 12
• Terminal screws M3
- Tightening torque Nm 0.8 ... 1.2 (7 ... 10.3 lb.in)
Main conductors Spring-type terminals

• Operating devices mm 3.0 x 0.5; 3.5 x 0.5


• Solid mm2 2 x (1 ... 10)
• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 x (1 ... 6)
• Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 2 x (1 ... 6)
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 2 x (18 ... 8)
Auxiliary conductors
• Operating devices 3.0 x 0.5; 3.5 x 0.5
• Solid mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 2.5)
• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5)
• Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5)
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 2 x (20 ... 14)
Main conductors Ring lug terminal connection

• Terminal screw mm M4, Pozidriv size 2


• Operating devices mm Ø 5 ... 6
• Tightening torque Nm 2 ... 2.5
• Usable ring lug terminals d3
mm d2 = min. 4.3
- DIN 46234 without insulation sleeve d2 mm d3 = max. 12.2
- DIN 46225 without insulation sleeve
- DIN 46237 with insulation sleeve
- JIS C2805 Type R without insulation sleeve
- JIS C2805 Type RAV with insulation sleeve
- JIS C2805 Type RAP with insulation sleeve
I2_12740

Auxiliary conductors
• Terminal screw M3, Pozidriv size 2
• Operating devices mm Ø 5 ... 6
• Tightening torque Nm 0.8 ... 1.2
• Usable ring terminal lugs mm d2 = min. 3.2
mm d3 = max. 7.5
1) If two different conductor cross-sections are connected to one clamping
point, both cross-sections must lie in the range specified.

Contactors Size S00 S0


Screw or spring-type Screw or spring-type Screw or spring-type
terminals terminals terminals
Integrated or 1- and 4-pole Laterally
snap-on snap-on mountable
auxiliary switch block auxiliary switch block auxiliary switch block
s and u rated data of the auxiliary contacts
Rated voltage V AC 600 600 600
Switching capacity A 600, Q 600 A 600, Q 600 A 300, Q 300
Uninterrupted current • At 240 V AC A 10 10 10

2/136 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


3/26 SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012
© Siemens AG 2015

Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS


Power Contactors for Switching Motors
Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT20.3. contactors SIRIUS 3RT20 contactors, 3-pole, up to 37 kW

Type 3RT2035 3RT2036 3RT2037 3RT2038


Size S2 S2 S2 S2
Dimensions (W x H x D) mm 55 x 114 x 130

H
• With mounted auxiliary switch block1) mm 55 x 114 x 174 / 55 x 114 x 178

D
W
• With mounted function module1) mm 55 x 114 x 199 / 55 x 114 x 202
General data
Permissible mounting position

2
The contactors are designed for operation on a 360° 22,5° 22,5°

3
NSB0_00478c
vertical mounting surface.

Assemblies
Contactors and
Upright mounting position

NSB0_00477a

Special version required


Mechanical endurance
• Basic units Operating cycles 10 million
• Basic units with snap-on auxiliary switch block Operating cycles 10 million
• Solid-state compatible auxiliary switch block Operating cycles 5 million
2)
Electrical endurance
Rated insulation voltage Ui (pollution degree 3) V 690
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 6
Protective separation between the coil and the main contacts V 400
(acc. to IEC 60947-1, Appendix N)
Mirror contacts
A mirror contact is an auxiliary NC contact that cannot be closed
simultaneously with an NO main contact.
• Integrated auxiliary switches Yes, acc. to IEC 60947-4-1, Appendix F
• 3RT202., 3RT232. (removable auxiliary switch block) Yes, acc. to IEC 60947-4-1, Appendix F
• 3RT202., 3RT232. (permanently mounted auxiliary switch block) Yes, acc. to IEC 60947-4-1, Appendix F
Permissible ambient temperature
• During operation °C -25 ... +60
• During storage °C -55 ... +80
Protection class IP on the front acc. to IEC 60529 IP20
Connection range IP00/open (where applicable, use additional terminal covers)
Touch protection on the front acc. To IEC 60529 Finger-safe, for vertical contact from the front
(screw and spring-type terminal)
Shock resistance rectangular pulse
• AC operation g/ms 11.8/5 and 7.4/10
• AC/DC operation g/ms 7.7/5 and 4.5/10
Shock resistance sine pulse
• AC operation g/ms 18.5/5 and 11.6/10
• AC/DC operation g/ms 12/5 and 7/10
3)
Conductor cross-sections
Short-circuit protection
Main circuit Short-circuit protection for contactors with overload relays
• Fuse links, operational class gG: See Configuration Manual "Configuring SIRIUS Innovations" 4)
LV HRC, type 3NA; DIAZED, type 5SB; NEOZED, type 5SE Short-circuit protection for fuseless load feeders
according to IEC 60947-4-1/EN 60947-4-1 See Chapter 8, "Load Feeders and Motor Starters for Use in the
Control Cabinet" "SIRIUS 3RA2 Load Feeders"
- Type of coordination "1" A 160 160 250 250
- Type of coordination "2" A 80 80 125 160
- Weld-free5) A On request
Auxiliary circuit
• Fuse links, operational class gG: A 10
DIAZED, type 5SB; NEOZED, type 5SE
(weld-free protection Ik ≤ 1 kA)
• Miniature circuit breakers 230 V, C characteristic A 10
(short-circuit current Ik < 400 A)
1)
Dimensions for devices with screw terminals / spring-type terminals.
2) For contact endurance of the main contacts, see page 3/17.
3)
For conductor cross-sections, see page 3/28.
4)
See http://support.automation.siemens.com/WW/view/en/39714188
5) Test conditions according to IEC 60947-4-1.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/137


Siemens IC 10 · 2015 3/29
© Siemens AG 2015

Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS


Power Contactors for Switching Motors
Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT20.3. contactors
SIRIUS 3RT20 contactors, 3-pole, up to 37 kW

Type 3RT2035 3RT2036 3RT2037 3RT2038


Size S2 S2 S2 S2
Control
Type of operating mechanism AC AC/DC
Solenoid coil operating range
• AC operation, 50 Hz 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us
32

• AC operation, 60 Hz -- 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us
• DC operation -- 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us
Power consumption of the solenoid coils (for cold coil and 1.0 x Us)
Contactors and
Assemblies

• AC operation, 50 Hz, standard version - Closing VA 190 --


- P.f. 0.72 --
- Closed VA 16 --
- P.f. 0.37 --
• AC operation, 50/60 Hz, standard version - Closing VA -- 210/188 --
- P.f. -- 0.69/0.65 --
- Closed VA -- 17.2/16.5 --
- P.f. -- 0.36/0.39 --
• AC operation, 50/60 Hz, for USA/Canada - Closing VA -- 212/188 --
- P.f. -- 0.67/0.65 --
- Closed VA -- 18.516.5 --
- P.f. -- 0.37/0.39 --
• AC/DC operation - Closing for AC operation VA -- 40
- P.f. -- 0.64/0.5
- Closed for AC operation VA -- 2
- P.f. -- 0.36/0.39
- Closing for DC operation W -- 23
- Closed for DC operation W -- 1

Permissible residual current of the electronics (with 0 signal)


• AC operation mA <20
• DC operation mA <20
Operating times for 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us1)
Total break time = Opening delay + Arcing time
• AC operation - Closing delay ms 10 ... 80 45 ... 70
- Opening delay ms 10 ... 18 35 ... 55
• DC operation - Closing delay ms -- 45 ... 60
- Opening delay ms -- 35 ... 55
• Arcing time ms 10 ... 20 10 ... 20
Operating times for 1.0 x Us1)
• AC operation - Closing delay ms 12 ...22 50 ... 60
- Opening delay ms 10 ...18 40 ... 50
• DC operation - Closing delay ms -- 45 ... 55
- Opening delay ms -- 40 ... 50

Main circuit
Load rating with AC
Utilization category AC-1,
switching resistive loads
• Rated operational current Ie At 40 °C up to 690 V A 60 70 80 90
At 60 °C up to 690 V A 55 60 70 80
• Rated power for AC loads2) 230 V kW 23 26 30 34
P.f. = 0.95 (at 60 °C) 400 V kW 39 46 53 59
690 V kW 68 79 91 102
• Minimum conductor At 40 °C mm2 16 25 25 35
cross-section for loads with Ie At 60 °C mm2 16 16 25 25
Utilization categories AC-2 and AC-3
• Rated operational currents Ie Up to 400 V A 40 50 65 80
440 V A 40 50 65 80
500 V A 40 50 65 80
690 V A 24 24 47 58
• Rated power for slipring At 230 V kW 11 15 18.5 22
or squirrel-cage motors 400 V kW 18.5 22 30 37
at 50 and 60 Hz 690 V kW 22 22 37 45
Thermal load capacity 10 s current3) A 400 420 520 640
Power loss per conducting path At Ie/AC-3 W 2.2 4 3.8 5.7

1) 2)
The OFF-delay of the NO contact and the ON-delay of the NC contact are Industrial furnaces and electric heaters with resistance heating, etc.
increased if the contactor coils are attenuated against voltage peaks (increased power consumption on heating up has been taken into account).
(varistor +2 ms to 5 ms, diode assembly: 2 to 6 times). 3) According to IEC 60947-4-1.
Rated values for various start-up conditions,
see Chapter 7, "Protection Equipment" "Overload Relays".

2/138 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


3/30 Siemens IC 10 · 2015
© Siemens AG 2015

Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS


Power Contactors for Switching Motors
Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT20.3. contactors
SIRIUS 3RT20 contactors, 3-pole, up to 37 kW

Type 3RT2035 3RT2036 3RT2037 3RT2038


Size S2 S2 S2 S2
Main circuit
Load rating with AC
Utilization category AC-4 (for Ia = 6 x Ie)
• Maximum values:

2
- Rated operational current Ie Up to 400 V A 35 41 55 55
- Rated power for squirrel-cage motors At 400 V kW 18.5 22 30 30

3
Assemblies
Contactors and
with 50 Hz and 60 Hz
• The following applies to a contact endurance
of about 200 000 operating cycles:
- Rated operational currents Ie Up to 400 V A 22 24 28 30
690 V A 18.5 20 22 24
- Rated power At 110 V kW 3.2 3.5 4.1 4.3
for squirrel-cage motors 230 V kW 6.7 7.3 8.5 9.1
with 50 Hz and 60 Hz 400 V kW 11.6 12.6 14.7 15.8
690 V kW 16.8 18.2 20 21.8
Load rating with DC
Utilization category DC-1, switching resistive loads (L/R ≤ 1 ms)
• Rated operational currents Ie (at 60 °C)
- 1 conducting path Up to 24 V A 55
60 V A 23
110 V A 4.5
220 V A 1
440 V A 0.4
600 V A 0.25
- 2 conducting paths in series Up to 24 V A 55
60 V A 45
110 V A 25
220 V A 5
440 V A 1
600 V A 0.8
- 3 conducting paths in series Up to 24 V A 55
60 V A 55
110 V A 55
220 V A 45
440 V A 2.9
600 V A 1.4
Utilization category DC-3/DC-5,
shunt-wound and series-wound motors (L/R ≤ 15 ms)
• Rated operational currents Ie (at 60 °C)
- 1 conducting path Up to 24 V A 35
60 V A 6
110 V A 2.5
220 V A 2
440 V A 0.1
600 V A 0.06
- 2 conducting paths in series Up to 24 V A 55
60 V A 45
110 V A 25
220 V A 5
440 V A 0.27
600 V A 0.16
- 3 conducting paths in series Up to 24 V A 55
60 V A 55
110 V A 55
220 V A 25
440 V A 0.6
600 V A 0.35
Switching frequency
Switching frequency z in operating cycles/hour
Contactors without overload relays
• No-load switching frequency AC h-1 5 000
AC/DC h-1 1 500
• Switching frequency z during rated operation1)
- Ie/AC-1 At 400 V h-1 1 200 1 000 800 700
- Ie/AC-2 At 400 V h-1 750 600 400 350
- Ie/AC-3 At 400 V h-1 1 000 800 700 500
- Ie/AC-4 At 400 V h-1 300 250 200 150
Contactors with overload relays
• Mean val ue h-1 15
1)
Dependence of the switching frequency z’ on the operational current I’ and operational voltage U’:
z’ = z x (Ie/I’) x (400 V/U’)1.5 x 1/h

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/139


Siemens IC 10 · 2015 3/31
© Siemens AG 2015

Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS


Power Contactors for Switching Motors
Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT20.3. contactors
SIRIUS 3RT20 contactors, 3-pole, up to 37 kW

Type 3RT2035 3RT2036 3RT2037 3RT2038


Size S2 S2 S2 S2
Conductor cross-sections (1 or 2 conductors connectable)
Main conductors Screw terminals

• Solid or stranded mm² 2 x (1 ... 35)1); 1 x (1 ... 50)1)


• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm² 2 x (1 ... 25)1); 1 x (1 ... 35)1)
2

• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 2 x (18 ... 2)1); 1 x (18 ... 1)1)

3
• Terminal screws Pozidriv size 2; ∅ 5 ... 6
Contactors and
Assemblies

- Tightening torque Nm 3 ... 4.5 (27 ... 40 lb.in)


Auxiliary and control conductors
• Solid or stranded mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5)1); 2 x (0.75 ... 2.5)1)
• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5)1); 2 x (0.75 ... 2.5)1)
• Solid or stranded AWG (2 x) AWG 2 x (20 ... 16)1); 2 x (18 ... 14)1)
• Terminal screws M3 (for Pozidriv size 2, ∅ 5 ... 6)
- Tightening torque Nm 0.8 ... 1.2 (7 ... 10.3 lb.in)
Auxiliary and control conductors2) Spring-type terminals

• Operating devices3) mm 3.0 x 0.5


• Solid or stranded mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 2.5)
• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5)
• Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 2.5)
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 2 x (20 ... 14)
1)
If two different conductor cross-sections are connected to one clamping
point, both cross-sections must lie in one of the ranges specified.
2)
Max. external diameter of the cable insulation: 3.6 mm.
On spring-type terminals with conductor cross-sections ≤ 1 mm²,
an insulation stop must be used, see Accessories, page 3/76.
3) Tool for opening the spring-type terminals;
see "Accessories", page 3/76.

Data for North America


Type 3RT2015 3RT2016 3RT2017 3RT2018
Size S00 S00 S00 S00
s and u rated data
Rated insulation voltage V AC 600
Uninterrupted current, at 40 °C, open and enclosed A 20
Maximum horsepower ratings
(from s and u approved values)
• Rated power for three-phase motors At 200 V hp 1.5 2 3 3
at 60 Hz 230 V hp 2 3 3 5
460 V hp 3 5 7.5 10
575 V hp 5 7.5 10 10
Short-circuit protection1) At 600 V kA 5
(contactor or overload relay)
2)
• Fuse CLASS J A 40
• Circuit breakers with overload protection A 50
acc. to UL 489
• Combination motor controllers type E Values on request.
according to UL 508 and UL 60947-4-1
Overload relays
• Type 3RU211 / 3RB301
• Setting range A 0.11 ... 16 / 0.1 ... 16
1)
For more information about short-circuit values, e.g. for protection against
short-circuit currents, see the UL reports on the individual devices,
www.siemens.com/sirius/manuals.
For the dimensioning of load feeders, see also the
Configuration Manual "Configuring SIRIUS Innovations for UL",
http://support.automation.siemens.com/WW/view/en/53433538.
2) Values for RK5 fuses on request.

2/140 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Siemens IC 10 · 2015 3/33
SIRIUS
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies
Contactors
SIRIUS for Switching Motors Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT20.4. contactors
3RT10 4. contactors

Technical data

Contactor Size S3 S3 S3
Type 3RT20 45 3RT20 46 3RT20 47
General data
Permissible mounting position AC and DC operation For DC operation and forward
The contactors are designed for operation inclination up to 22.5°: coil voltage

2
on a vertical mounting surface. tolerance 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us

Assemblies
Contactors and
Upright mounting position:

AC and DC operation Special design required.


Positions 13 to 16 of the Order No. must be changed to -1AA0.
Additional charge.

Mechanical Basic units Oper. 10 million


endurance Basic unit with snap-on auxiliary switch block cycles 10 million
Solid-state compatible aux. switch block 5 million
Electrical endurance See page 2/125.
Rated insulation voltage Ui (pollution degree 3) V 1000
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 6
Safe isolation between coil and main contacts V 690
(acc. to DIN VDE 0106 Part 101 and A1 [draft 2/89])
Positively driven operation 3RT20 4 ., 3RT23 4 ., 3RT24 5 . Yes, between main contacts and auxiliary NC contacts and within
There is positively driven operation if the NC and (removable aux. switch block) the auxiliary switch blocks acc. to ZH 1/457, IEC 60 947-4-1,
NO contacts cannot be closed at the same time Annex H (draft 17B/996/DC)
3RT20 4 ., 3RT23 4 ., 3RT24 5 . in accordance with Swiss regulations (SUVA) on request.
(permanent aux. switch block)
Permissible ambient temperature in operation °C –25 ... +60
when stored °C –55 ... +80
Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60 947-1 and DIN 40 050 IP 20 (terminal compartment IP 00), coil system IP 40
Shock resistance Rectangular pulse AC and DC operation g/ms 6.8/5 and 4/10
Sine pulse AC and DC operation g/ms 10.6/5 and 6.2/10
Conductor cross-sections See page 2/144.
Short-circuit protection of contactors without overload relays For short-circuit protection of contactors with overload relays, see
Section 3.
For short-circuit protection of fuseless load feeders, see Section 4.
Main circuit
Fuse links, utilization category gL/gG
NH Type 3NA, DIAZED Type 5SB, NEOZED Type 5SE
– acc. to IEC 60 947-4/ Type of coord. "1" 1) A 250 250
EN 60 947-4-4 (VDE 0660 Part 102)
Type of coord. "2" 1) A 125 160
Weld-free 2) A 63 100
Auxiliary circuit
Fuse links, utilization category gL/gG A 10
DIAZED Type 5SB, NEOZED Type 5SE (weld-free protection at Ik 1 kA)
or miniature circuit-breaker with C-characteristic (short-circuit current Ik < 400 A) A 10

1) According to excerpt from Type of coordination "2": 2) Test conditions acc. to IEC 60 947-4-1.
IEC 60 947-4-1 (VDE 0660 Part 102): No damage can be tolerated to the overload relay,
Type of coordination "1": but contact welding on the contactor is permitted if
Destruction of the contactor and the overload the contacts can be easily separated.
relay is permissible. The contactor and/or over-
load relay must be replaced if necessary.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/141


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT20.4. contactors

Technical data

Contactor Size S3 S3 S3
Type 3RT20 45 3RT20 46 3RT20 47
Control circuit
Coil voltage tolerance AC/DC 0.8 to 1.1 × Us
2

Power consumption of the coils (with coil in cold state and 1.0 × Us) Standard design
AC operation Hz 50 50/60 50 50/60
Contactors and
Assemblies

Closing VA 218 247 /211 270 298 /274


p.f. 0.61 0.62/ 0.57 0.68 0.7/ 0.62
Closed VA 21 25 / 18 22 27 / 20
p.f. 0.26 0.27/ 0.3 0.27 0.29/ 0.31
For USA and Canada
Hz 50 60 50 60
Closing VA 218 232 270 300
p.f. 0.61 0.55 0.68 0.52
Closed VA 21 20 22 21
p.f. 0.26 0.28 0.27 0.29
DC operation closing = closed W 15 15
Permissible residual current of the electronics
(with 0 signal)
< 25 mA × ----------- 
230 V
AC operation mA
 Us 
DC operation mA < 43 mA × 24
--------V- 
 Us 
Operating times at 0.8 to 1.1 × Us 1)
Break-time = opening time + arcing time
AC operation closing time ms 16 ... 57 17 ... 90
opening time ms 10 ... 19 10 ... 25
DC operation closing time ms 90 ... 230 90 ... 230
opening time ms 14 ... 20 14 ... 20
Arcing time ms 10 ... 15 10 ... 15
Operating times at 1.0 × Us 1)
AC operation closing time ms 18 ... 34 18 ... 30
opening time ms 11 ... 18 11 ... 23
DC operation closing time ms 100 ... 120 100 ... 120
opening time ms 16 ... 20 16 ... 20
Main circuit
Load ratings with AC
AC-1 utilization category, switching resistive load
Rated operational currents Ie at 40 °C up to 690 V A 100 120 120
1000 V A 50 60 70
at 60 °C up to 690 V A 90 100 100
1000 V A 40 50 60
Ratings at 230 V kW 34 38 38
of three-phase loads 2) 400 V kW 59 66 66
p.f. = 0.95 (at 60 °C) 500 V kW 74 82 82
690 V kW 102 114 114
1000 V kW 66 82 98
Minimum conductor cross-section with Ie load at 40 °C mm2 35 50 50
60 °C mm2 35 35 35
AC-2 and AC-3 utilization categories
Rated operational currents Ie up to 400 V A 65 80 95
500 V A 65 80 95
690 V A 47 58 58
1000 V A 25 30 30
Ratings of slipring or squirrel-cage at 230 V kW 18.5 22 22
motors at 50 Hz and 60 Hz 400 V kW 30 37 45
500 V kW 37 45 55
690 V kW 55 55 55
1000 V kW 30 37 37
Thermal loading capacity 10 s current 3) A 600 760 760
Power loss per conducting path at Ie/AC-3 W 4.6 7.7 10.8

1) The opening times of the NO contacts and the 2) Industrial furnaces and electric heaters with 3) Acc. to VDE 0660 Part 102.
closing times of the NC contacts increase if the resistance heating, for example (higher current For rated values for various starting conditions,
contactor coils are protected against voltage input allowed for during heating up). see Section 3.
peaks (varistor +2 ms to 5 ms, diode assem-
blies 2 to 6 times).

2/142 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies
Contactors
SIRIUS for Switching Motors Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT20.4. contactors
3RT10 4. contactors

Technical data

Contactor Size S3 S3 S3
Type 3RT20 45 3RT20 46 3RT20 47
Main circuit
Load ratings with AC
AC-4 utilization category (at Ia = 6 × Ie)

2
Rated operational current Ie up to 400 V A 55 66 80
Ratings of squirrel-cage motors at 400 V kW 30 37 45

Assemblies
Contactors and
at 50 Hz and 60 Hz
For a contact endurance of approx. 200 000 operating cycles:
Rated operational currents Ie up to 400 V A 28 34 42
690 V A 28 34 42
1000 V A 20 23 23
Ratings of squirrel-cage motors at 230 V kW 8.7 10.4 12
at 50 Hz and 60 Hz 400 V kW 15.1 17.9 22
500 V kW 18.4 22.4 27
690 V kW 25.4 30.9 38
1000 V kW 22 30 30
AC-5a utilization category, switching gas discharge lamps
per main conducting path at 230 V
Rating Rated operational
per lamp current per lamp (A)
uncorrected
L 18 W 0.37 Units 243 270
L 36 W 0.43 Units 209 232
L 58 W 0.67 Units 134 149
lead-lag
L 18 W 0.11 Units 818 909
L 36 W 0.21 Units 428 476
L 58 W 0.32 Units 281 312
Switching gas discharge lamps with correction, electronic ballast
per main conducting path at 230 V
Rating Capacitor Rated operational
per lamp (µF) current per lamp (A)
Parallel correction
L 18 W 4.5 0.11 Units 160 197 234
L 36 W 4.5 0.21 Units 160 197 234
L 58 W 7 0.32 Units 103 127 150
With electronic ballast,
single lamp
L 18 W 6.8 0.10 Units 455 560 665
L 36 W 6.8 0.18 Units 253 311 369
L 58 W 10 0.27 Units 168 207 246
With electronic ballast,
twin lamp
L 18 W 10 0.18 Units 253 311 369
L 36 W 10 0.35 Units 130 160 190
L 58 W 22 0.52 Units 88 108 128

AC-5b utilization category, switching incandescent lamps


per main conducting path at 230/220 V kW 9 14.6 17.3

AC-6a utilization category, switching three-phase transformers


with inrush n 30 20 30 20 30 20
Rated operational current Ie up to 400 V A 42.3 63.5 56.3 80 56.3 84.4
690 V A 42.3 47 56.3 58 56.3 58
Ratings of three-phase transformers at 230 V kVA 16.8 25.3 22.4 31.9 22.4 33.6
with an inrush of n = 30 or 20. 400 V kVA 29.3 43.9 39 55.4 39 58
The ratings must be re-calculated 500 V kVA 36.6 54.9 48.7 69.3 48.7 73.1
for other inrush factors x: 690 V kVA 50.3 56.2 67.3 69.3 67.3 69.3

Px = Pn 30

AC-6b utilization category, switching low-inductance


(low-loss, metallized-dielectric) three-phase capacitors
Ambient temperature 40 °C
Rated operational currents Ie up to 400 V A 57 72
Ratings of single capacitors at 230 V kvar 24 29
or of capacitor banks (minimum inductance between 400 V kvar 40 50
parallel capacitors 6 µH) at 50 Hz, 60 Hz and 525 V kvar 50 65
690 V kvar 40 50

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/143


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT20.4. contactors

Technical data

Contactor Size S3 S3 S3
Type 3RT20 45 3RT20 46 3RT20 47
Main circuit
Load ratings with DC
DC-1 utilization category,
2

switching resistive load (L/R ≤ 1 ms)


Rated operational current Ie (at 60 °C)
Contactors and
Assemblies

Number of conducting paths connected in series 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3


up to 24 V A 90 90 90 100 100 100 100 100 100
60 V A 23 90 90 60 100 100 60 100 100
110 V A 4.5 90 90 9 100 100 9 100 100
220 V A 1 5 70 2 10 80 2 10 80
440 V A 0.4 1 2.9 0.6 1.8 1.8 0.6 1.8 4.5
600 V A 0.26 0.8 1.4 0.4 1 1 0.4 1 2.6
DC-3 and DC-5 utilization categories,
shunt and series motors (L/R ≤ 15 ms)
Rated operational current Ie (at 60 °C)
Number of conducting paths connected in series 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3
up to 24 V A 40 90 90 40 100 100 40 100 100
60 V A 6 90 90 6.5 100 100 6.5 100 100
110 V A 2.5 90 90 2.5 100 100 2.5 100 100
220 V A 1 7 35 1 7 35 1 7 35
440 V A 0.15 0.42 0.8 0.15 0.42 0.8 0.15 0.42 0.8
600 V A 0.06 0.16 0.35 0.06 0.16 0.35 0.06 0.16 0.35
Operating frequency
Operating frequency z in operating cycles per hour AC DC AC DC AC DC
Contactors without overload relays No-load operating 1/h 5000 1000 5000 1000 5000 1000
frequency
Dependence of the operating frequency z’ on the
operational current I’ and the operational voltage U’: AC/DC AC/DC AC/DC
for AC-1 1/h 1000 900 900
for AC-2 1/h 400 400 350
z’ = z ⋅ ---- ⋅ ---------- 
I e 400 V 1.5
1/h for AC-3 1/h 1000 1000 850
I′  U′  for AC-4 1/h 300 300 250
Contactors with overload relays (mean value) 1/h 15 15 15

Contactor Size S3
Type 3RT20 4.
Conductor cross-sections
Screw connections Main conductor: Front terminal Back terminal Both terminals
(1 or 2 conductor With box terminal connected connected connected
connections possible) Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2.5 ... 35 2.5 ... 50 max. 2 × 35
Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 4 ... 50 10 ... 50 max. 2 × 35
Solid mm2 2.5 ... 16 2.5 ... 16 max. 2 × 16
Stranded mm2 4 ... 70 10 ... 70 max. 2 × 50
Ribbon cable (qty. × width × thickness) mm 6 × 9 × 0.8 6 × 9 × 0.8 2 × (6 × 9 × 0.8)
AWG conductor connections, solid and stranded AWG 10 ... 2/0 10 ... 2/0 2 × (10 ... 1/0)
– Terminal screws M 6 (hexagon socket)
– Tightening torque Nm 4 ... 6 (36 ... 53 lb.in)
Connection for drilled max. width mm 10 If bars larger than 12 × 10 mm are con-
copper bars nected, a 3RT19 46-4EA1 terminal cover is to
comply with the phase clearance.
Without box terminal Finely stranded with cable lug mm2 10 ... 501) If conductors larger than 25 mm2 are con-
With cable lugs Stranded with cable lug mm2 10 ... 701) nected, a 3RT19 46-4EA1 terminal cover is
(1 or 2 conductor AWG conductor connections, solid or stranded 7 ... 1/0 needed to comply with the phase clearance.
connections possible)
Auxiliary conductor:
Solid mm2 2 × (0.5 ... 1.5); 2 × (0.75 ... 2.5) acc. to IEC 60 947;
max. 2 × (0.75 ... 4)
Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 × (0.5 ... 1.5); 2 × (0.75 ... 2.5)
AWG conductor connections, solid or stranded AWG 2 × (20 ... 16); 2 × (18 ... 14); 1 × 12
– Terminal screws M3
– Tightening torque Nm 0.8 ... 1.2 (7 ... 10.3 lb.in)
Cage Clamp connections Auxiliary conductor:
(1 or 2 conductor Solid mm2 2 × (0.25 ... 2.5)
connections possible) Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 × (0.25 ... 1.5)
Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 2 × (0.25 ... 2.5)
AWG conductor connections, solid or stranded AWG 2 × (24 ... 14)
• For tool for opening
opening the Cage Clamp connection,
connection, see
see on accessories
accessories on page
page2/81
2/46.
• An "insulation
“insulation stop"
stop” must
must be
be used
used for
for conductor cross-sections ≤≤11 mm2,
conductor cross-sections see accessories
mm2, see accessories on page
page 2/46.
2/81.
• Max. outer diameter of conductor insulation:
insulation: 3.6 mm.
• For information about Cage Clamp
Clamp connections,
connections, see
see Appendix
Appendixpage
page19/17.
19/17.
1) Only
Only crimping
crimping cable
cablelugs
lugsacc.
acc.totoDIN
DIN46 46234
234

2/144 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT10.5. contactors

Technical data

Contactor Size S6 S6 S6
Type 3RT10 54 3RT10 55 3RT10 56
General data
Permissible mounting position
The contactors are designed for operation

2
on a vertical mounting surface.

Assemblies
Contactors and
Mechanical endurance Oper. 10 million
cycles
Electrical endurance See page 2/125
Rated insulation voltage Ui (pollution degree 3) V 1000
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 8
Safe isolation between coil, auxiliary contacts and main contacts V 690
(acc. to DIN VDE 0106 Part 101 and A1 [draft 2/89])
Positively driven operation Yes, between main contacts and auxiliary NC contacts and within
There is positively driven operation if the NC and the auxiliary switch blocks acc. to ZH 1/457, IEC 60 947-4-1,
NO contacts cannot be closed at the same time Annex H (draft 17B/996/DC)
Permissible ambient temperature in operation °C –25 ... +60/+55 with AS-Interface
when stored °C –55 ... +80
Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60 947-1 and DIN 40 050 IP 00/open type, coil system IP 20
Shock resistance Rectangular pulse g/ms 8.5/5 and 4.2/10
Sine pulse g/ms 13.4/5 and 6.5/10

Conductor cross-sections See page 2/147


Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) See page 2/108
Short-circuit protection of contactors without overload relays See Part 4.
Main circuit
Fuse links, utilization category gL/gG
NH Type 3NA, DIAZED Type 5SB, NEOZED Type 5SE
– acc. to IEC 60 947-4-1/EN 60 947-4-1 Type of coord. "1" 1) A 355 355
Type of coord. "2" 1) A 315 315
Weld-free 2) A 80 160
Auxiliary circuit
Fuse links, utilization category gL/gG A 10
(weld-free protection at Ik 1 kA)
DIAZED Type 5SB, NEOZED Type 5SE
or miniature circuit-breaker with C-characteristic (Ik < 400 A)

Contactor Size S6
Type 3RT10 5 .
Control circuit
Coil voltage tolerance AC/DC (UC) 0.8 × Us min ... 1.1 × Us max
Power consumption of solenoid mechanism Conventional op. mechanism Solid-state op. mechanism
(with coil in cold state and rated range Us min ... Us max) Us min Us max Us min Us max
AC operation Closing VA 250 300 190 280
p.f. 0.9 0.9 0.8 0.8
Closed VA 4.8 5.8 3.5 4.4
p.f. 0.8 0.8 0.5 0.4
DC operation Closing W 300 360 250 320
Closed W 4.3 5.2 2.3 2.8
PLC control input (EN 61 131-2/Type 2) DC 24 V/ 30 mA
Operating times Conventional op. mechanism Solid-state op. mechanism
(Break-time = opening time + arcing time) Operation via
A1/A2 PLC input
– at 0.8 × Us min ... 1.1 × Us max closing time ms 20 ... 95 95 ... 135 35 ... 75
opening time ms 40 ... 60 80 ... 90 80 ... 90
– at Us min ... Us max closing time ms 25 ... 50 100 ... 120 40 ... 60
opening time ms 40 ... 60 80 ... 90 80 ... 90
Arcing time ms 10 ... 15 10 ... 15 10 ... 15

1) According to excerpt from Type of coordination "2": 2) Test conditions acc. to IEC 60 947-4-1.
IEC 60 947-4-1 (VDE 0660 Part 102): No damage can be tolerated to the overload relay,
Type of coordination "1": but contact welding on the contactor is permitted if
Destruction of the contactor and the overload the contacts can be easily separated.
relay is permissible. The contactor and/or over-
load relay must be replaced if necessary.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/145


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT10.5. contactors

Technical data

Contactor Size S6 S6 S6
Type 3RT10 54 3RT10 55 3RT10 56
Main circuit
Load ratings with AC
AC-1 utilization category, switching resistive load
2

Rated operational currents Ie at 40 °C up to 690 V A 160 185 215


at 60 °C up to 690 V A 140 160 185
Contactors and
Assemblies

at 60 °C up to 1000 V A 80 90 100
Ratings of three-phase loads 1) at 230 V kW 53 60 70
p.f. = 0.95 (at 60 °C) 400 V kW 92 105 121
500 V kW 115 131 152
690 V kW 159 181 210
1000 V kW 131 148 165
Minimum conductor cross-section with Ie load at 40 °C mm2 70 95 95
60 °C mm2 50 70 95
AC-2 and AC-3 utilization categories
Rated operational currents Ie up to 500 V A 115 150 185
690 V A 115 150 170
1000 V A 53 65 65
Ratings of slipring or squirrel-cage at 230 V kW 37 50 61
motors at 50 Hz and 60 Hz 400 V kW 64 84 104
500 V kW 81 105 132
690 V kW 113 146 167
1000 V kW 75 90 90
Thermal loading capacity 10 s current 2) A 1100 1300 1480
Power loss per conducting path at Ie/AC-3/500 V W 7 9 13
AC-4 utilization category (at Ia = 6 × Ie)
Rated operational current Ie up to 400 V A 97 132 160
Ratings of squirrel-cage motors at 400 V kW 55 75 90
at 50 Hz and 60 Hz
For a contact endurance of approx. 200 000 operating cycles:
Rated operational currents Ie up to 500 V A 54 68 81
690 V A 48 57 65
1000 V A 34 38 42
Ratings of squirrel-cage motors at 230 V kW 16 20 25
at 50 Hz and 60 Hz 400 V kW 29 38 45
500 V kW 37 47 57
690 V kW 48 55 65
1000 V kW 49 55 60
AC-6a utilization category, switching three-phase transformers
with inrush n 30 20 30 20 30 20
Rated operational current Ie up to 690 V A 90 115 99 148 99 148
Ratings of three-phase transformers at 230 V kVA 35 45 39 58 39 58
with an inrush of n = 30 or 20. 400 V kVA 62 79 68 102 68 102
The ratings must be re-calculated 500 V kVA 77 99 85 128 85 128
for other inrush factors x: 690 V kVA 107 137 118 176 118 176
30 1000 V kVA 80 80 98 98 117 117
Px = Pn 30 ⋅ ------
x

AC-6b utilization category, switching low-inductance


(low-loss, metallized-dielectric) three-phase capacitors
Ambient temperature 40 °C
Rated operational currents Ie up to 500 V A 105 125 145
Ratings of single capacitors at 230 V kvar 42 50 58
or of capacitor banks (minimum inductance 400 V kvar 72 86 100
between parallel capacitors 6 µH) 500 V kvar 90 108 125
at 50 Hz, 60 Hz and 690 V kvar 72 86 100

1) Industrial furnaces and electric heaters with 2) Acc. to VDE 0660 Part 102.
resistance heating, for example (higher current For rated values for various starting conditions,
input allowed for during heating up). see Section 3.

2/146 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies
Contactors
SIRIUS for Switching Motors Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT10 5. contactors

Technical data

Contactor Size S6 S6 S6
Type 3RT10 54 3RT10 55 3RT10 56
Main circuit
Load ratings with DC
DC-1 utilization category,

2
switching resistive load (L/R ≤ 1 ms)
Rated operational current Ie (at 60 °C)

Assemblies
Contactors and
Number of conducting paths connected in series 1 2 3
up to 24 V A 160 160 160
60 V A 160 160 160
110 V A 18 160 160
220 V A 3.4 20 160
440 V A 0.8 3.2 1.4
600 V A 0.5 1.6 0.75
DC-3 and DC-5 utilization categories,
shunt and series motors (L/R ≤ 15 ms)
Rated operational current Ie (at 60 °C)
Number of conducting paths connected in series 1 2 3
up to 24 V A 160 160 160
60 V A 7.5 160 160
110 V A 2.5 160 160
220 V A 0.6 2.5 160
440 V A 0.17 0.65 11.5
600 V A 0.12 0.37 4
Operating frequency
Operating frequency z in operating cycles per hour
Contactors without overload relays No-load operating 1/h 2000 2000
frequency
Dependence of the operating frequency z’ on the for AC-1 1/h 800 800
operational current I’ and the operational voltage U’: for AC-2 1/h 400 300
for AC-3 1/h 1000 750
I 400 V 1.5 for AC-4 1/h 130 130
- ⋅ ----------
z’ = z ⋅ ---
I′  U ′  1/h
Contactors with overload relays (mean value) 1/h 60 60

Contactor Size S6
Type 3RT10 5.
Conductor cross-sections
Screw connections Main conductor: Front terminal Back terminal Both terminals
with 3RT19 55-4G box terminal (75 HP) connected connected connected
finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 16 ... 70 16 ... 70 max. 1 × 50, 1 × 70
Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 16 ... 70 16 ... 70 max. 1 × 50, 1 × 70
Stranded mm2 16 ... 70 16 ... 70 max. 2 × 70
AWG conductor connections, solid/stranded 6 ... 2/0 6 ... 2/0 max. 2 × 1/0
Ribbon cable (qty. x width × thickness) mm min. 3 × 9 × 0.8 min. 3 × 9 × 0.8
mm max. 6 × 15.5 × 0.8 max. 6 × 15.5 × 0.8 max. 2 × (6 × 15,5 × 0.8)
with 3RT19 56-4G box terminal
Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 16 ... 120 16 ... 120 max. 1 × 95, 1 × 120
Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 16 ... 120 16 ... 120 max. 1 × 95, 1 × 120
Stranded mm2 16 ... 120 16 ... 120 max. 2 × 120
AWG conductor connections, solid/stranded 6 ... 250 kcmil 6 ... 250 kcmil max. 2 × 3/0
Ribbon cable (qty. × width × thickness) mm min. 3 × 9 × 0.8 min. 3 × 9 × 0.8
mm max. 10 × 15.5 × 0.8 max. 10 × 15.5 × 0.8 max. 2 × (10 × 15.5 × 0.8)
– Terminal screws M 10 (hexagon socket, A/F4)
– Tightening torque Nm 10 ... 12 (90 ... 110 lb.in)
Without box terminal/busbar connection
Finely stranded with cable lug mm2 16 ... 95 If cable lugs acc. to DIN 46 235 are connected,
Stranded with cable lug mm2 25 ... 120 as of a conductor cross-section of 95 mm2 a
3RT19 56-4EA1 terminal cover is necessary to
comply with the phase clearance.
AWG conductor connections, solid or stranded AWG 4 ... 250 kcmil
Connecting bar (max. width) mm 17
– Terminal screws M 8 × 25 (A/F 13)
– Tightening torque Nm 10 ... 14 (89 ... 124 lb.in)

Auxiliary conductor:
Solid mm2 2 × (0.5 ...1.5); 2 × (0.75 ... 2.5) acc. to IEC 60 947;
max. 2 × (0.75 ... 4)
Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 × (0.5 ... 1.5); 2 × (0.75 ... 2.5)
AWG conductor connections, solid or stranded AWG 2 × (18 ... 14)
– Terminal screws M 3 (PZ 2)
– Tightening torque Nm 0.8 ... 1.2 (7 ... 10.3 lb.in)

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/147


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT10.6. contactors
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies

Technical data

Contactor Size S10 S10 S10


Type 3RT10 64 3RT10 65 3RT10 66
General data
Permissible mounting position
The contactors are designed for operation
2

on a vertical mounting surface.


Contactors and
Assemblies

Mechanical endurance Oper. 10 million


cycles
Electrical endurance See page 2/125
Rated insulation voltage Ui (pollution degree 3) V 1000
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 8

Safe isolation between coil, auxiliary contacts and main contacts V 690
(acc. to DIN VDE 0106 Part 101 and A1 [draft 2/89])
Positively driven operation Yes, between main contacts and auxiliary NC contacts and within
There is positively driven operation if the NC and the auxiliary switch blocks acc. to ZH 1/457, IEC 60 947-4-1, Annex
NO contacts cannot be closed at the same time H (draft 17B/996/DC)
Permissible ambient temperature in operation °C –25 ... +60/+55 with AS-Interface
when stored °C –55 ... +80
Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60 947-1 and DIN 40 050 IP 00/open type, coil system IP 20
Shock resistance Rectangular pulse g/ms 8.5/5 and 4.2/10
Sine pulse g/ms 13.4/5 and 6.5/10

Conductor cross-sections See page 2/150


Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) See page 2/108
Short-circuit protection
Main circuit
Fuse links, utilization category gL/gG
NH Type 3NA, DIAZED Type 5SB, NEOZED Type 5SE
– acc. to IEC 60 947-4-1/EN 60 947-4-1 Type of coord. "1" 1) A 500
Type of coord. "2" 1) A 400
Weld-free 2) A 250
Auxiliary circuit
Fuse links, utilization category gL/gG A 10
(weld-free protection at Ik 1 kA)
DIAZED Type 5SB, NEOZED Type 5SE
or miniature circuit-breaker with C-characteristic (Ik < 400 A)

Contactor Size S10


Type 3RT10 6 .
Control circuit
Coil voltage tolerance AC/DC (UC) 0.8 × Us min ... 1.1 × Us max
Power consumption of solenoid mechanism Conventional op. mechanism Solid-state op. mechanism
(with coil in cold state and rated range Us min ... Us max) Us min Us max Us min Us max
AC operation closing VA 490 590 400 530
p.f. 0.9 0.9 0.8 0.8
closed VA 5.6 6.7 4 5
p.f. 0.9 0.9 0.5 0.4
DC operation closing W 540 650 440 580
closed W 6.1 7.4 3.2 3.8
PLC control input (EN 61 131-2/Type 2) DC 24 V / 30 mA
Operating times Conventional op. mechanism Solid-state op. mechanism
(Break-time = opening time + arcing time) Operation via
A1/A2 PLC input
– at 0.8 × Us min ... 1.1 × Us max closing time ms 30 ... 95 105 ... 145 45 ... 80
opening time ms 40 ... 80 80 ... 100 80 ... 100
– at Us min ... Us max closing time ms 35 ... 50 110 ... 130 50 ... 65
opening time ms 50 ... 80 80 ... 100 80 ... 100
Arcing time ms 10 ... 15 10 ... 15 10 ... 15

1) According to excerpt from Type of coordination "2": 2) Test conditions acc. to IEC 60 947-4-1.
IEC 60 947-4-1 (VDE 0660 Part 102): No damage can be tolerated to the overload relay,
Type of coordination "1": but contact welding on the contactor is permitted if
Destruction of the contactor and the overload the contacts can be easily separated.
relay is permissible. The contactor and/or over-
load relay must be replaced if necessary.

2/148 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT10.6. contactors

Technical data

Contactor Size S10 S10 S10


Type 3RT10 64 3RT10 65 3RT10 66
Main circuit
Load ratings with AC
AC-1 utilization category, switching resistive load

2
Rated operational currents Ie at 40 °C up to 690 V A 275 330
at 60 °C up to 690 V A 250 300

Assemblies
Contactors and
at 60 °C up to 1000 V A 100 150
Ratings of three-phase loads 1) at 230 V kW 94 113
p.f. = 0.95 (at 60 °C) 400 V kW 164 197
500 V kW 205 246
690 V kW 283 340
1000 V kW 164 246
Minimum conductor cross-section with Ie load at 40 °C mm2 150 185
60 °C mm2 120 185
AC-2 and AC-3 utilization categories
Rated operational currents Ie up to 500 V A 225 265 300
690 V A 225 265 280
1000 V A 68 95 95
Ratings of slipring or squirrel-cage at 230 V kW 73 85 97
motors at 50 Hz and 60 Hz 400 V kW 128 151 171
500 V kW 160 189 215
690 V kW 223 265 280
1000 V kW 90 132 132
Thermal loading capacity 10 s current 2) A 1800 2400 2400
Power loss per conducting path at Ie/AC-3/500 V W 17 18 22
AC-4 utilization category (at Ia = 6 × Ie)
Rated operational current Ie up to 400 V A 195 230 280
Ratings of squirrel-cage motors at 400 V kW 110 132 160
at 50 Hz and 60 Hz
For a contact endurance of approx. 200 000 operating cycles:
Rated operational currents Ie up to 500 V A 96 117 125
690 V A 85 105 115
1000 V A 42 57 57
Ratings of squirrel-cage motors at 230 V kW 30 37 40
at 50 Hz and 60 Hz 400 V kW 54 66 71
500 V kW 67 82 87
690 V kW 82 102 112
1000 V kW 59 80 80
AC-6a utilization category, switching three-phase transformers
with inrush n 30 20 30 20 30 20
Rated operational current Ie up to 690 V A 151 227 182 265 182 273
Ratings of three-phase transformers at 230 V kVA 60 90 72 105 72 109
with an inrush of n = 30 or 20. 400 V kVA 105 157 126 183 126 189
The ratings must be re-calculated 500 V kVA 130 196 158 229 158 236
for other inrush factors x: 690 V kVA 180 271 217 317 217 326
1000 V kVA 117 117 164 164 164 164
30
Px = Pn 30 ------
x

AC-6b utilization category, switching low-inductance


(low-loss, metallized-dielectric) three-phase capacitors
Ambient temperature 40 °C
Rated operational currents Ie up to 500 V A 183 220
Ratings of single capacitors at 230 V kvar 73 88
or of capacitor banks (minimum inductance 400 V kvar 127 152
between parallel capacitors 6 µH) 500 V kvar 159 191
at 50 Hz, 60 Hz and 690 V kvar 127 152

1) Industrial furnaces and electric heaters 2) Acc. to VDE 0660 Part 102.
with resistance heating, for example (higher For rated values for various
current input allowed for during heating up). starting conditions, see Section 3.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/149


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT10.6. contactors

Technical data

Contactor Size S10 S10 S10


Type 3RT10 64 3RT10 65 3RT10 66
Main circuit
Load ratings with DC
DC-1 utilization category,
2

switching resistive load (L/R 1 ms)


Rated operational current Ie (at 60 °C)
Contactors and
Assemblies

Number of conducting paths connected in series 1 2 3 1 2 3


up to 24 V A 200 200 200 300 300 300
60 V A 200 200 200 300 300 300
110 V A 18 200 200 33 300 300
220 V A 3.4 20 200 3.8 300 300
440 V A 0.8 3.2 11.5 0.9 4 11
600 V A 0.5 1.6 4 0.6 2 5.2
DC-3 and DC-5 utilization categories,
shunt and series motors (L/R 15 ms)
Rated operational current Ie (at 60 °C)
Number of conducting paths connected in series 1 2 3 1 2 3
up to 24 V A 200 200 200 300 300 300
60 V A 7.5 200 200 11 300 300
110 V A 2.5 200 200 3 300 300
220 V A 0.6 2.5 200 0.6 2.5 300
440 V A 0.17 0.65 1.4 0.18 0.65 1.4
600 V A 0.12 0.37 0.75 0.125 0.37 0.75
Operating frequency
Operating frequency z in operating cycles per hour
Contactors without overload relays No-load operating 1/h 2000 2000 2000
frequency
Dependence of the operating frequency z’ on the for AC-1 1/h 750 800 750
operational current I’ and the operational voltage U’: for AC-2 1/h 250 300 250
for AC-3 1/h 500 700 500
Ie 1.5
400 V for AC-4 1/h 130 130 130
z’ = z ----
I
---------- 1/h
U
Contactors with overload relays (mean value) 1/h 60 60 60

Contactor Size S10


Type 3RT10 6.
Conductor cross-sections
Screw connections Main conductor: Front terminal Back terminal Both terminals
with 3RT19 66-4G box terminal connected connected connected
Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 70 ... 240 120 ... 185 min. 2 × 50,
max. 2 × 185
Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 70 ... 240 120 ... 185 min. 2 × 50,
max. 2 × 185
Stranded mm2 95 ... 300 120 ... 240 min. 2 × 70,
max. 2 × 240
AWG conductor connections, solid or AWG 3/0 ... 600 kcmil 250 ... 500 kcmil min. 2 × 2/0,
stranded max. 2 × 500 kcmil
Ribbon cable (qty. × width × thickness) mm min. 6 × 9 × 0.8 min. 6 × 9 × 0.8
mm max. 20 × 24 × 0.5 max. 20 × 24 × 0.5 max. 2 × (20 × 24 × 0.5)
– Terminal screws M 12 (hexagon
sokket, A/F 5)
– Tightening torque Nm 20 ... 22 (180 ... 195 lb.in)
Without box terminal/busbar connection
Finely stranded with cable lug mm2 50 ... 240 If cable lugs acc. to DIN 46 234 are con-
Stranded with cable lug mm2 70 ... 240 nected, as of a conductor cross-section of
240 mm2 and acc. to DIN 46 235 as of a con-
ductor cross-section of 185 mm2 a 3RT19 66-
4EA1 terminal cover is necessary to comply
with the phase clearance.
AWG conductor connections, solid or stranded AWG 2/0 ... 500 kcmil
Connecting bar (max. width) mm 25
– Terminal screws M 10 × 30 (A/F 17)
– Tightening torque Nm 14 ... 24 (124 ... 210 lb.in)
Auxiliary conductor:
Solid mm2 2 × (0.5 ... 1.5); 2 × (0.75 ... 2.5) acc. to IEC 60 947;
max. 2 × (0.75 ... 4)
Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 × (0.5 ... 1.5); 2 × (0.75 ... 2.5)
AWG conductor connections, solid or stranded AWG 2 × (18 ... 14)
– Terminal screws M 3 (PZ 2)
– Tightening torque Nm 0.8 ... 1.2 (7 ... 10.3 lb.in)

2/150 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT10.7. contactors

Technical data

Contactor Size S12 S12


Type 3RT10 75 3RT10 76
General data
Permissible mounting position
The contactors are designed for operation

2
on a vertical mounting surface.

Assemblies
Contactors and
Mechanical endurance Oper. 10 million
cycles
Electrical endurance See page 2/125
Rated insulation voltage Ui (pollution degree 3) V 1000
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 8
Safe isolation between coil, auxiliary contacts and main contacts V 690
(acc. to DIN VDE 0106 Part 101 and A1 [draft 2/89])
Positively driven operation Yes, between main contacts and auxiliary NC contacts and within
There is positively driven operation if the NC and the auxiliary switch blocks acc. to ZH 1/457, IEC 60 947-4-1,
NO contacts cannot be closed at the same time Annex H (draft 17B/996/DC)
Permissible ambient temperature in operation °C –25 ... +60/+55 with AS-Interface
when stored °C –55 ... +80
Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60 947-1 and DIN 40 050 IP 00/open type, coil system IP 20
Shock resistance Rectangular pulse g/ms 8.5/5 and 4.2/10
Sine pulse g/ms 13.4/5 and 6.5/10
Conductor cross-sections See page 2/153
Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) See page 2/108
Short-circuit protection
Main circuit
Fuse links, utilization category gL/gG
NH Type 3NA, DIAZED Type 5SB, NEOZED Type 5SE
– to IEC 60 947-4/EN 60 947-4-4 (VDE 0660 Part 102) Type of coord. "1" 1) A 630 630
Type of coord. "2" 1) A 500 500
Weld-free 2) A 250 315
Auxiliary circuit
Fuse links, utilization category gL/gG A 10
(weld-free protection at Ik 1 kA)
DIAZED Type 5SB, NEOZED Type 5SE
or miniature circuit-breaker with C-characteristic (Ik < 400 A)
Control circuit
Coil voltage tolerance AC/DC (UC) 0.8 × Us min ... 1.1 × Us max

Power consumption of solenoid mechanism Conventional op. mechanism Solid-state op. mechanism
(with coil in cold state and rated range Us min ... Us max) Us min Us max Us min Us max
AC operation closing VA 700 830 560 750
p.f. 0.9 0.9 0.8 0.8
closed VA 7.6 9.2 5.4 7
p.f. 0.9 0.9 0.8 0.8
DC operation closing W 770 920 600 800
closed W 8.5 10 4 5
PLC control input (EN 61 131-2/Type 2) DC 24 V/ 30 mA

Operating times Conventional op. mechanism Solid-state op. mechanism


(Break-time = opening time + arcing time) Operation via
A1/A2 PLC input
– at 0.8 × Us min ... 1.1 × Us max closing time ms 45 ... 100 120 ... 150 60 ... 90
opening time ms 60 ... 100 80 ... 100 80 ... 100
– at Us min ... Us max closing time ms 50 ... 70 125 ... 150 65 ... 80
opening time ms 70 ... 100 80 ... 100 80 ... 100
Arcing time ms 10 ... 15 10 ... 15 10 ... 15

1) According to excerpt from Type of coordination "2": 2) Test conditions acc. to IEC 60 947-4-1.
IEC 60 947-4-1 (VDE 0660 Part 102): No damage can be tolerated to the overload relay,
Type of coordination "1": but contact welding on the contactor is permitted if
Destruction of the contactor and the overload the contacts can be easily separated.
relay is permissible. The contactor and/or over-
load relay must be replaced if necessary.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/151


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT10.7. contactors

Technical data

Contactor Size S12 S12


Type 3RT10 75 3RT10 76
Main circuit
Load ratings with AC
AC-1 utilization category, switching resistive load
2

Rated operational currents Ie at 40 °C up to 690 V A 430 610


at 60 °C up to 690 V A 400 550 3)
Contactors and
Assemblies

at 60 °C up to 1000 V A 200 200


Ratings of three-phase loads 1) at 230 V kW 151 208
p.f. = 0.95 (at 60 °C) 400 V kW 263 362
500 V kW 329 452
690 V kW 454 624
1000 V kW 329 329
Minimum conductor cross-section with Ie load at 40 °C mm2 2 × 150 2 × 185
60 °C mm2 240 2 × 185
AC-2 and AC-3 utilization categories
Rated operational currents Ie up to 500 V A 400 500 4)
690 V A 400 450
1 000 V A 180 180
Ratings of slipring or squirrel-cage at 230 V kW 132 164
motors at 50 Hz and 60 Hz 400 V kW 231 291
500 V kW 291 363
690 V kW 400 453
1 000 V kW 250 250
Thermal loading capacity 10 s current 2) A 3200 4000
Power loss per conducting path at Ie/AC-3/500 V W 35 55
AC-4 utilization category (at Ia = 6 × Ie)
Rated operational current Ie up to 400 V A 350 430
Ratings of squirrel-cage motors at 400 V kW 200 250
at 50 Hz and 60 Hz
For a contact endurance of approx. 200 000 operating cycles:
Rated operational currents Ie up to 500 V A 150 175
690 V A 135 150
1 000 V A 80 80
Ratings of squirrel-cage motors at 230 V kW 48 56
at 50 Hz and 60 Hz 400 V kW 85 98
500 V kW 105 123
690 V kW 133 148
1 000 V kW 113 113
AC-6a utilization category, switching three-phase transformers
with inrush n 30 20 30 20
Rated operational current Ie up to 690 V A 251 377 270 404
Ratings of three-phase transformers at 230 V kVA 100 150 107 161
with an inrush of n = 30 or 20. 400 V kVA 173 261 187 280
The ratings must be re-calculated 500 V kVA 217 326 234 350
for other inrush factors x: 690 V kVA 300 450 323 483
1000 V kVA 311 311 311 311

AC-6b utilization category, switching low-inductance


(low-loss, metallized-dielectric) three-phase capacitors
Ambient temperature 40 °C
Rated operational currents Ie up to 500 V A 287 407
Ratings of single capacitors at 230 V kvar 114 162
or of capacitor banks (minimum inductance 400 V kvar 199 282
between parallel capacitors 6 µH) 500 V kvar 248 352
at 50 Hz, 60 Hz and 690 V kvar 199 282

1) Industrial furnaces and electric heaters 2) Acc. to VDE 0660 Part 102. 3) Ambient temperature 50 °C
with resistance heating, for example (higher For rated values for various for 3RT10 76-.N contactor
current input allowed for during heating up). starting conditions, see Section 3. 4) Ambient temperature 55 °C
for 3RT10 76-.N contactor

2/152 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies
Contactors
SIRIUS for Switching Motors Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT10.7. contactors
3RT10 7. contactors

Technical data

Contactor Size S12 S12


Type 3RT10 75 3RT10 76
Main circuit
Load ratings with DC
DC-1 utilization category,

2
switching resistive load (L/R 1 ms)
Rated operational current Ie (at 60 °C)

Assemblies
Contactors and
Number of conducting paths connected in series 1 2 3
up to 24 V A 400 400 400
60 V A 330 400 400
110 V A 33 400 400
220 V A 3.8 400 400
440 V A 0.9 4 11
600 V A 0.6 2 5.2
DC-3 and DC-5 utilization categories,
shunt and series motors (L/R 15 ms)
Rated operational current Ie (at 60 °C)
Number of conducting paths connected in series 1 2 3
up to 24 V A 400 400 400
60 V A 11 400 400
110 V A 3 400 400
220 V A 0.6 2.5 400
440 V A 0.18 0.65 1.4
600 V A 0.125 0.37 0.75
Operating frequency
Operating frequency z in operating cycles per hour
Contactors without overload relays No-load operating 1/h 2000 2000
frequency
Dependence of the operating frequency z’ on the for AC-1 1/h 700 500
operational current I’ and the operational voltage U’: for AC-2 1/h 200 170
for AC-3 1/h 500 420
Ie 400 V 1.5 for AC-4 1/h 130 130
z’ = z ----
I
---------- 1/h
U

Contactors with overload relays (mean value) 1/h 60 60

Contactor Size S12


Type 3RT10 7.
Conductor cross-sections
Screw connections Main conductor: Front terminal Back terminal Both terminals
with 3RT19 66-4G box terminal connected connected connected
Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 70 ... 240 120 ... 185 min. 2 × 50,
max. 2 × 185
Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 70 ... 240 120 ... 185 min. 2 × 50,
max. 2 × 185
Stranded mm2 95 ... 300 120 ... 240 min. 2 × 70,
max. 2 × 240
AWG conductor connections, solid or AWG 3/0 ... 600 kcmil 250 ... 500 kcmil min. 2 × 2/0,
stranded max. 2 × 500 kcmil
Ribbon cable (qty. × width × thickness) mm min. 6 × 9 × 0.8 min. 6 × 9 × 0.8
mm max. 20 × 24 × 0.5 max. 20 × 24 × 0.5 max. 2 × (20 × 24 × 0.5)
– Terminal screws M 12 (hexagon
socket, A/F 5)
– Tightening torque Nm 20 ... 22 (180 ... 195 lb.in)
Without box terminal/busbar connection
Finely stranded with cable lug mm2 50 ... 240 If cable lugs acc. to DIN 46 234 are con-
Stranded with cable lug mm2 70 ... 240 nected, as of a conductor cross-section of
240 mm2 and acc. to DIN 46 235 as of a con-
ductor cross-section of 185 mm2 a 3RT19 66-
4EA1 terminal cover is necessary to comply
with the phase clearance.
AWG conductor connections, solid or stranded AWG 2/0 ... 500 kcmil
Connecting bar (max. width) mm 25
– Terminal screws M 10 × 30 (A/F 17)
– Tightening torque Nm 14 ... 24 (124 ... 210 lb.in)
Auxiliary conductor:
Solid mm2 2 × (0.5 ... 1.5); 2 × (0.75 ... 2.5) acc. to IEC 60 947;
max. 2 × (0.75 ... 4)
Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 × (0.5 ... 1.5); 2 × (0.75 ... 2.5)
AWG conductor connections, solid or stranded AWG 2 × (18 ... 14)
– Terminal screws M 3 (PZ 2)
– Tightening torque Nm 0.8 ... 1.2 (7 ... 10.3 lb.in)

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/153


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT12.6. vacuum contactors

Technical data

Contactor Size S10 S10 S10


Type 3RT12 64 3RT12 65 3RT12 66
General data
Permissible mounting position
The contactors are designed for operation
2

on a vertical mounting surface.


Contactors and
Assemblies

Mechanical endurance Oper. 10 million


cycles
Electrical endurance See page 2/125
Rated insulation voltage Ui (pollution degree 3) V 1000
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 8
Safe isolation between coil, auxiliary contacts and main contacts V 690
(acc. to DIN VDE 0106 Part 101 and A1 [draft 2/89])
Positively driven operation Yes, between main contacts and auxiliary NC contacts and within
There is positively driven operation if the NC and the auxiliary switch blocks acc. to ZH 1/457, IEC 60 947-4-1,
NO contacts cannot be closed at the same time Annex H (draft 17B/996/DC)
Permissible ambient temperature in operation °C –25 ... +60/+55 with AS-Interface
when stored °C –55 ... +80
Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60 947-1 and DIN 40 050 IP 00/open type, coil system IP 20
Shock resistance Rectangular pulse g/ms 8.5/5 and 4.2/10
Sine pulse g/ms 13.4/5 and 6.5/10
Conductor cross-sections See page 2/156
Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) See page 2/108
Short-circuit protection
Main circuit
Fuse links, utilization category gL/gG
NH Type 3NA, DIAZED Type 5SB, NEOZED Type 5SE
– to IEC 60 947-4/EN 60 947-4-4 (VDE 0660Part 102) Type of coord. "1" 1) A 500
Type of coord. "2" 1) A 500
Weld-free 2) A 400
Auxiliary circuit
Fuse links, utilization category gL/gG A 10
(weld-free protection at Ik 1 kA)
DIAZED Type 5SB, NEOZED Type 5SE
or miniature circuit-breaker with C-characteristic (Ik < 400 A)
Control circuit
Coil voltage tolerance AC/DC (UC) 0.8 × Us min ... 1.1 × Us max

Power consumption of solenoid mechanism Conventional op. mechanism Solid-state op. mechanism
(with coil in cold state and rated range Us min ... Us max) Us min Us max Us min Us max
AC operation closing VA 530 630 420 570
p.f. 0.9 0.9 0.8 0.8
closed VA 6.1 7.4 4.3 5.6
p.f. 0.9 0.9 0.8 0.8
DC operation closing W 580 700 460 630
closed W 6.8 8.2 3.4 4.2
PLC control input (EN 61 131-2/Type 2) DC 24 V/ 30 mA

Operating times Conventional op. mechanism Solid-state op. mechanism


(Break-time = opening time + arcing time) Operation via
A1/A2 PLC input
– at 0.8 × Us min ... 1.1 × Us max closing time ms 30 ... 95 105 ... 145 45 ... 80
opening time ms 40 ... 80 80 ... 100 80 ... 100
– at Us min ... Us max closing time ms 35 ... 50 110 ... 130 50 ... 65
opening time ms 50 ... 80 80 ... 100 80 ... 100
Arcing time ms 10 ... 15 10 ... 15 10 ... 15

1) According to excerpt from Type of coordination "2": 2) Test conditions acc. to IEC 60 947-4-1.
IEC 60 947-4-1 (VDE 0660 Part 102): No damage can be tolerated to the overload relay,
Type of coordination "1": but contact welding on the contactor is permitted if
Destruction of the contactor and the overload the contacts can be easily separated.
relay is permissible. The contactor and/or over-
load relay must be replaced if necessary.

2/154 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT12.6. vacuum contactors

Technical data

Contactor Size S10 S10 S10


Type 3RT12 64 3RT12 65 3RT12 66
Main circuit
Load ratings with AC
AC-1 utilization category, switching resistive load

2
Rated operational currents Ie at 40 °C up to 1000 V A 330
at 60 °C up to 1000 V A 300

Assemblies
Contactors and
Ratings of three-phase loads 1) at 230 V kW 113
p.f. = 0.95 (at 60 °C) 400 V kW 197
500 V kW 246
690 V kW 340
1000 V kW 492
Minimum conductor cross-section with Ie load at 40 °C mm2 185
60 °C mm2 185
AC-2 and AC-3 utilization categories
Rated operational currents Ie up to 1000 V A 225 265 300
Ratings of slipring or squirrel-cage at 230 V kW 73 85 97
motors at 50 Hz and 60 Hz 400 V kW 128 151 171
500 V kW 160 189 215
690 V kW 223 265 288
1000 V kW 320 378 428
Thermal loading capacity 10 s current 2) A 1800 2120 2400
Power loss per conducting path at Ie/AC-3 W 9 12 14
AC-4 utilization category (at Ia = 6 × Ie)
Rated operational current Ie up to 690 V A 195 230 280
Ratings of squirrel-cage motors at 400 V kW 110 132 160
at 50 Hz and 60 Hz
For a contact endurance of approx. 400 000 operating cycles:
Rated operational currents Ie up to 690 V A 97 115 140
1000 V A 68 81 98
Ratings of squirrel-cage motors at 230 V kW 30 37 45
at 50 Hz and 60 Hz 400 V kW 55 65 79
500 V kW 68 81 98
690 V kW 94 112 138
1000 V kW 95 114 140
AC-6a utilization category, switching three-phase transformers
with inrush n 30 20
Rated operational current Ie up to 690 V A 185 278
Ratings of three-phase transformers at 230 V kVA 74 111
with an inrush of n = 30 or 20. 400 V kVA 128 193
The ratings must be re-calculated 500 V kVA 160 241
for other inrush factors x: 690 V kVA 221 332
1000 V kVA 320 482

AC-6b utilization category, switching low-inductance


(low-loss, metallized-dielectric) three-phase capacitors
Ambient temperature 40 °C
Rated operational currents Ie up to 500 V A 220
Ratings of single capacitors at 230 V kvar 88
or of capacitor banks (minimum inductance 400 V kvar 152
between parallel capacitors 6 µH) 500 V kvar 191
at 50 Hz, 60 Hz and 690 V kvar 152
Operating frequency
Operating frequency z in operating cycles per hour
Contactors without overload relays No-load operating 1/h 2000 2000
frequency
Dependence of the operating frequency z’ on the for AC-1 1/h 800 750
operational current I’ and the operational voltage U’: for AC-2 1/h 300 250
for AC-3 1/h 750 750
for AC-4 1/h 250 250

Contactors with overload relays (mean value) 1/h 60 60

1) Industrial furnaces and electric heaters 2) Acc. to VDE 0660 Part 102.
with resistance heating, for example (higher For rated values for various
current input allowed for during heating up). starting conditions, see Section 3.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/155


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies
Contactors forSwitching
Contactors for Switching Motors
Motors SIRIUS
3RT12.6. vacuum contactors
3RT12 6. vacuum contactors

Technical data

Contactor Size S10


Type 3RT12 6.
Conductor cross-sections
Screw connections Main conductor: Front terminal Back terminal Both terminals
with 3RT19 66-4G box terminal connected connected connected
2

Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 70 ... 240 120 ... 185 min. 2 × 50,
max. 2 × 185
Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 70 ... 240 120 ... 185 min. 2 × 50,
Contactors and
Assemblies

max. 2 × 185
Stranded mm2 95 ... 300 120 ... 240 min. 2 × 70,
max. 2 × 240
AWG conductor connections, solid or AWG 3/0 ... 600 kcmil 250 ... 500 kcmil min. 2 × 2/0,
stranded max. 1 × 500 kcmil
Ribbon cable (qty. × width × thickness) mm min. 6 × 9 × 0.8 min. 6 × 9 × 0.8
mm max. 20 × 24 × 0.5 max. 20 × 24 × 0.5 max. 2 × (20 × 24 ×
0.5)
– Terminal screws M 12 (hexagon
socket, A/F 5)
– Tightening torque Nm 20 ... 22 (180 ... 195 lb.in)
Without box terminal/busbar connection
Finely stranded with cable lug mm2 50 ... 240 If cable lugs acc. to DIN 46 234 are con-
Stranded with cable lug mm2 70 ... 240 nected, as of a conductor cross-section of
240 mm2 and acc. to DIN 46 235 as of a con-
ductor cross-section of 185 mm2 a 3RT19 66-
4EA1 terminal cover is necessary to comply
with the phase clearance.
AWG conductor connections, solid or stranded AWG 2/0 ... 500 kcmil
Connecting bar (max. width) mm 25
– Terminal screws M 10 × 30 (A/F 17)
– Tightening torque Nm 14 ... 24 (124 ... 210 lb.in)
Auxiliary conductor:
Solid mm2 2 × (0.5 ... 1.5); 2 × (0.75 ... 2.5) acc. to IEC 60 947;
max. 2 × (0.75 ... 4)
Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 × (0.5 ... 1.5); 2 × (0.75 ... 2.5)
AWG conductor connections, solid or stranded AWG 2 × (18 ... 14)
– Terminal screws M 3 (PZ 2)
– Tightening torque Nm 0.8 ... 1.2 (7 ... 10.3 lb.in)

2/156 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT12.7. contactors

Technical data

Contactor Size S12 S12


Type 3RT12 75 3RT12 76
General data
Permissible mounting position
The contactors are designed for operation

2
on a vertical mounting surface.

Assemblies
Contactors and
Mechanical endurance Oper. 10 million
cycles
Electrical endurance See page 2/125
Rated insulation voltage Ui (pollution degree 3) V 1000
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 8
Safe isolation between coil, auxiliary contacts and main contacts V 690
(acc. to DIN VDE 0106 Part 101 and A1 [draft 2/89])
Positively driven operation Yes, between main contacts and auxiliary NC contacts and within
There is positively driven operation if the NC and the auxiliary switch blocks acc. to ZH 1/457, IEC 60 947-4-1,
NO contacts cannot be closed at the same time Annex H (draft 17B/996/DC)
Permissible ambient temperature in operation °C –25 ... +60/+55 with AS-Interface
when stored °C –55 ... +80
Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60 947-1 and DIN 40 050 IP 00/open type, coil system IP 20
Shock resistance Rectangular pulse g/ms 8.5/5 and 4.2/10
Sine pulse g/ms 13.4/5 and 6.5/10
Conductor cross-sections See page 2/159
Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) See page 2/108
Short-circuit protection
Main circuit
Fuse links, utilization category gL/gG
NH Type 3NA, DIAZED Type 5SB, NEOZED Type 5SE
– to IEC 60 947-4/EN 60 947-4-4 (VDE 0660Part 102) Type of coord. "1" 1) A 800
Type of coord. "2" 1) A 800
Weld-free 2) A 500
Auxiliary circuit
Fuse links, utilization category gL/gG A 10
(weld-free protection at Ik 1 kA)
DIAZED Type 5SB, NEOZED Type 5SE
or miniature circuit-breaker with C-characteristic (Ik < 400 A)
Control circuit
Coil voltage tolerance AC/DC (UC) 0.8 × Us min ... 1.1 × Us max
Power consumption of solenoid mechanism Conventional op. mechanism Solid-state op. mechanism
(with coil in cold state and rated range Us min ... Us max) Us min Us max Us min Us max
AC operation closing VA 700 830 560 750
p.f. 0.9 0.9 0.8 0.8
closed VA 7.6 9.2 5.4 7
p.f. 0.9 0.9 0.8 0.8
DC operation closing W 770 920 600 800
closed W 8.5 10 4 5
PLC control input (EN 61 131-2/Type 2) DC 24 V/ 30 mA
Operating times Conventional op. mechanism Solid-state op. mechanism
(Break-time = opening time + arcing time) Operation via
A1/A2 PLC input
– at 0.8 × Us min ... 1.1 × Us max closing time ms 45 ... 100 120 ... 150 60 ... 90
opening time ms 60 ... 100 80 ... 100 80 ... 100
– at Us min ... Us max closing time ms 50 ... 70 125 ... 150 65 ... 80
opening time ms 70 ... 100 80 ... 100 80 ... 100
Arcing time ms 10 ... 15 10 ... 15 10 ... 15

1) According to excerpt from Type of coordination "2": 2) Test conditions acc. to IEC 60 947-4-1.
IEC 60 947-4-1 (VDE 0660 Part 102): No damage can be tolerated to the overload relay,
Type of coordination "1": but contact welding on the contactor is permitted if
Destruction of the contactor and the overload the contacts can be easily separated.
relay is permissible. The contactor and/or over-
load relay must be replaced if necessary.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/157


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT12.7. vacuum contactors

Technical data

Contactor Size S12 S12


Type 3RT12 75 3RT12 76
Main circuit
Load ratings with AC
AC-1 utilization category, switching resistive load
2

Rated operational currents Ie at 40 °C up to 1000 V A 610


at 60 °C up to 1000 V A 550
Contactors and
Assemblies

Ratings of three-phase loads 1) at 230 V kW 208


p.f. = 0.95 (at 60 °C) 400 V kW 362
500 V kW 452
690 V kW 624
1000 V kW 905
Minimum conductor cross-section with Ie load at 40 °C mm2 2 × 185
60 °C mm2 2 × 185
AC-2 and AC-3 utilization categories
Rated operational currents Ie up to 1000 V A 400 500
Ratings of slipring or squirrel-cage at 230 V kW 132 164
motors at 50 Hz and 60 Hz 400 V kW 231 291
500 V kW 291 363
690 V kW 400 507
1000 V kW 578 728
Thermal loading capacity 10 s current 2) A 3200 4000
Power loss per conducting path at Ie/AC-3 W 21 32

AC-4 utilization category (at Ia = 6 × Ie)


Rated operational current Ie up to 690 V A 350 430
Ratings of squirrel-cage motors at 50 Hz and 60 Hz at 400 V kW 200 250

For a contact endurance of approx. 400 000 operating cycles:


Rated operational currents Ie up to 690 V A 175 215
1000 V A 123 151
Ratings of squirrel-cage motors at 230 V kW 56 70
at 50 Hz and 60 Hz 400 V kW 98 122
500 V kW 124 153
690 V kW 172 212
1000 V kW 183 217
AC-6a utilization category, switching three-phase transformers
with inrush n 30 20
Rated operational current Ie up to 690 V A 279 419
Ratings of three-phase transformers at 230 V kVA 111 167
with an inrush of n = 30 or 20. 400 V kVA 193 290
The ratings must be re-calculated 500 V kVA 241 363
for other inrush factors x: 690 V kVA 332 501
1000 V kVA 482 726

AC-6b utilization category, switching low-inductance


(low-loss, metallized-dielectric) three-phase capacitors
Ambient temperature 40 °C
Rated operational currents Ie up to 500 V A 407
Ratings of single capacitors at 230 V kvar 162
or of capacitor banks (minimum inductance 400 V kvar 282
between parallel capacitors 6 µH) 500 V kvar 352
at 50 Hz, 60 Hz and 690 V kvar 282
Operating frequency
Operating frequency z in operating cycles per hour
Contactors without overload relays No-load operating 1/h 2000
frequency
Dependence of the operating frequency z’ on the for AC-1 1/h 700
operational current I’ and the operational voltage U’: for AC-2 1/h 250
for AC-3 1/h 750
for AC-4 1/h 250

Contactors with overload relays (mean value) 1/h 60

1) Industrial furnaces and electric heaters 2) Acc. to VDE 0660 Part 102.
with resistance heating, for example (higher For rated values for various
current input allowed for during heating up). starting conditions, see Section 3.

2/158 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies
Contactors
SIRIUS for Switching Motors Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT12.7. vacuum contactors
3RT12 7. vacuum contactors

Technical data

Contactor Size S12


Type 3RT12 7.
Conductor cross-sections
Screw connections Main conductor: Front terminal Back terminal Both terminals
with 3RT19 66-4G box terminal connected connected connected

2
Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 70 ... 240 120 ... 185 min. 2 × 50,
max. 2 × 185
Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 70 ... 240 120 ... 185 min. 2 × 50,

Assemblies
Contactors and
max. 2 × 185
Stranded mm2 95 ... 300 120 ... 240 min. 2 × 70,
max. 2 × 240
AWG conductor connections, solid or AWG 3/0 ... 600 kcmil 250 ... 500 kcmil min. 2 × 2/0,
stranded max. 2 × 500 kcmil
Ribbon cable (qty. × width × thickness) mm min. 6 × 9 × 0.8 min. 6 × 9 × 0.8
mm max. 20 × 24 × 0.5 max. 20 × 24 × 0.5 max. 2 × (20 × 24 × 0.5)
– Terminal screws M 12 (hexagon
socket, A/F 5)
– Tightening torque Nm 20 ... 22 (180 ... 195 lb.in)
Without box terminal/busbar connection
Finely stranded with cable lug mm2 50 ... 240 If cable lugs acc. to DIN 46 234 are con-
Stranded with cable lug mm2 70 ... 240 nected, as of a conductor cross-section of
240 mm2 and acc. to DIN 46 235 as of a con-
ductor cross-section of 185 mm2 a 3RT19 66-
4EA1 terminal cover is necessary to comply
with the phase clearance.
AWG conductor connections, solid or stranded AWG 2/0 ... 500 kcmil
Connecting bar (max. width) mm 25
– Terminal screws M 10 × 30 (A/F 17)
– Tightening torque Nm 14 ... 24 (124 ... 210 lb.in)
Auxiliary conductor:
Solid mm2 2 × (0.5 ... 1.5); 2 × (0.75 ... 2.5) acc. to IEC 60 947;
max. 2 × (0.75 ... 4)
Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 × (0.5 ... 1.5); 2 × (0.75 ... 2.5)
AWG conductor connections, solid or stranded AWG 2 × (18 ... 14)
– Terminal screws M 3 (PZ 2)
– Tightening torque Nm 0.8 ... 1.2 (7 ... 10.3 lb.in)

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/159


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Switching Motors
3RT24 contactors, 3-pole, for switching resistive loads (AC-1)
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies

Technical data
Contactor Size S3
Type 3RT24 46
General data
Permissible mounting position AC and DC operation For DC operation and forward
The contactors are designed for operation inclination up to 22.5°:
on a vertical mounting surface. coil voltage tolerance 0.85 ... 1.1 ×
2

Us
Contactors and
Assemblies

Upright mounting position:

AC operation Special design required.


Positions 13 ... 16 of the Order No. must be changed to -1AA0.
Additional charge.
DC operation –
Mechanical endurance Oper. 10 million
cycles
Electrical endurance Oper. 0.5 million
AC-1 utilization category at Ie cycles
Rated insulation voltage Ui (pollution degree 3) V 1000
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 6
Safe isolation between coil and main contacts V 690
(acc. to DIN VDE 0106 Part 101 and A1 [draft 2/89])
Permissible ambient temperature in operation °C –25 ... +60
when stored °C –55 ... +80
Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60 947-1 and DIN 40 050 IP 20 (terminal compartment IP 00), coil system IP 40
Shock resistance
Rectangular pulse AC and DC operation g/ms 6.8/5 and 4/10
Sine pulse AC and DC operation g/ms 10.6/5 and 6.2/10
Conductor cross-sections See page 2/162
Short-circuit protection of contactors without overload relays
Main circuit
Fuse links, utilization category gL/gG
NH, Type 3NA Type of coord. "1" 2) A 250
Fuse links, utilization category gR
SITOR, Type 3NE Type of coord. "2" 2) A 250
Auxiliary circuit
Fuse links, utilization category gL/gG (weld-free protection at Ik 1 kA) A 10
DIAZED Type 5SB, NEOZED Type 5SE
or miniature circuit-breaker with C-characteristic (Ik < 400 A) A 10
Control circuit
Coil voltage tolerance AC/DC 0.8 ... 1.1 × Us
Power consumption of the coils (with coil in cold state and 1.0 × Us) Standard design For USA and Canada
AC operation Hz 50 50/60 50 60
closing VA 270 298 /274 270 300
p.f. 0.68 0.7 / 0.62 0.68 0.52
closed VA 22 27 / 20 22 21
p.f. 0.27 0.29/ 0.31 0.27 0.29
DC operation closing = closed W 15
Operating times at 0.8 ... 1.1 × Us 1)
Break-time = opening time + arcing time
AC operation closing time ms 17 ... 90
opening time ms 10 ... 25
DC operation closing time ms 90 ... 230
opening time ms 14 ... 20
Arcing time ms 10 ... 15
Operating times at 1.0 × Us 1)
AC operation closing time ms 18 ... 30
opening time ms 11 ... 23
DC operation closing time ms 100 ... 120
opening time ms 16 ... 20

1) The opening times of the NO contacts and the 2) According to excerpt from Type of coordination "2":
closing times of the NC contacts increase if the IEC 60 947-4-1 (VDE 0660 Part 102): No damage can be tolerated to the overload
contactor coils are protected against voltage Type of coordination "1": relay, but contact welding on the contactor is
peaks: varistor +2 ms to 5 ms, diode assem- Destruction of the contactor and the overload permitted if the contacts can be easily sepa-
blies 2 to 6 times. relay is permissible. The contactor and/or over- rated.
load relay must be replaced if necessary.

2/160 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies
Contactors for Special Applications Contactors for Special Applications
3RT24 contactors, 3-pole, for switching resistive loads (AC-1) 3RT14 contactors, 3-pole,
for switching resistive loads (AC-1)

Technical data

Contactor Size S3
Type 3RT24 46
Main circuit
Load ratings with AC
AC-1 utilization category, switching resistive load

2
Rated operational currents Ie at 40 °C up to 690 V A 140
at 60 °C up to 690 V A 130

Assemblies
Contactors and
at 1 000 V A 60
Ratings at 230 V kW 50
of three-phase loads 400 V kW 86
p.f. = 0.95 (at 60 °C) 500 V kW 107
690 V kW 148
1 000 V kW 98
Minimum conductor cross-section with Ie load at 40 °C mm2 50
at 60 °C mm2 50
AC-2 and AC-3 utilization categories
With an electrical endurance of 1.3 million operating cycles
Rated operational current Ie up to 690 V A 44
Ratings of slipring or squirrel-cage at 230 V kW 12.7
motors at 50 Hz and 60 Hz (at 60 °C) 400 V kW 22
500 V kW 29.9
690 V kW 38.2
Power loss per conducting path at Ie/AC-1 W 12.5
Load ratings with DC
DC-1 utilization category, switching resistive load L/R 1 ms)
Number of conducting paths when connected in series 1 2 3
Rated operational currents Ie (at 60 °C) up to 24 V A 130 130 130
60 V A 80 130 130
110 V A 12 130 130
220 V A 2.5 13 130
440 V A 0.8 2.4 6
600 V A 0.48 1.3 3.4

DC-3 and DC-5 utilization categories, shunt and series motors


Number of conducting paths when connected in series 1 2 3
Rated operational currents Ie (at 60 °C) up to 24 V A 6 130 130
60 V A 3 130 130
110 V A 1.25 130 130
220 V A 0.35 1.75 4
440 V A 0.15 0.42 0.8
600 V A 0.1 0.27 0.45
Operating frequency
Operating frequency z in operating cycles per hour AC operation DC operation
Contactors without overload relays No-load operating fre- 1/h 5000 1000
quency
Rated op eration for AC-1 1/h 650 650
for AC-3 1/h 1000 1000
Dependence of the operating frequency z’ on the
operational current I’ and the operational voltage U’:

Ie 400 V
1.5
z’ = z ---- ----------
- 1/h
I U

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/161


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Special Applications
3RT24 contactors, 3-pole, for switcing resistive loads (AC-1)

T24 46
2 Assemblies
Contactors and

2/162 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Special Applications
3RT14 contactors, 3-pole, for switching resistive loads (AC-1)

Technical data
Contactor Size S6
Type 3RT14 56
General data
Permissible mounting position
The contactors are designed for operation
on a vertical mounting surface.

2
Mechanical endurance Oper. 10 million

Assemblies
Contactors and
cycles
Electrical endurance Oper. 0.5 million
AC-1 utilization category at Ie cycles
Rated insulation voltage Ui (pollution degree 3) V 1000
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 8
Safe isolation between coil, auxiliary contacts and main contacts V 690
(acc. to DIN VDE 0106 Part 101 and A1 [draft 2/89])
Permissible ambient temperature in operation °C –25 ... +60/+55 with AS-Interface
when stored °C –55 ... +80
Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60 947-1 and DIN 40 050 IP 00/open type, coil system IP 20
Shock resistance
Rectangular pulse g/ms 8.5/5 and 4.2/10
Sine pulse g/ms 13.4/5 and 6.5/10
Conductor cross-sections See page 2/164
Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) See page 2/108
Short-circuit protection
Main circuit
Fuse links, utilization category gL/gG,
NH, Type 3NA Type of coordination "1" A 355
Fuse links, utilization category gR,
SITOR, Type 3NE Type of coordination "2" A 350
Auxiliary circuit
Fuse links, utilization category gL/gG A 10
(weld-free protection at Ik 1 kA)
DIAZED Type 5SB, NEOZED Type 5SE
or miniature circuit-breaker with C-characteristic (Ik < 400 A)
Control circuit
Coil voltage tolerance AC/DC (UC) 0.8 × Us min ... 1.1 × Us max
Power consumption of solenoid mechanism Conventional op. mechanism Solid-state op. mechanism
(with coil in cold state and rated range Us min ... Us max) Us min Us max Us min Us max
AC operation closing VA 250 300 190 280
p.f. 0.9 0.9 0.8 0.8
closed VA 4.8 5.8 3.5 4.4
p.f. 0.8 0.8 0.5 0.4
DC operation closing W 300 360 250 320
closed W 4.3 5.2 2.3 2.8
PLC control input (EN 61 131-2/Type 2) DC 24 V/ 30 mA

Operating times Conventional op. mechanism Solid-state op. mechanism


(Break-time = opening time + arcing time) Operation via
A1/A2 PLC input
– at 0.8 × Us min ... 1.1 × Us max closing time ms 20 ... 95 95 ... 135 35 ... 75
opening time ms 40 ... 60 80 ... 90 80 ... 90
– at Us min ... Us max closing time ms 25 ... 50 100 ... 120 40 ... 60
opening time ms 40 ... 60 80 ... 90 80 ... 90
Arcing time ms 10 ... 15 10 ... 15 10 ... 15
Main circuit
Load ratings with AC
AC-1 utilization category, switching resistive load
Rated operational currents Ie at 40 °C up to 690 V A 275
at 60 °C up to 690 V A 250
at 1000 V A 100
Ratings at 230 V kW 95
of three-phase loads 400 V kW 165
p.f. = 0.95 (at 60 °C) 500 V kW 205
690 V kW 285
1000 V kW 165
Minimum conductor cross-section with Ie load at 40 °C mm2 2 × 70
at 60 °C mm2 120
Power loss per conducting path at Ie/AC-1 W 20

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/163


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Special Applications
3RT14 contactors, 3-pole, for switching resistive loads (AC-1)
2 Assemblies
Contactors and

2/164 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies
Contactors for Special Applications Contactors for Special Applications
3RT14 contactors, 3-pole, for switching resistive loads (AC-1) 3RT14 contactors, 3-pole,
for switching resistive loads (AC-1)

Technical data

Contactor Size S10 S12


Type 3RT14 66 3RT14 76
General data
Permissible mounting position
The contactors are designed for operation

2
on a vertical mounting surface.

Assemblies
Contactors and
Mechanical endurance Oper. 10 million
cycles
Electrical endurance Oper. 0.5 million
AC-1 utilization category at Ie cycles
Rated insulation voltage Ui (pollution degree 3) V 1000
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 8
Safe isolation between coil, auxiliary contacts and main contacts V 690
(acc. to DIN VDE 0106 Part 101 and A1 [draft 2/89])
Permissible ambient temperature in operation °C –25 ... +60/+55 with AS-Interface
when stored °C –55 ... +80
Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60 947-1 and DIN 40 050 IP 00/open type, coil system IP 20
Shock resistance
Rectangular pulse g/ms 8.5/5 and 4.2/10
Sine pulse g/ms 13.4/5 and 6.5/10
Conductor cross-sections See page 2/167
Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) See page 2/108
Short-circuit protection
Main circuit
Fuse links, utilization category gL/gG,
NH, Type 3NA Type of coordination "1" A 500 800
Fuse links, utilization category gR,
SITOR, Type 3NE Type of coordination "2" A 500 710
Auxiliary circuit
Fuse links, utilization category gL/gG A 10
(weld-free protection at Ik 1 kA)
DIAZED Type 5SB, NEOZED Type 5SE
or miniature circuit-breaker with C-characteristic (Ik < 400 A)

Contactor Size S10


Type 3RT14 66
Control circuit
Coil voltage tolerance AC/DC (UC) 0.8 × Us min ... 1.1 × Us max
Power consumption of solenoid mechanism Conventional op. mechanism Solid-state op. mechanism
(with coil in cold state and rated range Us min ... Us max) Us min Us max Us min Us max
AC operation closing VA 490 590 400 530
p.f. 0.9 0.9 0.8 0.8
closed VA 5.6 6.7 4 5
p.f. 0.9 0.9 0.5 0.4
DC operation closing W 540 650 440 580
closed W 6.1 7.4 3.2 3.8
PLC control input (EN 61 131-2/Type 2) DC 24 V/ 30 mA
Operating times Conventional op. mechanism Solid-state op. mechanism
(Break-time = opening time + arcing time) Operation via
A1/A2 PLC input
– at 0.8 × Us min ... 1.1 × Us max closing time ms 30 ... 95 105 ... 145 45 ... 80
opening time ms 40 ... 80 80 ... 200 80 ... 100
– at Us min ... Us max closing time ms 35 ... 50 110 ... 130 50 ... 65
opening time ms 50 ... 80 80 ... 100 80 ... 100
Arcing time ms 10 ... 15 10 ... 15 10 ... 15

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/165


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Special Applications
3RT14 contactors, 3-pole, for switching resistive loads (AC-1)
2 Assemblies
Contactors and

2/166 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Contactors for Special Applications
3RT14 contactors, 3-pole, for switching resistive loads (AC-1)

2
Assemblies
Contactors and

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/167


SIRIUS
3RT, 3RH Contactors for Special Applications
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies

Contactors for Special


3RT23 Contactors Applications
for Switching Resistive Loads (AC-1)
3RT23 contactors, 4-pole (4 NO), switching resistive loads
4-pole, 4 NO, 18 ... 42 A

More information
Contactors Type 3RT23 16 3RT23 17 3RT23 25 3RT23 26 3RT23 27
Size S00 S0
Dimensions (W x H x D)3) Width mm 45 x 57.5 x 73 60 x 85 x 97
General data
Permissible mounting position1)
2

Mechanical endurance Oper- 30 million 10 million


ating
cycles
Contactors and
Assemblies

Electrical endurance at Ie/AC-1 Oper- Approx. 0.5 million


ating
3

cycles
Rated insulation voltage Ui V 690
(pollution degree 3)
Permissible ambient temperature • During operation °C -25 ... +60
• During storage °C -55 ... +80
Degree of protection Device IP20 IP20
Acc. to EN 60947-1, Appendix C Connection range IP00
Touch protection acc.to EN 50274 Finger-safe
Short-circuit protection of contactors without overload relays
Main circuit
Fuse links, gG operational class: • Type of coordination "1"1) A 35 63
LV HRC 3NA, DIAZED 5SB, NEOZED 5SE • Type of coordination "2"1) A 20 20
according to IEC 60947-4-1/ • Weld-free A 10 16
EN 60947-4-1
Control
Solenoid coil operating range
• AC operation - At 50 Hz 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us --
- At 60 Hz 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us --
• DC operation - At 50 °C 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us --
- At 60 °C 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us --
• AC/DC operation -- 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us
Power consumption of the solenoid coils (when coil is cold and 1.0 x Us)
• AC operation, 50 Hz, - Closing VA -- 77
standard version - P.f. -- 0.82
- Closed VA -- 9.8
- P.f. -- 0.25
• AC operation, 50/60 Hz, - Closing VA 27/24.3 37/33 81/79
standard version - P.f. 0.8/0.75 0.8/0.75 0.72/0.74
- Closed VA 4.2/3.3 5.7/4.4 10.5/8.5
- P.f. 0.25/0.25 0.25/0.25 0.25/0.28
• AC operation, 60 Hz, - Closing VA 31.7 43 87
USA, Canada - P.f. 0.77 0.77 0.76
- Closed VA 4.8 6.5 9.4
- P.f. 0.25 0.25 0.28
• DC operation - Closing W 4 5.9
= Closed
Operating times for 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us2)
Total break time = Opening delay + Arcing time
• AC operation - Closing delay ms 8 ... 35 8 ... 33 9 ... 38 8 ... 40
- Opening delay ms 3.5 ... 14 4 ... 15 4 ... 16 4 ... 16
• DC operation - Closing delay ms 30 ... 100 50 ... 170
- Opening delay ms 7 ... 13 15 ... 17.5
• Arcing time ms 10 ... 15 10
Main circuit
AC capacity
Utilization category AC-1, switching resistive loads
• Rated operational currents Ie At 40 °C, up to 690 V A 18 22 35 40 50
At 60 °C, up to 690 V A 16 20 30 35 42
• Rated power for AC loads At 460 V HP 5 5 10 10 10
P.f. = 0.95 (at 40 °C)
• Minimum conductor cross-section At 40 °C mm2 2.5 2.5 10 10 10
for loads with Ie At 60 °C mm2 2.5 2.5 10 10 10
Utilization category AC-3
• Rated operational currents Ie At 60 °C, up to 400 V A 9 12 15.5 17 17
• Rated power for slipring At 460 V HP 5 5 10 10 10
or squirrel-cage motors at 60 Hz s

1) 3) Dimensions for devices with screw terminals. Size S0 for AC operation. DC


In accordance with the corresponding 3-pole 3RT2. contactors.
2) operation: Depth + 10mm.
With size S00, DC operation: Operating times at 0.85 ... 1.1 x U .

2/168 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


3/48 SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012
Overview
Standards
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies
The accessories for the 3-pole 3RT10 contactors can also be
used for the 4-pole versions.
SIRIUS
IEC 60947-1, EN 60947-1,
Contactors for Special Applications
IEC 60947-4-1, EN 60947-4-1,
IEC 60947-5-1, EN 60947-5-1 (auxiliary switches)
The contactors are suitable for switching mixed loads in distribu-
tion systems (e.g. for supplying heaters, lamps, motors, PC
power supply units) with p.f. > 0.8 according to IEC 60947-4-1,
The contactors
3RT23 are4-pole
contactors, suitable(4forNO),
use for
in any climate. They
switching are fin-
resistive loadstest conditions for utilization category AC-1.
ger-safe according to EN 50274.

Technical specifications
Type 3RT23 36 3RT23 44 3RT23 46
Size S2 S3 S3

4
Dimensions (W x H x D) mm 74.5 x 113.5 x 130 / 73 x 112 x 110 93 x 146 x 134

H
74.5 x 113.5 x 130

D
W
• With mounted auxiliary switch block mm 74.5 x 113.5 x 173.5 / 73 x 112 x 160 93 x 146 x 183

2
74.5 x 113.5 x 177.5
General technical specifications
Permissible mounting position1)

Assemblies
Contactors and
Mechanical endurance Operating 10 million
cycles
Electrical endurance at Ie/AC-1 Operating Approx. 0.5 million
cycles
Rated insulation voltage Ui V 690
(pollution degree 3)
Permissible ambient temperature
• During operation °C -25 ... +60
• During storage °C -55 ... +80
Degree of protection Device IP20
acc. to IEC 60947-1, Appendix C Connection range
Touch protection acc. to EN 50274 Finger-safe
Short-circuit protection of contactors without overload relays
Main circuit
Fuse links, operational class gG: • Type of coordination "1"1) A on request 250 250
LV HRC, 3NA; DIAZED, 5SB; NEOZED, 5SE • Type of coordination "2"1) A on request 125 160
according to IEC 60947-4-1/EN 60947-4-1 • Weld-free A on request 63 100
Control circuit
Coil operating range (AC/DC) 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us
Power consumption of the solenoid coils (when coil is cold and 1.0 x Us)
• AC operation, 50 Hz - Closing VA 190 270
- P.f. VA 0.72 0.68
- Closed VA 16 22
- P.f. VA 0.37 0.27
• AC operation, 50/60 Hz - Closing VA 210/188 298/274
- P.f. 0.69/0.65 0.72/0.62
- Closed VA 17.2/16.5 27/20
- P.f. 0.36/0.3 0.29/0.31
• DC operation - Closing W 15
= Closed
Operating times for 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us2)
Total break time = Opening delay + Arcing time
• DC operation - Closing delay ms 110 ... 200
- Opening delay ms 14 ... 20
• AC operation - Closing delay ms 10 ... 80 20 ... 50
- Opening delay ms 10 ... 18 10 ... 25
• Arcing time ms 10 ... 20 10 ... 15
Main circuit
AC capacity
Utilization category AC-1, switching resistive loads
• Rated operational currents Ie At 40 °C, up to 690 V A 60 110 140
At 60 °C, up to 690 V A 55 100 120
• Rated power for AC loads At 230 V kW 21 42 53
P.f. = 0.95 (at 40 °C) 400 V kW 36 72 92
• Minimum conductor cross-section At 40 °C mm² 16 50 50
for loads with Ie At 60 °C mm² 25 50 50
Utilization categories AC-2 and AC-3
• Rated operational currents Ie At 60 °C, up to 400 V A -- --
• Rated power for slipring At 230 V kW -- --
or squirrel-cage motors at 50 and 60 Hz 400 V kW -- --
1)
In accordance with the corresponding 3-pole 3RT1 contactors.
2)
With size S00, DC operation: Operating times for 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/169


IEC 60947-4-1, EN 60947-4-1, • For switching two separate loads
IEC 60947-5-1, EN 60947-5-1 (auxiliary switches)
Note:
The contactors are suitable for use in any climate. They are
Contactors and Contactor
finger-safe according Assemblies
to EN 50274. Single device for pole reversal; not suitable for reversing duty. SIRIUS
3RT25 contactors are not suitable for switching a load between
Contactors
used for the 4-pole for Special Applications
The accessories for the 3-pole 3RT20 contactors can also be
versions.
two current sources.
For a general description of sizes S00 to S2, see Chapter 3,
With sizes
3RT25 S0 and S2,
contactors, two auxiliary
4-pole (2 NO +contacts 1 NO
2 NC), for + 1 NC are
switching motors"Power contactors for switching motors"
included in the basic version. "SIRIUS 3RT20 contactors, 3-pole, up to 37 kW".
4

Technical specifications
Type 3RT2516 3RT2517 3RT2518 3RT2526 3RT2535 3RT2536
Size S00 S0 S2
General technical specifications
Permissible mounting position
2

The contactors are designed for operation on a 360° 22,5° 22,5°

NSB0_00478c
vertical mounting surface.
Contactors and
Assemblies

Upright mounting position

NSB0_00477a

Special version required


Mechanical endurance Operating 30 million 10 million
cycles
Electrical endurance at Ie/AC-1 Operating Approx. 0.5 million
cycles
Rated insulation voltage Ui V 690
(Pollution degree 3)
Permissible ambient temperature
• During operation °C -25 ... +60 -25 ... +60
• During storage °C -55 ... +80 -55 ... +80
Protection class IP on the front acc. to IEC 60529 IP20
Touch protection on the front acc. to IEC 60529 Finger-safe, for vertical contact from the front
(screw and spring-type terminal)
Short-circuit protection
Main circuit
Fuse links, operational class gG:
LV HRC, type 3NA; DIAZED, type 5SB; NEOZED, type 5SE
according to IEC 60947-4-1/EN 60947-4-1
• Type of coordination "1" A 35 63 125 160
• Type of coordination "2" A 20 35 63 80
• Weld-free A 10 16 -- --

Type 3RT2516 3RT2517 3RT2518 3RT2536 3RT2537


Size S00 S2
Dimensions (W x H x D)1) 45 x 57.5 x 73 / 45 x 70 x 73 74.5 x 113.5 x 130 / 74.5 x 113.5 x 130
H

• with mounted auxiliary switch block 45 x 57.5 x 116 / 45 x 70 x 121 74.5 x 113.5 x 173.5 / 74.5 x 113.5 x 177.5
D

Type 3RT2526
Size S0
Dimensions (W x H x D) for AC operation1)2) mm 60 x 85 x 97 / 60 x 101.5 x 97
H

• with mounted auxiliary switch block mm 60 x 85 x 141 / 60 x 101.5 x 144


D

W
Dimensions (W x H x D) for DC operation1)2) mm 60 x 85 x 107 / 60 x 101.5 x 107
• with mounted auxiliary switch block mm 60 x 85 x 151 / 60 x 101.5 x 154
1) Dimensions for devices with screw terminals/spring-type terminals.
2)
For size S0, devices for AC and DC operation differ in depth. The following
applies: Depth (DC) = Depth (AC) + 10 mm.

4/34 Siemens IC 10 · 2015

2/170 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


© Siemens AG 2015

Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS


Contactors for Special Applications Contactors for Special Applications

3RT25 contactors, 4-pole (2 NO + 2 NC), for switching motors


SIRIUS 3RT25 contactors, 4-pole, 2 NO + 2 NC, 4 ... 22 kW

Type 3RT2516 3RT2517 3RT2518 3RT2526 3RT2535 3RT2536


Size S00 S0 S2
Control circuit
Solenoid coil operating range
• AC operation at 50 Hz 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us
at 60 Hz 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us

2
• DC operation up to 50 °C 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us --
up to 60 °C 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us --
• AC/DC operation -- 0.8 x Usmin... 1.1 x Usmax

Assemblies
Contactors and
Power consumption of the solenoid coils see see 3RT2317 see 3RT2326 see 3RT233
(for cold coil and 1.0 x Us) 3RT2316
Operating times for 0.8 to 1.1 x Us see see 3RT2317 see 3RT2326 see 3RT233
(Total break time = Opening delay + Arcing time) 3RT2316

4
Main circuit
Load rating with AC
Utilization category AC-1
Switching resistive loads
• Rated operational currents Ie at 40 °C up to 690 V A 18 22 40 60 70
at 60 °C up to 690 V A 16 20 35 55 60
• Rated power for at 230 V kW 6 7.5 13.3 21 23
AC loads 400 V kW 10.5 13 23 36 39
p.f. = 0.95 (at 60 °C)
• Minimum conductor cross-section at 40 °C mm2 2.5 2.5 10 16 25
for loads with Ie
Utilization categories AC-2 and AC-3 AC1) DC1)
• Rated operational currents Ie NO up to 400 V A 9 12 16 25 25 35 41
(at 60 °C) NC up to 400 V A 9 9 9 25 20 35 41
• Rated power for slipring or squirrel-cage NO at 230 V kW 2.2 3 4 5.5 5.5 11
motors at 50 and 60 Hz NC at 230 V kW 2.2 2.2 2.2 5.5 5.5 11
NO at 400 V kW 4 5.5 7.5 11 11 18.5 22
NC at 400 V kW 4 4 4 11 7.5 18.5 22
Load rating with DC
Utilization category DC-1
Switching resistive loads (L/R ≤ 1 ms)
• Rated operational currents Ie (at 60 °C)
- 1 conducting path up to 24 V A 16 20 35 55 60
60 V A 16 20 20 23
110 V A 2.1 2.1 4.5 4.5
220 V A 0.8 0.8 1 1
440 V A 0.6 0.6 0.4 0.4
- 2 conducting paths in series up to 24 V A 16 20 35 55
60 V A 16 20 35 45
110 V A 12 12 35 45
220 V A 1.6 1.6 5 5
440 V A 0.8 0.8 1 1
Utilization category DC-3/DC-52)
Shunt-wound and series-wound motors (L/R ≤ 15 ms)
• Rated operational currents Ie (at 60 °C)
- 1 conducting path up to 24 V A 16 20 20 35
60 V A 0.5 0.5 5 6
110 V A 0.15 0.15 2.5 2.5
220 V A 0.75 0.75 1 1
440 V A -- -- 0.09 0.1
- 2 conducting paths in series up to 24 V A 16 20 35 55
60 V A 5 5 35 45
110 V A 0.35 0.35 15 25
220 V A -- -- 3 5
440 V A -- -- 0.27 0.27
1)
Values for devices with AC and DC operation: for 3RT25 26 with
DC operation, different values apply to AC-2 and AC-3 for the NC.
2)
For Us >24 V, the rated operational currents Ie for the NC contact
conducting paths are 50 % of the values for the NO contact
conducting paths.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/171


Siemens IC 10 · 2015 4/35
The auxiliary switch block which is snapped onto the capacitor
Function contactor contains the three leading NO contacts and in the
case of S00 one standard NC contact and in the case of S0 and
The 3RT16 capacitor contactors are special versions of the
Contactors and Contactor
3RT10 contactors size S00 to S3.Assemblies
The capacitors are precharged S3 one standard NO contact, which is unassigned. Size S00 also SIRIUS
by means of the mounted leading NO contacts and resistors; contains another unassigned NO contact in the basic unit.
Contactors for Special Applications

4
only then do the main contacts close. In addition, a 2-pole auxiliary switch block can be mounted lat-
This prevents disturbances in the network and welding of the erally on the 3RT16 47 capacitor contactors (2 NO, 2 NC or
3RT16 capacitor contactors
contactors. 1 NO + 1 NC versions); type 3RH19 21-1EA . . . The fitting of aux-
iliary switches for 3RT16 17 and 3RT16 27 is not expandable.

Technical specifications
All technical specifications not mentioned in the table below are those of the 3RT10 26 contactors for size S0 and to those of the
identical to those of the 3RT10 17 contactors for size S00, to 3RT10 45 contactors for size S3. .
Type 3RT16 17-.A. .3 3RT16 27-.A. .1 3RT16 47-.A. .1
Size S00 S0 S3
Dimensions (W x H x D) mm 45 x 101 x 105 45 x 100 x 130 70 x 167 x 183

H
2

including auxiliary switches and connecting cables

D
W
Contactors and
Assemblies

General technical specifications


Capacitor rating 230 V, 50/60 Hz kvar 3 … 7.5 3.5 … 15 3.5 … 30
at rated power 400 V, 50/60 Hz kvar 5 … 12.5 6 … 25 5 … 50
(utilization category AC-6b) 525 V, 50/60 Hz kvar 7.5 … 15 7.8 … 30 7.5 … 60
690 V, 50/60 Hz kvar 10 … 21 10 … 42 10 … 84
Auxiliary contacts mounted (unassigned) 1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO
Auxiliary contacts mountable (lateral), not for sizes S00 and S0 -- 2 NC + 2 NO or
1 NO + 1 NC
Max. switching frequency h-1 180 100
Electrical endurance Operating > 250 000 > 150 000 > 100 000
cycles
Ambient temperature °C 60
Short-circuit protection 1.6 ... 2.2 x Ie
Coil operating range 0.8 … 1.1 x Us
Conductor cross-sections (1 or 2 conductors connectable)
Main conductors Screw terminals

• Solid mm² 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5)2); 2 x (1 ... 2.5)2); --


2 x (0.75 ... 2.5)2) 2 x (2.5 ... 6)2)
according to according to
IEC 60947; IEC 60947;
max. 2 x (1 ... 4)2) max. 1 x 10 1)2)
• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm² 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5)2); 2 x (1 ... 2.5)2); --
2 x (0.75 ... 2.5)2) 2 x (2.5 ... 6) 1)2)
• AWG cables
- Solid AWG 2 x (20 ... 16) 2 x (16 ... 12) --
- Solid or stranded AWG 2 x (18 ... 14) 2 x (14 ... 10) --
- Stranded AWG 1 x 12 1x8 --
• Terminal screws M3 M4 (Pozidriv size 2) --
- Tightening torque Nm 0.8 ... 1.2 2 ... 2.5 --
lb.in 7 ... 10.3 18 ... 22 --
1) 3RV19 25-5AB feeder terminal for 16 mm².
2) If two different conductor cross-sections are connected to one clamping
point, both cross-sections must lie in one of the ranges specified.

Siemens IC 10 · 2012 4/35

2/172 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


SIRIUS
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies
3RT Coupling Contactors
Contactors for Special Applications
3RT20 coupling relays (interface) for switchiing motors 3RT20 coupling contactors (interface),
for switching motors, 3-pole, 3 ... 20 HP

More information
All technical specifications not mentioned in the table below are
identical to those of the 3RT20 contactors for switching motors
(see 2/130-2/132)
Contactors Type 3RT20 1.-.HB4. 3RT20 1.-.JB4. 3RT20 1.-.KB4. 3RT20 2.-.KB4.
Size S00 S00 S00 S0

2
Width mm 45 45 45 45
General data

Assemblies
Contactors and
Mechanical endurance Oper- 30 million 10 million
ating

3
cycles
Protective separation between the coil and the main contacts V 400
acc. to EN 60947-1, Appendix N
Control
Solenoid coil operating range 0.7 ... 1.25 x Us
Power consumption of the solenoid At Us 17 V W 1.6 2.3
coil 24 V W 2.8 4.5
(for cold coil)
Closing = Closed 30 V W 4.4 7
Permissible residual current < 10 mA x (24 V/Us) < 6 mA x (24 V/Us)
of the electronics (for 0 signal)
Overvoltage configuration of the solenoid coil Without overvolt- With diode With suppressor With varistor
age damping diode

Operating times of the coupling contactors


• Closing
- At 17 V ON-delay NO ms 40 ... 130 70 ... 270
OFF-delay NC ms 30 ... 80 60 ... 250
- At 24 V ON-delay NO ms 35 ... 60 65 ... 90
OFF-delay NC ms 25 ... 40 55 ... 80
- At 30 V ON-delay NO ms 25 ... 50 52 ... 65
OFF-delay NC ms 15 ... 30 43 ... 57
• Closing at 17 ... 30 V OFF-delay NO ms 7 ... 20 38 ... 65 7 ... 20 19 ... 21
ON-delay NC ms 20 ... 30 55 ... 75 20 ... 30 25 ... 31

Contactors Type 3RT20 1.-1MB4.-0KT0 3RT20 1.-1VB4. 3RT20 1.-1WB4.


Size S00 S00 S00
Width mm 45 45 45
General data
Mechanical endurance Oper- 30 million
ating
cycles
Protective separation between the coil and the main contacts V 400
acc. to EN 60947-1, Appendix N
Control
Solenoid coil operating range 0.85 ... 1.85 x Us
Power consumption of the solenoid At Us 24 V W 1.6
coil
(for cold coil)
Closing = Closed
Permissible residual current, On request
upright mounting position
Overvoltage configuration of the solenoid coil Without overvoltage With diode With suppressor diode
damping

Operating times of the coupling contactors


• Closing
- At 20.5 V ON-delay NO ms 30 ... 120
OFF-delay NC ms 20 ... 110
- At 24 V ON-delay NO ms 25 ... 90
OFF-delay NC ms 15 ... 80
- At 44 V ON-delay NO ms 15 ... 60
OFF-delay NC ms 10 ... 50
• Opening OFF-delay NO ms 5 ... 20 20 ... 80 5 ... 20
ON-delay NC ms 10 ... 30 30 ... 90 10 ... 30

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/173


SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 3/75
SIRIUS
Power Contactors for Switching Motors
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies

3TF6
3TF68 vacuum
and contactors,
3TF69 Vacuum contactors
3-pole, 335 ... 450 kW

Overview
Standards Electromagnetic compatibility
IEC 60947-1, EN 60947-1, The 3TF68/69 . . - . C contactors for AC operation are fitted with an
IEC 60947-4-1, EN 60947-4-1, electronically controlled solenoid operating mechanism with a
IEC 60947-5-1, EN 60947-5-1 (auxiliary switches) high interference immunity (for EMC values see page 3/115).
The 3TF68/69 contactors are climate-proof. The solenoid coil is connected to varistors for protection against
3 2

overvoltages.
They are finger-safe according to EN 50274. Terminal covers
may have to be fitted onto the connecting bars, depending on The 3TF68/69 . . - . Q .. contactors for AC operation are designed
Contactors and
Assemblies

the configuration with other devices (see Accessories and Spare for operation in systems with AC control supply voltage which is
Parts on page 2/56). subject to strong interference. The solenoid systems of these
contactors are configured in the DC economy circuit with rectifi-
Main contacts cation. The rectifier bridge is connected to varistors for protec-
Contact erosion indication with 3TF68/69 vacuum contactors tion against overvoltages.
The contact erosion of the vacuum interrupters can be checked Protection of the main current paths
during operation with the help of 3 white double slides on the
contactor base. If the distance indicated by one of the double An integrated RC varistor connection for the main current paths
slides is < 0.5 mm while the contactor is in the closed position, dampens the switching overvoltage rises to safe values. This
then the vacuum interrupter must be replaced. To ensure maxi- prevents multiple restricting. It can therefore be assumed that
mum reliability, it is recommended to replace all 3 vacuum inter- the motor winding cannot be damaged by switching overvolt-
rupters simultaneously. ages with steep voltage rises.
Note:
Auxiliary contacts
During operation in installations in which the emitted interference
Contact reliability limits cannot be observed, e.g. when used for output contactors
These auxiliary contacts are particularly suitable for solid-state in converters, 3TF68/69 . . - . Q contactors without a main current
circuits with currents ≥ 1 mA at a voltage ≥ 17 V. path circuit are recommended.

Technical specifications
Contactor Type 3TF68 and 3TF69
Rated data of the auxiliary contacts Acc. to IEC 60947-5-1
Rated insulation voltage Ui V 690
(pollution degree 3)
Conventional thermal current A 10
Ith = Rated operational current Ie/AC-12
AC load
Rated operational current Ie/AC-15/AC-14
• For rated operational voltage Ue
- At 24 V A 10
- At 110 V A 10
- At 125 V A 10
- At 220 V A 6
- At 230 V A 5.6
- At 380 V A 4
- At 400 V A 3.6
- At 500 V A 2.5
- At 660 V A 2.5
- At 690 V A 2.3
DC load
Rated operational current Ie/DC-12
• For rated operational voltage Ue
- At 24 V A 10
- At 60 V A 10
- At 110 V A 3.2
- At 125 V A 2.5
- At 220 V A 0.9
- At 440 V A 0.33
- At 600 V A 0.22
Rated operational current Ie/DC-13 Auxiliary contacts with
• For rated operational voltage Ue delayed NC contact: NS = No specification
- At 24 V A 10 6
- At 60 V A 5 NS
- At 110 V A 1.14 0.98
- At 125 V A 0.98 NS
- At 220 V A 0.48 NS
- At 440 V A 0.13 NS
- At 600 V A 0.07 0.07
s and u rated data of the auxiliary contacts
Rated voltage, max. V AC 600
Switching capacity A 600, P 600

2/174 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


3/112 Siemens IC 10 · 2012
SIRIUS
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies
Power Contactors for Switching Motors
3TF68 and 3TF69 Vacuum contactors 3TF6 vacuum contactors,
3-pole, 335 ... 450 kW

Contactor 3TF68 and 3TF69


Contact endurance of the auxiliary contacts
The contact endurance for utilization category AC-12 or 4
AC-15/AC-14 depends mainly on the breaking current. It is 3
NSB0_00651b

assumed that the operating mechanisms are switched ran- 2


domly, i.e. not synchronized with the phase angle of the

Operating cycles
supply system. 7

2
10
8
The characteristic curves apply to 230 V AC. 6

3
4

Assemblies
Contactors and
3
2
6
10
8
6
4
3
2
5
10
-2 -1 0 1
10 2 3 4 6 8 10 2 3 4 6 8 10 2 3 4 6 8 10 2
Breaking current a ( A )

3TF68 and 3TF69


Contact erosion indication with vacuum contactors
The contact erosion of the vacuum interrupters can be
checked during operation with the help of 3 white double
slides on the contactor base.
If the distance indicated by one of the double slides is
< 0.5 mm while the contactor is in the closed position, the
vacuum interrupter must be replaced. To ensure maximum
reliability, it is recommended to replace all 3 vacuum inter-
rupters.
Contact endurance of the main contacts
Contactor type 3TF68 3TF69
7 8 107
10 6 8 NSB0_00654a
8 6 6
4
6 4 4
4
Operating cycles at 400 V
Operating cycles at 230 V

Operating cycles at 690 V

2
Operating cycles at 500 V

2 2
6
2 6 10
10 8 10
6
6 8
10 6 8
8 6 6
4
6 4 4
4 2
2 2
2 5
5 10
10 8 10
5
10
5 8 6 8
8 6 6
4
6 4 4
4 2
2 2
2 4
4 10
10 8 10
4
10
4 8 6 8
8 6 6
4
6 4 4
4 2
2 2
2 3
3 10
10 10
3
100 200 400 600 1000 2000 4000 a (A) 6000
635
820 e (A)
335 Prated (kW)
450

Diagram legend:
Prated = Rated power for squirrel-cage motors at 400 V
a
= Breaking current
e
= Rated operational current

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/175


Siemens IC 10 · 2012 3/113
SIRIUS
Power Contactors for Switching Motors
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies

3TF6
3TF68 vacuum
and contactors,
3TF69 Vacuum contactors
3-pole, 335 ... 450 kW

Type 3TF68 3TF69


Size 14 14
Dimensions (W x H x D) mm 230 x 276 x 237 230 x 295 x 237

General data
3 2

Permissible mounting position, installation 22,5° 22,5°

NSB0_00649a
instructions1) 2) 90° 90°
Contactors and
Assemblies

The contactors are designed for operation on a verti-


cal mounting surface.

Mechanical endurance Operating 5 million


cycles
3)
Electrical endurance Operating
cycles
Rated insulation voltage Ui kV 1
(pollution degree 3)
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 8
Protective separation between the coil and the main contacts kV 1
acc. to IEC 60947-1, Appendix N
Mirror contacts Yes, acc. to IEC 60947-4-1, Appendix F
A mirror contact is an auxiliary NC contact that cannot be closed simul-
taneously with a NO main contact.
One NC contact each must be connected in series for the right and left
auxiliary switch block respectively.
Permissible ambient temperature
• During operation 5) °C -25 ... +55
• During storage °C -55 ... +80
Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60947-1, Appendix C IP00/open (where applicable, use additional terminal covers)
Touch protection acc. to EN 50274 Finger-safe with cover
Shock resistance
• Rectangular pulse
- AC operation g/ms 8.1/5 and 4.7/10 9.5/5 and 5.7/10
- DC operation g/ms 9/5 and 5.7/10 8.6/5 and 5.1/10
• Sine pulse
- AC operation g/ms 12.8/5 and 7.4/10 13.5/5 and 7.8/10
- DC operation g/ms 14.4/5 and 9.1/10 13.5/5 and 7.8/10
Conductor cross-sections See page 2/179.
Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) See page 2/108.
Short-circuit protection
Main circuit
Fuse links, gG operational class:
LV HRC, type 3NA; DIAZED, type 5SB; NEOZED, type 5SE
according to IEC 60947-4-1/EN 60947-4-1
• Type of coordination "1" A 1 000 1 250
• Type of coordination "2" A 500 630
• Weld-free4) A 400 500
Auxiliary circuit
• Short-circuit test with fuse links of gG operational class: A 10
LV HRC, type 3NA; DIAZED, type 5SB; NEOZED, type 5SE
with Ik = 1 kA acc. to IEC 60947-5-1
• Test with miniature circuit breaker up to 230 V with C characteristic: A 10
Short-circuit current Ik = 400 A acc. to IEC 60947-5-1
1)
To easily replace the laterally mounted auxiliary switches it is recom-
mended to maintain a minimum distance of 30 mm between the contac-
tors.
2)
If mounted at a 90° angle (conducting paths are horizontally above each
other), the switching frequency is reduced by 80% compared with the nor-
mal values.
3) See “Endurance of the auxillary contacts”, page 2/175.
4)
Test conditions according to IEC 60947-4-1.
5) For ambient temperatures > 55°C, only 3TF6.33-.Q..-Z A02 contactors
(= without connection of the main current path circuits) can be used.
Then derating is also possible with these contactors:
- AC-1: Ie = 782 A, 644 operating cycles/h;
- AC-3: operating range 0.85-1.05 x Us, 460 operating cycles/hour,
mechanical endurance 5 million operating cycles, lateral clearance
10 mm

2/176 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


3/114 Siemens IC 10 · 2012
SIRIUS
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies
Power Contactors for Switching Motors
3TF68 and 3TF69 Vacuum contactors 3TF6 vacuum contactors,
3-pole, 335 ... 450 kW

Contactor Type 3TF68 3TF69


Size 14 14
Control
Coil operating range 0.8 x Us min ... 1.1 x Us max
Power consumption of the solenoid coils
(when coil is cold and 1.0 x Us)

2
• AC operation, Us max - Closing VA/p.f. 1850/1 950/0.98
- Closed VA/p.f. 49/0.15 30.6/0.31
• AC operation, Us min - Closing VA/p.f. 1200/1 600/0.98

3
Assemblies
Contactors and
- Closed VA/p.f. 13.5/0.47 12.9/0.43
• DC economy circuit1) - Closing at 24 V W 1010 960
- Closed W 28 20.6
For contactors of type 3TF68/69 . . - . Q:
• AC operation, Us min2) - Closing VA/p.f. 1000/0.99 1150/0.99
- Closed VA/p.f. 11/1 11/1
Operating times for 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us (Values apply to cold and warm coil)
(Total break time = Opening delay + Arcing time)
• AC operation - Closing delay ms 70 ... 120 (22 ... 65)3) 80 ... 120
- Opening delay ms 70 ... 100 70 ... 80
• DC economy circuit - Closing delay ms 76 ... 110 86 ... 280
- Opening delay ms 50 19 ... 25
• Arcing time ms 10 ... 15 10
For contactors of type 3TF68/69 . . - . Q:
• AC operation - Closing delay ms 35 ... 90 45 ... 160
- Opening delay ms 65 ... 90 30 ... 80
Operating times for 1.0 x U s
(Total break time = Opening delay + Arcing time)
• AC operation - Closing delay ms 80 ... 100 (30 ... 45)3) 85 ... 100
- Opening delay ms 70 ... 100 70
• DC economy circuit - Closing delay ms 80 ... 90 90 ... 125
- Opening delay ms 50 19 ... 25
Minimum command duration Standard ms 120 120
for closing Reduced make-time ms 90 --
Minimum interval time between two ON commands ms 100 300
1) At 24 V DC; for further voltages, deviations of up to ±10 % are possible.
2) Including reversing contactor.
3) Values in brackets apply to contactors with reduced operating times.

Contactor Type 3TF6. 44- 3TF6. 44- 3TF6. 44- 3TF6. 44- 3TF6. 44-
.CF7 .CM7 .CP7 .CQ7 .CS7
Electromagnetic compatibility
Rated control supply voltage Us V AC 110 ... 132 200 ... 240 230 ... 277 380 ... 460 500 ... 600
Overvoltage type acc. to IEC 60801 Burst/Surge
Degree of severity acc. to IEC 60801
• Burst 3 4 4 4 4
• Surge 4 4 4 4 4
Overvoltage resistance
• Burst kV 2 4 4 4 4
• Surge kV 6 5 5 6 6

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/177


Siemens IC 10 · 2012 3/115
SIRIUS
Power Contactors for Switching Motors
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies

3TF6
3TF68 vacuum
and contactors,
3TF69 Vacuum contactors
3-pole, 335 ... 450 kW

Contactor Type 3TF68 3TF69


Size 14 14
Main circuit
AC capacity
Utilization category AC-1
Switching resistive loads
3 2

• Rated operational currents Ie At 40 °C up to 690 V A 700 910


At 55 °C up to 690 V A 630 850
At 55 °C up to 1000 V A 450 800
Contactors and
Assemblies

• Rated power for AC loads with p.f. = 0.95 230 V kW 240 323
at 55°C 400 V kW 415 558
500 V kW 545 735
690 V kW 720 970
1000 V kW 780 1 385
• Minimum conductor cross-sections for loads At 40°C mm2 2 x 240 Ie ≥ 800 A: 2 x 60 x 5
with Ie (copper busbars)
At 55°C mm2 2 x 185 Ie < 800 A: 2 x 240
Utilization categories AC-2 and AC-3
• Rated operational currents Ie Up to 690 V A 630 820
1000 V A 435 580
• Rated power for slipring or squirrel-cage mo- At 230 V kW 200 260
tors at 50 Hz and 60 Hz 400 V kW 347 450
500 V kW 434 600
690 V kW 600 800
1000 V kW 600 800
Thermal load capacity 10 s current A 5 040 7 000
Power loss per conducting path At Ie/AC-3 W 45 70
Utilization category AC-4 (for Ia = 6 x Ie)
• Rated operational current Ie Up to 690 V A 610 690
• Rated power for squirrel-cage motors At 400 V kW 355 400
with 50 Hz and 60 Hz
The following applies to a contact endurance
of about 200 000 operating cycles:
• Rated operational currents Ie Up to 690 V A 300 360
1000 V A 210 250
• Rated power for squirrel-cage motors At 230 V kW 97 110
with 50 Hz and 60 Hz 400 V kW 168 191
500 V1) kW 210 250
690 V1) kW 278 335
1000 V1) A 290 350
Switching frequency
Switching frequency z in operating cycles/hour
• Contactors without overload relays No-load switching 1/h 2 000 1 000
frequency AC
No-load switching 1/h 1 000 1 000
frequency DC
AC-1 1/h 700 700
AC-2 1/h 200 200
AC-3 1/h 500 500
AC-4 1/h 150 150
• Contactors with overload relays (mean value) 1/h 15 15
1) Max. permissible rated operational current Ie/AC-4 = Ie/AC-3 up to 500 V,
for reduced contact endurance and reduced switching frequency.

2/178 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


3/116 Siemens IC 10 · 2012
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies
Power Contactors for Switching MotorsSIRIUS
3TF68 and 3TF69 Vacuum contactors
3TF6 vacuum contactors,
3-pole, 335 ... 450 kW

Contactor Type 3TF68 3TF69


Size 14 14
Conductor cross-sections
Main conductors: Screw terminals

• Busbar connections
- Finely stranded with cable lug mm2 50 ... 240 50 ... 240

2
- Stranded with cable lug mm2 70 ... 240 50 ... 240
- Solid or stranded AWG 2/0 ... 500 MCM 2/0 ... 500 MCM

3
- Connecting bar (max. width) mm 50 60 (Ue ≤ 690 V)

Assemblies
Contactors and
50 (Ue > 690 V)
• Terminal screw M10 x 30 M12 x 40
- Tightening torque Nm 14 ... 24 (124 ... 210 lb.in) 20 ... 35 (177 ... 310 lb.in)
• With box terminal1)
- Connectable copper bars
- Width mm 15 ... 25 15 ... 38
- Max. thickness mm 1 x 26 or 2 x 11 1 x 46 or 2 x 18
- Terminal screw A/F 6 (hexagon socket) A/F 8 (hexagon socket)
- Tightening torque Nm 25 ... 40 35 ... 50
lb.in 221 ... 354 266 ... 443
Auxiliary conductors:
• Solid mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 1)2)/2 x (1 ... 2.5)2)
• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 1)2)/2 x (0.75 ... 2.5)2)
• Pin-end connector acc. to DIN 46231 mm2 2 x (1 ... 1.5)
• Solid or stranded AWG 2 x (18 ... 12)
• Tightening torque Nm 0.8 ... 1.4
lb.in 7 ... 12
1) See “Accessories and Spare Parts”, page 2/56.
2) If two different conductor cross-sections are connected to one clamping
point, both cross-sections must lie in one of the ranges specified.

Contactor Type 3TF68 3TF69


Size 14 14
s and u rated data
Rated insulation voltage V AC 600 600
Uninterrupted current
• Open and enclosed A 630 820
Maximum horsepower ratings
(s and u approved values)
• Rated power for induction motors
at 60 Hz
- At 200 V hp 231 290
- At 230 V hp 266 350
- At 460 V hp 530 700
- At 575 V hp 664 860
NEMA/EEMAC ratings
SIZE hp 6 7
• Uninterrupted current
- Open A 600 820
- Enclosed A 540 810
• Rated power for induction motors
at 60 Hz
- At 200 V hp 150 --
- At 230 V hp 200 300
- At 460 V hp 400 600
- At 575 V hp 400 600
Overload relays Type 3RB12 .
• Setting range A 200 ... 820

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/179


Siemens IC 10 · 2012 3/117
SIRIUS
Contactors for Special Applications
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies

Contactors for Switching DC Voltage


3TC
3TC contactors,
contactors
1- and 2-pole, 32 ... 400 A

Overview Application
3TC4 and 3TC5 The contactors are suitable for switching and controlling DC mo-
tors as well as all other DC circuits.
IEC 60947-1, EN 60947-1,
IEC 60947-4-1, EN 60947-4-1 A version with an especially large coil operating range is avail-
able for operation in electrically driven vehicles and in switch-
The contactors are finger-safe according to EN 50274. Terminal gears with significant fluctuations in the actuating voltage
covers may have to be fitted onto the connecting bars, depend-
2

.
ing on the configuration with other devices.
The DC motor ratings given in the tables are applicable to the
Contactors and
Assemblies

DC-3 and DC-5 utilization categories with two-pole switching


of the load or with the two conducting paths of the contactor con-
nected in series.
4

One contactor conducting path can switch full power up to


220 V. The ratings for higher voltages are available on request.
3TC7
IEC 60947-4-1, EN 60947-4-1.
The contactors are suitable for use in any climate. They are suit-
able for switching and controlling DC motors as well as all other
DC circuits.
The solenoid excitation is configured for a particularly large
operating range. It is between 0.7 or 0.8 to 1.2 x Us.
3TC74 contactors can be used at up to 750 V/400 A and 50 Hz
in AC-1 operation.

Technical specifications
Contactors Type 3TC4 and 3TC7 3TC5
Rated data of the auxiliary contacts
Rated insulation voltage Ui V 690
(pollution degree 3)
Conventional thermal current Ith = A 10 10
Rated operational current Ie/AC-12
AC load
Rated operational current Ie/AC-15/AC-14
• For rated operational voltage Ue
24 V A 10 10
110 V A 10 10
125 V A 10 10
220 V A 6 6
230 V A 5.6 5.6
380 V A 4 4
400 V A 3.6 3.6
500 V A 2.5 2.5
660 V A 2.5 2.5
690 V A -- --
DC load
Rated operational current Ie/DC-12
• For rated operational voltage Ue
24 V A 10 10
60 V A 10 10
110 V A 3.2 8
125 V A 2.5 6
220 V A 0.9 2
440 V A 0.33 0.6
600 V A 0.22 0.4
Rated operational current Ie/DC-13
• For rated operational voltage Ue
24 V A 10 10
60 V A 5 5
110 V A 1.14 2.4
125 V A 0.98 2.1
220 V A 0.48 1.1
440 V A 0.13 0.32
600 V A 0.07 0.21

2/180 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


4/50 Siemens IC 10 · 2012
SIRIUS
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies
Contactors for Special Applications
Contactors for Switching DC Voltage
3TC contactors 3TC contactors,
1- and 2-pole, 32 ... 400 A

Contactors Type 3TC44 ... 3TC56


s and u rated data of the auxiliary contacts
Rated voltage, max. V AC 600
Switching capacity A 600, P 600

Contactors Type 3TC44 ... 3TC78

2
Contact endurance of the main contacts
10 7 20

Assemblies
Contactors and
NSB0_00656
8 NSB0_00655
6 Mill.

Operating cycles at 500 V


4 18
Operating cycles at 500 V

3TC44 3TC48 3TC52 3TC56


2
16

4
10 6
8
6 14
4
12
2
5
10 10
8
6
4 8

2
6
10 4
8
6 4
4
2
2
0,5
10 3
200 400 50 100 150 200 250 300 a (A) 400
10 20 40 100 600 1000 a (A)

3TC44 to 3TC56 contactors 3TC74 and 3TC78 contactors


Legend for the diagrams:
Ia = Breaking current

Contactors Type 3TC44 3TC48 3TC52 3TC56


Size 2 4 8 12
General technical specifications
Permissible mounting positions 22,5° 22,5° 22,5° 22,5°
NSB0_00650c

The contactors are designed for operation on a


vertical mounting surface.

Mechanical endurance Operating cycles 10 million


Electrical endurance Operating cycles 1)

Rated insulation voltage Ui (pollution degree 3) V 800 1 000


Protective separation between the coil and the main contacts V Up to 300 Up to 660
acc. to IEC 60947-1, Appendix N
Mirror contacts2) Yes, acc. to IEC 60947-4-1, Appendix F
A mirror contact is an auxiliary NC contact that cannot be closed simultane-
ously with a NO main contact.
Permissible ambient temperature
• During operation °C -25 ... +55
• During storage °C -50 ... +80
Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60947-1, Appendix C IP00/open, for AC operation, coil assembly IP40
Shock resistance Rectangular pulse g/ms 7.5/5 and 3.4/10 10/5 and 5/10 12/5 and 5.5/10 12/5 and 5.6/10
Short-circuit protection
Main circuit
Fuse links, operational class gG:
LV HRC, type 3NA; DIAZED, type 5SB; NEOZED, type 5SE
• Type of coordination "1" A 50 160 250 400
• Type of coordination "2" A 35 63 80 250
Auxiliary circuit
• Short-circuit test with fuse links of gG operational class: A 16
DIAZED, type 5SB; NEOZED, type 5SE
with short-circuit current Ik = 1 kA acc. to IEC 60947-5-1
• Test with miniature circuit breaker up to 230 V with C characteristic: A 10
Short-circuit current Ik = 400 A acc. to IEC 60947-5-1
1) See the endurance diagram above. .
2) For 3TC44, one NC contact each must be connected in series for the right
and left auxiliary switch block respectively.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/181


Siemens IC 10 · 2012 4/51
SIRIUS
Contactors for Special Applications
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies

Contactors for Switching DC Voltage


3TC contactors,
3TC contactors
1- and 2-pole, 32 ... 400 A

Type 3TC44 3TC48 3TC52 3TC56


Size 2 4 8 12
Dimensions (W x H x D)

H
• DC operation mm 70 x 85 x 141 100 x 183 x 180 135 x 238 x 232 160 x 279 x 310

D
• AC operation W mm 70 x 85 x 100 100 x 183 x 154 135 x 238 x 200 160 x 279 x 251
Control circuits
Coil operating range 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us
2

Power consumption of the solenoid coils


(for cold coil and 1.0 x Us)
Contactors and
Assemblies

• DC operation - Closing = Closed W 10 19 30 86


• AC operation, 50 Hz coil - Closing VA/p.f. 68/0.86 300/0.5 640/0.48 1780/0.3
- Closed VA/p.f. 10/0.29 26/0.24 46/0.23 121/0.22
• AC operation, 60 Hz coil - Closing VA/p.f. 95/0.79 365/0.45 730/0.38 2140/0.3
4

- Closed VA/p.f. 12/0.3 35/0.26 56/0.24 140/0.29


• AC operation, 50/60 Hz coil - Closing VA/p.f. 79/73/0.83/0.78 -- -- --
at 50 Hz/60 Hz
- Closed VA/p.f. 11/9/0.28/0.27 -- -- --
at 50 Hz/60 Hz
Operating times (for 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us) (The values apply up to and including 20 % undervoltage,
Total break time = Opening delay + Arcing time 10 % overvoltage, as well as when the coil is cold and warm)
• DC operation - Closing delay ms 35 ... 190 90 ... 380 120 ... 400 110 ... 400
- Opening delay1) ms 10 ... 25 17 ... 28 22 ... 35 40 ... 110
• AC operation - Closing delay ms 10 ... 40 20 ... 50 20 ... 50 20 ... 50
- Opening delay1) ms 5 ... 25 5 ... 30 10 ... 30 10 ... 30
• Arcing time - DC-1 ms 20
- DC-3/DC-5 ms 30
Main circuit
Load rating with DC
Utilization category DC-1, switching resistive loads (L/R ≤ 1 ms)
• Rated operational currents Ie Up to Ue 750 V A 32 75 220 400
(at 55 °C)
2
• Minimum conductor cross-section mm 6 25 95 240
• Rated power at Ue At 220 V kW 7 16.5 48 88
440 V kW 14 33 97 176
600 V kW 19.2 45 132 240
750 V kW 24 56 165 300
Utilization category DC-3 and DC-5
Shunt-wound and series-wound motors (L/R ≤ 15 ms)
• Rated operational currents Ie Up to 220 V A 32 75 220 400
(at 55 °C) 440 V A 29 75 220 400
600 V A 21 75 220 400
750 V A 7.5 75 170 400
• Rated power at Ue At 110 V kW 2.5 6.5 20 35
220 V kW 5 13 41 70
440 V kW 9 27 82 140
600 V kW 9 38 110 200
750 V kW 4 45 110 250
Switching frequency
Switching frequency z in operating cycles/hour
AC/DC operation
• With resistive load DC-1 h-1 1 500 1 000
• For inductive load DC-3/DC-5 h-1 750 600
Conductor cross-sections (1 or 2 conductors connectable)
Main conductors: Screw terminals

• Solid mm2 2 x (2.5 ... 10) 2 x (6 ... 16) -- --


• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 x (1.5 ... 4) -- -- --
• Stranded with cable lug mm2 2 x 16 2 x 35 2 x 120 2 x 150
2
• Pin-end connector acc. to DIN 46231 mm 2 x (1 ... 6) -- -- --
• Busbars mm -- 15 x 2.5 25 x 4 2 x (25 x 3)
• Terminal screw M5 M6 M10 M10
Auxiliary conductors:
• Solid mm2 2 x (1 ... 2.5)
• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 x (0.75 ... 1.5)
1) The opening delay times can increase if the contactor coils are damped
against voltage peaks. Only 3TC44 contactors are allowed to be fitted with
diodes.

2/182 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


4/52 Siemens IC 10 · 2012
DC Power Controls Contactors for Special ApplicationsSIRIUS
DC Contactors Contactors for Switching DC Voltage
3TC contactors,
3TC contactors
1- and 2-pole, 32 ... 400 A

Type 3TC74 3TC78


Design 1-pole contactors 2-pole contactors

H
Dimensions mm 78 x 352 x 276 160 x 366 x 290

D
W

General technical specifications


Permissible mounting positions 22,5° 22,5° 22,5° 22,5°

NSB0_00650c

2
The contactors are designed for operation on a
vertical mounting surface.

Assemblies
Contactors and
Mechanical endurance Operating cycles 30 million
Electrical endurance Operating cycles 1)

Rated insulation voltage Ui (pollution degree 3) V 1 500

4
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 8
Protective separation between the coil and the main contacts V 630
acc. to IEC 60947-1, Appendix N
Permissible ambient temperature °C -25 ... +55
Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60947-1, Appendix C IP00/open
Short-circuit protection
Main circuit
Fuse links, operational class gG:
LV HRC, type 3NA
• Type of coordination "1" A 630
• Type of coordination "2" A 500
Auxiliary circuits
• Short-circuit test with fuse links of gG operational class: A 16
DIAZED, type 5SB; NEOZED, type 5SE
with short-circuit current Ik = 1 kA acc. to IEC 60947-5-1
• Test with miniature circuit breaker up to 230 V with C characteristic: A 10
Short-circuit current Ik = 400 A acc. to IEC 60947-5-1
Control circuits
Coil operating range
• DC operation At Uc = 24 V 0.8 ... 1.2 x Us
At Uc > 24 V 0.7 ... 1.2 x Us
• AC operation At Uc = 24 V 0.7 ... 1.15 x Us
At Uc > 24 V 0.7 ... 1.14 x Us
Power consumption of the solenoid coils (when coil is cold and 1.0 x Us)
• DC operation Closing = Closed W 46 92
• AC operation, 50 Hz Closing, VA 80 160
Closed 0.95 0.95
Operating times (The values apply up to and including 15 % undervoltage,
(Total break time = Opening delay + Arcing time) 10 % overvoltage, as well as when the coil is cold and warm)
• AC and DC operation - Closing delay ms 60 ... 100
- Opening delay ms 20 ... 35
• Arcing time at 0.06 ... 4 x Ie ms 40 ... 70
Main circuit
Load rating with DC
Utilization category DC-1, switching resistive loads (L/R ≤ 1 ms)
• Rated operational current Ie/DC-1 (at 55 °C) A 500 500
• Minimum conductor cross-section mm2 2 x 150 2 x 150
• Rated power At 220 V kW 110 110
440 V kW 220 220
600 V kW 300 300
750 V kW 375 375
1200 V kW — 600
1500 V kW — 750
• Critical currents, without arc extinction At 440 V A ≤7 —
600 V A ≤ 13 —
750 V A ≤ 15 —
≤ 800 V A — ≤7
1200 V A — ≤ 13
1500 V A — ≤ 15
2)
Utilization categories DC-3 and DC-5, switching DC motors
Permissible rated current for regenerative braking At 110 ... 600 V A 400
Switching frequency
Switching frequency z in operating cycles/hour
AC/DC operation
• With resistive load DC-1 h-1 750 1 000
• For inductive load DC-3/DC-5 h-1 500 500
1)
Endurance see page 2/181..
2) .
See Selection and ordering data.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/183


Siemens IC 10 · 2012 4/53
SIRIUS
Power Contactors for Switching Motors
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies

Accessories for 3RT1 Contactors


Accessories – 3RT1 contactors
General data

Technical specifications
Contactor Type 3RT19 2 6-2C 3RT19 26-2D 3RT19 26-2E 3RT19 26-2F 3RT19 26-2G
Solid-state timing relay blocks Solid-state time-delay auxiliary switch blocks
with semiconductor output
General data
Rated insulation voltage Ui V AC 250
32

Pollution degree 3
Overvoltage category III acc. to EN 60664-1
Permissible ambient temperature
Contactors and
Assemblies

• During operation °C -25 ... +60


• During storage °C -40 ... +80
Degree of protection acc. to EN 60947-1, Appendix C
• Cover IP40
• Terminals IP20
Shock resistance g/ms 15/11
Half-sine acc. to IEC 60068-2-27
Vibration resistance
according to IEC 60068-2-6 Hz/mm 10 ... 55/0.35
EMC tests Basic specification IEC 61000-6-4
Conductor connections
• Solid mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5), 2 x (0.75 ... 4)
• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 2.5)
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 2 x (18 ... 14)
• Terminal screws M3
• Tightening torque Nm 0.8 ... 1.2
lb.in 7 ... 10.3
Permissible mounting positions Any
Control
Operating range of excitation 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us, 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us,
0.95 ... 1.05 times the rated 0.95 ... 1.05 times the rated frequency
frequency
Rated power W 1 2
• Power consumption at 230 V AC, 50 Hz VA 1 4
Overvoltage protection Varistor integrated in timing relay --
Recovery time ms 50 150
Minimum ON period ms 35 200 (with OFF-delay)
Setting accuracy Typ. % ±15
With reference to upper limit of scale
Repeat accuracy Max. % ±1
Load side
Rated operational currents Ie
• Load current A 0.3 --
• AC-15, 230 V, 50 Hz A -- 3
• DC-13, 24 V A -- 1
• DC-13, 110 V A -- 0.2
• DC-13, 230 V A -- 0.1
Short-time loading capacity Up to 10 ms A 10 --
DIAZED protection gG operational class A -- 4
Residual current Max. mA 5 --
Voltage drop Max. VA 3.5 --
With conducting output
Mechanical endurance Operating 100 x 106 10 x 106
cycles
Switching frequency for load
• With Ie at 230 V AC h-1 2 00 2 500
• With 3RT20 16 contactor at 230 V AC h-1 2 500 5 000

2/184 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


3/94 Siemens IC 10 · 2012
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies Power Contactors for Switching MotorsSIRIUS
Accessories for 3RT1 Contactors
Accessories – 3RT1 contactors
General data

Function Function chart


Timing relay energized
Contact closed
Contact open
Solid-state timing relay blocks 1 NO contact (semiconductor output)
ON-delay, 3RT19 26-2C L1/L+ A2 can be connected
two-wire design A1/A2 to N(L-) using either

2
(varistor integrated) Timing relay

NSB0_0939a
A2 the contactor or the
A1
timing relay.
1

3
t
– – – – To be connected

Assemblies
Contactors and
A1/A2 A1 A2
Contactor optionally

NSB0_00556
2
A1 A2 1 Timing relay block
N/L- 2 Contactor

OFF-delay 3RT19 26-2D L1/L+


with auxiliary voltage A2 must only be
A1/A2
(varistor integrated) Timing relay S1 connected to N(L--)

NSB0_0940a
B1/A2 A1 B1 A2 from the timing relay.
> 35 ms
1
A1/A2 Do not connect
Contactor t A1 A2

NSB0_00557
2 1 Timing relay block
A1 A2
N/L 2 Contactor

Solid-state time-delay auxiliary switch blocks 1 NO + 1 NC


ON-delay 3RT19 26-2E
A1/A2

NSB0_00936
-7/-8
-5/-6 27 35
A1
t
A2
28 36
NSB0_01873

OFF-delay 3RT19 26-2F


without auxiliary voltage >200 ms
A1/A2
NSB0_00937

-7/-8 27 35
A1
-5/-6
t A2
28 36
NSB0_01874a

Solid-state time-delay auxiliary switch blocks 2 NO


Wye-delta function: 3RT19 26-2G
1 NO delayed, A1/A2
1 NO instantaneous,
NSB0_00938

dead time 50 ms Y -7/-8


(varistor integrated) -7/-8 27 37
A1
t 50 ms
A2
28 38
NSB0_01875

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/185


Siemens IC 10 · 2012 3/95
SIRIUS
Power Contactors for Switching Motors
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies

Accessories for 3RT1 Contactors


Accessories — 3RT1 contactors
General data

Contactor Type 3RH19 24, 3TX7 090


Coupling links for mounting on contactors
acc. to IEC 60947/EN 60947
General data
Rated insulation voltage Ui (pollution degree 3) V 300
Protective separation between coil and contacts V AC Up to 300
acc. to IEC 60947-1, Appendix N
32

Permissible ambient temperature


• During operation °C -25 ... +60
Contactors and
Assemblies

• During storage °C -40 ... +80


Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60947-1, Appendix C
• Connections IP20
• Enclosure IP40
Circuit diagram L1 B1+ B2- N
1

2
A1 1 Coupling link
A2 2 Contactor
NSB0_00182a

Conductor cross-sections
• Solid mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 2.5)
• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm² 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5)
Terminal screws M3
Control side
Rated control supply voltage Us V DC 24
Operating range V DC 17 ... 30
Power consumption at Us W 0.5
Nominal current input mA 20
Release voltage V ≥4
Function display Yellow LED
Protection circuit Varistor
Load side
Mechanical endurance Operating cycles 20 x 106
Electrical endurance at Ie Operating cycles 1 x 105
Switching frequency Operating cycles h-1 5 000
Make-time ms Approx. 7
Break-time ms Approx. 4
Bounce time ms Approx. 2
Contact material AgSnO
Switching voltage AC/DC V 24 ... 250
Permissible residual current of the electronics (with 0 signal) mA 2.5

2/186 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


3/96 Siemens IC 10 · 2012
SIRIUS
Contactor Relays
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies

Control Relays
SIRIUS 3RH2 contactor relays,
3RH2 control relays — size S00
4- and 8-pole

Technical specifications
Contactor relays Type 3RH2
Size S00
Permissible mounting positions
The contactor relays are designed for operation on a 360° 22,5° 22,5°

NSB0_00478c
vertical mounting surface.

2
Assemblies
Contactors and
Upright mounting position

NSB0_00477a

Special version required


(3RH21 22-2K . 40 coupling relays and contactor relays with extended
operating range on request)
Positively-driven operation of contacts in contactor relays
3RH2: Explanations:
5

Yes, in the basic unit and the auxiliary switch block as well as between There is positively-driven operation if it is ensured that the NC and NO con-
the basic unit and the front-mounted auxiliary switch block (removable) tacts cannot be closed at the same time.
acc. to:
• ZH 1/457 ZH1/457
• IEC 60947-5-1, Appendix L Safety Rules for Controls on Power-Operated Metalworking Presses.
3RH22:
Yes, in the basic unit and the auxiliary switch block as well as between IEC 60947-5-1, Appendix L
the basic unit and the snap-on auxiliary switch block (permanently Low-Voltage Controlgear, Controls and Contact Blocks. Special requirements
mounted) acc. to: for positively-driven contacts
• ZH 1/457
• IEC 60947-5-1, Appendix L
Note:
3RH29 11- . NF. solid-state compatible auxiliary switch blocks have no
positively-driven contacts.
Contact reliability
Contact reliability at 17 V, 1 mA acc. to IEC 60947-5-4 Frequency of contact faults <10-8 i.e. < 1 fault per 100 million operating
cycles
Contact endurance for AC-15/AC-14 and
DC-13 utilization categories
The contact endurance is mainly dependent on the breaking current. It is 30 NSB0_02061a
assumed that the operating mechanisms are switched randomly, i.e. not Basic unit
synchronized with the phase angle of the supply system.
Million operating cycles (106)

10
If magnetic circuits other than the contactor coil systems or solenoid
valves are present, e.g. magnetic brakes, protective measures for the 5 Basic unit with
4 attachable
load circuits are necessary, e.g. in the form of RC elements and free- 3
wheel diodes. contact block AC-15/AC-14
2
DC-13 DC-13 Basic unit with
The characteristic curves apply to: 1 220 V 110 V attachable
• 3RH21/3RH22 contactor relays
• 3RH24 latched contactor relays 0,5 contact block
• 3RH29 11 auxiliary switch blocks1)
• Auxiliary switch blocks for snapping onto the front, DC-13
max. 4-pole and for mounting onto the side in size S00 24V
0,1
0,05

0,01
0,01 0,03 0,05 0,1 0,3 0,5 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 10 a (A)
e -DC-13 e -DC-13 e -DC-13 e-AC-15
220 V 110 V 24 V < 230 V
Diagram legend:
a = Breaking current
e = Rated operational current

1) Ie = 6 A for AC-15/AC-14.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/187


5/6 Siemens IC 10 · 2012
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies
Contactor RelaysSIRIUS
Control Relays
3RH2 control relays — size S00
SIRIUS 3RH2 contactor relays,
4- and 8-pole

Type 3RH21 3RH22 3RH24


Size S00 S00 S00

H
Dimensions (W x H x D) with screw terminals mm 45 x 57.5 x 73 -- 90 x 57.5 x 73
• With mounted auxiliary switch block mm 45 x 57.5 x 116 45 x 57.5 x 116 --

D
W

General technical specifications


Mechanical endurance
2

• Basic units Operating 30 million 5 million


cycles
Contactors and
Assemblies

• Basic unit with snap-on auxiliary switch block Operating 10 million


cycles
• Solid-state compatible auxiliary switch block Operating 5 million
cycles
Rated insulation voltage Ui (pollution degree 3) V 690
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 6
Protective separation between the coil and the contacts in the basic unit V 400
acc. to IEC 60947-1, Appendix N
Permissible ambient temperature

5
• During operation °C -25 ... +60
• During storage °C -55 ... +80
Protection class IP on the front acc. to IEC 60529 IP20, coil assembly IP40
Touch protection on the front acc. to IEC 60529 Finger-safe, for vertical contact from the front
(screw and spring-type terminal)
Shock resistance • Rectangular pulse - AC operation g/ms 7.3/5 and 4.7/10
- DC operation g/ms >10/5 and >5/10
• Sine pulse - AC operation g/ms 11.4/5 and 7.3/10
- DC operation g/ms >15/5 and >8/10
Short-circuit protection
• Short-circuit test with fuse links of gG operational class: A 10
DIAZED, type 5SB; NEOZED, type 5SE
with short-circuit current Ik = 1 kA acc. to IEC 60947-5-1
• Test with miniature circuit breaker up to 230 V with C characteristic: A 6
Short-circuit current Ik = 400 A acc. to IEC 60947-5-1
Conductor cross-sections
Auxiliary conductors and coil terminals Screw terminals
(1 or 2 conductors can be connected)
2 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5)1); 2 x (0.75 ... 2.5)1) according to IEC 60947;
• Solid mm
max. 2 x (0.5 ... 4)
• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5)1); 2 x (0.75 ... 2.5)1)
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 2 x (20 ... 16)1); 2 x (18 ... 14)1)
• Terminal screw M3 (for standard screwdriver size 2 or Pozidriv 2)
- Tightening torque Nm 0.8 ... 1.2 (7 ... 10.3 lb.in)
Auxiliary conductors and coil terminals Spring-type terminals
(1 or 2 conductors can be connected)
• Operating devices mm 3.0 x 0.5; 3.5 x 0.5
• Solid mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 4)
• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 2.5)
• Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 2.5)
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 2 x (20 ... 12)
Auxiliary conductors for front and laterally mounted auxiliary switches
• Operating devices mm 3.0 x 0.5; 3.5 x 0.5
• Solid mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 2.5)
• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5)
• Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 2.5)
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 2 x (20 ... 14)
Auxiliary conductor and coil terminals Ring terminal lug connection

• Terminal screw d3
mm M3, Pozidriv size 2
• Operating devices d2 Nm Ø 5 ... 6
• Tightening torque mm 0.8 ... 1.2
• Usable ring terminal lugs mm d2 = min. 3.2
- DIN 46234 without insulation sleeve mm d3 = max. 7.5
- DIN 46225 without insulation sleeve
- DIN 46237 with insulation sleeve
I2_12740

- JIS C2805 Type R without insulation sleeve


- JIS C2805 Type RAV with insulation sleeve
- JIS C2805 Type RAP with insulation sleeve
1) If two different conductor cross-sections are connected to one clamping Tool for opening the spring-type terminals
point, both cross-sections must lie in one of the ranges specified. see Accessories, page 2/81.
Note: An insulation stop must be used for conductor cross-sections
Max. external diameter of the cable insulation: 3.6 mm. ≤1 mm 2, see Accessories, page 2/81.

2/188 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Siemens IC 10 · 2012 5/7
SIRIUS
Contactor Relays
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies

Control Relays
SIRIUS 3RH2 contactor relays,
3RH2 control relays — size S00
4- and 8-pole

Contactor relays Type 3RH2.


Size S00
Control circuits
Coil operating range
• AC operation At 50 Hz 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us
At 60 Hz 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us
• DC operation At +50 °C 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us

2
At +60 °C 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us
Power consumption of the solenoid coils

Assemblies
Contactors and
(when coil is cold and 1.0 x Us)
• AC operation, 50 Hz
- Closing VA/p.f. 37/0.8
- Closed VA/p.f. 5.7/0.25
• AC operation, 60 Hz
- Closing VA/p.f. 33/0.75
- Closed VA/p.f. 4.4/0.25
• DC operation W 4.0
(closing = closed)
5

Permissible residual current of the electronics


(with 0 signal)
• For AC operation1) < 4 mA x (230 V/Us)
• For DC operation < 10 mA x (24 V/Us)
Operating times2)
Total break time = OFF-delay + Arcing time
Values apply with coil in cold state and at operating temperature for
operating range
AC operation
• Closing
- ON-delay of NO contact With 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us ms 8 ... 33
With 1.0 x Us ms 9 ... 22
3RH24 minimum operating time ms ≥ 35
- OFF-delay of NC contact With 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us ms 6 ... 25
With 1.0 x Us ms 6.5 ... 19
• Opening
- OFF-delay of NO contact With 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us ms 4 ... 15
With 1.0 x Us ms 4.5 ... 15
3RH24 minimum operating time ms ≥ 30
- ON-delay of NC contact With 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us ms 5 ... 15
With 1.0 x Us ms 5 ... 15
DC operation
• Closing
- ON-delay of NO contact With 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us ms 30 ... 100
With 1.0 x Us ms 35 ... 50
3RH24 minimum operating time ms ≥ 100
- OFF-delay of NC contact With 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us ms 25 ... 90
With 1.0 x Us ms 30 ... 45
• Opening
- OFF-delay of NO contact With 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us ms 7 ... 13
With 1.0 x Us ms 7 ... 12
3RH24 minimum operating time ms ≥ 30
- ON-delay of NC contact With 0.8 ... 1.1 x Us ms 13 ... 19
With 1.0 x Us ms 13 ... 18
• Arcing time ms 10 ... 15
Dependence of the switching frequency z'
on the operational current I' and operational voltage U':
z' = z ⋅ Ie/I' ⋅ (Ue/U')1.5 ⋅ 1/h
1) The 3RT29 16-1GA00 additional load module is recommended
for higher residual currents (see page 2/76).
2) The OFF-delay of the NO contact and the ON-delay of the NC contact are
increased if the contactor coils are attenuated against voltage peaks
(noise suppression diode 6 to 10 times;
diode assembly 2 to 6 times, varistor +2 to 5 ms).

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/189


5/8 Siemens IC 10 · 2012
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies
Contactor RelaysSIRIUS
Coupling Relays
3RH2 control relays — size S00
SIRIUS 3RH2 contactor relays,
4- and 8-pole

Contactor relays Type 3RH2.


Size S00
Load side
AC capacity
Rated operational currents Ie
AC-12 A 10
2

AC-15/AC-14 for rated operational voltage Us


Up to 230 V A 6
400 V A 3
Contactors and
Assemblies

500 V A 2
690 V A 1
Load rating with DC
Rated operational currents Ie
DC-12 for rated operational voltage Us
• 1 conducting path 24 V A 6
60 V A 6
110 V A 3
220 V A 1

5
440 V A 0.3
600 V A 0.15
• 2 conducting paths in series 24 V A 10
60 V A 10
110 V A 4
220 V A 2
440 V A 1.3
600 V A 0.65
• 3 conducting paths in series 24 V A 10
60 V A 10
110 V A 10
220 V A 3.6
440 V A 2.5
600 V A 1.8
DC-13 for rated operational voltage Us
• 1 conducting path 24 V A 6
60 V A 2
110 V A 1
220 V A 0.3
440 V A 0.14
600 V A 0.1
• 2 conducting paths in series 24 V A 10
60 V A 3.5
110 V A 1.3
220 V A 0.9
440 V A 0.2
600 V A 0.1
• 3 conducting paths in series 24 V A 10
60 V A 4.7
110 V A 3
220 V A 1.2
440 V A 0.5
600 V A 0.26
Switching frequency
Switching frequency z in operating cycles/hour
• For rated operation AC-12/DC-12 h-1 1 000
For utilization category AC-15/AC-14 h-1 1 000
DC-13 h-1 1 000
• No-load switching frequency h-1 10 000
Dependence of the switching frequency z' on
the operational current I' and operational voltage U':
z' = z ⋅ Ie/I' ⋅ (Ue/U')1.5 ⋅ 1/h
s and u rated data
Basic units and auxiliary switch blocks
• Rated control supply voltage V AC max. 600
• Rated voltage V AC 600
• Switching capacity A 600, Q 600
• Uninterrupted current at 240 V AC A 10

2/190 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Siemens IC 10 · 2012 5/9
SIRIUS
Contactor Relays
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies
CouplingRelays
Control Relays
SIRIUS 3RH21 coupling relays
SIRIUS 3RH21 coupling relays for switching auxiliary circuits, 4-pole
for switching auxiliary circuits, 4-pole

Technical specifications
All technical specifications not mentioned in the table below are
identical to those of the 3RH21 contactor relays (see page 5/6).
Contactor type 3RH21 . . - . HB40 3RH21 . . - . JB40 3RH21 . . - . KB40
Size S00 S00 S00
Control circuits

2
Coil operating range 0.7 ... 1.85 x Us
Power consumption of the solenoid coil

Assemblies
Contactors and
(for cold coil)
Closing = Closed
• At Us = 17 V W 1.4
• At Us = 24 V W 2.8
• At Us = 30 V W 4.4
Permissible residual current < 10 mA x (24 V/Us)
of the electronics for 0 signal
Overvoltage configuration of the solenoid coil No overvoltage damping With diode With suppressor diode
5

Operating times
• Closing at 17 V
- ON-delay NO ms 40 ... 130
- OFF-delay NC ms 30 ... 80
• At 24 V
- ON-delay NO ms 35 ... 60
- OFF-delay NC ms 25 ... 40
• At 30 V
- ON-delay NO ms 25 ... 50
- OFF-delay NC ms 15 ... 30
• Opening at 17 ... 30 V
- OFF-delay NO ms 7 ... 20 38 ... 65 7 ... 20
- ON-delay NC ms 20 ... 30 55 ... 75 20 ... 30
Upright mounting position Request required

Contactor type 3RH21 . . - . MB40-0KT0 3RH21 . . - . VB40 3RH21 . . - . WB40


Size S00 S00 S00
Control circuits
Coil operating range 0.85 ... 1.85 x Us
Power consumption of the solenoid coil W 1.6
(for cold coil)
Closing = Closed at Us = 24 V
Permissible residual current < 8 mA x (24 V/Us)
of the electronics for 0 signal
Overvoltage configuration of the solenoid coil Diode, varistor or RC element, Built-in diode Built-in suppressor diode
attachable

Control circuits
Operating times
• Closing at 20.5 V
- ON-delay NO ms 30 ... 120
- OFF-delay NC ms 20 ... 110
• At 24 V
- ON-delay NO ms 25 ... 90
- OFF-delay NC ms 15 ... 80
• At 44 V
- ON-delay NO ms 15 ... 60
- OFF-delay NC ms 10 ... 50
• Closing at 17 ... 30 V
- OFF-delay NO ms 5 ... 20 20 ... 80 5 ... 20
- ON-delay NC ms 10 ... 30 30 ... 90 10 ... 30
Upright mounting position Request required

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/191


5/32 Siemens IC 10 · 2012
Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3RT Contactors
3RT2 and 3RH2 contactors and relays

Terminal designations and identification numbers for auxiliary contacts


Terminal designations Identification numbers
The terminal designations are 2-digit, e.g. 13, 14, 21, 22: The identification number indicates the number and type of the
• Tens digit: Sequence digit auxiliary contacts, e.g. 40, 31, 22, 13:
- Related terminals have the same sequence digit • 1st digit: number of normally open contacts (NO)
• 2nd digit: number of normally closed contacts (NC)
• Units digit: Function digit
2

- 1-2 for normally closed contacts (NC) Examples:


- 3-4 for normally open contacts (NO) • 31 = 3 NO + 1 NC
Contactors and
Assemblies

• 40 = 4 NO

Selection guide for mountable auxiliary switch blocks for power contactors and contactor relays
The auxiliary switch blocks of the 3RH29 series for mounting on Where the columns and lines intersect (blue and green in the
the front and side can be used for power contactors as well as example) you will find the identification number for the combina-
for contactor relays. tion of basic unit (column) and auxiliary switch block (line).
The possible combinations of basic unit and mounted auxiliary
switch block can be found in the tables below.

3-pole contactors Example 1 Example 2


Auxiliary Version 3RT20 1 3RT20 1 3RT20 2 Type 3RT20 motor contactor, 3RT20 motor contactor,
contacts S00 S00 S0 S00 with 1 NO S0 with 1 NO + 1 NC
NO NC 10 01 11
1 3 5
13 21 13 21
NSB0_00534a
IC01_00123
IC01_00122

SIRIUS
3. 4. 5. 6.
13 21 A1
14 22 14 22 SIRIUS
1 3 5 13 A1
2. 3. 4. 5.
2. 3. 4. 5. 5. 6. 7. 8. 3. 4. 5. 6.
According to EN 500121) Order No.
Auxiliary switches without NO contact 3. 4. 5. 6.
-- 1 .1 11 02 12 3RH29 11-.HA01 14 22 A2
NSB0_02124

NSB0_02112

NSB0_02114
2. 3. 4. 5.
2 4 6
2 4 6 14 A2
.2
Sequence 2. 3. 4. 5. 3. 4. 5. 6.
-- 2 .1 .1 12 03 13 3RH29 11-.HA02 digit
NSB0_02125

Type Auxiliary switch with 4 NC, Auxiliary switch with 3 NC,


3RH29 11-.FA04 3RH29 11-.HA03
.2 .2
.1 .1 .1 .1 .1 .1 .1

-- 3 .1 .1 .1 13 04 14 3RH29 11-.HA03
NSB0_02126

NSB0_02116

IC01_00131

.2 .2 .2
.2 .2 .2 .2 .2 .2 .2

-- 4 .1 .1 .1 .1 14 -- 3RH29 11-.FA04 Function .1 .1 .1 .1 .1 .1 .1


NSB0_02142

digit .2 .2 .2 .2 .2 .2 .2
Type 3RT20 motor contactor, S00 3RT20 motor contactor, S0
.2 .2 .2 .2 with auxiliary switch block with auxiliary switch block

Auxiliary switch with 1 NO contact


1 -- .3 20 11 21 3RH29 11-.HA10 3. 4. 5. 6.
SIRIUS
NSB0_02127

13 21 A1
SIRIUS
13 A1
4. 5. .1 .1 .1
2. 3.
.4
.1 .1 .1 .1

1 1 .1 .3 21 12 22 3RH29 11-.HA11
NSB0_02128

.2 .2 .2
14 22 A2
NSB0_02120

.2 .2 .2 .2
IC01_00132

.2 .4 14 A2

Terminal 13 21 31 41 51 13 21 31 41 51
design. 14 22 32 42 52 14 22 32 42 52
1) Combinations according to EN 50012, EN 50011 and IEC 60947-5-1
are in bold print. All combinations comply with EN 50005. Type Ident. No. 14 Ident. No. 14

2/192 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3RT Contactors
3RT2 and 3RH2 contactors and relays

Additional auxiliary switch blocks

2
3-pole contactors 4-pole contactors Contactor relays

Assemblies
Contactors and
Auxiliary contacts S00 S0 S00 S0/S2 S00
Version 3RT20 1 3RT20 1 3RT20 2 3RT23 1 3RT25 1 3RT23 3RT25 3RH21, 3RH24 3RH21, 3RH24 3RH21, 3RH24
NO NC 10 01 11 -- -- 11 11 40E 31E 22E
13 21 13 21 13 21 13 21 13 23 33 43 13 21 33 43 13 21 31 43
NSB0_00534a

NSB0_00534a

NSB0_00534a

IC01_00124

IC01_00125

IC01_00126
IC01_00123
IC01_00122

14 22 14 22 14 22 14 22 14 24 34 44 14 22 34 44 14 22 32 44

2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 3. 4. 5. 1. 2. 3. 1. 2. 3. 3. 4. 5. 3. 4. 5. 5. 6. 7. 8 5. 6. 7. 8 5. 6. 7. 8
5. 8. 6. 4. 4. 6. 6.
Front auxiliary switches According to EN 500121) According to EN 500121) According to EN 500111) Order No.
Without NO contact
-- 1 .1 11 02 12 01 01 12 12 41X 32X 23X 3RH29 11-.HA01
NSB0_02124

.2

-- 2 .1 .1 12 03 13 02 02 13 -- 42E 33X 24 3RH29 11-.HA02


NSB0_02125

.2 .2

-- 3 .1 .1 .1 13 04 14 03 -- -- -- 43 34 -- 3RH29 11-.HA03
NSB0_02126

.2 .2 .2

-- 4 .1 .1 .1 .1 14 -- -- -- -- -- -- 44E -- -- 3RH29 11-.FA04


NSB0_02142

.2 .2 .2 .2

With 1 NO contact
1 -- .3 20 11 21 10 10 21 21 50E 41E 32E 3RH29 11-.HA10
NSB0_02127

.4

1 1 .1 .3 21 12 22 11 11 22 22 51X 42X 33X 3RH29 11-.HA11


NSB0_02128

.2 .4

1 2 .1 .1 .3 22 13 23 12 12 23 -- 52 43 34 3RH29 11-.HA12
NSB0_02129

.2 .2 .4

1 3 .1 .1 .1 .3 23 14 24 13 -- -- -- 53X 44X -- 3RH29 11-.HA13


NSB0_02130

.2 .2 .2 .4

With 2 NO contacts
2 -- .3 .3 30 21 31 20 20 31 31 60E 51X 42X 3RH29 11-.HA20
NSB0_02131

.4 .4

2 1 .1 .3 .3 31 22 32 21 21 32 32 61 52 43 3RH29 11-.HA21
NSB0_02132

.2 .4 .4

2 2 .1 .1 .3 .3 32 23 33 22 22 33 -- 62X 53 44X 3RH29 11-.HA22


NSB0_02133

.2 .2 .4 .4

2 2 .3 .1 .1 .3 32 23 33 22 22 33 -- 62X 53 44X 3RH29 11-.FA22


NSB0_02221

.4 .2 .2 .4

1) Combinations according to EN 50012, EN 50011 and IEC 60947-5-1


are in bold print. All combinations comply with EN 50005.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/193


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3RT Contactors
3RT2 and 3RH2 contactors and relays

Additional auxillary switch blocks

3-pole contactors 4-pole contactors Contactor relays


Auxiliary contacts S00 S0 S00 S0/S2 S00
Version 3RT20 1 3RT20 1 3RT20 2 3RT23 1 3RT25 1 3RT23 3RT25 3RH21, 3RH24
NO NC 10 01 11 -- -- 11 11 40E 31E 22E
13 21 13 21 13 21 13 21 13 23 33 43 13 21 33 43 13 21 31 43

NSB0_00534a

NSB0_00534a

NSB0_00534a
2

IC01_00124

IC01_00125

IC01_00126
IC01_00123
IC01_00122

14 22 14 22 14 22 14 22 14 24 34 44 14 22 34 44 14 22 32 44
Contactors and
Assemblies

2. 3. 4. 5. 5. 6. 7. 8. 3. 4. 5. 6. 1. 2. 3. 4. 1. 2. 3. 4. 3. 4. 5. 6. 3. 4. 5. 6. 5. 6. 7. 8 5. 6. 7. 8 5. 6. 7. 8
According to EN 500121) According to EN 500121) According to EN 500111) Order No.
Front auxiliary switches with 3 NO contacts
3 -- .3 .3 .3 40 31 41 30 30 41 41 70 61 52 3RH29 11-.HA30
NSB0_02134

.4 .4 .4

3 1 .1 .3 .3 .3 41 32 42 31 31 42 42 71X 62X 53X 3RH29 11-.HA31


NSB0_02135

.2 .4 .4 .4

Front auxiliary switches with 4 NO contacts


4 -- .3 .3 .3 .3 50 41 51 40 40 51 51 80E 71X 62X 3RH29 11-.FA40
NSB0_02143

.4 .4 .4 .4

Acc. to EN 50005 Acc. to EN 50005 Acc. to EN 50005


Front auxiliary switches with make-before-break
-- 1 .7 .5 21 12 22 11 11 22 22 51 42 33 3RH29 11-.FB11
NSB0_02144

.8 .6

-- 2 .3 .1 .5 .7 32 23 33 22 22 33 -- 62 53 44 3RH29 11-.FB22
NSB0_02145

.4 .2 .6 .8

-- 3 .7 .7 .5 .5 32 23 33 22 22 33 -- 62 53 44 3RH29 11-.FC22
NSB0_02146

.8 .8 .6 .6

Front auxiliary switches with complete inscription2)


1 -- 73 20 11 21 10 10 21 21 50 41 32 3RH29 11-1AA10
IC01_00127

74

1 -- 73 20 11 21 10 10 21 21 50 41 32 3RH29 11-1BA10
IC01_00127

74

-- 1 71 11 02 12 01 01 12 12 41 32 23 3RH29 11-1AA01
IC01_00128

72

-- 1 71 11 02 12 01 01 12 12 41 32 23 3RH29 11-1BA01
IC01_00128

72

1 1 73 81 21 12 22 11 11 22 22 51 42 33 3RH29 11-1LA11
NSB0_02150

74 82

1 1 73 81 21 12 22 11 11 22 22 51 42 33 3RH29 11-1MA11
NSB0_02150

74 82

2 -- 73 83 30 21 31 20 20 31 31 60 51 42 3RH29 11-1LA20
NSB0_02151

74 84

2 -- 73 83 30 21 31 20 20 31 31 60 51 42 3RH29 11-1MA20
NSB0_02151

74 84

1) Combinations according to EN 50012, EN 50011 and IEC 60947- 2) Terminals from the top or bottom.
5-1 are in bold print. All combinations comply with EN 50005.

2/194 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3RT Contactors
3RT2 and 3RH2 contactors and relays

Additional auxillary switch blocks

3-pole contactors 4-pole contactors Contactor relays


Auxiliary contacts S00 S0 S00 S0/S2 S00
Version 3RT20 1 3RT20 1 3RT20 2 3RT23 1 3RT25 1 3RT23 3RT25 3RH21, 3RH24
NO NC 10 01 11 -- -- 11 11 40E 31E 22E

2
13 21 13 21 13 21 13 21 13 23 33 43 13 21 33 43 13 21 31 43

NSB0_00534a

NSB0_00534a

NSB0_00534a

IC01_00124

IC01_00125

IC01_00126
IC01_00123
IC01_00122

14 22 14 22 14 22 14 22 14 24 34 44 14 22 34 44 14 22 32 44

Assemblies
Contactors and
2. 3. 4. 5. 5. 6. 7. 8. 3. 4. 5. 6. 1. 2. 3. 4. 1. 2. 3. 4. 3. 4. 5. 6. 3. 4. 5. 6. 5. 6. 7. 8 5. 6. 7. 8 5. 6. 7. 8
Acc. to EN 50005 Acc. to EN 50005 According to EN 500111) Order No.
Front auxiliary switches with complete inscription (for contactor relays)
4 -- 53 63 73 83 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- 80E -- -- 3RH29 11-.GA40
NSB0_02156

54 64 74 84

3 1 53 61 73 83 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- 71E -- -- 3RH29 11-.GA31


NSB0_02155a

54 62 74 84

2 2 53 61 71 83 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- 62E -- -- 3RH29 11-.GA22


NSB0_02154a

54 62 72 84

1 3 53 61 71 81 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- 53E -- -- 3RH29 11-.GA13


NSB0_02153a

54 62 72 82

-- 4 51 61 71 81 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- 44E -- -- 3RH29 11-.GA04


NSB0_02152a

52 62 72 82

Front auxiliary switches with complete inscription, special version


4 -- 53 63 73 83 50 41 51 40 40 51 51 80E 71X 62X 3RH29 11-.XA40
ic01_00147

-0MA0

54 64 74 84

3 1 53 61 73 83 41 32 42 31 31 42 42 71E 62X 53 3RH29 11-.XA31


ic01_00146

-0MA0

54 62 74 84

2 2 53 61 71 83 32 23 33 22 22 33 -- 62E 53 44X 3RH29 11-.XA22


ic01_00145

-0MA0

54 62 72 84

-- 4 51 61 71 81 14 -- -- -- -- -- -- 44E -- -- 3RH29 11-.XA04


ic01_00143

-0MA0

52 62 72 82

Front auxiliary switches, Solid-state compatible


-- 2 .1 .1 12 03 13 02 02 13 -- 42 33 24 3RH29 11-.NF02
IC01_00133

.2 .2

1 1 .3 .1 21 12 22 11 11 22 22 51 42 33 3RH29 11-.NF11
NSB0_02147

.4 .2

2 -- .3 .3 30 21 31 20 20 31 31 60 51 42 3RH29 11-.NF20
IC01_00134

.4 .4

1) Combinations according to EN 50012, EN 50011 and IEC 60947-5-1


are in bold print. All combinations comply with EN 50005.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/195


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3RT Contactors
3RT2 and 3RH2 contactors and relays

Additional auxillary switch blocks


3-pole contactors 4-pole contactors Contactor relays
Auxiliary contacts S00 S0 S00 S0/S2 S00
Version 3RT20 1 3RT20 1 3RT20 2 3RT23 1 3RT25 1 3RT23 3RT25 3RH21, 3RH24
NO NC 10 01 11 -- -- 11 11 40E 31E 22E
13 21 13 21 13 21 13 21 13 23 33 43 13 21 33 43 13 21 31 43

NSB0_00534a

NSB0_00534a

NSB0_00534a

IC01_00124

IC01_00125

IC01_00126
IC01_00123
IC01_00122
2

14 22 14 22 14 22 14 22 14 24 34 44 14 22 34 44 14 22 32 44
Contactors and
Assemblies

2. 3. 4. 5. 5. 6. 7. 8. 3. 4. 5. 6. 1. 2. 3. 4. 1. 2. 3. 4. 3. 4. 5. 6. 3. 4. 5. 6. 5. 6. 7. 8 5. 6. 7. 8 5. 6. 7. 8
Left Right According to EN 500121) According to EN 500121) According to EN 500111) Order No.
Lateral auxiliary switches for size S00
-- 2 41 51 21 31 12 -- -- 02 02 -- -- -- -- -- 3RH29 11-.DA02
NSB0_02136

42 52 22 32
Anbau Anbau
-- 2 41 51
links 21 31
rechts 14 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- 3RH29 11-.DA02
NSB0_02136

42 52 22 32
Anbau Anbau
1 1 41 53
links 21 33
rechts 21 -- -- 11 11 -- -- -- -- -- 3RH29 11-.DA11
NSB0_02137

42 54 22 34

1 1 Anbau
41 53 Anbau
21 33 32 -- -- 22 22 -- -- -- -- -- 3RH29 11-.DA11
NSB0_02137

links rechts

42 54 22 34

2 -- Anbau
43 53 Anbau
23 33 30 -- -- 20 20 -- -- -- -- -- 3RH29 11-.DA20
NSB0_02138

links rechts

44 54 24 34

2 -- Anbau
43
4353
53 Anbau
23
233333 50 -- -- 40 40 -- -- -- -- -- 3RH29 11-.DA20
NSB0_02138
NSB0_02138

links rechts

44
44 54
54 24
24 34
34

2 -- Anbau
Anbau
41435353 Anbau
Anbau
21
233333 41 -- -- 31 31 -- -- -- -- -- 3RH29 11-.DA20 +
NSB0_02137
NSB0_02138

links
links rechts
rechts
3RH29 11-.DA11
1 1 4244 5454 2224 3434
Anbau Anbau
Anbau
2 -- 4143 51
53 2123 31
33 32 -- -- 22 22 -- -- -- -- -- 3RH29 11-.DA20 +
NSB0_02136
NSB0_02138

links rechts
rechts
3RH29 11-.DA02
-- 2 4244 5254 2224 3234
Anbau Anbau
Anbau
1 1 41 53
51 21 31
33 23 -- -- 13 -- -- -- -- -- -- 3RH29 11-.DA11 +
NSB0_02136
NSB0_02137

links rechts
rechts
3RH29 11-.DA02
-- 2 42 52
54 22 32
34
Anbau Anbau
Lateral auxiliary
links
switches for size S0
rechts
-- 2 51 61 31 41 12 03 13 02 02 13 -- -- -- -- 3RH29 21-.DA02
NSB0_02139

52 62 32 42
Anbau Anbau
-- 2 51
51 61
61 31
31 41
41 14 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- 3RH29 21-.DA02
NSB0_02139
NSB0_02139

links rechts

52
52 62
62 32
32 42
42
Anbau
Anbau Anbau
Anbau
1 1 51 63 31 43 21 12 22 11 11 22 22 -- -- -- 3RH29 21-.DA11
NSB0_02140

links
links rechts
rechts

52 64 32 44

1 1 Anbau
51 63 Anbau
31 43 32 23 33 22 22 33 -- -- -- -- 3RH29 21-.DA11
NSB0_02140

links rechts

52 64 32 44
Anbau Anbau 3RH29 21-.DA20
2 -- 53 63 33 43 30 21 31 20 20 31 31 -- -- --
NSB0_02141

links rechts

54 64 34 44
Anbau Anbau 3RH29 21-.DA20
2 -- 53
53 63
63 33
33 43
43 50 41 51 40 40 51 51 -- -- --
NSB0_02141
NSB0_02141

links rechts

54
54 64
64 34
34 44
44
Anbau
Anbau Anbau
Anbau
1) Combinations
links according
links rechtsto EN 50012, EN 50011 and IEC 60947-
rechts
5-1 are in bold print. All combinations comply with EN 50005.

2/196 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3RT Contactors
3RT2 and 3RH2 contactors and relays

Additional auxillary switch blocks

3-pole contactors 4-pole contactors Contactor relays


Auxiliary contacts S00 S0 S00 S0/S2 S00
Version 3RT20 1 3RT20 1 3RT20 2 3RT23 1 3RT25 1 3RT23 3RT25 3RH21, 3RH24
NO NC 10 01 11 -- -- 11 11 40E 31E 22E
13 21 13 21 13 21 13 21 13 23 33 43 13 21 33 43 13 21 31 43

NSB0_00534a

NSB0_00534a
NSB0_00534a

2
IC01_00126
IC01_00125
IC01_00124
IC01_00122

IC01_00123
14 22 14 22 14 22 14 22 14 24 34 44 14 22 34 44 14 22 32 44

Assemblies
Contactors and
2. 3. 4. 5. 5. 6. 7. 8. 3. 4. 5. 6. 1. 2. 3. 4. 1. 2. 3. 4. 3. 4. 5. 6. 3. 4. 5. 6. 5. 6. 7. 8 5. 6. 7. 8 5. 6. 7. 8
Left Right According to EN 500121) According to EN 500121) According to EN 500111) Order No.
Lateral auxiliary switches for size S0, S00
2 -- 51 53
63 63 43 4341
31 33 32 42 31 31 42 42 -- -- -- 3RH29 21-.DA20 +
NSB0_02140
NSB0_02141

3RH29 21-.DA11
1 1
52 54
64 64 32 34
44 44

2 -- Anbau
Anbau
51 5361 63
Anbau
Anbau
31 3341 4332 23 33 22 22 33 -- -- -- -- 3RH29 21-.DA20 +
NSB0_02139
NSB0_02141

links
links rechts
rechts
3RH29 21-.DA02
-- 2
52 5462 64 32 3442 44

1 1 Anbau
Anbau Anbau
Anbau23 14 24 13 -- -- -- -- -- -- 3RH29 21-.DA11 +
5151 6163 313341
41
NSB0_02139
NSB0_02140

links
links rechts
rechts
3RH29 21-.DA02
-- 2
5252 6264 323442
42

LateralAnbau
Anbau
auxiliary
links
links
Anbau
Anbau
switches
rechts
rechts
for contactor relays
-- 2 51 61 31 41 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- 42Z 33X 24 3RH29 21-.DA02
NSB0_02139

52 62 32 42

1 1 Anbau Anbau -- -- -- -- -- -- -- 51X 42X 33X 3RH29 21-.DA11


51 63 31 43
NSB0_02140

links rechts

52 64 32 44

2 -- Anbau Anbau -- -- -- -- -- -- -- 60Z 51X 42X 3RH29 21-.DA20


53 63 33 43
NSB0_02141

links rechts

54 64 34 44
Anbau
Lateral auxiliary Anbau
switches, Solid-state compatible for size S00
links rechts
1 1 41 53 23 31 21 -- -- 11 11 -- -- -- -- -- 3RH29 11-2DE11
NSB0_02137

42 54 24 32

1 1 Anbau Anbau 32 -- -- 22 22 -- -- -- -- -- 3RH29 11-2DE11


41415353 2323 3131
NSB0_02137
NSB0_02137

links rechts

4242 5454 24243232


Anbau
Anbau Anbau
Anbau
Laterallinks
auxiliary
links switches, Solid-state compatible for size S0, S00
rechts
rechts
1 1 51 63 33 41 21 12 22 11 11 22 22 -- -- -- 3RH29 21-2DE11
NSB0_02140

52 64 34 42

1 1 Anbau Anbau 32 23 33 22 22 33 -- -- -- -- 3RH29 21-2DE11


5151 6363 33334141
NSB0_02140
NSB0_02140

links rechts

5252 6464 34344242

LateralAnbau
Anbau
auxiliary
links
links
Anbau
Anbau
switches,
rechts
rechts
Solid-state compatible for contactor relays
1 1 51 63 33 41 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- 51X 42X 33X 3RH29 21-.DE11
NSB0_02140

52 64 34 42
Anbau
1) Combinations Anbau
links according
rechts to EN 50012, EN 50011 and IEC 60947-
5-1 are in bold print. All combinations comply with EN 50005.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/197


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3RT Contactors
3RT1 contactors and accessories

Internal circuit diagrams (applicable to screw, spring and ring lug connection)
Sizes S3 to S12 Contactors with 4 main contacts, sizes S3
Terminal designations according to EN 50 012 Terminal designations acc. to EN 50 005
3RT10 4 to 3RT10 7, 3RT12, 3RT14 contactors 3RT13/23 and 3RT15/25 contactors
4 NO 2 NO + 2 NC
-Q A1 1/L1 3/L2 5/L3 13 21
NO NC
2

NO NC
Contactors and
Assemblies

2/T1 4/T2 6/T3 14 22 (3RH19 21 auxiliary switch blocks acc. to EN 50 005 can be snapped on)

3RT10 4 to 3RT10 7, 3RT14 contactors


With 3RH19 21- . HA22 4-pole auxiliary contact block, mountable on the front
2 NO + 2 NC 3RT26 capacitor contactors
Ident. no. 22E Size S00 Sizes S0 and S2
L1 L2 L3 L1 L2 L3

F0 F0

3RT1. 5, 3RT1. 6, 3RT1. 7 contactors (sizes S6, S10, S12)


With 3RH19 21-1DA11 2-pole auxiliary switch blocks, laterally mountable
2 NO + 2 NC 51 61 51 63

1/L1

5/L3
3/L2

1/L1

5/L3
3/L2
A1 A1

A2

2/T1
4/T2
6/T3
A2

2/T1
4/T2
6/T3
52 62 52 64

3RH19 21- . HA../-.XA..4-pole auxiliary switch blocks,


for snapping onto the front 2)
3 NO + 1 NC 2 NO + 2 NC 2 NO + 2 NC 1 NO + 3 NC

IC01_00374

IC01_00375
Ident. no. 31 22 22 13
C1 C1

3RH19 21- . DA11, 3RH19 21-2DE11 first laterally mountable auxiliary


switch block (solid-state compatible)
1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC
left right

3RH19 21- . JA11, 3RH19 21-2JE11 second laterally mountable auxiliary


switch block (solid-state compatible)
(only for sizes S3 to S12)
1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC
left right

Surge suppressor (plug-in direction coded; exception: marked +/– for 3RT19 16-1T... diode assembly) for sizes S2 to S3

Diode Diode assembly Varistor RC element Diode with LED Varistor with LED

1) 3RH29 auxiliaries are intended to be used only with 3RT2 or 3RH2 base devices.
3RH19 auxiliaries are intended to be used only with 3RT1 or 3RH1 base devices.
2) Not for 3RT12. vacuum contactors

2/198 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3RT1 Contactors
3RT1 contactors and accessories

Internal circuit diagrams (applicable to screw connection and Spring-type terminal connection)
Accessories for size S61) to S12 contactors
Terminal designations acc. to EN 50 005
3RH19 21-.F..., 4-pole,
for snapping onto the front 1)
4 NO 3 NO + 1 NC 2 NO + 2 NC 4 NC 2 NO + 2 NC
Ident. no. 40 31 22 04 22 U

2
Assemblies
Contactors and
make-before-break

3RH19 21- . CA.. auxiliary switch blocks, single-pole, 3RH19 21-1CD.. auxiliary switch blocks, single-pole,
for snapping onto the front 2) with make-before-break contacts, for snapping onto the front 1)
1 NO 1 NC 1 NO 1 NC

(terminal designations according to EN 50 005 or


EN 50 012)

Accessories for size S0 to S12 contactors


Terminal designations acc. to EN 50 005
3RH19 21-1LA.. and 3RH19 21-1MA.. auxiliary switch block, 2-pole, Internal wiring
for snapping onto the front 1)
cable entry from above or below
2 NO 1 NO + 1 NC 2 NC

Example: 1 NO + 1 NC,
cable entry from below

3RH19 21- . FE22 solid-state compatible auxiliary switch block, 4-pole,


for snapping onto the front 1)
2 NO + 2 NC
Ident. no. 22

3RH19 21- . EA.. first laterally mountable auxiliary switch blocks (left) 3RH19 21- . EA.. first laterally mountable auxiliary switch blocks (right)
2 NO 1 NO + 1 NC 2 NC 2 NO 1 NO + 1 NC 2 NC

3RH19 21- . KA.. second laterally mountable auxiliary switch blocks (left) 3RH19 21- . KA.. second laterally mountable auxiliary switch blocks (right)
(only for sizes S3 to S12) (only for sizes S3 to S12)
2 NO 1 NO + 1 NC 2 NC 2 NO 1 NO + 1 NC 2 NC

1) RH29 auxiliaries are intended to be used only with 3RT2 or 3RH2 base devices.
3RH19 auxiliaries are intended to be used only with 3RT1 or 3RH1 base devices.
2) Not for 3RT12. vacuum contactors

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/199


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3RT Contactors and 3RH2 Control Relays
Accessories for size S00 to S3

Circuit diagrams
Accessories for size S3 contactors and control relays
Solid-state time-delay blocks
(see configuring aid on page 2/38)
3RT19 16-2C... 3RT19 16-2D... Sizes S2 to S12
ON-delay OFF-delay (with auxiliary voltage) 3RT19 16-2E.../2F.../2G... solid-state, time-delay auxiliary switch blocks
Size S00 Size S00
1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 2 NO
2

ON-delay OFF-delay WYE-delta function


Contactors and
Assemblies

(Integrated varistors not shown)

3RT19 26-2C... 3RT19 26-2D...


ON-delay OFF-delay (with auxiliary voltage)
Sizes S0 to S3 Sizes S0 to S3

A2 can only be connected


to N(L–) via the time-delay
relay.
x don’t connect

Time-delay block
Contactor
A2 can be connected to
N(L–) via either the contac-
tor or the time-delay relay.
- - - optional connection

Designation Circuit diagram Designation Circuit diagram


3RA2811-.CW10 3RA2814-.AW10 L1(+)
ON-delay OFF-delay, S1
1 CO contact A1 = B1 A3
15
Q
16 18
A2
N(-) 
3RA2812-.DW10 3RA2814-.FW10 L1(+)
OFF-delay with OFF-delay with S1
auxillary voltage auxillary voltage, A1 = B1 A3
1 NC contact/ 27 35
1 CO contact Q
28 36
A2
N(-)

3RA2813-.AW10 L1(+) 3RA2815-.AW10 L1(+)


ON-delay, S1 OFF-delay without S1
1 CO contact A1 auxillary voltage, A1
15 1 CO contact 15

Q Q
16 18 16 18
A2 A2
N(-)  N(-) 
3RA2813-.FW10 L1(+) 3RA2815-.FW10 L1(+)
ON-delay, S1 OFF-delay without S1
1 NC contact/ A1 auxillary voltage, A1
1 NO contact 27 35 1 NC contact/ 27 35
1 NO contact
Q Q
28 36 28 36
A2 A2
N(-) N(-) 
3RT29 accessories are intended to be used only with 3RT2 or 3RH2 base devices.
3RT19 auxiliaries are intended to be used only with 3RT1 or 3RH1 base devices.

2/200 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3RA Contactor Assemblies
3RA23 contactor assemblies for reversing

Circuit diagrams

Size S00 to S0 Control circuit (sizes S00 and S0)


Main circuit (terminal designations of contactors according to EN 50 012)
for momentary-contact operation for maintained-contact operation

2
Assemblies
Contactors and
The 3RA2913-2AA. (S00) and 3RA2913-2AA (S0)
installation kit contains wiring connectors for
connecting the main conducting paths, the
mechanical interlock and two connecting clips
for the contactors.

Sizes S2 to S3 Control circuit


Main circuit (terminal designations of contactors according to EN 50 005)
for momentary-contact operation for maintained-contact operation

The 3RA19 .3-2A installation kits contain, among The 3RA19 24-2B mechanical interlock contains one NC
other things, the wiring connectors on the top and contact for the NC contact interlock for each contactor
bottom for connecting the main conducting paths.

Position of terminals
Sizes S2 to S3
Terminal designations according to EN 50 005
3RA19 24-2B mechanical interlock (laterally mountable),
integrated in reversing contactor assemblies (reversing starters),
contains one NC contact for the electrical interlock for each contactor
2 NC
S0 "OFF" button
S1 "Clockwise ON" button
S2 "Counterclockwise ON" button
S "CW-OFF-CCW" button
K1 Clockwise contactor
K2 Counterclockwise contactor
F1 Fuses for main circuit
F3 Fuses for control circuit
F2 Overload relay

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/201


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3RA Contactor Assemblies
Circuit Diagrams for WYE-delta switching

Circuit diagrams
Size S00 / S0 Control circuits
Main circuit with 3RA2816-0EW20 function module (set of three)
snapped onto the front
2 Assemblies
Contactors and

Sizes S2 to S3 3RA2816-0EW20
Main circuit

Sizes S2 and S3
s

Control circuits
with 3RP15 7. time-delay relay,
laterally mounted (typical circuits)
for momentary-contact operation for maintained-contact operation

S0 "OFF" button
S1 "ON" button
S Maintained-contact switch
K1 Line contactor
K2 Star contactor
K3 Delta contactor
K4 Solid-state, time-delay auxiliary switch
block or time-delay relay
F0 Fuses
F1 Overload relay

Contact element 17/18 is only closed on the star step; the contact element is open
on the delta step and when de-energized.

2/202 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3T Contactors
3TF68 and 3TF69 vacuum contactors

Internal circuit diagrams


3TF68 44 and 3TF69 44 contactors 3TF68 33 and 3TF69 33 contactors
4 NO + 4 NC 3 NO + 3 NC
AC operation DC operation
max. complement of auxiliary max. complement of auxiliary
switches switches

2
Assemblies
Contactors and
Auxiliary switch blocks Auxiliary switch blocks Auxiliary switch blocks Auxiliary switch blocks
3TY7 681-1G 3TY7 561-1AA00 3TY7 561-1KA00 3TY7 561-1EA00
for coil reconnection, first auxiliary switch block second auxiliary switch block with make-before-break contacts
3TF68 and 3TF69, left or right left or right
DC economy circuit mounted on left mounted on right mounted on left mounted on right mounted on left mounted on right

Auxiliary switch blocks


3TY7 561-1.
solid-state compatible aux. switch block
mounted on left mounted on right

Interface for control by PLC


3TX7 090-0D
with surge suppression

Circuit diagrams for DC economy circuit · maintained-contact operation


3TF68 33 and 3TF69 33 contactors

Terminal designations according to EN 50 012.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/203


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
Coupling Relays
3RH21 coupling for switcing auxillary circuits

Terminal diagrams
DC operation
L+ is to be connected to coil terminal A1.
3RH21 coupling relays for auxiliary circuits,
size S00
Terminal designations according to EN 50 011
(it is not possible to snap on an auxiliary switch block)
2

Surge suppressor can be mounted


4 NO 3 NO + 1 NC 2 NO + 2 NC
Contactors and
Assemblies

Ident no.: 40E 31E 22E

Suppressor Diode integrate


4 NO 3 NO + 1 NC 2 NO + 2 NC
Ident no.:40E 31E 22E
13 23 33 43 13 21 33 43 13 21 31 43
A1(+) A1(+) A1(+)

A2(–) A2(–) A2(–)


14 24 34 44 14 22 34 44 14 22 32 44

Diode integrated
4 NO 3 NO + 1 NC 2 NO + 2 NC
Ident no.:40E 31E 22E

Position of terminals
Size S00
3RH21 coupling relays
4 NO 3 NO + 1 NC 2 NO + 2 NC
Ident no.: 40E 31E 22E

3RH19 21- . DA11 first laterally 3RH19 21- . JA11 second laterally
mountable auxiliary switch mountable auxiliary switch
block 1) block 1)
mountable on left or right mountable on left or right
(only for sizes S3 to S12)
1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC
left right left right

1) Note the location digit.


Can only be used if no 4-pole auxiliary
switch block is snapped onto the front.

2/204 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3RH2 Control & Latching Relays
3RH2 Terminal Designations

Terminal designations according to EN 50 011


3RH21 control relays
4 NO 3 NO + 1 NC 2 NO + 2 NC
Ident no.:40E 31E 22E

2
Assemblies
Contactors and
3RH21 40 control relays
with 3RH19 11-1GA.. auxiliary switch blocks snapped onto the front

8 NO 7 NO + 1 NC 6 NO + 2 NC 5 NO + 3 NC
Ident no.:80E 71E 62E 53E

4 NO + 4 NC
Ident no.:44E

3RH24 latched control relays


4 NO 3 NO + 1 NC
Ident no.: 40E 31E

2 NO + 2 NC
Ident no.: 22E

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/205


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3RT Contactors and 3RH Control Relays
3RT2 contactors and accessories

Position of terminals (applicable to screw connection and Cage Clamp connection)


Size S00 Sizes S3 to S12
Terminal designations according to EN 50 012 Terminal designations according to EN 50 012
3RT20 1 contactors, 3RT20 1 coupling relays, 3RT 20 3, 3RT 20 3, 3RT 20 4
3RT20 4, 3RT124 46 contactor
s, contactors
1 NO 1 NC 3RH19 21- . HA22
Ident. no. 10E 01 4-pole auxiliary switch block
2

snapped onto the front


2 NO + 2 NC
Ident. no. 22 E
Contactors and
Assemblies

3RT20 1 contactors (with 1 NO)


with auxiliary switch blocks snapped onto the front
3RH19 11-. H . . .
1 NO + 1 NC 2 NO + 2 NC
Ident. no.: 11 22
3RT20 3, 3RT20 4 3RT20 3, 3RT20 4
contactors contactors
with 4-pole auxiliary switch block with 4-pole auxiliary switch block
for snapping onto the front for snapping onto the front
3RH19 21- . HA31 3RH19 21- . HA13
3 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 3 NC
Ident. no. 31 E 13 E

2 NO + 3 NC 3 NO + 2 NC
Ident. no.: 23 32

Size S0 Size S2
Terminal designations according to EN 50 012 Terminal designations according to EN 50 012
3RT20 2 Contactors with 1NO + 1NC 3RT20 2 Contactors 3RT20 3 Contactors with 1NO + 1NC 3RT20 3 Contactors
3RT20 2 Coupling Relays with 3NO + 3NC 3RT20 3 Coupling Relays with 3NO + 3NC

1/L1 3/L2 5/L3 1/L1 3/L2 5/L3 1/L1 3/L2 5/L3 1/L1 3/L2 5/L3

13 21 A1 13 21 A1 13 21 A1 13 21 A1
1 1 3 3 1 1 3 3

2 2 4 4 2 2 4 4
14 22 A2 14 22 A2 14 22 A2 14 22 A2

2/T1 4/T2 6/T3 2/T1 4/T2 6/T3 2/T1 4/T2 6/T3 2/T1 4/T2 6/T3

2/206 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3RT Contactors
3RT1/2 contactors and accessories

Position of terminals (applicable to screw connection and Spring-type connection)

Accessories for size S3 to S12 contactors


Terminal designations acc. to EN 50 005
3RH19 21- . F... auxiliary switch blocks, 4-pole,
for snapping onto the front
4 NO 3 NO + 1 NC 2 NO + 2 NC 4 NC 2 NO + 2 NC

2
Ident. no. 40 31 22 04 22 U

Assemblies
Contactors and
make-before-break

3RH19 21-1LA.. auxiliary switch blocks, 2-pole, 3RH19 21-1MA.. auxiliary switch blocks, 2-pole,
for snapping onto the front, cable entry from above for snapping onto the front, cable entry from below
2 NO 1 NO + 1 NC 2 NC 2 NO 1 NO + 1 NC 2 NC

3RH19 21- . FE22 solid-state compatible auxiliary switch block, 4-pole,


for snapping onto the front
2 NO + 2 NC
Ident. no. 22

Terminal designations according to EN 50 005 or EN 50 012


3RH19 21- . CA.. auxiliary switch blocks, single-pole,
for snapping onto the front
1 NO 1 NC 1 NO 1 NC

with extended with extended


contact-making contact-making

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/207


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3RT Contactors
3RT1/2

Position of terminals
Accessories for size S2 to S12 contactors
Terminal designations acc. to EN 50 005
3RH19 21- . EA.. first laterally mountable auxiliary switch blocks (left) 3RH19 21- . EA.. first laterally mountable auxiliary switch blocks (right)
2 NO 1 NO + 1 NC 2 NC 2 NO 1 NO + 1 NC 2 NC
2 Assemblies
Contactors and

3RH19 21- . KA.. second laterally mountable auxiliary switch blocks (left) 3RH19 21- . KA.. second laterally mountable auxiliary switch blocks (right)
(only for sizes S3 to S12; can only be used if no auxiliary (only for sizes S3 to S12; can only be used if no auxiliary
switches are snapped onto the front) switches are snapped onto the front)
2 NO 1 NO + 1 NC 2 NC 2 NO 1 NO + 1 NC 2 NC

Accessories for size S3 to S12 contactors


Terminal designations acc. to DIN 46 199 Part 5
3RT19 26-2E.../2F.../2G... solid-state, time-delay auxiliary switch blocks
1 NO + 1 NC 1 NO + 1 NC 2 NO
ON-delay OFF-delay Star-delta function

3RT26 capacitor contactors


Size S00 Sizes S2 and S3
with 4-pole auxiliary switch block mounted on the front with 4-pole auxiliary switch block mounted on the front

The auxiliary switch block comprises 3 leading contacts The auxiliary switch block comprises 3 leading contacts
(not shown) and one unassigned NO contact. (not shown) and one unassigned NO contact.

2/208 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3RT1 Contactors
3RT1 contactors and accessories

Position of terminals (applicable to screw connection and Spring-type terminal connection)


Sizes S6 to S12
3RT1.5, 3RT1.6, 3RT1.7 contactors

with conventional op. mechanism with solid-state op. mechanism with solid-state op. mechanism
(3RT1. ..-.A...) (3RT1. ..-.N...) (3RT1. ..-.P...)
with laterally mountable auxiliary with laterally mountable auxiliary with laterally mountable auxiliary

2
switch blocks 3RH19 21-1DA11 switch blocks 3RH19 21-1DA11 switch blocks 3RH19 21-1DA11
(for 2 NO + 2 NC, incl. in contactor) (for 2 NO + 2 NC, incl. in contactor) (for 1 NO + 1 NC, incl. in contactor)
3RH19 21-1JA11 3RH19 21-1JA11 3RH19 21-1JA11

Assemblies
Contactors and
(expandable to 4 NO + 4 NC) (expandable to 4 NO + 4 NC) (expandable to 2 NO + 2 NC)
2 NO + 2 NC or 4 NO + 4 NC 2 NO + 2 NC or 4 NO + 4 NC 1 NO + 1 NC or 2 NO + 2 NC

Contactors with 4 main contacts, size S00 Contactors with 4 main contacts, sizes S2 to S3
Terminal designations acc. to EN 50 005 Terminal designations acc. to EN 50 005
3RT23 and 3RT25 contactor s 3RT13 and 3RT15 contactors
4 NO 2 NO + 2 NC 4 NO 2 NO + 2 NC
Size S0 with
integrated
1NO + 1NC aux
(13/14 + 21/22)
and only one set
of A1+A2 on front

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/209


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS
3T Contactors
3TF68 and 3TF69 vacuum contactors, 3-pole

Position of terminals
AC operation DC operation Solid-state compatible auxiliary switch blocks
3TY7 561-1 . for lateral mounting onto
3TF68 and 3TF69 contactors 3TF68 and 3TF69 contactors
size 6 to 14 contactors
4 NO + 4 NC 3 NO + 3 NC
max. complement of auxiliary
switches
mounted mounted
2

on left on right
Contactors and
Assemblies

2/210 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS

3RT20 contactors, 3-pole

Dimension drawings
3RT2.1.-1 contactor and 3RH21..-1 contactor relays
Size S00 and NEMA Size 0, screw connection Lateral clearance from
with surge suppressor and auxiliary switch block earthed parts = 6 mm

2
5 35

1) Laterally mountable

Assemblies
Contactors and
auxiliary switch block
3RH2911-1DA.. / -1DE.. /

50
-1EE..
2) Auxiliary switch block for
mounting on the front
3RH2911-1FA.. / -1GA.. /
-1HA.. / -1NF..

3RT2.1.-2 contactor and 3RH21..-2 contactor relay


Size S00, Spring-type terminal connection
with auxiliary switch block

5 35

1) Laterally mountable
auxiliary switch block
3RH2911-2DA.. / -2DE.. /
50
-2EE..
2) Auxiliary switch block for
mounting on the front
3RH2911-2FA.. / -2GA.. /
-2HA.. / -2NF..

3RT2.2.-1 contactors Size S0 and NEMA Size 1,


(screw-type connection system) with auxiliary switch blocks
mounted and other accessories

1) Laterally mountable
auxiliary switch block
3RH2921-1DA.. / -1DE..
2) Auxiliary switch block for
mounting on the front
3RH2911-1FA.. / -1GA.. /
-1HA.. / -1NF..
3) 3-phase infeed terminal
3RV2925-5AB

For specific dimensions, 2D / 3D CAD files and technical data, please visit www.siemens.com/cax

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/211


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS

3RT20 contactors, 3-pole

Dimension drawings
3RT2.2.-2 and 3RT202.-.....-0LA2 contactors
Size S0 (spring-loaded connection) with auxiliary switch blocks mounted
2

For size S0:


Contactors and
Assemblies

1) Laterally mountable
auxiliary switch block
3RH2921-2DA.. / -2DE..
2) Auxiliary switch block for
mounting on the front
3RH2911-2FA.. / -2GA.. /
-2HA.. / -2NF..

3RT20 3 contactors
Size S2 and NEMA Size 2, screw connection
with surge suppressor, auxiliary switch blocks and mounted overload relay
130
55 125 45
5

1/ L1 3/ L2 5/ L3
56.7

A1
21NC
13NO

11
113.4

97.5

14NO
22NC
3. 4. 5. 6. A2

3RT20
2.5

2/ T1 4/ T2 6/ T3
8

4.9
For specific dimensions, 2D / 3D CAD files and technical data, please visit www.siemens.com/cax
For size S2:
a = 0 mm with varistor < 240 V, diode assembly
a = 3.5 mm with varistor > 240 V
a = 17 mm with RC element
b = DC 15 mm deeper than AC
1) Auxiliary switch block, laterally mountable
2) Auxiliary switch block, mountable on the front
(1, 2 and 4-pole)
3) Surge suppressor
4) Drilling pattern

2/212 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS

3RT20 and 3RT24 contactors, 3-pole

Dimension drawings
3RT20 3 contactors
Size S2, Spring-type terminal connection
with surge suppressor, auxiliary switch blocks and mounted overload relay
130
55 125 45
5

2
1/ L1 3/ L2 5/ L3

Assemblies
Contactors and
56.7

A1
21NC
13NO

11
113.4

97.5
14NO
22NC
3. 4. 5. 6.
A2

3RT20

2.5
2/ T1 4/ T2 6/ T3

8
4.9
For specific dimensions, 2D / 3D CAD files and technical data, please visit www.siemens.com/cax For size S2:
a = 0 mm with varistor < 240 V, diode assembly
a = 3.5 mm with varistor > 240 V
a = 17 mm with RC element
b = DC 15 mm deeper than AC
1) Auxiliary switch block, laterally mountable
2) Auxiliary switch block, mountable on the front
(1, 2 and 4-pole)
3RT20 4, 3RT24 46 contactors Lateral clearance from
3) Surge suppressor
Size S3 and NEMA Size 3, screw connection earthed parts = 6 mm
4) Drilling pattern
with surge suppressor, auxiliary switch blocks
and mounted overload relay

For size S3:


a = 0 mm with varistor, diode assembly
and < 240 V
a = 3.5 mm with varistor and > 240 V
a = 17 mm with RC element
b = DC 13 mm deeper than AC
1) Auxiliary switch block, laterally mountable
2) Auxiliary switch block, mountable on the
front (1, 2 and 4-pole), same dimensions for
designs with screw or Spring-type
connection
3) Surge suppressor
4) Drilling pattern
5) For mounting on 35 mm standard mounting
rail (15 mm deep) acc. to EN 50 022
or 75 mm standard mounting rail acc. to
EN 50 023
For specific dimensions, 2D / 3D CAD files and technical data, please visit www.siemens.com/cax 6) Hexagon socket screw 4 mm

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/213


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS

3RT20 contactors, 3-pole

Dimension drawings
3RT20 4 contactors,
Size S3, Spring-type terminal connection
with surge suppressor, auxiliary switch blocks
and mounted overload relay
2 Assemblies
Contactors and

For size S3:


a = 0 mm with varistor, diode assembly
and < 240 V
a = 3.5 mm with varistor and > 240 V
a = 17 mm with RC element
b = DC 13 mm deeper than AC
1) Auxiliary switch block, laterally mountable
2) Auxiliary switch block, mountable on the
front (1, 2 and 4-pole), same dimensions for
designs with screw or Spring-type terminal
connection
3) Surge suppressor
4) Drilling pattern
5) For mounting on 35 mm standard mounting
rail (15 mm deep) acc. to EN 50 022
or 75 mm standard mounting rail acc. to
EN 50 023
For specific dimensions, 2D / 3D CAD files and technical data, please visit www.siemens.com/cax 6) Hexagon socket screw 4 mm

2/214 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS

3RT10 and 3RT14 contactors, 3-pole

Dimension drawings
3RT10 5, 3RT14 5 contactors
Size S6 and NEMA Size 4
with auxiliary switch block, laterally mountable and mountable on the front,
mounted overload relay and box terminals,
laterally mounted electronics module with remaining lifetime indication

2
Clearance from earthed parts with
directly mounted overload relay:
lateral: 10 mm

Assemblies
Contactors and
front: 20 mm

Drilling pattern

For size S6:


k = 120 mm (minimum clearance for removing the
withdrawable coil)
1) Second auxiliary switch block, laterally mountable
2) Auxiliary switch block, mountable on the front
3) RC element
4) 3RB10 overload relay, mounted
5) 3RT19 55-4G box terminal block
(hexagon socket 4 mm)
6) 3RT19 56-4G box terminal block
(hexagon socket 4 mm)
7) PLC connection DC 24 V and changeover switch
(with 3RT1...-.N)
8) Electronics module with remaining lifetime indica-
tion (auxiliary switch block not mountable on right-
For specific dimensions, 2D / 3D CAD files and technical data, please visit www.siemens.com/cax hand side)

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/215


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS

3RT10 and 3RT14 contactors, 3-pole

Dimension drawings
3RT10 6, 3RT14 6 contactors
Size S10
with auxiliary switch block, laterally mountable and mountable on the front,
mounted overload relay and box terminals,
laterally mounted electronics module with remaining lifetime indication
2 Assemblies
Contactors and

Drilling pattern

3RT10 7, 3RT14 7 contactors For sizes S10 and S12:


Size S12 Clearance from earthed parts with directly mounted
with auxiliary switch block, laterally mountable and mountable on the front, overload relay:
mounted overload relay and box terminals, lateral: 10 mm
laterally mounted electronics module with remaining lifetime indication front: 20 mm

Drilling pattern

For sizes S10 and S12:


k = 150 mm (minimum clearance for removing the
withdrawable coil)
1) Second auxiliary switch block, laterally mountable
2) Auxiliary switch block, mountable on the front
3) RC element
4) 3RB10 overload relay, mounted
5) Box terminal block (hexagon socket 6 mm)
6) PLC connection DC 24 V and changeover switch
(with 3RT1...-.N)
7) Electronics module with remaining lifetime indica-
tion (auxiliary switch block not mountable on right-
For specific dimensions, 2D / 3D CAD files and technical data, please visit www.siemens.com/cax hand side)

2/216 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS

3RT10 contactors, 3-pole with integrated safety

Dimension drawings
3RT10 contactors with integrated safety
Size S6


 

     

$ $

2
Assemblies
Contactors and
  /   /   /

   

1& 1&
   
1& 1&

12 12
   
12 12









12 12
   
12 12

1& 1&
   
1& 1&

  7   7   7




Size S10


 

     

$ $

  /   /   /

   

1& 1&
   
1& 1&

12 12
   
12 12









12 12
   
12 12

1& 1&
   
1& 1&

  7   7   7




Size S12


 

     

$ $

  /   /   /

   

1& 1&
   
1& 1&

12 12
   
12 12








12 12
   
12 12

1& 1&
   
1& 1&

  7   7   7




Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/217


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS

3RT12 vacuum contactors, 3-pole

Dimension drawings
3RT12 6 vacuum contactors
Size S10
with auxiliary switch block, laterally mountable,
mounted overload relay and box terminals,
laterally mounted electronics module with remaining lifetime indication
2 Assemblies
Contactors and

Drilling pattern

Detail
Contact erosion indicator for vacuum interrupters

3RT12 7 vacuum contactors


Size S12
with auxiliary switch block, laterally mountable,
mounted overload relay and box terminals,
laterally mounted electronics module with remaining lifetime indication

Drilling pattern

For sizes S10 and S12:


k = 150 mm (minimum clearance for removing the
withdrawable coil)
1) Second auxiliary switch block, laterally mountable
2) Position and contact erosion indicator
3) RC element
4) 3RB10 overload relay, mounted
5) Box terminal block (hexagon socket 6 mm)
6) PLC connection DC 24 V and changeover switch
(with 3RT1...-.N)
7) Electronics module with remaining lifetime indica-
tion (auxiliary switch block not mountable on right-
For specific dimensions, 2D / 3D CAD files and technical data, please visit www.siemens.com/cax hand side)

2/218 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS

3RT23 and 3RT25 contactors, 4-pole

Dimension drawings
3RT23 1 and 3RT25 1 contactors Lateral clearance from
Size S00, screw connection earthed parts = 6 mm
with surge suppressor and auxiliary switch block

For size S00:


5 35
1) Laterally mountable
auxiliary switch block

2
3RH2911-1DA.. / -1DE.. /
-1EE..

Assemblies
Contactors and
2) Auxiliary switch block for
mounting on the front

50
3RH2911-1FA.. / -1GA.. /
-1HA.. / -1NF..


3RT23 2 and 3RT25 2 contactors


Size S0 with coil terminal module
and auxiliary switch block

For size S0:


4) 4-pole contactor for switching 4
resistive loads 3RT232. 4-pole
pole-changing contactor for
changing the polarity of hoisting
gear motors (2 NO contacts and
2 NC contacts) 3RT252.
5) Coil terminal module 3RT2926-
4RA11/-4RB11
6) Auxiliary switch block for
mounting on the front

3RH2911-1AA.. / -1BA

3RT23 3 and 3RT25 3 contactorss


Size S2 with surge suppressor For sizes S2 and S3:
and auxiliary switch block 130
a = 0 mm with varistor < 240 V
74.6 125 45
5
a = 3.5 mm with varistor > 240 V
a = 17 mm with RC element and
1/L1 3/ L2 5/ L3 7/ L4 diode assembly
b = S2: DC 15 mm deeper than AC
S3: DC 13 mm deeper than AC
1) Auxiliary switch block, laterally
56.7

21NC
A1
mountable (right or left)
13NO
2) Auxiliary switch block, mountable
11 on the front, (1, 2 and 4-pole,
113.4

also 3RH19 21-1FE22 solid-state


97.5

compatible design)
3) Surge suppressor
14NO
22NC 4) Drilling pattern
3. 4. 5. 6. A2
5) For mounting on 35 mm standard
3RT23 mounting rail (15 mm deep) acc.
2.5

to EN 50 022 or, in the case of


size S3, 75mm standard mounting
2/T1 4/ T2 6/ T3 8/ T4
rail acc. to EN 50 023
8

6) Hexagon socket screw 4 mm


4.9
3RT23 4 contactors
Size S3 with surge suppressor
and auxiliary switch block

For specific dimensions, 2D / 3D CAD files and technical data, please visit www.siemens.com/cax

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/219


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS

3RT16 capacitor contactors

Dimension drawings
3RT16 17 capacitor contactors
Size S00
2 Assemblies
Contactors and

3RT16 27 capacitor contactors


Size S0

3RT16 47 capacitor contactors


Size S3

For specific dimensions, 2D / 3D CAD files and technical data, please visit www.siemens.com/cax

2/220 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS

3RA23 contactor assemblies for reversing

Dimension drawings
Size S00 / 3RA231
90 73

37

2
67.5

Assemblies
Contactors and
5

Size S0 / 3RA232
90 97
53
101

Size S2 / 3RA233 129.8


120 124.8

1/ L1 3/ L2 5/ L3 1/ L1 3/ L2 5/ L3
72.9

A1 A1
21NC 21NC
13NO 13NO
140.6

11 11

14NO 14NO
22NC 22NC
3. 4. 5. 6. A2 3. 4. 5. 6. A2

3RT20 3RT20

2/ T1 4/ T2 6/ T3 2/ T1 4/ T2 6/ T3

Size S3 / 3RA234

For specific dimensions, 2D / 3D CAD files and technical data, please visit www.siemens.com/cax

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/221


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS

3RA13 contactor assemblies for reversing

Dimension drawings
Size S6
2 Assemblies
Contactors and

Size S10

The assemblies shown on this page are for customer assembly with individual components.

2/222 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS

3RA13 contactor assemblies for reversing

Dimension drawings
Size S12

2
Assemblies
Contactors and
M10x30
(3x)

2.1
2.2
2.3
6

2
7 M10x35
944
RA -00 (3x)

3RA1953-2A
R A - 0 1 0 27

3RA1963-2A 1)
RA-01027a

3RA1973-2A 2)

1
) 3RT1.6
M10x30 2
) 3RT1.7
6 (3x)

M10x35
(3x) 1.1
1.2
The assemblies shown on this page are for customer assembly with individual components. 1.3

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/223


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS

3TF68 and 3TF69 vacuum contactors, 3TC4 and 3TC5 DC contactors

Dimension drawings
3TF68 vacuum contactors 3TF69 vacuum contactors
2 Assemblies
Contactors and

Detail Detail
A = Contact erosion indicator for vacuum interrupter contacts A = Contact erosion indicator for vacuum interrupter contacts

3TC4 and 3TC5 contactors


3TC44 contactors 3TC48 contactors
Size 2, AC and DC operation Size 4, AC and DC operation

t = minimum clearance from insulated components: 15 mm (600 V and 750 V) t = minimum clearance from insulated components: 15 mm (600 V),
20 mm (750 V)
from grounded components: 30 mm (600 V and 750 V) from grounded components: 35 mm (600 V),
55 mm (750 V)
a b a b c
DC operation 109 141 DC operation 112 180 21.5
AC operation 68 100 AC operation 86 154 23.5

3TC52 contactors 3TC56 contactors


Size 8, AC and DC operation Size 12, AC and DC operation

2
2

t = minimum clearance from insulated components: 20 mm (600 V and 750 V) t = minimum clearance from insulated components: 25 mm (600 V and 750 V)

from grounded components: 70 mm (600 V and 750 V) from grounded components: 80 mm (600 V),
100 mm (750 V)
a b a b
DC operation 147 232 DC operation 200 310
AC operation 115 200 AC operation 141 251

1) With box terminals for laminated copper bars 2) DC operation only


(accessories).

2/224 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS

Accessories for 3RT2 contactors

Dimension drawings
Terminal cover for box terminals Terminal cover for box terminals
for size S2, for size S3,
3RT29 36-4EA2 3RT19 46-4EA2

2
Assemblies
Contactors and
Terminal cover for cable lug and bar connection Auxiliary conductor terminal, 3-pole
for size S3, 3RT19 46-4F
3RT19 46-4EA1 Size S3
mounted on contactor

For specific dimensions, 2D / 3D CAD files and technical data, please visit www.siemens.com/cax

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/225


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS

Accessories for 3RA1 contactor assemblies

Dimension drawings

3RA19.2-2A baseplates for reversing contactor assemblies


2 Assemblies
Contactors and

A B C D E
S6 190 205 250 229 9
S10 240 249 300 275 11
S12 280 249 330 275 11

3RA19.2-2E, 3RA19.2-2F
baseplates for star-delta assemblies

A B C D E
S6-S6-S3 316 205 376 229 9
S6-S6-S6 343 205 403 229 9
S10-S10-S6 393 250 453 275 11
S10-S10-S10 423 250 483 275 11
S12-S12-S10 450 250 510 275 11
S12-S12-S12 465 250 525 275 11

For specific dimensions, 2D / 3D CAD files and technical data, please visit www.siemens.com/cax

2/226 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS

3RH21 and 3RH24 control relays

Dimension drawings
3RH21 control relays
Size S00, with screw connections 73
Lateral clearance from
5 35 earthed parts = 6 mm

2
50

Assemblies
Contactors and


3RH24 latched control relays


Size S00 73
90 68
29.8
57.5

7.5


3RH21 coupling relays

Dimension drawings
Size S00, with screw connections,
with surge suppressor
104.5
45 73 35 1) Surge suppressor
5 2) Drilling pattern
Deviating dimensions for
coupling relays with Spring-type
29.8

terminal connections
57.5

Height: 69.5 mm
50

5 1.2
3.8

For specific dimensions, 2D / 3D CAD files and technical data, please visit www.siemens.com/cax

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 2/227


Contactors and Contactor Assemblies SIRIUS

Notes
2 Assemblies
Contactors and

2/228 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Overload Relays
Industrial Control Product Catalog 2021

contents
Thermal overload relays Solid state overload relays
3 SIRIUS

Section

3
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
3RU21 overload relays up to 100 A 3RB24 overload relays up to 630A
with screw connection, CLASS 10 with IO-Link current monitoring
Page Page
Selection and ordering data Selection and ordering data
• Basic Unit 3/10 • Basic Unit 3/51
• Accessories 3/11 • Accessories 3/55
Description 3/8 - 3/9 Description 3/52 - 3/53
Technical data 3/12 - 3/14 Technical data 3/58 - 3/62
Circuit diagrams 3/15
Dimension drawings 3/16 - 3/17

SIRIUS 3RV motor starter protectors up to 100 A

3RB20/21, 3RB30/31 3RB22/23 overload relays


overload relays up to 630 A, up to 820 A for full motor 3UF7 SIMOCODE Pro Motor
3RB20/30 CLASS 10 or 20 protection, CLASS 5 to management and control devices
3RB21/31 CLASS 5, 10, 20, 30 CLASS 30 adjustable Page
Page Page Selection and ordering data
Selection and ordering data Selection and ordering data • Basic Unit 3/74 - 3/76
• Basic Unit 3/22 - 3/23 • Basic Unit 3/34 - 3/35 • Expansion modules 3/77 - 3/79
• Accessories 3/11 • Accessories 3/49 - 3/50 • Accessories 3/80 - 3/82
Description 3/18 - 3/19 Description 3/47 Description 3/63 - 3/68
Cross Reference Aid 3/21 Technical data 3/40 - 3/43 Technical data 3/69 - 3/73
Technical data 3/24 - 3/28 Dimension drawings 3/45 - 3/46 Software and licenses 3/83 - 3/86
Dimension drawings 3/30 Circuit diagrams 3/47
Circuit diagrams 3/31

(Section was last modified on 08/19/21) Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/1
Overload Relays
Overload Relays

General data
General data

Overview

Features 3RU21 3RB30/3RB31 3RB20/3RB21 3RB22/3RB23 3RB24 Benefits


General data
Sizes S00 ... S3 S00 ... S3 S6 ... S12 S00 ... S12 S00 ... S12 • Are coordinated with the dimensions, con-
3

nections and technical characteristics of


the other devices in the SIRIUS modular
system (contactors, etc., ...)
OVERLOAD
RELAYS

• Permit the mounting of slim and compact


load feeders in widths of 45 mm (S00),
45 mm (S0), 55 mm (S2), 70 mm (S3),
120 mm (S6) and 145 mm (S10/S12); this
does not include the current measuring
modules for the 3RB22 to 3RB24 evalua-
tion modules sizes S00 to S3
• Simplify configuration
Seamless 0.11 ... 100 A 0.1 ... 100 A 50 ... 630 A 0.3 ... 630 A 0.3 ... 630 A • Allows easy and consistent configuration
current range (up to 820 A)1) (up to 820 A)1) with one series of overload relays (for
small to large loads)
Protection functions
7

Tripping • Provides optimum inverse-time delayed


due to protection of loads against excessive tem-
overload perature rises due to overload
Tripping • Provides optimum inverse-time delayed
due to phase protection of loads against excessive tem-
unbalance perature rises due to phase unbalance
Tripping • Minimizes heating of induction motors
due to phase during phase failure
failure
Protection of — — • Enables the protection of single-phase
single-phase loads
loads
Tripping in the — 2) — 2) — 2) • Provides optimum temperature-depen-
event of dent protection of loads against excessive
overheating temperature rises e.g. for stator-critical
motors or in the event of insufficient cool-
by ant flow, contamination of the motor sur-
face or for long starting or braking
integrated operations
thermistor • Eliminates the need for additional special
motor protec- equipment
tion function
• Saves space in the control cabinet
• Reduces wiring outlay and costs
Tripping — • Provides optimum protection of loads
in the event of (only 3RB31) (only 3RB21) against high-resistance short circuits or
a ground fault ground faults due to moisture, condensed
water, damage to the insulation material,
by etc.
• Eliminates the need for additional special
internal ground- equipment
fault detection
(activatable) • Saves space in the control cabinet
• Reduces wiring outlay and costs
Available 1) Motor currents up to 820 A can be recorded and evaluated by a current
— Not available measuring module, e.g. 3RB29 06-2BG1 (0.3 to 3 A), in combination with a
3UF18 68-3GA00 (820 A/1 A) series transformer.
2) The SIRIUS 3RN thermistor motor protection devices can be used to pro-
vide additional temperature-dependent protection.

3/2 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


7/72 Siemens IC 10 · 2012
IC10_07_08.fm Page 73 Monday, October 7, 2013 7:09 PM

Overload Relays

Overload Relays
General data

General data

Features 3RU21 3RB30/3RB31 3RB20/3RB21 3RB22/3RB23 3RB24 Benefits


Features
RESET function • Allows manual or automatic resetting of

3
the device
Remote RESET • Allows the remote resetting of the device
function (by means of (only with (only with (electrically via (electrically

RELAYS
OVERLOAD
separate mod- 3RB31 3RB21 external but- with button or
ule) and external and external ton) via IO-Link)
auxiliary volt- auxiliary volt-
age 24 V DC) age 24 V DC)
TEST function • Allows easy checking of the function and
for auxiliary wiring
contacts
TEST function — • Allows checking of the electronics
for electronics
Status display • Displays the current operating state
Large current • Makes it easier to set the relay exactly to
adjustment the correct current value
button
Integrated auxil- -- • Allows the load to be switched off if neces-

7
iary contacts (2 ×) sary
(1 NO + 1 NC) • Can be used to output signals
Integrated auxil- — — — — • Enables the controlling of contactors
iary contacts directly from the higher-level control sys-
(1 CO and 1 NO tem through IO-Link
in series)
IO-Link — — — — • Reduction of wiring in the control cabinet
connection • Enables communication
Connection of — — — — • Enables local operation
optional hand-
held device
n capability
Communication capability through IO-Link
Full starter — — — — • Enables in combination with the
functionality SIRIUS 3RT contactors the assembly of
through IO-Link communication-capable motor starters
(direct-on-line, reversing and wye-delta
starting)
Reading out of — — — — • Enables the reading out of diagnostics in-
diagnostics formation such as overload, open circuit,
functions ground fault, etc.
Reading out of — — — — • Enables the reading out of current values
current values and their direct processing in the higher-
level control system
Reading out all — — — — • Enables the reading out of all set parame-
set parameters ters, e.g. for plant documentation
Available
— Not available

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/3

Siemens IC 10 · 2012
IC10_07_08.fm Page 74 Monday, October 7, 2013 7:09 PM

Overload Relays SIRIUS


Overload Relays
General data

General data

Features 3RU21 3RB30/3RB31 3RB20/3RB21 3RB22/3RB23 3RB24 Benefits


Design of load feeders
Short-circuit • Provides optimum protection of the loads
3

strength up to and operating personnel in the event of


100 kA short circuits due to insulation faults or
at 690 V faulty switching operations
OVERLOAD
RELAYS

(in conjunction
with the corre-
sponding fuses
or the corre-
sponding motor
starter protector)
Electrical and 1) 1)
• Simplifies configuration
mechanical • Reduces wiring outlay and costs
matching to
3RT contactors • Enables stand-alone installation as well as
space-saving direct mounting
Straight- — • Reduces the contact resistance
through trans- (S2, S3) (S3 to S6) (S00 ... S6) (S00 ... S6) (only one point of contact)
formers for • Saves wiring costs
main circuit2) (easy, no need for tools, and fast)
(in this case the
7

cables are • Saves material costs


routed through • Reduces installation costs
the feed-through
openings of the
overload relay
and connected
directly to the
box terminals of
the contactor)
Spring-type — — — • Enables fast connections
connection sys- (S00, S0) (S00, S0) • Permits vibration-resistant connections
tem for main cir-
cuit2) • Enables maintenance-free connections
Spring-type • Enables fast connections
connection sys- • Permits vibration-resistant connections
tem for auxiliary
circuits2) • Enables maintenance-free connections
Ring terminal — — — — • Enables fast connections
lug connection (S00, S0) • Permits vibration-resistant connections
method for main
and auxiliary • Enables maintenance-free connections
circuits2)
Full starter — — — — • Enables in combination with the
functionality SIRIUS 3RT contactors the assembly of
through IO-Link communication-capable motor starters
(direct-on-line, reversing and wye-delta
starting)
Starter function — — — — • Integration of feeders via IO-Link in the
control system up to 630 A or 820 A
Available 1) Exception: up to size S3, only stand-alone installation is possible.
— Not available 2) Alternatively available for screw terminals.

3/4 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


IC10_07_08.fm Page 75 Monday, October 7, 2013 7:09 PM

Overload Relays SIRIUS


Overload Relays
General data

General data

Features 3RU21 3RB30/3RB31 3RB20/3RB21 3RB22/3RB23 3RB24 Benefits


Other features
Temperature • Allows the use of the relays at high tem-

3
compensation peratures without derating
• Prevents premature tripping

RELAYS
OVERLOAD
• Allows compact installation of the control
cabinet without distance between the de-
vices/load feeders
Very high long- • Provides safe protection for the loads
term stability even after years of use
in severe operating conditions
Wide setting — • Minimize the configuration outlay and
ranges (1:4) (1:4) (1:10) (1:10) costs
• Minimize storage overheads, storage
costs, tied-up capital
Fixed trip class CLASS 10 3RB30: 3RB20: • Optimum motor protection for standard
CLASS 10A CLASS 10E or CLASS 10 or starts
CLASS 20E CLASS 20
Trip classes — 3RB31: 3RB21: • Enables solutions for very fast starting mo-
adjustable on

7
tors requiring special protection
the device (e.g. Ex motors)
CLASS 5, 10, 20, • Enables heavy starting solutions
30
• Reduces the number of versions
Low power loss — • Reduces energy consumption and energy
costs (up 98 % less energy is used than
for thermal overload relays).
• Minimizes temperature rises of the con-
tactor and control cabinet – in some cases
this may eliminate the need for control-
gear cabinet cooling.
• Direct mounting to contactor saves space,
even for high motor currents (i.e. no heat
decoupling is required).
Internal power —1) — — • Eliminates the need for configuration and
supply connecting an additional control circuit
Supplied from — — — • Eliminates the need for configuration and
an external volt- connecting an additional control circuit
age through
IO-Link
Overload — — — • Indicates imminent tripping of the relay di-
warning rectly on the device due to overload,
phase unbalance or phase failure through
flickering of the LEDs or in the case of the
3RB24 as a signal through IO-Link
• Allows the imminent tripping of the relay to
be signaled
• Allows measures to be taken in time in the
event of inverse-time delayed overloading
of the load for an extended period over the
current limit
Analog output — — — • Allows the output of an analog output sig-
nal for actuating moving-coil instruments,
feeding programmable logic controllers or
transfer to bus systems
• Eliminates the need for an additional mea-
suring transducer and signal converter
Available 1) SIRIUS 3RU21 thermal overload relays use a bimetal contactor
— Not available and therefore do not require a control supply voltage.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/5

Siemens IC 10 · 2012
Overload Relays SIRIUS
Overload Relays
General data
General data
Overview of overload relays – matching contactors
Overload Current Current Contactors (type, size, rating in HP)
relays measure- range 3RT20 1. 3RT20 2. 3RT20 3. 3RT20 4. 3RT20 5. 3RT20 6. 3RT20 7 3TF68/
ment 3TF69
S00 S0 S2 S3 S6 S10 S12 Size 14
Type Type A 3/5/7.5/10 5/7.5/10/15/20/25 30/40/50 50/60/70 100/125/150 150/200/250 300/400 500/700
SIRIUS 3RU21 thermal overload relays
3RU21 1 Integrated 0.11 … 16 — — — — — — —
3RU21 2 Integrated 1.8 … 40 — — — — — — —
3RU21 3 Integrated 22 … 80 — — — — — — —
3RU21 4 Integrated 28 … 100 — — — — — — —
3

3RU21

SIRIUS 3RB30 solid-state overload relays1)


OVERLOAD
RELAYS

3RB30 1 Integrated 0.1 … 16 — — — — — — —


3RB30 2 Integrated 0.1 … 40 — — — — — — —
3RB30 3 Integrated 12 … 80 — — — — — — —
3RB30 4 Integrated 32 … 115 — — — — — — —

3RB30

SIRIUS 3RB31 solid-state overload relays1)


3RB31 1 Integrated 0.1 … 16 — — — — — — —
3RB31 2 Integrated 0.1 … 40 — — — — — — —
3RB31 3 Integrated 12 … 80 — — — — — — —

7
3RB31 4 Integrated 32 … 115 — — — — — — —

3RB31

SIRIUS 3RB20 solid-state overload relays1)


3RB20 5 Integrated 50 … 200 — — — — — — —
3RB20 6 Integrated 55 … 630
3RB20 1 + Integrated 630 … 820 — — — — — — —
3UF18

3RB20
SIRIUS 3RB21 solid-state overload relays1)
3RB21 5 d 50 … 200 0
Integrated — — — — — — —
3RB21 6 Integrated 55 … 630
3RB21 1 + Integrated 630 … 820 — — — — — — —
3UF18

3RB21

Can be used 1) "Technical Specifications" for use of the overload relays with trip class
— Cannot be used ≥ CLASS 20 can be found in "Short-circuit protection with fuses for motor
feeders",

3/6 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Siemens IC 10 · 2012 7/77
Overload Relays SIRIUS
Overload Relays
General data
General data
Overview of overload relays – matching contactors (continued)
Overload Current Current Contactors (type, size, rating in HP)
relays measure- range 3RT20 1 3RT20 2 3RT20 3 3RT20 4 3RT20 5 3RT20 6 3RT20 7 3TF68/
ment 3TF69
S00 S0 S2 S3 S6 S10 S12 Size 14
Type Type A 3/5/7.5/1. 5/7.5/10/15/ 30/40/50 50/60/75 100/125/150 150/200/250 300/400 500/700
20/25
SIRIUS 3RB22 to 3RB24 solid-state overload relays1)
3RB29 0 0.3 … 25 — — — — — —
3RB29 0 10 … 100 — — — —
3RB22 83/
3RB23 83/ 3RB29 5 20 … 200 — — — —
3RB24 83+ 3RB29 6 63 … 630 — — — — —
3RB29 0 + 630 … 820 — — — — — — —

3
3UF18

RELAYS
OVERLOAD
3RB22, 3RB23

3RB24
7

Can be used 1) "Technical Specifications" for use of the overload relays with trip class
— Cannot be used ≥ CLASS 20 can be found in "Short-circuit protection with fuses for motor
feeders",

Connection methods
Depending on the device version of the 3RU2 and 3RB3 over-
load relays, the terminals for screw terminals, spring-type termi-
nals or ring terminal lug connection are configured for both the
main and auxiliary circuit in frame sizes S00 and S0.
The 3RU21 thermal overload relays come with screw terminals.
The electronic overload relays 3RB20 and 3RB21 are available
with screw terminals (box terminals) or spring-type terminals on
the auxiliary current side; the same applies for the evaluation
modules of the 3RB22 to 3RB24 electronic overload relays for
High-Feature applications.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/7


7/78 Siemens IC 10 · 2012
Overload Relays SIRIUS
Thermal Overload Relays
3RU21 up to 100 A, CLASS 10

Description
The 3RU thermal overload re- (see "Environmental consider-
lays up to 100 A are designed for ations") and comply with all the 
current-dependent protection of main international standards
applications with normal start-up and approvals (see "Specifica-
conditions (see "Trip classes") tions" and "Increased safety type
against impermissibly high rises of protection EEx").
in temperature as a result of
The accessories for the 3RU
overload or phase failure (see
thermal overload relays have
"Phase failure protection"). An
overload or phase failure causes
been designed on the principle 
that all requirements are cov- 
the motor current to rise above 
ered by a small number of vari-
the set rated motor current (see 
ants.
"Setting"). This current rise heats

NSB0_02075a
up the bimetal strips within the Application 
3

relay via heating elements


which, in turn, operate the auxil- The 3RU thermal overload re-
iary contacts via a tripping lays are designed for the protec-
OVERLOAD
RELAYS

mechanism due to their deflec- tion of three-phase and single-


tion (see "Auxiliary contacts"). phase AC and DC motors.
These switch the load off via a If single-phase AC or DC loads
contactor. The switch-off time is are to be protected using 3RU
dependent on the ratio of trip- thermal overload relays, all three  Connection for mounting onto contactors:
ping current to operational cur- bimetal strips should be heated. Optimally adapted in electrical, mechanical and design terms to the
rent Ie and is stored in the form of contactors. The overload relay can be connected directly to these
Therefore all main circuits of the contactor using these pins. Stand-alone installation is possible as
a tripping characteristic with relay must be connected in se- an alternative (in conjunction with a terminal bracket for stand-alone
long-term stability (see "Tripping ries. installation).
characteristics"). The "Tripped"
state is signalled by means of a Overload relays in WYE-delta  Selector switch for manual/automatic RESET and RESET button:
With this switch you can choose between manual and automatic
switching position indicator (see combinations RESET. A device set to manual RESET can be reset locally by
"Indication of status"). When overload relays are used pressing the RESET button. A remote RESET is possible using the
RESET modules (accessories), which are independent of size.
Resetting takes place manually in WYE-delta combinations, it is
or automatically (see "Manual important to note that only 1/√3
and automatic resetting") after a of the motor current flows  Switch position indicator and TEST function of the wiring:
Indicates a trip and enables the wiring test.
recovery time has elapsed (see through the mains contactor. An
"Recovery time"). overload relay mounted on the  Motor current setting:
main contactor must be set to Setting the device to the rated motor current is easy with the large
The 3RU thermal overload re- rotary knob.
lays are electrically and me- 0.58 times the motor current.
chanically optimised to the 3RT A second overload relay must be  STOP button:
If the STOP button is pressed, the NC contact is opened. This
contactors such that, in addition mounted on the star contactor if switches off the contactor downstream. The NC contact is closed
to individual mounting, they can your load is also to be optimally again when the button is released.
also be directly mounted onto protected in WYE operation. The
the contactors to save space WYE current is 1/3 of the rated  Supply terminals:
Depending on the device version, the terminals for screw,
(see "Design and mounting"). motor current. The relevant relay spring-type or ring lug terminal connection are configured for the
The main and auxiliary circuits must be set to this current. main and auxiliary circuit.
can be connected in various
ways (see "Connection"), includ- Control circuit A sealable transparent cover can be optionally mounted
(accessory). It secures the motor current setting against
ing the use of Cage Clamp termi- An additional power supply is adjustment.
nals. When the overload relay not required for operation of the
has been connected, it can be 3RU thermal overload relays. 3RU21 26-4FB00 thermal overload relays
tested for correct functioning us-
ing a TEST slide (see "TEST Ambient conditions
function"). In addition to the Trip classes
The 3RU thermal overload re-
TEST function, the 3RU ther- lays are temperature compen- The 3RU thermal overload re- lay for symmetrical three-pole
mal overload relay is equipped sating according to IEC 60 947- lay is available for normal start- loading between 105 % and
with a STOP function (see "STOP 4-1/DIN VDE 0660 Part 102 in up conditions in CLASS 10. For 120 % of the operational current.
function"). the temperature range –20 °C to further details about trip classes, Starting from the limiting tripping
For a wide variety of application +60 °C. For temperatures from see "Tripping characteristics". current, the tripping characteris-
possibilities for the 3RU thermal +60 °C to +80 °C, the upper set- tic moves on to larger tripping
Tripping characteristics currents based on the charac-
overload relay, please refer to ting value of the setting range
the sections "Application", must be reduced by a specific The tripping characteristics teristics of the so-called trip
"Ambient conditions", “Overload factor as given in the table be- show the relationship between classes (CLASS 10, CLASS 20
relays in WYE-delta combina- low. the tripping time and the tripping etc.). The trip classes describe
tions" and "Operation with fre- current as a multiple of the oper- time-intervals within which the
quency converters". Ambient Reduction factor ational current Ie and are speci- overload relay must trip with 7.2
temperature for the upper set- fied for symmetrical three-pole times the operational current Ie
The 3RU thermal overload re- in °C ting value and two-pole loading from cold. for symmetrical three-pole load-
lays can protect your loads from ing from cold.
overload and phase failure. You +60 1.0 The smallest current at which
must implement short-circuit +65 0.94 tripping occurs is called the lim- The tripping times are:
protection (see "Short-circuit +70 0.87
iting tripping current. In accor-
protection") by means of a fuse dance with IEC 60 947-4-1/ CLASS Tripping times
+75 0.81 DIN VDE 0660 Part 102, this
or circuit-breaker. 10A 2 s to 10 s
+80 0.73 must lie within certain specified
The 3RU thermal overload re- 10 4 s to 10 s
limits. The limits of the limiting
lays are environmentally friendly tripping current lie, in the case of 20 6 s to 20 s
the 3RU11 thermal overload re- 30 9 s to 30 s

3/8 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Overload Relays SIRIUS
Thermal Overload Relays
3RU21 up to 100 A, CLASS 10

Description
This is the schematic representation of a characteristic. The characteristics TEST function Operation with frequency
of the individual 3RU thermal overload relays can be requested from
Correct functioning of the ready converters
Technical Assistance at the e-mail address:
nst.technical-assistance@siemens.de 3RU thermal overload relay can The 3RU thermal overload re-
Tripping time
be tested with the TEST slide. The lays are suitable for operation with
10 000 slide is operated to simulate trip- frequency converters. Depending
ANSB00288 ping of the relay. During this simu- on the frequency of the converter,
100
min 5000 lation, the NC contact (95-96) is a current higher than the motor
60
40
s opened and the NO contact (97- current may have to be set due to
2000 98) is closed whereby the over- the occurrence of eddy currents
load relay checks that the auxiliary and skin effects.
1000
circuit is wired correctly. When the
10
500
3RU thermal overload relay is Environmental considerations
set to Automatic RESET, an auto-
5
matic reset takes place when the The devices are manufactured

3
200
TEST slide is released. The relay taking environmental consider-
2
100 must be reset using the RESET ations into account and comprise
3-pole
button when it is set to Manual environmentally-friendly and recy-

RELAYS
OVERLOAD
1 loading
50 RESET. clable materials.

20 2-pole STOP function Specifications


loading The 3RU thermal overload re-
10 When the STOP button is pressed,
the NC contact is opened and the lays comply with the requirements
5
series-connected contactor and of:
therefore the load is switched Off. • IEC 60 947-1/
2
The load is reconnected via the DIN VDE 0660 Part 100
1 contactor when the STOP button • IEC 60 947-4-1/
0,6 0,8 1 2 3 4 6 8 10 15 20 30 40 A 60 80 x n is released. DIN VDE 0660 Part 102
Current
• IEC 60 947-5-1/
The tripping characteristic of a Setting Status indication DIN VDE 0660 Part 200
three-pole 3RU thermal over- The 3RU thermal overload relay The current status of the 3RU
load relay (see characteristic for • IEC 60801-2, -3, -4, -5 and
is adjusted to the rated motor cur- thermal overload relay is indicated
symmetrical three-pole loading rent using a rotary knob. The scale by the position of the marking on • UL 508/CSA C 22.2.
from cold) is valid when all three of the rotary knob is calibrated in the "TEST function/switching posi-
bimetal strips are loaded with the The 3RU11 thermal overload re-
Amperes. tion indicator" slide. The marking lays are also safe from touch ac-
same current simultaneously. If, on the slide is on the left at the "O"
however, only two bimetal strips cording to DIN VDE 0106 Part 100
Manual and automatic mark following a trip due to over- and climate-proof to IEC 721.
are heated as a result of phase load or phase failure and at the "I"
failure, these two strips would resetting
mark otherwise.
have to provide the force neces- It is possible to switch between Degree of protection
sary for operating the release manual resetting and automatic "Increased safety" EEx
mechanism and, if no additional resetting by depressing and rotat- Auxiliary contacts
The 3RU thermal overload relay
measures were implemented, ing the blue button (RESET but- The 3RU thermal overload relay meets the requirements for over-
they would require a longer trip- ton). When manual resetting is se- is equipped with an NO contact load protection of motors of the
ping time or a higher current. lected, a reset can be performed for the tripped signal and an NC "Increased safety" type of protec-
These increased current levels directly on the device by pressing contact for switching off the con- tion EEx e IEC 50 019/
over long periods usually result in the RESET button. Remote reset- tactor. DIN VDE 0165, DIN VDE 0170,
damage to the consumer. To pre- ting can be implemented by using DIN VDE 171.
vent damage, the 3RU thermal the mechanical and electrical RE- Connection KEMA test certificate number
overload relay features phase fail- SET modules from the range of ac- Ex-97.Y.3235,
ure sensitivity which, thanks to an cessories (see "Accessories"). All the 3RU thermal overload DMT 98 ATEX G001,
appropriate mechanical mecha- When the blue button is set to Au- relays have screw terminals for EN 50 019: 1977 + A1 ... A5,
nism, results in accelerated trip- tomatic RESET, the relay will be re- the main and auxiliary circuits. Increased Safety "e": Appendix A,
ping according to the characteris- set automatically. Once the box terminals have Guideline for temperature moni-
tic for two-pole loading from cold. been removed from the main toring of squirrel cage motors dur-
A reset is not possible until the re- conductor connections of the
In contrast to a load in the cold covery time has elapsed (see "Re- ing operation.
state, a load at operating tempera- overload relays of size S3, it is
covery time"). possible to connect busbars.
ture has a lower heat reserve. This Accessories
fact affects the 3RU thermal Alternatively the devices are
Recovery time available with either spring loaded For the 3RU thermal overload
overload relay in that following an
extended period of loading at op- After tripping due to an overload, it or with ring lug terminals on both relay, there are:
erational current Ie, the tripping takes a certain length of time for the control and the main terminals. • one adapter for each of the
time reduces by about a quarter. the bimetal strips of the 3RU For details of various connection four overload relay sizes S00 to
thermal overload relays to cool possibilities, see the "Technical S3 for individual mounting
Phase failure protection down. The relay can only be reset data" and "Selection and ordering • one electrical remote RESET
once it has cooled down. This time data". module for all sizes in three
The 3RU thermal overload re- (recovery time) is dependent on different voltage variants
lays feature phase failure protec- the tripping characteristic and the • one mechanical remote RESET
Design and mounting
tion (see "Tripping characteris- level of the tripping current. module for all sizes
tics") for the purpose of minimizing The 3RU thermal overload re- • one cable release for all sizes
After tripping due to overload, the lays are suitable for direct mount-
the heating of the load during sin- for resetting inaccessible
gle-phase operation as a result of recovery time allows the load to ing on the 3RT contactors. They
cool down. devices
phase failure. can also be mounted as single • terminal covers
units if the appropriate adapters
are used. For details of the The accessories can also be used
mounting possibilities, see the for the 3RB solid state overload relay.
"Selection and ordering data" and
the "Technical data".

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/9


Overload Relays SIRIUS
Thermal Overload Relays
3RU21 up to 100 A, CLASS 10

Selection and ordering data


Features and technical characteristics • TEST function
• Auxiliary contacts: 1 NO + 1 NC • STOP button
• Manual/automatic RESET • Phase failure sensitivity
• Switching position indication • Sealable cover: optional in S00, S0 & S2. Integrated in S3
• CLASS 10

•• Terminal Types I †† Terminal Types II


Type Mounting Type Ltr Type Mounting Type Ltr
Ordering information
• For description, see page 3/8 Screw Direct to Contactor B0 Screw Direct to Contactor B0
3

• Replace the (••) with the letter


Number combination from the • For technical data, see pages Screw1) Stand Alone B1 Screw 4) Stand Alone B1
Terminal types I table 3/12-3/15
OVERLOAD
RELAYS

Spring2) Direct to Contactor C0 Spring 3) Direct to Contactor D0


• Replace the (…††) with the letter • For circuit diagrams, see page 3/15
Number combination from the Spring1) 2) Stand Alone C1 Spring 3) 4) Stand Alone D1
• For dimension drawings, see page
Terminal types II table
3/16-3/17. Ring Lug Direct to Contactor J0

3RU2116-1GB0 3RU2116-1GC0 3RU2126-4NB0 3RU2136-4RB1 3RU2146-4JB0

Thermal Overload Relays up to 40A Thermal Overload Relays up to 100A


Frame Size S00 and S0 •• Frame Size S2 and S3 ††
Setting Order No. Setting Order No. Weight Setting Order No. Setting Order No. Weight
Range Range approx. Range Range approx.
(screw/ (screw/
spring) spring)
A A kg A A kg
Frame Size S00: For mounting directly to 3RT201 contactors Frame Size S2: For mounting directly to
or for stand-alone installation 3RT203 contactors 4)
0.11 - 0.16 3RU2116-0A•• 1.4 - 2 3RU2116-1B•• 22 - 32 3RU2136-4E†† 47 - 57 3RU2136-4Q††
0.14 - 0.2 3RU2116-0B•• 1.8 - 2.5 3RU2116-1C•• 28 - 40 3RU2136-4F†† 54 - 65 3RU2136-4J††
0.13/0.15 0.34
0.18 - 0.25 3RU2116-0C•• 2.2 - 3.2 3RU2116-1D•• 36 - 45 3RU2136-4G†† 62 - 73 3RU2136-4K††
0.22 - 0.32 3RU2116-0D•• 2.8 - 4 3RU2116-1E•• 40 - 50 3RU2136-4H†† 70 - 80 3RU2136-4R††
0.28 - 0.4 3RU2116-0E•• 3.5 - 5 3RU2116-1F•• Frame Size S3: For mounting directly to
0.35 - 0.5 3RU2116-0F•• 4.5 - 6.3 3RU2116-1G•• 3RT204 contactors 4)
0.13/0.15 28 - 40 3RU2146-4F†† 57 - 75 3RU2146-4K††
0.45 - 0.63 3RU2116-0G•• 5.5 - 8 3RU2116-1H••
0.55 - 0.8 3RU2116-0H•• 7 - 10 3RU2116-1J•• 36 - 50 3RU2146-4H†† 70 - 90 3RU2146-4L††
0.7 - 1 3RU2116-0J•• 9 - 12.5 3RU2116-1K•• 45 - 63 3RU2146-4J†† 80 - 1005) 3RU2146-4M††
0.9 - 1.25 3RU2116-0K•• 11 - 16 3RU2116-4A•• 0.13/0.15
1.1 - 1.6 3RU2116-1A•• 1) Not available for size S0 3RU212 with current setting range below 14 A.
Frame Size S0: For mounting directly to 3RT202 contactors 2) Size S00 and S0: main and auxiliary conductor terminals are spring-type.
or for stand-alone installation 3) Size S2 and S3 auxiliary terminals are spring-type only. Main conductor
1.8 - 2.5 3RU2126-1C•• 11 - 16 3RU2126-4A•• terminals are screw.
2.2 - 3.2 3RU2126-1D•• 14 - 20 3RU2126-4B•• 4) 3RU Overloads in S2 and S3 frame are available preassembled with a
0.16/0.22
2.8 - 4 3RU2126-1E•• 17 - 22 3RU2126-4C•• terminal bracket for standalone mounting. S2 and S3 overloads can also
3.5 - 5 3RU2126-1F•• 20 - 25 3RU2126-4D•• be customer assembled to the terminal bracket (see Accessories).
4.5 - 6.3 3RU2126-1G•• 23 - 28 3RU2126-4N•• 5) For overload relays > 100A, see electronic overload relays.
5.5 - 8 3RU2126-1H•• 27 - 32 3RU2126-4E••
0.16/0.22
7 - 10 3RU2126-1J•• 30 - 36 3RU2126-4P••
9 - 12.5 3RU2126-1K•• 34 - 40 3RU2126-4F••

3/10 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Overload Relays SIRIUS
Accessories
3RU up to 100 A

Accessories

Design for type Order No. Weight


approx
Size kg
Terminal brackets for stand-alone installation 1)
For separate mounti ng of the overload relay; Screw S00 3RU29 16-3AA01 0.04
panel mount or snapped onto terminals S0 3RU29 26-3AA01 0.05
35 mm standard mounting rail, S2 3RU29 36-3AA01 0.18
size S3 also for 75 mm standard mounting rail S3 3RU29 46-3AA01 0.28
Spring S00 3RU29 16-3AC01 0.04
Loaded S0 3RU29 26-3AC01 0.06
terminals

3
3RU29 36-3AA01
Mechanical RESET

RELAYS
OVERLOAD
Resetting plunger, holder, and former overload reset adapter S00 to S3 3RU29 00-1A 0.038

Pushbuttons with extended stroke S00 to S3 3SU1200-0FB10-0AA0 0.020


IP 65 ∅ 22 mm, 12 mm hub
Extension plungers S00 to S3 3SU1900-0KG10-0AA0 0.004
For compensation of the distance bewteen the pushbutton and
with the unlatching button of the relay
pushbutton,
and reset Complete mechanical reset assembly S00 to S3 3SU1200-0KB10-0AA0 +
3RU29 00-1A extension 3RU1900-1A
Cable release with holder for RESET
For drilled hole ∅ 6.5 mm Length 400 mm S00 to S3 3RU29 00-1B 0.063
in the control panel Length 600 mm S00 to S3 3RU29 00-1C 0.073
max. control panel thickness 8 mm

3RU29 00-1

Module for remote RESET, electrical


Operating range 0.85 to 1.1 × Us S00 to S3
Power consumption AC 80 VA, DC 70 W
ON period 0.2 s to 4 s
AC/DC 24 V to 30 V 3RU19 00-2AB71 0.066
AC/DC 110 V to 127 V 3RU19 00-2AF71 0.066
AC/DC 220 V to 250 V 3RU19 00-2AM71 0.066

3RU19 00-2A.71
Terminal cover
Cover for cable lug S3 3RT19 46-4EA1 0.040
and bar connection

Cover for box terminals S2 3RT29 36-4EA2 0.020


S3 3RT29 46-4EA2 0.025

3RT1946-4EA1

Sealable covers
For covering the rotary setting dials. S00 to S2 3RV29 08-0P 0.100
Order in multiples of 10.

3RV29 08-0P
Tool for opening Spring Loaded terminal connections
Suitable up to a
For all SIRIUS devices with spring-type terminals
• Length: approx. 200 mm; 3RA2908-1A 0.045
3.0 × 0.5 mm (green)

3RA2908-1A

1)
The accessories are identical to those of the 3RB30/3RB31 solid-state overload relays.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/11


Overload Relays SIRIUS
Thermal Overload Relays
3RU21 up to 100 A, CLASS 10

Technical data

Type 3RU21 16 3RU21 26 3RU21 36 3RU21 46


Size S00 S0 S2 S3
Width 45 mm 45 mm 55 mm 70 mm
General data
Release on overload or phase failure
Trip class acc. to IEC 60 947-4-1 CLASS 10 10, 10A 10
Phase failure sensitivity Yes
Overload warning No
Resetting and recovery
Reset possibilities after tripping Manual, remote and automatic RESET 1)
Recovery time on automatic RESET min depending on the level of tripping current and the tripping characteristic
3

on manual RESET min depending on the level of tripping current and the tripping characteristic
on remote RESET min depending on the level of tripping current and the tripping characteristic
Features
OVERLOAD
RELAYS

Indication of status on the device Yes, using the slide "TEST function/ON-OFF indicator"
TEST function Yes
RESET button Yes
STOP button Yes
Safe operation of motors with “increased safety” type of protection
EC type test certificate number according to directive 94/9/EC (ATEX) DMT 98 ATEX G 001 II (2) GD On request

Ambient temperatures
Storage/transport °C –55 to +80 –55 to +80
Operation °C –40 to +70 –40 to +70
Temperature compensation °C up to +60 up to +60
Permissible rated current at Internal cabinet temperature of 60 °C % 100 (over +60°C, 100 (over +60°C,
the current must be reduced) current reduction
is not required)
Internal cabinet temperature of 70 °C % 87 87
Repeat terminals
Repeat coil terminal Yes Not required
Auxiliary switch repeat terminal Yes Not required
Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60529 IP 20 IP 20 2)
Touch protection acc. to IEC 61140 Finger-safe for vertical contact from the front
Finger-safe only with optional terminal covers
Shock resistance (sine) acc. to IEC 60068-2-27 g/ms 15/11 (auxiliary contacts 95/96 and 97/98: 8g/11ms) 8/10
EMC
• Interference immunity Not relevant
• Emitted interference Not relevant
Resistance to extreme climates (humidity) % 90 100
Dimensions see dimensional drawings
Site altitude m Up to 2000; above this on request
Installation angle The permissible installation angles for mounting onto contactors and indi-
vidual mounting are shown in the diagrams. For mounting in the shaded
area, adjustment compensation of 10 % is necessary.
Individual mounting

Contactor + overload relay

Type of installation/mounting Mounting onto contactor/stand-alone installation Direct mounting/


with terminal support (For screw and snap-on stand-alone
mounting onto TH 35 standard mounting rail) installation with
terminal support
(For screw and
snap-on mounting
1) Remote RESET in combination with the appropriate accessories.
onto TH34 standard
2) Terminal compartment: IP 00 degree of protection. mounting rail size;
size S3 also for
TH 75 standard
mounting rail."

3/12 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Overload Relays SIRIUS
Thermal Overload Relays
3RU21 up to 100 A, CLASS 10

Technical data

Type 3RU21 16 3RU21 26 3RU21 36 3RU21 46


Size S00 S0 S2 S3
Width 45 mm 45 mm 55 mm 70 mm
Main circuit
Rated insulation voltage Ui (pollution degree 3) V 690 1000
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 6 8
Rated operational voltage Ue V 690 1000
Type of current DC Yes
AC Yes, frequency range up to 400 Hz
Current setting A 0.11– 0.16 1.8 – 2.5 11-16 18 – 25
to 11 – 16 to 34 – 40 up to 70-80 to 80 – 100

3
Power loss per device (max.) W 4.1...6.3 6.2...7.5 8...14 10 to 16.5
Short-circuit protection With fuse without contactor See selection and ordering data

RELAYS
OVERLOAD
With fuse and contactor See technical data (short-circuit protection with fuses /
circuit-breaker for motor feeders)
Protective separation between main and auxiliary current paths V
Acc. to IEC 60947-1,
• Screw terminals or ring terminal lug connections 440 690: Setting 690 690
ranges <
_ 25 A
• Spring - type terminals 440 440: Setting 690
ranges > 25 A

Connection of the main circuit


Type of connection Screw terminals Screw connec-
tion with box ter-
minal 2)/ bar
connection
Screw terminals
• Terminal screw M3, Pozidriv M4, Pozidriv M6, Pozidriv Hexagon socket
size 2 size 2 size 2 screw 4 mm
• Operating devices mm Ø5 ... 6 Ø5 ... 6 Ø5 ... 6 Ø5 ... 6
• Tightening torque Nm 0.8 to 1.2 2 to 2.5 3 to 4.5 4 to 6
• Conductor cross-section Solid or stranded mm2 2 × (0.5 to 1.5), 2 × (1 to 2.5), 2x(2.5 to 35) 2 × (2.5 to 16)
(min./max.), 1 or 2 wires 2 × (0.75 to 2.5), 2 × (2.5 to 6), 1x(2.5 to 50)
max. 2 x 4 max. 2 ×
(2.5 to 10)
Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 × (0.5 to 1.5), 2 × (1 to 2.5), 2 x (1 to 25) 2 × (2.5 to 35),
2 × (0.75 to 2.5) 2 × (2.5 to 6) 1 x (1 to 35) 1 × (2.5 to 50)
max. 1 x 10
AWG conductor con., solid or stranded AWG 2 x (20 ... 16) 2 x (16 ... 12) 2 x (18 to 2) 2 × (10 to 1/0),
2 x (18 ... 14) 2 x (14 ... 8) 1 × (18 to 1) 1 × (10 to 2/0)
2 x 12
Ribbon cable (No. × width × thickness) mm – – – 2 × (6 × 9 × 0.8)
Bar connection
• Terminal screw – M 6 × 20
• Tightening torque Nm – 4 to 6
• Conductor cross-section Finely stranded with cable lug mm2 – 2 × 70
(min./max.) Stranded with cable lug mm2 – 2 × 70
AWG conductor connections, solid or AWG – 2/0
stranded with cable lug
With connecting bars (max. width) mm – 12
Auxiliary circuit
Main contacts: Number of NO contacts 1
Number of NC contacts 1
Assignment of auxiliary contacts 1 NO for the signal "tripped";
1 NC for disconnecting the contactor
Rated insulation voltage Ui (pollution degree 3) V 690
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 6
Switching capacity of auxiliary contacts
NC for AC Rated operational current Ie at Ue:
AC-14/AC-15 • 24 V A 4
• 120 V A 4
• 125 V A 4
• 230 V A 3
• 400 V A 2
• 600 V A 0.75
• 690 V A 0.75

1) For conductor cross-sections for Cage Clamp 2) The box terminal can be removed. After the
terminals, see "Connection of the auxiliary box terminal has been removed, bar connec-
circuit.” tion and lug connection is possible.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/13


Overload Relays SIRIUS
Thermal Overload Relays
3RU21 up to 100 A, CLASS 10

Technical data

Type 3RU21 16 3RU21 26 3RU21 36 3RU11 46


Size S00 S0 S2 S3
Width 45 mm 45 mm 55 mm 70 mm
NO for AC Rated operational current Ie at Ue:
AC-14/AC-15 • 24 V A 3 3
• 120 V A 3 3
• 125 V A 3 3
• 230 V A 2 2
• 400 V A 1 1
• 600 V A 0.75 0.6
• 690 V A 0.75 0.5
NC, NO for DC Rated operational current Ie at Ue:
DC-13 • 24 V A 1 1
3

• 60 V A On request On request
• 110 V A 0.22 0.22
• 125 V A 0.22 0.22
OVERLOAD
RELAYS

• 220 V A 0.11 0.11


Conventional thermal current Ith A 6 6
Contact reliability (suitable for PLC; 17 V, 5 mA) Yes Yes
Short-circuit protection
With fuse Utilization cat. gL/gG A 6
fast A 10
With miniature circuit-breaker (C characteristic) A 61)
Reliable operational voltage for protective separation V 440
between auxiliary current paths acc. to IEC 60947-1
Connection of the auxiliary circuit
Type of connection Screw terminal or Cage Clamp terminal
Connection characteristics Screw terminals Cage Clamp
terminals
• Terminal screw Pozidrive Size 2 –
• Tightening torque Nm 0.8 to 1.2 – × (0.25 to 2.5)
2
• Conductor cross-sections Solid or stranded mm2 2 × (0.5 to 1.5),
(min./max.), 1 or 2 wires 2 × (0.75 to 2.5)
Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 – 2 × (0.25 to 2.5)
Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 × (0.5 to 1.5), 2 × (0.25 to 1.5)
2 × (0.75 to 2.5)
AWG conductor connections, AWG 2 x (20 to 16) 2 × (20 to 14)
solid or stranded 2 x (18 to 14)

1) Up to Ik ≤ 0.5 kA; ≤ 260 V.

3/14 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Overload Relays SIRIUS
Thermal Overload Relays
3RU21 up to 100 A, CLASS 10

Circuit diagrams

Protection of DC motors

3
1-pole 2-pole

RELAYS
OVERLOAD
3RU21 16 overload relay

3RU21 26 to 3RU21 46 overload relays


RESET
STOP
TEST

-F 95 97

2/T1 4/T2 6/T3 96 98

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/15


Overload Relays SIRIUS
Thermal Overload Relays
3RU21 up to 100 A, CLASS 10

Dimension drawings
Screw connection
Lateral clearance to grounded components: at least 6 mm.
3RU21 16-..B0 3RU21 16-..B1
Size S00 Size S00
75.3 with adapter for installation as a single unit with accessories
73
68 45 79.5
34.9
4.5
30

37.8
45

89.15
87.9
3

77
76
61.7

60.4
OVERLOAD
RELAYS

70 5
5

4.5
3RU21 26-..B. 3RU21 26-..B1
Size S0 Size S0
3RT2...-.B.. (DC-Spule) 107 with adapter for installation as a single unit
3RT2...-.N.. (UC-Spule) 102
3RT2...-.A.. 97 45 94.7
(AC-Spule) 92

35.2
4.5

44.9
43

DCAC
97.1

45

85
108.8
66.7

66.8
84.8

4.5
3RT2...-.A.. 84.4
3RT2...-.B.. (DC-Spule) (AC-Spule) 84.6
3RT2...-.N.. (UC-Spule) 94.6

3RU21 36-..B. 3RU21 46-..B.


Size S2 Size S3
with adapter for installation as a single unit with adapter for installation as a single unit
130
125.1
55.2

55
130.5
91.2
76.5

75.6

95 NC 96 97 NO 98

2/T1 4/T2 6/T3

104.2
114.5

1) For mounting on 35 mm standard mounting rail


(15 mm deep) acc. to EN 50 022 Dimension drawings “Contactor with built-on overload relay” see
or 75 mm standard mounting rail acc. to EN 50023
contactors and contactor combinations.

3/16 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Overload Relays SIRIUS
Thermal Overload Relays
3RU21 up to 100 A, CLASS 10

Dimension drawings
Spring Loaded terminals
Lateral clearance to grounded components: at least 6 mm.
3RU21 16 -..C0 89.4 3RU21 16 -..C1
Size S00 84.4 Size S00 with with adapter for installation as a single unit
36

45 79.2 35
45
4.5

51.45
101.9
70.5

80

3
86.5

104

RELAYS
OVERLOAD
70 5 5

4.5
3RU21 26-..C0 3RU21 26-..C1
Size S0 Size S0 with adapter for installation as a single unit
3RT2...-.B.. (DC-Spule)
3RT2...-.N.. (UC-Spule) 107
102 45 94.7
3RT2...-.A.. 97
(AC-Spule)
92

55.8
132.9

114

DCAC
45 79.5

5
101.6

130
82.6
132.9

125.1
55.2

3RT2...-.A.. 84.4
3RT2...-.B.. (DC-Spule) (AC-Spule) 98.2
3RT2...-.N.. (UC-Spule) 108.2

3RU11 46-..D. 3RU2136-..D.


Size S3 Size S2
55
130.5
91.2
76.5

75.6

95 NC 96 97 NO 98

2/T1 4/T2 6/T3

104.2
114.5

1) For mounting on 35 mm standard mounting rail


(15 mm deep) acc. to EN 50 022
or 75 mm standard mounting rail acc. to EN 50 023

Dimension drawings “Contactor with built-on overload relay” see contactors


and contactor combinations.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/17


Overload Relays SIRIUS
3RB2 / 3RB3 Solid-State Overload Relays
3RB20, 3RB21, 3RB30, 3RB31 up to 630A for standard applications

Overview

The devices are manufactured in accordance with environmen-


tal guidelines and contain environmentally friendly and reusable
materials. They comply with important worldwide standards and
approvals.

Application
Industries
The 3RB2 / 3RB3 solid-state over load relays are suitable for
customers from all industries who want to provide optimum
inverse-time delayed protection of their electrical loads
3

(e.g. motors) under normal and heavy starting conditions


(CLASS 5 to CLASS 30), minimize project completion times,
inventories and power consumption, and optimize plant
OVERLOAD
RELAYS

availability and maintenance management.


Application
Connection for mounting onto contactors: The 3RB2 / 3RB3 solid-state overload relays have been
Optimally adapted in electrical, mechanical and design terms to the designed for the protection of three-phase motors in sinusoidal
contactors. The overload relay can be connected directly to these 50/60 Hz voltage networks. The relays are not suitable for the
contactor using these pins. Stand-alone installation is possible as
an alternative (in conjunction with a terminal bracket for stand-alone protection of single-phase AC or DC loads.
installation).
The 3RU thermal overload relay or the 3RB22/3RB23 solid-
Selector switch for manual/automatic RESET and RESET button: state overload relay can be used for single-phase AC loads.
With this switch you can choose between manual and automatic
RESET. A device set to manual RESET can be reset locally by For DC loads the 3RU thermal overload relays are available.
pressing the RESET button. On the 3RB21 a solid-state remote
is integrated into the unit. Ambient conditions
Switch position indicator and TEST function of the wiring: The devices are insensitive to external influences such as
Indicates a trip and enables the wiring test. shocks, corrosive environments, ageing and temperature
Solid state test: changes.
Enables a test of all important device components and functions.
Motor current setting: For the temperature range from –25 C to +60 °C, the
Setting the device to the rated motor current is easy with the large 3RB2 / 3RB3 solid-state overload relays compensate the
rotary knob. temperature according to IEC 60947-4-1.
Trip class setting/internal ground-fault detection (3RB21 only):
Using the rotary switch you can set the required trip class and activate The 3RB2 / 3RB3 solid-state overload relays are suitable for the
the internal ground-fault detection dependent on the starting conditions. overload protection of explosion-proof motors with "increased
safety" type of protection EEx e according to ATEX guideline
Connecting terminals (removable terminal block for auxiliary circuits): 94/9/EC. The relays meet the requirements of EN 60079-7 (Elec-
The generously sized terminals permit connection of two conductors trical apparatus for potentially explosive atmospheres –
auxiliary circuit can be connected with screw-type terminals or with Increased safety "e").
spring-loaded terminals.
The basic safety and health requirements of ATEX guideline
94/9/EG are fulfilled by compliance with
The 3RB and 3RB solid-state overload relays up to 630 A • EN 60947-1
with internal power supply have been designed for inverse-time
delayed protection of loads with normal and heavy starting • EN 60947-4-1
(see Function) against excessive temperature rise due to over- • EN 60947-5-1
load, phase unbalance or phase failure. An overload, phase un- • EN 60079-14
balance or phase failure result in an increase of the motor current
beyond the set motor rated current. This current rise is detected EU type test certificate for Group II, Category (2) G/D under
by the current transformers integrated into the devices and eval- application. It has the number PTB 09 ATEX 3001.
uated by corresponding solid-state circuits which then output a
pulse to the auxiliary contacts. The auxiliary contacts then switch Accessories
off the load by means of the contactors control circuit. The break
time depends on the ratio between the tripping current and set The following accessories are available for the 3RB2/3RB3
current Ie and is stored in the form of a long-term stable tripping solid-state overload relays:
characteristic (see Characteristic Curves). • One terminal bracket each for the overload relays size S00
In addition to inverse-time delayed protection of loads against and S0 (sizes S2 to S12 can be installed as single units without
excessive temperature rise due to overload, phase unbalance a terminal bracket)
and phase failure, the 3RB21/31 solid-state overload relays also • One mechanical remote RESET module for all sizes
allow internal ground-fault detection (not possible in conjunction
• One cable release for resetting devices which are difficult to
with wye-delta assemblies). This provides protection of loads
access (for all sizes)
against high-resistance short-circuits due to damage to the
insulation material, moisture, condensed water etc. • One sealable cover for all sizes
The "tripped" status is signaled by means of a switch position • Box terminals for sizes S6 and S10/S12
indicator (see Function). Resetting takes place either manually • Terminal covers for sizes S2 to S10/S12
or automatically after the recovery time has elapsed
(see Function).

3/18 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Overload Relays SIRIUS
3RB2 / 3RB3 Solid-State Overload Relays
3RB20, 3RB21, 3RB30, 3RB31 up to 630A for standard applications

Design
Device concept Overload relays in contactor assemblies for
Wye-Delta starting
The 3RB2 / 3RB3 solid-state overload relays are compact
devices, i.e. current measurement (transformer) and the evalua- When overload relays are used in combination with contactor
tion unit are integrated in a single enclosure. assemblies for Wye-Delta starting it must be noted that only
0.58 times the motor current flows through the line contactor.
Mounting options An overload relay mounted onto the line contactor must be set
The 3RB2 / 3RB3 solid-state overload relays are suitable for to 0.58 times the motor current.
direct and space-saving mounting onto 3RT1 / 3RT2 contactors When 3RB21 / 31 solid-state overload relays are used in combi-
and 3RW30/3RW31 soft starters as well as for stand-alone nation with contactor assemblies for Wye-Delta starting, the
installation. For more information on the mounting options, internal ground-fault detection must not be activated.
please see Technical Specifications and Selection and .
Ordering Data Operation with frequency converter

3
Connection technique The 3RB2 / 3RB3 solid-state overload relays are suitable for
frequencies of 50/60 Hz and the associated harmonics. This

RELAYS
OVERLOAD
Main circuit permits the 3RB2 / 3RB3 overload relays to be used on the
All sizes of the 3RB2 / 3RB3 solid-state overload relays can be incoming side of the frequency converter.
connected with screw-type terminals. As an alternative for sizes If motor protection is required on the outgoing side of the
S3 to S10/S12, the main circuits can be connected via the Bus- frequency converter, the 3RN thermistor motor protection
bar. Sizes S2 to S6 of the 3RB20/3RB21 relays are also available devices or the 3RU thermal overload relays are available for
with a straight-through transformer. In this case, the cables of the this purpose.
main circuit are routed directly through the feed-through open-
ings of the relay to the contactor terminals.
Auxiliary circuit
Connection of the auxiliary circuit (removable terminal block) is
possible with either screw terminals or spring-loaded terminals.
For more information on the connection options,
see Technical Specifications and Selection and Ordering Data.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/19


Overload Relays SIRIUS
3RB2 / 3RB3 Solid-State Overload Relays
3RB20, 3RB21, 3RB30, 3RB31 up to 630A for standard applications

Function
Basic functions Recovery time
The 3RB2 / 3RB3 solid-state overload relays are designed for: With the 3RB2 / 3RB3 solid-state overload relays the recovery
• Inverse-time delayed protection of loads from overloading time after inverse-time delayed tripping is between 0.5 and 3
minutes depending on the preloading when automatic RESET
• Inverse-time delayed protection of loads from phase is set. These recovery times allow the load (e.g. motor) to
unbalance cool down.
• Inverse-time delayed protection of loads from phase failure
If the button is set to manual RESET, the 3RB2 / 3RB3 devices
• Protection of loads from high-resistance short-circuits can be reset immediately after inverse-time delayed tripping.
(internal ground-fault detection only with 3RB21 / 31).
After a ground fault trip the 3RB21 / 31 solid-state overload relays
Control circuit (with ground-fault detection activated) can be reset immediately
without a recovery time regardless of the reset mode set.
The 3RB2 / 3RB3 solid-state overload relays have an internal
3

power supply, i.e. no additional supply voltage is required. TEST function


Short-circuit protection With motor current flowing, the TEST button can be used to
OVERLOAD
RELAYS

check whether the relay is working correctly (device/solid-state


Fuses or motor starter protectors must be used for short-circuit
TEST). Current measurement, motor model and trip unit are
protection. For assignments of the corresponding short-circuit
tested. If these components are OK, the device is tripped in
protection devices to the 3RB2 / 3RB3 solid-state overload re-
accordance with the table below. If there is an error, no tripping
lays with/without contactor see Technical Specifications and
takes place.
Selection and Ordering Data.
Trip class Required loading with the Tripping within
Trip classes rated current prior to press-
The 3RB20 / 30 solid-state overload relays are available for ing the test button
normal starting conditions with trip CLASS 10 or for heavy start- CLASS 5 2 min 8s
ing conditions with trip CLASS 20 (fixed setting in each case). CLASS 10 4 min 15 s
The 3RB21 / 31 solid-state overload relays are suitable for normal CLASS 20 8 min 30 s
and heavy starting. The required trip class (CLASS 5, 10, 20 or CLASS 30 12 min 45 s
30) can be adjusted by means of a rotary knob depending on the
current starting condition. Note: The test button must be kept pressed throughout the test.
For details of the trip classes see Characteristic Curves. Testing of the auxiliary contacts and the control current wiring is
possible with the switch position indicator slide. Actuating the
Phase failure protection slide simulates tripping of the relay. During this simulation the NC
The 3RB2 / 3RB3 solid-state overload relays are fitted with contact (95-96) is opened and the NO contact (97-98) is closed.
phase failure protection (see Characteristic Curves) in order to This tests whether the auxiliary circuit has been correctly wired.
minimize temperature rise of the load during single-phase After a test trip the relay is reset by pressing the RESET button.
operation.
Self-monitoring
Phase failure protection is not effective for loads with star-
connection and a grounded neutral point or a neutral point which The 3RB2 / 3RB3 solid-state overload relays have a self-moni-
is connected to a neutral conductor. toring feature, i.e. the devices constantly monitor their own basic
functions and trip if an internal fault is detected.
Setting
Display of operating status
The 3RB2 / 3RB3 solid-state overload relays are set to the
motor rated current by means of a rotary knob. The scale of the The respective operating status of the 3RB2 / 3RB3 solid-state
rotary knob is shown in amps. overload relays is displayed by means of the position of the
marking on the switch position indicator slide. After tripping due
With the 3RB21 / 31 solid-state overload relay it is also possible to overload, phase failure, phase unbalance or ground fault
to select the trip class (CLASS 5, 10, 20 or 30) using a second (ground fault detection possible only with 3RB21 / 31) the marking
rotary knob and to switch the internal ground-fault detection on on the slide is to the left on the "O" mark, otherwise it is on the "I"
and off. mark.
Manual and automatic reset Auxiliary contacts
In the case of the 3RB2 / 3RB3 solid-state overload relays, a The 3RB2 / 3RB3 solid-state overload relays are fitted with an
slide switch can be used to choose between automatic and NO contact for the "tripped" signal, and an NC contact for
manual resetting. switching off the contactor.
If manual reset is set, a reset can be carried out directly on the
device after a trip by pressing the blue RESET button. Resetting
is possible in combination with the mechanical reset options
from the accessories range (see Accessories). As an alternative
to the mechanical RESET options, the 3RB21 / 31 solid-state over-
load relays are equipped with an electrical remote RESET which
may be utilized by applying a voltage of 24 V DC to the terminals
A3 and A4.
If the slide switch is set to automatic RESET, the relay is reset
automatically.
The time between tripping and resetting is determined by the
recovery time.

3/20 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Overload Relays SIRIUS
3RB2 / 3RB3 Solid-State Overload Relays
3RB20, 3RB21, 3RB30, 3RB31 up to 630A for standard applications

Selection and ordering data

Size Order No. Setting range


A
3RB30 16-@RB0 0.1 ... 0.4
3RB30 16-@NB0 0.32 ... 1.25
S00 3RB30 16-@PB0 1 ... 4

3RB30 16-@SB0 3 ... 12

3RB30 26-@RB0

3
0.1 ... 0.4
3RB30 26-@NB0 0.32 ... 1.25
S0 3RB30 26-@PB0 1 ... 4

RELAYS
OVERLOAD
3RB30 26-@SB0 3 ... 12
3RB30 26-@QB0 6 ... 25
3RB30 36-@UB0 12.5 ... 50
S2
3RB30 36-@WB0 20 ... 80
3RB30 46-@UB0 12.5 ... 50
S3
3RB30 46-@XB0 32 ... 115
3RB20 56-@FW2
S6 50 ... 200
3RB20 56-@FC2
3RB20 66-@GC2 55 ... 250
S10/S12
3RB20 66-@MC2 160 ... 630

CLASS 10 1
CLASS 20 2

Size New Order No. Setting range


A
3RB31 13-4RB0 0.1 ... 0.4
3RB31 13-4NB0 0.32 ... 1.25
S00 3RB31 13-4PB0 1 ... 4

3RB31 13-4SB0 3 ... 12

3RB31 23-4RB0 0.1 ... 0.4


3RB31 23-4NB0 0.32 ... 1.25
S0 3RB31 23-4PB0 1 ... 4
3RB31 23-4SB0 3 ... 12
3RB31 23-4QB0 6 ... 25
3RB31 33-4UB0 12.5 ... 50
S2
3RB31 33-4WB0 20 … 80
3RB31 43-4UB0 12.5 ... 50
S3
3RB31 43-4XB0 32 ... 115
3RB21 53-4FW2
S6 50 ... 200
3RB21 53-4FC2
3RB21 63-4GC2 55 ... 250
S10/S12
3RB21 63-4MC2 160 ... 630

Note:

CLASS 5, 10, 20 and 30


can be set on the unit

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/21


Overload Relays SIRIUS
3RB2 / 3RB3 Solid-State Overload Relays
3RB20, 3RB21, 3RB30, 3RB31 up to 630A for standard applications

3RB20 solid-state overload relays


and stand-alone installation2)3), CLASS 10 or CLASS 20 for direct mounting1)2)
Features and technical specifications:
• Overload protection, phase failure protection and unbalance • Manual and automatic RESET
protection • Switch position indicator
• Internal power supply • TEST function and self-monitoring
• Auxiliary contacts 1 NO + 1 NC
Size Set current value Screw Terminal Spring Loaded Terminal Weight per
Contactor4) of the inverse-time delayed Order Number Order Number PU approx.
overload trip

A kg
Size S001)
S00 0.1 … 0.4 3RB30 16- @ RB0 3RB30 16-@RE0 0.172
3

0.32 … 1.25 3RB30 16- @ NB0 3RB30 16-@NE0 0.172


1…4 3RB30 16- @ PB0 3RB30 16-@PE0 0.172
OVERLOAD
RELAYS

3 … 12 3RB30 16- @ SB0 3RB30 16-@SE0 0.172


4 … 16 3RB30 16- @ TB0 3RB30 16-@TE0 0.172
3RB30 16-1RB0
Size S01)
S0 0.1 … 0.4 3RB30 26- @ RB0 3RB30 26-@RE0 0.250
0.32 … 1.25 3RB30 26- @ NB0 3RB30 26-@NE0 0.250
1…4 3RB30 26- @ PB0 3RB30 26-@PE0 0.250
3 … 12 3RB30 26- @ SB0 3RB30 26-@SE0 0.250
6 … 25 3RB30 26- @ QB0 3RB30 26-@QE0 0.250
10 … 40 3RB30 26- @ VB0 3RB30 26-@VE0 0.250
3RB30 26-1QB0
Size S2 1)3)5)
S2 12 … 50 with busbar 3RB30 36- @ UB0 3RB30 36-@UD0 0.360
with pass 3RB30 36- @ UW1 3RB30 36-@UX1 0.230
through CT’s
20 … 80 with busbar 3RB30 36- @ WB0 3RB30 36-@WD0 0.360
with pass 3RB30 36- @ WW1 3RB30 36-@WX1 0.230
through CT’s
3RB30 36-1UB0
Size S3 1)3)5)
S3 12.5 … 50 with busbar 3RB30 46- @ UB0 3RB30 46-@UD0 0.560
with pass 3RB30 46- @ UW1 3RB30 46-@UX1 0.450
through CT’s

32 … 115 with busbar 3RB30 46- @ XB0 3RB30 46-@XD0 0.560


with pass
3RB30 46- @ XW1 3RB30 46-@XX1 0.450
3RB30 46-1XB0 through CT’s
Size S6 2)5)

S6 50 … 200 with busbar 3RB20 56- @FC2 3RB20 56-@FF2 1.030


with pass 3RB20 56- @ FW2 3RB20 56-@FX2 0.690
through CT’s

3RB20 56-1FW2
Size S10/S122)
S10/S12 55 … 250 with busbar 3RB20 66- @ GC2 3RB20 66-@GF2 1.820
and size 14 160 … 630 3RB20 66- @ MC2 3RB20 66-@MF2 1.820
with busbar
(3TF68/
3TF69)

2 Class 20 2 Class 20
3RB20 66-1MC2
1 Class 10 1 Class 10

1) The relays with an Order No. ending with "0" are designed for direct mounting For accessories, see pages 3/49-3/50.
to the contactor. With the matching terminal brackets (see Accessories) the For description, see pages 3/18-3/20.
sizes S00 to S3 can also be installed as stand-alone units.
For technical data, see pages 3/24-3/29.
2) The relays with an Order No. ending with "2" are designed for direct
mounting and stand-alone installation. For 3TF68/3TF69 contactors, direct
For dimension drawings, see page 3/30.
mounting is not possible. For schematic diagrams, see page 3/31.
3) The relays with an Order No. ending with "1" are designed for stand-alone
installation.
4) Observe maximum rated operational current of the devices.
5) The relays with an Order No. with "X" in 10th position are equipped with a
straight-through transformer.

3/22 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Overload Relays SIRIUS
3RB2 / 3RB3 Solid-State Overload Relays
3RB20, 3RB21, 3RB30, 3RB31 up to 630A for standard applications

3RB21 / 3RB31 solid-state overload relays for direct mounting1)2)


and stand-alone installation2)3), CLASS 5, 10, 20 and 30 adjustable
Features and technical specifications:
• Overload protection, phase failure protection and unbalance • Manual and automatic RESET
protection • Electrical remote RESET integrated
• Internal ground fault detection (activatable) • Switch position indicator
• Internal power supply • TEST function and self-monitoring
• Auxiliary contacts 1 NO + 1 NC
Size Set current value Screw Terminal Spring Loaded Terminal Weight per PU
Contactor4) of the inverse-time delayed Order Number Order Number approx.
overload trip

A kg
Size S001)

3
S00 0.1 … 0.4 3RB31 13-4RB0 3RB31 13-4RE0 0.175
0.32 … 1.25 3RB31 13-4NB0 3RB31 13-4NE0 0.175

RELAYS
OVERLOAD
1…4 3RB31 13-4PB0 3RB31 13-4PE0 0.175
3 … 12 3RB31 13-4SB0 3RB31 13-4SE0 0.175
4 … 16 3RB31 13-4TB0 3RB31 13-4TE0 0.175
3RB31 13-4RB0
Size S01)
S0 0.1 … 0.4 3RB31 23-4RB0 3RB31 23-4RE0 0.215
0.32 … 1.25 3RB31 23-4NB0 3RB31 23-4NE0 0.215
1…4 3RB31 23-4PB0 3RB31 23-4PE0 0.215
3 … 12 3RB31 23-4SB0 3RB31 23-4SE0 0.215
6 … 25 3RB31 23-4QB0 3RB31 23-4QE0 0.215
3RB31 23-4QB0 10 … 40 3RB31 23-4VB0 3RB31 23-4VE0 0.215
Size S21)3)5)
S2 12 … 50 with busbar 3RB31 33-4UB0 3RB31 33-4UD0 0.360
with pass 3RB31 33-4UW1 3RB31 33-4UX1 0.230
through CT’s
20 … 80 with busbar 3RB31 33-4WB0 3RB31 33-4WD0 0.360
with pass 3RB31 33-4WW1 3RB31 33-4WX1 0.230
3RB31 33-4WB0 through CT’s
Size S31)3)5)
S3 12.5 … 50 with busbar 3RB31 43-4UB0 3RB31 43-4UD0 0.560
with pass 3RB31 43-4UW1 3RB31 43-4UX1 0.450
through CT’s
32 … 115 with busbar 3RB31 43-4XB0 3RB31 43-4XD0 0.560
with pass 3RB31 43-4XW1 3RB31 43-4XX1 0.450
through CT’s
3RB31 43-4XB0
Size S62)5)
S6 50 … 200 with busbar 3RB21 53-4FC2 3RB21 53-4FF2 1.030
with pass 3RB21 53-4FW2 3RB21 53-4FX2 0.690
through CT’s

3RB21 53-4FC2
Size S10/S122)
S10/S12 55 … 250 3RB21 63-4GC2 3RB21 63-4GF2 1.820
and size 14 160 … 630 3RB21 63-4MC2 3RB21 63-4MF2 1.820
(3TF68/
3TF69)

3RB21 63-4MC2
1) The relays with an Order No. ending with "0" are designed for direct mounting For accessories, see pages 3/49-3/50.
to the contactor. With the matching terminal brackets (see Accessories) the For description, see pages 3/18-3/21.
sizes S00 to S3 can also be installed as stand-alone units.
For technical data, see pages 3/24-3/29.
2) The relays with an Order No. ending with "2" are designed for direct
mounting and stand-alone installation. For 3TF68/3TF69 contactors, direct For dimension drawings, see page 3/30.
mounting is not possible. For schematic diagrams, see page 3/31.
3) The relays with an Order No. ending with "1" are designed for stand-alone
installation.
4) Observe maximum rated operational current of the devices.
5) The relays with an Order No. with "X" in 10th position are equipped with a
straight-through transformer.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/23
Overload Relays SIRIUS
3RB2 / 3RB3 Solid-State Overload Relays
3RB20, 3RB21, 3RB30, 3RB31 up to 630A for standard applications

Technical specifications
Type 3RB30 16, 3RB30 26, 3RB30 36 3RB30 46, 3RB30 56, 3RB30 66,
3RB31 13 3RB31 23 3RB31 33 3RB31 43 3RB31 53 3RB31 63
Size S00 S0 S2 S3 S6 S10/S12
Width 45 mm 45 mm 55 mm 70 mm 120 mm 145 mm
General data
Trips in the event of Overload, phase failure, and phase unbalance
+ ground fault (for 3RB31 only)
Trip class according to IEC 60947-4-1 CLASS 3RB30: 10E, 20E;
3RB31: 5E, 10E, 20E or 30E adjustable
Phase failure sensitivity Yes
Overload warning No
3

Reset and recovery


Manual and automatic RESET, 3RB31 has 3RB20: Manual and automatic RESET;
• Reset options after tripping an integrated connection for electrical 3RB21: Manual, automatic and remote RESET
remote RESET (24 V DC)
OVERLOAD
RELAYS

• Recovery time
- For automatic RESET min. Appox. 3 min Appox. 3 min
- For manual RESET min. Immediately Immediately
- For remote RESET min. Immediately Immediately
Features
• Display of operating status on device Yes, by means of switch position indicator slide
• TEST function Yes, test of electronics by pressing the button Test
Test of auxiliary contacts and wiring of control current circuit by actuating
the switch position indicator slide/self-monitoring
• RESET button Yes
• STOP button No
PTB 09 ATEX 3001 On PTB 09 ATEX 3001
Explosion protection – Safe operation of motors
II (2) G [Ex e] [Ex d] [Ex px] request II (2) G [Ex e] [Ex d] [Ex px]
with"Increased safety" type of protection
II (2) G [Ex t] [Ex p] II (2) G [Ex t] [Ex p]
EC type test certificate number according to directive 94/9/EC (ATEX)
Ambient temperatures
• Storage/transport °C -40 ... +80
• Operation °C -25 ... +60
• Temperature compensation °C +60
• Permissible rated current at
- Temperature inside control cabinet 60 °C, stand-alone installation % — 100 100 100 or 902)
- Temperature inside control cabinet 60 °C, mounted on contactor % 100 100 70 70
- Temperature inside control cabinet 70 °C % On request On request
Repeat terminals
• Coil repeat terminal Yes Not required
• Auxiliary contact repeat terminal Yes Not required
Degree of protection according to IEC 60529 IP20 3) IP203)
Touch protection according to IEC 61140 Finger-safe for vertical contact from the front Finger-safe, Finger-safe
for busbar with cover
connection
with cover
Shock resistance with sine according to IEC 60068-2-27 g/ms 15/11 (signaling contact 15/11 (signaling 15/11 (signaling contact
97/98 in position contact 97/98 in 97/98 in position
"tripped": 9g/ms) "Tripped" position: "tripped": 4 g/11ms)
8 g/11ms)
Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) – Interference immunity
• Conductor-related interference
- Burst according to IEC 61000-4-4 kV 2 (power ports), 1 (signal ports)
(corresponds to degree of severity 3)
- Surge according to IEC 61000-4-5 kV 2 (line to earth), 1 (line to line)
(corresponds to degree of severity 3)
• Electrostatic discharge according to IEC 61000-4-2 kV 8 (air discharge), 6 (contact discharge)
(corresponds to degree of severity 3)
• Field-related interference according to IEC 61000-4-3 V/m 10
(corresponds to degree of severity 3)
Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) – Degree of severity B according to EN 55011 (CISPR 11) and EN 55022 (CISPR 22)
Emitted interference
Resistance to extreme climates – air humidity % 95 100
Dimensions See dimensional drawings
Installation altitude above sea level m Up to 2000
Mounting position Any
Type of mounting Direct mounting/stand-alone installation Direct mounting /
with terminal support Stand-alone installation
1) Permissible rated current in case of heavy starting 2) 90 % for relay with current setting range 160A to 630A
Size S0 at 10 A up to 40 A 3) Terminal compartment: degree of protection IP00.
- CLASS 20, Ie max = 32 A
- CLASS 30, Ie max = 25 A

3/24 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Overload Relays SIRIUS
3RB2 / 3RB3 Solid-State Overload Relays
3RB20, 3RB21, 3RB30, 3RB31 up to 630A for standard applications

Type 3RB30 16, 3RB30 26, 3RB30 36, 3RB30 46,


3RB31 13 3RB31 23 3RB31 33 3RB31 43
Size S00 S0 S2 S3
Width 45 mm 45 mm 55 mm 70 mm
Main circuit
Rated insulation voltage Ui V 690 690 690 1000
(pollution degree 3)
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 6 6 6/8 8
Rated operational voltage Ue V 690 690 690 1000
Type of current
• Direct current No
• Alternating current Yes, 50/60 Hz ± 5%
Set current A 0.1 ... 0.4 to 0.1 ... 0.4 to 12.5 ... 50 12.5 ... 50 to
4 ... 16 10... 40 and 20 to 80 25 ... 100

3
Power loss per unit (max.) W 0.05 ... 0.2 0.05
Short-circuit protection

RELAYS
OVERLOAD
- With fuse without contactor See Selection and Ordering Data
- With fuse and contactor See Technical Specifications (short-circuit protection with fuses for motor feeders)
Protective separation between main and auxiliary V 690 for grounded networks, otherwise 600 V
conducting path according to IEC 60947-1 (pollution degree 2)
Connection for main circuit
Electrical connection version Screw terminal Screw terminal Screw terminal Screw terminal
with box terminal /

Screw terminal
• Terminal screw M3, Pozidriv size 2 M3, Pozidriv size 2 M4, Pozidriv size 2 M8, 4 mm Allen screw
• Tightening torque Nm 0.8 ... 1.2 2 ... 2.5 2 ... 2.5 4 ... 6
• Conductor cross-sections (min./max.)
- Solid or stranded mm2 2 × (0.5 ... 1.5)3) 2 × (1 ... 2.5) 3) 1 × (1 ... 50) 2 × (2.5 ... 16)
2 × (0.75 ... 2.5)3) 2 × (2.5 ... 10) 2 × (1 ... 35)
2 × (0.05 ... 4)3) (Solid or Stranded)
- Finely stranded with end sleeve (DIN 46228 T1) mm 2 2 × (0.5 ... 1.5)3) 2 × (1 ... 2.5) 3) 2 × (1 ... 25), 2 × (2.5 ... 35),
2 × (0.75 ... 2.5)3) 2 × (2.5 ... 6)3) 1 × (1 ... 35) 1 × (2.5 ... 50)
max. 1 x 10
- Stranded m m2 -- 2 × (10 ... 50),
1 × (10 ... 70)

- AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 2 × (20 ... 16)3) 2 × (16 ... 12)3) 2 × (18 ... 2) 2 × (10 ... 1/0),
2 × (18 ... 14)3) 2 × (14 ... 8)3) 1 × (18 ... 1) 2 × (10 ... 2/0)
2 × 12

- Ribbon cable conductors mm -- 2 × (6 × 9 × 0.8)


(number x width x circumference)
Busbar connections
• Terminal screw -- M 6 × 20
• Tightening torque Nm -- 4 ... 6
• Conductor cross-section (min./max.)
- Finely stranded with cable lug mm2 -- 2 × 70
- Stranded with cable lug m m2 -- 3 × 70
- AWG connections, solid or stranded, with cable lug AWG -- 2/0
- With connecting bar (max. width) mm -- 12
Straight-through transformers
• Diameter of opening mm – 15 18

1) For version with straight-through transformer up to 1000 VAC. 3) If two different conductor cross-sections are connected
2) For version with straight-through transformer up to 8 kV. to one clamping point, both cross-sections must lie in
the range specified.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/25


Overload Relays SIRIUS
3RB2 /3RB3 Solid-State Overload Relays
3RB20, 3RB21, 3RB30, 3RB31 up to 630A for standard applications

Type 3RB20 56, 3RB20 66,


3RB21 53 3RB21 63
Size S6 S10/S12
Width 120 mm 145 mm
Main circuit
Rated insulation voltage Ui (pollution degree 3) V 1000
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 8
Rated operational voltage Ue V 1000
Type of current
• Direct current No
• Alternating current Yes, 50/60 Hz ± 5 (other frequencies on request)
Set current A 50 ... 200 55 ... 250 to
160 ... 630
Power loss per unit (max.) W 0.05
3

Short-circuit protection
- With fuse without contactor See Selection and Ordering Data
OVERLOAD
RELAYS

- With fuse and contactor See Technical Specifications (short-circuit protection with fuses for motor feeders)
Safe isolation between main V 6901)
and auxiliary conducting path according to IEC 60947-1
Connection for main circuit
Electrical connection version Screw terminal with box terminal/ Screw terminal
Bus connection / with box terminal/
Straight-through transformer Bus connection
Screw terminal
• Terminal screw 4 mm Allen screw 5 mm Allen screw
• Tightening torque Nm 10 ... 12 20 ... 22
• Conductor cross-sections (min./max.), 1 or 2 conductors
- Solid mm2 --

- Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 With 3RT19 55-4G box terminal: 2 × (50 ... 185),
2 × (1 × max. 50, 1 × max. 70), front clamping point only:
1 × (10 ... 70) 1 × (70 ... 240)
With 3RT19 56-4G box terminal: rear clamping point only:
2 × (1 × max. 95, 1 × max. 120), 1 × (120 ... 185)
1 × (10 ... 120)
- Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 With 3RT19 55-4G box terminal: 2 × (50 ... 185),
2 × (1 × max. 50, 1 × max. 70), front clamping point only:
1 × (10 ... 70) 1 × (70 ... 240)
With 3RT19 56-4G box terminal: rear clamping point only:
2 × (1 × max. 95, 1 × max. 120), 1 × (120 ... 185)
1 × (10 ... 120)
2
- Stranded mm With 3RT19 55-4G box terminal: 2 × (70 ... 240),
2 × (max. 70), front clamping point only:
1 × (16 ... 70) 1 × (95 ... 300)
With 3RT19 56-4G box terminal: rear clamping point only:
2 × (max. 120), 1 × (120 ... 240)
1 × (16 ... 120)
- AWG conductors, solid or stranded AWG With 3RT19 55-4G box terminal: 2 × (2/0 ... 500 kcmil),
2 × (max. 1/0), front clamping point only:
1 × (6 ... 2/0) 1 × (3/0 ... 600 kcmil)
With 3RT19 56-4G box terminal: rear clamping point only:
2 × (max. 3/0), 1 × (250 kcmil ... 500 kcmil)
1 × (6 ... 250 kcmil)
- Ribbon cable conductors mm With 3RT19 55-4G box terminal: 2 × (20 × 24 × 0.5),
(number x width x circumference) 2 × (6 × 15.5 × 0.8), 1 × (6 × 9 × 0.8 ... 20 × 24 × 0.5)
1 × (3 × 9 × 0.8 ... 6 × 15.5 × 0.8)
With 3RT19 56-4G box terminal:
2 × (10 × 15.5 × 0.8),
1 × (3 × 9 × 0.8 ... 10 × 15.5 × 0.8)
Busbar connections
• Terminal screw M 8 × 25 M 10 × 30
• Tightening torque Nm 10 ... 14 14 ... 24
• Conductor cross-section (min./max.)
- Finely stranded with cable lug m m2 16 ... 952) 50 ... 2403)
- Stranded with cable lug m m2 25 ... 1202) 70 ... 2403)
- AWG connections, solid or stranded, with cable lug AWG 4 ... 250 kcmil 2/0 ... 500 kcmil
- With connecting bar (max. width) mm 15 25
Straight-through transformers
• Diameter of opening mm 24.5 --
• Conductor cross-section (max.)
2
- N YY mm 120 --
- H07RN-F mm2 70 --
1) For grounded networks, otherwise 600 V. 3) When connecting cable lugs according to DIN 46234 for conductor cross-
2) When connecting cable lugs according to DIN 46235, use the sections from 240 mm2 as well as DIN 46235 for conductor cross-sections
3RT19 56-4EA1 terminal cover for conductor cross-sections from 185 mm2, use the 3RT19 56-4EA1 terminal cover to ensure phase
from 95 mm2 to ensure phase spacing. spacing.

3/26 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Overload Relays SIRIUS
3RB2 / 3RB3 Solid-State Overload Relays
3RB20, 3RB21, 3RB30, 3RB31 up to 630A for standard applications

Type 3RB30 16, 3RB30 26, 3RB30 36, 3RB30 46, 3RB30 56, 3RB30 66,
3RB31 13 3RB31 23 3RB31 33 3RB31 43 3RB31 53 3RB31 63
Size S00 S0 S2 S3 S6 S10/S12
Width 45 mm 45 mm 55 mm 70 mm 120 mm 145 mm
Auxiliary circuit
Number of NO contacts 1
Number of NC contacts 1
Auxiliary contacts – assignment 1 NO for the signal "tripped",
1 NC for switching off the contactor
Rated insulation voltage Ui (pollution degree 3) V 300
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 4
Auxiliary contacts – Contact rating
• NC contact with alternating current AC-14/AC-15
Rated operational current Ie at Ue:

3
- 24 V A 4
- 120 V A 4

RELAYS
OVERLOAD
- 125 V A 4
- 250 V A 3

• NO contact with alternating current AC-14/AC-15:


Rated operational current Ie at Ue:
- 24 V A 4
- 120 V A 4
- 125 V A 4
- 250 V A 3
1)
• NC, NO contact with direct current DC-13:
Rated operational current Ie at Ue:
- 24 V A 2
- 60 V A 0.55
- 110 V A 0.3
- 125 V A 0.3
- 250 V A 0.11
• Continuous thermal current Ith A 5
• Contact reliability Yes
(suitability for PLC control; 17 V, 5 mA)
Short-circuit protection
• With fuse
- gL/gG operational class A 6
Ground-fault protection (only 3RB31) The information refers to sinusoidal residual currents at 50/60 Hz.
• Tripping value I∆ > 0.75 × Imotor
• Operating range I Lower current setting value < Imotor < 3.5 × upper current setting value
• Response time ttrip (in steady-state condition) s <1
Integrated electrical remote RESET (only 3RB31)
Connecting terminals A3, A4 24 V DC, max. 200 mA for approx. 20 ms, then < 10 mA
Protective separation between main V 300
and auxiliary conducting path according to IEC 60947-1
CSA, UL, and UR rated data
Auxiliary circuit – switching capacity 3RB30: B600, R300 B300, R300
3RB31: B300, R300
Connection of the auxiliary circuit
Connection type Screw terminal or spring-loaded terminals
Screw terminal
• Terminal screw Pozidriv size 2
• Tightening torque Nm 0.8 ... 1.2
• Conductor cross-sections (min./max.), 1 or 2 conductors
- Solid or stranded mm2 1 × (0.5 ... 4), 2 × (0.5 ... 2.5)
- F inely stranded with end sleeve mm2 1 × (0.5 ... 2.5), 2 × (0.5 ... 1.5)
- AWG conductors, solid or stranded AWG 2 × (20 ... 14)
Spring-loaded terminals
• Conductor cross-sections (min./max.), 1 or 2 conductors
- So l i d mm2 2 × (0.25 ... 1.5)
- Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 --
- F inely stranded with end sleeve mm 2 2 × (0.25 ... 1.5)
- Stranded m m2 2 × (0.25 ... 1.5)
- AWG conductors, solid or stranded AWG 2 × (24 ... 16)

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/27


Overload Relays SIRIUS
3RB2 / 3RB3 Solid-State Overload Relays
3RB20, 3RB21, 3RB30, 3RB31 up to 630A for standard applications

Short-circuit protection with fuses for motor starters


For short-circuit currents up to 50 kA at 400 to 690 V
Overload relays Contactor CLASS 690 V
5 and 10 20 30 Fuse links1)
LV HRC Type 3NA
DIAZED Type 5SB
NEOZED Type 5SE
gL/gG operational class
Rated operational current Ie AC-3 in A at Type of coordination2)
Setting range Type 400 V 500 V 690 V 400 V 500 V 690 V 400 V 500 V 690 V 1 2
Size S00
0.1 ... 0.4 A 3RT20 15 0.4 0.4 0.4 0.4 0.4 0.4 0.4 0.4 0.4 35 4
0.32 ... 1.25 A 3RT20 15 1.25 1.25 1.25 1.25 1.25 1.25 1.25 1.25 1.25 35 6
3

1 ... 4 A 3RT20 15 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 35 20
3RT20 16 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 35 20
OVERLOAD
RELAYS

3RT20 17 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 35 20
4 ... 16 A 3RT20 16 9 6.5 5.2 9 6.5 5.2 9 6.5 5.2 35 20
3RT20 17 12 9 6.3 10 9 6.3 9 9 6.3 35 20
3RT20 18 16 12.4 8.9 12.9 11.6 8.1 11.6 11.6 8.1 50 25
Size S0
3 ... 12 A 3RT20 23 9 6.5 5.2 9 6.5 5.2 -- -- -- 63 25
3RT20 24 12 12 9 12 12 9 12 12 9 63 25
3RT20 25 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 63 25
10 ... 40 3RT20 24 12 12 9 12 12 9 12 12 9 63 25
3RT20 25 17 17 13 16 16 13 14 14 13 63 25
3RT20 26 25 18 13 16 16 13 14 14 13 100 35
3RT20 27 32 32 21 18.6 18.6 15.1 16.2 16.2 15.1 125 50
3RT20 28 38 32 21 22.4 22.4 18.2 19.6 19.6 18.2 125 50
Size S2
12.5 ... 50 A 3RT20 35 40 40 24 40 40 24 36 36 36 160 80
3RT20 36 50 50 24 45 45 24 38 38 24 160 80
3RT20 37 50 50 47 48 48 47 42 42 42 250 125
3RT20 38 50 50 50 49 49 49 43 43 43 250 160
20 ... 80 A 3RT20 35 40 40 24 40 40 24 36 36 36 160 80
3RT20 36 50 50 24 45 45 24 38 38 24 160 80
3RT20 37 65 65 47 48 48 47 42 42 42 250 125
3RT20 38 80 80 58 49 49 49 43 43 43 250 160
Size S3
12.5 ... 50 A 3RT20 45 50 50 47 49 49 47 41.7 41.7 41.7 200 125
3RT20 46 50 50 50 50 50 50 45 45 45 200 160
32 ... 115 A 3RT20 45 65 65 47 49 49 47 41.7 41.7 41.7 200 125
3RT20 46 80 80 58 53 53 53 45 45 45 200 160
3RT20 47 95 95 58 59 59 58 50 50 50 200 160
3RT10 54 100 100 100 81.7 81.7 81.7 69 69 69 355 315
3RT10 55 -- -- -- 100 100 100 90 90 90 355 315
Size S6
50 ... 200 A 3RT10 54 115 115 115 81.7 81.7 81.7 69 69 69 355 315
3RT10 55 150 150 150 107 107 107 90 90 90 355 315
3RT10 56 185 185 170 131 131 131 111 111 111 355 315
Size S10/S12
55 ... 250 A 3RT10 64 225 225 225 160 160 160 135 135 135 500 400
3RT10 65 250 250 250 188 188 188 159 159 159 500 400
3RT10 66 250 250 250 213 213 213 180 180 180 500 400
160 ... 630 A 3RT10 64 225 225 225 160 160 160 -- -- -- 500 400
3RT10 65 265 265 265 188 188 188 -- -- -- 500 400
3RT10 66 300 300 280 213 213 213 180 180 180 500 400
3RT10 75 400 400 400 284 284 284 240 240 240 630 400
3RT10 76 500 500 450 355 355 355 300 300 300 630 500
3RT12 64 225 225 225 225 225 225 173 173 173 500 500
3RT12 65 265 265 265 265 265 265 204 204 204 500 500
3RT12 66 300 300 300 300 300 300 231 231 231 500 500
3RT12 75 400 400 400 400 400 400 316 316 316 800 800
3RT12 76 500 500 500 500 500 500 385 385 385 800 800
3TF683) 630 630 630 440 440 440 376 376 376 800 5004)
3TF693) 630 630 630 572 572 572 500 500 500 800 6304)
1) Please observe operational voltage. Type of coordination 2: the contactor or starter must not endanger
2) Coordination and short-circuit equipment according to EN 60947-4-1: persons or the installation in the event of a short-circuit.
Type of coordination 1: the contactor or starter must not endanger They must be suitable for further operation. There is a risk of contact welding.
persons or the installation in the event of a short-circuit. 3) Contactor cannot be mounted.
They do not need to be suitable for further operation without repair and the 4) Please ensure that the maximum AC-3 operational current has sufficient
renewal of parts. safety clearance from the rated current of the fuses.

3/28 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Overload Relays SIRIUS
3RB2 / 3RB3 Solid-State Overload Relays
3RB20, 3RB21, 3RB30, 3RB31 up to 630A for standard applications

Characteristic curves
The tripping characteristics show the relationship between the Tripping characteristics for 3-pole loads
tripping time and tripping current as multiples of the set current
Ie and are given for symmetrical three-pole and two-pole loads 1000
NSB0_01525
from the cold state. 800
600
The smallest current used for tripping is called the minimum trip- 400
ping current. According to IEC 60947-4-1, this current must be

Tripping time
s
within specified limits. The limits of the total tripping current for 200
the 3RB20/3RB21 solid-state overload relays for symmetrical
three-pole loads are between 105 % and 120 % of the set cur-
rent. 100
80
The tripping characteristic starts with the minimum tripping 60
current and continues with higher tripping currents based on the

3
40
characteristics of the so-called trip classes (CLASS 10,
CLASS 20 etc.). The trip classes describe time intervals within 20

RELAYS
OVERLOAD
which the overload relays have to trip with 7.2 times the set CLASS 30
current Ie from the cold state for symmetrical three-pole loads. CLASS 20
10
The tripping times according to IEC 60947-4-1, tolerance band 8
E, are as follows for: 6 CLASS 10
4
Trip class Tripping time CLASS 5
CLASS 5 3…5s 2
CLASS 10 5 … 10 s
CLASS 20 10 … 20 s 1
0,6 1 2 4 6 8 10× e
CLASS 30 20 … 30 s Tripping current

The tripping characteristic for a three-pole overload relay from Illustration 1


the cold state (see illustration 1) only apply if all three phases are
simultaneously loaded with the same current. In the event of a Tripping characteristics for 2-pole loads
phase failure the 3RB20/3RB21 solid-state overload relays 1000
switch off the contactor more quickly in order to minimize heating 800 NSB0_01526

of the load in accordance with the tripping characteristic for two- 600
pole loads from the cold state (see illustration 2). With phase 400
Tripping time

unbalance the devices switch off depending on the reason for s


the unbalance between the two characteristic curves. 200
Compared with a cold load, a load at operating temperature
obviously has a lower temperature reserve. The tripping time of 100
the 3RB2/3RB3 solid-state overload relays is reduced there- 80
fore to about 30 % when loaded with the set current Ie for an 60
extended period. 40

20
CLASS 30
10
8 CLASS 20
6
4 CLASS 10

2 CLASS 5

1
0,6 1 2 4 6 8 10× e
Tripping current

Illustration 2
The above illustrations are schematic representations of
characteristic curves.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/29


Overload Relays SIRIUS
3RB2 / 3RB3 Solid-State Overload Relays
3RB20, 3RB21, 3RB30, 3RB31 up to 630A for standard applications

Dimensional drawings
51
48 Ø11 25

65

NSB0_01510

57

147
122
85
45 73
Ø9
125
3RB30 16, 3RB31 13, size S00
NSB0_01518

6
145 61
3

156
3RB20 66, 3RB21 63, size S10/S12
OVERLOAD
RELAYS

71

108.7
103.7
NSB0_01511

55

45 84

3RB30 26, 3RB31 23, size S0

48.8
130
125.1
80.7

95 96 97 98
57

69.9
5.4 26.5 43.4

5
55

22.5

22.5
5
45

55
137.2
98.9
83.3

82.3

95 96 97 98 3RB30 36, 3RB31 33, size S2 with straight-through transformer

2/T1 4/T2 6/T3

103.3
113.1
3RB30 36, 3RB31 33, size S2
51

64
67
86

11
23 Ø6 63
35

NSB0_01515

2
60
Ø5
5
70 119
106

64
89

18
NSB0_01514

30

5 31
70
119
3RB30 46, 3RB31 43, size S3 16 34
3RB30 46, 3RB31 43, size S3 with straight-through transformer
37 17 79
Ø5
62
119
79
95
99

95
79
60

60

NSB0_01516 NSB0_01517

3 5
95 Ø7 95 Ø7 73
5 120 150
120 47
150
3RB20 56, 3RB21 53, size S6 3RB20 56, 3RB21 53, size S6 with straight-through transformer

3/30 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Overload Relays

3RB2 / 3RB3 Solid-State Overload Relays


3RB20, 3RB21, 3RB30, 3RB31 up to 630A for standard applications

Schematics

3RB30 16 overload relays

3
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
3RB30 26 to 3RB20 66 overload relays

3RB31 13 overload relays

3RB31 23 to 3RB21 63 overload relays

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/31
Overload Relays

3RB2 Solid-State Overload Relays


3RB22, 3RB23 for high-feature applications

Overview
The modular, solid-state overload relays with external power
supply type 3RB22 (with monostable auxiliary contacts) and
type 3RB23 (with bistable auxiliary contacts) up to 630 A (up to
820 A possible with a series transformer) have been designed
for inverse-time delayed protection of loads with normal and
heavy starting (see Function) against excessive temperature
rises due to overload, phase unbalance or phase failure. An
overload, phase unbalance or phase failure result in an increase
of the motor current beyond the set motor rated current. This
current rise is detected by means of a current measuring module
and electronically evaluated by a special evaluation module
which is connected to it. The evaluation electronics sends a
signal to the auxiliary contacts. The auxiliary contacts then
3

switch off the load by means of the contactors control circuit. The
break time depends on the ratio between the tripping current
and set current Ie and is stored in the form of a long-term stable
OVERLOAD
RELAYS

tripping characteristic (see Characteristic Curves). The "tripped"


status is signaled by means of a continuous red "Overload" LED.
The LED indicates imminent tripping of the relay due to overload,
3RB22/3RB23 evaluation module phase unbalance or phase failure by flickering when the limit
(1)Green "Ready" LED: current has been violated. This warning can also be used as a
A continuous green light signals that the device is working correctly. signal through auxiliary contacts.
(2)Red "Ground Fault" LED: In addition to the described inverse-time delayed protection of
A continuous red light signals a ground fault.
loads against excessive temperature rise, the 3RB22/3RB23
(3)Red "Thermistor" LED: solid-state overload relays also allow direct temperature moni-
A continuous red light signals an active thermistor trip. toring of the motor windings (full motor protection) by failsafe
(4)Red "Overload" LED: connection of a PTC sensor circuit. With this temperature-depen-
A continuous red light signals an active overload trip; a flickering red dent protection, the loads can be protected against overheating
light signals an imminent trip (overload warning). caused indirectly by reduced coolant flow, for example, which
(5)Motor current and trip class adjustment: cannot be detected by means of the current alone. In the event
Setting the device to the motor current and to the required trip class of overheating, the devices signal the contactor to switch off,
dependent on the starting conditions is easy with the two rotary knobs. and thus the load, by means of the auxiliary contacts. The
(6)Selector switch for manual/automatic RESET: "tripped" status is signaled by means of a continuous red "Ther-
With this switch you can choose between manual and automatic mistor" LED.
RESET.
(7)Test/RESET button: To also protect the loads against high-resistance short-circuits
Enables testing of all important device components and functions, due to damage to the insulation, humidity, condensed water,
plus resetting of the device after a trip when manual RESET is etc., the 3RB22/3RB23 solid-state overload relays offer the pos-
selected. sibility of internal ground fault monitoring in conjunction with a
(8)Connecting terminals (removable terminal block): function expansion module; not possible in conjunction with a
The generously sized terminals permit connection of two conductors contactor assembly for Wye-Delta starting). In the event of a
with different cross-sections for the auxiliary, control and sensor ground fault the 3RB22/3RB23 relays trip instantaneously. The
circuits. Connection is possible with screw-type terminals and alterna- "tripped" status is signaled by means of a red "Ground Fault"
tively with spring-loaded terminals. LED. Signaling through auxiliary contacts is also possible.
(9)3RB29 85 function expansion module:
Enables more functions to be added, e.g. internal ground fault After tripping due to overload, phase unbalance, phase failure,
detection and/or an analog output with corresponding signals. thermistor tripping or ground fault, the relay may be reset
manually or automatically after the recovery time has elapsed
(see Function).
In conjunction with a function expansion module the motor cur-
rent measured by the microprocessor can be output in the form
of an analog signal 4 ... 20 mA DC for operating rotary coil
instruments or for feeding into analog inputs of programmable
logic controllers. With an additional AS-Interface analog module
the current values can also be transferred over the AS-i bus
system.
The devices are manufactured in accordance with environmen-
tal guidelines and contain environmentally friendly and reusable
materials.
They comply with important worldwide standards and
approvals.

3RB29 06 current measuring module

3/32 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Overload Relays

3RB2 Solid-State Overload Relays


3RB22, 3RB23 for high-feature applications

"Increased safety" type of protection EEx e according to


Benefits ATEX guideline 94/9/EC
The most important features and benefits of the 3RB22/3RB23 The 3RB22/3RB23 solid-state overload relays are suitable for the
solid-state overload relays are listed in the overview table overload protection of explosion-proof motors with "increased
(see Overload Relays, General Data). safety" type of protection EEx e. The relays meet the
requirements of EN 60079-7 (Electrical apparatus for potentially
Application explosive atmospheres – Increased safety "e").

Industries When using 3RB23 solid-state overload relays for the protection
of EEx e motors, separate monitoring of the control supply
The 3RB22/3RB23 solid-state overload relays are suitable for voltage is recommended.
customers from all industries who want to provide optimum
inverse-time delayed and temperature-dependent protection of The basic safety and health requirements of ATEX guideline
their electrical loads (e.g. motors) under normal and heavy 94/9/EG are fulfilled by compliance with
starting conditions (CLASS 5 to CLASS 30), minimize project • EN 60947-1

3
completion times, inventories and power consumption, and • EN 60947-4-1
optimize plant availability and maintenance management.
• EN 60947-5-1

RELAYS
OVERLOAD
Application • EN 60079-14
The 3RB22/3RB23 solid-state overload relays have been EU type test certificate for Group II, Category (2) G/D under
designed for the protection of three-phase asynchronous and application. Number on request.
single-phase AC motors.
If single-phase AC motors are to be protected by the Accessories
3RB22/3RB23 solid-state overload relays, the main circuits of
the current measuring modules must be series-connected. The following accessories are available for the 3RB22/3RB23
solid-state overload relays:
Ambient conditions
• A sealable cover for the evaluation module
The devices are insensitive to external influences such as • Box terminal blocks for the current measuring modules size S6
shocks, corrosive environments, ageing and temperature and S10/S12
changes.
• Terminal covers for the current measuring modules size S6
For the temperature range from –25 C to +60 °C, the and S10/S12
3RB22/3RB23 solid-state overload relays compensate the • Push-in lugs for screw (panel) mounting the size S00 to S3
temperature according to IEC 60947-4-1. current measuring modules
Configuration notes for use of the devices below –25 °C or above
+60 °C on request.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/33


Overload Relays

3RB2 Solid-State Overload Relays


3RB22, 3RB23 for high-feature applications

3RB22/3RB23 solid-state overload relays for full motor protection with screw connection or spring-loaded terminals
for stand-alone installation, CLASS 5, 10, 20 and 30 adjustable
Features and technical specifications:
• Overload protection, phase failure protection and unbalance • TEST function and self-monitoring
protection • Internal ground fault detection with function expansion
• External power supply 24 ... 240 V AC/DC module
• Auxiliary contacts 2 NO +2 NC • Screw connection or spring-loaded terminals for auxiliary,
• Manual and automatic RESET control and sensor circuits
• Electrical remote RESET integrated • Input for PTC sensor circuit
• 4 LEDs for operating and status displays • Analog output with function expansion module
Size Version Connection type Order No. Weight per
Contactor PU approx.
kg
3

Evaluation modules
S00 ... S12 Monostable Screw connection 3RB22 83-4AA1 0.300
OVERLOAD
RELAYS

Spring-loaded 3RB22 83-4AC1 0.300


terminals
Bistable Screw connection 3RB23 83-4AA1 0.300
Spring-loaded 3RB23 83-4AC1 0.300
terminals

3RB2. 83-4AA1

3RB2. 83-4AC1
Function expansion modules
– Analog Basic 1 module1) 3RB29 85-2AA0 0.030
Analog output DC 4 ... 20 mA, with
overload warning
Analog Basic 1 GF module1)2) 3RB29 85-2AA1 0.030
Analog output DC 4 ... 20 mA, with
internal ground fault detection and
overload warning
Analog Basic 2 GF module1)2) 3RB29 85-2AB1 0.030
Analog output DC 4 ... 20 mA, with
internal ground fault detection and
ground fault signaling
Basic 1 GF module2) 3RB29 85-2CA1 0.030
with internal ground fault detection
and overload warning
Basic 2 GF module2) 3RB29 85-2CB1 0.030
with internal ground fault detection
and ground fault signaling
1) The analog signal 4 ... 20 mA DC can be used for operating rotary coil Note: Analog input modules, e. g. SM 331, must be configured
instruments or for feeding into analog inputs of programmable logic for 4-wire measuring transducers. In this case the analog input
controllers.
module must not supply current to the analog output of the
2) The following information on ground fault protection refers to sinusoidal 3RB22/ 3RB23 relay.
residual currents at 50/60 Hz:
- With a motor current of between 0.3 and 2 times the set current Ie the unit
will trip at a ground fault current equal to 30% of the set current.
- With a motor current of between 2 and 8 times the set current Ie the unit
will trip at a ground fault current equal to 15% of the set current.
- The trip delay amounts to between 0.5 and 1 second.

For accessories, see page 3/35


For description, see pages 3/32-3/33
For technical data, see pages 3/39-3/44.
For dimension drawings, see pages 3/45-3/46.
For schematic diagrams, see page 3/47.

3/34 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Overload Relays

3RB2 Solid-State Overload Relays


3RB22, 3RB23 for high-feature applications

Current measuring modules for direct mounting1) and stand-alone installation1)2)


Size Set current value of the Order No. Weight per
Con-tactor3) inverse-time delayed overload trip PU approx.
A kg
Size S00/S02)4)
S00/S0 0.3 … 3 3RB29 06-2BG1 0.100
2.4 … 25 3RB29 06-2DG1 0.150

3RB29 06-2.G1
Size S2/S32)4)

3
S2/S3 10 … 100 3RB29 06-2JG1 0.350

RELAYS
OVERLOAD
3RB29 06-2JG1
Size S61)4)
S6 20 … 200 with pass through CT’s 3RB29 56-2TG2 0.600
with busbar 3RB29 56-2TH2 1.000

3RB29 56-2TG2
Size S10/S121)
S10/S12 and 63 … 630 3RB29 66-2WH2 1.750
size 14 (3TF68/
3TF69)

3RB29 66-2WH2
1) The current measuring modules with an Order No. ending with "2" are 3) Observe maximum rated operational current of the devices.
designed for direct mounting and stand-alone installation. For 4) The modules with an Order No. with "G" in 11th position are equipped with
3TF68/3TF69 contactors, direct mounting is not possible. a straight-through transformer.
2) The current measuring modules with an Order No. ending with "1" are
designed for stand-alone installation.

Size Version Order No. Weight per


Contactor PU approx.
kg
Connecting cables (essential accessory)
S00 ... S12 For connection between evaluation module and current
measuring module
• Length 0.1 m 3RB29 87-2B 0.010
• Length 0.5 m 3RB29 87-2D 0.020

3RB29 87-2.

For description, see pages 3/36-3/37.


For technical data, see pages 3/39-3/44.
For dimension drawings, see pages 3/45-3/46.
For schematic diagrams, see page 3/47.

For description, see pages 3/35-3/36, 3/40-3/42.


For technical data, see pages 3/43-3/48.
For dimension drawings, see pages 3/49-3/50.
For schematic diagrams, see page 3/51.
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/35
Overload Relays

3RB2 Solid-State Overload Relays


3RB22, 3RB23 for high-feature applications

Design Function
Device concept Basic functions
The 3RB22/3RB23 solid-state overload relays are based on a The 3RB22/3RB23 solid-state overload relays are designed for:
modular device concept. Each device always comprises an • Inverse-time delayed protection of loads from overloading
evaluation module, which is independent of the motor current,
and a current measuring module, which is dependent on the mo- • Inverse-time delayed protection of loads from phase
tor current. The two modules are electrically interconnected by a unbalance
connection cable through the system interface. • Inverse-time delayed protection of loads from phase failure
The basic functionality of the evaluation module can be option- • Temperature-dependent protection of loads by connecting a
ally expanded with corresponding function expansion modules. PTC sensor circuit
The function expansion modules are integrated in the evaluation • Protection of loads from high-resistance short-circuits (internal
module for this purpose through a simple plug connection. ground-fault detection; detection of fault currents > 30 % of
the set current Ie)
3

Mounting options
• Output of an overload warning
Current measuring modules
OVERLOAD
RELAYS

• Output of an analog signal 4 to 20 mA DC as image of the


The current measuring modules size S00/S0 and S2/S3 are flowing motor current
designed for stand-alone installation. By contrast, the current
measuring modules size S6 and S10/S12 are suitable for The basic functions of the evaluation modules in conjunction
stand-alone installation or direct mounting. with function expansion modules are listed in the following table:

Evaluation modules Evaluation Function expan- Basic functions


module sion module
The evaluation modules can be mounted either on the current 3RB22 83-4AA1 None Inverse-time delayed protection,
measuring module (only sizes S00/S0 and S2/S3) or separately. temperature-dependent protection,
3RB22 83-4AC1
electrical remote RESET,
Connection technique 3RB23 83-4AA1 overload warning
3RB23 83-4AC1
Main circuit (current measuring module) 3RB29 85-2CA1 Inverse-time delayed protection,
temperature-dependent protection,
For sizes S00/S0, S2/S3 and S6, the main circuit can also be internal ground-fault detection,
connected by the straight-through transformer method. In this electrical remote RESET,
case, the cables of the main circuit are routed directly through overload warning
the feed-through openings of the relay to the contactor 3RB29 85-2CB1 Inverse-time delayed protection,
terminals. temperature-dependent protection,
internal ground-fault detection,
For sizes S6 and S10/S12, the main circuit can be connected electrical remote RESET,
with the help of the Busbar. In conjunction with the correspond- ground fault signal
ing box terminals, screw terminals are also available. 3RB29 85-2AA0 Inverse-time delayed protection,
temperature-dependent protection,
Auxiliary circuit (evaluation module) electrical remote RESET,
overload warning,
Connection of the auxiliary circuit (removable terminal block) is analog output
possible with either screw terminals or spring-loaded terminals.
3RB29 85-2AA1 Inverse-time delayed protection,
Overload relays in contactor assemblies for temperature-dependent protection,
internal ground-fault detection,
Wye-Delta starting electrical remote RESET,
When overload relays are used in combination with contactor overload warning,
analog output
assemblies for Wye-Delta starting it must be noted that only
0.58 times the motor current flows through the line contactor. An 3RB29 85-2AB1 Inverse-time delayed protection,
temperature-dependent protection,
overload relay mounted onto the line contactor must be set to internal ground-fault detection,
0.58 times the motor current. electrical remote RESET,
ground fault signal,
When 3RB22/3RB23 solid-state overload relays are used in analog output
combination with contactor assemblies for Wye-Delta starting,
the function expansion modules for internal ground-fault detec- Control circuit
tion must not be used.
The 3RB22/3RB23 solid-state overload relays require an exter-
Operation with frequency converter nal power supply (24–240 V AC/DC), i.e. an additional supply
voltage is necessary.
The 3RB22/3RB23 solid-state overload relays are suitable for
frequencies of 50/60 Hz and the associated harmonics. This Short-circuit protection
permits the 3RB22/3RB23 overload relays to be used on the
incoming side of the frequency converter. Fuses or motor starter protectors must be used for short-circuit
protection. For assignments of the corresponding short-circuit
If motor protection is required on the outgoing side of the fre- protection devices to the 3RB22/3RB23 solid-state overload re-
quency converter, the 3RN thermistor motor protection devices lays with/without contactor see Technical Specifications and
or the 3RU11 thermal overload relays are available for this pur- Selection and Ordering Data.
pose.
Trip classes
The 3RB22/3RB23 solid-state overload relays are suitable for
normal and heavy starting. The required trip class (CLASS 5, 10,
20 or 30) can be adjusted by means of a rotary knob depending
on the current starting condition.
For details of the trip classes see Characteristic Curves.

3/36 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Overload Relays

3RB2 Solid-State Overload Relays


3RB22, 3RB23 for high-feature applications

Phase failure protection TEST function


The 3RB22/3RB23 solid-state overload relays are fitted with The combined TEST/RESET button can be used to check
phase failure protection (see Characteristic Curves) in order to whether the relay is working correctly. The test can be aborted at
minimize temperature rises of the load during single-phase any time by letting go of the TEST/RESET button.
operation.
LEDs, the device configuration (this depends on which expan-
Setting sion module is plugged in) and the device hardware are tested
while the button is kept pressed for 6 seconds. Simultaneously
The 3RB22/3RB23 solid-state overload relays are set to the and for another 18 seconds a direct current proportional in size
motor rated current by means of two rotary knobs. to the maximum phase of the main current is fed in at the termi-
• The upper rotary knob (CLASS/Iemax) is divided into 4 ranges: nals I(+) and I(-). By comparing the analog signal, which is to be
1 A, 10 A, 100 A and 1000 A. The zone must be selected measured, with the main current, the accuracy of the current
which corresponds to the rated motor current and the current measurement can be determined. In this case 4 mA corre-
measuring module to be used with it. With the range selected sponds to 0 % and 20 mA to 125 % of the set current. After
the required trip class (CLASS 5, 10, 20 or 30) can be deter- 24 seconds the auxiliary contacts are switched and the feeder

3
mined. switch off as the result, bringing the test to an end.
• The lower rotary knob with percent scale (10 % ... 100 %) is After a test trip a faultless relay is reset by pressing the

RELAYS
OVERLOAD
then used to set the rated motor current in percent of the range TEST/RESET button. If a hardware fault is detected, the device
selected with the upper rotary button. trips and cannot be reset.
Example Self-monitoring
• Rating of induction motor = 45 kW (50 Hz, 400 V AC)
The 3RB22/3RB23 solid-state overload relays have a self-moni-
• Rated motor current = 80 A toring feature, i.e. the devices constantly monitor their own basic
• Required trip class = CLASS 20 functions and trip if an internal fault is detected.
• Selected transformer: 10 to 100 A Display of the operating status
Solution The particular operating status of the 3RB22/3RB23 solid-state
• Step 1: Use the upper rotary knob (CLASS) to select the 100 A overload relays is displayed by means of four LEDs:
range • Green "Ready" LED: A continuous green light signals that the
• Step 2: Within the 100 A range set the trip class CLASS 20 overload relay is ready for operation. The 3RB22/3RB23 over-
• Step 3: Set the lower rotary knob to 80 % (= 0.8) of load relays are not ready (LED "OFF") if there is no control
100 A × 0.8 = 80 A. supply voltage or if the function test was negative.
• Red "Ground fault" LED: A continuous red light signals a
If the current which is set on the evaluation module does not ground fault.
correspond to the current range of the connected current trans-
former, an error will result. • Red "Thermistor" LED: A continuous red light signals a
temperature-dependent trip.
Manual and automatic reset • Red "Overload" LED: A continuous red light signals an inverse-
In the case of the 3RB22/3RB23 solid-state overload relays, a time delayed trip; a flickering red light signals an imminent
slide switch can be used to choose between automatic and inverse-time delayed trip (overload warning).
manual resetting. Auxiliary contacts
If manual reset is set, a reset can be carried out directly on the The 3RB22/3RB23 solid-state overload relays have two outputs,
device after a trip by pressing the blue TEST/RESET button. each with one NO contact and one NC contact. Their basic as-
A remote RESET can be carried out electrically by jumpering the signment/function may be influenced by function expansion
terminals Y1 and Y2. modules.
If the slide switch is set to automatic RESET, the relay is reset The 3RB22 and 3RB23 differ with respect to the tripping charac-
automatically. teristics of their auxiliary contacts – monostable or bistable:
The time between tripping and resetting is determined by the The monostable 3RB22 solid-state overload relays will enter the
recovery time. "tripped" state if the control supply voltage fails (> 200 ms), and
Recovery time return to the original state they were in before the control supply
voltage failed when the voltage returns. These devices are there-
With the 3RB22/3RB23 solid-state overload relays the recovery fore especially suited for plants in which the control voltage is not
time after inverse-time delayed tripping is approx. 3 minutes strictly monitored.
regardless of the selected reset mode. The recovery time allows
the load to cool down. The bistable 3RB23 overload relays do not change their "tripped"
or "not tripped" status if the control voltage fails. The auxiliary
However, in the event of temperature-dependent tripping by contacts only switch over in the event of an overload and if the
means of a connected PTC thermistor sensor circuit, the device supply voltage is present. These devices are therefore espe-
can only be manually or automatically reset once the winding cially suited for plants in which the control voltage is monitored
temperature at the installation location of the PTC thermistor has separately.
fallen 5 Kelvin below its response temperature.
Response if the control supply voltage fails
After a ground fault trip the 3RB22/3RB23 solid-state overload
relay trips can be reset immediately without a recovery time. If the control supply voltage fails for more than 0.2 s, the output
relays respond differently depending on the version: Monostable
or bistable.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/37


Overload Relays

3RB2 Solid-State Overload Relays


3RB22, 3RB23 for high-feature applications

Response of the Monostable Bistable


output relays 3RB22 3RB23
in the event of
Failure of the control The device trips No change of the switch-
supply voltage ing status of the auxiliary
contacts
Return of the control The device resets No change of the switch-
supply voltage with- ing status of the auxiliary
out previous tripping contacts
Return of the control The device remains The device remains
supply voltage after tripped tripped
previous tripping Reset: Reset:
• For overload tripping, • For overload tripping,
after 3 minutes after 3 minutes
• For thermistor tripping, • For thermistor tripping,
3

after the temperature after the temperature


has fallen 5 K below the has fallen 5 K below the
response temperature response temperature
OVERLOAD
RELAYS

• For ground-fault trip- • For ground-fault trip-


ping, immediately ping, immediately

Monostable and bistable responses of the output relays

3/38 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


© Siemens AG 2015
Overload Relays

3RB2 Solid-State Overload Relays Overload Relays


SIRIUS 3RB2 Electronic Overload Relays
3RB22, 3RB23 for standard applications
3RB22, 3RB23 up to 630 A for High-Feature applications

Technical specifications
The following technical information is intended to provide an
initial overview of the various types of device and functions.
Detailed information, see
• Reference Manual "Protection Equipment – 3RU1, 3RB2 • or specific information on a particular article number via the
Overload Relays", product data sheet,
http://support.automation.siemens.com/WW/view/en/35681297 http://support.automation.siemens.com/WW/view/en/20357046/133200

Type – Overload relay: evaluation modules 3RB2283-4A.1 3RB2383-4A.1


Size contactor S00 ... S10/S12

H
Dimensions of evaluation modules mm 45 x 111 x 95
(W x H x D)

D
W

3
General data
Trips in the event of Overload, phase failure and phase unbalance (> 40 % according to NEMA),

RELAYS
OVERLOAD
+ ground fault (with corresponding function expansion module) and activation of the
thermistor motor protection (with closed PTC sensor circuit)
Trip class acc. to IEC 60947-4-1 CLASS 5, 10, 20 and 30 adjustable
Phase failure sensitivity Yes
Overload warning Yes, from 1.125 x Ie for symmetrical loads
and from 0.85 x Ie for unsymmetrical loads
Reset and recovery
• Reset options after tripping Manual, automatic and remote RESET
• Recovery time
- For automatic RESET min. - for tripping due to overcurrent: 3 (stored permanently)
- for tripping by thermistor: time until the motor temperature has fallen 5 K
below the response temperature

7
- for tripping due to a ground fault: no automatic RESET
- For manual RESET min. - for tripping due to overcurrent: 3 (stored permanently)
- for tripping by thermistor: time until the motor temperature has fallen 5 K
below the response temperature
- for tripping due to a ground fault: Immediately
- For remote RESET min. - for tripping due to overcurrent: 3 (stored permanently)
- for tripping by thermistor: time until the motor temperature has fallen 5 K
below the response temperature
- for tripping due to a ground fault: Immediately
Features
• Display of operating state on device Yes, with four LEDs:
- green LED "Ready"
- red LED "Ground Fault"
- red LED "Thermistor"
- red LED "Overload"
• TEST function Yes, test of LEDs, electronics, auxiliary contacts and wiring of control circuit by
pressing the button TEST/RESET / self-monitoring
• RESET button Yes, with the TEST/RESET button
• STOP button No
Protection and operation of explosion-proof motors
EC type test certificate number according to PTB 05 ATEX 3022 II (2) GD, --
directive 94/9/EC (ATEX) see
http://support.automation.siemens.com/WW/view/en/23115758
Ambient temperatures
• Storage/transport °C -40 ... +80
• Operation °C -25 ... +60
• Temperature compensation °C +60
• Permissible rated current
- Temperature inside control cabinet 60 °C % 100
- Temperature inside control cabinet 70 °C % On request
Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60529 IP20: Current measuring modules in sizes S6 and S10/S12 with busbar connection
in conjunction with cover.
Touch protection acc. to IEC 61140 Finger-safe: Current measuring modules in sizes S6 and S10/S12 with busbar
connection in conjunction with cover.
Shock resistance with sine acc. to IEC 60068-2-27 g/ms 15/11
Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) – Interference immunity
• Conductor-related interference
- Burst acc. to IEC 61000-4-4 kV 2 (power ports), 1 (signal port)
(corresponds to degree of severity 3)
- Surge acc. to IEC 61000-4-5 kV 2 (line to earth), 1 (line to line)
(corresponds to degree of severity 3)
• Electrostatic discharge according to IEC 61000-4-2 kV 8 (air discharge), 6 (contact discharge)
(corresponds to degree of severity 3)
• Field-related interference according to IEC 61000-4-3 V/m 10
(corresponds to degree of severity 3)
Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) – emitted interference Degree of severity A according to EN 55011 (CISPR 11) and EN 55022 (CISPR 22)

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial


Siemens ICControl Catalog
10 · 2015 3/39
7/137
Overload Relays

3RB2 Solid-State Overload Relays


3RB22, 3RB23 for standard applications

Type – Overload relay of current measuring module 3RB29 3RB29 3RB29 3RB29
Size S00/S0 S2/S3 S6 S10/S12
Width 45 mm 55 mm 120 mm 145 mm
Main circuit
Rated insulation voltage Ui (pollution degree 3) V 1000 1000
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 6 8
Rated operational voltage Ue V 690 1000
Type of current
• Direct current No
• Alternating current Yes, 50/60 Hz ± 5 % (other frequencies on request)
Set current A 0.3 ... 3; 10 ... 100 20 ... 200 63 ... 630
2.4 ... 25
Power loss per unit (max.) W 0.5
3

Short-circuit protection
• With fuse without contactor See Selection and Ordering Data
OVERLOAD
RELAYS

• With fuse and contactor See Technical Specifications (short-circuit protection with fuses for motor feeders)
Safe isolation between main and auxiliary V 6901)
conducting path according to IEC 60947-1

Connection for main circuit


Electrical connection version Screw terminals with box terminal

Screw terminal
• Terminal screw -- 4 mm Allen screw 5 mm Allen screw
• Tightening torque -- 10 ... 12 20 ... 22
• Conductor cross-sections (min./max.),
1 or 2 conductors
- Solid m m2 -- -- --
- Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 -- With 3RT19 55-4G box terminal: 2 × (50 ... 185),
2 × (1 × max. 50, 1 × max. 70), front clamping point only:
1 × (10 ... 70) 1 × (70 ... 240)
With 3RT19 56-4G box terminal: rear clamping point only:
2 × (1 × max. 95, 1 × max. 120), 1 × (120 ... 185)
1 × (10 ... 120)
- Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 -- With 3RT19 55-4G box terminal: 2 × (50 ... 185),
2 × (1 × max. 50, 1 × max. 70), front clamping point only:
1 × (10 ... 70) 1 × (70 ... 240)
With 3RT19 56-4G box terminal: rear clamping point only:
2 × (1 × max. 95, 1 × max. 120), 1 × (120 ... 185)
1 × (10 ... 120)
- Stranded mm2 -- With 3RT19 55-4G box terminal: 2 × (70 ... 240),
2 × (max. 70), front clamping point only:
1 × (16 ... 70) 1 × (95 ... 300)
With 3RT19 56-4G box terminal: rear clamping point only:
2 × (max. 120), 1 × (120 ... 240)
1 × (16 ... 120)
- AWG conductors, solid or stranded AWG -- With 3RT19 55-4G box terminal: 2 × (2/0 ... 500 kcmil),
2 × (max. 1/0), front clamping point only:
1 × (6 ... 2/0) 1 × (3/0 ... 600 kcmil)
With 3RT19 56-4G box terminal: rear clamping point only:
2 × (max. 3/0), 1 × (250 kcmil ... 500 kcmil)
1 × (6 ... 250 kcmil)
- Ribbon cable conductors mm -- With 3RT19 55-4G box terminal: 2 × (20 × 24 × 0.5),
(number x width x circumference) 2 × (6 × 15.5 × 0.8), 1 × (6 × 9 × 0.8 ...
1 × (3 × 9 × 0.8 ... 6 × 15.5 × 0.8) 20 × 24 × 0.5)
With 3RT19 56-4G box terminal:
2 × (10 × 15.5 × 0.8),
1 × (3 × 9 × 0.8 ...
10 × 15.5 × 0.8)
Busbar connections
• Terminal screw -- M8 × 25 M10 × 30
• Tightening torque Nm -- 10 ... 14 14 ... 24
• Conductor cross-section (min./max.) --
- Solid with cable lug m m2 -- 16 ... 952) 50 ... 2403)
- Stranded with cable lug m m2 -- 25 ... 1202) 70 ... 2403)
- AWG connections, solid or stranded, with cable lug AWG -- 4 ... 250 kcmil 2/0 ... 500 kcmil
- With connecting bar (max. width) mm -- 15 25
Straight-through transformers
• Diameter of opening mm 7.5 14 25 --
• Conductor cross-section (max.)
- N YY mm2 4) 4) 120 --
- H07RN-F mm2 4) 4)
70 --
1) For grounded networks, otherwise 600 V. 3) When connecting cable lugs according to DIN 46234 for conductor cross-
2) When connecting cable lugs according to DIN 46235, use the sections from 240 mm2 as well as DIN 46235 for conductor cross-sections
3RT19 56-4EA1 terminal cover for conductor cross-sections from 95 mm2 from 185 mm2, use the 3RT19 56-4EA1 terminal cover to ensure phase
to ensure phase spacing. spacing.
4) On request.

3/40 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


© Siemens AG 2015
Overload Relays

3RB2 Solid-State
Overload Relays Overload Relays
SIRIUS 3RB2 Electronic Overload Relays
3RB22, 3RB23 for standard applications
3RB22, 3RB23 up to 630 A for High-Feature applications

Type – Overload relay: evaluation modules 3RB2283-4A.1 3RB2383-4A.1


Size contactor S00 ... S10/S12

H
Dimensions of evaluation modules mm 45 x 111 x 95
(W x H x D)

D
W

General data (continued)


Resistance to extreme climates – air humidity % 100
Dimensions "Dimensional drawings", see
• Reference Manual "Protection Equipment – 3RU1, 3RB2 Overload Relays",
http://support.automation.siemens.com/WW/view/en/35681297
• Product data sheet,
http://support.automation.siemens.com/WW/view/en/20357046/133200
Installation altitude above sea level m Up to 2 000
Mounting position Any

3
Type of mounting
• Evaluation modules Stand-alone installation

RELAYS
OVERLOAD
• Current measuring module Size S00 to S3: Stand-alone installation,
S6 and S10/S12: stand-alone installation or mounting onto contactors

Type – Overload relay: evaluation modules 3RB2283-4A.1, 3RB2383-4A.1


Size contactor S00 ... S10/S12
Auxiliary circuit
Number of NO contacts 2
Number of NC contacts 2
Number of CO contacts --
Auxiliary contacts – assignment • Alternative 1
7

- 1 NO for the signal "tripped by overload and/or thermistor"


- 1 NC for disconnecting the contactor
- 1 NO for the signal "tripped by ground fault"
- 1 NC for disconnecting the contactor
or1)
• Alternative 2
- 1 NO for the signal "tripped by overload and/or thermistor and/or ground fault"
- 1 NC for disconnecting the contactor
- 1 NO for overload warning
- 1 NC for disconnecting the contactor
Rated insulation voltage Ui (pollution degree 3) V 300
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 4
Auxiliary contacts – contact rating
• NC contact with alternating current AC-14/AC-15,
rated operational current Ie at Ue
- 24 V A 6
- 120 V A 6
- 125 V A 6
- 250 V A 3
• NO contact with alternating current AC-14/AC-15,
rated operational current Ie at Ue
- 24 V A 6
- 120 V A 6
- 125 V A 6
- 250 V A 3
• NC contact, NO contact with direct current DC-13,
rated operational current Ie at Ue
- 24 V A 2
- 60 V A 0.55
- 110 V A 0.3
- 125 V A 0.3
- 250 V A 0.2
• Conventional thermal current Ith A 5
• Contact reliability Yes
(suitability for PLC control; 17 V, 5 mA)
Short-circuit protection
• With fuse, operational class gG A 6
• With miniature circuit breaker, C characteristic A 1.6
Protective separation between auxiliary current paths V 300
acc. to IEC 60947-1
CSA, UL, UR rated data
Auxiliary circuit – switching capacity B300, R300
1)
The assignment of auxiliary contacts may be influenced by function
expansion modules.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/41


7/138 Siemens IC 10 · 2015
© Siemens AG 2015
Overload Relays

3RB2 Solid-State Overload Relays Overload Relays


SIRIUS 3RB2 Electronic Overload Relays
3RB22, 3RB23 for standard applications
3RB22, 3RB23 up to 630 A for High-Feature applications

Type – Overload relay: evaluation modules 3RB2283-4A.1, 3RB2383-4A.1


Size contactor S00 ... S10/S12
Control circuit
Rated insulation voltage Ui V 300
(pollution degree 3)
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 4
Rated control supply voltage Us
• 50/60 Hz AC V 24 ... 240
• DC V 24 ... 240
Operating range
• 50/60 Hz AC 0.85 × Us min ≤ Us ≤ 1.1 × Us max
• DC 0.85 × Us min ≤ Us ≤ 1.1 × Us max
3

Rated power
• 50/60 Hz AC W 0.5
OVERLOAD
RELAYS

• DC W 0.5
Mains buffering time ms 200
Sensor circuit
Thermistor motor protection (PTC thermistor sensor)
• Summation cold resistance kΩ ≤ 1.5
• Response value kΩ 3.4 ... 3.8
• Return value kΩ 1.5 ... 1.65
Ground-fault detection The information refers to sinusoidal residual currents at 50/60 Hz.
• Tripping value IΔ1)
- For 0.3 × Ie < Imotor < 2.0 × Ie > 0.3 × Ie
- For 2.0 × Ie < Imotor < 8.0 × Ie > 0.15 × Imotor

7
• Response time ttrip ms 500 ... 1 000
Analog output1)2)
Rated values
• Output signal mA 4 ... 20
• Measuring range 0 ... 1.25 × Ie
4 mA corresponds to 0 × Ie
16.8 mA corresponds to 1.0 × Ie
20 mA corresponds to 1.25 × Ie
• Load, max. Ω 100
Conductor cross-sections for the auxiliary, control and
sensor circuit as well as the analog output
Connection type Screw terminals

Terminal screw M3, Pozidriv size 2


Operating devices mm 3.0 x 0.5
Prescribed tightening torque Nm 0.8 ... 1.2
Conductor cross-sections (min./max.),
1 or 2 conductors can be connected
• Solid or stranded mm2 1 × (0.5 ... 4)3), 2 × (0.5 ... 2.5)3)
2
• Finely stranded without end sleeve mm --
• Finely stranded with end sleeve (DIN 46228-1) mm2 1 × (0.5 ... 2.5)3), 2 × (0.5 ... 1.5)3)
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 2 × (20 ... 14)
Connection type Spring-type terminals

Operating devices mm 3.0 x 0.5


Conductor cross-sections (min./max.),
1 or 2 conductors can be connected
• Solid or stranded mm2 2 × (0.25 ... 1.5)
• Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 --
• Finely stranded with end sleeve (DIN 46228-1) mm2 2 × (0.25 ... 1.5)
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 2 × (24 ... 16)
1) 3)
For the 3RB22 and 3RB23 overload relays in combination with a If two different conductor cross-sections are connected to one clamping
corresponding function expansion module. point, both cross-sections must be in the range specified.
2)
Analog input modules, e.g. SM 331, must be configured for 4-wire
measuring transducers. In this case the analog input module must not
supply current to the analog output of the 3RB22 and 3RB23 relay.

3/42 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Siemens IC 10 · 2015 7/139
Overload Relays

3RB2 Solid-State Overload Relays


3RB22, 3RB23 for standard applications

Short-circuit protection with fuses for motor feeders


For short-circuit currents up to 50 kA at 400 to 690 V
Overload relays Contactor CLASS 690 V
5 and 10 20 30 Fuse links1)
LV HRC Type 3NA
DIAZED Type 5SB
NEOZED Type 5SE
gL/gG operational class
Rated operational current Ie AC-3 in A at Type of coordination2)
Setting range Type 400 V 500 V 690 V 400 V 500 V 690 V 400 V 500 V 690 V 1 2
Size S00/S0
0.3 ... 3 A 3RT20 15 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 35 20
3RT20 16 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 35 20

3
2.4 ... 25 A 3RT20 15 7 5 4 7 5 4 7 5 4 35 20
3RT20 16 9 6.5 5.2 9 6.5 5.2 9 6.5 5.2 35 20

RELAYS
OVERLOAD
3RT20 17 12 9 6.3 10 9 6.3 9 9 6.3 35 20
3RT20 23 9 6.5 5.2 9 6.5 5.2 -- -- -- 63 25
3RT20 24 12 12 9 12 12 9 12 12 9 63 25
3RT20 25 17 17 13 16 16 13 14 14 13 63 25
3RT20 26 25 18 13 16 16 13 14 14 13 100 35
Size S2/S3
On request 3RT20 35 On request
3RT20 36 On request
3RT20 45 On request
3RT20 46 On request
3RT20 47 On request

Size S6
20 ... 200 A 3RT10 54 115 115 115 81.7 81.7 81.7 69 69 69 355 315
3RT10 55 150 150 150 107 107 107 90 90 90 355 315
3RT10 56 185 185 170 131 131 131 111 111 111 355 315
Size S10/S12
160 ... 630 A 3RT10 64 225 225 225 160 160 160 135 135 135 500 400
3RT10 65 265 265 265 188 188 188 159 159 159 500 400
3RT10 66 300 300 280 213 213 213 180 180 180 500 400
3RT10 75 400 400 400 284 284 284 240 240 240 630 400
3RT10 76 500 500 450 355 355 355 300 300 300 630 500
3RT12 64 225 225 225 225 225 225 173 173 173 500 500
3RT12 65 265 265 265 265 265 265 204 204 204 500 500
3RT12 66 300 300 300 300 300 300 231 231 231 500 500
3RT12 75 400 400 400 400 400 400 316 316 316 800 800
3RT12 76 500 500 500 500 500 500 385 385 385 800 800
3TF683) 630 630 630 440 440 440 376 376 376 800 5004)
3TF693) 630 630 630 572 572 572 500 500 500 800 6304)

1) Please observe operational voltage.


2) Coordination and short-circuit equipment according to EN 60947-4-1:
Type of coordination 1: the contactor or starter must not endanger
persons or the installation in the event of a short-circuit.
They do not need to be suitable for further operation
without repair and the renewal of parts.
Type of coordination 2: the contactor or starter must not endanger
persons or the installation in the event of a short-circuit.
They must be suitable for further operation.
There is a risk of contact welding.
3) Contactor cannot be mounted.
4) Please ensure that the maximum AC-3 operational current has sufficient
safety clearance from the rated current of the fuses.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/43


Overload Relays

3RB2 Solid-State Overload Relays


3RB22, 3RB23 for standard applications

Characteristic curves
The tripping characteristics show the relationship between the Tripping characteristics for 3-pole loads
tripping time and tripping current as multiples of the set current
Ie and are given for symmetrical three-pole and two-pole loads 1000
NSB0_01525
from the cold state. 800
600
The smallest current used for tripping is called the minimum 400
tripping current. According to IEC 60947-4-1, this current must

Tripping time
s
be within specified limits. The limits of the minimum tripping 200
current for the 3RB22/3RB23 solid-state overload relays for
symmetrical three-pole loads are between 105 % and 120 % of
the set current. 100
80
The tripping characteristic starts with the minimum tripping 60
current and continues with higher tripping currents based on the
3

40
characteristics of the so-called trip classes (CLASS 10,
CLASS 20 etc.). The trip classes describe time intervals within 20
OVERLOAD
RELAYS

which the overload relays have to trip with 7.2 times the set CLASS 30
current Ie from the cold state for symmetrical three-pole loads. CLASS 20
10
The tripping times according to IEC 60947-4-1, tolerance band 8
E, are as follows for: 6 CLASS 10
4
Trip class Tripping time CLASS 5
CLASS 5 3…5s 2
CLASS 10 5 … 10 s
CLASS 20 10 … 20 s 1
0,6 1 2 4 6 8 10× e
CLASS 30 20 … 30 s Tripping current

The tripping characteristic for a three-pole overload relay from Illustration 1


the cold state (see illustration 1) only apply if all three phases are
simultaneously loaded with the same current. In the event of a Tripping characteristics for 2-pole loads
phase failure or a current unbalance of more than 40 %, the 1000
3RB22/3RB23 solid-state overload relays switch off the contac- 800 NSB0_01526

tor more quickly in order to minimize heating of the load in 600


accordance with the tripping characteristic for two-pole loads 400
Tripping time

from the cold state (see illustration 2). s


Compared with a cold load, a load at operating temperature ob- 200
viously has a lower temperature reserve. The tripping time of the
3RB22/3RB23 solid-state overload relays are reduced therefore 100
to about 30 % when loaded with the set current Ie for an 80
extended period. 60
40

20
CLASS 30
10
8 CLASS 20
6
4 CLASS 10

2 CLASS 5

1
0,6 1 2 4 6 8 10× e
Tripping current

Illustration 2
The above illustrations are schematic representations of
characteristic curves. The characteristic curves of the individual
3RB22/3RB23 solid-state overload relays can be requested from
Technical Assistance at the following e-mail address:
Technical-assistance@siemens.com

3/44 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Overload Relays

3RB2 Solid-State Overload Relays


3RB22, 3RB23 for standard applications

Dimensional drawings

86 4
5 59
30

12
106
80

NSB0_01519
45 36

3
5

3RB22 83-4, 3RB23 83-4 evaluation module

RELAYS
OVERLOAD
3RB29 06-2BG1, 3RB29 06-2DG1 current measuring module 3RB29 06-2JG1 current measuring module

3RB29 56-2TG2 current measuring module

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/45


Overload Relays

3RB2 Solid-State Overload Relays


3RB22, 3RB23 for standard applications
3 RELAYS
OVERLOAD

3RB29 56-2TH2 current measuring module

3RB29 66-2WH2 current measuring module

3/46 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Overload Relays

3RB2 Solid-State Overload Relays


3RB22, 3RB23 for standard applications

Schematics
Protection of single-phase motors
(not in conjunction with internal ground-fault detection)

3
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
3RB29 06-2.G1, 3RB29 56-2TG2 3RB29 56-2TH2, 3RB29 66-2WH2
Schematic representation of a possible application (3-phase)

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/47


Overload Relays

3RB2 Solid-State Overload Relays


3RB22, 3RB23 for standard applications

Connections
Evaluation module Function expan- Basic function s I nputs
sion module
A1/A2 T1/T2 Y1/Y2
3RB22 83-4AA1 None Inverse-time delayed protection, Power supply Connection for Electrical
3RB22 83-4AC1 temperature-dependent protection, 24 ... 240 V AC/DC PTC sensor remote RESET
electrical remote RESET,
3RB23 83-4AA1 overload warning
3RB23 83-4AC1 3RB29 85-2CA1 Inverse-time delayed protection, Power supply Connection for Electrical
temperature-dependent protection, 24 ... 240 V AC/DC PTC sensor remote RESET
internal ground-fault detection,
electrical remote RESET,
overload warning
3RB29 85-2CB1 Inverse-time delayed protection, Power supply Connection for Electrical
temperature-dependent protection, 24 ... 240 V AC/DC PTC sensor remote RESET
3

internal ground-fault detection,


electrical remote RESET,
ground fault signal
OVERLOAD
RELAYS

3RB29 85-2AA0 Inverse-time delayed protection, Power supply Connection for Electrical
temperature-dependent protection, 24 ... 240 V AC/DC PTC sensor remote RESET
electrical remote RESET,
overload warning, analog output
3RB29 85-2AA1 Inverse-time delayed protection, Power supply Connection for Electrical
temperature-dependent protection, 24 ... 240 V AC/DC PTC sensor remote RESET
internal ground-fault detection,
electrical remote RESET,
overload warning, analog output
3RB29 85-2AB1 Inverse-time delayed protection, Power supply Connection for Electrical
temperature-dependent protection, 24 ... 240 V AC/DC PTC sensor remote RESET
internal ground-fault detection,
electrical remote RESET,
ground fault signal, analog output

Evaluation module Function expan- Outputs


sion module
I (–) / I (+) 95/96 NC 97/98 NO 05/06 NC 07/08 NO
3RB22 83-4AA1 None No Switching off the Signal Overload warning Overload warning
3RB22 83-4AC1 contactor (inverse- "tripped"
time delayed/temper-
3RB23 83-4AA1 ature-dependent pro-
3RB23 83-4AC1 tection)
3RB29 85-2CA1 No Switching off the Signal Overload warning Overload warning
contactor (inverse- "tripped"
time delayed/temper-
ature-dependent pro-
tection + ground
fault)
3RB29 85-2CB1 No Switching off the Signal Switching off the Signal
contactor (inverse- "tripped" contactor (ground "ground fault trip"
time delayed/temper- fault)
ature-dependent pro-
tection)
3RB29 85-2AA0 Analog signal Switching off the Signal Overload warning Overload warning
contactor (inverse- "tripped"
time delayed/temper-
ature-dependent pro-
tection)
3RB29 85-2AA1 Analog signal Switching off the Signal Overload warning Overload warning
contactor (inverse- "tripped"
time delayed/temper-
ature-dependent pro-
tection + ground
fault)
3RB29 85-2AB1 Analog signal Switching off the Signal Switching off the Signal
contactor (inverse- "tripped" contactor (ground "ground fault trip"
time delayed/temper- fault)
ature-dependent pro-
tection)

3/48 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Overload Relays

3RB2/3RB3 Solid-State Overload Relays


Accessories

Overview
Overload relays for standard applications Overload relays for high-feature applications
The following accessories are available for the 3RB2/3RB3 The following accessories are available for the 3RB22/3RB23
solid-state overload relays: solid-state overload relays:
• One terminal bracket each for the overload relays size S00 • A sealable cover for the evaluation module
and S0 (sizes S2 to S12 can be installed as single units without • Box terminal blocks for the current measuring modules size S6
a terminal bracket) and S10/S12
• One mechanical RESET module for all sizes • Terminal covers for the current measuring modules size S6
• One cable release for resetting devices which are difficult to and S10/S12
access (for all sizes) • Push-in lugs for screw mounting the size S00 to S3 current
• One sealable cover for all sizes measuring modules

3
• Box terminal blocks for sizes S6 and S10/S12
• Terminal covers for sizes S2 to S10/S12

RELAYS
OVERLOAD
Selection and ordering data
Version Size Order No. Weight
per PU
approx.
kg
Terminal brackets for stand-alone installation 1) 2)
For separate mounti ng of the overload relay Screw S00 3RU29 16-3AA01 0.04
panel mount or snapped onto terminals S0 3RU29 26-3AA01 0.05
35 mm standard mounting rail, S2 3RU29 36-3AA01 0.18
size S3 also for 75 mm standard mounting rail S3 3RU29 46-3AA01 0.28

Spring S00 3RU29 16-3AC01 0.04


Loaded S0 3RU29 26-3AC01 0.06
terminals
3RU29.6-3AA01
Mechanical RESET 1) 2)

Resetting plungers, holders and formers S00 to S3 3RB39 80-0A 0.030


S6 to S12 3RU19 00-1A 0.038

Pushbuttons with extended stroke S3 to S12 3SB30 00-0EA11 0.021


(12 mm), IP65, Ø 22 mm
Extension plungers S3 to S12 3SX1 335 0.004
For compensation of the distance between a pushbutton
and the unlatching button of the relay
3RU19 00-1A Complete mechanical reset assembly S3 to S12 3SBES-RESET
with pushbutton and
extension plunger
Cable releases with holder for RESET 1) 2)
For holes with Ø 6.5 mm
in the mounting plate;
max. control panel thickness 8 mm
• Length 400 mm S00 to S2 3RB39 80-0B 0.060
• Length 600 mm S00 to S2 3RB39 80-0C 0.073
• Length 400 mm S3 to S12 3RU19 00-1B 0.063
• Length 600 mm S3 to S12 3RU19 00-1C 0.073

3RU19 00-1.

1) Accessories with a prefix of 3RB39 are intended for 3RB20/3RB30 overload relays only.
2) Only for 3RB20/3RB21. The accessories are identical to those of the
3RU1/3RU2 thermal overload relays.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/49
Overload Relays

3RB2 Solid-State Overload Relays


Accessories

Version Size Order No. List Pack Weight per


Price $ Units PU approx.
kg
Sealable covers
For covering the setting knobs
• For 3RB30/3RB31 S00 to S3 3RB39 84-0 10 units 0.003
• For 3RB20/3RB21 S6 to S12 3RB29 84-0 10 units 0.020
• For 3RB22 to 3RB24 – 3RB29 84-2 10 units 0.050
3RB3984-0
Terminal covers
Covers for cable lugs and rail connection
• Length 100 mm S6 3RT19 56-4EA1 0.067
3RT19 66-4EA1
3

• Length 120 mm S10/S12 0.124

Covers for box terminals


OVERLOAD
RELAYS

3RT19 46-4EA1 • Length 20.6 mm1) S2 3RT29 36-4EA2 0.016


• Length 20.8 mm1) S3 3RT29 46-4EA2 0.023
• Length 25 mm S6 3RT19 56-4EA2 0.028
• Length 30 mm S10/S12 3RT19 66-4EA2 0.038

Covers for screw connections S6 3RT19 56-4EA3 0.021


3RT19 36-4EA2 between contactor and overload relay, S10/S12 3RT19 66-4EA3 0.062
The figures show without box terminals
mounting on the contactor (1 unit required per combination)
Box terminal blocks
For round and ribbon cables
up to 70 mm2 2/0 AWG S62) 3RT19 55-4G 0.237
up to 120mm2 4/0 AWG S6 3RT19 56-4G 0.270
up to 240mm2 500 mcm S10/S12 3RT19 66-4G 0.676
For conductor cross-sections,
see LV 1 T "Technical Specifications"

3RT19 5.-4G
Push-in lugs
For screw fixing of 3RB22/3RB23 -- 3RP19 03 10 units 0.002
overload relays

3RP19 03
For screw mounting of 3RB29 06 current S00 ... S3 3RB29 00-0B 10 units 0.100
measuring modules
(2 units are required per module)

3RB19 00-0B
For more accessories (tools for spring-loaded terminals and
labeling plates), see page 3/57.
1) Only for 3RB20/3RB21. The accessories are identical to those of the
3RU11 thermal overload relays.
2) In the scope of supply for 3RT10 54-1 contactors (55 kW).

3/50 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Overload Relays

3RB2 Solid-State Overload Relays


Accessories

Overview
Overload relays for standard applications Overload relays for High-Feature applications
The following accessories are available for the 3RB20/3RB21 The following accessories are available for the 3RB22/3RB23
solid-state overload relays: solid-state overload relays:
• One terminal bracket each for the overload relays size S00 • A sealable cover for the evaluation module
and S0 (sizes S2 to S12 can be installed as stand-alone • Box terminal blocks for the current measuring modules size S6
installation without a terminal bracket) and S10/S12
• One mechanical remote RESET module for all sizes • Terminal covers for the current measuring modules size S6
• One cable release for resetting devices which are difficult to and S10/S12
access (for all sizes)
• One sealable cover for all sizes

3
• Box terminal blocks for sizes S6 and S10/S12
• Terminal covers for sizes S2 to S10/S12

RELAYS
OVERLOAD
Technical specifications
Terminal brackets for stand-alone installation
Type 3RB29 13-0AA1 3RB29 23-0AA1
For overload relay 3RB20 16, 3RB21 13 3RB20 26, 3RB21 23
Size S00 S0
Type of mounting For screw and snap-on mounting onto TH35 standard mounting rail
Connection for main circuit
Connection type Screw terminal
Screw terminal
• Terminal screw Pozidriv size 2
• Tightening torque Nm 0.8 ... 1.2 2 ... 2.5
• Conductor cross-section (min./max.), 1 or 2 conductors
- So l i d mm 2 1 × (0.5 ... 2.5), 1 × (1 ... 6),
Max. 1 × (... 4) Max. 1 × (... 10)
- Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 -- --
- F inely stranded with end sleeve mm 2 1 × (0.5 ... 2.5) 1 × (1 ... 6)
- Stranded m m2 1 × (0.5 ... 2.5), 1 × (1 ... 6),
Max. 1 × (... 4) Max. 1 × (... 10)
- AWG conductors, solid or stranded AWG 1 × (18 ... 14) 1 × (14 ... 10)

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/51


Overload Relays
Overload Relays

3RB24
SIRIUSSolid-State Overload
3RB2 Solid-State Relays
Overload Relays
3RB24
3RB24 for for IO-Link,
IO-Link, up630
up to to A
630
forAHigh-Feature applications
for High-Feature applications

Overview
break time depends on the ratio between the tripping current
and current setting Ie and is stored in the form of a long-term sta-

NSB0_02180
ble tripping characteristic see www.siemens.com/sirius/support
"Characteristic Curves"). The "tripped" status is signaled by
means of a continuously illuminated red "OVERLOAD" LED and
also reported as a group fault via IO-Link.
The LED indicates imminent tripping of the relay due to overload,
phase unbalance or phase failure by flickering when the limit
current has been violated. This warning can also be reported to
the higher-level PLC via IO-Link at the 3RB24 overload relay.
In addition to the described inverse-time delayed protection of
loads against excessive temperature rises, the 3RB24 solid-
3

state overload relays also allow direct temperature monitoring of


the motor windings (full motor protection) by connection with
OVERLOAD
RELAYS

broken-wire interlock of a PTC sensor circuit. With this tempera-


Green LED "DEVICE/IO-Link: ture-dependent protection, the loads can be protected against
A continuous green light signals that the device is working
correctly, a green flickering light signals the communication overheating caused indirectly by reduced coolant flow, for ex-
through IO-Link. ample, which cannot be detected by means of the current alone.
In the event of overheating, the devices switch off the contactor,
Red LED "GND FAULT": and thus the load, by means of the auxiliary contacts. The
A continuous red light signals an active ground-fault trip.
"tripped" status is signaled by means of a continuously illumi-
Red LED "THERMISTOR": nated "THERMISTOR" LED and also reported as a group fault via
A continuous red light signals an active thermistor trip. IO-Link.
Red LED "OVERLOAD": To the loads against incomplete ground faults due to damage to
A continuous red light signals an active overload trip; a flickering
red light signals an imminent trip (overload warning). the insulation, humidity, condensation, etc., to protect the elec-
tronic overload relay 3RB24 offer the possibility of internal
7

Motor current and trip class setting: ground-fault detection (for details see "Manual for SIRIUS 3RB24
Setting the device to the motor current and to the required trip Solid-State Overload Relay for IO-Link",, not possible in conjunc-
class dependent on the start-up conditions is easy with the two
rotary switches. tion with contactor assembly for wye-delta starting). In the event
of a ground fault, the 3RB24 relays trip instantaneously.
Selector switch for manual/automatic RESET:
With this switch you can choose between manual and automatic The "tripped" status is signaled by means of a flashing red LED
RESET. "Ground Fault" and reported at the overload relay 3RB24 as a
Test/RESET button: group fault via IO-Link.
Enables testing of all important device components and functions,
plus resetting of the device after a trip when manual RESET is The reset after overload, phase unbalance, phase failure, therm-
selected. istor or ground-fault tripping is performed manually by key on
site, via IO-Link or by electrical remote RESET or automatically
Connecting terminals (removable terminal block): after the cooling time (motor model) or for thermistor protection
The generously sized terminals permit connection of two
conductors with different cross-sections for the auxiliary, control after sufficient cooling. Power cuts in devices due to function
and sensor circuits. Connection is possible with screw connection monitoring (broken wire or short circuit on the thermistor) can
and alternatively with spring-type connection. only be reset on-site ("Function" see "Manual for SIRIUS 3RB24
Plug-in point for operator panel: Solid-State Overload Relay for IO-Link",). In conjunction with a
enables connection of the 3RA69 35-0A operator panel. function expansion module, the motor current measured by the
microprocessor can be output in the form of an analog signal DC
4 to 20 mA for operating rotary coil instruments or for feeding
into analog inputs of programmable logic controllers.
SIRIUS 3RB24 evaluation module
The current values can be transmitted to the higher-level control-
The modular electronic overload relay 3RB24, which is powered ler via IO-Link.
via IO-Link (with monostable auxiliary contacts) up to 630 A (up
to 820 A possible with a series transformer) have been designed The devices are manufactured in accordance with environmen-
for inverse-time delayed protection of loads with normal and tal guidelines and contain environmentally friendly and reusable
heavy starting ("Function" see "Manual for SIRIUS 3RB24 Solid- materials.
State Overload Relay for IO-Link",) against excessive tempera- They comply with all important worldwide standards and ap-
ture rises due to overload, phase unbalance or phase failure. It provals.
comprises an evaluation unit, a current measuring module and
a connecting cable. The evaluation module 3RB24 also offers an Type of protection "increased safety EEx e and explosion-
motor starter function: The contactors, which are connected via proof enclosure EEx d" in accordance with ATEX Directive
the auxiliary contacts, can also be actuated for operation via 94/9/EC
IO-Link. In this way, direct, reversing and star-delta starters up to The electronic overload relay 3RB24 (monostable) are suitable
630 A (or 830 A) can be connected to the controller wirelessly for the overload protection of explosion-proof motors of types of
via the IO-Link controller. protection EEx e and EEx d.
An overload, phase unbalance or phase failure result in an in- They comply with the requirements of EN 60079-7 (Electrical ap-
crease of the motor current beyond the set rated motor current. paratus for areas subject to explosion hazards - Increased
This
This current
current rise
rise is
is detected
detected by by means
means ofof the
the current
current measuring
measuring safety "e" as well as for flameproof enclosure "d");
module
module (see
(see page
page3/55)
7/134)andandelectronically
electronicallyevaluated
evaluatedby by
thethe see www.siemens.com/sirius/atex.
evaluation module
evaluation module which
which isis connected
connected toto it. The evaluation
evaluation elec-
elec- EC type test certificate for Group II, Category (2) G/D has been
tronics sends
tronics sends aa signal
signaltoto the
the auxiliary
auxiliarycontacts.
contacts.The Theauxiliary
auxiliary submitted. On request.
contacts then switch off the load by by means
means of of aa contactor.
contactor. The

3/52 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


7/128 Siemens IC 10 · 2012
Overload Relays
Overload Relays
3RB24 Solid-State Overload Relays SIRIUS 3RB2 Solid-State Overload Relays
3RB24 for IO-Link, up to 630 A for High-Feature applications 3RB24 for IO-Link, up to 630 A
for High-Feature applications
Order No. scheme
Digit of the Order No. 1st - 3rd 4th 5th 6th 7th 8th 9th 10th 11th
@@@ @ @ @ @ – @ @ @ @
Solid-state overload relays 3RB
SIRIUS 2nd generation 2
Device series @
Size, rated operational current and power @
Version of the automatic RESET, electrical remote RESET @
Trip class (CLASS) @
Setting range of the overload release @
Connection methods @
Installation type @

3
Example 3RB 2 4 8 3 – 4 A A 1

Note: For your orders, please use the order numbers quoted in the

RELAYS
OVERLOAD
catalog in the Selection and ordering data.
The Order No. scheme is presented here merely for information
purposes and for better understanding of the logic behind the
order numbers.

Benefits
The most important features and benefits of the 3RB24 solid-
state overload relays for IO-Link are listed in the overview table
(see "General Data", page 3/2 onwards).

Advantages through energy efficiency We offer you a unique portfolio for industrial energy manage-
ment, using an energy management system that helps to opti-

7
mally define your energy needs. We split up our industrial en-
ergy management into three phases – Identification, Evaluation
and Realization – and we support you with the appropriate hard-
ware and software solutions in every process phase.
The innovative products of the SIRIUS industrial controls portfo-
lio can also make a substantial contribution to a plant's energy
efficiency (see www.siemens.com/sirius/energysaving).
3RB24 solid-state overload relays for IO-Link contribute to en-
ergy efficiency throughout the plant as follows:
• Transmission of current values
4
0 24

• Reduced inherent power loss


1_ 0

• Less heating of the control cabinet


IC0

• Smaller control cabinet air conditioners can be used


Overview of the energy management process

Application
Industries If single-phase AC motors are to be protected by the 3RB24
solid-state overload relays, the main current paths of the current
The 3RB24 solid-state overload relays are suitable for customers measuring modules must be series-connected ("Schematics"
from all industries who want to guarantee optimum inverse-time see "Manual for SIRIUS 3RB24 Solid-State Overload Relay for
delayed and temperature-dependent protection of their electri- IO-Link",).
cal loads (e.g. motors) under normal and heavy starting condi-
tions (CLASS 5 to 30), minimize project completion times, inven- Ambient conditions
tories and energy consumption, and optimize plant availability
and maintenance management. The devices are insensitive to external influences such as
shocks, corrosive ambient conditions, ageing and temperature
Application fluctuations.
The 3RB24 solid-state overload relays have been designed for For the temperature range from –25 C to +60 °C, the 3RB24
the protection of three-phase asynchronous and single-phase solid-state overload relays compensate the temperature in ac-
AC motors. cordance with IEC 60947-4-1.
In addition to protection function, these devices can be used to- Configuration notes for use of the devices below –25 °C or
gether with contactors as direct or reversing starters (star-delta above +60 °C on request.
(wye-delta) start also possible), which are controlled via IO-Link.
This makes it possible to directly control drives via IO-Link from
a higher-level controller or on site via the optional hand-held de-
vice lamps and also, for example, to return current values di-
rectly via IO-Link.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/53


Siemens IC 10 · 2012 7/129
Overload Relays Overload Relays
3RB24 Solid-State Overload Relays SIRIUS 3RB2 Solid-State Overload Relays
3RB24 for IO-Link, up to 630 A
3RB24 for IO-Link, up to 630 A for High-Feature applications for High-Feature applications

Selection and ordering data


3RB24 solid-state overload relays (evaluation module) for full motor protection, stand-alone installation,
CLASS 5, 10, 20 and 30, adjustable
Type 3RB24 83-4A.1
Features and technical specifications
Overload protection, phase failure protection and unbalance protection
Supplied from an external voltage
24 V DC through IO-Link
Direct-on-line or reversing starters (wye-delta starting also possible) controllable through IO-Link
Auxiliary contacts
1 CO and 1 NO in series
Manual and automatic RESET
3

Remote-RESET
(electrically or via IO-Link)
4 LEDs for operating and status displays
OVERLOAD
RELAYS

TEST function and self-monitoring


Internal ground-fault detection
Screw or spring-type terminals for auxiliary, control and sensor circuits
Input for PTC sensor circuit
Analog output
IO-Link-specific functions
• Connection of direct-on-line, reversing and star-delta starters to the controller via IO-Link
• On-site controlling of the starter using the hand-held device
• Accessing process data (e.g. current values in all three phases) via IO-Link
• Accessing parameterization and diagnostics data (e.g. tripped signals) via IO-Link

7
Available

PU (UNIT, SET, M) = 1
PS* = 1 unit
PG = 41G

3RB24 83-4AA1 3RB24 83-4AC1

Size of Version Screw terminals Spring-type terminals


contactor
Order No. Price Order No. Price
per PU per PU

Evaluation modules
S00 ... S12 Monostable 3RB24 83-4AA1 3RB24 83-4AC1

Notes:
• Analog input modules, e.g. SM 331, must be configured for Current
Current measuring
measuring modules
modules and
and related
related connecting
connectingcables
cablessee
see
. transducers. The analog input module may
4-wire measuring page
page 3/55,
3/55, accessories
accessories see
see pages
pages3/56
3/56 and
and 3/57.
3/57.
not supply current to the analog output of the 3RB24 relay.

3/54 Siemens
* You can order Industry
this quantity Inc., Industrial
or a multiple thereof. Control Catalog
Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2012 7/133
Overload Relays
Overload Relays

3RB24
SIRIUSSolid-State Overload
3RB2 Solid-State Relays
Overload Relays
Current measuring modules for
Current measuring modules for 3RB22, 3RB23, 3RB24
3RB22, 3RB23, 3RB24

Selection and ordering data


Current measuring modules for mounting onto contactor1) and stand-alone installation1)2) (essential accessories)
Size con- Rating for Current set- Short-circuit pro- For over- DT Order No. Price PU Pack PG
tactor3) induction ting of the tection with fuse, load per PU (UNIT, Units
motor,4) inverse-time type of coordina- relays SET, M)
delayed tion "2", opera-
overload tional class gG5)
release
kW A A
Sizes S00/S02)6)
S00/S0 0.09 … 1.1 0.3 … 3 20 3RB22 to } 3RB29 06-2BG1 1 1 unit 41G
1.1 … 11 2.4 … 25 63 3RB24 } 3RB29 06-2DG1 1 1 unit 41G

3
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
3RB29 06-2.G1
Sizes S2/S32)6)
S2/S3 5.5 … 45 10 … 100 315 3RB22 to } 3RB29 06-2JG1 1 1 unit 41G
3RB24

3RB29 06-2JG1
Size S61)6)
7

S6 with 11 … 90 20 … 200 315 3RB22 to } 3RB29 56-2TH2 1 1 unit 41G


busbar 3RB24
connection
For mount- 3RB22 to } 3RB29 56-2TG2 1 1 unit 41G
ing to S6 3RB24
3RB29 56-2TG2 contactors
with box
terminals
Sizes S10/S121)
S10/S12 37 … 450 63 … 630 800 3RB22 to } 3RB29 66-2WH2 1 1 unit 41G
and 3RB24
size 14
(3TF68/
3TF69)

3RB29 66-2WH2
3)
Note: Observe maximum rated operational current of the devices.
4)
Guide value for 4-pole standard motors at 50 Hz 400 V AC. The actual
The connecting cable between the current measuring module starting and rated data of the motor to be protected must be considered
and the evaluation module is not included in the scope of sup- when selecting the units.
ply; please order separately. 5)
Maximum protection by fuse for overload relay, type of coordination "2".
"Fuse Values in Connection with Contactors" see
1)
The current measuring modules with an Order No. ending with "2" are - "Configuration Manual for Configuring SIRIUS – Selection Data for Load
designed for mounting onto contactor and stand-alone installation. For Feeders in Fuseless and Fused Designs"
3TF68/3TF69 contactors, direct mounting is not possible. - "Configuration Manual for Configuring SIRIUS Innovations – Selection
2) Data for Load Feeders in Fuseless and Fused Designs".
The current measuring modules with an Order No. ending with "1" are 6)
designed for stand-alone installation. The modules with an Order No. with "G" in penultimate position are
equipped with a straight-through transformer.

Accessories
Size of con- Version For over- DT Order No. Price PU Pack PG
tactor load relays per PU (UNIT, Units
SET, M)

Connecting cables (necessary accessories)


For connection between evaluation module
and current measuring module
S00 ... S3 • Length 0.1 m 3RB24, } 3RB29 87-2B 1 1 unit 41F
(only for mounting of the evaluation mod- 3RB29
ule directly onto the current measuring
module)
3RB29 87-2. S00 ... S12 • Length 0.5 m 3RB24, } 3RB29 87-2D 1 1 unit 41F
3RB29

Additional general
Additional generalaccessories
accessoriessee
seepage
page3/57.
3/57.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/55


* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
7/136 Siemens IC 10 · 2012 Illustrations are approximate
Overload Relays Overload Relays
3RB24 Solid-State Overload Relays SIRIUS 3RB2 Solid-State Overload Relays
Accessories for 3RB22, 3RB23, 3RB24 Accessories for 3RB22, 3RB23, 3RB24

Overview
Overload relays for High-Feature applications • Terminal covers for the 3RB29 current measuring modules
sizes S6 and S10/S12
The following optional accessories are available for the 3RB22 to
3RB24 solid-state overload relays: • Box terminal blocks for the 3RB29 current measuring modules
sizes S6 and S10/S12
• Operator panel for the evaluation modules 3RB24
• Push-in lugs for screw fixing for 3RB22 to 3RB24 evaluation
• Manual 3RB24 modules and 3RB29 06 current measuring modules
• Sealable cover for the evaluation modules 3RB22 to 3RB24

Selection and ordering data


Accessories for overload relay 3RB24
Version For over- DT Order No. Price PU Pack PG
3

load relays per PU (UNIT, Units


SET, M)
OVERLOAD
RELAYS

Operator panels for evaluation modules


Operator panels (set) 3RB24 A 3RA69 35-0A 1 1 unit 42F
1 set comprises:
• 1 x operator panel
• 1 x 3RA69 36-0A enabling module
• 1 x 3RA69 33-0B interface cover
3RA69 35-0A • 1 x fixing terminal
Note:
The connecting cable between the evaluation
module and the operator panel is not included
in the scope of supply; please order sepa-

7
rately.
Connecting cable 3RB24 } 3UF79 33-0BA00-0 1 1 unit 42J
Length 2 m (round),
for connecting the evaluation module to the
operator panel
Enabling modules (replacement) 3RB24 A 3RA69 36-0A 1 1 unit 42F
Interface covers 3RB24 A 3RA69 33-0B 1 5 units 42F
1) The manual is also available as a free PDF download on the Internet at Additional general accessories see next page.
www.siemens.com/sirius/support "Manuals/Operating Instructions".

3/56 Siemens
* You can order Industry
this quantity Inc., Industrial
or a multiple thereof. Control Catalog
Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2012 7/137
Overload Relays
Overload Relays
3RB24
SIRIUSSolid-State Overload
3RB2 Solid-State Relays
Overload Relays
Accessories for 3RB22, 3RB23, 3RB24
Accessories for 3RB22, 3RB23, 3RB24
General accessories
Version Size For over- Order No. PU Pack
load relays (UNIT, Units
SET, M)

Sealable covers for evaluation modules


For covering the setting knobs -- 3RB22 to 3RB29 84-2 1 10 units
3RB24

3RB29 84-2
Terminal covers for current measuring modules

3
Covers for cable lugs and busbar con-
nections

RELAYS
OVERLOAD
• Length 100 mm S6 3RB29 56 3RT19 56-4EA1 1 1 unit
• Length 120 mm S10/S12 3RB29 66 3RT19 66-4EA1 1 1 unit
Covers for box terminals
• Length 25 mm S6 3RB29 56 3RT19 56-4EA2 1 1 unit
• Length 30 mm S10/S12 3RB29 66 3RT19 66-4EA2 1 1 unit
Covers for screw terminals S6 3RB29 56 3RT19 56-4EA3 1 1 unit
between contactor and overload relay, S10/S12 3RB29 66 3RT19 66-4EA3 1 1 unit
without box terminals
(1 unit required per combination)
Box terminal blocks for current measuring modules
For round and ribbon cables
• Up to 70 mm2 S61) 3RT19 55-4G
7

3RB29 56 1 1 unit
• Up to 120 mm2 S6 3RB29 56 3RT19 56-4G 1 1 unit
• Up to 240 mm2 S10/S12 3RB29 66 3RT19 66-4G 1 1 unit
Technical specifications for conductor cross-sections see "Reference
Manual for Protection Equipment–
3RT19 5.-4G 3RU1, 3RB2 Overload Relays".
Push-in lugs for evaluation modules and current measuring modules
For screw fixing the evaluation modules -- 3RB22 to 3RP19 03 1 10 units
3RB24
3RP19 03
For screw fixing the current measuring S00 ... S3 3RB29 06 3RB19 00-0B 100 10 units
modules
(2 units per module)

3RB29 00-0B
1) In the scope of supply for 3RT10 54-1 contactors (55 kW).

Version Size Color For over- Order No. PU Pack


load relays (UNIT, Units
SET, M)

Tools for opening spring-type terminals


Spring-type
terminals
Screwdrivers Length approx. 200 Titanium Main and 3RA29 08-1A 1 1 unit
For all SIRIUS mm, gray/ auxiliary cir-
devices with spring- 3.0 mm x 0.5 mm black, cuit connec-
3RA29 08-1A
type terminals partially tion: 3RB2
insulated
Blank labels
Unit labeling 20 mm x 7 mm Titanium 3RB24 3RT29 00-1SB20 100 340 units
plates1) gray
for SIRIUS devices 20 mm x 7 mm Pastel 3RB22, 3RT29 00-1SB20 100 340 units
turquoise 3RB23
NSB0_01429b

3RT19 00-1SB20
1)
PC labeling system for individual inscription
of unit labeling plates available from:
murrplastik Systemtechnik GmbH
(see "Appendix" "External Partners").

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/57


* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
7/138 Siemens IC 10 · 2012 Illustrations are approximate
Overload Relays
Overload Relays
SIRIUSSolid-State
3RB24 3RB2 Solid-State Overload
Overload Relays
Relays
3RB24 for IO-Link, up to 630 A
for High-Feature
3RB24 for IO-Link, upapplications
to 630 A for High-Feature applications

Technical specifications
Type – Overload relay of evaluation modules 3RB24 83-4A.1
Size of contactor S00 ... S10/S12
General data
Trips in the event of Overload, phase failure and phase unbalance (> 40 % according to NEMA),
+ ground fault (connectable and disconnectable) and activation of the thermis-
tor motor protection (with closed PTC sensor circuit)
Trip class acc. to IEC 60947-4-1 CLASS 5, 10, 20 and 30 adjustable
Phase failure sensitivity Yes
Overload warning Yes, from 1.125 x Ie for symmetrical loads
and from 0.85 x Ie for unsymmetrical loads
Reset and recovery
• Reset options after tripping Manual and automatic RESET, electrical remote RESET or through IO-Link
3

• Recovery time
- For automatic RESET min - for tripping due to overcurrent: 3 (stored permanently)
- for tripping by thermistor: time until the motor temperature has fallen 5 K
OVERLOAD
RELAYS

below the response temperature


- for tripping due to a ground fault: no automatic RESET
- For manual RESET min - for tripping due to overcurrent: 3 (stored permanently)
- for tripping by thermistor: time until the motor temperature has fallen 5 K
below the response temperature
- for tripping due to a ground fault: Immediately
- For remote RESET min - for tripping due to overcurrent: 3 (stored permanently)
- for tripping by thermistor: time until the motor temperature has fallen 5 K
below the response temperature
- for tripping due to a ground fault: Immediately
Features
• Display of operating state on device Yes, with 4 LEDs
- Green LED "DEVICE/IO-Link"
7

- Red "Ground Fault" LED


- Red "Thermistor" LED
- Red "Overload" LED
• TEST function Yes, test of LEDs, electronics, auxiliary contacts and wiring of control circuit by
pressing the button TEST/RESET / self-monitoring
• RESET button Yes, with the TEST/RESET button
• STOP button No
Explosion protection – Safe operation of motors with "increased
safety EEX e and explosion-proof
enclosure EEx d" type of protection
EC type test certificate number according to On request
directive 94/9/EC (ATEX)
Ambient temperatures
• Storage/transport °C -40 ... +80
• Operation °C -25 ... +60
• Temperature compensation °C +60
• Permissible rated current
- Temperature inside control cabinet 60 °C % 100
- Temperature inside control cabinet 70 °C % On request
Repeat terminals
• Coil repeat terminals Not required
• Auxiliary contact repeat terminal Not required
Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60529 IP20: Current measuring modules in sizes S6 and S10/S12 with busbar
connection in conjunction with the cover
Touch protection acc. to IEC 61140 Finger-safe: Current measuring modules in sizes S6 and S10/S12 with busbar
connection in conjunction with the cover
Shock resistance with sine acc. to IEC 60068-2-27 g/ms 15/11
Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) – Interference immunity
• Conductor-related interference
- Burst acc. to IEC 61000-4-4 (corresponds to degree of severity 3) kV 2 (power ports), 1 (signal ports)
- Surge acc. to IEC 61000-4-5 (corresponds to degree of severity 3) kV 2 (line to earth), 1 (line to line)
• Electrostatic discharge according to IEC 61000-4-2 kV 8 (air discharge), 6 (contact discharge)
(corresponds to degree of severity 3)
• Field-related interference according to IEC 61000-4-3 V/m 10
(corresponds to degree of severity 3)
Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) – emitted interference Degree of severity A according to EN 55011 (CISPR 11) and
EN 55022 (CISPR 22)
Resistance to extreme climates – air humidity % 100
Dimensions "Dimensional drawings" see "Manual for SIRIUS 3RB24 Solid-State Overload
Relay for IO-Link".
Installation altitude above sea level m Up to 2 000
Mounting position Any
Type of mounting
• Evaluation modules Stand-alone installation
• Current measuring module Size S00 to S3: Stand-alone installation,
S6 and S10/S12: stand-alone installation or mounting onto contactors

3/58 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


7/130 Siemens IC 10 · 2012
Overload Relays
Overload Relays
3RB24 Solid-State Overload Relays SIRIUS 3RB2 Solid-State Overload Relays
3RB24 for IO-Link, up to 630 A
3RB24 for IO-Link, up to 630 A for High-Feature applications
for High-Feature applications

Type – Overload relay of evaluation modules 3RB24 83-4A.1


Size of contactor S00 ... S10/S12

H
Dimensions of evaluation modules (W x H x D) mm 45 x 111 x 95

D
W

Auxiliary circuit
Number of auxiliary switches 1 CO contact, 1 NO contact connected in series internally
Auxiliary contacts – assignment • 1 CO contact for selecting the contactor (for reversing starter func-
tion), actuated by the control system
• 1 NO contact for normal switching duty, actuated by the control sys-
tem (opens automatically when tripping occurs)
Rated insulation voltage Ui (pollution degree 3) V 300
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 4
Auxiliary contacts – contact rating

3
• NC contact with alternating current AC-14/AC-15, rated operational current Ie at Ue
- 24 V A 6

RELAYS
OVERLOAD
- 120 V A 6
- 125 V A 6
- 250 V A 3
• NO contact with alternating current AC-14/AC-15, rated operational current Ie at Ue
- 24 V A 6
- 120 V A 6
- 125 V A 6
- 250 V A 3
• NC contact, NO contact with direct current DC-13, rated operational current Ie at Ue
- 24 V A 2
- 60 V A 0.55
- 110 V A 0.3
- 125 V A 0.3

7
- 250 V A 0.2
• Conventional thermal current Ith A 5
• Contact reliability (suitability for PLC control; 17 V, 5 mA) Yes
Short-circuit protection
• With fuse, operational class gG A 6
• With miniature circuit breaker, C characteristic A 1.6
Protective separation between auxiliary conducting paths V 300
acc. to IEC 60947-1
CSA, UL, UR rated data
Auxiliary circuit – switching capacity B300, R300
Conductor cross-sections of the auxiliary circuit
Connection type Screw terminals

Terminal screw M3, Pozidriv size 2


Operating devices mm 3.0 x 0.5
Prescribed tightening torque Nm 0.8 ... 1.2
Conductor cross-sections (min./max.), 1 or 2 conductors can be connected
• Solid mm2 1 × (0.5 ... 4)1), 2 × (0.5 ... 2.5)1)
• Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 --
• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 1 × (0.5 ... 2.5)1), 2 × (0.5 ... 1.5)1)
• Stranded mm2 --
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 2 × (20 ... 14)
Connection type Spring-type terminals

Operating devices mm 3.0 x 0.5


Conductor cross-sections (min./max.), 1 or 2 conductors can be connected
• Solid mm2 2 × (0.25 ... 1.5)
• Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 –
• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 × (0.25 ... 1.5)
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 2 × (24 ... 16)

1) If two different conductor cross-sections are


connected to one clamping point, both
cross-sections must be in the range specified

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/59


Siemens IC 10 · 2012 7/131
Overload Relays
Overload Relays
SIRIUSSolid-State
3RB24 3RB2 Solid-State Overload
Overload Relays
Relays
3RB24 for IO-Link, up to 630 A
for High-Feature
3RB24 for IO-Link, upapplications
to 630 A for High-Feature applications

Type – Overload relay of evaluation modules 3RB24 83-4A.1


Size of contactor S00 ... S10/S12
Control and sensor circuit as well as the analog output
Rated insulation voltage Ui V 300
(pollution degree 3)
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 4
Rated control supply voltage Us
• DC V 24 through IO-Link
Operating range
• DC 0.85 × Us min ≤ Us ≤ 1.1 × Us max
Rated power
• DC W 0.5
Mains buffering time ms 200
3

Thermistor motor protection (PTC thermistor detector)


• Summation cold resistance kΩ ≤ 1.5
OVERLOAD
RELAYS

• Response value kΩ 3.4 ... 3.8


• Return value kΩ 1.5 ... 1.65
Ground-fault detection The information refers to sinusoidal residual currents at 50/60 Hz.
• Tripping value I∆
- For 0.3 × Ie < Imotor < 2.0 × Ie > 0.3 × Ie
- For 2.0 × Ie < Imotor < 8.0 × Ie > 0.15 × Imotor
• Response time ttrip ms 500 ... 1 000
Analog output1)
• Output signal mA 4 ... 20
• Measuring range 0 ... 1.25 × Ie
4 mA corresponds to 0 × Ie
7

16.8 mA corresponds to 1.0 × Ie


20 mA corresponds to 1.25 × Ie
• Load, max. Ω 100
Conductor cross-sections for the control and sensor circuit
as well as the analog output
Connection type Screw terminals

Terminal screw M3, Pozidriv size 2


Operating devices mm 3.0 x 0.5
Prescribed tightening torque Nm 0.8 ... 1.2
Conductor cross-sections (min./max.), 1 or 2 conductors can be connected
• Solid mm2 1 × (0.5 ... 4)2), 2 × (0.5 ... 2.5)2)
• Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 —
• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 1 × (0.5 ... 2.5)2), 2 × (0.5 ... 1.5)2)
• Stranded mm2 —
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 2 × (20 ... 14)
Connection type Spring-type terminals

Operating devices mm 3.0 x 0.5


Conductor cross-sections (min./max.), 1 or 2 conductors can be connected
• Solid mm2 2 × (0.25 ... 1.5)
• Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 —
• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 × (0.25 ... 1.5)
• Stranded mm2 2 × (0.25 ... 1.5)
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 2 × (24 ... 16)
1) Analog input modules, e.g. SM 331, must be configured for 4-wire measuring
transducers. The analog input module may not supply current to the
analog output of the 3RB24 overload relay.
2) Iftwo different conductor cross-sections are connected to one clamping
point, both cross-sections must be in the range specified.

3/60 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


7/132 Siemens IC 10 · 2012
Overload Relays
Overload Relays

3RB24
SIRIUSSolid-State Overload
3RB2 Solid-State Relays
Overload Relays
Current measuring modules for
Current measuring modules for 3RB22, 3RB23, 3RB24
3RB22, 3RB23, 3RB24

Overview
The current measuring modules are designed as system com-
ponents for connecting to evaluation units 3RB22 to 3RB24. Us-
ing these evaluation units the motor current is measured and the
measured value sent to the evaluation unit for evaluation. The
current measuring modules in sizes S00 to S3 up to 55 mm wide
are equipped with straight-through transformers and can be
snap-fitted under the evaluation units. The larger evaluation units
are installed directly on the contactor or as stand-alond units.

3
RELAYS
OVERLOAD
SIRIUS 3RB29 06 current measuring module

Technical specifications
Type – Overload relays: Current measuring 3RB29 06 3RB29 56 3RB29 66
modules
Size of contactor S00/S0 S2/S3 S6 S10/S12
H

Dimensions of current measuring modules mm 45 x 84 x 45 55 x 94 x 72 120 x 119 x 145 145 x 147 x 148
D

W
(W x H x D)
Main circuit
7

Rated insulation voltage Ui V 1 000


(pollution degree 3)
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 6 8
Rated operational voltage Ue V 1 000
Type of current
• Direct current No
• Alternating current Yes, 50/60 Hz ± 5 %
Current setting A 0.3 ... 3; 10 ... 100 20 ... 200 63 ... 630
2.4 ... 25
Power loss per unit (max.) W 0.5
Short-circuit protection
• With fuse without contactor See "Selection and ordering data" on page 3/55.
• With fuse and contactor See
- "Configuration Manual for Configuring SIRIUS – Selection Data for
Load Feeders in Fuseless and Fused Designs"
- "Configuration Manual for Configuring SIRIUS Innovations – Selection
Data for Load Feeders in Fuseless and Fused Designs"
Protective separation between main and auxiliary conducting paths V 690 for grounded networks, otherwise 600
acc. to IEC 60947-1 (pollution degree 2)

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/61


7/134 Siemens IC 10 · 2012
Overload Relays
Overload Relays
3RB24 Solid-State Overload Relays SIRIUS 3RB2 Solid-State Overload Relays
Current measuring modules for
Current measuring modules for 3RB22, 3RB23, 3RB24
3RB22, 3RB23, 3RB24

Type – Overload relays: Current measuring 3RB29 06 3RB29 56 3RB29 66


modules
Size of contactor S00/S0 S2/S3 S6 S10/S12

H
Dimensions of current measuring modules mm 45 x 84 x 45 55 x 94 x 72 120 x 119 x 145 145 x 147 x 148

D
W
(W x H x D)
Conductor cross-sections of the main circuit
Connection type Screw terminals with box terminal

Terminal screw mm — 4 mm Allen screw 5 mm Allen screw


Operating devices mm — 4 mm Allen screw 5 mm Allen screw
Prescribed tightening torque Nm — 10 ... 12 20 ... 22
Conductor cross-sections (min./max.), 1 or 2 conductors can be connected
• Solid mm2 — — —
3

• Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 — With 3RT19 55-4G 2 × (50 ... 185),
box terminal: rear clamping point
2 × (1 × max. 50, only:
OVERLOAD
RELAYS

1 × max. 70), 1 × (70 ... 240)


1 × (10 ... 70)
With 3RT19 56-4G Rear clamping point
box terminal: only:
2 × (1 × max. 95, 1 × (120 ... 185)
1 × max. 120),
1 × (10 ... 120)
• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 — With 3RT19 55-4G 2 × (50 ... 185),
box terminal: rear clamping point
2 × (1 × max. 50, only:
1 × max. 70), 1 × (70 ... 240)
1 × (10 ... 70)
With 3RT19 56-4G Rear clamping point

7
box terminal: only:
2 × (1 × max. 95, 1 × (120 ... 185)
1 × max. 120),
1 × (10 ... 120)
• Stranded mm2 — With 3RT19 55-4G 2 × (70 ... 240),
box terminal: rear clamping point
2 × (max. 70), only:
1 × (16 ... 70) 1 × (95 ... 300)
With 3RT19 56-4G
box terminal: Rear clamping point
2 × (max. 120), only:
1 × (16 ... 120) 1 × (120 ... 240)
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG — With 3RT19 55-4G 2 × (2/0 ... 500 kcmil),
box terminal: rear clamping point
2 × (max. 1/0), only:
1 × (6 ... 2/0) 1 × (3/0 ... 600 kcmil)
With 3RT19 56-4G
box terminal: Rear clamping point
2 × (max. 3/0), only:
1 × (6 ... 250 kcmil) 1×
(250 kcmil ... 500 kcmil)
• Ribbon cables (number x width x thickness) mm — With 3RT19 55-4G 2 × (20 × 24 × 0.5),
box terminal: 1 × (6 × 9 × 0.8 ...
2 × (6 × 15.5 × 0.8), 20 × 24 × 0.5)
1 × (3 × 9 × 0.8 ...
6 × 15.5 × 0.8)
With 3RT19 56-4G
box terminal:
2 × (10 × 15.5 × 0.8),
1 × (3 × 9 × 0.8 ...
10 × 15.5 × 0.8)
Connection type Busbar connections
Terminal screw — M8 × 25 M10 x 30
Prescribed tightening torque Nm — 10 ... 14 14 ... 24
Conductor cross-sections (min./max.), 1 or 2 conductors can be connected
• Solid with cable lug mm2 — 16 ... 951) 50 ... 2402)
• Stranded with cable lug mm2 — 25 ... 1201) 70 ... 2402)
• AWG cable, solid or stranded, with cable lug AWG — 4 ... 250 kcmil 2/0 ... 500 kcmil
• with connecting bar (max. width) mm — 17 25
Connection type Straight-through transformers
Diameter of opening mm 7.5 14 25 —
1) When connecting cable lugs according to DIN 46235 with conductor 2) When connecting cable lugs according to DIN 46234 with conductor
cross-sections of 95 mm2 and more, the 3RT19 56-4EA1 terminal cover cross-sections of 240 mm2 and more as well as to DIN 46235 with conduc-
must be used to ensure phase spacing. tor cross-sections of 185 mm2 and more, the 3RT19 56-4EA1 terminal
cover must be used for to keep the phase clearance.

3/62 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Siemens IC 10 · 2012 7/135
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 Motor Management and Control Devices
General data
General data

■ Overview
SIMOCODE pro offers, for example:
• Multifunctional, solid-state full motor protection that is
independent of the automation system
• Integrated control functions instead of hardware for the motor
control
• Detailed operational, service and diagnostics data
• Open communication via PROFIBUS, PROFINET/PROFIsafe,
Modbus RTU, and Ethernet IP and OPC UA – which also lets
you take advantage of the cloud
• Safety relay function for the fail-safe disconnection of motors
up to SIL 3 (IEC 61508, IEC 62061) or PL e with Category 4

3
(EN ISO 13849-1)
• SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal) is the software package for

RELAYS
OVERLOAD
SIMOCODE pro parameterization, start up and diagnostics.
Device series
Basic Performance with SIMOCODE pro C
SIMOCODE pro S and SIMOCODE pro V
The compact system for direct-on-line starters and reversing
More information starters or for controlling a motor starter protector.
Home page, see
Homepage, see www.usa.siemens.com/simocode
www.siemens.com/simocode General Performance with SIMOCODE pro S or
Industry
IndustryMall,
Mall,see
seewww.siemens.com/product?3UF7
www.siemens.com/product?3UF7 SIMOCODE pro V PN GP
TIA
TIA Selection
SelectionTool
ToolCloud
Cloud(TST
(TSTCloud)
Cloud) The smart system for direct-on-line, reversing, and wye-delta
• For SIMOCODE
• For SIMOCODEpro proS,S,see
see starters or for controlling a motor starter protector or soft starter.
https://mall.industry.siemens.com/spice/TSTWeb/?kmat=SimocodeProS
https://mall.industry.siemens.com/spice/TSTWeb/?kmat=SimocodeProS
• For SIMOCODE
• For SIMOCODEpro proV,V,see
see Its expandability with an expansion module/multifunction
https://mall.industry.siemens.com/spice/TSTWeb/?kmat=SimocodeProV
https://mall.industry.siemens.com/spice/TSTWeb/?kmat=SimocodeProV module provides comprehensive input/output project data
volume, precise ground-fault detection via the 3UL23 residual-
SIMOCODE pro is a flexible, modular motor management current transformers and temperature measurement.
system for motors with constant speeds in the low-voltage
performance range. It optimizes the connection between I&C High Performance with SIMOCODE pro V
and motor feeder, increases plant availability and allows The variable system with all control functions and with the
significant savings to be made for installation, commissioning, possibility of expanding the inputs, outputs and functions of
operation and maintenance of a system. the system at will using expansion modules

10
PROFINET IO / OPC UA ETHERNET / IP PROFIBUS MODBUS RTU

Current/voltage measuring module

Operator panel with display

Performance
High

Max. 5/7 expansion modules

Safety
SIMOCODE pro V PN SIMOCODE pro V EIP SIMOCODE pro V PB SIMOCODE pro V MR

Extended control functions


(e.g. positioner, pole-changing starter)

Current measuring module


Performance

Operator panel
General

1 expansion module
IC01_00548a

Basic control functions SIMOCODE pro V PN GP SIMOCODE pro S


(e.g. direct-on-line/reversing start)

Device series

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/63
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE pro 3UF7
SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 Motor Management and Control Devices
General data
General data

Basic Optional expansions


Current Basic unit Operator Multifunction module
measuring module panel
SIMOCODE pro S

PROFIBUS

Functions
3RELAYS
OVERLOAD

Optional expansions
One option can be selected
1 2 3
Basic
Current Basic unit Operator Ground-fault Temperature Digital module
measuring module panel module module Standard
SIMOCODE pro V PN GP

PROFINET

Functions
IC01_00532a
10

Basic Optional expansions


Current/voltage Basic unit Operator Earth-fault Temperature Digital modules Analog
measuring module panel module module Standard Fail-safe module
SIMOCODE pro V

Communication
Functions

Communication at basic unit via:


PROFIBUS/PROFIsafe Modbus RTU
PROFINET/PROFIsafe EtherNet/IP
OPC UA
System structure

3/64 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC

Siemens IC 10 · 2019
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 Motor Management and Control Devices
General data
General data

Expansion possibilities SIMOCODE pro C SIMOCODE pro S SIMOCODE pro V SIMOCODE pro V
Basic Performance General Performance General Performance High Performance
PROFIBUS PROFIBUS PROFINET GP PROFIBUS/Modbus PROFINET/
RTU EtherNet/IP
Operator panels ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓
Operator panels -- -- -- ✓ ✓
with display
Current measuring modules ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓
Current/voltage measuring modules -- -- -- ✓ ✓
Expansion modules:
• Digital modules -- -- 12) 2 2
• Fail-safe digital modules1) -- -- -- 1 1

3
• Analog modules -- -- -- 1 2

RELAYS
OVERLOAD
• Ground-fault modules -- -- 1 1 1
• Temperature modules -- -- 1 1 2
• Multifunction modules -- 1 -- -- --
1)
✓ Available The fail-safe digital module can be used instead of one of the two digital
-- Not available modules.
2)
Only monostable version can be used.

Per feeder each system always comprises one basic unit and added to the SIMOCODE pro V and SIMOCODE pro S by
one current measuring module. The two modules are connected means of optional expansion modules, thus supplementing the
together electrically through the system interface with a connec- inputs and outputs already existing on the basic unit. With the
tion cable and can be mounted mechanically connected (one DM-F Local and DM-F PROFIsafe fail-safe digital modules it is
behind the other) or separately (side by side). The motor current also possible to integrate the fail-safe disconnection of motors in
to be monitored determines the size of the current measuring the SIMOCODE pro V motor management system.
module.
All modules are connected by connection cables. The connec-
An operator panel for mounting in the control cabinet door is tion cables are available in various lengths. The maximum dis-
optionally connectable through a second system interface on tance between modules (e.g. between the basic unit and the
the basic unit. Both the current measuring module and the current measuring module) must not exceed 2.5 m. The total
operator panel are electrically supplied by the basic unit through length of all the connection cables per system interface of the
the connection cable. More inputs, outputs and functions can be basic unit may be up to 3 m.

Article No. scheme

10
Product versions Article number
SIMOCODE pro motor management system 3UF7 @@@– 1 @@0 @– 0
Type of unit/module e.g. 0 = basic unit @
Functional version of the module e.g. 20 = SIMOCODE pro S @@
Connection type of the current transformer e.g. A = through-hole technology @
Voltage version e.g. B = 24 V DC @
Enclosure color e.g. 1 = titanium gray @
Example 3UF7 0 2 0 – 1 A B 0 1 – 0
Note:
The Article No. scheme shows an overview of product versions For your orders, please use the article numbers quoted in the
for better understanding of the logic behind the article numbers. selection and ordering data.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/65

Siemens IC 10 · 2019
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE
SIMOCODE pro pro
3UF73UF7
Motor Management and Control Devices
General data
General data

■ Benefits
General customer benefits Recording of measuring curves
• Integrating the whole motor feeder into the process control by SIMOCODE pro can record measuring curves and therefore is
means of PROFIBUS DP, PROFINET/OPC UA, Modbus RTU able, for example, to present the progression of motor current
or EtherNet/IP significantly reduces the wiring between the during motor start up.
motor feeder and the PLC
• Decentralization of the automated processes by means of Flexible motor control implemented with integrated control
configurable control and monitoring functions in the feeder functions (instead of comprehensive hardware interlocks)
saves resources in the automation system and ensures full Many predefined motor control functions have already been
functionality and protection of the feeder even if the I&C or bus integrated into SIMOCODE pro, including all necessary logic
system fails operations and interlocks:
• The acquisition and monitoring of operating, service and • Overload relays
diagnostics data in the feeder and process control system
3

• Direct-on-line and reversing starters


increases plant availability as well as maintenance and
service-friendliness • Wye/delta starters (also with direction reversal)
OVERLOAD
RELAYS

• The high degree of modularity allows users to perfectly • Two speeds, motors with separate windings (pole-changing
implement their plant-specific requirements for each starter); also with direction reversal
motor feeder • Two speeds, motors with separate Dahlander windings
• The SIMOCODE pro system offers functionally graded and (also with direction reversal)
space-saving solutions for each customer application • Positioner actuation
• The replacement of the control circuit hardware with integrated • Solenoid valve actuation
control functions decreases the number of hardware compo- • Actuation of a motor starter protector
nents and wiring required and in this way limits stock keeping
costs and potential wiring errors • Soft starter actuation (also with direction reversal)
• The use of electronic full motor protection permits better These control functions are predefined in SIMOCODE pro and
utilization of the motors and ensures long-term stability of can be freely assigned to the inputs and outputs of the device
the tripping characteristic and reliable tripping even after (including the PROFIBUS/PROFINET process image).
years of service
These predefined control functions can also be flexibly adapted
• Thanks to the precision of the current, voltage, power and to each customized configuration of a motor feeder by means of
energy measurements, costs can be internally allocated with freely configurable logic modules (truth tables, counters, timers,
a high degree of accuracy edge evaluation, etc.) and with the help of standard functions
• By virtue of its wide frequency range (20 to 400 Hz), (power failure monitoring, emergency start, external faults, etc.),
SIMOCODE can be used in combination with the without additional auxiliary relays being necessary in the control
2nd-generation current/voltage measuring modules circuit.
in a wide range of motor applications. SIMOCODE pro makes a lot of additional hardware and wiring
Multifunctional, electronic full motor protection in the control circuit unnecessary, which results in a high level
for rated motor currents up to 820 A of standardization of the motor feeder in terms of its design and
circuit diagrams.
SIMOCODE pro offers comprehensive protection of the motor
10

feeder by means of a combination of different, multi-step and


delayable protection and monitoring functions:
• Inverse-time delayed electronic overload protection
(CLASS 5E to 40E)
• Thermistor motor protection
• Phase failure/unbalance protection
• Stall protection
• Monitoring of adjustable limit values for the motor current
• Voltage and power monitoring
• Monitoring of the power factor (motor idling/load shedding)
• Ground-fault monitoring
• Temperature monitoring, e.g. via Pt100/Pt1000
• Monitoring of operating hours, downtime and number of
starts etc.

3/66 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC

Siemens IC 10 · 2019
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 Motor Management and Control Devices
General data
General data
Detailed operational, service and diagnostics data Communication
SIMOCODE pro makes different operational, service and SIMOCODE pro V has either an integrated PROFIBUS DP
diagnostics data available and helps to detect potential faults or Modbus RTU interface (SUB-D or terminal connection)
in time and to prevent them by means of preventative measures. or a PROFINET or EtherNet/IP interface (2 x RJ45).
In the event of a malfunction, a fault can be diagnosed, localized
and rectified very quickly – there are no or very short downtimes. Fail-safe disconnection through PROFIBUS or PROFINET with
the PROFIsafe profile is also possible in conjunction with a
Operating data fail-safe controller (F-CPU) and the DM-F PROFIsafe fail-safe
• Motor switching state derived from the current flow in the main digital module.
circuit SIMOCODE pro PROFIBUS
• All phase currents SIMOCODE pro PROFIBUS supports, for example:
• All phase voltages and phase-to-phase voltages • Cyclic services (DPV0) and acyclic services (DPV1)
• Active power, apparent power and power factor • Extensive diagnostics and hardware interrupts

3
• Phase unbalance and phase sequence • Time stamp with high timing precision (SIMATIC S7)
• Ground-fault current for SIMOCODE pro V

RELAYS
OVERLOAD
• Frequency • DPV1 communication after the Y-Link
• Time to trip SIMOCODE pro PROFINET
• Motor temperature
SIMOCODE pro PROFINET supports, for example:
• Remaining cooling time etc.
• Line and ring bus topology (for 2-port devices with an
Service data integrated switch)
• Motor operating hours • Media redundancy via MRP protocol (for 2-port devices with
• Motor stop times an integrated switch)
• Number of motor starts • Operating, service and diagnostics data via standard web
browser
• Number of overload trips
• OPC UA server for open communication with visualization and
• Interval for compulsory testing of the enabling circuits control system
• Energy consumed • NTP-synchronized time
• Internal comments stored in the device etc. • Interval function and measured values for power
Diagnostics data management via PROFIenergy
• Numerous detailed early warning and fault messages • Module exchange without PC/memory module through
proximity detection
• Internal device fault logging with time stamp
• Extensive diagnostics and maintenance alarms
• Time stamping of freely selectable status, alarm or fault
messages etc. System redundancy with SIMOCODE pro PROFINET
Easy operation and diagnostics All SIMOCODE PROFINET devices support the system
redundancy mechanisms of PROFINET IO and therefore
Operator panel can be operated directly on fault-tolerant systems such as

10
The operator panel is used to control the motor feeder and can SIMATIC S7-400 H. As such, SIMOCODE pro can provide
replace all conventional pushbuttons and indicator lights to save decisive added value also for the field level of plants in which
space. It makes SIMOCODE pro or the feeder directly operable plant availability and control system redundancy are priorities.
in the control cabinet. It features all the status LEDs available on SIMOCODE pro Modbus RTU
the basic unit and externalizes the system interface for simple
parameterization or diagnosis on a PC/PG. SIMOCODE pro Modbus RTU supports, for example:
Operator panel with display • Communication at 1 200/2 400/4 800/9 600/19 200 or
57 600 baud
As an alternative to the 3UF720 standard operator panel for • Access to freely parameterizable process image via
SIMOCODE pro V, a 3UF721 operator panel with display is Modbus RTU
also available. This can additionally indicate current measured
values, operational and diagnostics data or status information of • Access to all operating, service and diagnostics data
the motor feeder at the control cabinet. The pushbuttons of the via Modbus RTU
operator panel can be used to control the motor. Furthermore, SIMOCODE pro EtherNet/IP
it is possible to set parameters such as rated motor current,
limit values, etc. directly via the operator panel with display SIMOCODE pro EtherNet/IP supports, for example:
(with SIMOCODE pro V PROFIBUS as of E15, SIMOCODE pro V • Line and ring bus topology thanks to an integrated switch
Modbus RTU as of E03 and with all SIMOCODE pro V PROFINET
and EtherNet/IP). • Ring structures via Device Level Ring (DLR) protocol
• Operating, service and diagnostics data via standard web
browser
• NTP-synchronized time
• Parameter assignment via SIMOCODE ES V14 or higher – via
local device interface and Ethernet

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/67
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE pro 3UF7
SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 Motor Management and Control Devices
General data
General data
Notes on security Advantages from integrated energy management
In order to protect plants, systems, machines and networks
against cyber threats, it is necessary to implement – and
continuously maintain – a holistic, state-of-the-art industrial
security concept. Siemens products and solutions represent
only one component of such a concept. Ready for Ready for
SIMATIC
siemens.com/ SIMATIC
For more information on Industrial Security, see Energy Suite
www.siemens.com/industrialsecurity. energysuite Energy Suite

Autonomous operation As an integrated option for the TIA Portal, the SIMATIC Energy
An essential feature of SIMOCODE pro is the autonomous Suite couples energy management with automation efficiently,
execution of all protection and control functions, even when making energy consumption at your production facility
communication to the I&C system is interrupted. This means transparent.
3

that even in the event of bus system or automation system Thanks to the simplified configuration of energy-measuring
failure, full functionality of the feeder is ensured or a specific components, e.g. SIMOCODE pro V, configuration effort is
behavior can be parameterized in case of such a fault, e.g. also clearly reduced.
OVERLOAD
RELAYS

targeted shutdown of the feeder or execution of particular


parameterized control mechanisms (such as reversal of the Thanks to end-to-end connection with higher-level energy
direction of rotation). management systems or cloud-based services, you can
seamlessly expand the recorded energy data to create a
cross-site energy management system.
The advantages at a glance:
• Automatic generation of energy management data
• Integration into TIA Portal and into automation
• Simple configuration
For more information, see
www.siemens.com/energysuite.

Application
SIMOCODE pro is often used for automated processes where With the DM-F Local and DM-F PROFIsafe fail-safe expansion
plant downtimes are very expensive (e.g. chemical, oil/gas, modules it is easy to integrate functions for fail-safe disconnection
water/wastewater, steel or cement industries) and where it is in the SIMOCODE pro V motor management system while
important to prevent plant downtimes through detailed retaining service-proven concepts. The strict separation of
operational, service and diagnostics data or to localize faults safety functions and operational functions proves particularly
very quickly when they occur. advantageous for planning, configuring and construction.
Seamless integration in the motor management system leads
SIMOCODE pro is modular and space-saving and suited to greater transparency for diagnostics and during operation
especially for operation in motor control centers (MCCs) of the system.
in the process industry and for power plant technology.
10

Suitable components for this purpose are the DM-F Local and
Applications DM-F PROFIsafe fail-safe expansion modules, depending on
• Protection and control of motors in hazardous areas for types the requirements:
of protection EEx e/d according to ATEX directive 2014/34/EU • The DM-F Local fail-safe digital module for when direct
- With heavy starting (paper, cement, metal and water assignment between a fail-safe hardware shutdown signal
industries) and a motor feeder is required, or
- In high-availability plants (chemical, oil, raw material
processing industries, power plants) • The DM-F PROFIsafe fail-safe digital module for when
a fail-safe controller (F-CPU) creates the signal for
• New: Dry-running protection of centrifugal pumps based disconnection and transmits it in a fail-safe manner
on active power monitoring for type of protection Ex b through PROFIBUS/PROFIsafe or PROFINET/PROFIsafe
Use of SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 with IE3/IE4 motors to the motor management system

Note: New: Dry-running protection of centrifugal pumps


with SIMOCODE pro in hazardous areas
When using the SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 in conjunction with highly
With special versions of the current/voltage measuring modules,
energy-efficient IE3/IE4 motors, please observe the information
SIMOCODE pro enables dry-running protection of centrifugal
on dimensioning and configuring, see Application Manual.
pumps through active power monitoring and motor switch-off.
This applies to centrifugal pumps with progressive flow
Safety technology for SIMOCODE pro characteristics, which are also suitable for pumping flammable
The safe disconnection of motors in the process industry is media and are also installed in hazardous areas. If the active
becoming increasingly important as the result of new and power, and thus the flow rate, falls below a minimum value,
revised standards and requirements in the safety technology the motor – and thus the centrifugal pump – is switched off.
field. When determining the limit values to be monitored, the user
is supported by a menu-guided teach-in process in the
engineering software.

3/68 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 Motor Management and Control Devices
Technical data
General data

■ Technical specifications
More information
Technical specifications, see Application Manual "SIRIUS Controls with IE3/IE4 motors", see
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16337/td https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/94770820
Manual Collection "SIMOCODE pro", see Configuration Manual "Load Feeders – SIRIUS Modular System", see
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109743951 https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/39714188
System Manual "SIMOCODE pro Safety Fail-Safe Digital Modules", see
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/50564852

General data
Type 3UF7
Permissible ambient temperature

3
• During operation °C -25 ... +60; 3UF721: 0 ... +60
• During storage and transport °C -40 ... +80; 3UF721: -20 ... +70
Degree of protection (acc. to IEC 60529)

RELAYS
OVERLOAD
• Measurement modules with busbar connection IP00
• Operator panel (front) and door adapter (front) with cover IP54
• Other components IP20
Shock resistance (sine pulse) g/ms 15/11
Mounting position Any
Frequency Hz 50/60  5%
EMC interference immunity (according to IEC 60947-1) Corresponds to degree of severity 3
• Conducted interference, burst acc. to IEC 61000-4-4 kV 2 (power ports)
kV 1 (signal port)
• Conducted interference, high frequency acc. to V 10
IEC 61000-4-6
• Conducted interference, surge acc. to IEC 61000-4-5 kV 2 (line to ground); 3UF7320-1AB, 3UF7330-1AB: 1 (line to ground)
kV 1 (line to line); 3UF7320-1AB, 3UF7330-1AB: 0.5 (line to line)
• Electrostatic discharge, ESD acc. to IEC 61000-4-2 kV 8 (air discharge); 3UF7020: Operator input during operation only on the front
kV 6 (contact discharge); 3UF721: 4 (contact discharge)
• Field-related interference acc. to IEC 61000-4-3 V/m 10
EMC emitted interference (according to IEC 60947-1)
• Conducted and radiated interference emission EN 55011/EN 55022 (CISPR 11/CISPR 22)
(corresponds to degree of severity A)
Protective separation (acc. to IEC 60947-1) All circuits in SIMOCODE pro are safely separated from each other according
to IEC 60947-1, i.e. they are designed with doubled creepage paths and
clearances. In this context, compliance with the instructions in the test report
"Safe Isolation" No. 2668 is required.

10

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/69

Siemens IC 10 · 2019
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE pro 3UF7
SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 Motor Management and Control Devices
Technical data
General data

Basic units
Type 3UF7000-1AU00-0, 3UF7010-1AU00-0, 3UF7000-1AB00-0, 3UF7010-1AB00-0,
3UF7011-1AU00-., 3UF7020-1AU01-0, 3UF7011-1AB00-., 3UF7020-0AB01-0,
3UF7012-1AU00-0, 3UF7013-1AU00-0 3UF7012-1AB00-0, 3UF7013-1AB00-0
Control circuit
Rated control supply voltage Us (acc. to IEC 61131-2) 110 ... 240 V AC/DC; 50/60 Hz 24 V DC
Operating range
• SIMOCODE pro C (3UF7000) and SIMOCODE pro V PROFIBUS 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us 0.80 ... 1.2 × Us
(3UF7010) SIMOCODE pro V Modbus RTU (3UF7012)
• SIMOCODE pro V PROFINET (3UF7011), SIMOCODE pro V
EtherNet/IP (3UF7013) and SIMOCODE pro S (3UF7020)
- Operation 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us 0.80 ... 1.2 × Us
- Start up 0.85 ... 1.1 x Us 0.85 ... 1.2 × Us
Power consumption1)
• SIMOCODE pro C (3UF7000) and SIMOCODE pro S (3UF7020) 7 VA/5 W 5W
3

• SIMOCODE pro V PROFIBUS (3UF7010) and SIMOCODE pro V 10 VA/7 W 7W


Modbus RTU (3UF7012)
• SIMOCODE pro V PROFIBUS E15/V4.0 (3UF7010-1A.00-0 -Z B01) 7 VA/5 W 4W
OVERLOAD
RELAYS

and SIMOCODE pro V Modbus RTU E03/V2.0


(3UF7012-1A.00-0-Z B01)
• SIMOCODE pro V PROFINET (3UF7011) and 11 VA/8 W 8W
SIMOCODE pro V EtherNet/IP (3UF7013)
Rated insulation voltage Ui V 300 (for pollution degree 3)
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 4
Relay outputs
• Number
- SIMOCODE pro C, SIMOCODE pro V (incl. SIMOCODE pro V PN GP) 3 monostable relay outputs
- SIMOCODE pro S 2 monostable relay outputs
• Specified short-circuit protection for auxiliary contacts
(relay outputs) - Fuse links 6 A operational class gG; 10 A quick-response (IEC 60947-5-1)
- Miniature circuit breaker 1.6 A, C characteristic (IEC 60947-5-1); 6 A, C characteristic (Ik < 500 A)
• Rated uninterrupted current A 6
• Rated switching capacity - AC-15 6 A/24 V AC; 6 A/120 V AC; 3 A/230 V AC
- DC-13 2 A/24 V DC; 0.55 A/60 V DC; 0.25 A/125 V DC
Inputs (binary) 4 inputs supplied internally by the device electronics (with 24 V DC)
and connected to a common potential
Thermistor motor protection (binary PTC)
• Summation cold resistance kΩ ≤ 1.5
• R esponse value kΩ 3.4 ... 3.8
• Return value kΩ 1.5 ... 1.65
2nd-generation current/voltage measuring modules
Type 3UF7..0- 3UF7..1- 3UF7..2- 3UF7..3- 3UF7..4-
1AA01-0 1AA01-0 1AA01-0 1.A01-0 1BA01-0
Main circuit
Current setting Ie
10

A 0.3 ... 4 3 ... 40 10 ... 115 20 ... 200 63 ... 630


Rated insulation voltage Ui V 690
Rated operational voltage Ue V 690
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 6
Rated frequency Hz 50/60
Type of current Three-phase current
Short circuit Additional short-circuit protection is required in the main circuit
Typical voltage measuring range
• Phase-to-phase voltage/line-to-line voltage (e.g. UL1 L2) V 110 ... 690
• Phase voltage (e.g. UL1 N) V 65 ... 400
Accuracy at 25 °C, 50/60 Hz
Valid for voltage range • Phase-to-phase voltage UL in the range 0.85 x 110 V ... 1.1 x 690 V
• Phase voltage UL in the range 0.85 x 65 V ... 1.1 x 400 V
Valid for current range A 0.25 ... 8/ 2.25 ... 80/ 7.5 ... 230/ 15 ... 400/ 47 ... 1 260/
8 ... 32 80 ... 320 230 ... 920 400 ... 1 600 1 260 ... 5 040
• Voltage measurement % ± 1.5
• Current measurement % ± 1.5/3 (typical)
• Temperature drift of current measurement
- 3UF7110-1AA01-0 % ± 0.02 K
- 3UF7111-1AA01-0, 3UF7112-1AA01-0, 3UF7113-1AA01-0, % ± 0.01 K
3UF7113-1BA01-0, 3UF7114-1BA01-0
• Power factor measurement (p.f. ≥ 0.5) % ± 1.5/5 (typical)
• Apparent power measurement (p.f. ≥ 0.5) % ± 3/5 (typical)
• Active power measurement (p.f. ≥ 0.5) % ± 5/10
• Energy measurement (p.f. ≥ 0.5) % ± 5/10
• Frequency measurement (p.f. ≥ 0.5) % ± 1.5
Notes on voltage measurement In the supply lines from the main circuit for voltage measurement of
• Supply lines for voltage measurement SIMOCODE pro it may be necessary to provide additional line protection!
1) All values are based on a combination consisting of basic unit,
current measuring module and operator panel.

3/70 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC

Siemens IC 10 · 2019
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 Motor Management and Control Devices
Technical data
General data

Current measuring modules


Type 3UF7100- 3UF7101- 3UF7102- 3UF7103- 3UF7104-
1AA00-0 1AA00-0 1AA00-0 1.A00-0 1BA00-0
Main circuit
Current setting Ie A 0.3 ... 3 2.4 ... 25 10 ... 100 20 ... 200 63 ... 630
Rated insulation voltage Ui V 690; 3UF7103 and 3UF7104: 1 000 (at pollution degree 3)
Rated operational voltage Ue V 690
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 6; 3UF7103 and 3UF7104: 8
Rated frequency Hz 50/60
Type of current Three-phase current
Short circuit Additional short-circuit protection is required in the main circuit
Accuracy of current measurement (in the range of 1 x minimum % 3 (typical)

3
current setting Iu to 8 x max. current setting Io)
Digital modules or multifunction modules

RELAYS
OVERLOAD
Type 3UF7300, 3UF7310, 3UF7600
Control circuit
Rated insulation voltage Ui V 300 (at pollution degree 3)
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 4
Relay outputs
• Number 2 monostable or bistable relay outputs (depending on the version)
• Specified short-circuit protection for auxiliary contacts
(relay outputs)
- Fuse links 6 A operational class gG; 10 A quick-response (IEC 60947-5-1)
- Miniature circuit breakers 1.6 A, C characteristic (IEC 60947-5-1); 6 A, C characteristic (Ik < 500 A)
• Rated uninterrupted current A 6
• Rated switching capacity
- AC-15 6 A/24 V AC; 6 A/120 V AC; 3 A/230 V AC
- DC-13 2 A/24 V DC; 0.55 A/60 V DC; 0.25 A/125 V DC
Inputs (binary) 4 inputs, electrically isolated, supplied externally with 24 V DC or
110 ... 240 V AC/DC depending on the version, connected to a common potential
Ground-fault modules or multifunction modules
Type 3UF7510, 3UF7600
Control circuit
Connectable residual-current transformer 3UL23
Type of current for monitoring Type A (AC and pulsating DC residual currents)
Adjustable response value 30 mA ... 40 A
Relative measurement error % 7.5
Temperature modules or multifunction modules
Type 3UF7600, 3UF7700

10
Sensor circuit
Number of temperature sensors
• 3UF7700 3 temperature sensors
• 3UF7600 1 temperature sensor
Typical sensor current
• Pt100 mA 1
• Pt1000/KTY83/KTY84/NTC mA 0.2
Open-circuit/short-circuit detection
• Sensor type Pt100/Pt1000 KTY83-110 KTY84 NTC
- Open circuit ✓ ✓ ✓ --
- Short circuit ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓
- Measuring range °C -50 ... +500 -50 ... +175 -40 ... +300 80 ... 160
Measuring accuracy at 20 °C ambient temperature (T20) K < 2
Deviation due to ambient temperature % 0.05 per K deviation from T20
(in % of measuring range)
Conversion time ms 500
Connection type Two- or three-wire connection
✓ Detection possible
-- Detection not possible

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/71

Siemens IC 10 · 2019
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE pro 3UF7
SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 Motor Management and Control Devices
Technical data
General data

Analog module
Type 3UF74
Control circuit
Inputs
• Channels 2 (passive)
• Parameterizable measuring ranges mA 0/4 ... 20
• Shielding Up to 30 m shield recommended, from 30 m shield required
• Max. input current (destruction limit) mA 40
• Accuracy % 1
• Input resistance  50
• Conversion time ms 150
• Resolution Bit 12
• Open-circuit detection With measuring range 4 ... 20 mA
Outputs
• Channels 1
3

• Parameterizable output range mA 0/4 ... 20


• Shielding Up to 30 m shield recommended, from 30 m shield required
• Max. voltage at output V DC 30
OVERLOAD
RELAYS

• Accuracy % 1
• Max. output load  500
• Conversion time ms 25
• Resolution Bit 12
• Short-circuit proof Yes
Connection type Two-wire connection
Electrical separation of inputs/output No
to the device electronics
Fail-safe digital modules
Type 3UF7320-1AB00-0 3UF7320-1AU00-0 3UF7330-1AB00-0 3UF7330-1AU00-0
Control circuit
Rated control supply voltage Us V 24 DC 110 ... 240 AC/DC; 24 DC 110 ... 240 AC/DC;
50/60 Hz 50/60 Hz
Power consumption 3W 9.5 VA/4.5 W 4W 11 VA/5.5 W
Rated insulation voltage V 300
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 4
Relay outputs
• Number 2 relay enabling circuits, 2 relay outputs
Version of the fuse link A 4, operational class gG
For short-circuit protection of the relay enabling circuit
Rated uninterrupted current A 5
Rated switching capacity
• AC-15 3 A/24 V AC; 3 A/120 V AC; 1.5 A/230 V AC
• DC-13 4 A/24 V DC; 0.55 A/60 V DC; 0.22 A/125 V DC
Inputs (binary) 5 (with internal power supply from the device electronics)
10

Cable length
• Between sensor/start signal and evaluation electronics m 1 500 1 500 -- --
• For further digital signals m -- -- 300 300
Safety data 1)
SIL level max. according to IEC 61508 3
Achievable performance level PL according to EN ISO 13849-1 e
Achievable category according to EN ISO 13849-1 4
Stop category according to EN 60204-1 0
Probability of a dangerous failure
for SIL 3 applications
• Per hour (PFHd) at a high demand rate 1/h 1.0 x 10-8 1.0 x 10-8
according to IEC 62061 for 2-channel sensor evaluation
• Per hour (PFDavg) at a low demand rate 2.0 x 10-6 2.0 x 10-6
according to IEC 61508 for 2-channel sensor evaluation
T1 value for proof test interval or a 20
service duration according to IEC 61508
1)
For more safety data, see System Manual
"SIMOCODE pro Safety Fail-Safe Digital Modules".

3/72 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

Siemens IC 10 · 2019
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 Motor Management and Control Devices
Technical data
General data

■ More information
Configuration instructions Types of protection EEx e and EEx d
When using an operator panel with display, please note that the The overload protection and the thermistor motor protection
type and number of expansion modules that can be connected of the SIMOCODE pro system comply with the requirements
are limited for the use of a SIMOCODE pro V PROFIBUS basic for overload protection of explosion-proof motors to the type
unit (with product version lower than E15) or SIMOCODE pro V of protection:
Modbus RTU (with product version lower than E03), see • EEx d "Flameproof enclosure" e.g. according to IEC 60079-1
• TIA Selection Tool • EEx e "Increased safety" e.g. according to IEC 60079-7
• SIMOCODE pro Manual Collection
When using SIMOCODE pro devices with a 24 V DC control
Protective separation voltage, electrical separation must be ensured using a battery
or a safety transformer according to IEC 61558-2-6.
All circuits in SIMOCODE pro are safely isolated from each other EC type test certificate: BVS 06 ATEX F 001

3
in accordance with IEC 60947-1. That is, they are designed with Test report: BVS PP 05.2029 EC.
double creepages and clearances. In the event of a fault,
therefore, no parasitic voltages can be formed in neighboring Type of protection Ex b

RELAYS
OVERLOAD
circuits. The instructions of test log No. 2668 must be complied
with. The function for dry-running protection of centrifugal pumps in
hazardous areas complies with the requirements of the following
type of protection:
• Ex b "Control of ignition source", ignition protection system b1,
e.g. according to EN 80079-37
SIMOCODE pro is registered for the dry-running protection
of centrifugal pumps by means of active power monitoring
according to both ATEX and IEC Ex.

10

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/73

Siemens IC 10 · 2019
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE
SIMOCODE pro pro
3UF73UF7
Motor Management and Control Devices
Basic units IE3/IE4 ready
Basic units

Selection and ordering data


Version SD Screw terminals PU PS*
(UNIT,
Article No. Price SET, M)
d per PU
SIMOCODE pro PROFIBUS
SIMOCODE pro C
PROFIBUS DP interface, 12 Mbps, RS 485
4 I/3 O freely assignable, input for thermistor connection,
monostable relay outputs
Rated control supply voltage Us:
• 24 V DC } 3UF7000-1AB00-0 1 1 unit
• 110 ... 240 V AC/DC } 3UF7000-1AU00-0 1 1 unit
3

3UF7000-1AB00-0
OVERLOAD
RELAYS

SIMOCODE pro S
PROFIBUS DP interface, 1.5 Mbps, RS 485
4 I/2 O freely assignable, input for thermistor connection,
monostable relay outputs, can be expanded by a
multifunction module
Note: The connection cable to the current measuring module
must be at least 15 cm.
Rated control supply voltage Us:
3UF7020-1AU01-0 • 24 V DC } 3UF7020-1AB01-0 1 1 unit
• 110 ... 240 V AC/DC } 3UF7020-1AU01-0 1 1 unit
SIMOCODE pro V1)
PROFIBUS DP interface, 12 Mbps, RS 485
4 I/3 O freely assignable, input for thermistor connection,
monostable relay outputs, can be expanded by expansion
modules
Rated control supply voltage Us:
• 24 V DC } 3UF7010-1AB00-0 1 1 unit
3UF7010-1AB00-0 • 110 ... 240 V AC/DC } 3UF7010-1AU00-0 1 1 unit

SIMOCODE pro PROFINET


SIMOCODE pro V PROFINET GP NEW NEU

ETHERNET/PROFINET IO,
OPC UA server and web server, 100 Mbps,
PROFINET system redundancy,
4 I/3 O freely assignable, input for
thermistor connection, monostable relay outputs,
10

can be expanded by expansion module,


web server in German/English/Chinese/Russian
2 x connection to bus through RJ45,
3UF7011-1AB00-1 Media Redundancy Protocol
Rated control supply voltage Us:
• 24 V DC } 3UF7011-1AB00-1 1 1 unit
• 110 ... 240 V AC/DC } 3UF7011-1AU00-1 1 1 unit
1 x connection to bus through RJ45,
Rated control supply voltage Us:
• 24 V DC } 3UF7011-1AB00-2 1 1 unit
• 110 ... 240 V AC/DC } 3UF7011-1AU00-2 1 1 unit
SIMOCODE pro V PROFINET
ETHERNET/PROFINET IO,
OPC UA server and web server, 100 Mbps,
2 x connection to bus through RJ45, PROFINET system redun-
dancy, media redundancy protocol,
4 I/3 O freely assignable, input for thermistor connection,
monostable relay outputs, can be expanded by expansion
modules,
web server in German/English/Chinese/Russian
Rated control supply voltage Us:
3UF7011-1AB00-0 • 24 V DC } 3UF7011-1AB00-0 1 1 unit
• 110 ... 240 V AC/DC } 3UF7011-1AU00-0 1 1 unit
1)
For the use of 2nd-generation current/voltage measuring modules,
SIMOCODE pro V PROFIBUS with product version E15 (V4.0) must
be ordered. This version does not have an NEPSI certificate. It can be
ordered at no extra charge. The article number must be supplemented
by "–Z" and the order code "B01", e.g. 3UF7010-1AB00-0 -Z B01.

3/74 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Siemens IC 10 · 2019
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 Motor Management and Control Devices
Basic units IE3/IE4 ready Basic units

Version SD Screw terminals PU PS*


(UNIT,
Article No. Price SET, M)
d per PU
SIMOCODE pro Modbus RTU
SIMOCODE pro V Modbus RTU1)5)
Modbus RTU interface, 57.6 Kbps, RS 485,
4 I/3 O freely assignable,
input for thermistor connection,
monostable relay outputs,
can be expanded by expansion modules
Rated control supply voltage Us:
• 24 V DC } 3UF7012-1AB00-0 1 1 unit
• 110 ... 240 V AC/DC } 3UF7012-1AU00-0 1 1 unit

3
3UF7012-1A.00-0
SIMOCODE pro EtherNet/IP

RELAYS
OVERLOAD
SIMOCODE pro V EtherNet/IP 1)
EtherNet/IP interface, web server, 100 Mbps,
2 x connection to bus through RJ45,
DLR media redundancy,
4 I/3 O freely assignable,
input for thermistor connection,
monostable relay outputs,
can be expanded by expansion modules,
web server in German/English/Chinese/Russian
Rated control supply voltage Us:
3UF7013-1AB00-0 • 24 V DC } 3UF7013-1AB00-0 1 1 unit
• 110 ... 240 V AC/DC } 3UF7013-1AU00-0 1 1 unit
SIMOCODE pro current or current/voltage measuring modules
Current measuring modules
• Straight-through transformers 0.3 ... 3 45 } 3UF7100-1AA00-0 1 1 unit
2.4 ... 25 45 } 3UF7101-1AA00-0 1 1 unit
10 ... 100 55 } 3UF7102-1AA00-0 1 1 unit
20 ... 200 120 } 3UF7103-1AA00-0 1 1 unit
• Busbar connection6) 20 ... 200 120 } 3UF7103-1BA00-0 1 1 unit
63 ... 630 145 } 3UF7104-1BA00-0 1 1 unit
3UF7103-1AA00-0 2nd-generation current/voltage measuring modules
for SIMOCODE pro V1)2)
Voltage measuring up to 690 V,
measured values with increased accuracy,
power, power factor and frequency monitoring

10
• Straight-through transformers 0.3 ... 4 45 } 3UF7110-1AA01-0 1 1 unit
3 ... 40 45 } 3UF7111-1AA01-0 1 1 unit
10 ... 115 55 } 3UF7112-1AA01-0 1 1 unit
20 ... 200 120 } 3UF7113-1AA01-0 1 1 unit
• Busbar connection6) 20 ... 200 120 } 3UF7113-1BA01-0 1 1 unit
3UF7110-1AA01-0 63 ... 630 145 } 3UF7114-1BA01-0 1 1 unit
Current/voltage measuring modules for dry-running protection of
centrifugal pumps in hazardous areas2)3)4) NEW NEU
• Straight-through transformers 0.3 ... 4 45 } 3UF7120-1AA01-0 1 1 unit
3 ... 40 45 } 3UF7121-1AA01-0 1 1 unit
10 ... 115 55 } 3UF7122-1AA01-0 1 1 unit
20 ... 200 120 } 3UF7123-1AA01-0 1 1 unit
• Busbar connection6) 20 ... 200 120 } 3UF7123-1BA01-0 1 1 unit
63 ... 630 145 } 3UF7124-1BA01-0 1 1 unit
3UF7123-1AA01-0
1) 5)
The SIMOCODE
SIMOCODE ES ES (TIA
(TIAPortal)
Portal)V14
V14software
softwareororhigher is is
higher necessary for for
necessary For the use of 2nd-generation current/voltage measuring modules,
parameterization, seepage
parameterization, see page3/83.
14/12. SIMOCODE pro V Modbus RTU with product version E03 (V2.0) must be
2)
When installing the basic unit on a current/voltage measuring module, ordered. This version does not have an NEPSI certificate. It can be ordered
the connection cable must be at least 15 cm long. at no extra charge. The article number must be supplemented by "–Z" and
3)
the order code "B01", e.g. 3UF7012-1AB00-0 -Z B01.
The current/voltage measuring modules for dry-running protection require 6)
SIMOCODE pro V PROFIBUS basic units as of product version E16 One terminal
terminal parts
parts kit
kit 3RT1955-4PA00 3RT1966-4PA00(see
3RT1955-4PA00 or 3RT1966-4PA00 (see page
page 3/82)
10/24)
(expected to be available from 03/2019), SIMOCODE pro V PROFINET is included
included in
in the
the scope
scopeof ofdelivery
deliveryfor
forconnection
connectiontotoaacontactor.
contactor.
as of product version E13 (expected to be available from 10/2018) or Note:
SIMOCODE pro V EtherNet/IP as of product version E04 (expected to
be available from 03/2019). SIMOCODE pro V basic unit in a hardened version via
4)
When using an operator panel with display with the current/voltage SIPLUS extreme upon request.
measuring modules for dry-running protection, an operator panel with
display as of product version E03 (both versions 3UF7210-1AA01-0 and
3UF7210-1BA01-0 expected to be available from 03/2019) is required.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/75


* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2019 10/17
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE
SIMOCODE pro pro
3UF73UF7
Motor Management and Control Devices
Basic units IE3/IE4 ready
Basic units

Version Current setting Width SD Screw terminals PU PS*


(UNIT,
Article No. Price SET, M)
A mm d per PU
SIMOCODE pro operator panels
Operator panels
Installation in control cabinet door or front plate, } 3UF7200-1AA01-0 1 1 unit
for plugging into all SIMOCODE pro basic units,
ten LEDs for status indication and user-assignable
buttons for controlling the motor, titanium gray

3UF7200-1AA01-0

Operator panels with display for SIMOCODE pro V


3

Installation in control cabinet door or front plate, for plugging


into SIMOCODE pro V, seven LEDs for status indication and
user-assignable buttons for controlling the motor, multilingual
OVERLOAD
RELAYS

display, e.g. for indication of measured values, status informa-


tion or fault messages, titanium gray
• English/German/French/Spanish/Portuguese/ } 3UF7210-1AA01-0 1 1 unit
Italian/Polish/Finnish
3UF7210-1.A01-0
• English/Chinese/Russian/Korean } 3UF7210-1BA01-0 1 1 unit
10

3/76 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Siemens IC 10 · 2019
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 Motor Management and Control Devices
Expansion modules
Expansion modules

■ Selection and ordering data


Version SD Screw terminals PU PS*
(UNIT,
Article No. Price SET, M)
d per PU
Expansion modules for SIMOCODE pro V
With SIMOCODE pro V, it is possible to expand the type and
number of inputs and outputs in steps. Each expansion module
has two system interfaces on the front. Through the one system
interface the expansion module is connected to the system
interface of the SIMOCODE pro V using a connection cable;
through the second system interface, further expansion modules
or the operator panel can be connected. The power supply for
the expansion modules is provided by the connection cable

3
through the basic unit.
Notes:
The SIMOCODE pro V PN GP basic unit can be used with the

RELAYS
OVERLOAD
3UF7300-1A.00-0 monostable digital module, the 3UF7510-
1AA00-0 ground-fault module, or the 3UF7700-1AA0-0 tem-
perature module.
Please order connection cable separately, see page 10/22.
Digital modules
Up to two digital modules can be used to add additional binary
inputs and relay outputs to the basic unit. The input circuits of
the digital modules are supplied from an external power supply.
Four binary inputs and two relay outputs,
up to two digital modules can be connected
Relay outputs Input voltage
Monostable 24 V DC } 3UF7300-1AB00-0 1 1 unit
110 ... 240 V AC/DC } 3UF7300-1AU00-0 1 1 unit
3UF7300-1AB00-0
Bistable 24 V DC } 3UF7310-1AB00-0 1 1 unit
110 ... 240 V AC/DC } 3UF7310-1AU00-0 1 1 unit

Analog modules
By means of the analog module, the basic unit can } 3UF7400-1AA00-0 1 1 unit
be optionally expanded by analog inputs and outputs
(0/4 ... 20 mA).
Two inputs (passive) for input and one output for output
of 0/4 ... 20 mA signals, max. one analog module can be con-
nected per pro V PB/MB RTU basic unit and max. two analog
modules per pro V PN/EIP basic unit

10
3UF7400-1AA00-0

Ground-fault modules
Ground-fault monitoring using 3UL23 residual-current trans- } 3UF7510-1AA00-0 1 1 unit
formers and ground-fault modules is used in cases where pre-
cise detection of the ground-fault current is required or power
systems with high impedance are grounded.
With the ground-fault module, it is possible to determine the
precise fault current as a measured value, and to define freely
selectable warning and trip limits in a wide range from 30 mA ...
40 A.
One input for connecting a 3UL23 residual-current transformer,
3UF7510-1AA00-0 up to one ground-fault module can be connected
Note:
Note:
For
For corresponding residual-current transformers,
corresponding residual-current transformers, see
see
page
page 10/94.
11/55.
Temperature modules
Irrespective of the thermistor motor protection of the basic units, } 3UF7700-1AA00-0 1 1 unit
up to an additional three analog temperature sensors can be
evaluated using a temperature module.
Sensor types: Pt100/Pt1000, KTY83/KTY84 or NTC
Three inputs for connecting up to three analog temperature
sensors, up to one temperature module can be connected per
pro V PB/MB RTU basic unit and up to two temperature mod-
ules per pro V PN/EIP basic unit

3UF7700-1AA00-0

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/77

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Siemens IC 10 · 2019
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE
SIMOCODE pro pro
3UF73UF7
Motor Management and Control Devices
Expansion modules
Expansion modules

Version SD Screw terminals PU PS*


(UNIT,
Article No. Price SET, M)
d per PU
Expansion modules for SIMOCODE pro S
With SIMOCODE pro S, it is possible to expand the type and
number of inputs and outputs. The expansion module has two
system interfaces on the front. Through the one system interface
the expansion module is connected to the system interface of
the SIMOCODE pro S using a connection cable; through the
second system interface, the operator panel can be connected.
The power supply for the expansion module is provided by the
connection cable through the basic unit.
Note:
Note:
Please order
Please order connection
connectioncable
cableseparately,
separately,see
seepage
page3/80.
10/22.
3

Multifunction modules
OVERLOAD
RELAYS

The multifunction module is the expansion module of


the SIMOCODE pro S device series with the following functions:
• Digital module function with four digital inputs and
two monostable relay outputs
• Ground-fault module function with an input for the connection
of a 3UL23 residual-current transformer with freely selectable
warning and trip limits in a wide zone of 30 mA ... 40 A
• Temperature module function with an input for connecting an
analog temperature sensor Pt100, Pt1000, KTY83, KTY84, or
3UF7600-1AU01-0 NTC
Max. one multifunction module can be connected per
pro S basic unit
Input voltage of the digital inputs:
• 24 V DC } 3UF7600-1AB01-0 1 1 unit
• 110 ... 240 V AC/DC } 3UF7600-1AU01-0 1 1 unit
10

3/78 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Siemens IC 10 · 2019
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 Motor Management and Control Devices
Fail-safe expansion modules
Fail-safe expansion modules

■ Selection and ordering data


Version SD Screw terminals PU PS*
(UNIT,
Article No. Price SET, M)
d per PU
Fail-safe expansion modules for SIMOCODE pro V
Thanks to the fail-safe expansion modules, SIMOCODE pro V
can be expanded with the function of a safety relay for the
fail-safe disconnection of motors. A maximum of one fail-safe
digital module can be connected; it can be used instead of a
digital module.
The fail-safe expansion modules are equipped likewise with
two system interfaces at the front for making the connection to
other system components. Unlike other expansion modules,

3
power is supplied to the modules through a separate terminal
connection.
Note:

RELAYS
OVERLOAD
Please order
order connection
connection cable
cableseparately,
separately,see
seepage
page3/80.
10/22.

DM-F Local fail-safe digital modules


For fail-safe disconnection using a hardware signal
Two relay enabling circuits, joint switching; two relay outputs,
common potential disconnected fail-safe; inputs for sensor
circuit, start signal, cascading and feedback circuit, safety
function adjustable using DIP switches
Rated control supply voltage Us:
• 24 V DC } 3UF7320-1AB00-0 1 1 unit
• 110 ... 240 V AC/DC } 3UF7320-1AU00-0 1 1 unit
3UF7320-1AB00-0
DM-F PROFIsafe fail-safe digital modules1)
For fail-safe disconnection using PROFIBUS/PROFIsafe
or PROFINET/PROFIsafe
Two relay enabling circuits, joint switching; two relay outputs,
common potential disconnected fail-safe; one input for feed-
back circuit; three binary standard inputs
Rated control supply voltage Us:
• 24 V DC } 3UF7330-1AB00-0 1 1 unit
• 110 ... 240 V AC/DC } 3UF7330-1AU00-0 1 1 unit
3UF7330-1AB00-0
1) Cannot be used in conjunction with SIMOCODE pro V for Modbus RTU
or EtherNet/IP communication.

10

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/79

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Siemens IC 10 · 2019
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE
SIMOCODE pro pro
3UF73UF7
Motor Management and Control Devices
Accessories
Accessories

■ Selection and ordering data


Version SD Article No. Price PU PS*
per PU (UNIT,
SET, M)
d
Connection cables (essential accessory)
In different lengths for connecting basic unit, current measuring
module, current/voltage measuring module, operator panel or
expansion modules
Version Length
Flat 0.025 m } 3UF7930-0AA00-0 1 1 unit
0.1 m } 3UF7931-0AA00-0 1 1 unit
0.15 m NEW NEU } 3UF7934-0AA00-0 1 1 unit
3UF7932-0AA00-0 0.3 m } 3UF7935-0AA00-0 1 1 unit
3

0.5 m } 3UF7932-0AA00-0 1 1 unit


Round 0.5 m } 3UF7932-0BA00-0 1 1 unit
OVERLOAD
RELAYS

1.0 m } 3UF7937-0BA00-0 1 1 unit


2.5 m } 3UF7933-0BA00-0 1 1 unit
PC cables and adapters
USB PC cables } 3UF7941-0AA00-0 1 1 unit
For connecting to the USB interface of a PC/PG,
for communication with SIMOCODE pro through
the system interface
3UF7941-0AA00-0
USB/serial adapters 5 3UF7946-0AA00-0 1 1 unit
For connecting an RS 232 PC cable to
the USB interface of a PC
Memory modules
Enable transmission to a new system, e.g. when a device is
replaced, without the need for additional aids or detailed knowl-
edge of the device.
Memory modules for SIMOCODE pro C } 3UF7900-0AA01-0 1 1 unit
3UF7901-0AA01-0 For saving the complete parameterization of a SIMOCODE pro
C system, titanium gray
Memory modules for SIMOCODE pro S and pro V } 3UF7901-0AA01-0 1 1 unit
For saving the complete parameterization of a SIMOCODE pro
system, titanium gray
Interface covers
For system interface, titanium gray 10 3RA6936-0B 1 5 units
10

3RA6936-0B
Addressing plugs
For assigning the PROFIBUS or Modbus RTU address without } 3UF7910-0AA00-0 1 1 unit
using a PC/PG to SIMOCODE pro through the system interface

3UF7910-0AA00-0

3/80 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Siemens IC 10 · 2019
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 Motor Management and Control Devices
Accessories
Accessories

Version SD Article No. Price PU PS*


per PU (UNIT,
SET, M)
d
Accessories for motor control centers
With the draw-out technology often used in motor control cen-
ters it is possible to integrate a SIMOCODE pro initialization
module in the switchboard on a permanent basis. Feeder-
related parameter and address data can then be permanently
assigned to this feeder.
Initialization modules } 3UF7902-0AA00-0 1 1 unit
3UF7902-0AA00-0 For automatic parameterization of SIMOCODE pro S
and SIMOCODE pro V basic units (pro V PROFIBUS
basic units from product version E09)

3
Y connection cables
For use in conjunction with the initialization module; connects
the basic unit, current measuring module or current/voltage

RELAYS
OVERLOAD
measuring module, and initialization module
System interface length Open cable end
0.1 m 1.0 m } 3UF7931-0CA00-0 1 1 unit
0.5 m 1.0 m } 3UF7932-0CA00-0 1 1 unit
1.0 m 1.0 m } 3UF7937-0CA00-0 1 1 unit
Bus connection terminals
For shield support and strain relief of the PROFIBUS cable on a } 3UF7960-0AA00-0 1 1 unit
SIMOCODE pro S

3UF7960-0AA00-0
Door adapters
For external connection of the system interface, } 3UF7920-0AA00-0 1 1 unit
e.g. outside a control cabinet

3UF7920-0AA00-0
Adapters for operator panel
The adapter enables the smaller 3UF7200 operator panel from } 3UF7922-0AA00-0 1 1 unit

10
SIMOCODE pro to be used in a front panel cutout in which pre-
viously, e.g. after a change of system, a larger 3UF52 operator
panel from SIMOCODE-DP had been used, degree of protec-
tion IP54

3UF7922-0AA00-0
Labeling strips
• For pushbuttons of the 3UF720 operator panel } 3UF7925-0AA00-0 100 400 units
• For pushbuttons of the 3UF721 operator panel with display } 3UF7925-0AA01-0 100 600 units
• For LEDs of the 3UF720 operator panel } 3UF7925-0AA02-0 100 1 200 units

3UF7925-0AA02-0
Push-in lugs
For screw fixing, e.g. on mounting plate,
2 units required per device
• Can be used for 3UF71.0, 3UF71.1 and 3UF71.2 2 3RV2928-0B 100 10 units
• Can be used for 3UF700, 3UF701, 3UF73, 3UF74, 3UF75 and 5 3RP1903 1 10 units
3UF77
3RV2928-0B • Can be used for 3UF7020, 3UF7600 2 3ZY1311-0AA00 1 10 units

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/81

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Siemens IC 10 · 2019
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
SIMOCODE
SIMOCODE pro pro
3UF73UF7
Motor Management and Control Devices
Accessories
Accessories

Version SD Article No. Price PU PS*


per PU (UNIT,
SET, M)
d
Terminal covers
Covers for cable lugs and busbar connections
• Length 100 mm, can be used for 3UF71.3-1BA0.-0 } 3RT1956-4EA1 1 1 unit
• Length 120 mm, can be used for 3UF71.4-1BA0.-0 2 3RT1966-4EA1 1 1 unit
Covers for box terminals
• Length 25 mm, can be used for 3UF71.3-1BA0.-0 } 3RT1956-4EA2 1 1 unit
• Length 30 mm, can be used for 3UF71.4-1BA0.-0 2 3RT1966-4EA2 1 1 unit
3RT1956-4EA1 Covers for screw terminals
Between contactor and current measuring module or
3

current/voltage measuring module for direct mounting


• Can be used for 3UF71.3-1BA0.-0 } 3RT1956-4EA3 1 1 unit
OVERLOAD
RELAYS

3RT1956-4EA2 • Can be used for 3UF71.4-1BA0.-0 2 3RT1966-4EA3 1 1 unit


Terminal parts kit
Can be used for current and/or current/voltage measuring modules with
standard mounting rail connection,
complete for one contactor
• M 8 x 25 5 3RT1955-4PA00 1 1 unit
• M 10 x 30 5 3RT1966-4PA00 1 1 unit
Box terminal blocks
For round and ribbon cables
• Up to 70 mm2, can be used for 3UF71.3-1BA0.-0 } 3RT1955-4G 1 1 unit
• Up to 120 mm2, can be used for 3UF71.3-1BA0.-0 } 3RT1956-4G 1 1 unit
• Up to 240 mm2, can be used for 3UF71.4-1BA0.-0 } 3RT1966-4G 1 1 unit

3RT195.-4G
Bus termination modules
With separate control supply voltage for bus termination
following the last unit on the bus line
Supply voltage:
• 115/230 V AC 5 3UF1900-1KA00 1 1 unit
• 24 V DC 5 3UF1900-1KB00 1 1 unit
10

3UF1900-1KA00

3/82 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Siemens IC 10 · 2019
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
Parameterization, Configuration and Visualization with SIRIUS
SIMOCODE pro 3UF7
SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal)
SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal) NEW NEU

Overview

SIMOCODE ES V15 Basic Standard Premium


Access via the local interface
on the device
Parameter assignment in list form
Parameter printing in list form
Operating
Diagnostics
Test
Service data
Analog value recording1)
Trend display of measured values --

3
Parameterizing with convenient --
graphical display

RELAYS
OVERLOAD
Parameterizing with the integrated --
graphics editor (CFC-based)
Printing of diagrams --
Parameter comparison --
Selection of SIMOCODE pro device configuration in SIMOCODE ES
(TIA Portal) Access via PROFIBUS/PROFINET/ -- --
Ethernet2)
More information Teleservice via MPI -- --
Homepage, see www.siemens.com/sirius-engineering Routing3) -- --
Industry
IndustryMall,
Mall,see
seewww.siemens.com/product?3ZS1
www.siemens.com/product?3ZS1 Function available
Technical
TIA specifications,
Selection see Cloud)
Tool Cloud (TST -- Function not available
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16716/td 1) For SIMOCODE pro V.
Software
Software download
download 2)
In combination with Modbus devices, SIMOCODE ES Premium does not
• For SIMOCODE pro S, see offer any additional functions compared with SIMOCODE ES Standard.
• SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal), see
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109752321 3)
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109752321
• For SIMOCODE pro V, see See http://support.automation.siemens.com/WW/view/en/109738745.
• SIMOCODE ES 2007, see
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109480470 Working with libraries
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109480470
Users can create copy templates for SIMOCODE pro device
SIMOCODE ES is the central software for configuration, startup, configuration and can manage them in global or project
operation and diagnostics of SIMOCODE pro. libraries.
SIMOCODE ES Version 15 is available as a powerful successor This way, individual modules, diagrams and complete device
to Version 2007, which is based on the central engineering configurations can be saved as reusable elements for frequently
framework Totally Integrated Automation Portal (TIA Portal). occurring tasks.
SIMOCODE ES V15 is integrated seamlessly when further Integrated graphics editor
TIA Portal-based software such as STEP 7 or WinCC is The graphics editor is a part of SIMOCODE ES Standard and
available, thus enabling users to achieve a consistent, SIMOCODE ES Premium. It is based on the Continuous Function
efficient and intuitive solution for all automation tasks. Chart (CFC) and adds a powerful tool to the parameterizing inter-
However, use of SIMOCODE ES V15 as stand-alone software face that enables easy parameterization of devices by drag &
also provides these advantages. drop. What is more, all the parameters can also be edited directly
in the graphics editor. Extremely compact documentation of all
Three program versions configured parameters is possible, as is the graphic online pre-
The user can choose between three different versions of sentation of the configured device functions including all signal
SIMOCODE ES: states during operation.
• SIMOCODE ES Basic
• SIMOCODE ES Standard
• SIMOCODE ES Premium
New: From V15, the powerful SIMOCODE ES Basic tool for
startup or maintenance personnel is available for downloading
free of charge in the Siemens Industry Online Support
(see "More information").
SIMOCODE ES Standard and Premium are the perfect tools for
engineers or configuration engineers on account of their larger
14

scope of functions and integrated graphics editor. Unlike the


Standard version, SIMOCODE ES Premium also permits param-
eterization and diagnostics via PROFIBUS/PROFINET/
Ethernet. Indication of all operating, service and diagnostics
data supplies important information about the current state of
the motor and plant at all times – everywhere on PROFIBUS/
PROFINET/Ethernet.
Parameterize easily and ergonomically with the CFC-based graphics
editor of SIMOCODE ES V15

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/83

Siemens IC 10 · 2019
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices

SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 Parameterization, Configuration and Visualization with SIRIUS

SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal)


NEW NEU
SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal)
Online functions for startup and diagnostics
To this end, SIMOCODE ES provides powerful functions for
startup and diagnostics of motor feeders. Besides a detailed
display of status information and the causes of faults, all avail-
able measurement and statistics data can be retrieved online.
Access to the fault and event memory and also to analog values
recorded on the device, e.g. current or voltage, is also possible.
3 RELAYS
OVERLOAD

Live trend display of SIMOCODE ES V15


Additional functions
SIMOCODE ES V15 offers numerous advantages of the
TIA Portal that can be used in an integrated working
environment.
Seamless integration
Commissioning functions of SIMOCODE ES V15 When using other TIA Portal-based software such as STEP 7 or
Trend display of measured values WinCC, for example, the configuration for devices and networks
for all components used is created in a standardized environ-
With this online function, SIMOCODE ES Standard or Premium ment.
can present the trends of different measured values. It is thus
possible for example to record and evaluate the start-up charac- Teleservice via MPI
teristic of a motor or its behavior under different load conditions. The SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal) Premium version supports the
use of MPI Teleservice (comprising the Teleservice software and
various Teleservice adapters) for remote diagnostics of the
devices. This facilitates diagnostics and maintenance, and it
shortens response times for service purposes.

■ Benefits
• Easy parameterization with the graphics editor based on the • Universally applicable through stand-alone version or seam-
Continuous Function Chart (CFC) reduces engineering work less integration into the central engineering framework when
and shortens startup times other TIA Portal-based software such as STEP 7 or WinCC are
• Clear plant documentation by means of graphic presentation available
• Detailed information, also when there are faults, is a help for • Parameter changes are also possible during normal operation
maintenance personnel and shortens downtimes • Users can create copy templates for device configurations
and can manage them in global libraries

14

3/84 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices
Parameterization, Configuration and Visualization with SIRIUS
SIMOCODE pro 3UF7
SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal)
SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal) NEW NEU

■ Selection and ordering data


Parameterization and service software for SIMOCODE pro 3UF7
• Delivered without PC cable
Version SD Article No. Price PU PS*
per PU (UNIT,
SET, M)
d
SIMOCODE ES V15 Basic
Basic functional scope } 3ZS1322-6CE13-0YG8 1 1 unit
including Premium Trial License
Engineering software,
software download, Class A,

3
6 languages (German/English/French/Italian/
Spanish/Chinese),
for all SIMOCODE pro,

RELAYS
OVERLOAD
online functions via system interface
SIMOCODE ES V15 Standard
Floating license for one user
Engineering software,
software and documentation on DVD,
6 languages (German/English/French/Italian/Spanish/
Chinese), Combo license for parallel use of versions 2007 and
V15 of SIRIUS ES, for all SIMOCODE pro,
online functions via system interface,
parameterizing with the integrated graphics editor (CFC-based)
• License key on USB flash drive, Class A } 3ZS1322-5CC13-0YA5 1 1 unit
• License key and software download, Class A } 3ZS1322-5CE13-0YB5 1 1 unit
3ZS1322-5CC13-0YA5
Upgrade for SIMOCODE ES 2007 Standard 2 3ZS1322-5CC13-0YE5 1 1 unit
Floating license for one user,
engineering software,
software and documentation on DVD,
license key on USB flash drive, Class A,
6 languages (German/English/French/Italian/Spanish/
Chinese), Combo license for parallel use of versions 2007 and
V15 of SIRIUS ES, for all SIMOCODE pro,
online functions via system interface,
parameterizing with integrated graphics editor (CFC-based)
Software Update Service } 3ZS1322-5CC00-0YL5 1 1 unit
For 1 year with automatic extension,
requires software version of SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal),
engineering software,
software and documentation on DVD,
online functions via system interface,
parameterizing with integrated graphics editor (CFC-based)
Notes:
SIMOCODE ES V12/V13/V14 licenses can also be used for
SIMOCODE ES V15.
Please orderPC
Please order PCcable
cableseparately,
separately,
seesee page
page 14/15.
3/80.
For aa description
descriptionofofthe
thesoftware
software versions,
versions, seesee page
page 14/12.
3/83.
14

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 3/85

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Siemens IC 10 · 2019
SIMOCODE 3UF Motor Management and Control Devices

SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 Parameterization, Configuration and Visualization with SIRIUS

SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal)


NEW NEU
SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal)

Version SD Article No. Price PU PS*


per PU (UNIT,
SET, M)
d
SIMOCODE ES V15 Premium
Floating license for one user
Engineering software,
software and documentation on DVD,
6 languages (German/English/French/Italian/Spanish/
Chinese), Combo license for parallel use of versions 2007 and
V15 of SIRIUS ES, for all SIMOCODE pro,
online functions via system interface and
PROFIBUS/PROFINET/Ethernet,
parameterizing with the integrated graphics editor (CFC-based)
3

• License key on USB flash drive, Class A } 3ZS1322-6CC13-0YA5 1 1 unit


3ZS1322-6CC13-0YA5 • License key and software download, Class A } 3ZS1322-6CE13-0YB5 1 1 unit
OVERLOAD
RELAYS

Upgrade for SIMOCODE ES 2007 Premium 2 3ZS1322-6CC13-0YE5 1 1 unit


Floating license for one user,
engineering software,
software and documentation on DVD,
license key on USB flash drive, Class A,
6 languages (German/English/French/Italian/Spanish/
Chinese), Combo license for parallel use of versions 2007 and
V15 of SIRIUS ES, for all SIMOCODE pro,
online functions via system interface and
PROFIBUS/PROFINET/Ethernet,
parameterizing with the integrated graphics editor (CFC-based)
Software Update Service } 3ZS1322-6CC00-0YL5 1 1 unit
For 1 year with automatic extension,
requires software version of SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal),
engineering software,
software and documentation on DVD,
online functions via system interface and
PROFIBUS/PROFINET/Ethernet,
parameterizing with integrated graphics editor (CFC-based)
Notes:
Please orderPC
Please order PCcable
cable separately,
separately, seesee Accessories.
page 3/80. Foraadescription
For descriptionofof
thethe software
software versions,
versions, see see
pagepage
3/83.14/12.

14

3/86 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Starters
Industrial Control Product Catalog 2021

contents
Self Protected Motor Starters per UL 508 Type E 3RA6
4 SIRIUS

Section

4
3RA61 / 3RA62 up to 32 A 3RA64 / 3RA65 up to 32 A 3RA68 up to 100 A

STARTERS
COMBINATION
for mounting rail, surface, for mounting rail, surface, for 3RA6 direct and
comb busbar, infeed system Page comb busbar, infeed system Page reversing starters Page
Selection and ordering data Selection and ordering data Selection and ordering data
• Direct start, Reversing duty 4/7 • Direct start, Reversing duty 4/8 • Infeed Components 4/16-4/19
• Accessories 4/9-4/13 • Accessories 4/9-4/13 • Accessories 4/20-4/21

Combination starters & starters for group installation 3RA2 Enclosed controllers 3RE4

3RA21 up to 100 A 3RA22 up to 100 A 3RE4 up to 50Hp @ 460V for


for mounting rail and Fast Bus for mounting rail and Fast Bus non-reversing and reversing
busbar systems Page busbar systems Page applications Page
Selection and ordering data Selection and ordering data Selection and ordering data
• Direct start 4/36-4/39 • Reversing duty 4/40-4/43 • Enclosed starters 4/75-4/77
• Accessories 4/44-4/52 • Accessories 4/44-4/52 • Enclosed contactors 4/78-4/79

Technical data 4/53-4/58 Technical data 4/53-4/58 Overload Relay 4/80


Installation guidelines 4/59-4/68 Installation guidelines 4/59-4/68 Accessories 4/84-4/85
Circuit diagrams 4/68 Circuit diagrams 4/68 Circuit diagrams 4/87-4/89
Dimension drawings 4/69-4/72 Dimension drawings 4/69-4/72 Dimension drawings 4/86

(Section was last modified on 10/05/21) Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/1
Compact Combination Starters
Load Feeders and Motor Starters for Use in the Control Cabinet
SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters
General data
General data

Overview
3RA6 fuseless compact starters and infeed system for 3RA6 Very high operational reliability
The high short-circuit breaking capacity and defined shut-down
when the end of service life is reached means that the
SIRIUS compact starter achieves a very high level of operational
reliability that would otherwise have only been possible with
considerable additional outlay. This sets it apart from devices
with similar functionality.
Safe disconnection
The auxiliary switches (NC contacts) of the 3RA6 compact
starters are designed as mirror contacts. This enables their use
for safe disconnection - e.g. EMERGENCY STOP up to SIL 1
(IEC 62061) or PL c (ISO 13849-1) or, if used in conjunction with
an additional infeed contactor, up to SIL 3 (IEC 62061) or PL e
(ISO 13849-1).
Communications integration through AS-Interface
To enable communications integration through AS-Interface
there is an AS-i add-on module available in several versions for
4

mounting instead of the control circuit terminals on the


SIRIUS compact starter.
COMBINATION
STARTERS

3RA62 reversing starter The design of the AS-i add-on module permits a group of up to
Integrated functionality 62 feeders with a total of four cables to be connected to the
control system. This reduces wiring work considerably com-
The SIRIUS 3RA6 compact starters are a generation of innova- pared to the parallel wiring method.
tive load feeders with the integrated functionality of a motor
starter protector, contactor and electronic overload relay. Communications integration using IO-Link
In addition, various functions of optional mountable accessories Up to 4 compact starters in IO-Link version (reversing and
(e.g. auxiliary switches, surge suppressors) are already direct-on-line starters) can be connected together and conve-
integrated in the SIRIUS compact starter. niently linked to the IO-Link master through a standardized

8
IO-Link connection. The SIRIUS 4SI electronic modules are used
e.g. as IO-Link masters for connection to the SIMATIC ET 200S
distributed I/O system.
The IO-Link connection enables a high density of information in
the local range.
Details of the communications integration using IO-Link, see
Chapter 14 Communications.
The diagnostics data of the process collected by the 3RA6
compact starter, e.g. short circuit, end of service life, limit
position etc., are not only indicated on the compact starter itself
but also transmitted to the higher-level control system through
IO-Link.
Thanks to the optionally available operator panel, which can be
installed in the control cabinet door, it is easy to control the 3RA6
compact starters with IO-Link from the control cabinet door.
Permanent wiring / easy replacement
Using the SIRIUS infeed system for 3RA6 (see page 4/16) it is
possible to carry out the wiring in advance without a compact
starter needing to be connected.

3RA6 compact starters with the integrated functionality of a motor starter


A compact starter is very easily replaced simply by pulling it out
protector, contactor and electronic overload relay. of the device without disconnecting the wiring.
Applications Even with screw connections or mounting on a standard mount-
ing rail there is no need to disconnect any wiring (on account of
The SIRIUS compact starters can be used wherever standard the removable main and control circuit terminals) in order to
three-phase motors up to 32 A (20 HP/460 V) are directly replace a compact starter.
started.
Consistent solution from the infeed to the motor feeder
The compact starters are not suitable for the protection of
DC loads. The SIRIUS infeed system for 3RA6 with integrated PE bar is
offered as a user-friendly possibility of feeding in summation
Approvals according to IEC, UL, CSA and CCC standards have currents up to 100 A with a maximum conductor cross-section of
been issued for the compact starters. 2/0 AWG and connecting the motor cable directly without
Low variance of devices additional intermediate terminals.

Thanks to wide setting ranges for the rated current and wide Screw and spring-type terminals
voltage ranges, the equipment variance is greatly reduced The SIRIUS compact starters and the infeed system for 3RA6 are
compared to conventional load feeders. available with screw and spring-type terminals.

4/2 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Siemens IC 10 · 2015 8/51
Compact Combination Starters
For Operation in the Control Cabinet
SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters
General data
General data
To comply with the clearance and creepage distances Note:
demanded according to UL 508 there are the following infeed
possibilities: More technical specifications can be found in the system
manual at
Type of infeed Feeder terminal Type www.siemens.com/compactstarter
(according to UL 508,
type E) Overload tripping times
Conventional wiring Terminal block for "Self- 3RV29 28-1H The overload tripping time can be set on the device to less than
Protected Combination
Motor Controller 10 s (CLASS 10) and less than 20 s (CLASS 20 for heavy start-
(Type E)" ing). As the breaker mechanism still remains closed after an
overload, resetting is possible by either local manual reset or au-
Three-phase busbars Three-phase infeed ter- 3RV29 25-5EB
minal for constructing toreset after 3 minutes cooling time.
"Type E Starters", With autoreset there is no need to open the control cabinet.
UL 508
Infeed systems for 3RA6 Infeed on left, 3RA68 13-8AB (screw Diagnostics options
50/70 mm2, screw terminals), The compact starter provides the following diagnostics options
terminal with 3 sockets, 3RA68 13-8AC
outgoing terminal on site:
(spring-type terminals)
with screw/spring-type • With LEDs
connections, - Connection to the control voltage
including PE bar
- Position of the main contacts
SIRIUS 3RA6 compact starters • With mechanical indication

4
- Tripping due to overload
The SIRIUS 3RA6 compact starters are universal motor starters - Tripping due to short-circuit
according to IEC/EN 60947-6-2. As control and protective

STARTERS
COMBINATION
- Tripping due to malfunction (end of service life reached
switching devices (CPS) they can connect, convey and discon- because of worn switching contacts or a worn switching
nect the thermal, dynamic and electrical loads from short-circuit mechanism or faults in the control electronics)
currents up to Iq = 53 kA, i.e. they are essentially weld-free. They
combine the functions of a motor starter protectors, a contactor These states can also be evaluated in the higher-level control
and a solid-state overload relay in a single enclosure and can be system:
used wherever standard induction motors up to 32 A (up to ap- • With conventional wiring using the integrated auxiliary and
prox. 20 HP at 480 V AC) are started directly. Available versions signaling switches of the compact starter
are the direct-on-line starters with 45 mm width and the revers-
ing starters with 90 mm width. • With AS-Interface or IO-Link in even greater detail using the
respective communication interface
The reversing starter version comes with not only an internal
electrical interlock but also with a mechanical interlock to prevent Four complement variants for 3RA6 compact starters
simultaneous actuation of both directions of rotation. • For standard mounting rail or screw mounting:
basic version including 1 pair of main circuit terminals and
3RA6 compact starters are supplied in 5 current setting ranges. 1 pair of control circuit terminals

6
The 3RA61 and 3RA62 have 2 control voltage ranges (AC/DC),
the 3RA64 and 3RA65 have one control voltage range (DC): • For standard mounting rail or screw mounting when using the
AS-i add-on module:
Current At 460 V AC for Rated control supply voltage for comes without control circuit terminals because the AS-i add-
setting induction on module is attached in lieu of them
range motors 3RA61, 3RA62 3RA64, 3RA65
compact starters compact starters • For use with the infeed system for 3RA6:
Standard for IO-Link
output P without main circuit terminals because they are supplied with
the infeed system and the expansion modules
A HP V AC/DC V DC
• For use with the infeed system for 3RA6 and AS-i add-on
0.1 ... 0.4 0.12 24 24 module:
0.32 ... 1.25 0.43 ... 1.68 110 ... 240 without main or control circuit terminals as they are not needed
1 ... 4 1.34 ... 5.36 • The control circuit terminals are always required by the com-
pact starters for IO-Link; the main circuit terminals depend on
3 ... 12 4.02 ... 16.1 the use of the infeed system.
8 ... 32 10.7 ... 42.9
Additional components of the 3RA6
Note: The two control circuit terminals on the 3RA61/3RA62 allow
The 3RA1 motor starters can be used as motor starters access to signalling contacts for overload (1 CO) and short-
> 32 A up to 100 A. circuit / malfunction (1 NO). Furthermore, the 3RA61 has two
auxiliary contacts (1 NO + 1 NC) for indicating the position of the
The SENTRON 3VL circuit breakers and the SIRIUS 3RT main contacts, while the 3RA62 has one auxiliary contact (1 NO)
contactors can be used for motor starters >100 A. per direction of rotation per main contact.
Operating conditions
The SIRIUS 3RA6 compact starters are suitable for use in nearly
all climates. They are intended for use in enclosed rooms in
which no severe operating conditions (such as dust, caustic va-
pors, hazardous gases) prevail. Suitable covers must be pro-
vided for installation in dusty and damp locations.
The SIRIUS compact starters are generally designed to degree
of protection IP20. The permissible ambient temperature during
operation is -20 to +60 °C.
The maximum short-circuit current based on UL testing is 30 kA
up to 12 A and 15 kA for the 8 ... 32 A versions at 480 V.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/3


SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 6/33
Compact Combination Starters

3RA6 Compact Starters


Overview

Function
Trip units Control through AS-Interface
The SIRIUS 3RA6 compact starters are equipped with the follow- For control through AS-Interface, the AS-i add-on module is
ing trip units: mounted instead of the two control circuit terminals on the
• Inverse-time delayed solid-state overload release SIRIUS 3RA6 compact starters (direct-on-line starters and re-
• Instantaneous electronic trip unit (electromagnetic short- versing starters).
circuit release)
The AS-i auxiliary voltage and the AS-i data line are installed on
The overload releases can be adjusted in accordance with the the AS-i add-on module easily and quickly without tools by
load current. means of two plug-in connector blocks with insulation displace-
ment connection.
The electronic trip units are permanently set to a value 13 times
the maximum rated current of the 4 A, 12 A and 32 A starter and The AS-i add-on module is equipped with the latest A/B technol-
thus enable trouble-free starting of motors. ogy and has an addressing socket onboard.
Trip classes An addressing unit is required and can be ordered for address-
ing the AS-i add-on module.
The trip classes of electronically delayed trip units are based on
the tripping time (tA) at 7.2 times the set current in the cold state Bit assignment (see below) is similar to that for the SIRIUS motor
(excerpt from IEC 60947-4): starters, which means that the same programming can be used
here.
CLASS 10: 4s < tA < 10 s
4

DI 0.0 ready
CLASS 20: 6s < tA < 20 s (for heavy starting)
DI 0.1 motor on
COMBINATION
STARTERS

The compact starter must trip within this time.


DI 0.2 group fault
Disconnection due to malfunction DI 0.3 group warning
The following malfunctions can be detected:
DO 0.0 motor on or motor clockwise
• End of service life
- Worn switching contacts (for electrical endurance see DO 0.1 motor counterclockwise
"Technical data")
- Worn switching mechanisms (for mechanical endurance see A 24 V DC PELV power supply unit according to EN 61140 safety
"Technical data") class III is required for the auxiliary voltage.
• Faults in the control electronics The AS-i data line is supplied with voltage by means of a
30 V DC AS-i power supply unit and is controlled by means of
Short-circuit protection the AS-i master.
If a short-circuit occurs, the short-circuit releases of the The AS-i add-on modules are available in the following five
SIRIUS 3RA6 compact starters isolate the faulty motor starter versions:
from the network and thus prevent further damage. The short-
circuit releases are factory-set to 14 times the value of the max- • AS-i add-on module for compact starters
imum rated current In of the device. • AS-i add-on module for compact starters with two local inputs
for safe disconnection of the "clockwise rotation" or "counter-
The SIRIUS compact starters have a short-circuit breaking ca- clockwise rotation" outputs
pacity up to 30 kA at a voltage of 480 V AC.
• AS-i add-on module with two free external inputs
Overload relay function • AS-i add-on module with two free external outputs
In the event of an overload, the compact starter switches off • AS-i add-on module with one free external input and output
without the breaker mechanism being opened.
The AS-i add-on module can only be used with compact starters
The overload trip can be signaled to the higher-level control sys- with a control voltage of 24 V AC/DC.
tem through an integrated signal switch.
Integrated auxiliary switches
The overload signal can be reset automatically or by means of a
manual reset. The control circuit terminals of the SIRIUS 3RA6 compact start-
ers have the following connections:
• A1/A2 for the control voltage for 3RA61,
A1/A2 and B1/B2 for the control voltage for 3RA62
• "Overload" signal switch
• "Fault" signal switch, e. g. "short-circuit"
• Internal auxiliary switch for position of the main contacts (in
case of direct-on-line starters: 1 NO + 1 NC with mirror contact
to the main contact; in case of reversing starters: 2 NO)

4/4 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Compact Combination Starters

3RA6 Compact Starters


Overview

Design
Mounting 3) By integrating in the infeed system for 3RA6
The 3RA6 compact starters can be mounted in 4 ways: The SIRIUS compact starters can be assembled with the infeed
system for 3RA6 (see "Infeed system for 3RA6").
1) By snapping onto a TH 35 standard mounting rail
The SIRIUS compact starters can be snapped onto a standard
mounting rail according to EN 60715 with a width of 35 mm.

4
ck
cli
NSB0_01880

STARTERS
COMBINATION
NSB0_01882
2) By screw fixing to a flat surface 4) By using the 8US busbar adapter for Fast Bus systems with
60 mm busbar center-to-center clearance
The SIRIUS compact starters are suitable for screw fixing to a flat
surface. One set of 3RA69 40-0A adapters for screw connection
(including push-in lugs) is required per direct-on-line starter, two
sets are required per reversing starter.

2
4
1
5

1
5

3 6
5

1
2
NSB0_01881

3
NSB0_01921

1 ... 5: order of mounting steps 4


4

1 ... 6: order of mounting steps

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/5


Compact Combination Starters

3RA6 Compact Starters


Overview

4a) By using an additional device holder in the case of


reversing starters
When the 8US busbar adapter is used on Fast Bus systems with
60 mm busbar center-to-center clearance, a device holder is
needed in addition for a reversing starter on account of its dou-
ble width.
The reversing starter is mounted in the same way as the direct-
on-line starter on the busbar adapter. Then the device holder is
snapped on alongside the busbar adapter.
4 STARTERS
COMBINATION

NSB0_01922

Mounting regulations
The module can be installed horizontally or vertically. For the dif-
ferent installations attention must be paid however to limit values
for protective separation according to IEC/EN 60947-2 of the
compact starters (for details see the "Technical specifications").
> 30

NSB0_01883

> 10 > 10
> 30

The following distances must be observed when mounting the


compact starters:
• Lateral clearance to grounded components: 10 mm
• Arcing space at top and bottom: 30 mm

4/6 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


For Operation in the Control Cabinet
Compact Combination Starters

SIRIUS
SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact
3RA6 Compact Starters
Starters
3RA61,
3RA61, 3RA62
3RA62 compact
compact starters
starters; 3RA61 direct-on-line starters
3RA61 direct-on-line starters

Selection and ordering data


Width 90 mm
Width 45 mm One set of
One set of 3RA69 3RA69
40-0A adapters 40-0A adapters
is required for is required for
screw fixing. screw fixing.

3RA61 20-1CB32 3RA61 20-2EB32 3RA62 50-1CP32 3RA62 50-1CP32

Standard induction motor Setting range Order No. Order No.


4-pole at 400 V AC1) for solid-state overload release
Standard output P

HP A

4
For use with the infeed system for 3RA6 and with
the AS-i add-on module or as a replacement device,

STARTERS
COMBINATION
without main and control circuit terminals
-- 0.1 ... 0.4 3RA6@@0-0A @32 —
1/2 0.32 ... 1.25 3RA6@@0-0B @32 —
2 1 ... 4 3RA6@@0-0C @32 —
7 1/2 3 ... 12 3RA6@@0-0D @32 —
20 8 ... 32 3RA6@@0-0E @32 —

Screw terminals2) Spring-type terminals

For standard mounting rail or screw mounting,


including 1 pair of main circuit terminals and
1 pair of control circuit terminals
-- 0.1 ... 0.4 3RA6@@0-1A @32 3RA6@@0-2A @32
6

1/2 0.32 ... 1.25 3RA6@@0-1B @32 3RA6@@0-2B @32


2 1 ... 4 3RA6@@0-1C @32 3RA6@@0-2C @32
7 1/2 3 ... 12 3RA6@@0-1D @32 3RA6@@0-2D @32
20 8 ... 32 3RA6@@0-1E @32 3RA6@@0-2E @32
For use in the infeed system for 3RA6,
without main circuit terminals, with 1 pair of control circuit terminals
-- 0.1 ... 0.4 3RA6@@0-1A @33 3RA6@@0-2A @33
1/2 0.32 ... 1.25 3RA6@@0-1B @33 3RA6@@0-2B @33
2 1 ... 4 3RA6@@0-1C @33 3RA6@@0-2C @33
7 1/2 3 ... 12 3RA6@@0-1D @33 3RA6@@0-2D @33
20 8 ... 32 3RA6@@0-1E @33 3RA6@@0-2E @33
For standard mounting rail or screw mounting
when using the AS-i add-on module
with 1 pair of main circuit terminals, without control circuit terminals
-- 0.1 ... 0.4 3RA6@@0-1A @34 3RA6@@0-2A @34
1/2 0.32 ... 1.25 3RA6@@0-1B @34 3RA6@@0-2B @34
2 1 ... 4 3RA6@@0-1C @34 3RA6@@0-2C @34
7 1/2 3 ... 12 3RA6@@0-1D @34 3RA6@@0-2D @34
20 8 ... 32 3RA6@@0-1E @34 3RA6@@0-2E @34

Order No. supplements for rated control supply voltage


• Direct-on-line starter 12 12
• Reversing duty starter 25 25
• 24 V AC/DC (for combining with AS-I add-on module) B B
• 110 … 240 V AC/DC P P

1)
Selection depends on the motor full load amps. Horse Power ratings pro-
vided for reference only.
2)
A set of 3RA69 40-0A adapters is required for screw mounting.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/7
6/40 SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 Illustrations are approximate
Compact Combination Starters

SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters


3RA64, 3RA65 compact starters for IO-Link

Selection and ordering data

• Direct-on-line starters
• Rated control supply voltage 24 V DC
• Width 45 mm
• One set of 3RA69 40-0A adapters is required for screw fixing
3RA64 with 3RA69 11-1A

Standard induction motor 3-pole Setting range Screw Spring-type


at 460 V AC Standard output P for solid-state overload release terminals terminals
HP 1) A Order No. Order No.
For standard mounting rail or screw moutning, including 1 pair of
main circuit terminals and 1 pair of control circuit terminals
-- 0.1 … 0.4 3RA64 00-1AB42 3RA64 00-2AB42
4

½ 0.32 … 1.25 3RA64 00-1BB42 3RA64 00-2BB42


2 1…4 3RA64 00-1CB42 3RA64 00-2CB42
COMBINATION
STARTERS

7½ 3 … 12 3RA64 00-1DB42 3RA64 00-2DB42


20 8 … 32 3RA64 00-1EB42 3RA64 00-2EB42
For use in the infeed system for 3RA6, without main circuit terminals,
with 1 pair of control circuit terminals
— 0.1 … 0.4 3RA64 00-1AB43 3RA64 00-2AB43
½ 0.32 … 1.25 3RA64 00-1BB43 3RA64 00-2BB43
2 1…4 3RA64 00-1CB43 3RA64 00-2CB43
7½ 3 … 12 3RA64 00-1DB43 3RA64 00-2DB43
20 8 … 32 3RA64 00-1EB43 3RA64 00-2EB43

• Reversing starters
• Rated control supply voltage 24 V DC
• Width 90 mm
• One set of 3RA69 40-0A adapters is required for screw fixing
3RA65 with 3RA69 11-1A

For standard mounting rail or screw moutning, including 1 pair of


main circuit terminals and 1 pair of control circuit terminals
— 0.1 … 0.4 3RA65 00-1AB42 3RA65 00-2AB42
½ 0.32 … 1.25 3RA65 00-1BB42 3RA65 00-2BB42
2 1…4 3RA65 00-1CB42 3RA65 00-2CB42
7½ 3 … 12 3RA65 00-1DB42 3RA65 00-2DB42
20 8 … 32 3RA65 00-1EB42 3RA65 00-2EB42
For use in the infeed system for 3RA6, without main circuit terminals,
with 1 pair of control circuit terminals
— 0.1 … 0.4 3RA65 00-1AB43 3RA65 00-2AB43
½ 0.32 … 1.25 3RA65 00-1BB43 3RA65 00-2BB43
2 1…4 3RA65 00-1CB43 3RA65 00-2CB43
7½ 3 … 12 3RA65 00-1DB43 3RA65 00-2DB43
20 8 … 32 3RA65 00-1EB43 3RA65 00-2EB43
1) Selection depends on the motor full load amps. Horse power ratings provided for reference only.

4/8 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


For Operation in the Control Cabinet
Compact Combination Starters
SIRIUS3RA6
SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact
Compact Starters
Starters
Accessories
Accessories

Overview
Accessories for SIRIUS 3RA6 compact starters 8US Fast Bus busbar adapters for 60 mm systems
The following accessories are available for the 3RA6 compact The compact starters are mounted directly with the aid of busbar
starters: adapters on the Fast Bus busbar systems with 60 mm center-to-
• AS-i add-on module: see AS-Interface Add-On Modules for center clearance in order to save space and to reduce infeed
3RA6, page 4/14 times and costs. These starters are suitable for copper busbars
with a width from 12 to 30 mm. The busbars can be 4 to 5 mm
• External auxiliary switch blocks: Snap-on auxiliary switch as or 10 mm thick.
versions 2 NO, 2 NC and 1 NO +1 NC with screw or spring-
type connections; the contacts of the auxiliary switch block The 8US Fast Bus busbar system can be loaded with a maxi-
open and close jointly with the main contacts of the compact mum summation current of 630A.
starter. The NC contacts are designed as mirror contacts. The "reversing starter" version requires a device holder along
• Control kit: aid for manually closing the main contacts in order side the busbar adapter for lateral mounting.
to evaluate the wiring and motor direction under conditions of
short-circuit protection The compact starters are snapped onto the adapter and con-
nected on the line side. This prepared unit is then plugged di-
• Adapter for screw mounting the compact starter, including rectly onto the busbar system, and is thus connected both me-
push-in lugs chanically and electrically at the same time.
• Main circuit terminals: Available in screw and spring-type ter-
minals For more accessories such as incoming and outgoing
terminals, flat copper profiles etc., see Section 5 “Fastbus

4
• Main circuit terminals for mixed connection method: Busbar Systems”.
With the main circuit terminal for the mixed connection method
it is also possible in the main circuit to change over from the Accessories for operation with closed control cabinet doors

STARTERS
COMBINATION
screw connection method on the incoming side to the spring- Door-coupling rotary operating mechanisms for standard and
type connection method on the outgoing side. emergency-stop applications are available for operating the
This enables for example the side-by-side mounting of several compact starter with closed control cabinet doors.
compact starters and their cost-effective connection using the
three-phase busbars on the infeed side. The motors are then Accessories for SIRIUS 3RA6 compact starters in IO-Link
directly connected by the quick and reliably contacting version
spring-type connection method.
The following accessories are available specifically for the
Accessories for UL applications 3RA64, 3RA65 compact starters:
The terminal block for "Self-Protected Combination Motor • The 4SI SIRIUS solid-state module as IO-Link master allows
Controller", type E is available for complying with the clearance for the simple and economical connection of SIRIUS controls
and creepage distances according to UL 508. with IO-Link (e.g up to four groups of 4 compact starters) to
the multifunctional SIMATIC ET 200S distributed I/O system.
Accessories for infeed using three-phase busbar systems • Additional connection cables for side-by-side mounting of up
6

The three-phase busbars can be used as an easy, time-saving to 4 compact starters


and clearly arranged means of feeding SIRIUS 3RA6 compact • Operator panel for local control and diagnostics of up to
starters with screw connection. Motor starter protectors size S00 4 compact starters coupled to each other
and S0 can also be integrated.
The busbars are suitable for between 2 and 5 devices. However,
any kind of extension up to a maximum summation current of
63 A is possible by clamping the terminals of an additional bus-
bar (rotated by 180°) underneath the terminals of the respective
last motor circuit protector.
A connecting piece is required for the combination with motor
starter protector size S00. S00 and S0 motor starter protectors of
the 3RV2 series do not require the additional connecting piece.
The motor starter protectors are supplied by appropriate feeder
terminals. Special feeder terminals are required for constructing
"Type E Starters" according to UL/CSA.
The three-phase busbar systems are finger-safe but empty
connection terminals must be fitted with covers. They are de-
signed for any short-circuit stress which can occur at the output
side of connected SIRIUS 3RA6 compact starters or motor
starter protectors.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/9


6/44 SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012
Compact Combination Starters For Operation in the Control Cabinet
SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters
Accessories
Accessories

Selection and ordering data


Version Order No. Std. Weight
pack approx.
qty.
kg
Accessories for 3RA6 compact starters
Control kits 3RA69 50-0A 1 unit 0.004
For mechanical actuation of the
compact starter

3RA69 50-0A
Adapters for screw mounting the 3RA69 40-0A 1 unit 0.152
compact starter
(set including push-in lugs)
Direct-on-line starters require 1 set,
reversing starters 2 sets.
4

3RA69 40-0A
Screw terminals
COMBINATION
STARTERS

Auxiliary switch blocks for compact starters


• 2 NO 3RA69 11-1A 1 unit 0.018
• 2 NC 3RA69 12-1A 1 unit 0.018
• 1 NO +1 NC 3RA69 13-1A 1 unit 0.018
3RA69 11-1A (these auxiliary contacts are positively driven.)
Main circuit terminals 3RA69 20-1A 1 unit 0.038
(line and load side)

3RA69 20-1A

6
Control circuit terminals
• For 3RA61 3RA69 20-1B 1 unit 0.042
• For 3RA62 3RA69 20-1C 1 unit 0.042
3RA69 20-1B
Spring-type terminals

Auxiliary switch blocks for compact starters


• 2 NO 3RA69 11-2A 1 unit 0.018
• 2 NC 3RA69 12-2A 1 unit 0.018
• 1 NO +1 NC 3RA69 13-2A 1 unit 0.018
3RA69 11-2A (these auxiliary contacts are positively driven.)
Main circuit terminals 3RA69 20-2A 1 unit 0.049
(line and load side)

3RA69 20-2A
Control circuit terminals
• For 3RA61 3RA69 20-2B 1 unit 0.036
• For 3RA62 3RA69 20-2C 1 unit 0.036
3RA69 20-2B

4/10 Siemens
* You can order thisIndustry
quantityInc.,
or aIndustrial
multiple Control
thereof.Catalog
Illustrations are approximate SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 6/45
For Operation in the Control Cabinet
Compact Combination Starters
SIRIUS3RA6
SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact
Compact Starters
Starters
Accessories
Accessories

Version Order No. Std. Weight


pack approx.
qty.
kg
Accessories for 3RA6 compact starters (continued)
Main circuit terminals for mixed connection 3RA69 20-3A 1 unit 0.044
method
One set comprises:
• 1 joint block on the line side for the screw connec-
tion method
• 1 joint block on the motor side for the spring-type
connection method

3RA69 20-3A

Version Order No. Std. Weight


pack approx.
qty.
kg
Accessories specifically for 3RA64, 3RA65 compact starters
with IO-Link

4
Additional connection cables (flat) for side-by-
side mounting of up to 4 compact starters
• 10-pole

STARTERS
COMBINATION
- 8 mm1) 3RA69 32-0A 5 units 0.007
- 200 mm1) 3RA69 33-0B 5 units 0.012
• 14-pole
- 8 mm2) 3RA69 31-0A 5 units 0.007
3RA69 31-0A - 200 mm 3RA69 33-0C 5 units 0.014
Operator panels 3RA69 35-0A 1 unit 0.052
- 1 operator panel
- 1 enabling module
- 1 interface cover
- 1 fixing terminal
3RA69 35-0A
Enabling block 3RA69 36-0A 1 unit 0.002
Blanking covers 3RA69 36-0B 5 units 0.001
6

Connection cable (round) for connecting the 3RA69 33-0A 1 unit 0.114
operator panel
10-pole, 2 000 mm
SIRIUS 4SI solid-state modules 3RK1 005-0LB00-0AA0 1 unit 0.057
IO-Link master for connection of up to
4 SIRIUS controls (max. 16 in groups of 4) with IO-
Link (3-wire connection) to
SIMATIC ET 200S,
width 15 mm,
supports firmware update
(STEP 7 V5.4 SP5 and higher)
Can be used with the following terminal
3RK1 005-0LB00-0AA0 modules:
• TM-E15S26-A1 (screw terminals)
• TM-E15C26-A1 (spring-type terminals)
• TM-E15N26-A1 (Fast Connect)
1) 10-pole connection cables are required for EMERGENCY-STOP group 2) Is included in the scope of supply of the SIRIUS 3RA6 compact starter in
concepts. IO-Link version.

Version Order No. Std. Weight


pack approx.
qty.
kg
Terminal blocks and phase barriers for
"Self-Protected Combination
Motor Controllers (Type E)" according to UL 508
Note:
UL 508 demands 1-inch clearance and 2-inch creepage distance on the line side for "Combination Motor Controller Type E".
The following terminal blocks or phase barriers must be used in 3RV20 motor starter protectors.
The terminal blocks or phase barriers cannot be used in combination with the 3RV19 .5 three-phase busbars.
For construction with three-phase busbars, see "Busbar accessories".
3RV29 28-1H Terminal blocks type E S00, S0 3RV29 28-1H 1 unit 0.065
For extended clearance and
creepage distances
(1 and 2 inch)

Siemens Industry
* You Inc., Industrial
can order Control
this quantity or aCatalog 4/11
multiple thereof.
6/46 SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 Illustrations are approximate
Motor Starter Protectors/Circuit Breakers
Compact Combination Starters SIRIUS 3RV2 Motor Starter Protectors/Circuit Breakers up to 80 A
Accessories
SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters
Busbar accessories
Accessories

Modular Number of motor starter protec- Rated For motor Order No. Std. Weight
spacing tors that can be connected current In starter pack approx.
Without With lateral With at 690 V protectors qty.
lateral auxiliary auxiliary
accesso- switch release
ries
mm A Size
Three-phase busbars1)
For feeding several motor starter protectors with screw terminals,
mounted side by side on standard mounting rails, insulated,
with touch protection
3RV1915-1AB
453) 2 -- -- 63 S00, S02) 3RV1915-1AB 1 unit 0.044
3 -- -- 63 S00, S02) 3RV1915-1BB 1 unit 0.071
4 -- -- 63 S00, S02) 3RV1915-1CB 1 unit 0.099
5 -- -- 63 S00, S02) 3RV1915-1DB 1 unit 0.124
3RV1915-1BB 554) -- 2 -- 63 S00, S02) 3RV1915-2AB
-- 3 -- 63 S00, S02) 3RV1915-2BB
-- 4 -- 63 S00, S02) 3RV1915-2CB
-- 5 -- 63 S00, S02) 3RV1915-2DB
2 -- -- 108 S2 3RV1935-1A
3RV1915-1CB
3 -- -- 108 S2 3RV1935-1B
4 -- -- 108 S2 3RV1935-1C
4

635) -- -- 2 63 S00, S02) 3RV1915-3AB


-- -- 4 63 S00, S02) 3RV1915-3CB
3RV1915-1DB 755) 3RV1935-3A
COMBINATION
STARTERS

-- 2 2 108 S2
-- 3 3 108 S2 3RV1935-3B
-- 4 4 108 S2 3RV1935-3C

7
1) 4)
Not suitable for 3RV21 motor starter protectors for motor protection For 3RV2 motor starter protectors with auxiliary switches with 1 NO + 1 NC,
with overload relay function and for 3RV27 and 3RV28 circuit breakers 2 NO and 2 NC mounted on the left (9 mm wide).
according to UL 489/CSA C22.2 No. 5. 5)
For 3RV2 motor starter protectors with mounted accessories (18 mm wide).
2)
Approved for motor starter protectors size S0 with In ≤ 32 A. Auxiliary switches with 2 NO + 2 NC or signaling switch (mounted on the
3)
For 3RV2 motor starter protectors without accessories mounted left) or with auxiliary release (mounted on the right).
on the side.

Conductor cross-section Tightening For motor Order No. Weight


Solid or Finely AWG cables, torque starter approx.
stranded stranded solid or protectors/
with end stranded circuit
sleeve breakers
mm² mm² AWG Nm Size
Three-phase infeed terminals
Connection from top
2.5 ... 25 2.5 ... 16 10 ... 4 3 ... 4 S00, S0 3RV2925-5AB 0.043
2x 2x 2x 4 ... 6 S2 3RV2935-5A
(2.5 ... 50)1), (2.5 ... 35)1), (10 ... 1/0)1),
3RV2925-5AB 1x 1x 1x
(2.5 ... 70)1) (2.5 ... 50)1) (10 ... 2/0)1)

3RV2935-5A
Connection from below
This terminal is connected in place of a switch, please take the
space requirement into account.
2.5 ... 25 2.5 ... 16 10 ... 4 Input: 4, S00, S0 3RV2915-5B 0.093
Output:
2 ... 2.5
3RV2915-5B
Three-phase infeed terminals for constructing "Type E Starters"
Connection from top
2.5 ... 25 2.5 ... 16 10 ... 4 3 ... 4 S00, S0 3RV2925-5EB 0.044
2x 2x 2x 4 ... 6 S2 3RV2935-5E
(2.5 ... 50)1), (2.5 ... 35)1), (10 ... 1/0)1),
3RV2925-5EB 1x 1x 1x
(2.5 ... 70)1) (2.5 ... 50)1) (10 ... 2/0)1)

1) If two different conductor cross-sections are connected to one clamping


3RV2935-5E point, both cross-sections must be in the range specified.

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2015 7/35
4/12 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog
Compact Combination Starters For Operation in the Control Cabinet
SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters
Accessories Accessories

Version Order No. Std. Weight


pack approx.
qty.
kg
8US Fast Bus busbar adapters for 60 mm systems
For flat copper profiles according to DIN 46433 8US12 11-1NS10 1 unit 0.337
Width: 12 ... 30 mm
Thickness: 4 ... 5 mm or 10 mm

8US12 11-1NS10
Device holders for lateral mounting along side the Fast Bus busbar
adapter for 60 mm systems
Required in addition to the busbar adapter for 8US12 50-1AA10 1 unit 0.239
mounting a reversing starter

4
STARTERS
COMBINATION
8US12 50-1AA10

Version Color of Version of Order No. Std. Weight


handle extension shaft pack approx.
qty.
mm kg
Door-coupling rotary operating mechanisms for operating the com-
pact starter with closed control cabinet doors
The door-coupling rotary operating mechanisms consist of a knob, a coupling driver and an extension shaft of 130/330 mm in
length (6 mm x 6 mm). The door-coupling rotary operating mechanisms are designed to degree of protection IP65. The door

6
interlocking prevents accidental opening of the control cabinet door in the ON position of the motor starter protector. The OFF
position can be locked with up to 3 padlocks.
Door-coupling rotary Black 130 3RV29 26-0B 1 unit 0.111
operating mecha-
nisms
3RV29 26-0B
EMERGENCY-STOP Red/ 130 3RV29 26-0C 1 unit 0.110
door-coupling Yellow
rotary operating
mechanisms

Version Order No. Std. Weight


pack approx.
qty.
kg
Tools for opening spring-type terminals by hand
Screwdrivers Spring-type terminals
for all SIRIUS devices with spring-type terminals
Length approx. 200 mm, 3RA29 08-1A 1 unit 0.045
3.0 mm x 0.5 mm,
titanium gray/black,
3RA29 08-1A partially insulated
Blank labels
Unit labeling plates1) 3RT29 00-1SB20 340 units 0.200
for SIRIUS devices
20 mm x 7 mm,
titanium gray
r
NSB0_01429b

3RT19 00-1SB20
1) PC labeling system for individual inscription of unit labeling plates
available from: Murrplastik Systems, Inc. www.murrplastik.com.

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/13
Illustrations are approximate SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 6/49
For Operation in the Control Cabinet
Compact Combination Starters
SIRIUS3RA6
SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact
Compact Starters
Starters
Add-on modules for AS-Interface
Add-on modules for AS-Interface

Overview
Various AS-i add-on modules are available for communication of
the 3RA6 compact starter with the control system using
AS-Interface:
• Standard version
• With two local inputs
• With two free external inputs
• With one free external input and one free external output
• With two free external outputs
• For local control
The AS-i add-on modules can be combined only in connection
with compact starters with a rated control supply voltage of
24 V AC/DC.
AS-i add-on module for communications controlling
With this new module it is also possible for the connected com-
pact starter to be operated directly using simple switches, i.e.
without recourse to AS-i Communication, if required.
4

"Automatic" mode
NC contacts can be connected to the inputs Y2 and Y4 through
COMBINATION
STARTERS

the local terminals on the AS-i add-on module. If the "+" connec-
tions are connected simultaneously to both local inputs, the
AS-i add-on module will be in "Automatic" mode, i.e. it will
communicate with the control system through AS-Interface.
Local control
Circuit diagram example for operating a 3RA61 20 direct-on-line starter
Opening the two inputs Y2 and Y4 will result in the direct using an AS-i add-on module for on-site controller
disconnection of the compact starter. Operation through AS-i
Communication is ended and the compact starter can now be
switched on and off directly using NO contacts (one NO contact
per direction of rotation on the reversing starter).
"LED AUX Power" must light up green, the 24 V DC supply must
be connected and the AS-i control supply voltage must no lon-
ger be applied.
6

Resetting to "Automatic" mode


Simultaneous application of a "1" signal at the local inputs. The
availability bit DI 0 is switched to a "1" signal.
If AS-i Communication is reset, the motor is first switched off and
then on again when requested by the control system.

Circuit diagram example for operating a 3RA62 50 reversing starter using


an AS-i add-on module for on-site controller

4/14 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


6/50 SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012
Compact Combination Starters For Operation in the Control Cabinet
SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters
Add-on modules for AS-Interface
Add-on modules for AS-Interface

Selection and ordering data


Version Order No. Std. Weight
pack approx.
qty.
kg
AS-i add-on modules
Standard version 3RA69 70-3A 1 unit 0.045
For communication of the compact starter with
the control system using AS-Interface
With two local inputs 3RA69 70-3B 1 unit 0.045
For safe disconnection through local safety
3RA69 70-3A relays, e.g. cable-operated switches
With two free external inputs 3RA69 70-3C 1 unit 0.045
Replaces the digital standard inputs
"Motor On" and "Group warning"
With one free external input and one free 3RA69 70-3D 1 unit 0.045
external output
Replaces the digital standard input
3RA69 70-3B to -3F "Group warning"
With two free external outputs 3RA69 70-3E 1 unit 0.045

4
Only for direct-on-line starters,
replaces the digital standard output
"Motor left"

STARTERS
COMBINATION
For local control 3RA69 70-3F 1 unit 0.045
Control of the compact starter optionally using
AS-Interface or local switches

Spare parts for AS-i add-on modules


Connectors for data and auxiliary supply cable
with 2 insulation displacement terminations for
standard litz wires 2 x 0.5 ... 0.75 mm2
• Flat, yellow, extender 3RK1901-0NA00 5 units
• Flat, black, extender 3RK1901-0PA00 5 units

Accessories for AS-i add-on modules


AS-Interface addressing unit V 3.0 3RK1904-2AB02 1 unit 0.540

6
• For AS-Interface modules and sensors and actuators
with integrated AS-Interface in accordance with
AS-i Specification V3.0
• For setting the AS-i address of standard slaves,
and slaves with extended addressing mode
(A/B slaves)
• With input/output test function and many other
commissioning functions
• Battery operation with 4 batteries type AA
(IEC LR6, NEDA 15)
• Scope of supply:
- Addressing unit with 4 batteries
- Addressing cable, with M12 plug to addressing plug
3RK1904-2AB02 (hollow plug), length 1.5m

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/15
Illustrations are approximate SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 6/51
For Operation in the Control Cabinet
Compact Combination Starters
SIRIUS
3RA6 3RA6 Compact
Compact Starters
Starters
Infeed systems for 3RA6 — up to 100 A
Infeed systems for 3RA6

Overview
The infeed system for 3RA6 compact starters enables far less In addition, the integrated PE bar means it is optionally possible
wiring in the main circuit and, thanks to the easy exchangeability to connect the motor cable directly to the infeed system without
of the compact starters, reduces the usual downtimes for additional intermediate terminals. The infeed system for 3RA6
maintenance work during the plant's operating phase. compact starters is designed for summation currents up to
100 A with a conductor cross-section of max. 2/0 AWG on the
The infeed system provides the possibility of completely feeder terminal block.
prewiring the main circuit without a compact starter needing to
be connected at the same time. As the result of the removable The infeed system can be mounted on a standard mounting rail
terminals in the main circuit, compact starters can be integrated or flat surfaces.
in an infeed system in an easy manner (without the use of tools).

1
4

3
COMBINATION
STARTERS

5 9
11

6
6

NSB0_01878

12 7

10

1 Feeder terminal 7 PE tap-off


2 Three-socket expansion module 8 Connecting plates
3 Two-socket expansion module 9 End cover
4 Expansion plug 10 45 mm adapter for SIRIUS motor starter protector size S0
5 PE infeed 11 3RA61 direct-on-line starter
6 PE expansion plug 12 3RA62 reversing starter

Infeed system for 3RA6 compact starters

4/16 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


6/52 SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012
Compact Combination Starters For Operation in the Control Cabinet
SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters
Infeed systems for 3RA6 — up to 100 A Infeed systems for 3RA6
1 Infeed 10 45 mm adapters for SIRIUS 3RV motor starter protectors
The 3-phase infeed is available as an infeed with screw connec- SIRIUS 3RV1 and 3RV2motor starter protectors size S0 with screw
tion (4-2 AWG up to 63 A or 0-2/0 AWG up to 100 A) and a an connection can be fitted to the adapter, enabling them to be
infeed with spring-type connection (4-2 AWG up to 63 A). plugged into the infeed system.
The infeed with spring-type terminal can be attached to the left Terminal blocks
side, as well as the right side, of an expansion module.
Using the terminal block, three phase power can be fed out of
The screw terminal infeeds are permanently fitted to the left side the infeed system; this means that single-phase, two-phase and
of a 3-socket expansion module. three-phase components can also be integrated in the system.
The infeeds with screw connection enable connection of the If the end cover is removed, the terminal block can be inserted
main conductors (L1, L2, L3) either from above or from below. into an expansion module.
The infeeds with screw connection come packaged with 1 end Expansion plug for SIRIUS 3RV29 infeed systems
cover, while the infeed with spring-type connection comes pack-
aged with 2 end covers. If the end cover is removed, the expansion plug for the SIRIUS
3RV29 infeed system can be inserted into an expansion module.
2 Three-socket expansion modules It connects the infeed system for 3RA6 compact starters with the
The expansion module with 3 sockets for compact starters is SIRIUS 3RV29 infeed system.
available with screw connection and with spring-type Maximum rated operational current
connection.
The following maximum rated operational currents apply for the
Expansion modules enable the infeed system to be expanded components of the infeed system for 3RA6:

4
and can be connected to each other in any number up to a max-
imum length of 1.2 meters. Component Maximum rated
operational current

STARTERS
COMBINATION
Two expansion modules are held together with the help of
2 connecting plates and 1 expansion plug. These assembly A
parts are included in the scope of supply of the respective Infeed with screw connection 0-2/0 AWG 100
expansion module.
Infeed with screw connection 4-2 AWG 63
When the infeed system for 3RA6 compact starters is used, the Infeed with spring-type connection 4-2 AWG 63
compact starters (plug-in modules) are easily mounted and re-
moved even when live. Expansion plugs 63

Optional possibilities: When several expansion modules are mounted side by side, the
• PE connection on motor starter side maximum rated operational current from the 2nd expansion
• Outfeed for external auxiliary devices module to the end of the row is 63 A.
• Connection to 3RV29 infeed system
• Integration of SIRIUS 3RV1 and 3RV2 motor starter protectors Proposal for upstream short-circuit protection devices
size S0 up to 25 A (using 3RA68 90-0BA adapter) The following short-circuit data apply for the components of the

6
Two-socket expansion modules infeed system for 3RA6 compact starters:
3
If only 2 instead of 3 additional sockets are required, then the Conductor Inscriptions Proposal for
2-socket expansion module is the right choice. It has the same cross- upstream short-circuit
section protection device
functionality as the 3-socket expansion module.
AWG
4 Expansion plug
Short-circuit protection for
Two expansion modules can be connected together using the infeed block (4-2 AWG)
expansion plug. Flexible expansion of the infeed system is thus with screw connection
possible. 14-2 Id, max = 19 kA, I²t = 440 kA²s 3RV10 41-4JA10

PE infeeds Short-circuit protection for


5
infeed block (0-2/0 AWG)
This module enables a PE cable to be connected. with screw connection

The PE infeed can be ordered with screw connection and 14-2/0 Id, max = approx. 22 kA 3RV10 41-4MA10
spring-type connection (2 AWG) and can be fitted on the right or Short-circuit protection for infeed block
left to the expansion block. with spring-type connection

6 PE expansion plug 12 Id, max = 9.5 kA, I²t = 85 kA²s 3RV10 21-4DA10
10 Id, max = 12.5 kA, I²t = 140 kA²s 3RV10 31-4EA10
The PE expansion plug is inserted from below and enables two
PE bars to be connected. 8 Id, max = 15 kA, I²t = 180 kA²s 3RV10 31-4HA10

PE tap-off 6-4 Id, max = 19 kA, I²t = 440 kA²s 3RV10 41-4JA10
7
Short-circuit protection for terminal block
The PE tap-off is available with screw connection and spring-
type connection (10-8 AWG). It is snapped into the infeed sys- 16 Id, max = 7.5 kA 5SY...
tem from below. 14 Id, max = 9.5 kA 1)

8 Connecting plates 12 Id, max = 9.5 kA


10 Id, max = 12.5 kA
Two connecting plates are used to hold together 2 adjacent
expansion modules. 1) To prevent the possibility of short-circuits, the cables on the terminal block
must be installed so that they are short-circuit proof according to
9 End covers EN 60439-1 Section 7.5.5.1.2.
On the last expansion module of a row, the slot provided for the
expansion plug can be covered by inserting the end cover.

Siemens SIRIUS
Industry Inc., Industrial
Innovations Control2012
Supplement Catalog 4/17
6/53
For Operation in the Control Cabinet
Compact Combination Starters
SIRIUS3RA6
SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact
Compact Starters
Starters
Infeed systems for 3RA6 — up to 100 A
Infeed systems for 3RA6

Selection and ordering data


Version Order No. Weight
approx.
kg
Three-phase infeeds and expansion modules
Infeeds with screw connection
4-2 AWG left
Infeed with screw connection with Screw terminals
permanently fitted 3-socket expansion
module with screw or spring-type
terminals on the outgoing side and
integrated PE bar
Expansion module with 3 sockets for
3 direct-on-line starters or 1 direct-on-line
3RA68 12-8AB starter and 1 reversing starter
• Screw terminals on outgoing side 3RA68 12-8AB 0.957

• Spring-type terminals on outgoing side 3RA68 12-8AC 0.990


4 STARTERS
COMBINATION

3RA68 12-8AC
Infeeds with screw connection
0-2/0 AWG left
Infeed with screw connection with Screw terminals
permanently fitted 3-socket expansion
module with screw or spring-type
terminals on the outgoing side and
integrated PE bar
Expansion module with 3 sockets for
3RA68 13-8AB 3 direct-on-line starters or 1 direct-on-line
starter and 1 reversing starter,
suitable for UL duty according to UL 508
Type E
• Screw terminals on outgoing side 3RA68 13-8AB 1.146
6

• Spring-type terminals on outgoing side 3RA68 13-8AC 1.179

3RA68 13-8AC
Infeeds with spring-type
connection 4-2 AWG left or right
Spring-type terminals

Up to 63 A 3RA68 30-5AC 0.283

3RA68 30-5AC

4/18 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
6/54 SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 Illustrations are approximate
Compact Combination Starters For Operation in the Control Cabinet
SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters
Infeed systems for 3RA6
Infeed systems for 3RA6

Version Order No. Weight


approx.
kg
Expansion modules
Two-socket expansion modules
With screw or spring-type terminals
and integrated PE bar
with 2 sockets for 2 direct-on-line starters or
1 reversing starter
Expansion plug and 2 connecting plates
are included in the scope of supply.
Screw terminals

3RA68 22-0AB • Screw terminals 3RA68 22-0AB 0.505


Spring-type terminals

• Spring-type terminals 3RA68 22-0AC 0.527

4
STARTERS
COMBINATION
3RA68 22-0AC
Three-socket expansion modules
With screw or spring-type terminals
and integrated PE bar
with 3 sockets for 3 direct-on-line starters or
1 direct-on-line starter and 1 reversing starter
Expansion plug and 2 connecting plates
are included in the scope of supply.
Screw terminals

3RA68 23-0AB • Screw terminals 3RA68 23-0AB 0.717


Spring-type terminals

• Spring-type terminals 3RA68 23-0AC 0.750

6
3RA68 23-0AC

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/19
Illustrations are approximate SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 6/55
For Operation in the Control Cabinet
Compact Combination Starters
SIRIUS3RA6
SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact
Compact Starters
Starters
Infeed systems for 3RA6
Infeed systems for 3RA6

Accessories
Version Order No. Weight
approx.
kg
Accessories for 3RA6 infeed systems
PE infeeds 4-2 AWG
Screw terminals

• Screw terminals 3RA68 60-6AB 0.060

3RA68 60-6AB
Spring-type terminals

• Spring-type terminals 3RA68 60-5AC 0.070


4 STARTERS
COMBINATION

3RA68 60-5AC
PE tap-offs 10-8 AWG
Screw terminals

• Screw terminals 3RA68 70-4AB 0.019

3RA68 70-4AB
Spring-type terminals

• Spring-type terminals 3RA68 70-3AC 0.017


6

3RA68 70-3AC
Expansion plugs
PE expansion plugs 3RA68 90-0EA 0.008

3RA68 90-0EA
Expansion plugs 3RA68 90-1AB 0.029
between 2 expansion modules
Is included in the scope of supply of the
expansion modules.

3RA68 90-1AB
Expansion plugs for SIRIUS 3RV19/29 infeed 3RA68 90-1AA 0.079
system
Connects infeed system for 3RA6 to
3RV29 infeed systems

3RA68 90-1AA

4/20 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
6/56 SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 Illustrations are approximate
Compact Combination Starters

SIRIUS 3RA6andCompact
Load Feeders Starters
Motor Starters for Use in the Control Cabinet
SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters
Infeed systems for 3RA6
Infeed systems for 3RA6

Version Order No. Weight


approx.

Accessories for infeed systems for 3RA6 (continued)


45 mm adapters
For SIRIUS 3RV1.2 and 3RV2.2 motor starter protectors. Size Screw terminals
S0 up to 25 A
• Screw terminals 3RA6890-0BA 0.152
(conductor cross-section AWG 10)

3RA6890-0BA
Terminal covers for infeeds with screw connection
IP20 terminal covers for infeeds with screw connection 3RA6880-2AB
25/35 mm² (3RA6812-8AB/AC)
(2 units per pack)

4
3RA6880-2AB

STARTERS
COMBINATION
IP20 terminal covers for infeeds with screw connection 3RA6880-3AB
50/70 mm² (3RA6813-8AB/AC)
(2 units per pack)

3RA6880-3AB
Terminal blocks
8

For integration of single-phase, 2-phase and Spring-type terminals


3-phase external components
• Spring-type terminals 3RV2917-5D .0.050

3RV2917-5D
Tools for opening spring-type terminals
Screwdrivers
For all SIRIUS devices with spring-type terminals Spring-type terminals

Length approx. 200 mm, 3RA2908-1A .0.045


3.0 mm x 0.5 mm,
titanium gray/black,
partially insulated
3RA2908-1A
System Manual "SIRIUS Compact Starters and Accessories"
The system manual can be downloaded free of charge in
PDF format from the Internet, see
http://support.automation.siemens.com/WW/view/en/
27136554/133300

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/21
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
8/78 Siemens IC 10 · 2015 Illustrations are approximate.
Compact Combination Starters For Operation in the Control Cabinet
SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters
General data
General data

More information
Type 3RA61 3RA62 3RA64 3RA65
Size S0
Number of poles 3
General technical specifications
Device standard IEC/EN 60947-6-2
Mounting dimensions (WxHxD)
• Screw terminals mm 45 x 170 x 165 90 x 170 x 165 45 x 170 x 165 90 x 170 x 165
• Spring-type terminals mm 45 x 191 x 165 90 x 191 x 165 45 x 191 x 165 90 x 191 x 165

D
W

Weight kg 1.4 2.3 -2.4 1.3 2.3


Permissible mounting positions No restrictions, preferably vertical or horizontal installation
Max. rated current Ie 0.1 ... 0.4 A A 0.4
in the respective setting range 0.32 ... 1.25 A A 1.25
1 ... 4 A A 4
3 ... 12 A A 12
8 ... 32 A A 32
Permissible ambient temperature
• During operation Acc. to IEC/EN 60721-3-3 °C -20 ... +60, with derating up to +70
4

• For installation in SIRIUS infeed system for 3RA6 °C -20 ... +40
• During storage IEC/EN 60732-3-1 °C -55 ... +80
• During transport IEC/EN 60721-3-2 °C -55 ... +80
COMBINATION
STARTERS

Permissible rated current of the compact starter,


when several compact starters are mounted side-
by-side on a vertical standard mounting rail
or in the 3RA6 infeed system
• For a control cabinet inside temperature of +40 °C % 100
• For a control cabinet inside temperature of +60 °C % 80
• For a control cabinet inside temperature of +70 °C % 60
Relative air humidity % 10 ... 90
Installation altitude m Up to 2 000 above sea level without restriction
Rated frequency Hz 50/60
Rated insulation voltage Ui V 690
(pollution degree 3)
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 6
Trip class (CLASS) Acc. to IEC 60947-4-1, 10/20

6
EN 60947-4-1
Rated short-circuit current Iq Acc. to IEC 60947-4-1, kA 30 (up to 12 A units)
at AC 50/60 Hz 480 V EN 60947-4-1 15 (8 ... 32 A unit)
Types of coordination Acc. to IEC 60947-6-2, Continuous
EN 60947-6-2
Power loss Pv max of all main current paths 0.4 A mW 10
Dependent on the rated current Ie 1.25 A mW 100
(upper setting range) 4A W 1
12 A W 1.8
32 A W 5.4
Max. switching frequency AC-41 1/h 750
AC-43 1/h 250
AC-44 1/h 15
Drive losses
Active power At 24 V
• 0.1 ... 12 A W 2.7
• 8 ... 32 A W 2.95
At 110 ... 240 V
• 0.1 ... 12 A W 3.4
• 8 ... 32 A W 3.8
Overload function
Ratio of lower to upper current mark 1:4
Shock resistance (sine-wave pulse) a = 60 m/s² = 6 g with 10 ms; for every 3 shocks in all axes
Vibratory load f = 4 ... 5.8 Hz; d =15 mm; f = 5.8 ... 500 Hz; a = 20 m/s2;10 cycles
Protection class IP on the front Acc. to IEC 60529 IP20
Touch protection on the front Acc. to IEC 60529 Finger-safe, for vertical contact from the front
(screw and spring-type terminal)
Isolating features of the compact starter Acc. to IEC/EN 60947-3 Yes: Isolation is assured only by moving the actuator into
the *OFF* position
Main and EMERGENCY-STOP switch Acc. to IEC 60204 Yes
characteristics of the compact starter and
accessories

4/22 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 6/35
For Operation in the Control Cabinet
Compact Combination Starters
SIRIUS3RA6
SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact
Compact Starters
Starters
General datadata
General

Type 3RA61 3RA62 3RA64 3RA65


Size S0
Number of poles 3
General technical specifications (continued)
Protective separation Acc. to IEC 60947-2
Control circuit to auxiliary circuit
• Horizontal standard mounting rail V Up to 400
• Other mounting position V Up to 250
Auxiliary circuit to auxiliary circuit
• Horizontal standard mounting rail V Up to 400
• Other mounting position V Up to 250
Main circuit to auxiliary circuit
• Any mounting position V Up to 400
EMC interference immunity Acc. to IEC/EN 60947-1 Corresponds to degree of severity 3
Conductor-related interference BURST acc. to
IEC/EN 61000-4-4
• In the main circuit kV 4 4
• In the auxiliary circuit kV 3 2
Conductor-related interference SURGE acc. to
IEC/EN 61000-4-5
• In the main circuit

4
- Conductor - Ground kV 4 2
- Conductor - Conductor kV 2 1
• In the auxiliary circuit
0.51)

STARTERS
COMBINATION
- Conductor - Ground kV 2
- Conductor - Conductor kV 1 0.51)
Auxiliary switches
• Integrated
- Position of the main contacts 1 NO + 1 NC 2 NO 1 NO + 1 NC 2 NO
- Overload/short-circuit signal 1 CO/1 NO
• Expandable
- Position of the main contacts 2 NO, 2 NC, 1 NO + 1 NC
Surge suppressors Integrated (Varistor)
Pollution degree 3
Depth from standard mounting rail mm 160
Electromagnetic operating mechanism
Control voltage V 24 AC/DC 24 DC
V 110 ... 240 AC/DC --
Frequency At AC Hz 50/60 ( ±5 %)
6

Primary operating range 0.7 ... 1.25 Us 0.85 ... 1.2 Us


No-load switching frequency 1/h 3 600
Make-time ms max. 70 Max. 70 + IO-Link communication
Break-time ms max. 120 Max. 120 + IO-Link communication
1) To maintain maximum interference immunity in a harsh electromagnetic
environment, additional overvoltage protection should be provided in the
control supply current circuit. A suitable choice is for example the Dehn
Blitzductor BVT AD 24 V, Art. No. 918 402 or an equivalent protective
element.
Manufacturer: DEHN+SÖHNE GmbH+Co. KG, Hans-Dehn-Straße. 1,
Postfach 1640, D-92306 Neumarkt

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/23


6/36 SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012
Compact Combination Starters For Operation in the Control Cabinet
SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters
General data
General data

Type 3RA61 20-.@B3., 3RA62 50-.@B3. 3RA61 20-.EB3., 3RA62 50-.EB3.


@ = A, B, C or D
Rated operational current 12 A Rated operational current 32 A
Rated control supply voltage V 24 AC 24 DC 24 AC 24 DC
Inrush peak current A 0.59 0.47 0.59 0.47
Hold current A 0.13 0.12 0.17 0.14
Closed W 2.8 2.9 3.5 3.1
Operating times, typical
• On ms <160 <140 <160 <140
• Off ms <35 <35 <30 <30
Type 3RA61 20-.@E3., 3RA62 50-.@P3. 3RA61 20-.EE3., 3RA62 50-.EE3.
@ = A, B, C or D
Rated operational current 12 A Rated operational current 32 A
Rated control supply voltage V 110 AC 240 AC 110 DC 240 DC 110 AC 240 AC 110 DC 240 DC
Inrush peak current A 0.24 0.40 0.17 0.29 0.24 0.40 0.17 0.29
Hold current A 0.06 0.08 0.03 0.02 0.06 0.07 0.04 0.03
Closed W 3.8 6 3.1 5.1 3.7 5.2 3.4 5.8
Operating times, typical
• On ms <160 <140 <150 <140 <160 <140 <150 <140
4

• Off ms <50 <80 <50 <70 <40 <60 <40 <60


Type 3RA64 00-.@B4., 3RA65 00-.@B4. 3RA64 00-.EB4., 3RA65 00-.EB4.
COMBINATION
STARTERS

@ = A, B, C or D
Rated operational current 12A Rated operational current 32 A
Rated control supply voltage V 24 DC 24 DC
Inrush peak current A 0.39 0.53
Hold current A 0.13 0.15
Closed W 2.9 3.4
Operating times, typical1)
• On ms <140 <140
• Off ms <35 <30

4/24 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 6/37
For Operation in the Control Cabinet
Compact Combination Starters
SIRIUS3RA6
SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact
Compact Starters
Starters
General datadata
General

Type 3RA61 3RA62 3RA64 3RA65


Size S0
Number of poles 3
Electromagnetic operating mechanism (continued)
Switching capacity at 480 V kA 30 (up to 12 A)
15 (8 ... 32 A)
Switching capacity at 600 V kA 10 (up to 12 A)
5 (8 ... 32 A)
Line protection At 10 kA AWG 14
At 50 kA AWG 12
Shock resistance
• Breaker mechanism OFF g 25
• Breaker mechanism ON g 15
Normal switching duty
Making capacity 12 x In
Breaking capacity 10 x In
Switching capacity dependent on Up to 12 A HP 7 1/2
rated current Up to 32 A HP 20
Endurance in operating cycles
• Electrical endurance At Ie = 0.9 x In and 400 V 3 ... 10 000 000 2 x 3 000 000 2 x 1 500 000
3 ... 10 000 000

4
Control circuit
Rated operational voltage

STARTERS
COMBINATION
• External auxiliary switch block V 400/690
• Internal auxiliary switch V 400/690
• Short-circuit signaling switch V 400
• Overload signaling switch V 400
Switching capacity
• External auxiliary switch block AC-15
• At Ue = 230 V A 6
• At Ue = 400 V A 3
• At Ue = 289/500 V A 2
• At Ue = 400/690 V A 1
DC-13
• At Ue = 24 V A 6
• At Ue = 60 V A 0.9
• At Ue = 125 V A 0.55
• At Ue = 250 V A 0.27
• Internal auxiliary switch AC-15
• At Ue = 230 V A 6
6

• At Ue = 400 V A 3
• At Ue = 289/500 V A 2
• At Ue = 400/690 V A 1
DC-13
• At Ue = 24 V A 10
• At Ue = 60 V A 2
• At Ue = 125 V A 1
• At Ue = 250 V A 0.27
• At Ue = 480 V A 0.1
• Signaling switch AC-15
• At Ue = 230 V A 3
• At Ue = 400 V A 1
DC-13
• At Ue = 24 V A 2
• At Ue = 250 V A 0.11

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/25


6/38 SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012
Compact Combination Starters For Operation in the Control Cabinet
SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters
General data
General data

Type 3RA61 3RA62 3RA64 3RA65


Size S0
Number of poles 3
External auxiliary switch block, internal auxiliary switch
Endurance in operating cycles
• Mechanical endurance 10 000 000 3 000 000
• Electrical endurance AC-15, 230 V
• At 6 A 200 000
• At 3 A 500 000
• At 1 A 2 000 000
• At 0.3 A 10 000 000
DC-13, 24 V
• At 6 A 30 0 00
• At 3 A 100 000
• At 0.5 A 2 000 000
• At 0.2 A 10 000 000
DC-13, 110 V
• At 1 A 40 000
• At 0.55 A 100 000
• At 0.3 A 300 000
• At 0.1 A 2 000 000
• At 0.04 A 10 000 000
DC-13, 220 V
• At 0.3 A 110 000
4

• At 0.1 A 650 000


• At 0.05 A 2 000 000
• At 0.018 A 10 000 000
COMBINATION
STARTERS

Contact stability At 17 V and 5 mA Oper- 1 incorrect switching operation per 100 000 000
ating
cycles
Short-circuit protection
• Short-circuit current IK 1.1 kA Fuse links A 10
operational class gG
- NEOZED Type 5SE
- DIAZED Type 5SB
- LV HRC Type 3NA
• Short-circuit current IK < 400 A Miniature circuit breaker up to A 10
230 V with C characteristic
Signaling switches
Endurance in operating cycles
• Mechanical endurance 20 000
• Electrical endurance AC-15 At 230 V and 3 A 6 050
Contact stability At 17 V and 5 mA Oper- 1 incorrect switching operation per 100 000 000

6
ating
cycles
Short-circuit protection
• Short-circuit current IK 1.1 kA Fuse links A 6
operational class gG
- NEOZED Type 5SE
- DIAZED Type 5SB
- LV HRC Type 3NA
• Short-circuit current IK < 400 A Miniature circuit breaker up to A 6
230 V with C characteristic
Overload (short-circuit current IK 1.1 kA) Fuse links A 4
operational class gG
- NEOZED Type 5SE
- DIAZED Type 5SB
- LV HRC Type 3NA

4/26 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 6/39
Compact Combination Starters

SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters


3RA6 — up to 32 A

Technical data
Connection type Screw connection Spring-type connection

Max. rated current Imax 12 A 32 A 12 A 32 A


Conductor cross-sections of
main circuit terminals
Tools Posidrive size 2 (3.5 x 0.5) mm, 8WA2 803
Prescribed tightening torque NM 2 ... 2.5 --
Minimum/maximum conductor cross-sections
• Solid mm2 2 x (1.5 ... 2.5) 2 x (2.5 ... 6) 2 x (1.5 ... 6) 2 x (2.5 ... 6)
mm2 2 x (2.5 ... 6) Max. 1 x 10 Max. 1 x 10 Max. 1 x 10
2
mm Max. 1 x 10

• Finely stranded without ferrule mm2 -- -- 2 x (1.5 ... 6) 2 x (2.5 ... 6)

• Finely stranded with ferrule mm2 2 x (1.5 ... 2.5) 2 x (2.5 ... 6) 2 x (1.5 ... 6) 2 x (2.5 ... 6)
2
mm 2 x (2.5 ... 6)

• AWG cables AWG 2 x (16 ...14) 2 x (14 ...10) 2 x (16 ...10) 2 x (14 ...10)
AWG 2 x (14 ...10) 1x8 1x8 1x8
AWG 1x8

4
Connection type Screw connection Spring-type connection

STARTERS
COMBINATION
Conductor cross-sections of
control circuit terminals
Tools Posidrive size 2 (3.0 x 0.5) mm, DIN ISO 2380-1A
Prescribed tightening torque NM 0.8 ... 1.2 --
Minimum/maximum conductor cross-sections
• Solid mm² 1 x (0.5 ... 4) 2 x (0.25 ... 1.5)
mm² 2 x (0.5 ... 2.5)

• Finely stranded without ferrule mm² -- 2 x (0.25 ... 1.5)

• Finely stranded with ferrule mm² 1 x (0.5 ... 2.5) 2 x (0.25 ... 1.5)
mm² 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5)

• AWG cables AWG 2 x (20 ... 14) 2 x (24 ... 16)


Conductor cross-sections of
the auxiliary switch for compact starters
Order No. 3RA69 1.-1A 3RA69 1.-2A
Tools Posidrive size 2 (2.5 x 0.4) mm, 8WA2 807
Prescribed tightening torque NM 0.8 ... 1.2 --
Conductor cross-sections
• Solid mm² 2 x (0.5 ...1.5) 2 x (0.25 ... 2.5)
mm² 2 x (0.75 ... 2.5)
mm² 2 x (1 ... 4)

• Finely stranded without ferrule mm² -- 2 x (0.25 ... 2.5)

• Finely stranded with ferrule mm² 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5) 2 x (0.25 ... 1.5)
mm² 2 x (0.75 ... 2.5)

• AWG cables AWG 2 x (20 ... 16) 2 x (24 ... 14)


AWG 2 x (18 ... 14)
AWG 1 x 12

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/27


Compact Combination Starters

SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters


3RA6 — up to 32A

Technical data
Order No. 3RA6970-3A, 3RA6970-3B, 3RA6970-3C, 3RA6970-3D,
3RA6970-3E
General data of the AS-i add-on module
Permissible ambient temperature
• Storage Acc. to IEC/EN 60721-3-1 °C -25 ... +70
• Transport Acc. to IEC/EN 60721-3-2 °C -25 ... +70
Degree of protection Acc. to IEC/EN 60947-1 IP20
EMC interference immunity Acc. to EN 50295
Conductor-related interference BURST acc. to kV 1/2
IEC/EN 61000-4-4
Electrostatic discharge Acc. to IEC/EN 61000-4-2 kV 6/8
Field-related interference Acc. to IEC/EN 61000-4-3 V/m 10 (80 MHz ... 2.7 GHz)
Maximum pick-up current mA 400
Maximum hold current mA 200
Power consumption, max. mA 30
IO code 7
ID code A
ID2 code E
4 STARTERS
COMBINATION

Order No. 3RA6970-3B, 3RA6970-3C, 3RA6970-3D, 3RA6970-3E


Connection type Screw connection

Conductor cross-sections of the AS-i add-on module


Tools Posidrive size 1
Prescribed tightening torque NM 0.5 ... 0.6
Conductor cross-sections
• Solid mm² 1 x (0.5 ... 2.5)
mm² 2 x (0.5 ... 1.0)
• Finely stranded with ferrule mm² 1 x (0.5 ... 2.5)
mm² 2 x (0.5 ... 1.0)
• AWG cables AWG 1 x (20 ... 12)

4/28 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Compact Combination Starters

SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters


Infeed systems for 3RA6 — up to 100 A

Technical data
Type 3RA6.
General data
Max. rated operational current
• Infeed with screw connection 0-2/0 AWG A 100
• Infeed with screw connection 4-2 AWG A 63
• Infeed with spring-type connection 10-3 AWG A 63
• Expansion plug A 63
Permissible ambient temperature
• During operation °C -20 ... +60 (over +40 current reduction is required)
- Permissible rated current at control cabinet inside temperature: +40 °C % 100
+60 °C % 80
• During storage/transport °C -55 ... +80
Relative air humidity % 10 ... 90
Installation altitude m Up to 2000 above sea level without restriction
Rated operational voltage Ue V 690 AC
Rated frequency Hz 50/60
Shock resistance a = 60 m/s² = 6g with 10 ms; for every 3 shocks in all axes
Vibratory load f =1 ... 6 Hz; d =15 mm 10 cycles
f =150 Hz; a = 2 g

4
Degree of protection Acc. to IEC 60947-1 IP20 (IP 00 terminal compart-
ment)

STARTERS
COMBINATION
Touch protection Acc. to EN 50274 Finger-safe
Degree of pollution 3
Short-circuit protection for Recommendation for upstream
short-circuit protection device
infeed with screw connection 4-2 AWG 3RV1041-4JA10
and infeed with screw connection 0-2/0 AWG 3RV1041-4MA10
Id,max kA < 21
I²t kA²s 530 LV HRC gL/gG 3NA3, 315 A
Short-circuit protection for infeed with spring- Recommendation for upstream
type connection short-circuit protection device
• Conductor cross-section 12 AWG Id,max kA < 9.5 3RV2021-4DA10
I²t kA²s 85
• Conductor cross-section 10 AWG Id,max kA < 12.5 3RV1031-4EA10
I²t kA²s 140
• Conductor cross-section 8 AWG Id,max kA < 15 3RV1031-4HA10
I²t kA²s 180
• Conductor cross-section 6-4 AWG Id,max kA < 19 3RV1041-4JA10
I²t kA²s 440
Short-circuit protection for terminal block Recommendation for upstream
short-circuit protection device
• Conductor cross-section 16 AWG Id,max kA 7.5 5SY...
1)
• Conductor cross-section 14 AWG Id,max kA 9.5
• Conductor cross-section 12 AWG Id,max kA 9.5
• Conductor cross-section 10 AWG Id,max kA 12.5
1)
To prevent the possibility of short-circuits, the cables on the terminal block
must be installed so that they are short-circuit resistant according to
EN 60439-1 Section 7.5.5.1.2.

Type 3RV29.
Connection type Spring-type connection

Conductor cross-sections of terminal block


Order No. 3RV29 17-5D
Conductor cross-sections
• Solid mm2 1.5 ... 6
• Finely stranded with ferrule mm2 1.5 ... 4
• Finely stranded without ferrule mm2 1.5 ... 6
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 15 ... 10

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/29


Compact Combination Starters

SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters


Infeed systems for 3RA6 — up to 100 A

Technical data
Type 3RA6.
Connection type Screw connection
Conductor cross-sections of infeed with screw connection
16-2 AWG (L1, L2, L3)1) and PE infeed 2 AWG2)
Order No. 3RA68 12-8AB, 3RA68 12-8AC, 3RA68 60-6AB
Tools Posidrive size 2
Specified tightening torque NM 3 ... 4.5

Conductor cross-sections
• Solid mm2 2.6 ... 16 2.6 ... 16 max. 2 x 16
• Stranded mm2 2.5 ... 35 2.5 ... 35 max. 2 x 25
• Finely stranded with ferrule mm2 2.5 ... 25 2.5 ... 25 max. 2 x 16
• Finely stranded without ferrule mm2 2.5 ... 25 2.5 ... 25 max. 2 x 16
• AWG cables AWG 12 ... 2 12 ... 2 max. 2 x (16 ... 2)
4

Connection type Screw connection

Conductor cross-sections of infeed with screw connection


COMBINATION
STARTERS

10-2/0 AWG (L1, L2, L3)1)


Order No. 3RA68 13-8AB, 3RA68 13-8AC
Tools SW 4
Specified tightening torque NM 6 ... 8

Conductor cross-sections
• Solid mm2 2.5 ... 16 2.5 ... 16 max. 2 x 16
• Stranded mm2 4 ... 70 10 ... 70 max. 2 x 50
• Finely stranded with ferrule mm2 2.5 ... 35 2.5 ... 50 max. 2 x 35
• Finely stranded without ferrule mm2 4 ... 50 10 ... 50 max. 2 x 35
• AWG cables AWG 10 ... 2/0 10 ... 2/0 max. 2 x (10 ... 1/0)

Connection type Spring-type connection


Conductor cross-sections of infeed with spring-type
connection 10-3 AWG (L1, L2, L3)1) and PE infeed 3 AWG
Order No. 3RA68 30-5AC, 3RA68 60-5AC
Tools 8WA2 806 mm 5.5 x 0.8
Conductor cross-sections
• Solid mm2 4 ... 16
• Stranded mm2 4 ... 35
• Finely stranded with ferrule mm2 4 ... 25
• Finely stranded without ferrule mm2 6 ... 25
• AWG cables AWG 10 ... 3
Connection type Screw connection Spring-type connection
Conductor cross-sections of infeed with screw connection 4-2 AWG (T1, T2, T3)2),
infeed with screw connection 0-2/0 AWG (T1, T2, T3)2)
2-socket and 3-socket expansion modules (T1, T2, T3)2) and PE tap-off 10-8 AWG
Order No. 3RA68 12-8AB, 3RA68 13-8AB, 3RA68 12-8AC, 3RA68 13-8AC,
3RA68 22-0AB, 3RA68 23-0AB, 3RA68 22-0AC, 3RA68 23-0AC,
3RA68 70-4AB 3RA68 70-3AC
Tools Posidrive size 2 (3.5 x 0.5) mm, 8WA2 803
Specified tightening torque NM 2 ... 2.5 --
Maximum rated current A 12 32 12 32
Conductor cross-sections
• Solid mm2 2 x (1 ... 2.5) 2 x (2.5 ... 6) 2 x (1.5 ... 6) 2 x (2.5 ... 6)
mm2 2 x (2.5 ... 6)
mm2 max. 1 x 10 max. 1 x 10 max. 1 x 10 max. 1 x 10
2
• Finely stranded with ferrule mm -- -- 2 x (1.5 ... 6) 2 x (2.5 ... 6)

• Finely stranded without ferrule mm2 2 x (1 ... 2.5) 2 x (2.5 ... 6) 2 x (1.5 ... 6) 2 x (2.5 ... 6)
mm2 2 x (2.5 ... 6)

• AWG cables AWG 2 x (16 ... 14) 2 x (14 ... 10) 2 x (16 ... 10) 2 x (14 ... 10)
AWG 2 x (14 ... 10)
AWG 1x8 1x8 1x8 1x8
1) L1, L2, L3 main conductors on input side. 2) T1, T2, T3 main conductors on output side.

4/30 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Compact Combination Starters

SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters


3RA6 — up to 32 A

Dimensional drawings
Direct-on-line starters and reversing starters

45 90
25 10 25 165

1701)
1912)
24
185
30

4
NSB0_01884

STARTERS
COMBINATION
1) Screw connection
2) Spring-loaded connection

Schematics
3RA61 direct-on-line starters

3RA6911-.A
33 43
1L1 3L2 5L3

9896
34 44

95 3RA6912-.A
RLT 13 21 31 41

Q1

14 22 32 42
>> >> >>
77
3RA6913-.A
31 43

78 A1 A2

32 44

NSB0_01924

2T1 4T2 6T3

Schematic for 3RA61 direct-on-line starters (main circuit)

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/31


Compact Combination Starters

SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters


3RA6 — up to 32 A

Dimensional drawings
3RA62 reversing starters

1L1 3L2 5L3

9896

95
3RA6911-.A 3RA6911-.A
23 33 53 63

24 34 54 64
RLT RLT
3RA6912-.A 3RA6912-.A
21 31 13 43 51 61
4

Q1 Q2
COMBINATION
STARTERS

22 32 14 44 52 62

3RA6913-.A 3RA6913-.A
21 33 51 63
77

>> >> >>


22 34 52 64

78

A2 A1 B1 B2

NSB0_01925

2T1 4T2 6T3

Schematic for 3RA62 reversing starters (main circuit)

4/32 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Compact Combination Starters

SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters


Infeed systems for 3RA6 — up to 100 A

■ Dimensional drawings
70 135 155

58

79

NSB0_01926
111

Ø4
,5

148
140

197

225
28
57 45

4
61
102
5
31

STARTERS
COMBINATION
65

Infeed with screw connection 0-2/0 AWG on left with fixed 3-socket expansion module with outgoing screw terminals

176

NSB0_01927
45 135 144
58

79
111
140

148

38
197

225

5
28

57 45
61

76
31
65

Infeed with screw connection 4-2 AWG on left with fixed 3-socket expansion module with outgoing screw terminals

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/33


Compact Combination Starters

SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters


Infeed systems for 3RA6 — up to 100 A

70 135 155

58

NSB0_01928
79
111
Ø4
,5
140

148
208

227
19
57 45

60
102 5 67
4

Infeed with screw connection 0-2/0 AWG on left with fixed 3-socket expansion module with outgoing spring-type terminals
COMBINATION
STARTERS

45 135 176

NSB0_01929
144
58

79
111

Ø4
,5
140

148
208

38
227
19

57 45
60

76 5 67

Infeed with screw connection 4-2 AWG on left with fixed 3-socket expansion module with outgoing spring-type terminals

97
79
154

NSB0_01930

27 5
86

Infeed with spring-type terminals

4/34 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Compact Combination Starters

SIRIUS 3RA6 Compact Starters


Infeed systems for 3RA6 — up to 100 A

135 90 97

NSB0_01931
58

58

79
Ø4 Ø4
,5 ,5

148

148
197

197

197
45 5 65

3-socket expansion module and 2-socket expansion module with outgoing screw te rminals

4
135 90 97

NSB0_01932

STARTERS
COMBINATION
58

58

79
Ø4 Ø4
,5 ,5
148

148
208

208

197

5
45 67
10
3-socket expansion module and 2-socket expansion module with outgoing spring-type te rminals
> 30

NSB0_01933
> 30

> 10 > 10

Minimum clearances to adjacent components when using infeed system for 3RA6

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/35


Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation

3RA2 Starters SIRIUS 3RA2 Motor Starters


3RA21 direct-on-line starters
Non-Reversing, AC Coil — up to 22 A
50/60 Hz 110/120 V AC

Selection and ordering data


Direct-on-line
Rated control supply voltage 50/60 Hz 110/120 V AC
starting With screw connections
• The motor starter protector and contactor are mechanically
and electrically connected by means of the link module.
• Auxiliary switches1) on the motor starter protector and the con-
tactor can be easily fitted due to the modular system.
• Integrated auxiliary switches:
- Contactor size S00: 1 NO;
- Contactor size S0: 1 NO + 1 NC
Combination Starter, UL508 Type F
All size S00 and S0 devices can be applied as Combination
3RA21 20 3RA21 10 3RA21 20
Starters with the addition of either of these line side connectors:
3RA21 10
3RV29 28-1H, 3RV29 25-5EB or 3RV29 28-1K.
Size UL Data FLA setting Consisting of the following single Assembled starter Weight
range inverse- devices approx.
Single-phase Three-phase 2)
SCCR time delayed Motor + Contactor + Link Screw terminals
HP ratings HP ratings at overload starter module
480 V release protector + Busbar
115 V 230 V 200 V 230 V 460 V 575 V adapter3) Order No.
4

kA A kg
Selection depends on motor full load amps
3RV20 3RT20 3RA
COMBINATION
STARTERS

S00 -- -- -- -- -- -- 65 0.11…0.16 11-0AA10 15-1AK61 1921-1DA00 3RA21 1@-0A@15-1AK6 0.575


-- -- -- -- -- -- 65 0.14…0.2 11-0BA10 + 8US1251- 3RA21 1@-0B@15-1AK6 0.575
-- -- -- -- -- -- 65 0.18…0.25 11-0CA10 5DS10 3RA21 1@-0C@15-1AK6 0.575
-- -- -- -- -- -- 65 0.22…0.32 11-0DA10 3RA21 1@-0D@15-1AK6 0.575
-- -- -- -- -- -- 65 0.28…0.4 11-0EA10 3RA21 1@-0E@15-1AK6 0.575
-- -- -- -- -- -- 65 0.35…0.5 11-0FA10 3RA21 1@-0F@15-1AK6 0.575
-- -- -- -- -- -- 65 0.45…0.63 11-0GA10 3RA21 1@-0G@15-1AK6 0.575
-- -- -- -- -- -- 65 0.55…0.8 11-0HA10 3RA21 1@-0H@15-1AK6 0.575
-- -- -- -- -- 1/2 65 0.7… 1 11-0JA10 3RA21 1@-0J@15-1AK6 0.575
-- -- -- -- 1/2 1/2 65 0.9… 1.25 11-0KA10 3RA21 1@-0K@15-1AK6 0.575
-- 1/10 -- -- 3/4 3/4 65 1.1… 1.6 11-1AA10 3RA21 1@-1A@15-1AK6 0.575
-- 1/8 -- -- 3/4 1 65 1.4… 2 11-1BA10 3RA21 1@-1B@15-1AK6 0.575
-- 1/6 1/2 1/2 1 1 1/2 65 1.8… 2.5 11-1CA10 3RA21 1@-1C@15-1AK6 0.575
1/10 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1/2 2 65 2.2… 3.2 11-1DA10 3RA21 1@-1D@15-1AK6 0.575
1/8 1/3 3/4 3/4 2 3 65 2.8… 4 11-1EA10 3RA21 1@-1E@15-1AK6 0.575

6
1/6 1/2 1 1 3 3 65 3.5… 5 11-1FA10 3RA21 1@-1F@15-1AK6 0.575
1/4 1/2 1 1 1/2 3 5 65 4.5… 6.3 11-1GA10 3RA21 1@-1G@15-1AK6 0.575
1/3 1 2 2 5 5 65 5.5… 8 11-1HA10 16-1AK61 3RA21 1@-1H@16-1AK6 0.575
1/2 1 1/2 2 3 5 7 1/2 65 7… 10 11-1JA10 3RA21 1@-1J@16-1AK6 0.575
1/2 2 3 3 7 1/2 10 65 9… 12 11-1KA10 17-1AK61 3RA21 1@-1K@17-1AK6 0.575
1 2 3 5 10 -- 65 11… 16 11-4AA10 18-1AK61 3RA21 1@-4A@18-1AK6 0.575
S0 1/6 1/2 1 1 3 3 65 3.5… 5 11-1FA10 24-1AK60 2921-1AA00 3RA21 2@-1F@24-0AK6 0.761
1/4 1/2 1 1 1/2 3 5 65 4.5… 6.3 11-1GA10 + 8US1251- 3RA21 2@-1G@24-0AK6 0.761
1/3 1 2 2 5 5 65 5.5… 8 11-1HA10 5NT10 3RA21 2@-1H@24-0AK6 0.761
1/2 1 1/2 2 3 5 7 1/2 65 7… 10 11-1JA10 3RA21 2@-1J@24-0AK6 0.761
1/2 2 3 3 7 1/2 10 65 9… 12.5 11-1KA10 3RA21 2@-1K@24-0AK6 0.761
1 2 3 5 10 -- 65 11… 16 21-4AA10 26-1AK60 3RA21 2@-4A@26-0AK6 0.761
1 1/2 3 5 5 10 -- 65 14… 20 21-4BA10 3RA21 2@-4B@26-0AK6 0.761
1 1/2 3 5 7 1/2 15 -- 50 17… 22 21-4CA10 27-1AK60 3RA21 2@-4C@27-0AK6 0.761
2 3 5 7 1/2 15 -- 50 20… 25 21-4DA10 3RA21 2@-4D@27-0AK6 0.761
2 5 7 1/2 10 20 -- 50 27… 32 21-4EA10 3RA21 2@-4E@27-0AK6 0.761

Order No. supplement for:


• Standard DIN rail or screw mounting with no additional auxiliaries 0 A
• Standard DIN rail or screw mounting with 1 SPDT NO/NC MSP auxiliary 5 A
(S00 frame contactor has 1NO auxiliary and S0 frame contactor has 1NO/1NC auxiliary)
• With Fast Bus adaptor and no additional auxiliaries 0 D
• With Fast Bus adaptor and 1 SPDT NO/NC MSP auxiliary 5 D
(S00 frame contactor has 1NO auxiliary and S0 frame contactor has 1NO/1NC auxiliary)

1) For auxiliary switches see Accessories page 4/44.


2) Selection depends on the motor full load amps.
HP ratings for reference only.
3) Used only for mounting starter on 8US Fast Bus busbar systems.

4/36 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Illustrations are approximate SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 6/13
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation

3RA2 Starters
Non-Reversing, AC and DC Coil — up to 100 A

Selection and ordering data


3RA21 30 Direct-on-line starting For 35 mm standard mounting rail or screw mounting
The motor starter protector and contactor are mechanically
and electrically connected by means of the link module.
Auxiliary switches1) on the motor starter protector and the
contactor can be easily fitted due to the modular system.
Integrated auxiliary switches:
- Contactor size S2: 1 NO & 1 NC
- Contactor size S3: 1 NO & 1 NC
Combination Starter, UL508 Type F
Size S2 devices can be applied as Combination Starters.
For versions of 50A or higher, the addition of a 3RV2938-1K
line side phase barrier is required.
Size S3 devices can be applied as Combination Starters with the
addition of a 3RT2946-4GA07 line side terminal kit

SCCR FLA setting Starter Size Consisting of the following individual devices
at range
480Y/ Inverse-time Order No.

4
277V delayed Motor starter + Contactor + Link module
overload protector +
kA release
Single-Phase HP Three-Phase2)

STARTERS
COMBINATION
Adapter for standard
Ratings HP ratings
mounting rail3)
115V 230V 200V 230V 460V 575V A
110VAC 50Hz / 120VAC 60 Hz
3 7.5 10 15 30 40 65 22... 32 3RA21 3@-4EA35-@AK6 S2 3RV20 31-4EA10 3RT2035-1AK60
3 10 15 15 40 50 65 28... 36 3RA21 3@-4PA36-@AK6 3RV20 31-4PA10
3 10 15 15 40 50 65 32... 40 3RA21 3@-4UA36-@AK6 3RV20 31-4UA10 3RT2036-1AK60 3RA2931-1AA00
3 10 15 15 40 50 65 35... 45 3RA21 3@-4VA36-@AK6 3RV20 31-4VA10 +
5 10 20 20 50 50 65 42... 52 3RA21 3@-4WA37-@AK6 3RV20 31-4WA10 3RT2037-1AK60 3RA2932-1AA00
(must be ordered
5 15 20 25 50 60 20 49... 59 3RA21 3@-4XA38- @AK6 3RV20 31-4XA10
3RT2038-1AK60 separately)
5 15 20 25 50 60 20 54... 65 3RA21 3@-4JA38- @AK6 3RV20 31-4JA10
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 65 28... 40 3RA21 4@-4FB45-@AK6 S3 3RV20 41-4FA10
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 65 36... 50 3RA21 4@-4HB45-@AK6 3RV20 41-4HA10 3RT2045-1AK60
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 65 45... 63 3RA21 4@-4JB45-@AK6 3RV20 41-4JA10
3RA1941-1AA00
10 20 30 30 75 75 65 57... 75 3RA21 4@-4KB46-@AK6 3RV20 41-4KA10
+
10 20 30 30 75 75 65 65... 84 3RA21 4@-4RB46-@AK6 3RV20 41-4RA10 3RT2046-1AK60 3RA2942-1AA00
10 20 30 30 75 – 65 75... 93 3RA21 4@-4YB46-@AK6 3RV20 41-4YA10
10 20 30 40 75 – 65 80...100 3RA21 4@-4MB47-@AK6 3RV20 41-4MA10 3RT2047-1AK60

24V UC
3 7.5 10 15 30 40 65 22... 32 3RA21 3 -4EA35-@NB3 S2 3RV20 31-4EA10 3RT2035-1NB30
3 10 15 15 40 50 65 28... 36 3RA21 3@-4PA36-@NB3 3RV20 31-4PA10
3 10 15 15 40 50 65 32... 40 3RA21 3@-4UA36-@NB3 3RV20 31-4UA10 3RT2036-1NB30
3 10 15 15 40 50 65 35... 45 3RA21 3@-4VA36-@NB3 3RV20 31-4VA10 3RA2931-1AA00
+
5 10 20 20 50 50 65 42... 52 3RA21 3@-4WA37-@NB3 3RV20 31-4WA10 3RT2037-1NB30 3RA2932-1AA00
5 15 20 25 50 60 20 49... 59 3RA21 3@-4XA38- @NB3 3RV20 31-4XA10 (must be ordered
3RT2038-1NB30
5 15 20 25 50 60 20 54... 65 3RA21 3@-4JA38- @NB3 3RV20 31-4JA10 separately)
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 65 28... 40 3RA21 4@-4FB45-@NB3 S3 3RV20 41-4FA10
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 65 36... 50 3RA21 4@-4HB45-@NB3 3RV20 41-4HA10 3RT2045-1NB30
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 65 45... 63 3RA21 4@-4JB45- @NB3 3RV20 41-4JA10
10 20 30 30 75 75 65 57... 75 3RA21 4@-4KB46-@NB3 3RV20 41-4KA10 3RA1941-1BA00
+
10 20 30 30 75 75 65 65... 84 3RA21 4@-4RB46-@NB3 3RV20 41-4RA10 3RT2046-1NB30
3RA2942-1AA00
10 20 30 30 75 – 65 70... 90 3RA21 4@-4YB46-@NB3 3RV20 41-4YA10
10 20 30 40 75 – 65 80...100 3RA21 4@-4MB47-@NB3 3RV20 41-4MA10 3RT2047-1NB30

Order No. supplement for:


• Standard DIN rail or screw mounting with no additional auxiliaries 0 0
• Standard DIN rail or screw mounting with 1 SPDT NO/NC MSP auxiliary
(S2 frame contactor has 1NO/1NC integrated auxiliary) 5 0 (S2)
(S3 frame contactor has 1NO top mounted auxiliary) 5 1 (S3)

1) For auxilary switches, see accessories page 4/44. Note:


2) Selection depends on motor full load amps. In the S2 frame, for 100kA SCCR versions, replace the prefix 3RA213x with
Horsepower ratings for reference only. 3RA215x. Rating exceptions would be the 59A and 65A versions having a
3)1)Adapters forswitches,
For auxilary standardsee
mounting rail are
accessories pageincluded for alldepends
2) Selection S3 starters and full load30kA
on motor
SCCR at 480Y/277V. For UL 508 type E/F, order 3RV2938-1K Phase
amps. Horse-
optional
4/50. to be ordered as accessories for S2 non-reversing starters.
power ratings for reference only. Barrier for field installation on all versions.
3) Adapters for standard mounting rail are also suitable
for screw mounting.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/37
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation
3RA2 Starters SIRIUS 3RA2 Motor Starters
Non-Reversing, DC Coil — up to 22 A 3RA21 direct-on-line starters
24 V DC

Direct-on-line
Rated control supply voltage 24 V DC
starting With screw connections
• The motor starter protector and contactor are mechanically
and electrically connected by means of the link module.
• Auxiliary switches1) on the motor starter protector and the con-
tactor can be easily fitted due to the modular system.
• Integrated auxiliary switches:
- Contactor size S00: 1 NO;
- Contactor size S0: 1 NO + 1 NC
Combination Starter, UL508 Type F
All size S00 and S0 devices can be applied as Combination
3RA21 20 3RA21 10 3RA21 20
Starters with the addition of either of these line side connectors:
3RA21 10
3RV29 28-1H, 3RV29 25-5EB or 3RV29 28-1K.
Size UL Data FLA setting Consisting of the following Assembled starter Weight
range inverse- single devices approx.
Single-phase Three-phase2) SCCR time delayed Motor + Contactor + Link Screw terminals
HP ratings HP ratings at overload starter module
480 V release protector + Busbar
115 V 230 V 200 V 230 V 460 V 575 V adapter3) Order No.
kA A kg
Selection depends on motor full load amps
4

3RV20 3RT20 3RA


S00 -- -- -- -- -- -- 65 0.11…0.16 11-0AA10 15-1BB41 1921-1DA00 3RA21 1@-0A@15-1BB4 0.630
COMBINATION
STARTERS

-- -- -- -- -- -- 65 0.14…0.2 11-0BA10 + 8US1251- 3RA21 1@-0B@15-1BB4 0.630


-- -- -- -- -- -- 65 0.18…0.25 11-0CA10 5DS10 3RA21 1@-0C@15-1BB4 0.630
-- -- -- -- -- -- 65 0.22…0.32 11-0DA10 3RA21 1@-0D@15-1BB4 0.630
-- -- -- -- -- -- 65 0.28…0.4 11-0EA10 3RA21 1@-0E@15-1BB4 0.630
-- -- -- -- -- -- 65 0.35…0.5 11-0FA10 3RA21 1@-0F@15-1BB4 0.630
-- -- -- -- -- -- 65 0.45…0.63 11-0GA10 3RA21 1@-0G@15-1BB4 0.630
-- -- -- -- -- -- 65 0.55…0.8 11-0HA10 3RA21 1@-0H@15-1BB4 0.630
-- -- -- -- -- 1/2 65 0.7… 1 11-0JA10 3RA21 1@-0J@15-1BB4 0.630
-- -- -- -- 1/2 1/2 65 0.9… 1.25 11-0KA10 3RA21 1@-0K@15-1BB4 0.630
-- 1/10 -- -- 3/4 3/4 65 1.1… 1.6 11-1AA10 3RA21 1@-1A@15-1BB4 0.630
-- 1/8 -- -- 3/4 1 65 1.4… 2 11-1BA10 3RA21 1@-1B@15-1BB4 0.630
-- 1/6 1/2 1/2 1 1 1/2 65 1.8… 2.5 11-1CA10 3RA21 1@-1C@15-1BB4 0.630
1/10 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1/2 2 65 2.2… 3.2 11-1DA10 3RA21 1@-1D@15-1BB4 0.630
1/8 1/3 3/4 3/4 2 3 65 2.8… 4 11-1EA10 3RA21 1@-1E@15-1BB4 0.630
1/6 1/2 1 1 3 3 65 3.5… 5 11-1FA10 3RA21 1@-1F@15-1BB4 0.630
1/4 1/2 1 1 1/2 3 5 65 4.5… 6.3 11-1GA10 3RA21 1@-1G@15-1BB4 0.630
1/3 1 2 2 5 5 65 5.5… 8 11-1HA10 16-1BB41 3RA21 1@-1H@16-1BB4 0.630

6
1/2 1 1/2 2 3 5 7 1/2 65 7… 10 11-1JA10 3RA21 1@-1J@16-1BB4 0.630
1/2 2 3 3 7 1/2 10 65 9… 12 11-1KA10 17-1BB41 3RA21 1@-1K@17-1BB4 0.630
1 2 3 5 10 -- 65 11…16 11-4AA10 18-1BB41 3RA21 1@-4A@18-1BB4 0.630
S0 1/6 1/2 1 1 3 3 65 3.5… 5 11-1FA10 24-1BB40 2921-1BA00 3RA21 2@-1F@24-0BB4 0.948
1/4 1/2 1 1 1/2 3 5 65 4.5… 6.3 11-1GA10 + 8US1251- 3RA21 2@-1G@24-0BB4 0.948
1/3 1 2 2 5 5 65 5.5… 8 11-1HA10 5NT10 3RA21 2@-1H@24-0BB4 0.948
1/2 1 1/2 2 3 5 7 1/2 65 7… 10 11-1JA10 3RA21 2@-1J@24-0BB4 0.948
1/2 2 3 3 7 1/2 10 65 9… 12.5 11-1KA10 3RA21 2@-1K@24-0BB4 0.948
1 2 3 5 10 -- 65 11… 16 21-4AA10 26-1BB40 3RA21 2@-4A@26-0BB4 0.948
1 1/2 3 5 5 10 -- 65 14… 20 21-4BA10 3RA21 2@-4B@26-0BB4 0.948
1 1/2 3 5 7 1/2 15 -- 50 17… 22 21-4CA10 27-1BB40 3RA21 2@-4C@27-0BB4 0.948
2 3 5 7 1/2 15 -- 50 20… 25 21-4DA10 3RA21 2@-4D@27-0BB4 0.948
2 5 7 1/2 10 20 -- 50 27… 32 21-4EA10 3RA21 2@-4E@27-0BB4 0.948

Order No. supplement for:


• Standard DIN rail or screw mounting with no additional auxiliaries 0 A
• Standard DIN rail or screw mounting with 1 SPDT NO/NC MSP auxiliary 5 A
(S00 frame contactor has 1NO auxiliary and S0 frame contactor has 1NO/1NC auxiliary)
• With Fast Bus adaptor and no additional auxiliaries 0 D
• With Fast Bus adaptor and 1 SPDT NO/NC MSP auxiliary 5 D
(S00 frame contactor has 1NO auxiliary and S0 frame contactor has 1NO/1NC auxiliary)

1) For auxiliary switches, see Accessories page 4/44.


2) Selection depends on the concrete motor full load amps.
HP ratings for reference only.
3) Use only for mounting starter on 8US Fast Bus busbar systems.

4/38 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Illustrations are approximate SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 6/15
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation

3RA2 Starters
Non-Reversing Fast Bus® — AC and DC Coil

Selection and ordering data


Direct-on-line starting For 60mm Fast Bus busbar systems
The motor starter protector and contactor are mechanically
and electrically connected by means of the link module.
Auxiliary switches1) on the motor starter protector and the
contactor can be easily fitted due to the modular system.
Integrated auxiliary switches:
- Contactor size S2: 1 NO & 1 NC
- Contactor size S3: 1 NO & 1 NC
Combination Starter, UL508 Type F
Size S2 devices can be applied as Combination Starters.
For versions of 50A or higher, the addition of a 3RV2938-1K
line side phase barrier is required.
Size S3 devices can be applied as Combination Starters with the
addition of a 3RT1946-4GA07 line side terminal kit

SCCR FLA setting Starter Size Consisting of the following individual devices
at range
480Y/ Inverse-time Order No.

4
277V delayed Motor starter + Contactor + Link module
overload protector +
kA release
Single-Phase Three-Phase2)

STARTERS
COMBINATION
HP Ratings HP ratings Adapter for standard
mounting rail3)
115V 230V 200V 230V 460V 575V A
110VAC 50Hz / 120 VAC 60Hz
3 7.5 10 15 30 40 65 22... 32 3RA21 3@-4ED35-@AK6 S2 3RV20 31-4EA10 3RT2035-1AK60
3 10 15 15 40 50 65 28... 36 3RA21 3@-4PD36- @AK6 3RV20 31-4PA10
3 10 15 15 40 50 65 32... 40 3RA21 3@-4UD36-@AK6 3RV20 31-4UA10 3RT2036-1AK60 3RA2931-1AA00
3 10 15 15 40 50 65 35... 45 3RA21 3@-4VD36-@AK6 3RV20 31-4VA10 +
5 10 20 20 50 50 65 42... 52 3RA21 3@-4WD37-@AK6 3RV20 31-4WA10 3RT2037-1AK60 8US1261-6MT10
5 15 20 25 50 60 20 49... 59 3RA21 3@-4XD38- @AK6 3RV20 31-4XA10
3RT2038-1AK60
5 15 20 25 50 60 20 54... 65 3RA21 3@-4JD38- @AK6 3RV20 31-4JA10
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 65 28... 40 3RA21 4@-4FD45-@ AK6 S3 3RV20 41-4FA10
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 65 36... 50 3RA21 4@-4HD45-@AK6 3RV20 41-4HA10 3RT2045-1AK60
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 65 45... 63 3RA21 4@-4JD45-@AK6 3RV20 41-4JA10 3RA1941-1AA00
10 20 30 30 75 75 3RA21 4@-4KD46-@AK6 3RV20 41-4KA10 +
65 57... 75
8US1211-4TR00
10 20 30 30 75 75 65 65... 84 3RA21 4@-4RD46-@AK6 3RV20 41-4RA10 3RT2046-1AK60
10 20 30 30 75 – 65 75... 93 3RA21 4@-4YD46-@AK6 3RV20 41-4YA10
10 20 30 40 75 – 65 80...100 3RA21 4@-4MD47-@AK6 3RV20 41-4MA10 3RT2047-1AK60

24V UC
3 7.5 10 15 30 40 65 22... 32 3RA21 3@-4ED35-@NB3 S2 3RV20 31-4EA10 3RT2035-1NB30
3 10 15 15 40 50 65 28... 36 3RA21 3@-4PD36-@NB3 3RV20 31-4PA10
3 10 15 15 40 50 65 32... 40 3RA21 3@-4UD36-@NB3 3RV20 31-4UA10 3RT2036-1NB30 3RA2931-1AA00
3 10 15 15 40 50 65 35... 45 3RA21 3@-4VD36-@NB3 3RV20 31-4VA10 +
5 10 20 20 50 50 65 42... 52 3RA21 3@-4WD37-@NB3 3RV20 31-4WA10 3RT2037-1NB30 8US1261-6MT10
5 15 20 25 50 60 20 49... 59 3RA21 3@-4XD38- @NB3 3RV20 31-4XA10
3RT2038-1NB30
5 15 20 25 50 60 20 54... 65 3RA21 3@-4JD38-@NB3 3RV20 31-4JA10
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 65 28... 40 3RA21 4@-4FD45-@NB3 S3 3RV20 41-4FA10
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 65 36... 50 3RA21 4@-4HD45-@NB3 3RV20 41-4HA10 3RT2045-1NB30
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 65 45... 63 3RA21 4@-4JD45-@NB3 3RV20 41-4JA10 3RA1941-1BA00
10 20 30 30 75 75 65 57... 75 3RA21 4@-4KD46-@NB3 3RV20 41-4KA10 +
10 20 30 30 75 75 65 65... 84 3RA21 4@-4RD46-@NB3 3RV20 41-4RA10 3RT2046-1NB30 8US1211-4TR00
10 20 30 30 75 – 65 75... 93 3RA21 4@-4YD46-@NB3 3RV20 41-4YA10
10 20 30 40 75 – 65 80...100 3RA21 4@-4MD47-@NB3 3RV20 41-4MA10 3RT2047-1NB30

Order No. supplement for:


• Standard DIN rail or screw mounting with no additional auxiliaries 0 0
• Standard DIN rail or screw mounting with 1 SPDT NO/NC MSP auxiliary
(S2 frame contactor has 1NO/1NC integrated auxiliary) 5 0 (S2)
(S3 frame contactor has 1NO top mounted auxiliary) 5 1 (S3)

1) For auxiliary switches, see Accessories page 4/44. Note:


2) Selection depends on motor full load amps. In the S2 frame, for 100kA SCCR versions, replace the prefix 3RA213x with
Horsepower ratings for reference only. 3RA215x. Rating exceptions would be the 59A and 65A versions having a
30kA SCCR at 480Y/277V. For UL 508 type E/F, order 3RV2938-1K Phase
Barrier for field installation on all versions.
1) For auxiliary switches, see accessories page 4/50.
2) Selection depends on motor full load amps. Horse-
power ratings for reference only.
Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/39
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation

3RA2 Starters SIRIUS 3RA2 Motor Starters


3RA22 reversing starters
Reversing, AC Coil — up to 22 A
50/60 Hz 110/120 V AC

Selection and ordering data


Reversing duty Rated control supply voltage 50/60 Hz 110/120 V AC
With screw connections
• The motor starter protector and contactor are mechan-
ically and electrically connected by means of the link
module.
• Auxiliary switches1) on the motor starter protector and
the contactor can be easily fitted due to the modular
system.
• With the contactor S0, an integrated NO contact is
available for free use.
Combination Starter, UL508 Type F
3RA22 10 3RA22 20 3RA22 10 3RA22 20 All size S00 and S0 devices can be applied as Combina-
tion Starters with the addition of either of these line side
connectors: 3RV29 28-1H, 3RV29 25-5EB or
3RV29 28-1K.
Size UL Data FLA setting Consisting of the following single devices Assembled starter Weight
range inverse- approx.
Single-phase Three-phase2) SCCR time delayed Motor starter + 2 contac- + Link module Screw terminals
HP ratings HP ratings at overload protector tors + Assembly kit
4

480 V release RH/RS3)


115 V 230 V 200 V 230 V 460 V 575 V Order No.
kA A kg
COMBINATION
STARTERS

Selection depends on motor full load amps


3RV20 3RT20 3RA
S00 -- -- -- -- -- -- 65 0.11…0.16 11-0AA10 15-1AK62 1921-1DA00 3RA22 10-0A @15-2AK6 0.824
-- -- -- -- -- -- 65 0.14…0.2 11-0BA10 + 2913-2AA14) 3RA22 10-0B @15-2AK6 0.824
-- -- -- -- -- -- 65 0.18…0.25 11-0CA10 + 2913-1DB1 (RS) 3RA22 10-0C @15-2AK6 0.824
-- -- -- -- -- -- 65 0.22…0.32 11-0DA10 3RA22 10-0D @15-2AK6 0.824
-- -- -- -- -- -- 65 0.28…0.4 11-0EA10 3RA22 10-0E @15-2AK6 0.824
-- -- -- -- -- -- 65 0.35…0.5 11-0FA10 3RA22 10-0F @15-2AK6 0.824
-- -- -- -- -- -- 65 0.45…0.63 11-0GA10 3RA22 10-0G @15-2AK6 0.824
-- -- -- -- -- -- 65 0.55…0.8 11-0HA10 3RA22 10-0H @15-2AK6 0.824
-- -- -- -- -- 1/2 65 0.7… 1 11-0JA10 3RA22 10-0J @15-2AK6 0.824
-- -- -- -- 1/2 1/2 65 0.9… 1.25 11-0KA10 3RA22 10-0K @15-2AK6 0.824
-- 1/10 -- -- 3/4 3/4 65 1.1… 1.6 11-1AA10 3RA22 10-1A @15-2AK6 0.824
-- 1/8 -- -- 3/4 1 65 1.4… 2 11-1BA10 3RA22 10-1B @15-2AK6 0.824
-- 1/6 1/2 1/2 1 1 1/2 65 1.8… 2.5 11-1CA10 3RA22 10-1C @15-2AK6 0.824
1/10 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1/2 2 65 2.2… 3.2 11-1DA10 3RA22 10-1D @15-2AK6 0.824

6
1/8 1/3 3/4 3/4 2 3 65 2.8… 4 11-1EA10 3RA22 10-1E @15-2AK6 0.824
1/6 1/2 1 1 3 3 65 3.5… 5 11-1FA10 3RA22 10-1F @15-2AK6 0.824
1/4 1/2 1 1 1/2 3 5 65 4.5… 6.3 11-1GA10 3RA22 10-1G @15-2AK6 0.824
1/3 1 2 2 5 5 65 5.5… 8 11-1HA10 16-1AK62 3RA22 10-1H @16-2AK6 0.824
1/2 1 1/2 2 3 5 7 1/2 65 7… 10 11-1JA10 3RA22 10-1J @16-2AK6 0.824
1/2 2 3 3 7 1/2 10 65 9… 12 11-1KA10 17-1AK62 3RA22 10-1K @17-2AK6 0.824
1 2 3 5 10 -- 65 11…16 11-4AA10 18-1AK62 3RA22 10-4A @18-2AK6 0.824
S0 1/6 1/2 1 1 3 3 65 3.5… 5 11-1FA10 24-1AK60 2921-1AA00 3RA22 20-1F @24-0AK6 1.434
1/4 1/2 1 1 1/2 3 5 65 4.5… 6.3 11-1GA10 + 2923-1BB1 (RH) 3RA22 20-1G @24-0AK6 1.434
1/3 1 2 2 5 5 65 5.5… 8 11-1HA10 + 2923-1DB1 (RS) 3RA22 20-1H @24-0AK6 1.434
1/2 1 1/2 2 3 5 7 1/2 65 7… 10 11-1JA10 3RA22 20-1J @24-0AK6 1.434
1/2 2 3 3 7 1/2 10 65 9… 12.5 11-1KA10 3RA22 20-1K @24-0AK6 1.434
1 2 3 5 10 -- 65 11… 16 21-4AA10 26-1AK60 3RA22 20-4A @26-0AK6 1.434
1 1/2 3 5 5 10 -- 65 14… 20 21-4BA10 3RA22 20-4B @26-0AK6 1.434
1 1/2 3 5 7 1/2 15 -- 50 17… 22 21-4CA10 27-1AK60 3RA22 20-4C @27-0AK6 1.434
2 3 5 7 1/2 15 -- 50 20… 25 21-4DA10 3RA22 20-4D @27-0AK6 1.434
2 5 7 1/2 10 20 -- 50 27… 32 21-4EA10 3RA22 20-4E @27-0AK6 1.434
Add. weight
Order No. supplement for mounting onto standard mounting rail or screw fixing
• Without standard mounting rail adapter for size S004) 1 A
• With 2 standard mounting rail adapters for size S0 2 B
Screw fixing with 2 push-in lugs each per motor starter is possible
Order No. supplement for mounting onto Fastbus 60mm busbar system for size S00 1 D 0.486
With 8US Fast Bus busbar adapter for size S0 2 D 0.293

1) For push-in lugs and auxiliary switches, see Accessories on pages 4/44 and 4/52.
2) Selection depends on the motor full load amps. HP ratings for reference only.
3) According to ordering option:
RH = assembly kit for reversing duty with standard rail mounting adapter in size S0.
RS = assembly kit for reversing duty with 8US Fast Bus busbar mounting.
4) With standard rail mounting or screw fixing, the 3RA29 13-2AA1
wiring kit is required for size S00.

4/40 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Illustrations are approximate SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 6/17
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation

3RA2 Starter
Reversing, AC Coil — up to 100 A

Selection and ordering data


3RA12 40 Reversing duty For 35 mm standard mounting rail or screw mounting
All starters are suitable for use in Group Installation applications
per NEC 430-53 (c)
Motor starter protector and contactor are linked electrically and
mechanically by means of a link module and adapter plate
Starter includes both electrical and mechanical interlocks
Auxiliary switches 1) can be added easily to the MSP and the con-
tactor
Combination Starter, UL508 Type F
Size S2 devices can be applied as Combination Starters.
For versions of 50A or higher, the addition of a 3RV2938-1K
line side phase barrier is required.
Size S3 devices can be applied as Combination Starters with the
addition of a 3RT1946-4GA07 line side terminal kit
SCCR: 65kA at 480V

FLA set- Starter Size Consisting of the following individual devices


ting range Order No.
Inverse-

4
time Motor starter + 2 Contactors + Link module
delayed protector +
overload assembly kit RH3)

STARTERS
COMBINATION
Single-Phase Three-Phase2)
HP Ratings HP ratings
115V 230V 200V 230V 460V 575V A
110VAC 50Hz / 120VAC 60Hz
3 7.5 10 15 30 40 22 ... 32 S2 3RV20 31-4EA10 3RT2035-1AK60
3 10 15 15 40 50 28 ... 36 3RV20 31-4PA10
3 10 15 15 40 50 32 ... 40 For customer 3RV20 31-4UA10 3RT2036-1AK60 3RA2931-1AA00
3 10 15 15 40 50 35 ... 45 assembly 3RV20 31-4VA10 +
3RV20 31-4WA10 3RT2037-1AK60 3RA2933-1BB1
5 10 20 20 50 50 42 ... 52
5 15 20 25 50 60 49 ... 59 3RV20 31-4XA10
3RT2038-1AK60
5 15 20 25 50 60 54 ... 65 3RV20 31-4JA10
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 28 ... 40 S3 3RV20 41-4FA10
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 36 ... 50 3RV20 41-4HA10 3RT2045-1AK60
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 45 ... 63 For customer 3RV20 41-4JA10 3RA1941-1AA00
10 20 30 30 75 75 57 ... 75 assembly 3RV20 41-4KA10 +
3RA1943-1B4)
10 20 30 30 75 75 65 ... 84 3RV20 41-4RA10 3RT2046-1AK60
10 20 30 30 75 – 75 ... 93 3RV20 41-4YA10
10 20 30 40 75 – 80 ...100 3RV20 41-4MA10 3RT2047-1AK60

24VDC
3 7.5 10 15 30 40 22... 32 S2 3RV20 31-4EA10 3RT2035-1NB30
3 10 15 15 40 50 28... 36 3RV20 31-4PA10
3 10 15 15 40 50 32... 40 For customer 3RV20 31-4UA10 3RT2036-1NB30 3RA2931-1AA00
3 10 15 15 40 50 35... 45 assembly 3RV20 31-4VA10 +
5 10 20 20 50 50 42... 52 3RV20 31-4WA10 3RA2933-1BB1
3RT2037-1NB30
5 15 20 25 50 60 49... 59 3RV20 31-4XA10
3RT2038-1NB30
5 15 20 25 50 60 54... 65 3RV20 31-4JA10
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 28 ... 40 S3 3RV20 41-4FA10
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 36 ... 50 3RV20 41-4HA10 3RT2045-1NB30
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 45 ... 63 For customer 3RV20 41-4JA10 3RA1941-1BA00
assembly +
10 20 30 30 75 75 57 ... 75 3RV20 41-4KA10
3RA1943-1B4)
10 20 30 30 75 75 65 ... 84 3RV20 41-4RA10 3RT2046-1NB30
10 20 30 30 75 – 75 ... 93 3RV20 41-4YA10
10 20 30 40 75 – 80 ...100 3RV20 41-4MA10 3RT2047-1NB30

RH = Reversing duty for rail mounting.


1) For auxiliary switches, see Accessories page 4/44.
2) Selection depends on motor full load amps. Horse power ratings for reference only.
RH = Reversing duty for rail mounting.
3)
1) Adapters forswitches,
For auxiliary standardsee
mounting rail are
accessories pagealso suitable
4/44. for screw
3) Adapters mounting.
for standard mounting rail are also suitable for
4)
2) Mechanical interlock
Selection depends mustfull
on motor beload
ordered
amps.separately;
Horse screw mounting. page 4/50
see Accessories
power ratings for reference only. 4) Mechanical interlock must be ordered separately; see
accessories page 4/50.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/41
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation

3RA2 Starter SIRIUS 3RA2 Motor Starters


Reversing, DC Coil — up to 22 A
3RA22 reversing starters
24 V DC

Reversing duty Rated control supply voltage 24 V DC


With screw connections
• The motor starter protector and contactor are mechan-
ically and electrically connected by means of the link
module.
• Auxiliary switches1) on the motor starter protector and
the contactor can be easily fitted due to the modular
system.
• With the contactor S0, an integrated NO contact is
available for free use.
Combination Starter, UL508 Type F
3RA22 10 3RA22 20 3RA22 10 3RA22 20 All size S00 and S0 devices can be applied as Combina-
tion Starters with the addition of either of these line side
connectors: 3RV29 28-1H, 3RV29 25-5EB or
3RV29 28-1K.
Size UL Data FLA setting Consisting of the following single devices Assembled starter Weight
range inverse- approx.
Single-phase Three-phase 2)
SCCR time delayed Motor starter + 2 contac- + Link module Screw terminals
HP ratings HP ratings at overload protector tors + Assembly kit
480 V release RH/RS3)
115 V 230 V 200 V 230 V 460 V 575 V Order No.
4

kA A kg
Selection depends on motor full load amps
COMBINATION
STARTERS

3RV20 3RT20 3RA


S00 -- -- -- -- -- -- 65 0.11…0.16 11-0AA10 15-1BB42 1921-1DA00 '+ 3RA22 10-0A@15-2BB4 0.934
-- -- -- -- -- -- 65 0.14…0.2 11-0BA10 2913-2AA14) '+ 3RA22 10-0B@15-2BB4 0.934
-- -- -- -- -- -- 65 0.18…0.25 11-0CA10 2913-1DB1 (RS) 3RA22 10-0C@15-2BB4 0.934
-- -- -- -- -- -- 65 0.22…0.32 11-0DA10 3RA22 10-0D@15-1BB4 0.934
-- -- -- -- -- -- 65 0.28…0.4 11-0EA10 3RA22 10-0E@15-2BB4 0.934
-- -- -- -- -- -- 65 0.35…0.5 11-0FA10 3RA22 10-0F@15-1BB4 0.934
-- -- -- -- -- -- 65 0.45…0.63 11-0GA10 3RA22 10-0G@15-2BB4 0.934
-- -- -- -- -- -- 65 0.55…0.8 11-0HA10 3RA22 10-0H@15-2BB4 0.934
-- -- -- -- -- 1/2 65 0.7… 1 11-0JA10 3RA22 10-0J@15-2BB4 0.934
-- -- -- -- 1/2 1/2 65 0.9… 1.25 11-0KA10 3RA22 10-0K@15-2BB4 0.934
-- 1/10 -- -- 3/4 3/4 65 1.1… 1.6 11-1AA10 3RA22 10-1A@15-2BB4 0.934
-- 1/8 -- -- 3/4 1 65 1.4… 2 11-1BA10 3RA22 10-1B@15-2BB4 0.934
-- 1/6 1/2 1/2 1 1 1/2 65 1.8… 2.5 11-1CA10 3RA22 10-1C@15-2BB4 0.934
1/10 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1/2 2 65 2.2… 3.2 11-1DA10 3RA22 10-1D@15-2BB4 0.934
1/8 1/3 3/4 3/4 2 3 65 2.8… 4 11-1EA10 3RA22 10-1E@15-2BB4 0.934
1/6 1/2 1 1 3 3 65 3.5… 5 11-1FA10 3RA22 10-1F@15-2BB4 0.934

6
1/4 1/2 1 1 1/2 3 5 65 4.5… 6.3 11-1GA10 3RA22 10-1G@15-2BB4 0.934
1/3 1 2 2 5 5 65 5.5… 8 11-1HA10 16-1BB42 3RA22 10-1H@16-2BB4 0.934
1/2 1 1/2 2 3 5 7 1/2 65 7… 10 11-1JA10 3RA22 10-1J@16-2BB4 0.934
1/2 2 3 3 7 1/2 10 65 9… 12 11-1KA10 17-1BB42 3RA22 10-1K@17-2BB4 0.934
1 2 3 5 10 -- 65 11…16 11-4AA10 18-1BB42 3RA22 10-4A@18-2BB4 0.934
S0 1/6 1/2 1 1 3 3 65 3.5… 5 11-1FA10 24-1BB40 2921-1BA00 '+ 3RA22 20-1F@24-0BB4 1.811
1/4 1/2 1 1 1/2 3 5 65 4.5… 6.3 11-1GA10 2923-1BB1 (RH) '+ 3RA22 20-1G@24-0BB4 1.811
1/3 1 2 2 5 5 65 5.5… 8 11-1HA10 2923-1DB1 (RS) 3RA22 20-1H@24-0BB4 1.811
1/2 1 1/2 2 3 5 7 1/2 65 7… 10 11-1JA10 3RA22 20-1J@24-0BB4 1.811
1/2 2 3 3 7 1/2 10 65 9… 12.5 11-1KA10 3RA22 20-1K@24-0BB4 1.811
1 2 3 5 10 -- 65 11… 16 21-4AA10 26-1BB40 3RA22 20-4A@26-0BB4 1.811
1 1/2 3 5 5 10 -- 65 14… 20 21-4BA10 3RA22 20-4B@26-0BB4 1.811
1 1/2 3 5 7 1/2 15 -- 50 17… 22 21-4CA10 27-1BB40 3RA22 20-4C@27-0BB4 1.811
2 3 5 7 1/2 15 -- 50 20… 25 21-4DA10 3RA22 20-4D@27-0BB4 1.811
2 5 7 1/2 10 20 -- 50 27… 32 21-4EA10 3RA22 20-4E@27-0BB4 1.811
Add. weight
Order No. supplement for mounting onto standard mounting rail or screw fixing
• Without standard mounting rail adapter for size S004) 1 A
• With 2 standard mounting rail adapters for size S0 2 B
Screw fixing with 2 push-in lugs each per motor starter is possible
Order No. supplement for mounting onto Fastbus 60mm busbar system for size S00 1 D 0.486
With 8US Fast Bus busbar adapter for size S0 2 D 0.306

1) For push-in lugs and auxiliary switches, see Accessories on pages 4/44 and 4/52.
2) Selection depends on the motor full load amps. HP ratings for reference only.
3) Code for abbreviations:
RH = assembly kit for reversing duty with standard rail mounting adapter in size S0.
RS = assembly kit for reversing duty with 8US Fast Bus busbar mounting.
4) With standard rail mounting or screw fixing, the 3RA29 13-2AA1 wiring kit and link
module are required for size S00.

4/42 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Illustrations are approximate SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 6/19
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation

3RA2 Starter
Reversing Fast Bus®, AC and DC Coil — up to 100 A

Selection and ordering data


Reversing duty For 60 mm Fast Bus busbar systems
Representative image
of assembled starter
All starters are suitable for use in Group Installation applications
per NEC 430-53 (c)
Motor starter protector and contactor are linked electrically and
mechanically by means of a link module and mounted on a Fast-
bus Shoe
Starter includes both electrical and mechanical interlocks
Auxiliary switches 1) can be added easily to the MSP and the
contactor
Size S3 is kit form only - assembly required
Combination Starter, UL508 Type F
Size S2 devices can be applied as Combination Starters
Size S3 devices can be applied as Combination Starters with the
addition of a 3RT2946-4GA07 line side terminal kit
SCCR: 65kA at 480V

FLA setting Starter Size Consisting of the following individual devices

4
range Order No.
Inverse-time Motor starter + Contactor + Link module
delayed protector +
overload

STARTERS
COMBINATION
Adapter shoe for
release Fastbus
Single-Phase Three-Phase2)
HP Ratings HP ratings
115V 230V 200V 230V 460V 575V A
110VAC 50Hz / 120VAC 60Hz
3 7.5 10 15 30 40 22... 32 S2 3RV20 31-4EA10 3RT2035-1AK60
3 10 15 15 40 50 28... 36 3RV20 31-4PA10
3 10 15 15 40 50 32... 40 3RV20 31-4UA10 3RT2036-1AK60 3RA2931-1AA00
For customer
3 10 15 15 40 50 35... 45 3RV20 31-4VA10 +
assembly
5 10 20 20 50 50 42... 52 3RV20 31-4WA10 3RT2037-1AK60 3RA2933-1DB1
5 15 20 25 50 60 49... 59 3RV20 31-4XA10
3RT2038-1AK60
5 15 20 25 50 60 54... 65 3RV20 31-4JA10
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 28... 40 S3 3RV20 41-4FA10
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 36... 50 3RV20 41-4HA10 3RT2045-1AK60
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 32... 40 For customer 3RV20 41-4JA10 3RA1941-1AA00
10 20 30 30 75 75 57... 75 assembly 3RV20 41-4KA10 +
10 20 30 30 75 75 3RA1943-2A3)
42... 52 3RV20 41-4RA10 3RT2046-1AK60
10 20 30 30 75 – 75... 93 3RV20 41-4YA10
10 20 30 40 75 – 80...100 3RV20 41-4MA10 3RT2047-1AK60

24VDC
3 7.5 10 15 30 40 22... 32 S2 3RV20 31-4EA10 3RT2035-1NB30
3 10 15 15 40 50 28... 36 3RV20 31-4PA10
3 10 15 15 40 50 32... 40 3RV20 31-4UA10 3RT2036-1NB30 3RA2931-1AA00
For customer
3 10 15 15 40 50 35... 45 assembly 3RV20 31-4VA10 +
5 10 20 20 50 50 42... 52 3RV20 31-4WA10 3RT2037-1NB30 3RA2933-1DB1
5 15 20 25 50 60 49... 59 3RV20 31-4XA10
3RT2038-1NB30
5 15 20 25 50 60 54... 65 3RV20 31-4JA10
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 28... 40 S3 3RV20 41-4FA10
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 36... 50 3RV20 41-4HA10 3RT2045-1NB30
7.5 15 25 30 60 60 45... 63 For customer 3RV20 41-4JA10 3RA1941-1BA00
assembly 3RV20 41-4KA10 +
10 20 30 30 75 75 57... 75
3RA 1943-2A3)
10 20 30 30 75 75 65... 84 3RV20 41-4RA10 3RT2046-1NB30
10 20 30 30 75 – 75... 93 3RV20 41-4YA10
10 20 30 40 75 – 80...100 3RV20 41-4MA10 3RT2047-1NB30

RH = Reversing duty for rail mounting.


1) For auxiliary switches, see Accessories page 4/44.
2) Selection depends on motor full load amps. Horsepower ratings for reference only.
RH = Reversing duty for rail mounting.
3)1)Mechanical
For auxiliaryinterlock
switches,must be orderedpage
see accessories separately;
4/44. 3)see Accessories
Mechanical pagemust
interlock 4/50.
be ordered separately; see
2) Selection depends on motor full load amps. Horse- accessories page 4/50.
power ratings for reference only.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/43
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation

3RA2 Accessories
Auxiliary switches

Overview
The accessories listed here are parts and add-ons for the 3RA2 direct-on-line and reversing
starters as well as components for the customer assembly of motor starters

Selection and ordering data

3RV29 01-1E 3RV29 01-2E 3RV29 01-1A 3RV29 01-2A 3RV29 02-1A 3RV29 02-2D

For MSPs Screw Weight Spring-type Weight


Terminals approx. Terminals approx.
Size Order No. kg Order No. kg

Auxillary switches for motor starter protectors 1


4

Transverse auxillary switches


For front mounting
COMBINATION
STARTERS

1 CO S00 ... S3 3RV29 01-1D 0.014 —

1 NO + 1 NC S00 ... S3 3RV29 01-1E 0.016 3RV29 01-2E 0.016

Lateral auxillary switches


Mountable on the left
1 NO + 1 NC S00 ... S3 3RV29 01-1A 0.036 3RV29 01-2A 0.035

1 One transverse auxillary switch and one lateral auxillary switch can be attached per motor starter protector.
When the lateral auxillary switch with 2 NO + 2 NC is used, a transverse auxillary switch is not allowed.

Rated control supply voltage Us For Screw Weight Spring-type Weight


MSPs Terminals approx. Terminals approx.
AC AC AC 50/60 Hz AC/DC 50/60 Hz,
50 Hz 60 Hz 100% ON period 1 DC 5s ON period 2
V V V V Size Order No. kg Order No. kg

Auxillary releases for motor starter protectors 3


Undervoltage releases

415 480 — — S00 ... S3 3RV29 02-1AV1 0.117 —

Shunt releases

— — 20…24 20...70 S00 ... S3 3RV29 02-1DB0 0.119 3RV29 02-2DB0 0.115

— — 90…110 70...190 3RV29 02-1DF0 0.119 3RV29 02-2DF0 0.115

1 The voltage range is valid for 100% (infinite) ON period. The response voltage lies at 0.9 of the lower limit of the voltage range.
2 The voltage range is valid for 5s ON period at AC 50 Hz/60 Hz and DC. The response voltage lies at 0.85 of the lower limit of the voltage range.
3 One auxiliary release can be mounted on the right per motor starter protector
(does not apply to 3RV21 motor starter protectors with overload reset function).

4/44 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation

3RA2 Accessories
Auxiliary switches, terminals

Selection and ordering data


For Version Screw Weight Spring-type Weight
Conductors Terminals approx. Terminals approx.
Size Order No. kg Order No. kg
Auxillary switch blocks for snapping on the front for contactors
Cable entry from below S00 ... S3 1-pole 1 NC 3RH29 11-1BA10 0.020 —
S00 ... S3 1-pole 1 NO 3RH29 11-1BA01 0.020 —
S00 ... S3 2-pole 1 NO + 1 NC 3RH29 11-1MA11 0.050 —
S00 ... S3 2-pole 2 NO 3RH29 11-1MA20 0.050 —
3RH29 11-1BA10

3RH29 11-1MA20

Cable entry from two sides S00 ... S3 4-pole 2 NO + 2 NC 3RH29 11-1FA22 0.060 3RH29 11-2FA22 0.049

4
S00 2-pole 1 NO + 1 NC 3RH29 11-1DA11 0.039 3RH29 11-2DA11 0.050

STARTERS
COMBINATION
S00 2-pole 2 NC 3RH29 11-1DA02 0.039 3RH29 11-2DA02 0.050
S0 ... S3 2-pole 1 NO + 1 NC 3RH29 21-1DA11 0.039 3RH29 21-2DA11 0.050
S0 ... S3 2-pole 2 NC 3RH29 21-1DA02 0.041 3RH29 21-2DA02 0.050
3RH29 11-1FA22
S0 ... S3 2-pole 2 NO 3RH29 21-1DA20 0.041 3RH29 21-2DA20 0.050

Laterally mountable auxiliary switch blocks for contactors

S00 2 NC 3RH29 11-1DA02 0.020 3RH29 11-2DA02 0.050


S00 1 NO + 1 NC 3RH29 11-1DA11 0.040 3RH29 11-2DA11 0.050
S00 1 NO 3RH29 11-1DA20 0.040 3RH29 11-2DA20 0.050
S0 ... S3 2 NC 3RH29 21-1DA02 0.050 3RH29 21-2DA02 0.050
S0 ... S3 1 NO + 1 NC 3RH29 21-1DA11 0.050 3RH29 21-2DA11 0.050
3RH29 11-1DA11
S0 ... S3 2 NO 3RH29 21-1DA20 0.050 3RH29 21-2DA20 0.050

Connection modules for contactors with screw terminals


Adaptors for contactors Ambient temperature Tu max = 60 °C
S00 Rated operational current 3RT19 16-4RD01 0.020 —
Ie at AC-3/400 V: 20A
S0 Rated operational current 3RT19 26-4RD01 0.020 —
3RT19 26-4RD01 Ie at AC-3/400 V: 25A

Plugs for contactors S00, S0 3RT19 00-4RE01 0.025 —

3RT19 00-4RE01

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/45
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation

3RA2 Accessories
Terminals

Selection and ordering data


For Version Screw Weight
Conductors Terminals approx.
Size Order No. kg
Auxillary switch blocks for snapping on the front for contactors

Note: UL 508 demands for “Combination Motor Controller Type E” 1” air gaps and 2” creepage distances
at lineside. The following terminal blocks must be used in S3 MSP’s 3RV10. The S2 MSP 3RV10 conforms
with stipulated air gaps and creepage distances without terminal block.
Terminal blocks are not required for use according to CSA. With size S0 these terminal blocks cannot
be used in combination with 3-phase busbars 3RV19.5. This also applies to size S3 in combination with
3RV29 28-1H transverse auxiliary switches.

Terminal block type E S00, S0 3RV29 28-1H 0.120


for extended air/creepage distance (1” and 2”) S00, S0 3RV29 28-1K 0.120
S2 3RV29 38-1K 0.120
3RV29 28-1K S3 3RT29 46-4GA07 0.120
4 STARTERS
COMBINATION

3RT19 46-4GA07

4/46 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation

3RA2 Accessories
Surge suppressors

Selection and ordering data


For Version Surge Weight
Conductors Rated control supply voltage Us Suppressors approx.
Size AC V DC V Order No. kg
Auxillary switch blocks for snapping on the front for contactors

Size S00 — For plugging onto the front side of the contactors with and without auxiliary switch blocks

3RT2.1 Varistors 24 … 48 AC 24 … 70 DC 3RT29 16-1BB00 0.010


48 … 127 AC 70 … 150 DC 3RT29 16-1BC00 0.010
3RT2.1 RC elements 24 … 48 AC 24 … 70 DC 3RT29 16-1CB00 0.010
48 … 127 AC 70 … 150 DC 3RT29 16-1CC00 0.010
3RT2.1 Noise suppression 12 … 250 DC 3RT29 16-1DG00 0.010
3RT2.1 Diode assemblies 12 … 250 DC 3RT29 16-1EH00 0.010
3RT29 16-1EH00 (diode and Zener diode) for DC
operation and short break times
Size S0 — For plugging onto the front side of the contacctors (prior to mounting of the auxiliary switch block)

4
3RT2.2 Varistors 24 … 48 AC 24 … 70 DC 3RT29 26-1BB00 0.010
48 … 127 AC 70 … 150 DC 3RT29 26-1BC00 0.010
3RT2.2 RC elements 24 … 48 AC 24 … 70 DC 3RT29 26-1CB00 0.010

STARTERS
COMBINATION
48 … 127 AC 70 … 150 DC 3RT29 26-1CC00 0.010
3RT2.2 Diode assemblies 24 DC 3RT29 26-1ER00 0.010
3RT29 26-1BB00 for DC operation and short break times 30 … 250 DC 3RT29 26-1ES00 0.010
Sizes S2
3RT2.3 Varistors 24 ... 48 AC 24 ... 70 DC 3RT29 36-1BB00 0.010
127 ... 240 AC 150 ... 250 DC 3RT29 36-1BD00 0.010
48 ... 127 AC 70 ... 150 DC 3RT29 36-1BC00 0.010

3RT2.3 RC elements 24 ... 48 AC 24 ... 70 DC 3RT29 36-1CB00 0.010


3RT2936-1B.00
127 ... 240 AC 150 ... 250 DC 3RT29 36-1CD00 0.010
48 ... 127 AC 70 ... 150 DC 3RT29 36-1CC00 0.010

3RT2.3 Diode assemblies -- 24 DC 3RT29 36-1ER00 0.010


-- 30 ... 250 DC 3RT29 36-1ES00 0.010

3RT2936-1E.00

Sizes S3
3RT20 4. Varistors 24 … 48 AC 24 … 70 DC 3RT29 36-1BB00 0.025
48 … 127 AC 70 … 150 DC 3RT29 36-1BC00 0.025
3RT20 4. RC elements 24 … 48 AC 24 … 70 DC 3RT29 36-1CB00 0.040
48 … 127 AC 70 … 150 DC 3RT29 36-1CC00 0.040
3RT20 4. Diode assemblies 24 DC 3RT29 36-1ER00 0.025
for DC operation and short break times, 30 … 250 DC 3RT29 36-1ES00 0.025
3RT2936-1CC00
can be plugged in at bottom

For additional surge suppression, see page 2/75

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/47
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation

3RA2 Accessories
Surge suppressors, link modules

Selection and ordering data


For For Actuating voltage Screw Pack Weight
MSP contactors of contactor Terminals Qty. approx.
Size Order No. kg
Auxillary switch blocks for snapping on the front for contactors

Electrical and mechanical link between motor starter protector and contactor

Single-unit S00, S0 S00 AC and DC 3RA19 21-1DA00


packaging S00, S0 S0 AC 3RA29 21-1AA00 1 unit 0.055
S00, S0 S0 DC 3RA29 21-1BA00 1 unit 0.068
3RA29 11-2AA00
S2 S2 AC and DC 3RA29 31-1AA00 1 unit 0.104
S3 S3 AC and DC 3RA19 41-1AA00 1 unit 0.090
Multi-unit S00, S0 S00 AC and DC 3RA19 21-1D 10 unit 0.021
packaging S00, S0 S0 AC 3RA29 21-1A 10 unit 0.001
S00, S0 S0 DC 3RA29 21-1B 10 unit 0.001
S2 S2 AC and DC 3RA29 31-1A 5 unit 0.104
4

S3 S3 AC and DC 3RA19 41-1A 5 unit 0.073


COMBINATION
STARTERS

Spring-type
Terminals
Electrical and mechanical link between motor starter protector and contactor Order No.
Single-unit S00 S00 AC and DC 3RA29 11-2AA00
packaging S0 S0 AC 1) and DC 3RA29 21-2AA00 1 unit 0.040
3RA29 11-2AA00 Multi-unit S00 S00 AC and DC 3RA29 11-2A 10 unit 0.400
packaging S0 S0 AC 1) and DC 3RA29 21-2A 10 unit 0.770
Hybrid link modules from motor starter protector to contactor

For mechanical and electrical connection between motor starter protector with screw terminals and contactor with
spring-type terminals
Single-unit S00 S00 AC and DC 3RA29 11-2FA00 1 unit 0.029
packaging S0 S0 AC 1) and DC 3RA29 21-2FA00 1 unit 0.056
3RA29 11-2FA00 Multi-unit S00 S00 AC and DC 3RA29 11-2F 10 unit 0.290
packaging S0 S0 AC 1) and DC 3RA29 21-2F 10 unit 0.560

For For Screw Pack Weight


MSPs soft starters Terminals Qty. approx.
Size Size Order No. kg
Link modules from motor starter protector to soft starters

Electrical and mechanical link between motor starter protector and soft starter
Single-unit S00/S0 S00/S0 3RA29 21-1BA00 1 unit 0.001
packaging

Multi-unit S00/S0 S00/S0 3RA29 21-1B 10 unit 0.001


packaging

Spring-type
Terminals
Electrical and mechanical link between motor starter protector and soft starter Order No.
Single-unit S00 S00 3RA29 11-2GA00 1 unit 0.038
packaging
S0 S0 3RA29 21-2GA00 1 unit 0.072
3RA29 11-2GA00 Multi-unit S00 S00 3RA29 11-2G 10 unit 0.380
packaging
S0 S0 3RA29 21-2G 10 unit 0.720

1) A spacer for height compensation on AC contactors with spring-type terminals,


size S0 is optionally available, see page 4/52.

4/48 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation

3RA2 Accessories
Mounting kits for Fast Bus

Accessories
For Version Screw Pack Weight
Conductors Terminals Qty. approx.
Size Order No. kg
Wiring kits for contactors

Reversing
S00 Electrical and mechanical connection for reversing 3RA29 13-2AA1 1 unit 0.001
contactors, optionally with integrated electrical
S0 and mechanical interlock 3RA29 23-2AA1 1 unit 0.001
S2 The kit contains: 3RA29 33-2AA1 1 unit 0.120
3RA29 23-2AA1 2 connecting pins for 2 contactors,
wiring modules on the top and bottom
• for main and auxiliary circuits

Wye-delta starting
S00 Electrical and mechanical link for three contactors 3RA29 13-2BB1 1 unit 0.001
of same size
S0 3RA29 23-2BB1 1 unit 0.001

4
S2-S2-S0 3RA29 33-2C 1 unit 0.070
3RA29 23-2BB1
S2-S2-S2 29RA2933-2BB1 1 unit 0.160

STARTERS
COMBINATION
Spring-type
Terminals

Reversing Duty
S00 Electrical and mechanical connection for reversing 3RA29 13-2AA2 1 unit 0.001
contactors, optionally with integrated electrical
S0 3RA29 23-2AA2 1 unit 0.001
and mechanical interlock
S2 The kit contains: 3RA29 33-2AA2 1 unit 0.001
2 connecting pins for 2 contactors, wiring
3RA29 23-2AA2 modules on the top and bottom
• for main circuits only

Wye-delta starting
S00 Electrical and mechanical link for three 3RA29 13-2BB2 1 unit 0.001
S0 contactors of same size 3RA29 23-2BB2 1 unit 0.001
S2-S2-S0 3RA29 33-2C 1 unit 0.001
S2-S2-S2 3RA29 33-2BB2 1 unit 0.001

Screw
Terminals
Wiring kits for contactors

Reversing
S00 Switches 2 contactors in series 3RA29 16-1A 1 unit 0.001
S0 3RA29 26-1A 1 unit 0.001
S2 3RA29 36-1A 1 unit 0.001

3RA29 16-1A

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/49
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation

3RA2 Accessories
Mounting kits for Fast Bus

Accessories
For For Version Screw Pack Weight
Conductors MSPs Terminals Qty. approx.
Size Size Order No. kg

Mechanical interlocks
S2/S3 -- For reversing contactors, laterally mounted, 3RA29 34-2B 0.010
no electrical connections
(each contactor has 1NO/1NC auxiliaries)

3RA29 34-2B

Terminals for contactor coil


S3 -- For A1 and A2 of reversing contactors 3RA19 23-3B 0.020
(includes 2 x A1 and 1 x A2)
4 STARTERS
COMBINATION

3RA19 23-3B

Standard mounting rail adapters


For mechanical fixing of motor start protector and contactor; for snapping
onto standard mounting rail or for screw fixing.
S00, S0 S00, S0 Single-unit packaging 3RA29 22-1AA00 1 unit 0.001
S2 S2 3RA19 31-1AA00 1 unit 0.020
S3 S3 3RA19 41-1AA00 1 unit 0.250
S00, S0 S00, S0 Multi-unit packaging 3RA29 22-1A 5 units 0.001
3RA29 22-1AA00
Side modules for standard mounting rail adaptors
S00 ...S3 S00 ...S3 For standard mountin rail adaptors 10 mm wide, 3RA19 02-1B 10 units 0.009
96 mm long, for widening standard mounting rail
adaptors when using lateral auxiliary switches,
For size S00 to S2: 2 units required.
For size S3: 3 units required

3RA19 02-1B

RH assembly kits for reversing duty and standard rail mounting


RH assembly kits for screw terminals
S0 S0 Comprising: • Wiring kits 3RA29 23-1BB1 1 unit 0.001
• 2 standard mounting rail adaptors
S2 S2 • 2 connecting wedges 3RA29 33-1BB1 1 unit 0.560
S3 S3 Link modules may be ordered seperately. 3RA29 43-1BB1 1 unit 0.810
Spring-type
RH assembly kits for spring-type terminals Terminals
S0 S0 Comprising: • Wiring kits 3RA29 23-1BB2 1 unit 0.001
• 2 standard mounting rail adaptors
• 2 connecting wedges
3RA29 23-1BB1 • Spacers
Link modules may be ordered seperately.

4/50 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation

3RA2 Accessories SIRIUS 3RA2 Motor Starters


Busbar adapters
Accessories

For For Version Order No. Std. Weight


motor contactors pack approx.
starter pro- qty.
tector
Size Size kg
Busbar adapters for 60 mm systems
For flat copper profiles according to DIN 46433
Width: 12 mm and 30 mm Thickness: 5 mm and 10 mm
also for T and double-T special profiles
For motor starter protectors and contactors with Screw
screw terminals terminals
S00 S00 Rated current 16 A, 8US12 51-5DS10 1 unit 0.183
45 mm wide, 200 mm long
S0 S0 Rated current 32 A, 8US12 51-5NT10 1 unit 0.183
45 mm wide, 260 mm long
S2 S2 Up to 65A, 8US12 61-6MT10 1 unit 0.572
8US12 51- 8US12 51-
5DS10 5DT11 55mm wide, 260mm long
For motor starter protectors and contactors with Spring-type
spring-type terminals terminals
S00 S00 Rated current 16 A, 8US12 51-5DT11 1 unit 0.183
45 mm wide, 260 mm long

4
S0 S0 Rated current 32 A, 8US12 51-5NT11 1 unit 0.183
45 mm wide, 260 mm long
Device holders for lateral mounting onto busbar adapters

STARTERS
COMBINATION
for 60 mm system
S00, S0 S00, S0 Up to 25 A, 8US12 50-5AS10 1 unit 0.183
45 mm wide, 200 mm long
S0 S0 Up to 40 A, 8US12 50-5AT10 1 unit 0.183
45 mm wide, 260 mm long
S2 S2 Up to 65A, 8US12 11-6MT10 1 unit 0.873
118mm wide, 260mm long
(includes 8US1261-6MT10 adapter)

8US12 50- 8US12 50-


5AS10 5AT10
Side modules for widening busbar adapters
8US19 98-2BJ10

6
-- -- Including connecting wedges, for 1 unit 0.023
widening busbar adapters or device
holders, 9 mm wide, 200 mm long
Spacers for fixing the motor starter onto the busbar adapter
-- S00, S0 (1 pack = 100 units) 8US19 98-1BA10 1 pack 0.183
Vibration and shock kits for high vibration and shock loads
-- S00, S0 8US19 98-1CA10 1 unit 0.183
RS assembly kits for reversing duty for 60 mm busbar systems
RS assembly kits for screw terminals Screw
terminals
S00, S0 S00 Comprising: 3RA29 13-1DB1 1 unit 0.001
S0 S0 • Wiring kits 3RA29 23-1DB1 1 unit 0.001
S00 S0 • Busbar adapters 3RA29 23-1EB1 1 unit 0.001
S2 S2 • Device holders 3RA29 33-1DB1 1 unit 1.235
• 2 connecting wedges
• Side modules
Link modules must be ordered
separately.
3RA29 23-1DB1
only Busbar adapter
pictured
RS assembly kits for spring-type terminals Spring-type
terminals
S00 S00 Comprising: 3RA29 13-1DB2 1 unit 0.001
S0 S0 • Wiring kits 3RA29 23-1DB2 1 unit 0.001
• Busbar adapters
• Device holders
• 2 connecting wedges
• Spacers
• Side modules
Link modules must be ordered
3RA29 23-1DB2 separately.
only Busbar adapter
pictured

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof. Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/51
Illustrations are approximate SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 6/27
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation
SIRIUS
3RA2 3RA2 Motor Starters
Accessories
Connecting wedges, spaces, and tools
Accessories

For For Version Order No. Std. Weight


motor contactors pack approx.
starter pro- qty.
tector
Size Size kg
Connecting wedges
For mechanical linking of busbar adapters and device 8US19 98-1AA00 100 units 0.100
holders or of standard mounting rail adapters (2 units
per combination required)
8US19 98-1AA00
Spacers
For height compensation on AC contactors size S0 Spring-type terminals
with spring-type terminals
S0 S0 Single-unit packaging 3RA29 11-1CA00 1 unit 0.001
S0 S0 Multi-unit packaging 3RA29 11-1C 5 units 0.001

3RA29 11-1CA00
4

Version Order No. Std. Weight


pack approx.
COMBINATION
STARTERS

qty.

kg
Tools for opening spring-type terminals by hand
Screwdrivers Spring-type terminals
for all SIRIUS devices with spring-type terminals
Length approx. 200 mm, 3RA29 08-1A 1 unit 0.045
3.0 mm x 0.5 mm,
titanium gray/black,
partially insulated
3RA29 08-1A
Blank labels
Unit labeling plates1) 3RT29 00-1SB20 340 units 0.200
for SIRIUS devices
20 mm x 7 mm,
pastel turquoise
6

NSB0_01429b

3RT19 00-1SB20
1) PC labeling system for individual inscription of
unit labeling plates available from:
murrplastik Systems, Inc.
www.murrplastik.com .

Selection and ordering data


For For Version Std. Weight
MSPs Conductors Pack approx.
Qty.
Size Size Order No. kg

Push-in lugs for screw fixing


S00 -- For screwing the motor starter protector onto 3RV29 28-0B 10 units 0.100
mounting plates; for each motor starter protector,
2 units are required.

3RV29 28-0B

4/52 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog * You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
6/28 SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012 Illustrations are approximate
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation


Components for IEC types of coordination 1 and 2 at AC 500 V

■ Technical data
Three-phase standard motor1) Setting range Motor starter Contactor2) Size
4-pole at AC 500 V Inverse-time delayed protector
overload release
Standard Motor current
output (guide value) Type Type
P I
kW A A
IEC Type of coordination 1 at Iq = 50 kA/AC 400 V
Normal starting Class 10
1.5 3.6 3.5 ... 5 3RV20 11-1FA10 3RT20 15-1AP00 S00
2.2 4.9 4.5 ... 6.3 3RV20 11-1GA10
3 6.5 5.5 ... 8 3RV20 11-1HA10

4 8.5 7 ... 10 3RV20 11-1JA10 3RT20 16-1AP01


5.5 11.5 9 ... 12.5 3RV20 11-1KA10 3RT20 17-1AP01
7.5 15.5 11 ... 16 3RV20 11-4AA10 3RT20 18-1AP01

IEC Type of coordination 2 at Iq = 50 kA/AC 400 V


Normal starting Class 10

4
0.06 0.2 0.14 ... 0.2 3RV20 11-0BA10 3RT20 15-1AP01 S00
0.06 0.2 0.18 ... 0.25 3RV20 11-0CA10
0.09 0.3 0.22 ... 0.32 3RV20 11-0DA10

STARTERS
COMBINATION
0.09 0.3 0.28 ... 0.4 3RV20 11-0EA10
0.12 0.4 0.35 ... 0.5 3RV20 11-0FA10
0.18 0.6 0.45 ... 0.63 3RV20 11-0GA10
0.18 0.6 0.55 ... 0.8 3RV20 11-0HA10
0.25 0.85 0.7 ... 1 3RV20 11-0JA10
0.37 1.1 0.9 ... 1.25 3RV20 11-0KA10
0.55 1.5 1.1 ... 1.6 3RV20 11-0AA10
0.75 1.9 1.4 ... 2 3RV20 11-1BA10
0.75 1.9 1.8 ... 2.5 3RV20 11-1CA10
1.1 2.7 2.2 ... 3.2 3RV20 11-1DA10
1.5 3.6 2.8 ... 4 3RV20 11-1EA10

1.5 3.6 3.5 ... 5 3RV20 11-1FA10 3RT20 24-1AP01 S0


2.2 4.9 4.5 ... 6.3 3RV20 11-1GA10
3 6.5 5.5 ... 8 3RV20 11-1HA10
4 8.5 7 ... 10 3RV20 11-1JA10
5.5 11.5 9 ... 12.5 3RV20 11-1KA10

7.5 15.5 11 ... 16 3RV20 21-4AA10 3RT20 26-1AP01


7.5 15.5 14 ... 20 3RV20 21-4BA10

11 22 17 ... 22 3RV20 21-4CA10 3RT20 27-1AP01


11 22 20 ... 35 3RV20 21-4DA10
15 29 27 ... 32 3RV20 21-4EA10

1) Selection depends on the actual startup 2) Rated control supply voltage 120 V AC. Other
and rated data of the protected motor. voltages are possible.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/53


Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation

Components for IEC types of coordination 1 and 2 at AC 500 V

■ Technical data
Three-phase standard motor1) Setting range Motor starter Contactor2) Size
4-pole at AC 500 V Inverse-time delayed protector
overload release
Standard Motor current
output (guide value) Type Type
P I
kW A A
IEC Type of coordination 1 at Iq = 50 kA/AC 500 V
Normal starting Class 10
On request 3RV2031-4DA10 3RT20 35-1AK60 S2
On request 3RV2031-4EA10 3RT20 35-1AK60
On request 3RV2031-4FA10 3RT20 35-1AK60
On request 3RV2031-4GA10 3RT20 36-1AK60
On request 3RV2031-4HA10 3RT20 36-1AK60

On request 3RV2041-4JA10 3RT20 45-1AK60 S3


On request 3RV2041-4KA10 3RT20 45-1AK60
On request 3RV2041-4LA10 3RT20 46-1AK60

IEC Type of coordination 2 at Iq = 50 kA/AC 500 V


4

Normal starting Class 10


COMBINATION
STARTERS

On request 3RV20 31-4AA10 3RT20 35-1AK60 S2


On request 3RV20 31-4BA10 3RT20 35-1AK60
On request 3RV20 31-4DA10 3RT20 35-1AK60
On request 3RV20 31-4EA10 3RT20 35-1AK60
On request 3RV20 31-4FA10 3RT20 35-1AK60
On request 3RV20 31-4GA10 3RT20 36-1AK60
On request 3RV20 31-4HA10 3RT20 36-1AK60

On request 3RV20 31-4JA10 3RT20 45-1AK60 S3


On request 3RV20 31-4KA10 3RT20 45-1AK60
On request 3RV20 31-4LA10 3RT20 46-1AK60

1) Selection depends on the actual startup 2) Rated control supply voltage 120 V AC. Other
and rated data of the protected motor. voltages are possible.

4/54 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation

Components for IEC types of coordination 1 and 2 at AC 690 V

■ Technical data
Three-phase standard motor Setting range Standard Subsequent Contactor1) Size Short-circuit
4-pole at AC 690 V3) MSP IEC circuit-breaker MSP switching capacity Iq
with at 690 V
limiting function
Standard Motor current
output (guide value)
Type Type Type
P I
kW A A kA

IEC Types of coordination 1 and 2 at AC 690 V


Normal starting Class 10

On request 11 ... 16 3RV13 31-4HC10 3RV20 31-4AA10 3RT20 35-1AK60 S2 50


On request 14 ... 20 Size S2 3RV20 31-4BA10 3RT20 35-1AK60
On request 18 ... 25 In= 50 A 3RV20 31-4DA10 3RT20 35-1AK60
On request 22 ... 32 3RV20 31-4EA10 3RT20 35-1AK60

On request 28 ... 40 3RV20 31-4FA10 3RT20 45-1AK602) S2/S3 50


On request 36 ... 45 3RV20 31-4GA10 3RT20 45-1AK602)
On request 40 ... 50 3RV20 31-4HA10 3RT20 46-1AK602)

4
Installation guidelines for AC 400/500 V
The following distances from earthed components must be observed when installing combinations:

STARTERS
COMBINATION
Motor starter protectors Distances from earthed or Z Z
in combination with contactors live parts

Y
MSP Rated operational Y X24) Z 1L1 3L2 5L3

Contactor voltage mm mm mm

3RV2. 1 with 3RT20 1 400/500 V 20 10 9 3RV2... 3RV2...

3RV2. 2 with 3RT20 1 400/500 V 30 10 9


3RT2 . 2 400/500 V 30 10 9
3RT2 . 3 400/500 V 30 10 9
2T1 4T2 6T3
3RV2. 3 with 3RT20 2 400/500 V 50 10 10
3RT2 . 3 400/500 V 50 10 10
1L1 3L2 5L3
3RT20 4 400/500 V 50 10 10 X2

3RV2. 4 with 3RT20 4 400 V 90 10 12


3RT20 4 500 V 220 10 20 3RT2... 3RT2...

2T1 4T2 6T3

No upstream circuit-breaker 1) Rated control supply voltage 120 V AC. Other 3) Selection depends on the specific startup
required; short-circuit proof up to 100 kA. voltages are possible. and rated data of the protected motor.
2) With these combinations, the distance between 4) Minimum distance to contactor at front.
the subsequent MSP and the contactor must be at For the MSP, no minimum distance
least 10 cm. at the front must be maintained.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/55


Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation

3RA2 — up to 100 A

■ Technical data
Installation guidelines for AC 690 V

Size Mounting method Standard surface mounting for sizes S0 Surface mounting for sizes S0
up to 5.5 kW, S2 and S3 from 7.5 to 11 kW
S0 Mounting on an insulated
base plate. If screws are used 3-phase busbar
for fixing, the screws must not Size S0:
be earthed. 3RV29 15-1A
Alternatively, the standard rail
adapter can be used for all Size S2:
units. 3RV19 35-1A

S2/S3 Mounting on an insulated


base plate. Alternatively, the
standard rail adapter
can also be used without
restriction.
4 STARTERS
COMBINATION

Connection module
See accessories

The following distances from earthed components must be observed when installing combinations:

Two MSPs in combination with contactors Distances from earthed or live components

MSP Contactor Rated operational Y1 Y2 Y3 X1 X2 Z


voltage mm mm mm mm mm mm
3RV2. 2 with 3RT20 2 690 V 80 10 95 20 14 20

3RV2. 3 with 3RT20 3 690 V 50 10 120 10 32 10


3RT20 4 690 V 50 10 120 10 40 10

a 3-phase busbar: b In combination with size S2


MSPs and size S3 contactors,
Size S0: 3RV29 15-1A
a spacing of 100 mm must be
Size S2: 3RV19 35-1A
maintained.

4/56 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation

3RA2 — up to 100 A

■ Technical data
General data
Specifications IEC 60 947-1, EN 60 947-1 (VDE 0660 Part 100)
IEC 60 947-2, EN 60 947-2 (VDE 0660 Part 101)
IEC 60 947-4-1, EN 60 947-4-1 (VDE 0660 Part 102)
Type 3RA2. 1 3RA2. 2 3RA2. 3 3RA2.4
Size S00 S0 S2 S3
Number of poles 3 3 3 3

Max. rated current Inmax A 16 32 65 100


(= max. rated operational current Ie)
Permissible ambient temperature °C for storage/transport –55 ... +80 –50 ... +80
°C for operation –20 ... +60 (restrictions apply –20 ... +60
at more than +60 °C)
Rated operational voltage Ue V 690
Rated frequency Hz 50/60
Rated insulation voltage Ui V 690
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 6

Release class (CLASS) acc. to IEC 60 947-4-1, 10


EN 60 947-4-1

4
(VDE 0660 Part 102)
Rated fused short-circuit current Iq at 50/60 Hz AC 400 V kA 150 100 50

STARTERS
COMBINATION
acc. to IEC 60 947-4-1, DIN EN 60 947-4-1 (VDE 0660 Part 102)
Types of coordination to IEC 60 947-4-1, EN 60 947-4-1 1)

(VDE 0660 Part 102)


Power losses Pv max of all • Up to 1.25 A W 2
main conducting paths • 1.6 - 6.3 A W 2.3
depending on the rated current In • 8 - 12 A W 3.5
(upper current setting range) • 16 A W 4.3
• 5- 6.3 A W 2.3
• 8 - 12 A W 3.5
• 16 - 32 A W 4.3
25 - 32 A W 16.2
40 A W 17.2
45 - 50 A W 21
63 A W 29
75 - 90 A W 45
100 A W 60

Power consumption of solenoid coils (with cold coil and Us, 50 Hz)
AC operation closing VA 27 65 190 270
p.f. 0.8 0.82 0.72 0.68
closed VA 4.2 8.5 16 22
p.f. 0.25 0.25 0.37 0.27
DC operation closing = closed W 4 5.9 – 15

Coil voltage tolerance for contactors 0.8 - 1.1 x Us


low limit at 55 °C 0.8 x Us –
at 60 °C 0.85 x Us –

Endurance of MSP
Mechanical endurance operating cycles 100 000 Up to 52A: 50 000 50 000
Electrical endurance operating cycles 100 000 from 65A: On request 50 000
Max. switching frequency per hour (motor starts) 1/h 15 15 15

Endurance of contactor
Mechanical endurance operating cycles 30 million 10 million
Electrical endurance operating cycles See endurance curves of contactors in Part 3.
Shock resistance (sine-wave acc. to IEC 60 068 Part 2-27 g up to 6 up to 6 up to 6 up to 6
pulse)
Touch protection on the front acc. to IEC 60529 IP 20 IP 20

Shock-hazard protection acc. to DIN VDE 0106 Part 100 Finger-safe


Phase failure sensitivity acc. to IEC 60 947-4-1, Yes
of MSP EN 60 947-4-1
(VDE 0660 Part 102)
Isolating characteristics acc. to IEC 60 947-2, Yes
of MSP EN 60 947-2
Main and EMERGENCY-STOP (VDE 0660 Part 101)
switch characteristics of MSP acc. to IEC 60 204-1, Yes (with overvoltage releases of
and accessories EN 60 204-1 category 1 under conditions of proper use)
(VDE 0113 Part 1)
Safe isolation between main and acc. to DIN VDE 0160 Part 101 up to 400 V
auxiliary circuits

Positively driven operation at contactors Yes Yes, from main contact to auxiliary NC contact
1) See selection and ordering data on pages 4/36 to 4/43.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/57


Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation


3RA2 — up to 100 A

Technical data

Conductor cross-sections of main circuit


Specifications IEC 60 947-1, EN 60 947-1 (VDE 0660 Part 100)
IEC 60 947-2, EN 60 947-2 (VDE 0660 Part 101)
IEC 60 947-4-1, EN 60 947-4-1 (VDE 0660 Part 102)
Type 3RA2. 1 3RA2. 2 3RA2.3 3RA21 4
Size S00 S0 S2 S3
Number of poles 3 3 3 3

Connection type Screw terminal Screw terminal Screw Terminals Box terminals
M3 Posidrive size 2 M3 Posidrive size 2 M6 Pozidriv size 2 Allen screw
Terminal screw

Conductor cross-sections (min./max)


1 or 2 conductors can be connected
• Solid and stranded mm2 2 x (0.5 … 1.5) 2) only for contactors 2 x (1 ... 25)2)
mm2 2 x (0.75 … 2.5 ) 2) 1 x (1 ... 35)2)
mm2 max. 2 x 4 2 x (1 ... 35)2)
1 x (1 ... 50)2)
• Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 –

• Finely stranded with end sleeves (DIN 46 228 T1) mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5) 2) 2 x (1 ... 16)2)
2 x (0.75 ... 2.5) 2)
4

1 x (1 ... 25)2)
2 x (1 ... 25)2)
1 x (1 ... 35)2)
COMBINATION
STARTERS

• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 2 x (20 ... 16) 2) 2 x (18 ... 3)2)
AWG 2 x (18 ... 14) 1 x (18 ... 2)2)
AWG 2 x 12 2 x (18 ... 2)2)
1 x (18 ... 1)2)

Minimum/maximum conductor cross-sections


flexible with ferrule
- 1 conductor mm2 0.75/25 2.5/501)
- 2 conductors mm2 0.75/16 2.5/351)
solid or stranded
- 1 conductor mm2 0.75/35 2.5/701)
- 2 conductors mm2 0.75/25 2.5/501)
Ribbon cable yes yes
Bus connection – yes
solid or stranded AWG 2 x (30 ... 2) –
stranded AWG – 2 x (10 ... 1/0)
Connection type Spring Loaded connection
• Solid and stranded mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 2.5) – 2 x (0.5 … 2.5)
• Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 2 x (0.5 … 2.5)
• Finely stranded with end sleeves mm2 2 x (0.5 … 2.5)
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 2 x (20 ... 12) 2 x (20 … 14)
Permissible mounting position

Attention:
acc. to DIN 43 602
Start command “I”
right-hand or above

1) Cable-lug and busbar connection possible after 2) If two different conductor cross-sections are connected
removing the box terminals. to one clamping point, both cross-sections must lie in the
range specified. If identical cross-sections are used, this
restriction does not apply.

4/58 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation


3RA2 — up to 100 A

Operating conditions Classification types Special equipment for customer


■ Overview 3RA combination starters are DIN VDE 0660 Part 102 and assembly can be ordered if
The 3RA combination starters climate-proof. They are intended IEC 60 947-4-1 make a distinc- other rated control supply volt-
consist of the 3RV MSP and for use in enclosed rooms in tion between two different types ages are required. The link mod-
the 3RT contactor. MSP and which no severe conditions of coordination (types 1 and 2). ules simplify customer assembly
contactor are prewired and (such as dust, caustic vapors, Any short-circuits that occur are of the load feeders.
mechanically connected with hazardous gases) prevail. Suita- cleared safely by both types of The corresponding distances
preassembled kits (link mod- ble enclosures must be pro- coordination. The only differ- from earthed or live parts, as
ules, connection assembly kits vided for installation in dusty ences concern the extent of the detailed in the technical data,
and mounting rail or busbar and damp locations. damage caused to the equip- must be observed.
adapters). ment by a short-circuit.
As the 3RA combination start- Customer assembly
ers are constructed from 3RV IEC Type of coordination 1
MSPs and 3RT contactors, the ■ Accessories The combination starter may be
The standard devices can be
same accessories can be used The accessories for the special combined optimally in terms of
for the combination starter as non-operational after a short-cir- both technical data and dimen-
equipment, such as auxiliary cuit has been cleared. Damage
for these MSPs and contactors. contacts and undervoltage trips, sions, thanks to the modular sys-
to the contactor or to the over- tem of the SIRIUS series.
Pre-assembled link modules can also be used for the 3RA load relay is permissible. In 3RA
are available as accessories for combination starters. load feeders, the MSP itself The combination starters can
the power spectrum up to 75 In addition, certain accessories always achieves type of coordi- thus be assembled easily by the
HP. The desired combination have been optimized for the nation 2. customer. It is simply necessary
starter can thus be assembled combination starters. They to assemble the standard 3RV
quickly and economically by include the top-connected, MSP and 3RT contactor and

4
the customer. A time saving is transverse auxiliary contact on IEC Type of coordination 2 the appropriate link module
also achieved with the link the MSP with one changeover together.
There must be no damage to the

STARTERS
COMBINATION
modules as – unlike with con- contact or one NO contact + overload trip or to any other For the order numbers for spe-
ventional wiring systems – there one NC contact. Special auxil- components after a short-circuit cial equipment and link mod-
is no need to rectify possible iary contact blocks that can be has been cleared. The 3RA ules, see the selection and
wiring errors. snapped on from below are combination starter can resume ordering data.
As a combination starter rated available for the contactor. operation without needing to be For the link modules for direct
for tap conductor protection for These two accessories enable be renewed. At most, it is per- starting or reversing mode and
group installation the 3RV the combination starters to be missible to weld the contactor assembly on a standard mount-
MSP is responsible for overload wired easily without having to contacts if they can be dis- ing rail or busbar, see accesso-
and short-circuit protection in route cables via the equipment. connected easily without any ries.
the motor circuit. Back-up pro- The special accessories for significant deformation.
If a MSP with a rotary operating
tective devices, such as fuses 3RA combination starters take mechanism is required for the
or SIEMENS Sentron circuit the form of link modules for lower setting ranges up to 12 A,
breakers are required as per 3RV MSPs and 3RT contactors.
NEC 430-53 guidelines for
■ Mounting the S0 MSP can also be assem-
bled with an S00 contactor. A
group installations for multiple Complete equipment special connecting module is
motor applications available for this purpose.
■ Technical data The 3RA combination starters
The 3RT contactor is ideal for can be ordered as complete For the installation of feeders, it
extremely complex switching For technical data, see pages equipment for direct starting or is imperative to use standard rail
tasks requiring durable compo- 4/56-4/58. Additional details for reversing mode. Control sup- adapters, as from size S2 for
nents. are contained in the respective ply voltages of 50 Hz AC 230 V direct starting and as from size
The permissible ambient tem- tables for the 3RV MSPs and or DC 24 V and assembly on a S0 for reversing, to ensure the
perature is 60 °C with butt- 3RT contactors. 35 mm standard mounting rail or necessary mechanical strength.
mounting and without derating in a 40 or 60 mm busbar system A standard rail adapter is not
(70 °C possible subject to cer- are possible. necessary if a busbar adapter is
tain restrictions). ■ Configuration used.
3RA combination starters are
available for motors up to 75 Hp Overload tripping times Assembly
at 460 V AC and setting ranges All the 3RA combination start- 3RA combination starters are
from 0.14 A to 100 A. ers described here are available for assembly on stand-
3RA combination starters are designed for normal starting, in ard mounting rails in accord-
supplied in four different other words for overload tripping ance with EN 50 022-35 x 15 or
sizes: times of less than 10 s on busbar adapters with a bus-
(CLASS 10). At rated-load oper- bar centre-line spacing of 40 or
Size Overall Max. For
ating temperature the tripping 60 mm and a busbar thickness
width rated three- times are shorter, depending on of 5 or 10 mm.
current phase the particular equipment and the The combination starters are
In max motors setting range. The exact values also suitable for screw fixing.
up to can be derived from the tripping
mm A HP characteristics of the MSPs. Size S00
S00 and
and S0
S0 can
can be
be
screwed on with
with the
the aid
aid of plug-
plug-
S00 45 8 5 in
in clips (see accessories
clips (see accessorieson on
S0 45 22 15 page 4/47).
page 4/47).
S2 55 50 40
S3 70 100 75

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/59


Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation
Load Feeders and Motor Starters for Use in the Control Cabinet
SIRIUS 3RA2 Load Feeders
3RA2 — up to 100 A
General data
Direct-on-line starting • For standard rail mounting or screw fixing • Sizes S00 and S0

1 1 1 1 2 push-in lugs
3RV2928-0B
(only for screw fixing)
2 Motor starter protector
Size S00/S0
3 Screw terminals
2 2
3 Motor starter protector
Size S00/S0
Spring-type terminals
4 Link module
(Screw terminals)
3RA1921-1DA00 (for S00)
3RA2921-1AA00 (for S0, AC contactor)
3RA2921-1BA00 (for S0, DC contactor)
5 Link module
(Spring-type terminals)
4 5 3RA2911-2AA00 for S00
6 3RA2921-2AA00 for S0
4

6 Link module
(Hybrid)
3RA2911-2FA00 for S00
COMBINATION
STARTERS

3RA2921-2FA00 for S0
7 Contactor
IC10_08_03.fm Page 9 Thursday, May 24, 2018 10:33 PM Size S00/S0
8 8
7 Screw terminals
8 Contactor
IC01_00636

Size S00/S0
Spring-type terminals

Load Feeders and Motor Starters for Use in the Control Cabinet
SIRIUS 3RA2 Load Feeders

8
Left: 3RA21 load feeder with screw terminals
Center: 3RA21 load feeder with spring-type terminals
Right: Motor starter protector combination with screw terminals, with contactor with spring-type terminals General data
Direct-on-line starting • For standard rail mounting • Up to Size S3
1 1 1 2 push-in lugs
2 3RV2928-0B
3
(only Motor starter protector
for screw 1fixing)
Size S3
2 Motor starter protector
Screw terminals
3 Size S00/S0
2 Screw terminals2 Standard mounting rail adapter
3RA1942-1AA00
1 1 3 Motor starter protector
3 Mounting plate
Size S00/S0
4 Link module
Screw terminals/spring-type terminals
3RA1941-1AA00
4 Link module
3RA2921-1BA00 (Screw Screw terminals)
terminals
5 Contactor
5 Link module
3RA2921-1BA00 forSize S3 and screw terminals
S00/S0
3RA2911-2GA00 forScrew
S00 terminals
and spring-type terminals
3RA2921-2GA00 6 for
SoftS0starter
and spring-type terminals
4 Size S3
5 6 Solid-state switching device (Screw terminals)
Screw terminals
4 4
7 Soft starter
Size S00/S0
Screw terminals/spring-type terminals

5 6
6
IC01_00655a

7
IC01_00637

Load feeder for direct-on-line starting and standard rail mounting in size S3 (the version with screw terminals is shown in the picture)
8

Left: Motor starter protector combination with solid-state switching device with screw terminals
Right: Motor starter protector combination with soft starter with spring-type terminals
4/60 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

Direct-on-line starting • For 60 mm busbar systems • Sizes S00 and S0


Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation
Load feeder for direct-on-line starting and standard rail mounting in size S3 (the version with screw terminals is shown in the picture)

8
3RA2 — up to 100 A

Direct-on-line starting • For 60 mm busbar systems • Sizes S00 and S0

1 2 1 60 mm busbar adapter
for screw terminals
8US1251-5DS10 for S00
8US1251-5NT10 for S0
2 60 mm busbar adapter
for spring-type terminals
8US1251-5DT11 for S00
8US1251-5NT11 for S0
3 4
3 Motor starter protector
Size S00/S0
Screw terminals
4 Motor starter protector
Size S00/S0
Spring-type terminals
5 Link module
Screw terminals
3RA1921-1DA00 for S00
3RA2921-1AA00 for S0, AC contactor
3RA2921-1BA00 for S0, DC contactor

IC01_00639
5
6

4
6 Link module
3RA2911-2AA00 for S00
3RA2921-2AA00 for S0

STARTERS
COMBINATION
IC10_08_03.fm Page 10 T hursday, May 24, 2018 10:33 PM (additional 3RA2911-1CA00 spacer
for height compensation on AC contactors
size S0 with spring-type terminals)
8
7
7 Contactor
Size S00/S0
Screw terminals
Load Feeders and Motor Starters for Use in the Control 8Cabinet
Contactor
SIRIUS 3RA2 Load Feeders Size S00/S0
Spring-type terminals
General
Left: dataload feeder for direct-on-line starting with busbar adapter with screw terminals
3RA21
Right: 3RA21 load feeder for direct-on-line starting with busbar adapter with spring-type terminals
Direct-on-line starting • For 60 mm busbar systems • Size S2

2 1 Motor starter protector


Siemens IC 10 · 2018 8/9
Size S2
Screw terminals
2 Busbar adapter 60 mm
8US1261-6MT10
1 3 Link module
3RA2931-1AA00
Screw terminals
4 Contactor
Size S2
Screw terminals
IC01_00640

4
8

3RA21 load feeder for direct-on-line starting with busbar adapter with screw terminals

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/61


Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation
Load Feeders and Motor Starters for Use in the Control Cabinet
SIRIUS 3RA2 Load Feeders
3RA2 — up to 100 A
General data
Reversing duty • For standard rail mounting or screw fixing • Size S00

1 1 1 Push-in lug
3RV2928-0B
(only for screw fixing)
2 Motor starter protector
3 Size S00/S0
2
Screw terminal
3 Motor starter protector
Size S00/S0
Spring-type terminal
4 Link module
Screw terminal
3RA1921-1DA00 for S00
3RA2921-1AA00 for S0, AC contactor
3RA2921-1BA00 for S0, DC contactor
5 Link module
Spring-type terminal
4 5 3RA2911-2AA00 for S00
3RA2921-2AA00 for S0
6 Contactor
4

Size S00/S0
Screw terminal
COMBINATION
STARTERS

7 Contactor
Size S00/S0
e Spring-type terminal

6 a

6 7
c
7
g

d
IC01_00641

8
h

b f

Wiring kit Wiring kit


3RA2913-2AA1 3RA2913-2AA2
a Upper wiring module e Upper wiring module
b Lower wiring module f Lower wiring module
c Two connecting clips for two contactors g Two connecting clips for two contactors
d Mechanical interlock h Mechanical interlock
(can be removed if necessary) (can be removed if necessary)

Left: 3RA22 load feeder with screw terminals with push-in lugs with two contactors for reversing duty and 3RA2913-2AA1 wiring kit for
connection of the contactors (incl. mechanical interlocking and connecting clips)
Right: 3RA22 load feeder with spring-type terminals with push-in lugs with two contactors for reversing duty and 3RA2913-2AA2 wiring kit
(incl. mechanical interlocking and connecting clips)

4/62 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation
Load Feeders and Motor Starters for Use in the Control Cabinet
SIRIUS 3RA2 Load Feeders
3RA2 — up to 100 A
General data
Reversing duty • For standard rail mounting • Size S0

2
2 RH assembly kit for reversing duty and
standard rail mounting in size S0

Screw terminals
3RA2923-1BB1
Spring-type terminals
1)
3RA2923-1BB2
1 Comprising:
• Wiring kit for the
main and auxiliary circuits
• Two standard mounting rail adapters
• Two connecting wedges
• Mechanical interlock
• Two connecting clips
• Fixing accessories

1 Motor starter protector


Size S0
3

4
Screw terminals/spring-type terminals
2 Standard mounting rail adapters
3RA2922-1AA00

STARTERS
COMBINATION
with two connecting wedges
8US1998-1AA00
3 Link module
a Screw terminals:
3RA2921-1AA00 for S0, AC contactor
4 3RA2921-1BA00 for S0, DC contactor
4 Spring-type terminals:
c 3RA2921-2AA00
2)

4 Contactor
Size S0
IC01_00642
8

d Screw terminals/spring-type terminals


Wiring kit
Screw terminals:
3RA2923-2AA1
Spring-type terminals:
3RA2923-2AA2
a Upper wiring module
b
b Lower wiring module
c Two connecting clips for two contactors
d Mechanical interlock
(can be removed if necessary)

1) Contains two 3RA2911-1CA00 spacers for


height compensation on AC contactors size S0
with spring-type terminals.
2)
Additionally two 3RA2911-1CA00 spacers
for height compensation on AC contactors
size S0 with spring-type terminals.

3RA22 load feeder for reversing duty and standard rail mounting in size S0
(the version with screw terminals is shown in the picture)
RH assembly kits for reversing duty and standard rail mounting
in size S0, see page 8/51.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/63


Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation
Load Feeders and Motor Starters for Use in the Control Cabinet
SIRIUS 3RA2 Load Feeders
3RA2 — up to 100 A
General data
Reversing duty • For standard rail mounting • Size S2

2 RH assembly kit for reversing duty and


2 standard rail mounting in size S2

3RA2933-1BB1
Comprising:
• Wiring kit for the
main and auxiliary circuits
• Two standard mounting rail adapters
1
• Two side modules
• Four connecting wedges
• Mechanical interlock
• Two connectors for two contactors
• Fixing accessories

1 Motor starter protector


Size S2
Screw terminals
2 Standard mounting rail adapter
IC01_00643
4

3RA2932-1AA00
with two side modules
3 3RA1902-1B
COMBINATION
STARTERS

and four connecting wedges


8US1998-1AA00
3 Link module
3RA2931-1AA00
Screw terminals
4 Contactor
a
size S2
4 Screw terminals
4 c
Wiring kit
d
Screw terminals

8
3RA2933-2AA1
a Upper wiring module
b Lower wiring module
c Two connectors for two contactors
d Mechanical interlock
3RA2934-2B (not part of the wiring
kit, must be ordered separately)

Load feeder for reversing duty and standard rail mounting in size S2
(the version with screw terminals is shown in the picture)
RH assembly kits for reversing duty and standard rail mounting
in size S2, see page 8/51.

4/64 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation
Load Feeders and Motor Starters for Use in the Control Cabinet
SIRIUS 3RA2 Load Feeders
3RA2 — up to 100 A
General data
Reversing duty • For standard rail mounting • size S3

2 Assembly kit (RH) for reversing duty and


2 mounting onto standard rails in size S3
3RA2943-1BB1
Comprising:
• Wiring kit for the
1
main and auxiliary circuits
• Two standard mounting rail adapters
• Three side modules
• Six connecting wedges
• Mechanical interlock
• Two connectors for two contactors
• Fixing accessories

1 Motor starter protector


size S3
IC01_00656a
2 Standard mounting rail adapter
3
3RA2932-1AA00
with two side modules

4
3RA1902-1B
and four connecting wedges

STARTERS
COMBINATION
8US1998-1AA00
3 Link module
a 3RA1941-1AA00
4 Contactor
4 size S3
c
4
d Wiring kit
Screw terminals
3RA2943-2AA1
a Upper wiring module
b Lower wiring module
8

c Two connectors for two contactors


d Mechanical interlock
3RA2934-2B (not part of the wiring kit,
must be ordered separately)
b

Load feeder for reversing duty and standard rail mounting in size S3
(the version with screw terminals is shown in the picture)
RH assembly kits for reversing duty and standard rail mounting
in size S3, see page 8/51.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/65


Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation
Load Feeders and Motor Starters for Use in the Control Cabinet
SIRIUS 3RA2 Load Feeders
3RA2 — up to 100 A
General data
Reversing duty • For 60 mm busbar systems • Sizes S00 and S0

3 RS assembly kit for reversing duty and


3
busbar mounting in size S00/S0

Screw terminals
3RA2913-1DB1 for S00
3RA2923-1DB1 for S0
Spring-type terminals
3RA2913-1DB2 for S00
1 3RA2923-1DB2 for S0 1)
Comprising:
• Wiring kit for the
main and auxiliary circuits
• Busbar adapter
• Device holder
• Two connecting wedges
• Mechanical interlock
• Two connecting clips for two contactors
• Fixing accessories
4

2 1 Motor starter protector


Size S00/S0
COMBINATION
STARTERS

Screw terminals/spring-type terminals


2 Link module
Screw terminals
3RA1921-1DA00 for S00
3RA2921-1AA00 for S0, AC contactor
a 3RA2921-1BA00 for S0, DC contactor
Spring-type terminals
4 3RA2911-2AA00 for S00
4 3RA2921-2AA00 for S0 2)
c
3 60 mm busbar adapter

8
Screw terminals
8US1251-5DS10 for S00/S0
IC01_00644

8US1251-5NT10 for S0
d Wiring kit
Screw terminals Spring-type terminals
3RA2913-2AA1 for S00 8US1251-5DT11 for S00/S0
3RA2923-2AA1 for S0 8US1251-5NT11 for S0
Spring-type terminals 2 connecting wedges
3RA2913-2AA2 for S00 8US1998-1AA00
3RA2923-2AA2 for S0 60 mm device holder
b a Upper wiring module 8US1250-5AS10 or
8US1250-5AT10
b Lower wiring module (according to left adapter)
c Two connecting clips for two contactors 4 Contactor
Mechanical interlock Size S00/S0
d (can be removed if necessary) Screw terminals/spring-type terminals

1) Contains two 3RA2911-1CA00 spacers


for height compensation on AC contactors
size S0 with spring-type terminals.
2) Additionally two 3RA2911-1CA00 spacers
for height compensation on AC contactors
size S0 with spring-type terminals.

3RA22 load feeder for reversing duty and 60 mm busbar


(the version with screw terminals is shown in the picture)
RS assembly kits for reversing duty and busbar mounting in
size S00/S0, see page 8/53.

4/66 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation
Load Feeders and Motor Starters for Use in the Control Cabinet
SIRIUS 3RA2 Load Feeders
3RA2 — up to 100 A
General data
Reversing duty • For 60 mm busbar systems • size S2

RS assembly kit for reversing duty and


busbar mounting in size S2
2
3RA2933-1DB1
Comprising:
• Wiring kit for the
main and auxiliary circuits
• Busbar adapter
1 • Mechanical interlock
• Two connectors for two contactors
• Fixing accessories

1 Motor starter protector


Size S2
Screw terminals
2 Busbar adapter 60 mm
8US1211-6MT10
3 Link module

4
3RA2931-1AA00
Screw terminals

STARTERS
COMBINATION
3 4 Contactor
Size S2
Screw terminals
Wiring kit
For screw terminals
3RA2933-2AA1
a Upper wiring module
b Lower wiring module
c Two connecting pins for two contactors
a
d Mechanical interlock
8

4 c 4 3RA2934-2B (not part of the wiring kit,


must be ordered separately)
d
IC01_00645

Load feeder for reversing duty and 60 mm busbar in size S2


(the version with screw terminals is shown in the picture)
RS assembly kits for reversing duty and busbar mounting in size S2,
see page 8/53.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/67


Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation


3RA2 — up to 100 A

Components for Fast Bus mounting


Adapter shoe
Link module 3RV204 with Reversing 3RT204
for AC: 3RA19 41-1A 8US1211-4TR00
for DC: 3RA19 41-1B
Mechanical
interlock
3RA19 24-2B

MSP
3RV204

3RA2943-2AA1 Wiring kit (screw type)


3RA2943-2AA2 Wiring kit (spring type)
Upper wiring module
4

Lower wiring module

2 Brackets
COMBINATION
STARTERS

2 Contactors FBS0070B
3RT204

Circuit diagrams
Direct-on-line starting
Size S00: 3RA21.1 Sizes S0, S2 and S3: 3RA21 2, 3RA21 3

Reversing duty
Size S00: 3RA22 Size S0: 3RA22

4/68 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation


3RA2 — up to 100 A

■ Dimension drawings
Size S00 · for standard rail mounting

4
S0 direct-on-line starter, S0/S0 and S00/S0 reversing starters,
AC, screw-type connection system AC, screw-type connection system

STARTERS
COMBINATION
3RA2120-..A 3RA2220-..B..-0AP0

Size S00 · for 40 mm and 60 mm busbar systems

S0/S0 and S00/S0 direct-on-line starters, S0/S0 and S00/S0 reversing starters,
AC, screw-type connection system AC, screw-type connection system
3RA2120-..D..-0AP0 3RA2220-..D..-0AP0

When mounting
When mountingthe
thecombinations,
combinations,observe
observe the
the installation
installation guidelines
guidelines (page
(page 4/60-4/61).
4/60-4/61).

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/69


Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation

3RA2 — up to 50 A

■ Dimension drawings
Size S0 · for standard rail mounting
4 STARTERS
COMBINATION

S0 direct-on-line starter, AC, screw-type S0/S0 and S00/S0 reversing starters,


connection system AC, screw-type connection system
3RA2120-..A 3RA2220-..B..-0AP0

Size S0 · for 40 mm and 60 mm busbar systems

S0/S0 and S00/S0 direct-on-line starters, AC, S0/S0 and S00/S0 reversing starters,
screw-type connection system AC, screw-type connection system
3RA2120-..D..-0AP0 3RA2220-..D..-0AP0

When mounting the combinations, observe the installation guidelines (page 4/60-4/61).
When mounting the combinations, observe the installation guidelines (page 4/60-4/61).

4/70 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation

3RA2 — up to 50 A

■ Dimension drawings
Size S2 · for standard rail mounting
Direct-on-line starting Reversing duty

4
1) Alternative fixing methods

STARTERS
COMBINATION
a) 2 35 mm mounting rails
acc. to DIN EN 50 022
Spacing: 125 mm
Depth: 7.5 or 15 mm.
b) 1 75 mm mounting rail
acc. to DIN EN 50 023.

Size S2 · for 40 mm and 60 mm busbar systems


Direct-on-line starting Reversing duty

1) Busbar adapter
suitable for rail thicknesses
of 5 and 10 mm
with chamfered edges.

When
When mounting thecombinations,
mounting the combinations,observe
observethe
the installation
installation guidelines
guidelines (page
(page 4/60-4/61).
4/58).

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/71


Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation


3RA2 — up to 100 A

■ Dimension drawings
Size S3 · for standard rail mounting
Direct-on-line starting
4 STARTERS
COMBINATION

Reversing duty

1) Alternative fixing methods


a) 2 35 mm mounting rails
acc. to DIN EN 50 022
Spacing: 125 mm
Depth: 7.5 or 15 mm.
b) 1 75 mm mounting rail
acc. to DIN EN 50 023.

When
When mounting
mountingthe
thecombinations,
combinations,observe thethe
observe installation guidelines
installation (page
guidelines 4/60guidelines
(page and 4/64).4/60-4/64).

4/72 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Enclosed IEC Controls
3RE4 IEC Controllers
General information

3RE4 Enclosed IEC Controllers


­

Product overview
3RE4 Enclosed IEC motor controllers
are well suited for both industrial and
commercial applications. They are durable
and dependable, particularly when it
comes to motor protection. Protecting the
performance of motors is a critical priority
and the 3RE4 enclosed starters are offered
with either thermal or solid-state overload
relays to maximize your motor protection.

4
Controller Features

STARTERS
COMBINATION
General Contactor
n UL motor horsepower rated n Horsepower rated per UL
n From fractional up to 60 Hp at 575 V n High contact reliability
n Non-combination type starters and contactors n NO and NC auxiliary contacts included as standard
n Reversing and non-reversing controllers n Permanently secured with screws on mounting panel
n Single phase and 3-phase loads n Screw type terminal connections
n Thermal and solid-state overload relays
n NEMA Type enclosures 1, 3/3R/4/12 and 4X 304 stainless steel
n Standard size and extra larger enclosures
n RoHS compliant
n Standards: UL 60947-4-1
n Certifications: cULus

Overload Relay Features


Thermal overload relays Solid-state overload relays
n Trip Class 10 n Selectable Trip Class 5, 10, 20 and 30
n Phase failure sensitivity n Overload, phase failure and unbalance protection
n UL for Single and three phase loads n Internal ground fault detection (selectable)
n Includes NC trip contact and NO alarm contact n Internal power supply
n Manual and automatic RESET (selectable) n Includes NC trip contact and NO alarm contact
n Switch position indicator n Manual and automatic RESET (selectable)
n TEST function n Electrical remote RESET integrated
n STOP button n Switch position indicator
n Sealable cover (optional) n TEST function and self-monitoring
n Screw-type terminals n Sealable cover (optional)
n Screw-type terminals

Available Factory Mods, Field Kits, Accessories


Factory modifications Field kits and accessories
n Push buttons n Push buttons
n Selector switches n Selector switches
n Pilot lights n Pilot lights
n Control power transformers n Auxiliary contacts
n Control power transformers
n Control relays and timers
n Control circuit fuse block
n Terminal blocks
n etc.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/73


Enclosed IEC Controls
3RE4 IEC Controllers
Catalog Numbering System

Catalog Numbering System

3RE4 Nomenclature 3RE4 1 2 2 – 3 A A 3 1 – 1 H Y 0


Non-Combination Controllers

Controller Type
11 = Non-combination non-reversing starter,1-phase, 2-pole
12 = Non-combination non-reversing starter,3-phase, 3-pole
14 = Non-combination reversing starter, 3-phase, 3-pole
16 = Non-combination non-reversing contactor
18 = Non-combination reversing contactor

Frame Size: UL60947-4-1 Hp Rating


15 = S00: 1-Ph Hp (0.25@115V, 0.5@208V, 0.75@230V), 3-Ph Hp (1.5@208V, 2@230V, 3@460V, 5@575V)
17 = S00: 1-Ph Hp (0.5@115V, 1.5@208V, 2@230V), 3-Ph Hp (3@208V, 3@230V, 7.5@460V, 10@575V)
23 = S0: 1-Ph Hp (1@115V, 1@208V, 1@230V), 3-Ph Hp (2@208V, 3@230V, 5@460V, 7.5@575V)
24 = S0: 1-Ph Hp (1@115V, 2@208V, 2@230V), 3-Ph Hp (3@208V, 3@230V, 7.5@460V, 10@575V)
25 = S0: 1-Ph Hp (1@115V, 2@208V, 3@230V), 3-Ph Hp (5@208V, 5@230V, 10@460V, 15@575V)
4

26 = S0: 1-Ph Hp (2@115V, 3@208V, 3@230V), 3-Ph Hp (7.5@208V, 7.5@230V, 15@460V, 20@575V)
27 = S0: 1-Ph Hp (2@115V, 5@208V, 5@230V), 3-Ph Hp (10@208V, 10@230V, 20@460V, 25@575V)
COMBINATION
STARTERS

28 = S0: 1-Ph Hp (3@115V, 5@208V, 5@230V), 3-Ph Hp (10@208V, 10@230V, 25@460V, 25@575V)
35 = S2: 1-Ph Hp (3@115V, 5@208V, 7.5@230V), 3-Ph Hp (10@208V, 15@230V, 30@460V, 40@575V)
36 = S2: 1-Ph Hp (3@115V, 7.5@208V, 10@230V), 3-Ph Hp (15@208V, 15@230V, 40@460V, 50@575V)
37 = S2: 1-Ph Hp (5@115V, 10@208V, 10@230V), 3-Ph Hp (20@208V, 20@230V, 50@460V, 50@575V)
38 = S2: 1-Ph Hp (5@115V, 10@208V, 15@230V), 3-Ph Hp (20@208V, 25@230V, 50@460V, 60@575V)

Enclosure Type and Size


A = NEMA Type 1 - standard size
B = NEMA Type 1 - large sizea
C = NEMA Type 3/3R/4/12 - standard size
E = NEMA Type 4X 304 SS - standard size

Disconnect Type
A = None

Nominal Coil Voltage


1 = 24 V AC 50/60Hz
2 = 24 V DC
3 = 110/120 V AC 50/60Hz
4 = 208 V AC 50/60Hz
5 = 220/240 V AC 50/60Hz
6 = 277 V AC 60Hz
7 = 480 V AC 60Hz
8 = 600 V AC 60Hz

Overload Relay Type


0 = (none)
1 = Thermal fixed trip Class 10
5 = Solid-state selectable trip Class 5-10-20-30

Overload Relay Amp Range


0Y = No overload relay (contactor)
See amp range selection on page 4/15.

Special
Y0 = (none)
Factory modifications (See selection starting on page 4/47.)

a Large size enclosures are not applicable for some configurations.


Refer to product selection tables for specifics.

4/74 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Enclosed IEC Controls
3RE4 Non-Reversing Starter, 3-Phase, 3-Pole, Thermal or Solid-State Overload Relay
Selection

Ordering Information Coil Selection (●)a


 Replace the (●) with the code from the coil Nominal Voltage Code
table on this page. 24 VAC 50/60 Hz 1
 Replace the () with the overload relay 24 VDC 2
(OLR) code from this page. 110/120 VAC 50/60 Hz 3
 Replace the (♦♦) with the OLR current
208 VAC 50/60 Hz 4
adjustment range from pg. 4/80.
 For factory modifications,
220/240 VAC 50/60 Hz 5
see page 4/81 – 4/83. 277 VAC 60 Hz 6
 For accessories, see page 4/84 – 4/85. 480 VAC 60 Hz 7
 For replacement parts, see page 4/85. 600 VAC 60 Hz 8
 For dimensions, see page 4/86.

 For wiring diagrams, see page 4/87 – 4/89.

Non-Reversing Starter, 3-Phase, 3-Pole, Thermal or Solid-State Overload Relay, Standard Enclosure

4
NEMA Type Enclosure (Standard Size)

STARTERS
COMBINATION
3-Phase Motor Hp Rating per UL Type 1 Type 3/3R/4/12 Type 4X 304 Stain. Steel Unused
General Purpose, Weatherproof, Watertight, Watertight, Dust-tight, Auxiliary
Indoor only Dust-tight Corrosion Resistant Contacts Frame Contactor
208 V 230 V 460 V 575 V Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number NO NC Size (for ref. only)
1.5 2 3 5 3RE4121–5AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4121–5CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4121–5EA●–♦♦Y0 1 0 S00 3RT2015
3 3 7.5 10 3RE4121–7AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4121–7CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4121–7EA●–♦♦Y0 1 0 S00 3RT2017
2 3 5 7.5 3RE4122–3AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4122–3CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4122–3EA●–♦♦Y0 1 1 S0 3RT2023
3 3 7.5 10 3RE4122–4AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4122–4CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4122–4EA●–♦♦Y0 1 1 S0 3RT2024
5 5 10 15 3RE4122–5AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4122–5CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4122–5EA●–♦♦Y0 1 1 S0 3RT2025
7.5 7.5 15 20 3RE4122–6AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4122–6CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4122–6EA●–♦♦Y0 1 1 S0 3RT2026
10 10 20 25 3RE4122–7AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4122–7CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4122–7EA●–♦♦Y0 1 1 S0 3RT2027
10 10 25 25 3RE4122–8AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4122–8CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4122–8EA●–♦♦Y0 1 1 S0 3RT2028
10 15 30 40 3RE4123–5AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4123–5CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4123–5EA●–♦♦Y0 1 1 S2 3RT2035
15 15 40 50 3RE4123–6AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4123–6CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4123–6EA●–♦♦Y0 1 1 S2 3RT2036
20 20 50 50 3RE4123–7AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4123–7CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4123–7EA●–♦♦Y0 1 1 S2 3RT2037
20 25 50 60 3RE4123–8AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4123–8CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4123–8EA●–♦♦Y0 1 1 S2 3RT2038
  
Thermal overload relay Class 10 = 1 1 1
Solid-state overload relay selectable Class = 5 5 5

Non-Reversing Starter, 3-Phase, 3-Pole, Thermal or Solid-State Overload Relay, Large Enclosure
NEMA Type Enclosure (Large Size)
Type 1 Type 3/3R/4/12 Type 4X 304 Stain. Steel Unused
3-Phase Motor Hp Rating per UL General Purpose, Weatherproof, Watertight, Watertight, Dust-tight, Auxiliary
Indoor only Dust-tight Corrosion Resistant Contacts Frame Contactor
208 V 230 V 460 V 575 V Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number NO NC Size (for ref. only)
1.5 2 3 5 3RE4121–5BA●–♦♦Y0 1 0 S00 3RT2015
3 3 7.5 10 3RE4121–7BA●–♦♦Y0 1 0 S00 3RT2017
2 3 5 7.5 3RE4122–3BA●–♦♦Y0 1 1 S0 3RT2023
3 3 7.5 10 3RE4122–4BA●–♦♦Y0 Not applicable — Standard enclosure includes 1 1 S0 3RT2024
5 5 10 15 3RE4122–5BA●–♦♦Y0 extra mounting space for accessories. 1 1 S0 3RT2025
7.5 7.5 15 20 3RE4122–6BA●–♦♦Y0 1 1 S0 3RT2026
10 10 20 25 3RE4122–7BA●–♦♦Y0 1 1 S0 3RT2027
10 10 25 25 3RE4122–8BA●–♦♦Y0 1 1 S0 3RT2028

Thermal overload relay Class 10 = 1
Solid-state overload relay selectable Class = 5

a For 3-phase controllers, 208 - 600 V coils will be wired secondary (if ordered). For single phase controllers, power transformer secondary (if ordered). 277 - 600 V
for incoming voltage. 24 and120 V coils will be wired 120 and 240 V coils will be wired for incoming voltage. coils do not apply.
as separate source or control power transformer 24 V coils will be wired as separate source or control

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/75


Enclosed IEC Controls
3RE4 Non-Reversing Starter, 1-Phase, 2-Pole, Thermal Overload Relay
Selection

Ordering Information Coil Selection (●)a


 Replace the (●) with the code from the coil Nominal Voltage Code
table on this page. 24 VAC 50/60 Hz 1
 Replace the () with the overload relay 24 VDC 2
(OLR) code from this page. 110/120 VAC 50/60 Hz 3
 Replace the (♦♦) with the OLR current
208 VAC 50/60 Hz 4
adjustment range from pg. 4/80.
 For factory modifications,
220/240 VAC 50/60 Hz 5
see page 4/81 – 4/83. 277 VAC 60 Hz 6
 For accessories, see page 4/84 – 4/85. 480 VAC 60 Hz 7
 For replacement parts, see page 4/85. 600 VAC 60 Hz 8
 For dimensions, see page 4/86.

 For wiring diagrams, see page 4/87 – 4/89.

Non-Reversing Starter, Single Phase, 2-Pole, Thermal Overload Relay, Standard Enclosure
4

NEMA Type Enclosure (Standard Size)


1-Phase Motor Hp
COMBINATION
STARTERS

Rating per UL Type 1 Type 3/3R/4/12 Type 4X 304 Stain. Steel Unused
General Purpose, Weatherproof, Watertight, Watertight, Dust-tight, Auxiliary
Indoor only Dust-tight Corrosion Resistant Contacts Frame Contactor
115 V 208 V 230 V Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number NO NC Size (for ref. only)
0.25 0.5 0.75 3RE4111–5AA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4111–5CA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4111–5EA●1–♦♦Y0 1 0 S00 3RT2015
0.5 1.5 2 3RE4111–7AA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4111–7CA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4111–7EA●1–♦♦Y0 1 0 S00 3RT2017
1 1 1 3RE4112–3AA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4112–3CA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4112–3EA●1–♦♦Y0 1 1 S0 3RT2023
1 2 2 3RE4112–4AA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4112–4CA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4112–4EA●1–♦♦Y0 1 1 S0 3RT2024
1 2 3 3RE4112–5AA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4112–5CA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4112–5EA●1–♦♦Y0 1 1 S0 3RT2025
2 3 3 3RE4112–6AA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4112–6CA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4112–6EA●1–♦♦Y0 1 1 S0 3RT2026
2 5 5 3RE4112–7AA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4112–7CA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4112–7EA●1–♦♦Y0 1 1 S0 3RT2027
3 5 5 3RE4112–8AA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4112–8CA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4112–8EA●1–♦♦Y0 1 1 S0 3RT2028
3 5 7.5 3RE4113–5AA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4113–5CA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4113–5EA●1–♦♦Y0 1 1 S2 3RT2035
3 7 10 3RE4113–6AA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4113–6CA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4113–6EA●1–♦♦Y0 1 1 S2 3RT2036
5 10 10 3RE4113–7AA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4113–7CA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4113–7EA●1–♦♦Y0 1 1 S2 3RT2037
5 10 15 3RE4113–8AA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4113–8CA●1–♦♦Y0 3RE4113–8EA●1–♦♦Y0 1 1 S2 3RT2038

Non-Reversing Starter, Single Phase, 2-Pole, Thermal Overload Relay, Large Enclosure
NEMA Type Enclosure (Large Size)
1-Phase Motor Hp
Rating per UL Type 1 Type 3/3R/4/12 Type 4X 304 Stain. Steel Unused
General Purpose, Weatherproof, Watertight, Watertight, Dust-tight, Auxiliary
Indoor only Dust-tight Corrosion Resistant Contacts Frame Contactor
115 V 208 V 230 V Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number NO NC Size (for ref. only)
0.25 0.5 0.75 3RE4111–5BA●1–♦♦Y0 1 0 S00 3RT2015
0.5 1.5 2 3RE4111–7BA●1–♦♦Y0 1 0 S00 3RT2017
1 1 1 3RE4112–3BA●1–♦♦Y0 1 1 S0 3RT2023
1 2 2 3RE4112–4BA●1–♦♦Y0 Not applicable — Standard enclosure includes 1 1 S0 3RT2024
1 2 3 3RE4112–5BA●1–♦♦Y0 extra mounting space for accessories. 1 1 S0 3RT2025
2 3 3 3RE4112–6BA●1–♦♦Y0 1 1 S0 3RT2026
2 5 5 3RE4112–7BA●1–♦♦Y0 1 1 S0 3RT2027
3 5 5 3RE4112–8BA●1–♦♦Y0 1 1 S0 3RT2028

a For 3-phase controllers, 208 - 600 V coils will be wired secondary (if ordered). For single phase controllers, power transformer secondary (if ordered). 277 - 600 V
for incoming voltage. 24 and120 V coils will be wired 120 and 240 V coils will be wired for incoming voltage. coils do not apply.
as separate source or control power transformer 24 V coils will be wired as separate source or control

4/76 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Enclosed IEC Controls
3RE4 Reversing Starter, 3-Phase, 3-Pole, Thermal or Solid-State Overload Relay
Selection

Ordering Information Coil Selection (●)a


 Replace the (●) with the code from the coil Nominal Voltage Code
table on this page. 24 VAC 50/60 Hz 1
 Replace the () with the overload relay 24 VDC 2
(OLR) code from this page. 110/120 VAC 50/60 Hz 3
 Replace the (♦♦) with the OLR current
208 VAC 50/60 Hz 4
adjustment range from pg. 4/80.
 For factory modifications,
220/240 VAC 50/60 Hz 5
see page 4/81 – 4/83. 277 VAC 60 Hz 6
 For accessories, see page 4/84 – 4/85. 480 VAC 60 Hz 7
 For replacement parts, see page 4/85. 600 VAC 60 Hz 8
 For dimensions, see page 4/86.

 For wiring diagrams, see page 4/87 – 4/89.

Reversing Starter, 3-Phase, 3-Pole, Thermal or Solid-State Overload Relay, Standard Enclosure

4
NEMA Type Enclosure (Standard Size)

STARTERS
COMBINATION
3-Phase Motor Hp Rating per UL Type 1 Type 3/3R/4/12 Type 4X 304 Stain. Steel Unused
General Purpose, Weatherproof, Watertight, Watertight, Dust-tight, Auxiliary
Indoor only Dust-tight Corrosion Resistant Contacts Frame Contactor
208 V 230 V 460 V 575 V Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number NO NC Size (for ref. only)
1.5 2 3 5 3RE4141–5AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4141–5CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4141–5EA●–♦♦Y0 2 2 S00 3RA2315
3 3 7.5 10 3RE4141–7AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4141–7CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4141–7EA●–♦♦Y0 2 2 S00 3RA2317
2 3 5 7.5 3RE4142–3AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4142–3CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4142–3EA●–♦♦Y0 2 0 S0 3RA2323
3 3 7.5 10 3RE4142–4AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4142–4CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4142–4EA●–♦♦Y0 2 0 S0 3RA2324
5 5 10 15 3RE4142–5AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4142–5CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4142–5EA●–♦♦Y0 2 0 S0 3RA2325
7.5 7.5 15 20 3RE4142–6AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4142–6CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4142–6EA●–♦♦Y0 2 0 S0 3RA2326
10 10 20 25 3RE4142–7AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4142–7CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4142–7EA●–♦♦Y0 2 0 S0 3RA2327
10 10 25 25 3RE4142–8AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4142–8CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4142–8EA●–♦♦Y0 2 0 S0 3RA2328
10 15 30 40 3RE4143–5AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4143–5CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4143–5EA●–♦♦Y0 2 0 S2 3RA2335
15 15 40 50 3RE4143–6AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4143–6CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4143–6EA●–♦♦Y0 2 0 S2 3RA2336
20 20 50 50 3RE4143–7AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4143–7CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4143–7EA●–♦♦Y0 2 0 S2 3RA2337
20 25 50 60 3RE4143–8AA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4143–8CA●–♦♦Y0 3RE4143–8EA●–♦♦Y0 2 0 S2 3RA2338
  
Thermal overload relay Class 10 = 1 1 1
Solid-state overload relay selectable Class = 5 5 5

Reversing Starter, 3-Phase, 3-Pole, Thermal or Solid-State Overload Relay, Large Enclosure
NEMA Type Enclosure (Large Size)
Type 1 Type 3/3R/4/12 Type 4X 304 Stain. Steel Unused
3-Phase Motor Hp Rating per UL General Purpose, Weatherproof, Watertight, Watertight, Dust-tight, Auxiliary
Indoor only Dust-tight Corrosion Resistant Contacts Frame Contactor
208 V 230 V 460 V 575 V Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number NO NC Size (for ref. only)
1.5 2 3 5 3RE4141–5BA●–♦♦Y0 2 0 S00 3RA2315
3 3 7.5 10 3RE4141–7BA●–♦♦Y0 2 0 S00 3RA2317
2 3 5 7.5 3RE4142–3BA●–♦♦Y0 2 0 S0 3RA2323
3 3 7.5 10 3RE4142–4BA●–♦♦Y0 Not applicable — Standard enclosure includes 2 0 S0 3RA2324
5 5 10 15 3RE4142–5BA●–♦♦Y0 extra mounting space for accessories. 2 0 S0 3RA2325
7.5 7.5 15 20 3RE4142–6BA●–♦♦Y0 2 0 S0 3RA2326
10 10 20 25 3RE4142–7BA●–♦♦Y0 2 0 S0 3RA2327
10 10 25 25 3RE4142–8BA●–♦♦Y0 2 0 S0 3RA2328

Thermal overload relay Class 10 = 1
Solid-state overload relay selectable Class = 5

a For 3-phase controllers, 208 - 600 V coils will be wired secondary (if ordered). For single phase controllers, power transformer secondary (if ordered). 277 - 600 V
for incoming voltage. 24 and120 V coils will be wired 120 and 240 V coils will be wired for incoming voltage. coils do not apply.
as separate source or control power transformer 24 V coils will be wired as separate source or control

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/77


Enclosed IEC Controls
3RE4 Non-Reversing Contactor, 3-Pole (for both 1-Phase and 3-Phase)
Selection

Ordering Information Coil Selection (●)a


 Replace the (●) with the code from the coil Nominal Voltage Code
table on this page. 24 VAC 50/60 Hz 1
 For factory modifications, 24 VDC 2
see page 4/81 – 4/83. 110/120 VAC 50/60 Hz 3
 For accessories, see page 4/84 – 4/85.
208 VAC 50/60 Hz 4
 For replacement parts, see page 4/85.
220/240 VAC 50/60 Hz 5
 For dimensions, see page 4/86.
277 VAC 60 Hz 6
 For wiring diagrams, see page 4/87 – 4/89.
480 VAC 60 Hz 7
600 VAC 60 Hz 8

Non-Reversing Contactor, 3-Pole (for both 1-Phase and 3-Phase), Standard Enclosure
4

NEMA Type Enclosure (Standard Size)


1-Phase Motor Hp 3-Phase Motor Hp
Rating per UL Rating per UL Type 1 Type 3/3R/4/12 Type 4X 304 Stain. Steel Unused
COMBINATION
STARTERS

General Purpose, Weatherproof, Watertight, Dust-tight, Auxiliary Contactor


Indoor only Watertight, Dust-tight Corrosion Resistant Contacts Frame (for ref.
115V 208V 230V 208V 230V 460V 575V Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number NO NC Size only)
0.25 0.5 0.75 1.5 2 3 5 3RE4161–5AA●0–0YY0 3RE4161–5CA●0–0YY0 3RE4161–5EA●0–0YY0 1 0 S00 3RT2015
0.5 1.5 2 3 3 7.5 10 3RE4161–7AA●0–0YY0 3RE4161–7CA●0–0YY0 3RE4161–7EA●0–0YY0 1 0 S00 3RT2017
1 1 1 2 3 5 7.5 3RE4162–3AA●0–0YY0 3RE4162–3CA●0–0YY0 3RE4162–3EA●0–0YY0 1 1 S0 3RT2023
1 2 2 3 3 7.5 10 3RE4162–4AA●0–0YY0 3RE4162–4CA●0–0YY0 3RE4162–4EA●0–0YY0 1 1 S0 3RT2024
1 2 3 5 5 10 15 3RE4162–5AA●0–0YY0 3RE4162–5CA●0–0YY0 3RE4162–5EA●0–0YY0 1 1 S0 3RT2025
2 3 3 7.5 7.5 15 20 3RE4162–6AA●0–0YY0 3RE4162–6CA●0–0YY0 3RE4162–6EA●0–0YY0 1 1 S0 3RT2026
2 5 5 10 10 20 25 3RE4162–7AA●0–0YY0 3RE4162–7CA●0–0YY0 3RE4162–7EA●0–0YY0 1 1 S0 3RT2027
3 5 5 10 10 25 25 3RE4162–8AA●0–0YY0 3RE4162–8CA●0–0YY0 3RE4162–8EA●0–0YY0 1 1 S0 3RT2028
3 5 7.5 10 15 30 40 3RE4163–5AA●0–0YY0 3RE4163–5CA●0–0YY0 3RE4163–5EA●0–0YY0 1 1 S2 3RT2035
3 7 10 15 15 40 50 3RE4163–6AA●0–0YY0 3RE4163–6CA●0–0YY0 3RE4163–6EA●0–0YY0 1 1 S2 3RT2036
5 10 10 20 20 50 50 3RE4163–7AA●0–0YY0 3RE4163–7CA●0–0YY0 3RE4163–7EA●0–0YY0 1 1 S2 3RT2037
5 10 15 20 25 50 60 3RE4163–8AA●0–0YY0 3RE4163–8CA●0–0YY0 3RE4163–8EA●0–0YY0 1 1 S2 3RT2038

Non-Reversing Contactor, 3-Pole (for both 1-Phase and 3-Phase), Large Enclosure
NEMA Type Enclosure (Large Size)
1-Phase Motor Hp 3-Phase Motor Hp Type 1 Type 3/3R/4/12 Type 4X 304 Stain. Steel Unused
Rating per UL Rating per UL General Purpose, Weatherproof, Watertight, Dust-tight, Auxiliary Contactor
Indoor only Watertight, Dust-tight Corrosion Resistant Contacts Frame (for ref.
115V 208V 230V 208V 230V 460V 575V Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number NO NC Size only)
0.25 0.5 0.75 1.5 2 3 5 3RE4161–5BA●0–0YY0 1 0 S00 3RT2015
0.5 1.5 2 3 3 7.5 10 3RE4161–7BA●0–0YY0 1 0 S00 3RT2017
1 1 1 2 3 5 7.5 3RE4162–3BA●0–0YY0 1 1 S0 3RT2023
1 2 2 3 3 7.5 10 3RE4162–4BA●0–0YY0 Not applicable — Standard enclosure includes 1 1 S0 3RT2024
1 2 3 5 5 10 15 3RE4162–5BA●0–0YY0 extra mounting space for accessories. 1 1 S0 3RT2025
2 3 3 7.5 7.5 15 20 3RE4162–6BA●0–0YY0 1 1 S0 3RT2026
2 5 5 10 10 20 25 3RE4162–7BA●0–0YY0 1 1 S0 3RT2027
3 5 5 10 10 25 25 3RE4162–8BA●0–0YY0 1 1 S0 3RT2028

a For 3-phase controllers, 208 - 600 V coils will be wired secondary (if ordered). For single phase controllers, power transformer secondary (if ordered). 277 - 600 V
for incoming voltage. 24 and120 V coils will be wired 120 and 240 V coils will be wired for incoming voltage. coils do not apply.
as separate source or control power transformer 24 V coils will be wired as separate source or control

4/78 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Enclosed IEC Controls
3RE4 Reversing Contactor, 3-Pole (for both 1-Phase and 3-Phase)
Selection

Ordering Information Coil Selection (●)a


 Replace the (●) with the code from the coil Nominal Voltage Code
table on this page. 24 VAC 50/60 Hz 1
 For factory modifications, 24 VDC 2
see page 4/81 – 4/83. 110/120 VAC 50/60 Hz 3
 For accessories, see page 4/84 – 4/85.
208 VAC 50/60 Hz 4
 For replacement parts, see page 4/85.
220/240 VAC 50/60 Hz 5
 For dimensions, see page 4/86.
277 VAC 60 Hz 6
 For wiring diagrams, see page 4/87 – 4/89.
480 VAC 60 Hz 7
600 VAC 60 Hz 8

Reversing Contactor, 3-Pole (for both 1-Phase and 3-Phase), Standard Enclosure

4
NEMA Type Enclosure (Standard Size)
1-Phase 3-Phase
Motor Hp Motor Hp Type 1 Type 3/3R/4/12 Type 4X 304 Stain. Steel Unused

STARTERS
COMBINATION
Rating per UL Rating per UL General Purpose, Weatherproof, Watertight, Dust-tight, Auxiliary Contactor
Indoor only Watertight, Dust-tight Corrosion Resistant Contacts Frame (for ref.
115V 230V 208V 230V 460V 575V Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number NO NC Size only)
0.25 0.75 1.5 2 3 5 3RE4181–5AA●0–0YY0 3RE4181–5CA●0–0YY0 3RE4181–5EA●0–0YY0 2 2 S00 3RA2315
0.5 2 3 3 7.5 10 3RE4181–7AA●0–0YY0 3RE4181–7CA●0–0YY0 3RE4181–7EA●0–0YY0 2 0 S00 3RA2317
1 1 2 3 5 7.5 3RE4182–3AA●0–0YY0 3RE4182–3CA●0–0YY0 3RE4182–3EA●0–0YY0 2 0 S0 3RA2323
1 2 3 3 7.5 10 3RE4182–4AA●0–0YY0 3RE4182–4CA●0–0YY0 3RE4182–4EA●0–0YY0 2 0 S0 3RA2324
1 3 5 5 10 15 3RE4182–5AA●0–0YY0 3RE4182–5CA●0–0YY0 3RE4182–5EA●0–0YY0 2 0 S0 3RA2325
2 3 7.5 7.5 15 20 3RE4182–6AA●0–0YY0 3RE4182–6CA●0–0YY0 3RE4182–6EA●0–0YY0 2 0 S0 3RA2326
2 5 10 10 20 25 3RE4182–7AA●0–0YY0 3RE4182–7CA●0–0YY0 3RE4182–7EA●0–0YY0 2 0 S0 3RA2327
3 5 10 10 25 25 3RE4182–8AA●0–0YY0 3RE4182–8CA●0–0YY0 3RE4182–8EA●0–0YY0 2 0 S0 3RA2328
3 7.5 10 15 30 40 3RE4183–5AA●0–0YY0 3RE4183–5CA●0–0YY0 3RE4183–5EA●0–0YY0 2 0 S2 3RA2335
3 10 15 15 40 50 3RE4183–6AA●0–0YY0 3RE4183–6CA●0–0YY0 3RE4183–6EA●0–0YY0 2 0 S2 3RA2336
5 10 20 20 50 50 3RE4183–7AA●0–0YY0 3RE4183–7CA●0–0YY0 3RE4183–7EA●0–0YY0 2 0 S2 3RA2337
5 15 20 25 50 60 3RE4183–8AA●0–0YY0 3RE4183–8CA●0–0YY0 3RE4183–8EA●0–0YY0 2 0 S2 3RA2338

Reversing Contactor, 3-Pole (for both 1-Phase and 3-Phase), Large Enclosure
1-Phase 3-Phase NEMA Type Enclosure (Large Size)
Motor Hp Motor Hp Type 1 Type 3/3R/4/12 Type 4X 304 Stain. Steel Unused
Rating per UL Rating per UL General Purpose, Weatherproof, Watertight, Dust-tight, Auxiliary Contactor
Indoor only Watertight, Dust-tight Corrosion Resistant Contacts Frame (for ref.
115V 230V 208V 230V 460V 575V Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number NO NC Size only)
0.25 0.75 1.5 2 3 5 3RE4181–5BA●0–0YY0 2 0 S00 3RA2315
0.5 2 3 3 7.5 10 3RE4181–7BA●0–0YY0 2 0 S00 3RA2317
1 1 2 3 5 7.5 3RE4182–3BA●0–0YY0 2 0 S0 3RA2323
1 2 3 3 7.5 10 3RE4182–4BA●0–0YY0 Not applicable — Standard enclosure includes 2 0 S0 3RA2324
1 3 5 5 10 15 3RE4182–5BA●0–0YY0 extra mounting space for accessories. 2 0 S0 3RA2325
2 3 7.5 7.5 15 20 3RE4182–6BA●0–0YY0 2 0 S0 3RA2326
2 5 10 10 20 25 3RE4182–7BA●0–0YY0 2 0 S0 3RA2327
3 5 10 10 25 25 3RE4182–8BA●0–0YY0 2 0 S0 3RA2328

a For 3-phase controllers, 208 - 600 V coils will be wired secondary (if ordered). For single phase controllers, power transformer secondary (if ordered). 277 - 600 V
for incoming voltage. 24 and120 V coils will be wired 120 and 240 V coils will be wired for incoming voltage. coils do not apply.
as separate source or control power transformer 24 V coils will be wired as separate source or control

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/79


Enclosed IEC Controls
Selection Tables for 3RE4 Overload Relays
Selection

Selection Tables for 3RE4 Overload Relays


Selection Information
 Replace the (♦♦) within the incomplete
3RE4 catalog number with a
code selected from the tables below.
The frame size must match that
of the 3RE4 product.

Thermal Solid-State
Overload Relay Overload Relay

Thermal Overload Relays, Trip Class 10, Single and Three Phase
Features and technical characteristics:
4

n Phase failure sensitivity n Manual and automatic RESET (selectable) n STOP button
n Includes NC trip contact and NO n Switch position indicator n Sealable cover (optional)
COMBINATION
STARTERS

alarm contact n TEST function n Screw-type terminals

Current Thermal Current Thermal Current Thermal


Adjustment Code Overload Relay Adjustment Code Overload Relay Adjustment Code Overload Relay
Range (Amp) ♦♦ (reference only) Range (Amp) ♦♦ (reference only) Range (Amp) ♦♦ (reference only)
Frame Size S00 Frame Size S0 Frame Size S2
0.7 - 1 0J 3RU2116-0JB0 1.8 - 2.5 1C 3RU2126-1CB0 22 - 32 4E 3RU2136-4EB0
0.9 - 1.25 0K 3RU2116-0KB0 2.2 - 3.2 1D 3RU2126-1DB0 28 - 40 4F 3RU2136-4FB0
1.1 - 1.6 1A 3RU2116-1AB0 2.8 - 4 1E 3RU2126-1EB0 36 - 45 4G 3RU2136-4GB0
1.4 - 2 1B 3RU2116-1BB0 3.5 - 5 1F 3RU2126-1FB0 40 - 50 4H 3RU2136-4HB0
1.8 - 2.5 1C 3RU2116-1CB0 4.5 - 6.3 1G 3RU2126-1GB0 47 - 57 4Q 3RU2136-4QB0
2.2 - 3.2 1D 3RU2116-1DB0 5.5 - 8 1H 3RU2126-1HB0 54 - 65 4J 3RU2136-4JB0
2.8 - 4 1E 3RU2116-1EB0 7 - 10 1J 3RU2126-1JB0 62 - 73 4K 3RU2136-4KB0
3.5 - 5 1F 3RU2116-1FB0 9 - 12.5 1K 3RU2126-1KB0 70 - 80 4R 3RU2136-4RB0
4.5 - 6.3 1G 3RU2116-1GB0 11 - 16 4A 3RU2126-4AB0
5.5 - 8 1H 3RU2116-1HB0 14 - 20 4B 3RU2126-4BB0
7 - 10 1J 3RU2116-1JB0 17 - 22 4C 3RU2126-4CB0
9 - 12.5 1K 3RU2116-1KB0 20 - 25 4D 3RU2126-4DB0
11 - 16 4A 3RU2116-4AB0 23 - 28 4N 3RU2126-4NB0
27 - 32 4E 3RU2126-4EB0
30 - 36 4P 3RU2126-4PB0
34 - 40 4F 3RU2126-4FB0

Solid-State Overload Relays, Selectable Trip Class 5, 10, 20 and 30, Three Phase Only
Features and technical characteristics:
n Overload, phase failure and unbalance n Includes NC trip contact and NO alarm n Switch position indicator
protection contact n TEST function and self-monitoring
n Internal ground fault detection (selectable) n Manual and automatic RESET (selectable) n Sealable cover (optional)
n Internal power supply n Electrical remote RESET integrated n Screw-type terminals

Current Solid-State Current Solid-State Current Solid-State


Adjustment Code Overload Relay Adjustment Code Overload Relay Adjustment Code Overload Relay
Range (Amp) ♦♦ (reference only) Range (Amp) ♦♦ (reference only) Range (Amp) ♦♦ (reference only)
Frame Size S00 Frame Size S0 Frame Size S2
0.32 - 1.25 4N 3RB3113-4NB0 0.32 - 1.25 4N 3RB3123-4NB0 12 - 50 4U 3RB3133-4UB0
1-4 4P 3RB3113-4PB0 1-4 4P 3RB3123-4PB0 20 - 80 4W 3RB3133-4WB0
3 - 12 4S 3RB3113-4SB0 3 - 12 4S 3RB3123-4SB0
4 - 16 4T 3RB3113-4TB0 6 - 25 4Q 3RB3123-4QB0
10 - 40 4V 3RB3123-4VB0

4/80 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Enclosed IEC Controls
3RE4 Factory Modifications
Selection

Selection Information
 These tables apply to 3RE4 products.
 Replace the last two characters of the
3RE4 catalog number (Y0), with a code selected
from the tables below.

Start-Stop Push Button Combinations


Description Code (Y0) Restrictions
(No modifications included) Y0 —
Start-Stop Push Buttons B0 1
Start-Stop Push Buttons, Red On Pilot Light B1 1
Start-Stop Push Buttons, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light B2 1
Start-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 208:120V B3 1 and 2
Start-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 208:120V, Red On Pilot Light B4 1 and 2
Start-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 208:120V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light B5 1 and 2

4
Start-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 208:24V B6 1 and 2
Start-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 208:24V, Red On Pilot Light B7 1 and 2

STARTERS
COMBINATION
Start-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 208:24V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light B8 1 and 2
Start-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 240:120V C0 1 and 2
Start-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 240:120V, Red On Pilot Light C1 1 and 2
Start-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 240:120V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light C2 1 and 2
Start-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 240:24V C3 1 and 3
Start-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 240:24V, Red On Pilot Light C4 1 and 3
Start-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 240:24V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light C5 1 and 3
Start-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:120V C6 1, 2 and 4
Start-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:120V, Red On Pilot Light C7 1, 2 and 4
Start-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:120V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light C8 1, 2 and 4
Start-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:24V D0 1, 3 and 4
Start-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:24V, Red On Pilot Light D1 1, 3 and 4
Start-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:24V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light D2 1, 3 and 4
Start-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 600:120V, Red On Pilot Light P0 1, 2 and 4

Fwd-Rev-Stop Push Button Combinations


Description Code (Y0) Restrictions
(No modifications included) Y0 —
Fwd-Rev-Stop Push Buttons D3 5
Fwd-Rev-Stop Push Buttons, Red On Pilot Light D4 5
Fwd-Rev-Stop Push Buttons, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light D5 5
Fwd-Rev-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 208:120V D6 2 and 5
Fwd-Rev-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 208:120V, Red On Pilot Light D7 2 and 5
Fwd-Rev-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 208:120V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light D8 2 and 5
Fwd-Rev-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 208:24V E0 3 and 5
Fwd-Rev-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 208:24V, Red On Pilot Light E1 3 and 5
Fwd-Rev-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 208:24V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light E2 3 and 5
Fwd-Rev-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 240:120V E3 2 and 5
Fwd-Rev-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 240:120V, Red On Pilot Light E4 2 and 5
Fwd-Rev-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 240:120V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light E5 2 and 5
Fwd-Rev-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 240:24V E6 3 and 5
Fwd-Rev-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 240:24V, Red On Pilot Light E7 3 and 5
Fwd-Rev-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 240:24V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light E8 3 and 5
Fwd-Rev-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:120V F0 2, 4 and 5
Fwd-Rev-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:120V, Red On Pilot Light F1 2, 4 and 5
Fwd-Rev-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:120V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light F2 2, 4 and 5
Fwd-Rev-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:24V F3 3, 4 and 5
Fwd-Rev-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:24V, Red On Pilot Light F4 3, 4 and 5
Fwd-Rev-Stop Push Buttons, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:24V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light F5 3, 4 and 5

Restrictions:
1. Valid only with non-reversing controllers.
2. Valid only with 120 V coil.
a ACPT in a NEMA type 1 enclosure with a size S00 or S0 controller 3. Valid only with 24 VAC coil.
requires a large size enclosure. A CPT in a NEMA type 1 enclosure
with a size S2 controller requires a standard size enclosure. 4. Not valid with single-phase controllers.
All other enclosure types may be standard size. 5. Not valid in NEMA Type 1 enclosures.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/81


Enclosed IEC Controls
3RE4 Factory Modifications
Selection

Selection Information
 These tables apply to 3RE4 products.
 Replace the last two characters of the
3RE4 catalog number (Y0), with a code selected
from the tables below.

Hand-Off-Auto Selector Switch Combinations


Description Code (Y0) Restrictions
(No modifications included) Y0 —
Hand-Off-Auto Selector Switch F6 1
Hand-Off-Auto Selector Switch, Red On Pilot Light F7 1
Hand-Off-Auto Selector Switch, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light F8 1
Hand-Off-Auto Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 208:120V G0 1 and 2
Hand-Off-Auto Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 208:120V, Red On Pilot Light G1 1 and 2
Hand-Off-Auto Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 208:120V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light G2 1 and 2
Hand-Off-Auto Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 208:24V G3 1 and 3
4

Hand-Off-Auto Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 208:24V, Red On Pilot Light G4 1 and 3
Hand-Off-Auto Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 208:24V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light G5 1 and 3
COMBINATION
STARTERS

Hand-Off-Auto Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 240:120V G6 1 and 2


Hand-Off-Auto Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 240:120V, Red On Pilot Light G7 1 and 2
Hand-Off-Auto Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 240:120V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light G8 1 and 2
Hand-Off-Auto Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 240:24V H0 1 and 3
Hand-Off-Auto Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 240:24V, Red On Pilot Light H1 1 and 3
Hand-Off-Auto Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 240:24V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light H2 1 and 3
Hand-Off-Auto Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:120V H3 1, 2 and 4
Hand-Off-Auto Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:120V, Red On Pilot Light H4 1, 2 and 4
Hand-Off-Auto Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:120V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light H5 1, 2 and 4
Hand-Off-Auto Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:24V H6 1, 3 and 4
Hand-Off-Auto Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:24V, Red On Pilot Light H7 1, 3 and 4
Hand-Off-Auto Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:24V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light H8 1, 3 and 4
Hand-Off-Auto Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 600:120V, Red On Pilot Light P1 1, 2 and 4

On-Off Selector Switch Combinations


Description Code (Y0) Restrictions
(No modifications included) Y0 —
On-Off Selector Switch J0 1
On-Off Selector Switch, Red On Pilot Light J1 1
On-Off Selector Switch, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light J2 1
On-Off Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 208:120V J3 1 and 2
On-Off Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 208:120V, Red On Pilot Light J4 1 and 2
On-Off Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 208:120V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light J5 1 and 2
On-Off Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 208:24V J6 1 and 3
On-Off Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 208:24V, Red On Pilot Light J7 1 and 3
On-Off Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 208:24V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light J8 1 and 3
On-Off Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 240:120V K0 1 and 2
On-Off Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 240:120V, Red On Pilot Light K1 1 and 2
On-Off Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 240:120V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light K2 1 and 2
On-Off Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 240:24V K3 1 and 3
On-Off Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 240:24V, Red On Pilot Light K4 1 and 3
On-Off Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 240:24V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light K5 1 and 3
On-Off Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:120V K6 1, 2 and 4
On-Off Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:120V, Red On Pilot Light K7 1, 2 and 4
On-Off Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:120V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light K8 1, 2 and 4
On-Off Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:24V L0 1, 3 and 4
On-Off Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:24V, Red On Pilot Light L1 1, 3 and 4
On-Off Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:24V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light L2 1, 3 and 4

Restrictions:
1. Valid only with non-reversing controllers.
a ACPT in a NEMA type 1 enclosure with a size S00 or S0 controller
2. Valid only with 120 V coil.
requires a large size enclosure. A CPT in a NEMA type 1 enclosure 3. Valid only with 24 VAC coil.
with a size S2 controller requires a standard size enclosure.
All other enclosure types may be standard size. 4. Not valid with single-phase controllers.

4/82 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Enclosed IEC Controls
3RE4 Factory Modifications
Selection

Selection Information
 These tables apply to 3RE4 products.
 Replace the last two characters of the
3RE4 catalog number (Y0), with a code selected
from the tables below.

Fwd-Off-Rev Selector Switch Combinations


Description Code (Y0) Restrictions
(No modifications included) Y0 —
Fwd-Off-Rev Selector Switch L3 —
Fwd-Off-Rev Selector Switch, Red On Pilot Light L4 —
Fwd-Off-Rev Selector Switch, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light L5 —
Fwd-Off-Rev Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 208:120V L6 1
Fwd-Off-Rev Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 208:120V, Red On Pilot Light L7 1
Fwd-Off-Rev Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 208:120V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light L8 1
Fwd-Off-Rev Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 208:24V M0 2

4
Fwd-Off-Rev Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 208:24V, Red On Pilot Light M1 2
Fwd-Off-Rev Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 208:24V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light M2 2

STARTERS
COMBINATION
Fwd-Off-Rev Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 240:120V M3 1
Fwd-Off-Rev Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 240:120V, Red On Pilot Light M4 1
Fwd-Off-Rev Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 240:120V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light M5 1
Fwd-Off-Rev Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 240:24V M6 2
Fwd-Off-Rev Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 240:24V, Red On Pilot Light M7 2
Fwd-Off-Rev Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 240:24V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light M8 2
Fwd-Off-Rev Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:120V N0 1 and 3
Fwd-Off-Rev Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:120V, Red On Pilot Light N1 1 and 3
Fwd-Off-Rev Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:120V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light N2 1 and 3
Fwd-Off-Rev Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:24V N3 2 and 3
Fwd-Off-Rev Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:24V, Red On Pilot Light N4 2 and 3
Fwd-Off-Rev Selector Switch, CPT Std Capacitya 480/240:24V, Red On Pilot Light, Green Off Pilot Light N5 2 and 3

Restrictions:
1. Valid only with 120 V coil.
2. Valid only with 24 VAC coil.
a ACPT in a NEMA type 1 enclosure with a size S00 or S0 controller
3. Not valid with single-phase controllers.
requires a large size enclosure. A CPT in a NEMA type 1 enclosure
with a size S2 controller requires a standard size enclosure.
All other enclosure types may be standard size.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/83


Enclosed IEC Controls
3RE4 Field Modifications and Accessories
Selection

Pilot Devices
Enclosure Catalog
Devicea NEMA Type Number

1 49SDPB5
Start-Stop Push Buttons,
momentaryb
3/3R/4/12 & 4X 49SDP05

1 NA
Fwd-Rev-Stop Push Buttons,
momentaryb
49SDPB5 49SDSBJ 49SDSB4 3/3R/4/12 & 4X 49SDP02

1 49SDSBJ
Hand-Off-Auto Selector Switch
3/3R/4/12 & 4X 49SDS01

Start Push Button Stop Push Button 1 49SDSB4


On-Off Selector Switch
3/3R/4/12 & 4X 49SDS04
4

1 49SDSBJ
Fwd-Off-Rev Selector Switch
2-Position Selector Switch 3-Position Selector Switch 49SDS02
COMBINATION
STARTERS

3/3R/4/12 & 4X

Pilot Lights
Enclosure Catalog
Devicea NEMA Type Voltage Number

Light module and lens color: 24 to 240 V AC/DC 49SDLBU


RED, GREEN, and AMBER.
1
Legends include:
ON, RUN, OFFc, OLR TRIPPEDd 277 V AC 49SDLBL

24 to 240 V AC/DC 49SDLB7RU


1
277 V AC 49SDLB7RL
Red FORWARD, Red REVERSE
3/3R/4/12 & 4X 24 to 240 V AC/DC 49SDL07RU
3/3R/4/12 & 4X 277 V AC 49SDL07RL
24 to 240 V AC/DC 49SDLB7GU
1
277 V AC 49SDLB7GL
Green FORWARD, Green REVERSE
3/3R/4/12 & 4X 24 to 240 V AC/DC 49SDL07GU
3/3R/4/12 & 4X 277 V AC 49SDL07GL
3/3R/4/12 & 4X 24 to 240 V AC/DC 49SDL0BRU
Red ON
3/3R/4/12 & 4X 277 V AC 49SDL0BRL
3/3R/4/12 & 4X 24 to 240 V AC/DC 49SDL0ARU
Red OFFc
3/3R/4/12 & 4X 277 V AC 49SDL0ARL
3/3R/4/12 & 4X 24 to 240 V AC/DC 49SDL0BGU
Green ON
3/3R/4/12 & 4X 277 V AC 49SDL0BGL
3/3R/4/12 & 4X 24 to 240 V AC/DC 49SDL0AGU
Green OFFc
3/3R/4/12 & 4X 277 V AC 49SDL0AGL

Auxiliary Contacts
Device Frame Size Catalog Number
1 NO & 1 NC laterally mounted, S00 3RH2911-1DA11
screw terminals S0 and S2 3RH2921-1DA11
2 NO laterally mounted, S00 NA
screw terminals S0 and S2 3RH2921-1DA20
2 NC laterally mounted, S00 3RH2911-1DA02
screw terminals S0 and S2 3RH2921-1DA02

a 3SU 22 mm devices. Pilot lights include LED bulbs. c To use as an OFF indicator, the contactor must have a d To use as an overload relay (OLR) trip indicator, the
b Each contactor must have a normally open (NO) normally closed (NC) auxiliary contact available for the OLR must have a normally open (NO) auxiliary contact
auxiliary contact available for seal-in circuit. Order circuit. Order separately as needed. available for the circuit.
separately as needed.

4/84 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Enclosed IEC Controls
3RE4 Field Modifications, Accessories, and Replacement Parts
Selection

Control Power Transformersa


Catalog Transformer Table
Device Frame Size Number Primary Volts Secondary Volts Code
45 VA, 1-secondary fuse S00 KT*050 120 24 1
75 VA, 2-primary and 1-secondary fuses S0 & S2 KT*075 208 24 G
208 120 H
240/480 24 4
240/480 120 8
 Replace * with code from Transformer Table.
277 24 5
 45VA CPT does not require primary fuses per NEC. 277 120 7
600 24 6
600 120 9

Control Relays and Timersab


Catalog Coil Voltage Table
Device Number Voltage Code
Control relay, 4 NO / 0 NC 3RH2140-1●●●0 24 VAC 50/60 Hz AB0
Control relay, 3 NO / 1 NC 3RH2131-1●●●0 24 VDC BB4

4
Control relay, 2 NO / 2 NC 3RH2122-1●●●0 110/120 VAC 50/60 Hz AK6
ON-delay timer, 0.05 sec. – 100 hr., 24 – 240V AC/DC 3RP2525-1BW30 208 VAC 50/60 Hz AM2

STARTERS
COMBINATION
OFF-delay timer, 0.05 sec. – 100 hr., 24 – 240V AC/DC 3RP2535-1AW30 220/240 VAC 50/60 Hz AP6
277 VAC 60 Hz —
 Replace ●●● with code from Coil Voltage Table. 480 VAC 60 Hz AV6
 Relays and timers include screw terminals.
Relay Timer 600 VAC 60 Hz —

Miscellaneous

Device Catalog Number


1-pole fuse block for control circuit, 600V / 30A, DIN rail mounted, CC fuses (not included) 3NW7513-0HG

2-pole fuse block for control circuit, 600V / 30A, DIN rail mounted, CC fuses (not included) 3NW7523-0HG

Ground Lug, 3 Conductor, 2-14 AWG AL/CU Wire 75D28182001

Terminal block, 1-point unwired, DIN rail mounted, 6mm, 26Ab 8WA10111DF11
3NW7513-0HG 8WA1808
End retainer for DIN railb 8WA1808

DIN rail kit, 35mm x 5 in, for mounting optional accessoriesa MTR5

75D28182001 MTR5 Sealable cover for rotary dial on overload relay (10 per package) 3RV29 08-0P

Replacement Parts

Device Catalog Number


Contactor parts (Obtain Cat. No. from device and refer to Industrial Control Catalog). —
Overload relay (Obtain Cat. No. from device and refer to Industrial Control Catalog). —
Overload Relay Reset Operator for all NEMA Type enclosures 49MBRS

Enclosure Kits
Type 1 Type 1 Type 3/3R/4/12 Type 4X 304 S.S.
Controller Frame Size & Type
NR = Non-Reversing Standard Size Large Sizee Standard Sizef Standard Sizef
R = Reversing Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number
S00 NR, S0 NR 49EC14EB110705R 49EC14GB140807Rc 49EFN121006XRX 49EFW121006XRX
S00 R, S0 R 49EC14GB140807Rc 49EC14IB201208Rd 49EFN121006XRX 49EFW121006XRX
S2 NR, S2 R 49EC14IB201208Rdf — 49EFN141208XRX 49EFW141208XRX

a The accessory in a NEMA type 1 enclosure requires a c Enclosure 49EC14GB140807R requires mounting adaptor e These large enclosures are required for certain
large size enclosure. All other enclosure types may be plate 49EFA070500XXA which is sold seperately. accessories as indicated in the Field Modification pages.
standard size. d Enclosure 49EC14IB201208R requires mounting adaptor f These standard size enclosures include extra mounting
b Requires DIN rail kit or equivalent. plate 49EFA060800XXA which is sold seperately. space for accessories.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/85


Enclosed IEC Controls
3RE4 Outline Diagrams
Technical information

A D

C
4 STARTERS
COMBINATION

Figure 1 Figure 2

3RE4 Non-Combination Type Controllers

Enclosure Outline Dimensions Mounting Conduit Size


Type Contactor Rating Fig. A B C D E K1 K2 K3
S00 NR, S0 NR 1 10.97 6.41 5.03 8.22 4.62 0.5 0.50-0.75 0.75–1
1 (standard size) S00 R, S0 R 1 13.53 7.97 6.38 10.25 6.00 0.50-0.75 0.75-1 1-1.25
S2 NR, S2 R 1 19.12 11.38 7.69 15.62 8.25 0.50-0.75 1-1.25 1.5-2
S00 NR, S0 NR 1 13.53 7.97 6.38 10.25 6.00 0.50-0.75 0.75-1 1-1.25
1 (large size)
S00 R, S0 R 1 19.12 11.38 7.69 15.62 8.25 0.50-0.75 1-1.25 1.5-2
S00 NR, S00 R, S0 NR, S0 R 2 12.00 10.00 6.00 11.30 7.44 — — —
3/3R/4/12 & 4X 304 SS
S2 NR, S2 R 2 14.00 12.00 8.00 13.30 9.44 — — —
Sxx = Frame size; NR = Non-reversing; R = Reversing
Mounting screw G is 0.25”.
Dimensions are in inches.

4/86 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Enclosed IEC Controls
3RE4 Wiring Diagrams
Technical information

4
STARTERS
COMBINATION

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/87


Enclosed IEC Controls
3RE4 Wiring Diagrams
Technical information
4 STARTERS
COMBINATION

4/88 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Enclosed IEC Controls
3RE4 Wiring Diagrams
Technical information

4
STARTERS
COMBINATION

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 4/89


Enclosed IEC Controls
3RE4 IEC Controllers
Notes
4 STARTERS
COMBINATION

4/90 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Fast Bus Busbar System
Industrial Control Product Catalog 2021

contents
Fast Bus busbar adapter system
5 Section

60 mm system Page
Selection and ordering data
• Busbar holders 5/9

5
• Fast Bus adapter shoes 5/11
• Incoming supply terminals 5/6

SYSTEMS
POWER DISTRIBUTION
• Copper busbar 5/6
• Busbar covers 5/6
• Other accessories 5/6

Overview 5/2
Introduction 5/3
Technical Data 5/3
Dimension drawings 5/10-5/15

FBCB Fast Bus circuit breakers Fast Bus combination starters

FBCB Fast Bus main and feeder 3RA2 Fast Bus combinations starters
circuit breakers Page 3RA6 Fast Bus compact starters
Selection and ordering data Selection and ordering data
• Fast Bus circuit breakers assemblies and kits 5/7 • See Section 4
• Fast Bus adapter shoes for VL breakers 5/8

(Section was last modified on 08/23/21) Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 5/1
Fast Bus

Fast Bus Busbar Adapter System


Overview

Busbar adapter systems

Busbar adapter systems


with busbar centerline spacing of 60 mm
5 SYSTEMS
POWER DISTRIBUTION

60 mm busbar system Page Page


for sharp-edged copper busbars Busbar holder 3RA2 Combination Starters see
to DIN 46 433, End and intermediate holders 5/6 section 4
width 20 mm to 30 mm, for flat copper profiles
thickness 5 mm and 10 mm
Fast Bus main circuit breakers 5/6 Incoming supply terminals 5/6
from 15 to 500A

Fast Bus circuit breakers 5/7


from 15 to 500A

5/2 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Fast Bus

Fast Bus Busbar Adapter System


Introduction

General Features Benefits


The Fast Bus Multi-Motor Control system • Simple economical installation • Saves installation time
is a 3-phase insulated busbar system • Compact design • Reduces space requirements
and is ideal for space saving in panel
designs. The system saves considerable • Requires fewer mounting holes • Minimizes layout time
line side wiring and space for multi-motor • Domestic and International approvals • Allows flexibility for domestic and
panels. It is also ideal for panels where export business
several feeder breakers are used and will • Touch safe
save significant wiring space and wiring • Protection for maintenance personnel
• Modular design
labor. The system is also ideal for future • Improves equipment mounting density
• Provision for system expansion
expansion planning. when building
• Reduces time and costs associated
control panels. SIRIUS 3RV/3RT starter • Clip-on shoes provide mechanical
with system expansion
combinations and Siemens circuit and electrical connections to panel
breakers are all adaptable to Fast Bus for mounted busbars • Reduces mounting and wiring time
convenient mounting and faster replace- and provides trouble free connec-
• Main and Feeder breakers mount to
ment times. tions
busbars
• Allows for quick retrofitting of breakers
Fast Bus is ideal for industrial applica-
tions where system availability is
important.

How to Select Fast Bus


1) Determine the required load.
2) Select method to power Fastbus.
—Main lug up to 800A using a single
set of lugs or up to 1400A using a

5
double set of lugs.
—Circuit breakers, 15A to 500A

SYSTEMS
POWER DISTRIBUTION
If load exceeds 500A, the CB must be
separately panel mounted and fed to
a main lug infeed module.
3) Select 3RV MSP & 3RT contactor
components and appropriate adapter
shoe or select preassembled 3RA
starters. See section 4.
4) Select appropriate length busbar,
busbar holders, insulation covers
and any other required components.

General Ratings of Fastbus System


IEC Domestic
Rated operating voltage 690V 600V
Rated insulation voltage, IEC VDE AC 1000V N/A
Temperature stability Up to 105 degrees C N/A
Busbar support and adapter shoe material Glass-reinforced polyamide Same
Color RAL 7035, light gray Same

For technical information


Ampacity
on E and F frame circuit
Busbar thickness and width breakers used as main
Thermal busbar currents, E-Cu, bare, at 35 °C ambient temperature in
5 x 20 mm 3/16” x 3/4” 362A and feeder breakers, see
accordance with DIN 43 6711
5 x 25 mm 3/16” x 1” 432A section 17
Busbar System Thermal current at
5 x 30 mm 3/16” x 1 1/8” 500A dimensions 65 °C 85 °C 105 °C
Busbar temperature
10 x 20 mm 3/8” x 3/4” 564A mm mm A A A
10 x 25 mm 3/8” x 1” 660A 20 x 5 60 274 362 430
25 x 5 60 327 432 513
10 x 30 mm 3/8” x 1 1/8” 756A 30 x 5 60 379 500 595
720mm2 --- 1400A
20 x 10 60 427 564 670
30 x 10 60 573 756 900

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 5/3


Fast Bus

Fast Bus Busbar Adapter System


Introduction

Fast Bus set-up Feeder/branch circuit Short-circuit strength


The permissible busbar temper- according to UL 508A
The Fast Bus system is designed ature is a decisive factor when The short-circuit strength of the
to be easy to use and to save dimensioning the busbars. The The feeder circuit is that part of busbar system is dependent on
set up time. busbar temperature is depen- a circuit which comes in front of the spacing of the busbar hold-
dent on the current, the current the last short circuit protection ers and on the busbar cross-
8US Busbar holders device (SCPD). The branch cir-
distribution, the busbar cross- section.
The 8US busbar holders are section, the busbar surface, the cuit is that part of the circuit
which follows after the last short The short-circuit strength of the
designed to accommodate position of the busbar, the con-
circuit protection device. When whole system is dependent on
vection and the ambient temper-
5

ampacities up to 1400A. In some the short-circuit strength of the


ature. The values stated in the the 8US1 busbar system is used
cases, the busbar holder will in a switchgear which must busbar system and the
accept busbars in either 5mm or table on page 5/3 can only be
comply with UL directives, it is components that are mounted
POWER DISTRIBUTION
SYSTEMS

10mm widths. Refer to page 5/6 considered as reference values


because the conditions vary important to establish whether it to the system.
for selection details. is to be used in the feeder circuit
with each location. The values
are based on constant current or the branch circuit. Compo-
High quality material nents used in the feeder circuit
over the whole busbar length.
Busbar supports and fuse bases require larger clearance in air
The trend toward busbars and creepage distances than in
are manufactured from glass- Applications
fiber reinforced, thermoplastic proves most advantageous the branch circuit.
polyester with the when the incoming supply is The 8US Fast Bus distribution
centrally located and the load is Simple Fast Bus system system is ideal for control panel
color RAL 7035, light gray. The
material ensures excellent distributed symmetrically on The two illustrations above show builders with multiple motor
mechanical, chemical and elec- both sides. the very basic items needed applications. These applica-
trical properties. Furthermore, when setting up a Fastbus sys- tions are most common in the
For the assemblies of a busbar
the material has an extremely tem. material handling, automotive,
system in the feeder circuit the
low flammability and meets the food processing, pharmaceuti-
UL directives specify compo- 8US1 Busbar holder (5/6)
requirements of UL 94 V0. cal and paper processing
nents with large clearance in air
and creepage distances (see 8US1 Ground busbar support industries.
the table below). Components of (shown attached however can be
8WC Busbar and mounted separately 5/6)
busbar systems the 8US1 busbar system which
meet this requirement can be Ground busbar available in
The most common size busbar found in this chapter. 5 x 20 mm to 10 x 30 mm
for applications in the US is the
Note: 8WC Busbar (8WC5053
8WC5053 (20 mm x 5 mm), how-
ever there are other styles avail- The design of an 8US1 busbar shown) FBB36 Busbar (5/6)
able depending on your appli- system for use in the feeder cir-
cation. cuit always presumes the use of
the UL base plate (8US19 22-
Busbar systems with 60 mm bus- 2UA01) so that the clearance in
bar center-to-center clearance air and creepage distance
have now become firmly estab- requirements are met.
lished in the US market.

Clearance in air Creepage distance


Between live parts 25.4 mm (1 inch) 50.8 mm (2 inch)
Between live parts and grounded, 25.4 mm (1 inch) 25.4 mm (1 inch)
non-insulated metal parts

5/4 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Fast Bus

Fast Bus Busbar Adapter System


Introduction

Fast Bus combination starters and group installation assemblies


Ratings for Group Installations per Standard Installation, NEC 430-52 Group Installation, NEC 430-53
NEC 430-53
Group Installation is an approach to build-
ing multiple motor control systems in
accordance with Section 430-53 of the
National Electrical Code. In Group installa-
tion, multiple motor starters can be
grouped under one short circuit protective
device. The 3RV MSPs have been UL
listed for use in Group Installations both
with and without 3RT contactors when
mounted on the Fast Bus system. A 3RT
contactor is added when remote opera-
tion of the motor is required.

Maximum rating of Group Branch Short Circuit


FLA FLA Circuit Protective Device
MSP Amp Amp Current Ratings 1) 2)
Type Range Range Fuse Circuit Breaker 240V 480V 600V
3RV201 S00 0.11-12.5 The main fuse should The main CB should be 65kA — 30kA
3RV201 S00 0.11-16 be selected based on selected based on the 65kA 65kA —

5
3RV202 S0 3.5-12.5 the FUSE selection CIRCUIT BREAKER 65kA — 30kA
3RV202 S0 3.5-25 procedure listed below. selection procedure 65kA 65kA —
3RV202 S0 28-32 listed below. 65kA 50kA —

SYSTEMS
POWER DISTRIBUTION
3RV202 S0 36-40 65kA 12kA —
3RV203 S2 11-50 65kA 65kA 25kA
3RV204 S3 28-100 65kA 65kA 30kA

The selection of components for Circuit Breaker Selection Fuse Selection


Group Installation is a simple pro- Select a circuit breaker (CB) between: Calculate the maximum fuse size per
cess of the following three steps: Minimum CB size (per NEC430-110): NEC430-53c.
1. Selection of the Branch Circuit Pro- Sum of all motor FLC (per NEC table Max Fuse Size =175% x FLC of larg-
tective Device, fuse or circuit 430-150) x115%. est motor + FLC of all other motors
breaker. Maximum CB size (per NEC430-53c): (FLC’s from NEC table 430-150).
2. Selection of the 3RA Motor Starter 250% x FLC of the largest motor +
based on the motor Full Load Amps. FLC of all other motors.

Assembled Starter FLA Short Circuit


Starter Frame Amp Current Ratings (Type E) 1 )
Type Size Range 240V 480Y/277V 600Y/347V

3RA201 S00 0.11-12.5 — — 30kA


3RA201 S00 0.11-16 65kA 65kA —
3RA202 S0 0.45-12.5 — — 30kA
3RA202 S0 0.45-25 65kA 65kA —
3RA202 S0 28-32 50kA 50kA —
3RA203 S2 11-50 65kA 65kA 25kA
3RA204 S3 28-75 — — 30kA
3RA204 S3 28-100 65kA 65kA —

1) Branch Circuit Protective Device for 480V-Ratings: The appropriate BCPD need to be determined in accordance with the National Electrical Code, Article 430-53 and the
application. The following devices are permitted:
Fuses: Classes RK1, RK5, J, G, T, CC or Circuit breakers: Listed Siemens type, with a marked short-circuit rating equal or larger than the available short-circuit
current rating. These devices were tested for group installation use at the above levels without any upstream branch circuit device.
2) 3RA2 used as Manual Motor Controller; Branch Circuit Protective Device for 600V-Ratings: Max. Class J 50A
3) Starter sizes S00,S0 and S3 require additional type E line side terminal adaptors on the MSP for type F applications. See section 1 accessories

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 5/5


Fast Bus

Fast Bus Busbar Adapter System


60 mm system

Selection and ordering data

Busbar holder Insulating Base Plate Busbar 3-phase

End cover

Busbar holder
Insulating Base Plate
End cover
Busbar 3-phase Ground
Busbar Neuteral or PE Busbar Neuteral or PE Terminals for Round busbar
Ground busbar holder Conductors holder
Terminals for Round
Conductors

Description UL Current UL508A Order No. Pack


rating Compliance1) Units
Base plate
3-pole system flat 230 mm x 1100 mm — required 8US19 22-2UA01

8US1922-2UA01 Copper Busbar with tin plating


12 mm x 5 mm x 1200 mm (47.25") for 60 mm systems 150A yes FBB12X512 3 pcs
5

12 mm x 10 mm x 1200 mm (47.25") for 60 mm systems 300A yes FBB12X1012 3 pcs


8WC5 12 mm x 10 mm x 2400 mm (94.49") for 60 mm systems 300A yes FBB12X1024 3 pcs
20 mm x 5 mm x 914 mm (36") for 60 mm systems 362A yes FBB36 3 pcs
POWER DISTRIBUTION
SYSTEMS

20 mm x 5 mm x 1200 mm (47.25") for 60 mm systems 362A yes FBB20X512 3 pcs


8US1948-2AA00 20 mm x 5 mm x 1524 mm (60”) for 60 mm systems 362A yes FBB60 3 pcs
20 mm x 5 mm x 2000 mm (78.74”) for 60 mm systems 362A yes 8WC5053 3 pcs
25 mm x 5 mm x 2000 mm (78.74”) for 60 mm systems 432A yes 8WC5054 3 pcs
30 mm x 5 mm x 1200 mm (47.25") for 60 mm systems 500A yes FBB30X512 3 pcs
30 mm x 5 mm x 2000 mm (78.74”) for 60 mm systems 500A yes 8WC5055 3 pcs
20 mm x 10 mm x 2000 mm (78.74") for 60 mm systems 564A yes 8WC5063 3 pcs
30 mm x 10 mm x 1200 mm (47.25") for 60 mm systems 756A yes FBB30X1012 3 pcs
8US1922-1AC00 30 mm x 10 mm x 2000 mm (78.74") for 60 mm systems 756A yes 8WC5065 3 pcs
500 mm² x 2400 mm (94.49") Twin T (TT) Busbar 1200A yes FBBTT50024 1 pc
8US1923-3UA01 720 mm² x 2400 mm (94.49”) Twin T (TT) Busbar 1400A yes 8US1948-2AA00 1 pc
Busbar holder (end and intermediate)
3-pole with inside mounting for 20 mm and 30 mm x 5 mm or 10 mm — yes 8US19 23-3UA01
3-pole with inside mounting for 25mm x 5mm or x 10mm — — 8US19 23-3AA00
3-pole with inside mounting for Twin T (TT) w/ end cover — yes 8US19 43-3AA01
Busbar holder end cover
8US1923-1AA01 3-pole end cover fits 8US19 23-3UA01 and 8US1923-3AA01 required 8US19 22-1AC00
Ground Busbar holder
1-pole with inside mounting for 20 mm - 30 mm x 5 mm or 10 mm2) n/a 8US19 23-1AA01
Cover profiles for Busbars
for 5 mm busbars up to 30 mm wide 1000 mm length — required 8US19 22-2AA00
8US1922-2AA00
for 10 mm busbas up to 30 mm 1000 mm length — required 8US19 22-2BA00
for Twin T (TT) busbar 1000 mm length — required 8US19 22-2DA00
Reserve Space Cover (for covering round terminals placed on 3-phase busbar)
Holder for reserve space cover 32mm height — required 8US1922-2EA00 4 pcs
Holder for reserve space cover 107 mm length — required 8US1922-2EA01 8 pcs
8US1922-2EB00
Reserve space cover 195mm height / 700mm length — required 8US1922-2EB00
Feeder Lugs (mounts to all busbar sizes on this page)
3-pole terminal plate with cover 20 mm x 200 mm 16-4 AWG 80A yes 5SH3538
3-pole terminal plate with cover 54 mm x 200 mm 10-2/0 AWG 175A yes 8US19 21-1BA00
3-pole terminal plate with cover 81 mm x 200 mm 2 AWG-250 MCM 440A yes 8US19 21-1AA00
5SH3538 3-pole terminal plate with cover 180 mm x 200 mm 250-600 MCM 560A yes FBT600F
8US1921-1BA00 3-pole terminal plate 154 mm x 184 mm 300-600 MCM 560A yes 8US19 41-2AA03
3-pole terminal plate 160 mm x 184 mm for flat bars up to 800A yes 8US19 41-2AA04
32 mm x 20 mm
Cover for 8US19 41-2AA03 and 04 180 mm x 200 mm x 90 mm — yes 8US19 22-1GC00
1) UL 508A labeled panels require the use of components that meet the creepage and air distances of 1” air clearance and 2” creepage
FBT600F w/cover distance. N/A = not applicable for given item.
2) Current rating dependent on size of busbar used. Refer to busbar selection data.

5/6 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Fast Bus

Fast Bus Busbar Adapter System


60 mm system – Circuit breaker assemblies and kits

Selection and ordering data


Description

FBCB Fast Bus circuit breakers


Offer a full range of feeder circuit breakers from 15A to 500A. assembly and must be torqued down to the busbar prior to
All Sentron kits 125A and under are pre-assembled on 60 mm assembly. For VL breakers, adaptors are available for up to
Fast Bus adaptor shoes and ready to place on the busbar. 500A breakers (both main and feeder orientation).
All other circuit breaker kits are pre-packaged for fast user See page 5/8.

3VA and GG Feeder Circuit Breakers


Bus bar system for 3VA circuit breakers For molded case circuit breakers / SCCR Rating
are available from 15A up to 500A.
3VA5 & GG 125A 3VA5 250A 3VA6 150A-250A 3VA5 400A-500A 3VA6 400A-500A
Type Part Number 65KA @ 480VAC 100KA @ 480VAC 150KA @ 480VAC 100KA @ 480VAC 150KA @ 480VAC
Busbar adapter system with 8US1211-4SS00 — — — —
60 mm busbar center-to-center
8US1213-4AP03 — — —
spacing, 3-pole
8US1213-4AH04 — — —

3VA and GG Main Circuit Breakers

Busbar adapter system with 60 mm 8US1215-4SS00 — — — —


busbar center-to-center spacing,
8US1213-4AP03 — — —
top-fed, 15A to 500A 3-pole
8US1213-4AH04 — — —

5
Design UL Current Rating Breaker Frame (SCCR Rating 1))

SYSTEMS
POWER DISTRIBUTION
Sentron and GG Feeder Circuit Breakers ED (25kA) HHED (65kA) FXD (35kA)

3 pole/600V fully assembled breakers and 15A FBCB015 — —


adaptors that quickly snap onto the Busbar. 20A FBCB020 FBCB020H —
25A FBCB025 FBCB025H —
30A FBCB030 FBCB030H —
35A FBCB035 FBCB035H —
40A FBCB040 FBCB040H —
45A FBCB045 FBCB045H —
50A FBCB050 FBCB050H —
60A FBCB060 — —
70A FBCB070 — —
80A FBCB080 — —
90A FBCB090 — —
100A FBCB100 — —
110A FBCB110 — —
FBCB100 125A FBCB125 — —

3 pole/600V kitted components for customer 150A — — FBCB150


assembly that require the adaptor to be torqued 175A — — FBCB175
down to the Busbars prior to assembly. 200A — — FBCB200
225A — — FBCB225
250A — — FBCB250

Design UL Current Rating Breaker Frame (SCCR Rating)

Sentron Main Circuit Breakers FXD (25kA)2) HFXD (65kA)

3 pole/600V kitted components for customer 100A FBCB100M FBCB100M-HB —


assembly that require the adaptor to be torqued 125A FBCB125M FBCB125M-HB —
down to the Busbars prior to assembly. 150A FBCB150M FBCB150M-HB —
175A FBCB175M FBCB175M-HB —
200A FBCB200M FBCB200M-HB —
225A FBCB225M FBCB225M-HB —
250A FBCB250M FBCB250M-HB —

FBCB250M
1) UL Short Circuit Current ratings are based on 480V. Contact Siemens for 600 V ratings.
2) FBCB100M -125M SCCR = 25kA @ 480V
FBCB150M -250M SCCR = 65kA @ 480V

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 5/7
Fast Bus

Fast Bus Busbar Adapter System


60 mm system – Busbar adapters and device holders

Selection and ordering data


Busbar Number Rated Con- Adapter Adapter Rated UL508A1) Order No. Pack Weight
device of mount- current necting length width voltage compliance units per PU
adapters ing rails cables UL approx
(35 mm) .
A AWG mm mm V kg
For SIRIUS
Size S00/S0
MSPs 1 25 12 182 45 600 yes 8US12 51-5DM07 0.183
Contactors 1 25 12 182 45 600 yes 8US12 51-5DM07 0.183
+ Overload relays
Direct start load 1 25 12 182 45 600 yes 8US12 51-5DM07 0.183
feeders
Reversing feeders
Busbar adapters 1 25 12 182 45 600 yes 8US12 51-5DM07 0.183
8US21 51-5DM07 + Device holders 1 -- -- 182 45 600 yes 8US12 50-5AM00 0.158
+ Connecting -- -- -- -- -- -- yes 8US19 98-1AA00 100 units 0.100
plates
Size S00/S0
Cage Clamp
Direct start load 1 12 14 182 45 600 yes 8US12 51-5CM47 0.190
feeders
Size S2
MSPs 1 50 8 182 55 600 vyes 8US12 61-5FM08 0.263
Contactors 1 50 8 182 55 600 yes 8US12 61-5FM08 0.263
+ Overload relays
5

8US21 60-5AM00 Direct start load 1 50 8 245 55 600 yes 8US12 61-5FP08 0.292
feeders
POWER DISTRIBUTION
SYSTEMS

Reversing feeders
Busbar adapters 1 50 8 242 55 600 yes 8US12 61-5FP08 0.292
Busbar adapters 1 -- -- 242 55 600 yes 8US12 60-5AM00 0.202
+ Device holders -- -- -- 242 55 600 yes 8US12 60-5AP00 0.243
+ Connecting -- -- -- -- -- -- yes 8US19 98-1AA00 100 units 0.100
plates
Size S3 80 4 215 72 600 yes 8US12 11-4TR00 4) 0.659
1 100 -- 200 72 600 yes FBS100723R 0.590
-- 100 -- 200 72 600 yes FBS100722 0.610

8US12 11-4TR00

Product scheduled
For VL UL circuit breakers 2)
VL150 UL, -- 150 Tubular 190 105 600 yes 8US12 13-4AQ03 1.020
DG frame con-
tacts
VL250 UL, -- 250 Tubular 190 105 600 yes 8US12 13-4AQ03 1.020
FG frame con-

for obsolescence
tacts
VL400 UL, -- 400 Tubular 296 140 600 yes 8US12 13-4AH00 1.900
8US12 13-4AQ03 JG frame con-
VL400X UL, tacts
LG frame -- 540 3) 296 140 600 yes 8US12 13-4AH00 1.900
con-

Fall 2022
Tubular tacts

8US12 13-4AH00

1) UL508A labeled panels require the use of components that meet the creepage and air distances of 1” air clearance and 2” creepage distance. 
N/A = not applicable for given item.
2) For use with 10mm x 30mm and twin T (TT) busbars only. Adaptors can be configured for main or feeder breakers applications.
3) Foruse with maximum 500A circuit breaker. Circuit breakers greater than 500A must be panel mounted off the busbar system and fed to the busbars
via an infeed module. See page 5/6.
4) Rated 100A @ 480V. Rated 100A @ 600V with Class J Fuses.

5/8 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog * You can order this quantity Product Category
or a multiple thereof. IEC
Fast Bus

Fast Bus Busbar Adapter System


60 mm system – Terminals and accessories

Selection and ordering data


Description Max Width UL508A Order No. List Pack
Amps Compliance1) Price $ Units
Terminals for round conductors
5 mm busbar thickness 3)
12 mm x 5 mm 180 16 - 6 AWG 8US19 21-2AA00 100
15 mm x 5 mm 270 12 - 2 AWG 8US19 21-2AB00 50
20 mm x 5 mm 400 6 - 2/0 AWG 8US19 21-2AD00 50
25 mm x 5 mm 440 6 - 250 MCM 8US19 21-2AC00 50
Terminals 30 mm x 5 mm 180 16 - 6 AWG 8US19 21-2AA01 15
270 12 - 2 AWG 8US19 21-2AB01 15
400 6 - 2/0 AWG 8US19 21-2AD01 15
440 6 - 250 MCM 8US19 21-2AC01 15
20 mm x 5 mm, 25 mm x 5 mm 500 3/0 - 350 MCM 8US19 41-2AA01 6
30 mm x 5 mm 600 300 - 600 MCM 8US19 41-2AA02 3
10 mm bar thickness
12 mm x 10 mm3) 180 16 - 6 AWG 8US19 21-2BA00 100
15 mm x 10 mm3), 20 mm x 10 mm 270 12 - 2 AWG 8US19 21-2BB00 50
25 mm x 10 mm, 30 mm x 10 mm 400 6 - 2/0 AWG 8US19 21-2BD00 50
440 6 - 250 MCM 8US19 21-2BC00 50
Terminals 180 16 - 6 AWG 8US19 21-2BA01 15
270 12 - 2 AWG 8US19 21-2BB01 15
400 6 - 2/0 AWG 8US19 21-2BD01 15
440 6 - 250 MCM 8US19 21-2BC01 15
20 mm x 10 mm, 25 mm x 10 mm 500 3/0 - 600 MCM 8US19 41-2AA01 6
30 mm x 10 mm 600 300 - 600 MCM 8US19 41-2AA02 3
Terminal covers for circular conductors (mounts to busbars)
For terminals up to 250 MCM 8US19 22-1GA00 10

5
200 mm long, 84 mm wide
For terminals up to 600 MCM 8US19 22-1GA02 1
200 mm long, 270 mm wide

SYSTEMS
POWER DISTRIBUTION
8US19 22-1GA00
For terminals up to 600 MCM FBC135
200 mm long, 135 mm wide

Accessories for busbar adapters and device holders


Mounting rail (35 mm) - plastic 45 mm n/a 8US1998-7CA15 10
complete with mounting screws 55 mm n/a 8US1998-7CA16 10
70 mm n/a 8US1998-4AA00 10
90 mm n/a 8US1998-7CA08 10
110 mm n/a 8US1998-7CA10 10
Mounting Rail
Connection holder - n/a 8US1998-1DA00 20
(for vertical bubar assembly)
fixes the MSP to the mounting rail 3) (for SIRIUS sizes S00/S0)
Screw holder - n/a 8US1998-1CA00 20
for supplementary screw fixing of the feeder
8US1998-1BA00 (for SIRIUS sizes S00/S0)

Spacer - n/a 8US1998-1BA00 100


fixes the busbar adapter to the device holder - n/a 8US1998-1BA01 1
(for SIRIUS sizes S00/S0)
FBC20
Connection wedges - n/a FBC20 20
for mechanical linking of adapters and switching device holders
(2 units required per combination)

Outgoing terminal rail for busbar adapters


Plug-type terminal
(complete with supporting element for attaching to busbar adapter
Load Side and switching device holder. Spring loaded terminals.)
Terminal
3 x 14 AWG (400 V) and 4 x 16AWG (250 V) 91 mm 45 mm n/a 8US1998-8AM07
7 x 14 AWG (400 V) 91 mm 54 mm n/a 8US1998-8AA10

Accessories for busbar adapters and device holders


Side module for busbar adapter expansion For adapters w/182 mm 182 mm 10 mm n/a 8US1998-2BM00
Side module for busbar adapter expansion For adapters w/200 mm 200 mm 9 mm n/a 8US1998-2BJ10

8US1998-2BM00
1) UL508A labeled panels require the use of components that meet the creepage and air distances of 1” air clearance and 2” creepage distance.
N/A = not applicable for given item.
2) Terminals must be manually spaced on the busbar to comply with UL508A distances of 1” air clearance and 2” creepage distance.
3) Cannot be used on Twin T (TT) profile up to 1400 A.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 5/9
Fast Bus

Fast Bus Busbar Adapter System


60 mm system

Dimension drawings

FBB36/FBB60 Copper Busbar 8US19 23-3UA01 8US19 43-3AA00


112
5 31 25 6 40 40

A 0.187
L1
(5) L1

75
0.75 L 2

185

166
(20)

120

209
L2

50
Dimension A
NSE0_02058

40

NSE0_02071

31
FBB36 36 (914) L3 L3
FBB60 60 (1524)
01573 123
25 51

Copper Busbar/TT profile, 8US19 48-2AA00 8US19 22-1AC00 with 8US19 23-3UA01 Support for blanking covers,
5

8US19 22-1AC00 with 8US19 23-3AA01 8US1922-2EA00

30 32
POWER DISTRIBUTION
SYSTEMS

10

40

60
6

200
10

NSE0_02070
NSE0_02073

9 49,4
62,5

8US19 22-2AA00 8US19 22-2BA00

5,2 10,2
8US19 23-1AA01 Blanking cover, 8US1922-2EB00
NSE0_00721
30,5
NSE0_00720
30,5

Length 1000 mm Length 1000 mm

8US19 22-2DA00
34
200

31
60
NSE0_01607

1,5
71
78

NSE0_02072

40 62,5

5/10 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Fast Bus

Fast Bus Busbar Adapter System


60 mm system

Dimension drawings

Infeed, 8US19 21-1BA00 Infeed, 8US19 41-2AA03

50 2 28
94
60
200

194

184

156
60

96
NSE0_02074
NSE0_02060

36
54 32 154 21 72
88 100

Infeed, 8US19 21-1AA00 Infeed, 8US19 41-2AA04

50 5 28,7

5
94
60

SYSTEMS
POWER DISTRIBUTION
200

194

184

148
60

88
NSE0_02053
NSE0_02059

28
160 8,8 72
81 32 100,2
88

Infeed 5SH3538 FBT600F (supplied with cover) FBT600F Cover

166
34

146
60

200
194
60
I2_13999a

20 28 32
180

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 5/11


Fast Bus

Fast Bus Busbar Adapter System


60 mm system

Dimension drawings

Busbar device adapter, 8US12 50-5AM00 Busbar device adapter, 8US12 60-5AP00

20
5

6
60
3,4

182

60
242
10
NSE0_02051
47,4 23,7
53,8 51,7

Busbar device adapter, 8US12 61-5FM08 Busbar device adapter, 8US12 11-4TR00

5
12
5

148
POWER DISTRIBUTION
SYSTEMS

40
20

NSE0_02062

60
68

6
60

214
200
164
5

182

60
60

NSE0_02068
Ø
2,
5

41 26,5
,4 60 54,5
Ø3 47,4 23,7 8,5 72
2,9

54 60,2

Busbar device adapter, 8US12 51-5DM07 Busbar device adapter, 8US12 61-5FP08
10

12
148

5
20
170

5
20

53
NSE0_02063

6
48

60
6

5
60
5

182

60
242
182

,4
Ø3
60

10

,5
Ø3
NSE0_02061

29,5 23,7 8,5


2,5

36 60,2 47,4 23,7 8,5


45 54 60,2

5/12 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Fast Bus

Fast Bus Busbar Adapter System


60 mm system

Dimension drawings

Busbar device adapter, 8US12 51-5CM47 Busbar device adapter, 8US12 13-4AQ01

31,5

23
38,8

60
114,5
114,5
190
35 NSE0_02066

105

Busbar device adapter, 8US12 13-4AQ03


8US19 98-2BM00

35,5
26,8

23

5
SYSTEMS
POWER DISTRIBUTION
60
131,5
182
64

190
131,5
NSE0_02069

14 14 35 NSE0_02065
32 105
42

Busbar device adapter, 8US12 13-4AH00


24

56
60
247,5

296
270

NSE0_02067
45
140 55

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 5/13


Fast Bus

Fast Bus Busbar Adapter System


60 mm system

Dimension drawings

8US1941-2AA01

51
Type a b c d e f Max tighening torque
5mm 8US1921-2AA0. 7.5 11.5 22.5 25 5 10 4 Nm
8US1921-2AB0. 10.5 15.5 29 35 5 10 6 Nm

max. 98
8US1921-2AC0. 17 23.5 36 55 5 12 15 Nm
8US1921-2AD0. 14.5 20.5 32 42 5 12 10 Nm

85,5
10mm 8US1921-2BA0. 7.5 11.5 22.5 25 10 10 4 Nm
8US1921-2BB0. 10.5 15.5 29 35 10 10 6 Nm
8US1921-2BC0. 17 23.5 36 55 10 12 15 Nm
8US1921-2BD0. 14.5 20.5 32 42 10 12 10 Nm
43 40

8US1921-2A / -2B 8US1941-2AA02

51

42
max. 86
max. 84
43 31
38
5 SYSTEMS
POWER DISTRIBUTION

FBC135 8US1922-1GA00

60

194
189

200
60

10 32
84 35
55

8US19 22-1GA02

5/14 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Fast Bus

Fast Bus Busbar Adapter System


60 mm system

Dimension drawings

8US19 98-1CA00 8US19 98-1DA00 8US19 98-4AA00 8US19 98-7CA08

27

35
29 29 9

NSE0_01599
7 14
74
90

8US19 98-7CA10 8US19 98-7CA15 8US19 98-7CA16 8US19 98-1BA00

8US19 98-8AM07 8US19 98-8AA10

5
SYSTEMS
POWER DISTRIBUTION
8US19 98-1CA00 8US19 98-1DA00

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 5/15


Fast Bus
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation
SIRIUS
SIRIUS3RA
3RA2Fast Bus
Motor Combination Starters and Group Installation Assemblies
Starters
General data
General data
Order No. scheme
Digit of the Order No. 1st - 4th 5th 6th 7th 8th 9th 10th 11th 12th 13th 14th 15th 16th
3rd
@@@ @ @ @ 0 – @ @ @ @ @ – @ @ @ @
SIRIUS starters 3RA
SIRIUS 2nd generation 2
Type of starter (direct-on-line starter = 1, @
reversing starter = 2)
Size (S00 = 1, S0 = 2) @
Setting range for overload release @ @
Design type and connection method @
Rated power at 460 V AC @ @
Integrated auxiliary switches of the contactor @
Operating range / solenoid coil circuit (contactor) @
Rated control supply voltage (contactor) @ @
Example 3RA 2 1 1 0 – 0 B A 1 5 – 1 A K 6
Note:
The Order No. scheme is presented here merely for information purposes and for better understanding of the logic behind the order
numbers. For your orders, please use the order numbers quote in the catalog in the Selection and ordering data.

Technical specifications
Direct-on-line starters/ Size Connection methods Mounting Control voltage Width W Height H Depth D
reversing starters
mm mm mm
SYSTEMS 5

Mounting dimensions
Direct-on-line starters S00 Screw terminals Standard mounting rails AC/DC 45 167 97
6POWER DISTRIBUTION

3RA21. 3RA21 1. Busbar adapters AC/DC 45 200 155


Spring-type terminals Standard mounting rails AC/DC 45 198 97
Busbar adapters AC/DC 45 260 155
S0 Screw terminals Standard mounting rails AC 45 193 97
3RA21 2. DC 45 193 107
H

Busbar adapters AC 45 260 155


D

W
DC 45 260 165
Spring-type terminals Standard mounting rails AC/DC 45 243 107
Busbar adapters AC/DC 45 260 165
Reversing starters S00 Screw terminals Standard mounting rails AC/DC 90 170 97
3RA22. 3RA22 1. Busbar adapters AC/DC 90 200 155
Spring-type terminals Standard mounting rails AC/DC 90 204 97
Busbar adapters AC/DC 90 260 155
S0 Screw terminals Standard mounting rail AC 90 265 120.3
3RA22 2. adapters DC 90 265 130
Busbar adapters AC 90 260 155
DC 90 260 165
Spring-type terminals Standard mounting rail AC/DC 90 270 131
adapters
Busbar adapters AC/DC 90 260 165

Type 3RA2. 1 3RA2. 2


Size S00 S0
Number of poles 3 3
Mechanics and environment
Permissible ambient temperature
• During operation °C -20 ... +60
• Storage and transport °C -55 ... +80
Weight kg 0.6 ... 1.5 0.8 ... 2.3
Permissible mounting 22
22
positions
9 9
3 9

Important: Acc. to DIN 43602 start command "I" at the right or top
Shock resistance Acc. to IEC 60086 Part 2-27 g Up to 6 Up to 6
(sine-wave pulse)
Degree of protection Acc. to IEC 60947-1 IP20

5/16 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


6/10 SIRIUS Innovations Supplement 2012
Combination Starters & Starters for Group Installation

SIRIUS 3RA Motor Starters


General data

Direct-on-line starting • For 60 mm busbar systems • Sizes S00 and S0

60 mm busbar adapter 60 mm busbar adapter


for screw terminals for spring-type terminals
8US12 51-5DS10 for S00 8US12 51-5DT11 for S00
8US12 51-5NT10 for S0 8US12 51-5NT11 for S0

Motor starter protector


Size S00/S0 Motor starter protector
Screw terminals Size S00/S0
Spring-type terminals

Link module
3RA19 21-1DA00 for S00 Link module
3RA29 21-1AA00 for S0, AC contactor 3RA29 11-2AA00 for S00
3RA29 21-1BA00 for S0, DC contactor 3RA29 21-2AA00 for S0 1)

Contactor
Size S00/S0
Spring-type terminals
Contactor

5
Size S00/S0
Screw terminals 1) Additional3RA29 11-1CA00

SYSTEMS
POWER DISTRIBUTION
spacer for height compensation
on AC contactors size S0 with
NSB0_02091a
spring-type terminals.

Left: 3RA21 motor starter for direct-on-line starting with busbar Right: 3RA21 motor starter for direct-on-line starting with busbar
adapters with screw connection adapters with spring-type connection

3RV203 with 3RT203 3RV204 with 3RT204

Adapter Shoe Adapter Shoe


8US1261-5FP08 8US1211-4TR00
MSP
3RV203 MSP
3RV204

Link Module
Link Module
3RA2931-1A AC/DC
3RA1941-1A AC/DC

Contactor Contactor
3RT203 3RT204

Bracket
FBS0 070B

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 5/17


Fast Bus

SIRIUS 3RA Fast Bus Combination Starters and Group Installation Assemblies
Selection

Reversing duty • For 60 mm busbar systems • Sizes S00 and S0

RS assembly kit for reversing duty and


busbar mounting
Screw connection: 60 mm busbar adapter
3RA29 13-1DB1 for S00
3RA29 23-1DB1 for S0 For screw terminals:
For spring-type connection: 8US12 51-5DS10 for S00
3RA29 13-1DB2 for S00 8US12 51-5NT10 for S0
3RA29 23-1DB2 for S0 1) For spring-type terminals:
Comprising: 8US12 51-5DT11 for S00
1 wiring kit 8US12 51-5NT11 for S0
1 busbar adapter
1 device holder
2 connecting wedges
1)
Also includes 3RA29 11-1CA00 spacer
for height compensation on AC contactors
size S0 with spring-type terminals.

Motor starter protector


Size S00/S0
2 connecting wedges
Screw terminals/
8US19 98-1AA00
spring-type terminals

Link module
5

For screw terminals:


3RA19 21-1DA00 for S00
3RA29 21-1AA00 for S0, AC contactor
POWER DISTRIBUTION
SYSTEMS

3RA29 21-1BA00 for S0, DC contactor 60 mm device holder


For spring-type terminals: 8US12 51-5AS10
3RA29 11-2AA00 for S00
2)
3RA29 21-2AA00 for S0

3
2 contactors
Size S00/S0
NSB0_02094b

Screw terminals/
spring-type terminals

Wiring kit
Screw connection:
2 3RA29 13-2AA1 for S00
3RA29 23-2AA1 for S0
Spring-type connection:
3RA29 13-2AA2 for S00
3RA29 23-2AA2 for S0
1 Upper wiring module
2 Lower wiring module
3 2 connecting clips
4 Mechanical interlock
2)
Additional 3RA29 11-1CA00 spacer (can be removed if necessary)
for height compensation on AC contactors
size S0 with spring-type terminals.

3RA22 motor starter for reversing duty and 60 mm standard mounting rail in size S00/S0
(the version with screw connection is shown in the picture)

5/18 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Fast Bus

SIRIUS 3RA Fast Bus Combination Starters and Group Installation Assemblies
Selection

Required Components for Fast Bus Mounting


3RV203 with Reversing 3RT203

a Link Module MSP Contactor Support Adapter Shoe


3RA2931-1A AC/DC 3RV203 8US1260-5AP00 8US1261-5FP08
b Mechanical Interlock (without DIN rail) and
3RA2934-2B with 8US1998-2BM00
c Fast Clips
FBC20

2 Contactors
3RT203

5
SYSTEMS
POWER DISTRIBUTION
3RA2933-2AA2
Wiring Kit
a Upper Wiring Module
u
b Lower Wiring module
u

3RV204 with Reversing 3RT204

a Link Module
3RA1941-1A AC/DC
b Mechanical Interlock Adapter Shoe
3RA2934-2B 8US1211-4TR00

MSP
3RV204

3RA2943-2AA1 a
u
Wiring Kit
a Upper Wiring Module
u
b Lower Wiring Module
u
b

2 Contactors
3RT204 2 Brackets
FBS0070B

b
u

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 5/19


Fast Bus

SIRIUS 3RA Fast Bus Combination Starters and Group Installation Assemblies
Dimensions

Dimensions, 3RV201 with 3RT201

3RA2110 3RA2210
Fast Bus Non-reversing Fast Bus Reversing

96.9
45 154.9 45 5

49
169.9
200
5

1) Lockable in OFF position. Padlock diameter 5 mm.


2) When a front auxiliary is installed on the contactor,
add 44 mm to the depth of the contactor.
POWER DISTRIBUTION
SYSTEMS

Dimensions, 3RV202 with 3RT201


Alle Bemassungswerte sind in Millimeter (mm) angegeben.
All dimensions are in millimeters (mm)
3RA2210-0.A1.-2AP0
3RA2120 3RA2220
3RA2110-0.D1.-1AP0
Fast Bus Non-reversing Fast Bus Reversing
Format/Size: DIN A4 Massstab/Scale: 1:2

97
96.9
45 5
49
193.4

1) Lockable in OFF position. Padlock diameter 5 mm.


2) When a front mount auxiliary is installed on the
contactor, add 44 mm to the depth of the contactor.

All dimensions shown in millimeters. For reference


purposes only. Not to be used for design or construc-
tion purposes.

3RA2120-1.A24-0AP0

5/20 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Fast Bus

SIRIUS 3RA Fast Bus Combination Starters and Group Installation Assemblies
Dimensions

3RV203 with 3RT203

3RA2230
3RA2130 Fast Bus Reversing
Fast Bus Non-reversing

1)
1)
34
14
53

2)
SIEMENS

2)
SIEMENS
259
309

259
309
SIEMENS
3)

5
SIEMENS SIEMENS

SYSTEMS
POWER DISTRIBUTION
NSK-8174

NSK-8175
7 18 18 68
17 28 95 10
10 55 142 10 17.5
DC 157 120
176

Lateral clearance to grounded


components minimum 6 mm.
1) Arcing space
2) Lockable in OFF position with padlock diameter 5 mm.
3) When a front mount auxiliary is installed on the
contactor, add 49 mm to the depth of the contactor.

All dimensions shown in millimeters. For reference


purposes only. Not to be used for design or construc-
tion purposes.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 5/21


Fast Bus

SIRIUS 3RA Fast Bus Combination Starters and Group Installation Assemblies
Dimensions

3RV204 with 3RT204


5 SYSTEMS
POWER DISTRIBUTION

Lateral clearance to grounded


components minimum 6 mm.
1) Arcing space
2) Lockable in OFF position with padlock diameter 5 mm.
3) When a front mount auxiliary is installed on the
contactor, add 49 mm to the depth of the contactor.

All dimensions shown in millimeters. For reference


purposes only. Not to be used for design or construc-
tion purposes.

5/22 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Hybrid Motor Starters
Industrial Control Product Catalog 2021

contents
SIRIUS 3RM1 motor starters
6 Section

General data 6/2 – 6/7


Selection and ordering 6/8 – 6/9
Accessories 6/10 – 6/11

ET 200SP motor starters


General data 6/12 – 6/18
SIRIUS Selection and ordering 6/19
3RM1
Base units and control module 6/20
Accessories 6/21

ET 200pro motor starters


General data 6/22 – 6/27
Standard motor starters 6/28
High Feature motor starters 6/29
ET 200pro isolator modules 6/30
ET 200pro safety motor starters 6/31
Solutions local/PROFIsafe
- Safety modules local 6/32 – 6/33
- Safety modules PROFIsafe 6/34
Accessories for ET 200pro motor starters 6/35 – 6/39
Software
Motor Starter ES 6/40
ET 200SP
SIRIUS M200D motor starters

6
General data 6/41 – 6/43
M200D motor starters for AS-Interface

STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
General data 6/44 – 6/46
M200D Basic motor starters 6/47
M200D Standard motor starters 6/48
M200D motor starters for PROFIBUS/PROFINET
General data 6/49 – 6/54
Communication modules, motor starter modules 6/55
Software
Motor Starter ES 6/56
Accessories
For all M200D motor starters 6/57 – 6/61
For M200D motor starters for AS-Interface 6/62 – 6/63
ET 200pro For M200D motor starters for PROFIBUS 6/64
For M200D motor starters for PROFINET 6/65

Hybrid fieldbus connections


General data 6/66
Selection and ordering 6/67

SIRIUS M200D

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 6/1


Hybrid Motor Starters
Load Feeders and Motor Starters for Use in the Control Cabinet
SIRIUS 3RM1 motor starters
Introduction
SIRIUS 3RM1 motor starters

■ Overview
SIRIUS 3RM1 motor starters are compact devices, 22.5 mm
wide, combining a large number of functions in a single
enclosure. They consist of combinations of relay contacts,
power semiconductors (hybrid technology), and an electronic
overload relay for operational switching of three-phase motors
up to 3 HP (at 480V).
The 3RM1 motor starters with overload protection with wide
setting range are available as direct-on-line starters and
reversing starters and as versions with safety-related shutdown
up to SIL 3/PL e.

3RM13 motor starter with reversing functionality, electronic overload


protection and safety-related shutdown
Seamlessly integrated safety right through to the main circuit
Functional safety in the main circuit needs to be both simple and
flexible.
The unique compatibility of hybrid 3RM1 fail-safe motor starters
and 3SK safety relays means that integrated functional safety
right through to the main circuit is no longer a problem.
Their compact design allows the motor starters to be installed to
the right of the safety relay in a simple manner, just like an output

8
expansion. The wiring of the safety-related signals to the relay
6

can be performed simply, quickly and in an error-free manner


using the device connector.
HYBRID MOTOR
STARTERS

The ergonomically designed enclosure with removable termi-


nals and terminal labeling in the hinged cover allows for the
cables to be conveniently diagonally mounted from the front.
Either screw or spring-loaded terminals with push-in technology
are available.
Highlights
• Fail-safe disconnection of motors up to 3 kW
• Problem-free combination of fail-safe motor starters and safety
relays
• End-to-end system, simple setup using device connectors
3SK + 3RM1
IC01_00533

• Ergonomic enclosure
Note:
For SIRIUS 3SK safety
safety relays,
relays, see
see page
page 11/12.
13/133.

Problem-free integration of functional safety into the main circuit through


the simple combination of 3RM1 and 3SK devices

6/2 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

Siemens IC 10 · 2020
Hybrid Motor Starters
Load Feeders and Motor Starters for Use in the Control Cabinet
SIRIUS 3RM1 motor starters
General data
SIRIUS 3RM1 motor starters
Article No. scheme
Product versions Article number
Product function Direct-on-line starters 3RM10 0 @ – @ AA @ 4
Failsafe direct-on-line starters 3RM11 0 @ – @ AA @ 4 with ATEX certification and safety-related shutdown
Reversing starters 3RM12 0 @ – @ AA @ 4
Failsafe reversing starters 3RM13 0 @ – @ AA @ 4 with ATEX certification and safety-related shutdown
Wide setting range for 0.1 ... 0.5 A 1
electronic overload 0.4 ... 2.0 A 2 For motor standard output up to 3/4 HP1)
release
1.6 ... 7.0 A (UL=6.1A) 7 For motor standard output up to 3 HP1)
Connection method Screw terminals 1
Spring-loaded terminals 2
(push-in)
Mixed connection method 3 Spring-loaded terminals (push-in)
Rated control supply 24 V DC 0
voltage Us 110 ... 230 V AC; 110 V DC 1
Example 3RM13 0 1 – 2 AA 0 4
1) Standard three-phase motor; the actual startup characteristics of the motor
as well as its rated data are important factors here.
Note:
The article number scheme shows an overview of product For your orders, please use the article numbers quoted in the
versions for better understanding of the logic behind the article selection and ordering data.
numbers.

■ Benefits
Product advantages
• Less space required in the control cabinet (20 to 80%) thanks Standards and approvals
to high functional density, which also means reduced wiring • IEC/EN 60947-4-2
and testing
8

• UL 60947-4-2

6
• Greater endurance and reduced heat losses thanks to hybrid • CSA
technology • ATEX

STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
• Lower costs for stock keeping and configuration as a result of • IEC 61508-1: SIL 3
the wide setting range of the electronic overload release • ISO 13849: PL e
(up to 1:5) • CCC approval for China
• Fast wiring without tools for rigid conductors or conductors
equipped with end sleeves thanks to spring-loaded terminals
(push-in)
• Safety-related shutdown in accordance with SIL 3/PL e by
shutting down the control supply voltage without additional
devices in the main circuit
•• The motor
motor starters
starters can be ideally
ideally combined
combinedwith
with3SK
3SK safety
safety
relays for safety-related
safety-related shutdown
shutdown (see
(seepage
page13/133).
11/12)
• Motor status feedback to the higher-level control system in the
case of 3RM10 and 3RM12 motor starters in the 24 V DC
version
• Virtually error-free wiring on the mains connection side and
reduction in short-circuit protective devices by means of
3RM19 infeed system
• ATEX certification of the overload protection of the 3RM1
Failsafe motor starters: "Increased safety" type of protection
EEx e according to ATEX directive 2014/34/EU
•• The 3RM1
3RM1 motor
motor starters
starters can
can be used with highly
highly energy-
energy-
efficient IE3/IE4 motors. In this regard,
regard, please
pleaseobserve
observethe
the
dimensioning and
information on dimensioning and configuring,
configuring,see
see
Application Manual.
Manual.
For more information about IE3/IE4, see page page 1/7.
1/7.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 6/3


Hybrid Motor Starters
Load Feeders and Motor Starters for Use in the Control Cabinet
SIRIUS 3RM1 motor starters
General data
SIRIUS 3RM1 motor starters

■ Technical specifications
More information
Industry
Industry Mall,
Mall, see
see www.siemens.com/product?3RM1
www.siemens.com/product?3RM1 FAQs, see
FAQs, see https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16311/faq
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16311/faq
Equipment
Equipment Manual,
Manual, see
see
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/66295730
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/66295730

Article number 3RM10, 3RM11,


3RM12 3RM13
General technical specifications:
Dimensions (W x H x D) mm 22.5 x 100 x 141.6
Ambient temperature
• During operation °C -25 … +60
• During storage °C -40 … +70
• During transport °C -40 … +70
Installation altitude at height above sea level, maximum m 4 000 2 000
Shock resistance 6 g / 11 ms
Vibration resistance 1 ... 6 Hz, 15 mm; 20 m/s², 500 Hz
Degree of protection IP20
Mounting position Vertical, horizontal, standing (consider derating)

IC01_00469

Article number 3RM1.01 3RM1.02 3RM1.07


Main circuit:
Operational voltage, rated value, maximum V 500
Operating frequency Hz 50/60
Operational current at AC-53a at 400 V at an ambient temperature of 40 °C A 0.5 2 7
Minimum load [% of IM] % 20

8
Adjustable current response value of the inverse-time delayed overload release A 0.1 ... 0.5 0.4 ... 2 1.6 ... 7
6

Article number 3RM1.0.-.AA04 3RM1.0.-.AA14


HYBRID MOTOR
STARTERS

Control circuit:
Type of voltage of the control supply voltage DC AC/DC
Control supply voltage
• At DC V 24 110
• At AC at 50 Hz V -- 110 … 230
Frequency of the control supply voltage Hz -- 50/60

6/4 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

Siemens IC 10 · 2020
Hybrid Motor Starters
Load Feeders and Motor Starters for Use in the Control Cabinet
SIRIUS 3RM1 motor starters
General data
SIRIUS 3RM1 motor starters

Type 3RM1.0.-1AA.4 3RM1.0.-3AA.4 3RM1.0.-2AA.4


Connections/terminals:
Type of electrical connection for main circuit Screw terminals Spring-loaded
(1 or 2 conductors can be connected) terminals
(push-in)
Connectable conductor cross-section for main contacts
• Solid mm² 1 x (0.5 ... 4), 2 x (0.5 ... 2.5) 1 x (0.5 ... 4)
• Finely stranded
- With end sleeve mm² 1 x (0.5 ... 4), 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5) 1 x (0.5 ... 2.5)
- Without end sleeve mm² -- 1 x (0.5 ... 4)
Type of electrical connection for auxiliary and control circuit Screw Spring-loaded terminals
(1 or 2 conductors can be connected) terminals (push-in)
Type of connectable conductor cross-sections for auxiliary contacts
• Solid mm² 1 x (0.5 ... 2.5), 1 x (0.5 ... 1.5), 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5)
2 x (1.0 ... 1.5)
• Finely stranded
- With end sleeve mm² 1 x (0.5 ... 2.5), 1 x (0.5 ... 1.0), 2 x (0.5 ... 1.0)
2 x (0.5 ... 1)
- Without end sleeve mm² -- 1 x (0.5 ... 1.5), 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5)
Type of connectable conductor cross-sections for AWG cables
• For main contacts 1 x (20 ... 12), 2 x (20 ... 14) 1 x (20 ... 12)
• For auxiliary contacts 1 x (20 ... 14), 1x (20 ... 16), 2 x (20 ... 16)
2 x (18 ... 16)

■ Accessories
More information
1
Equipment Manual,
Equipment Manual, see
see
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/66295730
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/66295730

Three-phase infeed system (3RM19 three-phase busbar


system)
The system permits an easy, time-saving and safe means of
feeding two or more 3RM1 motor starters. It can be used only
8

with motor starters with screw terminals and in combination with

6
8US1716-0RK00 adapters for mounting rails in the main circuit.
The maximum summation current must not exceed 25 A. The

STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
IC01_00169c
primary infeed is connected via a three-phase infeed terminal.
The busbars are available in three lengths, for two, three or five
motor starters. More than five devices can be connected by
clamping the connection tags of a second busbar rotated by
180°. 4
The three-phase busbars are finger-safe but empty connection
tags must be fitted with covers.
3

1 Four 3RM1 motor starters on standard mounting rail with one


free slot
2 3RM1920-1AA three-phase infeed terminal
3 Two 3RM1910-1DA three-phase busbars rotated through 180°
for the connection of up to nine motor starters
4 Covers for three 3RM1910-6AA connection tags respectively
for unused slots

3RM19 infeed system with three-phase infeed terminal: In the above


example, two three-phase busbars (5-pole busbars) rotated through
180° allow up to nine 3RM1 motor starters to be connected. Contact with
the unused connection tags in unoccupied positions is prevented safely
by the covers.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 6/5

Siemens IC 10 · 2020
Hybrid Motor Starters
Load Feeders and Motor Starters for Use in the Control Cabinet
SIRIUS 3RM1 motor starters
General data
SIRIUS 3RM1 motor starters
Fuse module for the use of 3RM1 motor starters on 8US busbar systems and mounting rails
The fuse module permits the very compact construction of a The fuse module can be combined with all 3RM1 motor starters.
load feeder with a maximum width of 22.5 mm. The 3RM1 motor The easily replaceable fuses protect the connected motor and
starter in combination with the integrated fuses for short-circuit the cables.
protection can therefore be used on 8US busbar systems.
Thanks to the range of different adapters, the fuse module can
be used in all 60 mm busbar systems and also in compact
busbar systems and on mounting rails. The interface to the
adapter also permits a simple and secure replacement of the
load feeder.

5 1 Busbar system
2 3 5
1 4 2 Cover profiles for busbars
3 Busbar adapter
4 Compact busbar adapter

5 3RM1 motor starter


6 3RM19 fuse module
7 3RM19 fuse module with open flap
(Flap cannot be opened when fuse
module is inserted. The fuse
module must be removed to change
the fuses.)

IC01_00611a

8
6 STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR

6
7

By means of the fuse module, 3RM1 motor starters can be used in busbar systems and 8US compact busbar systems, as well as on mounting rails

6/6 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Hybrid Motor Starters
Load Feeders and Motor Starters for Use in the Control Cabinet
SIRIUS 3RM1 motor starters
General data
SIRIUS 3RM1 motor starters
Device connectors for the control circuit Safe group shutdown can be implemented particularly easily in
conjunction with 3SK safety relays. In this case, up to five motor
The device connectors for 3RM1 motor starters (24 V DC control starters can be directly connected to 3SK safety relays via the
supply voltage only) reduce the outlay for cabling by looping device connector and then safely shut down (see page 13/133).
through the control supply voltage. The device connectors can
be snapped onto a standard mounting rail or fixed to a level
mounting panel using screws. 3SK safety relay 3RM1 motor starter

IC01_00178a
IC01_00218b

Motor

Ideal connection: Combination of four SIRIUS 3RM1 Failsafe motor


starters with SIRIUS 3SK safety relays
Electromechanical switching devices in series with hybrid
motor starters
Device connector with 3RM1 motor starter Switching an inductive load - in particular of motors < 1 kW with
high inductance - with an electromechanical switching device
Using the device connectors exclusively for feeding in the
(e.g. contactor) can cause high and steep voltage edges.
control supply voltage
The resulting faults/damage can be prevented by first
By using device connectors, a maximum of five motor starters
disconnecting with the hybrid motor starter or by using
can be supplied with 24 V DC control supply voltage. This
EMC suppression modules:
requires the control supply voltage to be applied to the A1 and
A2 terminals of only one motor starter. • For 3RT2916-1P.. EMC suppression modules for direct
mounting on the contactor, see page 2/78
8

Device daisy chain connectors can be used for gaps between

6
two motor starters. Device termination connectors terminate a •• For motor
motor suppression
suppression modules that are
are fitted
fitted in
in the
the main
main
circuit, (see page 8/94
see page 6/11).
group.

STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
Using the device connectors for safe group shutdown Note:

In combination with the 3RM11 and 3RM13 fail-safe motor For more
For moreinformation,
information,see
see
starters, the device connector can also be used for safety- https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109758696.
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109758696.
related shutdown. For this application, groups of no more than
five fail-safe motor starters can be connected using a device
connector, and the group must be terminated with a termination
connector. Removing the control voltage supply from the first
motor starter will safely shut down the whole group.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 6/7


Hybrid Motor Starters
Load Feeders and Motor Starters for Use in the Control Cabinet
SIRIUS 3RM1 motor starters
Selection and ordering data IE3/IE4 ready
SIRIUS 3RM1 motor starters

Selection and ordering data


More information
Industry Mall, see
Industry Mall, see www.siemens.com/product?3RM1
www.siemens.com/product?3RM1

Operational power Adjustable current Control supply voltage SD Article No. Price PU PS*
for three-phase response value of the per PU (UNIT,
motor inverse-time delayed At DC At AC at SET, M)
at 460 V1) overload release 50 Hz
HP A V V d
Direct-on-line starters
-- 0.1 … 0.5 24 -- 2 3RM1001-@AA04 1 1 unit
3/4 0.4 … 2 24 -- 2 3RM1002-@AA04 1 1 unit
3 1.6 … 6.1 24 -- 2 3RM1007-@AA04 1 1 unit
-- 0.1 … 0.5 110 110 ... 230 2 3RM1001-@AA14 1 1 unit
3/4 0.4 … 2 110 110 ... 230 2 3RM1002-@AA14 1 1 unit
3 1.6 … 6.1 110 110 ... 230 2 3RM1007-@AA14 1 1 unit

3RM1001-1AA04
Reversing starters
-- 0.1 … 0.5 24 -- 2 3RM1201-@AA04 1 1 unit
3/4 0.4 … 2 24 -- 2 3RM1202-@AA04 1 1 unit
3 1.6 … 6.1 24 -- 2 3RM1207-@AA04 1 1 unit
-- 0.1 … 0.5 110 110 ... 230 2 3RM1201-@AA14 1 1 unit
3/4 0.4 … 2 110 110 ... 230 2 3RM1202-@AA14 1 1 unit
3 1.6 … 6.1 110 110 ... 230 2 3RM1207-@AA14 1 1 unit

8
3RM1201-1AA04
6

Failsafe direct-on-line starters


-- 0.1 … 0.5 24 -- 2 3RM1101-@AA04 1 1 unit
HYBRID MOTOR
STARTERS

3/4 0.4 … 2 24 -- 2 3RM1102-@AA04 1 1 unit


3 1.6 … 6.1 24 -- 2 3RM1107-@AA04 1 1 unit
-- 0.1 … 0.5 110 110 ... 230 2 3RM1101-@AA14 1 1 unit
3/4 0.4 … 2 110 110 ... 230 2 3RM1102-@AA14 1 1 unit
3 1.6 … 6.1 110 110 ... 230 2 3RM1107-@AA14 1 1 unit

3RM1101-1AA04
Failsafe reversing starters
-- 0.1 … 0.5 24 -- 2 3RM1301-@AA04 1 1 unit
3/4 0.4 … 2 24 -- 2 3RM1302-@AA04 1 1 unit
3 1.6 … 6.1 24 -- 2 3RM1307-@AA04 1 1 unit
-- 0.1 … 0.5 110 110 ... 230 2 3RM1301-@AA14 1 1 unit
3/4 0.4 … 2 110 110 ... 230 2 3RM1302-@AA14 1 1 unit
3 1.6 … 6.1 110 110 ... 230 2 3RM1307-@AA14 1 1 unit

3RM1301-1AA04
Type of electrical connection
• Screw terminals for main circuit, screw terminals for control circuit 1
• Spring-loaded terminals (push-in) for main circuit, spring-loaded terminals (push-in) 2
for control circuit
• Screw terminals for main circuit, spring-loaded terminals (push-in) for control circuit 3
1)
The actual startup characteristics of the motor as well as its rated data are
important factors here.

6/8 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Siemens IC 10 · 2020
Hybrid Motor Starters
Load Feeders and Motor Starters for Use in the Control Cabinet
SIRIUS 3RM1 motor starters
Accessories
SIRIUS 3RM1 motor starters

Product designation SD Article No. Price PU PS*


per PU (UNIT,
SET, M)
d
Three-phase infeed system for 3RM1 with screw terminals
Three-phase infeed terminals } 3RM1920-1AA 1 1 unit
• For three-phase busbars

3RM1920-1AA
Three-phase busbars
• For 2 motor starters } 3RM1910-1AA 1 1 unit

3RM1910-1AA

• For 3 motor starters } 3RM1910-1BA 1 1 unit

3RM1910-1BA

• For 5 motor starters } 3RM1910-1DA 1 1 unit

3RM1910-1DA

Covers } 3RM1910-6AA 1 10 units


For 3 connection tags of the three-phase busbars
8

6
3RM1910-6AA
Fuse modules for 3RM1 for use on busbars or mounting rails

STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
Fuse module with 3NW6007-1 fuse 2 3RM1932-1AB 1 1 unit
Fuse module without fuse1) 10 3RM1930-1AA 1 1 unit

3RM1932-1AB
Adapters
Adapters for 60 mm busbar systems 5 8US1216-0AS00 1 1 unit
22.5 mm x 200 mm x 41.5 mm
Note: The adapter can be used on busbars with a width of
12 mm and a thickness of 5 mm or 10 mm.

8US1216-0AS00
Adapters for 60 mm compact busbar systems 5 8US1616-0AK02 1 1 unit
22.5 mm x 160 mm x 41.5 mm
Note: The adapter can be used on busbars with a width of
12 mm, 15 mm, 20 mm, 25 mm or 30 mm and a thickness
of 5 mm or 10 mm.

8US1616-0AK02
1) For details of alternative fuses, see
see Equipment
EquipmentManual.
Manual.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 6/9


* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
8/92 Siemens IC 10 · 2020 Illustrations are approximate
Hybrid Motor Starters
Load Feeders and Motor Starters for Use in the Control Cabinet
SIRIUS 3RM1 motor starters
Accessories
SIRIUS 3RM1 motor starters

Product designation SD Article No. Price PU PS*


per PU (UNIT,
SET, M)
d
Adapters
Adapter for 35 mm DIN mounting rails 5 8US1716-0RK00 1 1 unit
22.5 mm x 185 mm x 23.5 mm

8US1716-0RK00
Cover profiles1)2)
Cover profiles for busbars
12 mm x 5 mm x 1 000 mm 2 8US1922-2CA00 1 10 units
40 mm or 60 mm center-to-center busbar clearance
depending on busbar system
8US1922-2CA00
15 mm x 5 mm x 1 000 mm 2 8US1922-2AA00 1 10 units
20 mm x 5 mm x 1 000 mm
25 mm x 5 mm x 1 000 mm
30 mm x 5 mm x 1 000 mm
40 mm or 60 mm center-to-center busbar clearance
depending on busbar system
8US1922-2AA00
12 mm x 10 mm x 1 000 mm 2 8US1922-2BA00 1 10 units
15 mm x 10 mm x 1 000 mm
20 mm x 10 mm x 1 000 mm
25 mm x 10 mm x 1 000 mm
30 mm x 10 mm x 1 000 mm

8
6

60 mm center-to-center busbar clearance


8US1922-2BA00
Device connectors
HYBRID MOTOR
STARTERS

Device connectors 2 3ZY1212-2EA00 1 1 unit


For 3RM1 motor starters, 24 V DC, 22.5 mm

3ZY1212-2EA00
Device daisy chain connectors 2 3ZY1212-2AB00 1 1 unit
For 3RM1 motor starters 24 V DC, 22.5 mm
For gaps without motor starters in assemblies

3ZY1212-2AB00
Device termination connectors 2 3ZY1212-2FA00 1 1 unit
For 3RM1 motor starters, 24 V DC, 22.5 mm

3ZY1212-2FA00
1) 2) configuration of
of aa busbar
busbar system,
system, see
The cover profiles for busbars can be used for maintaining minimum For further accessories for the configuration
spacing between the load feeders. see Catalog
Catalog LV 10.
LV 10.

6/10 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2020
Hybrid Motor Starters
Load Feeders and Motor Starters for Use in the Control Cabinet
SIRIUS 3RM1 motor starters
Accessories
SIRIUS 3RM1 motor starters

Product designation SD Article No. Price PU PS*


per PU (UNIT,
d SET, M)
Removable terminals
Terminal for main circuit, 2-pole
Screw terminals

• Screw terminals, 2 3ZY1122-1BA00 1 6 units


1 x 4 mm²
Spring-loaded terminals
(push-in)
• Spring-loaded terminals (push-in), 2 3ZY1122-2BA00 1 6 units
1 x 4 mm²
3ZY1122-1BA00
Terminal for control circuit, 3-pole
Screw terminals

• Screw terminals, 2 3ZY1131-1BA00 1 6 units


1 x 2.5 mm²
Spring-loaded terminals
(push-in)
• Spring-loaded terminals (push-in), 2 3ZY1131-2BA00 1 6 units
1 x 2.5 mm²
3ZY1131-1BA00
Further accessories
Push-in lugs for wall mounting 2 3ZY1311-0AA00 1 10 units
2 lugs per device are required

3ZY1311-0AA00
8

Sealable covers, 22.5 mm 2 3ZY1321-2AA00 1 5 units

6
For simple protection against unauthorized access

STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
3ZY1321-2AA00
Coding pins for removable terminals 2 3ZY1440-1AA00 1 12 units
For mechanical coding of the terminals

3ZY1440-1AA00
Hinged cover
Replacement cover, without terminal labeling,
22.5 mm wide
• Titanium gray 2 3ZY1450-1AB00 1 5 units
• Yellow 2 3ZY1450-1BB00 1 5 units

3ZY1450-1AB00

Motor suppression module


• Square 15 3RK1911-6EA00 1 1 unit
• Round 15 3RK1911-6EB00 1 1 unit

3RK1911-6EA00
Screwdrivers Spring-loaded terminals
For all SIRIUS devices with spring-loaded terminals
Length approx. 200 mm, 2 3RA2908-1A 1 1 unit
3.0 mm x 0.5 mm,
titanium gray/black,
3RA2908-1A partially insulated

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 6/11

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Siemens IC 10 · 2020 Illustrations are approximate
Hybrid Motor Starters
Load Feeders and Motor Starters for Use in the Control Cabinet
ET 200SP motor starter
Introduction
ET 200SP motor starters

Overview

1 2 3 4 5 6 6 7
2

1
IC01_00662a

5 9
1 ET 200SP interface module

IC01_00613a
2 ET 200SP digital input
3 1 ET 200SP fail-safe motor starter 3 ET 200SP digital output
2 BaseUnit for ET 200SP motor starter 4 ET 200SP analog input
7 Dummy module consisting of
3 Fan 5 Dummy module consisting of BaseUnit + BU cover, 30 mm
BaseUnit + BU cover, 15 mm
4 3DI/LC module 8 3DI/LC module
4
6 ET 200SP motor starter F-DI and 9 Infeed bus cover
5 Infeed bus cover ET 200SP motor starter

Motor starter, BaseUnit, fan and 3DI/LC control module 3RK1308 motor starter in the ET 200SP I/O system

8
6

More information
HYBRID MOTOR
STARTERS

Homepage, www.siemens.com/ET200SP-motorstarter
Homepage, see www.siemens.com/ET200SP-motorstarter Further
Further components
components in in the
the ET
ET 200SP
200SP I/O
I/O system:
system:
Industry Mall,
Industry Mall, see
see www.siemens.com/product?3RK1308
www.siemens.com/product?3RK1308 •• Catalog
CatalogSTST70
70
TIA Selection
Selection Tool, see
see www.siemens.com/TST
www.siemens.com/TST •• Industry
Industry Mall, see
see www.siemens.de/product?ET200SP
www.siemens.de/product?ET200SP

ET 200SP motor starters


ET 200SP is a scalable and extremely flexible modular • The signal states in the process image of the motor starter
I/O system. provide information about protective devices (short circuit or
overload), the switching states of the motor starter, and
As I/O modules, the ET 200SP motor starters are an integral part system faults.
of this I/O system. They are switching and protection devices for
single- and three-phase loads and are available as direct-on-line Starter Kit
or reversing starters. The 3RK1908-1SK00
The 3RK1908-1SK00Starter
StarterKit
Kitisisa afavorably
favorablypriced complete
priced complete
Basic functionality package for
package forswitching
switchingand
andmonitoring
monitoring motors
motorsin the ET 200SP
in the ET 200SP
system, see page
system, see page6/21.
8/104.
All versions of the ET 200SP motor starter feature the following
functionality: It contains:
• Fully pre-wired motor starters for switching and protecting any • a 3RK1308-0BC00-0CP0 reversing starter (0.9 to 3 A)
AC loads up to 5.5 kW from 48 V AC to 500 V AC • a 3RK1908-0AP00-0AP0 BaseUnit with 500 V and
• Disconnection possible via fail-safe motor starters up to SIL 3 24 V AC/DC infeed
and PL e Cat. 4 • an EMC distance module
• With self-assembling 32 A power bus, i.e. the load voltage is (consisting of 6ES7193-6BP00-0BA0 BaseUnit plus
only fed in once for a group of motor starters 6ES7133-6CV15-1AM0 BU cover 15 mm)
• All control supply voltages connected only once, i.e. when Use of fan
modules are added they are automatically connected to the
next module For motor starters with a 12 A rated current, the
3RW4928-8VB00 fan is included in the scope of supply.
• Hot swapping is permissible
• Digital inputs can optionally be used via a 3DI/LC module This fan
fan can
can also
alsobe
beordered
orderedas asan
anoption
optionforformotor
motorstarters
starterswith
with
lower rated
rated currents,
currents,ififthe
theboundary
boundaryconditions
conditions demand
demand this.
this.
• Control of the motor starter from the control system and For information
informationon onthe
theambient
ambientconditions
conditionsforfor the
the use
use of of motor
motor
extensive diagnostics status via the cyclic process image starters, see chapter
starters, see chapter“Product
"Product overview”
overview" inin the
theEquipment
Equipment
• Diagnostics capability for active monitoring of the switching Manual.
and protection functions

6/12 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Hybrid Motor Starters

ET 200SP
Load Feedersmotor starter
and Motor Starters for Use in the Control Cabinet

Introduction
ET 200SP motor starters
Designing interference-free motor starters BaseUnits for motor starters
For interference-free operation of the ET 200SP station in
1 24 V and 500 V DC
accordance with IEC 60947-4-2 standard, use a dummy module
before the first motor starter. The dummy module consists of the 2 500 V AC
6ES7193-6BP00-0BA0 or 6ES7193-6BP00-0DA0 BaseUnit and 3 24 V DC
the 6ES7133-6CV15-1AM0 BU cover 15 mm.
4 without infeed
The 15 mm BU cover protects the plug contacts of the BaseUnit 5 3RK1908-0AP00-0EP0
against dirt. (not shown here)
Electromechanical switching devices in series with hybrid motor 6 3RK1908-0AP00-0FP0
starters (not shown here)

IC01_00535a
Switching an inductive load - in particular of motors <1 kW with 7 500 V AC
high inductance - with an electromechanical switching device with F-DI infeed
(e.g. contactor) can cause high and steep voltage edges. 8 500 V AC
1 2 3 4 7 8 9 10
The resulting faults/damage can be prevented by first with F-DI loop-through
disconnecting with the hybrid motor starter or by using EMC 9 without infeed
suppression modules: with F-DI infeed
• 3RT2916-1P.. EMC
• For 3RT2916-1P.. EMC suppression
suppression modules for direct 10 without infeed
mounting on the contactor, see page
page 13/133.
3/118 with F-DI loop-through
• For motor suppression modules
• modules that
that are
are fitted
fitted in
in the
the main
main
circuit, see
see page
page 18/104
6/21.
View of the BaseUnit infeeds for the motor starters
Note: BaseUnits are components for accommodating the ET 200SP
For more
more information,
information,see
see I/O modules.
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109758696..
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109758696. The self-assembling voltage buses integrated into the BaseUnits
3DI/LC control module reduce wiring outlay to the single infeed (both of auxiliary and
load voltage).
This is
is aa digital
digitalinput
inputmodule
modulewith
withthree
threeinputs
inputsfor
forlocal
localmotor
motor
starter functions
functions such
such as
as“manual
"manuallocal
localcontrol”,
control",“implementation
"implementation All modules following on the right are automatically supplied
of fast inputs”
inputs" or “end
"end position disconnection”.
disconnection". For
For aa list
list of
of all
allthe
the upon plugging the BaseUnits together, if BaseUnits are inserted
functions
functions permitted
permitted byby the
the 3DI/LC module, see chapter "Overview
“Overview with routing.
8

of functions"
functions”ininthetheEquipment
EquipmentManual.
Manual.

6
The rugged design and keyed connection technology enables
The module is plugged into the front of the motor starter from use in harsh industrial conditions.
which it is supplied with a 24 V DC operating voltage.

STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
The BaseUnits are available with various infeeds for the motor
starters.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 6/13


Hybrid Motor Starters
Load Feeders and Motor Starters for Use in the Control Cabinet
ET 200SP motor starter
General data
ET 200SP motor starters
Article No. scheme

Product versions Article number


Motor starters 3RK1308 – 0 @ @ 0 0 – 0 C P 0
Product function Direct-on-line starters A For motor standard output 0.09 ... 5.5 kW1)
Reversing starters B For motor standard output 0.09 ... 5.5 kW1)
Fail-safe direct-on-line starters C For motor standard output 0.09 ... 5.5 kW1)
Fail-safe reversing starters D For motor standard output 0.09 ... 5.5 kW1)
Current range 0.1 ... 0.4 A A Maximum current-carrying capacity when starting 4 A
0.3 ... 1 A B Maximum current-carrying capacity when starting 10 A
0.9 ... 3 A C Maximum current-carrying capacity when starting 30 A
2.8 ... 9 A D Maximum current-carrying capacity when starting 90 A
4 ... 12 A E Including fan (3RW4928-8VB00),
maximum current-carrying capacity when starting 100 A
Example 3RK1308 – 0 A D 0 0 – 0 C P 0
1)
For standard motors: Single- or three-phase asynchronous motors,
single-phase AC motors, single-phase asynchronous motors, at 400 V AC
and 500 V AC; the actual startup characteristics of the motor as well as its
rated data are important factors here.

Product versions Article number


BaseUnit 3RK1908 – 0 A P 0 0 – 0 @ P 0
BU infeed 24 V and 500 V AC A
24 V DC B
500 V AC C
without infeed D
500 V AC G with F-DI infeed
500 V AC H with F-DI loop-through
without infeed J with F-DI loop-through
without infeed K with F-DI infeed

8
6

Example 3RK1908 – 0 A P 0 0 – 0 A P 0

Note:
HYBRID MOTOR
STARTERS

The article number schemes show an overview of product ver- For your orders, please use the article numbers quoted in the
sions for better understanding of the logic behind the article selection and ordering data.
numbers.

■ Benefits
Product advantages • The ET 200SP
• 200SP motor
motor starters
starters can
can be used with highly energy-
highly energy
efficient IE3/IE4 motors,
efficient IE3/IE4 motors, see
see Application
ApplicationManual.
Manual.
The ET 200SP motor starters offer a number of advantages: Take the current characteristics
characteristics ofof the
the connected
connectedmotor
motorandand
• Fully integrated into the ET 200SP I/O system (including motor starter into account when dimensioning.
dimensioning. In In addition
additiontoto
TIA Selection Tool and TIA Portal) the rated current, the maximum
maximum permissible
permissiblecurrent
currentrange
rangeofof
• High degree of flexibility when it comes to safety applications the motor starter and the ratio of the rated current
current to
to the
via SIMATIC F-CPU or SIRIUS 3SK safety relays up to SIL 3 starting current
current of
of the
the motor are
are relevant.
relevant.
and PL e Cat. 4. For more information on IE3/IE4, see page page 1/7.
1/7.
• Simple, integrated current value transmission Standards and approvals
• Extensive parameterization by means of TIA Portal • IEC/EN 60947-4-2
• Increase of plant availability through fast replacement of units • UL 60947-4-2
(easy mounting and plug-in technology) • CSA
• Greater endurance and reduced heat losses thanks to hybrid • ATEX
technology
• IEC 61508-1: SIL 3
• Less space required in the control cabinet (20 to 80%) as a
result of greater functional density (direct-on-line and • ISO 13849: PL e
reversing starters in same width) • CCC approval for China
• Extensive diagnostics and information for preventive
maintenance
• Parameterizable inputs via 3DI/LC control module
• Less wiring and testing required as a result of integrating
several functions into a single device
• Lower overheads for stock keeping and configuration as a
result of the wide setting range of the electronic overload
release (up to 1:3)
• Technology has lower inherent power losses than speed-
controlledSiemens
6/14 drive systems, so that
Industry Inc., less cooling
Industrial (and smaller
Control Catalog
footprint) are possible
Hybrid Motor Starters
Load Feeders and Motor Starters for Use in the Control Cabinet
ET 200SP motor starter
General data
ET 200SP motor starters

Application
The ET 200SP motor starters are suitable for the following • Track switching and lifting table control in conveyor systems:
applications: Track switches can be implemented using the quick stop
• Switching and monitoring of function and lifting table controls by means of the "immediate
- three-phase motors with overload and short-circuit end position disconnection" function without any laborious
protection (e.g. 400 V asynchronous motors for secondary programming.
drives in conveyor systems) • Safe isolation of the drive from main power supply:
- single-phase motors with overload and short-circuit The isolating functions according to IEC 60947-1 offer
protection (e.g. 230 V motors for pump applications) protection against inadvertent activation during plant
- Resistive loads by means of current value and diagnostics maintenance.
via the maintenance function (e.g. for heaters)
Motor starters in the process industry
• Plant monitoring and energy management in conveyor
systems: For the ET 200SP motor starters, special BaseUnits are available
By means of the phase asymmetry and zero current detection that enable the device to be used in the ET 200SP HA
during current measurement, for example, drive belt I/O system, too. This is typically used in process engineering
monitoring and blocking monitoring are possible. applications.

Technical specifications
More information
Industry Mall, see
Industry Mall, see www.siemens.com/product?3RK1308
www.siemens.com/product?3RK1308 FAQs,
FAQs, see
see https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/21800/faq
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/21800/faq
Equipment Manual,
Manual, see
see
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109479973
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109479973

ET 200SP motor starters


Article number 3RK1308- 3RK1308- 3RK1308- 3RK1308- 3RK1308-
0AA00-0CP0 0AB00-0CP0 0AC00-0CP0 0AD00-0CP0 0AE00-0CP0
3RK1308- 3RK1308- 3RK1308- 3RK1308- 3RK1308-
0BA00-0CP0 0BB00-0CP0 0BC00-0CP0 0BD00-0CP0 0BE00-0CP0
Product category Motor starters
General technical specifications:
8

6
Width x height x depth mm 30 × 142 × 150

STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
H

Design of the switching contact Hybrid


Design of the motor protection Electronic
Installation altitude at height above sea level, m 4 000
maximum
Mounting position Vertical, horizontal, flat (observe derating)
Type of mounting Can be plugged into BaseUnit
Ambient temperature
• During operation °C -25 ... +60
• During transport °C -40 ... +70
• During storage °C -40 ... +70
Relative humidity during operation % 10 ... 95
Vibration resistance 15 mm up to 6 Hz; 2 g up to 500 Hz
Shock resistance 6 g / 11 ms
Type of coordination 1
Electrical data:
Supply voltage at DC rated value V 24
Operational power for AC-53a at 400 V kW 0.12 0.25 1.1 4 5.5
rated value
Operating frequency, rated value Hz 50 ... 60
Ultimate short-circuit current breaking capacity (Icu)
• at 400 V rated value kA 55
• at 500 V rated value kA 55
Adjustable current response value of the A 0.1 ... 0.4 0.3 ... 1 0.9 ... 3 2.8 ... 9 4 ... 12
inverse-time delayed overload release
Max. current carrying capacity at startup A 4 10 30 90 100
Max. permissible voltage for protective V 500
separation between main and auxiliary circuit
Insulation voltage, rated value V 500
Trip class CLASS 5 and 10 adjustable

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 6/15


Hybrid Motor Starters
Load Feeders and Motor Starters for Use in the Control Cabinet
ET 200SP motor starter
General data
ET 200SP motor starters
ET 200SP fail-safe motor starters
Article number 3RK1308- 3RK1308- 3RK1308- 3RK1308- 3RK1308-
0CA00-0CP0 0CB00-0CP0 0CC00-0CP0 0CD00-0CP0 0CE00-0CP0
3RK1308- 3RK1308- 3RK1308- 3RK1308- 3RK1308-
0DA00-0CP0 0DB00-0CP0 0DC00-0CP0 0DD00-0CP0 0DE00-0CP0
Product category Motor starters
General technical specifications:
Width x height x depth mm 30 × 142 × 150
H

Design of the switch contact Hybrid


Design of the motor protection Electronic
Installation altitude at height above sea level, m 2 000
maximum
Mounting position Vertical, horizontal, flat (observe derating)
Type of mounting Can be plugged into BaseUnit
Ambient temperature
• During operation °C -25 ... +60
• During transport °C -40 ... +70
• During storage °C -40 ... +70
Relative humidity during operation % 10 ... 95
Vibration resistance 15 mm up to 6 Hz; 2 g up to 500 Hz
Shock resistance 6 g / 11 ms
Type of coordination 1
Electrical data:
Supply voltage at DC rated value V 24
Operational power for AC-53a at 400 V, kW 0.12 0.25 1.1 4 5.5
rated value

8
Operating frequency, rated value Hz 50 ... 60
6

Ultimate short-circuit current breaking capacity (Icu)


• at 400 V rated value kA 55
HYBRID MOTOR
STARTERS

• at 500 V rated value kA 55


Adjustable current response value of the A 0.1 ... 0.4 0.3 ... 1 0.9 ... 3 2.8 ... 9 4 ... 12
inverse-time delayed overload release
Max. current carrying capacity at startup A 4 10 30 90 100
Max. permissible voltage for protective V 500
separation between main and auxiliary circuit
Insulation voltage, rated value V 500
Trip class CLASS 5 and 10 adjustable

6/16 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Hybrid Motor Starters
Load Feeders and Motor Starters for Use in the Control Cabinet
ET 200SP motor starter
General data
ET 200SP motor starters
BaseUnits for motor starters

Article number 3RK1908- 3RK1908- 3RK1908- 3RK1908- 3RK1908- 3RK1908- 3RK1908- 3RK1908-
0AP00-0AP0 0AP00-0BP0 0AP00-0CP0 0AP00-0DP0 0AP00-0GP0 0AP00-0HP0 0AP00-0JP0 0AP00-0KP0
Product designation BaseUnit
General technical
specifications:
Width x height x depth mm 30 × 215 × 75
H

Ambient temperature
• During operation °C -25 ... +60
• During transport °C -40 ... +70
• During storage °C -40 ... +70
Touch protection against Finger-safe
electric shock
Connections/terminals:
Type of connectable conductor
cross-sections
• At the inputs for supply voltage
- Solid 1 x 0.5 ... 2.5 mm2 --
- Finely stranded 1 x 0.5 ... 2.5 mm2 --
with end sleeve
- Finely stranded 1 x 0.5 ... 2.5 mm2 --
without end sleeve
- Solid for AWG cables 1 x 20 ... 12 --
• For infeed
- Solid 1 x 1 ... 6 mm2 -- 1 x 1 ... 6 mm2 -- 1 x 1 ... 6 mm2 --
- Finely stranded 1 x 1 ... 6 mm2 -- 1 x 1 ... 6 mm2 -- 1 x 1 ... 6 mm2 --
with end sleeve
- Finely stranded 1 x 1 ... 6 mm2 -- 1 x 1 ... 6 mm2 -- 1 x 1 ... 6 mm2 --
without end sleeve
8

- Solid for AWG cables 1 x 18 ... 10 -- 1 x 18 ... 10 -- 1 x 18 ... 10 --

6
• For load-side outgoing feeder
- Solid 1 x 0.5 ... 2.5 mm2
1 x 0.5 ... 2.5 mm2

STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
- Finely stranded
with end sleeve
- Finely stranded 1 x 0.5 ... 2.5 mm2
without end sleeve
- Solid for AWG cables 1 x 20 ... 12
Type of electrical connection for Spring-loaded terminals (push-in)
auxiliary and control circuits
Miscellaneous:
Type of screwdriver tip Slotted
Size of screwdriver tip Standard screwdriver 0.6 mm x 3.5 mm

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 6/17


Hybrid Motor Starters
Load Feeders and Motor Starters for Use in the Control Cabinet
ET 200SP motor starter
General data
ET 200SP motor starters
3DI/LC control module
Article number 3RK1908-1AA00-0BP0
Product designation 3DI/LC control module
General technical specifications:
Width x height x depth mm 30 × 54.5 × 42.3
H

Type of product Accessories


Number of digital inputs 4
Installation altitude at height above sea level, m 2 000
maximum
Mounting position Vertical, horizontal, flat
Type of mounting Can be plugged onto motor starter
Ambient temperature
• During operation °C -25 ... +60
• During transport °C -40 ... +70
• During storage °C -40 ... +70
Connections/terminals:
Connectable conductor
cross-section for auxiliary contacts
• Solid or stranded mm² 0.2 ... 1.5
• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm² 0.25 ... 1.5
• Finely stranded without end sleeve mm² 0.2 ... 1.5
AWG number as coded connectable conductor 24 ... 16
cross-section
Type of electrical connection for auxiliary and Spring-loaded terminals (push-in)
control circuits
Electrical data:
Type of voltage of the control supply voltage DC

8
6

Control supply voltage at DC rated value V 20.4 ... 28.8


Miscellaneous:
HYBRID MOTOR
STARTERS

Type of screwdriver tip Slotted


Size of screwdriver tip Standard screwdriver 0.6 mm x 3.5 mm

6/18 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Hybrid Motor Starters
Load Feeders and Motor Starters for Use in the Control Cabinet
ET 200SP motor starter
Selection and ordering data IE3/IE4 ready
ET 200SP motor starters

■ Selection and ordering data


Adjustable current response Max. current carrying SD Article No. Price PU (UNIT, PS*
value of the inverse-time capacity at startup per PU SET, M)
delayed overload release at 480V
A A d
Motor starters
Direct-on-line starters
0.1 ... 0.4 3.2 NEW NEU
2 3RK1308-0AA00-0CP0 1 1 unit
0.3 ... 1 8 2 3RK1308-0AB00-0CP0 1 1 unit
0.9 ... 3 24 2 3RK1308-0AC00-0CP0 1 1 unit
2.8 ... 9 72 2 3RK1308-0AD00-0CP0 1 1 unit
4 ... 12 72 2 3RK1308-0AE00-0CP0 1 1 unit

3RK1308-0AB00-0CP0
Reversing starters
0.1 ... 0.4 3.2 NEW NEU
2 3RK1308-0BA00-0CP0 1 1 unit
0.3 ... 1 8 2 3RK1308-0BB00-0CP0 1 1 unit
0.9 ... 3 24 2 3RK1308-0BC00-0CP0 1 1 unit
2.8 ... 9 72 2 3RK1308-0BD00-0CP0 1 1 unit
4 ... 12 72 2 3RK1308-0BE00-0CP0 1 1 unit

3RK1308-0BB00-0CP0
Fail-safe direct-on-line starters
0.1 ... 0.4 3.2 2 3RK1308-0CA00-0CP0 1 1 unit
8

NEW NEU

6
0.3 ... 1 8 2 3RK1308-0CB00-0CP0 1 1 unit
0.9 ... 3 24 2 3RK1308-0CC00-0CP0 1 1 unit
2.8 ... 9 72 2 3RK1308-0CD00-0CP0 1 1 unit

STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
4 ... 12 72 2 3RK1308-0CE00-0CP0 1 1 unit

3RK1308-0CE00-0CP0
Fail-safe reversing starters
0.1 ... 0.4 3.2 NEW NEU
2 3RK1308-0DA00-0CP0 1 1 unit
0.3 ... 1 8 2 3RK1308-0DB00-0CP0 1 1 unit
0.9 ... 3 24 2 3RK1308-0DC00-0CP0 1 1 unit
2.8 ... 9 72 2 3RK1308-0DD00-0CP0 1 1 unit
4 ... 12 72 2 3RK1308-0DE00-0CP0 1 1 unit

3RK1308-0DE00-0CP0

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 6/19

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Hybrid Motor Starters
Load Feeders and Motor Starters for Use in the Control Cabinet
ET 200SP motor starter
Base units and control module
ET 200SP motor starters

Type of product Operational Supply voltage SD Push-in terminals PU (UNIT, PS*


voltage of the DC SET, M)
of the AC infeed Article No. Price
infeed per PU
V V d
BaseUnits1)
For motor starters
• with AC/DC infeed 500 24 2 3RK1908-0AP00-0AP0 1 1 unit
• with DC infeed -- 24 2 3RK1908-0AP00-0BP0 1 1 unit
• with AC infeed 500 -- 2 3RK1908-0AP00-0CP0 1 1 unit
• without infeed -- -- 2 3RK1908-0AP00-0DP0 1 1 unit
For fail-safe motor starters NEW NEU

• with AC infeed, 500 -- 2 3RK1908-0AP00-0GP0 1 1 unit


with F-DI infeed for
3RK1908-0AP00-0AP0 fail-safe motor starters
• with AC infeed, 500 -- 2 3RK1908-0AP00-0HP0 1 1 unit
with F-DI loop-through for
fail-safe motor starters
• without AC/DC infeed, -- -- 2 3RK1908-0AP00-0JP0 1 1 unit
with F-DI loop-through for
fail-safe motor starters
• without AC/DC infeed, -- -- 2 3RK1908-0AP00-0KP0 1 1 unit
with F-DI infeed for
fail-safe motor starters
1)
The voltage is looped-through from BaseUnits with infeed to subsequent
BaseUnits without infeed.

Type of product Supply voltage Loop through the SD Push-in terminals PU (UNIT, PS*
at DC rated potential group SET, M)
value from the left Article No. Price
per PU

8
V d
6

BaseUnits
For dummy modules
HYBRID MOTOR
STARTERS

• dark, looping through the 24 Yes 1 6ES7193-6BP00-0BA0 1 1 unit


potential group
• light, opening a new 24 No 1 6ES7193-6BP00-0DA0 1 1 unit
potential group

6ES7193-6BP00-0BA0

Control supply voltage Product function SD Push-in terminals PU (UNIT, PS*


at DC SET, M)
rated value Local control Digital inputs Article No. Price
parameterizable per PU
V d
3DI/LC control module
20.4 ... 28.8 Yes Yes 2 3RK1908-1AA00-0BP0 1 1 unit

3RK1908-1AA00-0BP0

6/20 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Hybrid Motor Starters
Load Feeders and Motor Starters for Use in the Control Cabinet
ET 200SP motor starter
Accessories
ET 200SP motor starters

Product designation Type of product SD Article No. Price PU (UNIT, PS*


d per PU SET, M)

Accessories
BU cover 15 mm for BaseUnits 1 6ES7133-6CV15-1AM0 1 5 units
Type A0 or A1

6ES7133-6CV15-1AM0
BU cover 30 mm For protection of 2 3RK1908-1CA00-0BP0 1 1 unit
empty slots, 30 mm

3RK1908-1CA00-0BP0
Infeed bus cover For ET 200SP 2 3RK1908-1DA00-2BP0 1 1 unit
(1 bag containing
10 covers)

3RK1908-1DA00-2BP0
Mechanical bracket Mechanical, 2 3RK1908-1EA00-1BP0 1 1 unit
(1 bag containing for ET 200SP
8

6
5 mechanical brackets)

3RK1908-1EA00-1BP0

STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
Fan Can be used for 3RK1308 } 3RW4928-8VB00 1 1 unit

3RW4928-8VB00

Motor suppression module


• Square 15 3RK1911-6EA00 1 1 unit

3RK1911-6EA00

• Round 15 3RK1911-6EB00 1 1 unit

3RK1911-6EB00
Starter Kit NEW NEU
consists of 5 3RK1908-1SK00 1 1 unit
3RK1308-0BC00-0CP0
reversing starter
(0.9 ... 3 A),
3RK1908-0AP00-0AP0
BaseUnit with 500 V and
24 V AC/DC infeed, and
EMC distance module
(consisting of
6ES7193-6BP00-0BA0
BaseUnit plus
6ES7133-6CV15-1AM0 BU
cover 15 mm)
3RK1908-1SK00

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 6/21

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Siemens IC 10 · 2020
Hybrid Motor Starters
Motor Starters for Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
For Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
Introduction
Introduction

Overview
Flexible and cost-efficient distributed starter solutions
Be it their high degree of protection, compact design or inte-
grated multifunctionality – our motor starters and soft starters for
use in the field are ideal for realizing distributed drive solutions.
The modular concepts, distributed power supply and integrated
safety technology of our portfolio for a high degree of protection
consistently supports current trends in drive technology.

3RK1304 3RK1315
Type Page
ET 200pro motor starters
Motor starters in the SIMATIC ET 200pro I/O system up to 5.5 kW
Standard motor starters 3RK1304 6/28
High Feature motor starters 3RK1304 6/29
ET 200pro isolator modules • With switch disconnector function for safe disconnection 3RK1304 6/30
Safety modules local • Isolator module, 400 V disconnecting module 3RK1304 6/31
Safety modules PROFIsafe • F-Switch PROFIsafe 6ES7148 6/34
Accessories for ET 200pro motor starters • Incoming power supply, power loop-through connection on the field device, 3RK19 6/35
motor cable, power bus with power terminal connectors
6

ET 200pro – interface modules • For communication with PROFIBUS, PROFINET and IWLAN 6ES71 ST 70
ET 200pro – CPUs • Standard CPUs, fail-safe CPUs 6ES71 ST 70
HYBRID MOTOR
STARTERS

ET 200pro – I/O modules • Digital/analog expansion modules, fail-safe expansion modules, 6ES71 ST 70
power modules, ET 200pro pneumatic interfaces
9

ET 200pro PS • Stabilized power supplies 6ES7148 ST 70


ET 200pro FC-2 frequency converters 6SL35 D 31.2
ET 200pro add-on products • Modules for EtherNet/IP ZNX:EIP ST 70
SIRIUS M200D motor starters
Distributed motor starters up to 5.5 kW
M200D AS-i Basic motor starters 3RK1315 6/47
M200D AS-i Standard motor starters 3RK1325 6/48
M200D communication modules for PROFIBUS 3RK1305 6/55
M200D communication modules for PROFINET 3RK1335 6/55
M200D motor starter modules 3RK1395 6/55
Accessories • Incoming power supply, motor cable, power bus with power terminal connectors 3RK1911 6/59
• Motor control with I/O communication 3RK1902 6/61
• Motor control with AS-i communication 3RK1902 6/62
• Motor control with PROFIBUS 3RK1902 6/64
• Motor control with PROFINET 3RK1902 6/65
Hybrid fieldbus connections
• Passive and active 3RK1911 6/67

6/22 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Hybrid Motor Starters
Motor Starters for Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
ET 200pro motor starter ET 200pro Motor Starters
General data
General data

■ Overview
ET 200pro motor starters in I/O system ET 200pro
More information
SIMATIC ET 200pro is the modular I/O system with high degree
Homepage,
Homepage, see see www.siemens.com/ET200pro
www.siemens.com/ET200pro
of protection IP65/66/67 for local, cabinet-free use. The
ET 200pro motor starters with the high degree of protection IP65 Industry
Industry Mall,
Mall, see
see www.siemens.com/product?ET200pro
www.siemens.com/product?ET200pro
are an integral part of ET 200pro. Further
Further components
components in in the
the ET
ET 200pro
200pro distributed
distributed I/O
I/O system:
system:

• Interface modules, central
Interface modules, central units,
units, I/O
I/O modules,
modules, ETET 200pro
200pro PS,
PS,
see Catalog
see Catalog ST
ST 70
70
• ET200pro
• ET 200proFC-2
FC-2frequency
frequencyconverters,
converters, see
see Catalog
Catalog D 31.2
D 31.2

ET 200pro isolator modules (see page


page6/30)
9/10)
The isolator module with switch disconnector function is used for
safe disconnection of the 400 V operational voltage during
repair work in the plant and provides an integrated group fusing
function (i.e. additional group short-circuit protection for all
subsequently supplied motor starters).
Depending on the power distribution concept, all stations can be
equipped with an isolator module as an option.
Safety applications
Safety Solution local (see page
page6/31)
9/11)
With the Safety local modules
• Safety local isolator module and
• 400 V disconnecting module
ET 200pro motor starter: Isolator module, Standard starter and with an appropriate connection, safety level PL e
High Feature starter mounted on a wide module rack (according to ISO 13849-1) can be reached.
ET 200pro motor starters (see pagespages6/28
9/8 and 9/9)
and 6/29) Safety Solution PROFIsafe (see page6/34)
(see page 9/14)
• Only two variants up to 5.5 kW With the Safety PROFIsafe modules
• All settings can be parameterized by bus • F-Switch and
• 400 V disconnecting module

6
• Comprehensive diagnostic signals
with an appropriate connection, safety levels SIL 3
• Support for PROFIenergy (according to IEC 62061) and PL e (according to ISO 13849-1)

STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
• Overload can be acknowledged by remote RESET can also be reached.
• Current asymmetry monitoring

9
Functionality
• Stall protection With the ET 200pro motor starters, any three-phase loads can be
• EMERGENCY START function on overload protected and switched.
• Current value transmission by bus The ET 200pro motor starters are available with mechanical and
• Current limit monitoring also electronic contacts.
• Full support of acyclic services The ET 200pro electromechanical starters are offered as
• Direct-on-line or reversing starters direct-on-line starters (DSe) and reversing starters (RSe) as
• Power bus connection can be plugged in using Han Q4/2 Standard and High Feature versions. There are device versions
connectors with or without control for externally fed brakes with 400 V AC.
• Motor feeder with Han Q8/0 plug Compared with the Standard motor starters, the High Feature,
mechanical motor starter also has:
• Conductor cross-section up to 6 x 4 mm²
• Four digital inputs
• 25 A per segment (power looped through using jumper plug)
• Advanced parameterization options
• In the Standard and High Feature versions
(with 4 DI on-board) The ET 200pro electronic starters are offered as direct-on-line
• Electromechanical switching and electronic switching starters (sDSSte/sDSte) and reversing starters (sRSSte/sRSte) in
the High Feature version.
• Electronic starter for direct activation or with integrated soft
starter function Compared with the High Feature mechanical motor starters, the
• Supplied with 400 V AC brake contact as an option High Feature electronic motor starter also has:
• Temperature sensor can be connected • Soft starting and smooth ramp-down function
(Thermoclick or PTC type A) • Deactivated soft start function as an electronic starter for
• Provision of the motor current in PROFIenergy format to applications with a high switching frequency
higher-level systems, motor current shutdown in dead times • Advanced parameterization options
using PROFIenergy

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 6/23


Hybrid Motor Starters

ET 200pro
Motor motor
Starters starter
for Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
ET 200pro Motor Starters
General data
General data
As a result of the protection concept with solid-state overload • Expansions are easily possible through the subsequent
evaluation and the use of SIRIUS switching devices, size S00, adding of modules. The innovative plug-in technology also
additional advantages are realized on the Standard and does away with the wiring needed up to now. Through the hot
High Feature motor starters – advantages that soon make swapping function (disconnection and connection during
themselves positively felt particularly in manufacturing operation) a motor starter can be replaced within seconds if
processes with high plant stoppage costs: necessary, without having to shut down the ET 200pro station
• Configuration is made easier and flexibility is increased by the and with it the process in the plant. The motor starters are
fine modular structure with ET 200pro. When using ET 200pro therefore recommendable in particular for applications with
motor starters, the parts list per load feeder is reduced to two special demands on availability. Storage costs are also opti-
main items: the bus module and the motor starter. This makes mized by the low level of variance (two units up to 7.5 HP).
the ET 200pro ideal for modular machine concepts or solu- • With four locally acting inputs available on the High Feature
tions for conveying systems and in machine-tool building. motor starter it is possible to realize autonomous special
functions that work independently of the bus and the higher
level control system, e.g. as a quick stop on gate valve
controls or limit position disconnectors. In parallel with this, the
states of these inputs are signaled to the control system.
Article No. scheme

Product versions Article number


Motor starters 3RK1304 – 5 @ S @ 0 – @ A A @
Setting range 0.15 ... 2.0 A K
1.5 ... 12 A L
Product function Direct-on-line starters DSe 4 4 Standard
Reversing starters RSe 4 5 Standard
Direct-on-line starters DSe 4 2 High Feature
Reversing starters RSe 4 3 High Feature
Direct-on-line starters 7 2 High Feature
sDSSte/sDSte
Reversing starters sDSSte/sDSte 7 3 High Feature
Inputs/outputs Without brake output 0
With brake output 3 400 V AC, with High Feature + 4 inputs
6

Example 3RK1304 – 5 K S 4 0 – 4 A A 0
HYBRID MOTOR
STARTERS

Product versions Article number


9

Modules 3RK1304 – 0 H S 0 0 – @ A A 0
Product function Isolator modules 6
Isolator modules 7 Safety modules local
400 V disconnecting modules 8 Safety modules local/PROFIsafe
Example 3RK1304 – 0 H S 0 0 – 6 A A 0

Note:
The Article No. scheme shows an overview of product versions
for better understanding of the logic behind the article numbers.
For your orders, please use the article numbers quoted in the
selection and ordering data.

6/24 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Hybrid Motor Starters
Motor Starters for Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
ET 200pro motor starter ET 200pro Motor Starters
General data
General data

Type Standard motor starters High Feature motor starters


Technology designation1) DSe, RSe DSe, RSe sDSSte, sDSte,
sRSSte, sRSte
Device functions (firmware features)
Parameterizable rated operational current ✓
Integrated short-circuit protection ✓
Parameterizable current limit values -- ✓ 2 limit values
Parameterizable response in case of current limit violation -- ✓
Zero current monitoring ✓
Parameterizable response in case of zero current violation ✓
Parameterizable current asymmetry limit % -- Fixed limit value (30 x Ie) ✓ 30 ... 60 x Ie
Parameterizable response in case of asymmetry limit violation ✓
Motor blocking monitoring -- ✓
Parameterizable blocking current limit % -- ✓ 150 ... 1 000 x Ie
Parameterizable blocking time limit s -- ✓ 1 ... 5
Current value transmission ✓
Group warning diagnostics -- ✓ Parameterizable
Group diagnostics ✓ Parameterizable
EMERGENCY START ✓
Digital inputs -- ✓ 4 inputs
• Parameterizable input signal -- ✓ Latching/non-latching
• Parameterizable input level -- ✓ NC/NO contacts
• Parameterizable input signal delay ms -- ✓ 10 ... 80
• Parameterizable input signal extension ms -- ✓ 0 ... 200
• Parameterizable input control actions -- ✓ 12 different actions
Brake output (400 V AC) ✓ Order option
Parameterizable brake enabling delay s ✓ -2.5 ... +2.5
Parameterizable holding time of the brake during stopping s ✓ 0 ... 25
Parameterizable startup type -- ✓
Parameterizable ramp-down time -- ✓

6
Parameterizable starting voltage -- ✓
Parameterizable stopping voltage -- ✓

STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
Local device interface ✓
Firmware update ✓ By specialists

9
Thermal motor model ✓
Parameterizable trip class -- CLASS 10 fixed ✓ CLASS 5, 10, 15, 20
Parameterizable response in case of overload of thermal motor -- ✓ 3 possible states
model
Advance warning limit for motor heating % -- ✓ Parameterizable 0 ... 95
Advance warning limit time-related trip reserve s -- ✓ Parameterizable 0 ... 500
Parameterizable recovery time min -- ✓ 1 ... 30
Parameterizable protection against voltage failure -- Permanently integrated ✓
Reversing start function ✓ Order option
Parameterizable interlock time for reversing starters -- 150 ms fixed ✓ 0 ... 60 s
Integrated logbook functions ✓ 3 device logbooks
Integrated statistics data memory ✓
Parameterizable response in case of CPU/master stop ✓
PROFIenergy profile support
• Disconnection of the motor current during idle times ✓
• Measured motor current values ✓
Device indications
• Group fault SF LED (red)
• Switching state STATE LED (red, yellow, green)
• Device status DEVICE LED (red, yellow, green)
• Digital inputs -- IN 1 ... IN 4, LED
✓ Function available
-- Function not available
1) DS .... Direct-on-line starters
RS .... Reversing starters
DSS .. Direct-on-line soft starters
RSS .. Reversing soft starters
e ....... Electronic motor protection
te ...... Full motor protection (thermal + electronic)
s ....... Electronic switching with semiconductor.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 6/25

Siemens IC 10 · 2020
Hybrid Motor Starters
Motor Starters for Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
ET 200pro motor starter
ET 200pro Motor Starters
General data
General data

■ Benefits
ET 200pro motor starters provide the following advantages: • Extensive diagnostics and information for preventive
• High flexibility thanks to a modular and compact design maintenance
• Little variance among all motor starter versions • Parameterizable inputs for on-site control functions
(two units up to 5.5 kW) (High Feature)
• Extensive parameterization using STEP 7 HW Config • Cabinet-free design thanks to high degree of protection IP65
• Increase of plant availability through fast replacement of units
(easy mounting and plug-in technology)

■ Application
The SIMATIC ET 200pro motor starters are ideal for the use of Use of ET 200pro motor starters in conjunction with
several spatially concentrated distributed drive solutions in IE3/IE4 motors
which several motors, or digital or analog sensors and actuators
are addressed from a distributed station. They are perfectly Note:
suited for protecting and switching any AC loads. For the use of ET
use of ET 200pro
200pro motor
motorstarters
startersininconjunction
conjunctionwith
with highly
highly
energy-efficient IE3/IE4
energy-efficient IE3/IE4 motors,
motors, please
please observe
observe the information
the information
Application areas on dimensioning
dimensioningand andconfiguring;
configuring;
seesee Application
Application Manual.
Manual.
The SIMATIC ET 200pro motor starters are suitable for numerous
sectors of industry, e.g. machinery and plant engineering or
conveying applications.
6 STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
9

6/26 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Hybrid Motor Starters
Motor Starters for Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
ET 200pro motor starter ET 200pro Motor Starters
General data
General data

Technical specifications
More information
Equipment
Equipment Manual,
Manual, see
see Notes
Notes on security:
security:
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/22332388
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/22332388 System networking
networking requires
requires suitable
suitableprotective
protectivemeasures
measures(including
(including network
network
segmentation for IT
segmentation for IT security)
security)ininorder
ordertotoensure
ensuresafe
safeplant
plantoperation.
operation.
For more
For information on
more information on the
the subject
subjectof ofIndustrial
IndustrialSecurity,
Security,see
see
www.siemens.com/industrialsecurity.
www.siemens.com/industrialsecurity.

Type Standard motor starters High Feature motor starters


Mechanical switching Mechanical switching Electronic switching
without inputs with inputs with inputs and
soft starter function
Technology designation1) DSe, RSe DSe, RSe sDSSte, sDSte,
sRSSte, sRSte
Mechanics and environment
Motor starters or modules that can be connected to ET 200pro max. 8
With width of 110 mm
Mounting dimensions (W x H x D)
• Direct-on-line starters and reversing starters mm 110 x 230 x 150 110 x 230 x 160
Permissible ambient temperature
• During operation °C -25 ... +55, from +40 with derating
• During storage °C -40 ... +70
Permissible mounting position Vertical, horizontal
Vibration resistance acc. to IEC 60068, Part 2-6 g 2
Shock resistance acc. to IEC 60068, Part 2-27 g/ms Half-sine 15/11
Degree of protection IP65
Pollution degree 3, IEC 60664 (IEC 61131)
Electrical specifications
Power consumption at 24 V DC
• From auxiliary circuit L+/M (U1) mA Approx. 40
• From auxiliary circuit A1/A2 (U2) mA Approx. 200
Rated operational current Ie for power bus A 25

6
Rated operational voltage Ue V AC 400 (50/60 Hz)
• Approval according to EN 60947-1, Appendix N V AC Up to 400 (50/60 Hz) Up to 400 (50/60 Hz)
• Approval according to CSA and UL V AC Up to 600 (50/60 Hz) Up to 480 (50/60 Hz)

STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
Approval

9
• DIN VDE 0106, Part 101 V Up to 400 Up to 480
• CSA and UL approval V Up to 600 Up to 480
Conductor cross-sections
• Incoming power supply mm 2 Max. 6 x 4
Touch protection Finger-safe
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 6
Rated insulation voltage Ui V 400
Rated operational current Ie for starters
• AC-1 / 2 / 3 at 40 °C - At 400 V A 0.15 ... 2.0/1.5 ... 12.0 0.15 ... 2.0/1.5 ... 12.02)
- At 500 V A 0.15 ... 2.0/1.5 ... 9.0
• AC-4 at 40 °C - At 400 V A 0.15 ... 2.0/1.5 ... 4.0
Rated short-circuit breaking capacity kA 100 at 400 V
Type of coordination acc. to IEC 60947-4-1 1
Power of three-phase motors at 400 V kW Max. 5.5 Max. 5.5/43)
Utilization categories AC-1, AC-2, AC-3, AC-4 AC-53a4) (max. 9 A with
deactivated soft start
function up to CLASS 10)
Protective separation between main and auxiliary circuits V 400, acc. to EN 60947-1, Appendix N
Endurance of contactor
• Mechanical Operating cycles 30 million --
• Electrical Operating cycles Up to 10 million; depending on the current loading --
(see manual)
Permissible switching frequency Depending on the current loading, motor starting time, and relative ON period
(see manual)
Operating times for 0.85 ... 1.1 x Ue
• Closing delay ms 11 ... 50 --
• Opening delay ms 5 ... 45 --
1) 2)
DS .... Direct-on-line starters If the soft starter control function is deactivated, the permissible rated
RS .... Reversing starters operational current is reduced to 9 A up to CLASS 10.
DSS .. Direct-on-line soft starters 3)
With parameterization as electronic starter max. 4 kW.
RSS .. Reversing soft starters 4) 8-hour operation.
e ....... Electronic motor protection
te ...... Full motor protection (thermal + electronic)
s ....... Electronic switching with semiconductor.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 6/27

Siemens IC 10 · 2020
Hybrid Motor Starters
Motor Starters for Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
ET 200pro motor starter
ET 200pro Motor Starters
Standard motor starter IE3/IE4 ready
Standard motor starters

■ Overview
The functionality,
functionality,device
devicefunctions,
functions,and technical
and specifications
technical specifications
of the Standard motor starter
Standard motor starterare
aredescribed
describedinin“ET
"ET200pro
200proMotor
Motor
Starters, General
Generaldata”
data"see
(seepage
page 9/3onwards.
6/23 onwards).

■ Selection and ordering data


Version SD Article No. Price PU PS*
per PU (UNIT,
SET, M)
d
Standard motor starters, mechanical
Motor protection: thermal model
DSe direct-on-line starters1)
• Without brake output 2 3RK1304-5@S40-4AA0 1 1 unit
• With brake output 400 V AC 2 3RK1304-5@S40-4AA3 1 1 unit
RSe reversing starters1)
• Without brake output 2 3RK1304-5@S40-5AA0 1 1 unit
• With brake output 400 V AC 2 3RK1304-5@S40-5AA3 1 1 unit

Setting range Additional


Rated operational current price
DSe Standard • 0.15 ... 2.0 A K None
• 1.5 ... 12.0 A L ✓

✓ = Additional price
1) Only functions when
when used
used together
togetherwith
withthe
thebackplane
backplanebus
busmodule
moduleand
andthe
the
backplane bus module and the wide module
wide module rack. The backplane module rack
rack
must be
be ordered
ordered separately (see "Accessories
“Accessoriesfor
forET
ET200pro
200promotor
motor
starters",
starters”,page
page9/19).
6/39).
6 STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
9

6/28 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Hybrid Motor Starters
Motor Starters for Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
ET 200pro motor starter ET 200pro Motor Starters
High Feature motor starter IE3/IE4 ready
High Feature motor starters

■ Overview
The functionality,
functionality,device
devicefunctions,
functions,and
and technical
technical specifications
specifications The High Feature motor starter differs from the Standard motor
of
of the High Feature
the High Featuremotor
motorstarter
starterare
aredescribed
describedin in
“ET"ET 200pro
200pro starter in having more parameters and four integrated, freely-
Motor
Motor Starters, Generaldata”
Starters, General data"see
(seepage
page 9/3onwards.
6/23 onwards). parameterizable digital inputs.

■ Selection and ordering data


Version SD Article No. Price PU PS*
per PU (UNIT,
SET, M)
d
High Feature motor starters, mechanical
Motor protection: thermal model
DSe direct-on-line starters1)
• Without brake output and with 4 inputs 2 3RK1304-5@S40-2AA0 1 1 unit
• With brake output 400 V AC and 4 inputs 5 3RK1304-5@S40-2AA3 1 1 unit
RSe reversing starters1)
• Without brake output and with 4 inputs 2 3RK1304-5@S40-3AA0 1 1 unit
• With brake output 400 V AC and 4 inputs 2 3RK1304-5@S40-3AA3 1 1 unit

Setting range Additional


Rated operational current price
RSe High Feature • 0.15 ... 2.0 A None
K
• 1.5 ... 12.0 A L ✓
High Feature motor starters2), electronic
Full motor protection, comprising thermal motor protection and thermistor
motor protection
sDSSte/sDSte direct-on-line starters1)2)
• Without brake output and with 4 inputs 2 3RK1304-5@S70-2AA0 1 1 unit
• With brake output 400 V AC and 4 inputs 5 3RK1304-5@S70-2AA3 1 1 unit
Reversing starters sRSSte/sRSte1)2)

6
• Without brake output and with 4 inputs 2 3RK1304-5@S70-3AA0 1 1 unit
• With brake output 400 V AC and 4 inputs 2 3RK1304-5@S70-3AA3 1 1 unit

STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
Setting range Additional
Rated operational current price

9
sRSSte High Feature • 0.15 ... 2.0 A None
K
• 1.5 ... 12.0 A L ✓
✓ = Additional price
1) Only
Only functions
functions when
whenused
usedtogether
togetherwith
withthe
thebackplane
backplanebusbusmodule
moduleand
andthe
the
wide module
wide module rack.
rack. The
The backplane
backplane busbus module
module and
and the
the wide
wide module
module rack
rack
must be
must be ordered
ordered separately
separately (see
(see "Accessories
“AccessoriesforforETET 200pro
200pro motor
motor
starters",
starters”,page
page9/19).
6/39).
2)
The electronic motor starters can be used not only as electronic motor
starters with a high level of switching frequency but also as fully fledged
soft starters for soft starting and stopping. The changeover from motor
starter to soft starter takes place through reparameterization in HW Config.
Depending on the setting, this results in the following current ranges:
- Parameterization as electronic motor starter: 0.15 to 2 A and
1.5 to 9 A (4 kW)
- Parameterization as soft starter: 0.15 to 2 A and 1.5 to 12 A (5.5 kW).

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 6/29

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Hybrid Motor Starters
Motor Starters for Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
ET 200pro motor starter
ET 200pro Motor Starters
Isolator modules IE3/IE4 ready
ET 200pro isolator modules

■ Overview
The isolator module with integrated group fusing function The following properties apply to the isolator module:
(i.e. additional group short-circuit protection for all subsequently • Increase of plant availability through fast replacement of units
supplied motor starters) and switch disconnector function is (easy mounting and plug-in technology)
used for safe disconnection of the 400 V operational voltage in
the plant. • Cabinet-free design thanks to high degree of protection IP65

Depending on the power distribution concept, all stations can be isolator module
The isolator moduleisisavailable
available
in in addition
addition in ainsafety
a safety version
version
equipped with an isolator module as an option. (see “Safety
"Safety local
local isolator module"
module”on onpage
page 9/11).
6/31).

■ Technical specifications
Type Isolator modules Type Isolator modules
General data Degree of protection IP65
Mounting dimensions (W x H x D) Touch protection Finger-safe
• Direct-on-line starters and reversing mm 110 x 230 x 170 Pollution degree 3, IEC 60664 (IEC 61131)
starters
Rated impulse withstand kV 6
Permissible ambient temperature voltage Uimp
• During operation °C -25 ... +55
• During storage °C -40 ... +70 Rated insulation voltage Ui V 400
Permissible mounting position Any Rated operational current Ie
for starters
Vibration resistance acc. to g 2
IEC 60068 Part 2-6 • AC-1/2/3 at 40 °C
- At 400 V A 25
Shock resistance acc. to IEC 60068 g/ms Half-sine 15/11 - At 500 V A 25
Part 2-27
Rated short-circuit breaking kA 50 at 400 V
Power consumption capacity
• From auxiliary circuit L+/M (U1) mA Approx. 20
• From auxiliary circuit A1/A2 (U2) -- Type of coordination acc. to 2
IEC 60947-4-1
Rated operational current Ie A 25
for power bus Protective separation between V 400, according to
main and auxiliary circuits DIN VDE 0106, Part 101
Rated operational voltage Ue V 400
Device functions
Approvals according to • Group diagnostics Yes, parameterizable
• DIN VDE 0106, Part 101 V Up to 500
Device indications
6

• CSA and UL V Up to 600


• Group fault SF LED (red)
Conductor cross-sections
• Incoming power supply mm2 Max. 6 x 4
HYBRID MOTOR
STARTERS
9

■ Selection and ordering data


Version SD Article No. Price PU PS*
per PU (UNIT,
SET, M)
d
ET 200pro isolator modules, mechanical
Isolator modules1)
Rated operational current 25 A 2 3RK1304-0HS00-6AA0 1 1 unit

3RK1304-0HS00-6AA0
1) Only
Only functions when used
used together
togetherwith
withthe
therelated
related110
110mm
mmbackplane
backplanebus
bus
module and the wide module rack. The backplane bus module and the
wide module rack must be ordered separately (see page 6/39).
9/19).

6/30 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Hybrid Motor Starters Motor Starters for Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
ET 200pro Motor Starters
ET 200pro motor starter ET 200pro Safety Motor Starters Solutions Local/PROFIsafe
Safety modules
Safety modules local

■ Overview
Safety Solution local Functionality
With the Safety local modules Safety local isolator module
• Safety local isolator module and
• 400 V disconnecting module The Safety local isolator module features the same functions as
with an appropriate connection, safety level PL e a standard isolator module with an additional local safety
(according to ISO 13849-1) can be reached. function.
The Safety local isolator module contains a 3TK2841 module
and is equipped with M12 terminals for the connection of
external safety components.
Terminals 1 and 2 can be used to connect either one- or two-
channel EMERGENCY STOP circuits or protective door circuits
(IN 1, IN 2).
For monitored starts, an external START switch can be
connected to terminal 3.
The required safety functions can be set using two slide
switches located under the left M12 opening.
In the event of an EMERGENCY STOP, the Safety local isolator
module trips the downstream 400 V disconnecting module. This
safely separates the 400 V circuit up to PL e.
In combination with the 400 V disconnecting module, the
Safety local isolator module can be used for safety applications
up to PL e.
400 V disconnecting module
ET 200pro motor starter (Safety Solution local): Safety local isolator
module, disconnecting module, Standard starter and High Feature The 400 V disconnecting module can be used together with the
starter mounted on a wide module rack Safety local isolator module for local safety applications and
together with the F-Switch for PROFIsafe safety applications.
Safety local isolator module
It contains two contactors connected in series for safety-related

6
The Safety local isolator module is a repair switch with integrated disconnection of the main circuit.
safety evaluation functions that can be parameterized using
DIP switches. The auxiliary circuit supply of the device is over a safety power

STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
rail in the backplane bus module.
It is used for

9
• Connection of a one- or two-channel EMERGENCY STOP The 400 V disconnecting module can be used in conjunction
circuit up to PL e (protective door or EMERGENCY STOP with the Safety local isolator module or with the F-Switch for
pushbuttons) and parameterizable start behavior safety applications up to PL e.
• For controlling the 400 V disconnecting module by means of a
safety rail signal
400 V disconnecting module
The 400 V disconnecting module enables the safe disconnec-
tion of an operational voltage of 400 V up to PL e. For operation
in a Safety Solution local application, it functions only in
combination with the Safety local isolator module.
For operation in a Safety PROFIsafe application it functions only
in combination with the F-Switch.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 6/31


Motor
Hybrid Starters
Motor Startersfor
Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
ET 200pro Motor Starters
ET 200pro motor starter
ET 200pro Safety Motor Starters Solutions Local/PROFIsafe
Safety modules
Safety modules local

■ Technical specifications
Type Safety local isolator module 400 V disconnecting module
General data
Mounting dimensions (W x H x D)
• Direct-on-line starters and reversing starters mm 110 x 230 x 170 110 x 230 x 150
Permissible ambient temperature
• During operation °C -25 ... +55
• During storage °C -40 ... +70
Permissible mounting position Any
Vibration resistance acc. to IEC 60068, Part 2-6 2g
Shock resistance acc. to IEC 60068, Part 2-27 Half-sine 15 g/11 ms
Power consumption
• From auxiliary circuit L+/M (U1) mA Approx. 20
• From auxiliary circuit A1/A2 (U2) --
Rated operational current Ie for power bus A 25
Rated operational voltage Ue V 400 (50/60 Hz)
Approval DIN VDE 0106, Part 101 V Up to 500
CSA and UL approval V Up to 600
Conductor cross-sections
Incoming power supply mm2 Max. 6 x 4
Degree of protection IP65
Touch protection Finger-safe
Pollution degree 3, IEC 60664 (IEC 61131)
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 6
Rated insulation voltage Ui V 400
Rated operational current Ie for starters
• AC-1/2/3 at 40 °C
- At 400 V A 16 25
- At 500 V A 16 25
Rated short-circuit breaking capacity kA 50 at 400 V
6

Type of coordination acc. to IEC 60947-4-1 2


Protective separation between main and auxiliary circuits V 400,
according to DIN VDE 0106, Part 101
HYBRID MOTOR
STARTERS

Operating times for 0.85 ... 1.1 x Ue


• Closing delay ms -- 25 ... 100
9

• Opening delay ms -- 7 ... 10


Device functions
• Group diagnostics Yes, parameterizable
Device indications
• Group fault SF LED (red)

6/32 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Hybrid Motor Starters Motor Starters for Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
ET 200pro Motor Starters
ET 200pro motor starter ET 200pro Safety Motor Starters Solutions Local/PROFIsafe
Safety modules IE3/IE4 ready
Safety modules local

■ Selection and ordering data


Version SD Article No. Price PU PS*
per PU (UNIT,
SET, M)
d
Safety modules local
Safety local isolator module1)2)
Rated operational current 16 A 5 3RK1304-0HS00-7AA0 1 1 unit

3RK1304-0HS00-7AA0
400 V disconnecting modules3)4)
Rated operational current 25 A 2 3RK1304-0HS00-8AA0 1 1 unit

3RK1304-0HS00-8AA0
1)
The Safety local isolator module only functions when used together with
the 400 V disconnecting module.
2) Only
Only in combination
combination with with the
the special
special backplane
backplane bus
bus module
module for
for the
the
Safety local
Safety local isolator
isolator module
module (see
(see "Accessories
“AccessoriesforforETET200pro motor
200pro motor
starters",
starters”,page
page9/19).
6/39).
3)
The 400 V disconnecting module functions only when used together with

6
the Safety local isolator module or with the F-Switch.
4) The 400 V disconnecting module functions only when used together with
The 400 V disconnecting module functions only when used together with
the
the backplane
backplane bus module and and the
the wide
wide module
module rack.
rack. The
The backplane
backplane bus
bus

STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
module
module andand the
the wide
wide module
module rackrack must
must bebe ordered
ordered separately
separately (see
(see
"Accessories
“Accessoriesfor forETET200pro
200pro motor
motorstarters", page
starters”, 9/19).
page 6/39).

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 6/33

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Motor
Hybrid Starters
Motor Startersfor
Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
ET 200pro Motor Starters
ET 200pro motor starter
ET 200pro Safety Motor Starters Solutions Local/PROFIsafe
Safety modules PROFIsafe IE3/IE4 ready
Safety modules PROFIsafe

■ Overview
Safety Solution PROFIsafe Functionality
With the Safety PROFIsafe modules The PROFIsafe F-Switch is a fail-safe solid-state module for
• F-Switch and PROFIsafe safety applications. It has two fail-safe inputs and
• 400 V disconnecting module outputs for safe switching of the 24 V supply over backplane
with an appropriate connection, safety levels SIL 3 busbars. In combination with the 400 V disconnecting module,
(according to IEC 62061) and PL e (according to ISO 13849-1) fail-safe disconnection of ET 200pro motor starters is possible in
can be reached. PROFIsafe applications up to SIL 3/PL e.
F-Switch PROFIsafe 400 V disconnecting module
Fail-safe digital inputs/outputs in degrees of protection IP65 to See "Safety
“Safetymodules
moduleslocal",
local”,Overview,
Overview,page
page9/11
6/31and
and Technical
Technical
IP67 for near-machine, cabinet-free use. specifications, page
page6/32
9/12.
.
Fail-safe digital inputs
• For the fail-safe reading in of sensor information
(one-/two-channel)
• Including integrated discrepancy evaluation for 2v2 signals
• Internal sensor supplies (incl. testing) available
Fail-safe digital outputs
• Three fail-safe PP-switching outputs for safe switching of the
backplane busbars
The F-Switch is certified up to SIL 3/PL e and has detailed
diagnostics.
It supports PROFIsafe in PROFIBUS configurations as well as in
PROFINET configurations.

■ Selection and ordering data


Version SD Article No. Price PU PS*
per PU (UNIT,
6

SET, M)
d
HYBRID MOTOR
STARTERS

Safety modules PROFIsafe


400 V disconnecting modules1)2)
9

Rated operational current 25 A 2 3RK1304-0HS00-8AA0 1 1 unit

3RK1304-0HS00-8AA0
F-Switch PROFIsafe
24 V DC, including bus module 1 6ES7148-4FS00-0AB0 1 1 unit
Note:
Connection module must be ordered separately

6ES7148-1FS00-0AB0
Connection modules for F-Switch
24 V DC 1 6ES7194-4DA00-0AA0 1 1 unit
1) The 400 V disconnecting module functions only when used together with
the Safety local isolator module or with the F-Switch.
2) The 400 V disconnecting module functions only when used together with
400 V disconnecting module functions only when used together with
the backplane
backplane bus module and the wide wide module
module rack.
rack. The
The backplane
backplane bus
bus
module and the wide
wide module
module rack
rack must
must be
be ordered
ordered separately
separately (see
(see
"Accessories
“AccessoriesforforETET200pro
200promotor
motor starters", page
starters”, 9/19).
page 6/39).

6/34 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Hybrid Motor Starters Motor Starters for Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
ET 200pro Motor Starters
ET 200pro motor starter
Accessories
Accessories for ET 200pro motor starters

■ Overview

Infeed on
isolator module
1

RSM RSM

MS MS MS MS

NSA0_00467a
NSA0_00465a
3 4 7
2 9

5 / 6

M M 9 Power connection cable for isolator module

Basic design of an ET 200pro version with (from the left) connection Infeed on the RSM isolator module
module for IM, interface module for communication (IM), RSM isolator
module, two ET 200pro motor starters (MS), and connections for energy

6
Legend:
Legend:
Infeed on  Power
Power feeder plug(see
feeder plug (see page
page 9/17)
6/37)

STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
ET 200pro motor starter b Power
Power connection plug(see
connection plug (see page
page 9/17)
6/37)
c Power
Power jumper plug(see
jumper plug (see page
page 9/17)
6/37)

9
d Motor
Motor connection plug(see
connection plug (see page
page 9/17)
6/37)
e Motor
Motor plug (seepage
plug (see page 9/17)
6/37)
f Motor
Motor plug withEMC
plug with EMCsuppressor
suppressor circuit
circuit (see(see
pagepage
6/37)9/17)
MS MS g Power
Power loop-through plug(see
loop-through plug (see page
page 9/17)
6/37)
h Power connection cable (see page 9/17)
Power connection cable (see page 6/37)
i Power connection cable for isolator module (see page 9/17)
Power connection cable for isolator module (see page 6/37)
j Motor cable (see page 9/18)
Motor cable (see page 6/38)
NSA0_00466a

10
8

Infeed on the ET 200pro motor starter

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 6/35


Motor
Hybrid Starters
Motor Startersfor
Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
ET 200pro
ET 200pro Motor Starters
motor starter
Accessories
Accessories for ET 200pro motor starters
Power bus Interruption-free thanks to power terminal connectors
The power supply to the field devices (ET 200pro motor starters, In finger-safe connection technology the power T terminal
M200D motor starters) is provided via the power bus, in which connectors and power double-T terminal connectors connect
the power T terminal connectors or power double-T terminal the components of a feeder to the power bus. They ensure
connectors are connected by power bus cables. interruption-free operation, i.e. the power bus is not interrupted
when the components are unplugged.
Feeders
From the terminal connectors, spur lines with Han Q4/2 plugs
lead to the field devices, from which the motors are supplied with
power via motor connection cables.

11 Power bus line (sold by the meter)


12 Power T terminal connector
13 Power double-T terminal connector

11
12 13 13

ET 200pro

M200D M200D

IC01_00230a
6 STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
9

Motors

Power supply to the motors via the power bus with power T and double-T terminal connectors linked by power bus cables, spur lines to the field devices
(motor starters), and power loop-through connections to the motors via motor connection cables
Motor control via PROFIBUS Motor control via PROFINET
The interface modules (IM) for PROFIBUS can be combined For connection
For connectionmodules
moduleswith
with
thethe relevant
relevant accessories,
accessories, see see
with three different connection modules for connecting "Accessories for
“Accessories for ET
ET 200pro
200pro interface
interface modules"
modules”ininCatalog
Catalog ST
ST 70
70
PROFIBUS DP and the power supply: or the
or the Industry
Industry Mall.
Mall.
• Direct connection with cable gland
• ECOFAST connection with hybrid fieldbus cables (with two
copper cores for data transmission with PROFIBUS DP, and
four copper cores for the power supply), and ECOFAST plugs
(HanBrid)1)
• M12, 7/8" connection
- with M12 connecting cable and M12 plugs for data
transmission with PROFIBUS DP
- with 7/8" connecting cable and 7/8" plugs for the power
supply2)
For connection
connectionmodules
moduleswith
withthethe relevant
relevant accessories,
accessories, seesee
"Accessories
“Accessories for
forET
ET 200pro
200pro interface
interface modules"
modules”ininCatalog
CatalogST
ST70
70
or
or the
the Industry
Industry Mall.
Mall.

1) Hybrid 2)
Hybrid fieldbus
fieldbus connections
connections with
with HanBrid sockets designed as cabinet cabinet bushings
On the control cabinet bushings with
with two
twoM12
M12sockets
socketsfor
forthe
thePROFIBUS
PROFIBUS
bushings transmit
bushings transmit data and energy from the control cabinet
cabinet (IP20)
(IP20) to the
the M12 connecting cables (see page 6/66),
9/46), the
the 24
24 VV supply
supply of
of the
the motor
motor
field (IP65).
field (IP65). They
They are
are the interface
interface for jointly routing PROFIBUS
PROFIBUS DP DP and
and the
the starters is implemented via separate 7/8"
7/8" connecting
connecting cables.
cables.
auxiliary voltages
auxiliary voltages into
into the hybrid
hybrid fieldbus
fieldbus cable
cable (see
(see page
page 6/66).
9/46).

6/36 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Hybrid Motor Starters Motor Starters for Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
ET 200pro Motor Starters
ET 200pro motor starter
Accessories
Accessories for ET 200pro motor starters

Selection and ordering data


Version SD Article No. Price PU PS*
per PU (UNIT,
SET, M)
d
Incoming power supply
 Power feeder plugs
Connector set for incoming power supply, e.g. for
connecting to T terminal connectors, comprising a
coupling enclosure, straight outgoing feeder (with
bracket), pin insert for HAN Q4/2, incl. gland
• 5 male contacts, 2.5 mm2 5 3RK1911-2BS60 1 1 unit
• 5 male contacts, 4 mm2 5 3RK1911-2BS20 1 1 unit
• 5 male contacts, 6 mm2 5 3RK1911-2BS40 1 1 unit
 Power connection plugs
Connector set for incoming power supply for connection
to ET 200pro motor starters/ET 200pro isolator modules,
comprising a cable-end connector hood, angular
outgoing feeder, female insert for HAN Q4/2,
incl. gland
• 5 female contacts, 2.5 mm2 5 3RK1911-2BE50 1 1 unit
• 5 female contacts, 4 mm2 5 3RK1911-2BE10 1 1 unit
• 5 female contacts, 6 mm2 5 3RK1911-2BE30 1 1 unit
 Power connection cables, assembled at one end
Power connection cable for ET 200pro motor starters,
open at one end, for HAN Q4/2, angular, 4 x 4 mm2
• Length 1.5 m 5 3RK1911-0DB13 1 1 unit
• Length 5.0 m 5 3RK1911-0DB33 1 1 unit
 Power connection cables for isolator module,
assembled at one end
Power connection cable for ET 200pro isolator modules,
open at one end, for HAN Q4/2, angular, insert turned at
isolator module end, 4 x 4 mm2
• Length 1.5 m 30 3RK1911-0DF13 1 1 unit
• Length 5.0 m 30 3RK1911-0DF33 1 1 unit

6
Power loop-through on the field device
 Power jumper plugs 2 3RK1922-2BQ00 1 1 unit

STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
 Power loop-through plugs
Connector set for power loop-through for connection to

9
ET 200pro motor starters/ET 200pro isolator modules,
comprising a cable-end connector hood, angular
outgoing feeder, pin insert for HAN Q4/2,
incl. gland
• 4 male contacts, 2.5 mm2 5 3RK1911-2BF50 1 1 unit
• 4 male contacts, 4 mm2 5 3RK1911-2BF10 1 1 unit
Motor cables
 Motor connection plugs
Connector set for motor cable for connection to
ET 200pro motor starters, comprising a cable-end
connector hood, angular outgoing feeder, pin insert
for HAN Q8/0, incl. gland
• 8 male contacts, 1.5 mm2 5 3RK1902-0CE00 1 1 unit
• 6 male contacts, 2.5 mm2 5 3RK1902-0CC00 1 1 unit
 Motor plugs
Connector set for motor cable for connection to motors,
comprising a cable-end connector hood, straight
outgoing feeder, female insert for HAN 10e, incl. star
jumper, incl. gland
• 7 female contacts, 1.5 mm2 30 3RK1911-2BM21 1 1 set
• 7 female contacts, 2.5 mm2 30 3RK1911-2BM22 1 1 set
 Motor plugs with EMC suppressor circuit
Connector set for motor cable for connection to motors,
comprising a cable-end connector hood, straight
outgoing feeder, female insert for HAN 10e with
EMC suppressor circuit, incl. star jumper,
incl. gland
• 7 female contacts, 1.5 mm2 30 3RK1911-2BL21 1 1 set
• 7 female contacts, 2.5 mm2 30 3RK1911-2BL22 1 1 set

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 6/37

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Motor
Hybrid Starters
Motor Startersfor
Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
ET 200pro Motor Starters
ET 200pro motor starter
Accessories
Accessories for ET 200pro motor starters

Version SD Article No. Price PU PS*


per PU (UNIT,
SET, M)
d
Motor cables (continued)
 Motor cables, assembled at one end
Open at one end, HAN Q8, angular, length 5 m
• For motor without brake, for ET 200pro, 4 x 1.5 mm2 15 3RK1911-0EB31 1 1 unit
• For motor with brake for ET 200pro, 6 x 1.5 mm2 30 3RK1911-0ED31 1 1 unit
• For motor without brake, with thermistor, for ET 200pro, 30 3RK1911-0EF31 1 1 unit
6 x 1.5 mm2
• For motor with brake and thermistor for ET 200pro, 30 3RK1911-0EG31 1 1 unit
8 x 1.5 mm2
Power bus
 Power T terminal connectors
For 400 V AC, for connection of feeders (e.g. motor
starters) by means of standard round cable at any point
of the power bus, by insulation displacement connection,
used with preassembled bus segments
• 2.5 mm2/4 mm2 5 3RK1911-2BF01 1 1 unit
• 4 mm2/6 mm2 5 3RK1911-2BF02 1 1 unit
 Power double-T terminal connectors
For 400 V AC, for connection of feeders (e.g. motor
starters) by means of standard round cable at any point
of the power bus, by insulation displacement connection,
used with preassembled bus segments,
connection of two motor starters possible
• 4 mm2/6 mm2 5 3RK1911-2BG02 1 1 unit
Sealing set (comprising 2 seals)
For power T/power double-T terminal connectors
• For power cables with Ø 10 ... 13 mm 5 3RK1911-5BA00 1 1 unit
• For power cables with Ø 13 ... 16 mm 5 3RK1911-5BA10 1 1 unit
• For power cables with Ø 16 ... 19 mm 5 3RK1911-5BA20 1 1 unit
• For power cables with Ø 19 ... 22 mm X 3RK1911-5BA30 1 1 unit
3RK1911-5BA50
6

• Blanking plugs 5 1 1 unit


Further accessories for power connections
Crimping tool 15 3RK1902-0CW00 1 1 unit
HYBRID MOTOR
STARTERS

for pins/sockets, 4 mm2 and 6 mm2


9

3RK1902-0CW00
Dismantling tools
• For male and female contacts for 9-pole 15 3RK1902-0AB00 1 1 unit
HAN Q4/2 inserts
• For male and female contacts for 9-pole 5 3RK1902-0AJ00 1 1 unit
HAN Q8 inserts
Sealing caps
For 9-pole power sockets
• 1 unit per pack 5 3RK1902-0CK00 1 1 unit
• 10 units per pack 5 3RK1902-0CJ00 1 10 units

3RK1902-0CK00

6/38 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Hybrid Motor Starters Motor Starters for Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
ET 200pro Motor Starters
ET 200pro motor starter
Accessories
Accessories for ET 200pro motor starters

Version SD Article No. Price PU PS*


per PU (UNIT,
SET, M)
d
Further accessories
Module racks, wide1)
• Length 500 mm 1 6ES7194-4GB00-0AA0 1 1 unit
• Length 1 000 mm 1 6ES7194-4GB60-0AA0 1 1 unit
• Length 2 000 mm 1 6ES7194-4GB20-0AA0 1 1 unit
Module racks, wide, compact1)
• Length 500 mm 1 6ES7194-4GD00-0AA0 1 1 unit
• Length 1 000 mm 1 6ES7194-4GD10-0AA0 1 1 unit
• Length 2 000 mm 1 6ES7194-4GD20-0AA0 1 1 unit
Backplane bus modules 110 mm2) 2 3RK1922-2BA00 1 1 unit
Backplane bus module for Safety local isolator 2 3RK1922-2BA01 1 1 unit
modules
Handheld devices 5 3RK1922-3BA00 1 1 unit
For ET 200pro motor starters (or for ET 200S High
Feature and M200D motor starters) for local operation.
Notes:
• The motor-starter-specific serial interface cables must
be ordered separately.
• The RS 232 interface cable 3RK1922-2BP00 is used for
the MS ET 200pro.
RS 232 interface cable 5 3RK1922-2BP00 1 1 unit
Serial data connection between ET 200pro (or M200D)
3RK1922-3BA00
motor starters and the RS 232 interface of a
PC/PG/laptop (with the Motor Starter ES software)
or the handheld device 3RK1922-3BA00.
USB interface cable, 2.5 m 3 6SL3555-0PA00-2AA0 1 1 unit
Serial data connection between ET 200pro (or M200D)
motor starters and the USB interface of a PC/PG/laptop
(with the Motor Starter ES software).
M12 sealing caps } 3RK1901-1KA00 100 10 units
For sealing unused M12 input or output sockets

6
(one set contains ten sealing caps)

3RK1901-1KA00

STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
Motor suppression module
RC element for installation in motor terminal box

9
• Angular design 15 3RK1911-6EA00 1 1 unit

3RK1911-6EA00
• Round design 15 3RK1911-6EB00 1 1 unit

3RK1911-6EB00
1)
The wide module rack can accommodate all ET 200pro motor starters and
any optional modules (isolator module, Safety local isolator module and
400 V disconnecting module).
2)
The backplane bus module is a prerequisite for operation of the
ET 200pro motor starter and the optional module.
For more
For more connection
connectiontechnology
technology products,
products, seesee
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/65355810.
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/65355810..

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 6/39

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Motor
Hybrid Starters
Motor Startersfor
Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
ET 200pro Motor Starters
Motor starter ES
Software
Software
Motor Starter ES

■ Overview
More information
Industry Mall,
Industry Mall, see
see www.siemens.com/product?3ZS1
www.siemens.com/product?3ZS1
Technical
Technical specifications
specificationsand
andsystem
systemrequirements,
requirements,see
see
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16713/td
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16713/td

Motor Starter ES is used for the startup, parameterization,


diagnostics, documentation and preventive maintenance of
SIMATIC ET 200S, ET 200pro, ECOFAST and M200D motor
starters.
The software program is available in three versions which differ
in their user-friendliness, scope of functions and price.

Motor Starter ES for parameterization, monitoring, diagnostics and


testing of motor starters
6 STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
9

6/40 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Hybrid Motor Starters
Motor Starters for Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
SIRIUS M200D motor starters SIRIUS M200D Motor Starters
General data
General data

Overview
More information
Homepage, see
Homepage, see www.siemens.com/motorstarter
www.siemens.com/motorstarter
Industry
Industry Mall,
Mall, see
see www.siemens.com/product?M200D
www.siemens.com/product?M200D
TIA Selection
Selection Tool
Tool Cloud
Cloud (TST
(TST Cloud),
Cloud),see
see
https://www.siemens.com/tstcloud/?node=MS_M200D
https://www.siemens.com/tstcloud/?node=MS_M200D

Basic functionality
The versions of the M200D motor starter are equipped with the
following properties and functions:
• Available as direct-on-line and reversing starters in a rugged
design
• Electromechanical or electronic switching version
• Low variance – only two device versions up to 7.5 HP thanks
to wide range setting
• All versions have the same enclosure size.
• Degree of protection IP65
SIRIUS M200D AS-i Basic motor starter with manual local operation • Quick and fail-safe wiring of system and motor cables using
The intelligent and highly flexible SIRIUS M200D motor starters ISO 23570 plug-in connector technology (Q4/2 and Q8/0)
for distributed installation start, monitor and protect motors and • Robust and widely used M12 connection method for digital
loads up to 7.5 HP. inputs and outputs
The M200D motor starters are available in four versions: • Integrated feeder connector monitoring
• Full motor protection through overload protection and a
M200D M200D M200D M200D temperature sensor (PTC, TC)
AS-i Basic AS-i Standard PROFIBUS PROFINET
• Short-circuit and overload protection integrated
Motor control with
• Integrated repair switch lockable with three locks
AS-i communication PROFIBUS PROFINET (multi-level service)
Mechanical or electronic switching • Uniform wiring to the SINAMICS G110D, SINAMICS G110M

6
and SINAMICS G120D frequency inverters and to the
Electronic switching with soft starter functionality ET 200pro distributed I/O system

STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
-- • Extensive diagnostics concept using LEDs
• Optional integrated manual local control with key-operated

9
Function available
switch (ordering option)
-- Function not available
• Optionally available brake actuation with voltages from
180 V DC (no rectifier needed in motor) or 230/400 V AC
(ordering options)
Article No. scheme

Product versions Article number


Motor starters 3RK13 @ 5 – 6 @ S @ 1 – @ A @ @
Type AS-i Basic 1 A
AS-i Standard 2 A
PROFIBUS/PROFINET 9 D
Setting range for rated 0.15 ... 2 A K
operational current I A 1.5 ... 9 A N
1.5 ... 12 A L
Starter version Electromechanical starters 4 with integrated contactor
Electronic starters 7 with thyristors
Product function Direct-on-line starters 0
Reversing starters 1
Direct-on-line starters 2 with manual local operation
Reversing starters 3 with manual local operation
Brake actuation None 0
230/400 V AC 3
180 V DC 5
Example 3RK13 1 5 – 6 K S 4 1 – 3 A A 0

Note:
The Article No. scheme shows an overview of product versions For your orders, please use the article numbers quoted in the
for better understanding of the logic behind the article numbers. selection and ordering data.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 6/41


Hybrid Motor Starters
Motor Starters for Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
SIRIUS M200D motor starters
SIRIUS M200D Motor Starters
General data
General data

■ Benefits
M200D motor starters provide the following advantages for • Comprehensive offering of accessories, including
customers: ready-assembled cables
• High plant availability through plug-in capability of the main • The M200D motor starters can be installed with a few manual
circuit, communication and I/Os – relevant for installing and steps. The integrated plug-in technology enables far lower
replacing devices wiring outlay:
• Cabinet-free construction and near-motor installation thanks Preassembled cables can be plugged directly onto the motor
to the high degree of protection IP65 starter module.
• The motor starters record the actual current flow for the • Easy and user-friendly installation because all versions have
parameterizable electronic motor overload protection. the same enclosure dimensions.
Reliable messages concerning the overshooting or • Fast and user-friendly commissioning using optional manual
undershooting of setpoint values ensure comprehensive local operation
motor protection. All motor protection functions can be • Increase of process speed through integrated functions such
defined by simple parameterization as "Quick Stop" and "Disable Quick Stop", e.g. at points and
• Low stock levels and low order costs thanks to a wide setting crossings
range for the electronic motor protection of 1:10 • Optional manual local control with momentary-contact and
(only two device versions up to 7.5 HP) latching operation for easier startup and easier servicing
• The integrated wide range for the current enables a single
device to cover numerous standard motors of different sizes.

■ Application
The high degree of protection IP65 makes the M200D motor Use of SIRIUS M200D motor starters in conjunction with
starters suitable in particular for use on extensive conveying IE3/IE4 motors
systems such as are found in mail sorting centers, airports,
automotive factories and the packing industry. Note:
For the
the use
use of
ofSIRIUS
SIRIUSM200D
M200Dmotor
motorstarters in in
starters conjunction withwith
conjunction
For simple drive tasks, particularly in conveyor applications, the
new SINAMICS G110D frequency inverter series with a perform- highly energy-efficient
highly energy-efficient IE3/IE4
IE3/IE4 motors,
motors, please
please observe
observe the the
ance range from 0.75 kW to 7.5 kW and degree of protection information ondimensioning
information on dimensioning and
and configuring,
configuring, seesee Application
Application
IP65 is the ideal partner for the M200D motor starters. Manual.
Manual..

SINAMICS G110D converters allow for stepless speed control of


6

three-phase asynchronous motors and comply with the require-


ments for materials handling applications with frequency control.
HYBRID MOTOR
STARTERS

For simple drive tasks in conveyor applications in which a


9

frequency inverter integrated into the motor is required, the


SINAMICS G110M frequency inverter with a performance range
from 0.37 kW to 4 kW and degree of protection IP65/66 is the
ideal partner. The SINAMICS G110M is available individually as
a frequency converter for self-assembly and pre-mounted on
SIMOGEAR geared motors, and with its conveyor-specific
functions it satisfies the requirements of conveyor technology
applications.

6/42 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Hybrid Motor Starters Motor Starters for Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
SIRIUS M200D Motor Starters
SIRIUS M200D motor starters M200D Motor Starters for AS-Interface
General data
General data

Overview
motor control
For motor controlusing
usingAS-Interface
AS-Interface there
there areare
thethe following
following Mounting and installation
M200D motor
M200D motor starter
starterversions:
versions:SIRIUS
SIRIUS M200D
M200D AS-iAS-i Basic
Basic andand
SIRIUS M200D
M200DAS-i
AS-iStandard
Standard(basic
(basicfunctionality,
functionality, see page 9/21 The M200D motor starters can be installed with a few manual
SIRIUS see page 16/41 steps. The integrated plug-in technology enables far lower wir-
"SIRIUS M200D
“SIRIUS M200D Motor Starters” "General
MotorStarters" “Generaldata"
data” "Overview").
“Overview”). ing outlay. Connecting cables can be plugged directly onto the
SIRIUS M200D AS-i Basic motor starter module. Swapping of the connecting wires and
malfunctions within the plant are prevented by preassembled
Functionality cables. The AS-i bus is connected cost-effectively using an M12
• Easy and fast on-site startup through parameterization of local connection on the device. All versions have identical enclosure
setting knobs (DIP switches) and rotary coding switches for dimensions for easier system design and conversion.
adjusting the rated operational current. The rotary coding
switch has an OFF position for deactivating the overload Parameterization and configuration
protection with the help of the thermal motor model when The particularly robust M200D AS-i Standard motor starter is
using a temperature sensor. characterized by numerous functions which can be flexibly
Communications parameterized. It enables highly flexible parameterization
through the AS-i bus using data records from the user program
• AS-i communication with A/B addressing according to as well as user-friendly local parameterization using the
Spec V2.1 Motor Starter ES startup software through the local point-to-
• The AS-i bus is connected cost-effectively using an point interface.
M12 connection on the device. Of the four digital inputs, Functions can be flexibly assigned to the digital inputs and
two are contained in the process image and can therefore be outputs, adapting them to all possible conveyor applications.
used in the PLC program. The other two inputs are locally All motor protection functions, limit values and reactions can be
effective and permanently assigned with functions. defined by parameterization. The AS-i Standard is unique. In its
• The LEDs can provide comprehensive diagnostics of the 6E/4A process image the motor starter sends all four digital
device on the spot. In addition to diagnostics using the inputs and the digital output via the process image to the PLC in
PAE process image, the device can create up to 15 different cyclic mode. System configuration and system documentation
diagnostic signals per slave. The message with the highest are facilitated not least by a number of CAX data.
priority can be read out through the AS-i communication. This
is yet another new development which distinguishes the Operation
M200D AS-i Basic motor starter from the rest of the market and The new generation of motor starters is characterized by its
adds innovative technology, maximum availability and advanced functionality, maximum flexibility and extremely high
transparency to the system. degree of automation.

6
SIRIUS M200D AS-i Standard All digital inputs and outputs exist in the cyclic process image.
The intelligent and highly flexible M200D AS-i Standard motor All limit values for monitoring functions and their reactions are

STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
starter in A/B technology starts and protects motors and loads parameterizable and therefore adaptable to the application. The
up to 5.5 kW. They are available in direct-on-line or reversing motor starters record the actual current flow. Evaluating the

9
starter versions, in a mechanical version and also an electronic current of the parameterizable solid-state overload protection
version (the latter with soft start function). increases the availability of the drives, as do reliable messages
concerning the overshooting or undershooting of setpoint
The M200D AS-i Standard motor starter is the most functional values.
member of the SIRIUS motor starter family in the high degree of
protection IP65 for AS-i communication. Consistency with other Diagnostics and maintenance
products of the SIRIUS M200D motor starter range and with the
frequency converter and ET 200pro I/O system is assured. The M200D sets new standards for diagnostics. In addition to
diagnostics using the PAE process image and diagnostics by
Functionality "parameter echo" (up to 15 different diagnostic signals per slave
• AS-i communication with A/B addressing according to can be read out via AS-i communication), the possibility of
Spec 3.0 reading out diagnostic data records is unique on the market.
• Electronic version also with soft start function The AS-i Standard is recommended in particular for expansive
• AS-i slave profile 7AE/7A5 with process image 6E/4A and highly automated system components because the possi-
• Full TIA integration: All digital inputs and outputs exist in the bility of monitoring devices and systems with data records
cyclic process image and are visible through AS-i, providing (statistical data, measured values and device diagnostics)
maximum flexibility and best adaptability to the application. provides an in-depth view of the plant from the control room,
guaranteeing the monitoring process and increasing plant
• Additionally expanded diagnostics using data record through availability.
AS-i bus
• Complete plant monitoring using statistics data record and Preventive maintenance can be carried out with the integrated
current value monitoring by means of data records maintenance timer and plant downtimes prevented as a result in
advance.
• Parameterization through AS-i bus with the help of data
records or an expanded process image from the user program Local control of a drive is possible using the ordering option with
• Control of the motor starter using a command data record from integrated manual operation. This is yet another new develop-
the user program ment which distinguishes the M200D AS-i Standard motor starter
from the rest of the market and adds innovative technology,
• Flexible assignment of the digital inputs and outputs with all maximum availability and transparency to the plant.
available assignable input actions
• Parameterization using Motor Starter ES at the local interface
(ordering option for startup software)
• Diagnostics with the help of Motor Starter ES (ordering option
for startup software)

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 6/43

Siemens IC 10 · 2020
Motor
Hybrid Starters
Motor Startersfor
Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
SIRIUS M200D Motor Starters
SIRIUS M200D motor starters for AS-Interface
M200D Motor Starters for AS-Interface
General data
General data

SIRIUS M200D SIRIUS M200D


AS-i Basic AS-i Standard
Device functions (firmware features)
Slave on the bus
Fieldbus AS-i
Slave type A/B acc. to Spec 2.1 A/B acc. to Spec 3.0
Profile 7.A.E 7.A.E & 7.A.5
Number of assigned AS-i addresses on the bus 1 2
Number of stations per AS-i master Max. 62 devices Max. 31 devices
AS-i master profile M3 and higher M4 and higher
Parameter assignment
DIP switches --
Potentiometer for rated operational current --
Motor Starter ES --
Data records through AS-i --
Diagnostics
Diagnostics through parameter channel
Acyclic through data records --
Expanded process image PAE 4 bytes --
Process image
Process image 4E/3A 6E/4A
6

Data channels
Local optical interface (manual local)
HYBRID MOTOR
STARTERS

AS-i bus
9

Motor Starter ES through local interface --


Motor Starter ES through bus --
Data records1) (acyclic)
Parameter assignment --
Diagnostics --
Measured values --
Statistics --
Commands --
Inputs
Number 4
• Of these in the process image 2 through AS-i 4 through AS-i
Input action For permanently assigned functions, see manual Parameterizable: flexible
Quick stop Permanent function: latching, edge-triggered Parameterizable function: latching (edge-
triggered), non-latching (level-triggered)
Outputs
Number 1
Output action Permanent function: assigned with group fault Parameterizable: For function, see manual
Brake output
180 V DC / 230/400 V AC / none
Motor protection
Overload protection Electronic, wide range 1:10
Short-circuit protection
Full motor protection
Temperature sensor Parameterizable using DIP switches: Parameterizable via Motor Starter ES, data
PTC or Thermoclick or deactivated record: PTC or Thermoclick or deactivated
Function available
-- Function not available
1)
The data records are a reduced selection compared with
PROFIBUS/PROFINET.

6/44 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Hybrid Motor Starters Motor Starters for Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
SIRIUS M200D Motor Starters
SIRIUS M200D motor starters for AS-Interface M200D Motor Starters for AS-Interface
General data
General data

SIRIUS M200D SIRIUS M200D


AS-i Basic AS-i Standard
Device functions (firmware features) (continued)
Device function
Repair switch ✓
Current limit monitoring bottom -- ✓ Parameterizable
Current limit monitoring top -- ✓ Parameterizable
Zero current detection ✓ Permanent function: disconnection, less than ✓ Parameterizable
18.75% of the rated operational current Ie
Blocking current ✓ Permanent function: starting up of the motor: ✓ Parameterizable
Tripping limit up to 800% of the rated operational
current Ie for 10 s
Active operation: Threshold for tripping "blocking
current" up to 400% of the rated operational
current Ie
Asymmetry ✓ Permanent function: up to 30% of the rated ✓ Parameterizable
operational current Ie (only mechanical MS)
Load type ✓ Permanent function: Three-phase ✓ Parameterizable: single-phase and three-phase
Shutdown class ✓ Parameterizable using DIP switches: Parameterizable via Motor Starter ES, data
CLASS 10/deactivated record: CLASS 5, 10, 15, 20
Protection against voltage failure ✓ ✓ Parameterizable: activated/deactivated
Soft starter control function
Soft start function -- ✓ Only solid-state version

6
Bypass function -- ✓ Only solid-state version

STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
✓ Function available

9
-- Function not available

■ Application
The M200D AS-i standard is particularly suitable for highly auto- Use of M200D motor starters in conjunction with
mated applications in conveyor systems requiring devices and IE3/IE4 motors
systems to be monitored to prevent or limit plant downtime.
The option of planning the functions of the motor starter or its Note:
interfaces also creates the prerequisite for fine-adjustment to the For the use
use of
of SIRIUS
SIRIUSM200D
M200Dmotor
motorstarters
startersininconjunction with
conjunction with
function of the motor starter in the application and hence highly energy-efficient
highly energy-efficientIE3/IE4
IE3/IE4motors,
motors,please
please observe
observethethe
provides for extreme flexibility. information on dimensioning
information on dimensioningand andconfiguring,;
configuring,see see Application
Application
Manual.

■ Technical specifications
More information
Manuals for SIRIUS
SIRIUS M200D:
M200D: Notes
Notes on
on security:
security:
•• AS-i
AS-i Basic,
Basic, see
see In order
In order toto protect
protect plants,
plants, systems,
systems, machines
machines and
and networks
networks against
against cyber
cyber
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/35016496
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/35016496 threats, itit is
threats, is necessary
necessary to implement –– and
to implement and continuously
continuously maintain
maintain –– aa holistic,
holistic,
state-of-the-artindustrial
state-of-the-art industrial security
security concept.
concept. Siemens products and and solutions
solutions
•• AS-i
AS-i Standard,
Standard, see
see
represent only one component of such a concept.
represent concept.
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/38722160
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/38722160
For more
For more information
information onon the
the subject
subject of
of Industrial
Industrial Security,
Security, see
see
FAQs, see https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16324/faq
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16324/faq www.siemens.com/industrialsecurity.
www.siemens.com/industrialsecurity.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 6/45


Motor
Hybrid Starters
Motor Startersfor
Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
SIRIUS M200D Motor Starters
SIRIUS M200D motor starters for AS-Interface
M200D Motor Starters for AS-Interface
General data
General data

Type M200D motor starters


AS-i Basic AS-i Basic AS-i Standard AS-i Standard
electromechanical electronic electromechanical electronic
switching switching switching switching
Technology designation1) DSte/RSte sDSte/sRSte DSte/RSte sDSSte/sRSSte
Mechanics and environment
Mounting dimensions (W x H x D) mm 294 x 215 x 159
Permissible ambient temperature
• During operation °C -25 ... +55
• During storage °C -40 ... +70
Weight g 2 880/3 130 3 220/3 420 2 880/3 130 3 220/3 420
Permissible mounting position Vertical, horizontal, lying
Vibration resistance acc. to IEC 60068 Part 2-6 g 2
Shock resistance
• Acc. to IEC 60068 Part 2-27 g/ms 12/11 half-sine
• Without influencing the contact position g/ms 9.8/5 or 5.9/10
Degree of protection acc. to IEC 529 IP65
Installation altitude
• Up to 1 000 m No derating
• Up to 2 000 m 1% per 100 m
Cooling Convection
Protection class IEC 536 (VDE 0106-1) 1
Electrical specifications
Control circuit
Operating voltage UAs-i V DC 26.5 ... 31.6
Supply voltage Uaux V DC 20.4 ... 28.8
Power consumption from AS-i (incl. 200 mA sensor supply) mA < 300
Current consumption from Uaux (without digital output)
• Max. mA 155 15 (direct-on-line)/ 155 15 (direct-on-line)/
175 (reversing) 175 (reversing)
• Typ. mA 75 10 (direct-on-line)/ 75 10 (direct-on-line)/
75 (reversing) 75 (reversing)
6

Main circuit
Maximum power of three-phase motors at 400 V AC kW 5.5 4 5.5 5.5
HYBRID MOTOR
STARTERS

Rated operational voltage Ue


• Approval acc. to EN 60947-1 V AC 400 (50/60 Hz)
9

• Approval acc. to UL and CSA V AC 600 (50/60 Hz) 480 (50/60 Hz) 600 (50/60 Hz) 480 (50/60 Hz)
• Rated operational current range A 0.15 ... 2/1.5 ... 12 -- 0.15 ... 2/1.5 ... 12 --
• Rated operational current range for soft starting A -- 0.15 ... 2/1.5 ... 12
• Rated operational current range for direct-on-line starting A -- 0.15 ... 2/1.5 ... 9 -- 0.15 ... 2/1.5 ... 9
Rated operational current for starters Ie at 400 V AC
• 400 V at AC-1/2/3 A 12 -- 12 --
• 500 V at AC-1/2/3 A 9 -- 9 --
• 400 V at AC-4 A 4 -- 4 --
• 400 V at AC-53a A -- 9 -- 12 for soft starting
9 for direct-on-line
starting
Mechanical endurance of contactor Operating cycles 30 million -- 30 million --
Trip class CLASS 10 CLASS 5, 10, 15, 20
Type of coordination acc. to IEC 60947-4-1 1 (2 for device 1 1 (2 for device 1
version 2A) version 2A)
Permissible switching frequency see manual see manual
Rated ultimate short-circuit breaking capacity Iq
• At 400 V AC kA 50
• At 500 V AC kA 502) 202) 50 202)
Short-circuit protection
• At Iemax = 2 A Integrated, 2 x13 Ie = 26 A
• At Iemax = 9/12 A Integrated, 2 x13 Ie = 208 A
Brake actuation (option)
Operational voltage V 230/400 AC or 180 DC
Uninterrupted current A < 0.5 at 230/400 V AC
< 0.8 at 180 V DC
Short-circuit protection Yes, 1 A melting fuse
1) 2) Only systems with grounded neutral point permitted.
DS .... Direct-on-line starters
RS .... Reversing starters
DSS .. Direct-on-line soft starters
RSS .. Reversing soft starters
te ...... Full motor protection (thermal + electronic)
s ....... Electronic switching with semiconductor.

6/46 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Hybrid Motor Starters Motor Starters for Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
SIRIUS M200D Motor Starters
SIRIUS M200D motor starters for AS-Interface M200D Motor Starters for AS-Interface
Basic motor starter IE3/IE4 ready
M200D Basic motor starters

■ Selection and ordering data

M200D AS-i Basic without manual local operation M200D AS-i Basic with manual local operation

Version SD Article No. Price PU PS*


per PU (UNIT,
SET, M)
d
Electromechanical starters (with integrated contactor)
15 3RK1315-6@S41-@AA@ 1 1 unit
Rated operational current setting range/A Additional price
• 0.15 ... 2 K None
• 1.5 ... 12 L ✓
Direct-on-line starters/reversing starters
• Direct-on-line starters 0 None
• Reversing starters 1 ✓
• Direct-on-line starters with manual local operation 2 ✓
• Reversing starters with manual local operation 3 ✓
Brake actuation
• Without brake actuation 0 None
• Brake actuation (230/400 V AC) 3 ✓

6
• Brake actuation (180 V DC) 5 ✓
Electronic starters (with thyristors)

STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
15 3RK1315-6@S71-@AA@ 1 1 unit
Rated operational current setting range/A Additional price

9
• 0.15 ... 2 K None
• 1.5 ... 9 N ✓
Direct-on-line starters/reversing starters
• Direct-on-line starters 0 None
• Reversing starters 1 ✓
• Direct-on-line starters with manual local operation 2 ✓
• Reversing starters with manual local operation 3 ✓
Brake actuation
• Without brake actuation 0 None
• Brake actuation (230/400 V AC) 3 ✓
• Brake actuation (180 V DC) 5 ✓
✓ = Additional price

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 6/47

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Motor
Hybrid Starters
Motor Startersfor
Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
SIRIUS M200D Motor Starters
SIRIUS M200D motor starters for AS-Interface
M200D Motor Starters for AS-Interface
Standard motor starter IE3/IE4 ready
M200D Standard motor starters

■ Selection and ordering data

M200D AS-i Standard without manual local operation M200D AS-i Standard with manual local operation

Version SD Article No. Price PU PS*


per PU (UNIT,
SET, M)
d
Electromechanical starters (with integrated contactor)
15 3RK1325-6@S41-@AA@ 1 1 unit
Rated operational current setting range/A Additional price
• 0.15 ... 2 K None
• 1.5 ... 12 L ✓
Direct-on-line starters/reversing starters
• Direct-on-line starters 0 None
• Reversing starters 1 ✓
• Direct-on-line starters with manual local operation 2 ✓
• Reversing starters with manual local operation 3 ✓
Brake actuation
• Without brake actuation 0 None
6

• Brake actuation (230/400 V AC) 3 ✓


• Brake actuation (180 V DC) 5 ✓
HYBRID MOTOR
STARTERS

Electronic starters (with thyristors)


15 3RK1325-6@S71-@AA@ 1 1 unit
9

Rated operational current setting range/A Additional price


• 0.15 ... 2 K None
• 1.5 ... 12 L ✓
Direct-on-line starters/reversing starters
• Direct-on-line starters 0 None
• Reversing starters 1 ✓
• Direct-on-line starters with manual local operation 2 ✓
• Reversing starters with manual local operation 3 ✓
Brake actuation
• Without brake actuation 0 None
• Brake actuation (230/400 V AC) 3 ✓
• Brake actuation (180 V DC) 5 ✓
✓ = Additional price

6/48 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Hybrid Motor Starters Motor Starters for Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
SIRIUS M200D Motor Starters
SIRIUS M200D motor starters for PROFIBUS/PROFINET
M200D Motor Starters for PROFIBUS/PROFINET
General data
General data

Overview
The intelligent, highly flexible M200D PROFIBUS/PROFINET
motor starters are the most functional motor starters of the
SIRIUS motor starter family in the high degree of protection IP65
for PROFIBUS/PROFINET communication.
They start and protect motors and loads up to 7.5 HP.
Direct-on-line and reversing starter versions are available, in a
mechanical version and also an electronic version (the latter with
soft start function).
The particularly robust M200D PROFIBUS/PROFINET motor
starters are characterized by numerous functions which can be
flexibly parameterized. Their modular design comprises a motor
starter module and a communication module.
The M200D PROFINET motor starters enable TIA-integrated
parameterization through PROFINET from STEP 7 – in familiar,
user-friendly manner with the look and feel of PROFIBUS.
Functionality
• For basic
basicfunctionality,
functionality,see
seepage
page 9/21“SIRIUS
16/41 "SIRIUSM200D
M200DMotorMotor
Starters” "General
Starters" “General data"
data” "Overview"
“Overview” M200D motor starter module for PROFIBUS/PROFINET
• Electronic version also with soft start function (without communication module)
• Robust and widely used M12 connection method for the
digital inputs and outputs and the PROFIBUS/PROFINET bus
connection
• All four digital inputs and two digital outputs exist in the cyclic
process image. This provides complete transparency of the
process on the control level
• Full TIA integration: All digital inputs and outputs exist in the
cyclic process image and are visible through the bus,
providing maximum flexibility and excellent adaptability to the
application

6
• Flexible assignment of the digital inputs and outputs with all
available assignable input actions

STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
• Extensive diagnostics concept using LEDs and through the

9
bus with the TIA-compatible mechanisms
• Expanded diagnostics using data records
• Complete plant monitoring using statistics data record and
current value monitoring by means of data records
• Parameterization through PROFIBUS/PROFINET bus with the M200D communication module for PROFIBUS
help of data records from the user program
• Control of the motor starter using a command data record from
the user program
• Removable modular control unit – quicker device replacement
and therefore lower costs when device outages occur – since
existing wiring is on the control unit and only one device needs
to be replaced
• Parameterization in STEP 7 HW Config using Motor Starter ES
(ordering option for startup software)
• Startup and diagnostics with the help of Motor Starter ES
(ordering option for startup software)
• Trace function through Motor Starter ES for optimized startup
and tracking of process and device values
Only with PROFINET:
• Just one bus system from the MES level to the devices – no
routers
• More stations on the bus and possible configuration of flexible
bus structures M200D communication module for PROFINET
• Automatic re-parameterization in case of device replacement
thanks to proximity detection
• Wireless integration of plant segments in difficult
environments using WLAN
• Easier expansion of the system thanks to a higher number of
stations on the bus and elimination of terminating resistors

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 6/49


Motor
Hybrid Starters
Motor Startersfor
Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
SIRIUS M200D Motor Starters
SIRIUS M200D motor starters for PROFIBUS/PROFINET
M200D Motor Starters for PROFIBUS/PROFINET
General data
General data
Mounting and installation The motor starter is TIA-diagnostics compatible, which means
that when a fault is identified, a diagnostics alarm is distributed,
The M200D PROFIBUS/PROFINET motor starter is comprised of which invokes the diagnostics OB in the case of a SIMATIC
the communication module and the motor starter module. Only control. The fault can be evaluated as usual in the user program.
the motor starter module has to be replaced therefore when
replacing devices. This saves time and money. The communica- The M200D motor starter offers a large variety of diagnostics
tion module remains as an active station on the bus and all other data through data records. Its functionality is without equal on
system components continue running. This prevents downtimes. the market. There are extensive options for reading out data from
the motor starter for monitoring devices, systems or processes.
The integrated plug-in technology enables far lower wiring
outlay: Connecting cables can be plugged directly onto the The motor starter is equipped internally with three logbooks for
motor starter module. The PROFINET bus is connected cost- device faults, motor starter trips and events that are issued with
effectively using an M12 connection on the device. All versions a time stamp. These logbooks can be read out of the motor
have identical enclosure dimensions for easier system design starter at any time in the form of data records and provide the
and conversion. plant operator with plenty of information about the state of his
plant and process which he can use to carry out improvements.
Parameterization and configuration
With the slave pointer and statistical data functions it is possible
All motor protection functions, limit values and reactions can be to read out, for example, the maximum internal current values or
defined by parameterization. the number of motor starter connection operations for plant
The user has several user-friendly options for the parameteriza- monitoring purposes. This allows deviations in the process to be
tion. In addition to parameterization directly from STEP 7, which monitored, but also optimum initial commissioning to take place.
also permits automatic re-parameterization in case of device re- The user can draw conclusions about the actual load conditions
placement, it is possible to use the user-friendly Motor Starter ES of the devices in his process and on this basis can optimize his
startup software. By connecting a programming device directly plant maintenance intervals.
to PROFIBUS/PROFINET and the Motor Starter ES startup The device diagnostics data record contains details of all the
software, the devices can also be conveniently programmed states of the motor starter, the device configuration and the
from a central point through the bus. Also, parameters can be communication status as a basis for central device and plant
changed during operation from the user program using the data monitoring.
record mechanism so that the function of the motor starter is
adapted to the process when required. With the help of a PC and With installation and maintenance functions (I&M), information
the Motor Starter ES software it is also possible to perform the on modules employed and data specified by the user during
parameterization through the local point-to-point interface configuration, such as location designations, are stored in the
on-site. motor starter. I&M functions are used for troubleshooting faults
and localizing changes in hardware in a plant or checking the
Functions can be flexibly assigned to the digital inputs and system configuration. Reordering a device is particularly easy as
6

outputs, adapting them to all possible conveyor applications. the result.


All digital inputs and outputs exist in the cyclic process image.
All limit values for monitoring functions and their reactions are The integrated maintenance timer can be used to implement
HYBRID MOTOR
STARTERS

parameterizable and therefore adaptable to the application. preventative maintenance and avoid plant downtimes through
Consistency with other products of the SIRIUS M200D motor look-ahead servicing.
9

starter range and with the frequency converter and ET 200pro


I/O system is assured. Another new addition is the TRACE integrated into the Motor
Starter ES software. It can be used to record measured values
Only with M200D PROFINET motor starters as a function of time following a trigger event. This enables pro-
cess flows to be recorded and their timing optimized.
Thanks to the integrated proximity detection, the device name
does not need to be issued manually when a device is replaced. Local control of a drive is possible using the ordering option with
The name is issued automatically by the neighboring devices integrated manual operation. This is yet another new develop-
which note the "names" of the devices in their proximity. ment which distinguishes the M200D PROFIBUS/PROFINET
No additional startup measures are required therefore when motor starter from the rest of the market and adds innovative
replacing a device. technology, maximum availability and transparency to the
system.
The new motor starter generation is characterized by high
functionality, maximum flexibility and the highest level of automa- M200D PROFINET motor starters with PROFIenergy
tion. PROFINET is especially recommended for large-scale and
highly automated system components, since the possibility of Increasing energy prices, far-reaching ecological problems
monitoring the devices or plants with data records (statistical worldwide and the threat of climate change make it necessary
data, measured values and device diagnostics) ensures a for you to be more conscious about your use of energy.
broader insight into the plant by the control room, and hence Active and effective energy management is possible with
increases the availability of the plant sustainably. PROFIenergy.
Operation PROFIenergy is a manufacturer-independent profile on
The motor starters record the actual current flow. Evaluating the PROFINET, which can be used by all manufacturers, has been
current of the parameterizable solid-state overload protection standardized by PNO1) and supports switching off electrical
increases the availability of the drives, as do reliable signals devices during dead times and measuring the energy flow.
1)
concerning the overshooting or undershooting of setpoint In the PNO (PROFIBUS Nutzerorganisation e. V. – PROFIBUS User
Organization), manufacturers and users have come together to agree on
values. the PROFIBUS and PROFINET standardized communication technologies.
Diagnostics and maintenance
Diagnostics is provided through numerous mechanisms – and
can be used as the customer prefers.

6/50 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Hybrid Motor Starters Motor Starters for Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
SIRIUS M200D Motor Starters
SIRIUS M200D motor starters for PROFIBUS/PROFINET
M200D Motor Starters for PROFIBUS/PROFINET
General data
General data
Switching off during dead times PROFIenergy enables consumption data to be read off from the
devices in a unified form. This is recorded during operation and
PROFIenergy supports the targeted switching-off of loads can be displayed on a control panel, for example, or sent to
during dead time. overlying energy management software packages. This ensures
These can be planned short breaks of a few minutes (such as that the measured variables are in a uniform manufacturer-inde-
lunch breaks), longer dead times (such as nights) or unplanned pendent form and structure that is available to the user for further
dead times. Energy is always saved when no power is required. processing. These PROFIenergy functions thus provide the
basis for active load and energy management during operation.
Measuring and visualizing the energy flow as a basis of
energy management PROFIenergy in the M200D PROFINET motor starter
The objective of energy management is to optimize the use of The M200D PROFINET motor starter supports the "switching
energy in a company – from the purchasing of energy through to during dead times" and "current measurement values" functions
the consumption of energy – economically and ecologically. of the motor current using PROFIenergy. These are called
commands, because they trigger a reaction in the M200D motor
Analyses of energy consumption over time can be used to starter.
control energy flows, avoid energy peaks, improve ratings and
thus save costs.

SIRIUS M200D SIRIUS M200D


PROFIBUS PROFINET
Device functions (firmware features)
Slave on the bus
Fieldbus PROFIBUS to M12 PROFINET to M12
Adjustable number of stations 1 ... 125 1 ... 128 with CPU 315, CPU 317

6
1 ... 1 256 with CPU 319
Parameter assignment

STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
DIP switches For address setting and terminating resistor --
Motor Starter ES Through bus, optical interface

9
PROFIBUS/PROFINET data records
From STEP 7/HW Config
Diagnostics
Acyclic through data records
Diagnostic interrupt support
Process image
Process image 2 bytes PAE/2 bytes PAA
Data channels
Local optical interface (manual local)
Motor Starter ES through local interface
Using Motor Starter ES through bus
Data records (acyclic)
Parameter assignment Using DS 131 (DS = data record)
Diagnostics Device-specific DS 92
Measured values Measured values DS 94
Statistics Statistical data DS 95
Commands Using DS 93
Slave pointer Slave pointer DS 96
Logbook Using Motor Starter ES and data records: device faults DS 72, tripping operation DS 73, events DS 75
Device identification Using DS 100
I&M data Using DS 231 ... 234 Using data records 0xAFF0 ... 0xAFF3
Inputs
Number 4
• Of these in the process image 4
Input action Parameterizable: For flexibly assignable action, see manual
Quick stop Parameterizable: latching, non-latching
Function available
-- Function not available

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 6/51


Motor
Hybrid Starters
Motor Startersfor
Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
SIRIUS M200D Motor Starters
SIRIUS M200D motor starters for PROFIBUS/PROFINET
M200D Motor Starters for PROFIBUS/PROFINET
General data
General data

SIRIUS M200D SIRIUS M200D


PROFIBUS PROFINET
Device functions (firmware features) (continued)
Outputs
Number 2
• Of these in the process image 2
Output action Parameterizable: For flexibly assignable action, see manual

Brake output
180 V DC / 230/400 V AC / none
Motor protection
Overload protection Electronic, wide range 1:10
Short-circuit protection
Full motor protection
Temperature sensor Parameterizable via Motor Starter ES, data record: PTC or Thermoclick or deactivated
Device function
Repair switch
Current limit monitoring bottom Parameterizable
Current limit monitoring top Parameterizable
Zero current detection Parameterizable: tripping, warning
Blocking current Parameterizable
6

Asymmetry Parameterizable
Load type Parameterizable: single-phase and three-phase
HYBRID MOTOR
STARTERS

Shutdown class Parameterizable via Motor Starter ES, data record: CLASS 5, 10, 15, 20
9

Protection against voltage failure Parameterizable: activated/deactivated


Support for PROFIenergy profile
Switching during dead times -- 3
Measured motor current values -- 3
Soft starter control function
Soft start function
Bypass function Only solid-state version

Function available
-- Function not available

Benefits
M200D PROFINET motor starters with PROFIenergy
Both standards and laws are making environmental protection It is thus an objective within the industry to save energy and
and energy management increasingly important, as is the desire actively reduce CO2 emissions. By the careful use of valuable
to cut energy costs in production facilities and thus ensure a resources, the manufacturer-independent PROFIenergy profile
sustainable competitive advantage. on PROFINET can make an active contribution to environmental
protection.

Application
M200D PROFIBUS/PROFINET motor starters are particularly Adaptability of the motor starter functions and maximum
suitable for fully TIA-integrated, highly automated conveyor flexibility of the device enable a broad range of application
applications that meet all needs with regard to the monitoring of without any limits. The PROFINET-specific expansions are the
devices and systems and preventive maintenance. best assurance of a future-proof investment.

6/52 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Hybrid Motor Starters Motor Starters for Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
SIRIUS M200D Motor Starters
SIRIUS M200D motor starters for PROFIBUS/PROFINET
M200D Motor Starters for PROFIBUS/PROFINET
General data
General data

Technical specifications
More information
Equipment Manual
Manual for
for M200D
M200D PROFIBUS/PROFINET,
PROFIBUS/PROFINET, see Notes
Notes on
on security:
security:
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/38823402
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/38823402 In order
In order toto protect
protect plants,
plants, systems,
systems, machines
machines and
and networks
networks against
against cyber
cyber
FAQs, see https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16325/faq
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16325/faq threats, itit is
threats, is necessary
necessary to implement –– and
to implement and continuously
continuously maintain
maintain –– aa holistic,
holistic,
state-of-the-artindustrial
state-of-the-art industrial security
security concept.
concept. Siemens
Siemens products
products and
and solutions
solutions
represent only one component of such a concept.
represent concept.
For more
For more information
information onon the
the subject
subject of
of Industrial
Industrial Security,
Security, see
see
www.siemens.com/industrialsecurity.
www.siemens.com/industrialsecurity.

Type M200D PROFIBUS/PROFINET motor starter modules


Electromechanical switching Electronic switching
Technology designation1) DSte/RSte sDSSte/sRSSte
Mechanics and environment
Mounting dimensions (W x H x D)
• Without communication module mm 294 x 215 x 159
• With communication module mm 295 x 215 x 163
Permissible ambient temperature
• During operation °C -25 ... +55
• During storage °C -40 ... +70
Weight g 2 820/3 080 3 160/3 360
Permissible mounting position Vertical, horizontal, lying
Vibration resistance acc. to IEC 60068 Part 2-6 g 2
Shock resistance
• Acc. to IEC 60068 Part 2-27 g/ms 12/11 half-sine
• Without influencing the contact position g/ms 9.8/5 or 5.9/10
Degree of protection acc. to IEC 529 IP65
Installation altitude
• Up to 1 000 m No derating
• Up to 2 000 m 1% per 100 m
Cooling Convection

6
Protection class IEC 536 (VDE 0106-1) 1
Electrical specifications

STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
Main circuit
Maximum power of three-phase motors at 400 V AC kW 5.5

9
Rated operational voltage Ue
• Approval acc. to EN 60947-1 V AC 400 (50/60 Hz)
• Approval acc. to UL and CSA V AC 600 (50/60 Hz) 480 (50/60 Hz)
• Rated operational current range A 0.15 ... 2/1.5 ... 12 --
• Rated operational current range for soft starting A -- 0.15 ... 2/1.5 ... 12
• Rated operational current range for direct-on-line starting A -- 0.15 ... 2/1.5 ... 9
Rated operational current for starters Ie at 400 V AC
• 400 V at AC-1/2/3 A 12 --
• 500 V at AC-1/2/3 A 9 --
• 400 V at AC-4 A 4 --
• 400 V at AC-53a A -- 12 for soft starting,
9 for direct-on-line starting
Mechanical endurance of contactor Operating cycles 30 million --
Trip class CLASS 5, 10, 15, 20
Permissible switching frequency see manual
Rated ultimate short-circuit breaking capacity Iq
• At 400 V AC kA 50
• At 500 V AC kA 50 202)
Short-circuit protection
• At Iemax = 2 A Integrated, 2 x13 Ie = 26 A
• At Iemax = 9 /12 A Integrated, 2 x13 Ie = 208 A
1) DS .... Direct-on-line starters
RS .... Reversing starters
DSS .. Direct-on-line soft starters
RSS .. Reversing soft starters
te ...... Full motor protection (thermal + electronic)
s ....... Electronic switching with semiconductor.
2)
Only systems with grounded neutral point permitted.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 6/53


Motor
Hybrid Starters
Motor Startersfor
Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
SIRIUS M200D Motor Starters
SIRIUS M200D motor starters for PROFIBUS/PROFINET
M200D Motor Starters for PROFIBUS/PROFINET
General data
General data

Line voltage
380 V AC 400 V AC 440 V AC 480 V AC 500 V AC
Brake voltage with brake actuation 180 V DC1)
Operational voltage V 230/400 AC or 180 DC
Uninterrupted current A < 0.5 at 230/400 V AC, < 0.8 at 180 V DC
Short-circuit protection Yes, 1 A melting fuse
Rectified brake voltage V DC 171 180 198 216 225
Recommended brake coil voltage for Siemens motors V DC 170 ... 200 170 ... 200 184 ... 218 184 ... 218 --
1) Integrated brake actuation supplies DC power supply for the brake.

Type M200D communication modules


For PROFIBUS For PROFINET
Mechanics and environment
Mounting dimensions (W x H x D) mm 174 x 139 x 40
Permissible ambient temperature
• During operation °C -25 ... +55
• During storage °C -40 ... +70
Weight g 300
Permissible mounting position Vertical, horizontal, lying
Vibration resistance acc. to IEC 60068 Part 2-6 g 2
Shock resistance
• Acc. to IEC 60068 Part 2-27 g/ms 12/11 half-sine
• Without influencing the contact position g/ms 9.8/5 or 5.9/10
Degree of protection acc. to IEC 529 IP65
Installation altitude
• Up to 1 000 m No derating
• Up to 2 000 m 1% per 100 m
Cooling Convection
Protection class IEC 536 (VDE 0106-1) 1
Electrical specifications
6

Control circuit
Operational voltage
V DC 20.4 ... 28.8
HYBRID MOTOR
STARTERS

• UDC24V-NS
• UDC24V-S V DC 20.4 ... 28.8
9

Power consumption from


• UDC24V-NS mA < 300
• UDC24V-S mA < 100

6/54 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Hybrid Motor Starters Motor Starters for Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
SIRIUS M200D Motor Starters
SIRIUS M200D motor starters for PROFIBUS/PROFINET
M200D Motor Starters for PROFIBUS/PROFINET
Communication modules, motor starter modules
Communication modules, motor starter modules

■ Selection and ordering data

M200D motor starter module M200D motor starter M200D motor starter
PROFIBUS/PROFINET PROFIBUS PROFINET
(without communication module)

Version SD Article No. Price PU PS*


per PU (UNIT,
SET, M)
d
M200D communication modules for PROFIBUS
Communication module for PROFIBUS 15 3RK1305-0AS01-0AA0 1 1 unit
M12 connection for communication, 7/8" for 24 V power supply
M200D communication modules for PROFINET
Communication module for PROFINET 15 3RK1335-0AS01-0AA0 1 1 unit
M12 connection for communication, 7/8" for 24 V power supply
M200D PROFIBUS/PROFINET motor starter modules
Electromechanical starters (with integrated contactor)
15 3RK1395-6@S41-@AD@ 1 1 unit
Rated operational current setting range/A Additional price
• 0.15 ... 2 K None

6
• 1.5 ... 12 L ✓
Direct-on-line starters/reversing starters

STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
• Direct-on-line starters 0 None
• Reversing starters 1 ✓

9
• Direct-on-line starters with manual local operation 2 ✓
• Reversing starters with manual local operation 3 ✓
Brake actuation
• Without brake actuation 0 None
• Brake actuation (230/400 V AC) 3 ✓
• Brake actuation (180 V DC) 5 ✓
Electronic starters (with thyristors)
15 3RK1395-6@S71-@AD@ 1 1 unit
Rated operational current setting range/A Additional price
• 0.15 ... 2 K None
• 1.5 ... 12 L ✓
Direct-on-line starters/reversing starters
• Direct-on-line starters 0 None
• Reversing starters 1 ✓
• Direct-on-line starters with manual local operation 2 ✓
• Reversing starters with manual local operation 3 ✓
Brake actuation
• Without brake actuation 0 None
• Brake actuation (230/400 V AC) 3 ✓
• Brake actuation (180 V DC) 5 ✓
✓ = Additional price

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 6/55

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Motor
Hybrid Starters
Motor Startersfor
Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
SIRIUS M200D Motor Starters
Motor Starter ES
Software
Software
Motor Starter ES

■ Overview
More information
Industry Mall,
Industry Mall, see
see www.siemens.com/product?3ZS1
www.siemens.com/product?3ZS1
Technical
Technical specifications
specificationsand
andsystem
systemrequirements,
requirements,see
see
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16713/td
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16713/td

Motor Starter ES is used for the startup, parameterization,


diagnostics, documentation and preventive maintenance of
SIMATIC ET 200S, ET 200pro, ECOFAST and M200D motor
starters.
The software program is available in three versions which differ
in their user-friendliness, scope of functions and price.

Motor Starter ES for parameterization, monitoring, diagnostics and


testing of motor starters
6 STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
9

6/56 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Hybrid Motor Starters Motor Starters for Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
SIRIUS M200D Motor Starters
SIRIUS M200D Motor Starters Accessories
Accessories for all M200D motor starters
For all M200D motor starters

■ Overview

7
1

NSA0_00485a
NSA0_00484
2 4 9 10

5
M 8
3 6

1 Power feeder plug 7 Connection for motor control with AS-i communication
2 Power connection plug 8 AS-Interface M12 feeder
3 Power connection cable 9 Connection for digital input
(IO communication, 5-pole)
4 Motor connection plug
10 Connection for digital output
5 Motor plug (IO communication, 4- or 5-pole)
6 Motor cable

Power and motor connection on the M200D motor starter Communication connection using AS-Interface and digital inputs and

6
(in this example: M200D for AS-i) outputs

STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR

9
13 14 13 14

11 12 15 15
NSA0_00488a

NSA0_00487a

9 10 9 10

9 Connection for digital input


9 Connection for digital input (IO communication, 5-pole)
(IO communication, 5-pole) 10 Connection for digital output
10 Connection for digital output (IO communication, 4- or 5-pole)
(IO communication, 4- or 5-pole) 13 Connection for 24 V supply (infeed)
11 PROFIBUS connection (input) 14 Connection for 24 V supply (loop)
12 PROFIBUS connection (loop) 15 Connection with PROFINET
13 Connection for 24 V supply (infeed) (input on the left, loop on the right)

14 Connection for 24 V supply (loop)

Communication connection using PROFIBUS and digital inputs and Communication connection using PROFINET and digital inputs and
outputs outputs

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 6/57


Motor
Hybrid Starters
Motor Startersfor
Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
SIRIUS M200D Motor Starters
SIRIUS M200D Motor Starters
Accessories
Accessories for all M200D motor starters
For all M200D motor starters

16 Power bus cable (sold by the meter)


17 Power T terminal connector
18 Power double-T terminal connector

16
17 18 18

ET 200pro
M200D M200D

IC01_00231a
Motors

Power supply to the motors via the power bus with power T and double-T terminal connectors linked by power bus cables, spur lines to the field devices
6

(motor starters), and power loop-through connections to the motors via motor connection cables
Power bus Interruption-free thanks to power terminal connectors
HYBRID MOTOR
STARTERS

The power supply to the field devices (ET 200pro motor starters, In finger-safe connection technology the power T terminal
M200D motor starters) is provided via the power bus, in which
9

connectors and power double-T terminal connectors connect


the power T terminal connectors or power double-T terminal the components of a feeder to the power bus. They ensure
connectors are connected by power bus cables. interruption-free operation, i.e. the power bus is not interrupted
when the components are unplugged.
Feeders
From the terminal connectors, spur lines with Han Q4/2 plugs
lead to the field devices, from which the motors are supplied with
power via motor connection cables.

6/58 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Hybrid Motor Starters Motor Starters for Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
SIRIUS M200D Motor Starters
SIRIUS M200D Motor Starters Accessories
Accessories for all M200D motor starters
For all M200D motor starters

Selection and ordering data


The accessories listed below represent a basic selection
sorted by:
• Accessories for all M200D motor starters
• Accessories for M200D motor starters for AS-Interface
• Accessories for M200D motor starters for PROFIBUS
• Accessories for M200D motor starters for PROFINET
Version SD Article No. Price PU (UNIT, PS*
per PU SET, M)
d
Mountable accessories
M200D protective brackets 5 3RK1911-3BA00 1 1 unit
Incoming power supply
 Power feeder plugs
Connector set for incoming power supply, e.g. for
connecting to T terminal connectors, comprising a
coupling enclosure, straight outgoing feeder (with
bracket), pin insert for HAN Q4/2, incl. gland
• 5 male contacts, 2.5 mm2 5 3RK1911-2BS60 1 1 unit
• 5 male contacts, 4 mm2 5 3RK1911-2BS20 1 1 unit
• 5 male contacts, 6 mm2 5 3RK1911-2BS40 1 1 unit
 Power connection plugs
Connector set for incoming power supply for connection
to M200D motor starters, comprising a cable-end
connector hood, angular outgoing feeder, female insert
for HAN Q4/2, incl. gland
• 5 female contacts, 2.5 mm2, 5 3RK1911-2BE50 1 1 unit
2 female contacts, 0.5 mm2
• 5 female contacts, 4 mm2, 5 3RK1911-2BE10 1 1 unit
2 female contacts, 0.5 mm2
• 5 female contacts, 6 mm2, 5 3RK1911-2BE30 1 1 unit
2 female contacts, 0.5 mm2

6
 +  Power connection cables
Assembled at one end with "N" and jumper pin 11 and 12
for plug monitoring, with HAN Q4/2, angular;

STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
open at one end; 5 x 4 mm2
• Length 1.5 m 10 3RK1911-0DC13 1 1 unit

9
• Length 5.0 m 10 3RK1911-0DC33 1 1 unit
Motor cables
 Motor connection plugs
Connector set for motor cable for connection to
M200D motor starters, comprising a cable-end connector
hood, angular outgoing feeder, pin insert for HAN Q8/0,
incl. gland
• 8 male contacts, 1.5 mm2 5 3RK1902-0CE00 1 1 unit
• 6 male contacts, 2.5 mm2 5 3RK1902-0CC00 1 1 unit
 Motor plugs
Connector set for motor cable for connection to motors,
comprising a cable-end connector hood, straight
outgoing feeder, female insert for HAN 10e, incl. star
jumper, incl. gland
• 7 female contacts, 1.5 mm2 30 3RK1911-2BM21 1 1 set
• 7 female contacts, 2.5 mm2 30 3RK1911-2BM22 1 1 set
 +  Motor cables, assembled at one end
For connection to M200D motor starters, HAN Q8/0,
angular, length 5 m
• Motor cables for motor without brake, 4 x 1.5 mm2 15 3RK1911-0EB31 1 1 unit
• Motor cables for motor without brake with thermistor, 30 3RK1911-0EF31 1 1 unit
6 x 1.5 mm2
• Motor cables for motor with brake actuation, 30 3RK1911-0ED31 1 1 unit
braking voltage 400 V AC or 180 V DC, 6 x 1.5 mm2
• Motor cables for motor with brake actuation, 30 3RK1911-0EG31 1 1 unit
braking voltage 400 V AC or 180 V DC and thermistor,
8 x 1.5 mm2
• Motor cables for motor with brake actuation, 30 3RK1911-0EH31 1 1 unit
braking voltage 230 V AC,
6 x 1.5 mm2
• Motor cables for motor with brake actuation, 30 3RK1911-0EE31 1 1 unit
braking voltage 230 V AC and thermistor,
8 x 1.5 mm2

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 6/59

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Motor
Hybrid Starters
Motor Startersfor
Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
SIRIUS M200D Motor Starters
SIRIUS M200D Motor Starters
Accessories
Accessories for all M200D motor starters
For all M200D motor starters

Version SD Article No. Price PU (UNIT, PS*


per PU SET, M)
d
Power bus
 Power T terminal connectors
For 400 V AC, for connection of feeders (e.g. motor
starters) by means of standard round cable at any point
of the power bus, by insulation displacement connection,
used with preassembled bus segments
• 2.5 mm²/4 mm² 5 3RK1911-2BF01 1 1 unit
• 4 mm²/6 mm² 5 3RK1911-2BF02 1 1 unit
 Power double-T terminal connectors
For 400 V AC, for connection of feeders (e.g. motor
starters) by means of standard round cable at any point
of the power bus, by insulation displacement connection,
used with preassembled bus segments, connection of two
motor starters possible
• 4 mm²/6 mm² 5 3RK1911-2BG02 1 1 unit
Sealing set (comprising 2 seals)
For power T/power double-T terminal connectors
• For power cables with
- Ø 10 ... 13 mm 5 3RK1911-5BA00 1 1 unit
- Ø 13 ... 16 mm 5 3RK1911-5BA10 1 1 unit
- Ø 16 ... 19 mm 5 3RK1911-5BA20 1 1 unit
- Ø 19 ... 22 mm X 3RK1911-5BA30 1 1 unit
• Blanking plugs 5 3RK1911-5BA50 1 1 unit
Further accessories for power connections
Crimping tools for pins/sockets 4 mm2 and 6 mm2 15 3RK1902-0CW00 1 1 unit

3RK1902-0CW00
Dismantling tools
6

• For male and female contacts for 9-pole 15 3RK1902-0AB00 1 1 unit


HAN Q4/2 inserts
• For male and female contacts for 9-pole 5 3RK1902-0AJ00 1 1 unit
HYBRID MOTOR
STARTERS

HAN Q8 inserts
Sealing caps
9

For 9-pole power sockets


• 1 unit per pack 5 3RK1902-0CK00 1 1 unit
• 10 units per pack 5 3RK1902-0CJ00 1 10 units

3RK1902-0CK00

6/60 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Hybrid Motor Starters Motor Starters for Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
SIRIUS M200D Motor Starters
SIRIUS M200D Motor Starters Accessories
Accessories for all M200D motor starters
For all M200D motor starters

Version SD Article No. Price PU (UNIT, PS*


per PU SET, M)
d
Motor control with I/O communication
M12 plugs, straight 5 3RK1902-4BA00-5AA0 1 1 unit
Screw fixing, 5-pole screw terminals,
max. 0.75 mm2,
A-coded, max. 4 A

3RK1902-4BA00-5AA0
 M12 plugs, angular 5 3RK1902-4DA00-5AA0 1 1 unit
Screw fixing, 5-pole screw terminals,
max. 0.75 mm2,
A-coded, max. 4 A

3RK1902-4DA00-5AA0
,  Control cables, assembled at one end
M12 plugs, angular, screw fixing, 5-pole, 5 x 0.34 mm2,
A-coded, black PUR sheath, max. 4 A
• Cable length 1.5 m 5 3RK1902-4HB15-5AA0 1 1 unit
3RK1902-4H...-5AA0 • Cable length 5 m 5 3RK1902-4HB50-5AA0 1 1 unit
• Cable length 10 m 5 3RK1902-4HC01-5AA0 1 1 unit
Control cables, assembled at both ends
Straight M12 plug, straight M12 socket, screw fixing,
3RK1902-4PB15-3AA0 3-pole, 3 x 0.34 mm2,
A-coded, black PUR sheath, max. 4 A
• Cable length 1.5 m 5 3RK1902-4PB15-3AA0 1 1 unit
Further accessories
Handheld devices 5 3RK1922-3BA00 1 1 unit
For M200D motor starters (or for ET 200pro and ET 200S
High Feature motor starters) for local operation.
The motor starter-specific serial interface cables must be
ordered separately.
The RS 232 interface cable 3RK1922-2BP00 is used for the
MS M200D.

6
RS 232 interface cable 5 3RK1922-2BP00 1 1 unit
Serial data connection between M200D (or ET 200pro)

STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
motor starters and the RS 232 interface of a
PC/PG/laptop (with the Motor Starter ES software) or the
3RK1922-3BA00 handheld device 3RK1922-3BA00

9
USB interface cable, 2.5 m 3 6SL3555-0PA00-2AA0 1 1 unit
Serial data connection between M200D (or ET 200pro)
motor starters and the USB interface of a PC/PG/laptop
(with the Motor Starter ES software).
M12 sealing caps } 3RK1901-1KA00 100 10 units
For sealing unused M12 input or output sockets and
M12 sockets for PROFIBUS and PROFINET
communication modules
3RK1901-1KA00 (one set contains ten sealing caps)
RONIS SB30 keys } 3SU1950-0FB80-0AA0 1 1 unit
Replacement key for M200D
for "manual local control" ordering option

3SU1950-0FB80-0AA0

For more
For more connection
connectiontechnology
technology products,
products, seesee
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/65355810.
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/65355810..

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 6/61

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Motor
Hybrid Starters
Motor Startersfor
Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
SIRIUS M200D Motor Starters
SIRIUS M200D Motor Starters
Accessories
Accessories for M200D motor starters for AS-Interface
For M200D motor starters for AS-Interface

Selection and ordering data

Version SD Article No. Price PU (UNIT, PS*


per PU SET, M)
d
Motor control with AS-i communication
 Control cables, assembled at one end
M12 plug, angular, screw fixing, 4-pole, 4 x 0.34 mm2,
A-coded, black PUR sheath, max. 4 A
3RK1902-4GB50-4AA0 • Cable length 5 m 5 3RK1902-4GB50-4AA0 1 1 unit
 M12 sockets, angled 5 3RK1902-4CA00-4AA0 1 1 unit
For screw fixing, 4-pole screw terminals,
max. 0.75 mm2,
A-coded, max. 4 A

3RK1902-4CA00-4AA0
 AS-Interface M12 feeders
For flat cable For Cable length Cable end in
feeder
AS-i/Uaux M12 socket -- not available 2 3RK1901-2NR20 1 1 unit
M12 1m not available 2 3RK1901-2NR21 1 1 unit
cable box 2m not available 2 3RK1901-2NR22 1 1 unit

3RK1901-2NR21
Cable terminating pieces } 3RK1901-1MN00 1 10 units
For sealing of open cable ends (shaped AS-Interface
cable) in IP67

3RK1901-1MN00
6

AS-Interface shaped cable, see also page 2/82


Material Color Quantity
HYBRID MOTOR
STARTERS

Rubber Yellow (AS- 100 m roll 2 3RX9010-0AA00 1 1 unit


Interface)
9

1 km drum 5 3RX9012-0AA00 1 1 unit


Black 100 m roll 2 3RX9020-0AA00 1 1 unit
(24 V DC) 1 km drum 5 3RX9022-0AA00 1 1 unit
3RX90..-0AA00
TPE Yellow (AS- 100 m roll 2 3RX9013-0AA00 1 1 unit
Interface) 1 km drum 5 3RX9014-0AA00 1 1 unit
Black 100 m roll 2 3RX9023-0AA00 1 1 unit
(24 V DC) 1 km drum 5 3RX9024-0AA00 1 1 unit
TPE special Yellow (AS- 100 m roll 5 3RX9017-0AA00 1 1 unit
version Interface)
according to Black 100 m roll 5 3RX9027-0AA00 1 1 unit
UL Class 2 (24 V DC)
PUR Yellow (AS- 100 m roll 2 3RX9015-0AA00 1 1 unit
Interface) 1 km drum 5 3RX9016-0AA00 1 1 unit
Black 100 m roll 2 3RX9025-0AA00 1 1 unit
(24 V DC) 1 km drum 5 3RX9026-0AA00 1 1 unit

6/62 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Hybrid Motor Starters Motor Starters for Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
SIRIUS M200D Motor Starters
SIRIUS M200D Motor Starters Accessories
Accessories for M200D motor starters for AS-Interface
For M200D motor starters for AS-Interface

Version SD Article No. Price PU (UNIT, PS*


per PU SET, M)
d
Further accessories
AS-Interface addressing unit V3.0 2 3RK1904-2AB02 1 1 unit
• For AS-Interface modules and sensors and actuators
with integrated AS-Interface according to
AS-i Specification V3.0
• For setting the AS-i address of standard slaves, and
slaves with extended addressing mode (A/B slaves)
• With input/output test function and many other
commissioning functions
• Battery operation with four type AA batteries
(IEC LR6, NEDA 15)
• Scope of supply:
- Addressing unit with four batteries
- Addressing cable, with M12 plug to addressing plug
(hollow plug), length 1.5 m
3RK1904-2AB02
M12 addressing cables to M12 5 3RK1902-4PB15-3AA0 1 1 unit
• Standard M12 cable for addressing slaves with M12
connection, e.g. K60R modules
3RK1902-4PB15-3AA0 • When using the current version of the 3RK1904-2AB01
addressing unit
• 1.5 m
"SIRIUS M200D Motor Starter" manuals
Manual --
Equipment Manual
SIRIUS M200D
M200D AS-Interface
AS-InterfaceBasic
BasicMotor Starter,see
MotorStarter, see
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/35016496
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/35016496
Equipment Manual
Manual --
SIRIUS M200D
M200D AS-Interface
AS-InterfaceStandard Motor
Basic Motor seesee
Starter,
Starter,
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/38722160
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/38722160

6
STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 6/63

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Motor
Hybrid Starters
Motor Startersfor
Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
SIRIUS M200D Motor Starters
SIRIUS M200D Motor Starters
Accessories
Accessories for M200D motor starters for PROFIBUS
For M200D motor starters for PROFIBUS

Selection and ordering data

Version SD Article No. Price PU (UNIT, PS*


per PU SET, M)
d
Motor control with PROFIBUS
M12 plugs, angular
For screw fixing, 5-pole screw terminal,
max. 0.75 mm2, B-coded, no terminating resistor
•  5 female contacts 5 3RK1902-1DA00 1 1 unit

3RK1902-1DA00
•  5 male contacts 5 3RK1902-1BA00 1 1 unit

3RK1902-1BA00
Control cables, assembled at one end
M12, screw fixing, angular, B-coded, no terminating
resistor
3RK1902-1G. •  5 female contacts, 3 m 15 3RK1902-1GB30 1 1 unit
•  5 female contacts, 5 m 15 3RK1902-1GB50 1 1 unit
•  5 female contacts, 10 m 15 3RK1902-1GC10 1 1 unit
  Control cables, assembled at both ends
M12, screw fixing, angular, pin/socket
5-pole, B-coded, no terminating resistor
• 3.0 m 15 3RK1902-1NB30 1 1 unit
3RK1902-1N.
• 5.0 m 15 3RK1902-1NB50 1 1 unit
• 10.0 m 15 3RK1902-1NC10 1 1 unit
Further accessories
6

PROFIBUS trailing cables 1 6XV1830-3EH10 1 1M


Max. acceleration 4 m/s2, at least 3 000 000 bending
cycles, bending radius at least 60 mm, 2-core, shielded,
HYBRID MOTOR
STARTERS

sold by the meter, minimum order quantity 20 m,


maximum order quantity 1 000 m
9

PROFIBUS FC Food bus cables 1 6XV1830-0GH10 1 1M


with PE outer sheath for operation in the food and
beverage industry, 2-core, shielded, sold by the meter,
minimum order quantity 20 m, maximum order quantity
1 000 m
PROFIBUS FC Robust bus cables 1 6XV1830-0JH10 1 1M
with PUR outer sheath for operation in environments
exposed to chemicals and mechanical loads, 2-core,
shielded, sold by the meter, minimum order quantity 20 m,
maximum order quantity 1 000 m
Power cables 1 6XV1830-8AH10 1 1M
5-core, 5 x 1.5 mm2, trailing, sold by the meter,
minimum order quantity 20 m, maximum order quantity
1 000 m
Connection for 24 V power supply of the M200D PROFIBUS/PROFINET
See page 6/65
9/45
Equipment Manual "SIRIUS M200D PROFIBUS/PROFINET Motor Starters"
See
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/38823402
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/38823402

6/64 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Hybrid Motor Starters Motor Starters for Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
SIRIUS M200D Motor Starters
SIRIUS M200D Motor Starters Accessories
Accessories for M200D motor starters for PROFINET
For M200D motor starters for PROFINET

Selection and ordering data

Version SD Article No. Price PU (UNIT, PS*


per PU SET, M)
d
Motor control with PROFINET
 M12 plugs, angular
For screw fixing, 4-pole screw terminal,
max. 0.75 mm2, angular, D-coded
• 4 male contacts 5 3RK1902-2DA00 1 1 unit
 Control cables, assembled at one end
M12 for screw fixing, angular, 4-pole, D-coded,
• 4 male contacts, 3 m 15 3RK1902-2HB30 1 1 unit
3RK1902-2H. • 4 male contacts, 5 m 15 3RK1902-2HB50 1 1 unit
• 4 male contacts, 10 m 15 3RK1902-2HC10 1 1 unit
 Control cables, assembled at both ends
M12 for screw fixing, angular at both ends,
4-pole, D-coded, male contacts at both ends
3RK1902-2N. •3m 15 3RK1902-2NB30 1 1 unit
•5m 15 3RK1902-2NB50 1 1 unit
• 10 m 15 3RK1902-2NC10 1 1 unit
Further accessories
PROFINET IE FC TP standard cable GP 2 x 2 1 6XV1840-2AH10 1 1M
Sold by the meter
PROFINET IE FC TP trailing cable 2 x 2 1 6XV1840-3AH10 1 1M
Sold by the meter
PROFINET IE FC TP trailing cable GP 2 x 2 1 6XV1870-2D 1 1M
Sold by the meter
PROFINET IE FC TP torsion cable 2 x 2 1 6XV1870-2F 1 1M
Sold by the meter
PROFINET IE FC TP marine cable, 4-core 1 6XV1840-4AH10 1 1M
Sold by the meter
Power cables 1 6XV1830-8AH10 1 1M
5-core, 5 x 1.5 mm2, trailing, sold by the meter, minimum

6
order quantity 20 m, maximum order quantity 1 000 m

Connection for 24 V power supply of the M200D PROFIBUS/PROFINET

STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
Plugs
On M200D, 7/8" for screw fixing, angular,

9
screw terminal, 1.5 mm2
•  5 female contacts 5 3RK1902-3DA00 1 1 unit

3RK1902-3DA00
•  5 male contacts 5 3RK1902-3BA00 1 1 unit

3RK1902-3BA00
 Supply lines, assembled at one end
7/8" for screw fixing, angular, 1.5 mm2
• 5 female contacts, 3 m 15 3RK1902-3GB30 1 1 unit
• 5 female contacts, 5 m 15 3RK1902-3GB50 1 1 unit
• 5 female contacts, 10 m 15 3RK1902-3GC10 1 1 unit
3RK1902-3G.
  Supply lines, assembled at both ends
7/8", for screw fixing, angular at both ends,
5-pole pin/socket, 1.5 mm2
•3m 15 3RK1902-3NB30 1 1 unit
3RK1902-3N. •5m 15 3RK1902-3NB50 1 1 unit
• 10 m 15 3RK1902-3NC10 1 1 unit
7/8" sealing caps 1 6ES7194-3JA00-0AA0 1 10 units
1 pack = 10 units

6ES7194-3JA00-0AA0
Equipment Manual "SIRIUS M200D PROFIBUS/PROFINET Motor Starters"
See
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/38823402
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/38823402

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 6/65

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Hybrid Motor Starters
Motor Starters for Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
Hybrid fieldbus connections
General data
Hybrid fieldbus connections

Overview
Auxiliary power infeed
HanBrid plug-in connection technology offers the option of
feeding in or looping through two separate auxiliary voltages of
24 V DC (switched/unswitched) into the field in addition to the
PROFIBUS signal. The terminal block with spring-loaded
terminals on the rear (cabinet side) of the hybrid fieldbus
connection provides a variety of interconnecting options for
these auxiliary voltages.
Passive hybrid fieldbus connections
• Bushing from the control cabinet (IP20) into the field (IP65)
• HanBrid plug-in design socket/socket or pin/socket
• Direct connection or FastConnect connection for PROFIBUS at
Hybrid fieldbus connection with two HanBrid sockets the rear
• Terminal block with spring-loaded terminals (0.25 to 2.5 mm2)
for infeeding or forwarding the auxiliary voltages
IP20

IP65

Control cabinet bushing with two M12 sockets


Pin or socket Socket
6

Hybrid fieldbus connections with HanBrid sockets designed as Hybrid fieldbus connection as passive cabinet bushing
cabinet bushings transmit data and energy from the control
Active hybrid fieldbus connections with refresher function
HYBRID MOTOR
STARTERS

cabinet (IP20) to the field (IP65). They are the interface for jointly
routing PROFIBUS DP and the auxiliary voltages into the hybrid • Bushing from the control cabinet (IP20) into the field (IP65)
9

fieldbus cable. • Three independent, electrically separated PROFIBUS


On the cabinet bushings with two M12 sockets for the segments
PROFIBUS M12 connecting cables, the 24 V supply of the motor • Signal refresher function from and to all segments
starters is implemented via separate 7/8" connecting cables. • Automatic continuous baud rate detection
Passive and active hybrid fieldbus connections • Status/diagnostics displays with LEDs
The hybrid fieldbus connections are available in two versions • Cascading depth of a maximum nine hybrid fieldbus
which differ in their functionality: connections
• Passive version • HanBrid plug-in design socket/socket and pin/socket
• Active version with signal refresher function to considerably • M12 plug-in design socket/socket
increase the maximum PROFIBUS cable length • 9-pole Sub D socket connection for PROFIBUS at the rear
Connection methods • Terminal block with spring-loaded terminals (0.25 to 2.5 mm2)
for infeeding or forwarding the auxiliary voltages
The field side is connected using HanBrid or M12 plug-in
connections.
IP20
In the case of HanBrid, the following versions are available:
• Socket/socket for feeding into the field
• Pin/socket for looping through in the field
The M12 version is generally configured with socket/socket.
Refresher
Following connections are available at the rear (cabinet side) in
the case of the passive bushings:
• Direct connection
• FastConnect connection IP65

The active bushing with refresher function has 9-pole Sub D


sockets for the rear connection. Pin or socket Socket

Hybrid fieldbus connection as active control cabinet bushing with


refresher function

6/66 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

Siemens IC 10 · 2020
Hybrid Motor Starters
Motor Starters for Use in the Field, High Degree of Protection
Hybrid fieldbus connections
Selection and ordering
Hybrid fieldbus connections

Technical specifications
Type Passive hybrid fieldbus connections Active hybrid fieldbus connections
Mechanics and environment
Dimensions (W x H x D) mm 93 x 103 x 65
Cutout (W x H) mm 80 x 90
Temperature range °C -25 ... +60
Degree of protection IP20 internal/IP65 on field side
Material/enclosure mm Plastic (black PC), flame retardant
Electrical specifications
Rated operational voltage
• 24 V DC not switched (NS) V DC 24, ± 25%
• 24 V DC switched (S) V DC 24, ± 25%
Max. rated current A 10
Power supply -- From 24 V DC not switched (NS)
Max. power consumption mA -- 130
Mains buffering ms -- > 20
Baud rate detection -- Automatic
Maximum cascading depth -- 9 hybrid fieldbus connections
Baud rates kbps 9.6/19.2/45.45/93.75/187.5/500/1 500/3 000/6 000 /12 000
Electrical separation V DC 500

Selection and ordering data

Hybrid fieldbus connection With pin/socket Control cabinet bushing


on the field side: (HanBrid) on the field side
With socket/socket (HanBrid) With socket/socket (M12)

6
Link type / function Connection IP65 Connection IP20 SD Article No. Price PU (UNIT, PS*

STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR
(PROFIBUS) per PU SET, M)

9
d
Hybrid fieldbus connections
Passive
• Cu/Cu, for feeding into the field Socket/socket Direct connection 5 3RK1911-1AA22 1 1 unit
(2 x HanBrid)
• Cu/Cu, for looping through in the Pin/socket Direct connection 5 3RK1911-1AA32 1 1 unit
field (2 x HanBrid)
• Cu/Cu, for feeding into the field Socket/socket PROFIBUS FastConnect 5 3RK1911-1AF22 1 1 unit
(2 x HanBrid) bus connector
• Cu/Cu, for looping through in the Pin/socket PROFIBUS FastConnect 5 3RK1911-1AF32 1 1 unit
field (2 x HanBrid) bus connector
Active (refresher)
• Cu/Cu, for feeding into the field Socket/socket 9-pole Sub D socket 5 3RK1911-1AJ22 1 1 unit
(2 x HanBrid)
• Cu/Cu, for looping through in the Pin/socket 9-pole Sub D socket 5 3RK1911-1AJ32 1 1 unit
field (2 x HanBrid)
• Cu/Cu, for feeding into the field Socket/socket 9-pole Sub D socket 5 3RK1911-1AK22 1 1 unit
(2 x M12)

Version SD Article No. Price PU (UNIT, PS*


per PU SET, M)
d
Accessories
Sealing caps for HanBrid 1 6ES7194-1JB10-0XA0 1 10 units
Protective cover for bus and power supply connection
(pack of 10)

6ES7194-1JB10-0XA0
PROFIBUS ECOFASThybrid
PROFIBUS ECOFAST hybridcables,
cables,see
seeCatalog
CatalogSTST
7070
or or
Industry Mall.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 6/67

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Siemens IC 10 · 2020
Hybrid Motor Starters

Notes
6 STARTERS
HYBRID MOTOR

6/68 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Soft Starters & Drives
Industrial Control Product Catalog 2021

contents
Introduction
7 Section

7/2 – 7/3
SIRIUS 3RW soft starters
General data 7/4 – 7/11
High Performance soft starters
3RW55 soft starters
- General Data 7/12 – 7/25
- Inline circuit 7/26 – 7/29
- Inside-delta circuit 7/30 – 7/33
3RW55/55F
- Accessories 7/34 – 7/35
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters
- General Data 7/36 – 7/48
- Inline circuit 7/49
- Inside-delta circuit 7/50
- Accessories 7/51 – 7/52
General Performance soft starters
3RW52 soft starters
- General Data 7/53 – 7/64
- Inline circuit 7/65 – 7/66
- Inside-delta circuit 7/67 – 7/68
- Accessories 7/69 – 7/70
3RW52 Basic Performance soft starters
3RW50 soft starters
- General Data 7/71 – 7/79
- Inline circuit 7/80
- Accessories 7/81 – 7/82
3RW40 soft starters
- General Data 7/83 – 7/89
- Inline circuit 7/90 – 7/91

7
- Accessories 7/92 – 7/93
3RW30 soft starters

SOFT STARTERS
- General Data 7/94 – 7/101
- Inline circuit 7/102
- Accessories 7/103 – 7/104
3RW50
Soft Starter Software 7/105
Spare parts
For 3RW55/3RW55 Failsafe 7/105 – 7/107
For 3RW52 7/108 – 7/109
For 3RW50 7/110
Class 73/74 Enclosed Softstarter applications
Overview 7/111
Application 7/111
Selection and ordering data 7/112 - 7/123
Factory Modifications 7/124
Dimensional drawings 7/125
Schematics 7/126

3RW30 3RW40 SINAMICS G120X Drives


Introduction, Technical and General data 7/127 - 7/129
Selection and ordering data 7/130 - 7/132
Kits, options, features 7/133

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/1


Soft Starters
Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices

Introduction
Introduction

Overview
More information
Homepage,
Homepage, seesee www.usa.siemens.com/soft-starter
www.siemens.com/soft-starter Industry
Industry Online Support (SIOS)
(SIOS) topic
topic page,
page,see
see
Industry Mall,
Industry Mall, see
see www.siemens.com/product?3RW
www.siemens.com/product?3RW https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109747404
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109747404
TIA Selection
TIA Selection Tool
Tool Cloud
Cloud (TST
(TST Cloud),
Cloud),see
see Simulation Tool
Simulation Tool for
for Soft
Soft Starters
Starters(STS),
(STS), see
see page
page 6/8
6/8 or
or
https://www.siemens.com/tstcloud/?node=Sirius3rwFolder
https://www.siemens.com/tstcloud/?node=Sirius3rwFolder https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917

3RW55 3RW55 Failsafe 3RW52 3RW50 3RW40 3RW30


Page
3RW soft starters
High Performance soft starters
6

3RW55 soft starters • TIA integration optional 7/12


• Plug-in communication modules for PROFINET, PROFIBUS, EtherNet/IP and Modbus
• Removable HMI module with color display, local interface and slot for a micro SD memory
card
• Extended protection functions
• Up to 1000HP @ 480V (600V and 690V ratings also available)
• Automatic parameterization for simple commissioning and reliability even under changing
load conditions
• Hybrid switching devices for minimum power loss and three-phase motor control for
optimum/symmetrical motor control
• Pump stop for reduced mechanical loading and optimum pump stop control
• ATEX/IECEx certification
3RW55 Failsafe • TIA integration optional 7/36
soft starters • Plug-in communication modules for PROFINET, PROFIBUS, EtherNet/IP and Modbus
• Removable HMI module with color display, local interface and slot for a micro SD memory
card
7

• Extended protection functions


• Up to 400HP @ 480V
SOFT STARTERS

• SIL 1 - PL c / STO without additional components


• SIL 3 - PL e / STO with additional contactor and safety relay
• Hybrid switching devices for minimum power loss and three-phase motor control for
optimum/symmetrical motor control
• Pump stop for reduced mechanical loading and optimum pump stop control
• ATEX/IECEx certification
General Performance soft starters
3RW52 soft starters • TIA integration optional 7/53
• Plug-in communication modules for PROFINET, PROFIBUS, EtherNet/IP and Modbus
• HMI modules optional
• Soft starting and stopping
• Current limiting
• Motor overload protection (optionally with thermistor motor protection)
• Analog output (optional)
• Up to 400HP @ 480V (600V ratings also available)
• Hybrid switching devices for minimum power loss and three-phase motor control for
optimum/symmetrical motor control
• Soft Torque for reduced mechanical loading and optimum pump stop
• Parameterization using potentiometers

7/2 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

6/2 Siemens IC 10 · 2020


Soft Starters
Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices

Introduction
Introduction

3RW55 3RW55 Failsafe 3RW52 3RW50 3RW40 3RW30


Page
3RW soft starters
Basic Performance soft starters
3RW50 soft starters • TIA integration optional 7/71
• Communication modules for PROFINET, PROFIBUS, EtherNet/IP and Modbus
• HMI modules optional
• Soft starting and stopping
• Current limiting
• Motor overload protection (optionally with thermistor motor protection)
• Analog output (optional)
• Up to 400HP @ 480V (600V ratings also available)

6
• Hybrid switching devices for minimum power loss and two-phase motor control
• Soft Torque for reduced mechanical loading and optimum pump stop
• Parameterization using potentiometers
• ATEX/IECEx certification
3RW40 soft starters • Soft starting and stopping 7/83
• Current limiting
• Motor overload protection (optionally with thermistor motor protection)
• Up to 75HP @ 480V 600V ratings also available)
• Hybrid switching devices for minimum power loss and two-phase motor control
• ATEX certification
3RW30 soft starters • Soft starting with voltage ramp 7/94
• Up to 75HP @ 480V

For enclosed applications

7
Enclosures in • Complete starter includes 3RW40 or 3RW44 and CPT
NEMA 1, 3, 4, & 12 types 7/111
• Performance Range of up to 600 Hp (at 460 V)
UL/CSA listed

SOFT STARTERS
• Combination options include circuit breaker or fusible disconnect
• Application areas:
- Compressors - Lumber processing
- Pumps - Pulp & paper processing
- Stamping presses - Conveyors
- Cooling towers - Textiles
- Molding and extruding - HVAC
- Chippers and debarkers

Use of soft starters in conjunction with IE3/IE4 motors


Note:
For
For the
the use
use of SIRIUS
SIRIUS 3RW soft starters in conjunction
conjunction with
with highly
highly
energy-efficient
energy-efficientIE3/IE4
IE3/IE4motors,
motors,please observe
please observethethe
information
information
on
on dimensioning
dimensioningand
andconfiguring, see
configuring, Application
see ApplicationManual.
Manual.
For more information, see page 1/7.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/3

Siemens IC 10 · 2020
Soft Starters
Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
General data General data

Overview
More information
Homepage,
Homepage, seesee www.usa.siemens.com/soft-starter
www.siemens.com/soft-starter Industry
Industry Online
Online Support (SIOS) topic page,
(SIOS) topic page,see
see
Industry Mall,
Industry Mall, see
see www.siemens.com/product?3RW
www.siemens.com/product?3RW https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109747404
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109747404
TIA Selection
TIA Selection Tool
Tool Cloud
Cloud (TST
(TST Cloud),
Cloud),see
see Simulation Tool
Simulation Tool for
for Soft
SoftStarters
Starters(STS),
(STS), see
seepage
page 6/8
7/7 or
or
https://www.siemens.com/tstcloud/?node=Sirius3rwFolder
https://www.siemens.com/tstcloud/?node=Sirius3rwFolder https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917

SIRIUS 3RW soft starters – as versatile as your application

High 3RW55 (√3)


perormance 7.5 to 1000HP to 1700HP

3-phase controlled
3RW55 Failsafe

TIA integration
(√3)
7.5 to 400HP to 750HP

General 3RW52
performance 7.5 to 400HP

6
(√3)
to 750HP

2-phase controlled
Basic 3RW50
100 to 400HP
performance
3RW40
7.5 to 75HP

3RW30
1.5 to 75HP

Tupical
Pumping Ventilating Compressing Conveying Processing

IC01_00698
applications
7
SOFT STARTERS

7/4 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

Siemens IC 10 · 2020 6/5


Soft Starters
Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW
SIRIUS 3RW SoftSoft Starters
Starters
General
Generaldata
data

Applications High Performance General Basic Performance


Performance
SIRIUS soft starters 3RW55/3RW55-F 3RW52 3RW50 3RW40 3RW30
Selection aid for soft starters
Normal starting (CLASS 10)
Pumps ● ● ● ● ●
Pumps with special pump stop ● ❍ ❍
(to prevent water hammer)
Heat pumps ● ● ● ● ●
Hydraulic pumps ● ● ● ● ❍
Presses ● ● ● ● ❍
Conveyor belts ● ● ● ● ❍
Roller conveyors ● ● ● ● ❍
Screw conveyors ● ● ● ● ❍
6

Escalators ● ● ● ●
Piston compressors ● ● ● ●
Screw compressors ● ● ● ●
Small fans1) ● ● ● ●
Centrifugal blowers ● ● ● ●
Bow thrusters ● ● ● ●

Heavy starting (CLASS 20)


Stirrers ● ❍ ❍ ❍
Extruders ● ❍ ❍ ❍
Lathes ● ❍ ❍ ❍
Milling machines ● ❍ ❍ ❍

Heavy starting (CLASS 30)


Large fans2) ●

7
Circular saws/bandsaws ●
Centrifuges ●

SOFT STARTERS
Mills ●
Crushers ●

● Recommended soft starter 1) The mass inertia of the fan is <10 times the mass inertia of the motor.
2)
❍ Possible soft starter The mass inertia of the fan is 10 times the mass inertia of the motor.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/5

6/6 Siemens IC 10 · 2020


Soft Starters
Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
General data General data

Applications High Performance General Basic Performance


Performance
SIRIUS soft starters 3RW55 3RW55-F 3RW52 3RW50 3RW40 3RW30
General technical specifications
Operational current at 40 °C A 13 ... 2 217 13 ... 987 13 ... 987 143 ... 570 12.5 ... 106 3 ... 106
Operational voltage V 200 ... 6901) 200 ... 480 200 ... 600 200 ... 600 200 ... 600 200 ... 480
Operating power for three-phase motors
• At 400 V, at 40 °C - Inline circuit kW 5.5 ... 710 5.5 ... 315 5.5 ... 315 75 ... 315 5.5 ... 55 1.5 ... 55
- Inside-delta circuit kW 11 ... 1 200 11 ... 560 11 ... 560 -- -- --
• At 460/480 V at 50 °C - Inline circuit hp 7.5 ... 1 000 7.5 ... 400 7.5 ... 400 100 ... 400 7.5 ... 75 1.5 ... 75
- Inside-delta circuit hp 10 ... 1 700 10 ... 750 10 ... 750 -- -- --
Ambient temperature2) °C -25 ... +60 -25 ... +60 -25 ... +60 -25 ... +60 -25 ... +60 -25 ... +60
3)
Soft starting/ramp-down
Voltage ramp
Starting voltage % 20 ... 100 20 ... 100 30 ... 100 30 ... 100 40 ... 100 40 ... 100

6
Ramp-up and ramp-down time s 0 ... 360 0 ... 360 0 ... 20 0 ... 20 0 ... 20 0 ... 203)
Pump stop (torque control)4) -- -- -- --
• Starting torque % 10 ... 100 10 ... 100 -- -- -- --
• Torque limit % 20 ... 200 20 ... 200 -- -- -- --
Soft Torque (torque limit) -- -- -- --
Integral bypass contact system
Intrinsic device protection --
5) 5) 5) 5)
Motor overload protection --
6) 6) 6)
Thermistor motor protection evaluation --
6) 6)
Analog output -- --
Remote RESET --
Adjustable current limiting --
Inside-delta circuit1) -- -- --
Breakaway pulse -- -- -- --
Automatic parameterization
7

-- -- -- --
Pump cleaning -- -- -- --
Condition monitoring
SOFT STARTERS

-- -- -- --
User account administration8) -- -- -- --
Creep speed in both directions of rotation -- -- -- -- --
Reversing duty -- -- -- --
Reversing DC braking4)7) -- -- -- -- --
DC braking4)7) -- -- -- -- --
Dynamic DC braking4)7) -- -- -- -- --
Motor heating -- -- -- -- --
Communication function9) -- --
9) 9)
HMI module installable in the cabinet door -- --
9) 9)
Operating measured value display -- --
9) 9)
Logbooks -- --
9) 9)
Statistical data and slave pointer function -- --
Trace function8) -- -- -- --
Programmable control inputs and outputs -- -- -- --
Number of parameter sets 3 3 1 1 1 1
Parameterizable via software8) -- -- -- --
Number of controlled phases 3 3 3 2 2 2
Heavy starting CLASS 304) -- -- -- --
5) When using the motor
motor overload
overload protection
protection according
according to
to ATEX/IECEx,
ATEX/IECEx,an
an
Function available
-- Function not available upstream contactor may
may be
be required,
required, see
see page
page 6/11.
7/10.
6)
1)
Inside-delta circuit only up to operational voltage 600 V. Special device versions only.
2) 7) Not possible in inside-delta circuit.
Note derating above 40 °C.
3) Only soft starting available for 3RW30. 8)
With software Soft Starter ES (TIA Portal).
4) 9)
Calculate soft starter and motor with size allowance where required. Only in conjunction with special accessories.

7/6 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

Siemens IC 10 · 2020 6/7


Soft Starters
Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
General data
General data
Constraints
105
The 3RW soft starters should always be designed on the basis

NSB0_01704
of the required rated operational current of the motor. 100

Rated operational current e in %


The motor ratings listed in the selection and ordering data are
95
rough guide values and designed for basic starting conditions
(CLASS 10). For other starting conditions we recommend the 90
Simulation Tool for Soft Starters (STS).
85
Motor rating data in kW and hp is based on IEC 60947-4-1.
80
At an installation altitude above 2 000 m, max. permissible
operational voltage is reduced to 480 V. 75
70
0 1 000 2 000 3 000 4 000 5 000
Installation altitude in m

Installation altitude for SIRIUS 3RW soft starters


The selection and ordering data were determined for the following constraints (stand-alone installation without auxiliary fan)
6

Applications High Performance General Basic Performance


Performance
SIRIUS soft starters 3RW55/3RW55-F 3RW52 3RW50 3RW40 3RW30
Constraints
Maximum starting time s 20 10 3
Maximum starting current in % Ie 300
of motor current
Maximum number of starts per hour 1/h 5 20

Simulation Tool for Soft Starters (STS)


The Simulation Tool for Soft Starters (STS) provides a convenient
means of designing soft starters using a simple, quick and
easy-to-use interface.

7
Entering the motor and load data will simulate the application
and prompt suggestions for suitable soft starters.

SOFT STARTERS
Link to the free download of the Simulation Tool for Soft Starters
(STS).
• Simple, quick and user-friendly interface
• Detailed and up-to-date Siemens motor database, including
IE3/IE4 motors.
• Simulation of heavy starting up to CLASS 30
• Update-capable (e.g. motors, load types, functions)
• Fast simulations with minimum input data
• Immediate, graphical curve charts of start operations with limit
values
• Table view of suitable soft starters for the application Everything at a glance: Simulation and results list

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/7


Soft Starters
Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
General data
General data
Circuit concept Configuration
Three-phase controlled SIRIUS 3RW soft starters can be The solid-state 3RW soft starters are designed for normal
operated in two different types of circuit: starting. In case of heavy starting or increased starting
• Inline circuit frequency, a larger unit must be selected. The 3RW52 soft
The controls for isolating and protecting the motor are simply starters may be used in isolated supply networks (IT systems)
connected in series with the soft starter. The motor is up to 600 V AC and the 3RW55 soft starters even up to 690 V.
connected to the soft starter with three leads. For long starting times it is recommended to have a PTC sensor
• Inside-delta circuit or temperature switch in the motor. This also applies for the
The wiring is similar to that of wye-delta starters. The phases ramp-down modes torque control, pump stop and DC braking,
of the soft starter are connected in series with the individual because during the ramp-down time in these modes, an addi-
motor windings. The soft starter then only has to carry the tional current loading applies in contrast to free ramp-down.
phase current, amounting to about 58% of the rated motor No capacitive elements are permitted in the motor feeder
current (conductor current). between the SIRIUS 3RW soft starter and the motor
Comparison of the types of circuit (e.g. no reactive-power compensation equipment). In addition,
neither static systems for reactive-power compensation nor
L1 NSB0_00424
dynamic PFC (Power Factor Correction) must be operated in
L2
parallel during starting and ramp-down of the soft starter.
L3 This is important to prevent faults arising on the compensation
N equipment and/or the soft starter.
PE
All elements of the main circuit (such as fuses and controls)
should be dimensioned for direct-on-line starting, following the
local short-circuit conditions. Fuses and switching devices must

6
be ordered separately. The harmonic component load for start-
ing currents must be taken into consideration for the selection of
motor starter protectors (selection of release). Please observe
the maximum switching frequencies specified in the technical
specifications.
Notes:
When three-phase motors are switched on, voltage drops occur
as a rule on starters of all types (direct-on-line starters, wye-delta
starters, soft starters). The infeed transformer must always be
Inline circuit: Rated current Ie corresponds to the rated motor current In, dimensioned such that the voltage dip when starting the motor
three cables to the motor remains within the permissible tolerance. If the infeed
transformer is dimensioned with only a small margin, it is best for
the control voltage to be supplied from a separate circuit
L1 NSB0_00425
L2
(independently of the main voltage) in order to avoid the
L3
potential switching off of the soft starter.
7

N
For dimensioning soft starters,
dimensioning soft starters, we
we recommend
recommend our
our Simulation
Simulation
PE
Tool for Soft
Soft Starters
Starters (STS),
(STS), see page 6/8 or
page 7/7
our Technical Support:
Technical Support:
SOFT STARTERS

https://support.industry.siemens.com/My/ww/en/requests.
https://support.industry.siemens.com/My/ww/en/requests.
U2 L2 Recommended parameters for the initial commissioning of our
U1 SIRIUS 3RW soft starters are listed in every report of our
T1 T2 Simulation Tool for Soft Starters (STS). In addition, our
V1 High Performance soft starters provide support by means of
L1 V2 their commissioning wizards.

W2 W1 T3 L3

Inside-delta circuit: Rated current Ie corresponds to approx. 58% of the


rated motor current In, six cables to the motor (as for wye-delta starters)
Which circuit?
Using the inline circuit involves the lowest wiring outlay. If the soft
starter to motor connections are long, this circuit is preferable.
The wiring complexity is twice as high when using the inside-
delta circuit, but a smaller device can be used with the same
rating. Thanks to the choice of operating mode between the
inline circuit and inside-delta circuit, it is always possible to
select the most favorable solution.
The braking function is possible only in the inline circuit.
The inside-delta circuit cannot be used in 690 V line supplies.

7/8 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Soft Starters
Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
General data
General data
Motor feeders with soft starters There are operating states of the thyristors (caused, for example,
by high starting frequencies or heavy starting) that do not permit
The type of coordination according to which the motor feeder an overload to be disconnected by the SIRIUS 3RW soft starter.
with soft starter is mounted depends on the application-specific These cases are very rare but can not be ruled out in all cases.
requirements. Normally, fuseless mounting (combination of
motor starter protector and soft starter) is sufficient. In accordance with IEC 60947-4-2, the SIRIUS 3RW soft starters
are dimensioned and checked for operation with up to 8 times
If type of coordination "2" is to be fulfilled, then semiconductor the rated operational current Ie. For currents larger than this,
fuses must be fitted in the motor feeder. reliable disconnection of an overcurrent by the SIRIUS 3RW soft
Type of coordination "1" according to IEC 60947-4-1: starter is not ensured. Such large overcurrents have to be
ToC
1
After a short-circuit incident, the unit is defective and disconnected by a switching device at a higher level
therefore unsuitable for further use (protection of (e.g. by a circuit breaker or a fuse in conjunction with an optional
persons and system guaranteed). line contactor).
Motor protection by the SIRIUS 3RW soft starter is ensured for
ToC Type of coordination "2" according to IEC 60947-4-1: currents up to 8 times the rated operational current Ie in any
2
After a short-circuit incident the unit is suitable for case. Line protection is covered by the line-side motor starter
further use (protection of persons and system protector/circuit breaker or fuse. These motor feeder compo-
guaranteed). nents must be dimensioned accordingly and the cable cross-
sections must be chosen to match.
The type of coordination refers to soft starters in
combination with the stipulated protective device Line protection
(motor starter protector/fuse), not to any additional Line protection in motor feeders with soft starters is always
components in the feeder. covered by a fuse or a circuit breaker both in case of an overload
and in case of a short circuit. The circuit breaker must have an
6

The types of coordination are indicated in the overload release. That is the case for motor starter protectors
corresponding tables by the symbols shown on (e.g. SIRIUS 3RV20).
orange backgrounds.
Circuit breakers without an overload release (e.g. SIRIUS 3RV23
Feeder tests and events motor starter protectors) must not be used because they do not
provide overload protection. The feeder tests for these were
To keep the scope of feeder tests with SIRIUS 3RW soft starters therefore not performed. If the motor feeder with SIRIUS 3RW
within economically reasonable limits, tests were conducted with soft starters is configured without a fuse, motor starter protectors
feeder components (motor starter protectors/circuit breakers, must be used that ensure tripping on an overload.
fuses) that cover the greatest number of use cases (different soft
starter versions depending on, for example, line voltage, type of Motor protection
circuit, or necessary overdimensioning). For the combined tests If fuses are used to provide
provide protection
protection against
against overload
overload and
that were conducted, the values for the short-circuit breaking short circuit
circuit of
of the
the cables,
cables, the the motor
motorisisprotected
protectedby bythe
the
capacity Iq in kA were determined and documented. SIRIUS 3RW
3RW soft
softstarter.
starter.IfIfthe
theconstraints
constraints(simple
(simplestarting
starting
If the short-circuit breaking capacity is the same, of course, conditions CLASS
CLASS 10, 10, listed
listed maximum
maximumvalues values for
forstarting
starting
smaller circuit breakers or fuses can also be used for the current, starting
starting time
timeand
andnumber
numberofofstarts
startsper perhour)
hour)ofofpage
page6/8
7/7)
selected soft starter provided the dimensioning of the short- are observed,
observed, thethemotor
motorfeeders
feederscan canbe beconfigured
configuredaccording
accordingtoto

7
circuit components is suitable for the connected three-phase IEC as described in the section about soft soft starters
starters (an
(an optional
optional
motor and the line protection for the cables used. For type of line contactor
contactor isisnot
notrequired).
required).IfIfthese
thesepreconditions
preconditionsare aremet, thethe
met,
coordination "2" (with semiconductor protection), it is also SIRIUS 3RW
3RW soft
softstarters
startersareareable
abletototrip
tripononoverloads
overloadstoto protect
protect

SOFT STARTERS
necessary to compare the characteristics because the the motor
motor in
in any
any case.
case.
protection function would no longer be completely ensured if too In other starting conditions and on heavy starting, the following
small a fuse were selected. If the soft starter does not have a must be considered:
motor protection function, the motor protection must also be
dimensioned appropriately. Trip classes
Setting the motor current Tested fuseless switchgear assemblies comprising SIRIUS 3RW
soft starters and motor starter protectors only comply with
If circuit breakers with an overload release are used (e.g. SIRIUS CLASS 10.
3RV20 motor starter protector), we recommend activating the To configure tested motor feeders, for example, for CLASS 20 or
motor protection function of the SIRIUS 3RW soft starter to CLASS 30, fuses must be used together with SIRIUS 3RW soft
protect the motor and setting the soft starter to the rated opera- starters.
tional current Ie of the motor. We recommend setting the circuit
breaker in such a way that it provides line protection but does not Line contactor
usually trip before the soft starter when a motor overload occurs. In applications with high starting frequencies or heavy starting
Line protection and motor protection as of CLASS 20, we recommend combining fuses with the use of
a line contactor on the line side so that a motor overload is
Line protection and motor protection are not ensured in all disconnected by the fault signaling contact of the soft starter in
operating cases, depending on: any case (that is, even in rare cases in which disconnection by
• How the motor feeder is constructed (e.g. with fuses or motor the SIRIUS 3RW soft starter is no longer possible due to the
starter protectors) operating state of the thyristors).
• Whether the SIRIUS 3RW soft starters are operated within the
specification relevant for the tests (IEC 60947-4-2)
• documented constraints
• Or whether the documented constraints (see
(seepage
page7/7)
6/8)have
have
been observed.
observed

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/9


Soft Starters
Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
General data
General data
ATEX/IECEx-certified motor overload protection Line contactor or additional undervoltage release on the motor
starter protector
Ambient temperature during operation
In many ATEX/IECEx applications no additional measures
The SIRIUS 3RW soft starters are approved for operation in a (e.g. the use of a line contactor) are necessary with regard to the
temperature range of -25 to +60 °C. motor feeder configuration.
Please take into account derating of the rated operational The operation of the selected soft starter may, depending on the
current for ambient temperatures above 40 °C. amplitude of the line voltage and the type of motor connection
For more information, see Equipment Manual
Manual and
and the
the technical
technical (inline circuit or inside-delta circuit), result in the loss of the
data sheet of
of the
the selected
selectedsoft
softstarter.
starter. certified motor overload protection according to ATEX/IECEx if
one of the two remedial measures listed below is not
Trip class (electronic overload protection) implemented.
The motor and cables must be dimensioned for the selected trip Remedial measures
class.
• An additional line contactor in the main circuit
The rated data of the soft starters refers to normal starting • An additional undervoltage release for a motor feeder
(CLASS 10). For heavy starting (> CLASS 10), the soft starter configuration with a motor starter protector
may need to be overdimensioned as only a rated motor current
that is lower than the soft starter rated current can be set. The line contactor or the undervoltage release are connected to
error outputs 95, 96 and 98 of the selected soft starter
Short-circuit protection
Note:
The SIRIUS 3RW soft starter does not have short-circuit
protection. Short-circuit protection must be ensured. For ATEX/IECEx applications,
applications, the accompanying information on
accompanying information on
parameterization and commissioning
parameterization and commissioningmust
mustbe
beobserved
observedininthethe
Line protection

6
ATEX/IECEx chapters of the Equipment Manual
Manual for
for the
theselected
selected
Avoid impermissibly high cable surface temperatures by soft starter.
correctly dimensioning the cross-sections.
The cable cross-section must be adequately dimensioned.

Article No. scheme


Product versions Article number
Device type High Performance soft starters 3RW55 @ @ – @ @ @ @ @
General Performance soft starters 3RW52 @ @ – @ @ @ @ @
Basic Performance soft starters 3RW50 @ @ – @ @ @ @ @
3RW40 @ @ – @ @ @ @ @
3RW30 @ @ – @ @ @ @ @
Size/rated operational current Ie e.g. 15 = 25 A in size S1 @@
Connection type e.g. 1 = screw terminal @
7

Soft starter functionality e.g. AC = with bypass and analog output, @@


three-phase controlled
Rated control supply voltage Us e.g. 0 = 24 V AC/DC @
SOFT STARTERS

Rated operational voltage Ue e.g. 4 = 200 ... 480 V AC @


Example 3RW52 1 5 – 1 A C 0 4
Note:
The Article No. scheme shows an overview of product versions For your orders please use the article numbers quoted in the
for better understanding of the logic behind the article numbers. selection and ordering data.

7/10 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Soft Starters
Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW
SIRIUS 3RW SoftSoft Starters
Starters
General
Generaldata
data

■ Benefits
Can be flexibly deployed in many applications
Strong portfolio: Intelligent operation:
comprehensive, coordinated soft starter portfolio concentrated, application-specific functionality
6

• The right hardware for all requirements, • Can be used in a wide variety of applications:
soft starters for tasks ranging from simple to demanding starting in Basic, Pumping, ventilating, compressing, moving and processing
General and High Performance versions
• Integrated, self-learning automatic parameterization depending on motor
• Extensive portfolio for individual expansion: starting conditions
Optional HMIs for installation in the device or mounting on the control
cabinet door • Application-specific functionality such as pump cleaning and pump stop

• Communication via PROFINET, PROFIBUS, EtherNet/IP and Modbus • Condition monitoring:


Current and power monitoring with warning and alarm limits, starting time
• Design enclosure with removable terminals, space-saving thanks to monitoring
compact design and rugged thanks to coated printed circuit boards

• Can be used worldwide thanks to numerous certificates and approvals:


IEC, UL, CSA, CCC, ATEX/IECEx, shipbuilding

Efficient switching: Ready for a digital future:

7
hybrid switching technology on board data available whenever and wherever needed

SOFT STARTERS

• Energy-efficient switching and mechanical protection of the drive train • Support from tools and data during engineering
thanks to soft starters with hybrid switching technology
• Simulation Tool for Soft Starters for support during product selection
• Low-wear switching extends the service life of the devices
• Very simple, standardized commissioning and configuration via
• Soft starting prevents current peaks, thereby increasing the network Soft Starter ES in TIA Portal
stability
• Integration in the automation system via communication interfaces
• Protection against disturbances in the application.
Mechanical protection for the drive train • Data availability and analysis:
large volumes of data at any time and anywhere, even into MindSphere

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/11

6/12 Siemens IC 10 · 2020


Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters High Performance Soft Starters
3RW55 soft starters > General data 3RW55 soft starters > General data

Overview
More information
Homepage, see
Homepage, see www.usa.siemens.com/soft-starter
www.siemens.com/soft-starter Industry
Industry Online Support (SIOS)
(SIOS) topic
topicpage,
page,see
see
Industry
Industry Mall,
Mall, see
see www.siemens.com/product?3RW
www.siemens.com/product?3RW https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109747404
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109747404
TIA
TIA Selection
Selection Tool
Tool Cloud
Cloud (TST
(TST Cloud),
Cloud),see
see Simulation Tool
Simulation Tool for
for Soft
Soft Starters
Starters (STS),
(STS), see
see page
page 6/8
7/7 or
or
https://www.siemens.com/tstcloud/?node=Sirius3rwFolder
https://www.siemens.com/tstcloud/?node=3rw55 https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
SIRIUS Soft
SIRIUS Soft Starter
Starter ES
ES (TIA
(TIA Portal),
Portal), see page 14/2

Equipped with the utmost functionality, the SIRIUS 3RW55 High


Performance soft starters confidently handle even difficult
starting and stopping operations. Thanks to innovative torque
control, the device can be used for drives with an output of
between 7.5 to 1000HP @ 480V.
The functions have been specially designed to offer maximum
user friendliness. The HMI (with color display, local interface and
a slot for micro SD memory card) and plug-in communication
modules (PROFINET, PROFIBUS, EtherNet/IP and Modbus)
ensure maximum flexibility. With their modern hybrid switching
technology, the SIRIUS 3RW55 soft starters offer efficient
switching for long-term, energy-saving use.

6
5

6 1

7
7
SOFT STARTERS

IC01_00582a

4
2

1 3RW55 soft starter

2 Communication modules
6 HMI push-in lugs for wall mounting
3 Hinged cover
7 HMI IP65 door mounting kit
4 Fan covers
8 HMI soft starter connection cable
5 Terminal covers

3RW55 High Performance starters with accessories,


Performance soft starters accessories (see page7/35.
see page 6/35)

7/12 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

Siemens IC 10 · 2020 6/13


Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance
High Performance Soft Starters
Soft Starters
3RW55
3RW55soft
softstarters
starters>>General
Generaldata
data

■ Benefits
6

Product characteristics / function Performance features / benefits

Automatic parameterization Extremely easy commissioning and reliability even under changing load
conditions

Hybrid switching devices and three-phase motor control Minimum power loss and optimum/symmetrical motor control

7
Integration into TIA Portal – communication modules optional Efficient configuration and maximum flexibility in automation engineering

SOFT STARTERS
Removable HMI with color display, local interface, slot for micro SD memory Maximum flexibility with regard to user interface and intuitive menu guidance
card

Pump stop and torque control Reduced mechanical loading and optimum pump stop control

Certified according to ATEX/IECEx directive Suitable for the starting of explosion-proof motors

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/13

6/14 Siemens IC 10 · 2020


Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters High Performance Soft Starters
3RW55 soft starters > General data 3RW55 soft starters > General data

■ Technical specifications
More information
Technical specifications,
Technical specifications,see
see FAQs,
FAQs, see
see https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/25099/faq
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/25099/faq
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/25099/td
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/25099/td Simulation Tool
Simulation Tool for
for Soft
Soft Starters
Starters (STS),
(STS), see
see page
page 6/8
7/7 or
or
Equipment
Equipment Manual
Manual “SIRIUS
"SIRIUS 3RW55
3RW55 Soft Starter",
Starter”, see
see https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109753752
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109753752

Type 3RW551.-.HA.4 3RW552.-.HA.6 3RW552.-.HA.4 3RW554.-.HA.4 3RW554.-.HA.6 3RW555.-.HA.4 3RW555.-.HA.6


3RW551.-.HA.5 3RW553.-.HA.6 3RW553.-.HA.4
Installation/fixing/
dimensions
Width x height x depth mm 170 × 275 × 152 185 × 306 × 203 210 × 393 × 203 478 x 764 x 241
H

Type of mounting Screw fixing


Mounting position Vertical (can be rotated +/- 90° and tilted +/- 22.5° forward or backward)
Distance to be
maintained with

6
side-by-side mounting
• Above mm 100
• At the side mm 5
• Below mm 75
Maximum installation m 5 000 2 000 5 000 2 000 5 000 2 000
altitude above sea level1)
Degree of protection IP00
Ambient conditions
Ambient temperature
• During operation2) °C -25 ... +60
• During storage and °C -40 ... +80
transport
Environmental category
according to IEC 60721
• During operation 3K6 (no ice formation, no condensation), 3C3 (no salt mist),
3S2 (sand must not get into the devices), 3M6
7

• During storage 1K6 (only occasional condensation), 1C2 (no salt mist),
1S2 (sand must not enter the devices), 1M4
SOFT STARTERS

• During transport 2K2, 2C1, 2S1, 2M2 (max. height of fall 0.3 m)
1)
Derating from 1 000
000 m,
m, see
seecharacteristic
characteristiccurve
curveon
onpage
page6/8.
7/7.
2) Note derating above 40 °C.

7/14 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

Siemens IC 10 · 2020 6/15


Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance
High Performance Soft Starters
Soft Starters
3RW55
3RW55soft
softstarters
starters>>General
Generaldata
data

Type 3RW55..-.HA0. 3RW55..-.HA1.


Control circuit/control
Control supply voltage
• At AC/DC, rated value V 24/24 --/--
• At AC V -- 110 ... 250
• Relative negative tolerance/relative positive tolerance with AC % -20/20 -15/10
• Relative negative tolerance/relative positive tolerance with DC % -20/20 --/--
Frequency of the control supply voltage Hz 50 ... 60
• Relative negative tolerance/relative positive tolerance % -10/10
Type of overvoltage protection Varistors
Type of short-circuit protection for control circuit1) Fuse 4 A gG (Icu = 1 kA), fuse 6 A quick-response (Icu = 1 kA),
MCB C1 (Icu = 600 A), MCB C6 (Icu = 300 A)
1) Not included in scope of supply

Type 3RW55..-.HA.4 3RW55..-.HA.5 3RW55..-.HA.6


Power electronics
Operational voltage, rated value V 200 ... 480 200 ... 600 200 ... 690
• Relative negative tolerance/relative positive tolerance % -15/10
Operational voltage for inside-delta circuit, rated value V 200 ... 480 200 ... 600
• Relative negative tolerance/relative positive tolerance % -15/10
6

Operating frequency, rated value Hz 50 ... 60


• Relative negative tolerance/relative positive tolerance % -10/10
Minimum load [% of IM]1) % 10
Maximum cable length between soft starter and motor m 800
1) Relative to set Ie.

7
SOFT STARTERS

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/15

6/16 Siemens IC 10 · 2020


Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters High Performance Soft Starters
3RW55 soft starters > General data 3RW55 soft starters > General data

Type 3RW5513 3RW5514 10


3RW5515 3RW5516 3RW5517
Rated operational current Ie A 13 18 25 32 38
Power electronics
Load rating with rated operational current Ie
IEC + UL/CSA, individual mounting at 40/50/60 °C, A 13/11.5/10.5 18/15.9/13.8 25/22.3/19.6 32/28.4/26 38/33.5/30.5
AC-53a
Permissible rated motor current and starts/h
Normal starting (CLASS 10A)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 13/11.5/10.5 18/15.9/13.8 25/22.3/19.6 32/28.4/26 38/33.5/30.5
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 43 43 43 43 43
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 18 18 18 18 18
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 28 28 28 28 28
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 10 10 10 10 10
Normal starting (CLASS 10E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 13/11.5/10.5 18/15.9/13.8 25/22.3/19.6 32/28.4/26 38/33.5/30.5
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 21 21 21 21 21
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 8 8 8 8 8

6
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 13 13 13 13 13
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 4 4 4 4 4
Heavy starting (CLASS 20E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 13/11.5/10.5 18/15.9/13.8 25/22.3/19.6 29.6/27.2/23.6 33.5/30.5/27.5
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 10 10 10 10 10
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 4 4 4 4 4
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5
Heavy starting (CLASS 30E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 13/11.5/10.5 18/15.9/13.8 25/22.3/19.6 26/23.6/21.2 29/26/23
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 3 3 3 3 3
7

• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 4 4 4 4 4
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 1.8 1.8 1.8 1.8 1.8
SOFT STARTERS

Adjustable rated motor current IM


• Minimum/maximum A 2.5/13 3.5/18 5/25 6.5/32 7.5/38
• Minimum/maximum in inside-delta circuits A 4.3/22.5 6.1/31.1 8.7/43.3 11.3/55.4 13/65.8

7/16 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

Siemens IC 10 · 2020 6/17


Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance
High Performance Soft Starters
Soft Starters
3RW55
3RW55soft
softstarters
starters>>General
Generaldata
data

Type 3RW5521 3RW5524 3RW5525 3RW5526 3RW5527


Rated operational current Ie A 25 47 63 77 93
Power electronics
Load rating with rated operational current Ie
IEC + UL/CSA, individual mounting at 40/50/60 °C, A 25/22.3/19.6 47/41.6/36.2 63/55.5/50.5 77/68/62 93/82.5/75.5
AC-53a
Permissible rated motor current and starts/h
Normal starting (CLASS 10A)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 25/22.3/19.6 47/41.6/36.2 63/55.5/50.5 77/68/62 93/82.5/75.5
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 43 43 43 43 43
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 18 18 18 18 18
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 28 28 28 28 28
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 10 10 10 10 10
Normal starting (CLASS 10E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 25/22.3/19.6 47/41.6/36.2 63/55.5/50.5 77/68/62 93/82.5/75.5
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 21 21 21 21 21
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 8 8 8 8 8
6

• 350% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 13 13 13 13 13
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 4 4 4 4 4
Heavy starting (CLASS 20E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 25/22.3/19.6 47/41.6/36.2 63/55.5/50.5 77/68/62 93/82.5/75.5
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 10 10 10 10 10
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 4 4 4 4 4
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5
Heavy starting (CLASS 30E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 25/22.3/19.6 43.4/38/34.4 53/48/43 68/62/56 82.5/75.5/65
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 3 3 3 3 3

7
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 4 4 4 4 4
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 1.8 1.8 1.8 1.8 1.8

SOFT STARTERS
Adjustable rated motor current IM
• Minimum/maximum A 5/25 10/47 13/63 16/77 19/93
• Minimum/maximum in inside-delta circuits A 8.7/43.3 17.3/81.4 22.5/109 27.7/133 32.9/161

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/17

6/18 Siemens IC 10 · 2020


Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters High Performance Soft Starters
3RW55 soft starters > General data 3RW55 soft starters > General data

Type 10
3RW5534 3RW5535 3RW5536
Rated operational current Ie A 113 143 171
Power electronics
Load rating with rated operational current Ie
IEC + UL/CSA, individual mounting at 40/50/60 °C, A 113/101/89 143/128/118 171/153/141
AC-53a
Permissible rated motor current and starts/h
Normal starting (CLASS 10A)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 113/101/89 143/128/118 171/153/141
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 43 43 43
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 18 18 18
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 28 28 28
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 10 10 10
Normal starting (CLASS 10E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 113/101/89 143/128/118 171/153/141
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 21 21 21
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 8 8 8

6
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 13 13 13
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 4 4 4
Heavy starting (CLASS 20E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 109/97/85 128/113/103 141/129/117
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 10 10 10
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 4 4 4
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 2.5 2.5 2.5
Heavy starting (CLASS 30E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 89/81/74 108/98/88 117/105/93
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 3 3 3
7

• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 4 4 4
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 1.8 1.8 1.8
SOFT STARTERS

Adjustable rated motor current IM


• Minimum/maximum A 23/113 29/143 34/171
• Minimum/maximum in inside-delta circuits A 39.8/195 50.2/247 58.9/296

7/18 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

Siemens IC 10 · 2020 6/19


Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance
High Performance Soft Starters
Soft Starters
3RW55
3RW55soft
softstarters
starters>>General
Generaldata
data

Type 3RW5543 3RW5544 3RW5545 3RW5546 3RW5547 10


3RW5548
Rated operational current Ie A 210 250 315 370 470 570
Power electronics
Load rating with rated operational current Ie
IEC + UL/CSA, individual mounting at A 210/186/170 250/220/200 315/279/255 370/328/300 470/416/380 570/504/460
40/50/60 °C, AC-53a
Permissible rated motor current and starts/h
Normal starting (CLASS 10A)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 210/186/170 250/220/200 315/279/255 370/328/300 470/416/380 570/504/460
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 43 43 43 43 40 20
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 18 18 18 18 17 6
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 28 28 28 28 26 9
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 10 10 10 10 10 1
Normal starting (CLASS 10E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 210/186/170 250/220/200 315/279/255 370/328/300 470/416/380 551/490/445
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 21 21 21 21 17 8
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 8 8 8 8 6 1
6

• 350% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 13 13 13 13 10 2
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 4 4 4 4 2 --
Heavy starting (CLASS 20E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 162/146/130 200/180/160 231/207/183 258/230/202 272/254/236 284/262/240
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 10 10 10 10 10 10
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 4 4 4 4 4 4
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5
Heavy starting (CLASS 30E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 138/122/106 160/140/120 183/159/135 202/174/160 210/190/170 220/200/180
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 3 3 3 3 3 3

7
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 4 4 4 4 4 4
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 1.8 1.8 1.8 1.8 1.8 1.8

SOFT STARTERS
Adjustable rated motor current IM
• Minimum/maximum A 42/210 50/250 63/315 74/370 94/470 114/570
• Minimum/maximum in inside-delta circuits A 72.7/363 86.6/433 109.1/545 128.2/640 162.8/814 197.5/987

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/19

6/20 Siemens IC 10 · 2020


Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters High Performance Soft Starters
3RW55 soft starters > General data 3RW55 soft starters > General data

Type 3RW5552 3RW5553 3RW5554 3RW5556 3RW5558


Rated operational current Ie A 630 720 840 1 100 1 280
Power electronics
Load rating with rated operational current Ie
IEC + UL/CSA, individual mounting at 40/50/60 °C, A 630/561/510 720/641/580 840/748/670 1 100/979/890 1 280/1 139/1 030
AC-53a
Permissible rated motor current and starts/h
Normal starting (CLASS 10A)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 630/561/510 720/641/580 840/748/670 1 100/979/890 1 280/1 139/1 030
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 43 43 42 43 32
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 18 18 18 18 12
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 28 28 25 27 17
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 10 10 10 9 4
Normal starting (CLASS 10E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 630/561/510 720/641/580 840/748/670 1 100/979/890 1 225/1 130/1 030
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 21 21 19 18 15
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 8 8 7 7 5

6
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 13 13 10 9 1
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 4 4 2 2 1
Heavy starting (CLASS 20E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 500/450/400 520/470/420 570/520/470 920/840/760 980/900/810
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 10 10 10 10 10
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 4 4 4 4 4
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5
Heavy starting (CLASS 30E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 380/340/300 400/360/320 420/380/340 740/670/600 790/720/650
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 3 3 3 3 3
7

• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 4 4 4 4 4
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 1.8 1.8 1.8 1.8 1.8
SOFT STARTERS

Adjustable rated motor current IM


• Minimum/maximum A 114/630 144/720 168/840 220/1 100 258/1 280
• Minimum/maximum in inside-delta circuits A 197.5/987 249.4/1 247 291/1 454 381.1/1 905 446.9/2 217

7/20 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

Siemens IC 10 · 2020 6/21


Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters
3RW55 soft starters > General data
3RW55 soft starters > General data
Motor feeders according to IEC with 3RV2/3VA motor starter protectors/circuit breakers (without semiconductor protection)
Type of coordination "1", CLASS 10,
short-circuit breaking capacity Iq in kA, see table
Note:
generalrecommendations
For general recommendationsforforconstructing
constructing motor
motor feeders
feeders
with soft
soft starters,
starters, see
seepage
page7/9.
6/10.

Q1 Q1

Q11 Q11
NSB0_01902

IC01_00544
M M
3~ 3~

Soft starters Motor starter protectors Motor starter protectors


for 400 V systems for 500 V systems for 400 V systems for 500 V systems
Q11 Q1 Iq Q1 Iq Q1 Iq Q1 Iq
Type Type kA Type kA Type kA Type kA
Type of Inline circuit Inside-delta circuit
6

ToC
coordina- 1
tion "1"
3RW5513 3RV2032-4TA10 65 3RV2032-4TA10 18 3RV2032-4DA10 65 3RV2032-4DA10 18
3RW5514 3RV2032-4DA10 65 3RV2032-4DA10 15 3RV2032-4EA10 65 3RV2032-4EA10 15
3RW5515 3RV2032-4EA10 65 3RV2032-4EA10 15 3RV2032-4VA10 65 3RV2032-4VA10 15
3RW5516 3RV2032-4VA10 65 3RV2032-4VA10 10 3RV2032-4JA10 65 3RV2032-4JA10 10
3RW5517 3RV2032-4WA10 65 3RV2032-4WA10 10 3RV2032-4RA10 65 3RV2032-4RA10 10
3RW5521 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- --
3RW5524 3RV2032-4JA10 65 3RV2032-4JA10 10 3RV2032-4RA10 65 3RV2032-4RA10 10
3RW5525 3VA2163-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2163-7MN32-0AA0 20 3VA2110-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2110-7MN32-0AA0 20
3RW5526 3VA2110-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2110-7MN32-0AA0 20 3VA2216-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2216-7MN32-0AA0 20
3RW5527 3VA2216-7MN32-0AA0 15 3VA2216-7MN32-0AA0 10 3VA2220-7MN32-0AA0 15 3VA2220-7MN32-0AA0 10
3RW5534 3VA2216-7MN32-0AA0 65 -- -- 3VA2220-7MN32-0AA0 65 -- --
3RW5535 3VA2220-7MN32-0AA0 65 -- -- 3VA2325-7MN32-0AA0 65 -- --
3RW5536 3VA2325-7MN32-0AA0 30 3VA2325-7MN32-0AA0 10 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 30 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 10
3RW5543 3VA2325-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2325-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65
3RW5544 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2450-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2450-7MN32-0AA0 65
3RW5545 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65

7
3RW5546 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65
3RW5547 3VA2450-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2450-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2510-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2510-6HN32-0AA0 65
3RW5548 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2510-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2510-6HN32-0AA0 65

SOFT STARTERS
3RW5552 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2716-7AB05-0AA0 65 3VA2716-7AB05-0AA0 65
3RW5553 3VA2510-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2510-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2716-7AB05-0AA0 65 3VA2716-7AB05-0AA0 65
3RW5554 3VA2510-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2510-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2716-7AB05-0AA0 65 3VA2716-7AB05-0AA0 65
3RW5556 3VA2716-7AB05-0AA0 65 3VA2716-7AB05-0AA0 65 -- -- -- --
3RW5558 3VA2716-7AB05-0AA0 65 3VA2716-7AB05-0AA0 65 -- -- -- --

Note:
The service factor or measurement inaccuracies have been
taken into account, for example, for the selection of the specified
motor starter protectors/circuit breakers; the specified short-
circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are covered by combination
tests. Smaller motor starter protectors/circuit breakers than
those specified can be used at any time as smaller ones trip
more quickly in the event of a short circuit (unchanged short-
circuit breaking capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any
case. The dimensioning of the short-circuit components must,
however, be suitable for the connected three-phase motor and
the line protection for the cables used.
In 690 V systems, in motor feeder tests with soft starters demon-
strable short-circuit breaking capacities can only be achieved
with the use of fuses (Iq > 5 to 10 kA).

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/21


Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters High Performance Soft Starters
3RW55 soft starters > General data
3RW55 soft starters > General data
Motor feeders according to IEC with 3NA3 fuses
gG class full-range fuses for cable and line protection according
to IEC 60269-2, without semiconductor protection
Type of coordination "1",
short-circuit breaking capacity Iq = 65 kA
Note:
For general
generalrecommendations
recommendationsforforconstructing
constructing motor
motor feeders
feeders
with soft starters,
starters, see
see page
page7/9.
6/10.

F1 F1 F1

Q21 Q21 Q21

Q11 Q11 Q11

IC01_00545a
NSB0_01904

IC01_00565
M M M
3~ 3~ 3~

Soft starters gG class fuse Line contactor (optional) gG class fuse Line contactor (optional)
for systems for systems for systems for systems for systems for systems for systems for systems
up to 690 V up to 480 V up to 690 V up to 600 V up to 480 V up to 600 V up to 480 V up to 600 V

6
in the supply in the supply in the delta in the delta
cable cable
Q11 F1 Q21 Q21 F1 Q21 Q21 Q21 Q21
Type Type Type Type Type Type Type Type Type
Type of ToC Inline circuit Inside-delta circuit
coordina- 1
tion "1"
3RW5513 3NA3820-6 3RT2025 3RT2025 3NA3820-6 3RT2027 3RT2035 3RT2025 3RT2025
3RW5514 3NA3820-6 3RT2026 3RT2027 3NA3820-6 3RT2027 3RT2037 3RT2026 3RT2027
3RW5515 3NA3822-6 3RT2027 3RT2037 3NA3822-6 3RT2036 3RT2037 3RT2027 3RT2037
3RW5516 3NA3824-6 3RT2035 3RT2037 3NA3824-6 3RT2037 3RT2038 3RT2035 3RT2037
3RW5517 3NA3824-6 3RT2035 3RT2037 3NA3824-6 3RT2038 3RT2046 3RT2035 3RT2037
3RW5521 3NA3824-6 3RT2027 3RT2037 3NA3824-6 3RT2036 3RT2037 3RT2027 3RT2037
3RW5524 3NA3824-6 3RT2036 3RT2037 3NA3824-6 3RT2046 3RT2047 3RT2036 3RT2037
3RW5525 3NA3830-6 3RT2037 3RT2046 3NA3830-6 3RT2047 3RT1054 3RT2037 3RT2046
3RW5526 3NA3132-6 3RT2038 3RT2046 3NA3132-6 3RT1055 3RT1055 3RT2038 3RT2046
3RW5527 3NA3136-6 3RT2046 3RT2047 3NA3136-6 3RT1056 3RT1056 3RT2046 3RT2047
7

3RW5534 3NA3244-6 3RT1054 3RT1054 3NA3244-6 3RT1064 3RT1064 3RT1054 3RT1054


3RW5535 3NA3244-6 3RT1055 3RT1055 3NA3244-6 3RT1065 3RT1065 3RT1055 3RT1055
3RW5536 3NA3365-6 3RT1056 3RT1064 3NA3365-6 3RT1066 3RT1075 3RT1056 3RT1064
SOFT STARTERS

3RW5543 2 x 3NA3354-6 3RT1064 3RT1064 2 x 3NA3354-6 3RT1075 3RT1075 3RT1064 3RT1064


3RW5544 2 x 3NA3354-6 3RT1065 3RT1065 2 x 3NA3354-6 3RT1076 3RT1076 3RT1065 3RT1065
3RW5545 2 x 3NA3365-6 3RT1075 3RT1075 2 x 3NA3365-6 3TF68 3TF68 3RT1075 3RT1075
3RW5546 2 x 3NA3365-6 3RT1075 3RT1075 2 x 3NA3365-6 3TF69 3TF69 3RT1075 3RT1075
3RW5547 2 x 3NA3365-6 3RT1076 3RT1276 2 x 3NA3365-6 3TF69 3TF69 3RT1076 3RT1276
3RW5548 2 x 3NA3365-6 3TF68 3TF68 2 x 3NA3365-6 -- -- 3TF68 3TF68
3RW5552 2 x 3NA3365-6 3TF68 3TF69 -- -- -- 3TF68 3TF69
3RW5553 2 x 3NA3365-6 3TF69 3TF69 -- -- -- 3TF69 3TF69
3RW5554 2 x 3NA3365-6 -- -- -- -- -- -- --
3RW5556 3 x 3NA3365-6 -- -- -- -- -- -- --
3RW5558 3 x 3NA3365-6 -- -- -- -- -- -- --

Note:
The specified short-circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are
covered by combination tests. Smaller fuses than those speci-
fied can be used at any time as smaller ones trip more quickly in
the event of a short circuit (unchanged short-circuit breaking
capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any case. The
dimensioning of the short-circuit components must, however, be
suitable for the connected three-phase motor and the line
protection for the cables used.
In inside-delta circuits, motor feeders with soft starters can only
be operated in systems with up to 600 V.

7/22 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters
3RW55 soft starters > General data
3RW55 soft starters > General data
Motor feeders according to IEC with 3NE1/3NB3 SITOR fuses
gR class full-range fuses for semiconductor protection, cable
and line protection
Type of coordination "2",
short-circuit breaking capacity Iq = 65 kA
Note:
For general
generalrecommendations
recommendationsforforconstructing
constructing motor
motor feeders
feeders
with soft starters,
starters, see
see page
page7/9.
6/10.

F’1

Q21

Q11
NSB0_01905

M
3~

Soft starters gG class fuse Line contactor (optional)


for systems for systems for systems
6

up to 690 V up to 480 V up to 690 V


Q11 F’1 Q21 Q21
Type Type Type Type
Type of ToC Inline circuit
coordina- 2
tion "2"
3RW5513 3NE1815-0 3RT2025 3RT2025
3RW5514 3NE1802-0 3RT2026 3RT2027
3RW5515 3NE1817-0 3RT2027 3RT2037
3RW5516 3NE1818-0 3RT2035 3RT2037
3RW5517 3NE1820-0 3RT2035 3RT2037
3RW5521 3NE1817-0 3RT2027 3RT2037
3RW5524 3NE1021-2 3RT2036 3RT2037
3RW5525 3NE1022-0 3RT2037 3RT2046
3RW5526 3NE1224-0 3RT2038 3RT2046
3RW5527 3NE1224-0 3RT2046 3RT2047
3RW5534 3NE1225-0 3RT1054 3RT1054
3RW5535 3NE1227-0 3RT1055 3RT1055

7
3RW5536 3NE1230-0 3RT1056 3RT1064
3RW5543 3NE1230-21) 3RT1064 3RT1064

SOFT STARTERS
3RW5544 3NE1331-0 3RT1065 3RT1065
3RW5545 3NE1334-2 3RT1075 3RT1075
3RW5546 3NE1334-2 3RT1075 3RT1075
3RW5547 3NE1436-2 3RT1076 3RT1276
3RW5548 3NE1437-2 3TF68 3TF68
3RW5552 3NB3350-1KK26 3TF68 3TF69
3RW5553 3NB3351-1KK26 3TF69 3TF69
3RW5554 3NB3351-1KK26 -- --
3RW5556 3NB3354-1KK26 -- --
3RW5558 3NB3357-1KK26 -- --
1)
For systems up to 500 V.
Note:
The specified short-circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are
covered by combination tests. Smaller fuses than those speci-
fied can be used at any time as smaller ones trip more quickly in
the event of a short circuit (unchanged short-circuit breaking
capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any case. The
dimensioning of the short-circuit components must, however, be
suitable for the connected three-phase motor and the line
protection for the cables used.
In inside-delta
inside-delta circuits,
circuits, aa gR
gRclass
classfull-range
full-rangefuse
fusecould
couldnotnot
provide the semiconductor
semiconductor protection
protection ofof the
the delta-connected
delta-connected
soft starter with a short-circuit breaking capacitythat
breaking capacity thatisisade-
ade-
quate for practical
practical use.
use. InIn this
this case,
case,wewerecommend
recommendusing using
aR class partial-range
partial-range fuses
fusesforforsemiconductor
semiconductorprotection
protectionfor
for
type of coordination "2" (see
coordination “2” (see page
page 6/25).
7/24).

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/23


Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters High Performance Soft Starters
3RW55 soft starters > General data
3RW55 soft starters > General data
Motor feeders according to IEC with 3NE8 / 3NE3 / 3NC3 fuses
aR class partial-range fuses for semiconductor protection
Type of coordination "2",
short-circuit breaking capacity Iq = 65 kA
Note:
For general
generalrecommendations
recommendationsforforconstructing
constructing motor
motor feeders
feeders
with soft starters,
starters, see
see page
page7/9.
6/10.

F1 F1 F1

Q21 Q21 Q21


F3 F3 F3

Q11 Q11 Q11


NSB0_01906

IC01_00546a

IC01_00566
M M M
3~ 3~ 3~

Soft starters gG class fuse aR class fuse Line contactor gG class fuse aR class fuse Line contactor (optional)
(optional)

6
for systems for systems for sys- for sys- for systems for systems for systems for systems for sys- for sys-
up to 690 V up to 690 V tems tems up to 600 V up to 600 V up to 480 V up to 600 V tems tems
up to up to in the sup- in the sup- up to up to
480 V 690 V ply cable ply cable 480 V 600 V
in the delta in the delta
Q11 F1 F3 Q21 Q21 F1 F3 Q21 Q21 Q21 Q21
Type Type Type Type Type Type Type Type Type Type Type
Type of ToC Inline circuit Inside-delta circuit
coordina- 2
tion "2"
3RW5513 3NA3820-6 3NE8017-1 3RT2025 3RT2025 3NA3820-6 3NE8017-1 3RT2027 3RT2035 3RT2025 3RT2025
3RW5514 3NA3820-6 3NE8020-1 3RT2026 3RT2027 3NA3820-6 3NE8020-1 3RT2027 3RT2037 3RT2026 3RT2027
3RW5515 3NA3822-6 3NE8021-1 3RT2027 3RT2037 3NA3822-6 3NE8021-1 3RT2036 3RT2037 3RT2027 3RT2037
3RW5516 3NA3824-6 3NE8022-1 3RT2035 3RT2037 3NA3824-6 3NE8022-1 3RT2037 3RT2038 3RT2035 3RT2037
3RW5517 3NA3824-6 3NE8024-1 3RT2035 3RT2037 3NA3824-6 3NE8024-1 3RT2038 3RT2046 3RT2035 3RT2037
3RW5521 3NA3824-6 3NE8021-1 3RT2027 3RT2037 3NA3824-6 3NE8021-1 3RT2036 3RT2037 3RT2027 3RT2037
3RW5524 3NA3824-6 3NE8024-1 3RT2036 3RT2037 3NA3824-6 3NE8024-1 3RT2046 3RT2047 3RT2036 3RT2037
3RW5525 3NA3830-6 3NE3227 3RT2037 3RT2046 3NA3830-6 3NE3227 3RT2047 3RT1054 3RT2037 3RT2046
3RW5526 3NA3132-6 3NE3227 3RT2038 3RT2046 3NA3132-6 3NE3227 3RT1055 3RT1055 3RT2038 3RT2046
7

3RW5527 3NA3136-6 3NE3227 3RT2046 3RT2047 3NA3136-6 3NE3227 3RT1056 3RT1056 3RT2046 3RT2047
3RW5534 3NA3244-6 3NE3231 3RT1054 3RT1054 3NA3244-6 3NE3231 3RT1064 3RT1064 3RT1054 3RT1054
SOFT STARTERS

3RW5535 3NA3244-6 3NE3233 3RT1055 3RT1055 3NA3244-6 3NE3233 3RT1065 3RT1065 3RT1055 3RT1055
3RW5536 3NA3365-6 3NE3334-0B 3RT1056 3RT1064 3NA3365-6 3NE3334-0B 3RT1066 3RT1075 3RT1056 3RT1064
3RW5543 2 x 3NA3354-6 3NE3333 3RT1064 3RT1064 2 x 3NA3354-6 3NE3333 3RT1075 3RT1075 3RT1064 3RT1064
3RW5544 2 x 3NA3354-6 3NE3335 3RT1065 3RT1065 2 x 3NA3354-6 3NE3335 3RT1076 3RT1076 3RT1065 3RT1065
3RW5545 2 x 3NA3365-6 -- 3RT1075 3RT1075 2 x 3NA3365-6 -- 3TF68 3TF68 3RT1075 3RT1075
3RW5546 2 x 3NA3365-6 -- 3RT1075 3RT1075 2 x 3NA3365-6 -- 3TF69 3TF69 3RT1075 3RT1075
3RW5547 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NE3340-8 3RT1076 3RT1276 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NE3340-8 3TF69 3TF69 3RT1076 3RT1276
3RW5548 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NC3342-1U 3TF68 3TF68 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NC3342-1U -- -- 3TF68 3TF68
3RW5552 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NC3343-1U 3TF68 3TF69 -- 3NC3343-1U -- -- 3TF68 3TF69
3RW5553 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NC3343-1U 3TF69 3TF69 -- 3NC3343-1U -- -- 3TF69 3TF69
3RW5554 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NC3343-1U -- -- -- 3NC3343-1U -- -- -- --
3RW5556 3 x 3NA3365-6 3 x 3NE3340-8 -- -- -- 3 x 3NE3340-8 -- -- -- --
3RW5558 3 x 3NA3365-6 3 x 3NE3340-8 -- -- -- 3 x 3NE3340-8 -- -- -- --

Note:
The specified short-circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are For CLASS 10 applications,
applications, asas an
an alternative
alternativeto the gG
to the gGclass
class
covered by combination tests. Smaller fuses than those speci- full-range fuses
fuses for
for cable
cable and
andline
lineprotection
protection3NA3
3NA3(F1),
(F1),
fied can be used at any time as smaller ones trip more quickly in 3RV2/3VA
3RV2/3VA motor
motor starter
starter protectors/circuit
protectors/circuit breakers
breakers can also bebe
the event of a short circuit (unchanged short-circuit breaking used, possibly with reduced
possibly with reduced short-circuit
short-circuitbreaking
breakingcapacity
capacity
capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any case. The (see page 7/21).
6/22). In these cases, optional line contactors can be
dimensioning of the short-circuit components must, however, be dispensed with.
dispensed with.
suitable for the connected three-phase motor and the line
protection for the cables used. In inside-delta circuits, motor feeders with soft starters can only
be operated in systems with up to 600 V.

7/24 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters
3RW55 soft starters > General data
3RW55 soft starters > General data
Reversing operation with reversing contactors
Note:
For general
generalrecommendations
recommendationsforforconstructing
constructing motor
motor feeders
feeders
with soft starters,
starters, see
see page
page7/9.
6/10.
(For an example circuit, see
3RW55 Equipment Manual, Appendix A.3)
Soft starters Reversing contactor assembly For reversing contactor
for systems up to 480 V for systems up to 690 V for systems up to 480 V for systems up to 690 V
Q11 Q21 / Q22 Q21 / Q22 Q21 / Q22 Q21 / Q22
Type Type Type Type Type
3RW5513 3RA2325 3RA2325 3RT2025 3RT2025
3RW5514 3RA2326 3RA2327 3RT2026 3RT2027
3RW5515 3RA2327 3RA2337 3RT2027 3RT2037
3RW5516 3RA2335 3RA2337 3RT2035 3RT2037
3RW5517 3RA2335 3RA2337 3RT2035 3RT2037
3RW5521 3RA2327 3RA2337 3RT2027 3RT2037
3RW5524 3RA2336 3RA2337 3RT2036 3RT2037
3RW5525 3RA2337 3RA2346 3RT2037 3RT2046
3RW5526 3RA2338 3RA2346 3RT2038 3RT2046
3RW5527 3RA2346 3RA2347 3RT2046 3RT2047
3RW5534 -- -- 3RT1054 3RT1054
3RW5535 -- -- 3RT1055 3RT1055
3RW5536 -- -- 3RT1056 3RT1064
6

3RW5543 -- -- 3RT1064 3RT1064


3RW5544 -- -- 3RT1065 3RT1065
3RW5545 -- -- 3RT1075 3RT1075
3RW5546 -- -- 3RT1075 3RT1075
3RW5547 -- -- 3RT1076 3RT1276
3RW5548 -- -- 3TF68 3TF68
3RW5552 -- -- 3TF68 3TF69
3RW5553 -- -- 3TF69 3TF69
3RW5554 -- -- -- --
3RW5556 -- -- -- --
3RW5558 -- -- -- --

DC braking with braking contactors


Note:
For general
generalrecommendations
recommendationsforforconstructing
constructing motor
motor feeders
feeders
with soft starters,
starters, see
see page
page7/9.
6/10.
(For an example circuit, see

7
3RW55 Equipment Manual, Appendix A.3)
Soft starters DC braking contactor DC braking contactor assembly

SOFT STARTERS
for systems up to 400 V for systems up to 480 V for systems up to 690 V
with 2 NC contacts + with 3 NO contacts with 3 NO contacts with 3 NO contacts with 3 NO contacts
2 NO contacts parallel parallel parallel parallel parallel
Q11 Q93 Q91 Q92 Q91 Q92
Type Type Type Type Type Type
3RW5513 3RT2517 3RT2015 3RT2016 3RT2015 3RT2016
3RW5514 3RT2518 3RT2015 3RT2017 3RT2015 3RT2023
3RW5515 3RT2526 3RT2015 3RT2025 3RT2015 3RT2025
3RW5516 3RT2526 3RT2015 3RT2025 3RT2015 3RT2027
3RW5517 3RT2535 3RT2015 3RT2027 3RT2015 3RT2027
3RW5521 3RT2526 3RT2015 3RT2025 3RT2015 3RT2025
3RW5524 3RT2535 3RT2016 3RT2027 3RT2016 3RT2035
3RW5525 -- 3RT2024 3RT2027 3RT2024 3RT2037
3RW5526 -- 3RT2025 3RT2035 3RT2025 3RT2037
3RW5527 -- 3RT2027 3RT2036 3RT2027 3RT2037
3RW5534 -- 3RT2035 3RT2037 3RT2035 3RT2038
3RW5535 -- 3RT2036 3RT2038 3RT2036 3RT2046
3RW5536 -- 3RT2037 3RT2046 3RT2037 3RT2047
3RW5543 -- 3RT2045 3RT2047 3RT2045 3RT1054
3RW5544 -- 3RT2045 3RT1055 3RT2045 3RT1055
3RW5545 -- 3RT2446 3RT1056 3RT2446 3RT1056
3RW5546 -- 3RT1055 3RT1056 3RT1055 3RT1064
3RW5547 -- 3RT1456 3RT1065 3RT1456 3RT1065
3RW5548 -- 3RT1456 3RT1066 3RT1456 3RT1075
3RW5552 -- 3RT1065 3RT1075 3RT1065 3RT1075
3RW5553 -- 3RT1065 3RT1075 3RT1065 3RT1075
3RW5554 -- 3RT1466 3RT1076 3RT1466 3RT1076
3RW5556 -- 3RT1476 3TF68 3RT1476 3TF68
3RW5558 -- 3RT1476 3TF69 3RT1476 3TF69

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/25


Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters High Performance Soft Starters
3RW55 soft starters > Inline circuit IE3/IE4 ready 3RW55 soft starters > Inline circuit

■ Selection and ordering data


For normal starting (CLASS 10E)

3RW551. 3RW552.

At 40 °C At 50 °C SD1) Article No. Price PU PS*


Opera- Operating power for three- Opera- Rating [hp] for three-phase motors per PU (UNIT,
tional phase motors tional SET, M)
current At At At At current At At At At
230 V 400 V 500 V 690 V 200/208 V 220/230 V 460/480 V 575/600 V
A kW kW kW kW A hp hp hp hp d
Operational voltage 200 ... 480 V

6
13 3 5.5 -- -- 11.5 2 3 7.5 -- 5 3RW5513-@HA@4 1 1 unit
18 4 7.5 -- -- 15.9 3 5 10 -- 5 3RW5514-@HA@4 1 1 unit
25 5.5 11 -- -- 22.3 5 7.5 15 -- 5 3RW5515-@HA@4 1 1 unit
32 7.5 15 -- -- 28.4 7.5 10 20 -- 5 3RW5516-@HA@4 1 1 unit
38 11 18.5 -- -- 33.5 10 10 20 -- 5 3RW5517-@HA@4 1 1 unit
47 11 22 -- -- 41.6 10 10 30 -- 5 3RW5524-@HA@4 1 1 unit
63 18.5 30 -- -- 55.5 15 20 40 -- 5 3RW5525-@HA@4 1 1 unit
77 22 37 -- -- 68 20 25 50 -- 5 3RW5526-@HA@4 1 1 unit
93 22 45 -- -- 82.5 25 30 60 -- 5 3RW5527-@HA@4 1 1 unit

Type of electrical connection for the control circuit


Screw terminals 1
Spring-loaded terminals 3

Control supply voltage


24 V AC/DC 0
110 ... 250 V AC 1
7

1) 3RW55 soft starter with screw terminals for operational voltage up to 480 V:
Standard delivery time SD = 1 day (d).
SOFT STARTERS

Note:
For the constraints
constraints for
forthe
themotor
motoroutputs
outputsspecified
specifiedhere,
here, see
page 6/8. 7/7.
see page

7/26 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2020 6/27
Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters
3RW55 soft starters > Inline circuit IE3/IE4 ready
3RW55 soft starters > Inline circuit
For normal starting (CLASS 10E)

3RW553. 3RW554. 3RW555.


At 40 °C At 50 °C SD1) Article No. Price PU PS*
Opera- Operating power for Opera- Rating [hp] for three-phase motors per PU (UNIT,
tional three-phase motors tional SET, M)
current At At At At current At At At At
230 V 400 V 500 V 690 V 200/208 V 220/230 V 460/480 V 575/600 V
A kW kW kW kW A hp hp hp hp d
Operational voltage 200 ... 480 V
113 30 55 -- -- 101 30 30 75 -- 5 3RW5534-@HA@4 1 1 unit
6

143 37 75 -- -- 128 40 40 100 -- 5 3RW5535-@HA@4 1 1 unit


171 45 90 -- -- 153 50 50 100 -- 5 3RW5536-@HA@4 1 1 unit
210 55 110 -- -- 186 50 60 150 -- 5 3RW5543-@HA@4 1 1 unit
250 75 132 -- -- 220 60 75 150 -- 5 3RW5544-@HA@4 1 1 unit
315 90 160 -- -- 279 75 100 200 -- 5 3RW5545-@HA@4 1 1 unit
370 110 200 -- -- 328 100 125 250 -- 5 3RW5546-@HA@4 1 1 unit
470 132 250 -- -- 416 150 150 350 -- 5 3RW5547-@HA@4 1 1 unit
570 160 315 -- -- 504 150 200 400 -- 5 3RW5548-@HA@4 1 1 unit
630 200 355 -- -- 561 200 200 450 -- 15 3RW5552-@HA@4 1 1 unit
720 200 400 -- -- 641 200 250 500 -- 15 3RW5553-@HA@4 1 1 unit
840 250 450 -- -- 748 250 300 600 -- 15 3RW5554-@HA@4 1 1 unit
1 100 315 560 -- -- 979 350 400 850 -- 15 3RW5556-@HA@4 1 1 unit
1 280 400 710 -- -- 1 139 400 450 1 000 -- 15 3RW5558-@HA@4 1 1 unit

Type of electrical connection for the control circuit


Spring-loaded terminals 2
Screw terminals 6

7
Control supply voltage

SOFT STARTERS
24 V AC/DC 0
110 ... 250 V AC 1
1)
3RW55 soft starter with screw terminals for operational voltage up to 480 V:
Standard delivery time SD = 1 day (d).
Note:
For the constraints
constraints for
forthe
themotor
motoroutputs
outputsspecified
specifiedhere,
here, see
page 6/8. 7/7.
see page

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/27

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters High Performance Soft Starters
3RW55 soft starters > Inline circuit IE3/IE4 ready
3RW55 soft starters > Inline circuit
For normal starting (CLASS 10E)

3RW551. 3RW552.

At 40 °C At 50 °C SD1) Article No. Price PU PS*


Opera- Operating power for three- Opera- Rating [hp] for three-phase motors per PU (UNIT,
tional phase motors tional SET, M)
current At At At At current At At At At
230 V 400 V 500 V 690 V 200/208 V 220/230 V 460/480 V 575/600 V
A kW kW kW kW A hp hp hp hp d
Operational voltage 200 ... 600 V
13 3 5.5 7.5 -- 11.5 2 3 7.5 10 5 3RW5513-@HA@5 1 1 unit
18 4 7.5 11 -- 15.9 3 5 10 10 5 3RW5514-@HA@5 1 1 unit

6
25 5.5 11 15 -- 22.3 5 7.5 15 20 5 3RW5515-@HA@5 1 1 unit
32 7.5 15 18.5 -- 28.4 7.5 10 20 25 5 3RW5516-@HA@5 1 1 unit
38 11 18.5 22 -- 33.5 10 10 20 30 5 3RW5517-@HA@5 1 1 unit
Operational voltage 200 ... 690 V
25 5.5 11 15 22 22.3 5 7.5 15 20 5 3RW5521-@HA@6 1 1 unit
47 11 22 30 45 41.6 10 10 30 40 5 3RW5524-@HA@6 1 1 unit
63 18.5 30 37 55 55.5 15 20 40 50 5 3RW5525-@HA@6 1 1 unit
77 22 37 45 75 68 20 25 50 60 5 3RW5526-@HA@6 1 1 unit
93 22 45 55 90 82.5 25 30 60 75 5 3RW5527-@HA@6 1 1 unit

Type of electrical connection for the control circuit


Screw terminals 1
Spring-loaded terminals 3

Control supply voltage


24 V AC/DC 0
110 ... 250 V AC 1
7

1)
3RW55 soft starter with screw terminals for operational voltage up to 690 V:
Standard delivery time SD = 2 days (d).
SOFT STARTERS

Note:
For the constraints
constraints for
forthe
themotor
motoroutputs
outputsspecified
specifiedhere,
here, see
page 6/8. 7/7.
see page

7/28 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters
3RW55 soft starters > Inline circuit IE3/IE4 ready
3RW55 soft starters > Inline circuit
For normal starting (CLASS 10E)

3RW553. 3RW554. 3RW555.

At 40 °C At 50 °C SD1) Article No. Price PU PS*


Opera- Operating power for Opera- Rating [hp] for three-phase motors per PU (UNIT,
tional three-phase motors tional SET, M)
current At At At At current At At At At
230 V 400 V 500 V 690 V 200/208 V 220/230 V 460/480 V 575/600 V
A kW kW kW kW A hp hp hp hp d
Operational voltage 200 ... 690 V
113 30 55 75 110 101 30 30 75 100 5 3RW5534-@HA@6 1 1 unit
6

143 37 75 90 132 128 40 40 100 125 5 3RW5535-@HA@6 1 1 unit


171 45 90 110 160 153 50 50 100 150 5 3RW5536-@HA@6 1 1 unit
210 55 110 132 200 186 60 60 150 150 5 3RW5543-@HA@6 1 1 unit
250 75 132 160 250 220 60 75 150 200 5 3RW5544-@HA@6 1 1 unit
315 90 160 200 315 279 75 100 200 250 5 3RW5545-@HA@6 1 1 unit
370 110 200 250 355 328 100 125 250 300 5 3RW5546-@HA@6 1 1 unit
470 132 250 315 400 416 150 150 350 450 5 3RW5547-@HA@6 1 1 unit
570 160 315 355 560 504 150 200 400 500 5 3RW5548-@HA@6 1 1 unit
630 200 355 400 630 561 200 200 450 600 15 3RW5552-@HA@6 1 1 unit
720 200 400 500 710 641 200 250 500 700 15 3RW5553-@HA@6 1 1 unit
840 250 450 560 800 748 250 300 600 800 15 3RW5554-@HA@6 1 1 unit
1 100 215 560 710 1 000 979 350 400 850 1 100 15 3RW5556-@HA@6 1 1 unit
1 280 400 710 900 1 200 1 139 400 450 1 000 1 250 15 3RW5558-@HA@6 1 1 unit

Type of electrical connection for the control circuit


Spring-loaded terminals 2
Screw terminals 6

7
Control supply voltage

SOFT STARTERS
24 V AC/DC 0
110 ... 250 V AC 1
1)
3RW55 soft starter with screw terminals for operational voltage up to 690 V:
- Sizes 3 and 4: Standard delivery time SD = 2 days (d).
- Size 5: Standard delivery time SD = 5 days (d).
Note:
For the constraints
constraintsfor
forthe
themotor
motoroutputs
outputsspecified
specified here, see
here,
page 6/8. 7/7.
see page

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/29

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters High Performance Soft Starters
3RW55 soft starters > Inside-delta circuit IE3/IE4 ready 3RW55 soft starters > Inside-delta circuit

■ Selection and ordering data


For normal starting (CLASS 10E)

3RW551. 3RW552.

At 40 °C for inside-delta circuit At 50 °C for inside-delta circuit SD1) Article No. Price PU PS*
Opera- Operating power for Opera- Rating [hp] for three-phase motors per PU (UNIT,
tional three-phase motors tional SET, M)
current At At At current At At At At
230 V 400 V 500 V 200/208 V 220/230 V 460/480 V 575/600 V
A kW kW kW A hp hp hp hp d
Operational voltage 200 ... 480 V

6
22.5 5.5 11 -- 19.9 5 5 10 -- 5 3RW5513-@HA@4 1 1 unit
31.5 7.5 15 -- 28 7.5 7.5 20 -- 5 3RW5514-@HA@4 1 1 unit
43.3 11 18.5 -- 39 10 10 25 -- 5 3RW5515-@HA@4 1 1 unit
55.4 15 22 -- 49 15 15 30 -- 5 3RW5516-@HA@4 1 1 unit
65.8 18.5 30 -- 58 15 20 40 -- 5 3RW5517-@HA@4 1 1 unit
81.4 22 45 -- 72 20 25 50 -- 5 3RW5524-@HA@4 1 1 unit
109 30 55 -- 96 30 30 75 -- 5 3RW5525-@HA@4 1 1 unit
133 37 75 -- 118 30 40 75 -- 5 3RW5526-@HA@4 1 1 unit
161 45 90 -- 143 40 50 100 -- 5 3RW5527-@HA@4 1 1 unit

Type of electrical connection for the control circuit


Screw terminals 1
Spring-loaded terminals 3

Control supply voltage


24 V AC/DC 0
110 ... 250 V AC 1
7

1)
3RW55 soft starter with screw terminals for operational voltage up to 480 V:
Standard delivery time SD = 1 day (d).
SOFT STARTERS

Note:
For the constraints
constraints for
forthe
themotor
motoroutputs
outputsspecified
specifiedhere,
here, see
page 6/8. 7/7.
see page

7/30 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2020 6/31
Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters
3RW55 soft starters > Inside-delta circuit IE3/IE4 ready
3RW55 soft starters > Inside-delta circuit
For normal starting (CLASS 10E)

3RW553. 3RW554. 3RW555.

At 40 °C for inside-delta circuit At 50 °C for inside-delta circuit SD1) Article No. Price PU PS*
Opera- Operating power for three- Opera- Rating [hp] for three-phase motors per PU (UNIT,
tional phase motors tional SET, M)
current At At At current At At At At
230 V 400 V 500 V 200/208 V 220/230 V 460/480 V 575/600 V
A kW kW kW A hp hp hp hp d
Operational voltage 200 ... 480 V
196 55 110 -- 175 50 60 125 -- 5 3RW5534-@HA@4 1 1 unit
6

248 75 132 -- 222 75 75 150 -- 5 3RW5535-@HA@4 1 1 unit


296 90 160 -- 265 75 100 200 -- 5 3RW5536-@HA@4 1 1 unit
364 110 200 -- 322 100 125 250 -- 5 3RW5543-@HA@4 1 1 unit
433 132 250 -- 381 125 150 300 -- 5 3RW5544-@HA@4 1 1 unit
546 160 315 -- 483 150 200 400 -- 5 3RW5545-@HA@4 1 1 unit
641 200 355 -- 568 200 200 450 -- 5 3RW5546-@HA@4 1 1 unit
814 250 400 -- 721 250 250 600 -- 5 3RW5547-@HA@4 1 1 unit
987 315 560 -- 873 300 350 750 -- 5 3RW5548-@HA@4 1 1 unit
1 091 355 630 -- 972 350 400 850 -- 15 3RW5552-@HA@4 1 1 unit
1 247 400 710 -- 1 110 400 450 950 -- 15 3RW5553-@HA@4 1 1 unit
1 454 450 800 -- 1 295 450 550 1 150 -- 15 3RW5554-@HA@4 1 1 unit
1 905 560 1 000 -- 1 695 600 700 1 500 -- 15 3RW5556-@HA@4 1 1 unit
2 217 710 1 200 -- 1 973 700 850 1 700 -- 15 3RW5558-@HA@4 1 1 unit

Type of electrical connection for the control circuit


Spring-loaded terminals 2
Screw terminals 6

7
Control supply voltage

SOFT STARTERS
24 V AC/DC 0
110 ... 250 V AC 1
1)
3RW55 soft starter with screw terminals for operational voltage up to 480 V:
Standard delivery time SD = 1 day (d).
Note:
For the constraints
constraintsfor
forthe
themotor
motoroutputs
outputsspecified
specified here, see
here,
page 6/8. 7/7.
see page

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/31

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters High Performance Soft Starters
3RW55 soft starters > Inside-delta circuit IE3/IE4 ready
3RW55 soft starters > Inside-delta circuit
For normal starting (CLASS 10E)

3RW551. 3RW552.

At 40 °C for inside-delta circuit At 50 °C for inside-delta circuit SD1) Article No. Price PU PS*
Opera- Operating power for Opera- Rating [hp] for three-phase motors per PU (UNIT,
tional three-phase motors tional SET, M)
current At At At current At At At At
230 V 400 V 500 V 200/208 V 220/230 V 460/480 V 575/600 V
A kW kW kW A hp hp hp hp d
Operational voltage 200 ... 600 V
22.5 5.5 11 15 19.9 5 5 10 15 5 3RW5513-@HA@5 1 1 unit
31.5 7.5 15 18.5 28 7.5 7.5 20 25 5 3RW5514-@HA@5 1 1 unit

6
43.3 11 18.5 22 39 10 10 25 30 5 3RW5515-@HA@5 1 1 unit
55.4 15 22 30 49 15 15 30 40 5 3RW5516-@HA@5 1 1 unit
65.8 18.5 30 37 58 15 20 40 50 5 3RW5517-@HA@5 1 1 unit
43.3 11 18.5 22 39 10 10 25 30 5 3RW5521-@HA@6 1 1 unit
81.4 22 45 45 72 20 25 50 60 5 3RW5524-@HA@6 1 1 unit
109 30 55 55 96 30 30 75 75 5 3RW5525-@HA@6 1 1 unit
133 37 75 90 118 30 40 75 100 5 3RW5526-@HA@6 1 1 unit
161 45 90 110 143 40 50 100 125 5 3RW5527-@HA@6 1 1 unit

Type of electrical connection for the control circuit


Screw terminals 1
Spring-loaded terminals 3

Control supply voltage


24 V AC/DC 0
110 ... 250 V AC 1
1)
7

3RW55 soft starter with screw terminals for operational voltage up to 600 V:
Standard delivery time SD = 2 days (d).
Note:
SOFT STARTERS

For the constraints


constraints for
forthe
themotor
motoroutputs
outputsspecified
specifiedhere,
here, see
page 6/8. 7/7.
see page

7/32 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters
3RW55 soft starters > Inside-delta circuit IE3/IE4 ready
3RW55 soft starters > Inside-delta circuit
For normal starting (CLASS 10E)

3RW553. 3RW554. 3RW555.

At 40 °C for inside-delta circuit At 50 °C for inside-delta circuit SD1) Article No. Price PU PS*
Opera- Operating power for Opera- Rating [hp] for three-phase motors per PU (UNIT,
tional three-phase motors tional SET, M)
current At At At current At At At At
230 V 400 V 500 V 200/208 V 220/230 V 460/480 V 575/600 V
A kW kW kW A hp hp hp hp d
Operational voltage 200 ... 600 V
196 55 110 132 175 50 60 125 150 5 3RW5534-@HA@6 1 1 unit
6

248 75 132 160 222 75 75 150 200 5 3RW5535-@HA@6 1 1 unit


296 90 160 200 265 75 100 200 250 5 3RW5536-@HA@6 1 1 unit
364 110 200 250 322 100 125 250 300 5 3RW5543-@HA@6 1 1 unit
433 132 250 315 381 125 150 300 350 5 3RW5544-@HA@6 1 1 unit
546 160 315 355 483 150 200 400 500 5 3RW5545-@HA@6 1 1 unit
641 200 355 450 568 200 200 450 600 5 3RW5546-@HA@6 1 1 unit
814 250 400 500 721 250 250 600 800 5 3RW5547-@HA@6 1 1 unit
987 315 560 630 873 300 350 750 950 5 3RW5548-@HA@6 1 1 unit
1 091 355 630 710 972 350 400 850 1 050 15 3RW5552-@HA@6 1 1 unit
1 247 400 710 800 1 110 400 450 950 1 250 15 3RW5553-@HA@6 1 1 unit
1 454 450 800 900 1 295 450 550 1 150 1 450 15 3RW5554-@HA@6 1 1 unit
1 905 560 1 000 1 200 1 695 600 700 1 500 1 900 15 3RW5556-@HA@6 1 1 unit
2 217 710 1 200 1 500 1 973 700 850 1 700 2 200 15 3RW5558-@HA@6 1 1 unit

Type of electrical connection for the control circuit


Spring-loaded terminals 2
Screw terminals 6

7
Control supply voltage

SOFT STARTERS
24 V AC/DC 0
110 ... 250 V AC 1
1)
3RW55 soft starter with screw terminals for operational voltage up to 600 V:
- Sizes 3 and 4: Standard delivery time SD = 2 days (d).
- Size 5: Standard delivery time SD = 5 days (d).
Note:
For
For the constraints for
the constraints forthe
themotor
motoroutputs
outputsspecified
specifiedhere,
here, see
page 6/8. 7/7.
see page

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/33

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters High Performance Soft Starters
3RW55 soft starters > Accessories 3RW55 soft starters > Accessories

Selection and ordering data


Product Manufacturer's Type of Application SD Article No. Price PU PS*
designation Article No. of the product per PU (UNIT,
soft starter SET, M)
d
Fan covers
Fan cover 3RW551 (1x), -- -- } 3RW5983-0FC00 1 1 unit
3RW552 (2x),
3RW553 (2x)
3RW554 (1x) -- -- } 3RW5984-0FC00 1 1 unit
3RW5983-0FC00 3RW555 (3x) -- -- } 3RW5985-0FC00 1 1 unit
Terminal covers
Terminal cover 3RW552 (2x), -- -- } 3RW5983-0TC20 1 1 unit
3RW553 (2x)

3RW5983-0TC20
3RW554 (2x) -- -- } 3RW5984-0TC20 1 1 unit

6
3RW5984-0TC20

Enclosure components
Hinged cover 3RW55 Without cutout -- } 3RW5950-0GL20 1 1 unit

3RW5950-0GL20
Communication modules
7

Communica- 3RW55 PROFINET -- } 3RW5950-0CH00 1 1 unit


tion module High Feature
with integral
SOFT STARTERS

switch
PROFINET -- } 3RW5980-0CS00 1 1 unit
Standard
PROFIBUS -- } 3RW5980-0CP00 1 1 unit

3RW5980-0CS00
EtherNet/IP -- } 3RW5980-0CE00 1 1 unit

3RW5980-0CE00
Modbus RTU -- } 3RW5980-0CR00 1 1 unit
Modbus TCP -- } 3RW5980-0CT00 1 1 unit

3RW5980-0CR00

7/34 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2020 6/35
Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance
High Performance Soft Starters
Soft Starters
3RW55 soft starters > Accessories
3RW55 soft starters > Accessories

Product Manufacturer's Type of Application SD Article No. Price PU PS*


designation Article No. of the product per PU (UNIT,
soft starter SET, M)
d
HMI modules
IP65 door 3RW55 IP65 For HMI } 3RW5980-0HD00 1 1 unit
mounting kit modules
for HMI
modules

3RW5980-0HD00
Connecting cables
HMI connec- 3RW55 5 m, round For door } 3RW5980-0HC60 1 1 unit
tion cable 2.5 m, round mounting } 3UF7933-0BA00-0 1 1 unit
1.0 m, round } 3UF7937-0BA00-0 1 1 unit
0.5 m, round } 3UF7932-0BA00-0 1 1 unit
6

3UF793.-0BA00-0
Further accessories
Push-in lugs -- Two lugs are For HMI 2 3ZY1311-0AA00 1 10 units
for wall mount- required per modules and
ing device communica-
tion modules

3ZY1311-0AA00
Blank labels
Unit labeling 20 mm x For SIRIUS 20 3RT2900-1SB20 100 340 units
plates1) 7 mm, devices
titanium gray
IC01_00181

7
3RT2900-1SB20

SOFT STARTERS
3RW55 starter kit
SIRIUS 3RW55 -- Including 5 3RW5951-1ES04 1 1 unit
starter kit 3RW55 soft starter 13 A,
200 ... 480 V, 24 V AC/DC
Soft Starter ES V15.1,
24 V power supply unit,
connecting cable and
RJ45 network cable

3RW5951-1ES04
1)
PC labeling systems for individual inscription of unit labeling plates are
available from: murrplastik Systemtechnik GmbH (see page 16/15).

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/35

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Siemens IC 10 · 2020
Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters High Performance Soft Starters
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters > General data NEW NEU
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters > General data

Overview
More information
Homepage, see
Homepage, see www.usa.siemens.com/soft-starter
www.siemens.com/soft-starter Simulation
Simulation Tool
Tool for
for Soft
Soft Starters
Starters (STS),
(STS), see
see page
page 6/8
7/7 or
or
Industry
Industry Mall,
Mall, see
see www.siemens.com/product?3RW
www.siemens.com/product?3RW https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
Industry
Industry Online
Online Support
Support (SIOS)
(SIOS)topic
topicpage,
page,see
see SIRIUS Soft
SIRIUS Soft Starter
Starter ES
ES (TIA
(TIA Portal),
Portal), see page 14/2
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109747404
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109747404

Equipped with the utmost functionality, the SIRIUS 3RW55


Failsafe High Performance soft starters confidently handle even
difficult starting and stopping operations. Thanks to innovative
torque control, the device can be used for drives with an output
of between 7.5 to 400HP @ 480V.
The innovative 3RW55 Failsafe soft starter features an integrated
fail-safe digital input for directly connecting the EMERGENCY
STOP, and thus covers SIL 1 STO applications. The HMI (with
color display, local interface and a slot for micro SD memory
card) and plug-in communication modules (PROFINET,
PROFIBUS, EtherNet/IP and Modbus) ensure maximum
flexibility. With their modern hybrid switching technology, the
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters offer efficient switching for
long-term, energy-saving use.

6
5

1
6

7
7
SOFT STARTERS

IC01_00690

4
2

1 3RW55 Failsafe soft starter

2 Communication modules
6 HMI push-in lugs for wall mounting
3 Hinged cover
7 HMI IP65 door mounting kit
4 Fan covers
8 HMI soft starter connection cable
5 Terminal covers

3RW55 Failsafe
3RW55 High Performance
Failsafe High Performancesoft
softstarters
starterswith
withaccessories,
accessories see
(seepage
page7/51.
6/52)

7/36 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

Siemens IC 10 · 2020 6/37


Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance
High Performance Soft Starters
Soft Starters
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters > General data
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters > General data NEW NEU

■ Benefits
6

Product characteristics / function Performance features / benefits

Automatic parameterization Extremely easy commissioning and reliability even under changing load
conditions

Hybrid switching devices and three-phase motor control Minimum power loss and optimum/symmetrical motor control

7
Integration into TIA Portal – communication modules optional Efficient configuration and maximum flexibility in automation engineering

SOFT STARTERS
Removable HMI with color display, local interface, slot for micro SD memory Maximum flexibility with regard to user interface and intuitive menu guidance
card

Pump stop and torque control Reduced mechanical loading and optimum pump stop control

Certified according to ATEX/IECEx directive Suitable for the starting of explosion-proof motors

Fail-safe disconnection up to SIL 3 - PL e / STO Reduced costs and space requirements thanks to direct wiring of the
EMERGENCY STOP mushroom pushbutton to the soft starter for SIL 1

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/37

Siemens IC 10 · 2020
Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters High Performance Soft Starters
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters > General data NEW NEU
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters > General data

■ Technical specifications
More information
Technical specifications,
Technical specifications,see
see FAQs,
FAQs, see
see https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/25776/faq
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/25776/faq
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/25776/td
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/25776/td Simulation Tool
Simulation Tool for
for Soft
Soft Starters
Starters (STS),
(STS), see
see page
page 6/8
7/7 or
or
Equipment
Equipment Manual
Manual “SIRIUS
"SIRIUS 3RW55
3RW55 Soft Starter",
Starter”, see
see https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109753752
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109753752

Type 3RW551.-.HF.4 3RW552.-.HF.4 3RW554.-.HF.4


3RW553.-.HF.4
Installation/fixing/dimensions
Width x height x depth mm 170 × 275 × 152 185 × 306 × 203 210 × 393 × 203
H

D
W

Type of mounting Screw fixing


Mounting position Vertical (can be rotated +/- 90° and tilted +/- 22.5° forward or backward)
Distance to be maintained with side-by-side mounting
• Above mm 100
• At the side mm 5

6
• Below mm 75
Maximum installation altitude above sea level1) m 2 000
Degree of protection IP00
Ambient conditions
Ambient temperature
• During operation2) °C -25 ... +60
• During storage and transport °C -40 ... +80
Environmental category according to IEC 60721
• During operation 3K6 (no ice formation, no condensation), 3C3 (no salt mist),
3S2 (sand must not get into the devices), 3M6
• During storage 1K6 (only occasional condensation), 1C2 (no salt mist),
1S2 (sand must not enter the devices), 1M4
• During transport 2K2, 2C1, 2S1, 2M2 (max. height of fall 0.3 m)
1)
Derating from 1 000
000 m,
m, see
seecharacteristic
characteristiccurve
curveon
onpage
page6/8.
7/7.
2) Note derating above 40 °C.
7
SOFT STARTERS

7/38 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

Siemens IC 10 · 2020 6/39


Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance
High Performance Soft Starters
Soft Starters
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters > General data
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters > General data NEW NEU

Type 3RW55..-.HF0. 3RW55..-.HF1.


Control circuit/control
Control supply voltage
• At AC/DC, rated value V 24/24 --/--
• At AC V -- 110 ... 250
• Relative negative tolerance/relative positive tolerance with AC % -20/20 -15/10
• Relative negative tolerance/relative positive tolerance with DC % -20/20 --/--
Frequency of the control supply voltage Hz 50 ... 60
• Relative negative tolerance/relative positive tolerance % -10/10
Type of overvoltage protection Varistors
Type of short-circuit protection for control circuit1) Fuse 4 A gG (Icu = 1 kA), fuse 6 A quick-response (Icu = 1 kA),
MCB C1 (Icu = 600 A), MCB C6 (Icu = 300 A)
1) Not included in scope of supply

Type 3RW55..-.HF.4
Power electronics
Operational voltage, rated value V 200 ... 480
• Relative negative tolerance/relative positive tolerance % -15/10
Operational voltage for inside-delta circuit, rated value V 200 ... 480
• Relative negative tolerance/relative positive tolerance % -15/10
6

Operating frequency, rated value Hz 50 ... 60


• Relative negative tolerance/relative positive tolerance % -10/10
Minimum load [% of IM]1) % 10
Maximum cable length between soft starter and motor m 800
1) Relative to set Ie.

7
SOFT STARTERS

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/39

Siemens IC 10 · 2020
Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters High Performance Soft Starters
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters > General data
NEW NEU
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters > General data

Type 3RW5513 3RW5514 10


3RW5515 3RW5516 3RW5517
Rated operational current Ie A 13 18 25 32 38
Power electronics
Load rating with rated operational current Ie
IEC + UL/CSA, individual mounting at 40/50/60 °C, A 13/11.5/10.5 18/15.9/13.8 25/22.3/19.6 25/22.3/19.6 38/33.5/30.5
AC-53a
Permissible rated motor current and starts/h
Normal starting (CLASS 10A)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 13/11.5/10.5 18/15.9/13.8 25/22.3/19.6 32/28.4/26 38/33.5/30.5
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 43 43 43 43 43
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 18 18 18 18 18
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 28 28 28 28 28
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 10 10 10 10 10
Normal starting (CLASS 10E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 13/11.5/10.5 18/15.9/13.8 25/22.3/19.6 32/28.4/26 38/33.5/30.5
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 21 21 21 21 21
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 8 8 8 8 8

6
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 13 13 13 13 13
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 4 4 4 4 4
Heavy starting (CLASS 20E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 13/11.5/10.5 18/15.9/13.8 25/22.3/19.6 29.6/27.2/23.6 33.5/30.5/27.5
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 10 10 10 10 10
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 4 4 4 4 4
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5
Heavy starting (CLASS 30E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 13/11.5/10.5 18/15.9/13.8 25/22.3/19.6 26/23.6/21.2 29/26/23
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 3 3 3 3 3
7

• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 4 4 4 4 4
SOFT STARTERS

- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 1.8 1.8 1.8 1.8 1.8


Adjustable rated motor current IM
• Minimum/maximum A 2.5/13 3.5/18 5/25 6.5/32 7.5/38
• Minimum/maximum in inside-delta circuits A 4.3/22.5 6.1/31.1 8.7/43.3 11.3/55.4 13/65.8

7/40 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance
High Performance Soft Starters
Soft Starters
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters > General data
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters > General data NEW NEU

Type 3RW5524 3RW5525 3RW5526 3RW5527


Rated operational current Ie A 47 63 77 93
Power electronics
Load rating with rated operational current Ie
IEC + UL/CSA, individual mounting at 40/50/60 °C, A 47/41.6/36.2 63/55.5/50.5 77/68/62 93/82.5/75.5
AC-53a
Permissible rated motor current and starts/h
Normal starting (CLASS 10A)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 47/41.6/36.2 63/55.5/50.5 77/68/62 93/82.5/75.5
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 43 43 43 43
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 18 18 18 18
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 28 28 28 28
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 10 10 10 10
Normal starting (CLASS 10E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 47/41.6/36.2 63/55.5/50.5 77/68/62 93/82.5/75.5
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 21 21 21 21
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 8 8 8 8
6

• 350% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 13 13 13 13
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 4 4 4 4
Heavy starting (CLASS 20E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 47/41.6/36.2 63/55.5/50.5 77/68/62 93/82.5/75.5
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 10 10 10 10
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 4 4 4 4
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 2.5 0 0 0
Heavy starting (CLASS 30E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 43.4/38/34.4 53/48/43 68/62/56 82.5/75.5/65
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 3 3 3 3

7
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 4 4 4 4

SOFT STARTERS
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 1.8 1.8 1.8 1.8
Adjustable rated motor current IM
• Minimum/maximum A 10/47 13/63 16/77 19/93
• Minimum/maximum in inside-delta circuits A 17.3/81.4 22.5/109 27.7/133 32.9/161

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/41

Siemens IC 10 · 2020
Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters High Performance Soft Starters
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters > General data
NEW NEU
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters > General data

Type 3RW5534 3RW5535 3RW5536


Rated operational current Ie A 113 143 171
Power electronics
Load rating with rated operational current Ie
IEC + UL/CSA, individual mounting at 40/50/60 °C, A 113/101/89 143/128/118 171/153/141
AC-53a
Permissible rated motor current and starts/h
Normal starting (CLASS 10A)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 113/101/89 143/128/118 171/153/141
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 43 43 35
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 18 18 13
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 28 17 10
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 10 4 0
Normal starting (CLASS 10E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 113/101/89 143/128/118 171/153/141
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 21 21 14
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 8 7 4

6
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 13 4 0
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 4 0 0
Heavy starting (CLASS 20E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 109/97/85 128/113/103 141/129/117
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 10 10 10
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 4 4 4
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 6 6
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 0 0 0
Heavy starting (CLASS 30E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 89/81/74 108/98/88 117/105/93
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 3 3 3
7

• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 4 4 4
SOFT STARTERS

- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 1.8 1.8 1.8


Adjustable rated motor current IM
• Minimum/maximum A 23/113 29/143 34/171
• Minimum/maximum in inside-delta circuits A 39.8/195 50.2/247 58.9/296

7/42 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance
High Performance Soft Starters
Soft Starters
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters > General data
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters > General data NEW NEU

Type 3RW5543 3RW5544 3RW5545 3RW5546 3RW5547 10


3RW5548
Rated operational current Ie A 210 250 315 370 470 570
Power electronics
Load rating with rated operational current Ie
IEC + UL/CSA, individual mounting at 40/50/60 °C, A 210/186/170 250/220/200 315/279/255 370/328/300 470/416/380 570/504/460
AC-53a
Permissible rated motor current and starts/h
Normal starting (CLASS 10A)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 210/186/170 250/220/200 315/279/255 370/328/300 470/416/380 570/504/460
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 43 43 38 43 32 13
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 13 18 14 18 13 3
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 14 28 19 28 19 4
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 0 10 5 10 6 0.4
Normal starting (CLASS 10E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 210/186/170 250/220/200 315/279/255 370/328/300 470/416/380 551/490/445
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 13 21 14 20 13 5
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 2 8 4 8 3 --
6

• 350% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 0 13 5 12 6 1
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 0 4 0 3 0.4 --
Heavy starting (CLASS 20E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 162/146/130 200/180/160 231/207/183 258/230/202 272/254/236 284/262/240
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 10 10 10 10 10 10
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 4 4 4 4 4 4
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 2 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5
Heavy starting (CLASS 30E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 138/122/106 160/140/120 183/159/135 202/174/160 210/190/170 220/200/180
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 3 3 3 3 3 3

7
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 4 4 4 4 4 4

SOFT STARTERS
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 1.8 1.8 1.8 1.8 1.8 1.8
Adjustable rated motor current IM
• Minimum/maximum A 42/210 50/250 63/315 74/370 94/470 114/570
• Minimum/maximum in inside-delta circuits A 72.7/363 86.6/433 109.1/545 128.2/640 162.8/814 197.5/987

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/43

Siemens IC 10 · 2020
Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters High Performance Soft Starters
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters > General data
NEW NEU
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters > General data
Motor feeders according to IEC with 3RV2/3VA motor starter protectors/circuit breakers (without semiconductor protection)
Type of coordination "1", CLASS 10,
short-circuit breaking capacity Iq in kA, see table
Note:
generalrecommendations
For general recommendationsforforconstructing
constructing motor
motor feeders
feeders
with soft starters,
starters, see
see page
page7/9.
6/10.

Q1 Q1

Q11 Q11
NSB0_01902

IC01_00544
M M
3~ 3~

Soft starters Motor starter protectors Motor starter protectors


for 400 V systems for 480 V systems for 400 V systems for 480 V systems
Q11 Q1 Iq Q1 Iq Q1 Iq Q1 Iq
Type Type kA Type kA Type kA Type kA
Type of Inline circuit Inside-delta circuit

6
ToC
coordina- 1
tion "1"
3RW5513 3RV2032-4TA10 65 3RV2032-4TA10 18 3RV2032-4DA10 65 3RV2032-4DA10 18
3RW5514 3RV2032-4DA10 65 3RV2032-4DA10 15 3RV2032-4EA10 65 3RV2032-4EA10 15
3RW5515 3RV2032-4EA10 65 3RV2032-4EA10 15 3RV2032-4VA10 65 3RV2032-4VA10 15
3RW5516 3RV2032-4VA10 65 3RV2032-4VA10 10 3RV2032-4JA10 65 3RV2032-4JA10 10
3RW5517 3RV2032-4WA10 65 3RV2032-4WA10 10 3RV2032-4RA10 65 3RV2032-4RA10 10
3RW5524 3RV2032-4JA10 65 3RV2032-4JA10 10 3RV2032-4RA10 65 3RV2032-4RA10 10
3RW5525 3VA2163-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2163-7MN32-0AA0 20 3VA2110-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2110-7MN32-0AA0 20
3RW5526 3VA2110-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2110-7MN32-0AA0 20 3VA2216-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2216-7MN32-0AA0 20
3RW5527 3VA2216-7MN32-0AA0 15 3VA2216-7MN32-0AA0 10 3VA2220-7MN32-0AA0 15 3VA2220-7MN32-0AA0 10
3RW5534 3VA2216-7MN32-0AA0 65 -- -- 3VA2220-7MN32-0AA0 65 -- --
3RW5535 3VA2220-7MN32-0AA0 65 -- -- 3VA2325-7MN32-0AA0 65 -- --
3RW5536 3VA2325-7MN32-0AA0 30 3VA2325-7MN32-0AA0 10 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 30 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 10
3RW5543 3VA2325-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2325-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65
3RW5544 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2450-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2450-7MN32-0AA0 65
3RW5545 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65
3RW5546 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65
7

3RW5547 3VA2450-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2450-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2510-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2510-6HN32-0AA0 65


3RW5548 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2510-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2510-6HN32-0AA0 65
SOFT STARTERS

Note:
The service factor or measurement inaccuracies have been
taken into account, for example, for the selection of the specified
motor starter protectors/circuit breakers; the specified short-
circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are covered by combination
tests. Smaller motor starter protectors/circuit breakers than
those specified can be used at any time as smaller ones trip
more quickly in the event of a short circuit (unchanged short-
circuit breaking capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any
case. The dimensioning of the short-circuit components must,
however, be suitable for the connected three-phase motor and
the line protection for the cables used.

7/44 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters > General data
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters > General data NEW NEU

Motor feeders according to IEC with 3NA3 fuses


gG class full-range fuses for cable and line protection according
to IEC 60269-2, without semiconductor protection
Type of coordination "1",
short-circuit breaking capacity Iq = 65 kA
Note:
For general
generalrecommendations
recommendationsforforconstructing
constructing motor
motor feeders
feeders
with soft starters,
starters, see
see page
page7/9.
6/10.

F1 F1 F1

Q21 Q21 Q21

Q11 Q11 Q11

IC01_00545a
NSB0_01904

IC01_00565
M M M
3~ 3~ 3~

Soft starters gG class fuse Line contactor gG class fuse Line contactor (optional)
(optional)
for systems for systems for systems for systems for systems
6

up to 480 V up to 480 V up to 480 V up to 480 V up to 480 V


in the supply cable in the delta
Q11 F1 Q21 F1 Q21 Q21
Type Type Type Type Type Type
Type of ToC Inline circuit Inside-delta circuit
coordina- 1
tion "1"
3RW5513 3NA3820-6 3RT2025 3NA3820-6 3RT2027 3RT2025
3RW5514 3NA3820-6 3RT2026 3NA3820-6 3RT2027 3RT2026
3RW5515 3NA3822-6 3RT2027 3NA3822-6 3RT2036 3RT2027
3RW5516 3NA3824-6 3RT2035 3NA3824-6 3RT2037 3RT2035
3RW5517 3NA3824-6 3RT2035 3NA3824-6 3RT2038 3RT2035
3RW5524 3NA3824-6 3RT2036 3NA3824-6 3RT2046 3RT2036
3RW5525 3NA3830-6 3RT2037 3NA3830-6 3RT2047 3RT2037
3RW5526 3NA3132-6 3RT2038 3NA3132-6 3RT1055 3RT2038
3RW5527 3NA3136-6 3RT2046 3NA3136-6 3RT1056 3RT2046
3RW5534 3NA3244-6 3RT1054 3NA3244-6 3RT1064 3RT1054

7
3RW5535 3NA3244-6 3RT1055 3NA3244-6 3RT1065 3RT1055
3RW5536 3NA3365-6 3RT1056 3NA3365-6 3RT1066 3RT1056
3RW5543 2 x 3NA3354-6 3RT1064 2 x 3NA3354-6 3RT1075 3RT1064

SOFT STARTERS
3RW5544 2 x 3NA3354-6 3RT1065 2 x 3NA3354-6 3RT1076 3RT1065
3RW5545 2 x 3NA3365-6 3RT1075 2 x 3NA3365-6 3TF68 3RT1075
3RW5546 2 x 3NA3365-6 3RT1075 2 x 3NA3365-6 3TF69 3RT1075
3RW5547 2 x 3NA3365-6 3RT1076 2 x 3NA3365-6 3TF69 3RT1076
3RW5548 2 x 3NA3365-6 3TF68 2 x 3NA3365-6 -- 3TF68

Note:
The specified short-circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are
covered by combination tests. Smaller fuses than those speci-
fied can be used at any time as smaller ones trip more quickly in
the event of a short circuit (unchanged short-circuit breaking
capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any case. The
dimensioning of the short-circuit components must, however, be
suitable for the connected three-phase motor and the line
protection for the cables used.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/45


Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters High Performance Soft Starters
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters > General data
NEW NEU
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters > General data
Motor feeders according to IEC with 3NE1 SITOR fuses
gR class full-range fuses for semiconductor protection, cable
and line protection
Type of coordination "2",
short-circuit breaking capacity Iq = 65 kA
Note:
For general
generalrecommendations
recommendationsforforconstructing
constructing motor
motor feeders
feeders
with soft starters,
starters, see
see page
page7/9.
6/10.

F’1

Q21

Q11
NSB0_01905

M
3~

Soft starters gG class fuse Line contactor (optional)


for systems for systems

6
up to 480 V up to 480 V
Q11 F’1 Q21
Type Type Type
Type of ToC Inline circuit
coordina- 2
tion "2"
3RW5513 3NE1815-0 3RT2025
3RW5514 3NE1802-0 3RT2026
3RW5515 3NE1817-0 3RT2027
3RW5516 3NE1818-0 3RT2035
3RW5517 3NE1820-0 3RT2035
3RW5524 3NE1021-2 3RT2036
3RW5525 3NE1022-0 3RT2037
3RW5526 3NE1224-0 3RT2038
3RW5527 3NE1224-0 3RT2046
3RW5534 3NE1225-0 3RT1054
3RW5535 3NE1227-0 3RT1055
3RW5536 3NE1230-0 3RT1056
7

3RW5543 3NE1230-2 3RT1064


3RW5544 3NE1331-0 3RT1065
SOFT STARTERS

3RW5545 3NE1334-2 3RT1075


3RW5546 3NE1334-2 3RT1075
3RW5547 3NE1436-2 3RT1076
3RW5548 3NE1437-2 3TF68

Note:
The specified short-circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are
covered by combination tests. Smaller fuses than those speci-
fied can be used at any time as smaller ones trip more quickly in
the event of a short circuit (unchanged short-circuit breaking
capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any case. The
dimensioning of the short-circuit components must, however, be
suitable for the connected three-phase motor and the line
protection for the cables used.
inside-delta circuits,
In inside-delta circuits,aagR
gRclass
classfull-range
full-rangefuse
fusecould
couldnotnot
provide the
provide the semiconductor
semiconductor protection
protectionof ofthe
thedelta-connected
delta-connected
soft starter with a short-circuit breaking
breaking capacity
capacitythat
thatisis
adequate for
adequate for practical
practicaluse.
use.InInthis
thiscase,
case,we werecommend
recommendusing using
class partial-range
aR class partial-rangefuses
fusesfor
forsemiconductor
semiconductorprotection
protectionforfor
coordination “2”
type of coordination "2" (see page 7/47).
6/48).

7/46 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters > General data
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters > General data NEW NEU

Motor feeders according to IEC with 3NE8 / 3NE3 / 3NC3 fuses


aR class partial-range fuses for semiconductor protection
Type of coordination "2",
short-circuit breaking capacity Iq = 65 kA
Note:
For general
For generalrecommendations
recommendationsforforconstructing
constructing motor
motor feeders
feeders
soft starters,
with soft starters, see
seepage
page7/9.
6/10.

F1 F1 F1

Q21 Q21 Q21


F3 F3 F3

Q11 Q11 Q11


NSB0_01906

IC01_00546a

IC01_00566
M M M
3~ 3~ 3~

Soft starters gG class fuse aR class fuse Line contactor gG class fuse aR class fuse Line contactor (optional)
(optional)
6

for systems for systems for systems for systems for systems for systems for systems
up to 480 V up to 480 V up to 480 V up to 480 V up to 480 V up to 480 V up to 480 V
in the supply in the delta
cable
Q11 F1 F3 Q21 F1 F3 Q21 Q21
Type Type Type Type Type Type Type Type
Type of ToC Inline circuit Inside-delta circuit
coordina- 2
tion "2"
3RW5513 3NA3820-6 3NE8017-1 3RT2025 3NA3820-6 3NE8017-1 3RT2027 3RT2025
3RW5514 3NA3820-6 3NE8020-1 3RT2026 3NA3820-6 3NE8020-1 3RT2027 3RT2026
3RW5515 3NA3822-6 3NE8021-1 3RT2027 3NA3822-6 3NE8021-1 3RT2036 3RT2027
3RW5516 3NA3824-6 3NE8022-1 3RT2035 3NA3824-6 3NE8022-1 3RT2037 3RT2035
3RW5517 3NA3824-6 3NE8024-1 3RT2035 3NA3824-6 3NE8024-1 3RT2038 3RT2035
3RW5524 3NA3824-6 3NE8024-1 3RT2036 3NA3824-6 3NE8024-1 3RT2046 3RT2036
3RW5525 3NA3830-6 3NE3227 3RT2037 3NA3830-6 3NE3227 3RT2047 3RT2037
3RW5526 3NA3132-6 3NE3227 3RT2038 3NA3132-6 3NE3227 3RT1055 3RT2038
3RW5527 3NA3136-6 3NE3227 3RT2046 3NA3136-6 3NE3227 3RT1056 3RT2046

7
3RW5534 3NA3244-6 3NE3231 3RT1054 3NA3244-6 3NE3231 3RT1064 3RT1054
3RW5535 3NA3244-6 3NE3233 3RT1055 3NA3244-6 3NE3233 3RT1065 3RT1055
3RW5536 3NA3365-6 3NE3334-0B 3RT1056 3NA3365-6 3NE3334-0B 3RT1066 3RT1056

SOFT STARTERS
3RW5543 2 x 3NA3354-6 3NE3333 3RT1064 2 x 3NA3354-6 3NE3333 3RT1075 3RT1064
3RW5544 2 x 3NA3354-6 3NE3335 3RT1065 2 x 3NA3354-6 3NE3335 3RT1076 3RT1065
3RW5545 2 x 3NA3365-6 -- 3RT1075 2 x 3NA3365-6 -- 3TF68 3RT1075
3RW5546 2 x 3NA3365-6 -- 3RT1075 2 x 3NA3365-6 -- 3TF69 3RT1075
3RW5547 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NE3340-8 3RT1076 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NE3340-8 3TF69 3RT1076
3RW5548 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NC3342-1U 3TF68 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NC3342-1U -- 3TF68

Note:
The specified short-circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are
covered by combination tests. Smaller fuses than those speci-
fied can be used at any time as smaller ones trip more quickly in
the event of a short circuit (unchanged short-circuit breaking
capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any case. The
dimensioning of the short-circuit components must, however, be
suitable for the connected three-phase motor and the line
protection for the cables used.
For
For CLASS
CLASS 10
10 applications,
applications, asas an
an alternative
alternative to
to the
the gG
gG class
class
full-range fuses for
full-range fuses for cable
cable and
andline
lineprotection
protection3NA3
3NA3(F1),
(F1),
3RV2/3VA
3RV2/3VA motor
motor starter
starter protectors/circuit
protectors/circuit breakers
breakers can
can also be
also be
used,
used, possibly with reduced
possibly with reduced short-circuit
short-circuitbreaking
breakingcapacity
capacity
(see
(see page 6/45). In
page 7/44). In these
these cases,
cases, optional
optional line contactors can
line contactors can be
be
dispensed with.
dispensed with.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/47


Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters High Performance Soft Starters
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters > General data
NEW NEU
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters > General data
Reversing operation with reversing contactors
Note:
For general
generalrecommendations
recommendationsforforconstructing
constructing motor
motor feeders
feeders
with soft starters,
starters, see
see page
page7/9.
6/10.
(For an example circuit, see
3RW55 Equipment Manual, Appendix A.3)
Soft starters Reversing contactor assembly For reversing contactor
for systems up to 480 V for systems up to 480 V
Q11 Q21 / Q22 Q21 / Q22
Type Type Type
3RW5513 3RA2325 3RT2025
3RW5514 3RA2326 3RT2026
3RW5515 3RA2327 3RT2027
3RW5516 3RA2335 3RT2035
3RW5517 3RA2335 3RT2035
3RW5524 3RA2336 3RT2036
3RW5525 3RA2337 3RT2037
3RW5526 3RA2338 3RT2038
3RW5527 3RA2346 3RT2046
3RW5534 -- 3RT1054
3RW5535 -- 3RT1055
3RW5536 -- 3RT1056

6
3RW5543 -- 3RT1064
3RW5544 -- 3RT1065
3RW5545 -- 3RT1075
3RW5546 -- 3RT1075
3RW5547 -- 3RT1076
3RW5548 -- 3TF68
7
SOFT STARTERS

7/48 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters > Inline circuit IE3/IE4 ready
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters > Inline circuit NEW NEU

Selection and ordering data


For normal starting (CLASS 10E)

3RW551. 3RW552. 3RW553. 3RW554.


At 40 °C At 50 °C SD1) Article No. Price PU PS*
Opera- Operating power for Opera- Rating [hp] for three-phase motors per PU (UNIT,
tional three-phase motors tional SET, M)
current At At current At At At
230 V 400 V 200/208 V 220/230 V 460/480 V
A kW kW A hp hp hp d
Operational voltage 200 ... 480 V
13 3 5.5 11.5 2 3 7.5 5 3RW5513-@HF@4 1 1 unit
18 4 7.5 15.9 3 5 10 5 3RW5514-@HF@4 1 1 unit
6

25 5.5 11 22.3 5 7.5 15 5 3RW5515-@HF@4 1 1 unit


32 7.5 15 28.4 7.5 10 20 5 3RW5516-@HF@4 1 1 unit
38 11 18.5 33.5 10 10 20 5 3RW5517-@HF@4 1 1 unit
47 11 22 41.6 10 10 30 5 3RW5524-@HF@4 1 1 unit
63 18.5 30 55.5 15 20 40 5 3RW5525-@HF@4 1 1 unit
77 22 37 68 20 25 50 5 3RW5526-@HF@4 1 1 unit
93 22 45 82.5 25 30 60 5 3RW5527-@HF@4 1 1 unit

Type of electrical connection for the control circuit


Screw terminals 1
Spring-loaded terminals 3

Control supply voltage


24 V AC/DC 0
110 ... 250 V AC 1
Note:
1)
3RW55 soft starter with screw terminals for operational voltage up to 480 V:
For the constraints
constraints for
forthe
themotor
motoroutputs
outputsspecified
specifiedhere,
here, see

7
Standard delivery time SD = 1 day (d).
page 6/8. 7/7.
see page

SOFT STARTERS
At 40 °C At 50 °C SD1) Article No. Price PU PS*
Opera- Operating power for Opera- Rating [hp] for three-phase motors per PU (UNIT,
tional three-phase motors tional SET, M)
current At At current At At At
230 V 400 V 200/208 V 220/230 V 460/480 V
A kW kW A hp hp hp d
Operational voltage 200 ... 480 V
113 30 55 101 30 30 75 5 3RW5534-@HF@4 1 1 unit
143 37 75 128 40 40 100 5 3RW5535-@HF@4 1 1 unit
171 45 90 153 50 50 100 5 3RW5536-@HF@4 1 1 unit
210 55 110 186 50 60 150 5 3RW5543-@HF@4 1 1 unit
250 75 132 220 60 75 150 5 3RW5544-@HF@4 1 1 unit
315 90 160 279 75 100 200 5 3RW5545-@HF@4 1 1 unit
370 110 200 328 100 125 250 5 3RW5546-@HF@4 1 1 unit
470 132 250 416 150 150 350 5 3RW5547-@HF@4 1 1 unit
570 160 315 504 150 200 400 5 3RW5548-@HF@4 1 1 unit

Type of electrical connection for the control circuit


Spring-loaded terminals 2
Screw terminals 6

Control supply voltage


24 V AC/DC 0
110 ... 250 V AC 1
1)
3RW55 soft starter with screw terminals for operational voltage up to 480 V:
Note:
Standard delivery time SD = 1 day (d). For the constraints
constraints for
forthe
themotor
motoroutputs
outputsspecified
specifiedhere,
here, see
page 6/8. 7/7.
see page

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/49

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters High Performance Soft Starters
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters > Inside-delta circuit IE3/IE4 ready
NEW NEU
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters > Inside-delta circuit

Selection and ordering data

For normal starting (CLASS 10E)

3RW551. 3RW552. 3RW553. 3RW554.


At 40 °C for inside-delta circuit At 50 °C for inside-delta circuit SD1) Article No. Price PU PS*
Opera- Operating power for Opera- Rating [hp] for three-phase motors per PU (UNIT,
tional three-phase motors tional SET, M)
current At At current At At At
230 V 400 V 200/208 V 220/230 V 460/480 V
A kW kW A hp hp hp d
Operational voltage 200 ... 480 V
22.5 5.5 11 19.9 5 5 10 5 3RW5513-@HF@4 1 1 unit
31.5 7.5 15 28 7.5 7.5 20 5 3RW5514-@HF@4 1 1 unit

6
43.3 11 18.5 39 10 10 25 5 3RW5515-@HF@4 1 1 unit
55.4 15 22 49 15 15 30 5 3RW5516-@HF@4 1 1 unit
65.8 18.5 30 58 15 20 40 5 3RW5517-@HF@4 1 1 unit
81.4 22 45 72 20 25 50 5 3RW5524-@HF@4 1 1 unit
109 30 55 96 30 30 75 5 3RW5525-@HF@4 1 1 unit
133 37 75 118 30 40 75 5 3RW5526-@HF@4 1 1 unit
161 45 90 143 40 50 100 5 3RW5527-@HF@4 1 1 unit

Type of electrical connection for the control circuit


Screw terminals 1
Spring-loaded terminals 3

Control supply voltage


24 V AC/DC 0
110 ... 250 V AC 1
1) 3RW55 soft starter with screw terminals for operational voltage up to 480 V:
Note:
Standard delivery time SD = 1 day (d). the constraints
For the constraintsfor
forthe
themotor
motoroutputs
outputsspecified
specified here, see
here,
7

pagepage
see 6/8.7/7.
SOFT STARTERS

At 40 °C for inside-delta circuit At 50 °C for inside-delta circuit SD1) Article No. Price PU PS*
Opera- Operating power for Opera- Rating [hp] for three-phase motors per PU (UNIT,
tional three-phase motors tional SET, M)
current At At current At At At
230 V 400 V 200/208 V 220/230 V 460/480 V
A kW kW A hp hp hp d
Operational voltage 200 ... 480 V
196 55 110 175 50 60 125 5 3RW5534-@HF@4 1 1 unit
248 75 132 222 75 75 150 5 3RW5535-@HF@4 1 1 unit
296 90 160 265 75 100 200 5 3RW5536-@HF@4 1 1 unit
364 110 200 322 100 125 250 5 3RW5543-@HF@4 1 1 unit
433 132 250 381 125 150 300 5 3RW5544-@HF@4 1 1 unit
546 160 315 483 150 200 400 5 3RW5545-@HF@4 1 1 unit
641 200 355 568 200 200 450 5 3RW5546-@HF@4 1 1 unit
814 250 400 721 250 250 600 5 3RW5547-@HF@4 1 1 unit
987 315 560 873 300 350 750 5 3RW5548-@HF@4 1 1 unit

Type of electrical connection for the control circuit


Spring-loaded terminals 2
Screw terminals 6

Control supply voltage


24 V AC/DC 0
110 ... 250 V AC 1

1) Note:
3RW55 soft starter with screw terminals for operational voltage up to 480 V:
Standard delivery time SD = 1 day (d). For the
For the constraints
constraintsfor
forthe
themotor
motoroutputs
outputsspecified
specified here, see
here,
pagepage
see 6/8.7/7.

7/50 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2020 6/51
Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance
High Performance Soft Starters
Soft Starters
3RW55
3RW55Failsafe
Failsafesoft
softstarters
starters>>Accessories
Accessories

Selection and ordering data


Product Manufacturer's Type of Application SD Article No. Price PU PS*
designation Article No. of the product per PU (UNIT,
soft starter SET, M)
d
Fan covers
Fan cover 3RW551 (1x), -- -- } 3RW5983-0FC00 1 1 unit
3RW552 (2x),
3RW553 (2x)
3RW554 (1x) -- -- } 3RW5984-0FC00 1 1 unit
3RW5983-0FC00
Terminal covers
Terminal cover 3RW552 (2x), -- -- } 3RW5983-0TC20 1 1 unit
3RW553 (2x)

3RW5983-0TC20

3RW554 (2x) -- -- } 3RW5984-0TC20 1 1 unit


6

3RW5984-0TC20

Enclosure components
Hinged cover 3RW55 Without cutout -- } 3RW5950-0GL20 1 1 unit

3RW5950-0GL20
Communication modules

7
Communica- 3RW55 PROFINET -- } 3RW5950-0CH00 1 1 unit
tion module High Feature

SOFT STARTERS
with integral
switch
PROFINET -- } 3RW5980-0CS00 1 1 unit
Standard
PROFIBUS -- } 3RW5980-0CP00 1 1 unit

3RW5980-0CS00

EtherNet/IP -- } 3RW5980-0CE00 1 1 unit

3RW5980-0CE00
Modbus RTU -- } 3RW5980-0CR00 1 1 unit
Modbus TCP -- } 3RW5980-0CT00 1 1 unit

3RW5980-0CR00

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/51


* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
6/52 Siemens IC 10 · 2020 Illustrations are approximate
Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters High Performance Soft Starters
3RW55 Failsafe soft starters > Accessories 3RW55 Failsafe soft starters > Accessories

Product Manufacturer's Type of Application SD Article No. Price PU PS*


designation Article No. of the product per PU (UNIT,
soft starter SET, M)
d
HMI modules
IP65 door 3RW55 IP65 For HMI } 3RW5980-0HD00 1 1 unit
mounting kit modules
for HMI
modules

3RW5980-0HD00
Connecting cables
HMI connec- 3RW55 5 m, round For door } 3RW5980-0HC60 1 1 unit
tion cable 2.5 m, round mounting } 3UF7933-0BA00-0 1 1 unit
1.0 m, round } 3UF7937-0BA00-0 1 1 unit
0.5 m, round } 3UF7932-0BA00-0 1 1 unit

6
3UF793.-0BA00-0
Further accessories
Push-in lugs -- Two lugs are For HMI 2 3ZY1311-0AA00 1 10 units
for wall mount- required per modules and
ing device communica-
tion modules

3ZY1311-0AA00
Blank labels
Unit labeling -- 20 mm x For SIRIUS 20 3RT2900-1SB20 100 340 units
plates1) 7 mm, devices
titanium gray
IC01_00181
7

3RT2900-1SB20
SOFT STARTERS

1) PC labeling systems for individual inscription of unit labeling plates are


available from: murrplastik Systemtechnik GmbH (see page 16/15).

7/52 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2020 6/53
Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
General Performance
General Performance Soft Starters
Soft Starters
3RW52
3RW52soft
softstarters
starters>>General
Generaldata
data

Overview
More information
Homepage, www.siemens.com/soft-starter
Homepage, see www.usa.siemens.com/soft-starter Industry
Industry Online Support (SIOS)
(SIOS) topic
topic page,
page,see
see
Industry Mall,
Mall, see
see www.siemens.com/product?3RW52
www.siemens.com/product?3RW52 https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109747404
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109747404
TIA Selection
TIA Selection Tool
Tool Cloud
Cloud (TST
(TST Cloud),
Cloud),see
see Simulation Tool
Simulation Tool for
for Soft
Soft Starters
Starters (STS),
(STS), see
see page
page 6/8
7/7 or
or
https://www.siemens.com/tstcloud/?node=3rw52
https://www.siemens.com/tstcloud/?node=3rw52 https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
SIRIUS Soft
SIRIUS Soft Starter
Starter ES
ES(TIA
(TIA Portal)
Portal),for
see page 14/5 see page 14/5
diagnostics,

SIRIUS 3RW52 General Performance soft starters are the ideal


solution for standard applications. With ideal three-phase motor
control, they cover the performance range from 7.5 to 400HP
@ 480V.
Optional HMI modules, plug-in communication modules
(PROFINET, PROFIBUS, EtherNet/IP and Modbus) and either an
analog output or thermistor motor protection ensure maximum
flexibility. With their modern hybrid switching technology, the
SIRIUS 3RW52 soft starters offer efficient switching for
long-term, energy-saving use.
6

7
4

7
SOFT STARTERS
2
IC01_00581a

5
3

1 3RW52 soft starter

2 HMI modules
3 Communication modules
7 Push-in lugs for wall mounting
4 Hinged cover
8 IP65 door mounting kit
5 Fan covers
9 HMI soft starter connection cable
6 Terminal covers

3RW52 General
General Performance
Performance soft
soft starters
starters with
with accessories
accessories(see
(seepage 6/70),for
page7/69), forexpansion
expansionwith
withHMI
HMImodule
moduleororcommunication
communicationmodule
module

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/53

6/54 Siemens IC 10 · 2020


Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
General Performance Soft Starters General Performance Soft Starters
3RW52 soft starters > General data 3RW52 soft starters > General data

■ Benefits

6
Product characteristics / function Performance features / benefits

Hybrid switching devices and three-phase motor control Minimum power loss and optimum/symmetrical motor control

TIA-Integration – communication modules and HMI modules optional Efficient configuration and maximum flexibility in automation engineering

Soft Torque Reduced mechanical loading and optimum pump stop


7

Parameterization using potentiometers Simple and fast commissioning


SOFT STARTERS

Wide range for control supply and main voltage Low variance, high system availability even with weak supply networks

7/54 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

Siemens IC 10 · 2020 6/55


Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
General Performance
General Performance Soft Starters
Soft Starters
3RW52
3RW52soft
softstarters
starters>>General
Generaldata
data

Technical specifications
More information
Technical specifications,see
Technical specifications, see FAQs,
FAQs, see
see https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/25100/faq
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/25100/faq
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/25100/td
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/25100/td Simulation Tool
Simulation Tool for
for Soft
Soft Starters
Starters (STS),
(STS), see
see page
page 6/8
7/7 or
or
Equipment Manual
Manual “SIRIUS
"SIRIUS 3RW52 Soft Starter",
Starter”, see
see https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109753751
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109753751

Type 3RW5213 3RW5216 3RW5224 3RW5226 3RW5243


3RW5214 3RW5217 3RW5225 3RW5227 3RW5244
3RW5215 3RW5234 3RW5245
3RW5235 3RW5246
3RW5236 3RW5247
3RW5248
Installation/fixing/dimensions
Width x height x depth mm 170 × 275 × 152 185 × 306 × 203 210 × 393 × 203
H

Type of mounting Screw fixing


Mounting position For vertical For vertical For vertical For vertical mounting surface
mounting surface mounting surface mounting surface can be rotated +/- 90°,
6

can be rotated can be rotated can be rotated for vertical mounting surface can be
+/- 10° and tilted +/- 90°, +/- 10° and tilted tilted +/- 22.5° forward or backward
forward or for vertical forward or
backward mounting surface backward
can be tilted
+/- 22.5° forward
or backward
Distance to be maintained with side-by-side mounting
• Above mm 100
• At the side mm 5
• Below mm 75
Maximum installation altitude above sea level1) m 5 000
Degree of protection IP00
Ambient conditions
Ambient temperature
• During operation2) °C -25 ... +60

7
• During storage and transport °C -40 ... +80
Environmental category according to IEC 60721

SOFT STARTERS
• During operation 3K6 (no ice formation, no condensation), 3C3 (no salt mist),
3S2 (sand must not get into the devices), 3M6
• During storage 1K6 (only occasional condensation), 1C2 (no salt mist),
1S2 (sand must not enter the devices), 1M4
• During transport 2K2, 2C1, 2S1, 2M2 (max. height of fall 0.3 m)
1) Derating
Derating from 1 000 m,
m, see
see characteristic
characteristiccurve
curveon
onpage
page6/8.
7/7.
2)
Note derating above 40 °C.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/55

6/56 Siemens IC 10 · 2020


Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
General Performance Soft Starters General Performance Soft Starters
3RW52 soft starters > General data 3RW52 soft starters > General data

Type 3RW52..-..C0. 3RW52..-..C1.


Control circuit/control
Control supply voltage
• At AC/DC, rated value V 24/24 --/--
• At AC V -- 110 ... 250
• Relative negative tolerance/relative positive tolerance with AC % -20/20 -15/10
• Relative negative tolerance/relative positive tolerance with DC % -20/20 --/--
Frequency of the control supply voltage Hz 50 ... 60
• Relative negative tolerance/relative positive tolerance % -10/10
Type of overvoltage protection Varistors
Type of short-circuit protection for control circuit1) Fuse 4 A gG (Icu = 1 kA), fuse 6 A quick-response (Icu = 1 kA),
MCB C1 (Icu = 600 A), MCB C6 (Icu = 300 A)
1) Not included in scope of supply

Type 3RW52..-..C.4 3RW52..-..C.5


Power electronics
Operational voltage, rated value V 200 ... 480 200 ... 600
• Relative negative tolerance/relative positive tolerance % -15/10
Operational voltage for inside-delta circuit, rated value V 200 ... 480 200 ... 600
• Relative negative tolerance/relative positive tolerance % -15/10

6
Operating frequency, rated value Hz 50 ... 60
• Relative negative tolerance/relative positive tolerance % -10/10
Minimum load [% of IM]1) % 15
Maximum cable length between soft starter and motor m 800
1) Relative to the smallest adjustable Ie.
7
SOFT STARTERS

7/56 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

Siemens IC 10 · 2020 6/57


Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
General Performance
General Performance Soft Starters
Soft Starters
3RW52
3RW52soft
softstarters
starters>>General
Generaldata
data

Type 3RW5213 3RW5214 10


3RW5215 3RW5216 3RW5217
Rated operational current Ie A 13 18 25 32 38
Power electronics
Load rating with rated operational current Ie
IEC + UL/CSA, individual mounting at 40/50/60 °C, A 13/11.5/10.5 18/15.9/13.8 25/22.3/19.6 32/28.4/26 38/33.5/30.5
AC-53a
Permissible rated motor current and starts/h
Normal starting (CLASS 10A)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 13/11.5/10.5 18/15.9/13.8 25/22.3/19.6 32/28.4/26 38/33.5/30.5
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 43 43 43 43 43
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 18 18 18 18 18
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 28 28 28 28 28
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 10 10 10 10 10
Normal starting (CLASS 10E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 13/11.5/10.5 18/15.9/13.8 25/22.3/19.6 32/28.4/26 38/33.5/30.5
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 21 21 21 21 21
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 8 8 8 8 8
6

• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 13 13 13 13 13
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 4 4 4 4 4
Heavy starting (CLASS 20E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 13/11.5/10.5 18/15.9/13.8 25/22.3/19.6 29.6/27.2/23.6 33.5/30.5/27.5
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 10 10 10 10 10
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 4 4 4 4 4
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5
Adjustable rated motor current IM
• Minimum/maximum A 5.5/13 7.5/18 11.5/25 14/32 15.5/38
• Minimum/maximum in inside-delta circuits A 9.5/22.5 13/31.2 19.9/43.3 24.2/55.4 26.8/65.8

7
SOFT STARTERS

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/57

6/58 Siemens IC 10 · 2020


Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
General Performance Soft Starters General Performance Soft Starters
3RW52 soft starters > General data 3RW52 soft starters > General data

Type 3RW5224 3RW5225 3RW5226 3RW5227


Rated operational current Ie A 47 63 77 93
Power electronics
Load rating with rated operational current Ie
IEC + UL/CSA, individual mounting at 40/50/60 °C, A 47/41.6/36.2 63/55.5/50.5 77/68/62 93/82.5/75.5
AC-53a
Permissible rated motor current and starts/h
Normal starting (CLASS 10A)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 47/41.6/36.2 63/55.5/50.5 77/68/62 93/82.5/75.5
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 43 43 43 43
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 18 18 18 18
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 28 28 28 28
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 10 10 10 10
Normal starting (CLASS 10E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 47/41.6/36.2 63/55.5/50.5 77/68/62 93/82.5/75.5
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 21 21 21 21
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 8 8 8 8

6
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 13 13 13 13
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 4 4 4 4
Heavy starting (CLASS 20E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 47/41.6/36.2 63/55.5/50.5 65/59/53 93/82.5/75.5
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 10 10 10 10
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 4 3 4 4
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 4 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 2 0 2.5 2.5
Adjustable rated motor current IM
• Minimum/maximum A 20/47 25.5/63 32/77 40.5/93
• Minimum/maximum in inside-delta circuits A 34.6/81.4 44.2/109 55.4/133 70.1/161
7
SOFT STARTERS

7/58 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

Siemens IC 10 · 2020 6/59


Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
General Performance
General Performance Soft Starters
Soft Starters
3RW52
3RW52soft
softstarters
starters>>General
Generaldata
data

Type 10
3RW5234 3RW5235 3RW5236
Rated operational current Ie A 113 143 171
Power electronics
Load rating with rated operational current Ie
IEC + UL/CSA, individual mounting A 113/101/89 143/128/118 171/153/141
at 40/50/60 °C, AC-53a
Permissible rated motor current and starts/h
Normal starting (CLASS 10A)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 113/101/89 143/128/118 171/153/141
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 43 43 43
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 18 18 18
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 28 27 20
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 10 8 4
Normal starting (CLASS 10E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 113/101/89 139/127/116 158/146/129
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 21 21 21
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 8 8 8
6

• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 13 12 12
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 4 1 1
Heavy starting (CLASS 20E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 109/97/85 113/103/93 129/117/105
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 10 10 10
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 4 4 4
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 2.5 2.5 2.5
Adjustable rated motor current IM
• Minimum/maximum A 53/113 68/143 81/171
• Minimum/maximum in inside-delta circuits A 91.8/196 118/248 140/296

7
SOFT STARTERS

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/59

6/60 Siemens IC 10 · 2020


Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
General Performance Soft Starters General Performance Soft Starters
3RW52 soft starters > General data 3RW52 soft starters > General data

Type 3RW5243 3RW5244 3RW5245 3RW5246 3RW5247 10


3RW5248
Rated operational current Ie A 210 250 315 370 470 570
Power electronics
Load rating with rated operational current Ie
IEC + UL/CSA, individual mounting at 40/50/60 °C, A 210/186/170 250/220/200 315/279/255 370/328/300 470/416/380 570/504/460
AC-53a
Permissible rated motor current and starts/h
Normal starting (CLASS 10A)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 210/186/170 250/220/200 315/279/255 370/328/300 470/416/380 570/504/460
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 43 43 43 43 30 20
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 18 18 14 18 11 6
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 28 28 16 28 17 9
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 5 10 4 10 5 1
Normal starting (CLASS 10E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 197/184/170 250/220/200 279/255/231 370/328/300 398/362/326 460/416/372
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 21 21 21 21 21 18
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 8 8 8 8 8 7

6
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 12 13 12 13 13 11
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 1 4 3 4 4 2
Heavy starting (CLASS 20E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 162/146/130 200/180/160 195/171/147 258/230/202 272/236/218 284/262/240
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 10 10 10 10 10 10
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 4 4 4 4 4 4
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5
Adjustable rated motor current IM
• Minimum/maximum A 90/210 100/250 135/315 160/370 200/470 240/570
• Minimum/maximum in inside-delta circuits A 156/364 173/433 234/546 277/641 346/814 416/987
7
SOFT STARTERS

7/60 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

Siemens IC 10 · 2020 6/61


Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
General Performance Soft Starters
General Performance Soft Starters
3RW52 soft starters > General data
3RW52 soft starters > General data
Motor feeders according to IEC with 3RV2/3VA motor starter protectors/circuit breakers (without semiconductor protection)
Type of coordination "1", CLASS 10,
short-circuit breaking capacity Iq in kA, see table
Note:
generalrecommendations
For general recommendationsforforconstructing
constructing motor
motor feeders
feeders
starters, see
with soft starters, see page
page7/9.
6/10.

Q1 Q1

Q11 Q11
NSB0_01902

IC01_00544
M M
3~ 3~

Soft starters Motor starter protectors Motor starter protectors


for 400 V systems for 500 V systems for 400 V systems for 500 V systems
Q11 Q1 Iq Q1 Iq Q1 Iq Q1 Iq
Type Type kA Type kA Type kA Type kA
Type of Inline circuit Inside-delta circuit
6

ToC
coordina- 1
tion "1"
3RW5213 3RV2032-4TA10 65 3RV2032-4TA10 18 3RV2032-4DA10 65 3RV2032-4DA10 18
3RW5214 3RV2032-4DA10 65 3RV2032-4DA10 15 3RV2032-4EA10 65 3RV2032-4EA10 15
3RW5215 3RV2032-4EA10 65 3RV2032-4EA10 15 3RV2032-4VA10 65 3RV2032-4VA10 15
3RW5216 3RV2032-4VA10 65 3RV2032-4VA10 10 3RV2032-4JA10 65 3RV2032-4JA10 10
3RW5217 3RV2032-4WA10 65 3RV2032-4WA10 10 3RV2032-4RA10 65 3RV2032-4RA10 10
3RW5224 3RV2032-4JA10 65 3RV2032-4JA10 10 3RV2032-4RA10 65 3RV2032-4RA10 10
3RW5225 3VA2163-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2163-7MN32-0AA0 20 3VA2110-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2110-7MN32-0AA0 20
3RW5226 3VA2110-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2110-7MN32-0AA0 20 3VA2216-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2216-7MN32-0AA0 20
3RW5227 3VA2216-7MN32-0AA0 15 3VA2216-7MN32-0AA0 10 3VA2220-7MN32-0AA0 15 3VA2220-7MN32-0AA0 10
3RW5234 3VA2216-7MN32-0AA0 65 -- -- 3VA2220-7MN32-0AA0 65 -- --
3RW5235 3VA2220-7MN32-0AA0 65 -- -- 3VA2325-7MN32-0AA0 65 -- --
3RW5236 3VA2325-7MN32-0AA0 30 3VA2325-7MN32-0AA0 10 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 30 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 10
3RW5243 3VA2325-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2325-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65
3RW5244 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2450-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2450-7MN32-0AA0 65
3RW5245 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65
3RW5246 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65

7
3RW5247 3VA2450-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2450-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2510-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2510-6HN32-0AA0 65
3RW5248 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2510-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2510-6HN32-0AA0 65

SOFT STARTERS
Note:
The service factor or measurement inaccuracies have been
taken into account, for example, for the selection of the specified
motor starter protectors/circuit breakers; the specified short-
circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are covered by combination
tests. Smaller motor starter protectors/circuit breakers than
those specified can be used at any time as smaller ones trip
more quickly in the event of a short circuit (unchanged short-
circuit breaking capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any
case. The dimensioning of the short-circuit components must,
however, be suitable for the connected three-phase motor and
the line protection for the cables used.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/61


Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
General Performance Soft Starters General Performance Soft Starters
3RW52 soft starters > General data
3RW52 soft starters > General data
Motor feeders according to IEC with 3NA3 fuses
gG class full-range fuses for cable and line protection according
to IEC 60269-2, without semiconductor protection
Type of coordination "1",
short-circuit breaking capacity Iq = 65 kA
Note:
For general
For generalrecommendations
recommendationsforforconstructing
constructing motor
motor feeders
feeders
soft starters,
with soft starters, see
seepage
page7/9.
6/10.

F1 F1 F1

Q21 Q21 Q21

Q11 Q11 Q11

IC01_00545a
NSB0_01904

IC01_00565
M M M
3~ 3~ 3~

Soft starters gG class fuse Line contactor (optional) gG class fuse Line contactor (optional)
for systems for systems for systems for systems for systems for systems for systems for systems
up to 600 V up to 480 V up to 600 V up to 600 V up to 480 V up to 600 V up to 480 V up to 600 V

6
in the supply in the supply in the delta in the delta
cable cable
Q11 F1 Q21 Q21 F1 Q21 Q21 Q21 Q21
Type Type Type Type Type Type Type Type Type
Type of ToC Inline circuit Inside-delta circuit
coordina- 1
tion "1"
3RW5213 3NA3820-6 3RT2025 3RT2025 3NA3820-6 3RT2027 3RT2035 3RT2025 3RT2025
3RW5214 3NA3820-6 3RT2026 3RT2027 3NA3820-6 3RT2027 3RT2037 3RT2026 3RT2027
3RW5215 3NA3822-6 3RT2027 3RT2037 3NA3822-6 3RT2036 3RT2037 3RT2027 3RT2037
3RW5216 3NA3824-6 3RT2035 3RT2037 3NA3824-6 3RT2037 3RT2038 3RT2035 3RT2037
3RW5217 3NA3824-6 3RT2035 3RT2037 3NA3824-6 3RT2038 3RT2046 3RT2035 3RT2037
3RW5224 3NA3824-6 3RT2036 3RT2037 3NA3824-6 3RT2046 3RT2047 3RT2036 3RT2037
3RW5225 3NA3830-6 3RT2037 3RT2046 3NA3830-6 3RT2047 3RT1054 3RT2037 3RT2046
3RW5226 3NA3132-6 3RT2038 3RT2046 3NA3132-6 3RT1055 3RT1055 3RT2038 3RT2046
3RW5227 3NA3136-6 3RT2046 3RT2047 3NA3136-6 3RT1056 3RT1056 3RT2046 3RT2047
3RW5234 3NA3244-6 3RT1054 3RT1054 3NA3244-6 3RT1064 3RT1064 3RT1054 3RT1054
7

3RW5235 3NA3244-6 3RT1055 3RT1055 3NA3244-6 3RT1065 3RT1065 3RT1055 3RT1055


3RW5236 3NA3365-6 3RT1056 3RT1064 3NA3365-6 3RT1066 3RT1075 3RT1056 3RT1064
3RW5243 2 x 3NA3354-6 3RT1064 3RT1064 2 x 3NA3354-6 3RT1075 3RT1075 3RT1064 3RT1064
SOFT STARTERS

3RW5244 2 x 3NA3354-6 3RT1065 3RT1065 2 x 3NA3354-6 3RT1076 3RT1076 3RT1065 3RT1065


3RW5245 2 x 3NA3365-6 3RT1075 3RT1075 2 x 3NA3365-6 3TF68 3TF68 3RT1075 3RT1075
3RW5246 2 x 3NA3365-6 3RT1075 3RT1075 2 x 3NA3365-6 3TF69 3TF69 3RT1075 3RT1075
3RW5247 2 x 3NA3365-6 3RT1076 3RT1276 2 x 3NA3365-6 3TF69 3TF69 3RT1076 3RT1276
3RW5248 2 x 3NA3365-6 3TF68 3TF68 2 x 3NA3365-6 -- -- 3TF68 3TF68

Note:
The specified short-circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are
covered by combination tests. Smaller fuses than those speci-
fied can be used at any time as smaller ones trip more quickly in
the event of a short circuit (unchanged short-circuit breaking
capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any case. The
dimensioning of the short-circuit components must, however, be
suitable for the connected three-phase motor and the line
protection for the cables used.

7/62 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
General Performance Soft Starters
General Performance Soft Starters
3RW52 soft starters > General data
3RW52 soft starters > General data
Motor feeders according to IEC with 3NE1 SITOR fuses
gR class full-range fuses for semiconductor protection, cable
and line protection
Type of coordination "2",
short-circuit breaking capacity Iq = 65 kA
Note:
generalrecommendations
For general recommendationsforforconstructing
constructing motor
motor feeders
feeders
starters, see
with soft starters, see page
page7/9.
6/10.

F’1

Q21

Q11
NSB0_01905

M
3~

Soft starters gG class fuse Line contactor (optional)


for systems for systems for systems
6

up to 600 V up to 480 V up to 600 V


Q11 F’1 Q21 Q21
Type Type Type Type
Type of ToC Inline circuit
coordina- 2
tion "2"
3RW5213 3NE1815-0 3RT2025 3RT2025
3RW5214 3NE1802-0 3RT2026 3RT2027
3RW5215 3NE1817-0 3RT2027 3RT2037
3RW5216 3NE1818-0 3RT2035 3RT2037
3RW5217 3NE1820-0 3RT2035 3RT2037
3RW5224 3NE1021-2 3RT2036 3RT2037
3RW5225 3NE1022-0 3RT2037 3RT2046
3RW5226 3NE1224-0 3RT2038 3RT2046
3RW5227 3NE1224-0 3RT2046 3RT2047
3RW5234 3NE1225-0 3RT1054 3RT1054
3RW5235 3NE1227-0 3RT1055 3RT1055
3RW5236 3NE1230-0 3RT1056 3RT1064

7
3RW5243 3NE1230-21) 3RT1064 3RT1064
3RW5244 3NE1331-0 3RT1065 3RT1065

SOFT STARTERS
3RW5245 3NE1334-2 3RT1075 3RT1075
3RW5246 3NE1334-2 3RT1075 3RT1075
3RW5247 3NE1436-2 3RT1076 3RT1276
3RW5248 3NE1437-2 3TF68 3TF68
1)
For systems up to 500 V.
Note:
The specified short-circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are
covered by combination tests. Smaller fuses than those speci-
fied can be used at any time as smaller ones trip more quickly in
the event of a short circuit (unchanged short-circuit breaking
capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any case. The
dimensioning of the short-circuit components must, however, be
suitable for the connected three-phase motor and the line
protection for the cables used.
In inside-delta
inside-delta circuits,
circuits, aagR
gRclass
classfull-range
full-rangefusefusecould
couldnotnot
provide the semiconductor
provide the semiconductor protection
protection of of the
the delta-connected
delta-connected
soft starter with a short-circuit breaking
breaking capacity
capacitythatthatisis
adequate for practical
adequate for practicaluse.
use.InInthis
thiscase,
case,we werecommend
recommendusing using
aR class partial-range
partial-range fuses
fusesfor
forsemiconductor
semiconductorprotection
protectionforfor
type of coordination "2" (see
coordination “2” (see page
page 6/65).
7/64).

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/63


Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
General Performance Soft Starters General Performance Soft Starters
3RW52 soft starters > General data
3RW52 soft starters > General data
Motor feeders according to IEC with fuses 3NE8 / 3NE4 / 3NE3
aR class partial-range fuses for semiconductor protection
Type of coordination "2",
short-circuit breaking capacity Iq = 65 kA
Note:
For general
generalrecommendations
recommendationsforforconstructing
constructing motor
motor feeders
feeders
with soft starters,
starters, see
see page
page7/9.
6/10.

F1 F1 F1

Q21 Q21 Q21


F3 F3 F3

Q11 Q11 Q11


NSB0_01906

IC01_00546a

IC01_00566
M M M
3~ 3~ 3~

Soft starters gG class fuse aR class fuse Line contactor gG class fuse aR class fuse Line contactor (optional)
(optional)

6
for systems for systems for sys- for sys- for systems for systems for systems for systems for sys- for sys-
up to 600 V up to 500 V tems tems up to 600 V up to 600 V up to 480 V up to 600 V tems tems
up to up to in the supply in the supply up to up to
480 V 600 V cable cable 480 V 600 V
in the delta in the delta
Q11 F1 F3 Q21 Q21 F1 F3 Q21 Q21 Q21 Q21
Type Type Type Type Type Type Type Type Type Type Type
Type of ToC Inline circuit Inside-delta circuit
coordina- 2
tion "2"
3RW5213 3NA3820-6 3NE8017-1 3RT2025 3RT2025 3NA3820-6 3NE8017-1 3RT2027 3RT2035 3RT2025 3RT2025
3RW5214 3NA3820-6 3NE8020-1 3RT2026 3RT2027 3NA3820-6 3NE8020-1 3RT2027 3RT2037 3RT2026 3RT2027
3RW5215 3NA3822-6 3NE8021-1 3RT2027 3RT2037 3NA3822-6 3NE8021-1 3RT2036 3RT2037 3RT2027 3RT2037
3RW5216 3NA3824-6 3NE8022-1 3RT2035 3RT2037 3NA3824-6 3NE8022-1 3RT2037 3RT2038 3RT2035 3RT2037
3RW5217 3NA3824-6 3NE8024-1 3RT2035 3RT2037 3NA3824-6 3NE8024-1 3RT2038 3RT2046 3RT2035 3RT2037
3RW5224 3NA3824-6 3NE8024-1 3RT2036 3RT2037 3NA3824-6 3NE8024-1 3RT2046 3RT2047 3RT2036 3RT2037
3RW5225 3NA3830-6 3NE8024-1 3RT2037 3RT2046 3NA3830-6 3NE8024-1 3RT2047 3RT1054 3RT2037 3RT2046
3RW5226 3NA3132-6 3NE8024-1 3RT2038 3RT2046 3NA3132-6 3NE8024-1 3RT1055 3RT1055 3RT2038 3RT2046
7

3RW5227 3NA3136-6 3NE4124 3RT2046 3RT2047 3NA3136-6 3NE4124 3RT1056 3RT1056 3RT2046 3RT2047
3RW5234 3NA3244-6 3NE3332-0B 3RT1054 3RT1054 3NA3244-6 3NE3332-0B 3RT1064 3RT1064 3RT1054 3RT1054
3RW5235 3NA3244-6 3NE3334-0B 3RT1055 3RT1055 3NA3244-6 3NE3334-0B 3RT1065 3RT1065 3RT1055 3RT1055
SOFT STARTERS

3RW5236 3NA3365-6 3NE3335 3RT1056 3RT1064 3NA3365-6 3NE3335 3RT1066 3RT1075 3RT1056 3RT1064
3RW5243 2 x 3NA3354-6 3NE3333 3RT1064 3RT1064 2 x 3NA3354-6 3NE3333 3RT1075 3RT1075 3RT1064 3RT1064
3RW5244 2 x 3NA3354-6 3NE3336 3RT1065 3RT1065 2 x 3NA3354-6 3NE3336 3RT1076 3RT1076 3RT1065 3RT1065
3RW5245 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NE3336 3RT1075 3RT1075 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NE3336 3TF68 3TF68 3RT1075 3RT1075
3RW5246 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NE3336 3RT1075 3RT1075 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NE3336 3TF69 3TF69 3RT1075 3RT1075
3RW5247 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NE3340-8 3RT1076 3RT1276 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NE3340-8 3TF69 3TF69 3RT1076 3RT1276
3RW5248 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NE3340-8 3TF68 3TF68 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NE3340-8 -- -- 3TF68 3TF68

Note:
The specified short-circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are
covered by combination tests. Smaller fuses than those speci-
fied can be used at any time as smaller ones trip more quickly in
the event of a short circuit (unchanged short-circuit breaking
capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any case. The
dimensioning of the short-circuit components must, however, be
suitable for the connected three-phase motor and the line
protection for the cables used.
For CLASS 10 applications,
applications, asas an
an alternative
alternativetoto the
thegG
gGclass
class
full-range fuses for
full-range fuses for cable
cableand
andline
lineprotection
protection3NA3
3NA3(F1),
(F1),
3RV2/3VA
3RV2/3VA motor
motor starter
starter protectors/circuit
protectors/circuit breakers also be
breakers can also be
used, possibly
possibly with
with reduced
reducedshort-circuit
short-circuitbreaking
breakingcapacity
capacity
(see page 7/61).
6/62). In these cases, optional lineline contactors
contactors can
can be
be
dispensed with.
dispensed with.

7/64 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
General Performance
General Performance Soft Starters
Soft Starters
3RW52 IE3/IE4 ready
3RW52soft
softstarters
starters>>Inline
Inlinecircuit
circuit

Selection and ordering data


For normal starting (CLASS 10A)

3RW521. 3RW522. 3RW523. 3RW524.

At 40 °C At 50 °C SD1) Article No. Price PU PS*


Opera- Operating power for Opera- Rating [hp] for three-phase motors per PU (UNIT,
tional cur- three-phase motors tional cur- SET, M)
rent At At At rent At 200/208 At At At
230 V 400 V 500 V V 220/230 V 460/480 V 575/600 V
A kW kW kW A hp hp hp hp d
Operational voltage 200 ... 480 V
13 3 5.5 -- 11.5 2 3 7.5 -- 5 3RW5213-@@C@4 1 1 unit
18 4 7.5 -- 15.9 3 5 10 -- 5 3RW5214-@@C@4 1 1 unit
25 5.5 11 -- 22.3 5 7.5 15 -- 5 3RW5215-@@C@4 1 1 unit
6

32 7.5 15 -- 28.4 7.5 10 20 -- 5 3RW5216-@@C@4 1 1 unit


38 11 18.5 -- 33.5 10 10 20 -- 5 3RW5217-@@C@4 1 1 unit
47 11 22 -- 41.6 10 10 30 -- 5 3RW5224-@@C@4 1 1 unit
63 18.5 30 -- 55.5 15 20 40 -- 5 3RW5225-@@C@4 1 1 unit
77 22 37 -- 68 20 25 50 -- 5 3RW5226-@@C@4 1 1 unit
93 22 45 -- 82.5 25 30 60 -- 5 3RW5227-@@C@4 1 1 unit

Type of electrical connection for the control circuit


Screw terminals 1
Spring-loaded terminals 3
Product function
Analog output A
Thermistor motor protection T
Control supply voltage
24 V AC/DC 0
110 ... 250 V AC 1
Note:
1) 3RW52 soft starter with screw terminals for operational voltage up to 480 V:
Standard delivery time SD = 1 day (d). For the
the constraints
constraintsfor
forthe
themotor
motoroutputs
outputsspecified
specified here, see
here,

7
page 6/8.7/7.
see page

SOFT STARTERS
At 40 °C At 50 °C SD1) Article No. Price PU PS*
Opera- Operating power for Opera- Rating [hp] for three-phase motors per PU (UNIT,
tional cur- three-phase motors tional cur- SET, M)
rent At At At rent At At At At
230 V 400 V 500 V 200/208 V 220/230 V 460/480 V 575/600 V
A kW kW kW A hp hp hp hp d
Operational voltage 200 ... 480 V
113 30 55 -- 101 30 30 75 -- 5 3RW5234-@@C@4 1 1 unit
143 37 75 -- 128 40 40 100 -- 5 3RW5235-@@C@4 1 1 unit
171 45 90 -- 153 50 50 100 -- 5 3RW5236-@@C@4 1 1 unit
210 55 110 -- 186 60 60 150 -- 5 3RW5243-@@C@4 1 1 unit
250 75 132 -- 220 60 75 150 -- 5 3RW5244-@@C@4 1 1 unit
315 90 160 -- 279 75 100 200 -- 5 3RW5245-@@C@4 1 1 unit
370 110 200 -- 328 100 125 250 -- 5 3RW5246-@@C@4 1 1 unit
470 132 250 -- 416 150 150 350 -- 5 3RW5247-@@C@4 1 1 unit
570 160 315 -- 504 150 200 400 -- 5 3RW5248-@@C@4 1 1 unit

Type of electrical connection for the control circuit


Spring-loaded terminals 2
Screw terminals 6
Product function
Analog output A
Thermistor motor protection T
Control supply voltage
24 V AC/DC 0
110 ... 250 V AC 1
Note:
1) 3RW52 soft starter with screw terminals for operational voltage up to 480 V:
Standard delivery time SD = 1 day (d). For the constraints
For constraints for
for the
themotor
motoroutputs
outputsspecified
specifiedhere,
here, see
see page
page 6/8. 7/7.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/65


* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
6/66 Siemens IC 10 · 2020 Illustrations are approximate
Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
General Performance Soft Starters General Performance Soft Starters
3RW52 soft starters > Inline circuit IE3/IE4 ready
3RW52 soft starters > Inline circuit
For normal starting (CLASS 10A)

3RW521. 3RW522. 3RW523. 3RW524.

At 40 °C At 50 °C SD1) Article No. Price PU PS*


Opera- Operating power for Opera- Rating [hp] for three-phase motors per PU (UNIT,
tional cur- three-phase motors tional cur- SET, M)
rent At At At rent At At At At
230 V 400 V 500 V 200/208 V 220/230 V 460/480 V 575/600 V
A kW kW kW A hp hp hp hp d
Operational voltage 200 ... 600 V
13 3 5.5 7.5 11.5 2 3 7.5 10 5 3RW5213-@@C@5 1 1 unit
18 4 7.5 11 15.9 3 5 10 10 5 3RW5214-@@C@5 1 1 unit
25 5.5 11 15 22.3 5 7.5 15 20 5 3RW5215-@@C@5 1 1 unit

6
32 7.5 15 18.5 28.4 7.5 10 20 25 5 3RW5216-@@C@5 1 1 unit
38 11 18.5 22 33.5 10 10 20 30 5 3RW5217-@@C@5 1 1 unit
47 11 22 30 41.6 10 10 30 40 5 3RW5224-@@C@5 1 1 unit
63 18.5 30 37 55.5 15 20 40 50 5 3RW5225-@@C@5 1 1 unit
77 22 37 45 68 20 25 50 60 5 3RW5226-@@C@5 1 1 unit
93 22 45 55 82.5 25 30 60 75 5 3RW5227-@@C@5 1 1 unit

Type of electrical connection for the control circuit


Screw terminals 1
Spring-loaded terminals 3
Product function
Analog output A
Thermistor motor protection T
Control supply voltage
24 V AC/DC 0
110 ... 250 V AC 1
Note:
1) 3RW52 soft starter with screw terminals for operational voltage up to 600 V:
Standard delivery time SD = 2 days (d). For the
the constraints
constraintsfor
forthe
themotor
motoroutputs
outputsspecified
specified here, see
here,
7

pagepage
see 6/8.7/7.

At 40 °C At 50 °C SD1) Article No. Price PU PS*


SOFT STARTERS

Opera- Operating power for Opera- Rating [hp] for three-phase motors per PU (UNIT,
tional cur- three-phase motors tional cur- SET, M)
rent At At At rent At At At At
230 V 400 V 500 V 200/208 V 220/230 V 460/480 V 575/600 V
A kW kW kW A hp hp hp hp d
Operational voltage 200 ... 600 V
113 30 55 75 101 30 30 75 100 5 3RW5234-@@C@5 1 1 unit
143 37 75 90 128 40 40 100 125 5 3RW5235-@@C@5 1 1 unit
171 45 90 110 153 50 50 100 150 5 3RW5236-@@C@5 1 1 unit
210 55 110 132 186 60 60 150 150 5 3RW5243-@@C@5 1 1 unit
250 75 132 160 220 60 75 150 200 5 3RW5244-@@C@5 1 1 unit
315 90 160 200 279 75 100 200 250 5 3RW5245-@@C@5 1 1 unit
370 110 200 250 328 100 125 250 300 5 3RW5246-@@C@5 1 1 unit
470 132 250 315 416 150 150 350 450 5 3RW5247-@@C@5 1 1 unit
570 160 315 355 504 150 200 400 500 5 3RW5248-@@C@5 1 1 unit

Type of electrical connection for the control circuit


Spring-loaded terminals 2
Screw terminals 6
Product function
Analog output A
Thermistor motor protection T
Control supply voltage
24 V AC/DC 0
110 ... 250 V AC 1
Note:
1)
3RW52 soft starter with screw terminals for operational voltage up to 600 V:
Standard delivery time SD = 2 days (d). For the
For the constraints
constraintsfor
forthe
themotor
motoroutputs
outputsspecified
specified here, see
here,
see
page page
6/8.7/7.

7/66 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
General Performance
General Performance Soft Starters
Soft Starters
3RW52 IE3/IE4 ready
3RW52soft
softstarters
starters>>Inside-delta
Inside-deltacircuit
circuit

Selection and ordering data


For normal starting (CLASS 10A)

3RW521. 3RW522. 3RW523. 3RW524.


At 40 °C for inside-delta circuit At 50 °C for inside-delta circuit SD1) Article No. Price PU PS*
Opera- Operating power for Opera- Rating [hp] for three-phase motors per PU (UNIT,
tional cur- three-phase motors tional cur- SET, M)
rent At At At rent At At At At
230 V 400 V 500 V 200/208 V 220/230 V 460/480 V 575/600 V
A kW kW kW A hp hp hp hp d
Operational voltage 200 ... 480 V
22.5 5.5 11 -- 19.9 5 5 10 -- 5 3RW5213-@@C@4 1 1 unit
31.5 7.5 15 -- 28 7.5 7.5 20 -- 5 3RW5214-@@C@4 1 1 unit
43.3 11 18.5 -- 39 10 10 25 -- 5 3RW5215-@@C@4 1 1 unit
6

55.4 15 22 -- 49 15 15 30 -- 5 3RW5216-@@C@4 1 1 unit


65.8 18.5 30 -- 58 15 20 40 -- 5 3RW5217-@@C@4 1 1 unit
81.4 22 45 -- 72 20 25 50 -- 5 3RW5224-@@C@4 1 1 unit
109 30 55 -- 96 30 30 75 -- 5 3RW5225-@@C@4 1 1 unit
133 37 75 -- 118 30 40 75 -- 5 3RW5226-@@C@4 1 1 unit
161 45 90 -- 143 40 50 100 -- 5 3RW5227-@@C@4 1 1 unit

Type of electrical connection for the control circuit


Screw terminals 1
Spring-loaded terminals 3
Product function
Analog output A
Thermistor motor protection T
Control supply voltage
24 V AC/DC 0
1
110 ... 250 V AC Note:
1) 3RW52 soft starter with screw terminals for operational voltage up to 480 V: For the constraints
constraints for
for the
themotor
motoroutputs
outputsspecified
specifiedhere,
here, see

7
Standard delivery time SD = 1 day (d).
page 6/8. 7/7.
see page

SOFT STARTERS
At 40 °C for inside-delta circuit At 50 °C for inside-delta circuit SD1) Article No. Price PU PS*
Opera- Operating power for Opera- Rating [hp] for three-phase motors per PU (UNIT,
tional cur- three-phase motors tional cur- SET, M)
rent At At At rent At At At At
230 V 400 V 500 V 200/208 V 220/230 V 460/480 V 575/600 V
A kW kW kW A hp hp hp hp d
Operational voltage 200 ... 480 V
196 55 110 -- 175 50 60 125 -- 5 3RW5234-@@C@4 1 1 unit
248 75 132 -- 222 75 75 150 -- 5 3RW5235-@@C@4 1 1 unit
296 90 160 -- 265 75 100 200 -- 5 3RW5236-@@C@4 1 1 unit
364 110 200 -- 322 100 125 250 -- 5 3RW5243-@@C@4 1 1 unit
433 132 250 -- 381 125 150 300 -- 5 3RW5244-@@C@4 1 1 unit
546 160 315 -- 483 150 200 400 -- 5 3RW5245-@@C@4 1 1 unit
641 200 355 -- 568 200 200 450 -- 5 3RW5246-@@C@4 1 1 unit
814 250 400 -- 721 250 250 600 -- 5 3RW5247-@@C@4 1 1 unit
987 315 560 -- 873 300 350 750 -- 5 3RW5248-@@C@4 1 1 unit

Type of electrical connection for the control circuit


Spring-loaded terminals 2
Screw terminals 6
Product function
Analog output A
Thermistor motor protection T
Control supply voltage 0
24 V AC/DC 1
110 ... 250 V AC Note:
1) 3RW52 soft starter with screw terminals for operational voltage up to 480 V: For the constraints
constraintsfor
forthe
themotor
motoroutputs
outputsspecified
specified here, see
here,
Standard delivery time SD = 1 day (d).
page 6/8. 7/7.
see page

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/67


* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
6/68 Siemens IC 10 · 2020 Illustrations are approximate
Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
General Performance Soft Starters General Performance Soft Starters
3RW52 soft starters > Inside-delta circuit IE3/IE4 ready
3RW52 soft starters > Inside-delta circuit

For normal starting (CLASS 10A)

3RW521. 3RW522. 3RW523. 3RW524.

At 40 °C for inside-delta circuit At 50 °C for inside-delta circuit SD1) Article No. Price PU PS*
Opera- Operating power for Opera- Rating [hp] for three-phase motors per PU (UNIT,
tional cur- three-phase motors tional cur- SET, M)
rent At At At rent At At At At
230 V 400 V 500 V 200/208 V 220/230 V 460/480 V 575/600 V
A kW kW kW A hp hp hp hp d
Operational voltage 200 ... 600 V
22.5 5.5 11 15 19.9 5 5 10 15 5 3RW5213-@@C@5 1 1 unit
31.5 7.5 15 18.5 28 7.5 7.5 20 25 5 3RW5214-@@C@5 1 1 unit
43.3 11 18.5 22 39 10 10 25 30 5 3RW5215-@@C@5 1 1 unit

6
55.4 15 22 30 49 15 15 30 40 5 3RW5216-@@C@5 1 1 unit
65.8 18.5 30 37 58 15 20 40 50 5 3RW5217-@@C@5 1 1 unit
81.4 22 45 45 72 20 25 50 60 5 3RW5224-@@C@5 1 1 unit
109 30 55 55 96 30 30 75 75 5 3RW5225-@@C@5 1 1 unit
133 37 75 90 118 30 40 75 100 5 3RW5226-@@C@5 1 1 unit
161 45 90 110 143 40 50 100 125 5 3RW5227-@@C@5 1 1 unit

Type of electrical connection for the control circuit


Screw terminals 1
Spring-loaded terminals 3
Product function
Analog output A
Thermistor motor protection T
Control supply voltage 0
24 V AC/DC 1
110 ... 250 V AC Note:
1) 3RW52 soft starter with screw terminals for operational voltage up to 600 V: the constraints
For the constraintsfor
forthe
themotor
motoroutputs
outputsspecified
specified here, see
here,
Standard delivery time SD = 2 days (d). see
pagepage
6/8.7/7.
7

At 40 °C for inside-delta circuit At 50 °C for inside-delta circuit SD1) Article No. Price PU PS*
SOFT STARTERS

Opera- Operating power for Opera- Rating [hp] for three-phase motors per PU (UNIT,
tional cur- three-phase motors tional cur- SET, M)
rent At At At rent At At At At
230 V 400 V 500 V 200/208 V 220/230 V 460/480 V 575/600 V
A kW kW kW A hp hp hp hp d
Operational voltage 200 ... 600 V
196 55 110 132 175 50 60 125 150 5 3RW5234-@@C@5 1 1 unit
248 75 132 160 222 75 75 150 200 5 3RW5235-@@C@5 1 1 unit
296 90 160 200 265 75 100 200 250 5 3RW5236-@@C@5 1 1 unit
364 110 200 250 322 100 125 250 300 5 3RW5243-@@C@5 1 1 unit
433 132 250 315 381 125 150 300 350 5 3RW5244-@@C@5 1 1 unit
546 160 315 355 483 150 200 400 500 5 3RW5245-@@C@5 1 1 unit
641 200 355 450 568 200 200 450 600 5 3RW5246-@@C@5 1 1 unit
814 250 400 500 721 250 250 600 800 5 3RW5247-@@C@5 1 1 unit
987 315 560 630 873 300 350 750 950 5 3RW5248-@@C@5 1 1 unit

Type of electrical connection for the control circuit


Spring-loaded terminals 2
Screw terminals 6
Product function
Analog output A
Thermistor motor protection T
Control supply voltage 0
24 V AC/DC 1
110 ... 250 V AC
1)
3RW52 soft starter with screw terminals for operational voltage up to 600 V:
Note:
Standard delivery time SD = 2 days (d). For the constraints
constraintsfor
forthe
themotor
motoroutputs
outputsspecified
specifiedhere,
here, see
page 6/8. 7/7.
see page

7/68 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
General Performance
General Performance Soft Starters
Soft Starters
3RW52
3RW52soft
softstarters
starters>>Accessories
Accessories

Selection and ordering data


Product Manufacturer's Arti- Type of Application SD Article No. Price PU PS*
designation cle No. of the soft product per PU (UNIT,
starter SET, M)
d
Fan covers
Fan cover 3RW5216/17 (1x), -- -- } 3RW5983-0FC00 1 1 unit
3RW5226/27 (2x),
3RW523 (2x)
3RW524 (1x) -- -- } 3RW5984-0FC00 1 1 unit
3RW5983-0FC00
Terminal covers
Terminal 3RW522 (2x), -- -- } 3RW5983-0TC20 1 1 unit
cover 3RW523 (2x)

3RW5983-0TC20

3RW524 (2x) -- -- } 3RW5984-0TC20 1 1 unit


6

3RW5984-0TC20

Enclosure components
Hinged cover 3RW52 With cutout for -- } 3RW5950-0GL30 1 1 unit
High Feature
HMI module

3RW5950-0GL30

7
With cutout for -- } 3RW5950-0GL40 1 1 unit
Standard HMI

SOFT STARTERS
module

3RW5950-0GL40

Communication modules
Communica- 3RW52 PROFINET -- } 3RW5980-0CS00 1 1 unit
tion module Standard
PROFIBUS -- } 3RW5980-0CP00 1 1 unit
EtherNet/IP -- } 3RW5980-0CE00 1 1 unit

3RW5980-0CS00

Modbus RTU -- } 3RW5980-0CR00 1 1 unit


Modbus TCP -- } 3RW5980-0CT00 1 1 unit

3RW5980-0CR00

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/69


* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
6/70 Siemens IC 10 · 2020 Illustrations are approximate
Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
General Performance Soft Starters General Performance Soft Starters
3RW52 soft starters > Accessories
3RW52 soft starters > Accessories

Product Manufacturer's Arti- Type of Application SD Article No. Price PU PS*


designation cle No. of the soft product per PU (UNIT,
starter SET, M)
d
HMI modules
HMI module 3RW52 High Feature -- } 3RW5980-0HF00 1 1 unit

3RW5980-0HF00
Standard -- } 3RW5980-0HS00 1 1 unit

3RW5980-0HS00
IP65 door 3RW52 IP65 For HMI } 3RW5980-0HD00 1 1 unit
mounting kit modules
for HMI
modules

6
3RW5980-0HD00
Connecting cables
HMI 3RW52 5 m, round For door } 3RW5980-0HC60 1 1 unit
connection 2.5 m, round mounting } 3UF7933-0BA00-0 1 1 unit
cable
1.0 m, round } 3UF7937-0BA00-0 1 1 unit
0.5 m, round } 3UF7932-0BA00-0 1 1 unit

3UF793.-0BA00-0
7

0.1 m, flat for mounting in } 3UF7931-0AA00-0 1 1 unit


the device
SOFT STARTERS

3UF7931-0AA00-0
Further accessories
Push-in lugs -- Two lugs are For HMI 2 3ZY1311-0AA00 1 10 units
for wall required per modules and
mounting device communica-
tion modules

3ZY1311-0AA00
Blank labels
Unit labeling -- 20 mm x For SIRIUS 20 3RT2900-1SB20 100 340 units
plates1) 7 mm, devices
titanium gray
IC01_00181

3RT2900-1SB20
1)
PC labeling systems for individual inscription of unit labeling plates are
available from: murrplastik Systemtechnik GmbH (see page 16/15).

7/70 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
Basic Performance
Basic Performance Soft Starters
Soft Starters
3RW50
3RW50soft
softstarters
starters>>General
Generaldata
data NEW NEU

■ Overview
More information
Homepage, www.siemens.com/soft-starter
Homepage, see www.usa.siemens.com/soft-starter Simulation
Simulation Tool
Tool for
for Soft
Soft Starters
Starters (STS),
(STS), see
see page
page 6/8
7/7 or
or
Industry Mall,
Mall, see
see www.siemens.com/product?3RW50
www.siemens.com/product?3RW50 https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
TIA Selection
Industry Tool
Online Cloud (SIOS)
Support (TST Cloud), see see
topic page, SIRIUS Soft
SIRIUS Soft Starter
Starter ES
ES(TIA
(TIA Portal)
Portal),for
see page 14/5 see page 14/5
diagnostics,
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109747404
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109747404

SIRIUS 3RW50 Basic Performance soft starters are the compact


solution for standard applications. With two-phase motor control,
they cover the performance range from 75 to 300HP @ 480V.
Optional HMI modules for installation in the control cabinet door,
laterally mountable communication modules (PROFINET,
PROFIBUS, EtherNet/IP and Modbus) and either an analog
output or thermistor motor protection ensure maximum flexibility.
With their modern hybrid switching technology, the
SIRIUS 3RW50 soft starters offer efficient switching for
long-term, energy-saving use.
6

5 1 3RW50 soft starter


6

2 HMI modules
3 Communication modules
4
4 Box terminal blocks
5 Terminal covers for box terminals
6 Terminal covers for cable lugs
and busbar connections
1
7 Fan cover
8 Push-in lugs for wall mounting
9 IP65 door mounting kit

3 10 HMI soft starter connection cable

7
11 COM connecting cable
IC01_00571

SOFT STARTERS
7 8

2
9
4

5 6

10

3RW50
3RW50 Basic
Basic Performance soft starters with accessories (see page
accessories (see page7/81),
6/82),for
forexpansion
expansionwith
withHMI
HMImodule
moduleororcommunication
communicationmodule
module

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/71

6/72 Siemens IC 10 · 2020


Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
Basic Performance Soft Starters Basic Performance Soft Starters
3RW50 soft starters > General data NEW NEU
3RW50 soft starters > General data

■ Benefits

6
Product characteristics / function Performance features / benefits

Hybrid switching devices and two-phase motor control Minimum power loss and optimized motor control by avoiding DC components

Small and compact design Space-saving, clearly arranged control panel layout

TIA-Integration – communication modules and HMI modules optional Efficient configuration and maximum flexibility in automation engineering
7

Motor overload and intrinsic device protection without additional wiring Adjustable trip classes, integrated diagnostics functions
SOFT STARTERS

Soft Torque Reduced mechanical loading and optimum pump stop

Parameterization using potentiometers Simple and fast commissioning

Wide range for control supply and main voltage Low variance, high system availability even with weak supply networks

Certified according to ATEX/IECEx directive Suitable for the starting of explosion-proof motors with "increased safety" type
of protection

7/72 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

Siemens IC 10 · 2020 6/73


Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
Basic Performance
Basic Performance Soft Starters
Soft Starters
3RW50
3RW50soft
softstarters
starters>>General
Generaldata
data NEW NEU

■ Technical specifications
More information
Technical specifications,see
Technical specifications, see FAQs,
FAQs, see
see https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/25252/faq
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/25252/faq
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/25252/td
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/25252/td Simulation Tool
Simulation Tool for
for Soft
Soft Starters
Starters (STS),
(STS), see
see page
page 6/8
7/7 or
or
Equipment Manual
Manual “SIRIUS
"SIRIUS 3RW50 Soft Starters",
Starter”, see
see https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109753750
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109753750

Type 3RW5055 3RW5072


3RW5056 3RW5073
3RW5074
3RW5075
3RW5076
3RW5077
Installation/fixing/dimensions
Width x height x depth mm 120 × 198 × 249 160 × 230 × 282
H

Type of mounting Screw fixing


Mounting position For vertical mounting surface can be rotated +/- 90°,
for vertical mounting surface can be tilted +/- 22.5° forward or backward
6

Distance to be maintained with side-by-side mounting


• Above mm 100
• At the side mm 5
• Below mm 75
Maximum installation altitude above sea level1) m 5 000
Degree of protection IP00
Ambient conditions
Ambient temperature
• During operation2) °C -25 ... +60
• During storage and transport °C -40 ... +80
Environmental category according to IEC 60721
• During operation 3K6 (no ice formation, only occasional condensation), 3C3 (no salt mist),
3S2 (sand must not get into the devices), 3M6
• During storage 1K6 (only occasional condensation), 1C2 (no salt mist),
1S2 (sand must not enter the devices), 1M4

7
• During transport 2K2, 2C1, 2S1, 2M2 (max. height of fall 0.3 m)
1)
Derating from 11 000
000 m,
m,see
seecharacteristic
characteristiccurve
curveon
onpage
page6/8.
7/7.

SOFT STARTERS
2) Note derating above 40 °C.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/73

6/74 Siemens IC 10 · 2020


Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
Basic Performance Soft Starters Basic Performance Soft Starters
3RW50 soft starters > General data NEW NEU
3RW50 soft starters > General data

Type 3RW50..-..B0. 3RW50..-..B1.


Control circuit/control
Control supply voltage
• At AC/DC, rated value V 24/24 --/--
• At AC V -- 110 ... 250
• Relative negative tolerance/relative positive tolerance with AC % -20/20 -15/10
• Relative negative tolerance/relative positive tolerance with DC % -20/20 --/--
Frequency of the control supply voltage Hz 50 ... 60
• Relative negative tolerance/relative positive tolerance % -10/10
Type of overvoltage protection Varistors
Type of short-circuit protection for control circuit1) Fuse 4 A gG (Icu = 1 kA), fuse 6 A quick-response (Icu = 1 kA),
MCB C1 (Icu = 600 A), MCB C6 (Icu = 300 A)
1) Not included in scope of supply

Type 3RW50..-..B.4 3RW50..-..B.5


Power electronics
Operational voltage, rated value V 200 ... 480 200 ... 600
• Relative negative tolerance/relative positive tolerance % -15/10
Operating frequency, rated value Hz 50 ... 60
• Relative negative tolerance/relative positive tolerance % -10/10

6
Minimum load [% of IM]1) % 15
Maximum cable length between soft starter and motor m 800
1)
Relative to the smallest adjustable Ie.
7
SOFT STARTERS

7/74 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

Siemens IC 10 · 2020 6/75


Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
Basic Performance
Basic Performance Soft Starters
Soft Starters
3RW50
3RW50soft
softstarters
starters>>General
Generaldata
data NEW NEU

Type 3RW5055 3RW5056


Rated operational current Ie A 143 171
Power electronics
Load rating with rated operational current Ie
IEC + UL/CSA, individual mounting at 40/50/60 °C, A 143/128/118 171/153/141
AC-53a
Permissible rated motor current and starts/h
Normal starting (CLASS 10A)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 143/128/118 171/153/141
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM - Start-up time 5 s 1/h 43 43
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 18 18
• 350% IM - Start-up time 5 s 1/h 28 28
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 10 9
Normal starting (CLASS 10E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 143/128/118 171/153/141
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM - Start-up time 20 s 1/h 21 21
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 8 8
• 350% IM - Start-up time 20 s 1/h 12 9
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 4 --
Heavy starting (CLASS 20E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 108/98/88 135/123/111
6

ON period = 70%; motor protection activated


• 300% IM - Start-up time 20 s 1/h 10 10
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 4 4
• 350% IM - Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 2.5 2.5
Adjustable rated motor current IM
• Minimum/maximum A 68/143 81/117

Type 10
3RW5072 3RW5073 3RW5074 3RW5075 3RW5076 3RW5077
Rated operational current Ie A 210 250 315 370 470 570
Power electronics
Load rating with rated operational current Ie
IEC + UL/CSA, individual mounting at 40/50/60 °C, A 210/186/170 250/220/200 315/279/255 370/328/300 470/416/380 570/504/460
AC-53a
Permissible rated motor current and starts/h
Normal starting (CLASS 10A)

7
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 210/186/170 250/220/200 315/279/255 370/328/300 470/416/380 570/504/460
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated

SOFT STARTERS
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 43 43 43 43 43 28
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 18 18 18 18 18 11
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 5 s 1/h 28 28 28 28 28 16
- Start-up time 10 s 1/h 8 10 10 10 10 4
Normal starting (CLASS 10E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 210/186/170 250/220/200 315/279/255 370/328/300 470/416/380 570/504/460
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 21 21 21 21 20 21
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 8 8 8 8 7 8
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 8 13 12 13 12 13
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h -- 4 4 4 2 4
Heavy starting (CLASS 20E)
Rated motor current IM, Tu = 40/50/60 °C A 162/146/130 200/180/160 219/195/171 258/230/202 272/254/218 284/262/240
ON period = 70%; motor protection activated
• 300% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 10 10 10 10 10 10
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 4 4 4 4 4 4
• 350% IM
- Start-up time 20 s 1/h 7 7 7 7 7 7
- Start-up time 40 s 1/h 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5
Adjustable rated motor current IM
• Minimum/maximum A 90/210 100/250 135/315 160/370 200/470 240/570

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/75

6/76 Siemens IC 10 · 2020


Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Basic Performance Soft Starters SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
Basic Performance Soft Starters
3RW50 soft starters > General data
NEW NEU
3RW50 soft starters > General data
Motor feeders according to IEC with 3VA motor starter protectors/circuit breakers (without semiconductor protection)
Type of coordination "1", CLASS 10,
short-circuit breaking capacity Iq in kA, see table
Note:
For general
For generalrecommendations
recommendationsforforconstructing
constructing motor
motor feeders
feeders
soft starters,
with soft starters, see
seepage
page7/9.
6/10.

Q1

Q11
NSB0_01902

M
3~

Soft starters Motor starter protectors


for 400 V systems for 500 V systems
Q11 Q1 Iq Q1 Iq
Type Type kA Type kA
Type of Inline circuit

6
ToC
coordina- 1
tion "1"
3RW5055 3VA2220-7MN32-0AA0 20 3VA2220-7MN32-0AA0 20
3RW5056 3VA2220-7MN32-0AA0 20 3VA2220-7MN32-0AA0 20
3RW5072 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65
3RW5073 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65
3RW5074 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65 3VA2440-7MN32-0AA0 65
3RW5075 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65
3RW5076 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65
3RW5077 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65 3VA2580-6HN32-0AA0 65

Note:
The service factor or measurement inaccuracies have been
taken into account, for example, for the selection of the specified
motor starter protectors/circuit breakers; the specified short-
circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are covered by combination
tests. Smaller motor starter protectors/circuit breakers than
7

those specified can be used at any time as smaller ones trip


more quickly in the event of a short circuit (unchanged short-
circuit breaking capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any
SOFT STARTERS

case. The dimensioning of the short-circuit components must,


however, be suitable for the connected three-phase motor and
the line protection for the cables used.

7/76 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
Basic Performance Soft Starters
Basic Performance Soft Starters
3RW50 soft starters > General data
3RW50 soft starters > General data NEW NEU

Motor feeders according to IEC with 3NA3 fuses


gG class full-range fuses for cable and line protection according
to IEC 60269-2, without semiconductor protection
Type of coordination "1",
short-circuit breaking capacity Iq = 65 kA
Note:
For general
generalrecommendations
recommendationsforforconstructing
constructing motor
motor feeders
feeders
with soft starters,
starters, see
see page
page7/9.
6/10.

F1

Q21

Q11
NSB0_01904

M
3~

Soft starters gG class fuse Line contactor (optional)


for systems for systems for systems
up to 600 V up to 480 V up to 600 V
6

Q11 F1 Q21 Q21


Type Type Type Type
Type of ToC Inline circuit
coordina- 1
tion "1"
3RW5055 3NA3244-6 3RT1055 3RT1055
3RW5056 3NA3244-6 3RT1056 3RT1064
3RW5072 2 x 3NA3354-6 3RT1064 3RT1064
3RW5073 2 x 3NA3354-6 3RT1065 3RT1065
3RW5074 2 x 3NA3365-6 3RT1075 3RT1075
3RW5075 2 x 3NA3365-6 3RT1075 3RT1075
3RW5076 2 x 3NA3365-6 3RT1076 3RT1076
3RW5077 2 x 3NA3365-6 3TF68 3TF68

Note:
The specified short-circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are
covered by combination tests. Smaller fuses than those speci-

7
fied can be used at any time as smaller ones trip more quickly in
the event of a short circuit (unchanged short-circuit breaking

SOFT STARTERS
capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any case. The
dimensioning of the short-circuit components must, however, be
suitable for the connected three-phase motor and the line
protection for the cables used.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/77


Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Basic Performance Soft Starters SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
Basic Performance Soft Starters
3RW50 soft starters > General data
NEW NEU
3RW50 soft starters > General data
Motor feeders according to IEC with 3NE1 SITOR fuses
gR class full-range fuses for semiconductor protection, cable
and line protection
Type of coordination "2",
short-circuit breaking capacity Iq = 65 kA
Note:
For general
For generalrecommendations
recommendationsforfor constructing
constructing motor
motor feeders
feeders
with soft
with soft starters,
starters,see
seepage
page7/9.
6/10.

F’1

Q21

Q11
NSB0_01905

M
3~

Soft starters gG class fuse Line contactor (optional)


for systems for systems for systems

6
up to 600 V up to 480 V up to 600 V
Q11 F’1 Q21 Q21
Type Type Type Type
Type of ToC Inline circuit
coordina- 2
tion "2"
3RW5055 3NE1227-0 3RT1055 3RT1055
3RW5056 3NE1230-0 3RT1056 3RT1064
3RW5072 3NE1230-2 3RT1064 3RT1064
3RW5073 3NE1331-0 3RT1065 3RT1065
3RW5074 3NE1333-2 3RT1075 3RT1075
3RW5075 3NE1334-2 3RT1075 3RT1075
3RW5076 3NE1436-2 3RT1076 3RT1076
3RW5077 3NE1437-2 3TF68 3TF68

Note:
The specified short-circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are
7

covered by combination tests. Smaller fuses than those speci-


fied can be used at any time as smaller ones trip more quickly in
the event of a short circuit (unchanged short-circuit breaking
SOFT STARTERS

capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any case. The
dimensioning of the short-circuit components must, however, be
suitable for the connected three-phase motor and the line
protection for the cables used.

7/78 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
Basic Performance Soft Starters
Basic Performance Soft Starters
3RW50 soft starters > General data
3RW50 soft starters > General data NEW NEU

Motor feeders according to IEC with 3NE3 fuses


aR class partial-range fuses for semiconductor protection
Type of coordination "2",
short-circuit breaking capacity Iq = 65 kA
Note:
For general
For generalrecommendations
recommendationsforforconstructing
constructing motor
motor feeders
feeders
soft starters,
with soft starters, see
seepage
page7/9.
6/10.

F1

Q21
F3

Q11
NSB0_01906

M
3~

Soft starters gG class fuse aR class fuse Line contactor (optional)


for systems for systems for systems for systems
6

up to 600 V up to 600 V up to 480 V up to 600 V


Q11 F1 F3 Q21 Q21
Type Type Type Type Type
Type of ToC Inline circuit
coordina- 2
tion "2"
3RW5055 3NA3244-6 3NE3334-0B 3RT1055 3RT1055
3RW5056 3NA3244-6 3NE3335 3RT1056 3RT1064
3RW5072 2 x 3NA3354-6 3NE3333 3RT1064 3RT1064
3RW5073 2 x 3NA3354-6 3NE3335 3RT1065 3RT1065
3RW5074 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NE3335 3RT1075 3RT1075
3RW5075 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NE3336 3RT1075 3RT1075
3RW5076 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NE3340-8 3RT1076 3RT1076
3RW5077 2 x 3NA3365-6 3NE3340-8 3TF68 3TF68

Note:
The specified short-circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are
covered by combination tests. Smaller fuses than those speci-

7
fied can be used at any time as smaller ones trip more quickly in
the event of a short circuit (unchanged short-circuit breaking

SOFT STARTERS
capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any case. The
dimensioning of the short-circuit components must, however, be
suitable for the connected three-phase motor and the line
protection for the cables used.
For CLASS 10 applications, as an
applications, as an alternative
alternativeto
tothe
thegG gGclass
class
full-range fuses
full-range fuses for
for cable
cableand
andline
lineprotection
protection3NA3
3NA3(F1),(F1),
circuit breakers
3VA circuit breakers can
canalso
alsobe
beused,
used,possibly
possiblywith
withreduced
reduced
short-circuit breaking
breaking capacity
capacity(see
(seepage
page7/76).
6/77).InInthese
thesecases
cases,
optional line
optional line contactors
contactors can
can be
bedispensed
dispensedwith.
with.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/79


Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
Basic Performance Soft Starters Basic Performance Soft Starters
3RW50 soft starters > Inline circuit IE3/IE4 ready NEW NEU
3RW50 soft starters > Inline circuit

Selection and ordering data

For normal starting (CLASS 10E)

3RW5055 3RW5075

At 40 °C At 50 °C Size SD1) Article No. Price PU PS*


Opera- Operating power for Opera- Rating [hp] for three-phase motors per PU (UNIT,
tional three-phase motors tional SET, M)
current At At At current At At At At
230 V 400 V 500 V 200/208 V 220/230 V 460/480 V 575/600 V
A kW kW kW A hp hp hp hp d
Operational voltage 200 ... 480 V
143 37 75 90 128 30 30 100 -- S6 5 3RW5055-@@B@4 1 1 unit
171 45 90 110 153 30 40 100 -- S6 5 3RW5056-@@B@4 1 1 unit

6
210 55 110 132 186 40 50 150 -- S12 5 3RW5072-@@B@4 1 1 unit
250 75 132 160 220 50 60 150 -- S12 5 3RW5073-@@B@4 1 1 unit
315 90 160 200 279 60 75 200 -- S12 5 3RW5074-@@B@4 1 1 unit
370 110 200 250 328 75 100 250 -- S12 5 3RW5075-@@B@4 1 1 unit
470 132 250 315 416 100 125 350 -- S12 5 3RW5076-@@B@4 1 1 unit
570 160 315 355 504 125 150 400 -- S12 5 3RW5077-@@B@4 1 1 unit

Type of electrical connection for the control circuit


Spring-loaded terminals 2
Screw terminals 6
Product function
Analog output A
Thermistor motor protection T
Control supply voltage
0
24 V AC/DC
1
110 ... 250 V AC
1)
3RW50 soft starter with screw terminals for operational voltage up to 480 V: Note: For the
the constraints
constraintsfor
forthe
themotor
motoroutputs
outputsspecified
specified here,
here,
Standard delivery time SD = 1 day (d).
7

see page
page 7/7.
6/8.
SOFT STARTERS

At 40 °C At 50 °C Size SD1) Article No. Price PU PS*


Opera- Operating power for Opera- Rating [hp] for three-phase motors per PU (UNIT,
tional three-phase motors tional SET, M)
current At At At current At At At At
230 V 400 V 500 V 200/208 V 220/230 V 460/480 V 575/600 V
A kW kW kW A hp hp hp hp d
Operational voltage 200 ... 600 V
143 37 75 90 128 30 30 100 75 S6 5 3RW5055-@@B@5 1 1 unit
171 45 90 110 153 30 40 100 100 S6 5 3RW5056-@@B@5 1 1 unit
210 55 110 132 186 40 50 150 125 S12 5 3RW5072-@@B@5 1 1 unit
250 75 132 160 220 50 60 150 150 S12 5 3RW5073-@@B@5 1 1 unit
315 90 160 200 279 60 75 200 200 S12 5 3RW5074-@@B@5 1 1 unit
370 110 200 250 328 75 100 250 250 S12 5 3RW5075-@@B@5 1 1 unit
470 132 250 315 416 100 125 350 300 S12 5 3RW5076-@@B@5 1 1 unit
570 160 315 355 504 125 150 400 400 S12 5 3RW5077-@@B@5 1 1 unit

Type of electrical connection for the control circuit


Spring-loaded terminals 2
Screw terminals 6
Product function
Analog output A
Thermistor motor protection T
Control supply voltage
24 V AC/DC 0
110 ... 250 V AC 1
1)
3RW50 soft starter with screw terminals for operational voltage up to 600 V: Note: For
For the
the constraints
constraintsfor
forthe
themotor
motoroutputs
outputsspecified
specified here,
Standard delivery time SD = 2 days (d).
here,
see page
see page7/7.
6/8.

7/80 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2020 6/81
Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
Basic Performance
Basic Performance Soft Starters
Soft Starters
3RW50
3RW50soft
softstarters
starters>>Accessories
Accessories

■ Selection and ordering data


Product Manufacturer's Type of Application SD Article No. Price PU PS* PG
designation Article No. product per PU (UNIT,
of the soft starter SET, M)
d
Fan covers
Fan cover 3RW50 (1x) -- -- } 3RW5985-0FC00 1 1 unit 42S

3RW5985-0FC00
Box terminal block
Box terminal 3RW505 (2x) Up to 70 mm2 -- } 3RT1955-4G 1 1 unit 41B
block for round Up to 120 mm2 } 3RT1956-4G 1 1 unit 41B
and ribbon
cables 3RW507 (2x) Up to 240 mm2 } 3RT1966-4G 1 1 unit 41B
(with auxiliary
conductor
3RT1956-4G connection)
Terminal covers
Covers for 3RW505 (2x) -- -- } 3RT1956-4EA2 1 1 unit 41B
box terminals 3RW507 (2x) -- -- 2 3RT1966-4EA2 1 1 unit 41B
6

3RT1956-4EA2
Covers for 3RW505 (2x) -- -- } 3RT1956-4EA1 1 1 unit 41B
cable lugs and 3RW507 (2x) -- -- 2 3RT1966-4EA1 1 1 unit 41B
busbar
connections

3RT1956-4EA1
Communication modules
Communica- 3RW50 PROFINET -- } 3RW5980-0CS00 1 1 unit 42S
tion module Standard
PROFIBUS } 3RW5980-0CP00 1 1 unit 42S

7
EtherNet/IP } 3RW5980-0CE00 1 1 unit 42S
Modbus RTU } 3RW5980-0CR00 1 1 unit 42S
}

SOFT STARTERS
Modbus TCP 3RW5980-0CT00 1 1 unit 42S

3RW5980-0CS00
COM 3RW50 0.3 m -- } 3RW5900-0CC00 1 1 unit 42S
connection
cable
3RW5900-0CC00 For mounting
laterally on the
device

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/81


* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
6/82 Siemens IC 10 · 2020 Illustrations are approximate
Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
Basic Performance Soft Starters Basic Performance Soft Starters
3RW50 soft starters > Accessories 3RW50 soft starters > Accessories

Product Manufacturer's Type of Application SD Article No. Price PU PS* PG


designation Article No. product per PU (UNIT,
of the soft starter SET, M)
d
HMI modules
HMI module 3RW50 High Feature -- } 3RW5980-0HF00 1 1 unit 42S

3RW5980-0HF00
Standard -- } 3RW5980-0HS00 1 1 unit 42S

3RW5980-0HS00
IP65 door 3RW50 IP65 For HMI } 3RW5980-0HD00 1 1 unit 42S
mounting kit modules
for HMI
modules

6
3RW5980-0HD00
Connecting cables
HMI 3RW50 5 m, round For door } 3RW5980-0HC60 1 1 unit 42S
connection 2.5 m, round mounting } 3UF7933-0BA00-0 1 1 unit 42J
cable
1.0 m, round } 3UF7937-0BA00-0 1 1 unit 42J
0.5 m, round } 3UF7932-0BA00-0 1 1 unit 42J

3UF793.-0BA00-0
7

Further accessories
Push-in lugs -- Two lugs are For HMI 2 3ZY1311-0AA00 1 10 units 41L
SOFT STARTERS

for wall required per modules


mounting device and com-
munication
modules
3ZY1311-0AA00
Blank labels
Unit labeling -- 20 mm x 7 mm, For SIRIUS 20 3RT2900-1SB20 100 340 units 41B
plates1) titanium gray devices
IC01_00181

3RT2900-1SB20
1) PC labeling systems for individual inscription of unit labeling plates are
available from: murrplastik Systemtechnik GmbH (see page 16/15).

7/82 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2020 6/83
Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
Basic Performance
Basic Performance Soft Starters
Soft Starters
3RW40
3RW40soft
softstarters
starters>>General
Generaldata
data

Overview
More information
Homepage, www.siemens.com/soft-starter
Homepage, see www.usa.siemens.com/soft-starter TIA
TIA Selection
Selection Tool Cloud
Cloud (TST Cloud), see
Industry Mall,
Mall, see
see www.siemens.com/product?3RW40
www.siemens.com/product?3RW40 https://www.siemens.com/tstcloud/?node=3rw40
https://www.siemens.com/tstcloud/?node=3rw40
Simulation Tool
Simulation Tool for
for Soft
Soft Starters
Starters (STS),
(STS), see
see page
page 6/8
7/7 or
or
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917

The SIRIUS 3RW40 Basic Performance soft starters are suitable


for soft starting and stopping of three-phase asynchronous
motors.
Thanks to two-phase control, not only is the current kept at
minimum values in all three phases throughout the entire starting
time, but disturbing direct current components are also
eliminated. This not only enables the two-phase starting of
motors from 7.5 to 75HP @ 480V but also avoids the current and
torque peaks which occur e.g. with wye-delta starters.
The SIRIUS 3RW40 soft starters are suitable for the starting of
explosion-proof motors with "increased safety" type of protection
EEx e according to ATEX Directive 94/9/EC.
6

2 1 3RW40 soft starter

2 Link module to motor starter protector


3 Terminal cover for box terminals (S2, S3)
6
3 4 Terminal cover for
cable lug and busbar connections (S3)
5 Auxiliary terminal (S3)
5 6 Infeed terminal (S0)
4 7 Fan
8 Sealing cover

7
1

SOFT STARTERS
8
IC01_00539

3RW40 Basic
3RW40 Basic Performance
Performance soft starters with accessories
accessories (see
(see page
page7/92)
6/94)

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/83

6/84 Siemens IC 10 · 2020


Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
Basic Performance Soft Starters Basic Performance Soft Starters
3RW40 soft starters > General data 3RW40 soft starters > General data

■ Benefits

3RW402. 3RW403. 3RW404.

Product characteristics / function Performance features / benefits

Small and compact design Space-saving, clearly arranged control panel layout

Motor overload and intrinsic device protection without additional wiring Adjustable trip classes, integrated diagnostics functions

Integrated in the SIRIUS modular system Link modules to motor starter protectors

6
Hybrid switching devices and two-phase motor control Minimum power loss and optimized motor control by avoiding DC components

Certified according to ATEX Directive 94/9/EC Suitable for the starting of explosion-proof motors with "increased safety" type
of protection EEx e.

Optional thermistor motor protection Full motor protection


7
SOFT STARTERS

7/84 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

Siemens IC 10 · 2020 6/85


Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
Basic Performance
Basic Performance Soft Starters
Soft Starters
3RW40
3RW40soft
softstarters
starters>>General
Generaldata
data

Technical specifications
More information
Technical specifications,see
Technical specifications, see FAQs,
FAQs, see
see https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/25251/faq
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/25251/faq
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/25251/td
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/25252/td Simulation Tool
Simulation Tool for
for Soft
Soft Starters
Starters (STS),
(STS), see
see page
page 6/8
7/7 or
Equipment Manual
Manual “SIRIUS
"SIRIUS 3RW30/3RW40 SoftStarters",
3RW30/3RW40 Soft Starter”, see
see https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/38752095
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/38752095

Type 3RW402. 3RW403. 3RW404.


Mechanics and environment
Mounting dimensions (W x H x D)
• Screw terminals mm 45 x 125 x 154 55 x 144 x 170 70 x 160 x 188
• Spring-loaded terminals mm 45 x 150 x 154 55 x 144 x 170 70 x 160 x 188
H

D
W

Permissible ambient temperature


During operation °C -25 ... +60; (derating from +40)
During storage °C -40 ... +80
Weight kg 0.77 1.35 1.9
Permissible mounting position1)
• With auxiliary fan 22,5° 22,5°

NSB0_00649a
(for 3RW402. ... 3RW404.) 90° 90°
6

• Without auxiliary fan 10° 10°


(for 3RW402. ... 3RW404.) 10° 10°

Installation type1) Stand-alone NSB0_01897


installation

Permissible installation altitude m 5 000


(Derating from 1 000,
000, see
seecharacteristic
characteristiccurve
curveononpage
page6/8)
7/7)
Degree of protection IP00

7
1) In the case of deviations, please observe derating, see Equipment Manual
in the chapter "Configuring".

SOFT STARTERS
Type Terminal 3RW402., 3RW403., 3RW404.
Control electronics
Rated values
Rated control supply voltage A1/A2 V 24 AC/DC 110 ... 230 AC/DC
• Tolerance % ± 20 -15/+10
Rated frequency Hz 50/60
• Tolerance % ± 10

Type 3RW402.-..B.4, 3RW402.-..B.5,


3RW403.-..B.4, 3RW403.-..B.5,
3RW404.-..B.4 3RW404.-..B.5
Power electronics
Rated operational voltage V AC 200 ... 480 400 ... 600
Tolerance % -15/+10
Maximum blocking voltage (thyristor) V AC 1 600
Rated frequency Hz 50/60
Tolerance % ± 10
Uninterrupted duty at 40 °C (% of Ie) % 115
Minimum load (% of smallest adjustable rated motor current IM) % 20 (at least 2 A)
Maximum cable length between soft starter and motor m 300

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/85

6/86 Siemens IC 10 · 2020


Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
Basic Performance Soft Starters Basic Performance Soft Starters
3RW40 soft starters > General data 3RW40 soft starters > General data

Type 3RW4024 3RW4026 3RW4027 3RW4028


Power electronics
Load rating with rated operational current Ie
• According to IEC and UL/CSA1), individual mounting at A 12.5/11/10 25.3/23/21 32.2/29/26 38/34/31
40/50/60 °C, AC-53a
Smallest adjustable rated motor current IM
For the motor overload protection A 5 10 17 23
Power loss
• In operation after completed starting with uninterrupted rated W 2 8 13 19
operational current (40 °C) approx.
• During starting with current limiting set to 300% IM (40 °C) W 68 188 220 256
Permissible rated motor current and starts per hour
• For normal starting (CLASS 10) at 40/50 °C
- Rated motor current IM2), start-up time 3 s A 12.5/11 25/23 32/29 38/34
- Starts per hour3) 1/h 50/50 23/23 23/23 19/19
- Rated motor current IM2), start-up time 4 s A 12.5/11 25/23 32/29 38/34
- Starts per hour3) 1/h 36/36 15/15 16/16 12/12
• For heavy starting (CLASS 20) at 40/50 °C
- Rated motor current IM2), start-up time 6 s A 10/9 21/19 27/24 31/28
- Starts per hour3) 1/h 47/47 21/21 20/20 18/18
- Rated motor current IM2), start-up time 8 s A 10/9 21/19 27/24 31/28
- Starts per hour3) 1/h 34/34 15/15 14/14 13/13
1) Measurement at 60 °C according to UL/CSA not required. 3) For intermittent duty S4 with ON period = 30%, Tu = 40/50 °C, stand-alone

6
2)
Current limiting on soft starter set to 300% IM, Tu = 40/50 °C. Maximum installation vertical. The quoted switching frequencies do not apply for
adjustable rated motor current IM dependent on CLASS setting. automatic mode. Factors for permissible switching frequency in other
mounting position, direct mounting, side-by-side mounting, and
implementation of optional auxiliary fan, see Equipment Manual in the
chapter "Configuring".

Type 3RW4036 3RW4037 3RW4038 3RW4046 3RW4047


Power electronics
Load rating with rated operational current Ie
• According to IEC and UL/CSA1), individual mounting at A 45/42/39 63/58/53 72/62.1/60 80/73/66 106/98/90
40/50/60 °C, AC-53a
Smallest adjustable rated motor current IM
For the motor overload protection A 23 26 35 43 46
Power loss
• In operation after completed starting with uninterrupted rated W 6 12 15 12 21
operational current (40 °C) approx.
• During starting with current limiting set to 300% IM (40 °C) W 316 444 500 576 768
Permissible rated motor current and starts per hour
7

• For normal starting (CLASS 10) at 40/50 °C


- Rated motor current IM2), start-up time 3 s A 45/42 63/58 72/62 80/73 106/98
- Starts per hour3) 1/h 38/38 23/23 22/22 22/22 15/15
SOFT STARTERS

- Rated motor current IM2), start-up time 4 s A 45/42 63/58 72/62 80/73 106/98
- Starts per hour3) 1/h 26/26 15/15 15/15 15/15 10/10
• For heavy starting (CLASS 20) at 40/50 °C
- Rated motor current IM2), start-up time 6 s A 38/34 46/42 50/46 64/58 77/70
- Starts per hour3) 1/h 30/30 31/31 34/34 23/23 23/23
- Rated motor current IM2), start-up time 8 s A 38/34 46/42 50/46 64/58 77/70
- Starts per hour3) 1/h 21/21 22/22 24/24 16/16 16/16
1) Measurement at 60 °C according to UL/CSA not required. 3) For intermittent duty S4 with ON period = 30%, Tu = 40/50 °C, stand-alone
2)
Current limiting on soft starter set to 300% IM, Tu = 40/50 °C. Maximum installation vertical. The quoted switching frequencies do not apply for
adjustable rated motor current IM dependent on CLASS setting. automatic mode. Factors for permissible switching frequency in other
mounting position, direct mounting, side-by-side mounting, and
implementation of optional auxiliary fan, see Equipment Manual in the
chapter "Configuring".

7/86 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

Siemens IC 10 · 2020 6/87


Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
Basic Performance Soft Starters
Basic Performance Soft Starters
3RW40 soft starters > General data
3RW40 soft starters > General data
Motor feeders according to IEC with 3RV2 motor starter protectors (without semiconductor protection)
Type of coordination "1", CLASS 10,
short-circuit breaking capacity Iq in kA, see table
Note:
For general
generalrecommendations
recommendationsforforconstructing
constructing motor
motor feeders
feeders
with soft starters,
starters, see
see page
page7/9.
6/10.

Q1

Q11
NSB0_01902

M
3~

Soft starters Motor starter protectors


for 400 V systems for 500 V systems
Q11 Q1 Iq Q1 Iq
Type Type kA Type kA
Type of Inline circuit
6

ToC
coordina- 1
tion "1"
3RW4024 3RV2021-4AA10 55 3RV2021-4AA10 10
3RW4026 3RV2021-4DA10 55 3RV2021-4DA10 10
3RW4027 3RV2021-4EA10 55 3RV2021-4EA10 10
3RW4028 3RV2021-4FA10 55 3RV2021-4FA10 10
3RW4036 3RV2031-4WA10 10 3RV2031-4WA10 10
3RW4037 3RV2031-4JA10 10 3RV2031-4JA10 5
3RW4038 3RV2031-4KA10 10 3RV2031-4KA10 5
3RW4046 3RV2041-4RA10 11 3RV2041-4YA10 5
3RW4047 3RV2041-4MA10 11 3RV2041-4MA10 5

Note:
The specified short-circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are
covered by combination tests. Smaller motor starter protec-
tors/circuit breakers than those specified can be used at any
time as smaller ones trip more quickly in the event of a short

7
circuit (unchanged short-circuit breaking capacity) and thus
protect the soft starter in any case. The dimensioning of the
short-circuit components must, however, be suitable for the

SOFT STARTERS
connected three-phase motor and the line protection for the
cables used.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/87


Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
Basic Performance Soft Starters
Basic Performance Soft Starters
3RW40 soft starters > General data
3RW40 soft starters > General data
Motor feeders according to IEC with 3NE1 SITOR fuses
gR class full-range fuses for semiconductor protection, cable
and line protection
Type of coordination "2",
short-circuit breaking capacity Iq = 65 kA
Note:
For general
generalrecommendations
recommendationsforforconstructing
constructing motor
motor feeders
feeders
with soft starters,
starters, see
see page
page7/9.
6/10.

F’1

Q21

Q11
NSB0_01905

M
3~

Soft starters gG class fuse Line contactor (optional)


for systems for systems for systems for systems
up to 600 V up to 400 V up to 480 V up to 600 V
6

Q11 F’1 Q21 Q21 Q21


Type Type Type Type Type
Type of ToC Inline circuit
coordina- 2
tion "2"
3RW4024 3NE1814-0 3RT2025 3RT2025/ 3RT2025
3RT2018
(in size S00)
3RW4026 3NE1803-0 3RT2026 3RT2027 3RT2037
3RW4027 3NE1020-2 3RT2027 3RT2028 3RT2037
3RW4028 3NE1020-2 3RT2028 3RT2035 3RT2037
3RW4036 3NE1020-2 3RT2036 3RT2036 3RT2038
3RW4037 3NE1820-0 3RT2037 3RT2037 3RT2046
3RW4038 3NE1820-0 3RT2038 3RT2038 3RT2046
3RW4046 3NE1021-0 3RT2045 3RT2045 3RT2047
3RW4047 3NE1022-0 3RT2047 3RT2047 3RT1054

Note:
7

The specified short-circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are


covered by combination tests. Smaller fuses than those speci-
SOFT STARTERS

fied can be used at any time as smaller ones trip more quickly in
the event of a short circuit (unchanged short-circuit breaking
capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any case. The
dimensioning of the short-circuit components must, however, be
suitable for the connected three-phase motor and the line
protection for the cables used.

7/88 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
Basic Performance Soft Starters Basic Performance Soft Starters
3RW40 soft starters > General data
3RW40 soft starters > General data
Motor feeders according to IEC with 3NE8 / 3NE4 / 3NE3 / 3NC fuses
aR class partial-range fuses for semiconductor protection
Type of coordination "2",
short-circuit breaking capacity Iq = 65 kA
Note:
For general recommendationsfor
general recommendations forconstructing
constructing motor
motor feeders
feeders
with soft starters, see page
starters, see page7/9.
6/10.

F1

Q21
F3

Q11
NSB0_01906

M
3~

Soft starters gG class fuse aR class fuse Cylindrical Line contactor (optional)
fuses

6
for systems up for systems up for systems up for systems up for systems for systems for systems for systems
to 600 V to 600 V to 600 V to 600 V up to 480 V up to 400 V up to 480 V up to 600 V
Q11 F1 F3 F3 F3 F3 Q21 Q21 Q21
Type Type Type Type Type Type Type Type Type
Type of ToC Inline circuit
coordina- 2
tion "2"
3RW4024 3NA3820-6 -- 3NE4101 3NE8015-1 3NC2240 3RT2025 3RT2025/ 3RT2025
3RT2018
(in size S00)
3RW4026 3NA3822-6 -- 3NE4102 3NE8017-1 3NC2263 3RT2026 3RT2027 3RT2037
3RW4027 3NA3824-6 -- 3NE4118 3NE8018-1 3NC2280 3RT2027 3RT2028 3RT2037
3RW4028 3NA3824-6 -- 3NE4118 3NE8020-1 3NC2280 3RT2028 3RT2035 3RT2037
3RW4036 3NA3130-6 -- 3NE4120 3NE8020-1 3NC2280 3RT2036 3RT2036 3RT2038
3RW4037 3NA3132-6 -- 3NE4121 3NE8021-1 -- 3RT2037 3RT2037 3RT2046
3RW4038 3NA3132-6 3NE3221 -- 3NE8022-1 -- 3RT2038 3RT2038 3RT2046
3RW4046 3NA3136-6 3NE3222 -- 3NE8022-1 -- 3RT2045 3RT2045 3RT2047
3RW4047 3NA3136-6 3NE3224 -- 3NE8024-1 -- 3RT2047 3RT2047 3RT1054

7
Note:
The specified short-circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are

SOFT STARTERS
covered by combination tests. Smaller fuses than those speci-
fied can be used at any time as smaller ones trip more quickly in
the event of a short circuit (unchanged short-circuit breaking
capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any case. The
dimensioning of the short-circuit components must, however, be
suitable for the connected three-phase motor and the line
protection for the cables used.
For CLASS 10 applications,
applications, as as an
an alternative
alternativeto
tothe
thegG
gGclass
class
full-range fuses
full-range fuses for
for cable
cableand
andline
lineprotection
protection3NA3
3NA3(F1),
(F1),
3RV2 motor starter protectors can also be be used,
used, possibly
possiblywith
with
reduced short-circuit
reduced short-circuit breaking
breakingcapacity
capacity(see
(seepage
page7/87).
6/88).InIn
cases, optional
these cases, optional line
linecontactors
contactorscancanbebedispensed
dispensedwith.
with.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/89


Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
Basic Performance
Basic Performance Soft Starters
Soft Starters
3RW40 IE3/IE4 ready
3RW40soft
softstarters
starters>>Inline
Inlinecircuit
circuit

■ Selection and ordering data


For normal starting (CLASS 10)

3RW402. 3RW403. 3RW404.

3RW ambient temperature 40 °C 3RW ambient temperature 50 °C Size SD1) Article No. Price PU PS*
Rated values of Rated values of per PU (UNIT,
three-phase motors three-phase motors SET, M)
Opera- Rating at Opera- Rating at
tional operational voltage Ue tional operational voltage Ue
current Ie 230 V 400 V 500 V current Ie 200 V 230 V 460 V 575 V
A kW kW kW A hp hp hp hp d
Rated operational voltage Ue 200 ... 480 V
12.5 3 5.5 -- 11 3 3 7.5 -- S0 2 3RW4024-@BB@4 1 1 unit
6

25 5.5 11 -- 23 5 5 15 -- S0 2 3RW4026-@BB@4 1 1 unit


32 7.5 15 -- 29 7.5 7.5 20 -- S0 2 3RW4027-@BB@4 1 1 unit
38 11 18.5 -- 34 10 10 25 -- S0 2 3RW4028-@BB@4 1 1 unit
45 11 22 -- 42 10 15 30 -- S2 2 3RW4036-@BB@4 1 1 unit
63 18.5 30 -- 58 15 20 40 -- S2 2 3RW4037-@BB@4 1 1 unit
72 22 37 -- 62 20 20 40 -- S2 2 3RW4038-@BB@4 1 1 unit
80 22 45 -- 73 20 25 50 -- S3 2 3RW4046-@BB@4 1 1 unit
106 30 55 -- 98 30 30 75 -- S3 2 3RW4047-@BB@4 1 1 unit
Rated operational voltage Ue 400 ... 600 V
12.5 -- 5.5 7.5 11 -- -- 7.5 10 S0 5 3RW4024-@BB@5 1 1 unit
25 -- 11 15 23 -- -- 15 20 S0 5 3RW4026-@BB@5 1 1 unit
32 -- 15 18.5 29 -- -- 20 25 S0 5 3RW4027-@BB@5 1 1 unit
38 -- 18.5 22 34 -- -- 25 30 S0 5 3RW4028-@BB@5 1 1 unit
45 -- 22 30 42 -- -- 30 40 S2 5 3RW4036-@BB@5 1 1 unit
63 -- 30 37 58 -- -- 40 50 S2 5 3RW4037-@BB@5 1 1 unit
72 -- 37 45 62 -- -- 40 60 S2 5 3RW4038-@BB@5 1 1 unit
80 -- 45 55 73 -- -- 50 60 S3 5 3RW4046-@BB@5 1 1 unit
106 -- 55 75 98 -- -- 75 75 S3 5 3RW4047-@BB@5 1 1 unit
7

Article No. supplement for connection types


SOFT STARTERS

• Screw terminals 1
• Spring-loaded terminals2) 2

Control supply voltage


• 24 V AC/DC 0
• 110 ... 230 V AC/DC 1
1)
Soft starter Ue 200 to 480 V with screw terminals:
Standard delivery time SD = 1 day (d).
2)
Main connection from size S2: screw terminals.
Note:
the constraints
For the constraintsfor
forthe
themotor
motoroutputs
outputsspecified
specified here, see
here,
pagepage
see 6/8.7/7.

7/90 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


6/92 Siemens IC 10 · 2020 Illustrations are approximate
Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
Basic Performance Soft Starters Basic Performance Soft Starters
3RW40 soft starters > Inline circuit IE3/IE4 ready
3RW40 soft starters > Inline circuit
For normal starting (CLASS 10)

3RW402. 3RW403. 3RW404.

3RW ambient temperature 40 °C 3RW ambient temperature 50 °C Size SD1) Article No. Price PU PS*
Rated values of Rated values of per PU (UNIT,
three-phase motors three-phase motors SET, M)
Opera- Rating at Opera- Rating at
tional operational voltage Ue tional operational voltage Ue
current Ie 230 V 400 V 500 V current Ie 200 V 230 V 460 V 575 V
A kW kW kW A hp hp hp hp d
Rated operational voltage Ue 200 ... 480 V,
with thermistor motor protection,
rated control supply voltage Us 24 V AC/DC

6
12.5 3 5.5 -- 11 3 3 7.5 -- S0 5 3RW4024-@TB04 1 1 unit
25 5.5 11 -- 23 5 5 15 -- S0 5 3RW4026-@TB04 1 1 unit
32 7.5 15 -- 29 7.5 7.5 20 -- S0 5 3RW4027-@TB04 1 1 unit
38 11 18.5 -- 34 10 10 25 -- S0 5 3RW4028-@TB04 1 1 unit
45 11 22 -- 42 10 15 30 -- S2 5 3RW4036-@TB04 1 1 unit
63 18.5 30 -- 58 15 20 40 -- S2 5 3RW4037-@TB04 1 1 unit
72 22 37 -- 62 20 20 40 -- S2 5 3RW4038-@TB04 1 1 unit
80 22 45 -- 73 20 25 50 -- S3 5 3RW4046-@TB04 1 1 unit
106 30 55 -- 98 30 30 75 -- S3 5 3RW4047-@TB04 1 1 unit
Rated operational voltage Ue 400 ... 600 V,
with thermistor motor protection,
rated control supply voltage Us 24 V AC/DC
12.5 -- 5.5 7.5 11 -- -- 7.5 10 S0 5 3RW4024-@TB05 1 1 unit
25 -- 11 15 23 -- -- 15 20 S0 5 3RW4026-@TB05 1 1 unit
32 -- 15 18.5 29 -- -- 20 25 S0 5 3RW4027-@TB05 1 1 unit
38 -- 18.5 22 34 -- -- 25 30 S0 5 3RW4028-@TB05 1 1 unit
45 -- 22 30 42 -- -- 30 40 S2 5 3RW4036-@TB05 1 1 unit
63 -- 30 37 58 -- -- 40 50 S2 5 3RW4037-@TB05 1 1 unit

7
72 -- 37 45 62 -- -- 40 60 S2 5 3RW4038-@TB05 1 1 unit
80 -- 45 55 73 -- -- 50 60 S3 5 3RW4046-@TB05 1 1 unit

SOFT STARTERS
106 -- 55 75 98 -- -- 75 75 S3 5 3RW4047-@TB05 1 1 unit

Article No. supplement for connection types


• Screw terminals 1
• Spring-loaded terminals2) 2
1)
Soft starter Ue 200 to 480 V with screw terminals:
Standard delivery time SD = 1 day (d).
2) Main connection from size S2: screw terminals.
Note:
For the constraints
constraints for
forthe
themotor
motoroutputs
outputsspecified
specifiedhere,
here, see
page 6/8. 7/7.
see page

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/91

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
Basic Performance
Basic Performance Soft Starters
Soft Starters
3RW40
3RW40soft
softstarters
starters>>Accessories
Accessories

■ Selection and ordering data


Conductor cross-section Tightening For soft SD Article No. Price PU PS*
Solid or Finely AWG torque starters size per PU (UNIT,
stranded stranded cables, SET, M)
with end solid or
sleeve stranded
mm² mm² AWG Nm d
Three-phase infeed terminals
2.5 … 25 2.5 … 16 10 ... 4 3 ... 4 S0 } 3RV2925-5AB 1 1 unit
(3RW402.)

3RV2925-5AB

For soft starters Version SD Article No. Price PU PS*


Type Size per PU (UNIT,
SET, M)
d
Auxiliary terminals
Auxiliary terminals, 3-pole
3RW404. S3 For connection of auxiliary and control 5 3RT2946-4F 1 1 unit
6

cables (0.5 ... 2.5 mm2) to the main


conductor terminals

3RT2946-4F
Covers for soft starters
Terminal covers for box terminals
3RW403. S2 Additional touch protection to be fitted } 3RT2936-4EA2 1 1 unit
3RW404. S3 at the box terminals } 3RT2946-4EA2 1 1 unit
(two units required per device)

3RT2936-4EA2
Terminal covers for cable lugs and busbar connections
3RW404. S3 For complying with the voltage clear- 5 3RT1946-4EA1 1 1 unit
ances and as touch protection if box
terminal is removed
(two units required per device)
7
SOFT STARTERS

3RT1946-4EA1
Sealing covers
3RW402. to S0, S2, -- 5 3RW4900-0PB10 1 1 unit
3RW404. S3

3RW4900-0PB10

7/92 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


6/94 Siemens IC 10 · 2020 Illustrations are approximate
Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
Basic Performance Soft Starters Basic Performance Soft Starters
3RW40 soft starters > Accessories 3RW40 soft starters > Accessories

For motor For soft Version SD Article No. Price PU (UNIT, PS*
starter starters per PU SET, M)
protectors
Size Size d
Standard mounting rail adapters
For mechanical fixing of motor
starter protector and soft starter;
for snapping onto standard
mounting rail or for screw fixing
S2 S2 Single-unit packaging 2 3RA2932-1CA00 1 1 unit

3RA2932-1CA00 For soft starters SD Article No. Price PU (UNIT, PS*


Type Size per PU SET, M)
d
Fans (to increase switching frequency and for device mounting in positions
different to the standard position)
3RW402. S0 } 3RW4928-8VB00 1 1 unit
3RW403., S2, S3 } 3RW4947-8VB00 1 1 unit
3RW404.

6
3RW49..-8VB00

For soft starters Motor starter protectors SD Article No. Price PU (UNIT, PS*
Type Size Size per PU SET, M)
d
Link modules to motor starter protectors1)
Screw terminals

3RW402. S0 S00/S0 2 3RA2921-1BA00 1 1 unit


3RW4036 S2 S2 } 3RA2931-1AA00 1 1 unit
3RW404. S3 S3 } 3RA1941-1AA00 1 1 unit
Spring-loaded terminals
3RA2921-1BA00
3RW402. S0 S0 2 3RA2921-2GA00 1 1 unit

7
SOFT STARTERS
3RA2921-2GA00
1)
Can be used in size S0 up to 32 A.
Can be used in size S2 up to 65 A in combination with 3RA2932-1CA00
standard mounting rail adapter (specially for soft starters).
Can be used in size S3 only with mounting plate.

Version SD Article No. Price PU (UNIT, PS*


per PU SET, M)
d
Tools for opening spring-loaded terminals in sizes S00 and S0
Screwdrivers Spring-loaded terminals
For all SIRIUS devices with spring-loaded terminals
Length approx. 200 mm, 3.0 mm x 0.5 mm, 2 3RA2908-1A 1 1 unit
titanium gray/black, partially insulated
3RA2908-1A
Blank labels
Unit labeling plates1)
For SIRIUS devices
20 mm x 7 mm, titanium gray 20 3RT2900-1SB20 100 340 units
IC01_00181

3RT2900-1SB20
1)
PC labeling systems for individual inscription of unit labeling plates are
available from: murrplastik Systemtechnik GmbH (see page 16/14).

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/93


* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2020 6/95
Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
Basic Performance
Basic Performance Soft Starters
Soft Starters
3RW30
3RW30soft
softstarters
starters>>General
Generaldata
data

Overview
More information
Homepage, see
Homepage, see www.usa.siemens.com/soft-starter
www.siemens.com/soft-starter Simulation
Simulation Tool
Tool for
for Soft
Soft Starters
Starters (STS),
(STS), see
see page
page 6/8
7/7 or
Industry
Industry Mall,
Mall, see
see www.siemens.com/product?3RW
www.siemens.com/product?3RW https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/101494917
TIA
TIA Selection
Selection Tool
Tool Cloud
Cloud (TST
(TST Cloud),
Cloud),see
see SIRIUS Soft
SIRIUS Soft Starter
Starter ES
ES (TIA
(TIA Portal)
Portal),for
see page 14/5 see page 14/5
diagnostics,
https://www.siemens.com/tstcloud/?node=3rw30
https://www.siemens.com/tstcloud/?node=3rw30

The SIRIUS 3RW30 Basic Performance soft starters are suitable


for soft starting of three-phase asynchronous motors.
Thanks to two-phase control, not only is the current kept at
minimum values in all three phases throughout the entire starting
time, but disturbing direct current components are also elimi-
nated. This not only enables the two-phase starting of motors
from 1.5 to 75HP @ 480V but also avoids the current and torque
peaks which occur e.g. with wye-delta starters.
6

1 3RW30 soft starter


2

2 Link module to motor starter protector


3 Terminal cover for box terminals (S2, S3)
6
3 4 Terminal cover for
cable lugs and busbar connections (S3)
5 Auxiliary terminal (S3)
5 6 Infeed terminal (S00, S0)
4
7

1
SOFT STARTERS

IC01_00538

3RW30 Basic
Basic Performance soft starters
starters with accessories
accessories (see
(see page
page7/103)
6/105)

7/94 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

6/96 Siemens IC 10 · 2020


Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
Basic Performance Soft Starters Basic Performance Soft Starters
3RW30 soft starters > General data 3RW30 soft starters > General data

Benefits

3RW301. 3RW302. 3RW303. 3RW304.

Product characteristics / function Performance features / benefits

Small and compact design Space-saving, clearly arranged control panel layout

Parameterization using potentiometers Simple and fast commissioning

Integrated in the SIRIUS modular system Link modules to motor starter protectors

6
Hybrid switching devices and two-phase motor control Minimum power loss and optimized motor control by avoiding DC components

Technical specifications
More information
Equipment Manual
Equipment Manual “SIRIUS
"SIRIUS 3RW30/3RW40
3RW30/3RW40 Soft
Soft Starters",
Starters”,see
see Catalog
Catalog LV
LV 10,
10, see
see www.siemens.com/lowvoltage/lv10
www.siemens.com/lowvoltage/lv10
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/38752095
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/38752095
FAQs, see https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16213/faq
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16213/faq

Type 3RW301. 3RW302. 3RW303. 3RW304.


Mechanics and environment
Mounting dimensions (W x H x D)
• Screw terminals mm 45 x 95 x 151 45 x 125 x 151 55 x 144 x 168 70 x 160 x 186
• Spring-loaded terminals mm 45 x 117 x 151 45 x 150 x 151 55 x 144 x 168 70 x 160 x 186

7
H

SOFT STARTERS
Permissible ambient temperature
During operation °C -25 ... +60; (derating from +40)
During storage °C -40 ... +80
Weight kg 0.58 0.69 1.20 1.71
Permissible mounting position1) 10° 10°
(auxiliary fan not possible) 10° 10°
NSB0_01897

Installation type1) Stand-alone


installation

Permissible installation altitude m 5 000


(Derating
(Derating from 1 000,
000, see
seecharacteristic
characteristiccurve
curveononpage
page6/8)
7/7)
Degree of protection IP00

1)
In the case of deviations, please observe derating, see Equipment Manual
in the chapter "Configuring".

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/95

Siemens IC 10 · 2020 6/97


Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
Basic Performance
Basic Performance Soft Starters
Soft Starters
3RW30
3RW30soft
softstarters
starters>>General
Generaldata
data

Type Terminal 3RW301., 3RW302. 3RW303., 3RW304.


Control electronics
Rated values
Rated control supply voltage A1/A2 V 24 110 ... 230 24 110 ... 230
• Tolerance % 20 -15/+10 20 -15/+10
Rated frequency Hz 50/60
• Tolerance % ± 10

Type 3RW301. 3RW302. 3RW303. 3RW304.


Power electronics
Rated operational voltage V AC 200 ... 480
Tolerance % -15/+10
Rated frequency Hz 50/60
Tolerance % 10
Uninterrupted duty at 40 °C (% of Ie) % 115
Minimum load (% of Ie) % 10 (at least 1 A)
Maximum cable length between soft starter and motor m 300

Type 3RW3013 3RW3014 3RW3016 3RW3017 3RW3018


Power electronics
Load rating with rated operational current Ie
• According to IEC and UL/CSA1), individual mounting at 40/50/60 °C, AC-53a A 3.6/3.3/3 6.5/6/5.5 9/8/7 12.5/12/11 17.6/17/14
6

Power loss
• In operation after completed starting with uninterrupted rated operational W 0.25 0.5 1 2 4
current (40 °C) approx.
• During starting with 300% IM (40 °C) W 24 52 80 80 116
Permissible rated motor current and starts per hour
• For normal starting (CLASS 10) at 40/50 °C
- Rated motor current IM2), start-up time 3 s A 3.6/3.3 6.5/6.0 9/8 12.5/12.0 17.6/17.0
- Starts per hour3) 1/h 200/150 87/60 50/50 85/70 62/46
- Rated motor current IM2), start-up time 4 s A 3.6/3.3 6.5/6.0 9/8 12.5/12.0 17.6/17.0
- Starts per hour3) 1/h 150/100 64/46 35/35 62/47 45/32
1) Measurement at 60 °C according to UL/CSA not required. 3) For intermittent duty S4 with ON period = 30%, Tu = 40/50 °C, stand-alone
2)
At 300% IM, Tu = 40/50 °C. installation vertical. The quoted switching frequencies do not apply for
automatic mode.

Type 3RW3026 3RW3027 3RW3028


Power electronics
Load rating with rated operational current Ie
• According to IEC and UL/CSA1), individual mounting at 40/50/60 °C, AC-53a A 25.3/23/21 32.2/29/26 38/34/31
7

Power loss
• In operation after completed starting with uninterrupted rated operational W 8 13 19
current (40 °C) approx.
SOFT STARTERS

• During starting with 300% IM (40 °C) W 188 220 256


Permissible rated motor current and starts per hour
• For normal starting (CLASS 10) at 40/50 °C
- Rated motor current IM2), start-up time 3 s A 25/23 32/29 38/34
- Starts per hour3) 1/h 23/23 23/23 19/19
- Rated motor current IM2), start-up time 4 s A 25/23 32/29 38/34
- Starts per hour3) 1/h 15/15 16/16 12/12
1) Measurement at 60 °C according to UL/CSA not required. 3) For intermittent duty S4 with ON period = 30%, T = 40/50 °C, stand-alone
u
2)
At 300% IM, Tu = 40/50 °C. installation vertical. The quoted switching frequencies do not apply for
automatic mode. Factors for permissible switching frequency with
deviating mounting position, direct mounting, side-by-side mounting, see
Equipment Manual in the chapter "Configuring".

Type 3RW3036 3RW3037 3RW3038 3RW3046 3RW3047


Power electronics
Load rating with rated operational current Ie
• According to IEC and UL/CSA1), individual mounting at 40/50/60 °C, AC-53a A 45/42/39 65/58/53 72/62.1/60 80/73/66 106/98/90
Power loss
• In operation after completed starting with uninterrupted rated operational W 6 12 15 12 21
current (40 °C) approx.
• During starting with 300% IM (40 °C) W 316 444 500 576 768
Permissible rated motor current and starts per hour
• For normal starting (CLASS 10) at 40/50 °C
- Rated motor current IM2), start-up time 3 s A 45/42 63/58 72/62 80/73 106/108
- Starts per hour3) 1/h 38/38 23/23 22/22 22/22 15/15
- Rated motor current IM2), start-up time 4 s A 45/42 63/58 72/62 80/73 106/98
- Starts per hour3) 1/h 26/26 15/15 15/15 15/15 10/10
1) 3)
Measurement at 60 °C according to UL/CSA not required. For intermittent duty S4 with ON period = 30%, Tu = 40/50 °C, stand-alone
2)
At 300% IM, Tu = 40/50 °C. installation vertical. The quoted switching frequencies do not apply for
automatic mode.

7/96 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

6/98 Siemens IC 10 · 2020


Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
Basic Performance Soft Starters Basic Performance Soft Starters
3RW30 soft starters > General data 3RW30 soft starters > General data

Type 3RW3003-1CB54 3RW3003-2CB54


Mechanics and environment
Mounting dimensions (W x H x D)
• Screw terminals mm 22.5 x 100 x 120 --
• Spring-loaded terminals mm -- 22.5 x 101.6 x 120

D
W

Permissible ambient temperature


During operation °C -25 ... +60; (derating from +40)
During storage °C -40 ... +80
Weight kg 0.207 0.188
Permissible mounting position 10° 10°
10° 10°

NSB0_01897
Permissible installation altitude m 5 000
(Derating
(Derating from
from 1 000,
000, see
see characteristic
characteristiccurve
curveon
onpage
page6/8)
7/7)
Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60529 IP00
Control electronics
Rated values
Rated control supply voltage V 24 ... 230 AC/DC

6
• Tolerance % ± 10
Rated frequency at AC Hz 50/60
• Tolerance % ± 10
Power electronics
Rated operational voltage V AC 200 ... 400
Tolerance % ± 10
Rated frequency Hz 50/60
Tolerance % ± 10
Uninterrupted duty (% of Ie) % 100
Minimum load1) (% of Ie); at 40 °C % 9
Maximum conductor length between soft starter and motor m 1002)
Load rating with rated operational current Ie
• According to IEC and UL/CSA, individual mounting A 3/2.6/2.2
at 40/50/60 °C, AC-53a
• According to IEC and UL/CSA, side-by-side mounting A 2.6/2.2/1.8
at 40/50/60 °C, AC-53a
Power loss

7
• In operation after completed starting with uninterrupted rated W 6.5
operational current (40 °C) approx.

SOFT STARTERS
• With utilization of maximum switching frequency W 3
Permissible starts per hour
(cannot be increased by using a fan)
• For intermittent duty S4 Tu = 40 °C, stand-alone installation vertical 1/h 1 500
• ON period = 70% for 300% Ie 1/s 0.2
Dead time after uninterrupted duty
with Ie before restart s 0
1)
The rated motor current (specified on the motor's name plate) should at
least amount to the specified percentage of the SIRIUS soft starter unit's
rated operational current Ie.
2) If this value is exceeded, problems with line capacities may arise, which
can result in false firing.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/97

Siemens IC 10 · 2020 6/99


Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
Basic Performance Soft Starters
Basic Performance Soft Starters
3RW30 soft starters > General data
3RW30 soft starters > General data
Motor feeders according to IEC with 3RV2 motor starter protectors (without semiconductor protection)
Type of coordination "1", CLASS 10,
short-circuit breaking capacity Iq in kA, see table
Note:
For general
generalrecommendations
recommendationsforforconstructing
constructing motor
motor feeders
feeders
with soft starters,
starters, see
see page
page7/9.
6/10.

Q1

Q11
NSB0_01902

M
3~

Soft starters Motor starter protectors


for 400 V systems
Q11 Q1 Iq
Type Type kA
Type of Inline circuit
6

ToC
coordina- 1
tion "1"
3RW3003 3RV2011-1EA10 50
3RW3013 3RV2011-1FA10 5
3RW3014 3RV2011-1HA10 5
3RW3016 3RV2011-1JA10 5
3RW3017 3RV2011-1KA10 5
3RW3018 3RV2021-4BA10 5
3RW3026 3RV2021-4DA10 55
3RW3027 3RV2021-4EA10 55
3RW3028 3RV2021-4FA10 55
3RW3036 3RV2031-4WA10 10
3RW3037 3RV2031-4JA10 10
3RW3038 3RV2031-4KA10 10
3RW3046 3RV2041-4RA10 11
3RW3047 3RV2041-4MA10 11

Note:
7

The specified short-circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are


covered by combination tests. Smaller motor starter protec-
SOFT STARTERS

tors/circuit breakers than those specified can be used at any


time as smaller ones trip more quickly in the event of a short
circuit (unchanged short-circuit breaking capacity) and thus
protect the soft starter in any case. The dimensioning of the
short-circuit components must, however, be suitable for the
connected three-phase motor and the line protection for the
cables used.

7/98 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
Basic Performance Soft Starters Basic Performance Soft Starters
3RW30 soft starters > General data
3RW30 soft starters > General data
Motor feeders according to IEC with 3NA3 fuses
gG class full-range fuses for cable and line protection according
to IEC 60269-2, without semiconductor protection
Type of coordination "1",
short-circuit breaking capacity Iq = 65 kA
Note:
For
For general recommendationsfor
general recommendations forconstructing
constructing motor
motor feeders
feeders
with
with soft starters, see
see page
page7/9.
6/10.

F1

Q21

Q11
NSB0_01904

M
3~

Soft starters gG class fuse Line contactor (optional)


for systems up to 480 V for systems up to 400 V for systems up to 480 V

6
Q11 F1 Q21 Q21
Type Type Type Type
Type of ToC Inline circuit
coordina- 1
tion "1"
3RW30031) 3NA38052) 3RT2015 3RT2015
3RW3013 3NA3803-6 3RT2015 3RT2015
3RW3014 3NA3805-6 3RT2015 3RT2016
3RW3016 3NA3807-6 3RT2016 3RT2017
3RW3017 3NA3810-6 3RT2018 3RT2025
3RW3018 3NA3814-6 3RT2026 3RT2026
3RW3026 3NA3822-6 3RT2026 3RT2027
3RW3027 3NA3824-6 3RT2027 3RT2028
3RW3028 3NA3824-6 3RT2028 3RT2035
3RW3036 3NA3130-6 3RT2036 3RT2036
3RW3037 3NA3132-6 3RT2037 3RT2037
3RW3038 3NA3132-6 3RT2038 3RT2038

7
3RW3046 3NA3136-6 3RT2045 3RT2045
3RW3047 3NA3136-6 3RT2047 3RT2047
1)

SOFT STARTERS
Iq = 50 kA at 400 V.
2)
3NA3805-1 (NH00), 5SB261 (DIAZED), 5SE2201-6 (NEOZED).
Note:
The specified short-circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are
covered by combination tests. Smaller fuses than those speci-
fied can be used at any time as smaller ones trip more quickly in
the event of a short circuit (unchanged short-circuit breaking
capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any case. The
dimensioning of the short-circuit components must, however, be
suitable for the connected three-phase motor and the line
protection for the cables used.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/99


Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
Basic Performance Soft Starters
Basic Performance Soft Starters
3RW30 soft starters > General data
3RW30 soft starters > General data
Motor feeders according to IEC with 3NE1 SITOR fuses
gR class full-range fuses for semiconductor protection, cable
and line protection
Type of coordination "2",
short-circuit breaking capacity Iq = 65 kA
Note:
For general recommendationsfor
general recommendations forconstructing
constructing motor
motor feeders
feeders
with soft starters, see page
starters, see page7/9.
6/10.

F’1

Q21

Q11
NSB0_01905

M
3~

Soft starters gG class fuse Line contactor (optional)


for systems up to 480 V for systems up to 400 V for systems up to 480 V
6

Q11 F’1 Q21 Q21


Type Type Type Type
Type of ToC Inline circuit
coordina- 2
tion "2"
3RW30031) 3NE1813-02) 3RT2015 3RT2015
3RW3013 3NE1813-0 3RT2015 3RT2015
3RW3014 3NE1813-0 3RT2015 3RT2016
3RW3016 3NE1813-0 3RT2016 3RT2017
3RW3017 3NE1813-0 3RT2018 3RT2025
3RW3018 3NE1814-0 3RT2026 3RT2026
3RW3026 3NE1803-0 3RT2026 3RT2027
3RW3027 3NE1020-2 3RT2027 3RT2028
3RW3028 3NE1020-2 3RT2028 3RT2035
3RW3036 3NE1020-2 3RT2036 3RT2036
3RW3037 3NE1820-0 3RT2037 3RT2037
3RW3038 3NE1820-0 3RT2038 3RT2038
7

3RW3046 3NE1021-0 3RT2045 3RT2045


3RW3047 3NE1022-0 3RT2047 3RT2047
SOFT STARTERS

1) Iq = 50 kA at 400 V.
2)
No SITOR fuse required!
Alternatively: 3NA3803 (NH00), 5SB221 (DIAZED), 5SE2206 (NEOZED).
Note:
The specified short-circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are
covered by combination tests. Smaller fuses than those speci-
fied can be used at any time as smaller ones trip more quickly in
the event of a short circuit (unchanged short-circuit breaking
capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any case. The
dimensioning of the short-circuit components must, however, be
suitable for the connected three-phase motor and the line
protection for the cables used.

7/100 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
Basic Performance Soft Starters Basic Performance Soft Starters
3RW30 soft starters > General data
3RW30 soft starters > General data
Motor feeders according to IEC with 3NE8 / 3NE4 / 3NE3 / 3NC fuses
aR class partial-range fuses for semiconductor protection
Type of coordination "2",
short-circuit breaking capacity Iq = 65 kA
Note:
For general
generalrecommendations
recommendationsforforconstructing
constructing motor
motor feeders
feeders
with soft starters,
starters, see
see page
page7/9.
6/10.

F1

Q21
F3

Q11
NSB0_01906

M
3~

Soft starters gG class fuse aR class fuse Cylindrical fuses Line contactor (optional)
for systems for systems for systems for systems for systems for systems for systems

6
up to 480 V up to 480 V up to 480 V up to 480 V up to 480 V up to 400 V up to 480 V
Q11 F1 F3 F3 F3 F3 Q21 Q21
Type Type Type Type Type Type Type Type
Type of ToC Inline circuit
coordina- 2
tion "2"
3RW30031) 3NA38052) -- -- 3NE8015-1 3NC1010 3RT2015 3RT2015
3RW3013 3NA3803-6 -- 3NE4101 3NE8015-1 3NC2220 3RT2015 3RT2015
3RW3014 3NA3805-6 -- 3NE4101 3NE8015-1 3NC2220 3RT2015 3RT2016
3RW3016 3NA3807-6 -- 3NE4101 3NE8015-1 3NC2220 3RT2016 3RT2017
3RW3017 3NA3810-6 -- 3NE4101 3NE8015-1 3NC2250 3RT2018 3RT2025
3RW3018 3NA3814-6 -- 3NE4101 3NE8003-1 3NC2263 3RT2026 3RT2026
3RW3026 3NA3822-6 -- 3NE4102 3NE8017-1 3NC2263 3RT2026 3RT2027
3RW3027 3NA3824-6 -- 3NE4118 3NE8018-1 3NC2280 3RT2027 3RT2028
3RW3028 3NA3824-6 -- 3NE4118 3NE8020-1 3NC2280 3RT2028 3RT2035
3RW3036 3NA3130-6 -- 3NE4120 3NE8020-1 3NC2280 3RT2036 3RT2036
3RW3037 3NA3132-6 -- 3NE4121 3NE8021-1 -- 3RT2037 3RT2037

7
3RW3038 3NA3132-6 3NE3221 -- 3NE8022-1 -- 3RT2038 3RT2038
3RW3046 3NA3136-6 3NE3222 -- 3NE8022-1 -- 3RT2045 3RT2045
3RW3047 3NA3136-6 3NE3224 -- 3NE8024-1 -- 3RT2047 3RT2047

SOFT STARTERS
1) Iq = 50 kA at 400 V.
2)
3NA3805-1 (NH00), 5SB261 (DIAZED).
Note:
The specified short-circuit breaking capacities Iq in kA are
covered by combination tests. Smaller fuses than those speci-
fied can be used at any time as smaller ones trip more quickly in
the event of a short circuit (unchanged short-circuit breaking
capacity) and thus protect the soft starter in any case. The
dimensioning of the short-circuit components must, however, be
suitable for the connected three-phase motor and the line
protection for the cables used.
For CLASS 10 applications,
applications, as as an
an alternative
alternativeto tothe
thegG
gGclass
class
full-range
full-range fuses
fuses for
for cable
cableand
andline
lineprotection
protection3NA3
3NA3(F1),
(F1),3RV2
3RV2
motor starter protectors/circuit breakers
breakers can
can also
alsobebeused,
used,
possibly
possibly with
with reduced
reducedshort-circuit
short-circuitbreaking
breakingcapacity
capacity
(see page 6/100).InInthese
page 7/98). thesecases,
cases, optional line
optional contactors
line contactorscan
can
be dispensed
dispensed with.
with.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/101


Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
Basic Performance
Basic Performance Soft Starters
Soft Starters
3RW30 IE3/IE4 ready
3RW30soft
softstarters
starters>>Inline
Inlinecircuit
circuit

■ Selection and ordering data


For simple starting conditions

3RW301. 3RW302. 3RW303. 3RW304.


3RW ambient temperature 40 °C 3RW ambient temperature 50 °C Size SD1) Article No. Price PU PS*
Rated values of Rated values of per PU (UNIT,
three-phase motors three-phase motors SET, M)
Opera- Rating at Opera- Rating at
tional operational voltage Ue tional operational voltage Ue
current Ie 230 V 400 V 500 V current Ie 200 V 230 V 460 V 575 V
A kW kW kW A hp hp hp hp d
6

Rated operational voltage Ue 200 ... 480 V


3.6 0.75 1.5 -- 3 0.5 0.5 1.5 -- S00 2 3RW3013-@BB@4 1 1 unit
6.5 1.5 3 -- 6 1 1 3 -- S00 2 3RW3014-@BB@4 1 1 unit
9 2.2 4 -- 8 2 2 5 -- S00 2 3RW3016-@BB@4 1 1 unit
12.5 3 5.5 -- 12 3 3 7.5 -- S00 2 3RW3017-@BB@4 1 1 unit
17.6 4 7.5 -- 17 3 3 10 -- S00 2 3RW3018-@BB@4 1 1 unit
25 5.5 11 -- 23 5 5 15 -- S0 2 3RW3026-@BB@4 1 1 unit
32 7.5 15 -- 29 7.5 7.5 20 -- S0 2 3RW3027-@BB@4 1 1 unit
38 11 18.5 -- 34 10 10 25 -- S0 2 3RW3028-@BB@4 1 1 unit
45 11 22 -- 42 10 15 30 -- S2 2 3RW3036-@BB@4 1 1 unit
63 18.5 30 -- 58 15 20 40 -- S2 2 3RW3037-@BB@4 1 1 unit
72 22 37 -- 62 20 20 40 -- S2 2 3RW3038-@BB@4 1 1 unit
80 22 45 -- 73 20 25 50 -- S3 2 3RW3046-@BB@4 1 1 unit
106 30 55 -- 98 30 30 75 -- S3 2 3RW3047-@BB@4 1 1 unit

Article No. supplement for connection types


• Screw terminals 1
• Spring-loaded terminals2)
7

Control supply voltage Us


SOFT STARTERS

• 24 V AC/DC 0
• 110 ... 230 V AC/DC 1
Soft starters for easy starting conditions and high switching frequency,
rated operational voltage Ue 200 ... 400 V,
rated control supply voltage Us 24 ... 230 V AC/DC
3 0.55 1.1 -- A 0.5 0.5 -- -- 22.5 mm
• With screw terminals } 3RW3003-1CB54 1 1 unit
• With spring-loaded terminals } 3RW3003-2CB54 1 1 unit
1)
Soft starter Ue 200 to 480 V with screw terminals:
Standard delivery time SD = 1 day (d).
2) Main connection from size S2: screw terminals.
Note:
the constraints
For the constraintsfor
forthe
themotor
motoroutputs
outputsspecified
specified here, see
here,
pagepage
see 6/8.7/7.

7/102 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


6/104 Siemens IC 10 · 2020 Illustrations are approximate
Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
Basic Performance Soft Starters Basic Performance Soft Starters
3RW30 soft starters > Accessories 3RW30 soft starters > Accessories

Selection and ordering data


More information
Equipment Manual
Manual “SIRIUS
"SIRIUS 3RW30/3RW40
3RW30/3RW40 Soft
SoftStarters",
Starters”,see
see
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/38752095
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/38752095

Conductor cross-section Tightening For soft SD Article No. Price PU PS*


Solid or Finely AWG cables, torque starters size per PU (UNIT,
stranded stranded solid or SET, M)
with end stranded
sleeve
mm² mm² AWG Nm d
Three-phase infeed terminals
2.5 … 25 2.5 … 16 10 ... 4 3 ... 4 S00 } 3RV2925-5AB 1 1 unit
(3RW301.),
S0
(3RW302.)

3RV2925-5AB
For soft starters SD Article No. Price PU PS*
Type Size per PU (UNIT,
SET, M)
d

6
Auxiliary terminals
Auxiliary terminals, 3-pole
3RW304. S3 5 3RT2946-4F 1 1 unit

3RT2946-4F
Covers for soft starters
Terminal covers for box terminals
Additional touch protection to be fitted at the box terminals (two units
required per device)
3RW303. S2 } 3RT2936-4EA2 1 1 unit
3RW304. S3 } 3RT2946-4EA2 1 1 unit
3RT2946-4EA2
Terminal covers for cable lugs and busbar connections
For complying with the voltage clearances and as touch protection if
box terminal is removed
(two units required per device)

7
3RW304. S3 5 3RT1946-4EA1 1 1 unit

SOFT STARTERS
3RT1946-4EA1
For motor For soft Version SD Article No. Price PU PS*
starter starters per PU (UNIT,
protectors SET, M)
Si z e Size d
Mounting rails for mounting contactors for the customer assembly of 3RA21 load
feeders with busbar adapters for 60 mm systems
For the discrete configuration of direct-
on-line starters, an additional mounting
rail is needed for the contactor in addition
to the existing mounting rail on the bus-
bar adapter for the motor starter protec-
tor.
-- S0 For pushing onto the device adapter, in- 2 8US1998-7CB45 1 10 units
cluding fixing screws
8US1998-7CB45
Standard mounting rail adapters
For mechanical fixing of motor starter
protector and soft starter;
for snapping onto standard mounting rail
or for screw fixing
S2 S2 Single-unit packaging 2 3RA2932-1CA00 1 1 unit

3RA2932-1CA00

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/103


* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate Siemens IC 10 · 2020 6/105
Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
Basic Performance
Basic Performance Soft Starters
Soft Starters
3RW30
3RW30soft
softstarters
starters>>Accessories
Accessories

For soft starters Motor starter protectors SD Article No. Price PU PS*
Type Size Size per PU (UNIT,
SET, M)
d
Link modules to motor starter protectors1)
Screw terminals

3RW301. S00 S00 2 3RA2921-1BA00 1 1 unit


3RW302. S0 S00/S0 2 3RA2921-1BA00 1 1 unit
3RW3036 S2 S2 } 3RA2931-1AA00 1 1 unit
3RW304. S3 S3 } 3RA1941-1AA00 1 1 unit
3RA2921-1BA00
Spring-loaded terminals

3RW301. S00 S00 2 3RA2911-2GA00 1 1 unit


3RW302. S0 S0 2 3RA2921-2GA00 1 1 unit

3RA2921-2GA00
1)
Can be used in size S0 up to 32 A.
Can be used in size S2 up to 65 A in combination with 3RA2932-1CA00
6

standard mounting rail adapter (specially for soft starters).


Can be used in size S3 only on mounting plate.

Version Functionality Use SD Article No. Price PU PS*


Functions per PU (UNIT,
d SET, M)

Covers and push-in lugs (only for 3RW3003)


Sealable covers For securing against For devices 5 3RP1902 1 5 units
unauthorized adjustment of with 1 or 2 CO
setting knobs contacts
Push-in lugs -- For devices 5 3RP1903 1 10 units
3RP1902 for screw fixing with 1 or 2 CO
contacts

3RP1903

Version SD Article No. Price PU PS*


7

per PU (UNIT,
SET, M)
d
SOFT STARTERS

Tools for opening spring-loaded terminals


in sizes S00 and S0
Screwdrivers Spring-loaded terminals
For all SIRIUS devices with spring-loaded terminals
Length approx. 200 mm, 3.0 mm x 0.5 mm, 2 3RA2908-1A 1 1 unit
titanium gray/black, partially insulated
3RA2908-1A
Blank labels
Unit labeling plates1)
For SIRIUS devices
20 mm x 7 mm, titanium gray 20 3RT2900-1SB20 100 340 units
IC01_00181

3RT2900-1SB20
1) PC labeling systems for individual inscription of unit labeling plates are
available from: murrplastik Systemtechnik GmbH (see page 16/15).

7/104 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


6/106 Siemens IC 10 · 2020 Illustrations are approximate
Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters
Spare Parts
For 3RW55/3RW55 Failsafe
For 3RW55/3RW55 Failsafe

Type of product SD Article No. Price PU PS*


per PU (UNIT,
SET, M)
d
SIRIUS Soft Starter ES V16 Basic
Basic Function
Including Professional Trial License
Engineering software,
Software download
6 languages (English, German, French, Italian, Spanish, Chinese)
Online functions via system interface
No cost to download:
https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/document/109771657
SIRIUS Soft Starter ES V16 Professional
Floating License for one User
Engineering software,
Software and documentation on DVD
6 languages (English, German, French, Italian, Spanish, Chinese)
Online functions via system interface or PROFIBUS/PROFINET
• License Key on USB flash drive, includes DVD 5 3ZS1320-6CC12-0YA5 1 1 unit
• License Key download, without DVD } 3ZS1320-6CE12-0YB5 1 1 unit
IC10_06_07_3RW_ET.fm Page 108 Thursday, April 9, 2020 10:08 PM
Upgrade for Soft Starter ES 2007 Premium 5 3ZS1320-6CC12-0YE5 1 1 unit
6

3ZS1320-6CC12-0YA5 Floating License for one User


Engineering software,
Software and documentation on DVD
Switching Devices – Soft
License Key onStarters and Solid-State Switching
USB flash drive Devices
6 languages (English, German, French, Italian, Spanish, Chinese)
SIRIUS 3RW SoftOnline Starters
functions via system interface or PROFIBUS/PROFINET
Spare
Hints:
Parts
Licenses from Soft Starter ES Standard and Premium V14 to V15.1 can also be used for Soft Starter ES V16 Professional
For 3RW55/3RW55 Failsafe

Product Manufacturer's Type of product SD Article No. Price PU PS*


designation Article No. per PU (UNIT,
of the soft starter SET, M)
d
Fans
Fan 3RW551 (1x), -- } 3RW5983-0FF00 1 1 unit
3RW552 (2x),

7
3RW553 (2x)
3RW554 (1x) -- } 3RW5984-0FF00 1 1 unit

SOFT STARTERS
3RW555 (3x) -- } 3RW5985-0FF00 1 1 unit
3RW5983-0FF00
Terminals and terminal covers
Box terminal 3RW552 (2x) -- } 3RW5982-0TB00 1 1 unit
block

3RW5982-0TB00
Screw terminals

Removable 3RW551.-1H... (2x), contains 2 blocks each } 3RW5980-1TR00 1 1 unit


control terminals 3RW552.-1H... (2x), with 6 terminals
3RW553.-6H... (2x),
3RW554.-6H... (2x),
3RW555.-6H... (2x)
6

Spring-loaded terminals

3RW551.-3H... (2x), contains 2 blocks each } 3RW5980-2TR00 1 1 unit


3RW552.-3H... (2x), with 6 terminals
3RW553.-2H... (2x),
3RW5980-1TR00 3RW554.-2H... (2x),
3RW555.-2H... (2x)
Terminal cover 3RW555 -- } 3RW5955-0TC20 1 1 unit

3RW5955-0TC20

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/105

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters Spare Parts
For 3RW55/3RW55 Failsafe
For 3RW55/3RW55 Failsafe

Product Manufacturer's Type of product SD Article No. Price PU PS*


designation Article No. per PU (UNIT,
of the soft starter SET, M)
d
Enclosure components
Cover for control 3RW55..-.HA.. Titanium gray } 3RW5950-0GD20 1 1 unit
cable duct

3RW5950-0GD20
3RW55..-.HF.. Yellow NEW NEU
} 3RW5950-0GD30 1 1 unit

6
3RW5950-0GD30
Hinged cover 3RW55 With cutout for } 3RW5950-0GL30 1 1 unit
High Feature
HMI module

3RW5950-0GL30
7
SOFT STARTERS

7/106 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
High Performance Soft Starters
Spare Parts
For 3RW55/3RW55 Failsafe
For 3RW55/3RW55 Failsafe

Product Manufacturer's Type of product SD Article No. Price PU PS*


designation Article No. per PU (UNIT,
of the soft starter SET, M)
d
HMI modules
HMI module 3RW55 High Feature } 3RW5980-0HF00 1 1 unit

3RW5980-0HF00
Interface cover 3RW55 -- } 3RW5980-0HL00 1 1 unit

3RW5980-0HL00
6

Connection cable for installing the HMI module in the soft starter
Connection cable -- 0.1 m, flat } 3UF7931-0AA00-0 1 1 unit

3UF7931-0AA00-0
Transport packaging
Transport 3RW551 -- } 3RW5951-0VY00 1 1 unit
packaging 3RW552, 3RW553 -- } 3RW5953-0VY00 1 1 unit
3RW554 -- } 3RW5954-0VY00 1 1 unit
3RW555 -- } 3RW5955-0VY00 1 1 unit

7
SOFT STARTERS
3RW5953-0VY00

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/107

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Switching
Soft Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
Starters
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
General Performance Soft Starters
Spare Parts
For 3RW52
For 3RW52

Product Manufacturer's Article No. Type of product SD Article No. Price PU PS*
designation of the soft starter per PU (UNIT,
SET, M)
d
Fans
Fans 3RW5216/17 (1x), -- } 3RW5983-0FF00 1 1 unit
3RW5226/27 (2x),
3RW523 (2x)
3RW524 (1x) -- } 3RW5984-0FF00 1 1 unit

3RW5983-0FF00
Terminals
Box terminal block 3RW522 (2x) -- } 3RW5982-0TB00 1 1 unit

3RW5982-0TB00
Screw terminals

Removable control 3RW521.-1.C.., contains } 3RW5980-1TR00 1 1 unit


terminals 3RW522.-1.C.., 2 blocks
3RW523.-6.C.., each with
3RW524.-6.C.. 6 terminals
6

Spring-loaded terminals

3RW521.-3.C.., contains } 3RW5980-2TR00 1 1 unit


3RW522.-3.C.., 2 blocks
3RW523.-2.C.., each with
3RW524.-2.C.. 6 terminals
3RW5980-1TR00
Enclosure components
Enclosure base 3RW522, 3RW523 -- } 3RW5953-0GB00 1 1 unit
3RW524 -- } 3RW5954-0GB00 1 1 unit
7

3RW5953-0GB00
Cover for control 3RW52 Titanium gray } 3RW5950-0GD20 1 1 unit
SOFT STARTERS

cable duct

3RW5950-0GD20

7/108 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
General Performance Soft Starters Spare Parts
For 3RW52
For 3RW52

Product Manufacturer's Article No. Type of product SD Article No. Price PU PS*
designation of the soft starter per PU (UNIT,
SET, M)
d
Enclosure components
Hinged cover 3RW52 Without cutout } 3RW5950-0GL20 1 1 unit

3RW5950-0GL20
Transport packaging
Transport 3RW521 -- } 3RW5951-0VY00 1 1 unit
packaging 3RW522, 3RW523 -- } 3RW5953-0VY00 1 1 unit
3RW524 -- } 3RW5954-0VY00 1 1 unit

6
3RW5953-0VY00

7
SOFT STARTERS

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/109

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Soft Starters Switching Devices – Soft Starters and Solid-State Switching Devices
SIRIUS 3RW Soft Starters
Basic Performance Soft Starters Spare Parts
For 3RW50
NEW NEU
For 3RW50

Product Manufacturer's Article No. Type of product SD Article No. Price PU PS*
designation of the soft starter per PU (UNIT,
SET, M)
d
Fan
Fan 3RW505 (1x) -- } 3RW5905-0FF00 1 1 unit
3RW507 (1x) -- } 3RW5907-0FF00 1 1 unit

3RW5905-0FF00
Terminals
Screw terminals

Removable 3RW50..-6.B.. contains } 3RW5980-1TR00 1 1 unit


control terminals 2 blocks
each with
6 terminals
Spring-loaded terminals

3RW50..-2.B.. contains } 3RW5980-2TR00 1 1 unit


2 blocks
each with
6 terminals

6
3RW5980-1TR00
Enclosure components
Hinged cover 3RW50 -- } 3RW5900-0GL00 1 1 unit

3RW5900-0GL00
Transport packaging
Transport 3RW505 -- } 3RW5905-0VY00 1 1 unit
packaging 3RW507 -- } 3RW5907-0VY00 1 1 unit
7
SOFT STARTERS

3RW5905-0VY00

7/110 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Soft Starters

3RW Soft Starters


Soft starters for enclosed applications

Overview Application
The family of 3RW40 and 3RW44 softstarters are available in The Class 73/74 product is a fully enclosed solid state reduced
stand alone enclosed control designs for smooth starting and voltage starter designed for a wide variety of industrial applica-
stopping of standard NEMA design B three phase inductive mo- tions. The enclosed softstarter offerings are ideal for new as well
tors, thus eliminating physical stresses to the system and load as existing applications where total motor controls is required.
while minimizing starting current. These pre-engineered en-
closed designs offer convenience and flexibility in and UL/CSA Proper selection based on application data is made simple fol-
certified offering. Enclosed styles are available in combination lowing these easy steps:
and non-combination configurations through 600HP and system - Select proper RVSS by application
voltages of 200V, 230V, 480V, and 600V. • Select the 3RW40 versus the 3RW44 using the application
The Class 73 offers either the 3RW40 or 3RW44 in a non-combi- info provided in the open section of the catalog
nation style offering. These non-combination styles come stan- - Select the rating chart for normal starting or sever duty starting
dard with a choice of Type 1, 3R, 12, 4 NEMA rated enclosure, a
control transformer, Sirius softstarter with built-in overload and • Normal starting is rated at 350% of rated motor current
bypass, line side power terminal block, and a reset pushbutton. IM for 10 seconds and based on starts per hour – repre-
The enclosed offering can be powerfully matched with a wide sentative of a class 20 application.
variety of factory modified options such as pushbutton control, • Severe starting is rated at 350% of rated motor current
pilot lights, metering and other control options such as isolation Im for 20 seconds and based on starts per hour – repre-
contactors and emergency start bypass starters. 3RW44 en- sentative of a Class 20 application
closed styles are also available with optional through the door
keypad and Profibus communication. - Select model using Motor nameplate data
• Identify correct motor voltage column
The Class 74 offering includes all of the features of the Class 73
in a combination style design. Standard options are either a cir- • Select rate current or HP row
cuit breaker or fusible disconnect providing short circuit protec- • Find ordering number under desired enclosure type
tion and soft starting in one package. column (e.g. NEMA 1)
• Select appropriate system voltage
- Select factory modification on page 6/401)
Example:
3RW44, N12, CB disconnect, 460V, 200HP with a start/stop and
red run light
Order No.
74MT34BFAP A1 FC

Product Nomenclature
Class 73 and 74 Enclosed Soft Starters

7
SOFT STARTERS
Class
73 = Non-combination type
74 = Combination type

Size + Model Rating (Amps)


3RW40 3RW44
AR = 11 AT = 26
BR = 23 BT = 32 Phases
CR = 29 CT = 42 3 = 3 phase
DR = 34 DT = 51
ER = 42 ET = 68 Supply Voltage
FR = 58 FT = 82 6 = 200
GR = 62 GT = 100 2 = 230
HR = 73 HT = 117 3 = 380/415 Enclosure Type
JR = 98 JT = 145 4 = 460 B = NEMA 1
AS = 117 KT = 180 5 = 575 0 = NEMA 12
BS = 145 LT = 215 D = NEMA 3R Mod Box Type
CS = 205 MT = 280 E = NEMA 4 F = Standard
DS = 248 NT = 315 W = NEMA 4X SS G = Modified
ES = 315 PT = 385
FS = 385 QT = 494 Control Voltage
RT = 551 A = None
ST = 615 Disconnect Type
TT = 693 Blank = None
WT = 780 P = MCP
YT = 970 T = Thermal Magnetic
ZT = 1076 F = Fusible

1)
Some modifications will require a larger ‘Modified’ box than the standard box
e.g. Isolation contactor, space heater, etc. See page 7/124 for instructions.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/111
Soft Starters

3RW Soft Starters


3RW40 Size S0-S3 Non-Combo

Ordering Information
� Enclosed devices should be ordered by Ideal applications for 3RW40 enclosed
the FLA of the motor. softstarters
b Fans
� The 3RW40 is designed for normal b Pumps
starting applications. b Easy starting loads starting in less than
�  or factory modifications see page 7/124.
F 10 seconds
�  or dimensional drawings see page 7/125.
F
Class 73 starters are built to UL and CSA
standards
Class 73 non-combination starters include:
3RW40 Enclosed features: b NEMA rated enclosure
b Available in NEMA 1,12,3R,4, and b 3RW40 Sirius softstarter with built-in OL
4 stainless steel and bypass
b Compact size b Control Circuit Transformer
b Built-in Bypass contactor b Line side power terminal block
b Voltage ramp up and ramp down b Reset button
b Current limit adjustment of 125 - 550% b Isolation Contactor
b Internal overload class 10,15,or 20
b Internal self protection
b Fault monitoring
b Isolation Contactor

3RW40 for Standard Applications


Enclosed Non-Combination (Starter Only)

Rated MAX HP
a KW Class 10 Light Duty (350% * Ie for 10s)b
Operating OPEN Style List List List List NEMA 4/4X List
Current 200V 230V 460V 575V 380V (Starter Only) NEMA 1 Price $ NEMA 3R Price $ NEMA 12 Price $ NEMA 4 Price $ Stainless Steel Price $
11 3 3 7.5 — 6 3RW4024-1BB14 73AR3_BFA 73AR3_DFA 73AR3_0FA 73AR3_EFA 73AR3_WFA
23 5 7.5 15 — 13 3RW4026-1BB14 73BR3_BFA 73BR3_DFA 73BR3_0FA 73BR3_EFA 73BR3_WFA
29 7.5 10 20 — 16 3RW4027-1BB14 73CR3_BFA 73CR3_DFA 73CR3_0FA 73CR3_EFA 73CR3_WFA
34 10 10 25 — 18 3RW4028-1BB14 73DR3_BFA 73DR3_DFA 73DR3_0FA 73DR3_EFA 73DR3_WFA
42 10 15 30 — 23 3RW4036-1BB14 73ER3_BFA 73ER3_DFA 73ER3_0FA 73ER3_EFA 73ER3_WFA
58 15 20 40 — 31 3RW4037-1BB14 73FR3_BFA 73FR3_DFA 73FR3_0FA 73FR3_EFA 73FR3_WFA
62 20 20 40 — 33 3RW4038-1BB14 73GR3_BFA 73GR3_DFA 73GR3_0FA 73GR3_EFA 73GR3_WFA
73 20 25 50 — 39 3RW4046-1BB14 73HR3_BFA 73HR3_DFA 73HR3_0FA 73HR3_EFA 73HR3_WFA
98 30 30 75 — 52 3RW4047-1BB14 73JR3_BFA 73JR3_DFA 73JR3_0FA 73JR3_EFA 73JR3_WFA
200V 6 6 6 6 6
7

230V 2 2 2 2 2
380V 3 3 3 3 3
SOFT STARTERS

460V 4 4 4 4 4

a Starter size is dependent on the nameplate Full Load Amps (FLA) rating of the motor.  Starter selection is dependent on type of application. Ie = FLA rating of motor
HPs are for reference only. Enclosed ratings are at 40°C

7/112 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Soft Starters

3RW Soft Starters


Enclosed 3RW40

Ordering Information
Ideal applications for 3RW40 enclosed
�  nclosed devices should be ordered by
E
softstarters:
the FLA of the motor.
b Fans
�  he 3RW40 is designed for normal
T b Pumps
starting applications (Class 10 b Building/construction machines
applications). b Presses
� For factory modifications see page 7/124. b Escalators
b Transport systems
� For dimensional drawings see page 7/125. b Air conditioning systems
Class 73 non-combination starters include: b Ventilators
b NEMA rated enclosure b Assembly lines
3RW40 Enclosed features: Class 73 starters are built to UL and
b Available in NEMA 1, 12, 3R, 4, and 4 b 3RW40 Sirius softstarter with built-in OL
stainless steel and bypass CSA standards.
b Compact size b Control circuit transformer
b Built-in bypass contactor
b Voltage ramp up and ramp down b Line side power terminal block
b Current limit adjustment of 125 - 550% b Reset button
b Internal overload class 10, 15, or 20
b Internal self protection
b Fault monitoring
For all technical information, please consult the 2006 Industrial Controls Catalog or contact your local sales support center.

3RW40 for Standard Applications


Enclosed Non-Combination (Starter Only)
Rated MAX HP
a KW Class 10 Light Duty (350% * Im for 10s)b
Operating OPEN Style List List List List NEMA 4/4X List
Current 200V 230V 460V 575V 380V (Starter Only) NEMA 1 Price $ NEMA 3R Price $ NEMA 12 Price $ NEMA 4 Price $ Stainless Steel Price $
117 30 40 75 — 56 3RW4055-6BB34 73AS3_BFA 73AS3_DFA 73AS3_0FA 73AS3_EFA 73AS3_WFA
145 40 50 100 — 75 3RW4056-6BB34 73BS3_BFA 73BS3_DFA 73BS3_0FA 73BS3_EFA 73BS3_WFA
205 60 75 150 — 112 3RW4073-6BB34 73CS3_BFA 73CS3_DFA 73CS3_0FA 73CS3_EFA 73CS3_WFA
248 75 100 200 — 149 3RW4074-6BB34 73DS3_BFA 73DS3_DFA 73DS3_0FA 73DS3_EFA 73DS3_WFA
315 100 125 250 — 186 3RW4075-6BB34 73ES3_BFA 73ES3_DFA 73ES3_0FA 73ES3_EFA 73ES3_WFA
385 125 150 300 — 224 3RW4076-6BB34 73FS3_BFA 73FS3_DFA 73FS3_0FA 73FS3_EFA 73FS3_WFA
200V 6 6 6 6 6
230V 2 2 2 2 2
380V 3 3 3 3 3
460V 4 4 4 4 4

7
117 — — 75 100 — 3RW4055-6BB35 73AS35BFA 73AS35DFA 73AS350FA 73AS35EFA 73AS35WFA
145 — — 100 150 — 3RW4056-6BB35 73BS35BFA 73BS35DFA 73BS350FA 73BS35EFA 73BS35WFA
205 — — 150 200 — 3RW4073-6BB35 73CS35BFA 73CS35DFA 73CS350FA 73CS35EFA 73CS35WFA

SOFT STARTERS
248 — — 200 250 — 3RW4074-6BB35 73DS35BFA 73DS35DFA 73DS350FA 73DS35EFA 73DS35WFA
315 — — 250 300 — 3RW4075-6BB35 73ES35BFA 73ES35DFA 73ES350FA 73ES35EFA 73ES35WFA
385 — — 300 400 — 3RW4076-6BB35 73FS35BFA 73FS35DFA 73FS350FA 73FS35EFA 73FS35WFA

Enclosed Non-Combination (Starter Only)


Rated MAX HP
a KW Class 20 Severe Duty (350% * Ie for 20s)b
Operating OPEN Style List List List List NEMA 4/4X List
Current 200V 230V 460V 575V 380V (Starter Only) NEMA 1 Price $ NEMA 3R Price $ NEMA 12 Price $ NEMA 4 Price $ Stainless Steel Price $
112 30 40 75 — 56 3RW4055-6BB34 73AS3_BFA 73AS3_DFA 73AS3_0FA 73AS3_EFA 73AS3_WFA
132 40 50 100 — 75 3RW4056-6BB34 73BS3_BFA 73BS3_DFA 73BS3_0FA 73BS3_EFA 73BS3_WFA
185 60 60 125 — 93 3RW4073-6BB34 73CS3_BFA 73CS3_DFA 73CS3_0FA 73CS3_EFA 73CS3_WFA
205 60 75 150 — 112 3RW4074-6BB34 73DS3_BFA 73DS3_DFA 73DS3_0FA 73DS3_EFA 73DS3_WFA
280 75 100 200 — 149 3RW4075-6BB34 73ES3_BFA 73ES3_DFA 73ES3_0FA 73ES3_EFA 73ES3_WFA
340 100 125 250 — 186 3RW4076-6BB34 73FS3_BFA 73FS3_DFA 73FS3_0FA 73FS3_EFA 73FS3_WFA
200V 6 6 6 6 6
230V 2 2 2 2 2
380V 3 3 3 3 3
460V 4 4 4 4 4
112 — — 75 75 — 3RW4055-6BB35 73AS35BFA 73AS35DFA 73AS350FA 73AS35EFA 73AS35WFA
132 — — 100 125 — 3RW4056-6BB35 73BS35BFA 73BS35DFA 73BS350FA 73BS35EFA 73BS35WFA
185 — — 125 150 — 3RW4073-6BB35 73CS35BFA 73CS35DFA 73CS350FA 73CS35EFA 73CS35WFA
205 — — 150 200 — 3RW4074-6BB35 73DS35BFA 73DS35DFA 73DS350FA 73DS35EFA 73DS35WFA
280 — — 200 250 — 3RW4075-6BB35 73ES35BFA 73ES35DFA 73ES350FA 73ES35EFA 73ES35WFA
340 — — 250 300 — 3RW4076-6BB35 73FS35BFA 73FS35DFA 73FS350FA 73FS35EFA 73FS35WFA

a Starter size is dependent on the nameplate Full Load Amps (FLA) rating of the motor.
HPs are for reference only. Enclosed ratings are at 40°C.
b Starter selection is dependent on type of application. Im = FLA rating of motor.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/113
Soft Starters

3RW Soft Starters


3RW40 – Size S0-S3 Circuit Breaker

Ordering Information
� Enclosed devices should be ordered by Ideal applications for 3RW40 enclosed
the FLA of the motor. softstarters
b Fans
� The 3RW40 is designed for normal b Pumps
starting applications. b Easy starting loads starting in less than
�  or factory modifications see page 7/124.
F 10 seconds
�  or dimensional drawings see page 7/125.
F
Class 74 starters are built to UL and CSA
standards
Class 74 non-combination starters include:
3RW40 Enclosed features: b NEMA rated enclosure
b Available in NEMA 1, 12, 3R, 4, and b Circuit Breaker disconnect with shunt trip
4 stainless steel b 3RW40 Sirius softstarter with built-in OL
b Compact size and bypass
b Built-in Bypass contactor b Control Circuit Transformer
b Voltage ramp up and ramp down b Isolation Contactor
b Current limit adjustment of 125 - 550%
b Internal overload class 10, 15, or 20
b Internal self protection
b Fault monitoring
b Isolation Contactor

3RW40 for Standard Applications


Enclosed Circuit Breaker Combination (Starter With Circuit Breaker Disconnect)

Rated MAX HP
a KW Class 10 Light Duty (350% * Ie for 10s)b
Operating OPEN Style List List List List NEMA 4/4X List
Current 200V 230V 460V 575V 380V (Starter Only) NEMA 1 Price $ NEMA 3R Price $ NEMA 12 Price $ NEMA 4 Price $ Stainless Steel Price $
11 3 3 7.5 — 6 3RW4024-1BB14 74AR3_BFAP 74AR3_DFAP 74AR3_0FAP 74AR3_EFAP 74AR3_WFAP
23 5 7.5 15 — 13 3RW4026-1BB14 74BR3_BFAP 74BR3_DFAP 74BR3_0FAP 74BR3_EFAP 74BR3_WFAP
29 7.5 10 20 — 16 3RW4027-1BB14 74CR3_BFAP 74CR3_DFAP 74CR3_0FAP 74CR3_EFAP 74CR3_WFAP
34 10 10 25 — 18 3RW4028-1BB14 74DR3_BFAP 74DR3_DFAP 74DR3_0FAP 74DR3_EFAP 74DR3_WFAP
42 10 15 30 — 23 3RW4036-1BB14 74ER3_BFAP 74ER3_DFAP 74ER3_0FAP 74ER3_EFAP 74ER3_WFAP
58 15 20 40 — 31 3RW4037-1BB14 74FR3_BFAP 74FR3_DFAP 74FR3_0FAP 74FR3_EFAP 74FR3_WFAP
62 20 20 40 — 33 3RW4038-1BB14 74GR3_BFAP 74GR3_DFAP 74GR3_0FAP 74GR3_EFAP 74GR3_WFAP
73 20 25 50 — 39 3RW4046-1BB14 74HR3_BFAP 74HR3_DFAP 74HR3_0FAP 74HR3_EFAP 74HR3_WFAP
98 30 30 75 — 52 3RW4047-1BB14 74JR3_BFAP 74JR3_DFAP 74JR3_0FAP 74JR3_EFAP 74JR3_WFAP
7

200V 6 6 6 6 6
230V 2 2 2 2 2
380V 3 3 3 3 3
SOFT STARTERS

460V 4 4 4 4 4

a Starter size is dependent on the nameplate Full Load Amps (FLA) rating of the motor.  Starter selection is dependent on type of application. Ie = FLA rating of motor
HPs are for reference only. Enclosed ratings are at 40°C

7/114 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Soft Starters

Enclosed 3RW44

Ordering Information
� 
Enclosed devices should be ordered by Ideal applications for 3RW40 enclosed
the FLA of the motor. softstarters:
b Fans
�  he 3RW40 is designed for normal
T b Pumps
starting applications (Class 10 b Building/construction machines
applications). b Presses
�  or factory modifications see page 7/124.
F b Escalators
b Transport systems
�  or dimensional drawings see page 7/125.
F b Air conditioning systems
Class 74 non-combination starters include: b Ventilators
b Assembly lines
3RW40 Enclosed features: b NEMA rated enclosure
Class 74 starters are built to UL and CSA
b Available in NEMA 1, 12, 3R, 4, and 4 b Circuit breaker disconnect with shunt trip
stainless steel standards.
b 3RW40 Sirius softstarter with built-in OL
b Compact size and bypass
b Built-in bypass contactor
b Voltage ramp up and ramp down b Control circuit transformer

b Current limit adjustment of 125 - 550%
b Internal overload class 10, 15, or 20
b Internal self protection
b Fault monitoring
For all technical information, please consult the 2006 Industrial Controls Catalog or contact your local sales support center.

3RW40 for Standard Applications


Enclosed Circuit Breaker Combination (Starter with Circuit Breaker Disconnect)

Rated MAX HP
a KW Class 10 Light Duty (350% * Im for 10s)b
Operating OPEN Style List List List List NEMA 4/4X List
Current 200V 230V 460V 575V 380V (Starter Only) NEMA 1 Price $ NEMA 3R Price $ NEMA 12 Price $ NEMA 4 Price $ Stainless Steel Price $
117 30 40 75 — 56 3RW4055-6BB34 74AS3_BFAP 74AS3_DFAP 74AS3_0FAP 74AS3_EFAP 74AS3_WFAP
145 40 50 100 — 75 3RW4056-6BB34 74BS3_BFAP 74BS3_DFAP 74BS3_0FAP 74BS3_EFAP 74BS3_WFAP
205 60 75 150 — 112 3RW4073-6BB34 74CS3_BFAP 74CS3_DFAP 74CS3_0FAP 74CS3_EFAP
248 75 100 200 — 149 3RW4074-6BB34 74DS3_BFAP 74DS3_DFAP 74DS3_0FAP 74DS3_EFAP
315 100 125 250 — 186 3RW4075-6BB34 74ES3_BFAP 74ES3_DFAP 74ES3_0FAP 74ES3_EFAP
385 125 150 300 — 224 3RW4076-6BB34 74FS3_BFAP 74FS3_DFAP 74FS3_0FAP 74FS3_EFAP
200V 6 6 6 6 6
230V 2 2 2 2 2
380V 3 3 3 3 3
460V 4 4 4 4 4

7
117 — — 75 100 — 3RW4055-6BB35 74AS35BFAP 74AS35DFAP 74AS350FAP 74AS35EFAP 74AS35WFAP
145 — — 100 150 — 3RW4056-6BB35 74BS35BFAP 74BS35DFAP 74BS350FAP 74BS35EFAP 74BS35WFAP

SOFT STARTERS
205 — — 150 200 — 3RW4073-6BB35 74CS35BFAP 74CS35DFAP 74CS350FAP 74CS35EFAP
248 — — 200 250 — 3RW4074-6BB35 74DS35BFAP 74DS35DFAP 74DS350FAP 74DS35EFAP
315 — — 250 300 — 3RW4075-6BB35 74ES35BFAP 74ES35DFAP 74ES350FAP 74ES35EFAP
385 — — 300 400 — 3RW4076-6BB35 74FS35BFAP 74FS35DFAP 74FS350FAP 74FS35EFAP

Enclosed Circuit Breaker Combination (Starter with Circuit Breaker Disconnect)


Rated MAX HP
a KW Class 20 Severe Duty (350% * Ie for 20s)b
Operating OPEN Style List List List List NEMA 4/4X List
Current 200V 230V 460V 575V 380V (Starter Only) NEMA 1 Price $ NEMA 3R Price $ NEMA 12 Price $ NEMA 4 Price $ Stainless Steel Price $
112 30 40 75 — 56 3RW4055-6BB34 74AS3_BFAP 74AS3_DFAP 74AS3_0FAP 74AS3_EFAP 74AS3_WFAP
132 40 50 100 — 75 3RW4056-6BB34 74BS3_BFAP 74BS3_DFAP 74BS3_0FAP 74BS3_EFAP 74BS3_WFAP
185 60 60 125 — 93 3RW4073-6BB34 74CS3_BFAP 74CS3_DFAP 74CS3_0FAP 74CS3_EFAP
205 60 75 150 — 112 3RW4074-6BB34 74DS3_BFAP 74DS3_DFAP 74DS3_0FAP 74DS3_EFAP
280 75 100 200 — 149 3RW4075-6BB34 74ES3_BFAP 74ES3_DFAP 74ES3_0FAP 74ES3_EFAP
340 100 125 250 — 186 3RW4076-6BB34 74FS3_BFAP 74FS3_DFAP 74FS3_0FAP 74FS3_EFAP
200V 6 6 6 6 6
230V 2 2 2 2 2
380V 3 3 3 3 3
460V 4 4 4 4 4
112 — — 75 75 — 3RW4055-6BB35 74AS35BFAP 74AS35DFAP 74AS350FAP 74AS35EFAP 74AS35WFAP
132 — — 100 125 — 3RW4056-6BB35 74BS35BFAP 74BS35DFAP 74BS350FAP 74BS35EFAP 74BS35WFAP
185 — — 125 150 — 3RW4073-6BB35 74CS35BFAP 74CS35DFAP 74CS350FAP 74CS35EFAP
205 — — 150 200 — 3RW4074-6BB35 74DS35BFAP 74DS35DFAP 74DS350FAP 74DS35EFAP
280 — — 200 250 — 3RW4075-6BB35 74ES35BFAP 74ES35DFAP 74ES350FAP 74ES35EFAP
340 — — 250 300 — 3RW4076-6BB35 74FS35BFAP 74FS35DFAP 74FS350FAP 74FS35EFAP

a Starter size is dependent on the nameplate Full Load Amps (FLA) rating of the motor. b Starter selection is dependent on type of application. Im = FLA rating of motor.
HPs are for reference only. Enclosed ratings are at 40°C.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/115
Soft Starters

3RW Soft Starters


3RW40 – Size S0-S3 Fusible

Ordering Information
� Enclosed devices should be ordered by Ideal applications for 3RW40 enclosed
the FLA of the motor. softstarters
b Fans
� The 3RW40 is designed for normal b Pumps
starting applications. b Easy starting loads starting in less than
�  or factory modifications see page 7/124.
F 10 seconds
�  or dimensional drawings see page 7/125.
F
Class 74 starters are built to UL and CSA
standards
Class 73 non-combination starters include:
b NEMA rated enclosure
3RW40 Enclosed features: b Fusible Disconnect
b Available in NEMA 1, 12, 3R, 4, and b 3RW40 Sirius softstarter with built-in
4 stainless steel
b Compact size OL and bypass
b Built-in Bypass contactor b Control Circuit Transformer
b Voltage ramp up and ramp down b Isolation Contactor
b Current limit adjustment of 125 - 550%
b Internal overload class 10,15,or 20
b Internal self protection
b Fault monitoring
b Isolation Contactor

3RW40 for Standard Applications


Enclosed Fusible Combination (Starter With Fusible Disconnect)

Rated MAX HP
a KW Class 10 Light Duty (350% * Ie for 10s)b
Operating OPEN Style List List List List NEMA 4/4X List
Current 200V 230V 460V 575V 380V (Starter Only) NEMA 1 Price $ NEMA 3R Price $ NEMA 12 Price $ NEMA 4 Price $ Stainless Steel Price $
11 3 3 7.5 — 6 3RW4024-1BB14 74AR3_BFAF 74AR3_DFAF 74AR3_0FAF 74AR3_EFAF 74AR3_WFAF
23 5 7.5 15 — 13 3RW4026-1BB14 74BR3_BFAF 74BR3_DFAF 74BR3_0FAF 74BR3_EFAF 74BR3_WFAF
29 7.5 10 20 — 16 3RW4027-1BB14 74CR3_BFAF 74CR3_DFAF 74CR3_0FAF 74CR3_EFAF 74CR3_WFAF
34 10 10 25 — 18 3RW4028-1BB14 74DR3_BFAF 74DR3_DFAF 74DR3_0FAF 74DR3_EFAF 74DR3_WFAF
42 10 15 30 — 23 3RW4036-1BB14 74ER3_BFAF 74ER3_DFAF 74ER3_0FAF 74ER3_EFAF 74ER3_WFAF
58 15 20 40 — 31 3RW4037-1BB14 74FR3_BFAF 74FR3_DFAF 74FR3_0FAF 74FR3_EFAF 74FR3_WFAF
62 20 20 40 — 33 3RW4038-1BB14 74GR3_BFAF 74GR3_DFAF 74GR3_0FAF 74GR3_EFAF 74GR3_WFAF
73 20 25 50 — 39 3RW4046-1BB14 74HR3_BFAF 74HR3_DFAF 74HR3_0FAF 74HR3_EFAF 74HR3_WFAF
98 30 30 75 — 52 3RW4047-1BB14 74JR3_BFAF 74JR3_DFAF 74JR3_0FAF 74JR3_EFAF 74JR3_WFAF
200V 6 6 6 6 6
7

230V 2 2 2 2 2
380V 3 3 3 3 3
SOFT STARTERS

460V 4 4 4 4 4

a Starter size is dependent on the nameplate Full Load Amps (FLA) rating of the motor.  Starter selection is dependent on type of application. Ie = FLA rating of motor
HPs are for reference only. Enclosed ratings are at 40°C

7/116 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Soft Starters

Enclosed 3RW44

Ordering Information
�  nclosed devices should be ordered by
E Ideal applications for 3RW40 enclosed
the FLA of the motor. softstarters:
b Fans
�  he 3RW40 is designed for normal
T b Pumps
starting applications (Class 10 b Building/construction machines
applications). b Presses
�  or factory modifications see page 7/124.
F b Escalators
b Transport systems
�  or dimensional drawings see page 7/125.
F b Air conditioning systems
Class 74 combination starters include: b Ventilators
b Assembly lines
3RW40 Enclosed features: b NEMA rated enclosure
b Available in NEMA 1, 12, 3R, 4, and 4 Class 74 starters are built to UL and CSA
b Fusible disconnect
stainless steel standards.
b Compact size b 3RW40 Sirius softstarter with built-in OL
and bypass
b Built-in bypass contactor
b Voltage ramp up and ramp down b Control circuit transformer

b Current limit adjustment of 125 - 550%
b Internal overload class 10, 15, or 20
b Internal self protection
b Fault monitoring

For all technical information, please consult the 2006 Industrial Controls Catalog or contact your local sales support center.

3RW40 for Standard Applications


Enclosed Fusible Combination (Starter with Fusible Disconnect)

Rated MAX HP
a KW Class 10 Light Duty (350% * Im for 10s)b
Operating OPEN Style List List List List NEMA 4/4X List
Current 200V 230V 460V 575V 380V (Starter Only) NEMA 1 Price $ NEMA 3R Price $ NEMA 12 Price $ NEMA 4 Price $ Stainless Steel Price $
117 30 40 75 — 56 3RW4055-6BB34 74AS3_BFAF 74AS3_DFAF 74AS3_0FAF 74AS3_EFAF 74AS3_WFAF
145 40 50 100 — 75 3RW4056-6BB34 74BS3_BFAF 74BS3_DFAF 74BS3_0FAF 74BS3_EFAF 74BS3_WFAF
205 60 75 150 — 112 3RW4073-6BB34 74CS3_BFAF 74CS3_DFAF 74CS3_0FAF 74CS3_EFAF
248 75 100 200 — 149 3RW4074-6BB34 74DS3_BFAF 74DS3_DFAF 74DS3_0FAF 74DS3_EFAF
315 100 125 250 — 186 3RW4075-6BB34 74ES3_BFAF 74ES3_DFAF 74ES3_0FAF 74ES3_EFAF
385 125 150 300 — 224 3RW4076-6BB34 74FS3_BFAF 74FS3_DFAF 74FS3_0FAF 74FS3_EFAF
200V 6 6 6 6 6
230V 2 2 2 2 2
380V 3 3 3 3 3
460V 4 4 4 4 4

7
117 — — 75 100 — 3RW4055-6BB35 74AS35BFAF 74AS35DFAF 74AS350FAF 74AS35EFAF 74AS35WFAF
145 — — 100 150 — 3RW4056-6BB35 74BS35BFAF 74BS35DFAF 74BS350FAF 74BS35EFAF 74BS35WFAF

SOFT STARTERS
205 — — 150 200 — 3RW4073-6BB35 74CS35BFAF 74CS35DFAF 74CS350FAF 74CS35EFAF
248 — — 200 250 — 3RW4074-6BB35 74DS35BFAF 74DS35DFAF 74DS350FAF 74DS35EFAF
315 — — 250 300 — 3RW4075-6BB35 74ES35BFAF 74ES35DFAF 74ES350FAF 74ES35EFAF
385 — — 300 400 — 3RW4076-6BB35 74FS35BFAF 74FS35DFAF 74FS350FAF 74FS35EFAF

Enclosed Fusible Combination (Starter with Fusible Disconnect)


Rated MAX HP
a KW Class 20 Severe Duty (350% * Ie for 20s)b
Operating OPEN Style List List List List NEMA 4/4X List
Current 200V 230V 460V 575V 380V (Starter Only) NEMA 1 Price $ NEMA 3R Price $ NEMA 12 Price $ NEMA 4 Price $ Stainless Steel Price $
112 30 40 75 — 56 3RW4055-6BB34 74AS3_BFAF 74AS3_DFAF 74AS3_0FAF 74AS3_EFAF 74AS3_WFAF
132 40 50 100 — 75 3RW4056-6BB34 74BS3_BFAF 74BS3_DFAF 74BS3_0FAF 74BS3_EFAF 74BS3_WFAF
185 60 60 125 — 93 3RW4073-6BB34 74CS3_BFAF 74CS3_DFAF 74CS3_0FAF 74CS3_EFAF
205 60 75 150 — 112 3RW4074-6BB34 74DS3_BFAF 74DS3_DFAF 74DS3_0FAF 74DS3_EFAF
280 75 100 200 — 149 3RW4075-6BB34 74ES3_BFAF 74ES3_DFAF 74ES3_0FAF 74ES3_EFAF
340 100 125 250 — 186 3RW4076-6BB34 74FS3_BFAF 74FS3_DFAF 74FS3_0FAF 74FS3_EFAF
200V 6 6 6 6 6
230V 2 2 2 2 2
380V 3 3 3 3 3
460V 4 4 4 4 4
112 — — 75 75 — 3RW4055-6BB35 74AS35BFAF 74AS35DFAF 74AS350FAF 74AS35EFAF 74AS35WFAF
132 — — 100 125 — 3RW4056-6BB35 74BS35BFAF 74BS35DFAF 74BS350FAF 74BS35EFAF 74BS35WFAF
185 — — 125 150 — 3RW4073-6BB35 74CS35BFAF 74CS35DFAF 74CS350FAF 74CS35EFAF
205 — — 150 200 — 3RW4074-6BB35 74DS35BFAF 74DS35DFAF 74DS350FAF 74DS35EFAF
280 — — 200 250 — 3RW4075-6BB35 74ES35BFAF 74ES35DFAF 74ES350FAF 74ES35EFAF
340 — — 250 300 — 3RW4076-6BB35 74FS35BFAF 74FS35DFAF 74FS350FAF 74FS35EFAF

a Starter size is dependent on the nameplate Full Load Amps (FLA) rating of the motor. b Starter selection is dependent on type of application. Im = FLA rating of motor.
HPs are for reference only. Enclosed ratings are at 40°C.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/117
Soft Starters

Enclosed 3RW44

Ordering Information
�  nclosed devices should be ordered by
E Ideal applications for 3RW44 enclosed
the FLA of the motor. softstarters:
b Fans
�  he 3RW44 is designed for normal
T b Pumps
starting applications. b Conveying systems and lifts
3RW44 Enclosed features:
b Available in NEMA 1, 12, 3R, 4, and 4
�  or factory modifications see page 7/124.
F b Hydraulics
stainless steel b Machine tools
�  or dimensional drawings see page 7/125.
F b Mills saws
b Compact size
b Built-in bypass contactor Class 73 non-combination starters include: b Crushers and grinders
b Multiple starting/stopping techniques b Mixers
including torque control b NEMA rated enclosure
b HVAC systems
b Internal overload class 5, 10, 15, 20, or 30 b 3RW44 Sirius softstarter with built-in OL
The 3RW44 severe duty rating table should
b Built-in graphical LCD keypad and bypass
b Internal self protection be applied for high inertia applications
b Control circuit transformer

such rock crushers, chippers, screw
b Fault monitoring
b 3 parameter sets b Reset button compressors, ect.
b Communication capable via opt. Profibus Class 73 starters are built to UL and CSA
module
b Programmable inputs and outputs standards.
b External keypad available

3RW44 For High Feature Applications


Enclosed Non-Combination (Starter Only)

Rated MAX HP
a KW Class 10 Light Duty (350% * Im for 10s)b
Operating OPEN Style List List List List NEMA 4/4X List
Current 200V 230V 460V 575V 380V (Starter Only) NEMA 1 Price $ NEMA 3R Price $ NEMA 12 Price $ NEMA 4 Price $ Stainless Steel Price $
26 7.5 7.5 15 — 12 3RW4422-1BC34 73AT3_BFA 73AT3_DFA 73AT3_0FA 73AT3_EFA 73AT3_WFA
32 10 10 20 — 15 3RW4423-1BC34 73BT3_BFA 73BT3_DFA 73BT3_0FA 73BT3_EFA 73BT3_WFA
42 10 15 25 — 19 3RW4424-1BC34 73CT3_BFA 73CT3_DFA 73CT3_0FA 73CT3_EFA 73CT3_WFA
51 15 15 30 — 22 3RW4425-1BC34 73DT3_BFA 73DT3_DFA 73DT3_0FA 73DT3_EFA 73DT3_WFA
68 20 25 50 — 37 3RW4426-1BC34 73ET3_BFA 73ET3_DFA 73ET3_0FA 73ET3_EFA 73ET3_WFA
82 25 30 60 — 45 3RW4427-1BC34 73FT3_BFA 73FT3_DFA 73FT3_0FA 73FT3_EFA 73FT3_WFA
100 30 30 75 — 56 3RW4434-6BC34 73GT3_BFA 73GT3_DFA 73GT3_0FA 73GT3_EFA 73GT3_WFA
117 30 40 75 — 56 3RW4435-6BC34 73HT3_BFA 73HT3_DFA 73HT3_0FA 73HT3_EFA 73HT3_WFA
145 40 50 100 — 75 3RW4436-6BC34 73JT3_BFA 73JT3_DFA 73JT3_0FA 73JT3_EFA 73JT3_WFA
180 60 60 125 — 93 3RW4443-6BC34 73KT3_BFA 73KT3_DFA 73KT3_0FA 73KT3_EFA 73KT3_WFA
215 60 75 150 — 112 3RW4444-6BC34 73LT3_BFA 73LT3_DFA 73LT3_0FA 73LT3_EFA 73LT3_WFA
280 75 100 200 — 149 3RW4445-6BC34 73MT3_BFA 73MT3_DFA 73MT3_0FA 73MT3_EFA 73MT3_WFA
315 100 125 250 — 186 3RW4446-6BC34 73NT3_BFA 73NT3_DFA 73NT3_0FA 73NT3_EFA 73NT3_WFA
385 125 150 300 — 224 3RW4447-6BC34 73PT3_BFA 73PT3_DFA 73PT3_0FA 73PT3_EFA 73PT3_WFA
494 150 200 400 — 298 3RW4453-6BC34 73QT3_BFA 73QT3_DFA 73QT3_0FA 73QT3_EFA
7

551 150 200 450 — 336 3RW4454-6BC34 73RT3_BFA 73RT3_DFA 73RT3_0FA 73RT3_EFA
615 200 250 500 — 373 3RW4455-6BC34 73ST3_BFA 73ST3_DFA 73ST3_0FA 73ST3_EFA
693 200 250 550 — 410
SOFT STARTERS

3RW4456-6BC34 73TT3_BFA 73TT3_DFA 73TT3_0FA 73TT3_EFA


780 200 250 600 — 447 3RW4457-6BC34 73WT3_BFA 73WT3_DFA 73WT3_0FA
970 350 350 800 — 597 3RW4465-6BC34 73YT3_BFA 73YT3_0FA
1076 350 400 900 — 972 3RW4466-6BC34 73ZT3_BFA 73ZT3_0FA
200V 6 6 6 6 6
230V 2 2 2 2 2
380V 3 3 3 3 3
460V 4 4 4 4 4
26 — — 15 20 — 3RW4422-1BC35 73AT35BFA 73AT35DFA 73AT350FA 73AT35EFA 73AT35WFA
32 — — 20 25 — 3RW4423-1BC35 73BT35BFA 73BT35DFA 73BT350FA 73BT35EFA 73BT35WFA
42 — — 25 30 — 3RW4424-1BC35 73CT35BFA 73CT35DFA 73CT350FA 73CT35EFA 73CT35WFA
51 — — 30 40 — 3RW4425-1BC35 73DT35BFA 73DT35DFA 73DT350FA 73DT35EFA 73DT35WFA
68 — — 50 50 — 3RW4426-1BC35 73ET35BFA 73ET35DFA 73ET350FA 73ET35EFA 73ET35WFA
82 — — 60 75 — 3RW4427-1BC35 73FT35BFA 73FT35DFA 73FT350FA 73FT35EFA 73FT35WFA
100 — — 75 75 — 3RW4434-6BC35 73GT35BFA 73GT35DFA 73GT350FA 73GT35EFA 73GT35WFA
117 — — 75 100 — 3RW4435-6BC35 73HT35BFA 73HT35DFA 73HT350FA 73HT35EFA 73HT35WFA
145 — — 100 125 — 3RW4436-6BC35 73JT35BFA 73JT35DFA 73JT350FA 73JT35EFA 73JT35WFA
180 — — 125 150 — 3RW4443-6BC35 73KT35BFA 73KT35DFA 73KT350FA 73KT35EFA 73KT35WFA
215 — — 150 200 — 3RW4444-6BC35 73LT35BFA 73LT35DFA 73LT350FA 73LT35EFA 73LT35WFA
280 — — 200 250 — 3RW4445-6BC35 73MT35BFA 73MT35DFA 73MT350FA 73MT35EFA 73MT35WFA
315 — — 250 300 — 3RW4446-6BC35 73NT35BFA 73NT35DFA 73NT350FA 73NT35EFA 73NT35WFA
385 — — 300 400 — 3RW4447-6BC35 73PT35BFA 73PT35DFA 73PT350FA 73PT35EFA 73PT35WFA
494 — — 400 500 — 3RW4453-6BC35 73QT35BFA 73QT35DFA 73QT350FA 73QT35EFA
551 — — 450 600 — 3RW4454-6BC35 73RT35BFA 73RT35DFA 73RT350FA 73RT35EFA
615 — — 500 700 — 3RW4455-6BC35 73ST35BFA 73ST35DFA 73ST350FA 73ST35EFA
693 — — 550 750 — 3RW4456-6BC35 73TT35BFA 73TT35DFA 73TT350FA 73TT35EFA
780 — — 600 850 — 3RW4457-6BC35 73WT35BFA 73WT35DFA 73WT350FA 73WT35EFA
970 — — 800 1000 — 3RW4465-6BC35 73YT35BFA 73YT350FA
1076 — — 900 1100 — 3RW4466-6BC35 73ZT35BFA 73ZT350FA
a Starter
size is dependent on the nameplate Full Load Amps (FLA) rating of the motor. b Starter selection is dependent on type of application. Im = FLA rating of motor.
HPs are for reference only. Enclosed ratings are at 40°C.

7/118 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Soft Starters

Enclosed 3RW44

Ordering Information
�  nclosed devices should be ordered by
E Ideal applications for 3RW44 enclosed
the FLA of the motor. softstarters:
b Fans
�  he 3RW44 is designed for normal
T
b Pumps
starting applications.
3RW44 Enclosed features: b Conveying systems and lifts
b Available in NEMA 1, 12, 3R, 4, and 4
�  or factory modifications see page 7/124.
F b Hydraulics
stainless steel �  or dimensional drawings see page 7/125.
F b Machine tools
b Compact size b Mills saws
b Built-in bypass contactor Class 73 non-combination starters include: b Crushers and grinders
b Multiple starting/stopping techniques b NEMA rated enclosure b Mixers
including torque control
b Internal overload class 10, 15, or 20 b 3RW44 Sirius softstarter with built-in OL b HVAC systems
and bypass
b Built-in graphical LCD keypad The 3RW44 severe duty rating table should
b Internal self protection b Control circuit transformer be applied for high inertia applications
b Fault monitoring b Line side power terminal block such rock crushers, chippers, screw
b 3 parameter sets b Reset button compressors, ect.
b Communication capable via opt. Profibus
module Class 73 starters are built to UL and CSA
b Programmable inputs and outputs standards.
b External keypad available

3RW44 For High Feature Applications


Enclosed Non-Combination (Starter Only)

Rated MAX HP
a KW Class 20 Severe Duty (350% * Im for 20s)b
Operating OPEN Style List List List List NEMA 4/4X List
Current 200V 230V 460V 575V 380V (Starter Only) NEMA 1 Price $ NEMA 3R Price $ NEMA 12 Price $ NEMA 4 Price $ Stainless Steel Price $
26 7.5 7.5 15 — 12 3RW4422-1BC34 73AT3_BFA 73AT3_DFA 73AT3_0FA 73AT3_EFA 73AT3_WFA
32 10 10 20 — 15 3RW4423-1BC34 73BT3_BFA 73BT3_DFA 73BT3_0FA 73BT3_EFA 73BT3_WFA
42 10 15 25 — 19 3RW4424-1BC34 73CT3_BFA 73CT3_DFA 73CT3_0FA 73CT3_EFA 73CT3_WFA
51 15 15 30 — 22 3RW4425-1BC34 73DT3_BFA 73DT3_DFA 73DT3_0FA 73DT3_EFA 73DT3_WFA
68 20 25 50 — 37 3RW4426-1BC34 73ET3_BFA 73ET3_DFA 73ET3_0FA 73ET3_EFA 73ET3_WFA
82 25 30 60 — 45 3RW4427-1BC34 73FT3_BFA 73FT3_DFA 73FT3_0FA 73FT3_EFA 73FT3_WFA
97 30 30 60 — 45 3RW4434-6BC34 73GT3_BFA 73GT3_DFA 73GT3_0FA 73GT3_EFA 73GT3_WFA
113 30 40 75 — 56 3RW4435-6BC34 73HT3_BFA 73HT3_DFA 73HT3_0FA 73HT3_EFA 73HT3_WFA
134 40 50 75 — 56 3RW4436-6BC34 73JT3_BFA 73JT3_DFA 73JT3_0FA 73JT3_EFA 73JT3_WFA
175 50 60 100 — 75 3RW4443-6BC34 73KT3_BFA 73KT3_DFA 73KT3_0FA 73KT3_EFA 73KT3_WFA
195 60 75 125 — 93 3RW4444-6BC34 73LT3_BFA 73LT3_DFA 73LT3_0FA 73LT3_EFA 73LT3_WFA
243 75 75 150 — 112 3RW4445-6BC34 73MT3_BFA 73MT3_DFA 73MT3_0FA 73MT3_EFA 73MT3_WFA
263 75 100 200 — 149 3RW4446-6BC34 73NT3_BFA 73NT3_DFA 73NT3_0FA 73NT3_EFA 73NT3_WFA
326 100 125 250 — 186 3RW4447-6BC34 73PT3_BFA 73PT3_DFA 73PT3_0FA 73PT3_EFA 73PT3_WFA
494 150 150 400 — 224 3RW4453-6BC34 73QT3_BFA 73QT3_DFA 73QT3_0FA 73QT3_EFA

7
551 150 200 450 — 298 3RW4454-6BC34 73RT3_BFA 73RT3_DFA 73RT3_0FA 73RT3_EFA
615 200 200 500 — 336 3RW4455-6BC34 73ST3_BFA 73ST3_DFA 73ST3_0FA 73ST3_EFA
634 200 250 500 — 373 3RW4456-6BC34 73TT3_BFA 73TT3_DFA 73TT3_0FA 73TT3_EFA

SOFT STARTERS
650 200 250 550 — 410 3RW4457-6BC34 73WT3_BFA 73WT3_DFA 73WT3_0FA 73WT3_EFA
880 300 350 700 — 522 3RW4465-6BC34 73YT3_BFA 73YT3_0FA
940 300 350 750 — 559 3RW4466-6BC34 73ZT3_BFA 73ZT3_0FA ­
200V 6 6 6 6 6
230V 2 2 2 2 2
380V 3 3 3 3 3
460V 4 4 4 4 4
26 — — 15 20 — 3RW4422-1BC35 73AT35BFA 73AT35DFA 73AT350FA 73AT35EFA 73AT35WFA
32 — — 20 25 — 3RW4423-1BC35 73BT35BFA 73BT35DFA 73BT350FA 73BT35EFA 73BT35WFA
42 — — 25 30 — 3RW4424-1BC35 73CT35BFA 73CT35DFA 73CT350FA 73CT35EFA 73CT35WFA
51 — — 30 40 — 3RW4425-1BC35 73DT35BFA 73DT35DFA 73DT350FA 73DT35EFA 73DT35WFA
68 — — 50 50 — 3RW4426-1BC35 73ET35BFA 73ET35DFA 73ET350FA 73ET35EFA 73ET35WFA
82 — — 60 75 — 3RW4427-1BC35 73FT35BFA 73FT35DFA 73FT350FA 73FT35EFA 73FT35WFA
97 — — 60 75 — 3RW4434-6BC35 73GT35BFA 73GT35DFA 73GT350FA 73GT35EFA 73GT35WFA
113 — — 75 100 — 3RW4435-6BC35 73HT35BFA 73HT35DFA 73HT350FA 73HT35EFA 73HT35WFA
134 — — 75 125 — 3RW4436-6BC35 73JT35BFA 73JT35DFA 73JT350FA 73JT35EFA 73JT35WFA
175 — — 100 150 — 3RW4443-6BC35 73KT35BFA 73KT35DFA 73KT350FA 73KT35EFA 73KT35WFA
195 — — 125 200 — 3RW4444-6BC35 73LT35BFA 73LT35DFA 73LT350FA 73LT35EFA 73LT35WFA
243 — — 150 200 — 3RW4445-6BC35 73MT35BFA 73MT35DFA 73MT350FA 73MT35EFA 73MT35WFA
263 — — 200 250 — 3RW4446-6BC35 73NT35BFA 73NT35DFA 73NT350FA 73NT35EFA 73NT35WFA
326 — — 250 300 — 3RW4447-6BC35 73PT35BFA 73PT35DFA 73PT350FA 73PT35EFA 73PT35WFA
494 — — 400 500 — 3RW4453-6BC35 73QT35BFA 73QT35DFA 73QT350FA 73QT35EFA
551 — — 450 550 — 3RW4454-6BC35 73RT35BFA 73RT35DFA 73RT350FA 73RT35EFA
615 — — 500 600 — 3RW4455-6BC35 73ST35BFA 73ST35DFA 73ST350FA 73ST35EFA
693 — — 500 650 — 3RW4456-6BC35 73TT35BFA 73TT35DFA 73TT350FA 73TT35EFA
780 — — 550 700 — 3RW4457-6BC35 73WT35BFA 73WT35DFA 73WT350FA 73WT35EFA
880 — — 700 850 — 3RW4465-6BC35 73YT35BFA 73YT350FA
940 — — 750 900 — 3RW4466-6BC35 73ZT35BFA 73ZT350FA
a Starter size is dependent on the nameplate Full Load Amps (FLA) rating of the motor. b Starter selection is dependent on type of application. Im = FLA rating of motor.
HPs are for reference only. Enclosed ratings are at 40°C.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/119
Soft Starters

Enclosed 3RW44

Ordering Information
�  nclosed devices should be ordered by
E Ideal applications for 3RW44 enclosed
the FLA of the motor. softstarters:
b Fans
� T he 3RW44 is designed for normal
starting applications. b Pumps
b Conveying systems and lifts
3RW44 Enclosed features: � F or factory modifications see page 7/124. b Hydraulics
b Available in NEMA 1, 12, 3R, 4, and 4 � F or dimensional drawings see page 7/125. b Machine tools
stainless steel
b Compact size � F or stocked versions see page 7/89. b Mills saws
b Built-in bypass contactor Class 74 non-combination starters include: b Crushers and grinders
b Multiple starting/stopping techniques b NEMA rated enclosure
b Mixers
including torque control b HVAC systems
b Internal overload class 5, 10, 15, 20, or 30 b 3RW44 Sirius softstarter with built-in OL
b Built-in graphical LCD keypad and bypass The 3RW44 severe duty rating table should
b Internal self protection b Circuit breaker with disconnect be applied for high inertia applications
b Fault monitoring b Control circuit transformer such rock crushers, chippers, screw
b 3 parameter sets compressors, ect.
b Communication capable via opt. Profibus b Reset button
module Class 74 starters are built to UL and CSA
b Programmable inputs and outputs standards.
b External keypad available

3RW44 For High Feature Applications


Enclosed Combination with Circuit Breaker Disconnect
Rated MAX HP
a KW Class 10 Light Duty (350% * Im for 10s)b
Operating OPEN Style List List List List NEMA 4/4X List
Current 200V 230V 460V 575V 380V (Starter Only) NEMA 1 Price $ NEMA 3R Price $ NEMA 12 Price $ NEMA 4 Price $ Stainless Steel Price $
26 7.5 7.5 15 — 12 3RW4422-1BC34 74AT3_BFAP 74AT3_DFAP 74AT3_0FAP 74AT3_EFAP 74AT3_WFAP
32 10 10 20 — 15 3RW4423-1BC34 74BT3_BFAP 74BT3_DFAP 74BT3_0FAP 74BT3_EFAP 74BT3_WFAP
42 10 15 25 — 19 3RW4424-1BC34 74CT3_BFAP 74CT3_DFAP 74CT3_0FAP 74CT3_EFAP 74CT3_WFAP
51 15 15 30 — 22 3RW4425-1BC34 74DT3_BFAP 74DT3_DFAP 74DT3_0FAP 74DT3_EFAP 74DT3_WFAP
68 20 25 50 — 37 3RW4426-1BC34 74ET3_BFAP 74ET3_DFAP 74ET3_0FAP 74ET3_EFAP 74ET3_WFAP
82 25 30 60 — 45 3RW4427-1BC34 74FT3_BFAP 74FT3_DFAP 74FT3_0FAP 74FT3_EFAP 74FT3_WFAP
100 30 30 75 — 56 3RW4434-6BC34 74GT3_BFAP 74GT3_DFAP 74GT3_0FAP 74GT3_EFAP 74GT3_WFAP
117 30 40 75 — 56 3RW4435-6BC34 74HT3_BFAP 74HT3_DFAP 74HT3_0FAP 74HT3_EFAP 74HT3_WFAP
145 40 50 100 — 75 3RW4436-6BC34 74JT3_BFAP 74JT3_DFAP 74JT3_0FAP 74JT3_EFAP 74JT3_WFAP
180 60 60 125 — 93 3RW4443-6BC34 74KT3_BFAP 74KT3_DFAP 74KT3_0FAP 74KT3_EFAP
215 60 75 150 — 112 3RW4444-6BC34 74LT3_BFAP 74LT3_DFAP 74LT3_0FAP 74LT3_EFAP
280 75 100 200 — 149 3RW4445-6BC34 74MT3_BFAP 74MT3_DFAP 74MT3_0FAP 74MT3_EFAP
315 100 125 250 — 186 3RW4446-6BC34 74NT3_BFAP 74NT3_DFAP 74NT3_0FAP 74NT3_EFAP
385 125 150 300 — 224 3RW4447-6BC34 74PT3_BFAP 74PT3_DFAP 74PT3_0FAP 74PT3_EFAP
494 150 200 400 — 298 3RW4453-6BC34 74QT3_BFAT 74QT3_DFAT 74QT3_0FAT 74QT3_EFAT
7

551 150 200 450 — 336 3RW4454-6BC34 74RT3_BFAT 74RT3_DFAT 74RT3_0FAT 74RT3_EFAT
615 200 250 500 — 373 3RW4455-6BC34 74ST3_BFAT 74ST3_DFAT 74ST3_0FAT 74ST3_EFAT
693 200 250 550 — 410 3RW4456-6BC34 74TT3_BFAT 74TT3_DFAT 74TT3_0FAT 74TT3_EFAT
SOFT STARTERS

780 200 250 600 — 447 3RW4457-6BC34 74WT3_BFAT 74WT3_DFAT 74WT3_0FAT 74WT3_EFAT
970 350 350 800 — 597 3RW4465-6BC34 74YT3_BFAT 74YT3_0FAT
1076 350 400 900 — 672 3RW4466-6BC34 74ZT3_BFAT 74ZT3_0FAT
200V 6 6 6 6 6
230V 2 2 2 2 2
380V 3 3 3 3 3
460V 4 4 4 4 4
26 — — 15 20 — 3RW4422-1BC35 74AT35BFAP 74AT35DFAP 74AT350FAP 74AT35EFAP 74AT35WFAP
32 — — 20 25 — 3RW4423-1BC35 74BT35BFAP 74BT35DFAP 74BT350FAP 74BT35EFAP 74BT35WFAP
42 — — 25 30 — 3RW4424-1BC35 74CT35BFAP 74CT35DFAP 74CT350FAP 74CT35EFAP 74CT35WFAP
51 — — 30 40 — 3RW4425-1BC35 74DT35BFAP 74DT35DFAP 74DT350FAP 74DT35EFAP 74DT35WFAP
68 — — 50 50 — 3RW4426-1BC35 74ET35BFAP 74ET35DFAP 74ET350FAP 74ET35EFAP 74ET35WFAP
82 — — 60 75 — 3RW4427-1BC35 74FT35BFAP 74FT35DFAP 74FT350FAP 74FT35EFAP 74FT35WFAP
100 — — 75 75 — 3RW4434-6BC35 74GT35BFAP 74GT35DFAP 74GT350FAP 74GT35EFAP 74GT35WFAP
117 — — 75 100 — 3RW4435-6BC35 74HT35BFAP 74HT35DFAP 74HT350FAP 74HT35EFAP 74HT35WFAP
145 — — 100 125 — 3RW4436-6BC35 74JT35BFAP 74JT35DFAP 74JT350FAP 74JT35EFAP 74JT35WFAP
180 — — 125 150 — 3RW4443-6BC35 74KT35BFAP 74KT35DFAP 74KT350FAP 74KT35EFAP
215 — — 150 200 — 3RW4444-6BC35 74LT35BFAP 74LT35DFAP 74LT350FAP 74LT35EFAP
280 — — 200 250 — 3RW4445-6BC35 74MT35BFAP 74MT35DFAP 74MT350FAP 74MT35EFAP
315 — — 250 300 — 3RW4446-6BC35 74NT35BFAP 74NT35DFAP 74NT350FAP 74NT35EFAP
385 — — 300 400 — 3RW4447-6BC35 74PT35BFAP 74PT35DFAP 74PT350FAP 74PT35EFAP
494 — — 400 500 — 3RW4453-6BC35 74QT35BFAT 74QT35DFAT 74QT350FAT 74QT35EFAT
551 — — 450 600 — 3RW4454-6BC35 74RT35BFAT 74RT35DFAT 74RT350FAT 74RT35EFAT
615 — — 500 700 — 3RW4455-6BC35 74ST35BFAT 74ST35DFAT 74ST350FAT 74ST35EFAT
693 — — 550 750 — 3RW4456-6BC35 74TT35BFAT 74TT35DFAT 74TT350FAT 74TT35EFAT
780 — — 600 850 — 3RW4457-6BC35 74WT35BFAT 74WT35DFAT 74WT350FAT 74WT35EFAT
970 — — 800 1000 — 3RW4465-6BC35 74YT35BFAT 74YT350FAT
1076 — — 900 1100 — 3RW4466-6BC35 74ZT35BFAT 74ZT350FAT

a Starter size is dependent on the nameplate Full Load Amps (FLA) rating of the motor. b Starter selection is dependent on type of application. Im = FLA rating of motor.
HPs are for reference only. Enclosed ratings are at 40°C.

7/120 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Soft Starters

Enclosed 3RW44

Ordering Information
�  nclosed devices should be ordered by
E Ideal applications for 3RW44 enclosed
the FLA of the motor. softstarters:
�  he 3RW44 is designed for normal
T b Fans
starting applications. b Pumps
3RW44 Enclosed features: b Conveying systems and lifts
�  or factory modifications see page 7/124.
F
b Hydraulics
b Available in NEMA 1, 12, 3R, 4, and 4  or dimensional drawings see page 7/125.
F
stainless steel

b Machine tools
b Compact size �  or stocked versions see page 7/89.
F b Mills saws
b Built-in bypass contactor Class 74 non-combination starters include: b Crushers and grinders
b Multiple starting/stopping techniques b Mixers
including torque control b NEMA rated enclosure b HVAC systems
b Internal overload class 5, 10, 15, 20, or 30 b 3RW44 Sirius softstarter with built-in OL
b Built-in graphical LCD keypad and bypass The 3RW44 severe duty rating table should
b Internal self protection be applied for high inertia applications
b Fault monitoring b Circuit breaker with disconnect
such rock crushers, chippers, screw
b 3 parameter sets b Control circuit transformer compressors, ect.
b Communication capable via opt. Profibus b Reset button
module Class 74 starters are built to UL and CSA
b Programmable inputs and outputs standards.
b External keypad available

3RW44 For High Feature Applications


Enclosed Combination with Circuit Breaker Disconnect

Rated MAX HP
a KW Class 20 Severe Duty (350% * Im for 20s)b
Operating OPEN Style List List List List NEMA 4/4X List
Current 200V 230V 460V 575V 380V (Starter Only) NEMA 1 Price $ NEMA 3R Price $ NEMA 12 Price $ NEMA 4 Price $ Stainless Steel Price $
26 7.5 7.5 15 — 12 3RW4422-1BC34 74AT3_BFAP 74AT3_DFAP 74AT3_0FAP 74AT3_EFAP 74AT3_WFAP
32 10 10 20 — 15 3RW4423-1BC34 74BT3_BFAP 74BT3_DFAP 74BT3_0FAP 74BT3_EFAP 74BT3_WFAP
42 10 15 25 — 19 3RW4424-1BC34 74CT3_BFAP 74CT3_DFAP 74CT3_0FAP 74CT3_EFAP 74CT3_WFAP
51 15 15 30 — 22 3RW4425-1BC34 74DT3_BFAP 74DT3_DFAP 74DT3_0FAP 74DT3_EFAP 74DT3_WFAP
68 20 25 50 — 37 3RW4426-1BC34 74ET3_BFAP 74ET3_DFAP 74ET3_0FAP 74ET3_EFAP 74ET3_WFAP
82 25 30 60 — 45 3RW4427-1BC34 74FT3_BFAP 74FT3_DFAP 74FT3_0FAP 74FT3_EFAP 74FT3_WFAP
97 30 30 60 — 45 3RW4434-6BC34 74GT3_BFAP 74GT3_DFAP 74GT3_0FAP 74GT3_EFAP 74GT3_WFAP
113 30 40 75 — 56 3RW4435-6BC34 74HT3_BFAP 74HT3_DFAP 74HT3_0FAP 74HT3_EFAP 74HT3_WFAP
134 40 50 75 — 56 3RW4436-6BC34 74JT3_BFAP 74JT3_DFAP 74JT3_0FAP 74JT3_EFAP 74JT3_WFAP
175 50 60 100 — 75 3RW4443-6BC34 74KT3_BFAP 74KT3_DFAP 74KT3_0FAP 74KT3_EFAP
195 60 75 125 — 93 3RW4444-6BC34 74LT3_BFAP 74LT3_DFAP 74LT3_0FAP 74LT3_EFAP
243 75 75 150 — 112 3RW4445-6BC34 74MT3_BFAP 74MT3_DFAP 74MT3_0FAP 74MT3_EFAP
263 75 100 200 — 149 3RW4446-6BC34 74NT3_BFAP 74NT3_DFAP 74NT3_0FAP 74NT3_EFAP
326 100 125 250 — 186 3RW4447-6BC34 74PT3_BFAP 74PT3_DFAP 74PT3_0FAP 74PT3_EFAP
494 150 150 400 — 224 3RW4453-6BC34 74QT3_BFAT 74QT3_DFAT 74QT3_0FAT 74QT3_EFAT

7
551 150 200 450 — 298 3RW4454-6BC34 74RT3_BFAT 74RT3_DFAT 74RT3_0FAT 74RT3_EFAT
615 200 200 500 — 336 3RW4455-6BC34 74ST3_BFAT 74ST3_DFAT 74ST3_0FAT 74ST3_EFAT
634 200 250 500 — 373 3RW4456-6BC34 74TT3_BFAT 74TT3_DFAT 74TT3_0FAT 74TT3_EFAT

SOFT STARTERS
650 200 250 550 — 410 3RW4457-6BC34 74WT3_BFAT 74WT3_DFAT 74WT3_0FAT 74WT3_EFAT
880 300 350 700 — 522 3RW4465-6BC34 74YT3_BFAT 74YT3_0FAT
940 300 350 750 — 559 3RW4466-6BC34 74ZT3_BFAT 74ZT3_0FAT
200V 6 6 6 6 6
230V 2 2 2 2 2
380V 3 3 3 3 3
460V 4 4 4 4 4
26 — — 15 20 — 3RW4422-1BC35 74AT35BFAP 74AT35DFAP 74AT350FAP 74AT35EFAP 74AT35WFAP
32 — — 20 25 — 3RW4423-1BC35 74BT35BFAP 74BT35DFAP 74BT350FAP 74BT35EFAP 74BT35WFAP
42 — — 25 30 — 3RW4424-1BC35 74CT35BFAP 74CT35DFAP 74CT350FAP 74CT35EFAP 74CT35WFAP
51 — — 30 40 — 3RW4425-1BC35 74DT35BFAP 74DT35DFAP 74DT350FAP 74DT35EFAP 74DT35WFAP
68 — — 50 50 — 3RW4426-1BC35 74ET35BFAP 74ET35DFAP 74ET350FAP 74ET35EFAP 74ET35WFAP
82 — — 60 75 — 3RW4427-1BC35 74FT35BFAP 74FT35DFAP 74FT350FAP 74FT35EFAP 74FT35WFAP
97 — — 60 75 — 3RW4434-6BC35 74GT35BFAP 74GT35DFAP 74GT350FAP 74GT35EFAP 74GT35WFAP
113 — — 75 100 — 3RW4435-6BC35 74HT35BFAP 74HT35DFAP 74HT350FAP 74HT35EFAP 74HT35WFAP
134 — — 75 125 — 3RW4436-6BC35 74JT35BFAP 74JT35DFAP 74JT350FAP 74JT35EFAP 74JT35WFAP
175 — — 100 150 — 3RW4443-6BC35 74KT35BFAP 74KT35DFAP 74KT350FAP 74KT35EFAP
195 — — 125 200 — 3RW4444-6BC35 74LT35BFAP 74LT35DFAP 74LT350FAP 74LT35EFAP
243 — — 150 200 — 3RW4445-6BC35 74MT35BFAP 74MT35DFAP 74MT350FAP 74MT35EFAP
263 — — 200 250 — 3RW4446-6BC35 74NT35BFAP 74NT35DFAP 74NT350FAP 74NT35EFAP
326 — — 250 300 — 3RW4447-6BC35 74PT35BFAP 74PT35DFAP 74PT350FAP 74PT35EFAP
494 — — 400 500 — 3RW4453-6BC35 74QT35BFAT 74QT35DFAT 74QT350FAT 74QT35EFAT
551 — — 450 550 — 3RW4454-6BC35 74RT35BFAT 74RT35DFAT 74RT350FAT 74RT35EFAT
615 — — 500 600 — 3RW4455-6BC35 74ST35BFAT 74ST35DFAT 74ST350FAT 74ST35EFAT
693 — — 500 650 — 3RW4456-6BC35 74TT35BFAT 74TT35DFAT 74TT350FAT 74TT35EFAT
780 — — 550 700 — 3RW4457-6BC35 74WT35BFAT 74WT35DFAT 74WT350FAT 74WT35EFAT
880 — — 700 850 — 3RW4465-6BC35 74YT35BFAT 74YT350FAT
940 — — 750 900 — 3RW4466-6BC35 74ZT35BFAT 74ZT350FAT
a Starter size is dependent on the nameplate Full Load Amps (FLA) rating of the motor.
HPs are for reference only. Enclosed ratings are at 40°C.
b Starter selection is dependent on type of application. Im = FLA rating of motor.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/121
Soft Starters

Enclosed 3RW44

Ordering Information
�  nclosed devices should be ordered by
E Ideal applications for 3RW44 enclosed
the FLA of the motor. softstarters:
�  he 3RW44 is designed for normal
T b Fans
starting applications. b Pumps
3RW44 Enclosed features: b Conveying systems and lifts
�  or factory modifications see page 7/124.
F b Hydraulics
b Available in NEMA 1, 12, 3R, 4, and 4
stainless steel �  or dimensional drawings see page 7/125.
F b Machine tools
b Compact size Class 74 non-combination starters include: b Mills saws
b Built-in bypass contactor b Crushers and grinders
b Multiple starting/stopping techniques b NEMA rated enclosure
including torque control b Mixers
b 3RW44 Sirius softstarter with built-in OL b HVAC systems
b Internal overload class 5, 10, 15, 20, or 30 and bypass
b Built-in graphical LCD keypad b Fusible disconnect The 3RW44 severe duty rating table should
b Internal self protection be applied for high inertia applications
b Fault monitoring b Control circuit transformer
such rock crushers, chippers, screw
b 3 parameter sets b Reset button compressors, ect.
b Communication capable via opt. Profibus
module Class 74 starters are built to UL and CSA
b Programmable inputs and outputs standards.
b External keypad available
For all technical information, please consult the 2006 Industrial Controls Catalog or contact your local sales support center.

3RW44 For High Feature Applications


Enclosed Combination with Fusible Disconnect

Rated MAX HP
a KW Class 10 Light Duty b (350% * Im for 10s)
Operating OPEN Style List List List List NEMA 4/4X List
Current 200V 230V 460V 575V 380V (Starter Only) NEMA 1 Price $ NEMA 3R Price $ NEMA 12 Price $ NEMA 4 Price $ Stainless Steel Price $
26 7.5 7.5 15 — 12 3RW4422-1BC34 74AT3_BFAF 74AT3_DFAF 74AT3_0FAF 74AT3_EFAF 74AT3_WFAF
32 10 10 20 — 15 3RW4423-1BC34 74BT3_BFAF 74BT3_DFAF 74BT3_0FAF 74BT3_EFAF 74BT3_WFAF
42 10 15 25 — 19 3RW4424-1BC34 74CT3_BFAF 74CT3_DFAF 74CT3_0FAF 74CT3_EFAF 74CT3_WFAF
51 15 15 30 — 22 3RW4425-1BC34 74DT3_BFAF 74DT3_DFAF 74DT3_0FAF 74DT3_EFAF 74DT3_WFAF
68 20 25 50 — 37 3RW4426-1BC34 74ET3_BFAF 74ET3_DFAF 74ET3_0FAF 74ET3_EFAF 74ET3_WFAF
82 25 30 60 — 45 3RW4427-1BC34 74FT3_BFAF 74FT3_DFAF 74FT3_0FAF 74FT3_EFAF 74FT3_WFAF
100 30 30 75 — 56 3RW4434-6BC34 74GT3_BFAF 74GT3_DFAF 74GT3_0FAF 74GT3_EFAF 74GT3_WFAF
117 30 40 75 — 56 3RW4435-6BC34 74HT3_BFAF 74HT3_DFAF 74HT3_0FAF 74HT3_EFAF 74HT3_WFAF
145 40 50 100 — 75 3RW4436-6BC34 74JT3_BFAF 74JT3_DFAF 74JT3_0FAF 74JT3_EFAF 74JT3_WFAF
180 60 60 125 — 93 3RW4443-6BC34 74KT3_BFAF 74KT3_DFAF 74KT3_0FAF 74KT3_EFAF
215 60 75 150 — 112 3RW4444-6BC34 74LT3_BFAF 74LT3_DFAF 74LT3_0FAF 74LT3_EFAF
280 75 100 200 — 149 3RW4445-6BC34 74MT3_BFAF 74MT3_DFAF 74MT3_0FAF 74MT3_EFAF
7

315 100 125 250 — 186 3RW4446-6BC34 74NT3_BFAF 74NT3_DFAF 74NT3_0FAF 74NT3_EFAF
385 125 150 300 — 224 3RW4447-6BC34 74PT3_BFAF 74PT3_DFAF 74PT3_0FAF 74PT3_EFAF
494 150 200 400 — 298 3RW4453-6BC34 74QT3_BFAF 74QT3_0FAF
SOFT STARTERS

551 150 200 450 — 336 3RW4454-6BC34 74RT3_BFAF 74RT3_0FAF


615 200 250 500 — 373 3RW4455-6BC34 74ST3_BFAF 74ST3_0FAF
693 200 250 550 — 3RW4456-6BC34 74TT3_BFAF 74TT3_0FAF
780 200 250 600 — 447 3RW4457-6BC34 74WT3_BFAF 74WT3_0FAF
200V 6 6 6 6 6
230V 2 2 2 2 2
380V 3 3 3 3 3
460V 4 4 4 4 4
26 — — 15 20 — 3RW4422-1BC35 74AT35BFAF 74AT35DFAF 74AT350FAF 74AT35EFAF 74AT35WFAF
32 — — 20 25 — 3RW4423-1BC35 74BT35BFAF 74BT35DFAF 74BT350FAF 74BT35EFAF 74BT35WFAF
42 — — 25 30 — 3RW4424-1BC35 74CT35BFAF 74CT35DFAF 74CT350FAF 74CT35EFAF 74CT35WFAF
51 — — 30 40 — 3RW4425-1BC35 74DT35BFAF 74DT35DFAF 74DT350FAF 74DT35EFAF 74DT35WFAF
68 — — 50 50 — 3RW4426-1BC35 74ET35BFAF 74ET35DFAF 74ET350FAF 74ET35EFAF 74ET35WFAF
82 — — 60 75 — 3RW4427-1BC35 74FT35BFAF 74FT35DFAF 74FT350FAF 74FT35EFAF 74FT35WFAF
100 — — 75 75 — 3RW4434-6BC35 74GT35BFAF 74GT35DFAF 74GT350FAF 74GT35EFAF 74GT35WFAF
117 — — 75 100 — 3RW4435-6BC35 74HT35BFAF 74HT35DFAF 74HT350FAF 74HT35EFAF 74HT35WFAF
145 — — 100 125 — 3RW4436-6BC35 74JT35BFAF 74JT35DFAF 74JT350FAF 74JT35EFAF 74JT35WFAF
180 — — 125 150 — 3RW4443-6BC35 74KT35BFAF 74KT35DFAF 74KT350FAF 74KT35EFAF
215 — — 150 200 — 3RW4444-6BC35 74LT35BFAF 74LT35DFAF 74LT350FAF 74LT35EFAF
280 — — 200 250 — 3RW4445-6BC35 74MT35BFAF 74MT35DFAF 74MT350FAF 74MT35EFAF
315 — — 250 300 — 3RW4446-6BC35 74NT35BFAF 74NT35DFAF 74NT350FAF 74NT35EFAF
385 — — 300 400 — 3RW4447-6BC35 74PT35BFAF 74PT35DFAF 74PT350FAF 74PT35EFAF
494 — — 400 500 — 3RW4453-6BC35 74QT35BFAF 74QT350FAF
551 — — 450 600 — 3RW4454-6BC35 74RT35BFAF 74RT350FAF
615 — — 500 700 — 3RW4455-6BC35 74ST35BFAF 74ST350FAF
693 — — 550 750 — 3RW4456-6BC35 74TT35BFAF 74TT350FAF
780 — — 600 850 — 3RW4457-6BC35 74WT35BFAF 74WT350FAF
a Starter size is dependent on the nameplate Full Load Amps (FLA) rating of the motor. b Starter selection is dependent on type of application. Im = FLA rating of motor.
HPs are for reference only. Enclosed ratings are at 40°C.

7/122 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Soft Starters

Enclosed 3RW44

Ordering Information
�  nclosed devices should be ordered by
E Ideal applications for 3RW44 enclosed
the FLA of the motor. softstarters:
�  he 3RW44 is designed for normal
T b Fans
starting applications. b Pumps
3RW44 Enclosed features: b Conveying systems and lifts
�  or factory modifications see page 7/124.
F b Hydraulics
b Available in NEMA 1, 12, 3R, 4, and 4
stainless steel �  or dimensional drawings see page 7/125.
F b Machine tools
b Compact size Class 74 non-combination starters include: b Mills saws
b Built-in bypass contactor b Crushers and grinders
b Multiple starting/stopping techniques b NEMA rated enclosure
including torque control b Mixers
b 3RW44 Sirius softstarter with built-in OL b HVAC systems
b Internal overload class 5, 10, 15, 20, or 30 and bypass
b Built-in graphical LCD keypad b Fusible disconnect The 3RW44 severe duty rating table should
b Internal self protection be applied for high inertia applications
b Fault monitoring b Control circuit transformer
such rock crushers, chippers, screw
b 3 parameter sets b Reset button compressors, ect.
b Communication capable via opt. Profibus
module Class 74 starters are built to UL and CSA
b Programmable inputs and outputs standards.
b External keypad available
For all technical information, please consult the 2006 Industrial Controls Catalog or contact your local sales support center.

3RW44 For High Feature Applications


Enclosed Combination with Fusible Disconnect

Rated MAX HP
a KW Class 20 Severe Duty (350% * Im for 20s)b
Operating OPEN Style List List List List NEMA 4/4X List
Current 200V 230V 460V 575V 380V (Starter Only) NEMA 1 Price $ NEMA 3R Price $ NEMA 12 Price $ NEMA 4 Price $ Stainless Steel Price $
26 7.5 7.5 15 — 12 3RW4422-1BC34 74AT3_BFAF 74AT3_DFAF 74AT3_0FAF 74AT3_EFAF 74AT3_WFAF
32 10 10 20 — 15 3RW4423-1BC34 74BT3_BFAF 74BT3_DFAF 74BT3_0FAF 74BT3_EFAF 74BT3_WFAF
42 10 15 25 — 19 3RW4424-1BC34 74CT3_BFAF 74CT3_DFAF 74CT3_0FAF 74CT3_EFAF 74CT3_WFAF
51 15 15 30 — 22 3RW4425-1BC34 74DT3_BFAF 74DT3_DFAF 74DT3_0FAF 74DT3_EFAF 74DT3_WFAF
68 20 25 50 — 37 3RW4426-1BC34 74ET3_BFAF 74ET3_DFAF 74ET3_0FAF 74ET3_EFAF 74ET3_WFAF
82 25 30 60 — 45 3RW4427-1BC34 74FT3_BFAF 74FT3_DFAF 74FT3_0FAF 74FT3_EFAF 74FT3_WFAF
97 30 30 60 — 45 3RW4434-6BC34 74GT3_BFAF 74GT3_DFAF 74GT3_0FAF 74GT3_EFAF 74GT3_WFAF
113 30 40 75 — 56 3RW4435-6BC34 74HT3_BFAF 74HT3_DFAF 74HT3_0FAF 74HT3_EFAF 74HT3_WFAF
134 40 50 75 — 56 3RW4436-6BC34 74JT3_BFAF 74JT3_DFAF 74JT3_0FAF 74JT3_EFAF 74JT3_WFAF
175 50 60 100 — 75 3RW4443-6BC34 74KT3_BFAF 74KT3_DFAF 74KT3_0FAF 74KT3_EFAF
195 60 75 125 — 93 3RW4444-6BC34 74LT3_BFAF 74LT3_DFAF 74LT3_0FAF 74LT3_EFAF
243 75 75 150 — 112 3RW4445-6BC34 74MT3_BFAF 74MT3_DFAF 74MT3_0FAF 74MT3_EFAF

7
263 75 100 200 — 149 3RW4446-6BC34 74NT3_BFAF 74NT3_DFAF 74NT3_0FAF 74NT3_EFAF
326 100 125 250 — 186 3RW4447-6BC34 74PT3_BFAF 74PT3_DFAF 74PT3_0FAF 74PT3_EFAF
494 150 150 400 — 298 3RW4453-6BC34 74QT3_BFAF 74QT3_0FAF

SOFT STARTERS
551 150 200 450 — 336 3RW4454-6BC34 74RT3_BFAF 74RT3_0FAF
615 200 200 500 — 373 3RW4455-6BC34 74ST3_BFAF 74ST3_0FAF
634 200 250 500 — 373 3RW4456-6BC34 74TT3_BFAF 74TT3_0FAF
650 200 250 550 — 373 3RW4457-6BC34 74WT3_BFAF 74WT3_0FAF
200V 6 6 6 6 6
230V 2 2 2 2 2
380V 3 3 3 3 3
460V 4 4 4 4 4
26 — — 15 20 — 3RW4422-1BC35 74AT35BFAF 74AT35DFAF 74AT350FAF 74AT35EFAF 74AT35WFAF
32 — — 20 25 — 3RW4423-1BC35 74BT35BFAF 74BT35DFAF 74BT350FAF 74BT35EFAF 74BT35WFAF
42 — — 25 30 — 3RW4424-1BC35 74CT35BFAF 74CT35DFAF 74CT350FAF 74CT35EFAF 74CT35WFAF
51 — — 30 40 — 3RW4425-1BC35 74DT35BFAF 74DT35DFAF 74DT350FAF 74DT35EFAF 74DT35WFAF
68 — — 50 50 — 3RW4426-1BC35 74ET35BFAF 74ET35DFAF 74ET350FAF 74ET35EFAF 74ET35WFAF
82 — — 60 75 — 3RW4427-1BC35 74FT35BFAF 74FT35DFAF 74FT350FAF 74FT35EFAF 74FT35WFAF
97 — — 60 75 — 3RW4434-6BC35 74GT35BFAF 74GT35DFAF 74GT350FAF 74GT35EFAF 74GT35WFAF
113 — — 75 100 — 3RW4435-6BC35 74HT35BFAF 74HT35DFAF 74HT350FAF 74HT35EFAF 74HT35WFAF
134 — — 75 125 — 3RW4436-6BC35 74JT35BFAF 74JT35DFAF 74JT350FAF 74JT35EFAF 74JT35WFAF
175 — — 100 150 — 3RW4443-6BC35 74KT35BFAF 74KT35DFAF 74KT350FAF 74KT35EFAF
195 — — 125 200 — 3RW4444-6BC35 74LT35BFAF 74LT35DFAF 74LT350FAF 74LT35EFAF
243 — — 150 200 — 3RW4445-6BC35 74MT35BFAF 74MT35DFAF 74MT350FAF 74MT35EFAF
263 — — 200 250 — 3RW4446-6BC35 74NT35BFAF 74NT35DFAF 74NT350FAF 74NT35EFAF
326 — — 250 300 — 3RW4447-6BC35 74PT35BFAF 74PT35DFAF 74PT350FAF 74PT35EFAF
494 — — 400 500 — 3RW4453-6BC35 74QT35BFAF 74QT350FAF
551 — — 450 550 — 3RW4454-6BC35 74RT35BFAF 74RT350FAF
615 — — 500 600 — 3RW4455-6BC35 74ST35BFAF 74ST350FAF
693 — — 550 650 — 3RW4456-6BC35 74TT35BFAF 74TT350FAF
780 — — 600 700 — 3RW4457-6BC35 74WT35BFAF 74WT350FAF
a Starter size is dependent on the nameplate Full Load Amps (FLA) rating of the motor. b Starter selection is dependent on type of application. Im = FLA rating of motor.
HPs are for reference only. Enclosed ratings are at 40°C.

Product Category IEC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/123
Soft Starters

Factory Modifications

Modification 3RW Version Enclosed Style Enclosure Mod Suffix


Available modifications in STANDARD enclosure NEMA Type
Push Buttons
Start/Stop 3RW40/44 73/74 ALL A1
Emergency Stop 3RW40/44 73/74 ALL ES
Selector Switches
Hand-Off-Auto 3RW40/44 73/74 ALL A3
Hand-Off-Auto w/ start pushbutton 3RW40/44 73/74 ALL S3
Off-On 3RW40/44 73/74 ALL A4
Pilot Light
Red 'On' 3RW40/44 73/74 ALL FA
Green 'On’ 3RW40/44 73/74 ALL FB
Red 'Run’ 3RW40/44 73/74 ALL FC
Green 'Run’ 3RW40/44 73/74 ALL FD
LED Bulb Upgraded 3RW40/44 73/74 ALL FE
Red 'Off’ 3RW40/44 73/74 ALL FJ
Green 'Off’ 3RW40/44 73/74 ALL FK
Amber 'Fault' 3RW40/44 73/74 ALL FL
White 'Control Power On' 3RW40/44 73/74 ALL FW
Red, 'On’ Push-to-Test 3RW40/44 73/74 ALL FS
Green 'On’ Push-to-Test 3RW40/44 73/74 ALL FT
Green 'Off’ Push-to-Test 3RW40/44 73/74 ALL FU
Custom pilot light (state color and nameplate text) 3RW40/44 73/74 ALL FZ
Through the Door Metering
External keypad for 3RW44 3RW44 73/74 1,12 K1
Elapse time meter 3RW40/44 73/74 1,12 (120V) M5
Control Options
Profibus Communication Module (installed-connection cable not supplied) 3RW44 73/74 ALL P1
Profinet Communication Module (installed-connection cable not supplied) 3RW44 73/74 ALL P2
Ground Lug - 1 Conductor 3RW40/44 73/74 ALL L10
Alarm Package (horn, light, relay & push button) 3RW40/44 73/74 1,3R,12 M7
Electronic 8 function timing relay (.05s - 100h)
3RW40/44 73/74 ALL TR
24V/100-127V supplied mounted and unwired
R04
Control Relay supplied mounted
3RW40/44 73/74 ALL R22
and unwired (4 pole max)
R40
Circuit Breaker Shunt Trip (included std in 3RW40 versions) 3RW44 74 ALL L6
Function identification plate w/ marking as specified 3RW40/44 73/74 ALL N1
Service Entrance Labeled 3RW40/44 74 ALL N3
Terminal Block 3 point 3RW40/44 73/74 ALL TC3
Terminal Block 6 point 3RW40/44 73/74 ALL TC6
7

Terminal Block 9 point 3RW40/44 73/74 ALL TC9


Terminal Block 12 point 3RW40/44 73/74 ALL TC12
SOFT STARTERS

3RW Enclosure
Emergency HP Rated Bypass Starter Version Class NEMA Type Mod Suffix
3RW40ab 73/74 1/12/3R/4 A12

Available Modifications
Requiring the MODIFIED OPTIONS Box Size 3RW Enclosure
(to be used with the selections ending in GA*) Version Class NEMA Type Mod Suffix
Isolation Contactor  3RW40/44 73/74 1/12/3R/4 IC
100 VA Extra CPT Capacity 3RW40/44 73/74 ALL CA
Space Heater (120V separate control) 3RW40/44 73/74 ALL SH
Space Heater w/ T-stat (120V separate control) 3RW40/44 73/74 ALL ST
Lightning Arrestor 3RW40/44 73/74 ALL L

a (A) For sizes 73YT & 73ZT, mods IC & A12 are available individually or together;  Isolation contactor IC is included as standard with version 3RW40 model R (4th
(B) For sizes 74YT & 74ZT (combination w\CB), mods IC & A12 are only available character of the cat. no.) soft starters.
individually (NOT together); (C) For sizes 74YT & 74ZT (combination w\ fusible disc), d Pilot lights are transformer type as standard. For LED type bulbs, order suffix FE in
mods IC & A12 are NOT available individually or together. addition to the standard device suffix(es). For example, to order red “ON” and green
 An isolation contactor is included with the emergency HP rated bypass starter for “OFF” pilot lights with LED bulbs, order FA, FK and FE.
version 3RW40 soft starters.

7/124 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category IEC
Soft Starters

Class 73, 74

Dimensions are in inches and are for reference only (not for construction). Certain styles may deviate from values indicated.

Non-Combination Class 73 Combination Type Class 74


N1, N3R, N12, N4 Standard Enclosure N1, N3R, N12, N4 Standard Enclosure
Amps A B C Amps A B C
11 - 73 25 18 13 11 - 73 36 20 11
3RW40new 3RW40new
98 36 23 10 98 46 20 10
117-145 36 18 15 117 50 25 20
3RW40 205-315 36 22 20 145 - 205 66 25 20
3RW40
385 54 36 20 248 - 315 90 30 20
26 - 68 26 12.5 15 385 90 40 20
82 - 117 36 18 15 26 - 68 36 23 15
145 - 215 36 22 20 82 - 117 50 25 20
3RW44
280 - 385 54 36 20 145 - 215 66 25 20
494 - 780 90 40 20 280 90 30 20
3RW44
970 - 1076 90 50 20 315 - 384 90 40 20
494 90 40 20
551 - 780 90 40a 20
N4X Stainless Steel Standard Enclosure

7
970 - 1076 90 50 20
Amps A B C
3RW40new 11- 98 55 29 11 N1, N12 Fusible

SOFT STARTERS
117 36 18 15
Amps A B C
3RW40 145 - 205A 36 22 20
248 - 385 54 36 20 3RW44 494-780 90 50 20
26 - 51 26 12.5 15
68 - 82 36 18 15
3RW44 N4X Stainless Steel Standard Enclosure
100 - 117 36 22 20
145 - 385 54 36 20 Amps A B C
3RW40new 11- 98 55 29 11
117 - 145 54 36 20
N1, N3R, N12, N4 Modified Enclosure 3RW40
205 - 300 90 40 20
Amps A B C 26 - 42 36 23 15
3RW40 117-385 56 36 20 51 - 100 50 25 20
26-51 36 22 20 3RW44
3RW44 117 - 145 54 36 20
68-385 54 36 20 180 - 385 90 40 20

N4X Stainless Steel Modified Enclosure N1, N3R, N12, N4 Modified Enclosure
Amps A B C
Amps A B C
117 - 248 76 30 20
3RW40 117-385 54 36 20
3RW40 315 90 30 20
26-51 36 22 20
3RW44 385 90 40 20
68-385 54 36 20
26 - 215 76 30 20
3RW44 280 90 30 20
315 - 385 90 40 20

N4X Stainless Steel Modified Enclosure


Amps A B C
3RW40 117-145 76 30 20
3RW44 26-145 76 30 20
a Add 4” for N4.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/125


Soft Starters

Class 73, 74
7
SOFT STARTERS

7/126 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Drives

SINAMICS G120X
Introduction

SINAMICS G120X
An infrastructure drive for pumps, fans
and compressors
Siemens introduces an exciting new addition to the existing
SINAMICS product portfolio — the G120X — an “infrastructure”
drive up to 700 hp (630kW), which is targeted for pump, fan
and compressor applications in the water / wastewater, HVAC,
irrigation / agriculture and industrial chiller and refrigeration
industries.
Seamless process for higher efficiency
SINAMICS G120X is simple, seamless, cost- and energy-
efficient, robust, reliable and fit for digitalization. It integrates
easily into existing applications, works with any standard motor
(induction, synchronous and synchronous reluctance) and can be
configured for cost-optimization and resource-saving operation
which ultimately helps reduce total cost of ownership. SINAMICS
G120X meets all the latest industry standards with regard to
energy efficiency and product safety, and offers enhanced safety
with SIL3-rated safety functions and up to 100kA short-circuit
current rating according to new UL61800-5-1 design.

Application functions
Pump-specific

n Deragging or blockage protection n Blockage, leakage and dry-running protection


n Pipe filling n Cavitation protection
n Multi-pump control n Condensation protection
Pump switchover
n
n Frost protection
Stop mode
n

Service mode
n

Cascade control mode


n

7
Fan-specific
n Flying restart n Fire mode (essential service mode)

DRIVES
n Automatic restart n No load, torque and rotation (belt) monitoring with sensor
n Skip frequency bands

Increase energy efficiency and system performance

n Eco mode n Bypass mode n Support to high efficiency motors (PMSM and SRM)
n Hibernation or sleep mode n Energy / flow calculator n Real time clock and programmable timer (3)
Optimize pump and fan operation and increase system availability

n Keep running mode n PID controller n Dual ramp n Multi-speed setpoints

Protection functions
n Phase-loss detection for both supply and motor n Motor overload monitoring and protection
n Overvoltage controller n Motor short-circuit and ground fault protection
n Undervoltage controller n Speed and torque monitoring
n Drive overtemperature protection n Blocking and stalling monitoring and protection
n Loss of analog input signal monitoring n Detection of missing communication telegrams
n External fault and warning monitoring (up to 3) n Detection of communication bus interruption
n Motor overtemperature protection (with and without sensor)

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/127


Drives

SINAMICS G120X
Technical data

Technical data
Line voltage and output power range
FSA…FSF 3AC 200V (-20%)…240V (+10%) 1 hp…75 hp (0.75kW…55kW)
FSA…FSG 3AC 380V (-20%)…480V (+10%)  1 hp…400 hp (0.75kW…250kW)
FSH, FSJ 3AC 380V (-15%)…480V (+10%)  400 hp…700 hp (315kW…560kW)
FSD…FSG 3AC 500V (-20%)…690V (+10%)  4 hp…250 hp (3kW…250kW)
FSH, FSJ 3AC 500V (-15%)…690V (+10%)  350 hp…700 hp (315kW…630kW)
Output voltage 3AC 0V….line voltage x 0.97
Input frequency 47 Hz…63 Hz
Output frequency
FSA…FSG 0 Hz…550 Hz (depending upon the control mode)
FSH, FSJ 0 Hz…150 Hz (depending upon the control mode)
Fundamental power factor (Cos φ) 0.96…0.99
Efficiency class IE2 (Based on power losses according to EN 50598-2 and IEC 61800-9-2)
Efficiency (η) 98%
Motor control n V/Hz control (linear, linear with flux current control / FCC, parabolic and eco mode)
n Sensorless less vector control (SLVC)
Supported motor types n Asynchronous (induction) motor
n Permanent magnet synchronous motor (PMSM)
n Synchronous reluctance motor (SRM)

Degree of protection IP20 / UL Open Type


Operating temperature -4° F to 113° F (-20° C to 45° C) without derating
> 113° F up to 140° F (> 45° C up to 60° C) with derating
For PROFINET, EtherNet / IP™ up to 55° C (131° F) with derating
Overload
Low Overload (LO) / Variable Torque (VT) 110% x IL for 60s
High Overload (HO) / Constant Torque (CT) 150% x IH for 60s
Communication PROFINET, EtherNet / IP™, USS, Modbus RTU, BACnet MS / TP, PROFIBUS DP
Functional safety Hardware-based SIL3 Safe Torque Off (STO) function with on / off switch
Short-circuit current rating (SCCR) Up to 100kA according to NEW UL 61800-5-1 design
Control inputs and outputs
6 Digital Inputs (DI 0 … DI 5) 24V (12–30V) electrically isolated, 4mA current, PNP / NPN switchable
2 Digital (Relay) Outputs (DO 0…DO 1) Type C, 250V AC, 2A / 30V DC, 2A for resistive, inductive or capacitive load
7

2 Analog Inputs (AI 0…AI 1) Differential input 0V… 10V or -10V … +10V: typical current drain: 0.1 mA,
max. voltage 35V
DRIVES

0/4 mA ... 20 mA: 120 Ω input resistance, voltage < 10V, current < 80 mA
1 Analog Output (AO 0) Not isolated, switchable between voltage (0V… 10V) and current
(0/4 mA ... 20 mA) via parameter setting
1 motor temperature sensor input PTC, KTY, PT1000, bi-metallic switch with normally closed contact
1 failsafe digital input STO — electrically isolated
1 internal aux. supply voltage
24V DC, max. 250 mA
10V DC, max. 10 mA
1 external aux. supply voltage 24V DC (20.4 … 28.8V DC), current consumption 0.5A
1 memory card slot For optional SD memory cards (as a backup storage device for saving of the settings after drive com-
missioning, and also for a series commissioning of a several identical drives via cloning of the settings)
Additional control inputs and outputs (With optional I/O Extension Module)
2 Digital Inputs (DI 6…DI 7) 24V (12–30V) electrically isolated, 4mA current, PNP / NPN switchable
4 Digital (Relay) Outputs (DO 2…DO 5) 2x Type A and 2x Type C relay outputs rated 250V AC, 2A / 30V DC, 2A for resistive,
inductive or capacitive load
1 Analog Input (AI 2) Analog current input (0/4 mA … 20 mA) or Temperature sensor input
(Pt10000 / LG-Ni10000 / DIN-Ni1000)
1 motor temperature sensor input (AI 3) Temperature sensor input (Sensor Pt10000 / LG-Ni10000 / DIN-Ni1000)
2 Analog Output (AO 1 … AO 2) Not isolated, switchable between voltage (0V… 10V) and current (0/4 mA ... 20 mA)
via parameter setting
User interface
Standard Intelligent Operator Panel (IOP-2) — a high-resolution graphical color keypad
Optional Smart Access Module (SAM) Part number: 6SL3255-0AA00-5AA0 — a WiFi-based web server module and
engineering tool for quick setup and diagnostics using
a mobile device (PC, smartphone, tablet, etc.)
Basic Operator Panel (BOP-2) — a basic keypad
Blank (no Operator Panel / keypad)

7/128 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Drives

SINAMICS G120X
General data

SINAMICS G120X
It’s the simple, seamless and easy-to-use drive — right out of the box.
Digitalization
Digitalization and IoT based secured health monitoring

SINAMICS CONNECT 300 SINAMICS CONNECT 300 (Part number: 6SL3255-0AG30-0AA0) is the
and IoT gateway. It is designed to acquire data through the serial port of the
Analyze MyDrives SINAMICS G120X and synchronize the data to MindSphere (cloud-based
open IoT operating system of Siemens) using the MindSphere application
Analyze MyDrives (AMD).

This offers users the opportunity to analyze valuable operating data


gathered from the drive and enables the visualization and analysis of
status information, providing users with valuable data which can be used
as the basis for process optimization and maintenance strategies.

For more information visit: www.siemens.com/sinamics-digitalization

Certification
n CULUS
marking according to UL61800-5-1 and CSA C22.2 No. 274 with
Certification /
SCCR up to 100kA
 marking
n CE marking according to European Low-Voltage Directive 2014/35/
EU EU and IEC/EN 61800-5-1, Machinery directive 2006/42/EC and IEC/
EN 61800-5-2, EMC Directive 2014/30/EU and IEC/EN 61800-3, RoHS
directive 2011/65/EU and EN 50581
n IE2efficiency level based on power losses according to EN 50598-2 and
IEC 61800-9-2
n Safe torque off (STO) SIL3 rating according to IEC/EN 61800-5-2
n EAC, K, RCM (formerly C-Tick), REACH, RoHS II, SEMI F47

Additional D
Dimensions and clearance distances FSA...FSJ depth

Dimensions Max. weight of frame


Additional depth
Frame H W D with Operator Panel No filter With filter
kg (lbs)1 kg (lbs)1

7
size mm (inch) mm (inch) mm (inch) mm (inch)

FSA 232 (9.1) 73 (2.9) 3.4 (7.5) 3.6 (8)

DRIVES
FSB 275 (10.8) 100 (3.9) 209 (8.2) 5.8 (12.8) 6.2 (13.7)

FSC 295 (11.6) 140 (5.5) 7.11 (15.7) 7.7 (17)


H
FSD 472 (18.6) 200 (7.9) 9 (0.4) 18.8 (41.5) 19.5 (43)
239 (9.4)
FSE 551 (21.7) 275 (10.8) 26.7 (59) 28.7 (63.3)

FSF 709 (27.9) 305 (12) 66.5 (146.6) 71 (156.53)


360 (14.2)
FSG 999.4 (39.3) 305 (12) 120 (264.6)

FSH 1696 (66.8) 548 (21.6) — 162 (357.2)


393 (15.5) —
FSJ 1621 (63.8) 801 (31.5) 250 (551.16)
1Refer to SINAMICS G120X operating instructions or rating plate information of a unit to
obtain the weight specific to each rating / order number
W

For additional information on SINAMICS G120X


n SINAMICS G120X Catalog: click to download PDF

n SINAMICS G120X Webpage: www.usa.siemens.com/sinamics-g120x


n For additional technical information including operating instructions please visit SINAMICS

G120X Technical Reference site: https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/us/en/ps/25454

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/129


Drives

SINAMICS G120X
Selection and ordering data

SINAMICS G120X — Selection and ordering data


Voltage class 3AC 200...240V, 47...63Hz

Rated Output Current


Frame size kW (200V) hp (240V) IL, A (240V) Order number
0.75 1 4.2 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y C 1 0 – U 0
FSA 1.1 1.5 6 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y C 1 2 – U 0
1.5 2 7.4 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y C 1 4 – U 0
2 3 10.4 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y C 1 6 – U 0
FSB 3 4 13.6 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y C 1 8 – U 0
4 5.0 17.5 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y C 2 0 – U 0
5.5 7.5 22 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y C 2 2 – U 0
FSC
7.5 10 28 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y C 2 4 – U 0
11 15 42 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y C 2 6 – U 0
FSD 15 20 54 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y C 2 8 – U 0
18.5 25 68 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y C 3 0 – U 0
22 30 80 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y C 3 2 – U 0
FSE
30 40 104 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y C 3 4 – U 0
37 50 130 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y C 3 6 – U 0
FSF 45 60 154 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y C 3 8 – U 0
55 75 192 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y C 4 0 – U 0
Special coating according to IEC/EN 60721-3-3
Class 3C2 (Standard) 2
Class 3C3* 3
User interface
Blank (No operator panel / keypad) 1
BOP-2 (Basic keypad, Class 3C3*) 2
IOP-2 (Standard — high-resolution graphical color keypad, Class 3C3*) 3
I / O extension module
7

without I/O extenstion module 0


with I/O extenstion module, Class 3C3* 1
DRIVES

EMC class
No EMI / RFI filter U
Communication interface
PROFINET, EtherNet / IP™ (Standard) F
USS, Modbus, RTU, BACnet MS / TP B
PROFIBUS DP P
*Special coating or sealing for operation in harsh / corrosive environments

7/130 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Drives

SINAMICS G120X
Selection and ordering data

SINAMICS G120X — Selection and ordering data


Voltage class 3AC 380...480V, 47...63Hz
Rated Output Current
Frame size kW (400V) hp (480V) IL, A (480V) Order number
0.75 1 2.1 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y E 1 0 – 0
1.1 1.5 3 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y E 1 2 – 0
FSA 1.5 2 3.4 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y E 1 4 – 0
2.2 3 4.8 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y E 1 6 – 0
3 4 6.2 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y E 1 8 – 0
4 5 7.6 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y E 2 0 – 0
FSB 5.5 7.5 11 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y E 2 2 – 0
7.5 10 14 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y E 2 4 – 0
11 15 21 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y E 2 6 – 0
FSC
15 20 27 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y E 2 8 – 0
18.5 25 34 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y E 3 0 – 0
22 30 40 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y E 3 2 – 0
FSD
30 40 52 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y E 3 4 – 0
37 50 65 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y E 3 6 – 0
45 60 77 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y E 3 8 – 0
FSE
55 75 96 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y E 4 0 – 0
75 100 124 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y E 4 2 – 0
90 125 156 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y E 4 4 – 0
FSF
110 150 180 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y E 4 6 – 0
132 200 240 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y E 4 8 – 0
160 250 302 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y E 5 0 – 0
FSG 200 300 361 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y E 5 2 – 0
250 400 477 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y E 5 4 – 0
315 400 477 6 S L 3 2 2 0 – Y E 5 6 – C 0
FSH 355 450 515 6 S L 3 2 2 0 – Y E 5 8 – C 0
400 500 590 6 S L 3 2 2 0 – Y E 6 0 – C 0
450 500 663 6 S L 3 2 2 0 – Y E 6 2 – C 0
FSJ 500 600 724 6 S L 3 2 2 0 – Y E 6 4 – C 0

7
560 700 830 6 S L 3 2 2 0 – Y E 6 6 – C 0
Special coating according to IEC/EN 60721-3-3

DRIVES
Class 3C2 (Standard) 2
Class 3C3* 3
User interface
Blank (No operator panel / keypad) 1
BOP-2 (Basic keypad, Class 3C3*) 2
IOP-2 (Standard — high-resolution graphical color keypad, Class 3C3*) 3
I / O extension module
without I/O extenstion module 0
with I/O extenstion module, Class 3C3* 1
EMC class
No filter (Standard — without integrated EMI / RFI filter) for FSA to FSF only U
Filter C2 (With integrated EMI / RFI filter Category C2) for FSA to FSG only, see Note 1 A
Filter C3 (Standard — with integrated EMI / RFI filter Category C3) for FSG to FSJ only, see Note 1 C
Communication interface
PROFINET, EtherNet / IP™ (Standard) F
USS, Modbus, RTU, BACnet MS / TP B
PROFIBUS DP P
*Special coating or sealing for operation in harsh / corrosive environments
Note 1:  For frame sizes FSG, FSH and FSJ, the filter can be deactivated by removing a grounding screw / clip for applications in an ungrounded or
a high-resistance grounded or a corner-grounded supply system. Please refer to the SINAMICS G120X Operating Instructions for more information.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/131


Drives

SINAMICS G120X
Selection and ordering data

SINAMICS G120X — Selection and ordering data


Voltage class 3AC 500...690V, 47...63Hz
Rated Output Current
Frame size kW (690V) hp (600V) IL, A (600V) Order number
3 4 5 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y H 1 8 – 0
4 5 6.3 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y H 2 0 – 0
5.5 7.5 9 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y H 2 2 – 0
7.5 10 11 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y H 2 4 – 0
11 10 14 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y H 2 6 – 0
FSD
15 15 19 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y H 2 8 – 0
18.5 20 23 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y H 3 0 – 0
22 25 27 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y H 3 2 – 0
30 30 35 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y H 3 4 – 0
37 40 42 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y H 3 6 – 0
45 50 52 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y H 3 8 – 0
FSE
55 60 62 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y H 4 0 – 0
75 75 80 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y H 4 2 – 0
90 100 100 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y H 4 4 – 0
FSF
110 125 125 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y H 4 6 – 0
132 150 144 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y H 4 8 – 0
160 150 171 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y H 5 0 – C 0
FSG 200 200 208 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y H 5 2 – C 0
250 250 250 6 S L 3 2 0 – Y H 5 4 – C 0
315 350 345 6 S L 3 2 2 0 – Y H 5 6 – C 0
355 400 388 6 S L 3 2 2 0 – Y H 5 8 – C 0
FSH
400 450 432 6 S L 3 2 2 0 – Y H 6 0 – C 0
450 500 487 6 S L 3 2 2 0 – Y H 6 2 – C 0
500 500 546 6 S L 3 2 2 0 – Y H 6 4 – C 0
FSJ 560 600 610 6 S L 3 2 2 0 – Y H 6 6 – C 0
630 700 679 6 S L 3 2 2 0 – Y H 6 8 – C 0
Special coating according to IEC/EN 60721-3-3
Class 3C2 (Standard) 2
7

Class 3C3* 3
DRIVES

User interface
Blank (No operator panel / keypad) 1
BOP-2 (Basic keypad, Class 3C3*) 2
IOP-2 (Standard — high-resolution graphical color keypad, Class 3C3*) 3
I / O extension module
without I/O extenstion module 0
with I/O extenstion module, Class 3C3* 1
EMC class
No filter (Standard — without integrated EMI / RFI filter) for FSD to FSF only U
Filter C2 (With integrated EMI / RFI filter Category C2) for FSD to FSE only A
Filter C3 (With integrated EMI / RFI filter Category C3) for FSF to FSJ only, standard for FSG to FSJ, see Note 1 C
Communication interface
PROFINET, EtherNet / IP™ (Standard) F
USS, Modbus, RTU, BACnet MS / TP B
PROFIBUS DP P
*Special coating or sealing for operation in harsh / corrosive environments
Note 1:  For frame sizes FSG, FSH and FSJ, the filter can be deactivated by removing a grounding screw / clip for applications in an ungrounded or
a high-resistance grounded or a corner-grounded supply system. Please refer to the SINAMICS G120X Operating Instructions for more information.

7/132 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Drives

SINAMICS G120X
Push-through kits, Options and Features

FSA–FSC with PT kit FSD–FSG with PT kit

SINAMICS G120X IP20 Push-Through kits


Overall dimensions of SINAIMCS G120X with PT kit installed
SINAMICS Push-Through kit
G120X (PT) Width mm (inch) Height mm (inch) Depth mm (inch)
H = with H1= without T1 = front T2 = back
Frame size Part number W shield plate shield plate of PT bracket of PT bracket

7
FSA 6SL3261-6GA00-0BA0 127 (5.0) 324 (12.8) 234 (9.2) 160 (6.3) 57 (2.2)
FSB 6SL3261-6GB00-0BA0 154 (6.1) 384 (15.1) 279 (11.0) 153 (6.0) 66 (2.6)

DRIVES
FSC 6SL3261-6GC00-0BA0 192 (7.6) 407 (16.0) 295 (11.6) 154 (6.1) 65 (2.6)
FSD 6SL3261-6GD00-0BA0 271 (10.7) 647 (25.5) 514 (20.2) 142 (5.6) 98 (3.9)
FSE 6SL3261-6GE00-0BA0 360 (14.2) 773 (30.4) 600 (23.6) 145 (5.7) 93 (3.7)
FSF 6SL3261-6GF00-0BA0 396 (15.6) 1003 (39.5) 749 (29.5) 185 (7.3) 185 (7.3)
FSG 6SL3261-6GG00-0BA0 384 (15.1) 1275 (50.2) 1026 (40.4) 184 (7.3) 188 (7.4)

SINAMICS G120X — options and features


Options

n Special coating (Class 3C3) for operation of a drive in the harsh n Output dv / dt filter
environments where corrosive gases for example, Hydrogen Sulfide
n Output Sinusoidal filter
(H2S), Chlorine (Cl) or Ammonia (NH3) are often present
n Passive line harmonic filter
n Add-on Push-Through (PT) kit to enable UL Open Type / IP20 drive in
to UL Open Type / IP20 push-through drive (up to FSG) n EMI / RFI filters
n Input and output reactors n Communication:
PROFINET, EtherNet / IP™, USS,
Modbus RTU, BACnet MS / TP and PROFIBUS DP
n I/O extension module

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 7/133


Drives

Notes
7
DRIVES

7/134 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Solid-State Relays and Contactors
Industrial Control Product Catalog 2021

contents
Introduction
8 Section

8/2
Solid-state switching devices
General data 8/3
Solid-state switching devices for resistive loads
Solid-state relays
3RF21 solid-state relays, single-phase, 22.5 mm 8/8
3RF20 solid-state relays, single-phase, 45 mm 8/9
3RF22 solid-state relays, three-phase, 45 mm 8/10
Solid-state contactors
General data 8/11
3RF23 solid-state contactors, single-phase 8/12
3RF24 solid-state contactors, 3-phase 8/14
Solid-state switching devices for switching motors
Solid-state contactors
General data 8/15
3RF34 solid-state contactors, 3-phase 8/16
3RF34 solid-state reversing contactors, 3-phase 8/17
3RF29 Function modules
Assignment of modules 8/18
Converters 8/23
Load monitoring 8/24
Heating current monitoring 8/25
Power controllers 8/26
Power control regulators 8/27
Technical data
Solid-state relays
3RF21 solid-state relays, single-phase, 22.5 mm 8/29
3RF20 solid-state relays, single-phase, 45 mm 8/32
3RF22 solid-state relays, three-phase, 45 mm 8/34
Solid-state contactors
3RF23 solid-state contactors, single-phase 8/36
3RF24 solid-state contactors, three-phase 8/39
3RF34 solid-state contactors, three-phase 8/41

8
3RF29 Function modules
Converters, load monitors, power controller, heating current monitors 8/46

& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
Power control regulators 8/48
Thermal data 8/49
Dimensions 8/63
Wiring diagrams 8/72

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 8/1


Solid-State Switching Devices

Introduction

Overview

3RF21 3RF20 3RF22 3RF23 3RF24 3RF34 (Motor) 3RF29


Order No. Page
SIRIUS solid-state switching devices for switching resistive loads
Solid-state relays
22.5 mm solid-state relays, • Widths of 22.5 mm and 45 mm 3RF21, 8/9
45 mm solid-state relays • Compact and space-saving design 3RF20 8/10
• "Zero-point switching" version 3RF22 8/43
• Mounting onto existing heat sinks
Solid-state contactors
Solid-state contactors • Complete units comprising a solid-state relay and an optimized heat sink, 3RF23 8/24
"ready to use" 3RF24 8/46
• Compact and space-saving design
• Versions for resistive loads "zero-point switching"
and inductive loads "instantaneous switching"
• Special versions "Low Noise" and "Short-Circuit Resistant" 8/8, 8/12
Function modules For extending the functionality of the 3RF21 solid-state relays and the 3RF23
solid-state contactors for many different applications:
Converters • For converting an analog input signal into an on/off ratio; 3RF29 00-0EA18 8/13
can also be used on 3RF22 and 3RF24 3-phase switching devices
Load monitoring • For load monitoring of one or more loads (partial loads) 3RF29 20-0FA08, 8/14
3RF29 .0-0GA..
Heating current monitoring • For load monitoring of one or more loads (partial loads); 3RF29 ..-0JA.. 8/14
remote teach
Power control regulators • For supplying the current by means of a solid-state switching device de- 3RF29 ..-0KA. 8/14
pending on a setpoint value.
There is a choice of full-wave control and generalized phase control.
Power controllers • For supplying the current by means of a solid-state switching device 3RF29 .0-0HA.. 8/15
depending on a setpoint value.
Closed-loop control: Full-wave control or generalized phase control
SIRIUS Innovations solid-state switching devices for switching motors
Solid-state contactors
Solid-state contactors • Complete "ready to use" units with an integrated insulated heatsink 3RF34 8/16
Solid-state reversing contactors • Compact and space-saving design 8/17
• Version for motors, "instantaneous switching"
8

Nomenclature Guide
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors

3RF2 0 20 - 1 A A 0 2
SIRIUS SC Type Rating Terminal Type Switching Control Phases Coil Type Power Voltage

0 = 45 mm Relay 1 = Screw A = Zero Point A = 1-phase 0 = 24 VDC 2 = 24 - 230 VAC


1 = 22.5 mm Relay 2 = Spring B = Instantaneous B = 2-phase 2 = 110 - 230 VAC 4 = 230 - 460 VAC
2 = 3-phase 45 mm Relay 3 = Ring Tounge C = Low Noise C = 3-phase 4 = 4 - 30 VDC 5 = 48 - 600 VAC
3 = Contactor D = Short Circuit 5 = 230 VAC 6 = 400 - 600 VAC
4 = 3-phase Contactor
9 = Function Module

Note: This is only a guide to decode the model number. All possible combinations of these are not produced.
Character of "3" in position four indicates Sirius Innovations

8/2 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Solid-State Switching Devices

General data

Overview

3RF21 3RF20 3RF22 3RF23 3RF24 3RF34 (Motor) 3RF29

SIRIUS 3RF2 solid-state switching devices devices are constructed with complete insulation and can be
mounted directly to 3RV2 MSPs and SIRIUS overload relays,
Solid-state switching devices for resistive loads resulting in a very simple integration into motor feeders.
• Solid-state relays
• Solid-state contactors These three-phase solid-state contactors are equipped with a
two-phase control which is particularly suitable for typical motor
• Function modules current circuits without connecting to the neutral conductor.
Solid-state switching devices for switching motors Important features:
• Solid-state contactors • Insulated enclosure with integrated heat sink
• Solid state reversing contactors • Integrated mounting foot to snap on a standard mounting rail
The most reliable solution for any application or for assembly onto a support plate
• Variety of connection methods
Compared to electro mechanical contactors, our SIRIUS 3RF2
solid-state switching devices stand out due to their considerably • Plug-in control connection
longer service life. Thanks to the high product quality, their • Display via LEDs
switching is extremely precise, reliable and, above all, insuscep-
Selecting solid-state contactors
tible to faults. With its variable connection methods and a wide
spread of control voltages, the SIRIUS 3RF2 family is universally The solid-state contactors are selected on the basis of details of
applicable. Depending on the individual requirements of the ap- the network, the load and the ambient conditions. As the
plication, our modular switchgear can also be quite easily ex- solid-state contactors are already equipped with an optimally
panded by the addition of standardized function modules. matched heat sink, the selection process is considerably
simpler than that for solid-state relays.
Semiconductor relays
The following procedure is recommended:
SIRIUS SC semiconductor relays are suitable for surface mount-
ing on existing cooling surfaces. Installation is quick and easy, • Determine the rated current of the load and the mains voltage
involving just two screws. Depending on the nature of the heat • Select a solid-state contactor with the same or higher rated
sink, the capacity reaches up to 88 A on resistive loads. The current than the load
3RF21 semiconductor relays can be expanded with various • Testing the maximum permissible switching frequency based
function modules to adapt them to individual applications. on the characteristic curves. To do this, the starting current,
The semiconductor relays are available in 2 different widths: the starting time and the motor load in the operating phase
must be known.
• 3RF21 semiconductor relay with a width of 22.5 mm
• If the permissible switching frequency is below the desired
• 3RF20 and 3RF22 semiconductor relay with a width of 45 mm
frequency, it is possible to achieve an increase by overdimen-
sioning the motor.

8
Both variants are only available in the "zero-point switching" ver-
sion. This standard version is ideally suited for operation with re-
sistive loads. Benefits

& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
Selecting semiconductor relays • Devices with integrated heat sink, "ready to use"
When selecting semiconductor relays, in addition to information • Compact and space-saving design
about the power system, the load and the ambient conditions it • Reversing contactors with integrated interlocking
is also necessary to know details of the planned design. The
semiconductor relays can only conform to their specific techni- Application
cal specifications if they are mounted with appropriate care on
an adequately dimensioned heat sink. The following procedure Standards and approvals
is recommended: • IEC 60947-4-3
• Determine the rated current of the load and the mains voltage • UL 508, CSA for North America1)
• Select the relay design and choose a semiconductor relay with • CE marking for Europe
higher rated current than the load requires • C-Tick approval for Australia
1)
• Determine the thermal resistance of the proposed heat sink Please note: For reversing motor applications use overvoltage protection
device Type 3TX7462-3L; max. cut-off-voltage 6000 V; min. energy han-
• Check the correct relay size with the aid of the diagram dling capability 100 J.
Solid-state contactors for switching motors
The solid-state contactors for switching motors are intended for
frequently switching on and off three-phase current operating
mechanisms up to 5 HP and reversing up to 3 HP. The

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 8/3


Solid-State Switching Devices

General data

Type Solid-state relays Solid-state contactors Function modules


1-phase 3-phase 1-phase 3-phase Converter Load monitoring Heating Power Power
22.5 mm 45 mm 45 mm Basic Extended current control- regula-
monitoring lers tors
Usage
Simple use of existing solid-state -- -- -- -- -- --
relays
Complete device "Ready to use" -- -- -- -- -- --
Space-saving -- -- -- -- --
Can be extended with modular -- -- -- -- -- -- --
function modules
Frequent switching and monitor- -- -- -- -- -- --
ing of loads and solid-state
relays/solid-state contactors
Monitoring of up to 6 partial -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- --
loads
Monitoring of more than 6 partial -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- --
loads
Control of the heating power -- -- -- -- -- -- -- --
through an analog input
Power control -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- --
Startup
Easy setting of setpoints with -- -- -- -- -- -- --
"Teach" button
"Remote Teach" input for setting -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- --
setpoints
Mounting
Mounting onto mounting rails or -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- --
mounting plates
Can be snapped directly onto a -- -- -- -- --
solid-state relay or contactor
For use with "Coolplate" heat sink -- -- -- -- -- -- -- --
Cable routing
Connection of load circuit as for -- --
controls
Connection of load circuit from -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- --
above

Function is available
Function is possible

Note: Permissible for use at altitudes of more than 2500 m above sea level with
the following derating for 3RF2 Devices:
Site altitude 2500 m above sea level:
•Reduction of rated insulation voltage to 0,93 x Ui
•Reduction of load current to 0,93 x Ie
8

Site altitude 3000 m above sea level:


•Reduction of rated insulation voltage to 0,88 x Ui
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors

•Reduction of load current to 0,9 x Ie


Site altitude 4000 m above sea level:
•Reduction of rated insulation voltage to 0,79 x Ui
•Reduction of load current to 0,8 x Ie
Site altitude 5000 m above sea level:
•Reduction of rated insulation voltage to 0,75 x Ui
•Reduction of load current to 0,7 x Ie
These ratings apply to a maximum ambient temperature
of 40 °C (140 °F).

8/4 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Solid-State Switching Devices

General data

3RF24 three-phase solid-state contactors


Benefits
The compact design enables small compact units with currents
• Considerable space savings thanks to a width of only 22.5 mm
up to 50 A. All special features of the solid-state relays for saving
• Variety of connection techniques: screw connection, spring- time and space are effective here too.
type connection or ring terminal end, makes for easy
terminations Example plastic machine industry:
• Flexible for a wide range of applications with function modules Thanks to their high switching endurance, SIRIUS SC semicon-
for retrofitting ductor switching devices are ideally suited for use in the control
• Possibility of fuseless short-circuit resistant design of electroheat. This is because the more precise the temperature
regulation process has to be, the higher the switching frequency
Advantages: needs to be. The accurate regulation of electroheat is used for
• Saves time and costs with easy wiring, simple installation and example in many processes in the plastic machine industry:
fast commissioning • Band heaters heat the extrudate to the correct temperature in
• Extremely long life, low maintenance, rugged and reliable plastic extruders
• Space-saving and safe thanks to side-by-side mounting up to • Heat emitters heat plastic blanks to the correct temperature
an ambient temperature of +60 °C • Heat drums dry plastic granules
• Modular design: standardized function modules and heat sinks • Heating channels keep molds at the correct temperature in
can be used in conjunction with 22.5 mm style semiconductor order to manufacture different plastic parts without defects.
relays to satisfy unique application requirements
The powerful SIRIUS SC semiconductor relays and contactors
• Vibration-resistant and shock-resistant spring-loaded terminal can be used to control several heating loads at the same time.
connection system provides a superior connection even under By using a load monitoring module the individual partial loads
tough conditions can easily be monitored, and in the event of a failure a signal is
generated which can be sent to the controller.
Area of application Protecting the semiconductor relays and semiconductor contac-
tors with 5 SY supplemental protectors.
Applications
Short-circuit protection and line protection with 5 SY supplemen-
Solid-state relays tal protectors is easy to achieve with SIRIUS SC semiconductor
SIRIUS solid-state relays are suitable for surface mounting on relays and semiconductor contactors in comparison with
existing cooling surfaces. Installation is quick and easy, designing load feeders with fuses. A special version of the
involving just two screws. The special technology of the power semiconductor contactors can be protected against damage in
semiconductor ensures there is excellent thermal contact with the case of a short-circuit with 5 SY supplementary protector
the heat sink. Depending on the nature of the heat sink, the with type B tripping characteristic. This allows the low-cost and
capacity reaches up to 88 A on resistive loads. simple design of fuseless load feeders with full protection of
the switching device.
The solid-state relays are available in three different versions:
• 3RF21 single-phase solid-state relay with a width of 22.5 mm Design
• 3RF20 single-phase solid-state relay with a width of 45 mm
There is no typical design of a load feeder with semiconductor
• 3RF22 three-phase solid-state relay with a width of 45 mm relays or semiconductor contactors; instead, the great variety of
The 3RF21 and 3RF22 solid-state relays can be expanded with connection systems and control voltages offers universal
various function modules to adapt them to individual applica- application opportunities. SIRIUS SC semiconductor relays and
tions. semiconductor contactors can be installed in fuseless or fused
feeders, as required.
Solid-state contactors
There are special versions with which it is even possible to
The complete units consist of a solid-state relay plus optimized
achieve short-circuit strength in a fuseless design.
heat sink, and are therefore ready to use. They offer defined

8
rated currents to make selection as easy as possible. Depend- Mounting regulations
ing on the version, current intensities of up to 88 A are achieved.
Like all of our solid-state switching devices, one of their parti-

& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
cular advantages is their compact and space-saving design.
With their insulated mounting foot they can easily be snapped >70 (2,75)
onto a standard mounting rail, or they can be mounted on carrier
plates with fixing screws. This insulation enables them to be
>20 (0,8)

>20 (0,8)

>20 (0,8)

used in circuits with protective extra-low voltage (PELV) or safety


extra-low voltage (SELV) in building engineering. For other appli-
3RF24..

3RF24..

cations, such as for extended personal safety, the heat sink can
be grounded through a screw terminal.
The solid-state contactors are available in two different versions:
NSB0_01814

• 3RF23 single-phase solid-state contactors


>50 (2)
• 3RF24 three-phase solid-state contactors
3RF22 three-phase solid-state relay with a width of 45 mm
With its compact design, which stays the same even at currents Distances for stand-alone installation
of up to 55 A, the 3RF22 solid-state relay is the ultimate in space-
saving construction, at a width of 45 mm. Installation on cooling
surfaces is quick and easy, involving just two screws. The logical
connection arrangement, with the power infeed from above and
connection of the load from below, ensures tidy installation in the
control cabinet.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 8/5


Solid-State Switching Devices

General data

Performance characteristics
Functions
The performance of the semiconductor switching devices are
Connection substantially determined by the type of power semiconductors
All SIRIUS SC semiconductor switching devices are character- used and the internal design. In the case of the SIRIUS SC semi-
ized by the great variety of connection methods. You can conductor contactors and semiconductor relays, only thyristors
choose between the following connection techniques: are used instead of less powerful Triacs.

SIGUT connection system (screw) Two of the most important features of thyristors are the blocking
voltage and the maximum load integral:
The SIGUT connection system is the standard among industrial
switching devices. Open terminals and a plus-minus screw are Blocking voltage
just two features of this technology. Two conductors of up to Thyristors with a high blocking voltage can also be operated
6 mm² 1) can be connected in just one terminal. As a result, without difficulty in power systems with high interference volt-
loads of up to 50 A can be connected. ages. Separate protective measures, such as a protective circuit
Spring-loaded connection system with a varistor, are not necessary in most cases.

This innovative technology holds the conductor without screw With SIRIUS SC, for example, thyristors with 800 V blocking volt-
connection. This means that very high vibration resistance is age are fitted for operation in power systems up to 230 V. Thyris-
achieved. Two conductors of up to 2.5 mm² 1) can be connected tors with up to 1600 V are used for power systems with higher
to each terminal. As a result, loads of up to 20 A can be dealt voltages.
with. Maximum load integral
Ring terminal end connection One of the purposes of specifying the maximum load integral
The ring terminal end connection is equipped with an M5 screw. (I²t) is to determine the rating of the short-circuit protection. Only
Ring terminal ends of up to 25 mm² can be connected. In this a large power semiconductor with a correspondingly high I²t
way it is possible to connect conductors with up to 88 A safely. value can be given appropriate protection against destruction
Additional finger safety can be provided with a special cover. from a short-circuit by means of a protective device matched to
the application. However, SIRIUS SC is also characterized by the
Switching types optimum matching of the thyristors (I²t value) with the rated cur-
rents. The rated currents specified on the devices in conform-
In order to guarantee an optimized control method for different ance with EN 60947-4-3 were confirmed by extensive testing.
loads, the functionality of our semiconductor switching devices
can be adapted accordingly.
The "zero-point switching" method is ideal for resistive loads,
i.e. where the power semiconductor is activated at zero voltage.
For inductive loads, on the other hand, for example in the case
of valves, it is better to go with "instantaneous switching". By
distributing the ON point over the entire sine curve of the mains
voltage, disturbances are reduced to a minimum.
A special “low noise” version is available due to a special con-
trol, this special version can be used in public networks up to
16A without any additional measures such as interference sup-
pressor filters. As a result, it conforms to limit value curve class
B according to EN 60947-4-3 in terms of emitted interference.

Function
Two-phase controlled version
8

In many three-phase applications there is no need of a three-


phase controller. Loads in a delta circuit or wye circuit, which
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors

have no connection to the neutral conductor, can be safely


switched on and off using only two phases.
Nevertheless, the 3RF22 and 3RF24 three-phase solid-state
switching devices provide the possibility of connecting all three
phases to the switching device, with the middle phase looped
directly through the device. Thanks to the lower power loss
compared to a three-phase controlled device it is possible for
the mounted accessories to be more compact.
Three-phase controlled version
This version is used in three-phase applications which have to
switch all phases on and off for system reasons or in the case of
loads in a wye circuit with connection to the neutral conductor.

1) For mm2 to AWG conversion see page 19/21 of Industrial Controls catalog.

8/6 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Solid-State Switching Devices

General data

Selection and ordering data

Inscriptionand
Selection labels for 3RF2
ordering dataseries
Designation Labeling area Color Order No. Std. Weight
(W x H ) Pack per pack
Qty approx.
Designation Labeling
Labeling areaarea
ColorColor SD No.
Order Article No. Std. Price PUWeight PS* PG
mm xHmm
(W x(W )x H) Pack per PU (UNIT,kg
per pack
Blank labels Qty SET, M)approx.
10 x mm
Unit labeling plates mm x mm Pastel
x7mm d 00-1SB10
3RT19 816 units kg
0.110
Blank labels
Blank labels for "SIRIUS" 1) turquoise
Unit
Unit labeling
labeling plates 20
10 xx 10
plates for 7
7 x7 Pastel
Pastel 3RT19
Titanium gray
3RT19 3RT2900-1SB10
20 00-1SB20
00-1SB10 340
816 units
units 1000.220
816 units
0.110 41B
"SIRIUS" 1) 1) turquoise
for "SIRIUS" 20 x 7 turquoise
Titanium gray 20 3RT2900-1SB20 100 340 units 41B
Labels for sticking 19 20 xx 19
6
7 x6 Pastel
Pastel 3RT19 00-1SB60 3060 unit
340 units 0.150
Adhesive labels
for "SIRIUS"
3RT19
Titanium gray
turquoise 5 00-1SB20
3RT2900-1SB60 1000.220
3 060 units 41B
for SIRIUS turquoise
Labels for sticking 19 19 xx 6
6 Zinc
Pastel 3RT19
3RT19 00-1SD60
00-1SB60 3060
3060 units
unit 0.150
0.150
IC01_00181

Unit labeling plates for "SIRIUS" yellow


turquoise
(1 frame = 20 units) 19 x 6 Zinc 3RT19 00-1SD60 3060 units 0.150
1) Computer
Unit labeling labeling
3RT2900-1SB20 plates system for individual inscription of unit labeling yellow
plates
(1available
(1 frame
frame = from:
= 20
20 units)
units)
murrplastik Systemtechnik GmbH (http://www.murrplastik.de).
1) Computer
1) PC labeling labeling
systemssystem for individual
for individual inscription
inscription of unitoflabeling
unit labeling
platesplates
are
available
available from:
from: murrplastik Systemtechnik GmbH (see page 16/15).
murrplastik Systemtechnik GmbH (http://www.murrplastik.de).
Integration
Notes on integration in the load feeders
Integration Alternatively, if there is lower loading, protection can also be pro-
vided by standard fuses or miniature circuit breakers. This pro-
The SIRIUS solid-state switching devices are very easy to inte- tection is achieved
Notes on the
grate into integration in the
load feeders load feeders
thanks to their industrial connection Alternatively, if thereby overdimensioning
is lower the solid-state
loading, protection can alsoswitch-
be pro-
ing
vided devices accordingly.
by standard fuses orThe technical
miniature specifications
circuit breakers. and Thisthe
pro-
method
The SIRIUS andsolid-state
design. switching devices are very easy to inte- product
tection isdata sheetsby
achieved contain details both the
overdimensioning about the solid-state
solid-state switch-
grate into the
Particular load feeders
attention thanks be
must however to their
paid industrial connection
to the circumstances fuse protection
ing devices itself and The
accordingly. about use of the
technical devices withand
specifications conven-
the
method
of and design.
the installation and ambient conditions, as the performance of tional
product protection
data sheets equipment.
contain details both about the solid-state
the solid-state
Particular switching
attention must devices
howeverisbe largely
paid todependent on these.
the circumstances fuse protection itself
Semiconductor motorand andabout use of
reversing the devices
contactors canwith
be conven-
easily
Depending on theand
of the installation version,
ambientcertain restrictions
conditions, as themust be ob- of
performance tional
combinedprotection
with the equipment.
3RV motor starter protectors and 3RB2 over-
served. Detailed
the solid-state information,
switching for example
devices is largely in relation toon
dependent solid-
these. load relay from the SIRIUS modular system. Thus, fuseless and
state contactors about the minimum spacing and to be
solid-state Semiconductor motor and reversing contactors can be easily
Depending on the version, certain restrictions must ob- fuse motor with
combined feeders can motor
the 3RV be designed easily and and
starter protectors in a space-
3RB2 over-
relays
served.about the choice
Detailed of heat
information, forsink, is given
example in the technical
in relation to solid- saving manner.
specifications (see Technical Information LV 1and T or to
oursolid-state
Mall) and load relay from the SIRIUS modular system. Thus, fuseless and
state contactors about the minimum spacing fuse motor feeders can be designed easily and in aare
space-
the product
relays aboutdata sheets.of heat sink, is given in the technical
the choice The solid-state switching devices for resistive loads suitable
saving
for manner.
interference-free operation in industrial networks without fur-
specifications
Despite the rugged (see Technical Information LV that
power semiconductors 1 T orareour Mall)solid-
used, and
the product datadevices
sheets.respond more sensitively to short- ther measures. switching
The solid-state If they aredevices
used in for
public networks,
resistive loads itare
may be
suitable
state switching necessary for conducted interference to benetworks
reducedwithoutby means
circuits for interference-free operation in industrial fur-
Despite in the
the load feeder.
rugged power Consequently,
semiconductors special
that areprecautions
used, solid- of filters.
ther This does
measures. not are
If they include
usedthein special solid-stateit contactors
public networks, may be
have
state to be taken
switching againstrespond
devices destruction,
moredepending
sensitively on the type of
to short- of type 3RF23..-.CA.. "Lowinterference
Noise". These comply withbythemeans
class
design. necessary for conducted to be reduced
circuits in the load feeder. Consequently, special precautions B
of limit values
filters. This doesup tonot a rated current
include of 16 A.solid-state
the special If other versions are
contactors
have
Siemensto be taken against
generally destruction,
recommends usingdepending on the type of
SITOR semiconductor used,
of typeand at currents "Low
3RF23..-.CA.. of over 16 A,These
Noise". standard filterswith
comply canthebe class
used
design. fuses. These fuses also provide protection against
protection in ordervalues
B limit to comply up towith the limit
a rated values.
current of 16The
A. Ifdecisive factors are
other versions
destruction in the event
Siemens generally of a short-circuit
recommends using SITOReven semiconductor
when the solid- when
used, itandcomes to selecting
at currents of overthe
16filters are essentially
A, standard filters canthebecurrent
used
state contactors
protection fuses.andThesesolid-state
fuses also relays are fully
provide utilized.
protection against loading
in order and the other
to comply withparameters (operational
the limit values. voltage,
The decisive design
factors
destruction in the event of a short-circuit even when the solid- type,
when etc.)
it comes in the toload feeder.
selecting the filters are essentially the current
state contactors and solid-state relays are fully utilized. loading
Suitableand filtersthecanother
be parameters
ordered from(operational
EPCOS AG.voltage, design

8
type, etc.) in the load feeder.
You can find more information on the Internet at:
Suitable filters can be ordered from EPCOS AG.

& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
http://www.epcos.com
You can find more information on the Internet at:
http://www.epcos.com

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 8/7


Solid-State Switching Devices

Solid-State Relays
22.5 mm semiconductor relays

Selection and ordering data

3RF21 20-1AA02 3RF21 20-2AA02 3RF21 20-3AA02


2)
Type Maximum achiev- Screw connection Spring-loaded connec- Ring cable connection Std. Weight
current able power for type tion 3) Pack per pack
1) current and Ue = Qty approx.
115 V 230 V 400 V

A kW kW kW Order No. Order No. Order No. kg


Zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 24 V to 230 V
20 2.3 4.6 - 3RF21 20-1AA@2 3RF21 20-2AA@2 3RF21 20-3AA@2 1 unit 0.075
30 3.5 6.9 - 3RF21 30-1AA@2 - - 1 unit 0.075
50 5.8 11.5 - 3RF21 50-1AA@2 3RF21 50-2AA@2 3RF21 50-3AA@2 1 unit 0.075
70 8.1 16.1 - 3RF21 70-1AA@2 - - 1 unit 0.075
90 10.4 20.7 - 3RF21 90-1AA@2 3RF21 90-2AA@2 3RF21 90-3AA@2 1 unit 0.075
Zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 24 V to 230 V, control DC 4 ... 30 V
20 2.3 4.6 - 3RF21 20-1AA42 3RF21 20-2AA42 - 1 unit 0.075
30 3.5 6.9 - 3RF21 30-1AA42 - - 1 unit 0.075
Zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 48 V to 460 V
20 - 4.6 8 3RF21 20-1AA@4 3RF21 20-2AA@4 3RF21 20-3AA@4 1 unit 0.075
30 - 6.9 12 3RF21 30-1AA@4 - - 1 unit 0.075
50 - 11.5 20 3RF21 50-1AA@4 3RF21 50-2AA@4 4) 3RF21 50-3AA@4 1 unit 0.075
70 - 16.1 28 3RF21 70-1AA@4 - - 1 unit 0.075
90 - 20.7 36 3RF21 90-1AA@4 3RF21 90-2AA@4 3RF21 90-3AA@4 1 unit 0.075
Zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 48 V to 600 V, control DC 4 ... 30 V
20 - 4.6 8 3RF21 20-1AA45 3RF21 20-2AA45 - 1 unit 0.075
30 - 6.9 12 3RF21 30-1AA45 - - 1 unit 0.075
50 - 11.5 20 3RF21 50-1AA45 - - 1 unit 0.075
70 - 16.1 28 3RF21 70-1AA45 - - 1 unit 0.075
90 - 20.7 36 3RF21 90-1AA45 - 3RF21 90-3AA44 1 unit 0.075
Zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 48 V to 600 V, blocking voltage 1600 V
30 - - 12 3RF21 30-1AA@6 - - 1 unit 0.075
50 - - 20 3RF21 50-1AA@6 3RF21 50-2AA@6 3RF21 50-3AA@6 1 unit 0.075
70 - - 28 3RF21 70-1AA@6 - - 1 unit 0.075
90 - - 36 3RF21 90-1AA@6 3RF21 90-2AA@6 3RF21 90-3AA@6 1 unit 0.075
Zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 48 V to 600 V, control 24 V DC low power
70 - - 28 3RF21 70-1AA05-0KN0 - - 1 unit 0.075
Zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 24 V to 230 V, control 110 V to 230 V
50 - - - 3RF21 50-1BA22 - - 1 unit 0.075
8

instantaneous switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 48 V to 460 V, control 24 V DC


acc. to EN 61131-2
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors

20 - - - 3RF21 20-1BA04 - - 1 unit 0.075


30 - - - 3RF21 30-1BA04 - - 1 unit 0.075
50 - - - 3RF21 50-1BA04 - - 1 unit 0.075
70 - - - 3RF21 70-1BA04 - - 1 unit 0.075
90 - - - 3RF21 90-1BA04 - - 1 unit 0.075
Zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 48 V to 600 V, control 24 V DC
acc. to EN 61131-2, blocking voltage 1600 V
50 - - - 3RF21 50-1BA06 - - 1 unit 0.075
Low noise3) - zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 48 V to 460 V, control 24 V DC
acc. to EN 61131-2
70 - - - 3RF21 70-1CA04 - - 1 unit 0.075
Order No. extension for
rated control supply voltage Us
DC 24 V acc. to EN 61131-2 0 0 0
AC 110 V... 230 V 2 2 2
Other rated control supply voltages on request.
1) The type current provides information about the performance of the semi- 3) Please note that this version can only be used for a rated current of up to
conductor relay. The actual permitted operational current Ie can be smaller 20 A and a conductor cross section of 2.5 mm2. See page 19/21 of Indus-
depending on the connection method and cooling conditions. trial controls catalog for mm2 to AWG conversion chart.
2) Please note that this version can only be used for a rated current of up to 4) 50 A version with 24 AC/DC control - 3RF21 50-2AA14.
50 A and a conductor cross section of 10 mm2.
Note: See page 19/21 of Industrial Controls catalog for mm2 to AWG
conversion chart.

8/8 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category: SIRIUS SC
Solid-State Switching Devices

Solid-State Relays
45 mm semiconductor relays

Fused design with semiconductor protection


(similar to type of coordination "2")1)
The semiconductor protection for the SIRIUS SC control gear If a fuse is used with a higher rated current than specified, semi-
can be used with different protective devices. This allows conductor protection is no longer guaranteed. However, smaller
protection by means of LV HRC fuses of operational class gL/gG fuses with a lower rated current for the load can be used without
or supplementary protectors. The table on page 7/21 lists the problems.
maximum permissible fuses for each SIRIUS SC controlgear. For protective devices with operational class gL/gG and for
SITOR full range fuses 3NE1, the minimum cross-sections for the
conductor to be connected must be taken into account.

Selection and ordering data

3RF20 20-1AA02
Type Maximum achiev- Screw connection 2) Spring-loaded Ring cable connection Std. Weight
current able power for type connection 3) Pack per pack
1) current and Ue = Qty approx.
115 V 230 V 400 V

A kW kW kW Order No. Order No. Order No. kg


Zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 24 V to 230 V
20 2.3 4.6 - 3RF20 20-1AA@2 - - 1 unit 0.085
30 3.5 6.9 - 3RF20 30-1AA@2 - - 1 unit 0.085
50 5.8 11.5 - 3RF20 50-1AA@2 - - 1 unit 0.085
70 8.1 16.1 - 3RF20 70-1AA@2 - - 1 unit 0.085
88 10.4 20.7 - 3RF20 90-1AA@2 - - 1 unit 0.085
Zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 24 V to 230 V, control DC 4 ... 30 V
20 - - - - 3RF21 20-2AA42 - 1 unit 0.075
Zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 48 V to 460 V
20 - 4.6 8 3RF20 20-1AA@4 - - 1 unit 0.085
30 - 6.9 12 3RF20 30-1AA@4 - - 1 unit 0.085
50 - 11.5 20 3RF20 50-1AA@4 - - 1 unit 0.085
70 - 16.1 28 3RF20 70-1AA@4 - - 1 unit 0.085
88 - 20.7 36 3RF20 90-1AA@4 - - 1 unit 0.085
Zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 24 V to 230 V, control DC 4 ... 30 V
20 - - - 3RF20 20-1AA42 3RF21 20-2AA42 - 1 unit 0.085
30 - - - 3RF20 30-1AA42 - - 1 unit 0.085
Zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 48 V to 600 V, control DC 4 ... 30 V
20 - 4.6 8 3RF20 20-1AA45 - - 1 unit 0.085
50 - 11.5 20 3RF20 50-1AA45 - - 1 unit 0.085
70 - 16.1 28 3RF20 70-1AA45 - - 1 unit 0.085
90 - 20.7 36 3RF20 90-1AA45 - - 1 unit 0.085

8
Zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 48 V to 600 V, blocking voltage 1600 V
30 - - 12 3RF20 30-1AA@6 - - 1 unit 0.085

& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
50 - - 20 3RF20 50-1AA@6 - - 1 unit 0.085
70 - - 28 3RF20 70-1AA@6 - - 1 unit 0.085
88 - - 36 3RF20 90-1AA@6 - - 1 unit 0.085
Zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 48 V to 460 V, control DC 4 ... 30 V switching
50 - - - 3RF20 50-1AA44 - - 1 unit 0.085
Instantaneous switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 48 V to 460 V, control 24 V DC
acc. to EN 61131-2
30 - - - 3RF20 30-1BA04 - - 1 unit 0.085
Order No. extension for
rated control supply voltage Us
DC 24 V acc. to EN 61131-2 0 0 0
AC 110 V... 230 V 2 2 2
Other rated control supply voltages on request.
1) The type current provides information about the performance of the semi-
conductor relay. The actual permitted operational current Ie can be smaller
depending on the connection method and cooling conditions.
2) Please note that this version can only be used for a rated current of up to
50 A and a conductor cross section of 10mm2.
3) Screw terminals and spring terminals (control current side).
Note: For mm2 to AWG conversion chart see Industrial Controls catalog page
19/21.

Product Category: SIRIUS SC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 8/9
Solid-State Switching Devices

Solid-State Relays
3RF22 solid-state relays, 3-phase, 45 mm

Selection and ordering data


Selecting solid-state relays • Determine the rated current of the load and the mains voltage
When selecting solid-state relays, in addition to information • Select the relay design and choose a solid-state relay with
about the power system, the load and the ambient conditions it higher rated current than the load
is also necessary to know details of the planned design. The • Determine the thermal resistance of the proposed heat sink
solid-state relays can only conform to their specific technical • Check the correct relay size with the aid of the diagrams.
specifications if they are mounted with appropriate care on an
adequately dimensioned heat sink. The following procedure is
recommended:
Type current1) Rated control supply volt- Screw terminal2) Weight
age per pack
approx.
Order No.
A V kg
Zero-point switching
Rated operational voltage Ue 48 V ... 600 V
Two-phase controlled
30 4 ... 30 V DC 3RF22 30-1AB@5 0.150
55 3RF22 55-1AB@5 0.150
Three-phase controlled
30 4 ... 30 V DC 3RF22 30-1AC@5 0.150
55 3RF22 55-1AC@5 0.150

3RF22 30-1AB45 110 V AC 3


4 ... 30 V DC 4

Type current1) Rated control supply volt- Spring-loaded terminals3) Weight


age per pack
approx.
Order No.
A V kg
Zero-point switching
Rated operational voltage Ue 48 V ... 600 V
Two-phase controlled
30 4 ... 30 V DC 3RF22 30-2AB45 0.150
55 3RF22 55-2AB45 0.150
Three-phase controlled
30 4 ... 30 V DC 3RF22 30-2AC45 0.150
55 3RF22 55-2AC45 0.150

3RF22 30-2AB45
8

Type current1) Rated control supply volt- Ring terminal end connection Weight
age per pack
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors

approx.
Order No.
A V kg
Zero-point switching
Rated operational voltage Ue 48 V ... 600 V
Two-phase controlled
30 4 ... 30 V DC 3RF22 30-3AB45 0.150
55 3RF22 55-3AB45 0.150
Three-phase controlled
30 4 ... 30 V DC 3RF22 30-3AC45 0.150
55 3RF22 55-3AC45 0.150

3RF22 30-3AB45

1) The type current provides information about the performance of the 2) Please note that the version with an M4 screw terminal can only be used
solid-state relay. for a rated current of up to approx. 50 A and a conductor cross-section of
The actual permitted rated operational current Ie can be smaller 10 mm2.
depending on the connection method and cooling conditions. 3) Please note that this version can only be used for a rated current of up to
approx. 20 A and a conductor cross-section of 2.5 mm2.

8/10 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category: SIRIUS SC
Solid-State Switching Devices

Solid-State Contactors
General data

Overview
Solid-state contactors
Rated current of the Example Max. conductor Minimum cable
The complete units consist of a solid-state relay plus optimized miniature circuit Type1) cross-section length from
heat sink, and are therefore ready to use. They offer defined breaker contactor to
rated currents to make selection as easy as possible. Depend- load
ing on the version, current strengths of up to 88 A are achieved. 6A 5SY4 106-6, 1 mm2 5m
Like all of our solid-state switching devices, one of their particu- 5SX2 106-6
lar advantages is their compact and space-saving design. 10 A 5SY4 110-6, 1.5 mm2 8m
5SX2 110-6
With their insulated mounting foot they can easily be snapped 16 A 5SY4 116-6, 1.5 mm2 12 m
onto a standard mounting rail, or they can be mounted on sup- 5SX2 116-6
port plates with fixing screws. This insulation enables them to be 16 A 5SY4 116-6, 2.5 mm2 20 m
used in circuits with protective extra-low voltage (PELV) or safety 5SX2 116-6
extra-low voltage (SELV) in building management systems. For 20 A 5SY4 120-6, 2.5 mm2 20 m
other applications, such as for extended personal safety, the 5SX2 120-6
heat sink can be grounded through a screw terminal. 25 A 5SY4 125-6, 2.5 mm2 26 m
The solid-state contactors are available in 2 different versions: 5SX2 125-6

• 3RF23 single-phase solid-state contactors, 1) The miniature circuit breakers can be used up to a maximum rated voltage
of 480 V!
• 3RF24 three -phase solid-state contactors
Single-phase versions
The 3RF23 solid-state contactors can be expanded with various
function modules to adapt them to individual applications.
Version for resistive loads, "zero-point switching"
This standard version is often used for switching space heaters
on and off.
Version for inductive loads, "instantaneous switching"
In this version the solid-state contactor is specifically matched to
inductive loads. Whether it is a matter of frequent actuation of the
valves in a filling plant or starting and stopping small operating
mechanisms in packet distribution systems, operation is carried
out safely and noiselessly.
Special "Low noise" version
Thanks to a special control circuit, this special version can be
used in public networks up to 16 A without any additional mea-
sures such as interference suppressor filters. As a result it con-
forms to limit value curve class B according to EN 60947-4-3 in
terms of emitted interference.
Special "Short-circuit-proof" version The setup and installation above can also be used for the solid-
Skillful matching of the power semiconductor with the perfor- state relays with a I2t value of at least 6600 A2s.
mance capacity of the solid-state contactor means that "short- Three-phase versions

8
circuit strength" can be achieved with a standard miniature cir-
cuit breaker. In combination with a B-type MCB or a conven- The three-phase solid-state contactors for resistive loads up to
tional line protection fuse, the result is a short-circuit resistant 50 A are available with

& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
feeder. • two-phase control (suitable in particular for circuits without
In order to achieve problem-free short-circuit protection by connection to the neutral conductor) and
means of miniature circuit breakers, however, certain boundary • three-phase control (suitable for star circuits with connection to
conditions must be observed. As the magnitude and duration of the neutral conductor or for applications in which the system
the short-circuit current are determined not only by the short-cir- requires all phases to be switched).
cuit breaking response of the miniature circuit breaker but also
the properties of the wiring system, such as the internal resis- The converter function module can be snapped onto both ver-
tance of the input to the network and damping by controls and sions for the simple power control of AC loads by means of ana-
cables, particular attention must also be paid to these parame- log signals.
ters. The necessary cable lengths are therefore shown for the • Check the correct contactor size with the aid of the rated cur-
main factor, the line resistance, in the table above right. rent diagram, taking account of the design conditions.
The following miniature circuit breakers with a type B tripping
characteristic and 10 kA or 6 kA breaking capacity protect the
3RF23..-.DA.. solid-state contactors in the event of short-circuits
on the load and the specified conductor cross-sections and
lengths:

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 8/11


Solid-State Switching Devices

Solid-State Relays
SIRIUS SC semiconductor contactors – single phase selection

Selection and ordering data


Selecting solid-state contactors The following procedure is recommended:
The semiconductor contactors are selected on the basis of de- • Determine the rated current of the load and the mains voltage
tails of the power system, the load and the ambient conditions. • Select a semiconductor contactor with the same or higher
As the semiconductor contactors are already equipped with an rated current than the load
optimally matched heat sink, the selection process is consider- • Check the correct contactor size with the aid of the rated cur-
ably simpler than that for semiconductor relays. rent diagram, taking account of the design conditions

3RF23 10-1AA02 3RF23 30-1AA02 3RF23 40-1AA02 3RF23 50-3AA02 3RF23 70-3AA02 3RF23 90-3AA02
Type Maximum achiev- Screw connection Spring-loaded connec- Ring cable connection Std. Weight
current able power for tion Pack per pack
1)
Imax and Ue = Qty approx.
Imax. 115 V 230 V 400 V
A kW kW kW Order No. Order No. Order No. kg
Zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 24 V to 230 V
10.5 1.2 2.4 - 3RF23 10-1AA@2 3RF23 10-2AA@2 3RF23 10-3AA@2 1 unit 0.136
20 2.3 4.6 - 3RF23 20-1AA@2 3RF23 20-2AA@2 3RF23 20-3AA@2 1 unit 0.204
30 3.5 6.9 - 3RF23 30-1AA@2 - 3RF23 30-3AA@2 1 unit 0.354
40 4.6 9.2 - 3RF23 40-1AA@2 - 3RF23 40-3AA@2 1 unit 0.496
50 6 12 - 3RF23 50-1AA@2 - 3RF23 50-3AA@2 1 unit 0.496
70 8 16 - - - 3RF23 70-3AA@2 1 unit 0.944
Zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 24 V to 230 V, control 24 V DC acc. to EN 61131-2 3)
50 - - - 3RF20 50-4AA02 - - 1 unit 0.085
Zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 24 V to 230 V, control 24 V DC low power
20 - - - 3RF23 20-1AA02-0KN0 - - 1 unit 0.240
Zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 48 V to 460 V
10.5 - 2.4 4.2 3RF23 10-1AA@4 3RF23 10-2AA@4 3RF23 10-3AA@4 1 unit 0.136
20 - 4.6 8 3RF23 20-1AA@4 3RF23 20-2AA@4 3RF23 20-3AA@4 1 unit 0.204
30 - 6.9 12 3RF23 30-1AA@4 - 3RF23 30-3AA@4 1 unit 0.354
40 - 9.2 16 3RF23 40-1AA@4 - 3RF23 40-3AA@4 1 unit 0.496
50 - 12 20 3RF23 50-1AA@4 - 3RF23 50-3AA@4 1 unit 0.496
70 - 16 28 - - 3RF23 70-3AA@4 1 unit 0.944
Zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 24 V to 230 V, control 24 V AC/DC
10.5 - - - 3RF23 10-1AA12 - - 1 unit 0.165
Zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 48 V to 460 V, control 24 V DC low power
50 - - - 3RF23 10-1AA04-0KN0 - - 1 unit 0.165
Zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 48 V to 460 V, control 24 V AC/DC
10.5 - - - 3RF23 10-1AA14 - - 1 unit 0.165
20 - - - 3RF23 20-1AA14 - - 1 unit 0.240
30 - - - 3RF23 30-1AA14 - - 1 unit 0.400
40 - - - 3RF23 40-1AA14 - - 1 unit 0.550
50 - - - 3RF23 50-1AA14 - - 1 unit 0.550
Zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 48 V to 600 V, control DC 4 ... 30 V
8

10.5 - 2.4 4.2 3RF23 10-1AA45 - - 1 unit 0.135


20 - 4.6 8 3RF23 20-1AA45 - - 1 unit 0.204
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors

30 - 6.9 12 3RF23 30-1AA45 - - 1 unit 0.354


30 - - - 3RF23 30-1AA25 2) - - 1 unit 0.354
40 - 9.2 16 3RF23 40-1AA45 - 3RF23 40-3AA45 1 unit 0.496
50 - 12 20 3RF23 50-1AA45 - - 1 unit 0.496
70 - 16 26 - - 3RF23 70-3AA45 1 unit 0.944
Zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 48 V to 460 V, control 4 V ... 30 V DC
10.5 - - - 3RF23 10-1AA44 - - 1 unit 0.165
20 - - - 3RF23 20-1AA44 - 3RF23 20-3AA44 1 unit 0.240
30 - - - 3RF23 30-1AA44 - 3RF23 30-3AA44 1 unit 0.400
50 - - - - - 3RF23 50-3AA44 1 unit 0.400
Zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 48 V to 600 V, blocking voltage 1600 V
10.5 - - 4.2 3RF23 10-1AA@6 3RF23 10-2AA@6 3RF23 10-3AA@6 1 unit 0.136
20 - - 8 3RF23 20-1AA@6 3RF23 20-2AA@6 3RF23 20-3AA@6 1 unit 0.204
30 - - 12 3RF23 30-1AA@6 - 3RF23 30-3AA@6 1 unit 0.354
40 - - 16 3RF23 40-1AA@6 - 3RF23 40-3AA@6 1 unit 0.496
50 - - 20 3RF23 50-1AA@6 - 3RF23 50-3AA@6 1 unit 0.496
70 - - 28 - - 3RF23 70-3AA@6 1 unit 0.944
Order No. extension for
rated control supply voltage Us 0 0 0
DC 24 V acc. to EN 61131-2 2 2 2
AC 110 V ... 230 V
1) The type current provides information about the performance of the semi-
Other rated control supply voltages on request. conductor contactor. The actual permitted operational current Ie can be
smaller depending on the connection method and start-up conditions.
Derating acc. to curves from page 7/45, 7/46, 7/47.
2) 110 ... 230 AC control voltage.

8/12 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category: SIRIUS SC
Solid-State Switching Devices

Solid-State Contactors
SIRIUS SC semiconductor contactors – single phase selection

Type Maximum achiev- Screw connection Spring-loaded connec- Ring cable connection Std. Weight per
current able power for tion Pack pack approx.
1)
Imax and Ue = Qty
Imax. 115 V 230 V 400 V
A kW kW kW Order No. Order No. Order No. kg
Instantaneous switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 24 V to 230 V
10.5 1.2 2.4 - 3RF23 10-1BA@2 - - 1 unit 0.136
20 2.3 4.6 - 3RF23 20-1BA@2 - - 1 unit 0.204
30 3.5 6.9 - 3RF23 30-1BA@2 - - 1 unit 0.354
40 4.6 9.2 - 3RF23 40-1BA@2 - - 1 unit 0.496
50 6 12 - 3RF23 50-1BA@2 - - 1 unit 0.496
70 8 16 - 3RF23 70-1BA@2 - 3RF23 70-3BA@2 1 unit 0.944
88 10 20 - 3RF23 90-1BA@2 - - 1 unit 2.600
Instantaneous switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 48 V to 460 V
10.5 - 2.4 4.2 3RF23 10-1BA@4 - - 1 unit 0.136
20 - 4.6 8 3RF23 20-1BA@4 - - 1 unit 0.204
30 - 6.9 12 3RF23 30-1BA@4 - - 1 unit 0.354
40 - 9.2 16 3RF23 40-1BA@4 - - 1 unit 0.496
50 - 12 20 3RF23 50-1BA@4 - - 1 unit 0.496
70 - 16 28 3RF23 70-1BA@4 - 3RF23 70-3BA@4 1 unit 0.944
88 - 20 35 3RF23 90-1BA@4 - - 1 unit 2.600
Zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 48 V to 600 V, control 110 V to 230 V
30 - - - 3RF23 30-1AA25 - - 1 unit 0.400
Instantaneous switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 48 V to 600 V, blocking voltage 1600 V
10.5 - - 4.2 3RF23 10-1BA@6 - - 1 unit 0.136
20 - - 8 3RF23 20-1BA@6 - - 1 unit 0.204
30 - - 12 3RF23 30-1BA@6 - - 1 unit 0.354
40 - - 16 3RF23 40-1BA@6 - - 1 unit 0.496
50 - - 20 3RF23 50-1BA@6 - - 1 unit 0.496
70 - - 28 3RF23 70-1BA@6 - 3RF23 70-3BA@6 1 unit 0.944
88 - - 35 3RF23 90-1BA@6 - - 1 unit 2.600
Low noise, zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 24 V to 230 V
20 2.3 4.6 - 3RF23 20-1CA@2 3RF23 20-2CA@2 - 1 unit 0.204
30 - - - 3RF23 30-1CA02 - - 1 unit 0.204
Low noise, zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 48 V to 460 V
20 - 4.6 8 3RF23 20-1CA@4 3RF23 20-2CA@4 - 1 unit 0.204
Instantaneous switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 48 V to 460 V,
control DC 4 ... 30 V switching
20 - - - 3RF23 20-1BA44 - - 1 unit 0.240
30 - - - 3RF23 30-1BA44 - - 1 unit 0.400
50 - - - 3RF23 50-1BA44 - - 1 unit 0.550
Short-circuit resistant with B-automatic device, zero-point switching,
rated operational voltage Ue = 24 V to 230 V
20 2.3 4.6 - 3RF23 20-1DA@2 3RF23 20-2DA22 3RF23 20-3DA@2 1 unit 0.204
Short-circuit resistant with B-automatic device, zero-point switching,
rated operational voltage Ue = 48 V to 460 V
20 - 4.6 8 3RF23 20-1DA@4 3RF23 20-2DA24 3RF23 20-3DA@4 1 unit 0.204
20 - - - 3RF23 20-1DA44 2) - - 1 unit 0.204
30 - - - 3RF23 30-1DA44 2) - - 1 unit 0.204
Low noise, zero-point switching, rated operational voltage Ue = 48 V to 460 V,

8
control 4 V to 30 V DC
70 - - 28 3RF21 70-1CA04 - - 1 unit 0.240

& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
20 - - - 3RF23 20-1CA44 - - 1 unit 0.240
Order No. extension for
rated control supply voltage Us
DC 24 V acc. to EN 61131-2 0 0 0
AC 110 V ... 230 V 2 2 2
1) The type current provides information about the performance of the semi- Other rated control supply voltages on request.
conductor contactor. The actual permitted operational current Ie can be
smaller depending on the connection method and start-up conditions. 2) 4...30 DC control voltage
Derating acc. to curves from page 7/45, 7/46, 7/47.

Version Order No. Std. Weight per


Pack pack approx.
Qty
kg
Accessories
Terminal cover for 3RF21 semiconductor relays and 3RF23 semiconductor contactors 3RF29 00-3PA88 10 units 0.010
with ring terminal end (after simple adaptation, this terminal cover can also be used for
screw connection).

3RF29 00-3PA88

Product Category: SIRIUS SC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 8/13
Solid-State Switching Devices

Solid-State Contactors
3RF24 solid-state contactors, 3-phase

Selection and ordering data


Type current1) Rated control DT Screw terminals Std. Weight
Imax supply voltage Us Pack per pack
Qty approx.
Order No. List
A V Price $ kg
per PU
Zero-point switching
Rated operational voltage Ue 48 V ... 600 V
Two-phase controlled
10.5 4 ... 30 DC A 3RF24 10-1AB45 1 unit 0.320
20 B 3RF24 20-1AB45 1 unit 0.400
30 B 3RF24 30-1AB45 1 unit 0.540
40 B 3RF24 40-1AB45 1 unit 0.800
50 B 3RF24 50-1AB45 1 unit 1.100
10.5 110 AC A 3RF24 10-1AB35 1 unit 0.320
20 B 3RF24 20-1AB35 1 unit 0.400
30 B 3RF24 30-1AB35 1 unit 0.540
40 B 3RF24 40-1AB35 1 unit 0.800
50 B 3RF24 50-1AB35 1 unit 1.100
3RF24 20-1AB45
10.5 230 AC B 3RF24 10-1AB55 1 unit 0.320
20 B 3RF24 20-1AB55 1 unit 0.400
30 B 3RF24 30-1AB55 1 unit 0.540
40 B 3RF24 40-1AB55 1 unit 0.800
50 B 3RF24 50-1AB55 1 unit 1.100
Three-phase controlled
10.5 4 ... 30 DC B 3RF24 10-1AC45 1 unit 0.320
20 B 3RF24 20-1AC45 1 unit 0.540
30 A 3RF24 30-1AC45 1 unit 0.800
40 B 3RF24 40-1AC45 1 unit 1.100
50 B 3RF24 50-1AC45 1 unit 1.850
10.5 110 AC B 3RF24 10-1AC35 1 unit 0.320
20 B 3RF24 20-1AC35 1 unit 0.540
30 A 3RF24 30-1AC35 1 unit 0.800
40 B 3RF24 40-1AC35 1 unit 1.100
50 B 3RF24 50-1AC35 1 unit 1.850
3RF24 10-1AC45
10.5 230 AC B 3RF24 10-1AC55 1 unit 0.320
20 B 3RF24 20-1AC55 1 unit 0.540
30 B 3RF24 30-1AC55 1 unit 0.800
40 B 3RF24 40-1AC55 1 unit 1.100
50 B 3RF24 50-1AC55 1 unit 1.850

Spring-loaded
terminals

Zero-point switching · Integrated heat sink,


rated operational voltage Ue 48 ... 600 V AC
Two-phase controlled
10 4 ... 30 DC 5 3RF2410-2AB45 1 unit
20 5 3RF2420-2AB45 1 unit
8

10 230 AC 5 3RF2410-2AB55 1 unit


20 5 3RF2420-2AB55 1 unit
Three-phase controlled
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors

10 4 ... 30 DC 5 3RF2410-2AC45 1 unit


20 5 3RF2420-2AC45 1 unit
10 230 AC 5 3RF2410-2AC55 1 unit
3RF2410-2AB45 20 5 3RF2420-2AC55 1 unit

Ring terminal lug


connection

Zero-point switching · Integrated heat sink,


rated operational voltage Ue 48 ... 600 V AC
Two-phase controlled
50 4 ... 30 DC 5 3RF2450-3AB45 1 unit
50 230 AC 5 3RF2450-3AB55 1 unit
Three-phase controlled
50 4 ... 30 DC 5 3RF2450-3AC45 1 unit
50 230 AC 5 3RF2450-3AC55 1 unit
1)
The type current provides information about the performance of the solid- For accessories, see page 6/144.
state contactor. The actual permitted rated operational current Ie can be
smaller depending on the connection method and installation conditions.
For derating characteristic curves, see page 6/120, "More information".

8/14 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Solid-State Switching Devices

Solid-State Contactors for Switching Motors


General data

Overview
Selecting solid-state contactors
The solid-state contactors are selected on the basis of details of
the network, the load and the ambient conditions.
The following procedure is recommended:
• Determine the rated current of the load and the mains volt-
age
• Select a solid-state contactor with the same or higher rated
current than the load
• Testing the maximum permissible switching frequency
based on the characteristic curves (see “Technical Informa-
tion”). To do this, the starting current, the starting time and
the motor loaded in the operating phase must be known.
• If the permissible switching frequency is under the desired
frequency, it is possible to achieve an increase only by
overdimensioning the motor and the solid-state contactor!
Solid-state contactor for direct-on-line starting
The solid-state contactors for switching motors are intended for Benefits
frequently switching on and off three-phase current operating
mechanisms up to 7.5 kW and reversing up to 3.0 kW. The • Units with integrated heat sink, “ready to use”
devices are constructed with complete insulation and can be • Compact and space-saving design
mounted directly on SIRIUS motor starter protectors, overload • Reversing contactors with integrated interlocking
relays and current monitoring relays, resulting in a very simple
integration into motor feeders.
Application
These three-phase solid-state contactors are equipped with a
two-phase control which is particularly suitable for typical motor Use in load feeders
current circuits without connecting to the neutral conductor. There is no typical design of a load feeder with solid-state relays
Important features: or solid-state contactors; instead, the great variety of connec-
• Insulated enclosure with integrated heat sink tion methods and control voltages offers universal application
opportunities. SIRIUS solid-state relays and solid-state contac-
• Integrated mounting foot to snap on a standard mounting
tors can be installed in fuseless or fused feeders, as required.
rail or for assembly onto a support plate
• Variety of connection methods Standards and approvals
• Plug-in control connection • IEC 60947-4-2
• Display via LEDs • UL 508, CSA for North America1)
• Wide voltage range for AC control supply voltage • CE marking for Europe
Switching functions • C-Tick approval for Australia

8
The solid-state contactors for switching motors are “”instan- • CCC approval for China
taneous switching” because this method is particularly suited

& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
1) Please note: Use overvoltage protection device; max. cut-off-voltage 6000 V; min. energy
for inductive loads. By distributing the ON point over the entire handling capability 100 J.
sine curve of the mains voltage, disturbances are reduced to a
minimum

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 8/15


Solid-State Switching Devices for Switching Motors
Solid-State Switching Devices

Solid-StateContactors
Solid-State Contactors for Switching Motors
3RF34 solid-state contactors, 3-phase
3RF34 solid-state contactors, three-phase

Selection and ordering data


Motor contactors · Instantaneous switching · Two-phase controlled
Rated Rated HP at supply voltage Rated DT Screw terminals Std.
operational control supply Pack
current Ie voltage Us Qty
Single Phase Three Phase Configurator

200/ 230/ 200/ 230/ 460/ 575/ Order No.


A 115V 208V 240V 208V 240V 480V 600V V
Rated operational voltage Ue
48 ... 480 V AC
5.2 1/10 1/4 1/4 1/2 3/4 2 2 24 DC acc. to A 3RF34 05-1BB04 1 unit
9.2 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1/2 2 3 5 IEC 61131-2 B 3RF34 10-1BB04 1 unit
12.5 1/3 1/2 3/4 2 2 3 5 B 3RF34 12-1BB04 1 unit
16 1/3 3/4 1 2 2 5 7 B 3RF34 16-1BB04 1 unit
5.2 1/10 1/4 1/4 1/2 3/4 2 2 110 ... 230 AC B 3RF34 05-1BB24 1 unit
9.2 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1/2 2 3 5 B 3RF34 10-1BB24 1 unit
12.5 1/3 1/2 3/4 2 2 3 5 B 3RF34 12-1BB24 1 unit
16 1/3 3/4 1 2 2 5 7 B 3RF34 16-1BB24 1 unit
3RF34 05-1BB
Rated operational voltage Ue
48 ... 600 V AC, blocking voltage 1600 V
5.2 1/10 1/4 1/4 1/2 3/4 2 2 24 DC acc. to B 3RF34 05-1BB06 1 unit
9.2 IEC 61131-2 B 3RF34 10-1BB06 1 unit
6

1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1/2 2 3 5


12.5 1/3 1/2 3/4 2 2 3 5 B 3RF34 12-1BB06 1 unit
16 1/3 3/4 1 2 2 5 7 B 3RF34 16-1BB06 1 unit
5.2 1/10 1/4 1/4 1/2 3/4 2 2 110 ... 230 AC B 3RF34 05-1BB26 1 unit
9.2 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1/2 2 3 5 B 3RF34 10-1BB26 1 unit
12.5 1/3 1/2 3/4 2 2 3 5 B 3RF34 12-1BB26 1 unit
16 1/3 3/4 1 2 2 5 7 B 3RF34 16-1BB26 1 unit

3RF34 10-1BB

Rated Rated HP at supply voltage Rated DT Spring-type terminals Std.


operational control supply Pack
current Ie voltage Us
Single Phase Three Phase Configurator Qty

200/ 230/ 200/ 230/ 460/ 575/ Order No.


A 115V 208V 240V 208V 240V 480V 600V V
Rated operational voltage Ue
48 ... 480 V AC
5.2 1/10 1/4 1/4 1/2 3/4 2 2 24 DC acc. to B 3RF34 05-2BB04 1 unit
9.2 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1/2 2 3 5 IEC 61131-2 B 3RF34 10-2BB04 1 unit
12.5 1/3 1/2 3/4 2 2 3 5 B 3RF34 12-2BB04 1 unit
16 1/3 3/4 1 2 2 5 7 B 3RF34 16-2BB04 1 unit
5.2 1/10 1/4 1/4 1/2 3/4 2 2 110 ... 230 AC B 3RF34 05-2BB24 1 unit
9.2 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1/2 2 3 5 B 3RF34 10-2BB24 1 unit
8

12.5 1/3 1/2 3/4 2 2 3 5 B 3RF34 12-2BB24 1 unit


16 1/3 3/4 1 2 2 5 7 B 3RF34 16-2BB24 1 unit
3RF34 05-2BB
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors

Rated operational voltage Ue


48 ... 600 V AC, blocking voltage 1600 V
5.2 1/10 1/4 1/4 1/2 3/4 2 2 24 DC acc. to B 3RF34 05-2BB06 1 unit
9.2 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1/2 2 3 5 IEC 61131-2 B 3RF34 10-2BB06 1 unit
12.5 1/3 1/2 3/4 2 2 3 5 B 3RF34 12-2BB06 1 unit
16 1/3 3/4 1 2 2 5 7 B 3RF34 16-2BB06 1 unit
5.2 1/10 1/4 1/4 1/2 3/4 2 2 110 ... 230 AC B 3RF34 05-2BB26 1 unit
9.2 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1/2 2 3 5 B 3RF34 10-2BB26 1 unit
12.5 1/3 1/2 3/4 2 2 3 5 B 3RF34 12-2BB26 1 unit
16 1/3 3/4 1 2 2 5 7 B 3RF34 16-2BB26 1 unit

3RF34 10-2BB
For online configurator see www.siemens.com/sirius/configurators.

8/16 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Solid-State Switching Devices for SwitchingMotors
Solid-State Switching Devices

Solid-StateContactors
Solid-State Contactors for Switching Motors
3RF34 solid-state reversing contactors,
3RF34 solid-state – reversing contactors, 3-phase
three-phase

Selection and ordering data


Reversing contactors · Instantaneous switching · Two-phase controlled
Rated Rated HP at supply voltage Rated DT Screw terminals Std.
operational control supply Pack
current Ie voltage Us Qty
Single Phase Three Phase Configurator

200/ 230/ 200/ 230/ 460/ 575/ Order No.


A 115V 208V 240V 208V 240V 480V 600V V
Rated operational voltage Ue 48 ... 480 V AC
3.8 1/10 1/4 1/4 1/2 3/4 2 2 24 DC acc. to B 3RF34 03-1BD04 1 unit
5.4 1/6 1/3 1/3 1 1 3 5 IEC 61131-2 B 3RF34 05-1BD04 1 unit
7.4 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1/2 2 3 5 B 3RF34 10-1BD04 1 unit

3RF34 03-1BD
3.8 1/10 1/4 1/4 1/2 3/4 2 2 110 ... 230 AC B 3RF34 03-1BD24 1 unit
5.4 1/6 1/3 1/3 1 1 3 5 B 3RF34 05-1BD24 1 unit
7.4 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1/2 2 3 5 B 3RF34 10-1BD24 1 unit
6

3RF34 10-1BD
For online configurator see www.siemens.com/sirius/configurators.

Accessories

Version DT Order No. Price Std.


per PU Pack
Qty

Link modules for solid-state contactor to motor starter protector


Link module Screw terminals
between solid-state reversing contactor and motor starter
protector with screw terminals
For 3RV2 motor starter protectors size S00/S0 A 3RA29 21-1BA00 1 unit

3RA29 21-1BA00

8
Link adapters for solid-state contactor to overload relay
Link adapters

& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
for direct mounting of 3RB3 overload relays or 3RR2 current
monitoring relays to the solid-state contactor with screw
terminals
3RF39 00-0QA88
The adapter is snapped onto the enclosure of the 3RF34 con- A 3RF39 00-0QA88 1 unit
tactor and receives the fixing hooks of the 3RB3 overload
relays or the 3RR2 current monitoring relays for direct
mounting.
Blank labels
Unit labeling plates1)
for SIRIUS devices
20 mm × 7 mm, pastel turquoise D 3RT19 00-1SB20 340 units
NSB0_01429b

3SB19 00-1SB20
1) PC labeling system for individual inscription
of unit labeling plates available from:
murrplastik Systemtechnik GmbH

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 8/17

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.


Solid-State Switching Devices

3RF29 Function Modules


Selection Tables

Overview
Function modules for SIRIUS 3RF2 solid-state switching devices
A great variety of applications demand an expanded range of The following function modules are available:
functionality. With our function modules, these requirements can • Converters
be met really easily. The modules are mounted simply by click- • Load monitoring
ing them into place; straight away the necessary connections • Heating current monitoring
are made with the solid-state relay or contactor. The plug-in con- • Power controllers
nection to control the solid-state switching devices can simply • Power regulators
remain in use.
With the exception of the converter, the function modules can be
used only with single-phase solid-state switching devices.
Recommended assignment of the function modules to the 3RF21 single-phase solid-state relays
Order No. Accessories
Converters Load monitoring Heating current Power controllers1) Power regulators1)
Basic Extended monitoring
Type current = 20 A
3RF21 20-1A.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 20-0GA13 -- 3RF29 20-0KA13 3RF29 20-0HA13
3RF21 20-1A.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 20-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16
3RF21 20-1A.22 -- -- 3RF29 20-0GA33 -- -- --
3RF21 20-1A.24 -- -- 3RF29 20-0GA36 -- -- --
3RF21 20-1A.42 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 20-0GA13 -- 3RF29 20-0KA13 3RF29 20-0HA13
3RF21 20-1A.45 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 20-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16
3RF21 20-1B.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 20-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16
3RF21 20-2A.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- -- -- -- --
3RF21 20-2A.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- -- -- -- --
3RF21 20-2A.22 -- -- -- -- -- --
3RF21 20-2A.24 -- -- -- -- -- --
3RF21 20-2A.42 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- -- -- -- --
3RF21 20-2A.45 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- -- -- -- --
3RF21 20-3A.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 20-0GA13 -- -- 3RF29 20-0HA13
3RF21 20-3A.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 20-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16
3RF21 20-3A.22 -- -- 3RF29 20-0GA33 -- 3RF29 20-0KA13 3RF29 20-0HA13
3RF21 20-3A.24 -- -- 3RF29 20-0GA36 -- 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16
Type current = 30 A
3RF21 30-1A.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 50-0GA13 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA13
3RF21 30-1A.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 50-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF21 30-1A.06 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 50-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF21 30-1A.22 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA33 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA33
3RF21 30-1A.24 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36
3RF21 30-1A.26 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36
3RF21 30-1A.42 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 50-0GA13 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA13
3RF21 30-1A.45 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 50-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF21 30-1B.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 50-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
Type current = 50 A
3RF21 50-1A.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 50-0GA13 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA13
3RF21 50-1A.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 50-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
8

3RF21 50-1A.06 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 50-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF21 50-1A.22 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA33 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA33
3RF21 50-1A.24
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors

-- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36


3RF21 50-1A.26 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36
3RF21 50-1A.45 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 50-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF21 50-1B.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 50-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF21 50-1B.06 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 50-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF21 50-1B.22 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA33 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA33
3RF21 50-2A.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- -- -- -- --
3RF21 50-2A.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- -- -- -- --
3RF21 50-2A.06 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- -- -- -- --
3RF21 50-2A.14 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- -- -- -- --
3RF21 50-2A.22 -- -- -- -- -- --
3RF21 50-2A.24 -- -- -- -- -- --
3RF21 50-2A.26 -- -- -- -- -- --
3RF21 50-3A.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA13 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA13
3RF21 50-3A.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF21 50-3A.06 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF21 50-3A.22 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA33 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA33
3RF21 50-3A.24 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36
3RF21 50-3A.26 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36
1) The use of power controllers/regulators is also possible on zero-point
switching versions for full-wave control mode. The generalized phase con-
trol mode is recommended only for the combination with instantaneous
switching versions.

8/18 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Solid-State Switching Devices

3RF29 Function Modules


Selection Tables

Order No. Accessories


Converters Load monitoring Heating current Power controllers1) Power regulators1)
Basic Extended monitoring
Type current = 70 A
3RF21 70-1A.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 50-0GA13 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA13
3RF21 70-1A.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 50-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF21 70-1A.05 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 50-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF21 70-1A.06 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 50-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF21 70-1A.22 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA33 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA33
3RF21 70-1A.24 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36
3RF21 70-1A.26 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36
3RF21 70-1A.45 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 50-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF21 70-1B.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 50-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF21 70-1C.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 50-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
Type current = 90 A
3RF21 90-1A.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 50-0GA13 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA13
3RF21 90-1A.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 50-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF21 90-1A.06 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 50-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF21 90-1A.22 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA33 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA33
3RF21 90-1A.24 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36
3RF21 90-1A.26 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36
3RF21 90-1A.45 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 50-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF21 90-1B.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 50-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF21 90-2A.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- -- -- -- --
3RF21 90-2A.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- -- -- -- --
3RF21 90-2A.06 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- -- -- -- --
3RF21 90-2A.22 -- -- -- -- -- --
3RF21 90-2A.24 -- -- -- -- -- --
3RF21 90-2A.26 -- -- -- -- -- --
3RF21 90-3A.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 90-0GA13 -- -- 3RF29 90-0HA13
3RF21 90-3A.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 90-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 90-0KA16 3RF29 90-0HA16
3RF21 90-3A.06 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 90-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 90-0KA16 3RF29 90-0HA16
3RF21 90-3A.22 -- -- 3RF29 90-0GA33 -- -- 3RF29 90-0HA33
3RF21 90-3A.24 -- -- 3RF29 90-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 90-0HA36
3RF21 90-3A.26 -- -- 3RF29 90-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 90-0HA36
3RF21 90-3A.44 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 90-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 90-0KA16 3RF29 90-0HA16
1) The use of power controllers/regulators is also possible on zero-point
switching versions for full-wave control mode. The generalized phase con-
trol mode is recommended only for the combination with instantaneous
switching versions.

Recommended assignment of the function modules to the 3RF22 three-phase solid-state relays
Order No. Accessories
Converters Load monitoring Heating current Power controllers Power regulators
Basic Extended monitoring
Type current up to 55 A
3RF22 ..-1A... 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- -- -- -- --

8
3RF22 ..-2A... 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- -- -- -- --
3RF22 ..-3A... 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- -- -- -- --

& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
Recommended assignment of the function modules to the 3RF23 single-phase solid-state contactors
Order No. Accessories
Converters Load monitoring Heating current Power controllers1) Power regulators1)
Basic Extended monitoring
Type current Ie = 10.5 A
3RF23 10-1A.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 20-0GA13 3RF29 16-0JA13 3RF29 20-0KA13 3RF29 20-0HA13
3RF23 10-1A.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 20-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16
3RF23 10-1A.06 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 20-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16
3RF23 10-1A.12 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 20-0GA13 3RF29 16-0JA13 3RF29 20-0KA13 3RF29 20-0HA13
3RF23 10-1A.14 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 20-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16
3RF23 10-1A.22 -- -- 3RF29 20-0GA33 -- -- 3RF29 20-0HA33
3RF23 10-1A.24 -- -- 3RF29 20-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 20-0HA36
3RF23 10-1A.26 -- -- 3RF29 20-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 20-0HA36
3RF23 10-1A.44 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 20-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16
3RF23 10-1A.45 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 20-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 8/19


Solid-State Switching Devices

3RF29 Function Modules


Selection Tables

Order No. Accessories


Converters Load monitoring Heating current Power controllers1) Power regulators1)
Basic Extended monitoring
Type current Ie = 10.5 A
3RF23 10-1B.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 20-0GA13 3RF29 16-0JA13 3RF29 20-0KA13 3RF29 20-0HA13
3RF23 10-1B.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 20-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16
3RF23 10-1B.06 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 20-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16
3RF23 10-1B.22 -- -- 3RF29 20-0GA33 -- -- 3RF29 20-0HA33
3RF23 10-1B.24 -- -- 3RF29 20-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 20-0HA36
3RF23 10-1B.26 -- -- 3RF29 20-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 20-0HA36
3RF23 10-2A.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- -- -- -- --
3RF23 10-2A.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- -- -- -- --
3RF23 10-2A.06 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- -- -- -- --
3RF23 10-2A.22 -- -- -- -- -- --
3RF23 10-2A.24 -- -- -- -- -- --
3RF23 10-2A.26 -- -- -- -- -- --
3RF23 10-3A.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 20-0GA13 3RF29 16-0JA13 3RF29 20-0KA13 3RF29 20-0HA13
3RF23 10-3A.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 20-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16
3RF23 10-3A.06 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 20-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16
3RF23 10-3A.22 -- -- 3RF29 20-0GA33 -- -- 3RF29 20-0HA33
3RF23 10-3A.24 -- -- 3RF29 20-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 20-0HA36
3RF23 10-3A.26 -- -- 3RF29 20-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 20-0HA36
Type current Ie = 20 A
3RF23 20-1A.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 20-0GA13 -- 3RF29 20-0KA13 3RF29 20-0HA13
3RF23 20-1A.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 20-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16
3RF23 20-1A.06 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 20-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16
3RF23 20-1A.14 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 20-0GA16 -- 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16
3RF23 20-1A.22 -- -- 3RF29 20-0GA33 -- -- 3RF29 20-0HA33
3RF23 20-1A.24 -- -- 3RF29 20-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 20-0HA36
3RF23 20-1A.26 -- -- 3RF29 20-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 20-0HA36
3RF23 20-1A.44 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 20-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16
3RF23 20-1A.45 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 20-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16
3RF23 20-1B.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 20-0GA13 -- 3RF29 20-0KA13 3RF29 20-0HA13
3RF23 20-1B.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 20-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16
3RF23 20-1B.06 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 20-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16
3RF23 20-1B.22 -- -- 3RF29 20-0GA33 -- -- 3RF29 20-0HA33
3RF23 20-1B.24 -- -- 3RF29 20-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 20-0HA36
3RF23 20-1B.26 -- -- 3RF29 20-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 20-0HA36
3RF23 20-1B.44 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 20-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16
3RF23 20-1C.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 20-0GA13 -- 3RF29 20-0KA13 3RF29 20-0HA13
3RF23 20-1C.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 20-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16
3RF23 20-1C.22 -- -- 3RF29 20-0GA33 -- -- 3RF29 20-0HA33
3RF23 20-1C.24 -- -- 3RF29 20-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 20-0HA36
3RF23 20-1C.44 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 20-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16
3RF23 20-1D.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 20-0GA13 -- 3RF29 20-0KA13 3RF29 20-0HA13
3RF23 20-1D.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 20-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16
3RF23 20-1D.22 -- -- 3RF29 20-0GA33 -- -- 3RF29 20-0HA33
3RF23 20-1D.24 -- -- 3RF29 20-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 20-0HA36
3RF23 20-1D.44
8

3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 20-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16
3RF23 20-2A.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- -- -- -- --
3RF23 20-2A.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- -- -- -- --
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors

3RF23 20-2A.06 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- -- -- -- --


3RF23 20-2A.22 -- -- -- -- -- --
3RF23 20-2A.24 -- -- -- -- -- --
3RF23 20-2A.26 -- -- -- -- -- --
3RF23 20-2C.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- -- -- -- --
3RF23 20-2C.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- -- -- -- --
3RF23 20-2C.22 -- -- -- -- -- --
3RF23 20-2C.24 -- -- -- -- -- --
3RF23 20-2D.22 -- -- -- -- -- --
3RF23 20-2D.24 -- -- -- -- -- --
3RF23 20-3A.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 20-0GA13 -- 3RF29 20-0KA13 3RF29 20-0HA13
3RF23 20-3A.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 20-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16
3RF23 20-3A.06 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 20-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16
3RF23 20-3A.22 -- -- 3RF29 20-0GA33 -- -- 3RF29 20-0HA33
3RF23 20-3A.24 -- -- 3RF29 20-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 20-0HA36
3RF23 20-3A.26 -- -- 3RF29 20-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 20-0HA36
3RF23 20-3A.44 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 20-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16
1) The use of power controllers/regulators is also possible on zero-point
switching versions for full-wave control mode. The generalized phase con-
trol mode is recommended only for the combination with instantaneous
switching versions.

8/20 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Solid-State Switching Devices

3RF29 Function Modules


Selection Tables

Order No. Accessories


Converters Load monitoring Heating current Power controllers1) Power regulators1)
Basic Extended monitoring
Type current Ie = 20 A
3RF23 20-3D.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 20-0GA13 -- 3RF29 20-0KA13 3RF29 20-0HA13
3RF23 20-3D.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 20-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 20-0KA16 3RF29 20-0HA16
3RF23 20-3D.22 -- -- 3RF29 20-0GA33 -- -- 3RF29 20-0HA33
3RF23 20-3D.24 -- -- 3RF29 20-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 20-0HA36
Type current Ie = 30 A
3RF23 30-1A.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 50-0GA13 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA13
3RF23 30-1A.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 50-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF23 30-1A.06 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 50-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF23 30-1A.14 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF23 30-1A.22 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA33 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA33
3RF23 30-1A.24 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36
3RF23 30-1A.25 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36
3RF23 30-1A.26 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36
3RF23 30-1A.44 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF23 30-1A.45 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF23 30-1B.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 50-0GA13 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA13
3RF23 30-1B.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 50-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF23 30-1B.06 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 50-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF23 30-1B.22 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA33 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA33
3RF23 30-1B.24 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36
3RF23 30-1B.26 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36
3RF23 30-1B.44 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF23 30-1C.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 20-0FA08 3RF29 50-0GA13 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA13
3RF23 30-1D.44 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF23 30-3A.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA13 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA13
3RF23 30-3A.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF23 30-3A.066 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF23 30-3A.22 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA33 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA33
3RF23 30-3A.24 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36
3RF23 30-3A.26 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36
3RF23 30-3A.44 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA16 3RF29 32-0JA16 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
Type current Ie = 40 A
3RF23 40-1A.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA13 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA13
3RF23 40-1A.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA16 -- 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF23 40-1A.06 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA16 -- 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF23 40-1A.14 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA16 -- 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF23 40-1A.22 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA33 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA33
3RF23 40-1A.24 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36
3RF23 40-1A.26 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36
3RF23 40-1A.45 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA16 -- 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF23 40-1B.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA13 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA13
3RF23 40-1B.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA13 -- 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF23 40-1B.06 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA13 -- 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF23 40-1B.22 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA33 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA33

8
3RF23 40-1B.24 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36
3RF23 40-1B.26 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36

& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
3RF23 40-3A.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA13 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA13
3RF23 40-3A.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA16 -- 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF23 40-3A.06 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA16 -- 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF23 40-3A.22 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA33 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA33
3RF23 40-3A.24 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36
3RF23 40-3A.26 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36
3RF23 40-3A.45 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA16 -- 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
Type current Ie = 50 A
3RF23 50-1A.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA13 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA13
3RF23 50-1A.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA16 -- 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF23 50-1A.06 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA16 -- 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF23 50-1A.14 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA16 -- 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF23 50-1A.22 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA33 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA33
3RF23 50-1A.24 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36
3RF23 50-1A.26 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36
3RF23 50-1A.45 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA16 -- 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
1) The use of power controllers/regulators is also possible on zero-point
switching versions for full-wave control mode. The generalized phase con-
trol mode is recommended only for the combination with instantaneous
switching versions.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 8/21


Solid-State Switching Devices

3RF29 Function Modules


Selection Tables

Order No. Accessories


Converters Load monitoring Heating current Power controllers1) Power regulators1)
Basic Extended monitoring
Type current Ie = 50 A
3RF23 50-1B.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA13 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA13
3RF23 50-1B.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA16 -- 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF23 50-1B.06 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA16 -- 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF23 50-1B.22 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA33 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA33
3RF23 50-1B.24 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36
3RF23 50-1B.26 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36
3RF23 50-1B.44 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA16 -- 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF23 50-3A.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA13 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA13
3RF23 50-3A.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA16 -- 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF23 50-3A.06 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA16 -- 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF23 50-3A.22 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA33 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA33
3RF23 50-3A.24 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36
3RF23 50-3A.26 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36
3RF23 50-3A.44 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA16 -- 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
Type current Ie = 70 A
3RF23 70-1B.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA13 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA13
3RF23 70-1B.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA16 -- 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF23 70-1B.06 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA16 -- 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF23 70-1B.22 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA33 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA33
3RF23 70-1B.24 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36
3RF23 70-1B.26 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36
3RF23 70-3A.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 90-0GA13 -- 3RF29 90-0HA13
3RF23 70-3A.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 90-0GA16 -- 3RF29 90-0KA16 3RF29 90-0HA16
3RF23 70-3A.06 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 90-0GA16 -- 3RF29 90-0KA16 3RF29 90-0HA16
3RF23 70-3A.22 -- -- 3RF29 90-0GA33 -- -- 3RF29 90-0HA33
3RF23 70-3A.24 -- -- 3RF29 90-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 90-0HA36
3RF23 70-3A.26 -- -- 3RF29 90-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 90-0HA36
3RF23 70-3A.45 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 90-0GA16 -- 3RF29 90-0KA16 3RF29 90-0HA16
3RF23 70-3B.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 90-0GA13 -- 3RF29 90-0HA13
3RF23 70-3B.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 90-0GA16 -- 3RF29 90-0KA16 3RF29 90-0HA16
3RF23 70-3B.06 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 90-0GA16 -- 3RF29 90-0KA16 3RF29 90-0HA16
3RF23 70-3B.22 -- -- 3RF29 90-0GA33 -- -- 3RF29 90-0HA33
3RF23 70-3B.24 -- -- 3RF29 90-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 90-0HA36
3RF23 70-3B.26 -- -- 3RF29 90-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 90-0HA36
Type current Ie = 90 A
3RF23 90-1B.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA13 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA13
3RF23 90-1B.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA16 -- 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF23 90-1B.06 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 50-0GA16 -- 3RF29 50-0KA16 3RF29 50-0HA16
3RF23 90-1B.22 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA33 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA33
3RF23 90-1B.24 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36
3RF23 90-1B.26 -- -- 3RF29 50-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 50-0HA36
3RF23 90-3A.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 90-0GA13 -- -- 3RF29 90-0HA13
3RF23 90-3A.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 90-0GA16 -- 3RF29 90-0KA16 3RF29 90-0HA16
3RF23 90-3A.06 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 90-0GA16 -- 3RF29 90-0KA16 3RF29 90-0HA16
3RF23 90-3A.22 -- -- 3RF29 90-0GA33 -- -- 3RF29 90-0HA33
8

3RF23 90-3A.24 -- -- 3RF29 90-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 90-0HA36


3RF23 90-3A.26 -- -- 3RF29 90-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 90-0HA36
3RF23 90-3A.45
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors

3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 90-0GA16 -- 3RF29 90-0KA16 3RF29 90-0HA16


3RF23 90-3B.02 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 90-0GA13 -- -- 3RF29 90-0HA13
3RF23 90-3B.04 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 90-0GA16 -- 3RF29 90-0KA16 3RF29 90-0HA16
3RF23 90-3B.06 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- 3RF29 90-0GA16 -- 3RF29 90-0KA16 3RF29 90-0HA16
3RF23 90-3B.22 -- -- 3RF29 90-0GA33 -- -- 3RF29 90-0HA33
3RF23 90-3B.24 -- -- 3RF29 90-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 90-0HA36
3RF23 90-3B.26 -- -- 3RF29 90-0GA36 -- -- 3RF29 90-0HA36
1) The use of power controllers/regulators is also possible on zero-point
switching versions for full-wave control mode. The generalized phase con-
trol mode is recommended only for the combination with instantaneous
switching versions.

Recommended assignment of the function modules to the 3RF24 three-phase solid-state contactors
Order No. Accessories
Converters Load monitoring Heating current Power controllers Power regulators
Basic Extended monitoring
Type current up to 50 A
3RF24 ..-1..4. 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- -- -- -- --
3RF24 ..-2..4. -- -- -- -- -- --
3RF24 ..-3..4. 3RF29 00-0EA18 -- -- -- -- --
3RF24 ..-...5. -- -- -- -- -- --

8/22 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Solid-State Switching Devices

Function Modules
Converters

Overview Design
Converter for SIRIUS SC semiconductor switching devices Mounting
This module is used to convert analog drive signals, such as Simply snapping onto the 3RF21 semiconductor relays or 3RF23
those output from many temperature controllers, for example, semiconductor contactors establishes the connections to the
into a pulse-width-modulated digital signal. The connected semiconductor switching devices. The connector on the semi-
semiconductor contactors and relays can therefore regulate the conductor switching devices from the control circuit can be used
output of a load as a percentage. on the converter without rewiring.

Area of application Functions


The device is used for conversion from an analog input signal to The analog value from a temperature controller is present at the
an on/off ratio. The function module can only be used in conjunc- 0–10 V terminals. This controls the on-to-off period, as a function
tion with a 3RF21 semiconductor relay or a 3RF23 semiconduc- of voltage. The period duration is predefined at one second.
tor contactor. Conversion of the analog voltage is linear in the voltage range
from 0.1 to 9.9 V. At voltages below 0.1 V the connected switch-
ing device is not activated, while at voltages above 9.9 V the
connected switching device is always activated.

Technical specifications
Control input for converter and load monitoring

Type 3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 ..-0HA.

Analog input V 0 ... 10 0 ... 10


P er m i s s ible ra ng e V -1 ... 11 -1 ... 11
Input resistance kΩ 100 8
Period duration s 1 1

Selection and ordering data


Rated operational current Ie Rated operational voltage Ue Rated control supply Std. Weight
voltage Us Pack per pack
AC/DC 24 V Qty. approx.
A V Order No. kg

— — 3RF29 00-0EA18 1 unit 0.025

8
3RF29 00-0EA18

& Contactors
Solid-State Relays

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 8/23


Solid-State Switching Devices

Function Modules
Load monitoring

The "Teach" button can also be used to switch on the connected


Overview semiconductor switching device briefly for test purposes. In this
Load monitoring for SIRIUS SC semiconductor switching case the "ON" LED is switched on.
devices Partial load faults, "basic" load monitoring
With the addition of the load monitoring module many faults can If a decrease of at least 1/6 of the stored setpoint value is de-
be quickly detected by monitoring a load circuit connected to tected, a fault is signaled. The fault is indicated via a "Fault" LED
the semiconductor switching device. Examples include the fail- and by activation of the fault signaling output.
ure of load elements (up to 6 in the basic version or up to 12 in
the extended version), alloyed power semiconductors, a lack of OK Fault
voltage or a break in a load circuit. A fault is indicated by one or
Partial load failure/ Thyristor Mains failure/
more LEDs and reported to the controller via a PLC-compatible LEDs
load short-circuit defect fuse rupture
output.
ON/OFF -
The operating principle is based on monitoring of the current. Current
This figure is continuously compared with the reference value flowing
-
stored once during commissioning by the simple press of a but-
Group fault -
ton. In order to detect the failure of one of several loads, the cur-
rent decrease must be 1/6 (in the basic version) or 1/12 (in the Function is available
extended version) of the reference value. In the event of a fault, - Function not available
a contact (NC) is actuated and one or more LEDs indicate the
fault. Partial load faults, "extended" load monitoring
Depending on the setting of the "response time" potentiometer,
Area of application a decrease of at least 1/12 of the stored setpoint value after a re-
sponse time of between 100 ms and 3 s is signaled as a fault.
The device is used for monitoring one or more loads (partial The fault is indicated via a "Load" LED and by activation of the
loads). The function module can only be used in conjunction with fault signaling output.
a 3RF21 semiconductor relay or a 3RF23 semiconductor contac-
tor. The devices with spring-loaded connections in the load cir- The potentiometer can also be used to determine the response
cuit are not suitable for use with load monitoring modules. behavior of the fault signaling output. When delay values are set
in the left-hand half, the fault signal is stored. This can only be
reset by switching on and off by means of the control supply volt-
Design age.
Mounting When settings are made on the right-hand side, the fault output
Simply snapping the load monitoring module onto the 3RF21 is automatically reset after the deviation has been corrected.
semiconductor relays or 3RF23 semiconductor contactors es- Voltage compensation, "extended" load monitoring
tablishes the control connections to the semiconductor switch-
ing devices. Because of the special design, the straight-through In addition to the current, the load voltage is also monitored. This
transformer of the load monitoring module covers the lower main makes it possible to compensate for influences on the current
power connection. The cable to the load is simply pushed strength resulting from voltage fluctuations.
through and secured with the terminal screw. Thyristor fault

Functions If a current greater than the residual current of the switching de-
vice is measured in the deenergized state, the device triggers a
The function module is activated when an "ON" signal is applied thyristor fault after the set time delay. This means that the fault
(IN terminal). The module constantly monitors the current level output is activated and the "Fault" ("Thyristor" 1)) LED lights up.
and compares this with the setpoint value.
Supply fault
Start-up If no current is measured in the energized state, the device trig-
Pressing the "Teach" button switches the device on; the current gers a supply fault after the set time delay. This means that the
8

through the semiconductor switching device is measured and is fault output is activated and the "Fault" ("Supply"1)) LED lights up.
stored as the setpoint. During this process the two lower (red1)) 1) "Extended" load monitoring
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors

LEDs flash alternately; simultaneous maintained light from the 3


(red1)) LEDs indicates the conclusion of the teaching process.

Selection and ordering data


Rated Rated opera- Rated control supply Rated control supply Std. Weight Rated control Std. Weight
opera- tional voltage Ue voltage Us voltage Us Pack per pack supply Pack per pack
tional cur- AC 110 V AC/DC 24 V Qty approx. voltage Us Qty approx.
rent Ie DC 24 V
A V Order No. Order No. kg Order No. kg
Basic load monitoring
6 - - - 3RF29 06-0FA081) 1 unit 0.050
20 - - - 3RF29 20-0FA08
Extended load monitoring
20 110 ... 230 3RF29 20-0GA33 3RF29 20-0GA13 1 unit 0.120 -
20 400 ... 600 3RF29 20-0GA36 3RF29 20-0GA16 1 unit 0.120 -
50 110 ... 230 3RF29 50-0GA33 3RF29 50-0GA13 1 unit 0.120 -
50 400 ... 600 3RF29 50-0GA36 3RF29 50-0GA16 1 unit 0.120 -
90 110 ... 230 3RF29 90-0GA33 3RF29 90-0GA13 1 unit 0.120 -
90 400 ... 600 3RF29 90-0GA36 3RF29 90-0GA16 1 unit 0.120 -
1) To order with mounted 3RF29 00-0RA88 cover, add -0KH0 to part number.

8/24 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog Product Category: SIRIUS SC
Solid-State Switching Devices

3RF29 Function Modules


Heating current monitoring

Special versions:
Overview deviations from the standard version
Heating current monitoring for 3RF2 single-phase solid- 3RF29 ..-0JA1.-1KK0
state switching devices
If the current is below 50 % of the lower teach current during the
Many faults can be quickly detected by monitoring a load circuit teach routine, the device will go into "Standby" mode; the LOAD
connected to the solid-state switching device, as made possible LED will flicker. The device thus detects a non-connected load,
with this module. Examples include the failure of up to 6 load el- e. g. channels not required for tool heaters, and does not signal
ements, alloyed power semiconductors, a lack of voltage or a a fault. This mode can be reset by re-teaching.
break in a load circuit. A fault is indicated by LEDs and reported
to the controller by way of a relay output (NC contact).
Application
The principle of operation is based on permanent monitoring of
the current strength. This figure is continuously compared with The device is used for monitoring one or more loads (partial
the reference value stored once during start-up. In order to de- loads). The function module can only be used in conjunction with
tect the failure of one of several loads, the current difference a 3RF21 solid-state relay or a 3RF23 solid-state contactor. The
must be 1/6 of the reference value. In the event of a fault, an out- devices with spring-loaded connections in the load circuit are
put is actuated and the LEDs indicate the fault. not suitable.
The heating current monitoring has a teach input and therefore
differs from the load monitoring. This remote teaching function
enables simple adjustment to changing loads without manual
intervention.

Selection and ordering data


Rated operational Rated operational Order No. Std. Weight
current Ie voltage Ue Pack per pack
Qty approx.
A V kg
Heating current monitoring1)
Rated control supply voltage 24 V AC/DC
16 110 … 230 3RF29 16-0JA13 1 unit 0.175
16 110 … 230 3RF29 16-0JA13-1KK0 1 unit 0.175
16 400 … 600 3RF29 16-0JA16-1KK0 1 unit 0.175
32 110 … 230 3RF29 32-0JA13-1KK0 1 unit 0.175
32 400 … 600 3RF29 32-0JA16 1 unit 0.175
32 400 … 600 3RF29 32-0JA16-1KK0 1 unit 0.175

1) Supplied without control connector. The control connector can be pur-


chased from Phoenix Contact by quoting Order No. 1982 790
(2.5 HC/6-ST-5.08).

Version Order No. Std. Weight


Pack per pack
Qty approx.
kg
Optional accessories

8
Sealable covers 3RF29 00-0RA88 10 units 0.001
for function modules (not for converters)

& Contactors
3RF29 00-0RA88 Solid-State Relays

* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 8/25


Solid-State Switching Devices

3RF29 Function Modules


Power controllers

Overview Application
Power controllers for 3RF2 single-phase solid-state switch- The power controller can be used for:
ing devices • Complex heating systems
The power controller is a function module for the autonomous • Inductive loads
power control of complex heating systems and inductive loads. • Loads with temperature-dependent resistor
The following functions have been integrated: • Loads with ageing after long-time service
• Power controller for adjusting the power of the connected load. • Simple indirect control of temperature
Here, the setpoint value is set with a rotary knob on the module
as a percentage with reference to the 100 % power stored as The power controller can be used on the instantaneously switch-
a setpoint value. ing 3RF21 and 3RF23 solid-state switching devices (single-
phase). If only the full-wave operating mode is used, the power
• Inrush current limitation: With the aid of an adjustable voltage controller can also be used on the "zero-point switching" solid-
ramp, the inrush current is limited by means of phase control. state relays and contactors.
This is useful above all with loads such as lamps or infrared
lamps which have an inrush transient current. Power control
• Load circuit monitoring for detecting load failure, partial load The power controller adjusts the power in the connected load by
faults, alloyed power semiconductors, lack of voltage or a means of a solid-state switching device depending on the set-
break in the load circuit. point selection. It does not compensate for changes in the mains
Special versions: voltage or load resistance. The setpoint value can be predefined
deviations from the standard version externally as a 0 to 10 V signal or internally by means of a poten-
tiometer. Depending on the setting of the potentiometer (tR), the
3RF29 04-0KA13-0KC0 control is carried out according to the principle of full-wave con-
trol or generalized phase control.
During the teaching process the connected solid-state relay or
contactor is not activated; i. e. no current flow takes place. No Full-wave control
current reference value is stored. No part-load monitoring!
In this operating mode the output is adjusted to the required set-
3RF29 ..-0KA1.-0KT0 point value changing the on-to-off period. The period duration is
No part-load monitoring! predefined at one second.
Generalized phase control
In this operating mode the output is adjusted to the required set-
point value by changing the current flow angle. In order to ob-
serve the limit values of the conducted interference voltage for
industrial networks, the load circuit must include a reactor with a
rating of at least 200 µH.

Selection and ordering data


Rated operational Rated operational Order No. Std. Weight
current Ie voltage Ue Pack per pack
Qty approx.
A V kg
Power controllers
Rated control supply voltage 24 V AC/DC
4 110 … 230 3RF29 04-0KA13-0KC0 1 unit 0.175
8

4 3RF29 04-0KA13-0KT0 1 unit 0.175


20 3RF29 20-0KA13 1 unit 0.175
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors

50 3RF29 50-0KA13 1 unit 0.175


90 3RF29 90-0KA13 1 unit 0.175
20 400 … 600 3RF29 20-0KA16 1 unit 0.175
50 3RF29 50-0KA16 1 unit 0.175
50 3RF29 50-0KA16-0KT0 1 unit 0.175
90 3RF29 90-0KA16 1 unit 0.175

Version Order No. Std. Weight


Pack per pack
Qty approx.
kg
Optional accessories
Sealable covers 3RF29 00-0RA88 10 units 0.001
for function modules (not for converters)

3RF29 00-0RA88

8/26 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Solid-State Switching Devices

Function Modules
Power control regulators

Overview Functions
Power controllers for SIRIUS SC semiconductor switching Start-up
devices
Pressing the "Teach" button switches the device on; the current
This module provides similar functionality to a power control reg- through the semiconductor switching device and the mains volt-
ulator. age are detected and stored. The resultant output is taken as the
100% output for the setpoint selection. During this process the
The following functions are integrated: two lower red LEDs flash alternately. Simultaneous maintained
Power control regulator with proportional-action control for ad- light from the three red LEDs indicates the completion of the
justing the power of the connected load. Here, the setpoint is set "Teach" process.
with a rotary knob on the module as a percentage with reference The "Teach" button can also be used to switch on the connected
to the 100% power stored as a setpoint. In this way the power is semiconductor switching device briefly for test purposes. In this
kept constant even in the event of voltage fluctuations or a case the "ON" LED is switched on.
change in load resistance.
Inrush current limitation: With the aid of an adjustable voltage Setpoint selection
ramp, the inrush current is limited by means of phase control. The setting on the setpoint potentiometer (P) determines how the
This is useful above all with loads such as lamps which have an setpoint selection is to be made:
inrush transient current.
External setpoint selection
Load circuit monitoring for detecting load failure, alloyed power
semiconductors, lack of voltage or a break in the load circuit. At 0 % the setpoint selection is set via an external 0 – 10 V analog
signal (terminals IN / 0 – 10 V). The device is switched on and off
via the power supply (terminals A1 / A2).
Area of application
Internal setpoint selection
The power controller adjusts the current in the connected load
by means of a semiconductor switching device depending on a Above 0 % the setpoint is set using the potentiometer. To allow
setpoint. This compensates for changes in the mains voltage or this, the potential at terminal A1 must additionally be applied at
in the load resistance. The setpoint can be predefined externally the IN terminal. After removal of the "ON" signal, the switching
as a 0 to 10 V signal or internally by means of a potentiometer. module is switched off.
Depending on the setting of the potentiometer (tR), the adjust- Inrush current limitation
ment is carried out according to the principle of full-wave control
or generalized phase control. The ramp time (tR) for a voltage ramp on switching on is set with
the potentiometer for the purpose of inrush current limitation. If a
Full-wave control time longer than 0 s is set, the device operates according to the
In this operating mode the output is adjusted to the required set- phase-angle principle. If 0 s is set, there is no voltage ramp and
point by changing the on-to-off period. The period duration is the device operates according to the principle of full-wave con-
predefined at one second. trol.

Generalized phase control Load fault

In this operating mode the output is adjusted to the required set- If upon switching on with voltage applied the current flowing is
point by changing the current flow angle. In order to observe the not greater than the residual current of the switching device, the
limit values of the conducted interference voltage for industrial device triggers a load fault. The fault relay is activated and the
power systems, a choke rated at at least 200 µH must be in- "Load" LED lights up.
cluded in the load circuit. Thyristor fault
If a current greater than the residual current of the switching de-
Design vice is measured in the deenergized state, the device triggers a
Mounting thyristor fault. The fault relay is activated and the "Thyristor" LED

8
lights up.
Easy snapping onto the 3RF21 semiconductor relays or 3RF23
semiconductor contactors establishes the connections to the Supply fault

& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
semiconductor switching devices. Because of the special de- If no current is measured in the energized state, the device trig-
sign, the straight-through transformer of the power controller gers a supply fault. The fault relay is activated and the "Supply"
module covers the lower main power connection. The cable to LED lights up.
the load is simply pushed through and secured with the terminal
screw.

Selection and ordering data


Rated operational current Rated operational voltage Ue Rated control sup- Rated control sup- Std. Weight
Ie ply voltage Us ply voltage Us Pack per pack
AC 110 V AC/DC 24 V Qty approx.
A V Order No. Order No. kg
Power controllers1)
20 110 ... 230 3RF29 20-0HA33 3RF29 20-0HA13 1 unit 0.120
20 400 ... 600 3RF29 20-0HA36 3RF29 20-0HA16 1 unit 0.120
50 110 ... 230 3RF29 50-0HA33 3RF29 50-0HA13 1 unit 0.120
50 400 ... 600 3RF29 50-0HA36 3RF29 50-0HA16 1 unit 0.120
90 110 ... 230 3RF29 90-0HA33 3RF29 90-0HA13 1 unit 0.120
90 400 ... 600 3RF29 90-0HA36 3RF29 90-0HA16 1 unit 0.120

1) Optional sealable cover - 3RF29 00-0RA88 can be used.

Product Category: SIRIUS SC Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 8/27
Solid-State Switching Devices

3RF29 Function Modules


Power control regulators

Overview Function
Power control regulators for SIRIUS solid-state switching Setpoint selection
devices
The setpoint is selected either internally using the right-hand
The power control regulator is a function module for the autono- potentiometer P with 0 ... 100 % on the module or externally
mous power control regulation of complex heating systems and through the analog input 0 ... 10 V.
inductive loads, for the operation of loads with temperature-
dependent resistors or long-term aging, and for simple indirect 100 % corresponds in full-wave control to permanently On and
temperature control. in generalized phase control to a conduction angle of 180° and
hence maximum power.
The power control regulator can be used on the 3RF21 and
3RF23 instantaneous switching solid-state switching devices When the setpoint is selected internally the module is controlled
(single-phase). If only the full-wave control mode is used, the through the IN terminal. The terminal 10 then has no function.
power control regulator can also be used on the zero-point-
switching solid-state relays and contactors.
180° 100

Application

Modulation
Conduction angle
%
The power control regulator sets the load current of the solid-
state switching device depending on a setpoint value as a
90° 50
percentage. Changes in the mains voltage or in the load resis-
tance are not compensated in this case. The modulation, the
On/off ratio or the phase angle, remains unchanged in accor-
dance with the setpoint. The autonomous power control regula-

NSB0_01693
tion is performed between 0 and 100 % of the setpoint value
0° 0
Full-wave control
< 0,1 5,0 V > 9,9
If the left potentiometer tR is set to 0 s (= far left), the power External setpoint of analog voltage 0 ... 10 V
control regulator works according to the principle of full-wave
control. The power set, be it internal or external, is converted into 0 50 % 100
a pulse-width-modulated digital signal. The power control regu- Internal setpoint of potentiometer P
lator controls the On and Off time of the solid-state switching
device within a fixed period duration of 1 s so that the specified Input characteristic curve
power is applied to the load. The "ON" LED flashes in the same
rhythm as the solid-state switching device switches on and off. When the setpoint is selected externally (potentiometer P set far
left = 0 %) the module is controlled by applying the analog
Generalized phase control voltage 0 ... 10 V. 0 ... 10 V corresponds to 0 ... 100 % power.
Conversion of the voltage is linear between 0.1 and 9.9 V. Below
If the left potentiometer tR is set to higher than 0 s, the power
0.1 V the switching device remains off; at voltages above 9.9 V
control regulator works according to the principle of generalized
the power is always set to 100 %.
phase control. With generalized phase control, a choke rated at
at least 200 µH must be included in the load circuit in order to Inrush current limitation
observe the limit values of the conducted interference voltage
for industrial networks. The ramp time (tR) for a voltage ramp on switching on is set with
the left potentiometer for the purpose of inrush current limitation.
The set time refers to a power of 100 %. If, for example, a ramp
Design time of 10 s is set and the selected power is 60 %, then a power
of 60 % is reached after approx. 6 s.
Mounting
Easy snapping onto the 3RF21 solid-state relays or 3RF23 solid- Line and thyristor monitoring
8

state contactors establishes the connections to the solid-state The power control regulator recognizes supply failures and
switching devices. Because of the special design, the straight- thyristor faults. The faults are indicated by the LEDs on the mod-
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors

through transformer of the function module covers the lower ule and the fault output is activated.
main power connection. The cable to the load is simply pushed
through and secured with the terminal screw.

8/28 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Solid-State Switching Devices

Solid-State Relays
3RF21 Solid-state relays – technical data

Overview
22.5 mm semiconductor relays
With its compact design, which stays the same even at currents
of up to 88 A, the 3RF21 semiconductor relay is the ultimate in
space-saving construction, at a width of 22.5 mm. The logical
connection arrangement, with the power infeed from above and
connection of the load from below, ensures clean installation in
the control cabinet.

Technical specifications
Type 3RF21 ..-1.... 3RF21 ..-2.... 3RF21 ..-3....
General data
Ambient temperature
during operation, derating from 40 °C °C -25 ... +60
when stored °C -55 ... +80
Site altitude m 0 ... 1000; derating from 1000
Shock resistance g/ms 15/11
acc. to IEC 60068-2-27
Vibration resistance g 2
acc. to IEC 60068-2-6
Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC)
Emitted interference
• Conducted interference voltage Class A for industrial applications
acc. to IEC 60947-4-3
• Emitted, high-frequency interference Class A for industrial applications
voltage acc. to IEC 60947-4-3
Noise immunity
• Electrostatic discharge kV Contact discharge 4; air discharge 8; behavior criterion 2
acc. to IEC 61000-4-2
(corresponds to degree of severity 3)
• Induced RF fields acc. to IEC 61000-4-6 MHz 0.15 ... 80; 140 dBµV; behavior criterion 1
• Burst acc. to IEC 61000-4-4 kV 2/5.0 kHz; behavior criterion 1
• Surge acc. to IEC 61000-4-5 kV Conductor - ground 2; conductor - conductor 1; behavior criterion 2
Connection technique Screw-type connection Spring-loaded connection Ring cable connection
Main contact connection
Conductor cross-section
Solid mm2 2 x (1.5 ... 2.5), 2 x (2.5 ... 6) 2 x (0,5 ... 2.5) -
Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 x (1.5 ... 2.5), 2 x (2.5 ... 6), 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5) -
1 x 10
Finely stranded without end sleeves mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 2.5) -
Solid or stranded AWG conductors AWG 2 x (14 ... 10) 2 x (18 ... 14) -
Insulation stripping length mm 10 10 -
Terminal screw M4 - M5
• Tightening torque Nm 2 ... 2.5 - 2 ... 2.5
lb.in 18 ... 22 - 18 ... 22
Cable lug
• DIN - - DIN 46234
-5-2.5, -5-6, -5-10, -5-16, -5-25

8
• JIS - - JIS C 2805 R 2-5, 5.5-5, 8-5, 14-5
Auxiliary/control contact connections
Conductor cross-section mm2 1x (0.5 ... 2.5); 2x (0.5 ... 1) 0.5 ... 1.5 1x (0.5 ... 2.5); 2x (0.5 ... 1)

& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
AWG 20 ... 12 20 ... 12 20 ... 12
Insulation stripping length mm 7 10 7
Terminal screw M3 - M3
• Tightening torque Nm 0.5 ... 0.6 - 0.5 ... 0.6
lb.in 4.5 ... 5.3 - 4.5 ... 5.3

Type 3RF21 ..-....2 3RF21 ..-....4 3RF21 ..-....5 3RF21 ..-....6


Main circuit
Rated operational voltage Ue V 24 ... 230 230 ... 460 48 ... 600 400 ... 600
• Tolerance % -15 / +10
• Rated frequency Hz 50/60
Rated insulation voltage Ui V 600
Blocking voltage V 800 1200 1200 1600
Rate of voltage rise V/µs 1000

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 8/29


Solid-State Switching Devices

Solid-State Relays
3RF21 Solid-state – technical data

Order No. Imax 1) Ie acc. to IEC 60947-4-3 Ie acc. to UL/CSA Power loss Minimum load Leakage current
at Rthha/Tu = 40 °C at Rthha/Tu = 40 °C at Rthha/Tu = 50 °C at Imax current
A K/W A K/W A K/W W A mA
Main circuit
3RF21 20-..... 20 2.0 20 1.7 20 1.3 28.6 0.1 10
3RF21 30-1.... 30 1.1 30 0.79 30 0.56 44.2 0.5 10
3RF21 50-1.... 50 0.68 50 0.48 50 0.33 66 0.5 10
3RF21 50-2.... 50 0.68 20 2.6 20 2.9 66 0.5 10
3RF21 50-3.... 50 0.68 50 0.48 50 0.33 66 0.5 10
3RF21 70-1.... 70 0.40 50 0.77 50 0.6 94 0.5 10
3RF21 90-1.... 88 0.33 50 0.94 50 0.85 118 0.5 10
3RF21 90-2.... 88 0.33 20 2.8 20 3.5 118 0.5 10
3RF21 90-3.... 88 0.33 88 0.22 83 0.19 118 0.5 10
1) Imax provides information about the performance of the solid-state relay. Note: The required heat sinks for the corresponding load cur-
The actual permitted rated operational current Ie can be smaller depend- rents can be determined from the characteristic curves,
ing on the connection method and cooling conditions.
page 4/10. The minimum thickness values for the mounting sur-
face must be observed.

Order No. Rated impulse withstand capacity Itsm I2t value


A A2s
Main circuit
3RF21 20-..... 200 200
3RF21 30-..A.2 300 450
3RF21 30-..A.4 300 450
3RF21 30-..A.5 300 450
3RF21 30-..A.6 400 800
3RF21 50-..... 600 1800
3RF21 70-..A.2 1200 7200
3RF21 70-..A.4 1200 7200
3RF21 70-..A.5 1200 7200
3RF21 70-..A.6 1150 6600
3RF21 90-..... 1150 6600

Type 3RF21 ..-....2 3RF21 ..-....4 3RF21 ..-....5 3RF21 ..-....6


Main circuit
Rated operational voltage Ue V 24 ... 230 48 ... 460 48 ... 600 48 ... 600
• Operating range V 20 ... 253 40 ... 506 40 ... 660 40 ... 660
• Rated frequency Hz 50/60 ± 10 %
Rated insulation voltage Ui V 600
Blocking voltage V 800 1200 1600
Rage of voltage rise V/µs 1000

Type 3RF21 ..-...0. 3RF21 ..-...1. 3RF21 ..-...2. 3RF21 ..-...4.


8

Control circuit
Method of operation DC operation AC/DC operation AC operation DC operation
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors

Rated control supply voltage Us V 24 acc. to 24 AC 24 DC 110 ... 230 4 ... 30


EN 61131-2
Rated frequency Hz -- 50/60 -- 50/60 ± 10 % --
of the control supply voltage ± 10 %
Control supply voltage, max. V 30 26.5 AC 30 DC 253 30
Typical actuating current mA 20 / Low Power: 6.51) 20 20 15 20
Response voltage V 15 14 AC 15 DC 90 4
Drop-out voltage V 5 5 AC 5 DC 40 1
Operating times
• ON-delay ms 1 + max. one 10 + max. one 40 + max. one 1 + max. one
half-wave2) half-wave2) half-wave2) half-wave2)
• OFF-delay ms 1 + max. one 15 + max. one 40 + max. one 1 + max. one
half-wave half-wave half-wave half-wave

1)
Applies to the version "Low Power" 3RF21 ..-.AA..-0KN0.
2)
Only for zero-point-switching devices.

8/30 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Solid-State Switching Devices

Solid-State Relays
3RF21 solid-state relays – technical data

Fused version with semiconductor protection (similar to type of coordination "2")1)


The semiconductor protection for the SIRIUS controls can be If a fuse is used with a higher rated current than specified, semi-
used with different protective devices. This allows protection by conductor protection is no longer guaranteed. However, smaller
means of LV HRC fuses of gG operational class or miniature cir- fuses with a lower rated current for the load can be used without
cuit breakers. Siemens recommends the use of special SITOR problems.
semiconductor fuses. The table below lists the maximum per-
missible fuses for each SIRIUS control. For protective devices with gG operational class and for SITOR
3NE1 all-range fuses, the minimum cross-sections for the con-
ductor to be connected must be taken into account.
Order No. All-range fuses Semiconductor fuses/partial-range fuses
LV HRC design Cylindrical design LV HRC design Cylindrical design
gR/SITOR gR/NEOZED2) aR/SITOR aR/SITOR aR/SITOR aR/SITOR
SILIZED 10 mm x 38 mm 14 mm x 51 mm 22 mm x 58 mm
3NE1 5SE1 3NE8 3NC1 0 3NC1 4 3NC2 2
3RF21 20-...2 3NE1 814-0 5SE1 325 3NE8 015-1 3NC1 020 3NC1 420 3NC2 220
3RF21 20-...4 3NE1 813-04) 5SE1 320 3NE8 015-1 3NC1 0164) 3NC1 420 3NC2 220
3RF21 20-....53) 3NE1 813-04) 5SE1 320 3NE8 015-1 3NC1 0164) 3NC1 420 3NC2 220
3RF21 30-...2 3NE1 815-04) 5SE1 335 3NE8 003-1 3NC1 032 3NC1 432 3NC2 232
3RF21 30-...4 3NE1 815-04) 5SE1 3254) 3NE8 003-1 3NC1 0254) 3NC1 430 3NC2 232
3RF21 30-....53) 3NE1 815-04) 5SE1 3254) 3NE8 003-1 3NC1 0254) 3NC1 430 3NC2 232
3RF21 30-...6 3NE1 815-04) -- 3NE8 003-1 3NC1 032 3NC1 432 3NC2 232
3RF21 50-...2 3NE1 817-0 5SE1 350 3NE8 017-1 -- 3NC1 450 3NC2 250
3RF21 50-...4 3NE1 802-04) 5SE1 3354) 3NE8 017-1 -- 3NC1 450 3NC2 250
3RF21 50-....53) 3NE1 802-04) 5SE1 3354) 3NE8 017-1 -- 3NC1 450 3NC2 250
3RF21 50-...6 3NE1 803-04) -- 3NE8 017-1 -- 3NC1 450 3NC2 250
3RF21 70-...25) 3NE1 820-0 5SE1 3634) 3NE8 020-1 -- -- 3NC2 280
3RF21 70-...45) 3NE1 020-2 5SE1 3634) 3NE8 020-1 -- -- 3NC2 280
3RF21 70-....53)5) 3NE1 020-2 -- 3NE8 020-1 -- -- 3NC2 280
3RF21 70-...65) 3NE1 020-2 -- 3NE8 020-1 -- -- 3NC2 280
3RF21 90-...25) 3NE1 021-2 -- 3NE8 021-1 -- -- 3NC2 200
3RF21 90-...45) 3NE1 021-2 -- 3NE8 021-1 -- -- 3NC2 2804)
3RF21 90-....53)5) 3NE1 021-2 -- 3NE8 021-1 -- -- 3NC2 2804)
3RF21 90-...65) 3NE1 817-04) -- 3NE8 021-1 -- -- 3NC2 2804)

Order No. Cable and line protection fuses


LV HRC design4) Cylindrical design4) DIAZED4)
gG gG gG gG quick
10 mm x 38 mm 14 mm x 51 mm 22 mm x 58 mm
3NA2 3NW6 0 3NW6 1 3NW6 2 5SB
3RF21 20-...2 3NA2 803 3NW6 000-1 3NW6 101-1 -- 5SB1 41
3RF21 20-...4 3NA2 801 -- 3NW6 101-1 -- 5SB1 41
3RF21 20-....53) 3NA2 801 -- 3NW6 101-1 -- 5SB1 41
3RF21 30-...2 3NA2 803 -- 3NW6 103-1 -- 5SB1 71
3RF21 30-...4 3NA2 803 -- 3NW6 101-1 -- 5SB1 71
3RF21 30-....53) 3NA2 803 -- 3NW6 101-1 -- 5SB1 71
3RF21 30-...6 3NA2 803-6 -- -- -- --
3RF21 50-...2 3NA2 810 -- 3NW6 107-1 3NW6 207-1 5SB3 11
3RF21 50-...4 3NA2 807 -- -- 3NW6 205-1 5SB3 11

8
3RF21 50-....53) 3NA2 807 -- -- 3NW6 205-1 5SB3 11
3RF21 50-...6 3NA2 807-6 -- -- -- --
3RF21 70-...25) 3NA2 817 -- -- 3NW6 217-1 5SB3 31

& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
3RF21 70-...45) 3NA2 812 -- -- 3NW6 212-1 5SB3 31
3RF21 70-....53)5) 3NA2 812 -- -- 3NW6 212-1 --
3RF21 70-...65) 3NA2 812-6 -- -- -- --
3RF21 90-...25) 3NA2 817 -- -- 3NW6 217-1 --
3RF21 90-...45) 3NA2 812 -- -- 3NW6 212-1 --
3RF21 90-....53)5) 3NA2 812 -- -- 3NW6 212-1 --
3RF21 90-...65) 3NA2 812-6 -- -- -- --

Suitable fuse holders, fuse bases and controls can be found in


Catalog LV 1, Chapter 19.
1) Type of coordination "2" according to EN 60947-4-1:
In the event of a short-circuit, the controls in the load feeder must not
endanger persons or the installation. They must be suitable for further
operation. For fused configurations, the protective device must be
replaced.
2)
For use only with operational voltage Ue up to 400 V.
3) For use only with operational voltage Ue up to 506 V.
4)
These fuses have a smaller rated current than the solid-state relays.
5) These versions can also be protected against short-circuits with miniature
circuit breakers as described in the notes on "SIRIUS Solid-State
Contactors → Special Version Short-Circuit Resistant".

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 8/31


Solid-State Switching Devices

Solid-State Relays
3RF20 Solid-state relays – technical data

■ Overview
45 mm semiconductor relays
The semiconductor relays with a width of 45 mm provide for
connection of the power supply lead and the load from above.
This makes it easy to retrofit existing semiconductor relays. The
connection of the control cable also saves space in much the
same way as the 22.5 mm design, as it is simply plugged on.

■ Technical specifications
Type 3RF20
General data
Ambient temperature
during operation, derating at 40 °C °C -25 ... +60
when stored °C -55 ... +80
Site altitude m 0 ... 1000; derating from 1000
Shock resistance g/ms 15/11
acc. to IEC 60068-2-27
Vibration resistance g 2
acc. to IEC 60068-2-6
Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC)
Emitted interference
• Conducted interference voltage IEC Class A for industrial applications
acc. to 60947-4-3
• Emitted, high-frequency interference Class A for industrial applications
voltage acc. to IEC 60947-4-3
Noise immunity
• Electrostatic discharge kV Contact discharge 4; air discharge 8; behavior criterion 2
acc. to IEC 61000-4-2
(corresponds to degree of severity 3)
• Induced RF fields acc. to IEC 61000-4-6 MHz 0.15 ... 80; 140 dBµV; behavior criterion 1
• Burst acc. to IEC 61000-4-4 kV 2/5.0 kHz; behavior criterion 1
• Surge acc. to IEC 61000-4-5 kV Conductor - ground 2; conductor - conductor 1; behavior criterion 2
Connection, main contacts, screw con-
nection
Conductor cross-section
Solid mm2 2 x (1.5 ... 2.5); 2 x (2.5 ... 6)
Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 x (1.5 ... 2.5); 2 x (2.5 ... 6); 1 x 10
Solid or stranded AWG conductors AWG 2 x (14 ... 10)
Insulation stripping length mm 10
Terminal screw M4
• Tightening torque Nm 2 ... 2.5
lb.in 18 ... 22
Connection, auxiliary/control contacts,
screw connection
Conductor cross-section mm2 1x (0.5 ... 2.5); 2x (0.5 ... 1.0); AWG 20 ... 12
Insulation stripping length mm 7
Terminal screw M3
• Tightening torque Nm 0.5 ... 0.6
lb.in 4.5 ... 5.3
8

Type 3RF20 .0-1AA.2 3RF20 .0-1AA.4 3RF20..-....5 3RF20 .0-1AA.6


Solid-State Relays
& Contactors

Main circuit
Rated operational voltage Ue V 24 ... 230 230 ... 460 48 ... 600 400 ... 600
• Tolerance % -15/+10
• Rated frequency Hz 50/60
Rated insulation voltage Ui V 600
Blocking voltage V 800 1200 1200 1600
Rage of voltage rise V/µs 1000

8/32 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Solid-State Switching Devices

Solid-State Relays
3RF20 Solid-state relays – technical data

Order No. Imax1) Ie to IEC 60947-4-3 Ie to UL/CSA Power loss Minimum load Leakage current
at Rthha/Tu = 40 °C at Rthha/Tu = 40 °C at Rthha/Tu = 50 °C for Imax current
A K/W A K/W A K/W W A mA
Main circuit
3RF20 20-1AA.. 20 2.0 20 2.0 20 1.7 28.6 0.5 10
3RF20 30-1AA.. 30 1.1 30 1.1 30 0.88 44.2 0.5 10
3RF20 50-1AA.. 50 0.68 50 0.68 50 0.53 66 0.5 10
3RF20 70-1AA.. 70 0.4 50 0.95 50 0.8 94 0.5 10
3RF20 90-1AA.. 88 0.33 50 1.25 50 1.02 118 0.5 10
1) Imax provides information about the performance of the semiconductor
relay. The actual permitted operational current Ie can be smaller depend-
ing on the connection method and cooling conditions.

Order No. Rated impulse withstand I2t value


capacity Itsm
A A2s
Main circuit
3RF20 20-1AA.. 200 200
3RF20 30-1AA.2 300 450
3RF20 30-1AA.4 300 450
3RF20 30-1AA.6 400 800
3RF20 50-1AA.. 600 1800
3RF20 70-1AA.2 1200 7200
3RF20 70-1AA.4 1200 7200
3RF20 70-1AA.6 1150 6600
3RF20 90-1AA.. 1150 6600

Type 3RF20 .0-1AA0. 3RF20 .0-1AA4. 3RF20 .0-1AA2.


Control circuit
Method of operation DC operation DC operation AC operation
Rated control supply voltage Us V 24 acc. to EN 61131-2 4 ... 30V DC 110 ... 230
Max. rated control voltage V 30 30 253
Rated control current at Us mA 15 15 6
Rated frequency of the control supply voltage Hz - - 50/60
Response voltage V 15 4 90
current mA >2 >2 2
Drop-out voltage V 5 1 40
Operating times
closing time ms 1 + max. one half wave 1 + max. one half wave 40 + max. one half wave
opening time ms 1 + max. one half wave 1 + max. one half wave 40 + max. one half wave

Fused design with semiconductor protection

8
Order No. All-range fuse Semiconductor protection fuse Cable and line protection fuse
LV design Cylindrical design LV design Cylindrical design DIAZED quick

& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
gR/SITOR gL/gG/3NA 5SB
3NE1 10 × 38 mm 14 × 51 mm 22 × 58 mm 10 × 38 mm 14 × 51 mm 22 × 58 mm
aR/SITOR aR/SITOR aR/SITOR gL/gG 3NW gL/gG 3NW gL/gG 3NW
3NC1 0 3NC1 4 3NC2 2

3RF20 20-1AA.2 3NE1 814-0 3NC1 020 3NC1 420 3NC2 220 3NA2 803 3NW6 001-1 3NW6 101-1 - 5SB1 71
3RF20 20-1AA.4 3NE1 813-0 3NC1 016 3NC1 420 3NC2 220 3NA2 801 - 3NW6 101-1 - 5SB1 41
3RF20 30-1AA.2 3NE1 815-0 3NC1 032 3NC1 432 3NC2 232 3NA2 803 - 3NW6 103-1 - 5SB3 11
3RF20 30-1AA.4 3NE1 815-0 3NC1 025 3NC1 432 3NC2 232 3NA2 803 - 3NW6 101-1 - 5SB1 71
3RF20 30-1AA.6 3NE1 815-0 3NC1 032 3NC1 432 3NC2 232 3NA2 803-6 - - - -
3RF20 50-1AA.2 3NE1 817-0 - 3NC1 450 3NC2 250 3NA2 810 - 3NW6 107-1 3NW6 207-1 5SB3 21
3RF20 50-1AA.4 3NE1 802-0 - 3NC1 450 3NC2 250 3NA2 807 - - 3NW6 205-1 5SB3 11
3RF20 50-1AA.6 3NE1 803-0 - 3NC1 450 3NC2 250 3NA2 807-6 - - - -
3RF20 70-1AA.22) 3NE1 820-0 - - 3NC2 280 3NA2 817 - - 3NW6 217-1 5SB3 31
3RF20 70-1AA.42) 3NE1 020-2 - - 3NC2 280 3NA2 812 - - 3NW6 212-1 5SB3 21
3RF20 70-1AA.62) 3NE1 020-2 - - 3NC2 280 3NA2 812-6 - - - -
3RF20 90-1AA.22) 3NE1 021-2 - - 3NC2 200 3NA2 817 - - 3NW6 217-1 5SB3 31
3RF20 90-1AA.42) 3NE1 021-2 - - 3NC2 280 3NA2 812 - - 3NW6 212-1 5SB3 21
3RF20 90-1AA.62) 3NE1 020-2 - - 3NC2 280 3NA2 812-6 - - - -
1) Type of coordination "2" acc. to EN 60947-4-1: 2) These versions can also be protected against short-circuit with
In the event of a short-circuit, the control gear in the load feeder must not miniature circuit-breakers as described on page 7/11.
endanger persons or the installation. They must be suitable for further
operation. For fused configurations, the protective device must be
replaced.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 8/33


Solid-State Switching Devices

Solid-State Relays
3RF22 Solid-state relays – technical data

Overview
45 mm solid-state relays Important features:
• LED indicators
The 3RF22 solid-state relays with a width of 45 mm provide • Variety of connection techniques
space advantages over solutions with single-phase versions. • Plug-in control connection
The logical connection arrangement, with the power infeed from
• Zero-point switching
above and connection of the load from below, ensures tidy
• Two or three-phase controlled
installation in the control cabinet.

Technical specifications

Type 3RF22 ..-1.... 3RF22 ..-2.... 3RF22 ..-3....


General data
Ambient temperature
• During operation, derating from 40 °C °C -25 ... +60
• During storage °C -55 ... +80
Site altitude m 0 ... 1000; > 1000 ask Technical Assistance
Shock resistance acc. to g/ms 15/11
IEC 60068-2-27
Vibration resistance acc. to IEC 60068-2-6 g 2
Insulation strength at 50/60 Hz V rms 4000
(main/control circuit to ground)
Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC)
• Emitted interference
- Conducted interference voltage Class A for industrial applications1)
acc. to IEC 60947-4-3
- Emitted, high-frequency interference Class A for industrial applications
voltage acc. to IEC 60947-4-3
• Interference immunity
- Electrostatic discharge kV Contact discharge 4; air discharge 8; behavior criterion 2
acc. to IEC 61000-4-2
(corresponds to degree of severity 3)
- Induced RF fields MHz 0.15 ... 80; 140 dBµV; behavior criterion 1
acc. to IEC 61000-4-6
- Burst acc. to IEC 61000-4-4 kV 2/5.0 kHz; behavior criterion 1
- Surge acc. to IEC 61000-4-5 kV Conductor – ground 2; conductor – conductor 1; behavior criterion 2
Connection technique Screw terminal Spring-loaded connection Ring terminal end connection
Main contact connection
• Conductor cross-section
- So l i d mm 2 2 x (1.5 ... 2.5), 2 x (2.5 ... 6) 2 x (0.5 ... 2.5) --
- Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 x (1 ... 2.5), 2 x (2.5 ... 6), 1 x 10 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5) --
- Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 -- 2 x (0.5 ... 2.5) --
- Solid or stranded, AWG conductors 2 x (AWG 14 ... 10) 2 x (AWG 18 ... 14) --
• S tripped length mm 10 10
• Terminal screw M4 -- M5
- Tightening torque, Nm 2 ... 2.5 2.5 ... 2
5 ... 6 mm, PZ 2 lb.in 18 ... 22 18 ... 22
8

• Cable lug -- --
- acc. to DIN 46234 5-2.5 ... 5-25
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors

- acc. to JIS C 2805 R 2-5 ... 14-5


Connection, auxiliary/control contacts
• Conductor cross-section, mm 1 x (0.5 ... 2.5), 2 x (0.5 ... 1.0) 0.5 ... 2.5 1 x (0.5 ... 2.5), 2 x (0.5 ... 1.0)
with or without end sleeve AWG 20 ... 12 20 ... 12 20 ... 12
• S tripped length mm 7 10 7
• Terminal screw M3 -- M3
- Tightening torque, Nm 0.5 ... 0.6 0.5 ... 0.6
3.5 , PZ 1 lb.in 4.5 ... 5.3 4.5 ... 5.3
1) These products were built as Class A devices. The use of these devices in
residential areas could result in radio interference. In this case the may be
required to introduce additional damping measures.

8/34 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Solid-State Switching Devices

Solid-State Relays
3RF22 Solid-state relays – technical data

Type 3RF22 ..-.AB.5 3RF22 ..-.AC.5


Main circuit
Controlled phases Two-phase Three-phase
Rated operational voltage Ue V 48 ... 600 48 ... 600
• Operating range V 40 ... 660 40 ... 660
• Rated frequency Hz 50/60 ± 10 % 50/60 ± 10 %
Rated insulation voltage Ui V 600 600
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 6 6
Blocking voltage V 1200 1200
Rage of voltage rise V/µs 1.000 1.000

Order No. Imax1) Ie acc. to IEC 60947-4-3 Ie acc. to UL/CSA Power loss Minimum load Max. leakage
at Rthha/Tu = 40 °C at Rthha/Tu = 40 °C at Rthha/Tu = 50 °C at Imax current current
A K/W A K/W A K/W W A mA
Main circuit
3RF22 30-. AB.. 30 0.57 30 0.57 30 0.44 81 0.5 10
3RF22 55-1AB.. 55 0.18 50 0.27 50 0.19 151 0.5 10
3RF22 55-2AB.. 20 1.83 20 1.58
3RF22 55-3AB.. 50 0.27 50 0.19
3RF22 30-. AC.. 30 0.33 30 0.33 30 0.25 122 0.5 10
3RF22 55-1AC.. 55 0.09 50 0.15 50 0.1 226 0.5 10
3RF22 55-2AC.. 20 1.19 20 1.02
3RF22 55-3AC.. 88 0.15 83 0.1
1) Imax provides information about the performance of the solid-state relay.
The actual permitted rated operational current Ie can be smaller depend-
ing on the connection method and cooling conditions.

Order No. Rated impulse withstand capacity Itsm I2t value


A A2s
Main circuit
3RF22 30-....5 300 450
3RF22 55-....5 600 1800

Type 3RF22 ..-.AB4. / 3RF22 ..-.AC4.


Control circuit
Method of operation DC operation
Rated control supply voltage Us V 4 ... 30
Response voltage V 15
• For tripping current mA 2
Drop-out voltage V 1
Operating times

8
• ON-delay ms 1 + max. one half-wave
• OFF delay ms 1 + max. one half-wave

& Contactors
Solid-State Relays

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 8/35


Solid-State Switching Devices

Solid-State Contactors
3RF23 Solid-state contactors– technical data

■ Technical specifications
Order No. 3RF23 ..-.A... 3RF23 ..-.B... 3RF23 ..-.C... 3RF23 ..-.D...
General data
Ambient temperature
during operation, derating at 40 °C °C -25 ... +60
when stored °C -55 ... +80
Site altitude m 0 ... 1000; derating from 1000
Shock resistance acc. to IEC 60068-2-27 g/ms 15/11
Vibration resistance acc. to IEC 60068-2-6 g 2
Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC)
Emitted interference acc. to IEC 60947-4-3 Class A for industrial applications Class A for Class A for
• Conducted interference voltage industrial industrial
• Emitted high-frequency interference voltage applications; applications
Class B for resi-
dential/business/
commercial
areas up to 16 A,
AC51 Low Noise
Noise immunity
• Electrostatic discharge acc. to IEC 61000-4-2 kV Contact discharge 4; air discharge 8; behavior criterion 2
(corresponds to degree of severity 3)
• Induced RF fields acc. to IEC 61000-4-6 MHz 0.15 ... 80; 140 dBµV; behavior criterion 1
• Burst acc. to IEC 61000-4-4 kV 2/5.0 kHz; behavior criterion 1
• Surge acc. to IEC 61000-4-5 kV Conductor - ground 2; conductor - conductor 1; behavior criterion 2

Order No. 3RF23 ..-1.... 3RF23 ..-2.... 3RF23 ..-3....


General data
Connection technique Screw connection Spring-loaded connection Ring cable connection
Main contact connection
Conductor cross-section
Solid mm 2 2 x (1.5 ... 2.5), 2 x (2.5 ... 6) 2 x (0.5 ... 2.5) -
Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 x (1.5 ... 2.5), 2 x (2.5 ... 6), 1 x 10 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5) -
Finely stranded without end sleeves mm2 2 x (0.5 ... 2.5) -
Solid or stranded AWG conductors AWG 2 x (14 ... 10) 2 x (18 ... 14) -
Insulation stripping length mm 10 10 -
Terminal screw M4 - M5
• Tightening torque Nm 2 ... 2.5 - 2 ... 2.5
• Tightening torque lb.in 18 ... 22 - 18 ... 22
Cable lug
• DIN - - DIN 46234
-5-2.5, -5-6, -5-10, -5-16, -5-25
• JIS - - JIS C 2805 R 2-5, 5.5-5, 8-5, 14-5
Auxiliary/control contact
connections
Conductor cross-section mm2 1x (0.5 ... 2.5); 2x (0.5 ... 1.0) 0.5 ... 1.5 1x (0.5 ... 2.5); 2x (0.5 ... 1.0)
AWG 20 ... 12 20 ... 12 20 ... 12
Insulation stripping length mm 7 10 7
Terminal screw M3 - M3
• Tightening torque Nm 0.5 ... 0.6 - 0.5 ... 0.6
lb.in 4.5 ... 5.3 - 4.5 ... 5.3
8

Type 3RF23 ..-....2 3RF23 ..-....4 3RF21 ..-....5 3RF23 ..-....6


Main circuit
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors

Rated operational voltage Ue V 24 ... 230 230 ... 460 48 ... 600 400 ... 600
• Tolerance % -15/+10
• Rated frequency Hz 50/60 Hz
Rated insulation voltage Ui V 600
Blocking voltage V 800 1200 1200 1600
Rate of voltage rise V/µs 1000

Type 3RF23 ..-...0. 3RF23 ..-...2.


Control circuit
Method of operation DC operation AC operation
Rated control supply voltage Us V 24 to EN 61131-2 110 ... 230
Max. rated control voltage V 30 253
Rated control current at Us mA 15 6
Rated frequency of the control supply voltage Hz 50/60
Response voltage V 15 90
for tripping current mA 2 2
Drop-out voltage V 5 40
Operating times
closing time ms 1 + max. one half-wave 40 + max. one half-wave
opening time ms 1 + max. one half-wave 40 + max. one half-wave

8/36 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Solid-State Switching Devices

Solid-State Contactors
3RF23 Solid-state contactors – technical data

■ Technical specifications
Order No. Type current AC-511) Power loss at Minimum load Leakage Rated impulse I2t value
Imax acc. to UL/CSA Imax current current withstand
IEC 60947-4-3 capacity Itsm
at 40 °C at 40 °C at 50 °C
A A A W A mA A A 2s
Main circuit
3RF23 1.-.A..2 10.5 7.5 9.6 11 0.5 10 200 200
3RF23 1.-.A..4 200 200
3RF23 1.-.A.45
3RF23 1.-.A..6 400 800
3RF23 2.-.A..2 20 13.2 17.6 20 0.5 10 600 1800
3RF23 2.-.C..2 25 600 1800
3RF23 2.-.D..2 10 1150 6600
3RF23 2.-.A..4 10 600 1800
3RF23 2.-.C..4 25 600 1800
3RF23 2.-.D..4 10 1150 6600
3RF23 2.-.A.45
3RF23 2.-.A..6 10 600 1800
3RF23 3.-.A..2 30 22 27 33 0.5 10 600 1800
3RF23 3.-.A..4
3RF23 3.-.A.45
3RF23 3.-.A..6
3RF23 4.-.A..2 40 33 36 44 0.5 10 1200 7200
3RF23 4.-.A..4 1200 7200
3RF23 4.-.A.45
3RF23 4.-.A..6 1150 6600
3RF23 5.-.A..2 50 36 45 54 0.5 10 1150 6600
3RF23 5.-.A..4
3RF23 5.-.A.45
3RF23 5.-.A..6
3RF23 7.-.A..2 70 70 62 83 0.5 10 1150 6600
3RF23 7.-.A..4
3RF23 7.-.A.45
3RF23 7.-.A..6
3RF23 9.-.A..2 88 88 80 117 0.5 10 1150 6600
3RF23 9.-.A..4
3RF23 9.-.A.45
3RF23 9.-.A..6

Order No. Type current AC-511) Power loss Minimum Leakage Rated impulse I2t value
Imax acc. to UL/CSA AC-15 at Imax load current current withstand
IEC 60947- capacity Itsm
Parameters
at 40 °C 4-3 at 50 °C
at 40 °C
A A A A W A mA A A2s
Main circuit
3RF23 1.-.B..2 10.5 7.5 9.6 6 1200 1/h 11 0.5 10 200 200
3RF23 1.-.B..4 50 % ED 200 200

8
3RF23 1.-.B..6 400 800
3RF23 2.-.B..2 20 13.2 17.6 12 1200 1/h 20 0.5 10 600 1800
3RF23 2.-.B..4

& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
50 % ED
3RF23 2.-.B..6
3RF23 3.-.B..2 30 22 27 15 1200 1/h 33 0.5 10 600 1800
3RF23 3.-.B..4 50 % ED
3RF23 3.-.B..6
3RF23 4.-.B..2 40 33 36 20 1200 1/h 44 0.5 10 1200 7200
3RF23 4.-.B..4 50 % ED 1200 7200
3RF23 4.-.B..6 1150 6600
3RF23 5.-.B..2 50 36 45 25 1200 1/h 54 0.5 10 1150 6600
3RF23 5.-.B..4 50 % ED
3RF23 5.-.B..6
3RF23 7.-.B..2 70 70 62 27.5 1200 1/h 83 0.5 10 1150 6600
3RF23 7.-.B..4 50 % ED
3RF23 7.-.B..6
3RF23 9.-.B..2 88 88 80 30 1200 1/h 117 0.5 10 1150 6600
3RF23 9.-.B..4 50 % ED
3RF23 9.-.B..6
1) The type current provides information about the performance of the semi-
conductor contactor. The actual permitted operational current Ie can be
smaller depending on the connection method and start-up conditions.
Derating acc. to curves from page 7/34, 7/35, 7/36.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 8/37


Solid-State Switching Devices

Solid-State Contactors
3RF23 Solid-state contactors – technical data

Fused design with semiconductor protection


(similar to type of coordination "2")1)
The semiconductor protection for the SIRIUS SC controlgear can If a fuse is used with a higher rated current than specified, semi-
be used with different protective devices. This allows protection conductor protection is no longer guaranteed. However, smaller
by means of LV HRC fuses of operational class gL/gG or supple- fuses with a lower rated current for the load can be used without
mentary protectors. Siemens recommends the use of special problems.
SITOR semiconductor fuses. The table below lists the maximum For protective devices with operational class gL/gG and for
permissible fuses for each SIRIUS SC control gear. SITOR full range fuses 3NE1, the minimum cross-sections for the
conductor to be connected must be taken into account.

Order No. All-range fuse Semiconductor protection fuse Cable and line protection fuse
LV HRC Cylindrical design LV HRC Cylindrical design DIAZED quick
design design gL/gG 10 x 38 mm 5SB
gR/SITOR 10 x 38 mm 14 x 51 mm 22 x 58 mm 14 x 51 mm 22 x 58 mm
aR/SITOR aR/SITOR aR/SITOR 3NA gL/gG 3NW gL/gG 3NW gL/gG 3NW
3NE1
3NC1 0 3NC1 4 3NC2 2

3RF23 1.-....2 3NE1 813-0 3NC1 010 3NC1 410 3NC2 220 3NA2 803 3NW6 001-1 3NW6 101-1 - 5SB1 41
3RF23 1.-....4 3NE1 813-0 3NC1 010 3NC1 410 3NC2 220 3NA2 801 3NW6 001-1 3NW6 101-1 - 5SB1 41
3RF23 1.-....6 3NE1 813-0 3NC1 010 3NC1 410 3NC2 220 3NA2 803-6 - - - -
3RF23 2.-....2 3NE1 814-0 3NC1 020 3NC1 420 3NC2 220 3NA2 807 3NW6 007-1 3NW6 107-1 3NW6 207-1 5SB1 71
3RF23 2.-....4 3NE1 814-0 3NC1 020 3NC1 420 3NC2 220 3NA2 807 3NW6 005-1 3NW6 105-1 3NW6 205-1 5SB1 71
3RF23 2.-....6 3NE1 814-0 3NC1 020 3NC1 420 3NC2 220 3NA2 807-6 - - - -
3RF23 3.-....2 3NE1 803-0 3NC1 032 3NC1 432 3NC2 232 3NA2 810 - 3NW6 107-1 3NW6 207-1 5SB3 11
3RF23 3.-....4 3NE1 803-0 3NC1 032 3NC1 432 3NC2 232 3NA2 807 - 3NW6 105-1 3NW6 205-1 5SB3 11
3RF23 3.-....6 3NE1 803-0 3NC1 032 3NC1 432 3NC2 232 3NA2 807-6 - - - -
3RF23 4.-....2 3NE1 802-0 - 3NC1 440 3NC2 240 3NA2 817 - 3NW6 117-1 3NW6 217-1 5SB3 21
3RF23 4.-....4 3NE1 802-0 - 3NC1 440 3NC2 240 3NA2 812 - 3NW6 112-1 3NW6 212-1 5SB3 21
3RF23 4.-....6 3NE1 802-0 - 3NC1 440 3NC2 240 3NA2 812-6 - - - -
3RF23 5.-....2 3NE1 817-0 - 3NC1 450 3NC2 250 3NA2 817 - 3NW6 117-1 3NW6 217-1 5SB3 21
3RF23 5.-....4 3NE1 817-0 - 3NC1 450 3NC2 250 3NA2 812 - - 3NW6 210-1 5SB3 21
3RF23 5.-....6 3NE1 817-0 - 3NC1 450 3NC2 250 3NA2 812-6 - - - -
3RF23 7.-....2 3NE1 820-0 - - 3NC2 280 3NA2 817 - - 3NW6 217-1 5SB3 31
3RF23 7.-....4 3NE1 020-2 - - 3NC2 280 3NA2 812 - - 3NW6 210-1 5SB3 21
3RF23 7.-....6 3NE1 020-2 - - 3NC2 280 3NA2 812-6 - - - -
3RF23 9.-....2 3NE1 021-2 - - 3NC2 200 3NA2 817 - - 3NW6 217-1 5SB3 31
3RF23 9.-....4 3NE1 021-2 - - 3NC2 280 3NA2 812 - - 3NW6 210-1 5SB3 21
3RF23 9.-....6 3NE1 020-2 - - 3NC2 280 3NA2 812-6 - - - -
1) Type of coordination "2" acc. to EN 60947-4-1:
In the event of a short-circuit, the controlgear in the load feeder must not
endanger persons or the installation. They must be suitable for further
operation. For fused configurations, the protective device must be
replaced.
8
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors

8/38 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Solid-State Switching Devices

Solid-State Contactors
3RF24 Solid-state contactors – technical data

Overview
The complete units consist of a solid-state relay plus optimized circuits with protective extra-low voltage (PELV) or safety
heat sink, and are therefore ready to use. They offer defined extra-low voltage (SELV) in building engineering. For other appli-
rated currents to make selection as easy as possible. Depend- cations, such as for extended personal safety, the heat sink can
ing on the version, current intensities of up to 50 A are achieved. be grounded through a screw terminal.
Like all of our solid-state switching devices, one of their particu-
lar advantages is their compact and space-saving design. With Version for resistive loads, "zero-point switching"
their insulated mounting foot they can easily be snapped onto a This standard version is often used for switching space heaters
standard mounting rail, or they can be mounted on carrier plates on and off.
with fixing screws. This insulation enables them to be used in

Technical specifications

Order No. 3RF24 ..-1.... 3RF24 ..-2.... 3RF24 ..-3....


General data
Ambient temperature
• During operation, derating from 40 °C °C -25 ... +60
• During storage °C -55 ... +80
Site altitude m 0 ... 1000; derating from 1000
Shock resistance acc. to IEC 60068-2-27 g/ms 15/11
Vibration resistance acc. to IEC 60068-2-6 g 2
Insulation strength at 50/60 Hz V rms 4000
(main/control circuit to ground)
Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC)
• Emitted interference acc. to IEC 60947-4-3
- Conducted interference voltage Class A for industrial applications1)
- Emitted, high-frequency interference voltage Class A for industrial applications
• Interference immunity
- Electrostatic discharge kV Contact discharge 4; air discharge 8; behavior criterion 2
acc. to IEC 61000-4-2
(corresponds to degree of severity 3)
- Induced RF fields MHz 0.15 ... 80; 140 dBµV; behavior criterion 1
acc. to IEC 61000-4-6
- Burst acc. to IEC 61000-4-4 kV 2/5.0 kHz; behavior criterion 1
- Surge acc. to IEC 61000-4-5 kV Conductor – ground 2; conductor – conductor 1; behavior criterion 2
Connection technique Screw terminal Spring-loaded connection Ring terminal end connection
Main contact connection
• Conductor cross-section
- So l i d mm 2 2 x (1.5 ... 2.5), 2 x (2.5 ... 6) 2x (0.5 ... 2.5) --
- Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 x (1 ... 2.5), 2 x (2.5 ... 6), 1 x 10 2x (0.5 ... 1.5) --
- Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 -- 2x (0.5 ... 2.5) --
- Solid or stranded, AWG conductors 2 x (AWG 14 ... 10) 2 x (AWG 18 ... 14) --
• S tripped length mm 10 10 --
• Terminal screw M4 -- M5
- Tightening torque NM 2 ... 2.5 2 ... 2.5
lb.in 18 ... 22 18 ... 22

8
• Cable lug -- --
- acc. to DIN 46234 5-2.5 ... 5-25
- acc. to JIS C 2805 R 2-5 ,,, 14-5

& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
Connection, auxiliary/control contacts
• Conductor cross-section mm 1 x (0.5 ... 2.5), 2 x (0.5 ... 1.0) 0.5 ... 2.5 1 x (0.5 ... 2.5), 2 x (0.5 ... 1.0)
AWG AWG 20 ... 12 AWG 20 ... 12 AWG 20 ... 12
• S tripped length mm 7 10 7
• Terminal screw M3 -- M3
- Tightening torque, NM 0.5 ... 0.6 0.5 ... 0.6
∅ 3.5 , PZ 1 lb.in 4.5 ... 5.3 4.5 ... 5.3
1) These products were built as Class A devices. The use of these devices in
residential areas could result in radio interference. In this case the may be
required to introduce additional damping measures.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 8/39


Solid-State Switching Devices

Solid-State Contactors
3RF24 Solid-state contactors – technical data

Type 3RF24 ..-.AB.5 3RF24 ..-.AC.5


Main circuit
Controlled phases Two-phase Three-phase
Rated operational voltage Ue V 48 ... 600 48 ... 600
• Operating range V 40 ... 660 40 ... 660
• Rated frequency Hz 50/60 ± 10 % 50/60 ± 10 %
Rated insulation voltage Ui V 600 600
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 6 6
Blocking voltage V 1200 1200
Rage of voltage rise V/µs 1000 1000

Order No. Type current Rated operational current Ie Power loss at Minimum load Max. leakage Rated impulse I2t value
IAC-51 current current withstand
IAC-51 acc. to acc. to current Itsm
IEC 60947-4-3 UL/CSA
at 40 °C for 40°C for 50 °C
A A A w A mA A A²s
Main circuit
3RF24 10-.AB.5 10.5 7.5 9.5 21 0.1 10 200 200
3RF24 20-.AB.5 20 15 18 39 0.5 10 500 1800
3RF24 30-.AB.5 30 22 26 61 0.5 10 1200 7200
3RF24 40-.AB.5 40 32 35 81 0.5 10 1150 6600
3RF24 50-.AB.5 50 38 45 105 0.5 10 1150 6600
3RF24 10-.AC.5 10.5 7 9 32 0.1 10 300 450
3RF24 20-.AC.5 20 15 18 67 0.5 10 600 1800
3RF24 30-.AC.5 30 22 26 93 0.5 10 1200 7200
3RF24 40-.AC.5 40 29 35 121 0.5 10 1150 6600
3RF24 50-.AC.5 50 38 45 160 0.5 10 1150 6600
1) The type current provides information about the performance of the solid-
state contactor. The actual permitted rated operational current Ie can be
smaller depending on the connection method and start-up conditions.
For derating see the characteristic curves on page 4/18.

Type 3RF24 ..-...4. 3RF24 ..-...5.


Control circuit
Method of operation DC operation AC operation
Rated control supply voltage Us V 4 ... 30 190 ... 230
Rated frequency Hz -- 50/60 ± 10%
of the control supply voltage
Actuating voltage, max. V 30 253
• For actuating current mA 15 6
Response voltage V 4 180
• For tripping current mA >3 >2
Drop-out voltage V <1 < 40
8

Operating times
• ON-delay ms 1 + max. one half-wave 40 + max. one half-wave
• OFF delay ms 1 + max. one half-wave 40 + max. one half-wave
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors

8/40 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Solid-State Switching Devices
Solid-State Switching Devices for Switching Motors
Solid-State Contactors Solid-State Contactors
3RF34 Solid-state contactors – technical data
General data

Technical specifications
Type 3RF34 05-1BB.. 3RF34 10-1BB.., 3RF34 05-2BB.. 3RF34 10-2BB..,
3RF34 03-1BD.., 3RF34 12-1BB.., 3RF34 12-2BB..,
3RF34 05-1BD.. 3RF34 16-1BB.. 3RF34 16-2BB..

H
3RF34 10-1BD..

D
Dimensions (W x H x D) W mm 45 x 95 x 96.5 90 x 95 x 96.5 45 x 95 x 96.5 90 x 95 x 96.5
General technical specifications
Ambient temperature
• During operation, derating from 40 °C °C -25 ... +60
• During storage °C -55 ... +80
Installation altitude m 0 ... 1 000; derating from 1 000 on request
Shock resistance acc. to IEC 60068-2-27 g/ms 15/11
Vibration resistance acc. to IEC 60068-2-6 g 2
Insulation strength at 50/60 Hz V rms 4 000
(main/control circuit to floor)
Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC)
• Emitted interference according to IEC 60947-4-2
- Conducted interference voltage Class A for industrial applications1)
- Emitted, high-frequency interference voltage Class A for industrial applications
• Interference immunity
- Electrostatic discharge kV Contact discharge: 4; Air discharge: 8;
according to IEC 61000-4-2 Behavior criterion 2

6
(corresponds to degree of severity 3)
- Induced RF fields MHz 0.15 ... 80;
according to IEC 61000-4-6 140 dBµV; behavior criterion 1
- Burst acc. to IEC 61000-4-4 kV 2; at 5 kHz; behavior criterion 2
- Surge according to IEC 61000-4-52) kV Conductor - Ground: 2; Conductor - Conductor: 1; Behavior criterion 2
Connection type Screw terminals Spring-type terminals

Operating devices Standard screwdriver size 2 and Pozidriv 2 3.0 x 0.5 and 3.5 x 0.5
Conductor cross-sections, main contacts
• Solid mm2 2 x (1.5 ... 2.5)3), 2 x (2.5 ... 6)3) 2 x (0.5 ... 2.5)
• Finely stranded with end sleeve mm2 2 x (1 ... 2.5)3); 2 x (2.5 ... 6)3); 1 x 10 2 x (0.5 ... 1.5)
• Finely stranded without end sleeve mm2 -- 2 x (0.5 ... 2.5)
• AWG cables, solid or stranded 2 x (AWG 14 ... 10) 2 x (AWG 18 ... 14)
Conductor cross-sections, auxiliary/control contacts
• With/without end sleeve mm2 1 x (0.5 ... 2.5), 2 x (0.5 ... 1.0) 0.5 ... 2.5
• AWG cables, solid or stranded AWG 20 ... 12 AWG 20 ... 12
Permissible mounting positions ±10° ±10°

NSB0_01703

1)
These products were built as Class A devices. The use of these devices in

8
residential areas could result in radio interference. In this case these may
be required to introduce additional interference suppression measures.
2)
The following applies for reversing contactors: To maintain the values, a

& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
3TX7 462-3L surge suppressor (see "3TB Contactors", Chapter 3) should
be used between the phases L1 and L3 as close as possible to the revers-
ing contactor.
3)
If two different conductor cross-sections are connected to one clamping
point, both cross-sections must lie in one of the ranges specified.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 8/41


Siemens IC 10 · 2012 6/113
Solid-State Switching Devices for Switching Motors
Solid-State Switching Devices

Solid-State Contactors
Solid-State Contactors
3RF34 Solid-state contactors – technical data
3RF34 solid-state contactors, three-phase

Overview
These two-phase controlled, instantaneous switching solid-state
contactors in the insulting enclosure are offered in 45 mm width
to 5.2 A – and in 90 mm width to 16 A. This means that it is pos-
sible to operate motors up to 7.5 kW.

Technical specifications
Type 3RF34 05-.BB.. 3RF34 10-.BB.. 3RF34 12-.BB.. 3RF34 16-.BB..
Fuseless design
with 3RV2 motor starter protector, CLASS 10
Rated operational current IAC-531)
according to IEC 60947-4-2
• At 40 °C A 5.2 (4.5) 9.2 12.5 16
• UL/CSA, at 50 °C A 4.6 (4.0) 8.4 11.5 14
• At 60 °C A 4.2 (3.5) 7.6 10.5 12.5
Power loss at IAC-53
• At 40 °C W 10 (8) 16 22 28
Short-circuit protection with type of coordination "1"
at an operational voltage of Ue to 440 V
• Motor starter protector, type 3RV20 11-1GA10 3RV20 11-1JA10 3RV20 11-1KA10 3RV20 11-4AA10
• Current Iq kA 50 5 5 3
6

1)
The reduced values in brackets apply to a directly mounted circuit breaker
and simultaneous butt-mounting.

Type 3RF34 05-.BB.4 3RF34 05-.BB.6 3RF34 10-.BB.. 3RF34 12-.BB.4 3RF34 12-.BB.6 3RF34 16-.BB..
Fused design
with directly connected 3RB3 overload relay
Rated operational current IAC-53
according to IEC 60947-4-2
• At 40 °C A 4 7.8 9.5 11
• UL/CSA, at 50 °C A 3.6 7 8.5 10
• At 60 °C A 3.2 6.2 7.6 9
Power loss at IAC-53
• At 40 °C W 7 13 16 18
Minimum load current A 0.5
Max. off-state current mA 10
Rated peak withstand current Itsm A 200 600 600 1 200 1 150 1 150
I2t value A2s 200 1 800 1 800 7 200 6 600 6 600

Type 3RF34 ..-.BB.4 3RF34 ..-.BB.6


Main circuit
Controlled phases 2-phase 2-phase
Rated operational voltage Ue
8

V AC 48 ... 480 48 ... 600


• Operating range V AC 40 ... 506 40 ... 660
• Rated frequency Hz 50/60 ± 10 % 50/60 ± 10 %
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors

Rated insulation voltage Ui V 600 600


Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 6 6
Blocking voltage V 1 200 1 600
Rage of voltage rise V/µs 1 000 1 000

8/42 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


6/114 Siemens IC 10 · 2012
Solid-State Switching Devices
Solid-State Switching Devices for Switching Motors
Solid-State Contactors Solid-State Contactors
3RF34 Solid-state contactors – technical data
3RF34 solid-state contactors, three-phase

Type 3RF34 ..-.BB0. 3RF34 ..-.BB2.


Control circuits
Method of operation DC operation AC operation
Rated control supply voltage Us V 24 acc. to IEC 61131-2 110 ... 230
Rated frequency Hz -- 50/60 ± 10 %
of the control supply voltage
Control supply voltage, max. V 30 253
Typical actuating current mA 20 15
Response voltage V 15 90
Drop-out voltage V 5 < 40
Operating times
• ON-delay ms 1 5
• OFF-delay ms 1 + max. one half-wave 30 + max. one half-wave

Circuit diagrams
DC control supply voltage AC control supply voltage

1 L1 3 L2 5 L3 1 L1 3 L2 5 L3
A1 + A1 ~
A2 - A2 ~

6
NSB0_01794

NSB0_01795
2 T1 4 T2 6 T3 2 T1 4 T2 6 T3

3/N/PE 50 Hz 230/400 V
L1 DC 24 V
L2 L+
L3
L-
N
PE
F4
F1 F2 F3
U

S1
K1 R1
1 L1 3 L2 5 L3
A1+
A2-
NSB0_01778

8
2 T1 4 T2 6 T3

F1 ... F4 Fuses

& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
K1 Solid-state motor
M1 contactor
M M1 Motor
~ R1 3TX7 462-3L varistor
S1 "ON" switch

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 8/43


Siemens IC 10 · 2012 6/115
Solid-State Switching Devices for Switching Motors
Solid-State Switching Devices

Solid-State Contactors
Solid-State Contactors
3RF34
3RF34 solid-state
Solid-state reversing
reversing contactors,
contactors – technical data
three-phase

Overview
The integration of four conducting paths to a reverse switch, width with the three-phase reversing contactors. Devices with
combined in one enclosure makes this device a particularly 45 mm width cover motors up to 2.2 kW – and those with 90 mm
compact solution. Compared to conventional systems, for which width up to 3 kW.
two contactors are required, it is possible to save up to 50 %

Technical specifications
Type 3RF34 03-.BD.4 3RF34 05-.BD.4 3RF34 10-.BD.4
Fuseless design
with 3RV2 motor starter protector, CLASS 10
Rated operational current IAC-531)
according to IEC 60947-4-2
• At 40 °C A 3.8 (3.4) 5.4 (4.8) 7.4
• UL/CSA, at 50 °C A 3.5 (3.1) 5 (4.3) 6.8
• At 60 °C A 3.2 (2.8) 4.6 (3.8) 6.2
Power loss at IAC-53
• At 40 °C W 7 (6) 9 (8) 13
Short-circuit protection with type of coordination "1"
at an operational voltage of Ue to 440 V
• Motor starter protector, type 3RV20 11-1FA10 3RV20 11-1GA10 3RV20 11-1JA10
• Current Iq kA 50 50 10
6

1)
The reduced values in brackets apply to a directly mounted circuit breaker
and simultaneous butt-mounting.

Type 3RF34 03-.BD.4 3RF34 05-.BD.4 3RF34 10-.BD.4


Fused design
with directly connected 3RB3 overload relay
Rated operational current IAC-53
according to IEC 60947-4-2
• At 40 °C A 3.8 5.4 7.4
• UL/CSA, at 50 °C A 3.5 5 6.8
• At 60 °C A 3.2 4.6 6.2
Power loss at IAC-53
• At 40 °C W 6 8 16
Minimum load current A 0.5
Max. off-state current mA 10
Rated peak withstand current Itsm A 200 600
I2t value A2s 200 1 800

Type 3RF34 ..-.BD.4


Main circuit
Controlled phases 2-phase
Rated operational voltage Ue1) V AC 48 ... 480
8

• Operating range V AC 40 ... 506


• Rated frequency Hz 50/60 ± 10 %
Rated insulation voltage Ui V 600
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors

Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp kV 6


Blocking voltage V 1 200
Rage of voltage rise V/µs 1 000
1) To reduce the risk of a phase short circuit due to overvoltage, we recom-
mend using a varistor type 3TX7 462-3L between the phases L1 and L3
and as close as possible to the switchgear.
We recommend a design with semiconductor protection as short-circuit
protection.

8/44 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


6/118 Siemens IC 10 · 2012
Solid-State Switching Devices
Solid-State Switching Devices for Switching Motors
Solid-State Contactors Solid-State Contactors
3RF34 Solid-state reversing contactors – technical data 3RF34 solid-state reversing contactors,
three-phase

Type 3RF34 ..-.BD0. 3RF34 ..-.BD2.


Control circuits
Method of operation DC operation AC operation
Rated control supply voltage Us V 24 acc. to IEC 61131-2 110 ... 230
Rated frequency Hz -- 50/60 ± 10 %
of the control supply voltage
Control supply voltage, maximum V 30 253
Typical actuating current mA 15 10
Response voltage V 15 90
Drop-out voltage V 5 < 40
Operating times1)
• ON-delay ms 5 20
• OFF-delay ms 5 + max. one half-wave 10 + max. one half-wave
• Interlocking time ms 60 ... 100 50 ... 100
1) Caution! Risk of phase short circuit in automatic mode.
The control inputs must not be actuated until after a delay time of 40 ms
after the main voltage is applied

Circuit diagrams
DC control supply voltage AC control supply voltage

6
1 L1 3 L2 5 L3 1 L1 3 L2 5 L3
A1+ A1~

A2- A2~
A3+ A3~
NSB0_01776

NSB0_01777
2 T1 4 T2 6 T3 2 T1 4 T2 6 T3

3/N/PE 50 Hz 230/400 V
L1
L2
L3
N
PE
F1 F2 F3 F4
U

S1
K1 R1
1 L1 3 L2 5 L3 S2
A1~

8
A2~
A3~
NSB0_01779

& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
2 T1 4 T2 6 T3
F1 ... F4 Fuses
K1 Solid-state reversing
M1 contactor
M
~ M1 Motor
R1 3TX7 462-3L varistor
S1 "Counterclockwise" switch
S2 "Clockwise" switch

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 8/45


Siemens IC 10 · 2012 6/119
Solid-State Switching Devices

Function Modules
General and technical data

Overview
Function modules for SIRIUS SC semiconductor switching The plug-in connection to control the semiconductor switching
devices devices can simply remain in use.
A great variety of applications demand an expanded range of The following function modules are available:
functionality. These applications can easily be met with Sirius SC • Converter
function modules. The modules are mounted simply by clicking
them into place; straight away the necessary connections are • Load monitors (basic and enhanced)
made with the semiconductor relay or contactor. • Power controller

Technical specifications
Type 3RF29 ..-.E... 3RF29 ..-.F... 3RF29 ..-.G... 3RF29 ..-.H...
General data
Ambient temperature
during operation, derating at 40 °C °C -25 ... +60
when stored °C -55 ... +80
Site altitude m 0 ... 1000; derating from 1000
Shock resistance acc. to IEC 60068-2-27 g/ms 15/11
Vibration resistance acc. to IEC 60068-2-6 g 2
Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC)
Emitted interference
• Conducted interference voltage Class A for industrial applications1)
acc. to IEC 60947-4-3
• Emitted, high-frequency interference voltage Class A for industrial applications
acc. to IEC 60947-4-3
Noise immunity
• Electrostatic discharge acc. to IEC 61000-4-2 kV Contact discharge 4; air discharge 8; behavior criterion 2
(corresponds to degree of severity 3)
• Induced RF fields acc. to IEC 61000-4-6 MHz 0.15 ... 80; 140 dBμV; behavior criterion 1
• Burst acc. to IEC 61000-4-4 2 kV/5.0 kHz; behavior criterion 1
• Surge acc. to IEC 61000-4-5 kV Conductor - ground 2; conductor - conductor 1; behavior criterion 2
Connection, auxiliary/control contacts,
screw connection
Conductor cross-section mm2 1x (0.5 ... 2.5); 2x (0.5 ... 1) AWG 20 ... 12
• Insulation stripping length mm 7
Terminal screw M3
• Tightening torque Nm 0.5 ... 0.6
Converter diameter of hole mm - 7 17
1) Note limitations for power controller function module on page 2/31.

Type 3RF29 ..-.E..8 3RF29 ..-.F..8 3RF29 ..-.G..3 3RF29 ..-.G..6 3RF29 ..-.H..3 3RF29 ..-.H..6
Main circuit
Rated operational voltage Ue V -1) 110 ... 230 400 ... 600 110 ... 230 400 ... 600
• Tolerance % - -15 / +10
• Rated frequency Hz - 50/60
Rated insulation voltage Ui V - 600
Voltage detection
Measuring range V - 93.5 ... 253 340 ... 660 93.5 ... 253 340 ... 660
8

Mains voltage fluctuation compensation % - 20


1) Versions do not depend on main circuit.
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors

Type 3RF29 ..-...0. 3RF29 ..-...1. 3RF29 ..-...3.


Control circuit
Method of operation DC operation AC/DC operation AC operation
Rated control supply voltage Us V 24 24 110
Rated operating current mA 15 15 15
Max. rated control voltage V 30 30 121
Rated control current at maximum voltage mA 15 15 15
Rated frequency Hz - 50/60 50/60
of the control supply voltage
Response voltage V 15 15 90
for tripping current mA 2 2 2
Drop-out voltage V 5 5 -

Type 3RF29 2.- 3RF29 2.- 3RF29 2.- 3RF29 5.- 3RF29 5.- 3RF29 9.- 3RF29 9.-
.F... .G... .H... .G... .H... .G... .H...
Current detection
Rated operational current Ie A 20 50 90
Measuring range A 4 ... 22 4 ... 55 4 ... 99
Number of partial loads 6 12 - 12 - 12 -

8/46 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Solid-State Switching Devices

3RF29 Function Modules


General and technical data

Overview
Function modules for SIRIUS SC solid-state switching The following function modules are available:
devices • Converter
A great variety of applications demand an expanded range of • Load monitoring
functionality. With our function modules, these requirements can • Heating current monitoring
be met really easily. The modules are mounted simply by click-
ing them into place; straight away the necessary connections • Power control regulators
are made with the solid-state relay or contactor. The plug-in • Power controller
connection to control the solid-state switching devices can
simply remain in use.

Technical specifications

Type 3RF29 ..-.K...


General data
Ambient temperature
• During operation, derating from 40 °C °C -25 ... +60
• During storage °C -55 ... +80
Site altitude m 0 ... 1000; derating from 1000
Shock resistance acc. to IEC 60068-2-27 g/ms 15/11
Vibration resistance acc. to IEC 60068-2-27 g 2
Insulation resistance between load and MΩ 1.5
control circuit
Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC)
• Emitted interference
- Conducted interference voltage acc. to Class A for industrial applications 1)
IEC 60947-4-3
- Emitted, high-frequency interference voltage Class A for industrial applications
acc. to IEC 60947-4-3
• Interference immunity
- Electrostatic discharge acc. to IEC 61000-4-2 kV Contact discharge 4; air discharge 8; behavior criterion 2
(corresponds to degree of severity 3)
- Induced RF fields acc. to IEC 61000-4-6 MHz 0.15 ... 80; 140 dBμV; behavior criterion 1
- Burst acc. to IEC 61000-4-4 2 kV/5.0 kHz; behavior criterion 1
- Surge acc. to IEC 61000-4-5 kV Conductor – ground 2; conductor – conductor 1; behavior criterion 2
Connection, auxiliary/control contacts, screw
terminal
• Conductor cross-section mm2 1 x (0.5 ... 2.5), 2 x (0.5 ... 1.0), 1 x (AWG 20 ... 12)
• S tripped length mm 7
• Terminal screw M3
- Tightening torque Nm 0.5 ... 0.6
lb.in 4.5 ... 5.3
Converter, diameter of hole mm 17
1) These products were built as Class A devices. The use of these devices in
residential areas could result in radio interference. In this case the user

8
may require to introduce additional damping measures.

& Contactors
Solid-State Relays

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 8/47


Solid-State Switching Devices

3RF29 Function Modules


Power control regulators

Technical specifications

Type 3RF29 ..-0KA.3 3RF29 ..-0KA.6


Main circuit
Rated operational voltage Ue V 110 ... 230 400 ... 600
• Tolerance % -15/+10
• Rated frequency Hz 50/60
Rated insulation voltage Ui V 600
Voltage detection
• Measuring/teach range V 93.5 ... 253 340 ... 660
Compensation of mains voltage fluctuation % 20 (only within the measuring range)

Type 3RF29 04-0KA.. 3RF29 20-0KA.. 3RF29 50-0KA.. 3RF29 90-0KA..


Current measurement
Rated operational current Ie A 4 20 50 90
Current measurement
• Teach range A 0.15 ... 4 0.65 ... 20 1.6 ... 50 2.9 ... 90
• Measuring range A 0 ... 4 0 ... 22 0 ... 55 0 ... 99
• Minimum partial load current A -- 0.65 1.6 2.9
Number of partial loads 1 ... 6

Type 3RF29 ..-0KA1. 3RF29 ..-0KA3.


Control circuit A1–A2
General data
Rated control supply voltage Us V 24 AC/DC AC 110
• Operating range V 20.5 ... 26.5 DC 18 ... 30 90 ... 121
Rated frequency of the control supply voltage Hz 50/60 ± 10% -- 50/60 ± 10%
Current consumption mA < 40 < 20
Control input IN
Rated control voltage Uc V 24 AC/DC AC 110
• For actuating current mA < 15 < 15
• Actuating voltage, max. mA AC 26.5 DC 30 121
Control supply voltage, min./max. V AC 20.5 ... 26.5 DC 18 ... 30 90 ... 121
Response voltage V AC 14 DC 15 79
• For tripping current mA >2 >2 >2
Drop-out voltage V 5 5 15
Control input 0 ... 10 V
Input analog V 0 ... 10
8

• Permissible range V -1 ... 11


Input resistance kΩ 8
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors

Period duration s 1
Auxiliary circuit 11–12
Switching voltage V 24 AC/DC AC 110
• Actuating current (utilization category) A 0.5 (DC-12) 0.5 (AC-12)
• Switching voltage, min./max. V 15 ... 30 90 ... 121
Continuous thermal current, max. Ith A 1 1

8/48 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Solid-State Switching Devices

Semiconductor Relays and Contactors, Function Modules


Project planning aids

Characteristics
SIRIUS SC semiconductor relays
Dependence of the device current Ie on the ambient temperature Ta (Chart data for SIRIUS SC relays based on I max)
SIRIUS SC semiconductor relay with 20 A type current (3RF21 20/3RF20 20)1)
Min. thickness of the heat sink the relay is mounted to
4 mm
40

35

30

25

20

15

10

0
2 6 10 14 18 22 0 10 20 30 40 50 60

SIRIUS SC semiconductor relay with 30 A type current (3RF21 30/3RF20 30)

Min. thickness of the heat sink the relay is mounted to


4 mm 5 mm
60

50

40

30

20

10

0
6 10 14 18 22 26 30 34 0 10 20 30 40 50 60

SIRIUS SC semiconductor relay with 50 A type current (3RF21 50/3RF20 50)

8
Min. thickness of the heat sink the relay is mounted to
4 mm 5 mm 8 mm

& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
90

80

70

60

50

40

30

20

10

0
5 10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60 0 10 20 30 40 50 60

1) Arrangement example for Ie = 20 A and Ta = 40 C:


The task is to find the thermal resistance Rthha and the heat-sink overtem- This results in: dTha = Rthha x PM = 1.7 K/W x 28 W = 47.6 K. At
perature dTha. From the diagram on the left -> PM = 28 W, from the dia- dTha = 47.6 K the heat sink must therefore have an Rthha = 1.7 K/W.
gram on the right -> Rthha = 1.7 K/W. (Chart data for SIRIUS SC relays based on I max)

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 8/49


Solid-State Switching Devices

Semiconductor Relays and Contactors, Function Modules


Project planning aids

Dependence of the device current Ie on the ambient temperature Ta (Chart data for SIRIUS SC relays based on I max)
SIRIUS SC semiconductor relay with 70 A type current (3RF21 70/3RF20 70)
Min. thickness of the heat sink the relay is mounted to
4 mm 5 mm 8 mm 10 mm
120

100

80

60

40

20

0
10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 0 10 20 30 40 50 60

SIRIUS SC semiconductor relay with 88 A type current (3RF21 90/3RF20 90)


Min. thickness of the heat sink the relay is mounted to
4 mm 5 mm 8 mm 10 mm
120

100

80

60

40

20

0
10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 0 10 20 30 40 50 60

SIRIUS SC semiconductor contactors


Derating curves
SIRIUS SC semiconductor contactor with 10 A type current (3RF23 10)
8
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors

8/50 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Solid-State Switching Devices

Semiconductor Relays and Contactors, Function Modules


Project planning aids

Derating curves
SIRIUS SC semiconductor contactor with 20 A type current (3RF23 20)

SIRIUS SC semiconductor contactor with 30 A type current (3RF23 30)

SIRIUS SC semiconductor contactor with 40 A type current (3RF23 40)1)

8
& Contactors
Solid-State Relays

1) Identical current/temperature curves for individual and side-by-side


mounting.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 8/51


Solid-State Switching Devices

Semiconductor Relays and Contactors, Function Modules


Project planning aids

Derating curves
SIRIUS SC semiconductor contactor with 50 A type current (3RF23 50)1)

SIRIUS SC semiconductor contactor with 70 A type current (3RF23 70)1)

SIRIUS SC semiconductor contactor with 88 A type current (3RF23 90)1)


8
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors

1) Identical current/temperature curves for individual and side-by-side


mounting.

8/52 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Solid-State Switching Devices

Solid-State Relays
3RF22 solid-state relays, 3-phase, 45 mm

Characteristic curves
Dependence of the device current Ie on the ambient temperature Ta (two-phase controlled)

s
3 mm 5 mm
100
M in W

e in A
Rthha
Module power loss

80 0,35 K/W

0,45 K/W

0,56 K/W

60 0,75 K/W

1 K/W

1,3 K/W

1,7 K/W
40
2,2 K/W

3 K/W

4 K/W
20
5 K/W

7 K/W

10 K/W
0
4 8 12 16 20 24 28 32 36 0 10 20 30 40 50 60

Device current e in A Ambient temperature a in °C

Type current 30 A (3RF22 30-.AB..)

s
3 mm 5 mm
160
M in W

e in A
140
Rthha
Module power loss

0,13 K/W
120
0,18 K/W
0,25 K/W
100
0,37 K/W
0,55 K/W
80
0,8 K/W
1,2 K/W
60
2 K/W
3 K/W
40
4 K/W
5 K/W
20
7 K/W

8
10 K/W
0
5 15 25 35 45 55 0 10 20 30 40 50 60

& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
Device current e in A Ambient temperature a in °C

Type current 55 A (3RF22 55-.AB..)

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 8/53


Solid-State Switching Devices

Solid-State Relays
3RF22 solid-state relays, 3-phase, 45 mm

Dependence of the device current Ie on the ambient temperature Ta (three-phase controlled)

s
3 mm 5 mm 160
M in W

e in A
140

Rthha
Module power loss

120
0,26 K/W
0,33 K/W
100
0,44 K/W
0,62 K/W
80 0,9 K/W
1,3 K/W
60 1,7 K/W
2,2 K/W
40 3 K/W
4 K/W

20 5 K/W
7 K/W
10 K/W
0
4 8 12 16 20 24 28 32 36 0 10 20 30 40 50 60
Device current e in A Ambient temperature a in °C

Type current 30 A (3RF22 30-.AC..)

s
3 mm 5 mm
2 50
M in W

e in A
Rthha
Module power loss

2 00
0,06 K/W
0,09 K/W
0,15 K/W
1 50
0,25 K/W
0,4 K/W
0,6 K/W
1 00 0,8 K/W
1,1 K/W
1,5 K/W

50 2 K/W
3 K/W
4 K/W
6 K/W
8

0
5 15 25 35 45 55 0 10 20 30 40 50 60
Device current e in A Ambient temperature a in °C
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors

Type current 55 A (3RF22 55-.AC..) This results in:


Arrangement example dTha = Rthha × PM = 0.09 K/W × 227 W = 20.4 K.
Given conditions: Ie = 55 A and Ta = 40 C. At dTha = 20.4 K the heat sink must therefore have an
The task is to find the thermal resistance Rthha and the heat sink Rthha = 0.09 K/W.
overtemperature dTha.
From the diagram on the left → PM = 227 W,
from the diagram on the right → Rthha = 0.09 K/W.

8/54 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Solid-State Switching Devices

Solid-State Contactors
3RF24 solid-state contactors, 3-phase

Characteristic curves
Derating curves, two-phase controlled

14 26
24
12
in A

22

Module power loss PM in W


20
e

10 18
16
8
14
12
6
10
8
4
6

2 4

NSB0_01675
2

0 0
0 10 20 30 40 50 60 0 2 4 6 8 10 12
Ambient temperature Ta in °C Device current e in A

Type current 10.5 A (3RF24 10-.AB..)

25 50

45
in A

Module power loss PM in W


20 40
e

35

15 30

25

10 20

15

5 10
NSB0_01676

0 0
0 10 20 30 40 50 60 0 4 8 12 16 20 24
Ambient temperature Ta in °C Device current ein A

8
Type current 20 A (3RF24 20-.AB..)

40

& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
78
72
35
in A

66
Module power loss PM in W

30 60
e

54
25 48
42
20
36

15 30
24
10 18
12
NSB0_01677

5
6
0 0
0 10 20 30 40 50 60 0 6 12 18 24 30 36
Ambient temperature Ta in °C Device current ein A

Type current 30 A (3RF24 30-.AB..)

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 8/55


Solid-State Switching Devices

Solid-State Contactors
3RF24 solid-state contactors, 3-phase

50 110

45 100
in A

Module power loss PM in W


40 90
e

80
35
70
30
60
25
50
20
40
15
30
10 20

NSB0_01678
5 10

0 0
0 10 20 30 40 50 60 0 8 16 24 32 40 48
Ambient temperature Ta in °C Device current ein A

Type current 40 A (3RF24 40-.AB..)1)

60 120
55
in A

Module power loss PM in W


50 100
45
e

40 80
35
30 60
25
20 40
15

10 20
NSB0_01679

5
0 0
0 10 20 30 40 50 60 0 10 20 30 40 50
Ambient temperature Ta in °C Device current e in A
8

Type current 50 A (3RF24 50-.AB..)1)


Solid-State Relays
& Contactors

1) Identical current/temperature curves for stand-alone and side-by-side


installation.

8/56 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Solid-State Switching Devices

Solid-State Contactors
3RF24 solid-state contactors, 3-phase

Derating curves, three-phase controlled

14
36
12 33
in A

Module power loss PM in W


30
e

10 27
24
8
21
18
6
15
12
4
9

2 6

NSB0_01680
3

0 0
0 10 20 30 40 50 60 0 2 4 6 8 10 12
Ambient temperature Ta in °C Device current e in A

Type current 10.5 A (3RF24 10-.AC..)

25 75
70
65
in A

Module power loss PM in W


20 60
e

55
50
15 45
40
35
10 30
25
20
5 15
NSB0_01681

10
5
0 0
0 10 20 30 40 50 60 0 3 6 9 12 15 18 21 24
Ambient temperature Ta in °C Device current e in A

Type current 20 A (3RF24 20-.AC..) 1) Identical current/temperature curves for stand-alone and side-by-side
installation.

8
40
110
35

& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
100
in A

Module power loss PM in W

90
30
e

80
25 70
60
20
50
15
40

10 30

20
NSB0_01682

5
10

0 0
0 10 20 30 40 50 60 0 4 8 12 16 20 24 28 32 36
Ambient temperature Ta in °C Device current e in A

Type current 30 A (3RF24 30-.AC..)1)


1) Identical current/temperature curves for stand-alone and side-by-side
installation.

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 8/57


Solid-State Switching Devices

Solid-State Contactors
3RF24 solid-state contactors, 3-phase

50 160

45
140
in A

Module power loss PM in W


40
e

120
35
100
30

25 80

20
60
15
40
10

NSB0_01683
5 20

0 0
0 10 20 30 40 50 60 0 8 16 24 32 40 48
Ambient temperature Ta in °C Device current ein A

Type current 40 A (3RF24 40-.AC..)1)

60 200

180
in A

Module power loss PM in W


50
160
e

140
40
120

30 100

80
20
60

40
10
NSB0_01684

20

0 0
0 10 20 30 40 50 60 0 10 20 30 40 50
Ambient temperature Ta in °C Device current e in A

Type current 50 A (3RF24 50-.AC..)1)


8
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors

1) Identical current/temperature curves for stand-alone and side-by-side


installation.

8/58 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Solid-State Switching Devices

Solid-State Contactors
3RF34 solid-state contactors, 3-phase

Maximum permissible switching frequency depending on the starting time ta and the ON period tED

Ia Ie = 7,2 Ib Ie = 1
10000
Operating frequency 1/h

1000

Starting time

ta = 0,05 s
100
ta = 0,1 s
ta = 0,2 s
ta = 0,4 s
ta = 0,8 s

NSB0_01780
ta = 1,6 s
ta = 3,2 s
10
0,01 0,1 1 10 100 1000
t OP in s

For motors with a starting current of 4- to 7.2 times the rated current and with a full load

Ia Ie = 7,2 Ib Ie = 0,6
10000
Operating frequency 1/h

1000

Starting time

8
ta = 0,05 s
100

& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
ta = 0,1 s
ta = 0,2 s
ta = 0,4 s
ta = 0,8 s
NSB0_01781

ta = 1,6 s
ta = 3,2 s
10
0,01 0,1 1 10 100 1000
t ON in s

For motors with a starting current of 4- to 7.2 times the rated current and with a 60 % load

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 8/59


Solid-State Switching Devices

Solid-State Contactors
3RF34 solid-state contactors, 3-phase

Ia Ie = 4 Ib Ie = 1
10000
Operating frequency 1/h

1000

Starting time

ta = 0,05 s
100
ta = 0,1 s
ta = 0,2 s
ta = 0,4 s
ta = 0,8 s

NSB0_01782
ta = 1,6 s
ta = 3,2 s
10
0,01 0,1 1 10 100 1000
t OP in s

For motors with a starting current of up to 4 times the rated current and with a full load

Ia Ie = 4 Ib Ie = 0,6
10000
Operating frequency 1/h

1000

Starting time
8

ta = 0,05 s
100
ta = 0,1 s
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors

ta = 0,2 s
ta = 0,4 s
ta = 0,8 s
NSB0_01783

ta = 1,6 s
ta = 3,2 s
10
0,01 0,1 1 10 100 1000
t OP in s

For motors with a starting current of up to 4 times the rated current and with a 60 % load

8/60 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Solid-State Switching Devices

Solid-State Contactors
3RF34 solid-state reversing contactors, 3-phase

Maximum permissible switching frequency depending on the starting time ta and the ON period tED

Ia Ie = 7,2 Ib Ie = 1
10000
Operating frequency 1/h

1000

Starting time

ta = 0,05 s
100
ta = 0,1 s
ta = 0,2 s
ta = 0,4 s
ta = 0,8 s

NSB0_01784
ta = 1,6 s
ta = 3,2 s
10
0,01 0,1 1 10 100 1000
t OP in s

For motors with a starting current of 4- to 7.2 times the rated current and with a full load

Ia Ie = 7,2 Ib Ie = 0,6
10000
Operating frequency 1/h

1000

Starting time

8
ta = 0,05 s
100
ta = 0,1 s

& Contactors
Solid-State Relays
ta = 0,2 s
ta = 0,4 s
ta = 0,8 s
NSB0_01785

ta = 1,6 s
ta = 3,2 s
10
0,01 0,1 1 10 100 1000
t OP in s

For motors with a starting current of 4- to 7.2 times the rated current and with a 60 % load

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 8/61


Solid-State Switching Devices

Solid-State Contactors
3RF34 solid-state reversing contactors, 3-phase

Ia Ie = 4 Ib Ie = 1
10000
Operating frequency 1/h

1000

Starting time

ta = 0,05 s
100
ta = 0,1 s
ta = 0,2 s
ta = 0,4 s
ta = 0,8 s

NSB0_01786
ta = 1,6 s
ta = 3,2 s
10
0,01 0,1 1 10 100 1000
t OP in s

For motors with a starting current of up to 4 times the rated current and with a full load

Ia Ie = 4 Ib Ie = 0,6
10000
Operating frequency 1/h

1000

Starting time
8

ta = 0,05 s
100
ta = 0,1 s
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors

ta = 0,2 s
ta = 0,4 s
ta = 0,8 s
NSB0_01787

ta = 1,6 s
ta = 3,2 s
10
0,01 0,1 1 10 100 1000
t OP in s

For motors with a starting current of up to 4 times the rated current and with a 60 % load

8/62 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Solid-State Switching Devices

Semiconductor Relays and Contactors, Function Modules


Dimensions

Dimension drawings
SIRIUS SC semiconductor relays
22.5 mm semiconductor relays
Screw connection Spring-loaded Ring connection
3RF21 .0-1AA.. connection 3RF21 .0-2AA.. 3RF21 .0-3AA..

45 mm semiconductor relays
3RF20 .0-1AA.

8
& Contactors
Solid-State Relays

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 8/63


Solid-State Switching Devices

Solid-State Relays
3RF22 solid-state relays, 3-phase, 45 mm

Dimensional drawings
Solid-state relays

Spring-loaded Screw terminal Spring-loaded terminals Ring terminal end connection


terminals 3RF22 ..-1.... 3RF22 ..-2.... 3RF22 ..-3....

47,5
69

77

69
95

NSB0_01689a
13 31 29 33 29
26 47 45
30
47

Schematics
Two-phase controlled Three-phase controlled
DC control supply voltage DC control supply voltage

1 L1 3 L2 5 L3 1 L1 3 L2 5 L3
A1 + A1 +
A2 - A2 -

NSB0_01696
NSB0_01694

2 T1 4 T2 6 T3 2 T1 4 T2 6 T3
8
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors

8/64 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Solid-State Switching Devices

Semiconductor Relays and Contactors, Function Modules


Dimensions

Function modules for SIRIUS SC semiconductor switching devices


Converters Basic load monitoring
3RF29 00-0EA18 3RF29 00-0FA08

Extended load monitoring Power controllers


3RF29 .0-0GA.. 3RF29 .0-0HA..

Accessories for SIRIUS SC semiconductor switching devices

8
Terminal cover for SIRIUS semiconductor switching devices
3RF29 00-3PA88

& Contactors
Solid-State Relays

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 8/65


Solid-State Switching Devices

Semiconductor Relays and Contactors, Function Modules


Dimensions

SIRIUS SC semiconductor contactors


Semiconductor contactors with 10 A and 20 A type current
3RF23 10-..... 3RF23 20-..... Screw connection Spring-loaded connection Ring connection
3RF23 10-1.... 3RF23 10-2.... 3RF23 10-3....
3RF23 20-1.... 3RF2320-2.... 3RF23 20-3....

Semiconductor contactors with 30 A type current


Screw connection Ring connection
3RF23 30-1.... 3RF23 30-3....

Semiconductor contactors with 40 A and 50 A type current


Screw connection Ring connection
3RF23 40-1.... 3RF23 40-3....
3RF23 50-1.... 3RF23 50-3....
8
Solid-State Relays
& Contactors

8/66 Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog


Solid-State Switching Devices

Semiconductor Relays and Contactors, Function Modules


Dimensions

Semiconductor contactors with 70 A type current


Screw connection Rin g connection
3RF23 70-1.... 3RF23 70-3....

Semiconductor contactors with 88 A type current


Screw connection Ring connection
3RF23 90-1.... 3RF23 90-3....

8
& Contactors
Solid-State Relays

Siemens Industry Inc., Industrial Control Catalog 8/67


Solid-State Switching Devices

Solid-State Contactors
Dimensions

Dimensional drawings
Type current 10.5 A

Spring-loaded Screw terminal Spring-loaded terminals


terminals 3RF24 10-1.... 3RF24 10-2....

47,5
100

69
90

77
95

You might also like